Словник та асоційовані API для HTML та XHTML
Будь ласка, перевірте errata для любих помилок або проблем, помічених з часу публікації.
Це специфікація також доступна як HTML документ однією сторінкою. Дивіться також переклади.
Copyright © 2014 W3C® (MIT, ERCIM, Keio, Beihang), All Rights Reserved. W3C liability, trademark and document use rules apply.
Ця специфікація визначає п’яту головну редакцію базової мови для World Wide Web: Hypertext Markup Language (HTML). В цій версії введені нові можливості, що допомогають авторам веб застосувань, введені нові елементи, що базуються на дослідженнях переважаючих авторських операцій, та була надана особлива увага для визначення ясного критерію відповідності для клієнтських агентів, в спробі покращити взаємодію.
Цей розділ визначає статус документу на час публікації. Інші документи можуть замінювати цей документ. Список поточних публікацій W3C та остання редакція цього технічного докладу може бути знайдена в переліку технічних докладів W3C за адресою http://www.w3.org/TR/.
W3C HTML Working Group є робочою групою W3C, відповідальною за прогресс специфікації. Ця специфікація є рекомендацією від 28 жовтня 2014.
Якщо ви бажаєте зробити коментар щодо цього документу в тому вигляді, як це відслідковує W3C, будь-ласка надсилайте їх через нашу публічну базу даних (відкриті помилки). Якщо ви не в змозі зробити це, ви також можете надіслати повідомлення на пошту public-html@w3.org (підписка, архіви), та будуть вжиті заходи для передачі коментарів в нашу публічну базу даних. Ми вітаємо любий зворотній зв’язок.
Комплексиний набір тестів для цієї специфікації обслуговується та підтримується в актуальному стані як частина проекту WebPlatform Tests. Будь ласка дивіться Working Group звіт реалізації.
Робота над розвитком цієї специфікації відображується на http://www.w3.org/TR/html/. Рекомендація HTML5 представляє верстовий стовп в розвитку HTML, але далека від кінця шляху, та покращення все ще ідуть повним ходом. Можливо, що майбутні версії не будуть бульше публікуватись як монолітна специфікація, але скоріше як набір меньших модулів. Безвідносно, чи буде це так, чи ні, http://www.w3.org/TR/html/ буде підтримуватись як вхідна точка для всієї HTML технології.
Робота над розвитком цієї специфікації типово відбувається через специфікації розширень, з якими треба консультуватись, щоб побачити, які нові можливості були переглянуті.
Маса тексту цієї специфікації також доступна на сайті WHATWG HTML Living Standard, під ліцензією, що дозволяє повторне використання тексту специфікації.
Цей документ був переглянутий членами W3C Members, розробниками програмного забезпечення, та іншими групами W3C та зацікавленими сторонами, та затворджений Директором як Рекомендація W3C. Це стабільний документ, та може використовуватись як матеріал посилання, або цитуватись в іншому документі. Роль W3C в створенні цієї рекомендації є прикувати увагу до специфікації, та просувати її широке розповсюдження. Це розширить функціональність та взаємодію Web мережі.
Робота над цією специфікацією також виконана як WHATWG. Робоча група W3C HTML активно переслідує узгодженість HTML специфікації ж вивим стандартом WHATWG, в межах прівелею робочої групи W3C HTML. Є різні шляхи слідувати цій роботі на WHATWG:
svn checkout
http://svn.whatwg.org/webapps/
Наступні редакційні зміни були зроблені з часу Запропонованих рекомендацій:
application/xhtml+xml
впродовж PR, що призвело до невеликого оновлення до відповідного
розділу.Цей документ був вироблений групою, що оперує згідно патентної політики W3C Patent Policy від 5 лютого 2004 . W3C підтримує публічний перелік любих патентних розкрить, зроблених в зв’язку з результатами діяльності групи; ця сторінка такоже включає інструкції по розкриттю патентів. Будь-хто обізнаний з патентом, що, за його переконанням, містить Основні претензії, мусить розкрити інформацію в відповідності з розділом 6 патентної політики W3C Patent Policy.
Документ знаходиться під управлінням 14 October 2005 W3C Process Document.
p
elementhr
elementpre
elementblockquote
elementol
elementul
elementli
elementdl
elementdt
elementdd
elementfigure
elementfigcaption
elementdiv
elementmain
elementa
elementem
elementstrong
elementsmall
elements
elementcite
elementq
elementdfn
elementabbr
elementdata
elementtime
elementcode
elementvar
elementsamp
elementkbd
elementsub
and sup
elementsi
elementb
elementu
elementmark
elementruby
elementrb
elementrt
elementrtc
elementrp
elementbdi
elementbdo
elementspan
elementbr
elementwbr
elementimg
element
iframe
elementembed
elementobject
elementparam
elementvideo
elementaudio
elementsource
elementtrack
elementmap
elementarea
elementa
and area
elementsalternate
"author
"bookmark
"help
"icon
"license
"nofollow
"noreferrer
"prefetch
"search
"stylesheet
"tag
"table
element
caption
elementcolgroup
elementcol
elementtbody
elementthead
elementtfoot
elementtr
elementtd
elementth
elementtd
and th
elementsform
elementlabel
elementinput
element
type
attribute
type=hidden
)type=text
)
state and Search state (type=search
)type=tel
)type=url
)type=email
)type=password
)type=date
)type=time
)type=number
)type=range
)type=color
)type=checkbox
)type=radio
)type=file
)type=submit
)type=image
)type=reset
)type=button
)input
element attributes
maxlength
and minlength
attributessize
attributereadonly
attributerequired
attributemultiple
attributepattern
attributemin
and max
attributesstep
attributelist
attributeplaceholder
attributeinput
element APIsbutton
elementselect
elementdatalist
elementoptgroup
elementoption
elementtextarea
elementkeygen
elementoutput
elementprogress
elementmeter
elementfieldset
elementlegend
elementname
attributedirname
attributemaxlength
attributeminlength
attributedisabled
attributeautofocus
attributeautocomplete
attributeWindow
object
Window
objectWindowProxy
objectmultipart/x-mixed-replace
resourcesbutton
elementinput
element as a text entry
widgetinput
element
as domain-specific widgetsinput
element as a range controlinput
element as a color wellinput
element
as a checkbox and radio button widgetsinput
element as a file upload
controlinput
element as a buttonmarquee
elementmeter
elementprogress
elementselect
elementtextarea
elementkeygen
elementЦей розділ не є нормативним.
HTML завжди був мовою розмітки World Wide Web. HTML був спочатку розроблений як мова для семантичного опису документів, хоча його загальний дизайн та сприяття на протязі років дозволила йому використовуватись для опису декількох інших типів документів.
Головна площина, що не була адекватно адресована HTML - це невиразно визначений предмет веб застосування. Ця специфікація намагаєтсья виправити це, та в той же час оновити HTML специфікації, щоб адресувати питання, що постали в декілька останніх років.
Цей розділ не є нормативним.
Ця специфікація призначена для авторів документів та скриптів, що використовують можливості, визначені в цій специфікації, реалізаторов інструментів, що оперують сторінками, що використовують можливості, визначені в цій специфікації, та особ, бажаючих встановити коректність документів або реалізацій відповідно вимог цієї специфікації.
Цей документ можливо не підходить для читачів, що не мають хоча б поверхневого знайомства з Web технологіями, тому що місцями він жертвує ясністю заради точності, та кратістю задля повноти. Більш доступні підручники та авторські керівництва можуть надати м’якше введення в предмет.
Зокрема, обізнаність з основами DOM є необхідною для повного розуміння деяких з найбільш технічних частин цієї специфікації. Розуміння Web IDL, HTTP, XML, Unicode, кодування символів, JavaScript та CSS також буде подекуди корисним, але не є істотним.
Цей розділ не є нормативним.
Ця специфікація обмежена до запровадження мови розмітки семантичного рівня, та асоційованого семантичного рівня скриптинг-API для створення доступних сторінок для Web, в диапазоні від статичних документів до динамічних застосувань.
Межі цієї специфікації не включають провадження механізмів для медіа-специфічних настроєк презентації (хоча правила подання по замовчанню для Web переглядачів включені в кінці цієї специфікації, та декілька механізмів для підключення до CSS запроваджені як частина мови).
Межі цієї специфікації не описують всю операційну систему. Зокрема, програмне забезпечення для конфігурації обладнання, інструменти для маніпуляції зображеннями, та застосування, що, як очікується, користувачі можуть щоденно використовувати з високорівневими робочими станціями, знаходяться за межами розгляду. В термінах застосувань, ця специфікація осообливо націлена на застосування, що, як очікується, будуть використовуватись користувачем на нерегулярній основі, або регулярно, але з різних місць, з низькими вимогами до процесора. Приклади таких застосувань включають системи онлайн покупок, пошукові системи, ігри (особливо мультіплеєрні онлайн ігри), загально доступні телефонні або адресні книжки, комукаційні програми (клієнти електронної пошти, клієнти безпосередніх повідомлень, дискусійне програмне забезпечення), програми редагування документів etc.
Цей розділ не є нормативним.
В свої перші п’ять років (1990-1995) HTML пройшов через низку ревізій, та отримав декілька розширень, що в основному відбувались в CERN, та потім в IETF.
Зі створенням W3C, розробка HTML знову змінила місце зустрічі. Перша невдала спроба розширити HTML в 1995, відома як HTML 3.0, потім проклала шлях до більш прагматичного підходу, відомому як HTML 3.2, що був завершений в 1997. HTML4 швидко послідував піздніше в тому ж році.
Наступного року члени W3C вирішили остановити розвиток HTML, та замість цього почали роботу над базованим на XML еквівалентом, названим XHTML. Ці зусилля почались з переформулювання HTML4 в XML, відомий як XHTML 1.0, що не додавав нових можливостей, окрім нової серіалізації, та який був завершений в 2000. Після XHTML 1.0 фокус W3C розвернувся до полегшення для інших робочих груп розширювати XHTML, під гаслом XHTML Modularization. Паралельно з цім W3C робили над новою мовою, що не був сумісний з ранішніми мовами HTML та XHTML, та назвали його XHTML2.
З плином часу, доки розвиток HTML не був завершений в 1998, частини API для HTML, розроблені виробниками переглядачів були специфіковані та опубліковані під назвою DOM Level 1 (в 1998) та DOM Level 2 Core та DOM Level 2 HTML (починаючи в 2000 та досягши кульмінації в 2003). Ці зусилля згодом захлохли, з деякими специфікаціями DOM Level 3, опублікованими в 2004, але робоча група була закрита перед тим, як всі чорнетки Level 3 були завершені.
В 2003 вийшла публікація XForms, технології, що була позіційована як наступне покоління Web форм, та викликала поновлений інтерес до розвитку самого HTML, скоріше, ніж у пошуку замін до нього. Цей інтерес був породженний розумінням того, що постачання XML як Web технології було обмежено до повністю нових технологій (як RSS, та піздніше Atom), скоріше, ніж заміна для існуючих технологій постачання (як HTML).
Першим результатом цього поновленого інтересу була перевірка концепції, що показала, що можливо розширити форми HTML4 для провадження багатьох можливостей, що вводяться в XForms 1.0, без потреби того, щоб переглядачі реалізовали механізми подання, що були б несумісні з існуючими HTML Web сторінками. На цій ранішній стадії, хоча чернетка вже була публічно доступною, та був запрошений відгук з усіх джерел, специфікація була тільки під копірайтом Opera Software.
Ідея того, що розвиток HTML повинен бути знову відкритим, знайшла підтвердження на семінарі W3C в 2004, де Mozilla та Opera сумісно презентували W3C деякі з принципів, що лягли в основу роботи над HTML5 (описані нижче), разом з вищезгаданими чорновими пропозиціями, що стосувались лише можливостей форм. Пропозиція була відхилена на тих підставах, що вона конфліктувала з попередньо обраним напрямком розвитку Web; замість цього співробітники та члени W3C проголосували за продовження розробки основанної на XML заміни.
Скоро після цього, Apple, Mozilla та Opera сумісно анонсували свій намір продовжити роботу над зусиллями, під егідою нового притулку, названого WHATWG. Був створений публічний список розсилки, та чернетка була переміщена на сайт WHATWG. Копірайт був відповідно змінений, щоб бути сумісно власністю всіма трьома компаніями, та щоб дозволити повторне використання специфікації.
WHATWG базувався на декількох базових принципах. Зокрема, ці технології мали бути зворотньо сумісними. Специфікації та реалізації повинні були співпадати, навіть якщо це означало зміну специфікації, скоріше, ніж реалізації, та ті специфікації мали бути досить детальними, щоб реалізації могли досягти повної взаємодії без зворотнього інженірингу одна одної.
Остання вимога, зокрема, вимагає, щоб поле зору специфікації HTML5 вклчало те, що було попередньо специфіковано в трьох окремих документах: HTML4, XHTML1 та DOM2 HTML. Це також означає значно більше деталей, ніж раніше вважалось за норму.
В 2006, W3C в кінці кінців виявила інтерес прийняти участь в розробці HTML5, та в 2007 сформувалась робоча група, відряджена робити з WHATWG над розробкою специфікації HTML5. Apple, Mozilla та Opera дозволили W3C публіковати специфікацію під копірайтом W3C, при цьому маючи версію з менш обмежувальною ліцензією на сайті WHATWG.
На протязі декількох років обоє групи робили разом під керівництвом одного редактора: Ian Hickson. В 2011 групи дійшли висновку, що вони мають різні цілі: W3C бажала провести лінію на піску для можливостей Рекомендації HTML5, тоді як WHATWG бажала продовжувати роботу над Living Standard для HTML, постійно підтримуючи специфікацію та додаючи нові можливості. В середині 2012 на W3C була створена нова робоча команда, що мала подбати про створення Рекомендацій HTML5 та підготувати робочу чернетку для наступної версії HTML.
З тих пір W3C HTML WG отримували патчі від WHATWG, що латали помилки, зареєстровані на специфікації W3C HTML, або більш акуратно представляли реалізовану реальність в UA. На момент публікації цього документу були злиті патчі зі специфікації WHATWG HTML до версії 8152 включно. Редактори W3C HTML також додали патчі, що стали результатом дискуссій в W3C HTML WG, а також виправлення, що не поширюються WHATWG.
Було опубліковано окремий документ, де занотовано відмінності між HTML, визначеним в цьому документі, та мовою, описаною в специфікації HTML4. [HTMLDIFF]
Цей розділ не є нормативним.
Треба зізнатись, що багато аспектів HTML на перший погляд видаються безглуздими та суперечливими.
HTML, підтримуюч його DOM API, а також і багато з підтримуючих його технологій, були розроблені на протязі періоду часу в декілька десятиліть великим натовпом людей з різними пріоритетами, які, в багатьох випадках, не знали про існування один одного.
Таким чином, можливості поставали з багатьох джерел, та не завжди були спеціально розроблені в узгодженим шляхом. Більше того, завдяки унікальним властивостям Web, помилки реалізації часто ставали де-факто, і тепер де-юре, стандартами, оскільки вміст часто ненавмисно був написаний таким чином, що покладався на них, раніше, ніж вони були виправлені.
Не зважаючи на це, були зроблені зусилля дотримуватись певнихє цілей дизайну. Вони описані в декількох наступних підрозділах.
Цей розділ не є нормативним.
Щоб відгородити Web авторів від складностей багатопоточності, HTML та DOM API розроблені таким чином, що жоден скрипт ніколи не може визначити одночасне виконання іншого скрипту. Навіть в робочих потоках, намір полягав в тому, щоб поведінка реалізацій могла складати думку, що виконання повністю послідовне для всіх скриптів в усіх контекстах перегляду.
В цій моделі метод navigator.yieldForStorageUpdates()
є еквівалентом того, щоб дозволити виконуватись іншим скриптам, тоді як
викликаючий скрипт блокується.
Цей розділ не є нормативним.
Ця специфікація взаємодіє з, та покладається на широку різномаїть інших специфікацій. За деяких обставин, на жаль, конфлікти призводять до того, що ця специфікація порушує вимоги тих інших специфікацій. Коли це відбувається, провина має кожного разу бути занотована як "умисне порушення", з вказанням причини цього порушення.
Цей розділ не є нормативним.
HTML має велике число механізмів розширення, що можуть бути використані для додавання семантики в безпечний спосіб:
class
для розширення елементів, ефективно
створюючи свої власні елементи, при цьому використовуючи найбільш
відповідний існуючий "реальний" HTML елемент, так що переглядач та інші
інструменти, що не знають про розширення, можуть досить гарно
підтримувати його. Цей напрямок використовують, наприклад, мікроформати.data-*=""
.
Вони гарантовано ніколи не будуть доторкані переглядачами, та дозволяють
скриптам включати дані в HTML елементи, що потім можуть шукатись та
оброблятись іншими скриптами.<meta name="" content="">
для включення метаданних до сторінки, реєструючи розширення до набору заздалегідь
визначених імен метаданих.rel=""
для анотації посилань з
спеціальним значенням, реєструючи розширення до набору попередньо
визначених типів посилань. Це також використовується
мікроформатами. На додаток, абсолютні URL, що не містять жодних не-ASCII
символів, ані символів з диапазону U+0041 (LATIN CAPITAL LETTER A) до
U+005A (LATIN CAPITAL LETTER Z) (включно), можуть бути використані як
типи посилань.<script
type="">
з власним типом, для подальшої обробки інлайн
або скриптами на стороні серверу.embed
.
Це той шлях, яким робить Flash.Цей розділ не є нормативним.
Ця специфікація визначає абстрактну мову для опису документів та застосувань, та деякі API для взаємодії з представленими у пам’яті ресурсами, що використовують цю мову.
Представлення в пам’яті відоме як "DOM HTML", або скорочено "DOM".
Є різні конкретні синтаксиси, що можуть бути використані для передачі ресурсів, які використовують цю абстрактну мову, два з яких визначені в цій специфікації.
Перший такий конкретний синтаксис є синтаксис HTML. Це формат,
запропонований для більшості авторів. Він сумісний з більшістю
успадкованих Web переглядачів. Якщо документ переданий з типом text/html
MIME type,
тоді він буде оброблений у Web переглядачах як документ HTML. Ця
специфікація визначає версію 5.0 синтаксису HTML, відому як "HTML 5".
Другий конкретний синтаксис є синтаксис XHTML, який є застосуванням XML.
Коли документ переданий з типом XML MIME type,
таким як application/xhtml+xml
,
тоді він трактується в Web переглядачах як документ XML, та буде
розібраний XML процессором. Автори мають пам’ятати, що обробка XML та HTML
відрізняється; зокрема, навіть мінімальні помилки синтаксису будуть
заважати документу, що позначений як XML, щоб він був відтворений
повністю, тоді як вони будуть ігноровані в синтаксисі HTML. Ця
специфікація визначає версію 5.0 синтаксису XHTML, відому як "XHTML 5".
DOM, синтаксис HTML, та синтаксис XHTML не можуть всі представляти той же
самий вміст. Наприклад, за допомогою синтаксису HTML не можуть бути
представлені простори імен, але вони підтримуються в DOM та синтаксисі
XHTML. Подібно до цього, документи, що використовують можливість noscript
, можуть бути
представлені з використанням синтаксису HTML, але не можуть бути
представлені за допомогою синтаксисів DOM та XHTML. Коментарі, що містять
рядок "-->
" можуть бути представлені
тільки в DOM, не в HTML або XHTML синтаксисах.
Цей розділ не є нормативним.
Ця специфікація поділена на наступні головні розділи:
Також є деякі додатки, що перелічують застарілі особливості та IANA міркування, та декілька індексів.
Цю специфікацію слід читати як любу іншу специфікацію. Перше, її слід прочитати від обкладинки до обкладинки, декілька разів. Потім, її слід перечитати ззаду наперед, щонайменше один раз. Потім її слід прочитати, обираючи довільні розділи зі змісту, та слідувати всім перехресним посиланням.
Як описано в розділі про вимоги відповідності нижче, ця специфікація описує крітерії відповідності для різномаїття класів відповідності. Зокрема, є вимоги відповідності, що стосуються прод’юсерів, наприклад, авторів, та документів, що вони створюють, та є вимоги відповідності, що стосуються споживачів, наприклад, переглядачі Web. Вони можуть бути розрізнені по тому, що вони вимагають: вимоги до прод’юсерів констатують, що є можливим, та вимоги до споживачів встановлюють, як має діяти програмне забезпечення.
Наприклад, "значення атрибуту foo
повинно бути дійсним цілим" є вимогою до
прод’юсерів, тому що покладається на дійснімі значення; навпаки, вимога
"значення атрибуту foo
повинно бути
розібрано згідно правил
розбору цілих" є вимогою до споживачів, бо вказує, як обробляти
вміст.
Вимоги до прод’юсерів не мають вимагати будь-що від споживачів.
Продовжуючи приклад вище, вимога, що потребує щоб значення окремого атрибуту обмежена до дійснімих цілих підкреслено не натякає на будь-що, щодо вимог до споживача. Може бути таке, щоб від споживачів фактично вимагалось, щоб вони трактували атрибут як прозорий рядок, повністю безвідповідно до того, чи буде значення задовільняти вимогам, чи ні. Може бути (як в попередньому прикладі), що споживачі повинні розбирати значення з використанням специфічні правила, щоб встановити, чи є значення дійснімі (числові в даному випадку), щоб продовжити обробку.
Це визначення, вимога або пояснення.
Це замітка.
Це приклад.
Це відкрита проблема.
Це попередження.
interface Example { // це визначення IDL };
method
( [ optionalArgument
] )Це зауваження до авторів, що описують використання інтерфейсу.
/* це фрагмент CSS */
Визначення екземпляру терміну марковано як це. Використання цього терміну марковано як це або як це.
Визначення елементу, атрибуту або API марковано як це
. Посилання на цей елемент, атрибут або
API маркується як це
.
Інші фрагменти коду марковані як це
.
Змінні марковані наступним чином.
В алгоритмах кроки в синхронних розділах марковані за допомогою ⌛.
В деяких випадках вимоги надаються в формі списків з умовами та відповідними вимогами. В таких випадках вимоги, що стосуються до умови є завжди перший набір вимог, що слідують за умовою, навіть в випадку, коли є декілька наборів умов для ції вимог. Такі випадки виглядають наступним чином:
Цей розділ не є нормативним.
Деякі можливості HTML купують зручність користувача ціною його конфіденційності.
В основному, завдяки архітектурі інтернету, користувача може відрізнити від іншого завдяки IP адресі користувача. IP адреса не ідеально співпадає з користувачем; коли користувач переходіть від пристрою до пристрою, або з мережі до мережі, його IP адреса буде змінюватись; подібно, маршрутизація NAT, проксі сервери та комп’ютери загального користування допускають, що пакети для всіх користувачів виглядають як ті, що походять з однієї IP адреси, та насправді відображуються на багатьох користувачів. Технлогії, такі як цибульна маршрутизація, можуть бути застосовані ля подальшої анонімізації запитів, так що запити від одного користувача з одно вузла в інтернеті виглядають як ті, що приходять від багатьох окремих частин мережі.
Однак, IP адреса, що використовується для запитів користувача, не є єдиним механізмом, по якому запити користувача можеть бути співставлені один з одним. Наприклад, кукі, були спеціально розроблені для ціх цілей, та є основою більшості можливостей Web сессій, що дозволяють вам зайти на сайт, де ви маєте обліковий запис.
Є інші механізми, що є більш витонченими. Деякі характеристики системи користувача можуть використовуватись для відокремлення груп користувачів один від одного; збираючи досить такої інформації, може бути обчислений індивідуальний "цифровий відтиск" користувацького переглядача, що може бути настільки ж гарним, коли не краще, за IP адресу, коли треба констатувати, що запити ідуть від одного і того ж користувача.
Групування запитів таким чином, особливо між декількома сайтами, може використовуватись для незагрозливих (та навіть, можливо, позитивних) цілей, але також для злісних намірів. В якості приклада потенційно незагрозливого призначення може бути визначення, чи окрема людина переважно переглядає сайти з зображенням псів, ніж зображень котів (базуючись на тому. як часто вони відвідують відповідні сайти), та потім автоматично використовувати відповідні іллюстрації впродовж наступних відвідин тих же сайтів. Злісні наміри, однак, можуть включати уряди, що збирають інформацію, поєднуючи персональну адресу (визначену як адреса, введена при отриманні пошуку марштурів проїзду на сайті), з явною політичною приналежністью (визначаючи через контроль форумів, де користувачі приймають участь), та використати все це для визначення, що певна людина не має приймати участі в голосуванні на виборах.
Зважаючи на те, що злісні наміри можуть бути виключно злими, реалізатори користувацьких агентів заохочуються до прийняття рішень, як надати своїм користувачам інструментів для зменьшення витоку інформації, що може бути використана для збирання відбитків користувачів.
Нажаль, як натякає перший параграф цього розділу, іноді є велика користь, що походить від розголошення такої інформації, що також може бути використана для цілей відсліджування. Так що є непростим просто блокувати всі потенційні витоки. Наприклад, можливість заходити на сайт, щоб писати посилання під своїм ніком, потребує, щоб запити користувача були ідентифіковані як ті, що походять від одного користувача. Це вірно, по визначенню, більше або менше. Більш витончено, однак, може бути задіяна інформація, як ширина тексту, що треба для багатьох ефектів, пов’язанним з малюванням тексту на холсті (що включає малювання рамки кругом тексту). Це також надає деяку інформацію, та може використовуватись для групування запитів користувача. В цьому випадку, потенціально розкриваючи через брутфорс-пошук, які шрифти встановлені користувачем. Ця інформація значно варіює від кристувача до користувача.
Можливості в цій специфікації, що можить бути використані для відсліджування користувача
марковані так, як цей параграф.
Інші можливості на платформі, що можуть бути використані для тих же цілей, однак, включають, однак не обмежені наступними:
Screen
. [MQ]
[CSSOMVIEW]Цей розділ не є нормативним.
Базовий документ HTML document виглядає наступним чином:
<!DOCTYPE html> <html> <head> <title>Sample page</title> </head> <body> <h1>Sample page</h1> <p>This is a <a href="demo.html">simple</a> sample.</p> <!-- this is a comment --> </body> </html>
Документи HTML складаються з дерева елементів і тексту. Кожний елемент
відокремлюється в похідному тексті початковим тегом, таким як "<body>
",
та завершальним
тегом, таким як "</body>
".
(Деякі початкові теги та завершальні теги у деякіх випадках можуть
бути пропущені,
та випливають з інших тегів).
Теги мають бути вкладені таким чином, щоб елементи всі повністю містились в інших, без перекриття:
<p>Це є <em>дуже <strong>помилковим</em>!</strong></p>
<p>Це <em>є <strong>вірним</strong>.</em></p>
Ця специфікація визначає набір елементів, що можуть використовуватись в HTML, разом з правилами щодо шляхів, як ці елементи можуть бути вкладені.
Елементи можуть мати атрибути, що контролюють, як елементи роблять. В
прикладі нижче наводиться гіперпосилання,
сформоване з елемента a
та його
атрибута href
:
<a href="demo.html">просто</a>
Атрибути
розміщуються в стартовому тезі, та складаються з імені та значення, розділених символом "=
". Значення атрибуту може залишатись без
лапок, якщо воно не містить символи проміжку або будь що з "
'
`
=
<
або
>
. Інакше воно має бути в однакових,
одинарних або подвійних лапках. Значення, разом з символом "=
"може
бути пропущене, якщо значення є пустий рядок.
<!-- пусті атрибути --> <input name=address disabled> <input name=address disabled=""> <!-- атрибути зі значенням --> <input name=address maxlength=200> <input name=address maxlength='200'> <input name=address maxlength="200">
Користувацькі агенти HTML (Web переглядачі) розбирають цю розмітку, перетворюючи її на дерево DOM (Document Object Model). Дерево DOM є представленням документу в пам’яті.
Дерева DOM мають декілька типів вузлів, зокрема вузол DocumentType
,
вузли Element
, вузли Text
,
вузли Comment
, та, в деяких
випадках, вузли ProcessingInstruction
.
Фрагмент розмітки на початку цього розділу буде перетворений на наступне дерево DOM:
html
html
Кореневим елементом дерева є елемент html
, що є елементом, завжди
розташований в корені HTML документів. Вн містить два елементи, head
та body
,
а також вузол Text
між ними.
Є значно більше вузлів Text
в
дереві DOM, ніж дехто міг очікувати, оскільки джерело містить декілька
проміжків (що виглядають як "␣", та переноси рядків "⏎"), що призводить до
створенння вузлів Text
в DOM. Однак, з
історичних причин, не всі проміжки та переноси рядків в оригінальній
розмітці з’являються в DOM. Загалом, всі проміжки перед початковим тегом head
будуть тихо відкинуті, та всі
проміжки після завершального тегу body
будуть розміщені в кінці body
.
Елемент head
містить
елемент title
, що сам
містить вузол Text
, що містить текст
"Sample page". Подібно, елемент body
містить елемент h1
,
елемент p
та коментар.
Цім DOM деревом можна маніпулючати зі скриптив на сторінці. Скрипти
(типово JavaScript) є малими програмами, що можуть бути вбудовані за
допомогою елемента script
,
або використовуючи атрибути
обробника подій вмісту. Наприклад, є форма зі скриптом, що
встановлює значення елементу форми output
в значення "Hello World":
<form name="main"> Result: <output name="result"></output> <script> document.forms.main.elements.result.value = 'Hello World'; </script> </form>
Кожний елемент в дереві DOM представлений об’єктом, та ці об’єкти мають
API, і таким чином можуть бути маніпульовані. Наприклад, посилання (тобто
елемент a
в дереві вищу)
може змінити свій атрибут "href
" декількома шляхами:
var a = document.links[0]; // отримати перше посилання документу a.href = 'sample.html'; // змінити URL призначення для посилання a.protocol = 'https'; // змінити тілько частину схеми для URL a.setAttribute('href', 'http://example.com/'); // змінити вміст атрибуту напряму
Оскільки дерева DOM використовуються як спосіб представляти HTML документи, коли вони обробляються та представлені в реалізаціях (особливо інтерактивних реалізаціях, як Web переглядачі), ця специфікація загалом висловлюється в термінах DOM дерев, ніж в маркуванні, описаному вище.
Документи HTML представляють незалежне від медіа визначення інтерактивного вмісту. Документи HTML можуть бути представлені на єкрані, або через синтезатор мови, або на дисплеях Брайля. Щоб точно впливати на те, як буде виконуватись відтворення, автори можуть використовувати мову стилів, таку як CSS.
В наступному прикладі сторінка була зроблема жовтою-на-синьому з використанням CSS.
<!DOCTYPE html> <html> <head> <title>Sample styled page</title> <style> body { background: navy; color: yellow; } </style> </head> <body> <h1>Sample styled page</h1> <p>This page is just a demo.</p> </body> </html>
Для дадаткових відомостей щодо використання HTML автори заохочуються звертатись до підручників та довідників. Деякі з прикладів, включених в цю специфікацію, також можуть стати в нагоді, але початківці мають бути попереджені, що ця специфікація, в силу необхідності, визначає мову з рівнем деталізації, що з початку може бути складною для розуміння.
Цей розділ не є нормативним.
Коли HTML використовується для створення інтерактивних сайтів, треба бути уважним, щоб уникати створення вразливостей, через які атакуючі можуть скомпроментувати цілісність або самого сайта, або користувачів сайта.
Повне вивчення цієї теми знаходиться за межами цього документу, та автори суворо заохочуються вивчати ці питання з більшими деталями. Однак цей розділ намагаєтсья провадити швидке введення до деяких загальних підводних каменів в розробці HTML застосувань.
Модель безпеки Web базується на концепції "походження", та, відповідно, багато з потенційних атак на Web включають міжсайтові (involve cross-origin) дії. [ORIGIN]
Коли ви сприймаєте недовірений ввод, тобто введений користувачем вміст, як текстові коментарі, значення в параметрах URL, повідомлення з сайтів третіх сторін, таке інше, є безумовним обов’язком, що дані мають бути перевірені перед використанням, та відповідним чином виключені перед відтворенням. Невиконання цього може дозволити зловмисному користувачеві виконувати низку атак, починаючи з потенціальних підмін, таких як надання невірогідної користувацької інформації (від’ємний вік користувача), до поважних, таких, як виконання скриптів кожного разу, коли користувач переглядає сторінку, що включає інформацію, потенціально розповсюджуючу атаку. Або навіть катастрофічних, таких, як знищення всіх даних на сервері.
Для приклада, уявімо, що сторінка шукає рядок пошуку URL, щоб з’ясувати, що треба переглядати, та потім сайт скеровує користувача на іншу сторнку, щоб відобразити повідомлення:
<ul> <li><a href="message.cgi?say=Hello">Say Hello</a> <li><a href="message.cgi?say=Welcome">Say Welcome</a> <li><a href="message.cgi?say=Kittens">Say Kittens</a> </ul>
Якщо повідомлення тільки відображується користувачеві без виключення, зловмисний користувач може збудувати URL, що міститиме елемент скрипту:
http://example.com/message.cgi?say=%3Cscript%3Ealert%28%27Oh%20no%21%27%29%3C/script%3E
Якщо атакуючий потім переконає користувача-жертву відвідати цю сторінку, на сторінці буде виконуватись скрипт на розсуд атакуючого. Такий скрипт може зробити будь-яку кількість ворожих дій, обмежуючись тільки тим, що надає сайт: наприклад, якщо сайт є електронним магазином, такий скрипт може спричинити те, що користувач несвідомо зробить довільно багато небажаних покупок.
Це має назву міжсайтової скриптової атаки.
Є багато конструкцій, що можуть використовуватись для спроби ввести сайт в оману та змусити виконати код. Ось деякі, що мають мати на увазі автори, коли складають фільтри типу "білі списки":
img
, важливо також занести в
білий список любі проваджені атрибути. Якщо дехто дозволяє всі
атрибути, тоді атакуючий може, наприклад, використати атрибут onload
щоб виконати довільний скрипт.javascript:
",
але
користувацькі агенти можуть реалізувати (і дійсно, насправді
історично реалізують) інші.base
,
означає, що кожний елемент script
на сторінці з відносним посиланням може бути перехвачений, та,
подібним чином, любе підписання форми може бути перенаправлений на
ворожий сайт.Якщо сайт дозволяє користувачеві робити підписання форм зі специфічним для користувача побічним ефектом, наприклад, надсилати повідомлення на форум під іменем користувача, робити покупки або подавати заявку на паспорт, є важливим перевіряти, що запит зроблено був зроблений користувачем навмисно, скоріше, ніж інший сайт ввів користувача в оману, щоб він зробив запит несвідомо.
Ця проблема існує, бо форми HTML можуть бути підписані з інших походжень.
Сайти можуть запобігати таким атакам, створюючи форми зі специфічним
для користувача прихованими токенами, або перевіряючи заголовки Origin
для всіх запитів .
Сторіка, що надає користувачам інтерфейсу для виконання дій, що користувач, можливо, не бажає виконувати. Потребує бути розроблена таким чином, щоб запобігати можливості введення користувача в оману шляхом активації інтерфейсу.
Одних з шляхів, як користувач може бути введений в оману - це коли
ворожий сайт розміщує сайт-жертву в маленькому iframe
,
та потім переконує користувача клацнути, наприклад, коли користувач
грає і в гру на реакцію. Коли користувач грає в гру, ворожий сайт може
швидко розмістити iframe під курсором миші, прямо перед тим, як
користувач збираєтсья клацнути, і таким чином вводячи користувача в
оману, змушуючи його клацати на інтерфейсі сайта-жертви.
Щоб запобігати цьому, сайти, що не очікуються як такі, що будуть
використовуватись в фреймах, заохочуються використовувати свій
інтерфейс, тільки коли вони визначають, що не знаходяться у фреймі
(порівнюючи об’єкт window
зі значенням атрибута top
).
Цей розділ не є нормативним.
Скрипти в HTML мають семантику "виконуватись-до-завершення", що означає, що переглядач загалом буде виконувати скрипт безперервно, перед тим, як виконувати щось інше, таке як генерувати подальші події або продовжувати розбір документу.
З іншого боку, розбір файлів HTML виконується асинхронно та інкрементально, що означає, що парсер може призупинитись в любій точці, щоб дозволити виконання скрипта. Загалом це гарна річ, але це означає, що автори мають бути обережні, щоб уникати перехоплення обробників подій, після того, як подїї вже були спрацьовані.
Є два прийоми, щоб надійно зробити це: використовуйте атрибути вмісту обробника подій, або створіть елемент, та додайте обробники подій в тому ж скрипті. Останнє є безпечним, оскільки, як згадувалось раніше, скрипти виконуються до завершення, перед тим, як спрацюють подальші обробники подій.
Один зі шляхів, як це може проявлятись - це за допомогою
елементів img
та події
load
. Подія може спрацювати
так швидко, як елемент є розібраний, особливо коли зображення вже було в
кеші (що є загальним).
Тут автор використовує обробник onload
на елементі img
,
щоб відловити подію load
:
<img src="games.png" alt="Games" onload="gamesLogoHasLoaded(event)">
Якщо елемент був доданий скриптом, тоді настільки довго, доки обробники подій додані в тому ж скрипті, доти подій також не будуть страчені:
<script> var img = new Image(); img.src = 'games.png'; img.alt = 'Games'; img.onload = gamesLogoHasLoaded; // img.addEventListener('load', gamesLogoHasLoaded, false); // також буде робити </script>
Однак, якщо автор спочатку створює елемент img
,
та потім в окремому скрипті додає слухачів подій, є шанс, що подія load
спрацює в проміжку, що
призведе до втрати події:
<!-- Не використовуйте цей стиль, він може призвести то стану гонок! --> <img id="games" src="games.png" alt="Games"> <!-- подія 'load' може спрацювати тут, доки парсер бере відпочинок,
в якому разі ви не побачите її! --> <script> var img = document.getElementById('games'); img.onload = gamesLogoHasLoaded; // може ніколи не спрацювати! </script>
Цей розділ не є нормативним.
Автори заохочуються до використання перевірячів відповідності (також відомих як валідатори), щоб відловлювати загальні помилки. W3C провадить декілька сервісів онлайн валідаторів, включаючи Nu Markup Validation Service.
Цей розділ не є нормативним.
На відміну від попередніх вермій специфікації HTML, ця специфікація визначає в деяких деталях вимоги по обробці недійсних документів, так само, як і дійсних документів.
Однак, навіть враховуючи, що обробка недійсного вмісту в багатьох випадках гарно визначена, вимоги відповідності для документів все ще важливі: на практиці взаємодія (ситуація, коли всі реалізації обробляють окремий вміст надійним та ідентичним, або еквівалентним шляхом) не є єдиною метою вимог до відповідності документів. Цей розділ деталізує більш загальні причини, щоб прокладати різницю між відповідними документами та тими, що містять помилки.
Цей розділ не є нормативним.
Більшість можливостей презентації від попередніх версій HTML більше не є дійсними. Презентаційна розмітка загалом визнана такою, що має декілька проблем:
Хоча можливо використовувати презентаційну розмітку шляхом, що надає користувачам можливості доступу (assistive technologies, ATs) з дійсним досвідом (використовуючи ARIA), робити це значно більш складно, ніж робити це з використанням семантично відповідної розмітки. Більше того, навіть використовуючи такі прийоми не допомагає робити сторінки доступними для не--AT неграфічних користувачів, такіх, як користувачі текстових переглядачів.
Використовуючи незалежну від медіа розмітку, з іншого боку, надає простих шлях для документів створюватись таким чином, що вони робили для більшого прошарку користувачів (наприклад, текстових переглядачів).
Є істотно простіше обслуговувати сайт, написаний таким чином, що
розмітка не залежить від стилю. Наприклад, зміна кольору сайту, що
повсякчас використовує <font color="">
вимагає змін по всьому сайту, тоді як подібна заміна до сайту, що
базується на CSS може бути зроблена заміною одного файлу.
Презентаційна розмітка має тенденцію бути більш надлишковою, і, таким чином, призводить до більшіх розмірів файлів.
За ціх причин презентаційна розмітка була видалена з HTML в цій версії. Ця зміна не повинна нікого здивувати; в HTML4 відкинута презентаційна розмітка багато років тому, та проваджений в режим (HTML4 Transitional), щоб допомогти авторам відсунутися від презентаційної розмітки; піздніше, XHTML 1.1 пійшов далі та визнав застарілими ці функції в цілому.
Єдина можливість презентаціймої розмітки, що залишився в HTML, є атрибут
style
та елемент style
.
Використання атрибуту дещо бентежить в виробничому оточенні, але він може
бути корисним для швидкого макетування (коли його правила можуть бути
напряму переміщені в окремий лист стилів піздніше) та для надання
особливих стилів в незвичайних випадках, коли окремий лист стилів не буде
зручним. Подібно, елемент style
може біти використаний в синдикації (поєднанні вмісту з різних джерел
прим.) або для особливих для сторінки стилів, але, в основному, зовнішній
лист стилів, вірогідно, буде більш зручним, коли стилі стосуються
декількох сторінок.
Також варто відзначити, що деякі елементи, що до цього були
презентаційними, тепер були перевизначені в цій специфікації, щоб бути
незалежними від медіа: b
, i
, hr
,
s
, small
та u
.
Цей розділ не є нормативним.
Синтакс HTML обмежений, щоб запобігти широкому розмаїттю проблем.
Окремі недійсні синтаксичні конструкції, коли розбираються, продукують дерева DOM, що є вкрай неінтуітивними.
Щоб дозволити користувацькім агентам використовуватись в контрольованих оточеннях, при цьому не реалізуючі найбільш химерні та хитромудрі правила обробки помилок, користувацькм агентам дозволено зазнавати невдачі при виникненні помилок розбору.
Деяка поведінка обробки помилок, такая, як поведінка для
приклада <table><hr>...
,
зазначеного вище, несумісна з потоковими користувацькими агентами
(користувацькими агентами, що обробляють файли HTML за один
прохід, без зберігання стану). Щоб уникнути проблеми взаємодії з
такими користувацькими агентами, любий синтаксис, що призводить до
такої поведінки, визнаний недійсним.
Коли користувацький агент, що базується на XML, під’єднаний до HTML парсеру, є можливість того, що деякі інваріанти, що накладаються XML, такі, як те що коментарі ніколи не містять два послідовних знака тире, будуть порушені в HTML файлі. Обробка ціх випадків може вимагати, щоб парсер примусив HTML DOM до стану XML-суумісного інфосету. Більшість синтаксичних конструкцій, що потребують такої обробки, визнані недійсними.
Деякі синтаксичні конструкції можуть призвести до непропорційно низької продуктивності. Щоб знеохочувати використання таких конструкцій, вони типово зроблені невідповідними.
Наприклад, наступна розмітка призводить до низької продуктивності,
оскільки всі незакриті елементи i
мають бути реконструйовані в кожному параграфі, що дає все більше
елементів в кожному параграфі:
<p><i>He dreamt. <p><i>He dreamt that he ate breakfast. <p><i>Then lunch. <p><i>And finally dinner.
Отриманий DOM для цього фрагменту буде наступним:
Є синтаксичні конструкції, що з історичних причин є відносно ламкими. Щоб скоротити число користувачів, які випадково натрапляють на такі проблеми, вони зроблені невідповідними.
Наприклад, розбір деяких іменованих символьних посилань в атрибутах відбувається, навіть за відсутності фінальної крапки з комою. Є безпечним включати амперсанд, за яким слідують букви, що не формують іменоване символьне посилання. Але якщо символи зміняться так, що рядок утворить іменоване символьне посилання, вони, замість цього, будуть інтерпретовані як цей символ.
В цьому фрагменті значення атрибуту є "?bill&ted
":
<a href="?bill&ted">Bill and Ted</a>
Однак в наступному фрагменті значення атрибуту насправді "?art©
",
не бажане "?art©
",
оскільки навіть без закриваючої крапки з комою, "©
"
обробляється так само, як і "©
"
і таким чином після інтерпретації дає "©
":
<a href="?art©">Art and Copy</a>
Щоб уникнути цієї проблеми всі іменовані символьні посилання мають завершуватись на крапку з комою, та використання іменованих символьних посилань без крапки з комою відмічаються як помилки.
Таким чином, коректним шляхом виразити надані вище випадки буде наступне:
<a href="?bill&ted">Bill and Ted</a> <!-- &ted є гарним, оскільки це не іменоване символьне посилання -->
<a href="?art&copy">Art and Copy</a> <!-- & має бути виключеним, оскільки © є іменованим символьним посиланням -->
Відомо, що деякі синтаксичні конструкції викликають виключно тонкі або серйозні проблеми в унаслідованих користувацьких агентах, і, таким чином, помічені як невідповідні, щоб допомогти авторам уникати їх.
Наприклад, це є причиною, чому символ "`" (U+0060) не допущений в атрибутах без лапок. В деяких унаслідованих користувацьких агентах, часом він трактується як символ лапок.
Інший приклад цього є DOCTYPE, що потрібен для перемикання несумісного режиму, оскільки поведінка унаслідованих користувацьких агентів в сумісному режимі часто широко недокументована.
Певні обмеження ісунують цілковито щоб запобігти відомим проблемам безпеки.
Наприклад, обмеження на використання UTF-7 існує виключно для запобігання того, що автори стануть жертвою відомої міжсайтової скриптової атаки з використанням UTF-7. [UTF7]
Розмітка, коли наміри авторів є дуже неясними, часто зроблені невідповідними. Виправлення ціх помилок на ранній стадії робить подальшу підтримку простішою.
Коли користувач робить просту типографічну помилку, буде корисним, якщо помилка може бути віявлена на ранній стадії, тому що це може зберегти автору багато часу налагодження. Тому ця специфікація зазвичай вирішує, що це помилка, коли використовуються імена елементів, імена атрибутів, і таке інше, що не співпадають з іменами, визначеними в цій специфікації.
Наприклад, якщо автор набирає <capton>
замість <caption>
,
це може бути визнано як помилка, та автор може безпосередньо
виправити помилку набору.
З метою розвитку синтаксису мови в майбутньому, заборонені деякі, інакше нешкідліві можливості.
Наприклад, "атрибути" в заключних тегах наразі ігноруються, але вони є недійсними, на випадок, коли майбутні зміни в мові будуть використовувати цю можливість синтаксису, не конфліктуючи з вже розгорнутим (та дійсним!) вмістом.
Деякі автори знаходять корисним завжди практикувати оточення всіх атрибутів в лапки, та жавжди включають всі опціональні теги, віддаючи перевагу, що походить від такого власного налаштування, порівняно з невеликою користю від лаконічності, що набута за рахунок використання гнучкості синтаксису HTML. Щоб допомогти таким авторам, інструменти перевірки відповідності можуть провадити режими роботи, коли ці домовленості застосовуються примусово.
Цей розділ не є нормативним.
За межами синтаксису мови ця специфікація також накладає обмеження на те, як елементи та атрибути можуть бути задані. Ці обмеження присутні за подібних причин:
Щоб уникнути навірного уживання елементів з визначеним значенням, моделі вмісту визначені таким чином, щоб обмежувати, як елементи можуть вкладатись, коли це вкладання буде мати сумнівне значення.
Наприклад, це специфікація не дозволяє вкладання
елементу section
в
елемент kbd
, оскільки
дуже сумнівно, що автор помітить, що цілий розділ повинен бути
введений з клавіатури.
Подібно, щоб привернути увагу автора до помилок в використанні елементів, чіткі протиріччя в виражених семантиках також вважаються помилками відповідності.
В тексті нижче, наприклад, семантика не має сенсу: роздільник не може одночасно бути клітиною, як радіо перемикач не може бути індикатором прогресу.
<hr role="cell">
<input type=radio role=progressbar>
Іншим прикладом є обмеження на моделі вмісту елементу
ul
, що дозволяє тільки
елемент li
в якості
дочірнього. Списки по замовчанню складаються виключно з нуля або
більше елементів списку, так що якщо елемент ul
містить щось інше, ніж елемент li
,
не є зрозумілим, що мається на увазі.
Окремі елементи мають стилі по замовчанню, або поведінки, що в певних комбінаціях вірогідно призведуть до плутанини. Коли вони мають еквівалентні альтернативи без ціх проблем, заплутані комбінації не дозволяються.
Наприклад, елементи div
малюються як блокові бокси, та елементи span
як вбудовані бокси. Вкладання блокового боксу у вбудований бокс є
надмірно заплутаним; оскільки вкладаються тільки div
елементи, або вкладаються тільки span
елементи, або є вкладання елементів span
в елементи div
. Всі
прислуговуються тій же меті, що і вкладання елементу div
в елемент span
, але
тільки останній спричиняє блоковий бокс у вбудованому боксі. Тому
остання комбінація заборонена.
Слідуя цій же логіці інтерактивний
вміст не може бути вкладений. Наприклад, елемент button
не може містити елемент textarea
.
Це тому, що поведінка по замовчанню такого вкладеного елементу буде
бентежити користувача. Замість щоб вкладати ці елементи, вони мають
знаходитись пліч о пліч.
Часом дещо заборонене, оскільки дозволивши це вірогідно призведе до збентеження автора.
Наприклад, встановлення атрибуту disabled
в значення "false
"
не дозволяється, оскільки, не зважаючи на існування сенсу в тому, що
елемент є включеним, це, фактично, означає, що елемент є відключеним
(що має вагу для реалізацій, це сам факт присутності атрибута, не його
значення).
Деякі помилки відповідності спрощують мову, що треба вивчати авторам.
Наприклад, атрибут shape
елементу area
, не
зважаючи на те, що на практиці сприяє обоє значення, circ
та circle
, як
синоніми, заборона на використання значення circ
, спрощує
підручники та інші навчальні матеріали. Не буде ніякого зиску
дозволяти обоє, та це може призвести до додаткових непорозумінь при
вивченні мови.
Деякі елементи аналізуються у дещо ексцентричній манері (типово з історичних причин), та їх обмеження на модель вмісту призначені для запобігання розкриття автору ціх тонкощів.
Наприклад, елемент form
не дозволений всередені фразового
вмісту, оскільки при розборі як HTML, стартовий тег на початку
елементу form
буде натякати на завершальний тег елементу p
. Таким чином, наступна розмітка призведе до створення двох параграфів, не одного:
<p>Welcome. <form><label>Name:</label> <input></form>
Це розбираєтся саме так, як наступне:
<p>Welcome. </p><form><label>Name:</label> <input></form>
Деякі помилки призначені допомогти запобіганню проблем зі скриптами, що буде складно налагоджувати.
Це причина того, що є невідповідним мати два атрибути
id
з тим же значенням. Здубліковані ID призводять до того, що буде
обраний невірний елемент, з, часом, згубними ефектами, чию причину
складно визначити.
Деякі конструкції недозволені, оскільки історично вони спричиняли масове марнування часу розробки. Заохочуючи авторів уникати робити це, ми бажаємо, щоб автори зберігали час в подальших зусиллях.
Наприклад, атрибут src
елементу script
викликає те, що вміст елементу буде проігноровано. Однак це не
очевидно, особливо якщо вміст елементу виглядає як скрипт, що
виконується — це може призвести до того, що автори витратять масу
часу, намагаючись налаштувати вбудований скрипт, не усвідомлюючи, що
він не виконується. Щоб зменшити цю проблему, ця специфікація робить
невідповідним мати виконуваний скрипт в елементі script
,
якщо пристуниій елемент src
. Це означає, що автори, що
перевіряють свої документи, менш вірогідно змарнують час з цім типом
помилок.
Деякі автори бажають писати файли, що можуть бути інтерпретовані однаково як XML та HTML, зі схожими результатами. Однак ця практика загалом збентежлива, через включення міріади тонких складнощів (особливо коли мова йде про скрипти, стилі або любий спосіб автоматичной серіалізації). Ця специфікація має декілька обмежень, призначених щонайменше дещо пом’якшити складнощі. Це спрощує авторам використовувати це, як перехідний крок, коли той мігрує між HTML та XHTML.
Наприклад, є дещо ускладнені правила, оточуючі
атрибути атрибути lang
та
xml:lang
,
призначені для підтримки обох в синхронному вигляді.
Іншим прикладом може бути обмеження на значення
атрибутів xmlns
в серіалізації HTML,
що призначені надати впевненості, що елементи в відповідних документах
опиняться в тих же просторах імен, оброблені HTML або XML.
Як і з обмеженнями на синтаксис, націлених на додавання нових можливостей синтаксису в майбутнії мерсіях мови, деякі обмеження на моделі вмісту елементів та значень атрибутів призначені надати змогу подальшого розширення словника HTML.
Наприклад, обмежуючи значення атрибуту target
, що починаєтся з
символу "_" (U+005F) до тільки особливих, заздалегідь визначених,
значень дозволяє введення нових значень в майбутньому, без конфліктів
з визначеними автором значень.
Деякі обмеження призначені для підтримки обмежень, що зроблені в інших специфікаціях.
Наприклад, вимога, що атрибути, що приймають медіа запити, використовували тільки дійсні медіа запити, підсилює важливість слідування правилам відповідності тієї специфікації.
Цей розділ не є нормативним.
Наступні документи можуть бути цікавими читачам цієї специфікації.
Ця архітектурна специфікація надає авторам специфікацій, розробникам програмного забезпечення та розробникам вмісту загальний довідник для взаємооперабельних маніпуляцій з текстом в World Wide Web, побудованих на Universal Character Set, визначим спільно через Unicode Standard та ISO/IEC 10646. Затронуті теми включають використання термінів 'символ', 'кодування' та 'рядок', посилання на модель обробки, вибір та ідентифікацію кодування символів, виключення символів та індексацію рядків.
Оскільки Unicode містить таке велике число символів, та поєднує різні системи письма у всьому світі, некоректне використання може відкрити програми та системи для можливих атак безпеки. Це особливо важливо, коли більше і більше продуктів є інтернаціолізовані. Цей документ описує деякі з рішень безпеки, що програмісти, системні аналітики, розробники стандартів та користувачі повинні мати на увазі, та провадить особліві рекомендації для зменшення ризиків проблем.
Web Content Accessibility Guidelines (WCAG) 2.0 розкриває широкий диапазон рекомендацій, щоб зробити вміст Web більш доступним. Слідування цім вказівкам зробить вміст доступнішим для більшого числа людей з вадами, включачи сліпоту та слабкий зір, глухоту та страту слуху, ускладнене сприйняття, обмеженість в розпізнанні, обмежена рухомість, пошкодження мови, світочутливості, та комбінацій цього. Слудя цим настановам також часто зробить ваш Web вміст більш корисним загалом.
Ця специфікація провадить вказівки для розробки інструментів створення Web вмісту, що більш доступний для людей з вадами. Інструмент створення, що відповідає цім вказівкам, буде просувати доступність, впроваджуючи доступний користувацькій інтерфейс до авторів з вадами, а також дозволяючи, підтримуючи та просуваючи створення доступного Web вмісту для всіх авторів.
Цей документ надає вказівки для розробки користувацьких агентів, що знижують бар’єри для Web доступності для людей з вадами. Користувацькі агенти включають переглядачі та інши типи програмного забезпечення, що отримують та відображають вміст Web. Користувацький агент, що відповідає цім вказівкам, буде просувати доступність через свій власний інтерфейс, та через інші внутрішні механізми, включаючи здатність комунікувати з іншими технологіями (особливо технології доступності). Більше того, всі користувачі, не тільки користувачі з вадами, знайдуть, що відповідаючі користувацькі агенти є більш корисними.
Документ, що використовує розмітку polyglot є докуентом - потоком байтів, що розбираються до ідентичних дерев документів (за винятком атрибута xmlns на кореневому елементі), коли іде обробка HTML, та потім ообробляється як XML. Розмітка polyglot, що задовільняє всім визначеним наборам обмежень, інтерпретується як сумісний, незалежно від того, обробляється він як HTML або як XHTML, стосовно специфікації HTML5. Polyglot-розмітка використовує особливий DOCTYPE, декларації простору імен, та особливий реєстр літер — зазвичай малі літери, але інколи змішані (camel) — для імен атрибутів та елементів. Polyglot-розмітка використовує нижний реєстр для окремих значень атрибутів. Подальші обмеження включають такі для пустих елементів, іменованих посилань на сутності, та використання скриптів та стилів.
Це чорнова документація, відображаюча HTML елементи та атрибути на доступні API Ролі, Стани та Властивості на декількох платформах. Вона провадить рекомендації з отримання доступних імен та дескрипторів для HTML елементів. Вона також надає приклади реалізації можливостей доступності.
Ця специфікація посилаєтсья до обох, атрибутів HTML та XML, та атрибутів IDL, часто в одному і тому ж контексті. Коли є неясність, на що є поисилання, вони називаються як атрибути вмісту для HTML та XML атрибутів, та IDL атрибути для визначених на IDL інтерфейсах. Подібно до цього, термін "властивості" використовується для обох, властивостей об’єктів JavaScript та властивостей CSS. Коли це створює неоднозначність, вони кваліфікуються як властивості об’єктів та CSS властивості, відповідно.
Загалом, коли специфікація декларує, що можливість стосуєтся синтаксису HTML або XHTML синтаксису, це також включає одне друге. Коли, натомість, можливість стосується тільки однієї або іншої мови, вона називається та явно вказується, що це не стосується іншого формату, наприклад, "для HTML, ... (це не стосується до XHTML)".
Це специфікація використовує термін документ
для посилання на кожне використання HTML, диапазоні від стислих
статичних документів до довгих ессе або доповідей з багатим мультимедіа,
так само, як і до повноцінних інтерактивних застосувань. Термін
використовується для посилання до обох, об’єктів Document
та похідних DOM дерев, та до серіалізованих байтових потоків, з
використанням синтаксису
HTML або синтаксису
XHTML,
в залежності від контексту.
В контексті DOM структур, терміни HTML документ та XML документ використовуються як визначено в
специфікації DOM, та посилається на два режима, в яких можуть опинитися
об’єкти Document
. [DOM]
(Такі використання завжди пов’язани гіперпосиланнями до іншого
визначення).
В контексті байтових потоків, термін "HTML документ" посилаєтсья до
ресурсів, помічених як text/html
,
та термін "XML документ" посилається до ресурсів, помічених як MIME
тип XML.
Термін XHTML документ використовується
для посилання на обоє, Document
в
режимі XML
документу, що містить вузли елементів в просторі
імен HTML, та байтових потоків, помічених як MIME тип XML,
що містить елементи з простору імен HTML, в залежності від контексту.
Для спрощення, такі терміни, як показаний, відображений, та видимий можуть іноді використовуватись, коли мове іде про документ, що відтворюється користувачеві. Ці терміни не обов’язково мають на увазі візуальне медіа; вони повинні розглядатись як ті, що стосуються до інших медіа в еквівалентних шляхах.
Коли алгоритм B каже, що повертається до іншого алгоритму A, мається на увазі, що A викликає B. Повертаючисть до A, реалізація має продовжити там, де вона зупинилась, викликаючи B.
Термін "прозорий чорний" посилається на колір з червоного, зеленого, синього, та альфа каналу, де всі компоненти встановлені в нуль.
Специфікація використовує термін підтримується при посиланні на випадок, коли користувацький агент має реалізацію, що в змозі декодувати семантику зовнішнього ресурсу. Формат або тип, кажуть, підтримується, якщо реалізація може обробляти зовнішній ресурс цього формату або типу, без того, щоб ігнорувати критичні аспекти цього ресурсу. Коли окремий ресурс підтримується, може залежати від того, які можливості формату цього ресурсу будуть використовуватись.
Наприклад, зображення PNG може розглядатись як той формат, що підтримується, якщо його піксельні дані можуть бути декодовані на відтворені, навіть якщо реалізація і не знає, що зображення також містить дані анімаії.
Файл відео MPEG-4 не може розглядатись як підтримуваний формат, якщо формат компресії не підтримуєтсья, навіть якщо реалізація може визначити розміри стрічки з метаданих файла.
На що деякі специфікації, зокрема специфікація HTTP, посилається як представлення, в цій специфікації посилаєтсья як ресурс. [HTTP]
Термін MIME тип викоритсовується для посилання не те, що інколи називають інтернет медіа тип в літературі по протоклах. Термін медіа тип в цій специфікації використовується для посилання на тип медіа, призначеного для презентаціх, як використаний в специфікаціях CSS. [RFC2046] [MQ]
Рядок є чинним MIME типом, якщо він
співпадає з правилом media-type
,
визначеним в розділі 3.1.1.1 "Медіа типи" в RFC 7231. Зокрема, чинний
MIME тип може включати параметри MIME типу. [HTTP]
Рядок є чинним MIME типом
без параметрів, якщо він співпадає з правилом media-type
,
визначеним в розділі 3.1.1.1 "Медіа типи" в RFC 7231, але не містить
жодного символу ";" (U+003B). Іншими словами, він складається тільки з
типу та підтипу, без MIME параметрів типу. [HTTP]
Термін HTML MIME тип використовується для
посилання на MIME тип text/html
.
Критичні субресурси ресурса, це ті, що ресурс має мати, щоб оброблятися коректно. Ці ресурси вважаються критичними або ні, як визначається специфікацією, що визничає формат ресурсів.
Термін data:
URL посилається на URL,
що використовує схему data:
. [RFC2397]
Щоб спростити міграцію з HTML до XHTML, користувацькі
агенти, відповідні до цієї специфікації, будуть розташовувати елементи в
HTML в просторі імен http://www.w3.org/1999/xhtml
,
щонайменше для цілей DOM та CSS. Термін "HTML
елементи", коли використовується в цій специфікації, посилається
до любого елементу в цьому просторі імен, і таким чином, посилається до
обох, елементів HTML та XHTML.
За винятком, коли не вказано інше, всі елементи, визначені або згадані в
цій специфікації, походять з простору імен HTML ("http://www.w3.org/1999/xhtml
"),
та всі атрибути визначені або згадані в цій специфікації не мають простору
імен.
Термін тип елементу використовується для
посилання для набору елементів, що мають надане локальне ім’я та простір
імен. Наприклад, елементи button
мають тип елементу button
,
що означає, що вони мають локальне ім’я "button
"
та (неявно, як визначено вище) простір імен
HTML.
Імена атрибутів називають XML-сумісними,
якщо вони співпадають з утворенням Name
, визначеним в XML, вони не містять
символів ":" (U+003A), та їх перші три символи не є ASCII
чутливі до реєстру в співпадінні з рядком "xml
".
[XML]
Термін XML MIME тип використовується для
посилання на MIME типи
text/xml
, application/xml
,
та любий MIME тип, чий підтип закінчується
на чотири символи "+xml
". [RFC7303]
Кореневий елемент
об’єкту Document
є першим дочірнім
елементом Document
, якщо такий
існує. Якщо такого немає, то Document
не має кореневого елемента.
Термін кореневий елемент, коли не
посилається на кореневий елемент об’єкту Document
,
означає подальший вузол-предок елементу, про який іде мова, або сам вузол,
коли в нього немає предків. Коли вузол є частиною документу, тоді кореневим
елементом вузла дійсно є кореневий елемент документу; однак, якщо
вузол не є наразі частиною дерева документу, кореневий елемент буде
подвішеним вузлом.
Коли кореневий елемент елементу є кореневим
елементом об’єкта Document
, тоді кажуть, що він
кореневий відносно Document
.
Про елемент кажуть, що він вставлений в документ, коли
його кореневий елемент змінюється, та зараз
став кореневим елементом документу.
Аналогічно, елемент називаєтсья вилученим з документу,
коли його кореневий документ змінюється, та
більше не буде кореневим елементом
документу, та буде іншим елементом.
Домашняє піддерево вузла є таким піддеревом,
що має корінь в кореневому елементі вузла.
Коли вузол знаходиться в ієрархії Document
,
його домашнє піддерево є дерево того Document
.
Document
для Node
(такого, як елемент) є Document
, що
повертається IDL атрибутом ownerDocument
для
цього Node
.
Коли Node
є в
ієрархії Document
, тоді Document
завжди є Document
для Node
, і, таким чином, IDL
атрибут ownerDocument
для цього Node
завжди повертає цей Document
.
Document
атрибуту вмісту є Document
елементу того атрибуту.
Термін порядок дерева означає попередньо
визначений, спершу-вглиб, перебіг DOM вузлів (через відносини parentNode
/childNodes
).
Коли справа іде по те, що деякий елемент або атрибут ігнорується, або трактується як деяке інше значення, або обробляється як це було б чимось іншим, це посилається тільки до обробки вузла після того, як він потрапить в DOM. Користувацький агент не має змінювати DOM в таких ситуаціях.
Кажуть, що атрибут вмісту змінює значення, тільки якщо його нове значення відмінне від попереднього; встановлення атрибуту в значення, що він вже мав, не змінює його.
Термін порожній, коли застосовується до
значення атрибуту, вузла Text
, або
рядка, означає, що довжина тексту є нуль (тобто, навіть не містить
проміжків або символів управління).
Конструкція "об’єкт Foo
", де Foo
насправді є
інтерфейсом, часом використовується замість більш точного "об’єкт, що
реалізує інтерфейс Foo
".
Атрибут IDL, кажуть, був отриманий, коли його значення було використано (автором скрипту), та кажуть, був встановлений, коли йому надається нове значення.
Кажуть, що DOM об’єкт є живим, коли атрибути та методи цього об’єкта мають оперувати з дійсними підлягаючими даними, не зі знимками даних.
В контексті подій, терміни викликає спрацювання та відправляється
використовуються як визначено в специфікації DOM: викликає спрацювання події означає
створити та відправити
його, та відправлення
події означає слідувати крокам, що поширюють подію по дереву. Термін довірена
подія використовується для посилання на події, чий атрибут isTrusted
встановлений в true. [DOM]
Термін додаток посилається до набору сталих
обробників користувацького агента, що використовуються користувацьким
агентом, та що можуть прийняти участь в відтворенні вмісту об’єкту Document
, але не діють як дочірні контексти перегляду Document
, а ні вводять будь-яких
об’єктів Node
в ієрархію Document
DOM.
Типово такі обробники вмісту провадяться сторонніми виробниками, хоча користувацький агент також може призначити вбудовані обробники вмісту як додатки.
Користувацький агент не має розглядати типи text/plain
та application/octet-stream
як ті, що мають зареєстрований
додаток.
Одним прикладом додатку може бути переглядач PDF, що створює екземпляр для перегляду вмісту, коли користувач преходить до перегляду PDF. Це повинно вважати за додаток, безвідносно до того, чи це було частково реалізовано компонентом переглядача PDF, чи це було реалізовано самим користувацьким агентом. Однак, застосування перегляду PDF, що запускається окремо від користувацького агенту (на відміну від використання того ж інтерфейсу) не є додатком по визначенню.
Ця специфікація не визначає механізм для взаємодії з додатками, тому ще це, як очікується, є користуцький-агент- та платформа-специфічним. Деякі користувацькі агенти можуть підтримати існуючий механізм додатків, такий як Netscape Plugin API; інші можуть використовувати віддалені конвертери вмісту, або мати вбудовану підтримку для деяких типів вмісту. Насправді, ця специфікація загалом не вимагає, щоб користувацькі агенти підтримували додатки. [NPAPI]
Додаток може бути унебезпечним,
якщо він поважає семантику атрибуту sandbox
.
Наприклад, унебезпечений додаток може запобігати, щоб
його вміст створював спливаючі вікна, коли додаток створює екземпляр в
пісочниці iframe
.
Переглядачі мають пильно турбуватись при взаємодії з зовнішнім вмістом, що призначається для додатків. Стороннє програмне забезпечення виконується з тими ж привелеями, які має сам користувач. Таким чином, вразливості в сторонньому додаткові стають такі ж загрозливі, як і такі в користувацькому агенті.
Оскільки різні користувачі мають різні набори додатків, це надає вектор відбитків, що збільшує
шанси на те, що користувачі будуть ідентифіковані. Тому користувацькі
агенти заохочуються до підтримки однакових наборів додатків для кожного користувача.
Кодування символів, або просто кодування, де не виникає незрозумілості, є визначеним шляхом перетворення між байтовими потоками та рядками Unicode, як визначено в стандарті кодування. Кодування має ім’я кодування та одну або більше міток кодування, як це визначено в іменах та мітках в специфікації кодування. [ENCODING]
ASCII-сумісне кодування символів є однобайтним або перемінної-довжини кодуванням в якому байти 0x09, 0x0A, 0x0C, 0x0D, 0x20 - 0x22, 0x26, 0x27, 0x2C - 0x3F, 0x41 - 0x5A та 0x61 - 0x7A, ігноруючи байти, що є другими та подальшими байтами в мультибайтових послідовностях, всі відповідають однобайтним послідовностям, що відображуються на ті ж символи Unicode, що й байти в кодуванні Windows-1252. [ENCODING]
Це включає такі кодування, як Shift_JIS, HZ-GB-2312, та різноманітні ISO-2022, навіть зважаючи на те, що в ціх кодуваннях байти на кшталт 0x70 можуть бути частиною довших послідовностей, що не мають відношення до їх інтерпретації в якості ASCII. Це включає варіанти UTF-16, так само, як і забуті старі кодування, як UTF-7, GSM03.38 та варіанти EBCDIC.
Термін кодування UTF-16 посилається на всі варіанти UTF-16: UTF-16LE або UTF-16BE, в залежності від присутності або відсутності BOM. [ENCODING]
Термін одиниця коду використовується так, як
визначено в специфікації Web IDL: 16-бітне беззнакове ціле, найменьший
атомарний компонент DOMString
. (Це найкоротше
визначення, порівняно з тим, що використовується в Unicode, і не є тим же,
що і кодова точка) [WEBIDL]
Термін кодова точка Unicode означає скалярне значення Unicode, де це можливо, та ізольована сурогатна кодова точка, коли ні. Коли визначена вимога відповідності в термінах символів або кодових точок Unicode, пара кодових одиниць, що складаються з вищого сурогату, за яким слідує нижчий сурогат, що має трактуватись як єдина кодова точка, представлена парою сурогатів, але ізольовані сурогати мають кожний бути трактовані як єдина кодова точка зі значенням сурогату. [UNICODE]
В цій специфікації термін символ, коли не кваліфіковано що це Unicode символ, синхронізовано з терміном кодова точка Unicode.
Термін символ Unicode використовується для значення скалярне значення Unicode (тобто, люба кодова точка Unicode, що не є сурогатною кодовою точкою). [UNICODE]
Довжина кодової одииці рядка є число кодових одиниць в рядку.
Ця складність походить від історичного рішення визначити DOM API в термінах 16-бітних (UTF-16) кодових одиниць, скоріше ніж в термінах Unicode символів.
Всі діаграми, приклади, та зауваження в цій специфікації є ненормативними, таким же чином, як і всі розділи, що помічені як ненормативні. Все інше в цій специфікації є нормативним.
Ключаві слова "МУСИТЬ", "МУСИТЬ НЕ", "ПОТРЕБУЄ", "МАЄ", "МАЄ НЕ", "МОЖЕ" та "ОПЦІОНАЛЬНО" в нормативних частинах цього документу мають бути інтерпретовані, як описано в RFC2119. Ключове слово "МОЖЕ ОПЦІОНАЛЬНО" в нормативних частинах цього документу інтерпретується з тим же нормативним значенням, що й "МОЖЕ" та "ОПЦІОНАЛЬНО". Для спрощення читання ці слова не з’являються в великих літерах на протязі цієї специфікції. [RFC2119]
Вимоги, що перефразовані як імперативні, та є частиною алгоритмів (такі, як "відкиньте всі передуючі проміжки" або "поверніть false та перервіть ці кроки") мають бути інтерпретовані з додаванням значення ключового слова ("мусить", має", "може", таке інше), використаних при запровадженні цього алгоритма.
Наприклад, коли специфікація каже:
Щоб з’їсти помаранч, користувач мусить: 1. Очистити помаранч. 2. Відділити кожну скибку помаранча. 3. З'їсти скибки помаранча.
...це повинно бути еквівалентом до наступного:
Щоб з’їсти помаранч: 1. Користувач мусить очистити помаранч. 2. Користувач мусить відділити кожну скибку помаранча. 3. Користувач мусить з’їсти скибки помаранча.
Тут ключовим словом є "мусить".
Перший (імперативний) стиль загально переважає в цій специфікації з міркувань гарного стилю.
Вимоги відповідності викладені як алгоритми або особливі кроки, що можуть бути реалізовані в будь-який спосіб, до тих пір, доки результат еквівалентним. (Зокрема, алгоритми, визначені в цій специфікації, націлені щоб їм було легко слідувати, та не призначені бути виключино продуктивними).
Ця специфікація описує критерії відповідності для користувацьких агентів (призначено для реалізаторів) та документів (призначено для авторів та реалізаторів інструментів розробки).
Відповідні документи є такими, що відповідають всім критеріям відповідності для документів. В цілях спрощення читання, деякі з ціх вимог відповідності викладені як вимоги відповідності до авторів; такі вимоги є непрямими вимогами до документів: по визначенню, всі документи повинні мати автора. (В деяких випадках цім автором може бути сам користувацький агент — такі користувацькі агенти є предметом додаткових правил, як визначено нижче).
Наприклад, якщо вимога каже, що "автори мають не
використовувати елемент foobar
", це
має також на увазі, що документи не мають містити елементи з іменем foobar
.
Немає зв’язку між вимогами відповідності до документу, та вимогами відповідності до реалізацій. Користувацькі агенти не вільні обробляти невідповідні документи на свій розсуд; модель обробки, викладена в цій специфікації, застосовується до реалізацій, безвідносно до відповідності вхідного документа.
Користувацькі агенти підпадають в декілька (перетинаючихся) категорій, з різними вимогами відповідності.
Web переглядачі, що підтримують синтаксис XHTML, мусять обробляти елементи та атрибути з простору імен HTML, знайдені в XML документах, як описано в цій специфікації, і таким чином користувачі зможуть взаємодіяти з ними, за винятком, коли семантика ціх елементів була перевизначена іншими специфікаціями.
Відповідний XHTML процесор буде, знайшовши елемент
XHTML script
в XML
документі, виконувати скрипт, що міститься в цьому елементі. Однак,
якщо елемент знайдений в трансформації, вираженій в XSLT
(очікується, що агент також підтримує XSLT), тоді процесор буде
замість цього сприймати елемент script
як прозорий елемент, що формує частину трансформації.
Web переглядачі, що підтримують синтакс HTML, мають обробляти документи, помічені як MIME тип HTML, як описано в цій специфікації, так що користувачі можуть взаємодіяти з ними.
Якщо явно не вказано інше, специфікації, що
перевизначають семантику елементів HTML, не перевизначають вимоги до
DOM об’єктів, що представляють ці елементи. Наприклад, елемент script
в прикладі вище
буде як і раніше реалізувати інтерфейс HTMLScriptElement
.
Користувацькі агенти, що обробляють документи HTML та XHTML виключно для відтворення неінтерактивних їх версій, мають відповідати тим же крітеріям відповідності, що й Web переглядачі, за винятком того, що до вимог стосовно інтерактивності.
Типовим прикладом користувацьких агентів з неінтерактивною презентацією є принтери (статичні користувацькі агенти) та підвішені дисплеї (динамічні користувацькі агенти). Очікується, що більшість статичних користувацьких агентів з неінтерактивною презентацією також будуть з відсутністю підтримки скриптів.
Користувацький агент з неінтерактивною, але динамічною презентацією, буде все ще підтримувати скрипти, дозволяючи формам бути динамічно введеними, та таке інше. Однак, оскільки конфепція "фокусу" не відноситься до випадку, коли користувач не може взаємодіяти з документом, користувацькі агенти не мають підтримувати жодних пов’язаних з фокусом DOM API.
Користувацькі агенти, інтерактивні або ні, можуть бути відмічені (можливо як опція користувача), як підтримуючі запропоноване відтворення по замовчанню, визначене в цій специфікації.
Це не є обов’язковим. Зокрема, навіть користувацькі агенти, що реалізують запропоноване відтворення по замовчанню, заохочуються до надання налаштувань, що змінюють ці замовчання, щоб покращити досвід користувача, тобто, змінювати контраст кольору, використовувати різні стілі фокусу, або інакше робити досвід більш доступним та зручним для користувача.
Користувацькі агенти, відмічені як такі, що підтримують запропоноване відтворення по замовчанню, повивнні, коли відмічені таким чином, реалізовати правила з розділу відтворення. Цей розділ визначає поведінку, яку користувацькі агенти очікується що будуть реалізовати.
Реалізації, що не підтримують скрипти (або які мають свої скриптові можливості повністю відключеними) є винятком з підтримки подій та DOM інтерфейсів, зазначених в цій специфікації. Для частин цієї специфікації, що визначена в термінах моделі подій, або в термінах DOM, такі користувацькі агенти мають діяти так, якби події та DOM були б підтримані.
Скрипти можуть формувати суттєву частину застосування. Web переглядачі, що не підтримують скрипти, або відключили їх, можуть бути нездатні повністю втілити задуми автора.
Перевірювачі відповідності мусять перевіряти, що документ
відповідає стосовним крітеріям відповідності, визначиним в цій
специфікації. Автоматичні перевірювачі відповідності вільні від
пошуку помилок, що потребує інтерпретацію задуму автора (Наприклад,
коли документ не є відповідним, якщо вміст елемента blockquote
не є цитуванням. Перевірювачі відповідності, що виконуються без
надходження людського рішення, не мають перевіряти, чи елементи blockquote
містять
цитований матеріал).
Перевірювачі відповідності мають перевіряти, що вхідний документ відповідає, коли розбирається без контексту перегляду (що означає, що скрипти не виконуються, та що скриптовий флаг аналізатора відключений), та також мають перевіряти, що вхідний документ відповідає, коли розбирається в контексті переглядання, де скрипти виконуються, та що ці скрипти ніколи не призводять до невідповідних станів, за винятком перехідних станів під час виконання скрипту. (Це вимога тільки з категорії "МАЄ", а не "МУСИТЬ", оскільки вона була перевірена та визнана неможливою. [COMPUTABLE])
Термін "HTML валідатор" може використовуватись для посилання на перевірювач відповідності, що сам відповідає до стосовних до нього вимог цієї специфікації.
XML DTD не може виразити всі вимоги відповідності цієї специфікації. Таким чином, процесор валідації XML та DTD не можуть утворити перевірювач відповідності. Також, оскільки жоден з двох форматів, визначених в цій специфікації, не є застосуваннями SGML, система валідації SGML не може скласти перевірювач відповідності, також.
Щоб висловити це іншим шляхом, є три типи критеріїв відповідності:
Перевірювач відповідності мусить перевіряти перші дві. Простий, базований на DTD, валідатор, перевіряє тільки перший клас помилок, і, таким чином, не відповідає вимогам до перевірювача відповідності, згідно цієї специфікації.
Застосування, що обробляють документи HTML та XHTML з причин, інших, ніж або відтворення документів або перевірка їх на відповідність, повинні діяти в відповідності до семантики документів, що вони обробляють.
Інструмент, що генерує контур документу, але збільшує рівень вкладення для кожного параметра, та не збільшує рівень вкладення для кожного розділу, не буде відповідним.
Інструменти розробки та генератори розмітки мусять генерувати відповідні документи. Критерії відповідності, що стосуються розробників, також стосуються до інструментів розробки, відповідним чином.
До інструментів розробки не застосовується жорстких вимог, щодо використання елементів тільки за їх спеціальним призначенням, але тільки в межах, докі ці інструменти не в змозі визначити наміри автора. Однак інструменти розробки мусять не перекручувати використання елементу автоматично, або заохочувати користувача робити це.
Наприклад, не є відповідним використовувати елемент
address
для
інформації довільного вмісту; цей елемент може бути використаний
тільки для маркування контактної інформації для автора докуента або
розділу. Однак, оскільки інструмент розробки сокріш за все не в
змозі визначити різніцю, для інструменту розробки ця вимога
пом’якшена. Це не означає, однак, що інструмент розробки може
використовувати елементи address
для кожних блоків тексту прописом (наприклад); це означає, що
інструмент розробки не має перевіряти це, коли користувач
використовує інструмент для вставки контактної інформації для
розділу, що користувач дійсно робить це, та не вставляє замість
цього щось інше.
В термінах перевірки на сумісність, редактор має видавати документи, що відповідають то тієї ж міри, до якої перевірювач може перевірити.
Коли інструмент розробки використовуєтсья для редагування невідповідного документу, він може зберегти помилку відповідності в розділах документу, що не редагувалися впродовож сессії редагування (тобто, інструменту редагування дозволяється обходити помилковий вміст). Однак. інструмент розробки не має стверджувати, що вихідний документ є відповідним, коли такі помилки були збережені.
Очікується, що Інструменти розробки будуть надходити у двох варіантах: інструменти, що роблять і даними структури або симантики, та інструменти, що роблять основі залежного від медіа підходу What-You-See-Is-What-You-Get (WYSIWYG).
Перший підхід є преферентним механізмом для інструментів, що продукують HTML, оскільки структура в первинній інформації може бути використана для створення поінформованих виборів, в залежності від того, які HTML елементи та атрибути будуть більш підходящими.
Однак, WYSIWYG інструменти є легітимними. Інструменти WYSIWYG
повинні використовувати елементи, про які відомо, що вони є
доцільними, та не повинні використовувати елементи, про які нема
відомостей, чи є вони доцільними. Це може в деяких виняткових
випадках означати обмеження використання поточних елементів до
тільки декількох, таких як div
,
b
, i
та span
, та робить
вільним уживання атрибуту style
.
Всі інструменти розробки, WYSIWYG або ні, повинні докласти найбільших зусиль, щоб дозволити користувачам створювати гарно структурований, семантично багатий, незалежний від медіа вміст.
Користувацькі агенти можуть накласти залежні
від реалізації обмеження на інакше необмежений ввод, наприклад, для
захисту від атак відказу в обслуговуванні, для захисту від перевитрати
пам’яті або для обходу специфічних для платформи обмежень.
Для сумісності з існуючим вмістом та попередніми специфікаціями, ця специфікація описує два формата розробки: один базується на XML (посилається як синтаксис XHTML), та інший, що використовує власний формат, надихнутий SGML (посилається як синтаксис HTML). Реалізації мають підтримувати хоча б один з ціх двох форматів, хоча підтримка двох заохочується.
Деякі вимоги сумісності викладені як вимоги до елементів, атрибутів, методів або об’єктів. Такі вимоги підпадають у дві категорії: ті, що описують обмеження моделі вмісту, та ті, що описують реалізацію поведінки. Вимоги з першої категорії до документів та інструментів розробки. Вимоги з другої категорії є вимогами до користувацьких агентів. Подібно до цього, вимоги відповідності викладені як вимоги до авторів; такі вимоги мають інтерпретуватися як вимоги відповідності до документу, що продукує автор. (Іншими словами, ця специфікація не робить різниці між критеріями відповіднсоті для авторів, та критеріями відповідності до документу.)
Ця специфікаця покладається на декілька інших підлеглих специфікцій.
Нобір символів Unicode викорстовується для представлення текстуальних даних та стандарт кодування визначає вимоги щодо кодування символів. [UNICODE]
Ця специфікація вводить термінологію, базовану на термінах, визначених в цій специфікації, як зазначено раніше.
Наступні терміни використовуються як визначено в специфікації кодування: [ENCODING]
Декодер UTF-8 відрізняється від алгоритму декодування UTF-8. Останній спочатку відкідає Byte Order Mark (BOM), якщо він є, та потім викликає попереднів.
Алгоритм декодеру може продукувати помилку, на яку посилаються в цій специфікації як на помилку декодера.
Для спрощення сприйняття, кодування символів часом вживаються в цій специфікації з реєстром символів, що відрізняється від канонічного реєстру, наданому в стандарті кодування. (Наприклад, "UTF-16LE" замість "utf-16le".)
Реалізації, що підтримують синтаксис XHTML мусять підтримувати деяку версію XML, також, як і його відповідну специфікацію просторів імен, оскільки цей синтаксис використовує серіалізацію XML з просторами імен. [XML] [XMLNS]
Наступні терміни визначені в стандарті URL: [URL]
URLUtils
href
protocol
URLUtils
URLUtils
URLUtils
URLUtils
URLUtils
URLUtils
Наступні терміни визначені в специфікації Cookie: [COOKIES]
Наступні терміни визначені в специфікації CORS: [CORS]
Блоки IDL в цій специфікації є відповідні IDL фрагменти, як визначено в специфікації WebIDL. [WEBIDL]
Терміни підтримані індекси властивості, визначити значення індексованої властивості, підтримка іменованих властивостей, підтримані іменовані властивості, підтримані імена властивостей, визначення значення іменованої властивості, о’бєкти масиву платформи та тільки для читання (коли стосуєтсья для масивів) використовуються так, як визначено в специфікації Web IDL. Алгоритм для конвертації DOMString в послідовність символів Unicode подібний до того, що використовується в специфікації Web IDL.
Коли ця специфікація вимагає від користувацького агента створити
об’єкт Date
, що представляє окрему дату
(що може бути спеціальним значенням Not-a-Number), компонент
мілісекунд часу, якщо є, мусить бути відсічений до цілого, та
значення часу створеного об’єкту Date
мусить
представляти результат усічення дати.
Наприклад, беручи час 23045 мільйонних секунди
після 01:00 UTC першого січня 2000 року, тобто, час
2000-01-01T00:00:00.023045Z, та потім створюється об’єкт Date
,
що представляє цей час, буде представляти той же час, якби він
представляв час 2000-01-01T00:00:00.023Z, на 45 мільйонних раніше.
Якщо наданий час є NaN, то результатом буде об’єкт Date
,
що представляє значення часу NaN (вказує на те, що об’єкт не
представляє жодний момент часу).
Деякі частини мови, описані в цій специфікації, підтримують тільки JavaScript в якості скриптової мови. [ECMA262]
Термін "JavaScript" використовується для посилання на
ECMA262, скоріше ніж офіціальний термін ECMAScript, оскільки термін
JavaScript більш широко відомий. Подібно, тип
MIME, що використовується для послання на JavaScript в цій
специфікації є text/javascript
,
оскільки це найбільш загально використовуваний тип, не зважаючи на те, що він є офіційно
застарілим типом згідно з RFC 4329. [RFC4329]
Термін глобальне оточення JavaScript посилається на концепцію глобального оточення, визначену в специфікації ECMAScript.
Виключення ECMAScript SyntaxError
також визначено в специфікації ECMAScript. [ECMA262]
Document Object Model (DOM) є представленням — моделью —документу та його вмісту. DOM не є тільки API; крітерії відповідності реалізацій HTML визначені, в цій специфікації, в термінах операцій на DOM. [DOM]
Реалізації мають підтримувати DOM та події, визначені в DOM Events, оскільки ця специфікація визначена в термінах DOM, та деякі з ціх можливостей визначені як розширення до інтерфейсів DOM . [DOM] [DOMEVENTS]
Зокрема, наступні можливості визначені в специфікації DOM: [DOM]
Attr
Comment
DOMImplementation
Document
DocumentFragment
DocumentType
DOMException
ChildNode
Element
Node
NodeList
ProcessingInstruction
Text
HTMLCollection
item()
DOMTokenList
DOMSettableTokenList
createDocument()
createHTMLDocument()
createElement()
createElementNS()
getElementById()
insertBefore()
ownerDocument
childNodes
localName
parentNode
namespaceURI
tagName
id
textContent
Event
EventTarget
EventInit
target
isTrusted
EventTarget
Document
Node
, та концепція кроків клонування, що
використовуються цім алгоритмомMutationObserver
MutationObserver
MutationObserver
Термін постання в цій специфікації
використовується, як визначено в специфікації DOM. Наступні типи DOMException
визначені в DOM
специфікації: [DOM]
IndexSizeError
HierarchyRequestError
WrongDocumentError
InvalidCharacterError
NoModificationAllowedError
NotFoundError
NotSupportedError
InvalidStateError
SyntaxError
InvalidModificationError
NamespaceError
InvalidAccessError
SecurityError
NetworkError
AbortError
URLMismatchError
QuotaExceededError
TimeoutError
InvalidNodeTypeError
DataCloneError
Наприклад, щоб постало виключення TimeoutError
,
користувацький агент має побудувати об’єкт DOMException
,
чий тип був рядком "TimeoutError
"
(та чий код був номером 23, з історічних причин), та насправді
поставити цей об’єкт як виключення.
URL,
асоційований з Document
,
як визначено в специфікації DOM, посилається в цій специфікації як адреса документа.
Наступні можливості визначені в специфікації DOM Events: [DOMEVENTS]
MouseEvent
MouseEventInit
detail
інтерфейсу UIEvent
click
Ця специфікація часом використовує термін ім’я
для посилання на type
події; як в вислові "подія з ім’ям click
"
або "якщо подія називається keypress
".
Терміни "ім’я" та "тип" для подій є синонимами.
Наступні можливості визначені в специфікаціях аналізу та серіалізації: DOM Parsing and Serialization: [DOMPARSING]
innerHTML
outerHTML
Користувацькі агенти також заохочуються реалізувати
можливості, описані в API редагування HTML
та UndoManager
,
а також DOM Transaction specifications. [EDITING]
[UNDO]
Наступні частини специфікації повного екрану посилаються з цієї специфікації, як Fullscreen API, що взаємодіє з можливостями пісочниці в HTML: [FULLSCREEN]
requestFullscreen()
Інтерфейси ArrayBuffer та ArrayBufferView
та підлягаючі концепції зі специфікації типізованих масивів
використовуються для декількох можливостей в цій специфікації.
Інтерфейс типу Uint8ClampedArray
спеціально використовується в визначенні елементу canvas
2D API. [TYPEDARRAY]
Ця специфікація використовує наступні можливості, визначені в специфікації File API: [FILEAPI]
Blob
File
FileList
Blob.close()
Blob.type
Ця специфікація посилаєтсья на специфікацію XMLHttpRequest в деяких ненормативних зауваженнях та прикладах. Наступні можливості та терміни визначені в специфікації XMLHttpRequest: [XHR]
XMLHttpRequest
Ця специфікація посилаєтья на специфікацію подій прогресу для
опису, як дві специфікації взаємодіють, та щоб використати
можливості ProgressEvent
.
Наступні можливості та терміни визначені в специфікації продій
прогресу: [PROGRESS-EVENTS]
ProgressEvent
Наступні терміни визначені в Server-Sent Events: [EVENTSOURCE]
EventSource
Реалізації мають підтримувати мову медіа запитів Media Queries. [MQ]
Тоді як підтримка CSS в цілому не вимагається від реалізацій цієї специфікації (хоча це заохочується, щонайменше для Web переглядачів), деякі можливості визначені в термінах специфічних потреб CSS.
Зокрема, деякі можливості вимагають, щоб рядок був розібраний як значення CSS <color>. При розборі значення CSS, користувацький агент, згідно CSS специфікації, має застосовувати деякі правила обробки помилок. Це стосується також і до цієї специфікації. [CSSCOLOR] [CSS]
Наприклад, користувацький агент має закривати всі
відкриті конструкції, якщо він раптово натрапить на кінець листа
стилів. Таким чином, при аналізі рядка "rgb(0,0,0
"
(з пропущеною закриваючою дужкою) для значення кольору, закриваюча
дужка підпадає під це правило обробки помилок, та значення буде
отримано (колір 'black'). Однак, подібна конструкція "rgb(0,0,
"
(з відсутніми дужками та значенням синього кольору ) не може бути
розібраним, оскільки закриття відкритої конструкції не призводить до
життездатного значення.
Термін ідентифікатор посилання на CSS елемент використовується як визначено в специфікації CSS Image Values and Replaced Content для визначення API, що декларує ідентифікатори для використання з функцією CSS 'element()'. [CSSIMAGES]
Подібно до цього, термін провадить джерело малювання використовується як визначено в специфікації CSS Image Values and Replaced Content для визначення взаємодії окремих елементів HTML з функцією CSS 'element()'. [CSSIMAGES]
Термін розмір об’єкту по замовчанню також визначено в специфікації CSS Image Values and Replaced Content. [CSSIMAGES]
Підтримка для CSS Object Model потрібна для реалізацій, що підтримують скрипти. Наступні можливості та терміни іизначені в специфікації CSSOM: [CSSOM] [CSSOMVIEW]
Screen
LinkStyle
CSSStyleDeclaration
cssText
атрибут CSSStyleDeclaration
StyleSheet
sheet
disabled
Термін отрибут стилюCSS визначений в специфікації CSS Style Attributes. [CSSATTR]
Використання об’єкту CanvasRenderingContext2D
для
шрифтів залежить від можливостей, описаних в специфікаціях CSS Fonts
та Font Load Events, включаючи окремий FontLoader
.
[CSSFONTS] [CSSFONTLOAD]
Наступний інтерфейс визначений в специфікації SVG: [SVG]
SVGMatrix
Наступний інтерфейс визначений в специфікації WebGL: [WEBGL]
WebGLRenderingContext
Реалізації можуть підтримувати WebVTT як формат текстових треків для підзаголовків, заголовків, назв глав, метаданих, таке інше, для медіа ресурсів. [WEBVTT]
Наступні терміни, використані в цій специфікації, визначені в специфікації WebVTT:
Наступні терміни визначені в специфікації протоколу WebSocket: [WSP]
Наступні терміни визначені в Web Workers: [WEBWORKERS]
Worker
Наступні термін ивизначені в 2D Context: [CANVAS2D]
Наступні терміни визначені в Web Messaging: [WEBMSG]
MessagePort
Терміни сильна природна симантика використовується як визначено в специфікації ARIA. Термін неявна ARIA семантика по замовчанню має значення, як і термін неявна WAI-ARIA семантика як вона використовується в специфікації ARIA. [ARIA]
Атрибути role
та aria-*
визначені в специфікації
ARIA. [ARIA]
Специфікація не вимагає підтримки жодного окремого мережевого протоколу, мови листів стилів, скриптових мов, або жодної з DOM специфікацій, за межами того, що вказані як необхідні в вище наведеному переліку. Однак, мова, описана в цій специфікації, має уклін до CSS як мови стилів, JavaScript як скриптової мови, та HTTP як мережевого протоколу, да деякі можливості вважають, що використовуються ці мови та протоколи.
Користувацький агент, що реалізує HTTP протокол, має реалізувати специфікацію Web Origin Concept та також специфікацію HTTP State Management Mechanism (Cookies). [HTTP] [ORIGIN] [COOKIES]
Ця специфікація може мати деякі окремі додаткові вимоги до кодування символів, форматів зображень, аудіо форматів, та відео форматів в відповідних розділах.
Специфічні до постачальника ліцензовані розширення користувацького агента до цієї специфікації сурово знеохочуються. Документи мусять не використовувати такі розширення, бо роблячи це зменьшується взаємодія та фрагментується користувацька база, дозволяючи тільки користувачам окремих користувацьких агентів мати доступ до розглядаємого вмісту.
Якщо такі розширення, тим не менше, потрібні, наприклад, для експеріментальних цілей, тоді постачальники суворо закликаються використовувати тільки наступні механізми розширення:
Для можливостей рівня розмітки, що можуть бути обмежені до серіалізації XML, та не мають підтримуватись в HTML серіалізації, постачальники повинні використовувати механізми просторів імен для визначення власних просторів імен, в яких будуть підтримуватись нестандартні елементи та атрибути.
Для можливостей, що призначені для використання з синтаксисом
HTML, розширення повинні бути обмежені новими атрибутами в
формі "x-vendor-feature
", де vendor
є коротким рядком, що ідентифікує постачальника, що відповідає за
розширення, та feature є ім’ям
можливості. Нові вмена елементів не повинні створюватись.
Використання атрибутів для таких розширень ексклюзивно дозволяють
розширенням від декількох постачальників співіснувати на одному
елементі, що неможливо для елементів. Використання форми "x-vendor-feature
"
дозволяє розширенням бути зробленими без ризику конфлікту з
майбутніми додатками до специфікації.
Наприклад, переглядач з назвою "FerretBrowser" може використовувати "ferret" як префікс постачальника, тоді як переглядач на ім’я "Mellblom Browser" може використовувати "mb". Якщо обоє з ціх переглядачів вводять розширення, що перетворюють елементи в область подряпати-та-понюхати, автор, що експериментує з цими можлисостями, може написати:
<p>This smells of lemons! <span x-ferret-smellovision x-ferret-smellcode="LEM01" x-mb-outputsmell x-mb-smell="lemon juice"></span></p>
Імена атрибутів. що починаються з двох літер "x-
"
зарезервовані для використання користувацькими агентами, та гарантовано
ніколи не будуть формально додані до мови HTML. Для гнучкості, імена
атрибутів, що містять підкреслення (символ U+005F LOW LINE) також
зарезервовані для експеріментаньних цілей, та гарантовано ніколи не
будуть формально додані до мови HTML.
Сторінки, що використовують такі атрибути, по визначенню не є відповідними.
Для DOM розширень, тобто, де є нові методи та атрибути IDL, нові члени повинні мати префікси з спеціфічними до постачальників рядками, щоб запобігти стиканням з майутніми версіями цієї специфікації.
Для подій, експериментальні типи подій повинні мати специфічні до постачальника префікси.
Наприклад, якщо користувацький агент викликав "Pleasold"
щоб додати подію, коли користувач іде догори в ліфті, він має
викоритсовувати префікс "pleasold
",
та таким чином назвати свою подію "pleasoldgoingup
",
можливо
з атрибутом обробника події з назвою "onpleasoldgoingup
".
Всі розширення мусять бути визначені, так що використання розширень не заважатиме, а ні призведе до невідповідності функціональнсоті, визначеної в ції специфікації.
Наприклад, хоча ми дуже знеохочуємо робити це, реалізація "Foo
Browser" може додати новий атрибут IDL "fooTypeTime
"
до DOM інтерфейсу елемента управління, що повертає час, що зайнало в
користувача обрати поточне значення елемента (скажімо). З другого
боку, визначення нового елементу управління, що з’являється в массиві
форми elements
буде порушенням наведеної вище вимоги, оскільки це порушує
визначення elements
,
надане в цій специфікації.
При додаванні нових відзеркальних
IDL атрибутів, що відповідають до атрибутів вмісту в формі "x-vendor-feature
",
атрибут
IDL повинен мати назву "vendorFeature
" (тобто, в імені атрибуту
IDL "x
" відкидається).
Коли потрібні незалежні від постачальника розширення до цієї специфікації, то або ця специфікація має бути відповідно розширеною, або має бути написана специфікація розширення, що перекриє вимоги цієї специфікації. Коли будь-хто застосовує цю специфікацію в своїх діях, доходить визначеності, що вони будуть розпізнавати вимоги такої специфікації розширення, вона стає стосовною специфікацією.
Термінологія відповідності для документів залежить від природи змін, що вводяться такою стосовною специфікацією, та від вмісту, а також цільовою інтерпретацією документу. Стосовна специфікація МОЖЕ визначати новий вміст документу (наприклад, елементу foobar), МОЖЕ забороняти інакше відповідний вміст (наприклад, заборонити використання <table>), або МОЖЕ змінити семантику, DOM відображення, або інші правила обробки для вмісту, визначеному в специфікації. Коли документ не є відповідним документом HTML5, він не залежить від використання стосовних специфікацй: якщо синтаксис та семантика даного відповідного документу HTML5 незмінна при використанні стосовних специфікацій, тоді цей документ залишається відповідним документом HTML5. Якщо семантика або обробка даного (інакше відповідного) документу змінюється при використанні стосовних специфікацій, тоді він перестає бути відповідним документом HTML5. В таких випадках стосовна специфікація МАЄ визначати термінологію відповідності.
Як рекомендована, але не обов’язкова домовленість, така специфікація може визначати термінологію відповідності, наприклад, таким чином: "Документ відповідає HTML5+XXX", де XXX є коротким ім’ям для стосовної специфікації. (Приклад: "Документ, відповідний до HTML5+AutomotiveExtensions").
слідоцтвом з цього правила є те, що окремі коректні документи HTML5 можуть не бути відповідними документами HTML5 в присутності стосовних специфікацій. (Приклад: стосовна специфікація визначає <table> як частину меблів — документ, написаний відповідно до цієї специфікації, що містить елемент <table> НЕ Є відповідним документом HTML5, навіть якщо елемент і є синтаксично коректним HTML5.)
Користувацькі агенти мусть сприймати елементи та атрибути, що вони не розуміють, як семантично нейтральні; залишаючи їх в DOM (для DOM обробників), та стилізуючи їх відповідно до CSS (для CSS обробників), але не надаючи їм ніякого значення.
Коли підтримка можливості відключена (наприклад, відключені заміри небезпеки для попередження про проблему безпеки, або для допомоги в розробці, або з міркувань продуктивності), користувацькі агенти мусять діяти так, якби вони зовсім не мали цієї функції, та так, ніби ця функція зовсім не згадувалась в цій специфікації. Наприклад, якщо окрема функція досяжна через атрибут в інтерфейсі Web IDL, атрибут буде виключений з об’єктів, що реалізують цей інтерфейс — залишити атрибут на об’єкті, але зробити, щоб він повертав null, або викликати виключення, буде недостатньо.
Реалізації XPath 1.0, що оперують з документами
HTML, розібраними або створеними в спосіб, описаний в цій
специфікації (тобто, як частини document.evaluate()
API), мусять діяти так, якби наступне редагування було застосовано до
специфікації XPath 1.0.
Зпершу, виключіть цей параграф:
QName в перевірці вузлів розширюється до expanded-name, з використанням визначень простору імен з контексту виразу. Це розширення такого ж типу, що виконується для імен типів елементів в початкових та завершувальних тегах, за винятком того, що простір імен по замовчанню, визначений за допомогою
xmlns
не використовується: якщо QName не має префіксу, тоді URI префіксу імен є null (таким же чином розширюються імена атрибутів). Буде помилкою, якщо QName має префікс, для якого немає декларації простору імен в контексті виразу.
Замість цього розмістіть наступне:
QName в тексті вузла розширюється в expanded-name з використанням визначень простору імен з контексту виразу. Якщо QName має префікс, тоді мусить бути визначення простору імен для цього префіксу в контексті виразу, та відповідний URI простору імен буде тим, що асоційовано з префіксом. Буде помилкою, якщо QName має префікс, для якого немає декларації простору імен в контексті виразу.
Якщо QName не має префіксу, та тип головного вузлу є елемент, тоді використовується простір імен по замовчанню для елементу. В іншому випадку, якщо QName не має префіксу, URI простору імен є null. Простір імен по замовчанню для елемента є членом контексту для виразу XPath. Значення простору імен по замовчанню для елементу в виразах XPath в DOM3 XPath API визначені наступним чином:
- Якщо вузол контексту походить з HTML DOM, поле імен по замовчанню є "http://www.w3.org/1999/xhtml".
- Інакше, URI поля імен по замовчанню є null.
Це є еквівалентним до додавання простору імен по замовчанню з XPath 2.0 до XPath 1.0, та використання простіру імен HTML як простору імен елементів по замовчанню для документів HTML. Це вмотивовано бажанням мати сумісні реалізації зі старим вмістом HTML, при тому підтримуючи зміни, що ця специфікація вводить до HTML щодо простору імен, що використовується в елементах HTML, та за бажанням використовувати XPath 1.0 замість XPath 2.0.
Це є навмисне порушення специфікації XPath 1.0, вмотивоване бажанням мати реалізації, сумісні з застарілим вмістом, підтримуючи при цьому зміни, що ця специфікація вводить до HTML щодо простору імен, що використовуються в HTML елементах. [XPATH10]
Обробники XSLT 1.0, що виводять в DOM, коли методом виводу є "html" (або явно, або через правила по замовчанню XSLT 1.0) зазнають наступних змін:
Якщо програма трансформації виводить елементи без простору імен, обробним мусить, перед побудовою відповідного вузла елементу DOM, змінити простір імен елементу на простір імен HTML, перевести в нижній реєстр ASCII локальне ім’я елементу, та перевести в нижиній реєстр ASCII імена кожного атрибуту без простору імен елемента.
Ця вимога є навмисне порушення специфікації XSLT 1.0, необхідне, оскільки ця специфікація змінює простори імен та правила залежності від реєстру HTML, таким чином, що інакше буде несумісною з основаних на DOM трансформаціями XSLT. (Процесори, що сералізують виход, не зазнають змін) [XSLT10]
Ця специфікаця не задає точно, як обробка XSLT взаємодіє з
інфраструктурою HTML аналізатора (наприклад,
коли XSLT обробник діє так, якби він клав всі елементи в стек
відкритих елементів). Однак, обробники XSLT мусять зупинити
аналіз, якщо вони успішно завершили, та мусять встановити готовність
поточного документу спочатку до "interactive
", та потім до "complete
", якщо їх було перервано.
Ця специфікація не вказує, як XSLT взаємодіє з алгоритмом навігації, як вона пасує до циклу подій, або як будуть оброблятись сторінки помилок (тобто, чи будуть помилки XSLT заміщати зростаючий вихід XSLT, або будуть відтворюватись в потоці, таке інше).
Є також додаткові, ненормативні коментарі щодо взаємодії
XSLT та HTML в розділі елемента script
,
та щодо XSLT, XPath, та HTML в розділі
елемента template
.
Порівняння рядків з урахуванням реєстру літер означає, що порівняння викорується точно, кодова точка за кодовою точкою.
Порівняння двох рядків в спосіб ASCII-чутливий до реєстру ожначає, що рядки порівнюються точно, кодова точка за кодовою точкою, за винятком символів в диапазоні від U+0041 до U+005A (від LATIN CAPITAL LETTER A до LATIN CAPITAL LETTER Z), та відповідних символів в диапазоні від U+0061 до U+007A (від LATIN SMALL LETTER A до LATIN SMALL LETTER Z) також вважаються співпадаючими.
Порівняння двох рядків в сумісний безреєстровий спосіб означає, що використовується операція сумісного безреєстрового порівняння Unicode для порівняння двох рядків, без специфічних до мови підлаштувань. [UNICODE]
Якщо не вказане інше, порівняння рядків відбувається в з урахуванням реєстру.
Перетворення рядка в реєстр великих літер ASCII означає заміщення всіх символів в диапазоні від U+0061 до U+007A (від LATIN SMALL LETTER A до LATIN SMALL LETTER Z) на відповідні символи з диапазону від U+0041 до U+005A (від LATIN CAPITAL LETTER A до LATIN CAPITAL LETTER Z).
Перетворення рядка в реєстр малих літер ASCII означає заміщення всіх літер в диапазоні від U+0041 до U+005A (від LATIN CAPITAL LETTER A до LATIN CAPITAL LETTER Z) на відповідні символи в диапазоні від U+0061 до U+007A (від LATIN SMALL LETTER A до LATIN SMALL LETTER Z).
Шаблоном рядка є префікс співпадіння для рядка s, де шаблон не довший за s та відсікання s до довжини шаблону утворює два співпадаючі рядки.
Є багато місць в HTML, що сприймають окремі типи даних, такі, як дати та числа. Цей розділ описує крітерії відповідності для вміст ціх форматів, та як ії треба розбирати.
Реалізатори суворо попереджаються щодо уважної перевірки любих сторонніх бібліотек, що вони можуть вирішити застосовувати для розбору наведених нижче синтаксисів. Наприклад, бібліотеки дат вірогідно реалізують обробку помилок, що відрізняється від того, що вимагається в цій специфікації. Поведінка обробки помилок часто не визначена в специфікаціях, що описують синтаксиси дат, подібних до тих, що описані в цій специфікації. Таким чином, реалізації мають схильність значно відрізнятись в тому, як вони обробляють помилки.
Символи-проміжки, для цілей цієї специфікації, є U+0020 SPACE, "tab" (U+0009), "LF" (U+000A), "FF" (U+000C), та "CR" (U+000D).
Символи White_Space
є ті, що мають властивість Unicode "White_Space" в файлі даних Unicode PropList.txt
. [UNICODE]
Це не треба плутати зі значенням "White_Space" (скорочено
"WS") у властивості "Bidi_Class" в файлі даних Unicode Unicode.txt
.
Управляючі символи є ті, для яких
властивість Unicode "General_Category" має значення "Cc" в файлі
даних Unicode UnicodeData.txt
. [UNICODE]
Букви великого реєстру ASCII є символи в диапазоні великих літер ASCII.
Букви малого реєстру ASCII є символи в диапазоні малих літер ASCII.
Цифри ASCII є символи в диапазоні цифер ASCII.
Букво-цифрові символи ASCII є ті, що є або буквами великого реєстру ASCII, малого реєстру ASCII, або цифрами ASCII.
Шістнадцятирічні цифри ASCII є символи в диапазоні цифер ASCII, U+0041 LATIN CAPITAL LETTER A до U+0046 LATIN CAPITAL LETTER F, та U+0061 LATIN SMALL LETTER A до U+0066 LATIN SMALL LETTER F.
Шіснадцятирічні цифри ASCII великого реєстру є символи в диапазоні цифер ASCII та від U+0041 LATIN CAPITAL LETTER A до U+0046 LATIN CAPITAL LETTER F.
Шіснадцятирічні цифри ASCII малого реєстру є символи в диапазоні цифер ASCII та від U+0061 LATIN SMALL LETTER A до U+0066 LATIN SMALL LETTER F.
Деякі з мікро-парсерів, описаних нижче, слідують шаблону мати змінну input, що утримує рядок, що буде розібраний, та мати змінну position, що вказує на наступний символ, що буде розібраний в input.
Для персерів, що базуються на цьому шаблоні, крок, що потребує від користувацького агенту зібрати послідовність символів означає, що наступний алгоритм мусить бути виконаний, та characters буде встановлено в набір символів, що будуть зібрані:
Нехай input та position будуть тіми ж змінними, як з такими ж іменами в алгоритмі, що викликає ці кроки.
Нехай result буде пустим рядком.
Доки position не вказує на місце за кінцем input та символ під position є один з characters, додайте цей символ в кінець result та просуньте position на наступний символ в input.
Повернути result.
Цей крок пропускає проміжки, маючи на увазі, що користувацький агент мусить збирати послідовність символів що є символами проміжків. Зібрані символи не використовуються.
Коли користувацький агент відкидає переводи рядків з тексту, користувацький агент мусить видалити всі символи "LF" (U+000A) та "CR" (U+000D) з цього рядка.
Коли користувацьки агент відкидає передуючі та слідуючі проміжки з рядка, Користувацький агент мусить видалити всі символи проміжків, що на початку та в кінці рядка.
Коли користувацький агент відкидає та зжимає проміжки в рядку, він мусить замінити всі послідовності з одного або декількох символів проміжку в рядку на один символ U+0020 SPACE, та потім відкинути передуючі та слудуючі проміжки з рядка.
Коли користувацький агент має жорстко розбити рядок по окремому обмежувальному символу delimiter, він мусить використовувати наступний алгоритм:
Нехай input буде рядком, який ми розбираємо.
Нехай position буде вказівник в input, з початку вказуючий на початок рядка.
Нехай tokens буде впорядкованим списком токенів, спочатку пустим.
Доки position не знаходиться за кінцем input:
Збирати послідовність символів, що не є символом delimiter.
Додати зібраний на попередньому кроці рядок до tokens.
Просунути position на наступний символ в input.
Повернути tokens.
Для окремих випадків розділення рядка проміжками та комами, цей алгоритм не застосовується (ці алгоритми також виконують відкидання проміжків).
Декілька атрибутів є логічними (boolean) атрибутами. Присутність логічних атрибутів на елементі представляє значення true, та відсутність атрибуту представляє значення false.
Якщо атрибут присутній, його значення мусить бути або пустим рядком, або значення, що чутливим до реєстру чином співпадає з канонічним ім'ям атрибуту, без передуючих або слідуючих проміжків.
Значення "true" та "false" не дозволяються в логічних атрибутах. Щоб представити знчення false, атрибут повинен бути повністю відсутнім.
Ось приклад перемикача, що ввімкнений та заблокований. Атрибути checked
та disabled
є логічними атрибутами.
<label><input type=checkbox checked name=cheese disabled> Cheese</label>
Це може бути еквівалентно записане так:
<label><input type=checkbox checked=checked name=cheese disabled=disabled> Cheese</label>
Ви також можете змішувати стилі; наступне також еквівалентне:
<label><input type='checkbox' checked name=cheese disabled=""> Cheese</label>
Деякі атрибути визначені таким чином, що сприймають один з обмеженого набору ключових слів. Такі атрибути називаються атрибутами-переліками. Ключові слова визначається так, що кожне відповідає деякому стану (декілька ключових слів можуть відображатись на той же стан, і в цьому випадку ці ключові слова є синонімами одне одному; додатково, деякі з ключових слів можуть бути проголошені як невідповідні, та знаходяться в специфікії тільки з історичних причин). На додаток. два стани по замовчанню можуть бути надані. Перший це замовчання для невірного значення, другий це замовчання для відсутнього значення.
Якщо вказані атрибути-переліки, значення атрибуту мусить в чутливому до реєстру стилі співпадати з одним з ключових слів, що не проголошені невідповідними, без оточуючих проміжків.
Коли заданий атрибут, якщо значення в чутливому до реєстру стилі співпадає з наданим ключовим словом, тоді стан ключового слова є стан атрибуту, що представляє атрибут. Якщо значення атрибуту не співпадає з жодниз м наданих ключових слів, але атрибут має замовчання для невірного значення, тоді атрибут представляє цей стан. Інакше, якщо якщо втрибут не співпадає з жодним з ключових слів, але визначене замовчання для відсутнього значення, тоді це буде станом атрибуту. Інакше, якщо немає зомовчань, недійсні значення означають, що стан не представлений.
Коли атрибут не заданий, якщо визначене замовчання для відсутнього знчення, тоді це буде стан для (відсутнього) атрибуту. Інакше, відсутність атрибуту означає, що стан не представлений.
Пустий рядок може бути дійсним ключовим словом.
Рядок є дійсніме ціле, якщо він містить одну або більше цифру ASCII, опціонально з префіксом в вигляді символа "-" (U+002D).
Допустиме ціле без префіксу "-" (U+002D) представляє число, що представлене по основі десять цією послідовністю цифр. Допустиме ціле з префіксом "-" (U+002D) представляє число по основі десять, що є рядок цифр, які слідують за U+002D HYPHEN-MINUS, відняті від нуля.
Правила для розбору цілих надані в наступному алгоритмі. Коли викликається, він повинен слідувати наданому порядку, перериваючись на першому кроці, що повертає результат. Цей алгоритм повертає або ціле, або помилку.
Нехай input буде рядком, що ми розбираємо.
Нехай position буде вказівником в input, що спочатку вказує на початок рядка.
Нехай sign має значення "позитивне".
Якщо position після кінця input, повертаємо помилку.
Якщо символ, на який вказує на position (перший символ) є символ "-" (U+002D):
Інакше, якщо символ, на який вказує position (перший символ) є символ "+" (U+002B):
+
" ігнорується, але це
не є відповідним).Якщо символ, на який вказує position не є цифрою ASCII, повернути помилку.
Зібрти колекцію символів, що є цифрами ASCII, та інтерретувати останочну послідовність як ціле по базі десять. Нехай value буде цім цілим.
Якщо ign є "позитивним", повернути value, інакше повернути результат віднімання value від нуля.
Рядок є дійсним не-негативним цілим, якщо вона складається з однієї або більше цифр ASCII.
Допустиме не-негативні цілі представляють число, що представлене по базі десять цім рядком.
Правила для розбору не-негативних цілих надані в наступному алгоритмі. Коли викликається, кроки повинні слідувати в наданому порядку, завершуюсь на першому кроці, що повертає значення. ЦЦей алгоритм повертає або нуль, або позитивне ціле, або помилку.
Нехай input буде рядком, що розбирається.
Нехай value буде результатом розбору input з використанням правил для розбору цілих.
Якщо value є помилкою, повернути помилку.
Якщо value меньше нуля, повернути помилку.
Повернути значення value.
Рядок є дійсним числом з плаваючою крапкою, якщо він складається з:
Допустиме число з плаваючою крапкою представляє число, отримане від множення значущої частини на ступінь експоненти, де значуще є перша частина, інтерпретована по базі десять (включає десятичну крапку, та число після цієї десятичної крапки, якщо вона є, та інтерпретуючи значуще як негативне (від'ємне) число, якщо весь рядок починається з символу "-" (U+002D), та число не є нулем), та де експонента є числом після E, якщо є (інтерпретується як негативне число, якщо символ "-" (U+002D) знаходиться між E та числом, та число не є нуль, або інакше ігноруючи символ "+" (U+002B) між E та числом, якщо такий трапиться). Якщо немає E, тоді експонента розцінюється як рівна нулю.
Значення Infinity (безкінечність) ти Not-a-Number (NaN, не число) не є дійсними числами з плаваючою крапкою.
Найкраще представлення числа n як числа з плаваючою крапкою є рядок, отриманий від застосування оператора JavaScript ToString до n. Оператор JavaScript ToString не є унікально визначеним. Коли є декілька можливих рядків, що можуть бути отримані від JavaScript оператора ToString для окремого значення, користувацький агент мусить завжди повертати той же рядок для цього значення (хоча він може відрізнятись від значення, що використовують інші користувацькі агенти).
Правила для розбору значень з плаваючою крапкою надані в наступному алгоритмі. Цей алгоритм мусить припинятись на першому ж кроці, що повертає будь-що. Цей алгоритм буде повертати або число, або помилку.
Нехай input буде рядком, що буде розібраний.
Нехай position буде вказівником в input, з початку вказуючим на початок рядка.
Нехай value має значення 1.
Нехай divisor має значення 1.
Нехай exponent має значення 1.
Якщо position після кінця input, повертаємо помилку.
Якщо символ, на який вказує position є символ U+002D HYPHEN-MINUS (-):
Інакше, якщо символ, на який вказує position (перший символ) є символ "+" (U+002B):
+
" ігнорується, але це
не відповідно).Якщо символ, на який вказує position є "." (U+002E), та це не останній символ в input, та символ після того, на який вказує position є цифра ASCII, тоді встановити value в нуль, та перейти на крок, помічений як fraction.
Якщо символ, на який вказує position не є цифрою ASCII, повернути помилку.
Зібрати послідовність символів що є цифрами ASCII, та інтерпретувати отриману послідовність як ціле по основі десять. Помножити value на це ціле.
Fraction: Якщо символ, на який вказує positionє "." (U+002E), виконайте ці кроки:
Просуньте position на наступний символ.
Якщо position після кінця input, або символ, на який вказує position не є цифрою ASCII, "e" (U+0065), або "E" (U+0045), перестрибніть на крок, помічений conversion.
Якщо символ, на який вказує position є символ "e" (U+0065) або символ "E" (U+0045), пропустіть остаток ціх субкроків.
Fraction loop: перемножте divisorна десять .
Просуньте position на наступний символ.
Якщо position після кінця input, перестрибніть до кроку з назвою conversion.
Якщо символ, на який вказує position є цифра ASCII, перестрибніть назад до кроку, поміченого як fraction loop в ціх субкроках.
Якщо символ, на який вказує position ж символ "e" (U+0065) або "E" (U+0045), виконайте ці субкроки:
Просуньте position на наступний символ.
Якщо position після кінця input, перестрибніть не крок, помічений як conversion.
Якщо симол, на який вказує positionє символ "-" (U+002D):
Якщо position після кінця input, перестрибніть на крок з ім'ям conversion.
Інакше, якщо символ, на який вказує positio, є символом "+" (U+002B):
Якщо position після кінця input, перестрибніть крок, помічений як conversion.
Якщо символ, на який вказує positionне є цифрою ASCII, тоді перестрибніть на крок, помічений як conversion.
Зберіть послідовніть символів що є цифрами ASCII, та інтерпретуйте отриману послідовність як ціле по основі десять. Помножте exponent на це ціле.
Помножте value на десять, піднесене в ступінь exponent.
Conversion: Нехай S буде набором зі значень подвійної точності з плаваючою крапкою IEEE 754, за винятком −0, але з двома спеціальними значеннями: 21024 та −21024.
Нехай rounded-value буде число S, що найближче до value, обираючи число з парним значущим, якщо є два рівно віддалених значення. (Два спеціальних значення, 21024 та −21024 були визнані як парні значущі для ціх цілей).
Якщо rounded-value є 21024 or −21024, повернути помилку.
Повернути rounded-value.
Правила для розбору значень розмірностей надаються в наступному алгоритмі. Коли викликаються, кроки мусять слідувати в заданому порядку, перериваючись на першому кроці, що повертає значення. Цей алгоритм буде повертати або число, більше або рівне до 1.0, або помилку; якщо повертається число, тоді воно в подальшому квалівікується як відсоток або довжина.
Нехай input буде рядком, що буде розібраний.
Нехай position буде вказівником в input, що спочатку вказує на початок рядка.
Якщо position за кінцем input, повернути помилку.
Якщо символ, на який вказує position є символом U+002B PLUS SIGN character (+), просунути positionдо наступного символа .
Зібрати колекцію символів "0" (U+0030), та відкинути їх.
Якщо position після кінця input, повернути помилку.
Якщо символ, на який вказує position не є від "1" (U+0031) до "9" (U+0039), повернути помилку.
Зібрати колекцію символів що є цифрами ASCII, та інтерпретувати отриману послідовність як ціле на базі десять. Нехай value буде числом.
Якщо position після кінця input, повернути valueяк довжину .
Якщо символ, на який вказує position є символом U+002E FULL STOP character (.):
Просуньте position до наступного символа.
Якщо position після кінця input, or якщо символ, на який вказує position не є цифрою ASCII, тоді повертається valueяк довжина .
Нехай divisor має значення 1.
Fraction loop: Помножимо divisor на десять .
Просуньте position до наступного символа.
Якщо position після кінця input, повернути valueяк довжину .
Якщо символ, на який вказує position is an ASCII digit, return to the step labeled fraction loop in these substeps.
Якщо position після кінця input, повернути valueяк довжину .
Якщо символ, на який вказує position є символ "%" (U+0025), повернути valueяк відсотки .
Повернути value як довжину.
Дійсний список цілих є декілька дійснімих цілих, розділених символами U+002C COMMA, що не мають інших символів (зокрема, символів проміжку). На додаток, може існувати обмеження на число цілих, що можуть бути надані, або диапазон можливих значень.
Правила для розбору списку цілих наступні:
Нехай input буде рядком, що буде розібраний.
Нехай position буде вказівником в input, що спочатку вказує на початок рядка.
Нехай numbers буде напочатку пустим списком цілих. Цей список буде результатом алгоритму.
Якщо є символ в рядку inputв позиції position, та це або a U+0020 SPACE, U+002C COMMA, або символа U+003B SEMICOLON, тоді просунути position до наступного символа в input, або за кінець рядка, якщо більше немає символів.
Якщо position вказує за кінцем input, повернути numbers та завершитись .
Якщо символ в рядку input в позициї position є символом U+0020 SPACE, U+002C COMMA, або U+003B SEMICOLON, тоді повернутись на крок 4.
Нехай negated буде false.
Нехай value буде 0.
Нехай started буде false. Ця змінна встановлена в true, коли парсер бачить цифру або символ "-" (U+002D).
Нехай got number буде false. Ця змінна встановлена в true, коли парсер бачить цифру.
Нехай finished буде false. Ця змінна встановлена в true, щоб перемикнути парсер в режим, коли він ігнорує символи до наступного роздільника.
Нехай bogus буде false.
Розберітьr: Якщо символ в рядку input в позициї position є:
Слідувати цім крокам:
Слідувати цім субкрокам:
Слідувати цім субкрокам:
1,2,x,4
".Слідувати цім субкрокам:
Слідувати цім субкрокам:
Просуньте position до наступного символа в input, або за межі рядка, якщо немає більше символів.
Якщо position вказує на символ (та не є за кінцем input), перестрибніть до великого кроку Розберітьr вище.
Якщо negated є true, змінити значення value.
Якщо got number є true, додати value до списку numbers.
Повернути список numbers та завершитись.
Правила для розбору списку вимірів наступні. Ці правила повертають список з нуля або більше пар, що складаються з числа та одиниці виміру, де вимір може бути відсоток, відносне або абсолютне.
Нехай raw input буде рядком, що буде розібраний.
Якщо останній символ в raw input є символ a "," (U+002C), тоді видалити цей символ з raw input.
Розділити рядок raw input по комах. Нехай raw tokens буде результуючим списком токенів.
Нехай result буде пустим списком чисел/пар одиниць.
Для кожного токену в raw tokens, виконайте наступні кроки:
Нехай input буде токен.
Нехай position буде вказівником в input, що спочатку вказує на початок рядка.
Нехай value буде числом 0.
Нехай unit буде absolute.
Якщо position після кінця input, встановити unit на relative та перейти на останній субкрок.
Якщо символ в позиції position є цифра ASCII, зберіть послідовність символів що є цифрами ASCII, інтерпретуючи отриману послідовність як ціле по основі десять, та збільшіть value на це ціле.
Якщо символ в позиції position є символом "." (U+002E), виконайте ці субкроки:
Зібрати колекцію символів, що складається з символів проміжків та цифр ASCII. Нехай s буде результуючою послідовністю.
Видаліть всі символи проміжків в s.
Якщо s не є пустим рядком, виконайте ці субкроки:
Нехай length буде числом символів в s (після видалення проміжків).
Нехай fraction буде результатом інтерпретації s як ціле по основі десять, та потім ділення цього числа на 10length.
Збільшіть value на fraction.
Якщо символ в позиції символ в позиції position є символ "%" (U+0025), тоді встановіть unit в percentage.
Інакше, якщо символ символ в позиції position є символом U+002A ASTERISK (*), тоді вмтановіть unit в relative.
Додати елемент до result , що складаєтсья з отриманого значення value та одиниці виміру, заданому unit.
Повернути result.
В алгоритмі нижче, число днів в місяці month року year є: 31 якщо month є 1, 3, 5, 7, 8, 10, або 12; 30, якщо monthє 4, 6, 9, або 11; 29, якщо month є 2, та year є числом, що ділиться без залишку на 400, або якщо year є числом, що ділиться на 4, але не на 100; інакше 28. Це приймає до уваги високосні роки грегоріанського календаря. [GREGORIAN]
Коли цифри ASCII використовуються в синтаксисі дат та часу, визначеному в цьому розділі. ці числа виражені по основі десять.
Хоча формати, визначені тут, призначені бути підмножиною відповідних форматів ISO8601, цей розділ визначає правила розбору в більших деталях, ніж ISO8601. Таким чином, реалізатори заохочуються уважно дослідити любі біблиотеки розбору дат, перед використанням їх для реалізації правил розбору, описаних нижче; бібліотеки ISO8601 можуть не розбирати дати та час саме таким же чином. [ISO8601]
Ця специфікація посилається на пролептичний грегоріанский календар, що означає сучасний грегоріанський календар, зворотньо екстрапольований до року 1. Дата в пропевтичному грегоріанському календарі, на яку іноді явно посилаються як на пролептично-грегоріанську дату, така, що описується з використанням календаря, навіть якщо календар не використовувався в той час (або в тому місці) коли це відбувається. [GREGORIAN]
Використання грегоріанського календаря в цій специфікації,
як календаря передачі по дроту, є довільним вибором, базованим на
культурному підгрунті тих, хто приймав участь в ухвалі рішення. Дивіться
також розділ, що дискутує формати дати,
часу, та чисел в формах (для авторів), зауваження
щодо реалізації локалізації елементів форм, та елемент time
.
Місяць складється зі спеціфічної пролептично-грегеріанської дати без інформації про часовий пояс та без інформації про дату, окрім року та місяця. [GREGORIAN]
Рядок є дійсним рядокм місяця, що представляє рік year та місяць month , якщо він складаєтсья з наступних компонент в такому порядку:
Правила розбору рядка місяця наступні. Це буде повертати або рік та місяць, або нічого. Якщо в деякій точці плгоритм визнає "невдача", це означатиме, що він перервався в цій точці, та нічого не повернув.
Нехай input буде рядком, що буде розібраний.
Нехай position буде вказівником в input, що спочатку вказує на початок рядка.
Розберіть компонент місяця для отримання year та month. Якщо це нічого не поверне, тоді це невдача.
Якщо position не є за кінцем input, тоді це невдача.
Повернути year та month.
Правила для розбору компоненту місяця, беручи рядок input та position, наступні, . Це повертатиме або рік та місяць, або нічого. Якщо в жоднів точці алгоритму він зазнає "невдачі", це означатиме, що він перервав виконання та нічого не повертає.
Зібрати колекцію символів, що є цифрами ASCII. Якщо зібрана колекція не є щонайменш чотири символи довжиною, тоді це невдача. Інакше інтерпретувати результуючу послідовність як ціле по основі десять. Нехай це число буде year.
Якщо year не є числом, більше нуля, то це невдача.
Якщо position за кінцем input, або символ в позиції position не є символ U+002D HYPHEN-MINUS, то це невдача. Інакше, перемістити position вперед на один символ.
Зібрати колекцію символів, що є цифрами ASCII. Якщо зібрана колекція не є точно два символа довжиною, тоді це невдача. Інакше інтерпретувати результуючу послідовність як ціле по основі десять. Нехай це число буде month.
Якщо month не є в диапазоні 1 ≤ month ≤ 12, тоді це невдача.
Повернути year та month.
Дата складає специфічну пролептично-грегоріанську дату без інформації про часову зону, що складоється з року. місяця та дня. [GREGORIAN]
Рядок є дійсним рядком дати, що представляє рік year, місяць month, та день day , якщо вона складається з наступних компонент в такому порядку:
Правила для розбору рядка дати наступні. Це буде повертати або дату, або нічого. Якщо в деякій точці алгоритму від зазнає "невдачі", це означає, що він переривається та не повертає нічого.
Нехай input буде рядком, що буде розібраний.
Нехай position буде вказівником в input, що спочатку вказує на початок рядка.
Розберіть компоненти дати для отримання year, month,та day. Якщо це нічого не повертає, тоді це невдача.
Якщо position не після кінця input, тоді це невдача.
Нехай date буде дата, де рік year, місяць month, та день day.
Повернути date.
Правила для розбору компонент дати, беручи рядок input та positionнаступні. Це буде повертати рік, місяць, та день, або нічого. Якщо в любій точці алгоритм зазнає "невдачі", це означає, що він переривається, та не повертає нічого.
Розібрати компонент місяця для отримання year та month. Якщо це нічого не повертає, то це невдача.
Нехай maxday буде числом днів в місяці month року year.
Якщо position за межами кінця input, або якщо символ в позиції position не є символом U+002D HYPHEN-MINUS, це невдача. Інакше, пересунути positionвперед на один символ.
Зібрати колекцію символів, що є цифрами ASCII. Якщо зібрана колекція не є точно два символи довжиною, це невдача. Інакше інтерпретувати отриману послідовність як ціле по основі десять. Нехай це число буде day.
Якщо day не є числом в диапазоні 1 ≤ day ≤ maxday.
Повертає year, month, та day.
Дата без року складається з григоріанського місяця та дня місяця, але без асоційованого року. [GREGORIAN]
Рядок є дійсним рядком дати без року, що представляє місяць monthта день day, якщо він складається з наступних компонент в такому порядку:
Іншими словами, якщо month
є "02
", що означає лютий, тоді день може
бути 29, так, якби рік був високосним.
Правила для розбору рядка дати без року наступні. Це буде повертати або місяць та день, або нічого. Якщо в деякій точці алгоритм зазнає "збою", це означає, що від переривається, та не повертає нічого.
Нехай input буде рядком, що буде розібраний.
Нехай position буде вказівником в input, що спочатку вказує на початок рядка.
Розібрати компонент дати без року щоб отримати month та day. Якщо це нічого не повертає, тоді це невдача.
Якщо position не є за кінцем input, тоді це невдача.
Повернути month та day.
Правила для розбору компоненти дати без року, беручи рядок input та position, наступні. Це буде повертати або місяць та день, або нічого. Якщо в любій точці алгоритм зазнає "збою", це означає, що він перериваєтся в цій точці, та не повертає нічого.
Зібрати колекцію символів що є символами "-" (U+002D). Якщо зібрана колекція не є точно нуль або два символи довжиною, це є невдача.
Зібрати колекцію символів , що є цифрами ASCII. Якщо зібрана колекція не є точно два символи довжиною, це невдача. Інакше, інтерпретувати отриману послідовність як ціле по основі десять. Нехай це число буде month.
Якщо month не є число між 1 ≤ month ≤ 12, це невдача.
Нехай maxday буде число днів в місяці month любого довільного високосного року (такого як 4 або 2000).
Якщо position за кінцем input або символ в позиції position не є символом U+002D HYPHEN-MINUS, це невдача. Інакше пересунути positionвперед на один символ .
Зібрати колекцію символів, що є цифрами ASCII. Якщо зібрана колекція не є точно два символа довжиною, тоді це невдача. Інакше інтерпретувати отримати зібрану послідовність як ціле по основі десять. Нехай ц число буде day.
Якщо day не є число в диапазоні 1 ≤ day ≤ maxday, тоді це невдача.
Повернути month та day.
Час складається з певного часу без інформації щодо часового поясу, що складаєтсья з годин, хвилин, секунд, та долей секунди.
Рядок є дійсним рядком часу, що представляє години hour, хвилини minute, та секунди second , якщо він складається з наступних компонент в даному порядку:
Компонент second не може бути 60 або 61; високосні секунди не можуть бути представлені.
Правила розбору рядка часу наступні. Це буде повертати або час, або нічого. Якщо в деякій точці алгоритм дає "невдача", це означає, що він перериваєтсья, та не повертає нічого.
Нехай input буде рядком, що буде розібраний.
Нехай position буде вказівником в input, що спочатку вказує на початок рядка.
Розібрати компонент часу для отримання hour, minute та second. Якщо це не повертає нічого, тоді це невдача.
Якщо position не за межами кінця input, тоді невдача.
Нехай time буде час, з годинами hour, хвилинами minute, та секундами second.
Повернути time.
Правила розбору компоненту часу, беручи рядок input та position, наступні. Це буде повертати або години, хвилини та секунди, або нічого. Якщо в деякій точці алгоритм зазнає "невдачі", це означає, що він перериваєтсья в цій точці, та нічого не повертає.
Зібрати колекцію символів що є цифрами ASCII. Якщо зібрана послідовність не є точно довжиною два символи, тоді це невдача. Інакше інтерпретувати отриману послідовність як ціле по основі десять. Нехай це число буде hour.
Якщо position за кінцем input , або символ в позиції position не є символом U+003A COLON, тоді це невдача. Інакше рухати position вперед на один символ.
Зібрати колекцію символів що є цифрами ASCII. Якщо зібрана послідовність не є точно два символи довжиною, тоді це невдача. Інакше інтерпретувати отриману послідовність як ціле по основі десять. Нехай це число буде minute.
Нехай second буде рядком зі значенням "0".
Якщо position не за кінцем input та символ в позиції position є символом U+003A COLON, тоді виконайте ці субкроки:
Просуньте position до наступного символа в input.
Якщо position за кінцем input, або на останньому символі в input, або наступні два символи в input, починаючи з position не є обоє цифрами ASCII, тоді це невдача.
Зібрати колекцію символів що є або цифрами ASCII, або символами U+002E FULL STOP. Якщо зібрана послідовність довжиною три символи, або якщо вона довша, ніж три символи, та третій символ не символ U+002E FULL STOP, або вона має більше ніж один символ U+002E FULL STOP, тоді це невдача. Інакше нехай отриманий рядок буде second, замість попереднього значення.
Інтерпретувати second як число по основі десять (можливо з дробною частиною). Нехай second буде числом, замість вигляду рядка.
Якщо second не є числом в диапазоні 0 ≤ second < 60, тоді це невдача.
Повернути hour, minute та second.
Плаваючі дата та час складають специфічну пролептичну грегоріанську дату, що складається з року, місяця, дня, та часу, що складається з годин, хвилин, секунд, та долей секунд, вле виражені без часового поясу. [GREGORIAN]
Рядок є дійсним рядокм дати та часу, що представляє дату та час, якщо він складається з наступних компонент в зазначеному порядку:
Рядок є дійсним нормалізованим рядком дати та часу, що представляє дату та час, якщо він складається з наступних компонент в наданому порядку:
Правила розбору рядка плаваючої дати та часу наступні. Це буде повертати дату та час, або нічого. Якщо в деякій точці алгоритм зазнає "невдачі", це означає, що він переривається в цій точці, та не повертає нічого.
Нехай input буде рядком, що буде розібраний.
Нехай position буде вказівником в input, що спочатку вказує на початок рядка.
Розберіть компонент дати щоб отримати year, month та day. Якщо це нічого не повертає, тоді це невдача.
Якщо position за кінцем input або символ в позиції position не є ні символом U+0054 LATIN CAPITAL LETTER T (T) ні символом U+0020 SPACE, тоді це невдача. Інакше переміщуємо position вперед на один символ.
Розберіть a time component щоб отримати hour, minute та second. Якщо це нічого не повертає, тоді це невдача.
Якщо position не за кінцем input, тоді це невдача.
Нехай date буде дата з роком year, місяцем month та днем day.
Нехай time буде час з годинами hour, хвилинами minute та секундами second.
Повернути date та time.
Зміщення часового поясу складається зі знакового числа годин та хвилин.
Рядок є дійсним рядком зміщення часового поясу, що представляє зміщення часового поясу, якщо він складається з наступного:
Символ "Z" (U+005A), дозволений тільки в випадку, коли часовий пояс є UTC
Однієї з наступних компонент, у вказаному порядку:
Цей формат дозволяє зміщення часового поясу від -23:59 до +23:59. На практиці, однак, наразі диапазон зміщень існуючих часових поясів від -12:00 до +14:00, та компонент хвилин в існуючих часових поясах завжди 00, 30 або 45. Немає гарантії, що це буде тривати завжди; часові пояси змінюються країнами за бажанням, та не слідують стантарту.
Дивіться також приклади в розділі глобальні дата та час нижче, щодо деталей використання зміщень часових поясів, що передує формуванню формальних часових зон.
Правила розбору рядків зміщень часових поясів наступні. Це буде повертати або зміщення часового поясу, або нічого. Якщо в деякій точці алгоритм зазнає "невдачі", це означає, що він переривається в цій точці, та не повертає нічого.
Нехай input буде рядком, що буде розібраний.
Нехай position буде вказівником в input, що спочатку вказує на початок рядка.
Розберіть a time-zone offset component щоб отримати timezonehours and timezoneminutes. Якщо це нічого не повертає, тоді це невдача.
Якщо position не за кінцем input, тоді це невдача.
Повернути зміщення часового поясу що є timezonehours годин та timezoneminutes хвилин від UTC.
Правила розбору компоненти зміщенная часового поясу, беручи рядок input та position, наступні. Це буде повертати ходини часового поясу, та хвилини часового поясу, або нічого. Якщо в деякій точці алгоритм зазнає "невдачі", це означає, що він переривається в цій точці, та не повертає нічого.
Якщо символ в позиції position є символом U+005A LATIN CAPITAL LETTER Z (Z), тоді:
Нехай timezonehours буде 0.
Нехай timezoneminutes буде 0.
Просуньте position до наступного символа в input.
Інакше, якщо символ в позиції position або "+" (U+002B) або "-" (U+002D), тоді:
Якщо символ в позиції position є "+" (U+002B), встановити sign як "позитивне". Інакше це "-" (U+002D); встановити sign в "негативне".
Просуньте position до наступного символа в input.
Зібрати колекцію символів що є цифрами ASCII. Нехай s be зібрана послідовність.
Якщо s є рівно два символи довжини, тоді виконайте ці субкроки:
Інтерпретувати s як ціле по основі десять. Нехай це число буде timezonehours.
Якщо position за кінцем input, або якщо символ в позиції position не є символом U+003A COLON, тоді це невдача. Інакше пересунути positionвперед на один символ .
Зібрати колекцію символів що є цифрами ASCII. Якщо зібрана послідовність не є точно two characters long, тоді це невдача. Інакше інтерпретувати отриману послідовність як ціле по основі десять. Нехай це число буде timezoneminutes.
Якщо s є точно чотири символи довжини, тоді виконайте ці субкроки:
Інтерпретувати перші два символи s як ціле по основі десять. Нехай це число буде timezonehours.
Інтерпретувати останні два символи s як ціле по основі десять. Нехай це число буде timezoneminutes.
Інакше це невдача.
Інакше це невдача.
Повернутиtimezonehours and timezoneminutes.
Глобальна дата та час складає специфічну пролептичну грегоріанську дату, що складається з року, місяця та дня, та дати, що складається з годин, хвилин, секунд, та частин секунд, що виражені зі зміщенням часового поясу, що складається зі знакового цілого годин та хвилин. [GREGORIAN]
Рядок є дійсним рядком дати та часу, що представляють дату, час та зміщення часового поясу, якщо він складається з наступних компонент в такому порядку:
Час та дати перед формуванням UTC в середині дванадцятого сторіччя мають бути виражені та інтерпретовані в терміних UT1 (сучасний сонячний час на довжині 0°), не UTC (апроксимація UT1, з тіками за SI секунд). Час перед формуванням часових поясів мусить бути інтерпретований як час UT1, я явними часовими поясами, що апроксимують сучасну різницю між приблизним локальним часом, та часом, що наблюдається в Гринвічі, Лондон.
Наступне є деякими прикладами дат, записаних як дійсні рядки глобальних дати та часу.
0037-12-13 00:00Z
"1979-10-14T12:00:00.001-04:00
"8592-01-01T02:09+02:09
"Треба зауважити деякі речі щодо ціх дат:
T
" замінене проміжком, це має
бути поодинокий символ проміжку. Рядок "2001-12-21 12:00Z
"
(з двома проміжками між компонентами) не повинен розбиратись успішно.Зміщення не є повною специфікацією часового поясу. При роботі з дійсними значеннями дати та часу, виділіть окреме поле для часового поясу, можливо, згідно з часових поясів IANA. [TIMEZONES]
Рядок є дійсним рядком нормалізованого приведеного до UTC глобальної дати та часу, що представляє дату, час та зміщення часовох зони, як він складається з наступних компонент у вказаному порядку:
Правила розбору рядка глобаьлної дати та часу наступні. Це буде повертати час UTC, з асоційованою інформацією зміщення часового поясу, для обходу або цілей відобреження, або нічого. Якщо в деякій точці алгоритм зазнає "невдачі", це означає, що він переривається в цій точці, та не повертає нічого.
Нехай input буде рядком, що буде розібраний.
Нехай position буде вказівником в input, що спочатку вказує на початок рядка.
Розберіть компонент дати, щоб отримати year, month та day. Якщо це нічого не повертає, тоді це невдача.
Якщо position за кінцем input або символ в позиції position не символ U+0054 LATIN CAPITAL LETTER T (T), ні символ U+0020 SPACE, тоді це невдача. Інакше пересунути position вперед на один символ.
Розберіть компонент часу щоб отримати hour, minute та second. Якщо це нічого не повертає, тоді це невдача.
Якщо position за кінцем input, тоді це невдача.
Розберіть компонент зміщення часового поясу, щоб отримати timezonehours та timezoneminutes. Якщо це нічого не повертає, тоді це невдача.
Якщо position не за кінцем input, тоді це невдача.
Нехай time буде моментом часу в році year, місяці month, дні day, годині hour, хвилині minute, секунді second, віднімаючи години timezonehours та хвилини timezoneminutes. Цей момент в часі є моментом в часовому поясі UTC.
Нехай timezone буде timezonehours годин та timezoneminutes хвилин від UTC.
Повернутиtime та timezone.
Тиждень складає номер тижня в році, та число місяця, який представляє семиденний період, що починається в понеділок. Кожний тиждень в цій календарній системі, як 52 або 53, є такими семиденними періодами, як зазначено нижче. Семиденний період, що починається на грегоріанській даті в понеділок 29 грудня 1969 року (1969-12-29) визначений як тиждень номер 1 серед тижнів року 1970. Наступні тижні занумеровані послідовно. Тиждень перед числом першого тижня є останнім тижнем попереднього року, і навпаки. [GREGORIAN]
Рік тижнів з номером year має 53 тижні, якщо він відповідає або року year в пролептичному грегоріанському календарі , що має вівторок своїм першим днем (1 січня), або рік year в пролептичному грегоріанському календарі, що має середу своїм першим днем (1 січня), та де year є числом, що ділиться на 400, або число, що ділиться на 4, але не на 100. Всі інші роки мають 52 тижня.
Номер тижня останнього дня в тижнє-році, що має 53 тижня є 53; номер тижня останнього дня тижнє-року, що має 52 тижня, є 52.
Число тижнє-року окремого дня може бути іншим, ніж число року, що містить цей день в пролептичному грегоріанському календарі. Перший тиждень в тежнє-році y є тижнем, що містить перший вівторок в грегоріанському році y.
Для сучасних цілей, тиждень був визначений тут як еквівалентний то тижнів ISO, як визначено в ISO 8601. [ISO8601]
Рядок є дійсним рядком тижня, що представляє тижнє-рік year та тиждень week, якщо він складається з наступних компонентів в наданому порядку:
Правила розбору строки тижня наступні. Це буде повертати номер тижнє-рока, або нічого. Якщо в деякій точці алгоритм зазнає "невдачі", це означає, що він переривається в цій точці, та не повертає нічого.
Нехай input буде рядком, що буде розібраний.
Нехай position буде вказівником в input, що спочатку вказує на початок рядка.
Зібрати колекцію символів що є цифрами ASCII. Якщо зібрана послідовність не є щонайменьше чотири символи довжиною, тоді це невдача. Інакше інтерпретувати отриману послідовність як ціле по основі десять. Нехай це число буде year.
Якщо year не є число, більше за нуль, тоді це невдача.
Якщо position за кінцем input, або якщо символ в позиції position не є символом U+002D HYPHEN-MINUS, тоді це невдача. Інакше перемістити позицію вперед на один символ.
Якщо position за кінцем input або символ в позиції position не є символом "W" (U+0057), тоді це невдача. Інакше перемістити position вперед на один символ.
Зібрати колекцію символів що є цифрами ASCII. Якщо зібрана послідовність не є точно довжиною два символа, тоді це невдача. Інакше інтерпретувати отриману послідовність як ціле по основі десять. Нехай це число буде week.
Нехай maxweek буде номер тижня останнього дня року year.
Якщо week не є числом в диапазоні 1 ≤ week ≤ maxweek, тоді це невдача.
Якщо position не за кінцем input, тоді це невдача.
Повернути число тижнє-року year та номер тижня week.
Тривалість складається з числа секунд .
Оскільки місяці та секунди не сумісні (місяць не є точним числом секунд, але замість цього період, чия точна довжина залежить від точного дня, від якого ведеться відлік), тирвалість, як вона визначена в специфікації, не може включати місяці (або роки, що еквівалентні до дванадцяти місяців). Можуть бути описані тільки тривалості, що описують число секунд.
Рядок є дійсним рядком тривалості представляє тривалість t, якщо він складається з чогось з наступного:
Літерального символу U+0050 LATIN CAPITAL LETTER P, за яким один або більше субкомпонент, в наданому порядку, де число днів, часів, минут та секунд відповідає того ж числа секунд, що і t:
Однієї або більше цифр ASCII, за яким слідує символ U+0044 LATIN CAPITAL LETTER D, що представляє число днів.
Сивол U+0054 LATIN CAPITAL LETTER T, за яким слідує один або більше субкомпонент, в наданому порядку:
Одна або більше цифра ASCII, за якими слідує символ U+0048 LATIN CAPITAL LETTER H, що представляє число годин.
Одна або більше цифра ASCII, за якими слідує символ U+004D LATIN CAPITAL LETTER M, що представляє число хвилин.
Наступні компоненти:
Одна або більше цифра ASCII, що представляє число секунд.
Опціонально символ "." (U+002E), за яким слідує одна, дві або три цифри ASCII, що представляють дрібну частину секунд.
Символ U+0053 LATIN CAPITAL LETTER S.
Це, як і з декількома дата- та час-пов'язаними мікросинтаксами, визначеними в цій специфікації, базується на одному з форматів, визначених в ISO 8601. [ISO8601]
Одна або більше з компонент тривалості часу, кожний з різним маштабом компонента тривалості часу, в любому порядку; сума представлених секунд буде рівною з числом секунд в t.
Компонент тривалості часу є рядком, що складається з наступних компонент:
Нуль або більше символів проміжків.
Однієї або більше цифр ASCII, що представляють число одиниць виміру, маштабоване вказаним маштабом компонента тривалості часу (дивіться нижче), щоб представити число секунд.
Якщо маштаб компонента тривалості часу вказаний як 1 (тобто одиниці - секунди), тоді, опціонально, символ "." (U+002E), за яким слідує одна, дві або три цифри ASCII, що представлють частки секунди.
Нуль або більше проміжних символів.
Один або більше слідуючих символів, що представлють маштаб компонента тривалості часу одиниці виміру часу, що використовуютсья в числовій частині компонента тривалості часу:
Нуль або більше проміжних символів.
Це не базується на жодному з форматів в ISO 8601. Це призначено бути краще для читання людиною, ніж формат тривалості ISO 8601.
Правила розбору рядка тривалості наступні. Це буде повертати або тривалість, або нічого. Якщо в деякій точці алгоритм зазнає "невдачі", це означає, що він переривається в цій точці, та не повертає нічого.
Нехай input буде рядком, що буде розібраний.
Нехай position буде вказівником в input, що спочатку вказує на початок рядка.
Нехай months, seconds та component count всі дорівнюють нулю.
Нехай M-disambiguator буде minutes.
Інше значення цього флагу є місяці. Він використовується для однозначного трактування одиниць виміру "M" в травалості ISO8601, що використовує ті ж одиниці для місяців та хвилин. Місяці не дозволені, але розбираються для майбутньої сумісності та запобігання невірній інтерпретації тривалостей ISO8601, що можуть бути дійсними в інших контекстах.
Якщо position після кінця input, тоді це невдача.
Якщо символ в input, на який вказує position є символом U+0050 LATIN CAPITAL LETTER P, тоді просунути position до наступного символа, встановити M-disambiguator в months та пропустити проміжки.
Виконати наступні субкроки в циклі, доки крок, що потребує новий цикл, буде зруйнований, або весь алгоритм не зазнає невдачі:
Нехай units будуть невизначеним. Йому буде присвоєне одне з наступних значень: years, months, weeks, days, hours, minutes та seconds.
Нехай next character буде невизначеним. Це використовуєтсья для обробки символів з input.
Якщо position після кінця input, розірвати цикл.
Якщо символ в input, на який вказує position, є символом U+0054 LATIN CAPITAL LETTER T, тоді просунути position до наступного символа, встановити M-disambiguatorв minutes, пропустити проміжки та повернутись до початку циклу.
Встановити ext character в символ в input , на який вказує position.
Якщо next character є символ "." (U+002E), тоді N дорівнює нулю. (Не просувати position. Про це потурбуємось нижче).
Інакше, якщо next character є цифрою ASCII, then збирати послідовність символів що є цифрами ASCII, інтерпретувати отриману послідовність як ціле по основі десять та встановити N в це число.
Інакше, next character не є частиною числа; тоді це невдача.
Якщо position після кінця input, тоді це невдача.
Встановити next character в символ в input, на який вказує position та цього разу просунути position до наступного символа. (Якщо next character був символом U+002E FULL STOP character (.) до цього, він буде все ще цім символом цього разу).
Якщо next character є символом "." (U+002E), тоді виконайте ці субкроки:
Зібрати колекцію символів що є цифрами ASCII. Нехай s буде отриманою послідоавнстю.
Якщо s є пустим рядокм, тоді це невдача.
Нехай length буде числом символів в s.
Нехай fraction буде результатом інтерпретації s як цілого по основі десять та потім поділеного на 10length.
Збільшимо N на fraction.
Якщо position після кінця input, тоді це невдача.
Встановити next character в символ в input , на який вказує position, та просунемо position до наступного символа.
Якщо next character не символ U+0053 LATIN CAPITAL LETTER S, ні символ U+0073 LATIN SMALL LETTER S, тоді це невдача.
Встановити units в seconds.
Інакше виконати ці підкроки:
Якщо next character є символом проміжку, тоді пропустити проміжки, встановити next character в символ в input, на який вказує position та просунути position до наступного символа.
Якщо next character є символом U+0059 LATIN CAPITAL LETTER Y, або символом U+0079 LATIN SMALL LETTER Y, встановити units в years та встановити M-disambiguator в months.
Якщо next character є символом U+004D LATIN CAPITAL LETTER M або символом U+006D LATIN SMALL LETTER M, та M-disambiguator є months, встановити units в months.
Якщо next character є символом U+0057 LATIN CAPITAL LETTER W або символом U+0077 LATIN SMALL LETTER W, встановити units в weeks та встановити M-disambiguator в minutes.
Якщо next character є символом U+0044 LATIN CAPITAL LETTER D або символом U+0064 LATIN SMALL LETTER D, встановити units в days та встановити M-disambiguator в minutes.
Якщо next character є символом U+0048 LATIN CAPITAL LETTER H або символом U+0068 LATIN SMALL LETTER H, встановити units в hours та встановити M-disambiguatorв minutes.
Якщо next character є символом U+004D LATIN CAPITAL LETTER M або символом U+006D LATIN SMALL LETTER M, та M-disambiguator є minutes, встановити units в minutes.
Якщо next character є символом U+0053 LATIN CAPITAL LETTER S або символом U+0073 LATIN SMALL LETTER S, встановити units в seconds та встановити M-disambiguator в minutes.
Інакше, якщо next character нічого з символів вище, тоді це невдача.
Збільшити component count.
Нехай multiplier буде 1.
Якщо units є years, помножити multiplier на 12 та встановити units в months.
Якщо units є months, додати продукт N та multiplierдо months.
Інакше виконати ці підкроки:
Якщо units є weeks, помножити multiplier на 7 та встановити units в days.
Якщо units є days, помножити multiplier на 24 та встановити units в hours.
Якщо units is hours, помножити multiplier на 60 та встановити units в minutes.
Якщо units is minutes, помножити multiplier на 60 та встановити units в seconds.
Примусово, units is now seconds. Add the product of N and multiplier в seconds.
Якщо component count я нуль, це є невдача.
Якщо months не є нуль, це є невдача.
Повернути тривалість, що складається з seconds секунд.
Рядок є дійсним рядком дати з опціональим часом, якщо він також одне з наступного:
Правила розбору рядка дати та часу наступні. Алгоритм буде повертати дату, час, глобальні дату та час, або нічого. Якщо в деякій точці алгоритм зазнає "невдачі", це означає, що він переривається в цій точці, та не повертає нічого.
Нехай input буде рядком, що буде розібраний.
Нехай position буде вказівником в input, що спочатку вказує на початок рядка.
Встановити start position в ту ж позицію, що і position.
Встановити флаги date present та time present в true.
Розберіть компонент дати, щоб отримати year, month та day. Якщо це зазнає невдачі, встановити флагdate present в false.
Якщо date present є true, position не за кінцем input, та символ в позиції position є або символ "T" (U+0054) або символ U+0020 SPACE, тоді просуньте position до наступного символа в input.
Інакше, якщо date present є true, або position за кінцем input, або символ в позиції position не є символ "T" (U+0054), ні символ U+0020 SPACE, тоді встановити time present в false.
Інакше, якщо date present є false, встановити position назад на ту ж позицію, що і start position.
Якщо флаг time present є true, тоді розберіть компонент часу щоб отримати hour, minute та second. Якщо це нічого не повертає, тоді це невдача.
Якщо флаги date present та time present обоє є true, але position за кінцем input, тоді це невдача.
Якщо флаги date present та time present обоє є true, розберіть компонент зміщення часового поясу, щоб отримати timezonehours та timezoneminutes. Якщо це нічого не повертає, тоді це невдача.
Якщо position не за кінцем input, тоді це невдача.
Якщо флаг date present flag є true, та флаг time present є false, тоді нехай date буде датою з роком year, місяцем month та днем day, та повертаємо date.
Інакше, якщо флаг time present є true, та флаг date present є false, тоді нехай time буде часом, з годинами hour, хвилинами minute, та секундамиsecond, та повертаємо time.
Інакше, нехай time буде моментом часу, де рік year, місяць month, день day, години hour, хвилини minute, секунди second, віднімаючи timezonehours годин та timezoneminutes хвилин, цей момент в часі буде моментом в часовому поясі UTC; нехай timezone буде timezonehours годин, та timezoneminutes хвилинами від UTC; та повертаємо time та timezone.
Простий колір складається з трьох 8-бітних чисел в диапазоні 0..255, що представляють червоний, зелений та синій компоненти кольора, відповідно, в кольоровому просторі sRGB. [SRGB]
Рядок є дійсним простим кольором, якщо він точно сім символів довжиною, та перший символ є символ "#" (U+0023) та ініші шість символів всі є шістнадцятеричними символами ASCII, з першими двома цифрами, що представляють червоний компонент, середні два цифри представляють зелений компонент, та останні дві цифри представляють синій компонент, в шестнадцятеричній формі.
Рядок є дійсним простим кольором в нижньому реєстрі, якщо він є дійсним простим кольором та не використовує жодних символів з диапазону від U+0041 LATIN CAPITAL LETTER A до U+0046 LATIN CAPITAL LETTER F.
Правила дял розбору значень простих кольорів надані в наступному алгоритмі. Коли викликаються, кроки мусять слідувати в заданому порядку, перериваючись на першому кроці, що повертає значення. Цей алгоритм буде повертати або простий колів, або помилку.
Нехай input буде рядком, що буде розібраний.
Якщо input не є точно сім символів довжиною, повернути помилку.
Якщо перший символ в input не є символом U+0023 NUMBER SIGN (#), повернути помилку.
Якщо останні шість символів в input не є всі шістнадцятирічними цифрами ASCII, повернути помилку.
Нехай result буде простий колір.
Інтерпретувати другий та третій символи як шестнадцятеричне число, та надати результат красній компоненті result.
Інтерпретувати четвертий та п'ятий символи як шестнадцятеричне число, та надати результат зеленій компоненті result.
Інтерпретувати шостий та сьомий символи як шестнадцятеричне число, та надати результат синій компоненті result.
Повернутиresult.
Правила для серіалізації простих значень кольору, беручи простий колір, такі, як надані в наступному алгоритмі:
Нехай result буде рядок, що складається з одного символу "#" (U+0023).
Конвертувати червоний, зелений та синій компоненти в дозначні шістнадцятирічні числа, використовуючи шістнадцятирічні символи нижнього реєстру ASCII, вирівнюючи нулями, в разі необхідності, та додати ці числа до result, в порядку червоний, зелений, синій.
Повернутиresult, що буде дійсним простим кольлором в нижньому реєстрі.
Деякі застарілі унаслідувані атрибути розбирають колір в більш складний спосіб, використовуючи правила для розбору унаслідуваних значень кольору, що надаються в наступному алгоритмі. Коли викликаються, кроки мусять слідувати в заданому порядку, перериваючись на першому кроці, що повертає значення. Алгоритм буде повертати або простий колір або помилку.
Нехай input буде рядком, що буде розібраний.
Якщо input пустий рядок, повернути помилку.
Якщо input є ASCII
чутливо до реєстру співпадає з рядком "transparent
",
повернути помилку.
Якщо input є ASCII чутливо до реєстру співпадає з одним з ключових слів, перелічених в розділі ключові слова кольорів SVG з специфікації кольорів CSS3, тоді повернути простий колір, що відповідє ключовому слову. [CSSCOLOR]
Система кольорів CSS2 System Colors не розпознається.
Якщо input є чотири символи довжиною, та перший символ є символом "#" (U+0023), та інші три символи input всі є шестнадцятеричними символами ASCII, тоді виконайте ці субкроки:
Нехай result буде простий колір.
Інтерпретувати другий символ input як шестнадцятеричний символ; нехай червоний компонент result буде отримане число, помножене на 17.
Інтерпретувати третій символ input як шестнадцятеричний символ; нехай зелений компонент result буде отримане число, помножене на 17.
Інтерпретувати четвертий символ input як шестнадцятеричний символ; нехай синій компонент result буде отримане число, помножене на 17.
Повернутиresult.
Замінити всі символи в input, що
мають кодову крапку Unicode бульше ніж U+FFFF (тобто любі символи,
що не є на базовому багатомовному плані) на дво-символьний рядок "00
".
Якщо input довше ніж 128 символів, усікти input, залишаючи тільки перші 128 символів.
Якщо перший символ input є символ "#" (U+0023), видалити його.
Замінити либий символ в input, що не є шістнадцятиричним символом ASCII на символ "0" (U+0030).
Коли довжина input ноль, або не кратна трьом, додати символ "0" (U+0030) до input.
Розділити input на три рядка рівної довжини, щоб отримати три компоненти. Нехай length буде довжиною ціх компонент (одна третина довжини input).
Якщо length більше ніж 8, тоді видаліть передуючі length-8 символів в кожній компоненті, та зробіть lengthрівним 8.
Коли length більше ніж два, та перший символ в кожній компоненті є символ "0" (U+0030), видаліть цей символ, та зменьшіть length на один.
Якщо length все ще більше ніж два, усічіть кожний компонент, залишивши тільки два перші символи з кожної.
Нехай result буде простий колір.
Інтерпретувати перший компонент як шестнадцятеричне число; нехай червоний компонент result буде отримане число.
Інтерпретувати другий компонент як шестнадцятеричне число; нехай зелений компонент result буде отримане число.
Інтерпретувати третій компонент як шестнадцятеричне число; нехай синій компонент result буде отримане число.
Повернутиresult.
A set of space-separated tokens is a string containing zero or more words (known as tokens) separated by one or more space characters, where words consist of any string of one or more characters, none of which are space characters.
A string containing a set of space-separated tokens may have leading or trailing space characters.
An unordered set of unique space-separated tokens is a set of space-separated tokens where none of the tokens are duplicated.
An ordered set of unique space-separated tokens is a set of space-separated tokens where none of the tokens are duplicated but where the order of the tokens is meaningful.
Sets of space-separated tokens sometimes have a defined set of allowed values. When a set of allowed values is defined, the tokens must all be from that list of allowed values; other values are non-conforming. Якщо no such set of allowed values is provided, then all values are conforming.
How tokens in a set of space-separated tokens are to be compared (e.g. case-sensitively or not) is defined on a per-set basis.
When a user agent has to split a string on spaces, it must use the following algorithm:
Нехай input буде рядком, що буде розібраний.
Нехай position буде вказівником в input, що спочатку вказує на початок рядка.
Нехай tokens be an ordered list of tokens, initially empty.
While position is not past the end of input:
Зібрати колекцію символів що є not space characters.
Append the string collected in the previous step to tokens.
Повернутиtokens.
A set of comma-separated tokens is a string containing zero or more tokens each separated from the next by a single "," (U+002C) character, where tokens consist of any string of zero or more characters, neither beginning nor ending with space characters, nor containing any "," (U+002C) characters та optionally surrounded by space characters.
For instance, the string " a,b,,d d
"
consists of four tokens: "a", "b", the empty string та "d d". Leading
and trailing whitespace around each token doesn't count as part of the
token та the empty string can be a token.
Sets of comma-separated tokens sometimes have further restrictions on what consists a valid token. When such restrictions are defined, the tokens must all fit within those restrictions; other values are non-conforming. Якщо no such restrictions are specified, then all values are conforming.
When a user agent has to split a string on commas, it must use the following algorithm:
Нехай input буде рядком, що буде розібраний.
Нехай position буде вказівником в input, що спочатку вказує на початок рядка.
Нехай tokens be an ordered list of tokens, initially empty.
Token: Якщо position після кінця input, jump to the last step.
Зібрати колекцію символів що є not "," (U+002C) characters. Нехай s be the resulting sequence (which might be the empty string).
Append s to tokens.
Якщо position is not past the end of input, then the character в позициї is a "," (U+002C) character; advance position past that character.
Jump back to the step labeled token.
Повернутиtokens.
A valid hash-name reference to
an element of type type is a string
consisting of a "#" (U+0023) character followed by a string which exactly
matches the value of the name
attribute
of an element with type type in the
document.
The rules for parsing a hash-name reference to an element of type type наступні:
Якщо the string, що буде розібраний does not contain a U+0023 NUMBER SIGN character, or if the first such character в рядку is the last character в рядку, then return null and abort these steps.
Нехай s буде рядком from the character immediately after the first U+0023 NUMBER SIGN character в рядку, що буде розібраний up to the end of that string.
Повернути first element of type type
that has an id
attribute whose value is a case-sensitive
match for s or a name
attribute whose value is a compatibility
caseless match for s.
A string is a valid media query if it
matches the media_query_list
production
of the Media Queries specification. [MQ]
A string matches the environment of the user if it is the empty string, a string consisting of only space characters, or is a media query that matches the user's environment according to the definitions given in the Media Queries specification. [MQ]
A URL is a valid URL if it conforms to the authoring conformance requirements in the URL standard. [URL]
A string is a valid non-empty URL if it is a valid URL but it is not the empty string.
A string is a valid URL potentially surrounded by spaces if, after stripping leading and trailing whitespace from it, it is a valid URL.
A string is a valid non-empty URL potentially surrounded by spaces if, after stripping leading and trailing whitespace from it, it is a valid non-empty URL.
This specification defines the URL about:legacy-compat
as a reserved, though unresolvable, about:
URL, for use in DOCTYPEs
in HTML documents when needed for
compatibility with XML tools. [ABOUT]
This specification defines the URL about:srcdoc
as a reserved, though unresolvable, about:
URL, that is used as the document's
address of iframe
srcdoc
documents.
[ABOUT]
The fallback base URL of a Document
object is the absolute URL obtained by
running these substeps:
Якщо the Document
is an
iframe
srcdoc
document, then return the document
base URL of the Document
's
browsing context's browsing
context container's Document
and abort these steps.
Якщо the document's address
is about:blank
та the Document
's browsing
context has a creator
browsing context, then return the document
base URL of the creator Document
та abort these steps.
Повернути document's address.
The document base URL of a Document
object is the absolute URL obtained by
running these substeps:
Якщо there is no base
element that has an href
attribute in the Document
, then
the document base URL is the Document
's fallback
base URL; abort these steps.
Інакше the document base URL is the
frozen base URL of the first base
element in the Document
that has an href
attribute, in tree
order.
Resolving a URL is the process of taking a relative URL and obtaining the absolute URL that it implies.
To resolve a URL to an absolute URL relative to either another absolute URL or an element, the user agent must use the following steps. Resolving a URL can result in an error, in which case the URL is not resolvable.
Нехай url be the URL being resolved.
Нехай encoding be determined as follows:
Document
та
the URL character encoding is the document's
character encoding.Якщо encoding is a UTF-16 encoding, then change the value of encoding to UTF-8.
Якщо the algorithm was invoked with an absolute URL to use as the base URL, let base be that absolute URL.
Інакше let base be the element's base URL.
Apply the URL parser to url, with base as the base URL, with encoding as the encoding.
Якщо this returns failure, then abort these steps with an error.
Нехай parsed URL be the result of the URL parser.
Нехай serialized URL be the result of apply the URL serializer to parsed URL.
Повернутиserialized URL as the resulting absolute URL and parsed URL as the resulting parsed URL.
Given an element, the element's base
URL is the base URI of the element, as defined by the
XML Base specification, with the base URI of the document entity
being defined as the document base URL
of the Document
that owns the
element. [XMLBASE]
For the purposes of the XML Base specification, user agents must act as
if all Document
objects
represented XML documents.
It is possible for xml:base
attributes to be present even in HTML fragments, as such attributes can
be added dynamically using script. (Such scripts would not be
conforming, however, as xml:base
attributes are not allowed in HTML documents.)
When an xml:base
attribute is set, changed, or removed, the attribute's element та all
descendant elements, are affected
by a base URL change.
When a document's document base URL changes, all elements in that document are affected by a base URL change.
The following are base URL change steps, which run when an element is affected by a base URL change (as defined by the DOM specification):
Якщо the absolute URL identified by
the hyperlink is being shown to the user, or if any data derived
from that URL is affecting the display, then the href
attribute should be
re-resolved relative to the element and the
UI updated appropriately.
For example, the CSS :link
/:visited
pseudo-classes
might have been affected.
q
,
blockquote
, ins
, or del
element with a cite
attributeЯкщо the absolute URL identified by
the cite
attribute is being shown
to the user, or if any data derived from that URL is affecting the
display, then the URL should be re-resolved relative to the element and
the UI updated appropriately.
The element is not directly affected.
For instance, changing the base URL doesn't affect
the image displayed by img
elements, although subsequent accesses of the src
IDL attribute from script
will return a new absolute URL that
might no longer correspond to the image being shown.
User agents can implement a variety of transfer protocols, but this specification mostly defines behavior in terms of HTTP. [HTTP]
The HTTP GET method is equivalent to the default retrieval action of the protocol. For example, RETR in FTP. Such actions are idempotent and safe, in HTTP terms.
The HTTP response codes are equivalent to statuses in other protocols that have the same basic meanings. For example, a "file not found" error is equivalent to a 404 code, a server error is equivalent to a 5xx code та so on.
The HTTP headers are equivalent to fields in other protocols that have the same basic meaning. For example, the HTTP authentication headers are equivalent to the authentication aspects of the FTP protocol.
A referrer source is either a Document
or a URL.
When a user agent is to fetch a resource or URL, optionally from an origin origin, optionally using a specific referrer source as an override referrer source та optionally with any of a synchronous flag, a manual redirect flag, a force same-origin flag та a block cookies flag, the following steps must be run. (When a URL is to be fetched, the URL identifies a resource to be obtained.)
Якщо there is a specific override referrer source та it is a URL, then let referrer be the override referrer source та jump to the step labeled clean referrer.
Нехай document be the appropriate Document
as given by the following
list:
Document
.While document is an
iframe
srcdoc
document, let document be document's browsing
context's browsing
context container's Document
instead.
Якщо the origin of Document is not a scheme/host/port tuple, then set referrer to the empty string and jump to the step labeled clean referrer.
Нехай referrer be the document's address of document.
Clean referrer: Apply the URL parser to referrer and let parsed referrer be the resulting parsed URL.
Нехай referrer be the result of applying the URL serializer to parsed referrer, with the exclude fragment flag set.
Якщо referrer is not the empty
string, is not a data:
URL
та is not the URL "about:blank
",
then generate the address of the resource from which
Request-URIs are obtained as required by HTTP for the Referer
(sic) header from referrer. [HTTP]
Інакше the Referer
(sic) header must be omitted, regardless of its value.
Якщо the algorithm was not invoked with the synchronous flag, perform the remaining steps asynchronously.
Якщо the Document
with which
any tasks
queued
by this algorithm would be associated doesn't have an associated browsing context, then abort these
steps.
This is the main step.
Якщо the resource is to be obtained from an application cache, then use the data from that application cache, as if it had been obtained in the manner appropriate given its URL.
Якщо the resource is identified by an absolute
URL та the resource is to be obtained using an idempotent
action (such as an HTTP GET or equivalent) та it is
already being downloaded for other reasons (e.g. another invocation
of this algorithm) та this request would be identical to the
previous one (e.g. same Accept
and Origin
headers) та
the user agent is configured such that it is to reuse the data from
the existing download instead of initiating a new one, then use the
results of the existing download instead of starting a new one.
Інакше if the resource is identified by an absolute
URL with a scheme that does not define a mechanism щоб
отримати the resource (e.g. it is a mailto:
URL) or that the user agent does not support, then act as if the
resource was an HTTP 204 No Content response with no other metadata.
Інакше if the resource is identified by the URL about:blank
, then the resource
is immediately available and consists of the empty string, with no
metadata.
Інакше at a time convenient to the user and the user agent,
download (or otherwise obtain) the resource, applying the semantics
of the relevant specifications (e.g. performing an HTTP GET or POST
operation, or reading the file from disk, or expanding data:
URLs,
etc).
For the purposes of the Referer
(sic) header, use the address of the resource from which
Request-URIs are obtained generated in the earlier step.
For the purposes of the Origin
header, if the fetching
algorithm was explicitly initiated from an origin,
then the origin that initiated the HTTP
request is origin. Інакше this is
a request from a "privacy-sensitive" context.
[ORIGIN]
Якщо the algorithm was not invoked with the block cookies flag та there are cookies to be set, then the user agent must run the following substeps:
Wait until ownership of the storage mutex can be taken by this instance of the fetching algorithm.
Take ownership of the storage mutex.
Update the cookies. [COOKIES]
Release the storage mutex so that it is once again free.
Якщо the fetched resource is an HTTP redirect or equivalent, then:
Abort these steps and return failure from this algorithm, as if the remote host could not be contacted.
Continue, using the fetched resource (the redirect) as the result of the algorithm. Якщо the calling algorithm subsequently requires the user agent to transparently follow the redirect, then the user agent must resume this algorithm from the main step, but using the target of the redirect as the resource to fetch, rather than the original resource.
First, apply any relevant requirements for redirects (such as
showing any appropriate prompts). Then, redo main step,
but using the target of the redirect as the resource to fetch,
rather than the original resource. For HTTP requests, the new
request must include the same headers as the original request,
except for headers for which other requirements are specified
(such as the Host
header). [HTTP]
The HTTP specification requires that 301, 302 та 307 redirects, when applied to methods other than the safe methods, not be followed without user confirmation. That would be an appropriate prompt for the purposes of the requirement in the paragraph above. [HTTP]
Якщо the algorithm was not invoked with the synchronous flag: When the resource is available, or if there is an error of some description, queue a task that uses the resource as appropriate. Якщо the resource can be processed incrementally, as, for instance, with a progressively interlaced JPEG or an HTML file, additional tasks may be queued to process the data as it is downloaded. The task source for these tasks is the networking task source.
Інакше return the resource or error information to the calling algorithm.
Якщо the user agent can determine the actual length of the resource
being fetched for an
instance of this algorithm та if that length is finite, then that length
is the file's size.
Інакше the subject of the algorithm (that is, the resource being
fetched) has no known size.
(For example, the HTTP Content-Length
header might provide this information.)
The user agent must also keep track of the number of bytes downloaded for each instance of this algorithm. This number must exclude any out-of-band metadata, such as HTTP headers.
The application cache processing model introduces some changes to the networking model to handle the returning of cached resources.
The navigation processing model handles redirects itself, overriding the redirection handling that would be done by the fetching algorithm.
Whether the type sniffing rules apply to the fetched resource depends on the algorithm that invokes the rules — they are not always applicable.
Anything in this specification that refers to HTTP also applies to
HTTP-over-TLS, as represented by URLs
representing the https
scheme. [HTTP]
User agents should report certificate errors to the user and must either refuse to download resources sent with erroneous certificates or must act as if such resources were in fact served with no encryption.
User agents should warn the user that there is a potential problem whenever the user visits a page that the user has previously visited, if the page uses less secure encryption on the second visit.
Not doing so can result in users not noticing man-in-the-middle attacks.
Якщо a user connects to a server with a self-signed certificate, the user agent could allow the connection but just act as if there had been no encryption. Якщо the user agent instead allowed the user to override the problem and then displayed the page as if it was fully and safely encrypted, the user could be easily tricked into accepting man-in-the-middle connections.
Якщо a user connects to a server with full encryption, but the page then refers to an external resource that has an expired certificate, then the user agent will act as if the resource was unavailable, possibly also reporting the problem to the user. Якщо the user agent instead allowed the resource to be used, then an attacker could just look for "secure" sites that used resources from a different host and only apply man-in-the-middle attacks to that host, for example taking over scripts in the page.
Якщо a user bookmarks a site that uses a CA-signed certificate та then later revisits that site directly but the site has started using a self-signed certificate, the user agent could warn the user that a man-in-the-middle attack is likely underway, instead of simply acting as if the page was not encrypted.
The Content-Type metadata of a resource must be obtained and interpreted in a manner consistent with the requirements of the MIME Sniffing specification. [MIMESNIFF]
The sniffed type of a resource must be found in a manner consistent with the requirements given in the MIME Sniffing specification for finding the sniffed media type of the relevant sequence of octets. [MIMESNIFF]
The rules for sniffing images specifically and the rules for distinguishing if a resource is text or binary are also defined in the MIME Sniffing specification. Both sets of rules return a MIME type as their result. [MIMESNIFF]
It is imperative that the rules in the MIME Sniffing specification be followed exactly. When a user agent uses different heuristics for content type detection than the server expects, security problems can occur. For more details, see the MIME Sniffing specification. [MIMESNIFF]
meta
elementsThe algorithm
for extracting a character encoding from a meta
element,
given a string s, is as follows. It
either returns a character encoding або нічого.
Нехай position буде вказівником в s, що спочатку вказує на початок рядка.
Loop: Find the first seven characters in s
after position що є an ASCII
чутливі до реєстру match for the word "charset
".
Якщо no such match is found, return nothing and abort these steps.
Skip any space
characters that immediately follow the word "charset
"
(there might not be any).
Якщо the next character is not a "=" (U+003D), then move position to point just before that next character та jump back to the step labeled loop.
Skip any space characters that immediately follow the equals sign (there might not be any).
Process the next character as follows:
This algorithm is distinct from those in the HTTP specification (for example, HTTP doesn't allow the use of single quotes and requires supporting a backslash-escape mechanism that is not supported by this algorithm). While the algorithm is used in contexts that, historically, were related to HTTP, the syntax as supported by implementations diverged some time ago. [HTTP]
A CORS settings attribute is an enumerated attribute. The following table lists the keywords and states for the attribute — the keywords in the left column map to the states in the cell in the second column on the same row as the keyword.
Keyword | State | Brief description |
---|---|---|
anonymous
|
Anonymous | Cross-origin CORS requests for the element will have the omit credentials flag set. |
use-credentials
|
Use Credentials | Cross-origin CORS requests for the element will not have the omit credentials flag set. |
The empty string is also a valid keyword та maps to the Anonymous state. The attribute's
invalid value default is the Anonymous state. For the purposes
of reflection, the
canonical case for the Anonymous
state is the anonymous
keyword. The missing value default, used when the attribute is
omitted, is the No
CORS state.
When the user agent is required to perform a potentially CORS-enabled fetch of an absolute URL URL with a mode mode that is either "No CORS", "Anonymous", or "Use Credentials", optionally using a referrer source referrer source, with an origin origin та with a default origin behaviour default which is either "taint" or "fail", it must run the first applicable set of steps from the following list. The default origin behaviour is only used if mode is "No CORS". This algorithm wraps the fetch algorithm above та labels the obtained resource як або CORS-same-origin or CORS-cross-origin, or blocks the resource entirely.
data:
URLabout:blank
виконати ці підкроки:
Fetch URL, using referrer source if one was specified, with the manual redirect flag set.
Loop: Wait for the fetch algorithm to know if the result is a redirect or not.
Follow the first appropriate steps from the following list:
Set URL to the target URL of the redirect and return to the top of the potentially CORS-enabled fetch algorithm (this time, one of the other branches below might be taken, based on the value of mode).
The origin of the target URL of the redirect is the same origin as origin.
Transparently follow the redirect and jump to the step labeled loop above.
The resource is available, it is not a redirect та its origin is the same origin as origin.
The tasks from the fetch algorithm are queued normally та for the purposes of the calling algorithm, the obtained resource is CORS-same-origin.
The URL does not have the same origin as origin.
Fetch URL, using referrer source if one was specified.
The tasks from the fetch algorithm are queued normally, but for the purposes of the calling algorithm, the obtained resource is CORS-cross-origin. The user agent may report a cross-origin resource access failure to the user (e.g. in a debugging console).
The URL does not have the same origin as origin та default is fail.
Discard any data fetched as part of this algorithm та prevent any tasks from such invocations of the fetch algorithm from being queued. For the purposes of the calling algorithm, the user agent must act as if there was a fatal network error and no resource was obtained. The user agent may report a cross-origin resource access failure to the user (e.g. in a debugging console).
The URL does not have the same origin as origin.
Run these steps:
Perform a cross-origin request with the request URL set to URL, with the CORS referrer source set to referrer source if one was specified, the source origin set to origin та with the omit credentials flag set if mode is "Anonymous" and not set otherwise. [CORS]
Wait for the CORS cross-origin request status to have a value.
Jump to the appropriate step from the following list:
Discard all fetched data and prevent any tasks from the fetch algorithm from being queued. For the purposes of the calling algorithm, the user agent must act as if there was a fatal network error and no resource was obtained. Якщо a CORS resource sharing check failed, the user agent may report a cross-origin resource access failure to the user (e.g. in a debugging console).
The tasks from the fetch algorithm are queued normally та for the purposes of the calling algorithm, the obtained resource is CORS-same-origin.
Some IDL attributes are defined to reflect a particular content attribute. This means that on getting, the IDL attribute returns the current value of the content attribute та on setting, the IDL attribute changes the value of the content attribute to the given value.
In general, on getting, if the content attribute is not present, the IDL attribute must act as if the content attribute's value is the empty string; and on setting, if the content attribute is not present, it must first be added.
Якщо a reflecting IDL attribute is a DOMString
attribute
whose content attribute is defined to contain a URL, then
on getting, the IDL attribute must resolve the value of the content attribute
relative to the element and return the resulting absolute
URL if that was successful, or the empty string otherwise; and on
setting, must set the content attribute to the specified literal value.
Якщо the content attribute is absent, the IDL attribute must return the
default value, if the content attribute has one, or else the empty
string.
Якщо a reflecting IDL attribute is a DOMString
attribute
whose content attribute is defined to contain one or more URLs,
then on getting, the IDL attribute must split the content attribute on spaces
and return the concatenation of resolving
each token URL to an absolute URL relative
to the element, with a single U+0020 SPACE character between each URL,
ignoring any tokens that did not resolve successfully. Якщо the content
attribute is absent, the IDL attribute must return the default value, if
the content attribute has one, or else the empty string. On setting, the
IDL attribute must set the content attribute to the specified literal
value.
Якщо a reflecting IDL attribute is a DOMString
attribute
whose content attribute is an enumerated
attribute та the IDL attribute is limited
to only known values, then, on getting, the IDL attribute must
return the conforming value associated with the state the attribute is
in (in its canonical case), if any, or the empty string if the attribute
is in a state that has no associated keyword value or if the attribute
is not in a defined state (e.g. the attribute is missing and there is no
missing value default); and on setting, the content attribute
must be set to the specified new value.
Якщо a reflecting IDL attribute is a DOMString
attribute
but doesn't fall into any of the above categories, then the getting та
встановитиting must be done in a transparent, case-preserving manner.
Якщо a reflecting IDL attribute is a boolean
attribute, then on getting the IDL attribute must return true if the
content attribute is set та false if it is absent. On setting, the
content attribute must be removed if the IDL attribute is set to false
та must be set to the empty string if the IDL attribute is set to true.
(This corresponds to the rules for boolean content attributes.)
Якщо a reflecting IDL attribute has a signed integer type (long
)
then, on getting, the content attribute must be parsed according to the
rules for parsing signed integers
та if that is successful та the value is in the range of the IDL
attribute's type, the resulting value must be returned. Якщо, on the
other hand, it fails or returns an out of range value, or if the
attribute is absent, then the default value must be returned instead, or
0 if there is no default value. On setting, the given value must be
converted to the shortest possible string representing the number as a valid integer and then that string must be
used as the new content attribute value.
Якщо a reflecting IDL attribute has a signed integer type (long
)
that is limited to only
non-negative numbers then, on getting, the content attribute
must be parsed according to the rules
for parsing non-negative integers та if that is successful та the
value is in the range of the IDL attribute's type, the resulting value
must be returned. Якщо, on the other hand, it fails or returns an out of
range value, or if the attribute is absent, the default value must be
returned instead, or −1 if there is no default value. On setting, if the
value is negative, the user agent must throw an IndexSizeError
exception. Інакше the given value must be converted to the shortest
possible string representing the number as a valid
non-negative integer and then that string must be used as the new
content attribute value.
Якщо a reflecting IDL attribute has an unsigned integer type
(unsigned long
) then, on getting, the content attribute
must be parsed according to the rules
for parsing non-negative integers та if that is successful та the
value is in the range 0 to 2147483647 inclusive, the resulting value
must be returned. Якщо, on the other hand, it fails or returns an out of
range value, or if the attribute is absent, the default value must be
returned instead, or 0 if there is no default value. On setting, first,
if the new value is in the range 0 to 2147483647, then let n
be the new value, otherwise let n be the
default value, or 0 if there is no default value; then, n
must be converted to the shortest possible string representing the
number as a valid non-negative
integer and that string must be used as the new content attribute
value.
Якщо a reflecting IDL attribute has an unsigned integer type (unsigned
long
) that is limited
to only non-negative numbers greater than zero, then the
behavior is similar to the previous case, but zero is not allowed. On
getting, the content attribute must first be parsed according to the rules for parsing
non-negative integers та if that is successful та the value is in
the range 1 to 2147483647 inclusive, the resulting value must be
returned. Якщо, on the other hand, it fails or returns an out of range
value, or if the attribute is absent, the default value must be returned
instead, or 1 if there is no default value. On setting, if the value is
zero, the user agent must throw an IndexSizeError
exception. Інакше first, if the new value is in the range 1 to
2147483647, then let n be the new value,
otherwise let n be the default value, or
1 if there is no default value; then, n
must be converted to the shortest possible string representing the
number as a valid non-negative
integer and that string must be used as the new content attribute
value.
Якщо a reflecting IDL attribute has a floating-point number type (double
or unrestricted double
), then, on getting, the content
attribute must be parsed according to the rules
for parsing floating-point number values та if that is successful,
the resulting value must be returned. Якщо, on the other hand, it fails,
or if the attribute is absent, the default value must be returned
instead, or 0.0 if there is no default value. On setting, the given
value must be converted to the best
representation of the number as a floating-point number and then
that string must be used as the new content attribute value.
Якщо a reflecting IDL attribute has a floating-point number type (double
or unrestricted double
) that is limited
to numbers greater than zero, then the behavior is similar to
the previous case, but zero and negative values are not allowed. On
getting, the content attribute must be parsed according to the rules
for parsing floating-point number values та if that is successful
and the value is greater than 0.0, the resulting value must be returned.
Якщо, on the other hand, it fails or returns an out of range value, or
if the attribute is absent, the default value must be returned instead,
or 0.0 if there is no default value. On setting, if the value is less
than or equal to zero, then the value must be ignored. Інакше the given
value must be converted to the best
representation of the number as a floating-point number and then
that string must be used as the new content attribute value.
The values Infinity and Not-a-Number (NaN) values throw an exception on setting, as defined in the Web IDL specification. [WEBIDL]
Якщо a reflecting IDL attribute has the type DOMTokenList
or DOMSettableTokenList
,
then on getting it must return a DOMTokenList
or DOMSettableTokenList
object (as appropriate) whose associated element is the element in
question and whose associated attribute's local name is the name of the
attribute in question. The same DOMTokenList
or DOMSettableTokenList
object must be returned every time for each attribute.
Якщо a reflecting IDL attribute has the type HTMLElement
,
or an interface that descends from HTMLElement
,
then, on getting, it must run the following algorithm (stopping at the
first point where a value is returned):
document.getElementById()
method would find when called on the content attribute's document if
it were passed as its argument the current value of the corresponding
content attribute.On setting, if the given element has an id
attribute та has the same home subtree as the element of the attribute
being set та the given element is the first element in that home
subtree whose ID
is the value of that id
attribute, then the content attribute must be set to the value of that id
attribute. Інакше the content attribute must be set to the empty string.
The HTMLAllCollection
, HTMLFormControlsCollection
,
HTMLOptionsCollection
,
interfaces are collections derived
from the HTMLCollection
interface.
The HTMLAllCollection
interface is used for generic collections of
elements just like HTMLCollection
,
with the exception that its namedItem()
method
returns an HTMLCollection
object when there are multiple matching elements та that its item()
method can be used as a synonym for its namedItem()
method.
It is intended only for the legacy document.all
attribute.
interface HTMLAllCollection : HTMLCollection {
// inherits length and item(unsigned long index)
(HTMLCollection or Element)? item(DOMString name);
legacycaller getter (HTMLCollection or Element)? namedItem(DOMString name); // shadows inherited namedItem()
HTMLAllCollection tags(DOMString tagName);
};
length
Returns the number of elements in the collection.
item
(index)Returns the item with index index from the collection. The items are sorted in tree order.
item
(name)item
(name)namedItem
(name)namedItem
(name)Returns the item with ID or name name from the collection.
Якщо there are multiple matching items, then an HTMLCollection
object containing all those elements is returned.
Only a
, applet
,
area
, embed
,
form
, frame
,
frameset
, iframe
,
img
та object
elements can have a name for the purpose of this method; their name is
given by the value of their name
attribute.
tags
(tagName)Returns a collection that is a filtered view of the current collection, containing only elements with the given tag name.
The object's supported property
indices are as defined for HTMLCollection
objects.
The supported property names
consist of the non-empty values of all the id
attributes of all the
elements represented by the
collection та the non-empty values of all the name
attributes of all the a
, applet
, area
,
embed
, form
,
frame
, frameset
,
iframe
, img
та object
elements represented
by the collection, in tree order,
ignoring later duplicates, with the id
of an element preceding its name
if it contributes both, they differ
from each other та neither is the duplicate of an earlier entry.
The item(name)
and namedItem(name)
methods must act according to the following algorithm:
Нехай collection be an HTMLCollection
object rooted at the same node as the HTMLAllCollection
object on which the method was invoked, whose filter matches only
elements that already match the filter of the HTMLAllCollection
object on which the method was invoked and що є either:
The tags(tagName)
method must return
an HTMLAllCollection
rooted at the same node as the HTMLAllCollection
object on which the method was invoked, whose filter matches only HTML
elements whose local name is the tagName
argument and that already match the filter of the HTMLAllCollection
object on which the method was invoked. In HTML
documents, the argument must first be converted
to ASCII lowercase.
The HTMLFormControlsCollection
interface is used for collections of listed elements in form
and fieldset
elements.
interface HTMLFormControlsCollection : HTMLCollection {
// inherits length and item()
legacycaller getter (RadioNodeList or Element)? namedItem(DOMString name); // shadows inherited namedItem()
};
interface RadioNodeList : NodeList {
attribute DOMString value;
};
length
Returns the number of elements in the collection.
item
(index)Returns the item with index index from the collection. The items are sorted in tree order.
namedItem
(name)namedItem
(name)Returns the item with ID
or name
name from the collection.
Якщо there are multiple matching items, then a RadioNodeList
object containing all those elements is returned.
Returns the value of the first checked radio button represented by the object.
Can be set, to check the first radio button with the given value represented by the object.
The object's supported property
indices are as defined for HTMLCollection
objects.
The supported property names
consist of the non-empty values of all the id
and name
attributes of all the elements
represented by the collection,
in tree order, ignoring later duplicates,
with the id
of an element preceding its name
if it contributes both, they differ from each other та neither is the
duplicate of an earlier entry.
The namedItem(name)
method must act
according to the following algorithm:
id
attribute or a name
attribute equal to name, then return
that node and stop the algorithm.id
attribute or a name
attribute equal to name, then return
null and stop the algorithm.RadioNodeList
object representing a live view of the HTMLFormControlsCollection
object, further filtered so that the only nodes in the RadioNodeList
object are those that have either an id
attribute or a name
attribute equal to name.
The nodes in the RadioNodeList
object must be sorted in tree order.RadioNodeList
object.Members of the RadioNodeList
interface inherited from the NodeList
interface must behave as they would on a NodeList
object.
The value
IDL attribute on the RadioNodeList
object, on getting, must return the value returned by running the
following steps:
Нехай element be the first element
in tree order represented by the RadioNodeList
object that is an
input
element whose type
attribute is in the Radio
Button state and whose checkedness є true. Інакше let it
be null.
Якщо element is null, or if it is
an element with no value
attribute, return the empty string.
Інакше return the value of element's
value
attribute.
On setting, the value
IDL attribute must run the following steps:
Нехай element be the first element
in tree order represented by the RadioNodeList
object that is an
input
element whose type
attribute is in the Radio
Button state and whose value
content attribute is
present and equal to the new value, if any. Інакше let it be null.
Якщо element is not null, then set its checkedness to true.
The HTMLOptionsCollection
interface is used for collections of option
elements. It is always
rooted on a select
element
and has attributes and methods that manipulate that element's descendants.
interface HTMLOptionsCollection : HTMLCollection { // inherits item() attribute unsigned long length; // shadows inherited length legacycaller HTMLOptionElement? (DOMString name); setter creator void (unsigned long index, HTMLOptionElement? option); void add((HTMLOptionElement or HTMLOptGroupElement) element, optional (HTMLElement or long)? before = null); void remove(long index); attribute long selectedIndex; };
length
[ = value ]Returns the number of elements in the collection.
When set to a smaller number, truncates the number of option
elements in the corresponding container.
When set to a greater number, adds new blank option
elements to that container.
item
(index)Returns the item with index index from the collection. The items are sorted in tree order.
namedItem
(name)namedItem
(name)Returns the item with ID
or name
name from the collection.
Якщо there are multiple matching items, then the first is returned.
add
(element
[, before ] )Inserts element before the node given by before.
The before argument can be a number, in which case element is inserted before the item with that number, or an element from the collection, in which case element is inserted before that element.
Якщо before is omitted, null, or a number out of range, then element will be added at the end of the list.
This method will throw a HierarchyRequestError
exception if element is an ancestor of
the element into which it is to be inserted.
selectedIndex
[ = value ]Returns the index of the first selected item, if any, or −1 if there is no selected item.
Can be set, to change the selection.
The object's supported property
indices are as defined for HTMLCollection
objects.
On getting, the length
attribute must return the number of nodes represented
by the collection.
On setting, the behavior depends on whether the new value is equal to,
greater than, or less than the number of nodes represented
by the collection at that time. Якщо the number is the same, then
setting the attribute must do nothing. Якщо the new value is greater,
then n new option
elements with no attributes and no child nodes must be appended to the select
element on which the HTMLOptionsCollection
is
rooted, where n is the difference
between the two numbers (new value minus old value). Mutation events
must be fired as if a DocumentFragment
containing the new option
elements had been inserted. Якщо the new value is lower, then the last n nodes in the collection must be removed
from their parent nodes, where n is the
difference between the two numbers (old value minus new value).
Setting length
never
removes or adds any optgroup
elements та never adds new children to existing optgroup
elements (though it can remove children from them).
The supported property names
consist of the non-empty values of all the id
and name
attributes of all the
elements represented by the
collection, in tree order, ignoring
later duplicates, with the id
of an element preceding its name
if it contributes both,
they differ from each other та neither is the duplicate of an earlier
entry.
The legacy
caller of the HTMLOptionsCollection
interface must act like the namedItem()
method on the ancestor HTMLCollection
interface.
When the user agent is to set the value of a new indexed property or set the value of an existing indexed property for a given property index index to a new value value, it must run the following algorithm:
Якщо value is null, invoke the
steps for the remove
method with index as the argument та
abort these steps.
Нехай length be the number of nodes represented by the collection.
Нехай n be index minus length.
Якщо n is greater than zero, then append
a DocumentFragment
consisting of n-1
new option
elements
with no attributes and no child nodes to the select
element on which the HTMLOptionsCollection
is rooted.
Якщо n is greater than or equal to
zero, append
value to the select
element. Інакше replace
the indexth element in the
collection by value.
The add(element, before)
method must act according to the following algorithm:
Якщо element is an ancestor of the
select
element on
which the HTMLOptionsCollection
is rooted, then throw a HierarchyRequestError
exception and abort these steps.
Якщо before is an element, but that
element isn't a descendant of the select
element on which the HTMLOptionsCollection
is rooted, then throw a NotFoundError
exception and abort these steps.
Якщо element and before are the same element, then return and abort these steps.
Якщо before is a node, then let reference be that node. Інакше if before is an integer та there is a beforeth node in the collection, let reference be that node. Інакше let reference be null.
Якщо reference is not null, let parent be the parent node of reference.
Інакше let parent be the select
element on which the HTMLOptionsCollection
is rooted.
Act as if the DOM insertBefore()
method
was invoked on the parent node, with
element as the first argument and reference as the second argument.
The remove(index)
method must act
according to the following algorithm:
Якщо the number of nodes represented by the collection is zero, abort these steps.
Якщо index is not a number greater than or equal to 0 and less than the number of nodes represented by the collection, abort these steps.
Нехай element be the indexth element in the collection.
Remove element from its parent node.
The selectedIndex
IDL attribute must act like the identically named attribute on the select
element on which the HTMLOptionsCollection
is
rooted
The DOMStringMap
interface
represents a set of name-value pairs. It exposes these using the scripting
language's native mechanisms for property access.
When a DOMStringMap
object
is instantiated, it is associated with three algorithms, one for getting
the list of name-value pairs, one for setting names to certain values та
one for deleting names.
[OverrideBuiltins] interface DOMStringMap { getter DOMString (DOMString name); setter creator void (DOMString name, DOMString value); deleter void (DOMString name); };
The supported property names
on a DOMStringMap
object at
any instant are the names of each pair returned from the algorithm for
getting the list of name-value pairs at that instant, in the order
returned.
To determine
the value of a named property name
in a DOMStringMap
, the user
agent must return the value component of the name-value pair whose name
component is name in the list returned
by the algorithm for getting the list of name-value pairs.
To set the value of a new or existing named property name
to value value, the algorithm for
setting names to certain values must be run, passing name
as the name and the result of converting value
to a DOMString
as the value.
To delete an existing named property name, the algorithm for deleting names must be run, passing name as the name.
The DOMStringMap
interface definition here is only intended for JavaScript environments.
Other language bindings will need to define how DOMStringMap
is to be implemented for those languages.
The dataset
attribute on elements exposes the data-*
attributes on the element.
Given the following fragment and elements with similar constructions:
<img class="tower" id="tower5" data-x="12" data-y="5" data-ai="robotarget" data-hp="46" data-ability="flames" src="towers/rocket.png alt="Rocket Tower">
...one could imagine a function splashDamage()
that takes some arguments, the first of which is the element to process:
function splashDamage(node, x, y, damage) { if (node.classList.contains('tower') && // checking the 'class' attribute node.dataset.x == x && // reading the 'data-x' attribute node.dataset.y == y) { // reading the 'data-y' attribute var hp = parseInt(node.dataset.hp); // reading the 'data-hp' attribute hp = hp - damage; if (hp < 0) { hp = 0; node.dataset.ai = 'dead'; // setting the 'data-ai' attribute delete node.dataset.ability; // removing the 'data-ability' attribute } node.dataset.hp = hp; // setting the 'data-hp' attribute } }
Some objects support being copied and closed in one operation. This is called transferring the object та is used in particular to transfer ownership of unsharable or expensive resources across worker boundaries.
The following Transferable
types exist:
The following IDL block formalizes this:
[NoInterfaceObject] interface Transferable { }; ArrayBuffer implements Transferable; MessagePort implements Transferable;
To transfer a Transferable
object to a new owner, the user agent must run the steps defined
for the type of object in question. The steps will return a new object
of the same type та will permanently neuter the original object.
(This is an irreversible and non-idempotent operation; once an object
has been transferred, it cannot be transferred, or indeed used, again.)
To transfer an ArrayBuffer
object old to a new owner owner,
a user agent must create a new ArrayBuffer
object pointing at the same underlying data as old,
thus obtaining new, must neuter the old
object та must finally return new. [TYPEDARRAY]
Rules for how to transfer a MessagePort
object are given in the relevant sections of this specification.
When a user agent is required щоб отримати a structured
clone of a value, optionally with a transfer map, it
must run the following algorithm, which either returns a separate value,
or throws an exception. Якщо a transfer map is provided, it
consists of an association list of Transferable
objects to placeholder objects.
Нехай input be the value being cloned.
Нехай transfer map be the transfer map passed to the algorithm, if any, or the empty list otherwise.
Нехай memory be an association list of pairs of objects, initially empty. This is used to handle duplicate references. In each pair of objects, one is called the source object and the other the destination object.
For each mapping in transfer map,
add a mapping from the Transferable
object (the source object) to the placeholder object (the
destination object) to memory.
Нехай output be the value resulting from calling the internal structured cloning algorithm with input as the "input" argument та memory as the "memory" argument.
Повернутиoutput.
The internal structured cloning algorithm is always called with two arguments, input and memory та its behavior is as follows:
Якщо input is the source object of a pair of objects in memory, then return the destination object in that pair of objects and abort these steps.
Якщо input is a primitive value, then return that value and abort these steps.
Нехай deep clone be none.
The input value is an object. Jump to the appropriate step below:
Boolean
objectНехай output be a newly constructed Boolean object with the same value as input.
Number
objectНехай output be a newly constructed Number object with the same value as input.
String
objectНехай output be a newly constructed String object with the same value as input.
Date
objectНехай output be a newly
constructed Date
object with the same value as input.
RegExp
objectНехай output be a newly
constructed RegExp
object with the same pattern
and flags as input.
The value of the lastIndex
property is not copied.
Blob
objectЯкщо input has been disabled
through the close()
method, throw a DataCloneError
exception and abort the overall structured
clone algorithm. Інакше let output
be a newly constructed object of the same class as input,
corresponding to the same underlying data.
FileList
objectНехай output be a newly
constructed FileList
object containing a list of newly constructed File
objects corresponding to the same underlying data as those in input, maintaining their relative
order.
ImageData
objectНехай output be a newly
constructed ImageData
object whose width
,
height
та resolution
attributes have values equal to the corresponding attributes on
input та whose data
attribute has the value obtained from invoking the internal
structured cloning algorithm recursively with the value of
the data
attribute on input as the new "input" argument and memory
as the new "memory" argument.
ArrayBuffer
objectЯкщо input has been neutered, throw a DataCloneError
exception
and abort the overall structured
clone algorithm. Інакше let output
be a newly constructed ArrayBuffer
object whose contents are a copy of input's
contents, with the same length.
ArrayBufferView
objectНехай output be a newly constructed object of the same class as input, with each IDL attribute defined for that class being set to the value obtained from invoking the internal structured cloning algorithm recursively with the value of the attribute on input as the new "input" argument and memory as the new "memory" argument.
Only IDL attributes defined on the class
(including the ArrayBufferView
attributes) are cloned. Properties added by a script, for
example, are not cloned.
Array
objectНехай output be a newly
constructed empty Array
object whose length
is equal to the length
of input та set deep
clone to own.
This means that the length of sparse arrays is preserved.
Object
objectНехай output be a newly
constructed empty Object
object та set deep clone to own.
Map
objectНехай output be a newly
constructed empty Map
object
та set deep clone to map.
Set
objectНехай output be a newly
constructed empty Set
object
та set deep clone to set.
Нехай output be a clone of the object as defined by the other specification.
Error
, Function
)Throw a DataCloneError
exception and abort the overall structured
clone algorithm.
For the purposes of the algorithm above, an object is a particular type of object class if its [[Class]] internal property is equal to class.
For example, "input
is an Object
object" if input's
[[Class]] internal property is equal to the string "Object
".
Add a mapping from input (the source object) to output (the destination object) to memory.
Якщо deep clone is set to map, тоді виконайте ці субкроки. These substeps use the terminology and typographic conventions used in the JavaScript specification's definition of Maps. [ECMA262]
Нехай source be the List that
is the value of input's
[[MapData]] internal slot, if any. Якщо there is no such slot,
then instead throw a DataCloneError
exception and abort the overall structured
clone algorithm. [ECMA262]
Нехай target be the List that is the value of output's [[MapData]] internal slot.
For each Record {[[key]], [[value]]} entry that is an element of source, run the following substeps:
Нехай key have the value obtained from invoking the internal structured cloning algorithm recursively with entry.[[key]] as the new "input" argument and memory as the new "memory" argument.
Нехай value have the value obtained from invoking the internal structured cloning algorithm recursively with entry.[[value]] as the new "input" argument and memory as the new "memory" argument.
Нехай new entry be the Record {[[key]]: key, [[value]]: value}.
Append new entry as the last element of target.
Set deep clone to own.
Якщо deep clone is set to set, тоді виконайте ці субкроки. These substeps use the terminology and typographic conventions used in the JavaScript specification's definition of Sets. [ECMA262]
Нехай source be the List that
is the value of input's
[[SetData]] internal slot, if any. Якщо there is no such slot,
then instead throw a DataCloneError
exception and abort the overall structured
clone algorithm. [ECMA262]
Нехай target be the List that is the value of output's [[SetData]] internal slot.
For each entry that is an element of source that is not empty, run the following substeps:
Нехай new entry have the value obtained from invoking the internal structured cloning algorithm recursively with entry as the new "input" argument and memory as the new "memory" argument.
Append new entry as the last element of target.
Set deep clone to own.
Якщо deep clone is set to own, then, for each enumerable own property in input, run the following steps:
Нехай name be the name of the property.
Нехай source value be the result of calling the [[Get]] internal method of input with the argument name. Якщо the [[Get]] internal method of a property involved executing script та that script threw an uncaught exception, then abort the overall structured clone algorithm, with that exception being passed through to the caller.
Нехай cloned value be the result of invoking the internal structured cloning algorithm recursively with source value as the "input" argument and memory as the "memory" argument. Якщо this results in an exception, then abort the overall structured clone algorithm, with that exception being passed through to the caller.
Add a new property to output having the name name та having the value cloned value.
The order of the properties in the input and output objects must be the same та any properties whose [[Get]] internal method involves running script must be processed in that same order.
This does not walk the prototype chain.
Property descriptors, setters, getters та analogous features are not copied in this process. For example, the property in the input could be marked as read-only, but in the output it would just have the default state (typically read-write, though that could depend on the scripting environment).
Properties of Array objects are not treated any differently than those of other Objects. In particular, this means that non-index properties of arrays are copied as well.
Повернутиoutput.
This algorithm preserves cycles and preserves the identity of duplicate objects in graphs.
The following callback function type is used in various APIs that
interact with File
objects:
callback FileCallback = void (File file);
There is an implied strong reference from any IDL attribute that returns a pre-existing object to that object.
The простір імен HTML is: http://www.w3.org/1999/xhtml
The MathML namespace is: http://www.w3.org/1998/Math/MathML
The SVG namespace is: http://www.w3.org/2000/svg
The XLink namespace is: http://www.w3.org/1999/xlink
The XML namespace is: http://www.w3.org/XML/1998/namespace
The XMLNS namespace is: http://www.w3.org/2000/xmlns/
Data mining tools and other user agents that perform operations on content without running scripts, evaluating CSS or XPath expressions, or otherwise exposing the resulting DOM to arbitrary content, may "support namespaces" by just asserting that their DOM node analogues are in certain namespaces, without actually exposing the above strings.
In the HTML syntax, namespace prefixes and namespace declarations do not have the same effect as in XML. For instance, the colon has no special meaning in HTML element names.
Every XML and HTML document in an HTML UA is represented by a Document
object. [DOM]
The document's address is an absolute
URL that is initially set when the Document
is created but that can change during the lifetime of the Document
,
for example when the user navigates
to a fragment
identifier on the page or when the pushState()
method is called
with a new URL.
Interactive user agents typically expose the document's address in their user interface. This is the primary mechanism by which a user can tell if a site is attempting to impersonate another.
When a Document
is created by a script
using the createDocument()
or createHTMLDocument()
APIs, the document's address is
the same as the document's address
of the responsible document specified
by the script's settings object та the Document
is both ready
for post-load tasks and completely
loaded immediately.
The document's referrer is an absolute URL that can be set when the Document
is created. Якщо it is not
explicitly set, then its value is the empty string.
Each Document
object has a reload
override flag that is originally unset. The flag is set by the document.open()
and document.write()
methods in certain situations. When the flag is set, the Document
also has a reload override buffer
which is a Unicode string that is used as the source of the document when
it is reloaded.
When the user agent is to perform an overridden reload, given a source browsing context, it must act as follows:
Нехай source be the value of the browsing context's active document's reload override buffer.
Нехай address be the browsing context's active document's address.
Navigate
the browsing context to a resource
whose source is source, with replacement
enabled and exceptions enabled.
The source browsing context is
that given to the overridden reload algorithm. When
the navigate algorithm creates a Document
object for this purpose, set that Document
's
reload override flag та встановити
its reload override buffer to source.
When it comes time to set the document's address in the navigation algorithm, use address as the override URL.
Document
objectThe DOM specification defines a Document
interface, which this
specification extends significantly:
enum DocumentReadyState { "loading", "interactive", "complete" }; [OverrideBuiltins] partial /*sealed*/ interface Document { // resource metadata management [PutForwards=href, Unforgeable] readonly attribute Location? location; attribute DOMString domain; readonly attribute DOMString referrer; attribute DOMString cookie; readonly attribute DOMString lastModified; readonly attribute DocumentReadyState readyState; // DOM tree accessors getter object (DOMString name); attribute DOMString title; attribute DOMString dir; attribute HTMLElement? body; readonly attribute HTMLHeadElement? head; readonly attribute HTMLCollection images; readonly attribute HTMLCollection embeds; readonly attribute HTMLCollection plugins; readonly attribute HTMLCollection links; readonly attribute HTMLCollection forms; readonly attribute HTMLCollection scripts; NodeList getElementsByName(DOMString elementName); // dynamic markup insertion Document open(optional DOMString type = "text/html", optional DOMString replace = ""); WindowProxy open(DOMString url, DOMString name, DOMString features, optional boolean replace = false); void close(); void write(DOMString... text); void writeln(DOMString... text); // user interaction readonly attribute WindowProxy? defaultView; readonly attribute Element? activeElement; boolean hasFocus(); attribute DOMString designMode; boolean execCommand(DOMString commandId, optional boolean showUI = false, optional DOMString value = ""); boolean queryCommandEnabled(DOMString commandId); boolean queryCommandIndeterm(DOMString commandId); boolean queryCommandState(DOMString commandId); boolean queryCommandSupported(DOMString commandId); DOMString queryCommandValue(DOMString commandId); // special event handler IDL attributes that only apply to Document objects [LenientThis] attribute EventHandler onreadystatechange; }; Document implements GlobalEventHandlers;
referrer
Returns the
address of the Document
from which the user navigated to this one, unless it was blocked or
there was no such document, in which case it returns the empty string.
The noreferrer
link type can be used to block the referrer.
The referrer
attribute must return the
document's referrer.
In the case of HTTP, the referrer
IDL attribute will
match the Referer
(sic)
header that was sent when fetching
the current page.
Typically user agents are configured to not report referrers
in the case where the referrer uses an encrypted protocol and the current
page does not (e.g. when navigating from an https:
page to an http:
page).
cookie
[ = value
]Returns the HTTP cookies that apply to the Document
.
Якщо there are no cookies or cookies can't be applied to this
resource, the empty string will be returned.
Can be set, to add a new cookie to the element's set of HTTP cookies.
Якщо the contents are sandboxed into a
unique origin (e.g. in an iframe
with the sandbox
attribute), a SecurityError
exception will be thrown on getting та встановитиting.
The cookie
attribute represents the cookies of the resource identified by the
document's address.
A Document
object that falls into
one of the following conditions is a cookie-averse
Document
object:
Document
that has no browsing
context.Document
whose address does not use a
server-based naming authority.On getting, if the document is a cookie-averse
Document
object, then the user agent must return the
empty string. Інакше if the Document
's
origin is not a scheme/host/port tuple, the user
agent must throw a SecurityError
exception. Інакше the user agent must first obtain
the storage mutex and then return the cookie-string for the
document's address for a "non-HTTP" API, decoded using the UTF-8
decoder. [COOKIES]
On setting, if the document is a cookie-averse
Document
object, then the user agent must do nothing.
Інакше if the Document
's origin
is not a scheme/host/port tuple, the user agent must throw a SecurityError
exception. Інакше the user agent must obtain
the storage mutex and then act as it would when receiving a set-cookie-string
for the document's address via
a "non-HTTP" API, consisting of the new value encoded as UTF-8. [COOKIES]
[RFC3629]
Since the cookie
attribute is
accessible across frames, the path restrictions on cookies are only a
tool to help manage which cookies are sent to which parts of the site та
are not in any way a security feature.
lastModified
Returns the date of the last modification to the document, as
reported by the server, in the form "MM/DD/YYYY hh:mm:ss
",
in the user's local time zone.
Якщо the last modification date is not known, the current time is returned instead.
The lastModified
attribute, on getting, must return the date and time of the Document
's
source file's last modification, in the user's local time zone, in the
following format:
All the numeric components above, other than the year, must be given as two цифрами ASCII representing the number in base ten, zero-padded if necessary. The year must be given as the shortest possible string of four or more цифрами ASCII representing the number in base ten, zero-padded if necessary.
The Document
's source file's last
modification date and time must be derived from relevant features of the
networking protocols used, e.g. from the value of the HTTP Last-Modified
header of the document, or from metadata in the file system for local
files. Якщо the last modification date and time are not known, the
attribute must return the current date and time in the above format.
readyState
Returns "loading
" while the Document
is loading, "interactive
"
once it is finished parsing but still loading sub-resources та "complete
" once it has loaded.
The readystatechange
event fires on the Document
object when this value changes.
Each document has a current
document readiness. When a Document
object is created, it must have its current
document readiness set to the string "loading
"
if the document is associated with an HTML
parser, an XML parser, or an XSLT
processor та to the string "complete
"
otherwise. Various algorithms during page loading affect this value.
When the value is set, the user agent must fire
a simple event named readystatechange
at the
Document
object.
A Document
is said to have an active parser if it is associated with an HTML parser or an XML
parser that has not yet been stopped or aborted.
The readyState
IDL attribute must, on getting, return the current
document readiness.
The html
element of a
document is the document's root element, if there is one and it's an html
element, or null otherwise.
head
Returns the head
element.
The head
element of a
document is the first head
element that is a child of the html
element, if there is one, or null otherwise.
The head
attribute, on getting, must return the head
element of the document (a head
element or null).
title
[ = value
]Returns the document's title, as given by the
title
element.
Can be set, to update the document's title. Якщо there is no head
element, the new
value is ignored.
In SVG documents, the SVGDocument
interface's title
attribute takes precedence.
The title
element of a
document is the first title
element in the document (in tree order), if there is one, or null
otherwise.
The title
attribute must, on getting, run the following algorithm:
Якщо the root element is an svg
element in the "http://www.w3.org/2000/svg
"
namespace та the user agent supports SVG, then return the value that
would have been returned by the IDL attribute of the same name on
the SVGDocument
interface. [SVG]
Інакше let value be a concatenation
of the data of all the child Text
nodes of the title
element, in tree order, or the
empty string if the title
element is null.
Strip and collapse whitespace in value.
Повернутиvalue.
On setting, the following algorithm must be run. Mutation events must be fired as appropriate.
Якщо the root element is an svg
element in the "http://www.w3.org/2000/svg
"
namespace та the user agent supports SVG, then the setter must act
as if it was the setter for the IDL attribute of the same name on
the Document
interface defined
by the SVG specification. Stop the algorithm here. [SVG]
title
element
is null and the head
element is null, then the attribute must do nothing. Stop the
algorithm here.title
element
is null, then a new title
element must be created and appended to the
head
element. Нехай element
be that element. Інакше let element be
the title
element.Text
node whose data is
the new value being assigned must be appended to element.The title
IDL attribute defined above must replace the attribute of the same name
on the Document
interface defined
by the SVG specification when the user agent supports both HTML and SVG.
[SVG]
body
[ = value
]Returns the body element.
Can be set, to replace the body element.
Якщо the new value is not a body
or frameset
element, this will
throw a HierarchyRequestError
exception.
The body element of a document is the
first child of the html
element that is either a body
element or a frameset
element. Якщо
there is no such element, it is null.
The body
attribute, on getting, must return the
body element of the document (either a body
element, a frameset
element, or
null). On setting, the following algorithm must be run:
body
or frameset
element, then throw
a HierarchyRequestError
exception and abort these steps.replaceChild()
method had been called with the new value and the incumbent body element as its two
arguments respectively, then abort these steps.HierarchyRequestError
exception and abort these steps.images
Returns an HTMLCollection
of the img
elements in
the Document
.
embeds
plugins
Повернутиan HTMLCollection
of the embed
elements
in the Document
.
links
Returns an HTMLCollection
of the a
and area
elements in the Document
that
have href
attributes.
forms
Повернутиan HTMLCollection
of the form
elements in
the Document
.
scripts
Повернутиan HTMLCollection
of the script
elements
in the Document
.
The images
attribute must return an HTMLCollection
rooted at the Document
node, whose
filter matches only img
elements.
The embeds
attribute must return an HTMLCollection
rooted at the Document
node, whose
filter matches only embed
elements.
The plugins
attribute must return the same object as that returned by the embeds
attribute.
The links
attribute must return an HTMLCollection
rooted at the Document
node, whose
filter matches only a
elements with href
attributes and area
elements with href
attributes.
The forms
attribute must return an HTMLCollection
rooted at the Document
node, whose
filter matches only form
elements.
The scripts
attribute must return an HTMLCollection
rooted at the Document
node, whose
filter matches only script
elements.
getElementsByName
(name)Returns a NodeList
of elements
in the Document
that have a name
attribute with the value name.
The getElementsByName(name)
method takes a string
name та must return a live
NodeList
containing all the HTML
elements in that document that have a name
attribute whose value is equal to the name
argument (in a case-sensitive manner), in
tree order. When the method is invoked on a Document
object again with the same
argument, the user agent may return the same as the object returned by
the earlier call. In other cases, a new NodeList
object must be returned.
The Document
interface supports named properties.
The supported property names at
any moment consist of the values of the name
content attributes of all the applet
,
exposed embed
,
form
, iframe
,
img
та exposed
object
elements in the Document
that have non-empty name
content attributes та the values of the id
content attributes of all the
applet
and exposed
object
elements in the Document
that have non-empty id
content attributes та the
values of the id
content attributes of all the img
elements in the Document
that have
both non-empty name
content
attributes and non-empty id
content attributes. The supported
property names must be in tree order,
ignoring later duplicates, with values from id
attributes coming before
values from name
attributes when the
same element contributes both.
To determine the
value of a named property name
when the
Document
object is indexed for property retrieval,
the user agent must return the value obtained using the following steps:
Нехай elements be the list of named elements with the
name name in the Document
.
There will be at least one such element, by definition.
Якщо elements has only one element
та that element is an iframe
element, then return the WindowProxy
object of the nested browsing
context represented by that iframe
element та abort these steps.
Інакше if elements has only one element, return that element and abort these steps.
Otherwise return an HTMLCollection
rooted at the Document
node,
whose filter matches only named elements with the
name name.
Named elements with the name name, for the purposes of the above algorithm, are those що є either:
applet
, exposed
embed
, form
,
iframe
, img
,
or exposed object
elements that have a name
content attribute whose value is name,
orapplet
or exposed
object
elements that
have an id
content attribute whose value is name,
orimg
elements that have
an id
content attribute whose value is name
та that have a non-empty name
content attribute present also.An embed
or object
element is said to be exposed if it has no exposed object
ancestor та, for object
elements, is additionally either not showing its fallback
content or has no object
or embed
descendants.
The dir
attribute on the Document
interface
is defined along with the dir
content attribute.
Elements, attributes та attribute values in HTML are defined (by this
specification) to have certain meanings (semantics). For example, the ol
element represents an ordered
list та the lang
attribute represents the language of the content.
These definitions allow HTML processors, such as Web browsers or search engines, to present and use documents and applications in a wide variety of contexts that the author might not have considered.
As a simple example, consider a Web page written by an author who only considered desktop computer Web browsers:
<!DOCTYPE HTML> <html> <head> <title>My Page</title> </head> <body> <h1>Welcome to my page</h1> <p>I like cars and lorries and have a big Jeep!</p> <h2>Where I live</h2> <p>I live in a small hut on a mountain!</p> </body> </html>
Because HTML conveys meaning, rather than presentation, the same page can also be used by a small browser on a mobile phone, without any change to the page. Instead of headings being in large letters as on the desktop, for example, the browser on the mobile phone might use the same size text for the whole the page, but with the headings in bold.
But it goes further than just differences in screen size: the same page could equally be used by a blind user using a browser based around speech synthesis, which instead of displaying the page on a screen, reads the page to the user, e.g. using headphones. Instead of large text for the headings, the speech browser might use a different volume or a slower voice.
That's not all, either. Since the browsers know which parts of the page are the headings, they can create a document outline that the user can use to quickly navigate around the document, using keys for "jump to next heading" or "jump to previous heading". Such features are especially common with speech browsers, where users would otherwise find quickly navigating a page quite difficult.
Even beyond browsers, software can make use of this information. Search engines can use the headings to more effectively index a page, or to provide quick links to subsections of the page from their results. Tools can use the headings to create a table of contents (that is in fact how this very specification's table of contents is generated).
This example has focused on headings, but the same principle applies to all of the semantics in HTML.
Authors must not use elements, attributes, or attribute values for purposes other than their appropriate intended semantic purpose, as doing so prevents software from correctly processing the page.
For example, the following document is non-conforming, despite being syntactically correct:
<!DOCTYPE HTML> <html lang="en-GB"> <head> <title> Demonstration </title> </head> <body> <table> <tr> <td> My favourite animal is the cat. </td> </tr> <tr> <td> —<a href="http://example.org/~ernest/"><cite>Ernest</cite></a>, in an essay from 1992 </td> </tr> </table> </body> </html>
...because the data placed in the cells is clearly not tabular data
(and the cite
element
mis-used). This would make software that relies on these semantics fail:
for example, a speech browser that allowed a blind user to navigate
tables in the document would report the quote above as a table,
confusing the user; similarly, a tool that extracted titles of works
from pages would extract "Ernest" as the title of a work, even though
it's actually a person's name, not a title.
A corrected version of this document might be:
<!DOCTYPE HTML> <html lang="en-GB"> <head> <title> Demonstration </title> </head> <body> <blockquote> <p> My favourite animal is the cat. </p> </blockquote> <p> —<a href="http://example.org/~ernest/">Ernest</a>, in an essay from 1992 </p> </body> </html>
Authors must not use elements, attributes, or attribute values що є not permitted by this specification or other applicable specifications, as doing so makes it significantly harder for the language to be extended in the future.
In the next example, there is a non-conforming attribute value ("carpet") and a non-conforming attribute ("texture"), which is not permitted by this specification:
<label>Carpet: <input type="carpet" name="c" texture="deep pile"></label>
Here would be an alternative and correct way to mark this up:
<label>Carpet: <input type="text" class="carpet" name="c" data-texture="deep pile"></label>
Through scripting and using other mechanisms, the values of attributes, text та indeed the entire structure of the document may change dynamically while a user agent is processing it. The semantics of a document at an instant in time are those represented by the state of the document at that instant in time та the semantics of a document can therefore change over time. User agents must update their presentation of the document as this occurs.
HTML has a progress
element that describes a progress bar. Якщо its "value" attribute is
dynamically updated by a script, the UA would update the rendering to show
the progress changing.
The nodes representing HTML elements in the DOM must implement та expose to scripts, the interfaces listed for them in the relevant sections of this specification. This includes HTML elements in XML documents, even when those documents are in another context (e.g. inside an XSLT transform).
Elements in the DOM represent things; that is, they have intrinsic meaning, also known as semantics.
For example, an ol
element represents an ordered list.
The basic interface, from which all the HTML
elements' interfaces inherit та which must be
used by elements that have no additional requirements, is the HTMLElement
interface.
interface HTMLElement : Element { // metadata attributes attribute DOMString title; attribute DOMString lang; attribute boolean translate; attribute DOMString dir; readonly attribute DOMStringMap dataset; // user interaction attribute boolean hidden; void click(); attribute long tabIndex; void focus(); void blur(); attribute DOMString accessKey; readonly attribute DOMString accessKeyLabel; attribute DOMString contentEditable; readonly attribute boolean isContentEditable; attribute boolean spellcheck; }; HTMLElement implements GlobalEventHandlers; interface HTMLUnknownElement : HTMLElement { };
The HTMLElement
interface holds
methods and attributes related to a number of disparate features та the
members of this interface are therefore described in various different
sections of this specification.
The HTMLUnknownElement
interface must be used for HTML elements
що є not defined by this specification (or other
applicable specifications).
Each element in this specification has a definition that includes the following information:
A list of categories to which the element belongs. These are used when defining the content models for each element.
A non-normative description of where the element can be used. This information is redundant with the content models of elements that allow this one as a child та is provided only as a convenience.
For simplicity, only the most specific expectations are listed. For example, an element that is both flow content and phrasing content can be used anywhere that either flow content or phrasing content is expected, but since anywhere that flow content is expected, phrasing content is also expected (since all phrasing content is flow content), only "where phrasing content is expected" will be listed.
A normative description of what content must be included as children and descendants of the element.
A non-normative description of whether, in the text/html
syntax, the start
and end
tags can be omitted. This information is redundant with the normative
requirements given in the optional
tags section та is provided in the element definitions only as a
convenience.
A normative list of attributes that may be specified on the element (except where otherwise disallowed), along with non-normative descriptions of those attributes. (The content to the left of the dash is normative, the content to the right of the dash is not.)
A normative definition of a DOM interface that such elements must implement.
This is then followed by a description of what the element represents, along with any additional normative conformance criteria that may apply to authors and implementations. Examples are sometimes also included.
Except where otherwise specified, attributes on HTML elements may have any string value, including the empty string. Except where explicitly stated, there is no restriction on what text can be specified in such attributes.
Each element defined in this specification has a content model: a
description of the element's expected contents. An HTML element must have contents that match the
requirements described in the element's content model. The contents of an element are its children
in the DOM, except for template
elements, where the children are those in the template
contents (a separate DocumentFragment
assigned to the element when the element is created).
The space
characters are always allowed between elements. User agents
represent these characters between elements in the source markup as Text
nodes in the DOM.
Empty Text
nodes and Text
nodes consisting of just sequences of those characters are considered inter-element whitespace.
Inter-element whitespace, comment nodes та processing instruction nodes must be ignored when establishing whether an element's contents match the element's content model or not та must be ignored when following algorithms that define document and element semantics.
Thus, an element A is said
to be preceded or followed by a second element B
if A and B
have the same parent node and there are no other element nodes or Text
nodes (other than inter-element
whitespace) between them. Similarly, a node is the only child
of an element if that element contains no other nodes other than inter-element
whitespace, comment nodes та processing instruction nodes.
Authors must not use HTML elements anywhere except where they are explicitly allowed, as defined for each element, or as explicitly required by other specifications. For XML compound documents, these contexts could be inside elements from other namespaces, if those elements are defined as providing the relevant contexts.
For example, the Atom specification defines a content
element. When its type
attribute has
the value xhtml
, the Atom
specification requires that it contain a single HTML div
element. Thus, a div
element is allowed in that context, even though this is not explicitly
normatively stated by this specification. [ATOM]
In addition, HTML elements may be orphan nodes (i.e. without a parent node).
For example, creating a td
element and storing it in a global variable in a script is conforming,
even though td
elements are
otherwise only supposed to be used inside tr
elements.
var data = { name: "Banana", cell: document.createElement('td'), };
Each element in HTML falls into zero or more categories that group elements with similar characteristics together. The following broad categories are used in this specification:
Some elements also fall into other categories, which are defined in other parts of this specification.
These categories are related as follows:
Sectioning content, heading content, phrasing content, embedded content та interactive content are all types of flow content. Metadata is sometimes flow content. Metadata and interactive content are sometimes phrasing content. Embedded content is also a type of phrasing content та sometimes is interactive content.
Other categories are also used for specific purposes, e.g. form controls are specified using a number of categories to define common requirements. Some elements have unique requirements and do not fit into any particular category.
Metadata content is content that sets up the presentation or behavior of the rest of the content, or that sets up the relationship of the document with other documents, or that conveys other "out of band" information.
Elements from other namespaces whose semantics are primarily metadata-related (e.g. RDF) are also metadata content.
Thus, in the XML serialization, one can use RDF, like this:
<html xmlns="http://www.w3.org/1999/xhtml" xmlns:r="http://www.w3.org/1999/02/22-rdf-syntax-ns#"> <head> <title>Hedral's Home Page</title> <r:RDF> <Person xmlns="http://www.w3.org/2000/10/swap/pim/contact#" r:about="http://hedral.example.com/#"> <fullName>Cat Hedral</fullName> <mailbox r:resource="mailto:hedral@damowmow.com"/> <personalTitle>Sir</personalTitle> </Person> </r:RDF> </head> <body> <h1>My home page</h1> <p>I like playing with string, I guess. Sister says squirrels are fun too so sometimes I follow her to play with them.</p> </body> </html>
This isn't possible in the HTML serialization, however.
Most elements що є used in the body of documents and applications are кваліфікується as flow content.
a
abbr
address
area
(if it is a
descendant of a map
element)article
aside
audio
b
bdi
bdo
blockquote
br
button
canvas
cite
code
data
datalist
del
dfn
div
dl
em
embed
fieldset
figure
footer
form
h1
h2
h3
h4
h5
h6
header
hr
i
iframe
img
input
ins
kbd
keygen
label
main
map
mark
math
meter
nav
noscript
object
ol
output
p
pre
progress
q
ruby
s
samp
script
section
select
small
span
strong
sub
sup
svg
table
template
textarea
time
u
ul
var
video
wbr
Sectioning content is content that defines the scope of headings and footers.
Each sectioning content element potentially has a heading and an outline. See the section on headings and sections for further details.
There are also certain elements що є sectioning roots. These are distinct from sectioning content, but they can also have an outline.
Heading content defines the header of a section (whether explicitly marked up using sectioning content elements, or implied by the heading content itself).
Phrasing content is the text of the document, as well as elements that mark up that text at the intra-paragraph level. Runs of phrasing content form paragraphs.
a
abbr
area
(if it is a
descendant of a map
element)audio
b
bdi
bdo
br
button
canvas
cite
code
data
datalist
del
dfn
em
embed
i
iframe
img
input
ins
kbd
keygen
label
map
mark
math
meter
noscript
object
output
progress
q
ruby
s
samp
script
select
small
span
strong
sub
sup
svg
template
textarea
time
u
var
video
wbr
Most elements що є кваліфікується as phrasing content can only contain elements що є themselves кваліфікується as phrasing content, not any flow content.
Text, in the
context of content models, means either nothing, or Text
nodes. Text
is sometimes used as a content model on its own, but is also phrasing
content та can be inter-element
whitespace (if the Text
nodes
are empty or contain just space characters).
Text
nodes and attribute values must
consist of Unicode characters, must not contain
U+0000 characters, must not contain permanently undefined Unicode
characters (noncharacters) та must not contain control
characters other than space
characters.
This specification includes extra constraints on the exact value of Text
nodes and attribute values depending on
their precise context.
Embedded content is content that imports another resource into the document, or content from another vocabulary that is inserted into the document.
Elements що є from namespaces other than the простір імен HTML and that convey content but not metadata, are embedded content for the purposes of the content models defined in this specification. (For example, MathML, or SVG.)
Some embedded content elements can have fallback content: content that is to be used when the external resource cannot be used (e.g. because it is of an unsupported format). The element definitions state what the fallback is, if any.
Interactive content is content that is specifically intended for user interaction.
a
audio
(if the controls
attribute is
present)button
embed
iframe
img
(if the usemap
attribute is
present)input
(if the type
attribute is not
in the Hidden
state)keygen
label
object
(if the usemap
attribute is
present)select
textarea
video
(if the controls
attribute is
present)Certain elements in HTML have an activation
behavior, which means that the user can activate them. This triggers
a sequence of events dependent on the activation mechanism та normally
culminating in a click
event, as described below.
The user agent should allow the user to manually trigger elements that have an activation behavior, for instance using keyboard or voice input, or through mouse clicks. When the user triggers an element with a defined activation behavior in a manner other than clicking it, the default action of the interaction event must be to run synthetic click activation steps on the element.
Each element has a click in progress flag, initially set to false.
When a user agent is to run synthetic click activation steps on an element, the user agent must run the following steps:
Якщо the element's click in progress flag is set to true, then abort these steps.
Set the click in progress flag on the element to true.
Run pre-click activation steps on the element.
Fire a click
event at the element. Якщо the run
synthetic click activation steps algorithm was invoked because
the click()
method was invoked, then the isTrusted
attribute must
be initialized to false.
Якщо this click
event is not canceled, run
post-click activation steps on the element.
Якщо the event is canceled, the user agent must run canceled activation steps on the element instead.
Set the click in progress flag on the element to false.
When a pointing device is clicked, the user agent must run these steps:
Якщо the element's click in progress flag is set to true, then abort these steps.
Set the click in progress flag on the element to true.
Нехай e be the nearest activatable element of the element designated by the user (defined below), if any.
Якщо there is an element e, run pre-click activation steps on it.
Dispatch
the required click
event.
Якщо there is an element e and the
click
event is not canceled, run
post-click activation steps on element e.
Якщо there is an element e and the event is canceled, run canceled activation steps on element e.
Set the click in progress flag on the element to false.
The algorithms above don't run for arbitrary synthetic
events dispatched by author script. The click()
method can be used to make the
run synthetic click
activation steps algorithm happen programmatically.
Click-focusing behavior (e.g. the focusing of a text field when user clicks in one) typically happens before the click, when the mouse button is first depressed та is therefore not discussed here.
Given an element target, the nearest activatable element is the element returned by the following algorithm:
Якщо target has a defined activation behavior, then return target and abort these steps.
Якщо target has a parent element, then set target to that parent element and return to the first step.
Інакше there is no nearest activatable element.
When a user agent is to run pre-click activation steps on an element, it must run the pre-click activation steps defined for that element, if any.
When a user agent is to run canceled activation steps on an element, it must run the canceled activation steps defined for that element, if any.
When a user agent is to run
post-click activation steps on an element, it must run the activation behavior defined for that
element, if any. Activation behaviors can refer to the click
event that was fired by the
steps above leading up to this point.
As a general rule, elements whose content model allows any flow
content or phrasing content
should have at least one node in its contents that is palpable
content and that does not have the hidden
attribute specified.
This requirement is not a hard requirement, however, as there are many cases where an element can be empty legitimately, for example when it is used as a placeholder which will later be filled in by a script, or when the element is part of a template and would on most pages be filled in but on some pages is not relevant.
Conformance checkers are encouraged to provide a mechanism for authors to find elements that fail to fulfill this requirement, as an authoring aid.
The following elements are palpable content:
a
abbr
address
article
aside
audio
(if the controls
attribute is
present)b
bdi
bdo
blockquote
button
canvas
cite
code
data
dfn
div
dl
(if the element's
children include at least one name-value group)em
embed
fieldset
figure
footer
form
h1
h2
h3
h4
h5
h6
header
i
iframe
img
input
(if the type
attribute is not
in the Hidden
state)ins
kbd
keygen
label
main
map
mark
math
meter
nav
object
ol
(if the element's
children include at least one li
element)output
p
pre
progress
q
ruby
s
samp
section
select
small
span
strong
sub
sup
svg
table
textarea
time
u
ul
(if the element's
children include at least one li
element)var
video
Script-supporting elements are those that do not represent anything themselves (i.e. they are not rendered), but are used to support scripts, e.g. to provide functionality for the user.
The following elements are script-supporting elements:
Some elements are described as transparent; they have "transparent" in the description of their content model. The content model of a transparent element is derived from the content model of its parent element: the elements required in the part of the content model that is "transparent" are the same elements as required in the part of the content model of the parent of the transparent element in which the transparent element finds itself.
For instance, an ins
element inside a ruby
element cannot contain an rt
element, because the part of the ruby
element's content model that allows ins
elements is the part that allows phrasing
content та the rt
element is not phrasing content.
In some cases, where transparent elements are nested in each other, the process has to be applied iteratively.
Consider the following markup fragment:
<p><object><param><ins><map><a href="/">Apples</a></map></ins></object></p>
To check whether "Apples" is allowed inside the a
element, the content models are examined. The a
element's content model is transparent, as is the map
element's, as is the ins
element's, as is the part of the object
element's in which the ins
element is found. The object
element is found in the p
element, whose content model is phrasing
content. Thus, "Apples" is allowed, as text is phrasing content.
When a transparent element has no parent, then the part of its content model that is "transparent" must instead be treated as accepting any flow content.
The term paragraph as defined in
this section is used for more than just the definition of the p
element. The paragraph concept defined here is
used to describe how to interpret documents. The p
element is merely one of several ways of marking up a paragraph.
A paragraph is typically a run of phrasing content that forms a block of text with one or more sentences that discuss a particular topic, as in typography, but can also be used for more general thematic grouping. For instance, an address is also a paragraph, as is a part of a form, a byline, or a stanza in a poem.
In the following example, there are two paragraphs in a section. There is also a heading, which contains phrasing content that is not a paragraph. Note how the comments and inter-element whitespace do not form paragraphs.
<section> <h1>Example of paragraphs</h1> This is the <em>first</em> paragraph in this example. <p>This is the second.</p> <!-- This is not a paragraph. --> </section>
Paragraphs in flow content are defined
relative to what the document looks like without the a
,
ins
, del
та map
elements complicating
matters, since those elements, with their hybrid content models, can
straddle paragraph boundaries, as shown in the first two examples below.
Generally, having elements straddle paragraph boundaries is best avoided. Maintaining such markup can be difficult.
The following example takes the markup from the earlier example and
puts ins
and del
elements around some of the markup to show that the text was changed
(though in this case, the changes admittedly don't make much sense).
Notice how this example has exactly the same paragraphs as the previous
one, despite the ins
and del
elements — the ins
element straddles the heading and the first paragraph та the del
element straddles the boundary between the two paragraphs.
<section> <ins><h1>Example of paragraphs</h1> This is the <em>first</em> paragraph in</ins> this example<del>. <p>This is the second.</p></del> <!-- This is not a paragraph. --> </section>
Нехай view be a view of the DOM that
replaces all a
, ins
,
del
та map
elements in the document with their contents. Then, in view,
for each run of sibling phrasing content
nodes uninterrupted by other types of content, in an element that
accepts content other than phrasing
content as well as phrasing content,
let first be the first node of the run
та let last be the last node of the run.
For each such run that consists of at least one node that is neither embedded content nor inter-element
whitespace, a paragraph exists in the original DOM from
immediately before first to immediately
after last. (Paragraphs can thus span
across a
, ins
,
del
та map
elements.)
Conformance checkers may warn authors of cases where they have
paragraphs that overlap each other (this can happen with object
,
video
, audio
та canvas
elements та
indirectly through elements in other namespaces that allow HTML to be
further embedded therein, like svg
or
math
).
A paragraph is also formed explicitly by p
elements.
The p
element can
be used to wrap individual paragraphs when there would otherwise not be
any content other than phrasing content to separate the paragraphs from
each other.
In the following example, the link spans half of the first paragraph, all of the heading separating the two paragraphs та half of the second paragraph. It straddles the paragraphs and the heading.
<header> Welcome! <a href="about.html"> This is home of... <h1>The Falcons!</h1> The Lockheed Martin multirole jet fighter aircraft! </a> This page discusses the F-16 Fighting Falcon's innermost secrets. </header>
Here is another way of marking this up, this time showing the paragraphs explicitly та splitting the one link element into three:
<header> <p>Welcome! <a href="about.html">This is home of...</a></p> <h1><a href="about.html">The Falcons!</a></h1> <p><a href="about.html">The Lockheed Martin multirole jet fighter aircraft!</a> This page discusses the F-16 Fighting Falcon's innermost secrets.</p> </header>
It is possible for paragraphs to overlap when using certain elements that define fallback content. For example, in the following section:
<section> <h1>My Cats</h1> You can play with my cat simulator. <object data="cats.sim"> To see the cat simulator, use one of the following links: <ul> <li><a href="cats.sim">Download simulator file</a> <li><a href="http://sims.example.com/watch?v=LYds5xY4INU">Use online simulator</a> </ul> Alternatively, upgrade to the Mellblom Browser. </object> I'm quite proud of it. </section>
There are five paragraphs:
object
element.The first paragraph is overlapped by the other four. A user agent that supports the "cats.sim" resource will only show the first one, but a user agent that shows the fallback will confusingly show the first sentence of the first paragraph as if it was in the same paragraph as the second one та will show the last paragraph as if it was at the start of the second sentence of the first paragraph.
To avoid this confusion, explicit p
elements can be used. For example:
<section> <h1>My Cats</h1> <p>You can play with my cat simulator.</p> <object data="cats.sim"> <p>To see the cat simulator, use one of the following links:</p> <ul> <li><a href="cats.sim">Download simulator file</a> <li><a href="http://sims.example.com/watch?v=LYds5xY4INU">Use online simulator</a> </ul> <p>Alternatively, upgrade to the Mellblom Browser.</p> </object> <p>I'm quite proud of it.</p> </section>
The following attributes are common to and may be specified on all HTML elements (even those not defined in this specification):
These attributes are only defined by this specification as attributes for HTML elements. When this specification refers to elements having these attributes, elements from namespaces що є not defined as having these attributes must not be considered as being elements with these attributes.
For example, in the following XML fragment, the "bogus
"
element does not have a dir
attribute as defined in this specification, despite having an
attribute with the literal name "dir
".
Thus, the directionality of the
inner-most span
element
is 'rtl',
inherited from the div
element indirectly through the "bogus
"
element.
<div xmlns="http://www.w3.org/1999/xhtml" dir="rtl"> <bogus xmlns="http://example.net/ns" dir="ltr"> <span xmlns="http://www.w3.org/1999/xhtml"> </span> </bogus> </div>
To enable assistive technology products to expose a more fine-grained
interface than is otherwise possible with HTML elements and attributes, a
set of annotations for
assistive technology products can be specified (the ARIA role
and aria-*
attributes). [ARIA]
The following event handler content attributes may be specified on any HTML element:
onabort
onblur
*oncancel
oncanplay
oncanplaythrough
onchange
onclick
oncuechange
ondblclick
ondurationchange
onemptied
onended
onerror
*onfocus
*oninput
oninvalid
onkeydown
onkeypress
onkeyup
onload
*onloadeddata
onloadedmetadata
onloadstart
onmousedown
onmouseenter
onmouseleave
onmousemove
onmouseout
onmouseover
onmouseup
onmousewheel
onpause
onplay
onplaying
onprogress
onratechange
onreset
onresize
*onscroll
*onseeked
onseeking
onselect
onshow
onstalled
onsubmit
onsuspend
ontimeupdate
ontoggle
onvolumechange
onwaiting
The attributes marked with an asterisk have a different
meaning when specified on body
elements as those elements expose event
handlers of the Window
object
with the same names.
While these attributes apply to all elements, they are not
useful on all elements. For example, only media elements will ever receive a volumechange
event fired
by the user agent.
Custom
data attributes (e.g. data-foldername
or data-msgid
) can be specified on any HTML element,
to store custom data specific to the page.
In HTML documents, elements in the простір
імен HTML may have an xmlns
attribute specified, if та only if, it has the exact value "http://www.w3.org/1999/xhtml
".
This does not apply to XML documents.
In HTML, the xmlns
attribute has absolutely no effect. It is basically a talisman. It is
allowed merely to make migration to and from XHTML mildly easier. When
parsed by an HTML parser, the attribute ends
up in no namespace, not the "http://www.w3.org/2000/xmlns/
"
namespace like namespace declaration attributes in XML do.
In XML, an xmlns
attribute
is part of the namespace declaration mechanism та an element cannot
actually have an xmlns
attribute in no
namespace specified.
The XML specification also allows the use of the xml:space
attribute in the XML namespace on any
element in an XML
document. This attribute has no effect on HTML
elements, as the default behavior in HTML is to preserve whitespace.
[XML]
There is no way to serialize the xml:space
attribute on HTML elements in the text/html
syntax.
id
attributeThe id
attribute specifies its element's unique
identifier (ID). [DOM]
The value must be unique amongst all the IDs in the element's home subtree and must contain at least one character. The value must not contain any space characters.
There are no other restrictions on what form an ID can take; in particular, IDs can consist of just digits, start with a digit, start with an underscore, consist of just punctuation, etc.
An element's unique identifier can be used for a variety of purposes, most notably as a way to link to specific parts of a document using fragment identifiers, as a way to target an element when scripting та as a way to style a specific element from CSS.
Identifiers are opaque strings. Particular meanings should not be
derived from the value of the id
attribute.
title
attributeThe title
attribute represents advisory information for
the element, such as would be appropriate for a tooltip. On a link, this
could be the title or a description of the target resource; on an image,
it could be the image credit or a description of the image; on a
paragraph, it could be a footnote or commentary on the text; on a
citation, it could be further information about the source; on interactive
content, it could be a label for, or instructions for, use of the
element; and so forth. The value is text.
Relying on the title
attribute is currently discouraged as many user agents do not expose the
attribute in an accessible manner as required by this specification (e.g.
requiring a pointing device such as a mouse to cause a tooltip to appear,
which excludes keyboard-only users and touch-only users, such as anyone
with a modern phone or tablet).
Якщо this attribute is omitted from an element, then it implies that the
title
attribute of the nearest ancestor HTML
element with a title
attribute set is also relevant to this element. Setting the attribute
overrides this, explicitly stating that the advisory information of any
ancestors is not relevant to this element. Setting the attribute to the
empty string indicates that the element has no advisory information.
Якщо the title
attribute's value contains "LF" (U+000A) characters, the content is split
into multiple lines. Each "LF" (U+000A) character represents a line break.
Caution is advised with respect to the use of newlines in title
attributes.
For instance, the following snippet actually defines an abbreviation's expansion with a line break in it:
<p>My logs show that there was some interest in <abbr title="Hypertext Transport Protocol">HTTP</abbr> today.</p>
Some elements, such as link
,
abbr
та input
,
define additional semantics for the title
attribute beyond the semantics
described above.
The advisory information of an element is the value that the following algorithm returns, with the algorithm being aborted once a value is returned. When the algorithm returns the empty string, then there is no advisory information.
Якщо the element is a link
,
style
, dfn
,
or abbr
element, then:
if the element has a title
attribute,
return the value of that attribute,
otherwise, return the empty string.
Інакше if the element has a title
attribute, then return its
value.
Інакше if the element has a parent element, then return the parent element's advisory information.
Інакше return the empty string.
User agents should inform the user when elements have advisory information, otherwise the information would not be discoverable.
The title
IDL attribute must reflect the title
content attribute.
lang
and xml:lang
attributesThe lang
attribute (in no namespace) specifies the primary language for the
element's contents and for any of the element's attributes that contain
text. Its value must be a valid BCP 47 language tag, or the empty string.
Setting the attribute to the empty string indicates that the primary
language is unknown. [BCP47]
The lang
attribute in the XML namespace is defined in
XML. [XML]
Якщо these attributes are omitted from an element, then the language of this element is the same as the language of its parent element, if any.
The lang
attribute in no namespace may be used on any HTML element.
The lang
attribute in the XML namespace may be used on HTML
elements in XML documents, as well as
elements in other namespaces if the relevant specifications allow it (in
particular, MathML and SVG allow lang
attributes in the XML namespace
to be specified on their elements). Якщо both the lang
attribute in no namespace and the lang
attribute in the XML namespace are specified on the
same element, they must have exactly the same value when compared in an ASCII чутливі до реєстру manner.
Authors must not use the lang
attribute in
the XML namespace on HTML
elements in HTML documents. To ease
migration to and from XHTML, authors may specify an attribute in no
namespace with no prefix and with the literal localname "xml:lang
"
on HTML elements in HTML
documents, but such attributes must only be specified if a lang
attribute in no namespace is also
specified та both attributes must have the same value when compared in an
ASCII чутливі до реєстру manner.
The attribute in no namespace with no prefix and with the
literal localname "xml:lang
" has no
effect on language processing.
To determine the language of a node, user
agents must look at the nearest ancestor element (including the element
itself if the node is an element) that has a lang
attribute
in the XML namespace set or is an HTML element and has a lang
in no namespace attribute set.
That attribute specifies the language of the node (regardless of its
value).
Якщо both the lang
attribute in no namespace and the lang
attribute in the XML
namespace are set on an element, user agents must use the
lang
attribute in the XML namespace та the lang
attribute in no namespace must be
ignored for the purposes
of determining the element's language.
Якщо neither the node nor any of the node's ancestors, including the root element, have either attribute set, but there is a pragma-set default language set, then that is the language of the node. Якщо there is no pragma-set default language set, then language information from a higher-level protocol (such as HTTP), if any, must be used as the final fallback language instead. In the absence of any such language information та in cases where the higher-level protocol reports multiple languages, the language of the node is unknown та the corresponding language tag is the empty string.
Якщо the resulting value is not a recognized language tag, then it must be treated as an unknown language having the given language tag, distinct from all other languages. For the purposes of round-tripping or communicating with other services that expect language tags, user agents should pass unknown language tags through unmodified та tagged as being BCP 47 language tags, so that subsequent services do not interpret the data as another type of language description. [BCP47]
Thus, for instance, an element with lang="xyzzy"
would be matched by the selector :lang(xyzzy)
(e.g. in CSS), but it would not be matched by :lang(abcde)
,
even though both are equally invalid. Similarly, if a Web browser and
screen reader working in unison communicated about the language of the
element, the browser would tell the screen reader that the language was
"xyzzy", even if it knew it was invalid, just in case the screen reader
actually supported a language with that tag after all. Even if the
screen reader supported both BCP 47 and another syntax for encoding
language names та in that other syntax the string "xyzzy" was a way to
denote the Belarusian language, it would be incorrect for the
screen reader to then start treating text as Belarusian, because "xyzzy"
is not how Belarusian is described in BCP 47 codes (BCP 47 uses the code
"be" for Belarusian).
Якщо the resulting value is the empty string, then it must be interpreted as meaning that the language of the node is explicitly unknown.
User agents may use the element's language to determine proper processing or rendering (e.g. in the selection of appropriate fonts or pronunciations, for dictionary selection, or for the user interfaces of form controls such as date pickers).
The lang
IDL attribute must reflect the lang
content attribute in no namespace.
translate
attributeThe translate
attribute is an enumerated attribute
that is used to specify whether an element's attribute values and the
values of its Text
node children are
to be translated when the page is localized, or whether to leave them
unchanged.
The attribute's keywords are the empty string, yes
та no
. The empty string and the yes
keyword map to the yes state. The no
keyword maps to the no state. In addition, there is a third state,
the inherit state, which is the missing value default (and
the invalid value default).
Each element (even non-HTML elements) has a translation
mode, which is in either the translate-enabled
state or the no-translate state. Якщо an HTML element's
translate
attribute is in the yes state, then the element's translation
mode is in the translate-enabled
state; otherwise, if the element's translate
attribute is in the no
state, then the element's translation mode
is in the no-translate state. Інакше either
the element's translate
attribute is in the inherit state, or the element is not an HTML element and thus does not have a translate
attribute; in either case,
the element's translation mode is in the
same state as its parent element's, if any, or in the translate-enabled
state, if the element is a root element.
When an element is in the translate-enabled
state, the element's translatable
attributes and the values of its Text
node children are to be translated when the page is localized. Attributes
of the element що є not listed as translatable
attributes should not be translated.
When an element is in the no-translate
state, the element's attribute values (including the values of translatable
attributes) and the values of its Text
node children are to be left as-is when the page is localized, e.g.
because the element contains a person's name or a the name of a computer
program.
The following attributes are translatable attributes:
abbr
on th
elementsalt
on area
, img
та input
elementscontent
on meta
elements, if the name
attribute specifies a metadata name whose value is known to be
translatabledownload
on a
and area
elementslabel
on optgroup
, option
та track
elementslang
on HTML elements; must be "translated" to
match the language used in the translationplaceholder
on input
and textarea
elementssrcdoc
on iframe
elements; must
be parsed and recursively processedstyle
on HTML elements; must be parsed and
recursively processed (e.g. for the values of 'content' properties)title
on all HTML elementsvalue
on input
elements with a
type
attribute in the Button
state or the Reset
Button stateThe translate
IDL attribute must, on getting, return true if the element's translation
mode is translate-enabled та
false otherwise. On setting, it must set the content attribute's value
to "yes
" if the new value є true та set
the content attribute's value to "no
"
otherwise.
In this example, everything in the document is to be translated when the page is localized, except the sample keyboard input and sample program output:
<!DOCTYPE HTML> <html> <!-- default on the root element is translate=yes --> <head> <title>The Bee Game</title> <!-- implied translate=yes inherited from ancestors --> </head> <body> <p>The Bee Game is a text adventure game in English.</p> <p>When the game launches, the first thing you should do is type <kbd translate=no>eat honey</kbd>. The game will respond with:</p> <pre><samp translate=no>Yum yum! That was some good honey!</samp></pre> </body> </html>
xml:base
attribute (XML only)The xml:base
attribute is defined in XML Base. [XMLBASE]
The xml:base
attribute may be used on HTML elements of XML documents. Authors must not use the xml:base
attribute on HTML elements in HTML
documents.
dir
attributeThe dir
attribute specifies the element's text directionality. The attribute is an
enumerated attribute with the
following keywords and states:
ltr
keyword, which maps to the ltr
stateIndicates that the contents of the element are explicitly directionally isolated left-to-right text.
rtl
keyword, which maps to the rtl
stateIndicates that the contents of the element are explicitly directionally isolated right-to-left text.
auto
keyword, which maps to the auto stateIndicates that the contents of the element are explicitly directionally isolated text, but that the direction is to be determined programmatically using the contents of the element (as described below).
The heuristic used by this state is very crude (it just looks at the first character with a strong directionality, in a manner analogous to the Paragraph Level determination in the bidirectional algorithm). Authors are urged to only use this value as a last resort when the direction of the text is truly unknown and no better server-side heuristic can be applied. [BIDI]
For textarea
and pre
elements, the
heuristic is applied on a per-paragraph level.
The attribute has no invalid value default and no missing value default.
The directionality of an element (any element, not just an HTML element) is either 'ltr' or 'rtl' та is determined as per the first appropriate set of steps from the following list:
dir
attribute is in the ltr
statedir
attribute is not in a defined state (i.e. it is not present or has an
invalid value)input
element whose type
attribute is in the Telephone
state та the dir
attribute is not in a defined state (i.e. it is not present or has an
invalid value)The directionality of the element is 'ltr'.
dir
attribute is in the rtl
stateThe directionality of the element is 'rtl'.
input
element whose type
attribute is in the Text,
Search,
Telephone,
URL,
or E-mail
state та the dir
attribute is in the auto
statetextarea
element and the dir
attribute is in the auto
stateЯкщо the element's value contains a character of bidirectional character type AL or R та there is no character of bidirectional character type L anywhere before it in the element's value, then the directionality of the element is 'rtl'. [BIDI]
Інакше if the element's value is not the empty string, or if the element is a root element, the directionality of the element is 'ltr'.
Інакше the directionality of the element is the same as the element's parent element's directionality.
dir
attribute is in the auto
statebdi
element and the dir
attribute is not in a defined state (i.e. it is not present or has an
invalid value)Find the first character in tree order that matches the following criteria:
The character is from a Text
node that is a descendant of the element whose directionality is being
determined.
The character is of bidirectional character type L, AL, or R. [BIDI]
The character is not in a Text
node that has an ancestor element that is a descendant of the
element whose directionality
is being determined and that is either:
Якщо such a character is found and it is of bidirectional character type AL or R, the directionality of the element is 'rtl'.
Якщо such a character is found and it is of bidirectional character type L, the directionality of the element is 'ltr'.
Інакше if the element is empty and is not a root element, the directionality of the element is the same as the element's parent element's directionality.
Інакше the directionality of the element is 'ltr'.
dir
attribute is not in a
defined state (i.e. it is not present or has an invalid value)The directionality of the element is the same as the element's parent element's directionality.
Since the dir
attribute is only defined for HTML elements,
it cannot be present on elements from other namespaces. Thus, elements
from other namespaces always just inherit their directionality from their
parent element, or, if they don't have one, default to 'ltr'.
This attribute has rendering requirements involving the bidirectional algorithm.
The directionality of an attribute of an HTML element, which is used when the text of that attribute is to be included in the rendering in some manner, is determined as per the first appropriate set of steps from the following list:
dir
attribute is in the auto stateFind the first character (in logical order) of the attribute's value that is of bidirectional character type L, AL, or R. [BIDI]
Якщо such a character is found and it is of bidirectional character type AL or R, the directionality of the attribute is 'rtl'.
Інакше the directionality of the attribute is 'ltr'.
The following attributes are directionality-capable attributes:
abbr
on th
elementsalt
on area
, img
та input
elementscontent
on meta
elements, if the name
attribute specifies a metadata name whose value is primarily intended to
be human-readable rather than machine-readablelabel
on optgroup
, option
та track
elementsplaceholder
on input
and textarea
elementstitle
on all HTML elementsdir
[ = value
]Returns the html
element's
dir
attribute's value, if any.
Can be set, to either "ltr
", "rtl
", or "auto
"
to replace the html
element's dir
attribute's value.
Якщо there is no html
element, returns the empty string and ignores new values.
The dir
IDL attribute on an element must reflect the dir
content attribute of that element, limited
to only known values.
The dir
IDL attribute on Document
objects
must reflect the dir
content attribute of the
html
element, if any, limited
to only known values. Якщо there is no such element, then the
attribute must return the empty string and do nothing on setting.
Authors are strongly encouraged to use the dir
attribute to indicate text
direction rather than using CSS, since that way their documents will
continue to render correctly even in the absence of CSS (e.g. as
interpreted by search engines).
This markup fragment is of an IM conversation.
<p dir=auto class="u1"><b><bdi>Student</bdi>:</b> How do you write "What's your name?" in Arabic?</p> <p dir=auto class="u2"><b><bdi>Teacher</bdi>:</b> ما اسمك؟</p> <p dir=auto class="u1"><b><bdi>Student</bdi>:</b> Thanks.</p> <p dir=auto class="u2"><b><bdi>Teacher</bdi>:</b> That's written "شكرًا".</p> <p dir=auto class="u2"><b><bdi>Teacher</bdi>:</b> Do you know how to write "Please"?</p> <p dir=auto class="u1"><b><bdi>Student</bdi>:</b> "من فضلك", right?</p>
Given a suitable style sheet and the default alignment styles for the p
element, namely to align the text
to the start edge of the paragraph, the resulting rendering
could be as follows:
As noted earlier, the auto
value is not a panacea. The final paragraph in this example is
misinterpreted as being right-to-left text, since it begins with an
Arabic character, which causes the "right?" to be to the left of the
Arabic text.
class
attributeEvery HTML
element may have a class
attribute specified.
The attribute, if specified, must have a value that is a set of space-separated tokens representing the various classes that the element belongs to.
The classes that an HTML
element has assigned to it consists of all the classes returned
when the value of the class
attribute is split
on spaces. (Duplicates are ignored.)
Assigning classes to an element affects class matching in
selectors in CSS, the getElementsByClassName()
method in the DOM та other such features.
There are no additional restrictions on the tokens authors can use in the
class
attribute, but authors are encouraged to use values that describe the
nature of the content, rather than values that describe the desired
presentation of the content.
The className
and classList
IDL attributes, defined in the DOM specification, reflect
the class
content attribute. [DOM]
style
attributeAll HTML elements may have the style
content attribute set.
This is a CSS styling attribute as
defined by the CSS Styling Attribute Syntax specification. [CSSATTR]
In user agents that support CSS, the attribute's value must be parsed when the attribute is added or has its value changed, according to the rules given for CSS styling attributes. [CSSATTR]
Documents that use style
attributes on any of their elements must still be comprehensible and
usable if those attributes were removed.
In particular, using the style
attribute to hide and
show content, or to convey meaning that is otherwise not included in the
document, is non-conforming. (To hide and show content, use the hidden
attribute.)
style
Returns a CSSStyleDeclaration
object for the element's style
attribute.
The style
IDL attribute is defined in the CSS Object Model (CSSOM) specification.
[CSSOM]
In the following example, the words that refer to colors are marked up
using the span
element and
the style
attribute to make those words show up in the relevant colors in visual
media.
<p>My sweat suit is <span style="color: green; background: transparent">green</span> and my eyes are <span style="color: blue; background: transparent">blue</span>.</p>
data-*
attributesA custom data attribute is an
attribute in no namespace whose name starts with the string "data-
", has at least one character
after the hyphen, is XML-compatible та
contains no uppercase ASCII letters.
All attribute names on HTML elements in HTML documents get нижиній реєстр ASCIId automatically, so the restriction on ASCII uppercase letters doesn't affect such documents.
Custom data attributes are intended to store custom data private to the page or application, for which there are no more appropriate attributes or elements.
These attributes are not intended for use by software that is independent of the site that uses the attributes.
For instance, a site about music could annotate list items representing tracks in an album with custom data attributes containing the length of each track. This information could then be used by the site itself to allow the user to sort the list by track length, or to filter the list for tracks of certain lengths.
<ol> <li data-length="2m11s">Beyond The Sea</li> ... </ol>
It would be inappropriate, however, for the user to use generic software not associated with that music site to search for tracks of a certain length by looking at this data.
This is because these attributes are intended for use by the site's own scripts та are not a generic extension mechanism for publicly-usable metadata.
Every HTML element may have any number of custom data attributes specified, with any value.
dataset
Returns a DOMStringMap
object for the element's data-*
attributes.
Hyphenated names become camel-cased. For example, data-foo-bar=""
becomes element.dataset.fooBar
.
The dataset
IDL attribute provides convenient accessors for all the data-*
attributes on an element. On
getting, the dataset
IDL attribute must return a DOMStringMap
object, associated with the following algorithms, which expose these
attributes on their element:
data-
"
and whose remaining characters (if any) do not include any uppercase
ASCII letters, in the order that those attributes are listed
in the element's attribute list,
add a name-value pair to list
whose name is the attribute's name with the first five characters
removed and whose value is the attribute's value.SyntaxError
exception and abort these steps.data-
at the
front of name.setAttribute()
would have thrown an exception when setting an attribute with the
name name, then this must throw
the same exception.data-
at the
front of name.This algorithm will only get invoked by the WebIDL specification for names що є given by the earlier algorithm for getting the list of name-value pairs. [WEBIDL]
The same object must be returned each time.
Якщо a Web page wanted an element to represent a space ship, e.g. as
part of a game, it would have to use the class
attribute along with data-*
attributes:
<div class="spaceship" data-ship-id="92432" data-weapons="laser 2" data-shields="50%" data-x="30" data-y="10" data-z="90"> <button class="fire" onclick="spaceships[this.parentNode.dataset.shipId].fire()"> Fire </button> </div>
Notice how the hyphenated attribute name becomes camel-cased in the API.
Authors should carefully design such extensions so that when the attributes are ignored and any associated CSS dropped, the page is still usable.
User agents must not derive any implementation behavior from these attributes or values. Specifications intended for user agents must not define these attributes to have any meaningful values.
JavaScript libraries may use the custom data attributes, as they are considered to be part of the page on which they are used. Authors of libraries що є reused by many authors are encouraged to include their name in the attribute names, to reduce the risk of clashes. Where it makes sense, library authors are also encouraged to make the exact name used in the attribute names customizable, so that libraries whose authors unknowingly picked the same name can be used on the same page та so that multiple versions of a particular library can be used on the same page even when those versions are not mutually compatible.
For example, a library called "DoQuery" could use attribute names like
data-doquery-range
та a library called
"jJo" could use attributes names like data-jjo-range
.
The jJo library could also provide an API to set which prefix to use
(e.g. J.setDataPrefix('j2')
, making
the attributes have names like data-j2-range
).
Text content in HTML
elements with Text
nodes in
their contents
та text in attributes of HTML elements that
allow free-form text, may contain characters in the ranges U+202A to
U+202E and U+2066 to U+2069 (the bidirectional-algorithm formatting
characters). However, the use of these characters is restricted so that
any embedding or overrides generated by these characters do not start and
end with different parent elements та so that all such embeddings and
overrides are explicitly terminated by a U+202C POP DIRECTIONAL FORMATTING
character. This helps reduce incidences of text being reused in a manner
that has unforeseen effects on the bidirectional algorithm. [BIDI]
The aforementioned restrictions are defined by specifying that certain parts of documents form bidirectional-algorithm formatting character ranges та then imposing a requirement on such ranges.
The strings resulting from applying the following algorithm to an HTML element element are bidirectional-algorithm formatting character ranges:
Нехай output be an empty list of strings.
Нехай string be an empty string.
Нехай node be the first child node of element, if any, or null otherwise.
Loop: Якщо node is null, jump to the step labeled end.
Process node according to the first matching step from the following list:
Text
nodeAppend the text data of node to string.
br
elementЯкщо string is not the empty string, push string onto output та let string be empty string.
Нехай node be node's next sibling, if any, or null otherwise.
Jump to the step labeled loop.
End: Якщо string is not the empty string, push string onto output.
Повернутиoutput as the bidirectional-algorithm formatting character ranges.
The value of a namespace-less attribute of an HTML element is a bidirectional-algorithm formatting character range.
Any strings that, as described above, are bidirectional-algorithm
formatting character ranges must match the string
production in the following ABNF, the character set for which is Unicode.
[ABNF]
string = *( plaintext ( embedding / override / isolation ) ) plaintext embedding = ( lre / rle ) string pdf override = ( lro / rlo ) string pdf isolation = ( lri / rli / fsi ) string pdi lre = %x202A ; U+202A LEFT-TO-RIGHT EMBEDDING rle = %x202B ; U+202B RIGHT-TO-LEFT EMBEDDING lro = %x202D ; U+202D LEFT-TO-RIGHT OVERRIDE rlo = %x202E ; U+202E RIGHT-TO-LEFT OVERRIDE pdf = %x202C ; U+202C POP DIRECTIONAL FORMATTING lri = %x2066 ; U+2066 LEFT-TO-RIGHT ISOLATE rli = %x2067 ; U+2067 RIGHT-TO-LEFT ISOLATE fsi = %x2068 ; U+2068 FIRST STRONG ISOLATE pdi = %x2069 ; U+2069 POP DIRECTIONAL ISOLATE plaintext = *( %x0000-2029 / %x202F-2065 / %x206A-10FFFF ) ; any string with no bidirectional-algorithm formatting characters
While the U+2069 POP DIRECTIONAL ISOLATE character implicitly also ends open embeddings and overrides, text that relies on this implicit scope closure is not conforming to this specification. All strings of embeddings, overrides та isolations need to be explicitly terminated to conform to this section's requirements.
Authors are encouraged to use the dir
attribute, the bdo
element та the bdi
element,
rather than maintaining the bidirectional-algorithm formatting characters
manually. The bidirectional-algorithm formatting characters interact
poorly with CSS.
User agents must implement the Unicode bidirectional algorithm to determine the proper ordering of characters when rendering documents and parts of documents. [BIDI]
The mapping of HTML to the Unicode bidirectional algorithm must be done in one of three ways. Either the user agent must implement CSS, including in particular the CSS 'unicode-bidi', 'direction' та 'content' properties та must have, in its user agent style sheet, the rules using those properties given in this specification's rendering section, or, alternatively, the user agent must act as if it implemented just the aforementioned properties and had a user agent style sheet that included all the aforementioned rules, but without letting style sheets specified in documents override them, or, alternatively, the user agent must implement another styling language with equivalent semantics. [CSSWM] [CSSGC]
The following elements and attributes have requirements defined by the rendering section that, due to the requirements in this section, are requirements on all user agents (not just those that support the suggested default rendering):
Authors are encouraged to make use of the following documents for guidance on using ARIA in HTML beyond that which is provided in this section:
Authors may use the ARIA role
and aria-*
attributes on HTML elements, in accordance
with the requirements described in the ARIA specifications, except where
these conflict with the strong native
semantics
described below. These exceptions are intended to prevent
authors from making assistive technology products report nonsensical
states that do not represent the actual state of the document. [ARIA]
User agents are required to implement ARIA semantics on all HTML elements, as defined in the ARIA specifications. The default implicit ARIA semantics defined below must be recognized by implementations for the purposes of ARIA processing. [ARIAIMPL]
The ARIA attributes defined in the ARIA specifications та the strong native semantics and default implicit ARIA semantics defined below, do not have any effect on CSS pseudo-class matching, user interface modalities that don't use assistive technologies, or the default actions of user interaction events as described in this specification.
Every HTML element may have an ARIA role
attribute specified. This is an
ARIA Role attribute as defined by [ARIA] Section
5.4 Definition of Roles.
The attribute, if specified, must have a value that is a set of space-separated tokens representing the various WAI-ARIA roles that the element belongs to.
The WAI-ARIA role that an HTML element has assigned to it is the first
non-abstract role found in the list of values generated when the role
attribute is split on spaces.
Every HTML element may have ARIA state and property attributes specified. These attributes are defined by [ARIA] in Section 6.6, Definitions of States and Properties (all aria-* attributes).
A subset of the ARIA State and Property attributes are defined as "Global States and Properties" in Section 6.4. Global States and Properties of the [ARIA] Specification.
These attributes, if specified, must have a value that is the ARIA value type in the "Value" field of the definition for the state or property, mapped to the appropriate HTML value type according to [ARIA] Section 10.2 Mapping WAI-ARIA Value types to languages using the HTML 5 mapping.
ARIA State and Property attributes can be used on any element. They are not always meaningful, however та in such cases user agents might not perform any processing aside from including them in the DOM. State and property attributes are processed according to the requirements of the sections Strong Native Semantics and Implicit ARIA semantics, as well as [ARIA] and [ARIAIMPL].
The following table defines the strong native semantics and corresponding default implicit ARIA semantics that apply to HTML elements. Each language feature (element or attribute) in a cell in the first column implies the ARIA semantics (any role, states та properties) given in the cell in the second column of the same row. When multiple rows apply to an element, the role from the last row to define a role must be applied та the states and properties from all the rows must be combined.
Documents must not use any role
values with elements in the
following table other than the corresponding role value (if any) as listed
for that element in the second column, or the role
value "presentation
",
if the second column indicates that element's semantics can be removed by
using the "presentation
" role
value.
In the majority of cases setting an
ARIA role
and/or aria-*
attribute that
matches the default implicit
ARIA semantics is unnecessary and not recommended as these
properties are already set by the browser.
Language feature | Strong native semantics and default implicit ARIA semantics |
---|---|
area element that
creates a hyperlink |
link role |
base element |
No role |
datalist element
|
listbox role, with the aria-multiselectable
property set to "false" |
fieldset element
|
group role (semantics may be removed by
using the presentation role) |
footer element that
is not a descendant of an article
or section element.
|
contentinfo role (semantics may be removed
by using the presentation role) |
head element |
No role |
header element that
is not a descendant of an article
or section element.
|
banner role (semantics may be removed by
using the presentation role) |
hr element |
separator role (semantics may be removed by
using the presentation role) |
html element |
No role |
img element whose alt
attribute's value is empty |
presentation role |
input element with a
type
attribute in the Checkbox
state |
aria-checked state set to "mixed" if the
element's indeterminate
IDL attribute є true, or "true" if the element's checkedness є true, or "false"
otherwise |
input element with a
type
attribute in the Color
state |
No role |
input element with a
type
attribute in the Date
state |
No
role, with the aria-readonly property
set to "true" if the element has a readonly attribute |
input element with a
type
attribute in the E-mail
state with no suggestions
source element |
textbox role, with the aria-readonly
property set to "true" if the element has a readonly attribute |
input element with a
type
attribute in the File
Upload state |
No role |
input element with a
type
attribute in the Hidden
state |
No role |
input element with a
type
attribute in the Number
state |
spinbutton role, with the aria-readonly
property set to "true" if the element has a readonly attribute, the aria-valuemax property set to the element's maximum, the aria-valuemin
property set to the element's minimum та, if the result of
applying the rules
for parsing floating-point number values to the element's value
is a number, with the aria-valuenow property
set to that number |
input element with a
type
attribute in the Password
state |
textbox role, with the aria-readonly
property set to "true" if the element has a readonly attribute |
input element with a
type
attribute in the Radio
Button state |
aria-checked state set to "true" if the
element's checkedness
є true, or "false" otherwise |
input element with a
type
attribute in the Range
state |
slider role, with the aria-valuemax
property set to the element's maximum, the aria-valuemin
property set to the element's minimum та the aria-valuenow
property set to the result of applying the rules
for parsing floating-point number values to the element's value,
if that results in a number, or the default value
otherwise |
input element with a
type
attribute in the Reset
Button state |
button role |
input element with a
type
attribute in the Search
state with no suggestions
source element |
textbox role, with the aria-readonly
property set to "true" if the element has a readonly attribute |
input element with a
type
attribute in the Submit
Button state |
button role |
input element with a
type
attribute in the Telephone
state with no suggestions
source element |
textbox role, with the aria-readonly
property set to "true" if the element has a readonly attribute |
input element with a
type
attribute in the Text
state with no suggestions
source element |
textbox role, with the aria-readonly
property set to "true" if the element has a readonly attribute |
input element with a
type
attribute in the Text,
Search,
Telephone,
URL,
or E-mail
states with a suggestions
source element |
combobox role, with the aria-owns
property set to the same value as the list attribute та the aria-readonly property set to "true" if the
element has a readonly
attribute |
input element with a
type
attribute in the Time
state |
No
role, with the aria-readonly property
set to "true" if the element has a readonly attribute |
input element with a
type
attribute in the URL
state with no suggestions
source element |
textbox role, with the aria-readonly
property set to "true" if the element has a readonly attribute |
keygen element |
No role |
label element |
No role |
link element that
creates a hyperlink |
link role
|
main element |
main role (semantics may be removed by using
the presentation role) |
meta element |
No role |
meter element |
No role |
nav element |
navigation role (semantics may be removed by
using the presentation role) |
noscript element
|
No role |
optgroup element
|
No role |
option element that
is in a list
of options or that represents a suggestion in a datalist
element |
option role, with the aria-selected
state set to "true" if the element's selectedness є true, or
"false" otherwise. |
param element |
No role |
progress element
|
progressbar role, with, if the progress bar
is determinate, the aria-valuemax property
set to the maximum value of the progress bar, the aria-valuemin
property set to zero та the aria-valuenow
property set to the current value of the progress bar |
script element |
No role |
select element with
a multiple
attribute |
listbox role, with the aria-multiselectable
property set to "true" |
select element with
no multiple
attribute |
listbox role, with the aria-multiselectable
property set to "false" |
source element |
No role |
style element |
No role |
template element
|
No role |
textarea element
|
textbox role, with the aria-multiline
property set to "true" та the aria-readonly
property set to "true" if the element has a readonly attribute |
title element |
No role |
Element that is disabled | The aria-disabled state set to "true" |
Element that is inert | The aria-disabled state set to "true"
|
Element that is a candidate for constraint validation but that does not satisfy its constraints | The aria-invalid state set to "true" |
Some HTML elements have native semantics that can be overridden. The following table lists these elements and their default implicit ARIA semantics, along with the restrictions that apply to those elements. Each language feature (element or attribute) in a cell in the first column implies, unless otherwise overridden, the ARIA semantic (role, state, or property) given in the cell in the second column of the same row, but this semantic may be overridden under the conditions listed in the cell in the third column of that row.
Language feature | Default implicit ARIA semantic | Restrictions |
---|---|---|
a element that creates a
hyperlink |
link role |
Якщо specified, role must be one of the following: link ,
button , checkbox ,
menuitem , menuitemcheckbox ,menuitemradio ,
option , radio , tab ,
or treeitem |
address element |
No role | Якщо specified, role must be contentinfo |
article element |
article role |
Якщо specified, role must be one of the following: article ,
document , application ,
or main |
aside element |
complementary role |
Якщо specified, role must be one of the following: complementary ,
note , search or presentation |
audio element |
No role | Якщо specified, role must be application |
body element |
document role |
Якщо specified, role must be either document
or application |
button element |
button role |
Якщо specified, role must be one of the following: button ,
link , menuitem , menuitemcheckbox , menuitemradio
or radio |
embed element |
No role | Якщо specified, role must be one of the following: application ,
document , or img
|
h1
element |
No role | Якщо specified, role must be one of the following: heading ,
tab or presentation |
h2
element |
No role | Якщо specified, role must be one of the following: heading ,
tab or presentation |
h3
element |
No role | Якщо specified, role must be one of the following: heading ,
tab or presentation |
h4
element |
No role | Якщо specified, role must be one of the following: heading ,
tab or presentation |
h5
element |
No role | Якщо specified, role must be one of the following: heading ,
tab or presentation |
h6
element |
No role | Якщо specified, role must be one of the following: heading ,
tab or presentation |
iframe element |
No role | Якщо specified, role must be one of the following: application ,
document , img , or presentation |
img element whose alt
attribute's value is absent |
img role |
No restrictions |
img element whose alt
attribute's value is present and not empty |
img role |
No restrictions |
input element with a
type
attribute in the Button
state |
button role |
Якщо specified, role must be one of the following: button ,
link , menuitem , menuitemcheckbox , menuitemradio
or radio |
input element with a
type
attribute in the Checkbox
state |
checkbox role |
Якщо specified, role must be either checkbox
or menuitemcheckbox |
input element with a
type
attribute in the Image
Button state |
button role |
Якщо specified, role must be one of the following: button ,
link , menuitem , menuitemcheckbox , menuitemradio
or radio |
input element with a
type
attribute in the Radio
Button state |
radio role |
Якщо specified, role must be either radio
or menuitemradio |
input , select
or textarea
element with a required attribute |
The aria-required state set to "true" |
Якщо specified, the aria-required state
must be set to "true" |
input , select
or textarea
element without a required attribute |
aria-required set to "false" |
Якщо specified, the aria-required state set
to "true" or "false" |
li element whose parent
is an ol or ul
element |
listitem role |
Якщо specified, role must be one of the following: listitem ,
menuitem , menuitemcheckbox ,
menuitemradio , option ,
radio , tab , treeitem
or presentation |
menu element with a type
attribute in the toolbar
state |
toolbar role |
Якщо specified, role must be one of the following: directory ,
list , listbox , menu ,
menubar , tablist , toolbar , or tree or presentation |
object element |
No role | Якщо specified, role must be one of the following: application ,
document , img , or presentation |
ol element |
list role |
Якщо specified, role must be one of the following: directory ,
list , listbox , menu ,
menubar , radiogroup , tablist , toolbar , tree
or presentation |
output element |
status role |
No restrictions |
section element |
region role
Note:It is strongly recommended that user agents
such as screen readers only convey the presence of та provide
navigation for |
Якщо specified, role must be one of the following: alert ,
alertdialog , application ,
contentinfo , dialog , document , log , main ,
marquee , region , search , status or presentation
|
ul element |
list role |
Якщо specified, role must be one of the following: directory ,
group , list , listbox ,
menu , menubar , radiogroup ,
tablist , toolbar , tree or presentation |
video element |
No role | Якщо specified, role must be application |
Element with a hidden
attribute |
The aria-hidden state set to "true" |
Якщо specified, the aria-hidden state set
to "true" or "false" |
Element without a hidden
attribute |
The aria-hidden state set to "false" |
Якщо specified, the aria-hidden state set
to "true" or "false" |
The entry "no role", when used as a strong native semantic, means that no role can be used and that the user agent has no default mapping to ARIA roles. (However, it could have its own mappings to the accessibility layer.) When used as a default implicit ARIA semantic, it means the user agent has no default mapping to ARIA roles. (However, it could have its own mappings to the accessibility layer.)
The WAI-ARIA specification neither requires or forbids user agents from enhancing native presentation and interaction behaviors on the basis of WAI- ARIA markup. Even mainstream user agents might choose to expose metadata or navigational features directly or via user-installed extensions; for example, exposing required form fields or landmark navigation. User agents are encouraged to maximize their usefulness to users, including users without disabilities.
Conformance checkers are encouraged to phrase errors such that authors
are encouraged to use more appropriate elements rather than remove
accessibility annotations. For example, if an a
element is marked as having the button
role, a
conformance checker could say "Use a more appropriate element to
represent a button, for example a button
element or an input
element" rather than "The button
role cannot be
used with a
elements".
These features can be used to make accessibility tools render content to their users in more useful ways. For example, ASCII art, which is really an image, appears to be text та in the absence of appropriate annotations would end up being rendered by screen readers as a very painful reading of lots of punctuation. Using the features described in this section, one can instead make the ATs skip the ASCII art and just read the caption:
<figure role="img" aria-labelledby="fish-caption"> <pre> o .'`/ ' / ( O .-'` ` `'-._ .') _/ (o) '. .' / ) ))) >< < `\ |_\ _.' '. \ '-._ _ .-' '.) jgs `\__\ </pre> <figcaption id="fish-caption"> Joan G. Stark, "<cite>fish</cite>". October 1997. ASCII on electrons. 28×8. </figcaption> </figure>
html
elementhead
element followed
by a body
element.manifest
— Application cache manifesthtml
element's start tag can be omitted if the first
thing inside the html
element is not a comment.html
element's end tag can be omitted if the html
element is not immediately followed by a comment.interface HTMLHtmlElement : HTMLElement {};
The html
element represents
the root of an HTML document.
Authors are encouraged to specify a lang
attribute on the root html
element, giving the document's language. This aids speech synthesis tools
to determine what pronunciations to use, translation tools to determine
what rules to use та so forth.
The manifest
attribute gives the address of the document's application
cache manifest,
if there is one. Якщо the attribute is present, the attribute's value must
be a valid
non-empty URL potentially surrounded by spaces.
The manifest
attribute only has
an effect during the early stages of document load. Changing the
attribute dynamically thus has no effect (and thus, no DOM API is provided
for this attribute).
For the purposes of application cache selection, later base
elements cannot affect the resolving of relative URLs in manifest
attributes, as the
attributes are processed before those elements are seen.
The window.applicationCache
IDL attribute provides scripted access to the offline application
cache mechanism.
The html
element in the
following example declares that the document's language is English.
<!DOCTYPE html> <html lang="en"> <head> <title>Swapping Songs</title> </head> <body> <h1>Swapping Songs</h1> <p>Tonight I swapped some of the songs I wrote with some friends, who gave me some of the songs they wrote. I love sharing my music.</p> </body> </html>
head
elementhtml
element.iframe
srcdoc
document
or if title information is available from a higher-level protocol: Zero
or more elements of metadata content,
of which no more than one is a title
element and no more than one is a base
element.title
element and no more than one is a base
element.head
element's start tag may be omitted if the element
is empty, or if the first thing inside the head
element is an element.head
element's end tag may be omitted if the head
element is not immediately followed by a space
character or a comment.interface HTMLHeadElement : HTMLElement {};
The head
element represents
a collection of metadata for the Document
.
The collection of metadata in a head
element can be large or small. Here is an example of a very short one:
<!doctype html> <html> <head> <title>A document with a short head</title> </head> <body> ...
Here is an example of a longer one:
<!DOCTYPE HTML> <HTML> <HEAD> <META CHARSET="UTF-8"> <BASE HREF="http://www.example.com/"> <TITLE>An application with a long head</TITLE> <LINK REL="STYLESHEET" HREF="default.css"> <LINK REL="STYLESHEET ALTERNATE" HREF="big.css" TITLE="Big Text"> <SCRIPT SRC="support.js"></SCRIPT> <META NAME="APPLICATION-NAME" CONTENT="Long headed application"> </HEAD> <BODY> ...
The title
element is a required child in most situations, but when a higher-level
protocol provides title information, e.g. in the Subject line of an e-mail
when HTML is used as an e-mail authoring format, the title
element can be omitted.
title
elementhead
element
containing no other title
elements.interface HTMLTitleElement : HTMLElement { attribute DOMString text; };
The title
element represents
the document's title or name. Authors should use titles that identify
their documents even when they are used out of context, for example in a
user's history or bookmarks, or in search results. The document's title is
often different from its first heading, since the first heading does not
have to stand alone when taken out of context.
There must be no more than one title
element per document.
Якщо it's reasonable for the Document
to have no title, then the title
element is probably not required. See the head
element's content model for a description of when the element is required.
text
[ = value
]Returns the contents of the element, ignoring child nodes що єn't Text
nodes.
Can be set, to replace the element's children with the given value.
The IDL attribute text
must return a concatenation of the contents of all the Text
nodes що є children of the title
element (ignoring any other nodes such as comments or elements), in tree
order. On setting, it must act the same way as the textContent
IDL attribute.
Here are some examples of appropriate titles, contrasted with the top-level headings that might be used on those same pages.
<title>Introduction to The Mating Rituals of Bees</title> ... <h1>Introduction</h1> <p>This companion guide to the highly successful <cite>Introduction to Medieval Bee-Keeping</cite> book is...
The next page might be a part of the same site. Note how the title describes the subject matter unambiguously, while the first heading assumes the reader knows what the context is and therefore won't wonder if the dances are Salsa or Waltz:
<title>Dances used during bee mating rituals</title> ... <h1>The Dances</h1>
The string to use as the document's title is given by the document.title
IDL attribute.
User agents should use the document's title when referring to the
document in their user interface. When the contents of a title
element are used in this way, the
directionality of that title
element should be used to set the directionality of the document's title
in the user interface.
base
elementhead
element
containing no other base
elements.href
— Document base URLtarget
— Default browsing context for hyperlink
navigation and form
submissioninterface HTMLBaseElement : HTMLElement { attribute DOMString href; attribute DOMString target; };
The base
element allows
authors to specify the document base URL
for the purposes of resolving
relative URLs та the name of the default browsing
context for the purposes of following
hyperlinks. The element does not represent
any content beyond this information.
There must be no more than one base
element per document.
A base
element must have
either an href
attribute, a target
attribute, or both.
The href
content attribute, if specified, must contain a valid
URL potentially surrounded by spaces.
A base
element, if it has
an href
attribute, must come before any other elements in the tree that have
attributes defined as taking URLs,
except the html
element (its
manifest
attribute isn't affected by base
elements).
The target
attribute, if specified, must contain a valid
browsing context name or keyword, which specifies which browsing
context is to be used as the default when hyperlinks and forms
in the Document
cause navigation.
A base
element, if it has a
target
attribute, must come before any elements in the tree that represent hyperlinks.
Якщо there are multiple base
elements with target
attributes, all but the first are ignored.
A base
element that is
the first base
element
with an href
content attribute in a particular Document
has a frozen base URL. The frozen
base URL must be set, synchronously, whenever any
of the following situations occur:
base
element
becomes the first base
element in tree order with an href
content attribute in its Document
.base
element is
the first base
element
in tree order with an href
content attribute in its Document
та its href
content attribute is
changed.To set the frozen base URL,
resolve
the value of the element's href
content attribute relative to the Document
's
fallback base URL; if this is
successful, set the frozen base URL to
the resulting absolute URL,
otherwise, set the frozen base URL to
the fallback base URL.
The href
IDL attribute, on getting, must return the result of running the
following algorithm:
Якщо the base
element
has no href
content attribute, then return the document
base URL and abort these steps.
Нехай fallback base url be the Document
's fallback
base URL.
Нехай url be the value of the href
attribute of the base
element.
Resolve
url relative to fallback
base url (thus, the base
href
attribute isn't affected by xml:base
attributes or base
elements).
Якщо the previous step was successful, return the resulting absolute URL and abort these steps.
Інакше return the empty string.
The href
IDL attribute, on setting, must set the href
content attribute to the
given new value.
The target
IDL attribute must reflect the content attribute
of the same name.
In this example, a base
element is used to set the document base
URL:
<!DOCTYPE html> <html> <head> <title>This is an example for the <base> element</title> <base href="http://www.example.com/news/index.html"> </head> <body> <p>Visit the <a href="archives.html">archives</a>.</p> </body> </html>
The link in the above example would be a link to "http://www.example.com/news/archives.html
".
link
elementnoscript
element that is a child of a head
element.href
— Address of the hyperlinkcrossorigin
— How the element handles crossorigin requestsrel
— Relationship between the document containing the hyperlink and the
destination resourcemedia
— Applicable mediahreflang
— Language of the linked resourcetype
— Hint for the type of the referenced resourcesizes
— Sizes of the icons (for rel
="icon
")title
attribute has special semantics on this element: Title of the link;
alternative style sheet set name.link
(default - do not set).aria-*
attributes applicable
to the allowed roles.role
value interface HTMLLinkElement : HTMLElement {
attribute boolean disabled;
attribute DOMString href;
attribute DOMString crossOrigin;
attribute DOMString rel;
attribute DOMString rev;
readonly attribute DOMTokenList relList;
attribute DOMString media;
attribute DOMString hreflang;
attribute DOMString type;
[PutForwards=value] readonly attribute DOMSettableTokenList sizes;
};
HTMLLinkElement implements LinkStyle;
The link
element allows
authors to link their document to other resources.
The destination of the link(s) is given by the href
attribute, which must be
present and must contain a valid
non-empty URL potentially surrounded by spaces. Якщо
the href
attribute is absent, then the element does not define a link.
A link
element must have a
rel
attribute.
Якщо the rel
attribute is used, the element is restricted to the head
element.
The types of link indicated (the relationships) are given by the value of
the rel
attribute, which, if present, must have a value that is a set
of space-separated tokens. The allowed
keywords and their meanings are defined in a later section. Якщо
the rel
attribute is absent, has no keywords, or if none of the keywords used
are allowed according to the definitions in this specification, then the
element does not create any links.
Two categories of links can be created using the link
element: Links
to external resources and hyperlinks.
The link types section defines whether a
particular link type is an external resource or a hyperlink. One link
element can create multiple
links (of which some might be external resource links and some might be
hyperlinks); exactly which and how many links are created depends on the
keywords given in the rel
attribute. User agents must process the links on a per-link basis, not a
per-element basis.
Each link created for a link
element is handled separately. For instance, if there are two link
elements with rel="stylesheet"
, they
each count as a separate external resource та each is affected by its own
attributes independently. Similarly, if a single link
element has a rel
attribute with the value next stylesheet
,
it creates both a hyperlink (for the next
keyword) and an external
resource link (for the stylesheet
keyword) та they are affected by other attributes (such as media
or title
) differently.
For example, the following link
element creates two hyperlinks (to the same page):
<link rel="author license" href="/about">
The two links created by this element are one whose semantic is that the target page has information about the current page's author та one whose semantic is that the target page has information regarding the license under which the current page is provided.
The crossorigin
attribute is a CORS settings attribute.
It is intended for use with external resource links.
The exact behavior for links to external resources depends on the exact relationship, as defined for the relevant link type. Some of the attributes control whether or not the external resource is to be applied (as defined below).
For external resources що є represented in the DOM (for example, style sheets), the DOM representation must be made available (modulo cross-origin restrictions) even if the resource is not applied. To obtain the resource, the user agent must run the following steps:
Якщо the href
attribute's value is the empty string, then abort these steps.
Resolve
the URL given by the href
attribute, relative to
the element.
Якщо the previous step fails, then abort these steps.
Do a potentially
CORS-enabled fetch of the resulting absolute
URL, with the mode being the current state of the
element's crossorigin
content attribute, the origin being the
origin of the link
element's Document
та the default
origin behaviour set to taint.
The resource obtained in this fashion can be either CORS-same-origin or CORS-cross-origin.
User agents may opt to only try щоб отримати such resources when they are needed, instead of pro-actively fetching all the external resources що є not applied.
The semantics of the protocol used (e.g. HTTP) must be followed when fetching external resources. (For example, redirects will be followed and 404 responses will cause the external resource to not be applied.)
Once the attempts щоб отримати the resource and its critical
subresources are complete, the user agent must, if the loads were
successful, queue a task to fire
a simple event named load
at the link
element, or,
if the resource or one of its critical
subresources failed to completely load for any reason (e.g. DNS
error, HTTP 404 response, a connection being prematurely closed,
unsupported Content-Type), queue a task to
fire a simple event named error
at the link
element.
Non-network errors in processing the resource or its subresources (e.g.
CSS parse errors, PNG decoding errors) are not failures for the purposes
of this paragraph.
The task source for these tasks is the DOM manipulation task source.
The element must delay the load event of the element's document until all the attempts щоб отримати the resource and its critical subresources are complete. (Resources that the user agent has not yet attempted щоб отримати, e.g. because it is waiting for the resource to be needed, do not delay the load event.)
Interactive user agents may provide users with a means to follow the hyperlinks created
using the link
element,
somewhere within their user interface. The exact interface is not
defined by this specification, but it could include the following
information (obtained from the element's attributes, again as defined
below), in some form or another (possibly simplified), for each
hyperlink created with each link
element in the document:
rel
attribute)title
attribute).href
attribute).hreflang
attribute).media
attribute).User agents could also include other information, such as the type of
the resource (as given by the type
attribute).
Hyperlinks created with the link
element and its rel
attribute apply to the whole page. This contrasts with the rel
attribute of a
and area
elements, which
indicates the type of a link whose context is given by the link's location
within the document.
The media
attribute says which media the resource applies to. The value must be a valid media query.
Якщо the link is a hyperlink then the media
attribute is purely advisory та describes for which media the document
in question was designed.
However, if the link is an external
resource link, then the media
attribute is prescriptive.
The user agent must apply the external resource when the media
attribute's value matches
the environment and the other relevant conditions apply та must
not apply it otherwise.
The external resource might have further restrictions
defined within that limit its applicability. For example, a CSS style
sheet might have some @media
blocks.
This specification does not override such further restrictions or
requirements.
The default, if the media
attribute is omitted, is "all
", meaning that by default links apply to
all media.
The hreflang
attribute on the link
element has the same semantics as the hreflang
attribute on a
and area
elements.
The type
attribute gives the MIME type of the linked
resource. It is purely advisory. The value must be a valid
MIME type.
For external
resource links, the type
attribute is used as a hint to user agents so that they can avoid fetching
resources they do not support. Якщо the attribute is
present, then the user agent must assume that the resource is of the
given type (even if that is not a valid MIME
type, e.g. the empty string). Якщо the attribute is omitted, but
the external resource link type has a default type defined, then the
user agent must assume that the resource is of that type. Якщо the UA
does not support the given MIME type for the
given link relationship, then the UA should not obtain the resource; if the UA does
support the given MIME type for the given link
relationship, then the UA should obtain the resource at the appropriate
time as specified for the external
resource link's particular type. Якщо the attribute is omitted та
the external resource link type does not have a default type defined,
but the user agent would obtain
the resource if the type was known and supported, then the user agent
should obtain
the resource under the assumption that it will be supported.
User agents must not consider the type
attribute authoritative —
upon fetching the resource, user agents must not use the type
attribute to determine its
actual type. Only the actual type (as defined in the next paragraph) is
used to determine whether to apply the resource, not the
aforementioned assumed type.
Якщо the external resource link type defines rules for processing the resource's Content-Type metadata, then those rules apply. Інакше if the resource is expected to be an image, user agents may apply the image sniffing rules, with the official type being the type determined from the resource's Content-Type metadata та use the resulting sniffed type of the resource as if it was the actual type. Інакше if neither of these conditions apply or if the user agent opts not to apply the image sniffing rules, then the user agent must use the resource's Content-Type metadata to determine the type of the resource. Якщо there is no type metadata, but the external resource link type has a default type defined, then the user agent must assume that the resource is of that type.
The stylesheet
link type defines rules for processing the resource's Content-Type metadata.
Once the user agent has established the type of the resource, the user agent must apply the resource if it is of a supported type and the other relevant conditions apply та must ignore the resource otherwise.
Якщо a document contains style sheet links labeled as follows:
<link rel="stylesheet" href="A" type="text/plain"> <link rel="stylesheet" href="B" type="text/css"> <link rel="stylesheet" href="C">
...then a compliant UA that supported only CSS style sheets would
fetch the B and C files та skip the A file (since text/plain
is not the MIME type for CSS style sheets).
For files B and C, it would then check the actual types returned by
the server. For those що є sent as text/css
, it would
apply the styles, but for those labeled as text/plain
,
or any other type, it would not.
Якщо one of the two files was returned without a Content-Type
metadata, or with a syntactically incorrect type like Content-Type: "null"
,
then the default type for stylesheet
links would
kick in. Since that default type is text/css
,
the style sheet would nonetheless be applied.
The title
attribute gives the title of the link. With one exception, it is purely
advisory. The value is text. The exception is for style sheet links, where
the title
attribute defines alternative
style sheet sets.
The title
attribute on link
elements
differs from the global title
attribute of most other elements in that a link without a title does not
inherit the title of the parent element: it merely has no title.
The sizes
attribute is used with the icon
link type. The attribute must not be specified on link
elements that do not have a rel
attribute that specifies the icon
keyword.
The activation behavior of link
elements that create hyperlinks is to run the following steps:
Якщо the link
element's Document
is not fully active, then abort these steps.
Follow
the hyperlink created by the link
element.
HTTP Link:
headers, if
supported, must be assumed to come before any links in the document, in
the order that they were given in the HTTP message. These headers are to
be processed according to the rules given in the relevant
specifications. [HTTP] [WEBLINK]
Registration of relation types in HTTP Link: headers is distinct from HTML link types та thus their semantics can be different from same-named HTML types.
The IDL attributes href
,
rel
,
rev
,
media
,
hreflang
,
type
та sizes
each must reflect the respective content
attributes of the same name.
The crossOrigin
IDL attribute must reflect the crossorigin
content
attribute, limited to only
known values.
The IDL attribute relList
must reflect
the rel
content attribute.
The IDL attribute disabled
only applies to style sheet links. When the link
element defines a style sheet link, then the disabled
attribute behaves as
defined for
the alternative style sheets DOM. For all other link
elements it always return false and does nothing on setting.
The LinkStyle
interface is also
implemented by this element; the styling processing
model defines how. [CSSOM]
Here, a set of link
elements provide some style sheets:
<!-- a persistent style sheet --> <link rel="stylesheet" href="default.css"> <!-- the preferred alternate style sheet --> <link rel="stylesheet" href="green.css" title="Green styles"> <!-- some alternate style sheets --> <link rel="alternate stylesheet" href="contrast.css" title="High contrast"> <link rel="alternate stylesheet" href="big.css" title="Big fonts"> <link rel="alternate stylesheet" href="wide.css" title="Wide screen">
The following example shows how you can specify versions of the page that use alternative formats, are aimed at other languages та що є intended for other media:
<link rel=alternate href="/en/html" hreflang=en type=text/html title="English HTML"> <link rel=alternate href="/fr/html" hreflang=fr type=text/html title="French HTML"> <link rel=alternate href="/en/html/print" hreflang=en type=text/html media=print title="English HTML (for printing)"> <link rel=alternate href="/fr/html/print" hreflang=fr type=text/html media=print title="French HTML (for printing)"> <link rel=alternate href="/en/pdf" hreflang=en type=application/pdf title="English PDF"> <link rel=alternate href="/fr/pdf" hreflang=fr type=application/pdf title="French PDF">
meta
elementcharset
attribute is present, or if the element's http-equiv
attribute is in
the encoding
declaration state: in a head
element.http-equiv
attribute is present but not in the encoding declaration state:
in a head
element.http-equiv
attribute is present but not in the encoding declaration state:
in a noscript
element
that is a child of a head
element.name
attribute is present: where metadata
content is expected.name
— Metadata namehttp-equiv
— Pragma directivecontent
— Value of the elementcharset
— Character encoding
declarationinterface HTMLMetaElement : HTMLElement { attribute DOMString name; attribute DOMString httpEquiv; attribute DOMString content; };
The meta
element represents
various kinds of metadata that cannot be expressed using the title
,
base
, link
,
style
та script
elements.
The meta
element can
represent document-level metadata with the name
attribute, pragma directives
with the http-equiv
attribute та the file's character
encoding declaration when an HTML document is serialized to string
form (e.g. for transmission over the network or for disk storage) with the
charset
attribute.
Exactly one of the name
,
http-equiv
та charset
,
attributes must be specified.
Якщо either name
or http-equiv
is specified, then the content
attribute must also be specified. Інакше it must be omitted.
The charset
attribute specifies the character encoding used by the document. This is a
character encoding declaration.
Якщо the attribute is present in an XML
document, its value must be an ASCII
чутливі до реєстру match for the string "UTF-8
"
(and the document is therefore forced to use UTF-8 as its encoding).
The charset
attribute on the meta
element has no effect in XML documents та is only allowed in order to
facilitate migration to and from XHTML.
There must not be more than one meta
element with a charset
attribute per document.
The content
attribute gives the value of the document metadata or pragma directive
when the element is used for those purposes. The allowed values depend on
the exact context, as described in subsequent sections of this
specification.
Якщо a meta
element has a name
attribute, it sets document metadata. Document metadata is expressed in
terms of name-value pairs, the name
attribute on the meta
element giving the name та the content
attribute on the same
element giving the value. The name specifies what aspect of metadata is
being set; valid names and the meaning of their values are described in
the following sections. Якщо a meta
element has no content
attribute, then the value part of the metadata name-value pair is the
empty string.
The name
and content
IDL attributes must reflect the respective
content attributes of the same name. The IDL attribute httpEquiv
must reflect
the content attribute http-equiv
.
This specification defines a few names for the name
attribute of the meta
element.
Names are чутливі до реєстру та must be compared in an ASCII чутливі до реєстру manner.
application-name
The value must be a short free-form string giving the name of the Web
application that the page represents. Якщо the page is not a Web
application, the application-name
metadata name must not be used. Translations of the Web application's
name may be given, using the
attribute to specify the language of each name.
There must not be more than one meta
element with a given language and with its name
attribute set to the value application-name
per
document.
User agents may use the application name in UI in preference to the
page's title
, since
the title might include status messages and the like relevant to the
status of the page at a particular moment in time instead of just
being the name of the application.
To find the application name to use given an ordered list of languages (e.g. British English, American English та English), user agents must run the following steps:
Нехай languages be the list of languages.
Нехай default language be the language of the Document
's
root
element, if any та if that language is not unknown.
Якщо there is a default language та if it is not the same language as any of the languages is languages, append it to languages.
Нехай winning language be the
first language in languages for
which there is a meta
element in the Document
that has its name
attribute set to the value application-name
and whose language is the language in
question.
Якщо none of the languages have such a meta
element, then abort these steps; there's no given application
name.
Повернути value of the content
attribute of
the first meta
element in the Document
in
tree order that has its name
attribute set to the
value application-name
and whose language is winning
language.
author
The value must be a free-form string giving the name of one of the page's authors.
description
The value must be a free-form string that describes the page. The
value must be appropriate for use in a directory of pages, e.g. in a
search engine. There must not be more than one meta
element with its name
attribute set to the value description
per document.
generator
The value must be a free-form string that identifies one of the software packages used to generate the document. This value must not be used on pages whose markup is not generated by software, e.g. pages whose markup was written by a user in a text editor.
Here is what a tool called "Frontweaver" could include in its
output, in the page's head
element, to identify itself as the tool used to generate the page:
<meta name=generator content="Frontweaver 8.2">
keywords
The value must be a set of comma-separated tokens, each of which is a keyword relevant to the page.
This page about typefaces on British motorways uses a meta
element to specify some keywords that users might use to look for
the page:
<!DOCTYPE HTML> <html> <head> <title>Typefaces on UK motorways</title> <meta name="keywords" content="british,type face,font,fonts,highway,highways"> </head> <body> ...
Many search engines do not consider such keywords, because this feature has historically been used unreliably and even misleadingly as a way to spam search engine results in a way that is not helpful for users.
To obtain the list of keywords that the author has specified as applicable to the page, the user agent must run the following steps:
Нехай keywords be an empty list.
For each meta
element with a name
attribute and a content
attribute and whose name
attribute's value is
keywords
,
run the following substeps:
Split
the value of the element's content
attribute on commas.
Add the resulting tokens, if any, to keywords.
Remove any duplicates from keywords.
Повернутиkeywords. This is the list of keywords that the author has specified as applicable to the page.
User agents should not use this information when there is insufficient confidence in the reliability of the value.
For instance, it would be reasonable for a content management system to use the keyword information of pages within the system to populate the index of a site-specific search engine, but a large-scale content aggregator that used this information would likely find that certain users would try to game its ranking mechanism through the use of inappropriate keywords.
Extensions to the predefined set of metadata names may be registered in the WHATWG Wiki MetaExtensions page. [WHATWGWIKI]
Anyone is free to edit the WHATWG Wiki MetaExtensions page at any time to add a type. These new names must be specified with the following information:
The actual name being defined. The name should not be confusingly similar to any other defined name (e.g. differing only in case).
A short non-normative description of what the metadata name's meaning is, including the format the value is required to be in.
A list of other names that have exactly the same processing requirements. Authors should not use the names defined to be synonyms, they are only intended to allow user agents to support legacy content. Anyone may remove synonyms що є not used in practice; only names that need to be processed as synonyms for compatibility with legacy content are to be registered in this way.
One of the following:
Якщо a metadata name is found to be redundant with existing values, it should be removed and listed as a synonym for the existing value.
Якщо a metadata name is registered in the "proposed" state for a period of a month or more without being used or specified, then it may be removed from the registry.
Якщо a metadata name is added with the "proposed" status and found to be redundant with existing values, it should be removed and listed as a synonym for the existing value. Якщо a metadata name is added with the "proposed" status and found to be harmful, then it should be changed to "discontinued" status.
Anyone can change the status at any time, but should only do so in accordance with the definitions above.
Conformance checkers may use the information given on the WHATWG Wiki MetaExtensions page to establish if a value is allowed or not: values defined in this specification or marked as "proposed" or "ratified" must be accepted, whereas values marked as "discontinued" or not listed in either this specification or on the aforementioned page must be reported as invalid. Conformance checkers may cache this information (e.g. for performance reasons or to avoid the use of unreliable network connectivity).
When an author uses a new metadata name not defined by either this specification or the Wiki page, conformance checkers should offer to add the value to the Wiki, with the details described above, with the "proposed" status.
Metadata names whose values are to be URLs
must not be proposed or accepted. Links must be represented using the link
element, not the meta
element.
When the http-equiv
attribute is specified on a meta
element, the element is a pragma directive.
The http-equiv
attribute is an enumerated attribute.
The following table lists the keywords defined for this attribute. The
states given in the first cell of the rows with keywords give the states
to which those keywords map. Some of the keywords are
non-conforming, as noted in the last column.
State | Keyword | Notes |
---|---|---|
Content Language | content-language |
Non-conforming |
Encoding declaration | content-type |
|
Default style | default-style |
|
Refresh | refresh |
|
Cookie setter | set-cookie |
Non-conforming |
When a meta
element is inserted
into the document, if its http-equiv
attribute is
present and represents one of the above states, then the user agent must
run the algorithm appropriate for that state, as described in the
following list:
http-equiv="content-language"
) This feature is non-conforming. Authors are encouraged
to use the lang
attribute instead.
This pragma sets the pragma-set default language. Until such a pragma is successfully processed, there is no pragma-set default language.
Якщо the meta
element has no content
attribute, then abort these steps.
Якщо the element's content
attribute
contains a "," (U+002C) character then abort these steps.
Нехай input be the value of the
element's content
attribute.
Нехай position point at the first character of input.
Зібрати колекцію символів що є not space characters.
Нехай candidate буде рядком that resulted from the previous step.
Якщо candidate is the empty string, abort these steps.
Set the pragma-set default language to candidate.
This pragma is almost, but not quite, entirely unlike
the HTTP Content-Language
header of the same name. [HTTP]
http-equiv="content-type"
)
The encoding
declaration state is just an alternative form of setting the charset
attribute: it is a character encoding
declaration. This state's user agent
requirements are all handled by the parsing section of the
specification.
For meta
elements with
an http-equiv
attribute in the Encoding declaration state,
the content
attribute must have a value that is an ASCII
чутливі до реєстру match for a string that consists of: the
literal string "text/html;
",
optionally followed by any number of space characters, followed by the
literal string "charset=
", followed
by one of the labels
of the character
encoding of the character
encoding declaration.
A document must not contain both a meta
element with an http-equiv
attribute in the encoding declaration state
and a meta
element with
the charset
attribute present.
The encoding
declaration state may be used in HTML
documents and in XML Documents.
Якщо the encoding
declaration state is used in XML
Documents, the name of the character
encoding must be an ASCII
чутливі до реєстру match for the string "UTF-8
"
(and the document is therefore forced to use UTF-8 as its encoding).
The encoding declaration state has no effect in XML documents та is only allowed in order to facilitate migration to and from XHTML.
http-equiv="default-style"
)
This pragma sets the name of the default alternative style sheet set.
Якщо the meta
element has no content
attribute, or if that attribute's value is the empty string,
then abort these steps.
Set the preferred style
sheet set to the value of the element's content
attribute. [CSSOM]
http-equiv="refresh"
) This pragma acts as timed redirect.
Якщо another meta
element with an http-equiv
attribute
in the Refresh
state has already been successfully processed (i.e. when
it was inserted the user agent processed it and reached the last
step of this list of steps), then abort these steps.
Якщо the meta
element has no content
attribute, or if that attribute's value is the empty string,
then abort these steps.
Нехай input be the value of the
element's content
attribute.
Нехай position point at the first character of input.
Зібрати колекцію символів що є цифрами ASCII та parse the resulting string using the rules for parsing non-negative integers. Якщо the sequence of characters collected is the empty string, then no number will have been parsed; abort these steps. Інакше let time be the parsed number.
Зібрати колекцію символів що є цифрами ASCII and "." (U+002E) characters. Ignore any collected characters.
Нехай url be the address of the current page.
Якщо символ in input pointed to by position is a ";" (U+003B) character or a "," (U+002C) character, then advance position до наступного символа. Інакше jump to the last step.
Якщо символ in input pointed to by position is a "U" (U+0055) character or a U+0075 LATIN SMALL LETTER U character (u), then advance position до наступного символа. Інакше jump to the last step.
Якщо символ in input pointed to by position is a "R" (U+0052) character or a U+0072 LATIN SMALL LETTER R character (r), then advance position до наступного символа. Інакше jump to the last step.
Якщо символ in input pointed to by position is s "L" (U+004C) character or a U+006C LATIN SMALL LETTER L character (l), then advance position до наступного символа. Інакше jump to the last step.
Якщо символ in input pointed to by position is a "=" (U+003D), then advance position до наступного символа. Інакше jump to the last step.
Якщо символ in input pointed to by position is either a "'" (U+0027) character or """ (U+0022) character, then let quote be that character та просунути position до наступного символа. Інакше let quote be the empty string.
Нехай url be equal to the substring of input from the character в позициї to the end of the string.
Якщо quote is not the empty string та there is a character in url equal to quote, then truncate url at that character, so that it and all subsequent characters are removed.
Strip any trailing space characters from the end of url.
Strip any "tab" (U+0009), "LF" (U+000A) та "CR" (U+000D) characters from url.
Resolve
the url value to an absolute
URL, relative to the meta
element. Якщо this fails, abort these steps.
Perform one or more of the following steps:
After the refresh has come due (as defined below), if the
user has not canceled the redirect and if the meta
element's Document
's active sandboxing flag
set does not have the sandboxed
automatic features browsing context flag set, navigate the
Document
's browsing
context to url, with replacement enabled та
with the Document
's browsing context as the source
browsing context.
For the purposes of the previous paragraph, a refresh is said to have come due as soon as the later of the following two conditions occurs:
meta
element was inserted into
the Document
, adjusted to take into
account user or user agent preferences.Provide the user with an interface that, when selected, navigates
a browsing context to url, with the Document
's
browsing context as the source browsing context.
Do nothing.
In addition, the user agent may, as with anything, inform the user of any and all aspects of its operation, including the state of any timers, the destinations of any timed redirects та so forth.
For meta
elements with
an http-equiv
attribute in the Refresh
state, the content
attribute must have a value consisting either of:
URL
",
followed by a "=" (U+003D) character, followed by a valid
URL that does not start with a literal "'" (U+0027) or """
(U+0022) character.In the former case, the integer represents a number of seconds before the page is to be reloaded; in the latter case the integer represents a number of seconds before the page is to be replaced by the page at the given URL.
A news organization's front page could include the following markup
in the page's head
element, to ensure that the page automatically reloads from the
server every five minutes:
<meta http-equiv="Refresh" content="300">
A sequence of pages could be used as an automated slide show by making each page refresh to the next page in the sequence, using markup such as the following:
<meta http-equiv="Refresh" content="20; URL=page4.html">
http-equiv="set-cookie"
)
This pragma sets an HTTP cookie. [COOKIES]
It is non-conforming. Real HTTP headers should be used instead.
Якщо the meta
element has no content
attribute, or if that attribute's value is the empty string, then
abort these steps.
Act as if receiving
a set-cookie-string for the
document's address via a "non-HTTP" API, consisting of the
value of the element's content
attribute encoded
as UTF-8. [COOKIES] [RFC3629]
There must not be more than one meta
element with any particular state in the document at a time.
Extensions to the predefined set of pragma directives may, under certain conditions, be registered in the WHATWG Wiki PragmaExtensions page. [WHATWGWIKI]
Such extensions must use a name that is identical to an HTTP header registered in the Permanent Message Header Field Registry та must have behavior identical to that described for the HTTP header. [IANAPERMHEADERS]
Pragma directives corresponding to headers describing metadata, or not requiring specific user agent processing, must not be registered; instead, use metadata names. Pragma directives corresponding to headers that affect the HTTP processing model (e.g. caching) must not be registered, as they would result in HTTP-level behavior being different for user agents that implement HTML than for user agents that do not.
Anyone is free to edit the WHATWG Wiki PragmaExtensions page at any time to add a pragma directive satisfying these conditions. Such registrations must specify the following information:
The actual name being defined. The name must match a previously-registered HTTP name with the same requirements.
A short non-normative description of the purpose of the pragma directive.
Conformance checkers must use the information given on the WHATWG Wiki PragmaExtensions page to establish if a value is allowed or not: values defined in this specification or listed on the aforementioned page must be accepted, whereas values not listed in either this specification or on the aforementioned page must be rejected as invalid. Conformance checkers may cache this information (e.g. for performance reasons or to avoid the use of unreliable network connectivity).
A character encoding declaration is a mechanism by which the character encoding used to store or transmit a document is specified.
The following restrictions apply to character encoding declarations:
In addition, due to a number of restrictions on meta
elements, there can only be one meta
-based
character encoding declaration per document.
Якщо an HTML
document does not start with a BOM та its encoding
is not explicitly given by Content-Type
metadata та the document is not an
iframe
srcdoc
document, then the character encoding used must be an ASCII-compatible
character encoding та the encoding must be specified using a meta
element with a charset
attribute or a meta
element with an http-equiv
attribute in the encoding
declaration state.
A character encoding declaration is required (either in the Content-Type metadata or explicitly in the file) even if the encoding is US-ASCII, because a character encoding is needed to process non-ASCII characters entered by the user in forms, in URLs generated by scripts та so forth.
Якщо the document is an iframe
srcdoc
document,
the document must not have a character
encoding declaration. (In this case, the source is already decoded,
since it is part of the document that contained the iframe
.)
Якщо an HTML
document contains a meta
element with a charset
attribute or a meta
element
with an http-equiv
attribute in the encoding declaration state,
then the character encoding used must be an ASCII-compatible
character encoding.
Authors should use UTF-8. Conformance checkers may advise authors against using legacy encodings. [RFC3629]
Authoring tools should default to using UTF-8 for newly-created documents. [RFC3629]
Encodings in which a series of bytes in the range 0x20 to
0x7E can encode characters other than the corresponding characters in the
range U+0020 to U+007E represent a potential security vulnerability: a
user agent that does not support the encoding (or does not support the
label used to declare the encoding, or does not use the same mechanism to
detect the encoding of unlabeled content as another user agent) might end
up interpreting technically benign plain text content as HTML tags and
JavaScript. Authors should therefore not use these encodings. For example,
this applies to encodings in which the bytes corresponding to "<script>
"
in ASCII can encode a different string. Authors should not use such
encodings, which are known to include JIS_C6226-1983,
JIS_X0212-1990, HZ-GB-2312,
JOHAB
(Windows code page 1361),
encodings based on ISO-2022
та encodings based on EBCDIC. Furthermore, authors must not use the
CESU-8, UTF-7, BOCU-1 and SCSU encodings, which also fall into this
category; these encodings were never intended for use for Web content. [RFC1345] [RFC1842]
[RFC1468] [RFC2237]
[RFC1554] [CP50220]
[RFC1922]
[RFC1557] [CESU8]
[UTF7] [BOCU1] [SCSU]
Authors should not use UTF-32, as the encoding detection algorithms described in this specification intentionally do not distinguish it from UTF-16. [UNICODE]
Using non-UTF-8 encodings can have unexpected results on form submission and URL encodings, which use the document's character encoding by default.
In XHTML, the XML declaration should be used for inline character encoding information, if necessary.
In HTML, to declare that the character encoding is UTF-8, the author
could include the following markup near the top of the document (in the
head
element):
<meta charset="utf-8">
In XML, the XML declaration would be used instead, at the very top of the markup:
<?xml version="1.0" encoding="utf-8"?>
style
elementnoscript
element that is a child of a head
element.type
attribute, but must match
requirements described in prose below.media
— Applicable mediatype
— Type of embedded resourcetitle
attribute has special semantics on this element: Alternative style sheet
set name.interface HTMLStyleElement : HTMLElement { attribute boolean disabled; attribute DOMString media; attribute DOMString type; }; HTMLStyleElement implements LinkStyle;
The style
element allows
authors to embed style information in their documents. The style
element is one of several inputs to the styling
processing model. The element does not represent content for the user.
The type
attribute gives the styling language. Якщо the attribute is present, its
value must be a valid MIME type that
designates a styling language. The charset
parameter must not be specified. The default value for the type
attribute, which is used if
the attribute is absent, is "text/css
". [RFC2318]
When examining types to determine if they support the language, user
agents must not ignore unknown MIME parameters — types with unknown
parameters must be assumed to be unsupported. The charset
parameter must be treated as an unknown parameter for the purpose of
comparing MIME types
here.
The media
attribute says which media the styles apply to. The value must be a valid
media query. The user agent must apply the
styles when the media
attribute's value matches the
environment and the other relevant conditions apply та must not
apply them otherwise.
The styles might be further limited in scope, e.g. in CSS
with the use of @media
blocks. This
specification does not override such further restrictions or
requirements.
The default, if the media
attribute is omitted, is "all
", meaning that by default styles apply to
all media.
The title
attribute on style
elements
defines alternative style sheet
sets. Якщо the style
element has no title
attribute, then it has no title; the title
attribute of ancestors does not
apply to the style
element.
[CSSOM]
The title
attribute on style
elements, like the title
attribute on link
elements,
differs from the global title
attribute in that a style
block without a title does not inherit the title of the parent element: it
merely has no title.
The textContent
of a style
element must match the style
production
in the following ABNF, the character set for which is Unicode. [ABNF]
style = no-c-start *( c-start no-c-end c-end no-c-start ) no-c-start = < any string that doesn't contain a substring that matches c-start > c-start = "<!--" no-c-end = < any string that doesn't contain a substring that matches c-end > c-end = "-->"
All descendant elements must be processed, according to their
semantics, before the style
element itself is evaluated. For styling languages that consist of pure
text (as opposed to XML), user agents must evaluate style
elements by passing the concatenation of the contents of all the Text
nodes що є children of the style
element (not any other
nodes such as comments or elements), in tree
order, to the style system. For XML-based styling languages, user
agents must pass all the child nodes of the style
element to the style system.
All URLs found by the styling language's processor must be resolved, relative to the element (or as defined by the styling language), when the processor is invoked.
Once the attempts щоб отримати the style sheet's critical
subresources, if any, are complete, or, if the style sheet has no
critical subresources, once the
style sheet has been parsed and processed, the user agent must, if the
loads were successful or there were none, queue
a task to fire a simple event
named load
at the style
element, or, if one of
the style sheet's critical
subresources failed to completely load for any reason (e.g. DNS
error, HTTP 404 response, a connection being prematurely closed,
unsupported Content-Type), queue a task to
fire a simple event named error
at the style
element.
Non-network errors in processing the style sheet or its subresources
(e.g. CSS parse errors, PNG decoding errors) are not failures for the
purposes of this paragraph.
The task source for these tasks is the DOM manipulation task source.
The element must delay the load event of the element's document until all the attempts щоб отримати the style sheet's critical subresources, if any, are complete.
This specification does not specify a style system, but CSS is expected to be supported by most Web browsers. [CSS]
The media
and type
IDL attributes must reflect the respective
content attributes of the same name.
The disabled
IDL attribute behaves as defined for the alternative style sheets DOM.
The LinkStyle
interface is also
implemented by this element; the styling processing
model defines how. [CSSOM]
The following document has its stress emphasis styled as bright red text rather than italics text, while leaving titles of works and Latin words in their default italics. It shows how using appropriate elements enables easier restyling of documents.
<!DOCTYPE html> <html lang="en-US"> <head> <title>My favorite book</title> <style> body { color: black; background: white; } em { font-style: normal; color: red; } </style> </head> <body> <p>My <em>favorite</em> book of all time has <em>got</em> to be <cite>A Cat's Life</cite>. It is a book by P. Rahmel that talks about the <i lang="la">Felis Catus</i> in modern human society.</p> </body> </html>
The link
and style
elements can provide styling information for the user agent to use when
rendering the document. The CSS and CSSOM specifications specify what
styling information is to be used by the user agent and how it is to be
used. [CSS] [CSSOM]
The style
and link
elements implement the LinkStyle
interface. [CSSOM]
For style
elements, if
the user agent does not support the specified styling language, then the
sheet
attribute of the element's LinkStyle
interface must return null. Similarly, link
elements that do not represent external
resource links that contribute to the styling processing model
(i.e. that do not have a stylesheet
keyword in their rel
attribute), for which the
link is an alternative stylesheet but whose title
content attribute is absent or
empty, or whose resource is CORS-cross-origin,
must have their LinkStyle
interface's sheet
attribute return null.
Інакше the LinkStyle
interface's
sheet
attribute must return null if the corresponding element is not in
a Document
та otherwise must return a StyleSheet
object with the following properties: [CSSOM]
The style sheet type must be the same as the style's specified
type. For style
elements, this is the same as the type
content attribute's
value, or text/css
if that is
omitted. For link
elements, this is the Content-Type
metadata of the specified resource.
For link
elements,
the location must be the result of resolving the URL given by the
element's href
content attribute, relative to the element, or the empty string if
that fails. For style
elements, there is no location.
The media must be the same as the value of the element's media
content attribute, or the empty string, if the attribute is omitted.
The title must be the same as the value of the element's title
content attribute, if the
attribute is present and has a non-empty value. Якщо the attribute
is absent or its value is the empty string, then the style sheet
does not have a title (it is the empty string). The title is used
for defining alternative
style sheet sets.
For link
elements,
true if the link
is an alternative stylesheet. In all other cases, false.
The same object must be returned each time.
The disabled
IDL attribute on link
and
style
elements must return
false and do nothing on setting, if the sheet
attribute of their LinkStyle
interface is null. Інакше it
must return the value of the StyleSheet
interface's disabled
attribute on getting та forward the new value to that same attribute on
setting.
The rules for handling alternative style sheets are defined in the CSS object model specification. [CSSOM]
Style sheets, whether added by a link
element, a style
element,
an <?xml-stylesheet>
PI, an HTTP Link:
header, or some other mechanism, have a style
sheet ready flag, which is initially unset.
When a style sheet is ready to be applied, its style
sheet ready flag must be set. Якщо the style sheet referenced no
other resources (e.g. it was an internal style sheet given by a style
element with no @import
rules), then the style rules must be synchronously made available to
script; otherwise, the style rules must only be made available to script
once the event loop reaches its "update the
rendering" step.
A style sheet in the context of the Document
of an HTML parser or XML
parser is said to be a
style sheet that is blocking scripts if the element was created
by that Document
's parser та the
element is either a style
element or a link
element
that was an external
resource link that contributes to the styling processing model
when the element was created by the parser та the element's style sheet
was enabled when the element was created by the parser та the element's
style sheet ready flag is not yet set
та, the last time the event loop reached step
1, the element was in
that Document
та the user agent hasn't given up on
that particular style sheet yet. A user agent may give up on a style
sheet at any time.
Giving up on a style sheet before the style sheet loads, if the style sheet eventually does still load, means that the script might end up operating with incorrect information. For example, if a style sheet sets the color of an element to green, but a script that inspects the resulting style is executed before the sheet is loaded, the script will find that the element is black (or whatever the default color is) та might thus make poor choices (e.g. deciding to use black as the color elsewhere on the page, instead of green). Implementors have to balance the likelihood of a script using incorrect information with the performance impact of doing nothing while waiting for a slow network request to finish.
A Document
has
a style sheet that is blocking scripts if there is either a
style sheet that is blocking scripts in the context of that Document
, or if that Document
is in a browsing context that has a parent browsing context та the active document of that parent
browsing context itself has
a style sheet that is blocking scripts.
A Document
has
no style sheet that is blocking scripts if it does not have a style sheet
that is blocking scripts as defined in the previous paragraph.
body
elementhtml
element.onafterprint
onbeforeprint
onbeforeunload
onhashchange
onmessage
onoffline
ononline
onpagehide
onpageshow
onpopstate
onstorage
onunload
body
element's start tag may be omitted if the element
is empty, or if the first thing inside the body
element is not a space character or a comment,
except if the first thing inside the body
element is a meta
, link
, script
,
style
, or template
element.
body
element's end tag may be omitted if the body
element is not immediately followed by a comment.document
role
(default - do not set), application
.aria-*
attributes applicable
to the allowed roles.interface HTMLBodyElement : HTMLElement { }; HTMLBodyElement implements WindowEventHandlers;
The body
element represents the content of the document.
In conforming documents, there is only one body
element. The document.body
IDL attribute provides scripts with easy access to a document's body
element.
Some DOM operations are defined in terms of "the
body element". This refers to a particular element in the DOM, as
per the definition of the term та not any arbitrary body
element.
The body
element exposes as
event handler content
attributes a number of the event handlers
of the Window
object. It also mirrors
their event handler IDL
attributes.
The onblur
,
onerror
,
onfocus
,
onload
,
onresize
та onscroll
event handlers of the Window
object, exposed on the body
element, replace the generic event handlers
with the same names normally supported by HTML
elements.
Thus, for example, a bubbling error
event dispatched on a child of the body
element of a Document
would
first trigger the onerror
event handler content
attributes of that element, then that of the root html
element та only then would it trigger the onerror
event handler content attribute
on the body
element. This is
because the event would bubble from the target, to the body
,
to the html
, to the Document
, to the Window
та the event
handler on the body
is
watching the Window
not the body
. A regular event listener
attached to the body
using addEventListener()
, however, would be run
when the event bubbled through the body
and not when it reaches the Window
object.
This page updates an indicator to show whether or not the user is online:
<!DOCTYPE HTML> <html> <head> <title>Online or offline?</title> <script> function update(online) { document.getElementById('status').textContent = online ? 'Online' : 'Offline'; } </script> </head> <body ononline="update(true)" onoffline="update(false)" onload="update(navigator.onLine)"> <p>You are: <span id="status">(Unknown)</span></p> </body> </html>
article
elementmain
element descendants.article
(default - do not set), application
, document
or main
.aria-*
attributes applicable
to the allowed roles.HTMLElement
.The article
element represents a complete, or
self-contained, composition in a document, page, application, or site and
that is, in principle, independently distributable or reusable, e.g. in
syndication. This could be a forum post, a magazine or newspaper article,
a blog entry, a user-submitted comment, an interactive widget or gadget,
or any other independent item of content.
When article
elements
are nested, the inner article
elements represent articles що є in principle related to the contents of
the outer article. For instance, a blog entry on a site that accepts
user-submitted comments could represent the comments as article
elements nested within the article
element for the blog entry.
Author information associated with an article
element (q.v. the address
element) does not apply to nested article
elements.
When used specifically with content to be redistributed in
syndication, the article
element is similar in purpose to the entry
element in Atom. [ATOM]
When the main content of the page (i.e. excluding footers, headers,
navigation blocks та sidebars) is all one single self-contained
composition, the content should be marked up with a main
element and the content may also be marked with an article
,
but it is technically redundant in this case (since it's self-evident that
the page is a single composition, as it is a single document).
This example shows a blog post using the article
element, with some schema.org annotations:
<article itemscope itemtype="http://schema.org/BlogPosting"> <header> <h1 itemprop="headline">The Very First Rule of Life</h1> <p><time itemprop="datePublished" datetime="2009-10-09">3 days ago</time></p> <link itemprop="url" href="?comments=0"> </header> <p>Якщо there's a microphone anywhere near you, assume it's hot and sending whatever you're saying to the world. Seriously.</p> <p>...</p> <footer> <a itemprop="discussionUrl" href="?comments=1">Show comments...</a> </footer> </article>
Here is that same blog post, but showing some of the comments:
<article itemscope itemtype="http://schema.org/BlogPosting"> <header> <h1 itemprop="headline">The Very First Rule of Life</h1> <p><time itemprop="datePublished" datetime="2009-10-09">3 days ago</time></p> <link itemprop="url" href="?comments=0"> </header> <p>Якщо there's a microphone anywhere near you, assume it's hot and sending whatever you're saying to the world. Seriously.</p> <p>...</p> <section> <h1>Comments</h1> <article itemprop="comment" itemscope itemtype="http://schema.org/UserComments" id="c1"> <link itemprop="url" href="#c1"> <footer> <p>Posted by: <span itemprop="creator" itemscope itemtype="http://schema.org/Person"> <span itemprop="name">George Washington</span> </span></p> <p><time itemprop="commentTime" datetime="2009-10-10">15 minutes ago</time></p> </footer> <p>Yeah! Especially when talking about your lobbyist friends!</p> </article> <article itemprop="comment" itemscope itemtype="http://schema.org/UserComments" id="c2"> <link itemprop="url" href="#c2"> <footer> <p>Posted by: <span itemprop="creator" itemscope itemtype="http://schema.org/Person"> <span itemprop="name">George Hammond</span> </span></p> <p><time itemprop="commentTime" datetime="2009-10-10">5 minutes ago</time></p> </footer> <p>Hey, you have the same first name as me.</p> </article> </section> </article>
Notice the use of footer
to give the information for each comment (such as who wrote it and
when): the footer
element can appear at the start of its section when
appropriate, such as in this case. (Using header
in this case wouldn't be wrong either; it's mostly a matter of authoring
preference.)
section
elementregion
role
(default - do not set), alert
, alertdialog
, application
, contentinfo
, dialog
, document
,
log
, main
, marquee
,
presentation
,
search
or status
.aria-*
attributes applicable
to the allowed roles.HTMLElement
.The section
element represents a generic section of a
document or application. A section, in this context, is a thematic
grouping of content. The theme of each section
should be identified, typically by including a heading (h1
-h6
element)
as a child of the section
element.
Examples of sections would be chapters, the various tabbed pages in a tabbed dialog box, or the numbered sections of a thesis. A Web site's home page could be split into sections for an introduction, news items та contact information.
Authors are encouraged to use the article
element instead of the section
element when it would make sense to syndicate the contents of the element.
The section
element is not a generic container element. When an element is needed only
for styling purposes or as a convenience for scripting, authors are
encouraged to use the div
element instead. A general rule is that the section
element is appropriate only if the element's contents would be listed
explicitly in the document's outline.
In the following example, we see an article (part of a larger Web page) about apples, containing two short sections.
<article> <header> <h2>Apples</h2> <p>Tasty, delicious fruit!</p> </header> <p>The apple is the pomaceous fruit of the apple tree.</p> <section> <h3>Red Delicious</h3> <p>These bright red apples are the most common found in many supermarkets.</p> </section> <section> <h3>Granny Smith</h3> <p>These juicy, green apples make a great filling for apple pies.</p> </section> </article>
Here is a graduation programme with two sections, one for the list of people graduating та one for the description of the ceremony. (The markup in this example features an uncommon style sometimes used to minimize the amount of inter-element whitespace.)
<!DOCTYPE Html> <Html ><Head ><Title >Graduation Ceremony Summer 2022</Title ></Head ><Body ><H1 >Graduation</H1 ><Section ><H2 >Ceremony</H2 ><P >Opening Procession</P ><P >Speech by Validactorian</P ><P >Speech by Class President</P ><P >Presentation of Diplomas</P ><P >Closing Speech by Headmaster</P ></Section ><Section ><H2 >Graduates</H2 ><Ul ><Li >Molly Carpenter</Li ><Li >Anastasia Luccio</Li ><Li >Ebenezar McCoy</Li ><Li >Karrin Murphy</Li ><Li >Thomas Raith</Li ><Li >Susan Rodriguez</Li ></Ul ></Section ></Body ></Html>
In this example, a book author has marked up some sections as chapters
and some as appendices та uses CSS to style the headers in these two
classes of section differently. The whole book is wrapped in an article
element as part of an
even larger document containing other books.
<article class="book"> <style> section { border: double medium; margin: 2em; } section.chapter h1 { font: 2em Roboto, Helvetica Neue, sans-serif; } section.appendix h1 { font: small-caps 2em Roboto, Helvetica Neue, sans-serif; } </style> <header> <h2>My Book</h2> <p>A sample with not much content</p> <p><small>Published by Dummy Publicorp Ltd.</small></p> </header> <section class="chapter"> <h3>My First Chapter</h3> <p>This is the first of my chapters. It doesn't say much.</p> <p>But it has two paragraphs!</p> </section> <section class="chapter"> <h3>It Continutes: The Second Chapter</h3> <p>Bla dee bla, dee bla dee bla. Boom.</p> </section> <section class="chapter"> <h3>Chapter Three: A Further Example</h3> <p>It's not like a battle between brightness and earthtones would go unnoticed.</p> <p>But it might ruin my story.</p> </section> <section class="appendix"> <h3>Appendix A: Overview of Examples</h3> <p>These are demonstrations.</p> </section> <section class="appendix"> <h3>Appendix B: Some Closing Remarks</h3> <p>Hopefully this long example shows that you <em>can</em> style sections, so long as they are used to indicate actual sections.</p> </section> </article>
nav
elementmain
element descendants.navigation
role (default - do not set) or
presentation
.aria-*
attributes applicable
to the allowed roles.HTMLElement
.The nav
element
represents a section of a page that links to
other pages or to parts within the page: a section with navigation links.
In cases where the content of a nav
element represents a list of items, use list markup to aid understanding
and navigation.
Not all groups of links on a page need to be in a nav
element — the element is
primarily intended for sections that consist of major navigation blocks.
In particular, it is common for footers to have a short list of links to
various pages of a site, such as the terms of service, the home page та a
copyright page. The footer
element alone is sufficient for such cases; while a nav
element can be used in such cases, it is usually unnecessary.
User agents (such as screen readers) що є targeted at users who can benefit from navigation information being omitted in the initial rendering, or who can benefit from navigation information being immediately available, can use this element as a way to determine what content on the page to initially skip or provide on request (or both).
In the following example, the page has several places where links are present, but only one of those places is considered a navigation section.
<body itemscope itemtype="http://schema.org/Blog"> <header> <h1>Wake up sheeple!</h1> <p><a href="news.html">News</a> - <a href="blog.html">Blog</a> - <a href="forums.html">Forums</a></p> <p>Last Modified: <span itemprop="dateModified">2009-04-01</span></p> <nav> <h1>Navigation</h1> <ul> <li><a href="articles.html">Index of all articles</a></li> <li><a href="today.html">Things sheeple need to wake up for today</a></li> <li><a href="successes.html">Sheeple we have managed to wake</a></li> </ul> </nav> </header> <main> <article itemprop="blogPosts" itemscope itemtype="http://schema.org/BlogPosting"> <header> <h1 itemprop="headline">My Day at the Beach</h1> </header> <div itemprop="articleBody"> <p>Today I went to the beach and had a lot of fun.</p> ...more content... </div> <footer> <p>Posted <time itemprop="datePublished" datetime="2009-10-10">Thursday</time>.</p> </footer> </article> ...more blog posts... </main> <footer> <p>Copyright © <span itemprop="copyrightYear">2010</span> <span itemprop="copyrightHolder">The Example Company</span> </p> <p><a href="about.html">About</a> - <a href="policy.html">Privacy Policy</a> - <a href="contact.html">Contact Us</a></p> </footer> </body>
Notice the main
element
being used to wrap the main content of the page. In this case, all
content other than the page header and footer.
You can also see microdata annotations in the above example that use the schema.org vocabulary to provide the publication date and other metadata about the blog post.
In the following example, there are two nav
elements, one for primary navigation around the site та one for
secondary navigation around the page itself.
<body> <h1>The Wiki Center Of Exampland</h1> <nav> <ul> <li><a href="/">Home</a></li> <li><a href="/events">Current Events</a></li> ...more... </ul> </nav> <main> <header> <h1>Demos in Exampland</h1> <p>Written by A. N. Other.</p> </header> <nav> <ul> <li><a href="#public">Public demonstrations</a></li> <li><a href="#destroy">Demolitions</a></li> ...more... </ul> </nav> <div> <section id="public"> <h1>Public demonstrations</h1> <p>...more...</p> </section> <section id="destroy"> <h1>Demolitions</h1> <p>...more...</p> </section> ...more... </div> <footer> <p><a href="?edit">Edit</a> | <a href="?delete">Delete</a> | <a href="?Rename">Rename</a></p> </footer> </main> <footer> <p><small>© copyright 1998 Exampland Emperor</small></p> </footer> </body>
A nav
element doesn't have
to contain a list, it can contain other kinds of content as well. In
this navigation block, links are provided in prose:
<nav> <h1>Navigation</h1> <p>You are on my home page. To the north lies <a href="/blog">my blog</a>, from whence the sounds of battle can be heard. To the east you can see a large mountain, upon which many <a href="/school">school papers</a> are littered. Far up thus mountain you can spy a little figure who appears to be me, desperately scribbling a <a href="/school/thesis">thesis</a>.</p> <p>To the west are several exits. One fun-looking exit is labeled <a href="http://games.example.com/">"games"</a>. Another more boring-looking exit is labeled <a href="http://isp.example.net/">ISP™</a>.</p> <p>To the south lies a dark and dank <a href="/about">contacts page</a>. Cobwebs cover its disused entrance та at one point you see a rat run quickly out of the page.</p> </nav>
aside
elementmain
element descendants.complementary
role (default - do not set), note
, search
or presentation
.aria-*
attributes applicable
to the allowed roles.HTMLElement
.The aside
element represents a section of a page that
consists of content that is tangentially related to the content around the
aside
element та which could
be considered separate from that content. Such sections are often
represented as sidebars in printed typography.
The element can be used for typographical effects like pull quotes or
sidebars, for advertising, for groups of nav
elements та for other content that is considered separate from the main
content of the page.
It's not appropriate to use the aside
element just for parentheticals, since those are part of the main flow of
the document.
The following example shows how an aside is used to mark up background material on Switzerland in a much longer news story on Europe.
<aside> <h1>Switzerland</h1> <p>Switzerland, a land-locked country in the middle of geographic Europe, has not joined the geopolitical European Union, though it is a signatory to a number of European treaties.</p> </aside>
The following example shows how an aside is used to mark up a pull quote in a longer article.
... <p>He later joined a large company, continuing on the same work. <q>I love my job. People ask me what I do for fun when I'm not at work. But I'm paid to do my hobby, so I never know what to answer. Some people wonder what they would do if they didn't have to work... but I know what I would do, because I was unemployed for a year та I filled that time doing exactly what I do now.</q></p> <aside> <q> People ask me what I do for fun when I'm not at work. But I'm paid to do my hobby, so I never know what to answer. </q> </aside> <p>Of course his work — or should that be hobby? — isn't his only passion. He also enjoys other pleasures.</p> ...
The following extract shows how aside
can be used for blogrolls and other side content on a blog:
<body> <header> <h1>My wonderful blog</h1> <p>My tagline</p> </header> <aside> <!-- this aside contains two sections що є tangentially related to the page, namely, links to other blogs та links to blog posts from this blog --> <nav> <h1>My blogroll</h1> <ul> <li><a href="http://blog.example.com/">Example Blog</a> </ul> </nav> <nav> <h1>Archives</h1> <ol reversed> <li><a href="/last-post">My last post</a> <li><a href="/first-post">My first post</a> </ol> </nav> </aside> <aside> <!-- this aside is tangentially related to the page also, it contains twitter messages from the blog author --> <h1>Twitter Feed</h1> <blockquote cite="http://twitter.example.net/t31351234"> I'm on vacation, writing my blog. </blockquote> <blockquote cite="http://twitter.example.net/t31219752"> I'm going to go on vacation soon. </blockquote> </aside> <article> <!-- this is a blog post --> <h1>My last post</h1> <p>This is my last post.</p> <footer> <p><a href="/last-post" rel=bookmark>Permalink</a> </footer> </article> <article> <!-- this is also a blog post --> <h1>My first post</h1> <p>This is my first post.</p> <aside> <!-- this aside is about the blog post, since it's inside the <article> element; it would be wrong, for instance, to put the blogroll here, since the blogroll isn't really related to this post specifically, only to the page as a whole --> <h1>Posting</h1> <p>While I'm thinking about it, I wanted to say something about posting. Posting is fun!</p> </aside> <footer> <p><a href="/first-post" rel=bookmark>Permalink</a> </footer> </article> <footer> <nav> <a href="/archives">Archives</a> — <a href="/about">About me</a> — <a href="/copyright">Copyright</a> </nav> </footer> </body>
h1
, h2
,
h3
, h4
,
h5
та h6
elementsheading
role
(default - do not set), tab
or presentation
.aria-*
attributes applicable
to the allowed roles.interface HTMLHeadingElement : HTMLElement {};
These elements represent headings for their sections.
The semantics and meaning of these elements are defined in the section on headings and sections.
These elements have a rank given by the number in
their name. The h1
element is said to have the highest rank, the h6
element has the lowest rank та two elements with the same name have equal
rank.
h1
–h6
elements
must not be used to markup subheadings, subtitles, alternative titles and
taglines unless intended to be the heading for a new section or
subsection. Instead use the markup patterns in the Common
idioms without dedicated elements section of the specification.
As far as their respective document outlines (their heading and section structures) are concerned, these two snippets are semantically equivalent:
<body> <h1>Нехай's call it a draw(ing surface)</h1> <h2>Diving in</h2> <h2>Simple shapes</h2> <h2>Canvas coordinates</h2> <h3>Canvas coordinates diagram</h3> <h2>Paths</h2> </body>
<body> <h1>Нехай's call it a draw(ing surface)</h1> <section> <h1>Diving in</h1> </section> <section> <h1>Simple shapes</h1> </section> <section> <h1>Canvas coordinates</h1> <section> <h1>Canvas coordinates diagram</h1> </section> </section> <section> <h1>Paths</h1> </section> </body>
Authors might prefer the former style for its terseness, or the latter style for its convenience in the face of heavy editing; which is best is purely an issue of preferred authoring style.
header
elementheader
,
footer
, or main
element descendants.banner
role
(default - do not set) or presentation
.aria-*
attributes applicable
to the allowed roles.HTMLElement
.The header
element represents introductory content for its
nearest ancestor sectioning content
or sectioning root element. A header
typically contains a group of introductory or navigational aids.
When the nearest ancestor sectioning content or sectioning root element is the body element, then it applies to the whole page.
A header
element is intended to usually contain the section's heading (an h1
–h6
element), but this is not required. The header
element can also be used to wrap a section's table of contents, a search
form, or any relevant logos.
Here are some sample headers. This first one is for a game:
<header> <p>Welcome to...</p> <h1>Voidwars!</h1> </header>
The following snippet shows how the element can be used to mark up a specification's header:
<header> <h1>Scalable Vector Graphics (SVG) 1.2</h1> <p>W3C Working Draft 27 October 2004</p> <dl> <dt>This version:</dt> <dd><a href="http://www.w3.org/TR/2004/WD-SVG12-20041027/">http://www.w3.org/TR/2004/WD-SVG12-20041027/</a></dd> <dt>Previous version:</dt> <dd><a href="http://www.w3.org/TR/2004/WD-SVG12-20040510/">http://www.w3.org/TR/2004/WD-SVG12-20040510/</a></dd> <dt>Latest version of SVG 1.2:</dt> <dd><a href="http://www.w3.org/TR/SVG12/">http://www.w3.org/TR/SVG12/</a></dd> <dt>Latest SVG Recommendation:</dt> <dd><a href="http://www.w3.org/TR/SVG/">http://www.w3.org/TR/SVG/</a></dd> <dt>Editor:</dt> <dd>Dean Jackson, W3C, <a href="mailto:dean@w3.org">dean@w3.org</a></dd> <dt>Authors:</dt> <dd>See <a href="#authors">Author List</a></dd> </dl> <p class="copyright"><a href="http://www.w3.org/Consortium/Legal/ipr-notic ... </header>
The header
element is not sectioning content; it
doesn't introduce a new section.
In this example, the page has a page heading given by the h1
element та two subsections whose headings are given by h2
elements. The content after the header
element is still part of the last subsection started in the header
element, because the header
element doesn't take part in the outline
algorithm.
<body> <header> <h1>Little Green Guys With Guns</h1> <nav> <ul> <li><a href="/games">Games</a> <li><a href="/forum">Forum</a> <li><a href="/download">Download</a> </ul> </nav> <h2>Important News</h2> <!-- this starts a second subsection --> <!-- this is part of the subsection entitled "Important News" --> <p>To play today's games you will need to update your client.</p> <h2>Games</h2> <!-- this starts a third subsection --> </header> <p>You have three active games:</p> <!-- this is still part of the subsection entitled "Games" --> ...
footer
elementheader
,
footer
, or main
element descendants.contentinfo
role (default - do not set) or
presentation
.aria-*
attributes applicable
to the allowed roles.HTMLElement
.The footer
element represents a footer for its nearest
ancestor sectioning content or sectioning
root element. A footer typically contains information about its
section such as who wrote it, links to related documents, copyright data
та the like.
When the footer
element contains entire sections, they represent
appendices, indexes, long colophons, verbose license agreements та other
such content.
Contact information for the author or editor of a section
belongs in an address
element, possibly itself inside a footer
.
Bylines and other information that could be suitable for both a header
or a footer
can be placed in either (or neither). The primary purpose of these
elements is merely to help the author write self-explanatory markup that
is easy to maintain and style; they are not intended to impose specific
structures on authors.
Footers don't necessarily have to appear at the end of a section, though they usually do.
When the nearest ancestor sectioning content or sectioning root element is the body element, then it applies to the whole page.
The footer
element is not sectioning content; it
doesn't introduce a new section.
Here is a page with two footers, one at the top and one at the bottom, with the same content:
<body> <footer><a href="../">Back to index...</a></footer> <div> <h1>Lorem ipsum</h1> <p>The ipsum of all lorems</p> </div> <p>A dolor sit amet, consectetur adipisicing elit, sed do eiusmod tempor incididunt ut labore et dolore magna aliqua. Ut enim ad minim veniam, quis nostrud exercitation ullamco laboris nisi ut aliquip ex ea commodo consequat. Duis aute irure dolor in reprehenderit in voluptate velit esse cillum dolore eu fugiat nulla pariatur. Excepteur sint occaecat cupidatat non proident, sunt in culpa qui officia deserunt mollit anim id est laborum.</p> <footer><a href="../">Back to index...</a></footer> </body>
Here is an example which shows the footer
element being used both for a site-wide footer and for a section footer.
<!DOCTYPE HTML> <HTML><HEAD> <TITLE>The Ramblings of a Scientist</TITLE> <BODY> <H1>The Ramblings of a Scientist</H1> <MAIN> <ARTICLE> <H1>Episode 15</H1> <VIDEO SRC="/fm/015.ogv" CONTROLS PRELOAD> <P><A HREF="/fm/015.ogv">Download video</A>.</P> </VIDEO> <FOOTER> <!-- footer for article --> <P>Published <TIME DATETIME="2009-10-21T18:26-07:00">on 2009/10/21 at 6:26pm</TIME></P> </FOOTER> </ARTICLE> <ARTICLE> <H1>My Favorite Trains</H1> <P>I love my trains. My favorite train of all time is a Köf.</P> <P>It is fun to see them pull some coal cars because they look so dwarfed in comparison.</P> <FOOTER> <!-- footer for article --> <P>Published <TIME DATETIME="2009-09-15T14:54-07:00">on 2009/09/15 at 2:54pm</TIME></P> </FOOTER> </ARTICLE> </MAIN> <FOOTER> <!-- site wide footer --> <NAV> <P><A HREF="/credits.html">Credits</A> — <A HREF="/tos.html">Terms of Service</A> — <A HREF="/index.html">Blog Index</A></P> </NAV> <P>Copyright © 2009 Gordon Freeman</P> </FOOTER> </BODY> </HTML>
Some site designs have what is sometimes referred to as "fat footers" — footers that contain a lot of material, including images, links to other articles, links to pages for sending feedback, special offers... in some ways, a whole "front page" in the footer.
This fragment shows the bottom of a page on a site with a "fat footer":
... <footer> <nav> <section> <h1>Articles</h1> <p><img src="images/somersaults.jpeg" alt=""> Go to the gym with our somersaults class! Our teacher Jim takes you through the paces in this two-part article. <a href="articles/somersaults/1">Part 1</a> · <a href="articles/somersaults/2">Part 2</a></p> <p><img src="images/kindplus.jpeg"> Tired of walking on the edge of a clif<!-- sic -->? Our guest writer Lara shows you how to bumble your way through the bars. <a href="articles/kindplus/1">Read more...</a></p> <p><img src="images/crisps.jpeg"> The chips are down, now all that's left is a potato. What can you do with it? <a href="articles/crisps/1">Read more...</a></p> </section> <ul> <li> <a href="/about">About us...</a> <li> <a href="/feedback">Send feedback!</a> <li> <a href="/sitemap">Sitemap</a> </ul> </nav> <p><small>Copyright © 2015 The Snacker — <a href="/tos">Terms of Service</a></small></p> </footer> </body>
address
elementheader
,
footer
, or address
element descendants.contentinfo
role.aria-*
attributes applicable
to the allowed roles.HTMLElement
.The address
element represents the contact information for
its nearest article
or body
element ancestor. Якщо that
is the body element, then the contact
information applies to the document as a whole.
For example, a page at the W3C Web site related to HTML might include the following contact information:
<ADDRESS> <A href="../People/Raggett/">Dave Raggett</A>, <A href="../People/Arnaud/">Arnaud Le Hors</A>, contact persons for the <A href="Activity">W3C HTML Activity</A> </ADDRESS>
The address
element must not be used to represent arbitrary addresses (e.g. postal
addresses), unless those addresses are in fact the relevant contact
information. (The p
element is
the appropriate element for marking up postal addresses in general.)
The address
element must not contain information other than contact information.
For example, the following is non-conforming use of the address
element:
<ADDRESS>Last Modified: 1999/12/24 23:37:50</ADDRESS>
Typically, the address
element would be included along with other information in a footer
element.
The contact information for a node node
is a collection of address
elements defined by the first applicable entry from the following list:
article
elementbody
elementThe contact information consists of all the address
elements that have node as an
ancestor and do not have another body
or article
element
ancestor that is a descendant of node.
article
elementbody
elementThe contact information of node is
the same as the contact information of the nearest article
or body
element
ancestor, whichever is nearest.
Document
has a
body elementThe contact information of node is
the same as the contact information of the
body element of the Document
.
There is no contact information for node.
User agents may expose the contact information of a node to the user, or use it for other purposes, such as indexing sections based on the sections' contact information.
In this example the footer contains contact information and a copyright notice.
<footer> <address> For more details, contact <a href="mailto:js@example.com">John Smith</a>. </address> <p><small>© copyright 2038 Example Corp.</small></p> </footer>
The h1
–h6
elements
are headings.
The first element of heading content in an element of sectioning content represents the heading for that section. Subsequent headings of equal or higher rank start new (implied) sections, headings of lower rank start implied subsections що є part of the previous one. In both cases, the element represents the heading of the implied section.
h1
–h6
elements
must not be used to markup subheadings, subtitles, alternative titles and
taglines unless intended to be the heading for a new section or
subsection. Instead use the markup patterns in the Common
idioms without dedicated elements section of the specification.
Certain elements are said to be sectioning roots, including blockquote
and td
elements. These
elements can have their own outlines, but the sections and headings inside
these elements do not contribute to the outlines of their ancestors.
Sectioning content elements are always considered subsections of their nearest ancestor sectioning root or their nearest ancestor element of sectioning content, whichever is nearest, regardless of what implied sections other headings may have created.
For the following fragment:
<body> <h1>Foo</h1> <h2>Bar</h2> <blockquote> <h3>Bla</h3> </blockquote> <p>Baz</p> <h2>Quux</h2> <section> <h3>Thud</h3> </section> <p>Grunt</p> </body>
...the structure would be:
body
section, containing the "Grunt" paragraph)
section
section) Notice how the section
ends the earlier implicit section so that a later paragraph ("Grunt") is
back at the top level.
Sections may contain headings of any rank та authors are strongly encouraged to use headings of the appropriate rank for the section's nesting level.
Authors are also encouraged to explicitly wrap sections in elements of sectioning content, instead of relying on the implicit sections generated by having multiple headings in one element of sectioning content.
For example, the following is correct:
<body> <h4>Apples</h4> <p>Apples are fruit.</p> <section> <h2>Taste</h2> <p>They taste lovely.</p> <h6>Sweet</h6> <p>Red apples are sweeter than green ones.</p> <h1>Color</h1> <p>Apples come in various colors.</p> </section> </body>
However, the same document would be more clearly expressed as:
<body> <h1>Apples</h1> <p>Apples are fruit.</p> <section> <h2>Taste</h2> <p>They taste lovely.</p> <section> <h3>Sweet</h3> <p>Red apples are sweeter than green ones.</p> </section> </section> <section> <h2>Color</h2> <p>Apples come in various colors.</p> </section> </body>
Both of the documents above are semantically identical and would produce the same outline in compliant user agents.
This third example is also semantically identical та might be easier to maintain (e.g. if sections are often moved around in editing):
<body> <h1>Apples</h1> <p>Apples are fruit.</p> <section> <h1>Taste</h1> <p>They taste lovely.</p> <section> <h1>Sweet</h1> <p>Red apples are sweeter than green ones.</p> </section> </section> <section> <h1>Color</h1> <p>Apples come in various colors.</p> </section> </body>
This final example would need explicit style rules to be rendered well in legacy browsers. Legacy browsers without CSS support would render all the headings as top-level headings.
There are currently no known implementations of the
outline algorithm in graphical browsers or assistive technology user
agents, although the algorithm is implemented in other software such as
conformance checkers. Therefore the outline
algorithm cannot be relied upon to convey document structure to users.
Authors are advised to use heading rank (h1
-h6
) to
convey document structure.
This section defines an algorithm for creating an outline for a sectioning content element or a sectioning root element. It is defined in terms of a walk over the nodes of a DOM tree, in tree order, with each node being visited when it is entered and when it is exited during the walk.
The outline for a sectioning
content element or a sectioning root
element consists of a list of one or more potentially nested sections. A section is a container that corresponds to
some nodes in the original DOM tree. Each section can have one heading
associated with it та can contain any number of further nested sections. The algorithm for the outline also associates each node in
the DOM tree with a particular section and potentially a heading.
(The sections in the outline aren't section
elements, though some may correspond to such elements — they are merely
conceptual sections.)
The following markup fragment:
<body> <h1>A</h1> <p>B</p> <h2>C</h2> <p>D</p> <h2>E</h2> <p>F</p> </body>
...results in the following outline being created for the body
node (and thus the entire document):
Section created for body
node.
Associated with heading "A".
Also associated with paragraph "B".
Nested sections:
The algorithm that must be followed during a walk of a DOM subtree rooted at a sectioning content element or a sectioning root element to determine that element's outline is as follows:
Нехай current outline target be null. (It holds the element whose outline is being created.)
Нехай current section be null. (It holds a pointer to a section, so that elements in the DOM can all be associated with a section.)
Create a stack to hold elements, which is used to handle nesting. Initialize this stack to empty.
Walk over the DOM in tree order, starting with the sectioning content element or sectioning root element at the root of the subtree for which an outline is to be created та trigger the first relevant step below for each element as the walk enters and exits it.
The element being exited is a heading
content element or an element with a hidden
attribute.
Pop that element from the stack.
hidden
attributeDo nothing.
hidden
attributePush the element being entered onto the stack. (This causes the algorithm to skip that element and any descendants of the element.)
Run these steps:
Якщо current outline target is not null, виконати ці підкроки:
Якщо the current section has no heading, create an implied heading and let that be the heading for the current section.
Push current outline target onto the stack.
Нехай current outline target be the element that is being entered.
Нехай current section be a newly created section for the current outline target element.
Associate current outline target with current section.
Нехай there be a new outline for the new current outline target, initialized with just the new current section as the only section in the outline.
Run these steps:
Якщо the current section has no heading, create an implied heading and let that be the heading for the current section.
Pop the top element from the stack та let the current outline target be that element.
Нехай current section be the last section in the outline of the current outline target element.
Append the outline of the sectioning content element being exited to the current section. (This does not change which section is the last section in the outline.)
Run these steps:
Якщо current outline target is not null, push current outline target onto the stack.
Нехай current outline target be the element that is being entered.
Нехай current outline target's parent section be current section.
Нехай current section be a newly created section for the current outline target element.
Нехай there be a new outline for the new current outline target, initialized with just the new current section as the only section in the outline.
Run these steps:
Якщо the current section has no heading, create an implied heading and let that be the heading for the current section.
Нехай current section be current outline target's parent section.
Pop the top element from the stack та let the current outline target be that element.
The current outline target is the element being exited та it is the sectioning content element or a sectioning root element at the root of the subtree for which an outline is being generated.
Якщо the current section has no heading, create an implied heading and let that be the heading for the current section.
Skip to the next step в загальному переліку кроків. (The walk is over.)
Якщо the current section has no heading, let the element being entered be the heading for the current section.
Інакше if the element being entered has a rank equal to or higher than the heading of the last section of the outline of the current outline target, or if the heading of the last section of the outline of the current outline target is an implied heading, then create a new section and append it to the outline of the current outline target element, so that this new section is the new last section of that outline. Нехай current section be that new section. Нехай the element being entered be the new heading for the current section.
Інакше виконати ці підкроки:
Нехай candidate section be current section.
Heading loop: Якщо the element being entered has a rank lower than the rank of the heading of the candidate section, then create a new section та append it to candidate section. (This does not change which section is the last section in the outline.) Нехай current section be this new section. Нехай the element being entered be the new heading for the current section. Abort these substeps.
Нехай new candidate section be the section that contains candidate section in the outline of current outline target.
Нехай candidate section be new candidate section.
Повернутиto the step labeled heading loop.
Push the element being entered onto the stack. (This causes the algorithm to skip any descendants of the element.)
Recall that h1
has the highest rank та h6
has the lowest rank.
Do nothing.
In addition, whenever the walk exits a node, after doing the steps above, if the node is not associated with a section yet, associate the node with the section current section.
Associate all nodes with the heading of the section with which they are associated, if any.
The tree of sections created by the algorithm above, or a proper subset thereof, must be used when generating document outlines, for example when generating tables of contents.
The outline created for the body element
of a Document
is the outline
of the entire document.
When creating an interactive table of contents, entries should jump the user to the relevant sectioning content element, if the section was created for a real element in the original document, or to the relevant heading content element, if the section in the tree was generated for a heading in the above process.
Selecting the first section of the document therefore always
takes the user to the top of the document, regardless of where the first
heading in the body
is to
be found.
The outline depth of a heading
content element associated with a section section
is the number of sections
що є ancestors of section in the
outermost outline that section
finds itself in when the outlines
of its Document
's elements are
created, plus 1. The outline depth of a heading content element not associated
with a section
is 1.
User agents should provide default headings for sections that do not have explicit section headings.
Consider the following snippet:
<body> <nav> <p><a href="/">Home</a></p> </nav> <p>Hello world.</p> <aside> <p>My cat is cute.</p> </aside> </body>
Although it contains no headings, this snippet has three sections: a
document (the body
) with
two subsections (a nav
and an aside
). A user
agent could present the outline as follows:
These default headings ("Untitled document", "Navigation", "Sidebar") are not specified by this specification та might vary with the user's language, the page's language, the user's preferences, the user agent implementor's preferences, etc.
The following JavaScript function shows how the tree walk could be implemented. The root argument is the root of the tree to walk (either a sectioning content element or a sectioning root element) та the enter and exit arguments are callbacks що є called with the nodes as they are entered and exited. [ECMA262]
function (root, enter, exit) { var node = root; start: while (node) { enter(node); if (node.firstChild) { node = node.firstChild; continue start; } while (node) { exit(node); if (node == root) { node = null; } else if (node.nextSibling) { node = node.nextSibling; continue start; } else { node = node.parentNode; } } } }
Цей розділ не є нормативним.
The following document shows a straight-forward application of the outline algorithm. First, here is the document, which is a book with very short chapters and subsections:
<!DOCTYPE HTML> <title>The Tax Book (all in one page)</title> <h1>The Tax Book</h1> <h2>Earning money</h2> <p>Earning money is good.</p> <h3>Getting a job</h3> <p>To earn money you typically need a job.</p> <h2>Spending money</h2> <p>Spending is what money is mainly used for.</p> <h3>Cheap things</h3> <p>Buying cheap things often not cost-effective.</p> <h3>Expensive things</h3> <p>The most expensive thing is often not the most cost-effective either.</p> <h2>Investing money</h2> <p>You can lend your money to other people.</p> <h2>Losing money</h2> <p>Якщо you spend money or invest money, sooner or later you will lose money. <h3>Poor judgement</h3> <p>Usually if you lose money it's because you made a mistake.</p>
This book would form the following outline:
Notice that the title
element does not participate in the outline.
Here is a similar document, but this time using section
elements to get the same effect:
<!DOCTYPE HTML> <title>The Tax Book (all in one page)</title> <h1>The Tax Book</h1> <section> <h1>Earning money</h1> <p>Earning money is good.</p> <section> <h1>Getting a job</h1> <p>To earn money you typically need a job.</p> </section> </section> <section> <h1>Spending money</h1> <p>Spending is what money is mainly used for.</p> <section> <h1>Cheap things</h1> <p>Buying cheap things often not cost-effective.</p> </section> <section> <h1>Expensive things</h1> <p>The most expensive thing is often not the most cost-effective either.</p> </section> </section> <section> <h1>Investing money</h1> <p>You can lend your money to other people.</p> </section> <section> <h1>Losing money</h1> <p>Якщо you spend money or invest money, sooner or later you will lose money. <section> <h1>Poor judgement</h1> <p>Usually if you lose money it's because you made a mistake.</p> </section> </section>
This book would form the same outline:
A document can contain multiple top-level headings:
<!DOCTYPE HTML> <title>Alphabetic Fruit</title> <h1>Apples</h1> <p>Pomaceous.</p> <h1>Bananas</h1> <p>Edible.</p> <h1>Carambola</h1> <p>Star.</p>
This would form the following simple outline consisting of three top-level sections:
Effectively, the body
element is split into three.
Mixing both the h1
–h6
model
and the section
/h1
model
can lead to some unintuitive results.
Consider for example the following, which is just the previous example
but with the contents of the (implied) body
wrapped in a section
:
<!DOCTYPE HTML> <title>Alphabetic Fruit</title> <section> <h1>Apples</h1> <p>Pomaceous.</p> <h1>Bananas</h1> <p>Edible.</p> <h1>Carambola</h1> <p>Star.</p> </section>
The resulting outline would be:
This result is described as unintuitive because it results in
three subsections even though there's only one section
element. Effectively, the section
is split into three, just like the implied body
element in the previous example.
(In this example, "(untitled page)" is the implied heading for
the body
element, since it
has no explicit heading.)
Headings never rise above other sections. Thus, in the following
example, the first h1
does not actually describe the page header; it describes the header for
the second half of the page:
<!DOCTYPE HTML> <title>Feathers on The Site of Encyclopedic Knowledge</title> <section> <h1>A plea from our caretakers</h1> <p>Please, we beg of you, send help! We're stuck in the server room!</p> </section> <h1>Feathers</h1> <p>Epidermal growths.</p>
The resulting outline would be:
Thus, when an article
element starts with a nav
block and only later has its heading, the result is that the nav
block is not part of the same section as the rest of the article
in the outline. For instance, take this document:
<!DOCTYPE HTML> <title>We're adopting a child! — Ray's blog</title> ... <h1>Ray's blog</h1> <main> <article> <header> <nav> <a href="?t=-1d">Yesterday</a>; <a href="?t=-7d">Last week</a>; <a href="?t=-1m">Last month</a> </nav> </header> <h2>We're adopting a child!</h2> <p>As of today, Janine and I have signed the papers to become the proud parents of baby Diane! We've been looking forward to this day for weeks.</p> </article> </main> ...
The resulting outline would be:
Also worthy of note in this example is that the header
and main
elements have no
effect whatsoever on the document outline.
Цей розділ не є нормативним.
Element | Purpose |
---|---|
Example | |
body |
|
<!DOCTYPE HTML> <html> <head> <title>Steve Hill's Home Page</title> </head> <body> <p>Hard Trance is My Life.</p> </body> </html> |
|
article
|
|
<article> <img src="/tumblr_masqy2s5yn1rzfqbpo1_500.jpg" alt="Yellow smiley face with the caption 'masif'"> <p>My fave Masif tee so far!</p> <footer>Posted 2 days ago</footer> </article> <article> <img src="/tumblr_m9tf6wSr6W1rzfqbpo1_500.jpg" alt=""> <p>Happy 2nd birthday Masif Saturdays!!!</p> <footer>Posted 3 weeks ago</footer> </article> |
|
section
|
|
<h1>Biography</h1> <section> <h1>The facts</h1> <p>1500+ shows, 14+ countries</p> </section> <section> <h1>2010/2011 figures per year</h1> <p>100+ shows, 8+ countries</p> </section> |
|
nav |
|
<nav> <ul> <li><a href="/">Home</a> <li><a href="/biog.html">Bio</a> <li><a href="/discog.html">Discog</a> </ul> </nav> |
|
aside |
|
<h1>Music</h1> <p>As any burner can tell you, the event has a lot of trance.</p> <aside>You can buy the music we played at our <a href="buy.html">playlist page</a>.</aside> <p>This year we played a kind of trance that originated in Belgium, Germany та the Netherlands in the mid 90s.</p> |
|
h1 –h6 |
A section heading |
<h1>The Guide To Music On The Playa</h1> <h2>The Main Stage</h2> <p>Якщо you want to play on a stage, you should bring one.</p> <h2>Amplified Music</h2> <p>Amplifiers up to 300W or 90dB are welcome.</p> |
|
header
|
|
<article> <header> <h1>Hard Trance is My Life</h1> <p>By DJ Steve Hill and Technikal</p> </header> <p>The album with the amusing punctuation has red artwork.</p> </article> |
|
footer
|
|
<article> <h1>Hard Trance is My Life</h1> <p>The album with the amusing punctuation has red artwork.</p> <footer> <p>Artists: DJ Steve Hill and Technikal</p> </footer> </article> |
Цей розділ не є нормативним.
A section
forms part of
something else. An article
is its own thing. But how does one know which is which? Mostly the real
answer is "it depends on author intent".
For example, one could imagine a book with a "Granny Smith" chapter that
just said "These juicy, green apples make a great filling for apple
pies."; that would be a section
because there'd be lots of other chapters on (maybe) other kinds of
apples.
On the other hand, one could imagine a tweet or reddit comment or tumblr
post or newspaper classified ad that just said "Granny Smith. These juicy,
green apples make a great filling for apple pies."; it would then be article
s because that was the
whole thing.
A comment on an article is not part of the article
on which it is commenting, therefore it is its own article
.
p
elementA p
element's end tag may be omitted if the p
element is immediately followed by an address
,
article
, aside
,
blockquote
, div
, dl
,
fieldset
, footer
,
form
, h1
,
h2
,
h3
,
h4
,
h5
,
h6
,
header
, hgroup
,
hr
, main
,
nav
, ol
,
p
, pre
,
section
, table
,
or ul
, element, or if
there is no more content in the parent element and the parent element
is not an a
element.
aria-*
attributes applicable
to the allowed roles.interface HTMLParagraphElement : HTMLElement {};
The p
element represents
a paragraph.
While paragraphs are usually represented in visual media by blocks of text що є physically separated from adjacent blocks through blank lines, a style sheet or user agent would be equally justified in presenting paragraph breaks in a different manner, for instance using inline pilcrows (¶).
The following examples are conforming HTML fragments:
<p>The little kitten gently seated himself on a piece of carpet. Later in his life, this would be referred to as the time the cat sat on the mat.</p>
<fieldset> <legend>Personal information</legend> <p> <label>Name: <input name="n"></label> <label><input name="anon" type="checkbox"> Hide from other users</label> </p> <p><label>Address: <textarea name="a"></textarea></label></p> </fieldset>
<p>There was once an example from Femley,<br> Whose markup was of dubious quality.<br> The validator complained,<br> So the author was pained,<br> To move the error from the markup to the rhyming.</p>
The p
element
should not be used when a more specific element is more appropriate.
The following example is technically correct:
<section> <!-- ... --> <p>Last modified: 2001-04-23</p> <p>Author: fred@example.com</p> </section>
However, it would be better marked-up as:
<section> <!-- ... --> <footer>Last modified: 2001-04-23</footer> <address>Author: fred@example.com</address> </section>
Or:
<section> <!-- ... --> <footer> <p>Last modified: 2001-04-23</p> <address>Author: fred@example.com</address> </footer> </section>
List elements (in particular, ol
and ul
elements) cannot be
children of p
elements. When
a sentence contains a bulleted list, therefore, one might wonder how it
should be marked up.
For instance, this fantastic sentence has bullets relating to
and is further discussed below.
The solution is to realise that a paragraph, in HTML terms, is not a logical concept, but a structural one. In the fantastic example above, there are actually five paragraphs as defined by this specification: one before the list, one for each bullet та one after the list.
The markup for the above example could therefore be:
<p>For instance, this fantastic sentence has bullets relating to</p> <ul> <li>wizards, <li>faster-than-light travel та <li>telepathy, </ul> <p>and is further discussed below.</p>
Authors wishing to conveniently style such "logical" paragraphs
consisting of multiple "structural" paragraphs can use the div
element instead of the p
element.
Thus for instance the above example could become the following:
<div>For instance, this fantastic sentence has bullets relating to <ul> <li>wizards, <li>faster-than-light travel та <li>telepathy, </ul> and is further discussed below.</div>
This example still has five structural paragraphs, but now the author
can style just the div
instead of having to consider each part of the example separately.
hr
elementseparator
(default - do not set) or presentation
.aria-*
attributes applicable
to the allowed roles.interface HTMLHRElement : HTMLElement {};
The hr
element represents
a paragraph-level thematic break, e.g. a scene
change in a story, or a transition to another topic within a section of a
reference book.
The following fictional extract from a project manual shows two
sections that use the hr
element to separate topics within the section.
<section> <h1>Communication</h1> <p>There are various methods of communication. This section covers a few of the important ones used by the project.</p> <hr> <p>Communication stones seem to come in pairs and have mysterious properties:</p> <ul> <li>They can transfer thoughts in two directions once activated if used alone.</li> <li>Якщо used with another device, they can transfer one's consciousness to another body.</li> <li>Якщо both stones are used with another device, the consciousnesses switch bodies.</li> </ul> <hr> <p>Radios use the electromagnetic spectrum in the meter range and longer.</p> <hr> <p>Signal flares use the electromagnetic spectrum in the nanometer range.</p> </section> <section> <h1>Food</h1> <p>All food at the project is rationed:</p> <dl> <dt>Potatoes</dt> <dd>Two per day</dd> <dt>Soup</dt> <dd>One bowl per day</dd> </dl> <hr> <p>Cooking is done by the chefs on a set rotation.</p> </section>
There is no need for an hr
element between the sections themselves, since the section
elements and the h1
elements imply thematic changes themselves.
The following extract from Pandora's Star by Peter F.
Hamilton shows two paragraphs that precede a scene change and the
paragraph that follows it. The scene change, represented in the printed
book by a gap containing a solitary centered star between the second and
third paragraphs, is here represented using the hr
element.
<p>Dudley was ninety-two, in his second life та fast approaching
time for another rejuvenation. Despite his body having the physical
age of a standard fifty-year-old, the prospect of a long degrading
campaign within academia was one he regarded with dread. For a
supposedly advanced civilization, the Intersolar Commonwealth could be
appallingly backward at times, not to mention cruel.</p>
<p><i>Maybe it won't be that bad</i>, he told himself. The lie was
comforting enough to get him through the rest of the night's
shift.</p>
<hr>
<p>The Carlton AllLander drove Dudley home just after dawn. Like the
astronomer, the vehicle was old and worn, but perfectly capable of
doing its job. It had a cheap diesel engine, common enough on a
semi-frontier world like Gralmond, although its drive array was a
thoroughly modern photoneural processor. With its high suspension and
deep-tread tyres it could plough along the dirt track to the
observatory in all weather and seasons, including the metre-deep snow
of Gralmond's winters.</p>
The hr
element
does not affect the document's outline.
pre
elementaria-*
attributes applicable
to the allowed roles.interface HTMLPreElement : HTMLElement {};
The pre
element represents
a block of preformatted text, in which structure is represented by
typographic conventions rather than by elements.
In the HTML syntax, a leading newline
character immediately following the pre
element start tag is stripped.
Some examples of cases where the pre
element could be used:
Authors are encouraged to consider how preformatted text will be experienced when the formatting is lost, as will be the case for users of speech synthesizers, braille displays та the like. For cases like ASCII art, it is likely that an alternative presentation, such as a textual description, would be more universally accessible to the readers of the document.
To represent a block of computer code, the pre
element can be used with a code
element; to represent a block of computer output the pre
element can be used with a samp
element. Similarly, the kbd
element can be used within a pre
element to indicate text that the user is to enter.
In the following snippet, a sample of computer code is presented.
<p>This is the <code>Panel</code> constructor:</p> <pre><code>function Panel(element, canClose, closeHandler) { this.element = element; this.canClose = canClose; this.closeHandler = function () { if (closeHandler) closeHandler() }; }</code></pre>
In the following snippet, samp
and kbd
elements are mixed
in the contents of a pre
element to show a session of Zork I.
<pre><samp>You are in an open field west of a big white house with a boarded front door. There is a small mailbox here. ></samp> <kbd>open mailbox</kbd> <samp>Opening the mailbox reveals: A leaflet. ></samp></pre>
The following shows a contemporary poem that uses the pre
element to preserve its unusual formatting, which forms an intrinsic
part of the poem itself.
<pre> maxling it is with a heart heavy that i admit loss of a feline so loved a friend lost to the unknown (night) ~cdr 11dec07</pre>
blockquote
elementcite
- Link to the source of the quotation.aria-*
attributes applicable
to the allowed roles.interface HTMLQuoteElement : HTMLElement { attribute DOMString cite; };
The HTMLQuoteElement
interface is also used by the q
element.
The blockquote
element represents content that is quoted from
another source, optionally with a citation which must be within a footer
or cite
element та optionally with in-line changes such as annotations and
abbreviations.
Content inside a blockquote
other than citations and in-line changes must be quoted from another
source, whose address, if it has one, may be cited in the cite
attribute.
In cases where a page contains contributions from multiple people, such as comments on a blog post, 'another source' can include text from the same page, written by another person.
Якщо the cite
attribute is present, it must be a valid
URL potentially surrounded by spaces. To obtain
the corresponding citation link, the value of the attribute must be resolved relative to the element. User
agents may allow users to follow such citation links, but they are
primarily intended for private use (e.g. by server-side scripts collecting
statistics about a site's use of quotations), not for readers.
The cite
IDL attribute must reflect the element's cite
content attribute.
The content of a blockquote
may be abbreviated, may have context added or may have annotations. Any
such additions or changes to quoted text must be indicated in the text (at
the text level). This may mean the use of notational conventions or
explicit remarks, such as "emphasis mine".
For example, in English, abbreviations are traditionally identified using square brackets. Consider a page with the sentence "Fred ate the cracker. He then said he liked apples and fish."; it could be quoted as follows:
<blockquote> <p>[Fred] then said he liked [...] fish.</p> </blockquote>
Quotation marks may be used to delineate between quoted text
and annotations within a blockquote
.
For example, an in-line note provided by the author:
<figure> <blockquote> "That monster custom, who all sense doth eat Of habit's devil," <abbr title="et cetera">&c.</abbr> not in Folio "What a falling off was there ! From me, whose love was of that dignity That it went hand in hand even with the vow I made to her in marriage та to decline Upon a wretch." </blockquote> <footer> — <cite class="title">Shakespeare manual</cite> by <cite class="author">Frederick Gard Fleay</cite>, p19 (in Google Books) </footer> </figure>
In the example above, the citation is contained within the
footer
of a figure
element, this groups and associates the information, about the quote,
with the quote. The figcaption
element was not used, in this case, as a container for the citation as
it is not a caption.
Attribution for the quotation, may be be placed inside the blockquote
element, but must be within a cite
element for in-text attributions or within a footer
element.
For example, here the attribution is given in a footer
after the quoted text, to clearly relate the quote to its attribution:
<blockquote> <p>I contend that we are both atheists. I just believe in one fewer god than you do. When you understand why you dismiss all the other possible gods, you will understand why I dismiss yours.</p> <footer>— <cite>Stephen Roberts</cite></footer> </blockquote>
Here the attribution is given in a cite
element on the last line of the quoted text. Note that a link to the
author is also included.
<blockquote> The people recognize themselves in their commodities; they find their soul in their automobile, hi-fi set, split-level home, kitchen equipment. — <cite><a href="http://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/Herbert_Marcuse">Herbert Marcuse</a></cite> </blockquote>
Here the attribution is given in a footer
after the quoted text та metadata about the reference has been added
using the Microdata
syntax (note it could have equally been marked up using RDFA
Lite).
<blockquote> <p>... she said she would not sign any deposition containing the word "amorous" instead of "advances". For her the difference was of crucial significance та one of the reasons she had separated from her husband was that he had never been amorous but had consistently made advances.</p> <footer itemscope itemtype="http://schema.org/Book"> <span itemprop="author">Heinrich Böll</span>, <span itemprop="name">The Lost Honor of Katharina Blum</span>, <span itemprop="datePublished">January 1, 1974</span> </footer> </blockquote>
There is no formal method for indicating the markup in a blockquote
is from a quoted
source. It is suggested that if the footer
or cite
elements are
included and these elements are also being used within a blockquote
to identify citations, the elements from the quoted source could be
annotated with metadata to identify their origin, for example by using the
class
attribute (a defined extensibility
mechanism).
In this example the source of a quote includes a cite
element, which is annotated using the class
attribute:
<blockquote> <p>My favorite book is <cite class="from-source">At Swim-Two-Birds</cite></p> <footer>- <cite>Mike[tm]Smith</cite></footer> </blockquote>
Here a blockquote
element is used in conjunction with a figure
element and its figcaption
:
<figure> <blockquote> <p>The truth may be puzzling. It may take some work to grapple with. It may be counterintuitive. It may contradict deeply held prejudices. It may not be consonant with what we desperately want to be true. But our preferences do not determine what's true. We have a method та that method helps us to reach not absolute truth, only asymptotic approaches to the truth — never there, just closer and closer, always finding vast new oceans of undiscovered possibilities. Cleverly designed experiments are the key.</p> </blockquote> <figcaption><cite>Carl Sagan</cite>, in "<cite>Wonder and Skepticism</cite>", from the <cite>Skeptical Enquirer</cite> Volume 19, Issue 1 (January-February 1995)</figcaption> </figure>
This next example shows the use of cite
alongside blockquote
:
<p>His next piece was the aptly named <cite>Sonnet 130</cite>:</p> <blockquote cite="http://quotes.example.org/s/sonnet130.html"> <p>My mistress' eyes are nothing like the sun,<br> Coral is far more red, than her lips red,<br> ...
This example shows how a forum post could use blockquote
to show what post a user is replying to. The article
element is used for each post, to mark up the threading.
<article> <h1><a href="http://bacon.example.com/?blog=109431">Bacon on a crowbar</a></h1> <article> <header><strong>t3yw</strong> 12 points 1 hour ago</header> <p>I bet a narwhal would love that.</p> <footer><a href="?pid=29578">permalink</a></footer> <article> <header><strong>greg</strong> 8 points 1 hour ago</header> <blockquote><p>I bet a narwhal would love that.</p></blockquote> <p>Dude narwhals don't eat bacon.</p> <footer><a href="?pid=29579">permalink</a></footer> <article> <header><strong>t3yw</strong> 15 points 1 hour ago</header> <blockquote> <blockquote><p>I bet a narwhal would love that.</p></blockquote> <p>Dude narwhals don't eat bacon.</p> </blockquote> <p>Next thing you'll be saying they don't get capes and wizard hats either!</p> <footer><a href="?pid=29580">permalink</a></footer> <article> <article> <header><strong>boing</strong> -5 points 1 hour ago</header> <p>narwhals are worse than ceiling cat</p> <footer><a href="?pid=29581">permalink</a></footer> </article> </article> </article> </article> <article> <header><strong>fred</strong> 1 points 23 minutes ago</header> <blockquote><p>I bet a narwhal would love that.</p></blockquote> <p>I bet they'd love to peel a banana too.</p> <footer><a href="?pid=29582">permalink</a></footer> </article> </article> </article>
This example shows the use of a blockquote
for short snippets, demonstrating that one does not have to use p
elements inside blockquote
elements:
<p>He began his list of "lessons" with the following:</p> <blockquote>One should never assume that his side of the issue will be recognized, let alone that it will be conceded to have merits.</blockquote> <p>He continued with a number of similar points, ending with:</p> <blockquote>Finally, one should be prepared for the threat of breakdown in negotiations at any given moment and not be cowed by the possibility.</blockquote> <p>We shall now discuss these points...
Examples of how to represent a
conversation are shown in a later section; it is not appropriate to
use the cite
and blockquote
elements for this purpose.
ol
elementli
element: Palpable content.li
and script-supporting elements.reversed
- Number the list backwards.start
- Ordinal value of the first item type
- Kind of list marker.list
role
(default - do not set), directory
, listbox
, menu
,
menubar
, presentation
, tablist
, toolbar
or tree
.aria-*
attributes applicable
to the allowed roles.interface HTMLOListElement : HTMLElement { attribute boolean reversed; attribute long start; attribute DOMString type; };
The ol
element represents
a list of items, where the items have been intentionally ordered, such
that changing the order would change the meaning of the document.
The items of the list are the li
element child nodes of the ol
element, in tree order.
The reversed
attribute is a boolean attribute. Якщо
present, it indicates that the list is a descending list (..., 3, 2, 1).
Якщо the attribute is omitted, the list is an ascending list (1, 2, 3,
...).
The start
attribute, if present, must be a valid integer
giving the ordinal value of the first list
item.
Якщо the start
attribute is present, user agents must parse it as an integer, in
order to determine the attribute's value. The default value, used if the
attribute is missing or if the value cannot be converted to a number
according to the referenced algorithm, is 1 if the element has no reversed
attribute та is the number of child li
elements otherwise.
The first item in the list has the ordinal
value given by the ol
element's start
attribute, unless that li
element has a value
attribute with a value that can be successfully parsed, in which case it
has the ordinal value given by that value
attribute.
Each subsequent item in the list has the ordinal
value given by its value
attribute, if it has one, or, if it doesn't, the ordinal
value of the previous item, plus one if the reversed
is absent, or minus one
if it is present.
The type
attribute can be used to specify the kind of marker to use in the list, in
the cases where that matters (e.g. because items are to be referenced by
their number/letter). The attribute, if specified, must have a value that
is a case-sensitive match for one of the
characters given in the first cell of one of the rows of the following
table. The type
attribute represents the state given in the cell in the second column of
the row whose first cell matches the attribute's value; if none of the
cells match, or if the attribute is omitted, then the attribute
represents the decimal
state.
Keyword | State | Description | Examples for values 1-3 and 3999-4001 | |||||||
---|---|---|---|---|---|---|---|---|---|---|
1
(U+0031) |
decimal | Decimal numbers | 1. | 2. | 3. | ... | 3999. | 4000. | 4001. | ... |
a
(U+0061) |
lower-alpha | Lowercase latin alphabet | a. | b. | c. | ... | ewu. | ewv. | eww. | ... |
A
(U+0041) |
upper-alpha | Uppercase latin alphabet | A. | B. | C. | ... | EWU. | EWV. | EWW. | ... |
i
(U+0069) |
lower-roman | Lowercase roman numerals | i. | ii. | iii. | ... | mmmcmxcix. | i̅v̅. | i̅v̅i. | ... |
I
(U+0049) |
upper-roman | Uppercase roman numerals | I. | II. | III. | ... | MMMCMXCIX. | I̅V̅. | I̅V̅I. | ... |
User agents should render the items of the list in a manner consistent
with the state of the type
attribute of the ol
element.
Numbers less than or equal to zero should always use the decimal system
regardless of the type
attribute.
For CSS user agents, a mapping for this attribute to the 'list-style-type' CSS property is given in the rendering section (the mapping is straightforward: the states above have the same names as their corresponding CSS values).
The reversed
,
start
та type
IDL attributes must reflect the respective
content attributes of the same name. The start
IDL attribute has the same
default as its content attribute.
The following markup shows a list where the order matters та where the
ol
element is therefore
appropriate. Compare this list to the equivalent list in the ul
section to see an example of the same items using the ul
element.
<p>I have lived in the following countries (given in the order of when I first lived there):</p> <ol> <li>Switzerland <li>United Kingdom <li>United States <li>Norway </ol>
Note how changing the order of the list changes the meaning of the document. In the following example, changing the relative order of the first two items has changed the birthplace of the author:
<p>I have lived in the following countries (given in the order of when I first lived there):</p> <ol> <li>United Kingdom <li>Switzerland <li>United States <li>Norway </ol>
ul
elementli
element: Palpable content.li
and script-supporting elements.list
role
(default - do not set), directory
, group
,
listbox
, menu
, menubar
,
presentation
,
tablist
, toolbar
or tree
.aria-*
attributes applicable
to the allowed roles.interface HTMLUListElement : HTMLElement {};
The ul
element represents
a list of items, where the order of the items is not important — that is,
where changing the order would not materially change the meaning of the
document.
The items of the list are the li
element child nodes of the ul
element.
The following markup shows a list where the order does not matter та
where the ul
element is
therefore appropriate. Compare this list to the equivalent list in the ol
section to see an example of
the same items using the ol
element.
<p>I have lived in the following countries:</p> <ul> <li>Norway <li>Switzerland <li>United Kingdom <li>United States </ul>
Note that changing the order of the list does not change the meaning of the document. The items in the snippet above are given in alphabetical order, but in the snippet below they are given in order of the size of their current account balance in 2007, without changing the meaning of the document whatsoever:
<p>I have lived in the following countries:</p> <ul> <li>Switzerland <li>Norway <li>United Kingdom <li>United States </ul>
li
elementol
elements.ul
elements.ol
element: value
- Ordinal value of the list itemAn li
element's end tag may be omitted if the li
element is immediately followed by another li
element or if there is no more content in the parent element.
listitem
role
(default - do not set), menuitem
, menuitemcheckbox
, menuitemradio
, option
, tab
,
treeitem
or presentation
.aria-*
attributes applicable
to the allowed roles.interface HTMLLIElement : HTMLElement { attribute long value; };
The li
element represents
a list item. Якщо its parent element is an ol
,
or ul
, then the element is an
item of the parent element's list, as defined for those elements. Інакше
the list item has no defined list-related relationship to any other li
element.
Якщо the parent element is an ol
element, then the li
element
has an ordinal value.
The value
attribute, if present, must be a valid integer
giving the ordinal value of the list item.
Якщо the value
attribute is present, user agents must parse it as an integer, in
order to determine the attribute's value. Якщо the attribute's value
cannot be converted to a number, the attribute must be treated as if it
was absent. The attribute has no default value.
The value
attribute is processed relative to the element's parent ol
element (q.v.), if there is one. Якщо there is not, the attribute has no
effect.
The value
IDL attribute must reflect the value of the value
content attribute.
The following example, the top ten movies are listed (in reverse
order). Note the way the list is given a title by using a figure
element and its figcaption
element.
<figure> <figcaption>The top 10 movies of all time</figcaption> <ol> <li value="10"><cite>Josie and the Pussycats</cite>, 2001</li> <li value="9"><cite lang="sh">Црна мачка, бели мачор</cite>, 1998</li> <li value="8"><cite>A Bug's Life</cite>, 1998</li> <li value="7"><cite>Toy Story</cite>, 1995</li> <li value="6"><cite>Monsters, Inc</cite>, 2001</li> <li value="5"><cite>Cars</cite>, 2006</li> <li value="4"><cite>Toy Story 2</cite>, 1999</li> <li value="3"><cite>Finding Nemo</cite>, 2003</li> <li value="2"><cite>The Incredibles</cite>, 2004</li> <li value="1"><cite>Ratatouille</cite>, 2007</li> </ol> </figure>
The markup could also be written as follows, using the reversed
attribute on the ol
element:
<figure> <figcaption>The top 10 movies of all time</figcaption> <ol reversed> <li><cite>Josie and the Pussycats</cite>, 2001</li> <li><cite lang="sh">Црна мачка, бели мачор</cite>, 1998</li> <li><cite>A Bug's Life</cite>, 1998</li> <li><cite>Toy Story</cite>, 1995</li> <li><cite>Monsters, Inc</cite>, 2001</li> <li><cite>Cars</cite>, 2006</li> <li><cite>Toy Story 2</cite>, 1999</li> <li><cite>Finding Nemo</cite>, 2003</li> <li><cite>The Incredibles</cite>, 2004</li> <li><cite>Ratatouille</cite>, 2007</li> </ol> </figure>
While it is conforming to include heading elements (e.g. h1
) inside
li
elements, it likely does not
convey the semantics that the author intended. A heading starts a new
section, so a heading in a list implicitly splits the list into spanning
multiple sections.
dl
elementdt
elements followed by one or more dd
elements, optionally intermixed with script-supporting
elements.aria-*
attributes applicable
to the allowed roles.interface HTMLDListElement : HTMLElement {};
The dl
element represents
an association list consisting of zero or more name-value groups (a
description list). A name-value group consists of one or more names (dt
elements) followed by one or more
values (dd
elements), ignoring
any nodes other than dt
and dd
elements. Within a single dl
element, there should not be more
than one dt
element for each
name.
Name-value groups may be terms and definitions, metadata topics and values, questions and answers, or any other groups of name-value data.
The values within a group are alternatives; multiple paragraphs forming
part of the same value must all be given within the same dd
element.
The order of the list of groups та of the names and values within each group, may be significant.
Якщо a dl
element is empty,
it contains no groups.
Якщо a dl
element has one
or more non-whitespace
Text
node children, or has child
elements що є neither dt
nor
dd
elements, all such Text
nodes and elements, as well as their
descendants (including any dt
or dd
elements), do not form
part of any groups in that dl
.
Якщо a dl
element has one
or more dt
element children
but no dd
element children,
then it consists of one group with names but no values.
Якщо a dl
element has one
or more dd
element children
but no dt
element children,
then it consists of one group with values but no names.
Якщо a dl
element's first dt
or dd
element child is a dd
element, then the first group has no associated name.
Якщо a dl
element's last dt
or dd
element child is a dt
element, then the last group has no associated value.
When a dl
element doesn't match its content model, it is often due to accidentally
using dd
elements in the
place of dt
elements and
vice versa. Conformance checkers can spot such mistakes and might be
able to advise authors how to correctly use the markup.
In the following example, one entry ("Authors") is linked to two values ("John" and "Luke").
<dl> <dt> Authors <dd> John <dd> Luke <dt> Editor <dd> Frank </dl>
In the following example, one definition is linked to two terms.
<dl> <dt lang="en-US"> <dfn>color</dfn> </dt> <dt lang="en-GB"> <dfn>colour</dfn> </dt> <dd> A sensation which (in humans) derives from the ability of the fine structure of the eye to distinguish three differently filtered analyses of a view. </dd> </dl>
The following example illustrates the use of the dl
element to mark up metadata of sorts. At the end of the example, one
group has two metadata labels ("Authors" and "Editors") and two values
("Robert Rothman" and "Daniel Jackson").
<dl> <dt> Last modified time </dt> <dd> 2004-12-23T23:33Z </dd> <dt> Recommended update interval </dt> <dd> 60s </dd> <dt> Authors </dt> <dt> Editors </dt> <dd> Robert Rothman </dd> <dd> Daniel Jackson </dd> </dl>
The following example shows the dl
element used to give a set of instructions. The order of the
instructions here is important (in the other examples, the order of the
blocks was not important).
<p>Determine the victory points as follows (use the first matching case):</p> <dl> <dt> Якщо you have exactly five gold coins </dt> <dd> You get five victory points </dd> <dt> Якщо you have one or more gold coins та you have one or more silver coins </dt> <dd> You get two victory points </dd> <dt> Якщо you have one or more silver coins </dt> <dd> You get one victory point </dd> <dt> Otherwise </dt> <dd> You get no victory points </dd> </dl>
The following snippet shows a dl
element being used as a glossary. Note the use of dfn
to indicate the word being defined.
<dl> <dt><dfn>Apartment</dfn>, n.</dt> <dd>An execution context grouping one or more threads with one or more COM objects.</dd> <dt><dfn>Flat</dfn>, n.</dt> <dd>A deflated tire.</dd> <dt><dfn>Home</dfn>, n.</dt> <dd>The user's login directory.</dd> </dl>
The dl
element
is inappropriate for marking up dialogue. Examples
of how to mark up dialogue are shown below.
dt
elementdd
or dt
elements inside dl
elements.header
,
footer
, sectioning
content, or heading content
descendants.A dt
element's end tag may be omitted if the dt
element is immediately followed by another dt
element or a dd
element.
aria-*
attributes applicable
to the allowed roles.HTMLElement
.The dt
element represents
the term, or name, part of a term-description group in a description list
(dl
element).
The dt
element
itself, when used in a dl
element, does not indicate that its contents are a term being defined, but
this can be indicated using the dfn
element.
This example shows a list of frequently asked questions (a FAQ) marked
up using the dt
element for
questions and the dd
element
for answers.
<article> <h1>FAQ</h1> <dl> <dt>What do we want?</dt> <dd>Our data.</dd> <dt>When do we want it?</dt> <dd>Now.</dd> <dt>Where is it?</dt> <dd>We are not sure.</dd> </dl> </article>
dd
elementdt
or dd
elements inside dl
elements.A dd
element's end tag may be omitted if the dd
element is immediately followed by another dd
element or a dt
element,
or if there is no more content in the parent element.
aria-*
attributes applicable
to the allowed roles.HTMLElement
.The dd
element represents
the description, definition, or value, part of a term-description group in
a description list (dl
element).
A dl
can be used to define
a vocabulary list, like in a dictionary. In the following example, each
entry, given by a dt
with a
dfn
, has several dd
s,
showing the various parts of the definition.
<dl> <dt><dfn>happiness</dfn></dt> <dd class="pronunciation">/'hæ p. nes/</dd> <dd class="part-of-speech"><i><abbr>n.</abbr></i></dd> <dd>The state of being happy.</dd> <dd>Good fortune; success. <q>Oh <b>happiness</b>! It worked!</q></dd> <dt><dfn>rejoice</dfn></dt> <dd class="pronunciation">/ri jois'/</dd> <dd><i class="part-of-speech"><abbr>v.intr.</abbr></i> To be delighted oneself.</dd> <dd><i class="part-of-speech"><abbr>v.tr.</abbr></i> To cause one to be delighted.</dd> </dl>
figure
elementfigcaption
element followed by flow content.figcaption
element.aria-*
attributes applicable
to the allowed roles.HTMLElement
.The figure
element represents
some flow content, optionally with a
caption, that is self-contained (like a complete sentence) and is
typically referenced as a single unit from the main flow of the document.
Self-contained in this context does not necessarily mean
independent. For example, each sentence in a paragraph is self-contained;
an image that is part of a sentence would be inappropriate for figure
,
but an entire sentence made of images would be fitting.
The element can thus be used to annotate illustrations, diagrams, photos, code listings, etc.
When a figure
is
referred to from the main content of the document by identifying it by
its caption (e.g. by figure number), it enables such content to be
easily moved away from that primary content, e.g. to the side of the
page, to dedicated pages, or to an appendix, without affecting the flow
of the document.
Якщо a figure
element
is referenced by its relative position, e.g. "in the photograph above"
or "as the next figure shows", then moving the figure would disrupt the
page's meaning. Authors are encouraged to consider using labels to refer
to figures, rather than using such relative references, so that the page
can easily be restyled without affecting the page's meaning.
The first figcaption
element child of the element, if any, represents the caption of the figure
element's contents. Якщо
there is no child figcaption
element, then there is no caption.
A figure
element's
contents are part of the surrounding flow. Якщо the purpose of the page is
to display the figure, for example a photograph on an image sharing site,
the figure
and figcaption
elements can be used to explicitly provide a caption for that figure. For
content that is only tangentially related, or that serves a separate
purpose than the surrounding flow, the aside
element should be used (and can itself wrap a figure
).
For example, a pull quote that repeats content from an article
would be more appropriate in an aside
than in a figure
, because
it isn't part of the content, it's a repetition of the content for the
purposes of enticing readers or highlighting key topics.
This example shows the figure
element to mark up a code listing.
<p>In <a href="#l4">listing 4</a> we see the primary core interface API declaration.</p> <figure id="l4"> <figcaption>Listing 4. The primary core interface API declaration.</figcaption> <pre><code>interface PrimaryCore { boolean verifyDataLine(); void sendData(in sequence<byte> data); void initSelfDestruct(); }</code></pre> </figure> <p>The API is designed to use UTF-8.</p>
Here we see a figure
element to mark up a photo that is the main content of the page (as in a
gallery).
<!DOCTYPE HTML> <title>Bubbles at work — My Gallery™</title> <figure> <img src="bubbles-work.jpeg" alt="Bubbles, sitting in his office chair, works on his latest project intently."> <figcaption>Bubbles at work</figcaption> </figure> <nav><a href="19414.html">Prev</a> — <a href="19416.html">Next</a></nav>
In this example, we see an image that is not a figure, as
well as an image and a video що є. The first image is literally part of
the example's second sentence, so it's not a self-contained unit та thus
figure
would be
inappropriate.
<h2>Malinko's comics</h2> <p>This case centered on some sort of "intellectual property" infringement related to a comic (see Exhibit A). The suit started after a trailer ending with these words: <blockquote> <img src="promblem-packed-action.png" alt="ROUGH COPY! Promblem-Packed Action!"> </blockquote> <p>...was aired. A lawyer, armed with a Bigger Notebook, launched a preemptive strike using snowballs. A complete copy of the trailer is included with Exhibit B. <figure> <img src="ex-a.png" alt="Two squiggles on a dirty piece of paper."> <figcaption>Exhibit A. The alleged <cite>rough copy</cite> comic.</figcaption> </figure> <figure> <video src="ex-b.mov"></video> <figcaption>Exhibit B. The <cite>Rough Copy</cite> trailer.</figcaption> </figure> <p>The case was resolved out of court.
Here, a part of a poem is marked up using figure
.
<figure> <p>'Twas brillig та the slithy toves<br> Did gyre and gimble in the wabe;<br> All mimsy were the borogoves,<br> And the mome raths outgrabe.</p> <figcaption><cite>Jabberwocky</cite> (first verse). Lewis Carroll, 1832-98</figcaption> </figure>
In this example, which could be part of a much larger work discussing a
castle, nested figure
elements are used to provide both a group caption and individual
captions for each figure in the group:
<figure> <figcaption>The castle through the ages: 1423, 1858 та 1999 respectively.</figcaption> <figure> <figcaption>Etching. Anonymous, ca. 1423.</figcaption> <img src="castle1423.jpeg" alt="The castle has one tower та a tall wall around it."> </figure> <figure> <figcaption>Oil-based paint on canvas. Maria Towle, 1858.</figcaption> <img src="castle1858.jpeg" alt="The castle now has two towers and two walls."> </figure> <figure> <figcaption>Film photograph. Peter Jankle, 1999.</figcaption> <img src="castle1999.jpeg" alt="The castle lies in ruins, the original tower all that remains in one piece."> </figure> </figure>
The figure is sometimes referenced only implicitly from the content:
<article> <h1>Fiscal negotiations stumble in Congress as deadline nears</h1> <figure> <img src="obama-reid.jpeg" alt="Obama and Reid sit together smiling in the Oval Office."> <figcaption>Barrak Obama and Harry Reid. White House press photograph.</figcaption> </figure> <p>Negotiations in Congress to end the fiscal impasse sputtered on Tuesday, leaving both chambers grasping for a way to reopen the government and raise the country's borrowing authority with a Thursday deadline drawing near.</p> ... </article>
figcaption
elementfigure
element.aria-*
attributes applicable
to the allowed roles.HTMLElement
.The figcaption
element represents a caption or legend for the
rest of the contents of the figcaption
element's parent figure
element, if any.
div
elementaria-*
attributes applicable
to the allowed roles.interface HTMLDivElement : HTMLElement {};
The div
element has no
special meaning at all. It represents its
children. It can be used with the class
, lang
та title
attributes to mark up semantics
common to a group of consecutive elements.
Authors are strongly encouraged to view the div
element as an element of last resort, for when no other element is
suitable. Use of more appropriate elements instead of the div
element leads to better accessibility for readers and easier
maintainability for authors.
For example, a blog post would be marked up using article
,
a chapter using section
,
a page's navigation aids using nav
та a group of form controls using fieldset
.
On the other hand, div
elements can be useful for stylistic purposes or to wrap multiple
paragraphs within a section що є all to be annotated in a similar way.
In the following example, we see div
elements used as a way to set the language of two paragraphs at once,
instead of setting the language on the two paragraph elements
separately:
<article lang="en-US"> <h1>My use of language and my cats</h1> <p>My cat's behavior hasn't changed much since her absence, except that she plays her new physique to the neighbors regularly, in an attempt to get pets.</p> <div lang="en-GB"> <p>My other cat, coloured black and white, is a sweetie. He followed us to the pool today, walking down the pavement with us. Yesterday he apparently visited our neighbours. I wonder if he recognises that their flat is a mirror image of ours.</p> <p>Hm, I just noticed that in the last paragraph I used British English. But I'm supposed to write in American English. So I shouldn't say "pavement" or "flat" or "colour"...</p> </div> <p>I should say "sidewalk" and "apartment" and "color"!</p> </article>
main
elementarticle
, aside
, footer
,
header
or nav
element ancestors.main
role
(default - do not set) or presentation
.aria-*
attributes applicable
to the allowed roles.HTMLElement
The main
element represents
the main content of the body
of a document or application. The main content area consists of content
that is directly related to or expands upon the central topic of a
document or central functionality of an application.
The main
element is not sectioning content and
has no effect on the document outline
The main content area of a document includes content that is unique to that document and excludes content that is repeated across a set of documents such as site navigation links, copyright information, site logos and banners and search forms (unless the document or applications main function is that of a search form).
User agents that support keyboard navigation of content are
strongly encouraged to provide a method to navigate to the main
element and once navigated to, ensure the next element in the focus order
is the first focusable element within the main
element. This will provide a simple method for keyboard users to bypass
blocks of content such as navigation links.
Authors must not include more than one main
element in a document.
Authors must not include the main
element as a descendant of an article
,
aside
, footer
,
header
or nav
element.
The main
element is not suitable for use to identify the main content areas of sub
sections of a document or application. The simplest solution is to not
mark up the main content of a sub section at all та just leave it as
implicit, but an author could use a grouping content or sectioning content element as
appropriate.
Authors are advised to use ARIA role="main"
attribute on the main
element until user agents implement the required role mapping.
<main role="main"> ... </main>
In the following example, we see 2 articles about skateboards (the main
topic of a Web page) the main topic content is identified by the use of
the main
element.
<!-- other content --> <main> <h1>Skateboards</h1> <p>The skateboard is the way cool kids get around</p> <article> <h2>Longboards</h2> <p>Longboards are a type of skateboard with a longer wheelbase and larger, softer wheels.</p> <p>... </p> <p>... </p> </article> <article> <h2>Electric Skateboards</h2> <p>These no longer require the propelling of the skateboard by means of the feet; rather an electric motor propels the board, fed by an electric battery.</p> <p>... </p> <p>... </p> </article> </main> <!-- other content -->
Here is a graduation programme the main content section is defined by the
use of the main
element.
Note in this example the main
element contains a nav
element consisting of links to sub sections of the main content.
<!DOCTYPE html> <html> <head>
<title>Graduation Ceremony Summer 2022</title> </head> <body> <header>The Lawson Academy: <nav> <ul> <li><a href="courses.html">Courses</a></li> <li><a href="fees.html">Fees</a></li> <li><a>Graduation</a></li> </ul> </nav> </header> <main> <h1>Graduation</h1> <nav> <ul> <li><a href="#ceremony">Ceremony</a></li> <li><a href="#graduates">Graduates</a></li> <li><a href="#awards">Awards</a></li> </ul> </nav> <H2 id="ceremony">Ceremony</H2> <p>Opening Procession</p> <p>Speech by Valedictorian</p> <p>Speech by Class President</p> <p>Presentation of Diplomas</p> <p>Closing Speech by Headmaster</p> <h2 id="graduates">Graduates</h2> <ul> <li>Eileen Williams</li> <li>Andy Maseyk</li> <li>Blanca Sainz Garcia</li> <li>Clara Faulkner</li> <li>Gez Lemon</li> <li>Eloisa Faulkner</li> </ul> <h2 id="awards">Awards</h2> <ul> <li>Clara Faulkner</li> <li>Eloisa Faulkner</li> <li>Blanca Sainz Garcia</li> </ul> </main> <footer> Copyright 2012 B.lawson</footer> </body> </html>
a
elementhref
- Address of the hyperlinktarget
- Default browsing context for hyperlink
navigation and form
submissiondownload
- Whether to download the resource instead of navigating to it та its
file name if sorel
- Relationship between the document containing the hyperlink and the
destination resourcehreflang
- Language of the linked resourcetype
- Hint for the type of the referenced resourcelink
(default - do not set), button
, checkbox
,
menuitem
, menuitemcheckbox
, menuitemradio
, tab
or treeitem
aria-*
attributes applicable
to the allowed roles.interface HTMLAnchorElement : HTMLElement { attribute DOMString target; attribute DOMString download; attribute DOMString rel; attribute DOMString rev; readonly attribute DOMTokenList relList; attribute DOMString hreflang; attribute DOMString type; attribute DOMString text; }; HTMLAnchorElement implements URLUtils;
Якщо the a
element has an href
attribute, then it represents a hyperlink
(a hypertext anchor) labeled by its contents.
Якщо the a
element has no href
attribute, then the element represents a
placeholder for where a link might otherwise have been placed, if it had
been relevant, consisting of just the element's contents.
The target
,
download
,
rel
,
hreflang
та type
attributes must be omitted if the href
attribute is not present.
Якщо a site uses a consistent navigation toolbar on every page, then
the link that would normally link to the page itself could be marked up
using an a
element:
<nav> <ul> <li> <a href="/">Home</a> </li> <li> <a href="/news">News</a> </li> <li> <a>Examples</a> </li> <li> <a href="/legal">Legal</a> </li> </ul> </nav>
The href
,
target
,
download
та
attributes affect what happens when users follow hyperlinks or download hyperlinks created using
the a
element. The rel
, hreflang
та type
attributes may be used
to indicate to the user the likely nature of the target resource before
the user follows the link.
The activation behavior of a
elements that create hyperlinks is to run the following steps:
Якщо the a
element's Document
is not fully
active, then abort these steps.
Якщо either the a
element has a download
attribute and the algorithm is not allowed
to show a popup, or the element's target
attribute is
present and applying the
rules for choosing a browsing context given a browsing context
name, using the value of the target
attribute as the
browsing context name, would result in there not being a chosen
browsing context, тоді виконайте ці субкроки:
Якщо there is an entry
settings object, throw an InvalidAccessError
exception.
Abort these steps without following the hyperlink.
Якщо the target of the click
event is an img
element
with an ismap
attribute specified, then server-side image map processing must be
performed, as follows:
click
event was a real pointing-device-triggered click
event on the img
element, then let x be the
distance in CSS pixels from the left edge of the image's left
border, if it has one, or the left edge of the image otherwise, to
the location of the click та let y
be the distance in CSS pixels from the top edge of the image's top
border, if it has one, or the top edge of the image otherwise, to
the location of the click. Інакше let x
and y be zero.Finally, the user agent must follow the hyperlink or download the hyperlink created
by the a
element, as
determined by the download
attribute
and any expressed user preference. Якщо the steps above defined a hyperlink suffix, then take
that into account when following or downloading the hyperlink.
text
Same as textContent
.
The IDL attributes download
,
target
,
rel
,
rev
,
hreflang
та type
,
must reflect the respective content attributes
of the same name.
The IDL attribute relList
must reflect the rel
content attribute.
The text
IDL attribute, on getting, must return the same value as the textContent
IDL attribute on the element та on setting, must act as if the textContent
IDL attribute on the
element had been set to the new value.
The a
element also supports
the URLUtils
interface. [URL]
When the element is created та whenever the element's href
content attribute is
set, changed, or removed, the user agent must invoke the element's URLUtils
interface's set the input algorithm with the
value of the href
content attribute, if any, or the empty string otherwise, as the given
value.
The element's URLUtils
interface's get
the base algorithm must simply return the
element's base URL.
The element's URLUtils
interface's query
encoding is the document's
character encoding.
When the element's URLUtils
interface invokes its update
steps with a string value, the
user agent must set the element's href
content attribute to the
string value.
The a
element may be wrapped
around entire paragraphs, lists, tables та so forth, even entire
sections, so long as there is no interactive content within (e.g.
buttons or other links). This example shows how this can be used to make
an entire advertising block into a link:
<aside class="advertising"> <h1>Advertising</h1> <a href="http://ad.example.com/?adid=1929&pubid=1422"> <section> <h1>Mellblomatic 9000!</h1> <p>Turn all your widgets into mellbloms!</p> <p>Only $9.99 plus shipping and handling.</p> </section> </a> <a href="http://ad.example.com/?adid=375&pubid=1422"> <section> <h1>The Mellblom Browser</h1> <p>Web browsing at the speed of light.</p> <p>No other browser goes faster!</p> </section> </a> </aside>
em
elementaria-*
attributes applicable
to the allowed roles.HTMLElement
.The em
element represents
stress emphasis of its contents.
The level of stress that a particular piece of content has is given by
its number of ancestor em
elements.
The placement of stress emphasis changes the meaning of the sentence. The element thus forms an integral part of the content. The precise way in which stress is used in this way depends on the language.
These examples show how changing the stress emphasis changes the meaning. First, a general statement of fact, with no stress:
<p>Cats are cute animals.</p>
By emphasizing the first word, the statement implies that the kind of animal under discussion is in question (maybe someone is asserting that dogs are cute):
<p><em>Cats</em> are cute animals.</p>
Moving the stress to the verb, one highlights that the truth of the entire sentence is in question (maybe someone is saying cats are not cute):
<p>Cats <em>are</em> cute animals.</p>
By moving it to the adjective, the exact nature of the cats is reasserted (maybe someone suggested cats were mean animals):
<p>Cats are <em>cute</em> animals.</p>
Similarly, if someone asserted that cats were vegetables, someone correcting this might emphasize the last word:
<p>Cats are cute <em>animals</em>.</p>
By emphasizing the entire sentence, it becomes clear that the speaker is fighting hard to get the point across. This kind of stress emphasis also typically affects the punctuation, hence the exclamation mark here.
<p><em>Cats are cute animals!</em></p>
Anger mixed with emphasizing the cuteness could lead to markup such as:
<p><em>Cats are <em>cute</em> animals!</em></p>
The em
element isn't a
generic "italics" element. Sometimes, text is intended to stand out from
the rest of the paragraph, as if it was in a different mood or voice.
For this, the i
element is
more appropriate.
The em
element also isn't
intended to convey importance; for that purpose, the strong
element is more appropriate.
strong
elementaria-*
attributes applicable
to the allowed roles.HTMLElement
.The strong
element represents
strong importance, seriousness, or urgency for its contents.
Importance: The strong
element can be used in a heading, caption, or paragraph to distinguish the
part that really matters from other parts of the that might be more
detailed, more jovial, or merely boilerplate.
For example, the first word of the previous paragraph is
marked up with strong
to
distinguish it from the more detailed text in the rest of the paragraph.
Seriousness: The strong
element can be used to mark up a warning or caution notice.
Urgency: The strong
element can be used to denote contents that the user needs to see sooner
than other parts of the document.
The relative level of importance of a piece of content is given by its
number of ancestor strong
elements; each strong
element increases the importance of its contents.
Changing the importance of a piece of text with the strong
element does not change the meaning of the sentence.
Here, the word "chapter" and the actual chapter number are mere
boilerplate та the actual name of the chapter is marked up with strong
:
<h1>Chapter 1: <strong>The Praxis</strong></h1>
In the following example, the name of the diagram in the caption is
marked up with strong
,
to distinguish it from boilerplate text (before) and the description
(after):
<figcaption>Figure 1. <strong>Ant colony dynamics</strong>. The ants in this colony are affected by the heat source (upper left) and the food source (lower right).</figcaption>
In this example, the heading is really "Flowers, Bees та Honey", but
the author has added a light-hearted addition to the heading. The strong
element is thus used to
mark up the first part to distinguish it from the latter part.
<h1><strong>Flowers, Bees та Honey</strong> and other things I don't understand</h1>
Here is an example of a warning notice in a game, with the various parts marked up according to how important they are:
<p><strong>Warning.</strong> This dungeon is dangerous. <strong>Avoid the ducks.</strong> Take any gold you find. <strong><strong>Do not take any of the diamonds</strong>, they are explosive and <strong>will destroy anything within ten meters.</strong></strong> You have been warned.</p>
In this example, the strong
element is used to denote the part of the text that the user is intended
to read first.
<p>Welcome to Remy, the reminder system.</p> <p>Your tasks for today:</p> <ul> <li><p><strong>Turn off the oven.</strong></p></li> <li><p>Put out the trash.</p></li> <li><p>Do the laundry.</p></li> </ul>
small
elementaria-*
attributes applicable
to the allowed roles.HTMLElement
.The small
element represents
side comments such as small print.
Small print typically features disclaimers, caveats, legal restrictions, or copyrights. Small print is also sometimes used for attribution, or for satisfying licensing requirements.
The small
element does not "de-emphasize" or lower the importance of text emphasized
by the em
element or marked as
important with the strong
element. To mark text as not emphasized or important, simply do not mark
it up with the em
or strong
elements respectively.
The small
element should
not be used for extended spans of text, such as multiple paragraphs,
lists, or sections of text. It is only intended for short runs of text.
The text of a page listing terms of use, for instance, would not be a
suitable candidate for the small
element: in such a case, the text is not a side comment, it is the main
content of the page.
In this example, the small
element is used to indicate that value-added tax is not included in a
price of a hotel room:
<dl> <dt>Single room <dd>199 € <small>breakfast included, VAT not included</small> <dt>Double room <dd>239 € <small>breakfast included, VAT not included</small> </dl>
In this second example, the small
element is used for a side comment in an article.
<p>Example Corp today announced record profits for the second quarter <small>(Full Disclosure: Foo News is a subsidiary of Example Corp)</small>, leading to speculation about a third quarter merger with Demo Group.</p>
This is distinct from a sidebar, which might be multiple paragraphs long and is removed from the main flow of text. In the following example, we see a sidebar from the same article. This sidebar also has small print, indicating the source of the information in the sidebar.
<aside> <h1>Example Corp</h1> <p>This company mostly creates small software and Web sites.</p> <p>The Example Corp company mission is "To provide entertainment and news on a sample basis".</p> <p><small>Information obtained from <a href="http://example.com/about.html">example.com</a> home page.</small></p> </aside>
In this last example, the small
element is marked as being important small print.
<p><strong><small>Continued use of this service will result in a kiss.</small></strong></p>
s
elementaria-*
attributes applicable
to the allowed roles.HTMLElement
.The s
element represents
contents що є no longer accurate or no longer relevant.
The s
element is
not appropriate when indicating document edits; to mark a span of text as
having been removed from a document, use the del
element.
In this example a recommended retail price has been marked as no longer relevant as the product in question has a new sale price.
<p>Buy our Iced Tea and Lemonade!</p> <p><s>Recommended retail price: $3.99 per bottle</s></p> <p><strong>Now selling for just $2.99 a bottle!</strong></p>
cite
elementaria-*
attributes applicable
to the allowed roles.HTMLElement
.The cite
element represents
a reference to a creative work. It must include the title of the work or
the name of the author(person, people or organization) or an URL
reference, which may be in an abbreviated form as per the conventions used
for the addition of citation metadata.
Creative works include a book, a paper, an essay, a poem, a score, a song, a script, a film, a TV show, a game, a sculpture, a painting, a theatre production, a play, an opera, a musical, an exhibition, a legal case report, a web site, a web page, a blog post or comment, a forum post or comment, a tweet, a written or oral statement, etc.
Here is an example of the author of a quote referenced using the cite
element:
<p>In the words of <cite>Charles Bukowski</cite> - <q>An intellectual says a simple thing in a hard way. An artist says a hard thing in a simple way.</q></p>
This second example identifies the author of a tweet by referencing the
authors name using the cite
element:
<blockquote class="twitter-tweet"> <p>♥ Bukowski in <a href="https://twitter.com/search?q=%23HTML5&src=hash">#HTML5</a> spec examples <a href="http://t.co/0FIEiYN1pC">http://t.co/0FIEiYN1pC</a></p><cite>— karl dubost (@karlpro) <a href="https://twitter.com/karlpro/statuses/370905307293442048">August 23, 2013</a></cite> </blockquote>
In this example the cite
element is used to reference the title of a work in a bibliography:
<p><cite>Universal Declaration of Human Rights</cite>, United Nations, December 1948. Adopted by General Assembly resolution 217 A (III).</p>
In this example the cite
element is used to reference the title of a television show:
<p>Who is your favorite doctor (in <cite>Doctor Who</cite>)?</p>
A very common use for the cite
element is to identify the author of a comment in a blog post or forum,
as in this example:
<article id="comment-1"> Comment by <cite><a href="http://oli.jp">Oli Studholme</a></cite> <time datetime="2013-08-19T16:01">August 19th, 2013 at 4:01 pm</time> <p>Unfortunately I don't think adding names back into the definition of <code>cite</code> solves the problem: of the 12 blockquote examples in <a href="http://oli.jp/example/blockquote-metadata/">Examples of block quote metadata</a>, there's not even one that's <em>just</em> a person’s name.</p> <p>A subset of the problem, maybe…</p> </article>
Another common use for the cite
element is to reference the URL
of a search result, as in
this example:
<div id="resultStats">About 416,000,000 results 0.33 seconds) </div> ... <p><a href="http://www.w3.org/html/wg/">W3C <i>HTML Working Group</i></a></p> <p><cite>www.w3.org/<b>html</b>/wg/</cite></p> <p>15 Apr 2013 - The <i>HTML Working Group</i> is currently chartered to continue its work through 31 December 2014. A Plan 2014 document published by the...</p> ...
A citation is not a quote (for which the
q
element is appropriate).
This is incorrect usage, because cite
is not for quotes:
<p><cite>This is wrong!, said Hillary.</cite> is a quote from the popular daytime TV drama When Ian became Hillary.</p>
This is an example of the correct usage:
<p><q>This is correct, said Hillary.</q> is a quote from the popular daytime TV drama <cite>When Ian became Hillary</cite>.</p>
q
elementcite
- Link to the source of the quotation or more information about the editaria-*
attributes applicable
to the allowed roles.HTMLQuoteElement
.The q
element represents
some phrasing
content quoted from another source.
Quotation punctuation (such as quotation marks) that is quoting the
contents of the element must not appear immediately before, after, or
inside q
elements; they will be
inserted into the rendering by the user agent.
Content inside a q
element
must be quoted from another source, whose address, if it has one, may be
cited in the cite
attribute. The source may be fictional, as when quoting characters in a
novel or screenplay.
Якщо the cite
attribute is present, it must be a valid
URL potentially surrounded by spaces. To obtain
the corresponding citation link, the value of the attribute must be resolved
relative to the element. User agents may allow users to follow
such citation links, but they are primarily intended for private use (e.g.
by server-side scripts collecting statistics about a site's use of
quotations), not for readers.
The q
element must not be used
in place of quotation marks that do not represent quotes; for example, it
is inappropriate to use the q
element for marking up sarcastic statements.
The use of q
elements to mark
up quotations is entirely optional; using explicit quotation punctuation
without q
elements is just as
correct.
Here is a simple example of the use of the q
element:
<p>The man said <q>Things що є impossible just take longer</q>. I disagreed with him.</p>
Here is an example with both an explicit citation link in the q
element та an explicit citation
outside:
<p>The W3C page <cite>About W3C</cite> says the W3C's mission is <q cite="http://www.w3.org/Consortium/">To lead the World Wide Web to its full potential by developing protocols and guidelines that ensure long-term growth for the Web</q>. I disagree with this mission.</p>
In the following example, the quotation itself contains a quotation:
<p>In <cite>Example One</cite>, he writes <q>The man said <q>Things що є impossible just take longer</q>. I disagreed with him</q>. Well, I disagree even more!</p>
In the following example, quotation marks are used instead of the q
element:
<p>His best argument was ❝I disagree❞, which I thought was laughable.</p>
In the following example, there is no quote — the quotation marks are
used to name a word. Use of the q
element in this case would be inappropriate.
<p>The word "ineffable" could have been used to describe the disaster resulting from the campaign's mismanagement.</p>
dfn
elementdfn
element descendants.title
attribute has special semantics on this element.aria-*
attributes applicable
to the allowed roles.HTMLElement
.The dfn
element represents
the defining instance of a term. The paragraph,
description list group,
or section
that is the nearest ancestor of the dfn
element must also contain the definition(s) for the term given by the dfn
element.
Defining term: Якщо the dfn
element has a title
attribute, then the exact value of that attribute is the term being
defined. Інакше if it contains exactly one element child node and no child
Text
nodes та that child element is an
abbr
element with a title
attribute, then the exact
value of that attribute is the term being defined. Інакше it is
the exact textContent
of the dfn
element that gives the term
being defined.
Якщо the title
attribute of the dfn
element
is present, then it must contain only the term being defined.
The title
attribute of ancestor elements does not affect dfn
elements.
An a
element that links to a dfn
element represents an instance
of the term defined by the dfn
element.
In the following fragment, the term "Garage Door Opener" is first defined in the first paragraph, then used in the second. In both cases, its abbreviation is what is actually displayed.
<p>The <dfn><abbr title="Garage Door Opener">GDO</abbr></dfn> is a device that allows off-world teams to open the iris.</p> <!-- ... later in the document: --> <p>Teal'c activated his <abbr title="Garage Door Opener">GDO</abbr> and so Hammond ordered the iris to be opened.</p>
With the addition of an a
element, the reference can be made explicit:
<p>The <dfn id=gdo><abbr title="Garage Door Opener">GDO</abbr></dfn> is a device that allows off-world teams to open the iris.</p> <!-- ... later in the document: --> <p>Teal'c activated his <a href=#gdo><abbr title="Garage Door Opener">GDO</abbr></a> and so Hammond ordered the iris to be opened.</p>
abbr
elementtitle
attribute has special semantics on this element.aria-*
attributes applicable
to the allowed roles.HTMLElement
.The abbr
element represents
an abbreviation or acronym, optionally with its expansion. The title
attribute may be used to
provide an expansion of the abbreviation. The attribute, if specified,
must contain an expansion of the abbreviation та nothing else.
The paragraph below contains an abbreviation marked up with the abbr
element. This paragraph defines the
term "Web Hypertext Application Technology Working Group".
<p>The <dfn id=whatwg><abbr title="Web Hypertext Application Technology Working Group">WHATWG</abbr></dfn> is a loose unofficial collaboration of Web browser manufacturers and interested parties who wish to develop new technologies designed to allow authors to write and deploy Applications over the World Wide Web.</p>
An alternative way to write this would be:
<p>The <dfn id=whatwg>Web Hypertext Application Technology Working Group</dfn> (<abbr title="Web Hypertext Application Technology Working Group">WHATWG</abbr>) is a loose unofficial collaboration of Web browser manufacturers and interested parties who wish to develop new technologies designed to allow authors to write and deploy Applications over the World Wide Web.</p>
This paragraph has two abbreviations. Notice how only one is defined;
the other, with no expansion associated with it, does not use the abbr
element.
<p>The <abbr title="Web Hypertext Application Technology Working Group">WHATWG</abbr> started working on HTML5 in 2004.</p>
This paragraph links an abbreviation to its definition.
<p>The <a href="#whatwg"><abbr title="Web Hypertext Application Technology Working Group">WHATWG</abbr></a> community does not have much representation from Asia.</p>
This paragraph marks up an abbreviation without giving an expansion, possibly as a hook to apply styles for abbreviations (e.g. smallcaps).
<p>Philip` and Dashiva both denied that they were going to get the issue counts from past revisions of the specification to backfill the <abbr>WHATWG</abbr> issue graph.</p>
Якщо an abbreviation is pluralized, the expansion's grammatical number (plural vs singular) must match the grammatical number of the contents of the element.
Here the plural is outside the element, so the expansion is in the singular:
<p>Two <abbr title="Working Group">WG</abbr>s worked on this specification: the <abbr>WHATWG</abbr> and the <abbr>HTMLWG</abbr>.</p>
Here the plural is inside the element, so the expansion is in the plural:
<p>Two <abbr title="Working Groups">WGs</abbr> worked on this specification: the <abbr>WHATWG</abbr> and the <abbr>HTMLWG</abbr>.</p>
Abbreviations do not have to be marked up using this element. It is expected to be useful in the following cases:
abbr
element
with a title
attribute is an alternative to including the expansion inline (e.g. in
parentheses).abbr
element with
a title
attribute or include the expansion inline in the text the first time the
abbreviation is used.abbr
element can be used without a title
attribute.Providing an expansion in a title
attribute once will not
necessarily cause other abbr
elements in the same document with the same contents but without a title
attribute to behave as if they had the same expansion. Every abbr
element is independent.
data
elementvalue
- Machine-readable value aria-*
attributes applicable
to the allowed roles.interface HTMLDataElement : HTMLElement { attribute DOMString value; };
The data
element represents
its contents, along with a machine-readable form of those contents in the
value
attribute.
The value
attribute must be present. Its value must be a representation of the
element's contents in a machine-readable format.
When the value is date- or time-related, the more specific time
element can be used instead.
The element can be used for several purposes.
When combined with microformats or
microdata,
the element serves to provide both a machine-readable value for
the purposes of data processors та a human-readable value for the purposes
of rendering in a Web browser. In this case, the format to be used in the
value
attribute is determined by the microformats or microdata vocabulary in
use.
The element can also, however, be used in conjunction with scripts in the
page, for when a script has a literal value to store alongside a
human-readable value. In such cases, the format to be used depends only on
the needs of the script. (The data-*
attributes can also be useful in such situations.)
The value
IDL attribute must reflect the content attribute
of the same name.
time
elementdatetime
- Machine-readable valuearia-*
attributes applicable
to the allowed roles.interface HTMLTimeElement : HTMLElement { attribute DOMString dateTime; };
The time
element represents
its contents, along with a machine-readable form of those contents in the
datetime
attribute. The kind of content is limited to various kinds of dates,
times, time-zone offsets та durations, as described below.
The datetime
attribute may be present. Якщо present, its value must be a representation
of the element's contents in a machine-readable format.
A time
element that does
not have a datetime
content attribute must not have any element descendants.
The datetime value of a time
element is the value of the element's datetime
content attribute, if
it has one, or the element's textContent
,
if it does not.
The datetime value of a time
element must match one of the following syntaxes.
<time>2011-11</time>
<time>2011-11-12</time>
<time>11-12</time>
<time>14:54</time>
<time>14:54:39</time>
<time>14:54:39.929</time>
<time>2011-11-12T14:54</time>
<time>2011-11-12T14:54:39</time>
<time>2011-11-12T14:54:39.929</time>
<time>2011-11-12 14:54</time>
<time>2011-11-12 14:54:39</time>
<time>2011-11-12 14:54:39.929</time>
Times with dates but without a time zone offset are useful for specifying events що є observed at the same specific time in each time zone, throughout a day. For example, the 2020 new year is celebrated at 2020-01-01 00:00 in each time zone, not at the same precise moment across all time zones. For events that occur at the same time across all time zones, for example a videoconference meeting, a valid global date and time string is likely more useful.
<time>Z</time>
<time>+0000</time>
<time>+00:00</time>
<time>-0800</time>
<time>-08:00</time>
For times without dates (or times referring to events that recur on multiple dates), specifying the geographic location that controls the time is usually more useful than specifying a time zone offset, because geographic locations change time zone offsets with daylight savings time. In some cases, geographic locations even change time zone, e.g. when the boundaries of those time zones are redrawn, as happened with Samoa at the end of 2011. There exists a time zone database that describes the boundaries of time zones and what rules apply within each such zone, known as the time zone database. [TZDATABASE]
<time>2011-11-12T14:54Z</time>
<time>2011-11-12T14:54:39Z</time>
<time>2011-11-12T14:54:39.929Z</time>
<time>2011-11-12T14:54+0000</time>
<time>2011-11-12T14:54:39+0000</time>
<time>2011-11-12T14:54:39.929+0000</time>
<time>2011-11-12T14:54+00:00</time>
<time>2011-11-12T14:54:39+00:00</time>
<time>2011-11-12T14:54:39.929+00:00</time>
<time>2011-11-12T06:54-0800</time>
<time>2011-11-12T06:54:39-0800</time>
<time>2011-11-12T06:54:39.929-0800</time>
<time>2011-11-12T06:54-08:00</time>
<time>2011-11-12T06:54:39-08:00</time>
<time>2011-11-12T06:54:39.929-08:00</time>
<time>2011-11-12 14:54Z</time>
<time>2011-11-12 14:54:39Z</time>
<time>2011-11-12 14:54:39.929Z</time>
<time>2011-11-12 14:54+0000</time>
<time>2011-11-12 14:54:39+0000</time>
<time>2011-11-12 14:54:39.929+0000</time>
<time>2011-11-12 14:54+00:00</time>
<time>2011-11-12 14:54:39+00:00</time>
<time>2011-11-12 14:54:39.929+00:00</time>
<time>2011-11-12 06:54-0800</time>
<time>2011-11-12 06:54:39-0800</time>
<time>2011-11-12 06:54:39.929-0800</time>
<time>2011-11-12 06:54-08:00</time>
<time>2011-11-12 06:54:39-08:00</time>
<time>2011-11-12 06:54:39.929-08:00</time>
Times with dates and a time zone offset are useful for specifying specific events, or recurring virtual events where the time is not anchored to a specific geographic location. For example, the precise time of an asteroid impact, or a particular meeting in a series of meetings held at 1400 UTC every day, regardless of whether any particular part of the world is observing daylight savings time or not. For events where the precise time varies by the local time zone offset of a specific geographic location, a valid floating date and time string combined with that geographic location is likely more useful.
<time>2011-W46</time>
<time>2011</time>
<time>0001</time>
<time>PT4H18M3S</time>
<time>4h 18m 3s</time>
Many of the preceding valid syntaxes describe "floating" date and/or time values (they do not include a time-zone offset). Care is needed when converting floating time values to or from global ("incremental") time values (e.g., JavaScript's Date object). In many cases, an implicit time-of-day and time zone are used in the conversion and may result in unexpected changes to the value of the date itself. [TIMEZONES]
The machine-readable equivalent of the element's contents must be obtained from the element's datetime value by using the following algorithm:
Якщо parsing a month string from the element's datetime value returns a month, that is the machine-readable equivalent; abort these steps.
Якщо parsing a date string from the element's datetime value returns a date, that is the machine-readable equivalent; abort these steps.
Якщо parsing a yearless date string from the element's datetime value returns a yearless date, that is the machine-readable equivalent; abort these steps.
Якщо parsing a time string from the element's datetime value returns a time, that is the machine-readable equivalent; abort these steps.
Якщо parsing a floating date and time string from the element's datetime value returns a floating date and time, that is the machine-readable equivalent; abort these steps.
Якщо parsing a time-zone offset string from the element's datetime value returns a time-zone offset, that is the machine-readable equivalent; abort these steps.
Якщо parsing a global date and time string from the element's datetime value returns a global date and time, that is the machine-readable equivalent; abort these steps.
Якщо parsing a week string from the element's datetime value returns a week, that is the machine-readable equivalent; abort these steps.
Якщо the element's datetime value consists of only цифрами ASCII, at least one of which is not "0" (U+0030), then the machine-readable equivalent is the base-ten interpretation of those digits, representing a year; abort these steps.
Якщо parsing a duration string from the element's datetime value returns a duration, that is the machine-readable equivalent; abort these steps.
There is no machine-readable equivalent.
The algorithms referenced above are intended to be designed such that for any arbitrary string s, only one of the algorithms returns a value. A more efficient approach might be to create a single algorithm that parses all these data types in one pass; developing such an algorithm is left as an exercise to the reader.
The dateTime
IDL attribute must reflect the element's datetime
content attribute.
The time
element can be
used to encode dates, for example in microformats. The following shows a
hypothetical way of encoding an event using a variant on hCalendar that
uses the time
element:
<div class="vevent"> <a class="url" href="http://www.web2con.com/">http://www.web2con.com/</a> <span class="summary">Web 2.0 Conference</span>: <time class="dtstart" datetime="2005-10-05">October 5</time> - <time class="dtend" datetime="2005-10-07">7</time>, at the <span class="location">Argent Hotel, San Francisco, CA</span> </div>
Here, a fictional microdata vocabulary based on the Atom vocabulary is
used with the time
element
to mark up a blog post's publication date.
<article itemscope itemtype="http://n.example.org/rfc4287"> <h1 itemprop="title">Big tasks</h1> <footer>Published <time itemprop="published" datetime="2009-08-29">two days ago</time>.</footer> <p itemprop="content">Today, I went out and bought a bike for my kid.</p> </article>
In this example, another article's publication date is marked up using
time
, this time using the
schema.org microdata vocabulary:
<article itemscope itemtype="http://schema.org/BlogPosting"> <h1 itemprop="headline">Small tasks</h1> <footer>Published <time itemprop="datePublished" datetime="2009-08-30">yesterday</time>.</footer> <p itemprop="articleBody">I put a bike bell on his bike.</p> </article>
In the following snippet, the time
element is used to encode a date in the ISO8601 format, for later
processing by a script:
<p>Our first date was <time datetime="2006-09-23">a Saturday</time>.</p>
In this second snippet, the value includes a time:
<p>We stopped talking at <time datetime="2006-09-24T05:00-07:00">5am the next morning</time>.</p>
A script loaded by the page (and thus privy to the page's internal
convention of marking up dates and times using the time
element) could scan through the page and look at all the time
elements therein to create an index of dates and times.
For example, this element conveys the string "Tuesday" with the additional semantic that the 12th of November 2011 is the meaning that corresponds to "Tuesday":
Today is <time datetime="2011-11-12">Tuesday</time>.
In this example, a specific time in the Pacific Standard Time timezone is specified:
Your next meeting is at <time datetime="2011-11-12T15:00-08:00">3pm</time>.
code
elementaria-*
attributes applicable
to the allowed roles.HTMLElement
.The code
element represents
a fragment of computer code. This could be an XML element name, a file
name, a computer program, or any other string that a computer would
recognize.
There is no formal way to indicate the language of computer code being
marked up. Authors who wish to mark code
elements with the language used, e.g. so that syntax highlighting scripts
can use the right rules, can use the class
attribute, e.g. by adding a class
prefixed with "language-
" to the element.
The following example shows how the element can be used in a paragraph to mark up element names and computer code, including punctuation.
<p>The <code>code</code> element represents a fragment of computer code.</p> <p>When you call the <code>activate()</code> method on the <code>robotSnowman</code> object, the eyes glow.</p> <p>The example below uses the <code>begin</code> keyword to indicate the start of a statement block. It is paired with an <code>end</code> keyword, which is followed by the <code>.</code> punctuation character (full stop) to indicate the end of the program.</p>
The following example shows how a block of code could be marked up
using the pre
and code
elements.
<pre><code class="language-pascal">var i: Integer; begin i := 1; end.</code></pre>
A class is used in that example to indicate the language used.
See the pre
element for more details.
var
elementaria-*
attributes applicable
to the allowed roles.HTMLElement
.The var
element represents
a variable. This could be an actual variable in a mathematical expression
or programming context, an identifier representing a constant, a symbol
identifying a physical quantity, a function parameter, or just be a term
used as a placeholder in prose.
In the paragraph below, the letter "n" is being used as a variable in prose:
<p>Якщо there are <var>n</var> pipes leading to the ice cream factory then I expect at <em>least</em> <var>n</var> flavors of ice cream to be available for purchase!</p>
For mathematics, in particular for anything beyond the simplest of
expressions, MathML is more appropriate. However, the var
element can still be used to refer to specific variables що є then
mentioned in MathML expressions.
In this example, an equation is shown, with a legend that references
the variables in the equation. The expression itself is marked up with
MathML, but the variables are mentioned in the figure's legend using var
.
<figure> <math> <mi>a</mi> <mo>=</mo> <msqrt> <msup><mi>b</mi><mn>2</mn></msup> <mi>+</mi> <msup><mi>c</mi><mn>2</mn></msup> </msqrt> </math> <figcaption> Using Pythagoras' theorem to solve for the hypotenuse <var>a</var> of a triangle with sides <var>b</var> and <var>c</var> </figcaption> </figure>
Here, the equation describing mass-energy equivalence is used in a
sentence та the var
element
is used to mark the variables and constants in that equation:
<p>Then he turned to the blackboard and picked up the chalk. After a few moment's thought, he wrote <var>E</var> = <var>m</var> <var>c</var><sup>2</sup>. The teacher looked pleased.</p>
samp
elementaria-*
attributes applicable
to the allowed roles.HTMLElement
.The samp
element represents
(sample) output from a program or computing system.
See the pre
and
kbd
elements for more details.
This example shows the samp
element being used inline:
<p>The computer said <samp>Too much cheese in tray two</samp> but I didn't know what that meant.</p>
This second example shows a block of sample output. Nested samp
and kbd
elements allow for
the styling of specific elements of the sample output using a style
sheet. There's also a few parts of the samp
що є annotated with even more detailed markup, to enable very precise
styling. To achieve this, span
elements are used.
<pre><samp><span class="prompt">jdoe@mowmow:~$</span> <kbd>ssh demo.example.com</kbd> Last login: Tue Apr 12 09:10:17 2005 from mowmow.example.com on pts/1 Linux demo 2.6.10-grsec+gg3+e+fhs6b+nfs+gr0501+++p3+c4a+gr2b-reslog-v6.189 #1 SMP Tue Feb 1 11:22:36 PST 2005 i686 unknown <span class="prompt">jdoe@demo:~$</span> <span class="cursor">_</span></samp></pre>
kbd
elementaria-*
attributes applicable
to the allowed roles.HTMLElement
.The kbd
element represents
user input (typically keyboard input, although it may also be used to
represent other input, such as voice commands).
When the kbd
element is
nested inside a samp
element, it represents the input as it was echoed by the system.
When the kbd
element contains
a samp
element, it
represents input based on system output, for example invoking a menu item.
When the kbd
element is
nested inside another kbd
element, it represents an actual key or other single unit of input as
appropriate for the input mechanism.
Here the kbd
element is
used to indicate keys to press:
<p>To make George eat an apple, press <kbd><kbd>Shift</kbd>+<kbd>F3</kbd></kbd></p>
In this second example, the user is told to pick a particular menu
item. The outer kbd
element
marks up a block of input, with the inner kbd
elements representing each individual step of the input та the samp
elements inside them
indicating that the steps are input based on something being displayed
by the system, in this case menu labels:
<p>To make George eat an apple, select <kbd><kbd><samp>File</samp></kbd>|<kbd><samp>Eat Apple...</samp></kbd></kbd> </p>
Such precision isn't necessary; the following is equally fine:
<p>To make George eat an apple, select <kbd>File | Eat Apple...</kbd></p>
sub
and sup
elementsaria-*
attributes applicable
to the allowed roles.HTMLElement
.The sup
element represents a superscript and the sub
element represents a subscript.
These elements must be used only to mark up typographical
conventions with specific meanings, not for typographical presentation for
presentation's sake. For example, it would be inappropriate for the sub
and sup
elements to be used in the name of the LaTeX document preparation system.
In general, authors should use these elements only if the absence
of those elements would change the meaning of the content.
In certain languages, superscripts are part of the typographical conventions for some abbreviations.
<p>The most beautiful women are <span lang="fr"><abbr>M<sup>lle</sup></abbr> Gwendoline</span> and <span lang="fr"><abbr>M<sup>me</sup></abbr> Denise</span>.</p>
The sub
element can
be used inside a var
element,
for variables that have subscripts.
Here, the sub
element is used to represent the subscript that identifies the variable
in a family of variables:
<p>The coordinate of the <var>i</var>th point is (<var>x<sub><var>i</var></sub></var>, <var>y<sub><var>i</var></sub></var>). For example, the 10th point has coordinate (<var>x<sub>10</sub></var>, <var>y<sub>10</sub></var>).</p>
Mathematical expressions often use subscripts and
superscripts. Authors are encouraged to use MathML for marking up
mathematics, but authors may opt to use sub
and sup
if detailed
mathematical markup is not desired. [MATHML]
<var>E</var>=<var>m</var><var>c</var><sup>2</sup>
f(<var>x</var>, <var>n</var>) = log<sub>4</sub><var>x</var><sup><var>n</var></sup>
i
elementaria-*
attributes applicable
to the allowed roles.HTMLElement
.The i
element represents
a span of text in an alternate voice or mood, or otherwise offset from the
normal prose in a manner indicating a different quality of text, such as a
taxonomic designation, a technical term, an idiomatic phrase from another
language, transliteration, a thought, or a ship name in Western texts.
Terms in languages different from the main text should be annotated with
lang
attributes (or, in XML, lang
attributes in the XML namespace).
The examples below show uses of the i
element:
<p>The <i class="taxonomy">Felis silvestris catus</i> is cute.</p> <p>The term <i>prose content</i> is defined above.</p> <p>There is a certain <i lang="fr">je ne sais quoi</i> in the air.</p>
In the following example, a dream sequence is marked up using i
elements.
<p>Raymond tried to sleep.</p> <p><i>The ship sailed away on Thursday</i>, he dreamt. <i>The ship had many people aboard, including a beautiful princess called Carey. He watched her, day-in, day-out, hoping she would notice him, but she never did.</i></p> <p><i>Finally one night he picked up the courage to speak with her—</i></p> <p>Raymond woke with a start as the fire alarm rang out.</p>
Authors can use the class
attribute on the i
element to
identify why the element is being used, so that if the style of a
particular use (e.g. dream sequences as opposed to taxonomic terms) is to
be changed at a later date, the author doesn't have to go through the
entire document (or series of related documents) annotating each use.
Authors are encouraged to consider whether other elements might be more
applicable than the i
element,
for instance the em
element
for marking up stress emphasis, or the dfn
element to mark up the defining instance of a term.
Style sheets can be used to format i
elements, just like any other element can be restyled. Thus, it is not the
case that content in i
elements
will necessarily be italicized.
b
elementaria-*
attributes applicable
to the allowed roles.HTMLElement
.The b
element represents
a span of text to which attention is being drawn for utilitarian purposes
without conveying any extra importance and with no implication of an
alternate voice or mood, such as key words in a document abstract, product
names in a review, actionable words in interactive text-driven software,
or an article lede.
The following example shows a use of the b
element to highlight key words without marking them up as important:
<p>The <b>frobonitor</b> and <b>barbinator</b> components are fried.</p>
In the following example, objects in a text adventure are highlighted
as being special by use of the b
element.
<p>You enter a small room. Your <b>sword</b> glows brighter. A <b>rat</b> scurries past the corner wall.</p>
Another case where the b
element is appropriate is in marking up the lede (or lead) sentence or
paragraph. The following example shows how a BBC
article about kittens adopting a rabbit as their own could be
marked up:
<article> <h2>Kittens 'adopted' by pet rabbit</h2> <p><b class="lede">Six abandoned kittens have found an unexpected new mother figure — a pet rabbit.</b></p> <p>Veterinary nurse Melanie Humble took the three-week-old kittens to her Aberdeen home.</p> [...]
As with the i
element, authors
can use the class
attribute on the b
element to
identify why the element is being used, so that if the style of a
particular use is to be changed at a later date, the author doesn't have
to go through annotating each use.
The b
element should be used
as a last resort when no other element is more appropriate. In particular,
headings should use the h1
to h6
elements, stress emphasis should use the em
element, importance should be denoted with the strong
element та text marked or highlighted should use the mark
element.
The following would be incorrect usage:
<p><b>WARNING!</b> Do not frob the barbinator!</p>
In the previous example, the correct element to use would have been strong
, not b
.
Style sheets can be used to format b
elements, just like any other element can be restyled. Thus, it is not the
case that content in b
elements
will necessarily be boldened.
u
elementaria-*
attributes applicable
to the allowed roles.HTMLElement
.The u
element represents
a span of text with an unarticulated, though explicitly rendered,
non-textual annotation, such as labeling the text as being a proper name
in Chinese text (a Chinese proper name mark), or labeling the text as
being misspelt.
In most cases, another element is likely to be more appropriate: for
marking stress emphasis, the em
element should be used; for marking key words or phrases either the b
element or the mark
element should be used, depending on the context; for marking book titles,
the cite
element should be
used; for labeling text with explicit textual
annotations, the ruby
element should be used; for labeling ship names in Western texts, the i
element should be used.
The default rendering of the u
element in visual presentations clashes with the conventional rendering of
hyperlinks (underlining). Authors are encouraged to avoid using the u
element where it could be confused
for a hyperlink.
mark
elementaria-*
attributes applicable
to the allowed roles.HTMLElement
.The mark
element represents
a run of text in one document marked or highlighted for reference
purposes, due to its relevance in another context. When used in a
quotation or other block of text referred to from the prose, it indicates
a highlight that was not originally present but which has been added to
bring the reader's attention to a part of the text that might not have
been considered important by the original author when the block was
originally written, but which is now under previously unexpected scrutiny.
When used in the main prose of a document, it indicates a part of the
document that has been highlighted due to its likely relevance to the
user's current activity.
This example shows how the mark
element can be used to bring attention to a particular part of a
quotation:
<p lang="en-US">Consider the following quote:</p> <blockquote lang="en-GB"> <p>Look around and you will find, no-one's really <mark>colour</mark> blind.</p> </blockquote> <p lang="en-US">As we can tell from the <em>spelling</em> of the word, the person writing this quote is clearly not American.</p>
(Якщо the goal was to mark the element as misspelt, however, the u
element, possibly with a class,
would be more appropriate.)
Another example of the mark
element is highlighting parts of a document що є matching some search
string. Якщо someone looked at a document та the server knew that the
user was searching for the word "kitten", then the server might return
the document with one paragraph modified as follows:
<p>I also have some <mark>kitten</mark>s who are visiting me these days. They're really cute. I think they like my garden! Maybe I should adopt a <mark>kitten</mark>.</p>
In the following snippet, a paragraph of text refers to a specific part of a code fragment.
<p>The highlighted part below is where the error lies:</p> <pre><code>var i: Integer; begin i := <mark>1.1</mark>; end.</code></pre>
This is separate from syntax highlighting, for which span
is more appropriate.
Combining both, one would get:
<p>The highlighted part below is where the error lies:</p> <pre><code><span class=keyword>var</span> <span class=ident>i</span>: <span class=type>Integer</span>; <span class=keyword>begin</span> <span class=ident>i</span> := <span class=literal><mark>1.1</mark></span>; <span class=keyword>end</span>.</code></pre>
This is another example showing the use of mark
to highlight a part of quoted text that was originally not emphasized.
In this example, common typographic conventions have led the author to
explicitly style mark
elements in quotes to render in italics.
<article> <style> blockquote mark, q mark { font: inherit; font-style: italic; text-decoration: none; background: transparent; color: inherit; } .bubble em { font: inherit; font-size: larger; text-decoration: underline; } </style> <h1>She knew</h1> <p>Did you notice the subtle joke in the joke on panel 4?</p> <blockquote> <p class="bubble">I didn't <em>want</em> to believe. <mark>Of course on some level I realized it was a known-plaintext attack.</mark> But I couldn't admit it until I saw for myself.</p> </blockquote> <p>(Emphasis mine.) I thought that was great. It's so pedantic, yet it explains everything neatly.</p> </article>
Note, incidentally, the distinction between the em
element in this example, which is part of the original text being quoted
та the mark
element, which
is highlighting a part for comment.
The following example shows the difference between denoting the importance
of a span of text (strong
)
as opposed to denoting the relevance of a span of text (mark
). It is an extract from a
textbook, where the extract has had the parts relevant to the exam
highlighted. The safety warnings, important though they may be, are
apparently not relevant to the exam.
<h3>Wormhole Physics Introduction</h3> <p><mark>A wormhole in normal conditions can be held open for a maximum of just under 39 minutes.</mark> Conditions that can increase the time include a powerful energy source coupled to one or both of the gates connecting the wormhole та a large gravity well (such as a black hole).</p> <p><mark>Momentum is preserved across the wormhole. Electromagnetic radiation can travel in both directions through a wormhole, but matter cannot.</mark></p> <p>When a wormhole is created, a vortex normally forms. <strong>Warning: The vortex caused by the wormhole opening will annihilate anything in its path.</strong> Vortexes can be avoided when using sufficiently advanced dialing technology.</p> <p><mark>An obstruction in a gate will prevent it from accepting a wormhole connection.</mark></p>
ruby
elementaria-*
attributes applicable
to the allowed roles.HTMLElement
. The ruby
element allows
one or more spans of phrasing content to be marked with ruby annotations.
Ruby annotations are short runs of text presented alongside base text,
primarily used in East Asian typography as a guide for pronunciation or to
include other annotations. In Japanese, this form of typography is also
known as furigana. Ruby text can appear on either side та
sometimes both sides, of the base text та it is possible to control its
position using CSS. A more complete introduction to ruby can be found in
the Use Cases & Exploratory Approaches for Ruby Markup
document as well as in CSS Ruby Module Level 1. [RUBY-UC]
[CSSRUBY]
The content model of ruby
elements consists of one or more of the following sequences:
rb
elements. rt
or rtc
elements, each of which
either immediately preceded or followed by an rp
elements. The ruby
, rb
,
rtc
та rt
elements can be used for a variety of kinds of annotations, including in
particular (though by no means limited to) those described below. For more
details on Japanese Ruby in particular та how to render Ruby for Japanese,
see Requirements for Japanese Text Layout. [JLREQ]
The rp
element can be used as
fallback content when ruby rendering is not supported.
Annotations (the ruby text) are associated individually with each ideographic character (the base text). In Japanese this is typically hiragana or katakana characters used to provide readings of kanji characters.
<ruby>base<rt>annotation</ruby>
When no rb
element is
used, the base is implied, as above. But you can also make it
explicit. This can be useful notably for styling, or when consecutive
bases are to be treated as a group, as in the jukugo ruby example
further down.
<ruby><rb>base<rt>annotation</ruby>
In the following example, notice how each annotation corresponds to a single base character.
<ruby>日<rt>に</rt></ruby><ruby>本<rt>ほん</rt></ruby> <ruby>語<rt>ご</rt></ruby>で<ruby>書<rt>か</rt></ruby> いた<ruby>作<rt>さく</rt></ruby><ruby>文<rt>ぶん</rt></ruby>です。
Ruby text interspersed in regular text provides structure akin to the following image:
This example can also be written as follows, using one ruby
element with two segments of base text and two annotations (one for
each) rather than two back-to-back ruby
elements each with one base text segment and annotation (as in the
markup above):
<ruby>日<rt>に</rt>本<rt>ほん</rt>語<rt>ご</rt></ruby> で<ruby>書<rt>か</rt></ruby> いた<ruby>作<rt>さく</rt>文<rt>ぶん</rt></ruby>です。
Group ruby is often used where phonetic annotations don't map to discreet base characters, or for semantic glosses that span the whole base text. For example, the word "today" is written with the characters 今日, literally "this day". But it's pronounced きょう (kyou), which can't be broken down into a "this" part and a "day" part. In typical rendering, you can't split text that is annotated with group ruby; it has to wrap as a single unit onto the next line. When a ruby text annotation maps to a base that is comprised of more than one character, then that base is grouped.
The following group ruby:
Can be marked up as follows:
<ruby>今日<rt>きょう</ruby>
Jukugo refers to a Japanese compound noun, i.e. a word made up of more than one kanji character. Jukugo ruby is a term that is used not to describe ruby annotations over jukugo text, but rather to describe ruby with a behaviour slightly different from mono or group ruby. Jukugo ruby is similar to mono ruby, in that there is a strong association between ruby text and individual base characters, but the ruby text is typically rendered as grouped together over multiple ideographs when they are on the same line.
The distinction is captured in this example:
Which can be marked up as follows:
<ruby>法<rb>華<rb>経<rt>ほ<rt>け<rt>きょう</ruby>
In this example, each rt
element is paired with its respective rb
element, the difference with an interleaved rb
/rt
approach being that the
sequences of both base text and ruby annotations are implicitly placed
in common containers so that the grouping information is captured.
For more details on Jukugo Ruby rendering, see Appendix F in the Requirements for Japanese Text Layout and Use Case C: Jukugo ruby in the Use Cases & Exploratory Approaches for Ruby Markup. [JLREQ] [RUBY-UC]
In some contexts, for instance when the font size or line height are too small for ruby to be readable, it is desirable to inline the ruby annotation such that it appears in parentheses after the text it annotates. This also provides a convenient fallback strategy for user agents that do not support rendering ruby annotations.
Inlining takes grouping into account. For example, Tokyo is written with two kanji characters, 東, which is pronounced とう та 京, which is pronounced きょう. Each base character should be annotated individually, but the fallback should be 東京(とうきょう) not 東(とう)京(きょう). This can be marked up as follows:
<ruby>東<rb>京<rt>とう<rt>きょう</ruby>
Note that the above markup will enable the usage of parentheses when
inlining for browsers that support ruby layout, but for those that
don't it will fail to provide parenthetical fallback. This is where
the rp
element is useful.
It can be inserted into the above example to provide the appropriate
fallback when ruby layout is not supported:
<ruby>東<rb>京<rp>(<rt>とう<rt>きょう<rp>)</ruby>
Sometimes, ruby can be used to annotate a base twice.
In the following example, the Chinese word for San Francisco (旧金山, i.e. “old gold mountain”) is annotated both using pinyin to give the pronunciation та with the original English.
Which is marked up as follows:
<ruby><rb>旧<rb>金<rb>山<rt>jiù<rt>jīn<rt>shān<rtc>San Francisco</ruby>
In this example, a single base run of three base characters is
annotated with three pinyin ruby text segments in a first (implicit)
container та an rtc
element is introduced in order to provide a second single ruby
text annotation being the city's English name.
We can also revisit our jukugo example above with 上手 ("skill") to show how it can be annotation in both kana and romaji phonetics while at the same time maintaining the pairing to bases and annotation grouping information.
Which is marked up as follows:
<ruby><rb>上<rb>手<rt>じよう<rt>ず<rtc><rt>jou<rt>zu</ruby>
Text that is a direct child of the rtc
element implicitly produces a ruby text segment as if it were
contained in an rt
element. In this contrived example, this is shown with some symbols що
є given names in English and French with annotations intended to
appear on either side of the base symbol.
<ruby> ♥<rt>Heart<rtc lang=fr>Cœur</rtc> ☘<rt>Shamrock<rtc lang=fr>Trèfle</rtc> ✶<rt>Star<rtc lang=fr>Étoile </ruby>
Similarly, text directly inside a ruby
element implicitly produces a ruby base as if it were contained in an
rb
element та rt
children of ruby
are
implicitly contained in an rtc
container. In effect, the above example is equivalent (in meaning,
though not in the DOM it produces) to the following:
<ruby> <rb>♥</rb><rtc><rt>Heart</rt></rtc><rtc lang=fr><rt>Cœur</rt></rtc> <rb>☘</rb><rtc><rt>Shamrock</rt></rtc><rtc lang=fr><rt>Trèfle</rt></rtc> <rb>✶</rb><rtc><rt>Star</rt></rtc><rtc lang=fr><rt>Étoile</rt></rtc> </ruby>
Within a ruby element, content is parcelled into a series of ruby segments. Each ruby segment is described by:
rb
element.
rtc
elements, or to sequences of rt
elements implicitly recognised as contained in an anonymous ruby
text container. Each ruby text container is
described by zero or more ruby text annotations each of
which is a DOM range that may contain phrasing content or an rt
element та an annotations range that is a range including all the
annotations for that container. A ruby
text container is also known (primarily in a CSS context) as a ruby annotation container.
Furthermore, a ruby element contains ignored
ruby content. Ignored ruby content does not form part of the
document's semantics. It consists of some inter-element
whitespace and rp
elements, the latter of which are used for legacy user agents that do
not support ruby at all.
The process of annotation pairing associates ruby annotations with ruby bases. Within each ruby segment, each ruby base in the ruby base container is paired with one ruby text annotation from the ruby text container, in order. Якщо there are not enough ruby text annotations in a ruby annotation container, the last one is associated with any excess ruby bases. (Якщо there are not any in the ruby annotation container, an anonymous empty one is assumed to exist.) Якщо there are not enough ruby bases, any remaining ruby text annotations are assumed to be associated with empty, anonymous bases inserted at the end of the ruby base container.
Note that the terms ruby segment, ruby base, ruby text annotation, ruby text container, ruby base container та ruby annotation container have their equivalents in CSS Ruby Module Level 1. [CSSRUBY]
Informally, the segmentation and categorisation algorithm below
performs a simple set of tasks. First it processes adjacent rb
elements, text nodes та non-ruby elements into a list of bases. Then it
processes any number of rtc
elements or sequences of rt
elements що є considered to automatically map to an anonymous ruby
text container. Put together these data items form a ruby
segment as detailed in the data model above. It will continue to
produce such segments until it reaches the end of the content of a given
ruby
element. The
complexity of the algorithm below compared to this informal description
stems from the need to support an author-friendly syntax and being
mindful of inter-element white space.
At any particular time, the segmentation and
categorisation of content of a ruby
element is the
result that would be obtained from running the following algorithm:
ruby
element for which the algorithm is being run. rp
element, then increment index by one and jump to the step
labelled process a ruby child. (Note that this has the effect
of including this element in any range that we are currently
processing. This is done intentionally so that misplaced rp
can be processed correctly; semantically they are ignored all the
same.) rt
element, тоді виконайте ці субкроки:
rtc
element, тоді виконайте ці субкроки:
rtc
element and a DOM range whose start is the boundary point (root, index)
and whose end
is the boundary
point (root, index plus one). Append
this new ruby annotation
container at the end of current annotation containers.
rt
element, an rtc
element, or an rp
element, then set index to the value of lookahead
index and jump to the step labelled process a ruby
child. rb
element, тоді виконайте ці субкроки:
When the steps above say to commit a ruby segment, it means to run the following steps at that point in the algorithm:
When the steps above say to commit the base range, it means to run the following steps at that point in the algorithm:
When the steps above say to commit current annotations, it means to run the following steps at that point in the algorithm:
When the steps above say to commit an automatic base, it means to run the following steps at that point in the algorithm:
rb
elementruby
element.An rb
element's end tag may be omitted if the rb
element is immediately followed by an rb
,
rt
, rtc
or rp
element, or if there
is no more content in the parent element.
aria-*
attributes applicable
to the allowed roles.HTMLElement
. The rb
element marks the
base text component of a ruby annotation. When it is the child of a ruby
element, it doesn't represent anything itself, but its parent ruby
element uses it as part of
determining what it represents.
An rb
element that is not
a child of a ruby
element
represents the same thing as its children.
rt
elementruby
or
of an rtc
element.An rt
element's end tag may be omitted if the rt
element is immediately followed by an rb
,
rt
, rtc
or rp
element, or if there
is no more content in the parent element.
aria-*
attributes applicable
to the allowed roles.HTMLElement
. The rt
element marks the
ruby text component of a ruby annotation. When it is the child of a ruby
element or of an rtc
element that is itself the child of a ruby
element, it doesn't represent
anything itself, but its ancestor ruby
element uses it as part of determining what it represents.
An rt
element that is not
a child of a ruby
element
or of an rtc
element that
is itself the child of a ruby
element represents the same thing as its
children.
rtc
elementruby
element.rt
elements.An rtc
element's end tag may be omitted if the rtc
element is immediately followed by an rb
,
rtc
or rp
element, or if there is no more content in the parent element.
aria-*
attributes applicable
to the allowed roles.HTMLElement
. The rtc
element marks a ruby text container for ruby text
components in a ruby annotation. When it is the child of a ruby
element it doesn't represent
anything itself, but its parent ruby
element uses it as part of determining what it represents.
An rtc
element that is
not a child of a ruby
element represents the same thing as its
children.
When an rtc
element is
processed as part of the segmentation and categorisation of content for
a ruby
element, the
following algorithm defines how to process
an rtc
element:
rtc
element for which the algorithm is being run. rt
element, тоді виконайте ці субкроки:
When the steps above say to commit an automatic annotation, it means to run the following steps at that point in the algorithm:
rp
elementruby
element, either immediately before or immediately after an rt
or rtc
element, but not
between rt
elements. An rp
element's end tag may be omitted if the rp
element is immediately followed by an rb
,
rt
, rtc
or rp
element, or if there
is no more content in the parent element.
aria-*
attributes applicable
to the allowed roles.HTMLElement
. The rp
element is used to
provide fallback text to be shown by user agents that don't support ruby
annotations. One widespread convention is to provide parentheses around
the ruby text component of a ruby annotation.
The contents of the rp
elements are typically not displayed by user agents which do support ruby
annotations
An rp
element that
is a child of a ruby
element represents nothing. An
rp
element whose parent
element is not a ruby
element represents its children.
The example shown previously, in which each ideograph in the text 漢字 is annotated with its phonetic
reading, could be expanded to use rp
so that in legacy user agents the readings are in parentheses (please note
that white space has been introduced into this example in order to make it
more readable):
...
<ruby>
漢
<rb>字</rb>
<rp> (</rp>
<rt>かん</rt>
<rt>じ</rt>
<rp>) </rp>
</ruby>
...
In conforming user agents the rendering would be as above, but in user agents that do not support ruby, the rendering would be:
... 漢字 (かんじ) ...
When there are multiple annotations for a segment, rp
elements can also be placed between the annotations. Here is another copy
of an earlier contrived example showing some symbols with names given in
English and French using double-sided annotations, but this time with rp
elements as well:
<ruby> ♥<rp>: </rp><rt>Heart</rt><rp>, </rp><rtc><rt lang=fr>Cœur</rt></rtc><rp>.</rp> ☘<rp>: </rp><rt>Shamrock</rt><rp>, </rp><rtc><rt lang=fr>Trèfle</rt></rtc><rp>.</rp> ✶<rp>: </rp><rt>Star</rt><rp>, </rp><rtc><rt lang=fr>Étoile</rt></rtc><rp>.</rp> </ruby>
This would make the example render as follows in non-ruby-capable user agents:
♥: Heart, Cœur. ☘: Shamrock, Trèfle. ✶: Star, Étoile.
bdi
elementdir
global attribute has special semantics on this element.aria-*
attributes applicable
to the allowed roles.HTMLElement
.The bdi
element represents
a span of text that is to be isolated from its surroundings for the
purposes of bidirectional text formatting. [BIDI]
The dir
global attribute defaults to auto
on this element (it never inherits from the parent element like with other
elements).
This element is especially useful when embedding user-generated content with an unknown directionality.
In this example, usernames are shown along with the number of posts
that the user has submitted. Якщо the bdi
element were not used, the username of the Arabic user would end up
confusing the text (the bidirectional algorithm would put the colon and
the number "3" next to the word "User" rather than next to the word
"posts").
<ul> <li>User <bdi>jcranmer</bdi>: 12 posts. <li>User <bdi>hober</bdi>: 5 posts. <li>User <bdi>إيان</bdi>: 3 posts. </ul>
bdo
elementdir
global attribute has special semantics on this element.aria-*
attributes applicable
to the allowed roles.HTMLElement
.The bdo
element represents
explicit text directionality formatting control for its children. It
allows authors to override the Unicode bidirectional algorithm by
explicitly specifying a direction override. [BIDI]
Authors must specify the dir
attribute on this element, with the value ltr
to specify a left-to-right
override and with the value rtl
to specify a right-to-left override. The auto
value must not be specified.
span
elementaria-*
attributes applicable
to the allowed roles.interface HTMLSpanElement : HTMLElement {};
The span
element doesn't
mean anything on its own, but can be useful when used together with the global attributes, e.g. class
, lang
, or dir
. It represents
its children.
In this example, a code fragment is marked up using span
elements and class
attributes so that its keywords and identifiers can be color-coded from
CSS:
<pre><code class="lang-c"><span class="keyword">for</span> (<span class="ident">j</span> = 0; <span class="ident">j</span> < 256; <span class="ident">j</span>++) { <span class="ident">i_t3</span> = (<span class="ident">i_t3</span> & 0x1ffff) | (<span class="ident">j</span> << 17); <span class="ident">i_t6</span> = (((((((<span class="ident">i_t3</span> >> 3) ^ <span class="ident">i_t3</span>) >> 1) ^ <span class="ident">i_t3</span>) >> 8) ^ <span class="ident">i_t3</span>) >> 5) & 0xff; <span class="keyword">if</span> (<span class="ident">i_t6</span> == <span class="ident">i_t1</span>) <span class="keyword">break</span>; }</code></pre>
br
elementaria-*
attributes applicable
to the allowed roles.interface HTMLBRElement : HTMLElement {};
The br
element represents
a line break.
While line breaks are usually represented in visual media by physically moving subsequent text to a new line, a style sheet or user agent would be equally justified in causing line breaks to be rendered in a different manner, for instance as green dots, or as extra spacing.
br
elements must be used only
for line breaks що є actually part of the content, as in poems or
addresses.
The following example is correct usage of the br
element:
<p>P. Sherman<br> 42 Wallaby Way<br> Sydney</p>
br
elements must not be used
for separating thematic groups in a paragraph.
The following examples are non-conforming, as they abuse the br
element:
<p><a ...>34 comments.</a><br> <a ...>Add a comment.</a></p>
<p><label>Name: <input name="name"></label><br> <label>Address: <input name="address"></label></p>
Here are alternatives to the above, which are correct:
<p><a ...>34 comments.</a></p> <p><a ...>Add a comment.</a></p>
<p><label>Name: <input name="name"></label></p> <p><label>Address: <input name="address"></label></p>
Якщо a paragraph consists of nothing but a
single br
element, it
represents a placeholder blank line (e.g. as in a template). Such blank
lines must not be used for presentation purposes.
Any content inside br
elements must not be considered part of the surrounding text.
This element has rendering requirements involving the bidirectional algorithm.
wbr
elementaria-*
attributes applicable
to the allowed roles.HTMLElement
.The wbr
element represents
a line break opportunity.
In the following example, someone is quoted as saying something which,
for effect, is written as one long word. However, to ensure that the
text can be wrapped in a readable fashion, the individual words in the
quote are separated using a wbr
element.
<p>So then he pointed at the tiger and screamed "there<wbr>is<wbr>no<wbr>way<wbr>you<wbr>are<wbr>ever<wbr>going<wbr>to<wbr>catch<wbr>me"!</p>
Here, especially long lines of code in a program listing have suggested
wrapping points given using wbr
elements.
<pre>... Heading heading = Helm.HeadingFactory(HeadingCoordinates[1], <wbr>HeadingCoordinates[2], <wbr>HeadingCoordinates[3], <wbr>HeadingCoordinates[4]); Course course = Helm.CourseFactory(Heading, <wbr>Maps.MapFactoryFromHeading(heading), <wbr>Speeds.GetMaximumSpeed().ConvertToWarp()); ...</pre>
Any content inside wbr
elements must not be considered part of the surrounding text.
This element has rendering requirements involving the bidirectional algorithm.
Цей розділ не є нормативним.
Element | Purpose | Example |
---|---|---|
a |
Hyperlinks |
Visit my <a href="drinks.html">drinks</a> page. |
em |
Stress emphasis |
I must say I <em>adore</em> lemonade. |
strong |
Importance |
This tea is <strong>very hot</strong>. |
small |
Side comments |
These grapes are made into wine. <small>Alcohol is addictive.</small> |
s |
Inaccurate text |
Price: <s>£4.50</s> £2.00! |
cite |
Titles of works |
The case <cite>Hugo v. Danielle</cite> is relevant here. |
q |
Quotations |
The judge said <q>You can drink water from the fish tank</q> but advised against it. |
dfn |
Defining instance |
The term <dfn>organic food</dfn> refers to food produced without synthetic chemicals. |
abbr |
Abbreviations |
Organic food in Ireland is certified by the <abbr title="Irish Organic Farmers and Growers Association">IOFGA</abbr>. |
data |
Machine-readable equivalent |
Available starting today! <data value="UPC:022014640201">North Coast Organic Apple Cider</data> |
time |
Machine-readable equivalent of date- or time-related data |
Available starting on <time datetime="2011-11-12">November 12th</time>! |
code |
Computer code |
The <code>fruitdb</code> program can be used for tracking fruit production. |
var |
Variables |
Якщо there are <var>n</var> fruit in the bowl, at least <var>n</var>÷2 will be ripe. |
samp |
Computer output |
The computer said <samp>Unknown error -3</samp>. |
kbd |
User input |
Hit <kbd>F1</kbd> to continue. |
sub |
Subscripts |
Water is H<sub>2</sub>O. |
sup |
Superscripts |
The Hydrogen in heavy water is usually <sup>2</sup>H. |
i |
Alternative voice |
Lemonade consists primarily of <i>Citrus limon</i>. |
b |
Keywords |
Take a <b>lemon</b> and squeeze it with a <b>juicer</b>. |
u |
Annotations |
The mixture of apple juice and <u class="spelling">eldeflower</u> juice is very pleasant. |
mark |
Highlight |
Elderflower cordial, with one <mark>part</mark> cordial to ten <mark>part</mark>s water, stands a<mark>part</mark> from the rest. |
ruby , rb ,
rp , rt ,
rtc |
Ruby annotations |
<ruby> <rb>OJ <rp>(<rtc><rt>Orange Juice</rtc><rp>)</ruby> |
bdi |
Text directionality isolation |
The recommended restaurant is <bdi lang="">My Juice Café (At The Beach)</bdi>. |
bdo |
Text directionality formatting |
The proposal is to write English, but in reverse order. "Juice" would become "<bdo dir=rtl>Juice</bdo>" |
span |
Other |
In French we call it <span lang="fr">sirop de sureau</span>. |
br |
Line break |
Simply Orange Juice Company<br>Apopka, FL 32703<br>U.S.A. |
wbr |
Line breaking opportunity |
www.simply<wbr>orange<wbr>juice.com |
The ins
and del
elements represent edits to the document.
ins
elementcite
- Link to the source of the quotation or more information about the edit
datetime
- Date and (optionally) time of the change aria-*
attributes applicable
to the allowed roles.HTMLModElement
interface.The ins
element represents
an addition to the document.
The following represents the addition of a single paragraph:
<aside> <ins> <p> I like fruit. </p> </ins> </aside>
As does the following, because everything in the aside
element here counts as phrasing content
and therefore there is just one paragraph:
<aside> <ins> Apples are <em>tasty</em>. </ins> <ins> So are pears. </ins> </aside>
ins
elements should not cross
implied paragraph
boundaries.
The following example represents the addition of two paragraphs, the
second of which was inserted in two parts. The first ins
element in this example thus crosses a paragraph boundary, which is
considered poor form.
<aside> <!-- don't do this --> <ins datetime="2005-03-16 00:00Z"> <p> I like fruit. </p> Apples are <em>tasty</em>. </ins> <ins datetime="2007-12-19 00:00Z"> So are pears. </ins> </aside>
Here is a better way of marking this up. It uses more elements, but none of the elements cross implied paragraph boundaries.
<aside> <ins datetime="2005-03-16 00:00Z"> <p> I like fruit. </p> </ins> <ins datetime="2005-03-16 00:00Z"> Apples are <em>tasty</em>. </ins> <ins datetime="2007-12-19 00:00Z"> So are pears. </ins> </aside>
del
elementcite
- Link to the source of the quotation or more information about the edit
datetime
- Date and (optionally) time of the change aria-*
attributes applicable
to the allowed roles.HTMLModElement
interface.The del
element represents
a removal from the document.
del
elements should not cross
implied paragraph
boundaries.
The following shows a "to do" list where items that have been done are crossed-off with the date and time of their completion.
<h1>To Do</h1> <ul> <li>Empty the dishwasher</li> <li><del datetime="2009-10-11T01:25-07:00">Watch Walter Lewin's lectures</del></li> <li><del datetime="2009-10-10T23:38-07:00">Download more tracks</del></li> <li>Buy a printer</li> </ul>
ins
and del
elementsThe cite
attribute may be used to specify the address of a document that explains
the change. When that document is long, for instance the minutes of a
meeting, authors are encouraged to include a fragment identifier pointing
to the specific part of that document that discusses the change.
Якщо the cite
attribute is present, it must be a valid
URL potentially surrounded by spaces that explains the change. To obtain the corresponding citation link, the value of the
attribute must be resolved relative to the element. User
agents may allow users to follow such citation links, but they are
primarily intended for private use (e.g. by server-side scripts collecting
statistics about a site's edits), not for readers.
The datetime
attribute may be used to specify the time and date of the change.
Якщо present, the datetime
attribute's value must be a valid
date string with optional time.
User agents must parse the datetime
attribute according to
the parse a date or time string
algorithm. Якщо that doesn't return a date or a global date and time, then the
modification has no associated timestamp (the value is non-conforming;
it is not a valid date
string with optional time). Інакше the modification is marked as
having been made at the given date
or global
date and time. Якщо the given value is a global date and time then user agents
should use the associated time-zone offset information to determine
which time zone to present the given datetime in.
This value may be shown to the user, but it is primarily intended for private use.
The ins
and del
elements must implement the HTMLModElement
interface:
interface HTMLModElement : HTMLElement { attribute DOMString cite; attribute DOMString dateTime; };
The cite
IDL attribute must reflect the element's cite
content attribute. The dateTime
IDL attribute must reflect the element's datetime
content attribute.
Цей розділ не є нормативним.
Since the ins
and del
elements do not affect paragraphing, it is possible, in some cases where
paragraphs are implied
(without explicit p
elements),
for an ins
or del
element to span both an entire paragraph or other non-phrasing
content elements and part of another paragraph. For example:
<section> <ins> <p> This is a paragraph that was inserted. </p> This is another paragraph whose first sentence was inserted at the same time as the paragraph above. </ins> This is a second sentence, which was there all along. </section>
By only wrapping some paragraphs in p
elements, one can even get the end of one paragraph, a whole second
paragraph та the start of a third paragraph to be covered by the same ins
or del
element (though this is very confusing та not considered good practice):
<section> This is the first paragraph. <ins>This sentence was inserted. <p>This second paragraph was inserted.</p> This sentence was inserted too.</ins> This is the third paragraph in this example. <!-- (don't do this) --> </section>
However, due to the way implied
paragraphs are defined, it is not possible to mark up the end of one
paragraph and the start of the very next one using the same ins
or del
element. You instead
have to use one (or two) p
element(s) and two ins
or del
elements, as for example:
<section> <p>This is the first paragraph. <del>This sentence was deleted.</del></p> <p><del>This sentence was deleted too.</del> That sentence needed a separate <del> element.</p> </section>
Partly because of the confusion described above, authors are strongly
encouraged to always mark up all paragraphs with the p
element, instead of having ins
or del
elements that cross implied paragraphs
boundaries.
Цей розділ не є нормативним.
The content models of the ol
and ul
elements do not allow ins
and del
elements as children. Lists always represent all their items, including
items that would otherwise have been marked as deleted.
To indicate that an item is inserted or deleted, an ins
or del
element can be wrapped
around the contents of the li
element. To indicate that an item has been replaced by another, a single li
element can have one or more del
elements followed by one or
more ins
elements.
In the following example, a list that started empty had items added and removed from it over time. The bits in the example that have been emphasized show the parts що є the "current" state of the list. The list item numbers don't take into account the edits, though.
<h1>Stop-ship bugs</h1> <ol> <li><ins datetime="2008-02-12T15:20Z">Bug 225: Rain detector doesn't work in snow</ins></li> <li><del datetime="2008-03-01T20:22Z"><ins datetime="2008-02-14T12:02Z">Bug 228: Water buffer overflows in April</ins></del></li> <li><ins datetime="2008-02-16T13:50Z">Bug 230: Water heater doesn't use renewable fuels</ins></li> <li><del datetime="2008-02-20T21:15Z"><ins datetime="2008-02-16T14:25Z">Bug 232: Carbon dioxide emissions detected after startup</ins></del></li> </ol>
In the following example, a list that started with just fruit was replaced by a list with just colors.
<h1>List of <del>fruits</del><ins>colors</ins></h1> <ul> <li><del>Lime</del><ins>Green</ins></li> <li><del>Apple</del></li> <li>Orange</li> <li><del>Pear</del></li> <li><ins>Teal</ins></li> <li><del>Lemon</del><ins>Yellow</ins></li> <li>Olive</li> <li><ins>Purple</ins></li> </ul>
Цей розділ не є нормативним.
The elements that form part of the table model have complicated content
model requirements that do not allow for the ins
and del
elements, so
indicating edits to a table can be difficult.
To indicate that an entire row or an entire column has been added or
removed, the entire contents of each cell in that row or column can be
wrapped in ins
or del
elements (respectively).
Here, a table's row has been added:
<table> <thead> <tr> <th> Game name <th> Game publisher <th> Verdict <tbody> <tr> <td> Diablo 2 <td> Blizzard <td> 8/10 <tr> <td> Portal <td> Valve <td> 10/10 <tr> <td> <ins>Portal 2</ins> <td> <ins>Valve</ins> <td> <ins>10/10</ins> </table>
Here, a column has been removed (the time at which it was removed is given also, as is a link to the page explaining why):
<table> <thead> <tr> <th> Game name <th> Game publisher <th> <del cite="/edits/r192" datetime="2011-05-02 14:23Z">Verdict</del> <tbody> <tr> <td> Diablo 2 <td> Blizzard <td> <del cite="/edits/r192" datetime="2011-05-02 14:23Z">8/10</del> <tr> <td> Portal <td> Valve <td> <del cite="/edits/r192" datetime="2011-05-02 14:23Z">10/10</del> <tr> <td> Portal 2 <td> Valve <td> <del cite="/edits/r192" datetime="2011-05-02 14:23Z">10/10</del> </table>
Generally speaking, there is no good way to indicate more complicated edits (e.g. that a cell was removed, moving all subsequent cells up or to the left).
img
elementusemap
attribute: Interactive
content.alt
- Replacement text for use when images are not availablesrc
- Address of the resourcecrossorigin
- How the element handles crossorigin requestsusemap
- Name of image map to use ismap
- Whether the image is a server-side image mapwidth
- Horizontal dimensionheight
- Vertical dimensionpresentation
role only, for an img
element whose alt
attribute's value is empty (alt=""
),
otherwise any role
value.aria-*
attributes applicable
to the allowed roles.[NamedConstructor=Image(optional unsigned long width, optional unsigned long height)] interface HTMLImageElement : HTMLElement { attribute DOMString alt; attribute DOMString src; attribute DOMString crossOrigin; attribute DOMString useMap; attribute boolean isMap; attribute unsigned long width; attribute unsigned long height; readonly attribute unsigned long naturalWidth; readonly attribute unsigned long naturalHeight; readonly attribute boolean complete; };
An img
element represents an
image.
The image given by the src
attributes is the embedded content; the value of the alt
attribute provides equivalent
content for those who cannot process images or who have image loading
disabled.
The requirements on the alt
attribute's value are described in the next section.
The src
attribute must be present та must contain a valid
non-empty URL potentially surrounded by spaces referencing a
non-interactive, optionally animated, image resource that is neither paged
nor scripted.
The requirements above imply that images can be static bitmaps (e.g. PNGs, GIFs, JPEGs), single-page vector documents (single-page PDFs, XML files with an SVG root element), animated bitmaps (APNGs, animated GIFs), animated vector graphics (XML files with an SVG root element that use declarative SMIL animation) та so forth. However, these definitions preclude SVG files with script, multipage PDF files, interactive MNG files, HTML documents, plain text documents та so forth. [PNG] [GIF] [JPEG] [PDF] [XML] [APNG] [SVG] [MNG]
The img
element must not be
used as a layout tool. In particular, img
elements should not be used to display transparent images, as such images
rarely convey meaning and rarely add anything useful to the document.
The crossorigin
attribute is a CORS settings attribute.
Its purpose is to allow images from third-party sites that allow
cross-origin access to be used with canvas
.
An img
is always in one of
the following states:
When an img
element is
either in the partially
available state or in the completely
available state, it is said to be available.
An img
element is
initially unavailable.
When an img
element is available,
it provides a paint source whose
width is the image's intrinsic width, whose height is the image's
intrinsic height та whose appearance is the intrinsic appearance of the
image.
In a browsing context where scripting is disabled, user agents may obtain images immediately or on demand. In a browsing context where scripting is enabled, user agents must obtain images immediately.
A user agent that obtains images immediately must synchronously update
the image data of an img
element whenever that element is created with a src
attribute. A user agent that
obtains images immediately must also synchronously update
the image data of an img
element whenever that element has its src
or crossorigin
attribute set,
changed, or removed.
A user agent that obtains images on demand must update
the image data of an img
element whenever it needs the image data (i.e. on demand), but only if
the img
element has a src
attribute та only if the img
element is in the unavailable
state. When an img
element's src
or crossorigin
attribute set, changed, or removed, if the user agent only obtains
images on demand, the img
element must return to the unavailable
state.
Each img
element has a last selected source, which must
initially be null та a current pixel
density, which must initially буде невизначеним.
When an img
element has a
current pixel density that is not
1.0, the element's image data must be treated as if its resolution, in
device pixels per CSS pixels, was the current
pixel density.
For example, if the current pixel density is 3.125, that means that there are 300 device pixels per CSS inch та thus if the image data is 300x600, it has an intrinsic dimension of 96 CSS pixels by 192 CSS pixels.
Each Document
object must have a
list of available images. Each
image in this list is identified by a tuple consisting of an absolute
URL, a CORS settings attribute
mode та, if the mode is not No CORS, an origin.
User agents may copy entries from one Document
object's list of available images
to another at any time (e.g. when the Document
is created, user agents can add to it all the images що є loaded in
other Document
s), but must not
change the keys of entries copied in this way when doing so. User agents
may also remove images from such lists at any time (e.g. to save
memory).
When the user agent is to update the
image data of an img
element, it must run the following steps:
Повернути img
element
to the unavailable
state.
Якщо an instance of the fetching algorithm is still running for this element, then abort that algorithm, discarding any pending tasks generated by that algorithm.
Forget the img
element's current image data, if any.
Якщо the user agent cannot support images, or its support for images has been disabled, then abort these steps.
src
attribute specified and its
value is not the empty string, let selected
source be the value of the element's src
attribute та selected
pixel density be 1.0. Інакше let selected
source be null and selected pixel
density буде невизначеним.
Нехай the img
element's last selected source
be selected source and the img
element's current
pixel density be selected pixel
density.
Якщо selected source is not null, виконати ці підкроки:
Resolve selected source, relative to the element. Якщо that is not successful, abort these steps.
Нехай key be a tuple consisting
of the resulting absolute URL, the
img
element's crossorigin
attribute's mode та, if that mode is not No CORS, the Document
object's origin.
Якщо the list of available
images contains an entry for key,
then set the img
element to the completely
available state, update the presentation of the image
appropriately, queue a task to fire a simple event named load
at the img
element та abort these steps.
Asynchronously await a stable state, allowing the task that invoked this algorithm to continue. The synchronous section consists of all the remaining steps of this algorithm until the algorithm says the synchronous section has ended. (Steps in synchronous sections are marked with ⌛.)
⌛ Якщо another instance of this algorithm for this img
element was started after this instance (even if it aborted and is
no longer running), then abort these steps.
Only the last instance takes effect, to avoid multiple
requests when, for example, the src
and crossorigin
attributes
are all set in succession.
⌛ Якщо selected source is null,
then set the element to the broken
state, queue a task to fire
a simple event named error
at the img
element та
abort these steps.
⌛ Queue a task to fire
a progress event named loadstart
at the img
element.
⌛ Do a potentially
CORS-enabled fetch of the absolute
URL that resulted from the earlier step, with the mode
being the current state of the element's crossorigin
content
attribute, the origin being the origin
of the img
element's Document
та the default origin
behaviour set to taint.
The resource obtained in this fashion, if any, is the img
element's image data. It can be either CORS-same-origin
or CORS-cross-origin; this affects
the origin of the image itself (e.g. when
used on a canvas
).
Fetching the image must delay the load event of the element's document until the task that is queued by the networking task source once the resource has been fetched (defined below) has been run.
This, unfortunately, can be used to perform a rudimentary port scan of the user's local network (especially in conjunction with scripting, though scripting isn't actually necessary to carry out such an attack). User agents may implement cross-origin access control policies що є stricter than those described above to mitigate this attack, but unfortunately such policies are typically not compatible with existing Web content.
Якщо the resource is CORS-same-origin,
each task
that is queued
by the networking task source
while the image is being fetched
must fire a progress event
named progress
at
the img
element.
End the synchronous section, continuing the remaining steps asynchronously, but without missing any data from the fetch algorithm.
As soon as possible, jump to the first applicable entry from the following list:
multipart/x-mixed-replace
The next task
that is queued by the networking
task source while the image is being fetched must set the img
element's state to partially
available.
Each task
that is queued by the networking
task source while the image is being fetched must update the presentation of the
image, but as each new body part comes in, it must replace the
previous image. Once one body part has been completely decoded,
the user agent must set the img
element to the completely
available state and queue a task
to fire a simple event named
load
at the img
element.
The progress
and loadend
events are not fired for multipart/x-mixed-replace
image streams.
The next task
that is queued by the networking
task source while the image is being fetched must set the img
element's state to partially
available.
That task та each subsequent task, that is queued by the networking task source while the image is being fetched must update the presentation of the image appropriately (e.g. if the image is a progressive JPEG, each packet can improve the resolution of the image).
Furthermore, the last task that is queued by the networking task source once the resource has been fetched must additionally run the steps for the matching entry in the following list:
Set the img
element to the completely
available state.
Add the image to the list of available images using the key key.
Якщо the resource is CORS-same-origin:
fire a progress event
named load
at the img
element.
Якщо the resource is CORS-cross-origin:
fire a simple event
named load
at the img
element.
Якщо the resource is CORS-same-origin:
fire a progress event
named loadend
at the img
element.
Якщо the resource is CORS-cross-origin:
fire a simple event
named loadend
at the img
element.
Якщо the resource is CORS-same-origin:
fire a progress event
named load
at the img
element.
Якщо the resource is CORS-cross-origin:
fire a simple event
named load
at the img
element.
Якщо the resource is CORS-same-origin:
fire a progress event
named loadend
at the img
element.
Якщо the resource is CORS-cross-origin:
fire a simple event
named loadend
at the img
element.
Either the image data is corrupted in some fatal way such that
the image dimensions cannot be obtained, or the image data is
not in a supported file format; the user agent must set the img
element to the broken state, abort the fetching algorithm, discarding any pending tasks
generated by that algorithm та then queue
a task to first fire a
simple event named error
at the img
element
and then fire a simple event
named loadend
at
the img
element.
While a user agent is running the above algorithm for an element x, there must be a strong reference from the
element's Document
to the element
x, even if that element is not in its Document
.
When an img
element is in
the completely available
state and the user agent can decode the media data without
errors, then the img
element is said to be fully
decodable.
Whether the image is fetched successfully or not (e.g. whether the response code was a 2xx code or equivalent) must be ignored when determining the image's type and whether it is a valid image.
This allows servers to return images with error responses та have them displayed.
The user agent should apply the image sniffing rules to determine the type of the image, with the image's associated Content-Type headers giving the official type. Якщо these rules are not applied, then the type of the image must be the type given by the image's associated Content-Type headers.
User agents must not support non-image resources with the img
element (e.g. XML files whose root element is an HTML element). User
agents must not run executable code (e.g. scripts) embedded in the image
resource. User agents must only display the first page of a multipage
resource (e.g. a PDF file). User agents must not allow the resource to
act in an interactive fashion, but should honor any animation in the
resource.
This specification does not specify which image types are to be supported.
What an img
element
represents depends on the src
attribute and the alt
attribute.
src
attribute is set and the alt
attribute is set to the empty stringThe image is either decorative or supplemental to the rest of the content, redundant with some other information in the document.
Якщо the image is available and the user agent is configured to display that image, then the element represents the element's image data.
Інакше the element represents nothing та may be omitted completely from the rendering. User agents may provide the user with a notification that an image is present but has been omitted from the rendering.
src
attribute is set and the alt
attribute is set to a value that isn't emptyThe image is a key part of the content; the alt
attribute gives a textual
equivalent or replacement for the image.
Якщо the image is available and the user agent is configured to display that image, then the element represents the element's image data.
Інакше the element represents the text
given by the alt
attribute. User agents may provide the user with a notification that
an image is present but has been omitted from the rendering.
src
attribute is set and the alt
attribute is notThere is no textual equivalent of the image available.
Якщо the image is available and the user agent is configured to display that image, then the element represents the element's image data.
Інакше the user agent should display some sort of indicator that there is an image that is not being rendered та may, if requested by the user, or if so configured, or when required to provide contextual information in response to navigation, provide caption information for the image, derived as follows:
Якщо the image is a descendant of a figure
element that has a child figcaption
element та, ignoring the figcaption
element and its descendants, the figure
element has no Text
node
descendants other than inter-element
whitespace та no embedded
content descendant other than the img
element, then the contents of the first such figcaption
element are the caption information; abort these steps.
There is no caption information.
src
attribute is not set and either the alt
attribute is set to the empty
string or the alt
attribute is not set at allThe element represents nothing.
The element represents the text given by
the alt
attribute.
The alt
attribute does not represent advisory information. User agents must not
present the contents of the alt
attribute in the same way as content of the title
attribute.
While user agents are encouraged to repair cases
of missing alt
attributes, authors must not rely on such behavior. Requirements
for providing text to act as an alternative for images are
described in detail below.
The contents of img
elements, if any, are ignored for the purposes of rendering.
The usemap
attribute, if present, can indicate that the image has an associated image
map.
The ismap
attribute, when used on an element that is a descendant of an a
element with an href
attribute, indicates by its presence that the element provides access to a
server-side image map. This affects how events are handled on the
corresponding a
element.
The ismap
attribute is a boolean attribute. The
attribute must not be specified on an element that does not have an
ancestor a
element with an href
attribute.
The img
element supports dimension attributes.
The alt
,
src
IDL attributes must reflect the respective
content attributes of the same name.
The crossOrigin
IDL attribute must reflect the crossorigin
content
attribute, limited to only
known values.
The useMap
IDL attribute must reflect the usemap
content attribute.
The isMap
IDL attribute must reflect the ismap
content attribute.
width
[ = value
]height
[ = value
]These attributes return the actual rendered dimensions of the image, or zero if the dimensions are not known.
They can be set, to change the corresponding content attributes.
naturalWidth
naturalHeight
These attributes return the intrinsic dimensions of the image, or zero if the dimensions are not known.
complete
Returns true if the image has been completely downloaded or if no image is specified; otherwise, returns false.
Image
( [ width
[, height ] ] )Returns a new img
element, with the width
and height
attributes set to the values passed in the relevant arguments, if
applicable.
The IDL attributes width
and height
must return the rendered width and height of the image, in CSS pixels,
if the image is being rendered та is
being rendered to a visual medium; or else the intrinsic width and
height of the image, in CSS pixels, if the image is available but not being rendered to a
visual medium; or else 0, if the image is not available. [CSS]
On setting, they must act as if they reflected the respective content attributes of the same name.
The IDL attributes naturalWidth
and naturalHeight
must return the intrinsic width and height of the image, in CSS pixels,
if the image is available,
or else 0. [CSS]
The IDL attribute complete
must return true if any of the following conditions є true:
src
attribute is omitted. img
element is completely available.
img
element is broken. Інакше the attribute must return false.
The value of complete
can thus change while a
script
is executing.
A constructor is provided for creating HTMLImageElement
objects (in addition to the factory methods from DOM such as createElement()
):
Image(width,
height)
. When invoked as
a constructor, this must return a new HTMLImageElement
object (a new img
element).
Якщо the width argument is present, the
new object's width
content attribute must be set to width.
Якщо the height argument is also
present, the new object's height
content attribute must be set to height.
The element's document must be the active
document of the browsing context
of the Window
object on which the
interface object of the invoked constructor is found.
Text alternatives, [WCAG] are a primary way of making visual information accessible, because they can be rendered through any sensory modality (for example, visual, auditory or tactile) to match the needs of the user. Providing text alternatives allows the information to be rendered in a variety of ways by a variety of user agents. For example, a person who cannot see a picture can have the text alternative read aloud using synthesized speech.
The alt
attribute on images is a very
important accessibility attribute. Authoring useful alt
attribute content requires the author to carefully consider the context in
which the image appears and the function that image may have in that
context. The guidance included here addresses the most common ways authors
use images. Additional guidance and techniques are available in Resources
on Alternative Text for Images.
Except where otherwise specified, the alt
attribute must be
specified and its value must not be empty; the value must be an
appropriate functional replacement for the image. The specific
requirements for the alt
attribute content depend on the
image's function in the page, as described in the following sections.
To determine an appropriate text alternative it is important to think about why an image is being included in a page. What is its purpose? Thinking like this will help you to understand what is important about the image for the intended audience. Every image has a reason for being on a page, because it provides useful information, performs a function, labels an interactive element, enhances aesthetics or is purely decorative. Therefore, knowing what the image is for, makes writing an appropriate text alternative easier.
When an a
element that is a hyperlink, or a button
element, has no text content but contains one or more images, include text
in the alt
attribute(s) that together convey the purpose of
the link or button.
In this example, a user is asked to pick her preferred color from a
list of three. Each color is given by an image, but for users who cannot
view the images, the color names are included within the alt
attributes of the images:
<ul> <li><a href="red.html"><img src="red.jpeg" alt="Red"></a></li> <li><a href="green.html"><img src="green.jpeg" alt="Green"></a></li> <li><a href="blue.html"><img src="blue.jpeg" alt="Blue"></a></li> </ul>
In this example, a link contains a logo. The link points to the W3C web site from an external site. The text alternative is a brief description of the link target.
<a href="http://w3.org"> <img src="images/w3c_home.png" width="72" height="48" alt="W3C web site"> </a>
This example is the same as the previous example, except that the link is on the W3C web site. The text alternative is a brief description of the link target.
<a href="http://w3.org"> <img src="images/w3c_home.png" width="72" height="48" alt="W3C home"> </a>
Depending on the context in which an image of a logo is used it could be appropriate to provide an indication that the image is a logo as part of the text alternative. Refer to section 4.7.1.1.19 Logos, insignia, flags, or emblems.
In this example, a link contains a print preview icon. The link points to a version of the page with a print stylesheet applied. The text alternative is a brief description of the link target.
<a href="preview.html"> <img src="images/preview.png" width="32" height="30" alt="Print preview."> </a>
In this example, a button contains a search icon. The button submits a search form. The text alternative is a brief description of what the button does.
<button> <img src="images/search.png" width="74" height="29" alt="Search"> </button>
In this example, a company logo for the PIP Corporation has
been split into the following two images, the first containing the word
PIP and the second with the abbreviated word CO. The
images are the sole content of a link to the PIPCO home page. In
this case a brief description of the link target is provided. As the
images are presented to the user as a single entity the text alternative
PIP CO home is in the alt
attribute of the first
image.
<a href="pipco-home.html"> <img src="pip.gif" alt="PIP CO home"><img src="co.gif" alt=""> </a>
Users can benefit when content is presented in graphical form, for example as a flowchart, a diagram, a graph, or a map showing directions. Users also benefit when content presented in a graphical form is also provided in a textual format, these users include those who are unable to view the image (e.g. because they have a very slow connection, or because they are using a text-only browser, or because they are listening to the page being read out by a hands-free automobile voice Web browser, or because they have a visual impairment and use an assistive technology to render the text to speech).
In the following example we have an image of a pie chart, with text in
the alt
attribute representing the data shown in the pie
chart:
<img src="piechart.gif" alt="Pie chart: Browser Share - Internet Explorer 25%, Firefox 40%, Chrome 25%, Safari 6% and Opera 4%.">
In the case where an image repeats the previous paragraph in graphical
form. The alt
attribute content labels the image.
<p>According to a recent study Firefox has a 40% browser share, Internet Explorer has 25%, Chrome has 25%, Safari has 6% and Opera has 4%.</p> <p><img src="piechart.gif" alt="Pie chart representing the data in the previous paragraph."></p>
It can be seen that when the image is not available, for example
because the src
attribute value is incorrect, the text
alternative provides the user with a brief description of the image
content:
In cases where the text alternative is lengthy, more than a
sentence or two, or would benefit from the use of structured markup,
provide a brief description or label using the alt
attribute
та an associated text alternative.
Here's an example of a flowchart image, with a short text alternative
included in the alt
attribute, in this case the text
alternative is a description of the link target as the image is the sole
content of a link. The link points to a description, within the same
document, of the process represented in the flowchart.
<a href="#desc"><img src="flowchart.gif" alt="Flowchart: Dealing with a broken lamp."></a> ... ... <div id="desc"> <h2>Dealing with a broken lamp</h2> <ol> <li>Check if it's plugged in, if not, plug it in.</li> <li>Якщо it still doesn't work; check if the bulb is burned out. Якщо it is, replace the bulb.</li> <li>Якщо it still doesn't work; buy a new lamp.</li> </ol> </div>
In this example, there is an image of a chart. It would be
inappropriate to provide the information depicted in the chart as a
plain text alternative in an alt
attribute as the
information is a data set. Instead a structured text alternative is
provided below the image in the form of a data table using the data that
is represented in the chart image.
Indications of the highest and lowest rainfall for each season have been included in the table, so trends easily identified in the chart are also available in the data table.
United Kingdom | Japan | Australia | |
---|---|---|---|
Spring | 5.3 (highest) | 2.4 | 2 (lowest) |
Summer | 4.5 (highest) | 3.4 | 2 (lowest) |
Autumn | 3.5 (highest) | 1.8 | 1.5 (lowest) |
Winter | 1.5 (highest) | 1.2 | 1 (lowest) |
<figure> <figcaption>Rainfall Data</figcaption> <img src="rainchart.gif" alt="Bar chart: Average rainfall in millimetres by Country and Season."> <table> <caption>Rainfall in millimetres by Country and Season.</caption> <tr><td><th scope="col">UK <th scope="col">Japan<th scope="col">Australia</tr> <tr><th scope="row">Spring <td>5.5 (highest)<td>2.4 <td>2 (lowest)</tr> <tr><th scope="row">Summer <td>4.5 (highest)<td>3.4<td>2 (lowest)</tr> <tr><th scope="row">Autumn <td>3.5 (highest) <td>1.8 <td>1.5 (lowest)</tr> <tr><th scope="row">Winter <td>1.5 (highest) <td>1.2 <td>1 lowest</tr> </table> </figure>
The figure
element is used to group the Bar Chart image and data table. The figcaption
element
provides a caption for the grouped content.
Sometimes, an image only contains text та the purpose of the image is to
display text using visual effects and /or fonts. It is strongly
recommended that text styled using CSS be used, but if this is not
possible, provide the same text in the alt
attribute as is in the image.
This example shows an image of the text "Get Happy!" written in a fancy multi colored freehand style. The image makes up the content of a heading. In this case the text alternative for the image is "Get Happy!".
<h1><img src="gethappy.gif" alt="Get Happy!"></h1>
In this example we have an advertising image consisting of text, the phrase "The BIG sale" is repeated 3 times, each time the text gets smaller and fainter, the last line reads "...ends Friday" In the context of use, as an advertisement, it is recommended that the image's text alternative only include the text "The BIG sale" once as the repetition is for visual effect and the repetition of the text for users who cannot view the image is unnecessary and could be confusing.
<p><img src="sale.gif" alt="The BIG sale ...ends Friday."></p>
In situations where there is also a photo or other graphic along with the image of text, ensure that the words in the image text are included in the text alternative, along with any other description of the image that conveys meaning to users who can view the image, so the information is also available to users who cannot view the image.
When an image is used to represent a character that cannot otherwise be represented in Unicode, for example gaiji, itaiji, or new characters such as novel currency symbols, the text alternative should be a more conventional way of writing the same thing, e.g. using the phonetic hiragana or katakana to give the character's pronunciation.
In this example from 1997, a new-fangled currency symbol that looks like a curly E with two bars in the middle instead of one is represented using an image. The alternative text gives the character's pronunciation.
Only 5.99!
<p>Only <img src="euro.png" alt="euro ">5.99!
An image should not be used if Unicode characters would serve an identical purpose. Only when the text cannot be directly represented using Unicode, e.g. because of decorations or because the character is not in the Unicode character set (as in the case of gaiji), would an image be appropriate.
Якщо an author is tempted to use an image because their default system font does not support a given character, then Web Fonts are a better solution than images.
An illuminated manuscript might use graphics for some of its letters. The text alternative in such a situation is just the character that the image represents.
nce upon a
time and a long long time ago...
<p><img src="initials/fancyO.png" alt="O">nce upon a time and a long long time ago...
Sometimes, an image consists of a graphics such as a chart and associated text. In this case it is recommended that the text in the image is included in the text alternative.
Consider an image containing a pie chart and associated text. It is recommended wherever possible to provide any associated text as text, not an image of text. Якщо this is not possible include the text in the text alternative along with the pertinent information conveyed in the image.
<p><img src="figure1.gif" alt="Figure 1. Distribution of Articles by Journal Category. Pie chart: Language=68%, Education=14% and Science=18%."></p>
Here's another example of the same pie chart
image, showing a short text alternative included in the alt
attribute and a longer text alternative in text. The figure
and figcaption
elements are used to associate the longer text alternative with the
image. The alt
attribute is used to label the image.
<figure> <img src="figure1.gif" alt="Figure 1"> <figcaption><strong>Figure 1.</strong> Distribution of Articles by Journal Category. Pie chart: Language=68%, Education=14% and Science=18%.</figcaption> </figure>
The advantage of this method over the previous example is
that the text alternative is available to all users at all times. It
also allows structured mark up to be used in the text alternative, where
as a text alternative provided using the alt
attribute
does not.
An image that isn't discussed directly by the surrounding text but still
has some relevance can be included in a page using the img
element. Such images are more than mere decoration, they may augment the
themes or subject matter of the page content and so still form part of the
content. In these cases, it is recommended that a text alternative be
provided.
Here is an example of an image closely related to the subject matter of
the page content but not directly discussed. An image of a painting
inspired by a poem, on a page reciting that poem. The following snippet
shows an example. The image is a painting titled the "Lady of Shallot",
it is inspired by the poem and its subject matter is derived from the
poem. Therefore it is strongly recommended that a text alternative is
provided. There is a short description of the content of the image in
the alt
attribute and a link below the image to a longer description located at
the bottom of the document. At the end of the longer description there
is also a link to further information about the painting.
<header> <h1>The Lady of Shalott</h1> <p>A poem by Alfred Lord Tennyson</p> </header> <img src="shalott.jpeg" alt="Painting of a young woman with long hair, sitting in a wooden boat. "> <p><a href="#des">Description of the painting</a>.</p> <!-- Full Recitation of Alfred, Lord Tennyson's Poem. --> ... ... ... <p id="des">The woman in the painting is wearing a flowing white dress. A large piece of intricately patterned fabric is draped over the side. In her right hand she holds the chain mooring the boat. Her expression is mournful. She stares at a crucifix lying in front of her. Beside it are three candles. Two have blown out. <a href="http://bit.ly/5HJvVZ">Further information about the painting</a>.</p>
This example illustrates the provision of a text alternative identifying an image as a photo of the main subject of a page.
<img src="orateur_robin_berjon.png" alt="Portrait photo(black and white) of Robin."> <h1>Robin Berjon</h1> <p>What more needs to be said?</p>
In many cases, the image is actually just supplementary та its presence
merely reinforces the surrounding text. In these cases, the alt
attribute must be present but its
value must be the empty string.
In general, an image falls into this category if removing the image doesn't make the page any less useful, but including the image makes it a lot easier for users of visual browsers to understand the concept.
It is not always easy to write a useful text alternative for an image, another option is to provide a link to a description or further information about the image when one is available.
In this example of the same image, there is a short text alternative
included in the alt
attribute та there is a link after the
image. The link points to a page containing information
about the painting.
The Lady of Shalott
A poem by Alfred Lord Tennyson.
Full recitation of Alfred, Lord Tennyson's poem.
<header><h1>The Lady of Shalott</h1> <p>A poem by Alfred Lord Tennyson</p></header> <figure> <img src="shalott.jpeg" alt="Painting of a woman in a white flowing dress, sitting in a small boat."> <p><a href="http://bit.ly/5HJvVZ">About this painting.</a></p> </figure> <!-- Full Recitation of Alfred, Lord Tennyson's Poem. -->
Purely decorative images are visual enhancements, decorations or embellishments that provide no function or information beyond aesthetics to users who can view the images.
Mark up purely decorative images so they can be ignored by assistive
technology by using an empty alt
attribute (alt=""
).
While it is not unacceptable to include decorative images inline, it is
recommended if they are purely decorative to include the image using CSS.
Here's an example of an image being used as a decorative banner for a
person's blog, the image offers no information and so an empty alt
attribute is used.
Clara's Blog
Welcome to my blog...
<header> <div><img src="border.gif" alt="" width="400" height="30"></div> <h1>Clara's Blog</h1> </header> <p>Welcome to my blog...</p>
When images are used inline as part of the flow of text in a sentence, provide a word or phrase as a text alternative which makes sense in the context of the sentence it is apart of.
I you.
I <img src="heart.png" alt="love"> you.
My
breaks.
My <img src="heart.png" alt="heart"> breaks.
When a picture has been sliced into smaller image files що є then
displayed together to form the complete picture again, include a text
alternative for one of the images using the alt
attribute as
per the relevant relevant guidance for the picture as a whole та then
include an empty alt
attribute on the other images.
In this example, a picture representing a company logo for the PIP
Corporation has been split into two pieces, the first containing
the letters "PIP" and the second with the word "CO". The text alternatve
PIP CO is in the alt
attribute of the first image.
<img src="pip.gif" alt="PIP CO"><img src="co.gif" alt="">
In the following example, a rating is shown as three filled stars and
two empty stars. While the text alternative could have been "★★★☆☆", the
author has instead decided to more helpfully give the rating in the form
"3 out of 5". That is the text alternative of the first image та the
rest have empty alt
attributes.
<p>Rating: <meter max=5 value=3> <img src="1" alt="3 out of 5"> <img src="1" alt=""><img src="1" alt=""> <img src="0" alt=""><img src="0" alt=""> </meter></p>
img
element has a usemap
attribute which references a map
element containing area
elements that have href
attributes, the img
is considered to be interactive content. In such cases, always provide a
text alternative for the image using the alt
attribute.
Consider the following image which is a map of Katoomba, it has 2 interactive regions corresponding to the areas of North and South Katoomba:
The text alternative is a brief description of the image. The alt
attribute on each of the area
elements provides text describing the content of the target page of each
linked region:
<p>View houses for sale in North Katoomba or South Katoomba:</p> <p><img src="imagemap.png" width="209" alt="Map of Katoomba" height="249" usemap="#Map"> <map name="Map"> <area shape="poly" coords="78,124,124,10,189,29,173,93,168,132,136,151,110,130" href="north.html" alt="Houses in North Katoomba"> <area shape="poly" coords="66,63,80,135,106,138,137,154,167,137,175,133,144,240,49,223,17,137,17,61" alt="Houses in South Katoomba" href="south.html"> </map>
Generally, image maps should be used instead of slicing an image for links.
Sometimes, when you create a composite picture from multiple images, you
may wish to link one or more of the images. Provide an alt
attribute for each linked image to
describe the purpose of the link.
In the following example, a composite picture is used to represent a "crocoduck"; a fictional creature which defies evolutionary principles by being part crocodile and part duck. You are asked to interact with the crocoduck, but you need to exercise caution...
<h1>The crocoduck</h1> <p>You encounter a strange creature called a "crocoduck". The creature seems angry! Perhaps some friendly stroking will help to calm it, but be careful not to stroke any crocodile parts. This would just enrage the beast further.</p> <a href="?stroke=head"><img src="crocoduck1.png" alt="Stroke crocodile's angry, chomping head"></a> <a href="?stroke=body"><img src="crocoduck2.png" alt="Stroke duck's soft, feathery body"></a>
Images of pictures or graphics include visual representations of objects, people, scenes, abstractions, etc. This non-text content, [WCAG] can convey a significant amount of information visually or provide a specific sensory experience, [WCAG] to a sighted person. Examples include photographs, paintings, drawings and artwork.
An appropriate text alternative for a picture is a brief description, or
name [WCAG].
As in all text alternative authoring decisions, writing suitable text
alternatives for pictures requires human judgment. The text value is
subjective to the context where the image is used and the page author's
writing style. Therefore, there is no single 'right' or 'correct' piece of
alt
text for any particular image. In addition to providing a
short text alternative that gives a brief description of the non-text
content, also providing supplemental content through another means when
appropriate may be useful.
This first example shows an image uploaded to a photo-sharing site. The
photo is of a cat, sitting in the bath. The image has a text alternative
provided using the img
element's alt
attribute. It also has a caption provided by
including the img
element
in a figure
element and
using a figcaption
element to identify the caption text.
Lola prefers a bath to a shower.
<figure> <img src="664aef.jpg" alt="Lola the cat sitting under an umbrella in the bath tub."> <figcaption>Lola prefers a bath to a shower.</figcaption> </figure>
This example is of an image that defies a complete description, as the
subject of the image is open to interpretation. The image has a text
alternative in the alt
attribute which gives users who
cannot view the image a sense of what the image is. It also has a
caption provided by including the img
element in a figure
element and using a figcaption
element to identify the caption text.
The first of the ten cards in the Rorschach test.
<figure> <img src="Rorschach1.jpg" alt="An abstract, freeform, vertically symmetrical, black inkblot on a light background."> <figcaption>The first of the ten cards in the Rorschach test.</figcaption> </figure>
Webcam images are static images що є automatically updated periodically. Typically the images are from a fixed viewpoint, the images may update on the page automatically as each new image is uploaded from the camera or the user may be required to refresh the page to view an updated image. Examples include traffic and weather cameras.
This example is fairly typical; the title and a time stamp are included
in the image, automatically generated by the webcam software. It would
be better if the text information was not included in the image, but as
it is part of the image, include it part of the text alternative. A
caption is also provided using the figure
and figcaption
elements. As the image is provided to give a visual indication of the
current weather near a building, a link to a local weather forecast is
provided, as with automatically generated and uploaded webcam images it
may be impractical to provide such information as a text alternative.
The text of the alt
attribute includes a prose version of
the timestamp, designed to make the text more understandable when
announced by text to speech software. The text alternative also includes
a description of some aspects of what can be seen in the image which are
unchanging, although weather conditions and time of day change.
View from the top of Sopwith house, looking towards North Kingston. This image is updated every hour.
View the latest weather details for Kingston upon Thames.
<figure> <img src="webcam1.jpg" alt="Sopwith house weather cam. Taken on the 21/04/10 at 11:51 and 34 seconds. In the foreground are the safety rails on the flat part of the roof. Nearby there are low rise industrial buildings, beyond are blocks of flats. In the distance there's a church steeple."> <figcaption>View from Sopwith house, looking towards north Kingston. This image is updated every hour.</figcaption> </figure> <p>View the <a href="http://news.bbc.co.uk/weather/forecast/4296?area=Kingston">latest weather details</a> for Kingston upon Thames.</p>
In some cases an image is included in a published document, but the
author is unable to provide an appropriate text alternative. In such cases
the minimum requirement is to provide a caption for the image using the figure
and figcaption
elements under the following conditions:
img
element is in a figure
element figure
element
contains a figcaption
element figcaption
element contains content other than inter-element whitespace figcaption
element and its descendants, the figure
element has no Text
node descendants
other than inter-element whitespace та no embedded content descendant
other than the img
element.
In other words, the only content of the figure
is an img
element and a figcaption
element та the figcaption
element must
include (caption) content.
Such cases are to be kept to an absolute minimum. Якщо there
is even the slightest possibility of the author having the ability to
provide real alternative text, then it would not be acceptable to omit the
alt
attribute.
In this example, a person uploads a photo, as part of a bulk upoad of many images, to a photo sharing site. The user has not provided a text alternative or a caption for the image. The site's authoring tool inserts a caption automatically using whatever useful information it has for the image. In this case it's the file name and date the photo was taken.
clara.jpg, taken on 12/11/2010.
<figure> <img src="clara.jpg"> <figcaption>clara.jpg, taken on 12/11/2010.</figcaption> </figure>
Notice that even in this example, as much useful information as
possible is still included in the figcaption
element.
In this second example, a person uploads a photo to a photo sharing
site. She has provided a caption for the image but not a text
alternative. This may be because the site does not provide users with
the ability to add a text alternative in the alt
attribute.
Eloisa with Princess Belle
<figure> <img src="elo.jpg"> <figcaption>Eloisa with Princess Belle</figcaption> </figure>
Sometimes the entire point of the image is that a textual description is not available та the user is to provide the description. For example, software that displays images and asks for alternative text precisely for the purpose of then writing a page with correct alternative text. Such a page could have a table of images, like this:
<table> <tr><tr> <th> Image <th> Description<tr> <td> <figure> <img src="2421.png"> <figcaption>Image 640 by 100, filename 'banner.gif'</figcaption> </figure> <td> <input name="alt2421"> <tr> <td> <figure> <img src="2422.png"> <figcaption>Image 200 by 480, filename 'ad3.gif'</figcaption> </figure> <td> <input name="alt2422"> </table>
Since some users cannot use images at all (e.g. because they
are blind) the alt
attribute is only allowed to be omitted when no text alternative is
available and none can be made available, as in the above examples.
Generally authors should avoid using img
elements for purposes other than showing images.
Якщо an img
element is being
used for purposes other than showing an image, e.g. as part of a service
to count page views, use an empty alt
attribute.
An example of an img
element used to collect web page statistics. The alt
attribute is empty as the image has no meaning.
<img src="http://server3.stats.com/count.pl?NeonMeatDream.com" width="0" height="0" alt="">
It is recommended for the example use above the width
and height
attributes be set to zero.
Another example use is when an image such as a spacer.gif is
used to aid positioning of content. The alt
attribute is
empty as the image has no meaning.
<img src="spacer.gif" width="10" height="10" alt="">
It is recommended that that CSS be used to position content
instead of img
elements.
An icon is usually a simple picture representing a program, action, data file or a concept. Icons are intended to help users of visual browsers to recognize features at a glance.
Use an empty alt
attribute when an icon is supplemental to text conveying the same meaning.
In this example, we have a link pointing to a site's home page, the
link contains a house icon image and the text "home". The image has an
empty alt
text. Where images are used in this way, it
would also be appropriate to add the image using CSS
<a href="home.html"><img src="home.gif" width="15" height="15" alt="">Home</a>
#home:before { content: url(home.png); } <a href="home.html" id="home">Home</a>
In this example, there is a warning message, with a warning icon. The
word "Warning!" is in emphasized text next to the icon. As the
information conveyed by the icon is redundant the img
element is given an an empty alt
attribute.
Warning!
Your session is about to expire.
<p><img src="warning.png" width="15" height="15" alt=""> <strong>Warning!</strong> Your session is about to expire</p>
When an icon conveys additional information not available in text, provide a text alternative.
In this example, there is a warning message, with a warning icon. The icon emphasizes the importance of the message and identifies it as a particular type of content.
Your
session is about to expire.
<p><img src="warning.png" width="15" height="15" alt="Warning!"> Your session is about to expire</p>
Many pages include logos, insignia, flags, or emblems, which stand for a company, organization, project, band, software package, country, or other entity. What can be considered as an appropriate text alternative depends upon, like all images, the context in which the image is being used and what function it serves in the given context.
Якщо a logo is the sole content of a link, provide a brief description of
the link target in the alt
attribute.
This example illustrates the use of the HTML5 logo as the sole content of a link to the HTML specification.
<a href="http://dev.w3.org/html5/spec/spec.html"> <img src="HTML5_Logo.png" alt="HTML 5.1 specification"></a>
Якщо a logo is being used to represent the entity, e.g. as a page heading, provide the name of the entity being represented by the logo as the text alternative.
This example illustrates the use of the WebPlatform.org logo being used to represent itself.
and other developer resources
<h2><img src="images/webplatform.png" alt="WebPlatform.org"> and other developer resources<h2>
The text alternative in the example above could also
include the word "logo" to describe the type of image content. Якщо so,
it is suggested that square brackets be used to delineate this
information: alt="[logo] WebPlatform.org"
.
Якщо a logo is being used next to the name of the what that it
represents, then the logo is supplemental. Include an empty alt
attribute as the text alternative is already provided.
This example illustrates the use of a logo next to the name of the organization it represents.
WebPlatform.org
<img src="images/webplatform1.png" alt=""> WebPlatform.org
Якщо the logo is used alongside text discussing the subject or entity the logo represents, then provide a text alternative which describes the logo.
This example illustrates the use of a logo next to text discussing the subject the logo represents.
HTML5 is a language for structuring and presenting content for the World Wide Web, a core technology of the Internet. It is the latest revision of the HTML standard (originally created in 1990 and most recently standardized as HTML4 in 1997) and currently remains under development. Its core aims have been to improve the language with support for the latest multimedia while keeping it easily readable by humans and consistently understood by computers and devices (web browsers, parsers etc.).
<p><img src="HTML5_Logo.png" alt="HTML5 logo: Shaped like a shield with the text 'HTML' above and the numeral '5' prominent on the face of the shield."></p> Information about HTML5
CAPTCHA stands for "Completely Automated Public Turing test to tell Computers and Humans Apart". CAPTCHA images are used for security purposes to confirm that content is being accessed by a person rather than a computer. This authentication is done through visual verification of an image. CAPTCHA typically presents an image with characters or words in it that the user is to re-type. The image is usually distorted and has some noise applied to it to make the characters difficult to read.
To improve the accessibility of CAPTCHA provide text alternatives that identify and describe the purpose of the image та provide alternative forms of the CAPTCHA using output modes for different types of sensory perception. For instance provide an audio alternative along with the visual image. Place the audio option right next to the visual one. This helps but is still problematic for people without sound cards, the deaf-blind та some people with limited hearing. Another method is to include a form that asks a question along with the visual image. This helps but can be problematic for people with cognitive impairments.
It is strongly recommended that alternatives to CAPTCHA be used, as all forms of CAPTCHA introduce unacceptable barriers to entry for users with disabilities. Further information is available in Inaccessibility of CAPTCHA.
This example shows a CAPTCHA test which uses a distorted image of text.
The text alternative in the alt
attribute provides
instructions for a user in the case where she cannot access the image
content.
Example code:
<img src="captcha.png" alt="Якщо you cannot view this image an audio challenge is provided."> <!-- audio CAPTCHA option that allows the user to listen and type the word --> <!-- form that asks a question -->
Markup generators (such as WYSIWYG authoring tools) should, wherever possible, obtain a text alternative from their users. However, it is recognized that in many cases, this will not be possible.
For images що є the sole contents of links, markup generators should examine the link target to determine the title of the target, or the URL of the target та use information obtained in this manner as the text alternative.
For images that have captions, markup generators should use the figure
and figcaption
elements to provide the image's caption.
As a last resort, implementors should either set the alt
attribute to the empty string,
under the assumption that the image is a purely decorative image that
doesn't add any information but is still specific to the surrounding
content, or omit the alt
attribute altogether, under the assumption that the image is a key part
of the content.
Markup generators may specify a generator-unable-to-provide-required-alt
attribute on img
elements
for which they have been unable щоб отримати a text alternative and for
which they have therefore omitted the alt
attribute. The value of this
attribute must be the empty string. Documents containing such attributes
are not conforming, but conformance checkers will silently
ignore this error.
This is intended to avoid markup generators from being
pressured into replacing the error of omitting the alt
attribute with the even more
egregious error of providing phony text alternatives, because
state-of-the-art automated conformance checkers cannot distinguish phony
text alternatives from correct text alternatives.
Markup generators should generally avoid using the image's own file name as the text alternative. Similarly, markup generators should avoid generating text alternatives from any content that will be equally available to presentation user agents (e.g. Web browsers).
This is because once a page is generated, it will typically not be updated, whereas the browsers that later read the page can be updated by the user, therefore the browser is likely to have more up-to-date and finely-tuned heuristics than the markup generator did when generating the page.
A conformance checker must report the lack of an alt
attribute as an error unless one
of the conditions listed below applies:
The img
element is in
a figure
element
that satisfies the
conditions described above.
The img
element has a
(non-conforming) generator-unable-to-provide-required-alt
attribute whose value is the empty string. A conformance checker
that is not reporting the lack of an alt
attribute as an error must
also not report the presence of the empty generator-unable-to-provide-required-alt
attribute as an error. (This case does not represent a case where
the document is conforming, only that the generator could not
determine appropriate alternative text — validators are not required
to show an error in this case, because such an error might encourage
markup generators to include bogus alternative text purely in an
attempt to silence validators. Naturally, conformance checkers may
report the lack of an alt
attribute as an error even in the presence of the generator-unable-to-provide-required-alt
attribute; for example, there could be a user option to report all
conformance errors even those that might be the more or less
inevitable result of using a markup generator.)
iframe
elementsrc
- Address of the resourcesrcdoc
- A document to render in the iframe
name
- Name of nested browsing contextsandbox
- Security rules for nested contentwidth
- Horizontal dimensionheight
- Vertical dimensionapplication
,
document
, img
or presentation
.aria-*
attributes applicable
to the allowed roles.interface HTMLIFrameElement : HTMLElement {
attribute DOMString src;
attribute DOMString srcdoc;
attribute DOMString name;
[PutForwards=value] readonly attribute DOMSettableTokenList sandbox;
attribute DOMString width;
attribute DOMString height;
readonly attribute Document? contentDocument;
readonly attribute WindowProxy? contentWindow;
};
The iframe
element represents
a nested browsing context.
The src
attribute gives the address of a page that the nested
browsing context is to contain. The attribute, if present, must be a
valid
non-empty URL potentially surrounded by spaces.
The srcdoc
attribute gives the content of the page that the nested
browsing context is to contain. The value of the attribute is the
source of an iframe
srcdoc
document.
For iframe
elements in HTML documents, the srcdoc
attribute, if present,
must have a value using the HTML syntax that
consists of the following syntactic components, in the given order:
html
element.For iframe
elements in XML documents, the srcdoc
attribute, if present,
must have a value that matches the production labeled document
in the XML specification. [XML]
In the HTML syntax, authors need only
remember to use """ (U+0022) characters to wrap the attribute contents and
then to escape all """ (U+0022) and U+0026 AMPERSAND (&) characters та
to specify the sandbox
attribute, to ensure safe embedding of content.
Due to restrictions of the XHTML syntax, in XML the "<" (U+003C) character needs to be escaped as well. In order to prevent attribute-value normalization, some of XML's whitespace characters — specifically "tab" (U+0009), "LF" (U+000A) та "CR" (U+000D) — also need to be escaped. [XML]
Якщо the src
attribute and the srcdoc
attribute are both specified together, the srcdoc
attribute takes priority.
This allows authors to provide a fallback URL for legacy
user agents that do not support the srcdoc
attribute.
When an iframe
element
is inserted
into a document, the user agent must create a nested
browsing context та then process
the iframe
attributes for the "first time".
When an iframe
element
is removed
from a document, the user agent must discard the nested
browsing context.
This happens without any unload
events firing (the nested browsing
context and its Document
are
discarded,
not unloaded).
Whenever an iframe
element with a nested browsing
context has its srcdoc
attribute set, changed, or removed, the user agent must process
the iframe
attributes.
Similarly, whenever an iframe
element with a nested browsing
context but with no srcdoc
attribute specified has
its src
attribute set, changed, or removed, the user agent must process
the iframe
attributes.
When the user agent is to process
the iframe
attributes, it must run the first
appropriate steps from the following list:
srcdoc
attribute is specifiedNavigate the element's child browsing context to a
resource whose Content-Type is text/html
, whose URL
is about:srcdoc
та whose
data consists of the value of the attribute. The resulting Document
must be considered an
iframe
srcdoc
document.
src
attribute specified та the
user agent is processing the iframe
's
attributes for the "first time"Queue a task to run the iframe load event steps.
The task source for this task is the DOM manipulation task source.
Якщо the value of the src
attribute is missing,
or its value is the empty string, let url
буде рядком "about:blank
".
Інакше resolve
the value of the src
attribute, relative to the iframe
element.
Якщо that is not successful, then let url
буде рядком "about:blank
".
Інакше let url be the resulting
absolute URL.
Якщо there exists an ancestor browsing context whose active document's address, ignoring fragment identifiers, is equal to url, then abort these steps.
Navigate the element's child browsing context to url.
Any navigation
required of the user agent in the process
the iframe
attributes algorithm must be completed as
an explicit self-navigation override and with the iframe
element's document's browsing context as the source
browsing context.
Furthermore, if the active document of the element's child browsing context before such a navigation was not completely loaded at the time of the new navigation, then the navigation must be completed with replacement enabled.
Similarly, if the child browsing
context's session history
contained only one Document
when
the process the iframe
attributes algorithm was invoked та that was the about:blank
Document
created when the child
browsing context was created, then any navigation required of the user agent in that
algorithm must be completed with replacement
enabled.
When a Document
in an iframe
is marked as completely loaded, the
user agent must synchronously run the iframe
load event steps.
A load
event
is also fired at the iframe
element when it is created if no other data is loaded in it.
Each Document
has an iframe
load in progress flag and a mute
iframe load flag. When a Document
is created, these flags must be unset for that Document
.
The iframe load event steps наступні:
Нехай child document be the active
document of the iframe
element's nested browsing
context.
Якщо child document has its mute iframe load flag set, abort these steps.
Set child document's iframe load in progress flag.
Fire a simple event named load
at the iframe
element.
Unset child document's iframe load in progress flag.
This, in conjunction with scripting, can be used to probe the URL space of the local network's HTTP servers. User agents may implement cross-origin access control policies що є stricter than those described above to mitigate this attack, but unfortunately such policies are typically not compatible with existing Web content.
When the iframe
's browsing
context's active document is not ready for post-load tasks та
when anything in the iframe
is delaying
the load event of the iframe
's
browsing context's active
document та when the iframe
's
browsing context is in the delaying
load
events mode, the iframe
must delay
the load event of its document.
Якщо, during the handling of the load
event, the browsing context in the iframe
is again navigated, that will further delay
the load event.
Якщо, when the element is created, the srcdoc
attribute is not set та
the src
attribute is either also not set or set but its value cannot be resolved, the browsing context will remain at
the initial about:blank
page.
Якщо the user navigates
away from this page, the iframe
's
corresponding WindowProxy
object
will proxy new Window
objects for new
Document
objects, but the src
attribute will not change.
The name
attribute, if present, must be a valid
browsing context name. The given value is used to name the nested
browsing context. When the browsing context is
created, if the attribute is present, the browsing
context name must be set to the value of this attribute;
otherwise, the browsing context name
must be set to the empty string.
Whenever the name
attribute is set, the nested browsing
context's name
must be changed to the new value. Якщо the attribute is removed, the browsing context name must be set to
the empty string.
The sandbox
attribute, when specified, enables a set of extra restrictions on any
content hosted by the iframe
.
Its value must be an unordered
set of unique space-separated tokens що є ASCII
чутливі до реєстру. The allowed values are allow-forms
, allow-pointer-lock
,
allow-popups
,
allow-same-origin
,
allow-scripts
та allow-top-navigation
.
When the attribute is set, the content is treated as being from a unique
origin, forms, scripts та various potentially
annoying APIs are disabled, links are prevented from targeting other browsing contexts та plugins are secured.
The allow-same-origin
keyword causes the content to be treated as being from its real origin
instead of forcing it into a unique origin; the allow-top-navigation
keyword allows the content to navigate its top-level
browsing context; and the allow-forms
, allow-pointer-lock
,
allow-popups
and allow-scripts
keywords re-enable forms, the pointer lock API, popups та scripts
respectively. [POINTERLOCK]
Setting both the allow-scripts
and
allow-same-origin
keywords together when the embedded page has the same
origin as the page containing the iframe
allows the embedded page to simply remove the sandbox
attribute and then
reload itself, effectively breaking out of the sandbox altogether.
These flags only take effect when the nested
browsing context of the iframe
is navigated.
Removing them, or removing the entire sandbox
attribute, has no
effect on an already-loaded page.
Potentially hostile files should not be served from the
same server as the file containing the iframe
element. Sandboxing hostile content is of minimal help if an attacker can
convince the user to just visit the hostile content directly, rather than
in the iframe
. To limit
the damage that can be caused by hostile HTML content, it should be served
from a separate dedicated domain. Using a different domain ensures that
scripts in the files are unable to attack the site, even if the user is
tricked into visiting those pages directly, without the protection of the
sandbox
attribute.
When an iframe
element
with a sandbox
attribute has its nested browsing
context created (before the initial about:blank
Document
is created) та when an iframe
element's sandbox
attribute is set or
changed while it has a nested
browsing context, the user agent must parse the sandboxing directive
using the attribute's value as the input
та the iframe
element's
nested browsing context's iframe
sandboxing flag set as the output.
When an iframe
element's sandbox
attribute is removed while it has a nested
browsing context, the user agent must empty the iframe
element's nested browsing context's
iframe
sandboxing
flag set as the output.
In this example, some completely-unknown, potentially hostile, user-provided HTML content is embedded in a page. Because it is served from a separate domain, it is affected by all the normal cross-site restrictions. In addition, the embedded page has scripting disabled, plugins disabled, forms disabled та it cannot navigate any frames or windows other than itself (or any frames or windows it itself embeds).
<p>We're not scared of you! Here is your content, unedited:</p> <iframe sandbox src="http://usercontent.example.net/getusercontent.cgi?id=12193"></iframe>
It is important to use a separate domain so that if the attacker convinces the user to visit that page directly, the page doesn't run in the context of the site's origin, which would make the user vulnerable to any attack found in the page.
In this example, a gadget from another site is embedded. The gadget has scripting and forms enabled та the origin sandbox restrictions are lifted, allowing the gadget to communicate with its originating server. The sandbox is still useful, however, as it disables plugins and popups, thus reducing the risk of the user being exposed to malware and other annoyances.
<iframe sandbox="allow-same-origin allow-forms allow-scripts" src="http://maps.example.com/embedded.html"></iframe>
Suppose a file A contained the following fragment:
<iframe sandbox="allow-same-origin allow-forms" src=B></iframe>
Suppose that file B contained an iframe also:
<iframe sandbox="allow-scripts" src=C></iframe>
Further, suppose that file C contained a link:
<a href=D>Link</a>
For this example, suppose all the files were served as text/html
.
Page C in this scenario has all the sandboxing flags set. Scripts are
disabled, because the iframe
in A has scripts disabled та this overrides the allow-scripts
keyword set on the iframe
in B. Forms are also disabled, because the inner iframe
(in B) does not have the allow-forms
keyword set.
Suppose now that a script in A removes all the sandbox
attributes in A
and B. This would change nothing
immediately. Якщо the user clicked the link in C, loading page D into
the iframe
in B, page D
would now act as if the iframe
in B had the allow-same-origin
and allow-forms
keywords set, because that was the state of the nested
browsing context in the iframe
in A when page B was loaded.
Generally speaking, dynamically removing or changing the sandbox
attribute is
ill-advised, because it can make it quite hard to reason about what will
be allowed and what will not.
The iframe
element
supports dimension attributes for
cases where the embedded content has specific dimensions (e.g. ad units
have well-defined dimensions).
An iframe
element never
has fallback content, as it will always
create a nested browsing context,
regardless of whether the specified initial contents are successfully
used.
Descendants of iframe
elements represent nothing. (In legacy user agents that do not support iframe
elements, the contents
would be parsed as markup that could act as fallback content.)
When used in HTML
documents, the allowed content model of iframe
elements is text, except that invoking the HTML
fragment parsing algorithm with the iframe
element as the context
element and the text contents as the input
must result in a list of nodes що є all phrasing
content, with no parse
errors having occurred, with no script
elements being anywhere in the list or as descendants of elements in the
list та with all the elements in the list (including their descendants)
being themselves conforming.
The iframe
element must
be empty in XML documents.
The HTML parser treats markup
inside iframe
elements as
text.
The IDL attributes src
,
srcdoc
,
name
та sandbox
must reflect the respective content attributes
of the same name.
The contentDocument
IDL attribute must return the Document
object of the active document of the iframe
element's nested
browsing context, if any and if its effective
script origin is the same origin as
the effective script origin
specified by the incumbent
settings object, or null otherwise.
The contentWindow
IDL attribute must return the WindowProxy
object of the iframe
element's nested browsing context,
if any, or null otherwise.
Here is an example of a page using an iframe
to include advertising from an advertising broker:
<iframe src="http://ads.example.com/?customerid=923513721&format=banner" width="468" height="60"></iframe>
embed
elementsrc
- Address of the resourcetype
- Type of embedded resourcewidth
- Horizontal dimensionheight
-
Vertical dimensionapplication
,
document
or img
or presentation
.interface HTMLEmbedElement : HTMLElement { attribute DOMString src; attribute DOMString type; attribute DOMString width; attribute DOMString height; legacycaller any (any... arguments); };
Depending on the type of content instantiated by the embed
element, the node may also support other interfaces.
The embed
element provides
an integration point for an external (typically non-HTML) application or
interactive content.
The src
attribute gives the address of the resource being embedded. The attribute,
if present, must contain a valid
non-empty URL potentially surrounded by spaces.
The type
attribute, if present, gives the MIME type by
which the plugin to instantiate is selected. The value must be a valid
MIME type. Якщо both the type
attribute and the src
attribute are present, then the
type
attribute must specify the same type as the explicit Content-Type metadata of the resource
given by the src
attribute.
When the element is created with neither a src
attribute nor a type
attribute та when attributes
are removed such that neither attribute is present on the element
anymore та when the element has a media
element ancestor та when the element has an ancestor object
element that is not showing its fallback
content, any plugin instantiated for the
element must be removed та the embed
element then represents nothing.
An embed
element is said
to be potentially
active when the following conditions are all met simultaneously:
Document
or was in a Document
the last time
the event loop reached step 1.Document
is fully active.src
attribute set or a type
attribute set (or both).src
attribute is either absent or its value is not the empty string.object
element that is not showing its fallback
content.Whenever an embed
element that was not potentially
active becomes potentially
active та whenever a potentially
active embed
element that is remaining potentially
active and has its src
attribute set, changed, or removed or its type
attribute set, changed, or
removed, the user agent must queue a task
using the embed task source to run the embed
element
setup steps.
The embed
element
setup steps наступні:
Якщо another task
has since been queued to run the
embed
element setup steps for this element, then
abort these steps.
src
attribute setThe user agent must resolve
the value of the element's src
attribute, relative to
the element. Якщо that is successful, the user agent should fetch the resulting absolute
URL, from the element's browsing
context scope origin if it has one. The task that is queued by the networking
task source once the resource has been fetched must run the following steps:
Якщо another task
has since been queued to run the
embed
element setup steps for this
element, then abort these steps.
Determine the type of the content being embedded, as follows (stopping at the first substep that determines the type):
Якщо the element has a type
attribute та
that attribute's value is a type that a plugin
supports, then the value of the type
attribute is
the content's
type.
Інакше if applying the URL parser algorithm to the URL of the specified resource (after any redirects) results in a parsed URL whose path component matches a pattern that a plugin supports, then the content's type is the type that that plugin can handle.
For example, a plugin might say that it
can handle resources with path components that end
with the four character string ".swf
".
Інакше if the specified resource has explicit Content-Type metadata, then that is the content's type.
Інакше the content has no type and there can be no appropriate plugin for it.
Якщо the previous step determined that the content's type is image/svg+xml
,
then run the following substeps:
Якщо the embed
element is not associated with a nested
browsing context, associate the element with a
newly created nested
browsing context та, if the element has a name
attribute,
set the browsing
context name of the element's nested
browsing context to the value of this attribute.
Navigate the
nested browsing
context to the fetched resource, with replacement
enabled та with the embed
element's document's browsing
context as the source
browsing context. (The src
attribute of
the embed
element doesn't get updated if the browsing context gets
further navigated to other locations.)
The embed
element now represents its
associated nested
browsing context.
Інакше find and instantiate an appropriate plugin
based on the content's
type та hand that plugin the
content of the resource, replacing any previously
instantiated plugin for the element. The embed
element now represents this plugin
instance.
Whether the resource is fetched successfully or not (e.g. whether the response code was a 2xx code or equivalent) must be ignored when determining the content's type and when handing the resource to the plugin.
This allows servers to return data for plugins even with error responses (e.g. HTTP 500 Internal Server Error codes can still contain plugin data).
Fetching the resource must delay the load event of the element's document.
src
attribute setThe user agent should find and instantiate an appropriate plugin
based on the value of the type
attribute. The embed
element now
represents this plugin instance.
The embed
element has no
fallback content. Якщо the user agent
can't find a suitable plugin when attempting to find and instantiate one
for the algorithm above, then the user agent must use a default plugin.
This default could be as simple as saying "Unsupported Format".
Whenever an embed
element that was potentially
active stops being potentially
active, any plugin that had been
instantiated for that element must be unloaded.
When a plugin is to be
instantiated but it cannot be secured and the sandboxed
plugins browsing context flag is set on the embed
element's Document
's active
sandboxing flag set, then the user agent must not instantiate the
plugin та must instead render the embed
element in a manner that conveys that the plugin
was disabled. The user agent may offer the user the option to override
the sandbox and instantiate the plugin anyway; if
the user invokes such an option, the user agent must act as if the
conditions above did not apply for the purposes of this element.
Plugins that cannot be secured are disabled in sandboxed browsing contexts because they might not honor the restrictions imposed by the sandbox (e.g. they might allow scripting even when scripting in the sandbox is disabled). User agents should convey the danger of overriding the sandbox to the user if an option to do so is provided.
Any namespace-less attribute other than name
, align
, hspace
та vspace
may be specified on the embed
element, so long as its
name is XML-compatible and contains no uppercase ASCII letters. These
attributes are then passed as parameters to the plugin.
All attributes in HTML documents get lowercased automatically, so the restriction on uppercase letters doesn't affect such documents.
The four exceptions are to exclude legacy attributes that have side-effects beyond just sending parameters to the plugin.
The user agent should pass the names and values of all the attributes
of the embed
element that
have no namespace to the plugin used, when one is
instantiated.
The HTMLEmbedElement
object representing the element must expose the scriptable interface of
the plugin instantiated for the embed
element, if any. At a minimum, this interface must implement the legacy caller operation. (It is suggested
that the default behavior of this legacy caller operation, e.g. the
behavior of the default plugin's legacy caller operation, be to throw a
NotSupportedError
exception.)
The embed
element supports
dimension attributes.
The IDL attributes src
and type
each must reflect the respective content
attributes of the same name.
Here's a way to embed a resource that requires a proprietary plugin, like Flash:
<embed src="catgame.swf">
Якщо the user does not have the plugin (for example if the plugin vendor doesn't support the user's platform), then the user will be unable to use the resource.
To pass the plugin a parameter "quality" with the value "high", an attribute can be specified:
<embed src="catgame.swf" quality="high">
This would be equivalent to the following, when using an object
element instead:
<object data="catgame.swf"> <param name="quality" value="high"> </object>
object
elementusemap
attribute: Interactive
content.param
elements, then, transparent.data
- Address of the resourcetype
- Type of embedded resourcetypemustmatch
- Whether the type
attribute and the Content-Type
value need to match for the resource to be usedname
- Name of nested browsing contextusemap
- Name of image map to use form
- Associates the control with a form
elementwidth
- Horizontal dimensionheight
- Vertical dimensionapplication
,
document
or img
or presentation
.aria-*
attributes applicable
to the allowed roles.interface HTMLObjectElement : HTMLElement { attribute DOMString data; attribute DOMString type; attribute boolean typeMustMatch; attribute DOMString name; attribute DOMString useMap; readonly attribute HTMLFormElement? form; attribute DOMString width; attribute DOMString height; readonly attribute Document? contentDocument; readonly attribute WindowProxy? contentWindow; readonly attribute boolean willValidate; readonly attribute ValidityState validity; readonly attribute DOMString validationMessage; boolean checkValidity(); void setCustomValidity(DOMString error); legacycaller any (any... arguments); };
Depending on the type of content instantiated by the object
element, the node also supports other interfaces.
The object
element can
represent an external resource, which, depending on the type of the
resource, will either be treated as an image, as a nested
browsing context, or as an external resource to be processed by a plugin.
The data
attribute, if present, specifies the address of the resource. Якщо
present, the attribute must be a valid
non-empty URL potentially surrounded by spaces.
Authors who reference resources from other origins that they do not trust are urged to use the
typemustmatch
attribute defined below. Without that attribute, it is possible in certain
cases for an attacker on the remote host to use the plugin mechanism to
run arbitrary scripts, even if the author has used features such as the
Flash "allowScriptAccess" parameter.
The type
attribute, if present, specifies the type of the resource. Якщо present,
the attribute must be a valid MIME type.
At least one of either the data
attribute or the type
attribute must be present.
The typemustmatch
attribute is a boolean attribute whose
presence indicates that the resource specified by the data
attribute is only to be used
if the value of the type
attribute and the Content-Type of the
aforementioned resource match.
The typemustmatch
attribute must not be specified unless both the data
attribute and the type
attribute are present.
The name
attribute, if present, must be a valid
browsing context name. The given value is used to name the nested
browsing context, if applicable.
Whenever one of the following conditions occur:
Document
changes
whether it is fully active, object
elements changes to or from showing its fallback
content, classid
attribute is set, changed, or removed, classid
attribute is not present та its data
attribute is set,
changed, or removed, classid
attribute nor its data
attribute are present та its type
attribute is set,
changed, or removed, ...the user agent must queue a task to run
the following steps to (re)determine what the object
element represents. The task source for this
task is the
DOM manipulation task source.
This task
being queued
or actively running must delay the load
event of the element's document.
Якщо the user has indicated a preference that this object
element's fallback content be shown
instead of the element's usual behavior, then jump to the step below
labeled fallback.
For example, a user could ask for the element's fallback content to be shown because that content uses a format that the user finds more accessible.
Якщо the element has an ancestor media
element, or has an ancestor object
element that is not showing its fallback
content, or if the element is not in a Document
with a browsing
context, or if the element's Document
is not fully active, or if the element
is still in the stack of open
elements of an HTML parser or XML parser, or if the element is not being
rendered, then jump to the step below labeled fallback.
Якщо the classid
attribute is present та has a value that isn't the empty string,
then: if the user agent can find a plugin
suitable according to the value of the classid
attribute та
either plugins aren't being
sandboxed or that plugin can be secured, then that plugin
should be used та the value of the data
attribute, if any, should be passed to the plugin.
Якщо no suitable plugin can be found, or if
the plugin reports an error, jump to the step
below labeled fallback.
Якщо the data
attribute is present and its value is not the empty string, then:
Якщо the type
attribute is present and its value is not a type that the user
agent supports та is not a type that the user agent can find a plugin for, then the user agent may jump to
the step below labeled fallback without fetching the
content to examine its real type.
Resolve
the URL specified by the data
attribute, relative
to the element.
Якщо that failed, fire a simple
event named error
at the element, then jump to the step below labeled fallback.
Fetch the resulting absolute URL, from the element's browsing context scope origin if it has one.
Fetching the resource must delay the load event of the element's document until the task that is queued by the networking task source once the resource has been fetched (defined next) has been run.
For the purposes of the application cache networking model, this fetch operation is not for a child browsing context (though it might end up being used for one after all, as defined below).
Якщо the resource is not yet available (e.g. because the resource was not available in the cache, so that loading the resource required making a request over the network), then jump to the step below labeled fallback. The task that is queued by the networking task source once the resource is available must restart this algorithm from this step. Resources can load incrementally; user agents may opt to consider a resource "available" whenever enough data has been obtained to begin processing the resource.
Якщо the load failed (e.g. there was an HTTP 404 error, there
was a DNS error), fire a simple
event named error
at the element, then jump to the step below labeled fallback.
Determine the resource type, as follows:
Нехай the resource type be unknown.
Якщо the object
element has a type
attribute and a
typemustmatch
attribute та the resource has associated Content-Type metadata
та the type specified in the resource's Content-Type metadata
is an ASCII чутливі до
реєстру match for the value of the element's type
attribute, then
let resource type be that
type and jump to the step below labeled handler.
Якщо the object
element has a typemustmatch
attribute, jump to the step below labeled handler.
Якщо the user agent is configured to strictly obey Content-Type headers for this resource та the resource has associated Content-Type metadata, then let the resource type be the type specified in the resource's Content-Type metadata та jump to the step below labeled handler.
This can introduce a vulnerability, wherein a site is trying to embed a resource that uses a particular plugin, but the remote site overrides that and instead furnishes the user agent with a resource that triggers a different plugin with different security characteristics.
Якщо there is a type
attribute
present on the object
element та that attribute's value is not a type that the
user agent supports, but it is a type that a plugin
supports, then let the resource
type be the type specified in that type
attribute та
jump to the step below labeled handler.
Run the appropriate set of steps from the following list:
Нехай binary be false.
Якщо the type specified in the resource's Content-Type
metadata is "text/plain
" та the
result of applying the rules
for distinguishing if a resource is text or binary
to the resource is that the resource is not text/plain
,
then set binary to
true.
Якщо the type specified in the resource's Content-Type
metadata is "application/octet-stream
",
then set binary to
true.
Якщо binary is false, then let the resource type be the type specified in the resource's Content-Type metadata та jump to the step below labeled handler.
Якщо there is a type
attribute present on the object
element та its value is not application/octet-stream
,
then run the following steps:
Якщо the attribute's value is a type that a plugin supports, or the
attribute's value is a type that starts with "image/
"
that is not also an XML
MIME type, then let the resource
type be the type specified in that type
attribute.
Jump to the step below labeled handler.
Якщо there is a type
attribute present on the object
element, then let the tentative
type be the type specified in that type
attribute.
Інакше let tentative type be the sniffed type of the resource.
Якщо tentative type
is not application/octet-stream
,
then let resource type
be tentative type
and jump to the step below labeled handler.
Якщо applying the URL parser algorithm to the URL of the specified resource (after any redirects) results in a parsed URL whose path component matches a pattern that a plugin supports, then let resource type be the type that that plugin can handle.
For example, a plugin might say that it can
handle resources with path components that end with
the four character string ".swf
".
It is possible for this step to finish, or for one of the substeps above to jump straight to the next step, with resource type still being unknown. In both cases, the next step will trigger fallback.
Handler: Handle the content as given by the first of the following cases that matches:
Якщо plugins are being sandboxed and the plugin that supports resource type cannot be secured, jump to the step below labeled fallback.
Інакше the user agent should use the plugin that supports resource type and pass the content of the resource to that plugin. Якщо the plugin reports an error, then jump to the step below labeled fallback.
image/
"The object
element must be associated with a newly created nested
browsing context, if it does not already have one.
Якщо the URL of the given resource is not about:blank
, the
element's nested
browsing context must then be navigated to that
resource, with replacement
enabled та with the object
element's document's browsing
context as the source
browsing context. (The data
attribute of
the object
element doesn't get updated if the browsing context gets
further navigated to other locations.)
Якщо the URL of the given resource is
about:blank
, then,
instead, the user agent must queue
a task to fire a
simple event named load
at the object
element. No load
event is fired at the about:blank
document itself.
The object
element represents the nested
browsing context.
Якщо the name
attribute is present, the browsing
context name must be set to the value of this
attribute; otherwise, the browsing
context name must be set to the empty string.
In certain situations, e.g. if the resource
was fetched
from an application cache
but it is an HTML file with a manifest
attribute
that points to a different application cache
manifest, the navigation
of the browsing context
will be restarted so as to load the resource afresh from the
network or a different application
cache. Even if the resource is then found to have a
different type, it is still used as part of a nested
browsing context: only the navigate
algorithm is restarted, not this object
algorithm.
image/
" та support for images has
not been disabledApply the image sniffing rules to determine the type of the image.
The object
element represents the specified
image. The image is not a nested
browsing context.
Якщо the image cannot be rendered, e.g. because it is malformed or in an unsupported format, jump to the step below labeled fallback.
The given resource type is not supported. Jump to the step below labeled fallback.
Якщо the previous step ended with the resource type being unknown, this is the case that is triggered.
The element's contents are not part of what the object
element represents.
Once the resource is completely loaded, queue
a task to fire a simple
event named load
at the element.
The task source for this task is the DOM manipulation task source.
Якщо the data
attribute is absent but the type
attribute is present та
the user agent can find a plugin suitable
according to the value of the type
attribute та either plugins aren't being sandboxed or
the plugin can be secured, then that plugin
should be used. Якщо these conditions
cannot be met, or if the plugin reports an
error, jump to the step below labeled fallback.
Fallback: The object
element represents the element's
children, ignoring any leading param
element children. This is the element's fallback
content. Якщо the element has an instantiated plugin,
then unload it.
When the algorithm above instantiates a plugin,
the user agent should pass to the plugin used the
names and values of all the attributes on the element, in the order they
were added to the element, with the attributes added by the parser being
ordered in source order, followed by a parameter named "PARAM" whose
value is null, followed by all the names and values of parameters given by param
elements що є children of the object
element, in tree order. Якщо the plugin
supports a scriptable interface, the HTMLObjectElement
object representing the element should expose that interface. The object
element represents
the plugin. The plugin is
not a nested browsing context.
Plugins are considered sandboxed for the
purpose of an object
element if the sandboxed
plugins browsing context flag is set on the object
element's Document
's active
sandboxing flag set.
Due to the algorithm above, the contents of object
elements act as fallback content, used
only when referenced resources can't be shown (e.g. because it returned
a 404 error). This allows multiple object
elements to be nested inside each other, targeting multiple user agents
with different capabilities, with the user agent picking the first one
it supports.
Whenever the name
attribute is set, if the object
element has a nested browsing context,
its name must be changed to the
new value. Якщо the attribute is removed, if the object
element has a browsing context, the browsing context name must be set to
the empty string.
The usemap
attribute, if present while the object
element represents an image, can indicate that the object has an
associated image map. The
attribute must be ignored if the object
element doesn't represent an image.
The form
attribute is used to explicitly associate the object
element with its form owner.
Constraint validation: object
elements are always barred
from constraint validation.
The object
element
supports dimension attributes.
The IDL attributes data
,
type
and name
each must reflect the respective content
attributes of the same name. The typeMustMatch
IDL
attribute must reflect the typemustmatch
content
attribute. The useMap
IDL attribute must reflect the usemap
content attribute.
The contentDocument
IDL attribute must return the Document
object of the active document of the object
element's nested
browsing context, if any and if its effective
script origin is the same origin as
the effective script origin
specified by the incumbent
settings object, or null otherwise.
The contentWindow
IDL attribute must return the WindowProxy
object of the object
element's nested browsing context,
if it has one; otherwise, it must return null.
The willValidate
,
validity
та validationMessage
attributes та the checkValidity()
та setCustomValidity()
methods, are part of the constraint
validation API. The form
IDL attribute is part of the element's forms API.
All object
elements
have a legacy
caller operation. Якщо the object
element has an instantiated plugin that supports
a scriptable interface that defines a legacy caller operation, then that
must be the behavior of the object's legacy caller operation. Інакше the
object's legacy caller operation must be to throw a NotSupportedError
exception.
In the following example, a Java applet is embedded in a page using the
object
element.
(Generally speaking, it is better to avoid using applets like these and
instead use native JavaScript and HTML to provide the functionality,
since that way the application will work on all Web browsers without
requiring a third-party plugin. Many devices, especially embedded
devices, do not support third-party technologies like Java.)
<figure> <object type="application/x-java-applet"> <param name="code" value="MyJavaClass"> <p>You do not have Java available, or it is disabled.</p> </object> <figcaption>My Java Clock</figcaption> </figure>
In this example, an HTML page is embedded in another using the object
element.
<figure> <object data="clock.html"></object> <figcaption>My HTML Clock</figcaption> </figure>
The following example shows how a plugin can be used in HTML (in this
case the Flash plugin, to show a video file). Fallback is provided for
users who do not have Flash enabled, in this case using the video
element to show the video for those using user agents that support video
та finally providing a
link to the video for those who have neither Flash nor a video
-capable
browser.
<p>Look at my video: <object type="application/x-shockwave-flash"> <param name=movie value="http://video.example.com/library/watch.swf"> <param name=allowfullscreen value=true> <param name=flashvars value="http://video.example.com/vids/315981"> <video controls src="http://video.example.com/vids/315981"> <a href="http://video.example.com/vids/315981">View video</a>. </video> </object> </p>
param
elementobject
element, before any flow content.name
- Name of parametervalue
- Value of parameterinterface HTMLParamElement : HTMLElement { attribute DOMString name; attribute DOMString value; };
The param
element defines
parameters for plugins invoked by object
elements. It does not represent
anything on its own.
The name
attribute gives the name of the parameter.
The value
attribute gives the value of the parameter.
Both attributes must be present. They may have any value.
Якщо both attributes are present та if the parent element of the param
is an object
element, then the element defines a parameter with the given name-value
pair.
Якщо either the name or value of a parameter defined by a param
element that is the child of an object
element that represents an instantiated plugin
changes та if that plugin is communicating with
the user agent using an API that features the ability to update the plugin when the name or value of a parameter so changes, then the
user agent must appropriately exercise that ability to notify the plugin
of the change.
The IDL attributes name
and value
must both reflect the respective content
attributes of the same name.
The following example shows how the param
element can be used to pass a parameter to a plugin, in this case the
O3D plugin.
<!DOCTYPE HTML> <html lang="en"> <head> <title>O3D Utah Teapot</title> </head> <body> <p> <object type="application/vnd.o3d.auto"> <param name="o3d_features" value="FloatingPointTextures"> <img src="o3d-teapot.png" title="3D Utah Teapot illustration rendered using O3D." alt="When O3D renders the Utah Teapot, it appears as a squat teapot with a shiny metallic finish on which the surroundings are reflected, with a faint shadow caused by the lighting."> <p>To see the teapot actually rendered by O3D on your computer, please download and install the <a href="http://code.google.com/apis/o3d/docs/gettingstarted.html#install">O3D plugin</a>.</p> </object> <script src="o3d-teapot.js"></script> </p> </body> </html>
video
elementcontrols
attribute: Interactive
content.src
attribute: zero or more track
elements, then transparent, but with no media element descendants.src
attribute: zero or more source
elements, then zero or
more track
elements, then
transparent, but with no media
element descendants.src
- Address of the resourcecrossorigin
- How the element handles crossorigin requestsposter
- Poster frame to show prior to video playbackpreload
- Hints how much buffering the media resource
will likely needautoplay
- Hint that the media resource can be
started automatically when the page is loadedmediagroup
- Groups media
elements together with an implicit MediaController
loop
- Whether to loop the media resourcemuted
- Whether to mute the media resource by
defaultcontrols
- Show user agent controlswidth
- Horizontal dimensionheight
- Vertical dimensionapplication
.aria-*
attributes applicable
to the allowed roles.interface HTMLVideoElement : HTMLMediaElement { attribute unsigned long width; attribute unsigned long height; readonly attribute unsigned long videoWidth; readonly attribute unsigned long videoHeight; attribute DOMString poster; };
A video
element is used
for playing videos or movies та audio files with captions.
Content may be provided inside the video
element. User agents should not show this content to
the user; it is intended for older Web browsers which do not
support video
, so that
legacy video plugins can be tried, or to show text to the users of these
older browsers informing them of how to access the video contents.
In particular, this content is not intended to address
accessibility concerns. To make video content accessible to the partially
sighted, the blind, the hard-of-hearing, the deaf та those with other
physical or cognitive disabilities, a variety of features are available.
Captions can be provided, either embedded in the video stream or as
external files using the track
element. Sign-language tracks can be provided, again either embedded in
the video stream or by synchronizing multiple video
elements using the mediagroup
attribute or a MediaController
object. Audio descriptions can be provided, either as a separate track
embedded in the video stream, or a separate audio track in an audio
element slaved to the same controller as
the video
element(s), or in
text form using a WebVTT file referenced using
the track
element and
synthesized into speech by the user agent. WebVTT can also be used to
provide chapter titles. For users who would rather not use a media element
at all, transcripts or other textual alternatives can be provided by
simply linking to them in the prose near the video
element. [WEBVTT]
The video
element is a media element whose media
data is ostensibly video data, possibly with associated audio data.
The src
,
preload
,
autoplay
,
mediagroup
,
loop
,
muted
та controls
attributes are the
attributes common to all media elements.
The poster
attribute gives the address of an image file that the user agent can show
while no video data is available. The attribute, if present, must contain
a valid
non-empty URL potentially surrounded by spaces.
Якщо the specified resource is to be used, then, when the element is
created or when the poster
attribute is set, changed, or removed, the user agent must run the
following steps to determine the element's poster
frame (regardless of the value of the element's show
poster flag):
Якщо there is an existing instance of this algorithm running for
this video
element,
abort that instance of this algorithm without changing the poster
frame.
Якщо the poster
attribute's value is the empty string or if the attribute is absent,
then there is no poster frame; abort
these steps.
Resolve
the poster
attribute's value relative to the element. Якщо this fails, then
there is no poster frame; abort these
steps.
Fetch the resulting absolute
URL, from the element's Document
's
origin. This must delay
the load event of the element's document.
Якщо an image is thus obtained, the poster frame is that image. Інакше there is no poster frame.
The image given by the poster
attribute, the poster
frame, is intended to be a representative frame of the video
(typically one of the first non-blank frames) that gives the user an idea
of what the video is like.
A video
element
represents what is given for the first matching condition in the list
below:
readyState
attribute is
either HAVE_NOTHING
,
or HAVE_METADATA
but no video data has yet been obtained at all, or the element's readyState
attribute is any subsequent value but the media
resource does not have a video channel)video
element represents its poster
frame, if any, or else transparent black with no intrinsic
dimensions.video
element is paused,
the current
playback position is the first frame of video та the element's show poster flag is setvideo
element represents its poster
frame, if any, or else the first frame of the video.video
element is paused
та the frame of video corresponding to the current playback position is
not available (e.g. because the video is seeking or buffering)video
element is neither potentially playing
nor paused
(e.g. when seeking or stalled)video
element represents the last frame of the video to
have been rendered.video
element is pausedvideo
element represents the frame of video corresponding
to the current
playback position.video
element has a video channel and is potentially
playing)video
element represents the frame of video at the
continuously increasing "current" position. When the current playback position
changes such that the last frame rendered is no longer the frame
corresponding to the current
playback position in the video, the new frame must be rendered.Which frame in a video stream corresponds to a particular playback position is defined by the video stream's format.
The video
element also represents any text track cues whose text
track cue active flag is set and whose text
track is in the showing
mode та any audio from the media resource,
at the current playback position.
Any audio associated with the media resource must, if played, be played synchronized with the current playback position, at the element's effective media volume.
In addition to the above, the user agent may provide messages to the user (such as "buffering", "no video loaded", "error", or more detailed information) by overlaying text or icons on the video or other areas of the element's playback area, or in another appropriate manner.
User agents that cannot render the video may instead make the element represent a link to an external video playback utility or to the video data itself.
When a video
element's media resource has a video channel, the
element provides a paint source
whose width is the media resource's intrinsic width, whose
height is the media resource's intrinsic height та whose
appearance is the frame of video corresponding to the current playback position, if
that is available, or else (e.g. when the video is seeking or buffering)
its previous appearance, if any, or else (e.g. because the video is
still loading the first frame) blackness.
videoWidth
videoHeight
These attributes return the intrinsic dimensions of the video, or zero if the dimensions are not known.
The intrinsic width and intrinsic height of the media resource are the dimensions of the resource in CSS pixels after taking into account the resource's dimensions, aspect ratio, clean aperture, resolution та so forth, as defined for the format used by the resource. Якщо an anamorphic format does not define how to apply the aspect ratio to the video data's dimensions щоб отримати the "correct" dimensions, then the user agent must apply the ratio by increasing one dimension and leaving the other unchanged.
The videoWidth
IDL attribute must return the intrinsic width of the video
in CSS pixels. The videoHeight
IDL attribute must return the intrinsic height of the
video in CSS pixels. Якщо the element's readyState
attribute is HAVE_NOTHING
,
then the attributes must return 0.
Whenever the intrinsic width or intrinsic height of the
video changes (including, for example, because the selected video track was changed),
if the element's readyState
attribute is not HAVE_NOTHING
,
the user agent must queue a task to fire
a simple event named resize
at the media
element.
The video
element supports
dimension attributes.
In the absence of style rules to the contrary, video content should be rendered inside the element's playback area such that the video content is shown centered in the playback area at the largest possible size that fits completely within it, with the video content's aspect ratio being preserved. Thus, if the aspect ratio of the playback area does not match the aspect ratio of the video, the video will be shown letterboxed or pillarboxed. Areas of the element's playback area that do not contain the video represent nothing.
In user agents that implement CSS, the above requirement can be implemented by using the style rule suggested in the rendering section.
The intrinsic width of a video
element's playback area is the intrinsic width of the poster
frame, if that is available and the element currently represents
its poster frame; otherwise, it is the intrinsic width of the video
resource, if that is available; otherwise the intrinsic width is
missing.
The intrinsic height of a video
element's playback area is the intrinsic height of the poster
frame, if that is available and the element currently represents
its poster frame; otherwise it is the intrinsic height of the
video resource, if that is available; otherwise the intrinsic height is
missing.
The default object size is a width of 300 CSS pixels and a height of 150 CSS pixels. [CSSIMAGES]
User agents should provide controls to enable or disable the display of closed captions, audio description tracks та other additional data associated with the video stream, though such features should, again, not interfere with the page's normal rendering.
User agents may allow users to view the video content in manners more
suitable to the user (e.g. full-screen or in an independent resizable
window). As for the other user interface features, controls to enable
this should not interfere with the page's normal rendering unless the
user agent is exposing a user interface.
In such an independent context, however, user agents may make full user
interfaces visible, with, e.g., play, pause, seeking та volume controls,
even if the controls
attribute is absent.
User agents may allow video playback to affect system features that could interfere with the user's experience; for example, user agents could disable screensavers while video playback is in progress.
The poster
IDL attribute must reflect the poster
content attribute.
This example shows how to detect when a video has failed to play correctly:
<script> function failed(e) { // video playback failed - show a message saying why switch (e.target.error.code) { case e.target.error.MEDIA_ERR_ABORTED: alert('You aborted the video playback.'); break; case e.target.error.MEDIA_ERR_NETWORK: alert('A network error caused the video download to fail part-way.'); break; case e.target.error.MEDIA_ERR_DECODE: alert('The video playback was aborted due to a corruption problem or because the video used features your browser did not support.'); break; case e.target.error.MEDIA_ERR_SRC_NOT_SUPPORTED: alert('The video could not be loaded, either because the server or network failed or because the format is not supported.'); break; default: alert('An unknown error occurred.'); break; } } </script> <p><video src="tgif.vid" autoplay controls onerror="failed(event)"></video></p> <p><a href="tgif.vid">Download the video file</a>.</p>
audio
elementcontrols
attribute: Interactive
content.controls
attribute: Palpable
content.src
attribute: zero or more track
elements, then transparent, but with no media element descendants.src
attribute: zero or more source
elements, then zero or
more track
elements, then
transparent, but with no media
element descendants.src
- Address of the resourcecrossorigin
- How the element handles crossorigin requestspreload
- Hints how much buffering the media resource
will likely needautoplay
- Hint that the media resource can be
started automatically when the page is loadedmediagroup
- Groups media
elements together with an implicit MediaController
loop
- Whether to loop the media resourcemuted
- Whether to mute the media resource by
defaultcontrols
- Show user agent controlsapplication
.aria-*
attributes applicable
to the allowed roles.[NamedConstructor=Audio(optional DOMString src)] interface HTMLAudioElement : HTMLMediaElement {};
An audio
element represents
a sound or audio stream.
Content may be provided inside the audio
element. User agents should not show this content to
the user; it is intended for older Web browsers which do not
support audio
, so that
legacy audio plugins can be tried, or to show text to the users of these
older browsers informing them of how to access the audio contents.
In particular, this content is not intended to address
accessibility concerns. To make audio content accessible to the deaf or to
those with other physical or cognitive disabilities, a variety of features
are available. Якщо captions or a sign language video are available, the video
element can be used instead
of the audio
element to
play the audio, allowing users to enable the visual alternatives. Chapter
titles can be provided to aid navigation, using the track
element and a WebVTT file. And, naturally,
transcripts or other textual alternatives can be provided by simply
linking to them in the prose near the audio
element. [WEBVTT]
The audio
element is a media element whose media
data is ostensibly audio data.
The src
,
preload
,
autoplay
,
mediagroup
,
loop
,
muted
та controls
attributes are the
attributes common to all media elements.
When an audio
element is
potentially playing, it must have its
audio data played synchronized with the current
playback position, at the element's effective
media volume.
When an audio
element is
not potentially playing, audio must
not play for the element.
Audio
( [ url
] )Returns a new audio
element, with the src
attribute set to the value passed in the argument, if applicable.
A constructor is provided for creating HTMLAudioElement
objects (in addition to the factory methods from DOM such as createElement()
):
Audio(src)
.
When invoked as a constructor, it must return a new HTMLAudioElement
object (a new audio
element). The element must have its preload
attribute set to the
literal value "auto
".
Якщо the src argument is present, the
object created must have its src
content attribute set to the
provided value та the user agent must invoke the object's resource selection algorithm
before returning. The element's document must be the active
document of the browsing context
of the Window
object on which the
interface object of the invoked constructor is found.
source
elementtrack
elements.src
- Address of the resourcetype
- Type of embedded resourceinterface HTMLSourceElement : HTMLElement { attribute DOMString src; attribute DOMString type; attribute DOMString media; };
The source
element allows
authors to specify multiple alternative media resources for media elements. It does not represent anything on its own.
The src
attribute gives the address of the media
resource. The value must be a valid
non-empty URL potentially surrounded by spaces. This attribute must
be present.
Dynamically modifying a source
element and its attribute when the element is already inserted in a video
or audio
element will have no effect. To change what is playing, just use the src
attribute on the media element directly,
possibly making use of the canPlayType()
method to
pick from amongst available resources. Generally, manipulating source
elements manually after the document has been parsed is an unnecessarily
complicated approach.
The type
attribute gives the type of the media resource,
to help the user agent determine if it can play this media
resource before fetching it. Якщо specified, its value must be a valid MIME type. The codecs
parameter, which certain MIME types define, might be necessary to specify
exactly how the resource is encoded. [RFC6381]
The following list shows some examples of how to use the codecs=
MIME parameter in the type
attribute.
<source src='video.mp4' type='video/mp4; codecs="avc1.42E01E, mp4a.40.2"'>
<source src='video.mp4' type='video/mp4; codecs="avc1.58A01E, mp4a.40.2"'>
<source src='video.mp4' type='video/mp4; codecs="avc1.4D401E, mp4a.40.2"'>
<source src='video.mp4' type='video/mp4; codecs="avc1.64001E, mp4a.40.2"'>
<source src='video.mp4' type='video/mp4; codecs="mp4v.20.8, mp4a.40.2"'>
<source src='video.mp4' type='video/mp4; codecs="mp4v.20.240, mp4a.40.2"'>
<source src='video.3gp' type='video/3gpp; codecs="mp4v.20.8, samr"'>
<source src='video.ogv' type='video/ogg; codecs="theora, vorbis"'>
<source src='video.ogv' type='video/ogg; codecs="theora, speex"'>
<source src='audio.ogg' type='audio/ogg; codecs=vorbis'>
<source src='audio.spx' type='audio/ogg; codecs=speex'>
<source src='audio.oga' type='audio/ogg; codecs=flac'>
<source src='video.ogv' type='video/ogg; codecs="dirac, vorbis"'>
The media
attribute gives the intended media type of the media
resource, to help the user agent determine if this media
resource is useful to the user before fetching it. Its value must be
a valid media query.
The resource selection algorithm is
defined in such a way that when the media
attribute is omitted the
user agent acts the same as if the value was "all
",
i.e. by default the media resource is
suitable for all media.
Якщо a source
element
is inserted as a child of a media element
that has no src
attribute and whose networkState
has the value
NETWORK_EMPTY
,
the user agent must invoke the media element's
resource
selection algorithm.
The IDL attributes src
,
type
та media
must reflect the respective content attributes
of the same name.
Якщо the author isn't sure if user agents will all be able to render
the media resources provided, the author can listen to the error
event on the last source
element and trigger fallback behavior:
<script> function fallback(video) { // replace <video> with its contents while (video.hasChildNodes()) { if (video.firstChild instanceof HTMLSourceElement) video.removeChild(video.firstChild); else video.parentNode.insertBefore(video.firstChild, video); } video.parentNode.removeChild(video); } </script> <video controls autoplay> <source src='video.mp4' type='video/mp4; codecs="avc1.42E01E, mp4a.40.2"'> <source src='video.ogv' type='video/ogg; codecs="theora, vorbis"' onerror="fallback(parentNode)"> ... </video>
track
elementkind
- The type of text tracksrc
- Address of the resourcesrclang
- Language of the text tracklabel
- User-visible labeldefault
- Enable the track if no other text track is
more suitableinterface HTMLTrackElement : HTMLElement { attribute DOMString kind; attribute DOMString src; attribute DOMString srclang; attribute DOMString label; attribute boolean default; const unsigned short NONE = 0; const unsigned short LOADING = 1; const unsigned short LOADED = 2; const unsigned short ERROR = 3; readonly attribute unsigned short readyState; readonly attribute TextTrack track; };
The track
element allows
authors to specify explicit external timed text tracks for media elements. It does not represent anything on its own.
The kind
attribute is an enumerated attribute.
The following table lists the keywords defined for this attribute. The
keyword given in the first cell of each row maps to the state given in the
second cell.
Keyword | State | Brief description |
---|---|---|
subtitles
|
Subtitles | Transcription or translation of the dialogue, suitable for when the sound is available but not understood (e.g. because the user does not understand the language of the media resource's audio track). Overlaid on the video. |
captions
|
Captions | Transcription or translation of the dialogue, sound effects, relevant musical cues та other relevant audio information, suitable for when sound is unavailable or not clearly audible (e.g. because it is muted, drowned-out by ambient noise, or because the user is deaf). Overlaid on the video; labeled as appropriate for the hard-of-hearing. |
descriptions
|
Descriptions | Textual descriptions of the video component of the media resource, intended for audio synthesis when the visual component is obscured, unavailable, or not usable (e.g. because the user is interacting with the application without a screen while driving, or because the user is blind). Synthesized as audio. |
chapters
|
Chapters | Chapter titles, intended to be used for navigating the media resource. Displayed as an interactive (potentially nested) list in the user agent's interface. |
metadata
|
Metadata | Tracks intended for use from script. Not displayed by the user agent. |
The attribute may be omitted. The missing value default is the subtitles state.
The src
attribute gives the address of the text track data. The value must be a valid
non-empty URL potentially surrounded by spaces. This attribute must
be present.
Якщо the element has a src
attribute whose value is not the empty string and whose value, when the
attribute was set, could be successfully resolved relative to the element, then the
element's track URL is the resulting absolute
URL. Інакше the element's track URL is
the empty string.
Якщо the element's track URL identifies a WebVTT
resource та the element's kind
attribute is not in the metadata
state, then the WebVTT file must be a WebVTT
file using cue text. [WEBVTT]
Furthermore, if the element's track URL
identifies a WebVTT resource та the element's kind
attribute is in the chapters
state, then the WebVTT file must be both a WebVTT
file using chapter title text and a WebVTT
file using only nested cues. [WEBVTT]
The srclang
attribute gives the language of the text track data. The value must be a
valid BCP 47 language tag. This attribute must be present if the element's
kind
attribute is in the subtitles
state. [BCP47]
Якщо the element has a srclang
attribute whose value
is not the empty string, then the element's track
language is the value of the attribute. Інакше the element has
no track language.
The label
attribute gives a user-readable title for the track. This title is used by
user agents when listing subtitle, caption та audio description tracks in
their user interface.
The value of the label
attribute, if the attribute is present, must not be the empty string.
Furthermore, there must not be two track
element children of the same media element
whose kind
attributes are in the same state, whose srclang
attributes are both
missing or have values that represent the same language та whose label
attributes are again both
missing or both have the same value.
Якщо the element has a label
attribute whose value is not the empty string, then the element's track label is the value of the attribute.
Інакше the element's track label is an empty
string.
The default
attribute is a boolean attribute, which,
if specified, indicates that the track is to be enabled if the user's
preferences do not indicate that another track would be more appropriate.
Each media element must have no more than
one track
element child
whose kind
attribute is in the subtitles
or captions
state and whose default
attribute is specified.
Each media element must have no more than
one track
element child
whose kind
attribute is in the description
state and whose default
attribute is specified.
Each media element must have no more than
one track
element child
whose kind
attribute is in the chapters
state and whose default
attribute is specified.
There is no limit on the number of track
elements whose kind
attribute is in the metadata
state and whose default
attribute is specified.
readyState
Returns the text track readiness state, represented by a number from the following list:
NONE
(0)The text track not loaded state.
LOADING
(1)The text track loading state.
LOADED
(2)The text track loaded state.
ERROR
(3)The text track failed to load state.
track
Returns the TextTrack
object
corresponding to the text track of the track
element.
The readyState
attribute must return the numeric value corresponding to the text
track readiness state of the track
element's text track, as defined by the
following list:
NONE
(numeric value 0)LOADING
(numeric value 1)LOADED
(numeric value 2)ERROR
(numeric value 3)The track
IDL attribute must, on getting, return the track
element's text track's corresponding TextTrack
object.
The src
,
srclang
,
label
та default
IDL attributes must reflect the respective
content attributes of the same name. The kind
IDL attribute must reflect
the content attribute of the same name, limited
to only known values.
This video has subtitles in several languages:
<video src="brave.webm"> <track kind=subtitles src=brave.en.vtt srclang=en label="English"> <track kind=captions src=brave.en.hoh.vtt srclang=en label="English for the Hard of Hearing"> <track kind=subtitles src=brave.fr.vtt srclang=fr lang=fr label="Français"> <track kind=subtitles src=brave.de.vtt srclang=de lang=de label="Deutsch"> </video>
(The lang
attributes on the last two describe the language of the label
attribute, not the
language of the subtitles themselves. The language of the subtitles is
given by the srclang
attribute.)
Media elements
(audio
and video
,
in this specification) implement the following interface:
enum CanPlayTypeEnum { "" /* empty string */, "maybe", "probably" };
interface HTMLMediaElement : HTMLElement {
// error state
readonly attribute MediaError? error;
// network state
attribute DOMString src;
readonly attribute DOMString currentSrc;
attribute DOMString crossOrigin;
const unsigned short NETWORK_EMPTY = 0;
const unsigned short NETWORK_IDLE = 1;
const unsigned short NETWORK_LOADING = 2;
const unsigned short NETWORK_NO_SOURCE = 3;
readonly attribute unsigned short networkState;
attribute DOMString preload;
readonly attribute TimeRanges buffered;
void load();
CanPlayTypeEnum canPlayType(DOMString type);
// ready state
const unsigned short HAVE_NOTHING = 0;
const unsigned short HAVE_METADATA = 1;
const unsigned short HAVE_CURRENT_DATA = 2;
const unsigned short HAVE_FUTURE_DATA = 3;
const unsigned short HAVE_ENOUGH_DATA = 4;
readonly attribute unsigned short readyState;
readonly attribute boolean seeking;
// playback state
attribute double currentTime;
readonly attribute unrestricted double duration;
Date getStartDate();
readonly attribute boolean paused;
attribute double defaultPlaybackRate;
attribute double playbackRate;
readonly attribute TimeRanges played;
readonly attribute TimeRanges seekable;
readonly attribute boolean ended;
attribute boolean autoplay;
attribute boolean loop;
void play();
void pause();
// media controller
attribute DOMString mediaGroup;
attribute MediaController? controller;
// controls
attribute boolean controls;
attribute double volume;
attribute boolean muted;
attribute boolean defaultMuted;
// tracks
readonly attribute AudioTrackList audioTracks;
readonly attribute VideoTrackList videoTracks;
readonly attribute TextTrackList textTracks;
TextTrack addTextTrack(TextTrackKind kind, optional DOMString label = "", optional DOMString language = "");
};
The media element attributes, src
,
crossorigin
,
preload
,
autoplay
,
mediagroup
,
loop
,
muted
та controls
,
apply to all media
elements. They are defined in this section.
Media elements are used to present audio data, or video and audio data, to the user. This is referred to as media data in this section, since this section applies equally to media elements for audio or for video. The term media resource is used to refer to the complete set of media data, e.g. the complete video file, or complete audio file.
A media resource can have multiple audio
and video tracks. For the purposes of a media
element, the video data of the media
resource is only that of the currently selected track (if any) given
by the element's videoTracks
attribute та the audio data of the media
resource is the result of mixing all the currently enabled tracks
(if any) given by the element's audioTracks
attribute.
Both audio
and video
elements can be
used for both audio and video. The main difference between the two is
simply that the audio
element has no playback area for visual content (such as video or
captions), whereas the video
element does.
Except where otherwise explicitly specified, the task source for all the tasks queued in this section and its subsections is the media element event task source of the media element in question.
error
Returns a MediaError
object
representing the current error state of the element.
Returns null if there is no error.
All media
elements have an associated error status, which records the last
error the element encountered since its resource selection algorithm
was last invoked. The error
attribute, on getting, must return the MediaError
object created for this last error, or null if there has not been an
error.
interface MediaError { const unsigned short MEDIA_ERR_ABORTED = 1; const unsigned short MEDIA_ERR_NETWORK = 2; const unsigned short MEDIA_ERR_DECODE = 3; const unsigned short MEDIA_ERR_SRC_NOT_SUPPORTED = 4; readonly attribute unsigned short code; };
error
. code
Returns the current error's error code, from the list below.
The code
attribute of a MediaError
object
must return the code for the error, which must be one of the following:
MEDIA_ERR_ABORTED
(numeric value 1)MEDIA_ERR_NETWORK
(numeric value 2)MEDIA_ERR_DECODE
(numeric value 3)MEDIA_ERR_SRC_NOT_SUPPORTED
(numeric value 4)src
attribute was not suitable.The src
content attribute on media elements gives the address of the
media resource (video, audio) to show. The attribute, if present, must
contain a valid
non-empty URL potentially surrounded by spaces.
The crossorigin
content attribute on media
elements is a CORS settings
attribute.
Якщо a src
attribute of a media element is set or
changed, the user agent must invoke the media
element's media element
load algorithm. (Removing the src
attribute does not do this,
even if there are source
elements present.)
The src
IDL attribute on media elements must reflect
the content attribute of the same name.
The crossOrigin
IDL attribute must reflect the crossorigin
content
attribute, limited to only
known values.
currentSrc
Returns the address of the current media resource.
Returns the empty string when there is no media resource.
The currentSrc
IDL attribute is initially the empty string. Its value is changed by the
resource
selection algorithm defined below.
There are two ways to specify a media
resource, the src
attribute, or source
elements. The attribute overrides the elements.
A media resource can be described in terms
of its type, specifically a MIME type,
in some cases with a codecs
parameter.
(Whether the codecs
parameter is allowed
or not depends on the MIME type.) [RFC6381]
Types are usually somewhat incomplete descriptions; for example "video/mpeg
"
doesn't say anything except what the container type is та even a type like
"video/mp4; codecs="avc1.42E01E, mp4a.40.2"
"
doesn't include information like the actual bitrate (only the maximum
bitrate). Thus, given a type, a user agent can often only know whether it
might be able to play media of that type (with varying levels of
confidence), or whether it definitely cannot play media of that
type.
A type that the user agent knows it cannot render is one that describes a resource that the user agent definitely does not support, for example because it doesn't recognize the container type, or it doesn't support the listed codecs.
The MIME type "application/octet-stream
"
with no parameters is never a
type that the user agent knows it cannot render. User agents must
treat that type as equivalent to the lack of any explicit Content-Type metadata when it is used to label
a potential media resource.
Only the MIME type "application/octet-stream
"
with no parameters is special-cased here; if any parameter appears with
it, it will be treated just like any other MIME type.
This is a deviation from the rule
that unknown MIME type parameters
should be ignored.
canPlayType
(type)Returns the empty string (a negative response), "maybe", or "probably" based on how confident the user agent is that it can play media resources of the given type.
The canPlayType(type)
method must return the
empty string if type is a
type that the user agent knows it cannot render or is the type "application/octet-stream
";
it must return "probably
"
if the user agent is confident that the type represents a media
resource that it can render if used in with this audio
or video
element; and it
must return "maybe
"
otherwise. Implementors are encouraged to return "maybe
" unless the type
can be confidently established as being supported or not. Generally, a
user agent should never return "probably
" for a type
that allows the codecs
parameter if
that parameter is not present.
This script tests to see if the user agent supports a (fictional) new
format to dynamically decide whether to use a video
element or a plugin:
<section id="video"> <p><a href="playing-cats.nfv">Download video</a></p> </section> <script> var videoSection = document.getElementById('video'); var videoElement = document.createElement('video'); var support = videoElement.canPlayType('video/x-new-fictional-format;codecs="kittens,bunnies"'); if (support != "probably" && "New Fictional Video Plugin" in navigator.plugins) { // not confident of browser support // but we have a plugin // so use plugin instead videoElement = document.createElement("embed"); } else if (support == "") { // no support from browser and no plugin // do nothing videoElement = null; } if (videoElement) { while (videoSection.hasChildNodes()) videoSection.removeChild(videoSection.firstChild); videoElement.setAttribute("src", "playing-cats.nfv"); videoSection.appendChild(videoElement); } </script>
The type
attribute of the source
element allows the user agent to avoid downloading resources that use
formats it cannot render.
networkState
Returns the current state of network activity for the element, from the codes in the list below.
As media
elements interact with the network, their current network activity
is represented by the networkState
attribute. On getting, it must return the current network state of the
element, which must be one of the following values:
NETWORK_EMPTY
(numeric value 0)NETWORK_IDLE
(numeric value 1)NETWORK_LOADING
(numeric value 2)NETWORK_NO_SOURCE
(numeric value 3)The resource
selection algorithm defined below describes exactly when the networkState
attribute changes value and what events fire to indicate changes in this
state.
load
()Causes the element to reset and start selecting and loading a new media resource from scratch.
All media elements have an autoplaying flag, which must begin in the true state та a delaying-the-load-event flag, which must begin in the false state. While the delaying-the-load-event flag є true, the element must delay the load event of its document.
When the load()
method on a media element is invoked, the
user agent must run the media
element load algorithm.
The media element load algorithm consists of the following steps.
Abort any already-running instance of the resource selection algorithm for this element.
Якщо there are any tasks from the media element's media element event task source in one of the task queues, then remove those tasks.
Якщо there are any tasks that were queued by the resource selection algorithm (including the algorithms that it itself invokes) for this same media element from the DOM manipulation task source in one of the task queues, then remove those tasks.
Basically, pending events and callbacks for the media element are discarded when the media element starts loading a new resource.
Якщо the media element's networkState
is set to
NETWORK_LOADING
or NETWORK_IDLE
,
queue a task to fire
a simple event named abort
at the media
element.
Якщо the media element's networkState
is not
set to NETWORK_EMPTY
,
тоді виконайте ці субкроки:
Queue a task to fire
a simple event named emptied
at the media
element.
Якщо a fetching process is in progress for the media element, the user agent should stop it.
Якщо readyState
is not set to HAVE_NOTHING
, then
set it to that state.
Якщо the paused
attribute is false, then set it to true.
Якщо seeking
є true, set it to false.
Set the current playback position to 0.
Set the official playback position to 0.
Якщо this changed the official
playback position, then queue a
task to fire a simple
event named timeupdate
at the
media element.
Set the initial playback position to 0.
Set the timeline offset to Not-a-Number (NaN).
Update the duration
attribute to Not-a-Number (NaN).
The user agent will not
fire a durationchange
event for this particular change of the duration.
Set the playbackRate
attribute to the value of the defaultPlaybackRate
attribute.
Set the error
attribute to null and the autoplaying
flag to true.
Invoke the media element's resource selection algorithm.
Playback of any previously playing media resource for this element stops.
The resource selection algorithm for a media element is as follows. This algorithm is always invoked synchronously, but one of the first steps in the algorithm is to return and continue running the remaining steps asynchronously, meaning that it runs in the background with scripts and other tasks running in parallel. In addition, this algorithm interacts closely with the event loop mechanism; in particular, it has synchronous sections (which are triggered as part of the event loop algorithm). Steps in such sections are marked with ⌛.
Set the element's networkState
attribute
to the NETWORK_NO_SOURCE
value.
Set the element's show poster flag to true.
Set the media element's delaying-the-load-event flag to true (this delays the load event).
Asynchronously await a stable state, allowing the task that invoked this algorithm to continue. The synchronous section consists of all the remaining steps of this algorithm until the algorithm says the synchronous section has ended. (Steps in synchronous sections are marked with ⌛.)
⌛ Якщо the media element's blocked-on-parser flag is false, then populate the list of pending text tracks.
⌛ Якщо the media element has a src
attribute, then let mode be attribute.
⌛ Інакше if the media element does
not have a src
attribute but has a source
element child, then let mode be children and let candidate
be the first such source
element child in tree order.
⌛ Otherwise the media element has
neither a src
attribute nor a source
element child: set the networkState
to NETWORK_EMPTY
та abort these
steps; the synchronous section
ends.
⌛ Set the media element's networkState
to NETWORK_LOADING
.
⌛ Queue a task to fire
a simple event named loadstart
at the media
element.
Якщо mode is attribute, тоді виконайте ці субкроки:
⌛ Якщо the src
attribute's value is the empty string, then end the synchronous
section та jump down to the failed
with attribute step below.
⌛ Нехай absolute URL be the absolute URL that would have resulted
from resolving
the URL specified by the src
attribute's value
relative to the media element when
the src
attribute was last changed.
⌛ Якщо absolute URL was
obtained successfully, set the currentSrc
attribute
to absolute URL.
End the synchronous section, continuing the remaining steps asynchronously.
Якщо absolute URL was obtained successfully, run the resource fetch algorithm with absolute URL. Якщо that algorithm returns without aborting this one, then the load failed.
Failed with attribute: Reaching this step indicates that the media resource failed to load or that the given URL could not be resolved. Queue a task to run the following steps, using the DOM manipulation task source:
Set the error
attribute to a new MediaError
object whose code
attribute is
set to MEDIA_ERR_SRC_NOT_SUPPORTED
.
Set the element's networkState
attribute to the NETWORK_NO_SOURCE
value.
Set the element's show poster flag to true.
Fire a simple event
named error
at the media element.
Set the element's delaying-the-load-event flag to false. This stops delaying the load event.
Wait for the task queued by the previous step to have executed.
Abort these steps. Until the load()
method is invoked
or the src
attribute is changed, the element won't attempt to load another
resource.
Інакше the source
elements will be used; виконати ці підкроки:
⌛ Нехай pointer be a position defined by two adjacent nodes in the media element's child list, treating the start of the list (before the first child in the list, if any) and end of the list (after the last child in the list, if any) as nodes in their own right. One node is the node before pointer та the other node is the node after pointer. Initially, let pointer be the position between the candidate node and the next node, if there are any, or the end of the list, if it is the last node.
As nodes are inserted and removed into the media element, pointer must be updated as follows:
Other changes don't affect pointer.
⌛ Process candidate: Якщо candidate
does not have a src
attribute, or if its src
attribute's value is
the empty string, then end the synchronous
section та jump down to the failed
with elements step below.
⌛ Нехай absolute URL be the absolute URL that would have resulted
from resolving
the URL specified by candidate's
src
attribute's value relative to the candidate
when the src
attribute was last changed.
⌛ Якщо absolute URL was not obtained successfully, then end the synchronous section та jump down to the failed with elements step below.
⌛ Якщо candidate has a type
attribute whose
value, when parsed as a MIME type
(including any codecs described by the codecs
parameter, for types that define that parameter), represents a
type that the user agent knows it cannot render, then end
the synchronous section та
jump down to the failed with elements
step below.
⌛ Якщо candidate has a media
attribute whose
value does not match the environment,
then end the synchronous section
та jump down to the failed with elements
step below.
⌛ Set the currentSrc
attribute to absolute URL.
End the synchronous section, continuing the remaining steps asynchronously.
Run the resource fetch algorithm with absolute URL. Якщо that algorithm returns without aborting this one, then the load failed.
Failed with elements: Queue
a task, using the DOM
manipulation task source, to fire
a simple event named error
at the candidate element.
Asynchronously await a stable state. The synchronous section consists of all the remaining steps of this algorithm until the algorithm says the synchronous section has ended. (Steps in synchronous sections are marked with ⌛.)
⌛ Forget the media element's media-resource-specific tracks.
⌛ Find next candidate: Нехай candidate be null.
⌛ Search loop: Якщо the node after pointer is the end of the list, then jump to the waiting step below.
⌛ Якщо the node after pointer
is a source
element, let candidate be that
element.
⌛ Просуньте pointer so that the node before pointer is now the node that was after pointer та the node after pointer is the node after the node that used to be after pointer, if any.
⌛ Якщо candidate is null, jump back to the search loop step. Інакше jump back to the process candidate step.
⌛ Waiting: Set the element's networkState
attribute to the NETWORK_NO_SOURCE
value.
⌛ Set the element's show poster flag to true.
⌛ Set the element's delaying-the-load-event flag to false. This stops delaying the load event.
End the synchronous section, continuing the remaining steps asynchronously.
Wait until the node after pointer is a node other than the end of the list. (This step might wait forever.)
Asynchronously await a stable state. The synchronous section consists of all the remaining steps of this algorithm until the algorithm says the synchronous section has ended. (Steps in synchronous sections are marked with ⌛.)
⌛ Set the element's delaying-the-load-event flag back to true (this delays the load event again, in case it hasn't been fired yet).
⌛ Set the networkState
back to NETWORK_LOADING
.
⌛ Jump back to the find next candidate step above.
The resource fetch algorithm for a media element and a given absolute URL is as follows:
Нехай the current media resource be the resource given by the absolute URL passed to this algorithm. This is now the element's media resource.
Remove all media-resource-specific text tracks from the media element's list of pending text tracks, if any.
Optionally, run the following substeps. This is the expected
behavior if the user agent intends to not attempt to fetch the
resource until the user requests it explicitly (e.g. as a way to
implement the preload
attribute's none
keyword).
Set the networkState
to NETWORK_IDLE
.
Queue a task to fire
a simple event named suspend
at the
element, using the DOM
manipulation task source.
Set the element's delaying-the-load-event flag to false. This stops delaying the load event.
Wait for the task to be run.
Wait for an implementation-defined event (e.g. the user requesting that the media element begin playback).
Set the element's delaying-the-load-event flag back to true (this delays the load event again, in case it hasn't been fired yet).
Set the networkState
to NETWORK_LOADING
.
Perform a potentially
CORS-enabled fetch of the current
media resource's absolute URL,
with the mode being the state of the media
element's crossorigin
content
attribute, the origin being the origin
of the media element's Document
та the default origin behaviour set to taint.
The resource obtained in this fashion, if any, contains the media
data. It can be CORS-same-origin
or CORS-cross-origin; this affects
whether subtitles referenced in the media
data are exposed in the API and, for video
elements, whether a canvas
gets tainted when the video is drawn on it.
While the load is not suspended (see below), every 350ms (±200ms)
or for every byte received, whichever is least frequent, queue a task to fire
a simple event named progress
at the element.
The stall timeout is a user-agent
defined length of time, which should be about three seconds. When a
media element that is actively
attempting щоб отримати media data has
failed to receive any data for a duration equal to the stall
timeout, the user agent must queue a
task to fire a simple event
named stalled
at the element.
User agents may allow users to selectively block or slow media data downloads. When a media element's download has been blocked altogether, the user agent must act as if it was stalled (as opposed to acting as if the connection was closed). The rate of the download may also be throttled automatically by the user agent, e.g. to balance the download with other connections sharing the same bandwidth.
User agents may decide to not download more
content at any time, e.g. after buffering five minutes of a one hour
media resource, while waiting for the user to decide whether to play
the resource or not, while waiting for user input in an interactive
resource, or when the user navigates away from the page. When a media element's download has been
suspended, the user agent must queue a task,
using the DOM manipulation
task source, to set the networkState
to NETWORK_IDLE
and fire a simple event named suspend
at the element. Якщо and when downloading of the resource resumes,
the user agent must queue a task to set
the networkState
to NETWORK_LOADING
.
Between the queuing of these tasks, the load is suspended (so progress
events don't fire, as described above).
The preload
attribute provides a hint regarding how much buffering the author
thinks is advisable, even in the absence of the autoplay
attribute.
When a user agent decides to completely stall a download, e.g. if it is waiting until the user starts playback before downloading any further content, the element's delaying-the-load-event flag must be set to false. This stops delaying the load event.
The user agent may use whatever means necessary to fetch the resource (within the constraints put forward by this and other specifications); for example, reconnecting to the server in the face of network errors, using HTTP range retrieval requests, or switching to a streaming protocol. The user agent must consider a resource erroneous only if it has given up trying to fetch it.
This specification does not currently say whether or how to check the MIME types of the media resources, or whether or how to perform file type sniffing using the actual file data. Implementors differ in their intentions on this matter and it is therefore unclear what the right solution is. In the absence of any requirement here, the HTTP specification's strict requirement to follow the Content-Type header prevails ("Content-Type specifies the media type of the underlying data." ... "Якщо and only if the media type is not given by a Content-Type field, the recipient МОЖЕ attempt to guess the media type via inspection of its content and/or the name extension(s) of the URI used to identify the resource.").
The networking task source tasks to process the data as it is being fetched must, when appropriate, include the relevant substeps from the following list:
DNS errors, HTTP 4xx and 5xx errors (and equivalents in other protocols) та other fatal network errors that occur before the user agent has established whether the current media resource is usable, as well as the file using an unsupported container format, or using unsupported codecs for all the data, must cause the user agent to execute the following steps:
The user agent should cancel the fetching process.
Abort this subalgorithm, returning to the resource selection algorithm.
Create an AudioTrack
object to represent the audio track.
Update the media element's audioTracks
attribute's AudioTrackList
object with the new AudioTrack
object.
Fire
a trusted
event with the name addtrack
, that
does not bubble and is not cancelable та that uses the TrackEvent
interface, with
the track
attribute initialized to the new AudioTrack
object, at this AudioTrackList
object.
Create a VideoTrack
object to represent the video track.
Update the media element's videoTracks
attribute's VideoTrackList
object with the new VideoTrack
object.
Fire
a trusted
event with the name addtrack
, that
does not bubble and is not cancelable та that uses the TrackEvent
interface, with
the track
attribute initialized to the new VideoTrack
object, at this VideoTrackList
object.
This indicates that the resource is usable. The user agent must follow these substeps:
Establish the media timeline for the purposes of the current playback position, the earliest possible position та the initial playback position, based on the media data.
Update the timeline offset to the date and time that corresponds to the zero time in the media timeline established in the previous step, if any. Якщо no explicit time and date is given by the media resource, the timeline offset must be set to Not-a-Number (NaN).
Set the current playback position and the official playback position to the earliest possible position.
Update the duration
attribute
with the time of the last frame of the resource, if known,
on the media timeline
established above. Якщо it is not known (e.g. a stream that
is in principle infinite), update the duration
attribute
to the value positive Infinity.
The user agent will
queue a task to fire
a simple event named durationchange
at the element at this point.
For video
elements, set the videoWidth
and videoHeight
attributes та queue a task to fire a simple event named
resize
at the media element.
Further resize
events will
be fired if the dimensions subsequently change.
Set the readyState
attribute to HAVE_METADATA
.
A loadedmetadata
DOM event will be fired
as part of setting the readyState
attribute to a new value.
Нехай jumped be false.
Якщо the media element's default playback start position is greater than zero, then seek to that time та let jumped be true.
Нехай the media element's default playback start position be zero.
Якщо either the media resource or the address of the current media resource indicate a particular start time, then set the initial playback position to that time and, if jumped is still false, seek to that time and let jumped be true.
For example, with media formats that support the Media Fragments URI fragment identifier syntax, the fragment identifier can be used to indicate a start position. [MEDIAFRAG]
Якщо either the media resource
or the address of the current
media resource indicate a particular set of audio or
video tracks to enable, or if the user agent has information
that would enable it to select specific tracks to improve
the user's experience, then the relevant audio tracks must
be enabled in the element's audioTracks
object та, of the relevant video tracks, the one that is
listed first in the element's videoTracks
object must be selected. All other tracks must be disabled.
This could again be triggered by Media Fragments URI fragment identifier syntax, but it could also be triggered e.g. by the user agent selecting a 5.1 surround sound audio track over a stereo audio track. [MEDIAFRAG]
Якщо the media element has a current media controller, then: if jumped є true and the initial playback position, relative to the current media controller's timeline, is greater than the current media controller's media controller position, then seek the media controller to the media element's initial playback position, relative to the current media controller's timeline; otherwise, seek the media element to the media controller position, relative to the media element's timeline.
Once the readyState
attribute reaches HAVE_CURRENT_DATA
,
after the loadeddata
event has been fired, set the element's delaying-the-load-event
flag to false. This stops delaying the load event.
A user agent that is attempting to reduce network
usage while still fetching the metadata for each media
resource would also stop buffering at this point,
following the rules described
previously, which involve the networkState
attribute switching to the NETWORK_IDLE
value
and a suspend
event firing.
The user agent is required to determine the duration of the media resource and go through this step before playing.
Fire a simple event named progress
at the media element.
Set the networkState
to NETWORK_IDLE
and fire a simple event
named suspend
at the media element.
Якщо the user agent ever discards any media
data and then needs to resume the network activity щоб
отримати it again, then it must queue a
task to set the networkState
to NETWORK_LOADING
.
Якщо the user agent can keep the media resource loaded, then the algorithm will continue to its final step below, which aborts the algorithm.
Fatal network errors that occur after the user agent has
established whether the current media
resource is usable (i.e. once the media
element's readyState
attribute
is no longer HAVE_NOTHING
) must
cause the user agent to execute the following steps:
The user agent should cancel the fetching process.
Set the error
attribute to a new MediaError
object whose code
attribute is
set to MEDIA_ERR_NETWORK
.
Fire a simple event
named error
at the media element.
Set the element's networkState
attribute to the NETWORK_IDLE
value.
Set the element's delaying-the-load-event flag to false. This stops delaying the load event.
Abort the overall resource selection algorithm.
Fatal errors in decoding the media data that occur after the user agent has established whether the current media resource is usable must cause the user agent to execute the following steps:
The user agent should cancel the fetching process.
Set the error
attribute to a new MediaError
object whose code
attribute is
set to MEDIA_ERR_DECODE
.
Fire a simple event
named error
at the media element.
Якщо the media element's readyState
attribute has a value equal to HAVE_NOTHING
,
set the element's networkState
attribute to the NETWORK_EMPTY
value, set the element's show
poster flag to true та fire
a simple event named emptied
at the
element.
Інакше set the element's networkState
attribute to the NETWORK_IDLE
value.
Set the element's delaying-the-load-event flag to false. This stops delaying the load event.
Abort the overall resource selection algorithm.
The fetching process is aborted by the user, e.g. because the
user pressed a "stop" button, the user agent must execute the
following steps. These steps are not followed if the load()
method itself is
invoked while these steps are running, as the steps above handle
that particular kind of abort.
The user agent should cancel the fetching process.
Set the error
attribute to a new MediaError
object whose code
attribute is
set to MEDIA_ERR_ABORTED
.
Fire a simple event
named abort
at the media element.
Якщо the media element's readyState
attribute has a value equal to HAVE_NOTHING
,
set the element's networkState
attribute to the NETWORK_EMPTY
value, set the element's show
poster flag to true та fire
a simple event named emptied
at the
element.
Інакше set the element's networkState
attribute to the NETWORK_IDLE
value.
Set the element's delaying-the-load-event flag to false. This stops delaying the load event.
Abort the overall resource selection algorithm.
The server returning data that is partially usable but cannot be optimally rendered must cause the user agent to render just the bits it can handle та ignore the rest.
Якщо the media data is CORS-same-origin, run the steps to expose a media-resource-specific text track with the relevant data.
Cross-origin videos do not expose their subtitles, since that would allow attacks such as hostile sites reading subtitles from confidential videos on a user's intranet.
When the networking task source has queued the last task as part of fetching the media resource (i.e. once the download has completed), if the fetching process completes without errors, including decoding the media data та if all of the data is available to the user agent without network access, then, the user agent must move on to the next step. This might never happen, e.g. when streaming an infinite resource such as Web radio, or if the resource is longer than the user agent's ability to cache data.
While the user agent might still need network access щоб отримати parts of the media resource, the user agent must remain on this step.
For example, if the user agent has discarded the
first half of a video, the user agent will remain at this step even
once the playback
has ended, because there is always the chance the user will
seek back to the start. In fact, in this situation, once playback has ended, the user agent will
end up firing a suspend
event, as described earlier.
Якщо the user agent ever reaches this step (which can only happen if the entire resource gets loaded and kept available): abort the overall resource selection algorithm.
When a media element is to forget
the media element's media-resource-specific tracks, the user
agent must remove from the media element's
list of text tracks all the media-resource-specific
text tracks, then empty the media
element's audioTracks
attribute's AudioTrackList
object, then empty the media element's videoTracks
attribute's VideoTrackList
object. No events (in particular, no removetrack
events) are
fired as part of this; the error
and emptied
events, fired by the
algorithms that invoke this one, can be used instead.
The preload
attribute is an enumerated attribute.
The following table lists the keywords and states for the attribute — the
keywords in the left column map to the states in the cell in the second
column on the same row as the keyword. The attribute can be changed even
once the media resource is being buffered
or played; the descriptions in the table below are to be interpreted with
that in mind.
Keyword | State | Brief description |
---|---|---|
none
|
None | Hints to the user agent that either the author does not expect the user to need the media resource, or that the server wants to minimize unnecessary traffic. This state does not provide a hint regarding how aggressively to actually download the media resource if buffering starts anyway (e.g. once the user hits "play"). |
metadata
|
Metadata | Hints to the user agent that the author does not expect the user
to need the media resource, but that fetching the resource metadata
(dimensions, track list, duration, etc) та maybe even the first few
frames, is reasonable. Якщо the user agent precisely fetches no more
than the metadata, then the media element
will end up with its readyState attribute set
to HAVE_METADATA ;
typically though, some frames will be obtained as well and it will
probably be HAVE_CURRENT_DATA
or HAVE_FUTURE_DATA .
When the media resource is playing, hints to the user agent that
bandwidth is to be considered scarce, e.g. suggesting throttling the
download so that the media data is obtained at the slowest possible
rate that still maintains consistent playback. |
auto
|
Automatic | Hints to the user agent that the user agent can put the user's needs first without risk to the server, up to and including optimistically downloading the entire resource. |
The empty string is also a valid keyword та maps to the Automatic state. The attribute's missing value default is user-agent defined, though the Metadata state is suggested as a compromise between reducing server load and providing an optimal user experience.
Authors might switch the attribute from "none
" or "metadata
" to "auto
" dynamically once the
user begins playback. For example, on a page with many videos this might
be used to indicate that the many videos are not to be downloaded unless
requested, but that once one is requested it is to be downloaded
aggressively.
The preload
attribute is intended to provide a hint to the user agent about what the
author thinks will lead to the best user experience. The attribute may
be ignored altogether, for example based on explicit user preferences or
based on the available connectivity.
The preload
IDL attribute must reflect the content attribute
of the same name, limited to
only known values.
The autoplay
attribute can override the preload
attribute (since if the
media plays, it naturally has to buffer first, regardless of the hint
given by the preload
attribute). Including both is not an error, however.
buffered
Returns a TimeRanges
object
that represents the ranges of the media
resource that the user agent has buffered.
The buffered
attribute must return a new static normalized
TimeRanges
object that represents the ranges of the media resource, if any, that the user agent
has buffered, at the time the attribute is evaluated. Users agents must
accurately determine the ranges available, even for media streams where
this can only be determined by tedious inspection.
Typically this will be a single range anchored at the zero point, but if, e.g. the user agent uses HTTP range requests in response to seeking, then there could be multiple ranges.
User agents may discard previously buffered data.
Thus, a time position included within a range of the
objects return by the buffered
attribute at one time can end up being not included in the range(s) of
objects returned by the same attribute at later times.
duration
Returns the length of the media resource, in seconds, assuming that the start of the media resource is at time zero.
Returns NaN if the duration isn't available.
Returns Infinity for unbounded streams.
currentTime
[ = value
]Returns the official playback position, in seconds.
Can be set, to seek to the given time.
Will throw an InvalidStateError
exception if there is no selected media
resource or if there is a current
media controller.
A media resource has a media timeline that maps times (in seconds) to positions in the media resource. The origin of a timeline is its earliest defined position. The duration of a timeline is its last defined position.
Establishing
the media timeline: Якщо the media
resource somehow specifies an explicit timeline whose origin is
not negative (i.e. gives each frame a specific time offset and gives the
first frame a zero or positive offset), then the media
timeline should be that timeline. (Whether the media
resource can specify a timeline or not depends on the media resource's format.) Якщо the media
resource specifies an explicit start time and date, then
that time and date should be considered the zero point in the media
timeline; the timeline offset will
be the time and date, exposed using the getStartDate()
method.
Якщо the media resource has a discontinuous timeline, the user agent must extend the timeline used at the start of the resource across the entire resource, so that the media timeline of the media resource increases linearly starting from the earliest possible position (as defined below), even if the underlying media data has out-of-order or even overlapping time codes.
For example, if two clips have been concatenated into one video file, but the video format exposes the original times for the two clips, the video data might expose a timeline that goes, say, 00:15..00:29 and then 00:05..00:38. However, the user agent would not expose those times; it would instead expose the times as 00:15..00:29 and 00:29..01:02, as a single video.
In the rare case of a media resource
that does not have an explicit timeline, the zero time on the media
timeline should correspond to the first frame of the media
resource. In the even rarer case of a media
resource with no explicit timings of any kind, not even frame
durations, the user agent must itself determine the time for each frame
in a user-agent-defined manner.
An example of a file format with no explicit timeline but
with explicit frame durations is the Animated GIF format. An example of
a file format with no explicit timings at all is the JPEG-push format (multipart/x-mixed-replace
with JPEG frames, often used as the format for MJPEG streams).
Якщо, in the case of a resource with no timing information, the user agent will nonetheless be able to seek to an earlier point than the first frame originally provided by the server, then the zero time should correspond to the earliest seekable time of the media resource; otherwise, it should correspond to the first frame received from the server (the point in the media resource at which the user agent began receiving the stream).
At the time of writing, there is no known format that lacks explicit frame time offsets yet still supports seeking to a frame before the first frame sent by the server.
Consider a stream from a TV broadcaster, which begins streaming on a
sunny Friday afternoon in October та always sends connecting user
agents the media data on the same media timeline, with its zero time
set to the start of this stream. Months later, user agents connecting
to this stream will find that the first frame they receive has a time
with millions of seconds. The getStartDate()
method
would always return the date that the broadcast started; this would
allow controllers to display real times in their scrubber (e.g.
"2:30pm") rather than a time relative to when the broadcast began ("8
months, 4 hours, 12 minutes та 23 seconds").
Consider a stream that carries a video with several concatenated
fragments, broadcast by a server that does not allow user agents to
request specific times but instead just streams the video data in a
predetermined order, with the first frame delivered always being
identified as the frame with time zero. Якщо a user agent connects to
this stream and receives fragments defined as covering timestamps
2010-03-20 23:15:00 UTC to 2010-03-21 00:05:00 UTC and 2010-02-12
14:25:00 UTC to 2010-02-12 14:35:00 UTC, it would expose this with a media timeline starting at 0s and
extending to 3,600s (one hour). Assuming the streaming server
disconnected at the end of the second clip, the duration
attribute would
then return 3,600. The getStartDate()
method
would return a Date
object with a time corresponding to
2010-03-20 23:15:00 UTC. However, if a different user agent connected
five minutes later, it would (presumably) receive fragments
covering timestamps 2010-03-20 23:20:00 UTC to 2010-03-21 00:05:00 UTC
and 2010-02-12 14:25:00 UTC to 2010-02-12 14:35:00 UTC та would expose
this with a media timeline starting at
0s and extending to 3,300s (fifty five minutes). In this case, the getStartDate()
method would return a Date
object with a time
corresponding to 2010-03-20 23:20:00 UTC.
In both of these examples, the seekable
attribute would
give the ranges that the controller would want to actually display in
its UI; typically, if the servers don't support seeking to arbitrary
times, this would be the range of time from the moment the user agent
connected to the stream up to the latest frame that the user agent has
obtained; however, if the user agent starts discarding earlier
information, the actual range might be shorter.
In any case, the user agent must ensure that the earliest possible position (as defined below) using the established media timeline, is greater than or equal to zero.
The media timeline also has an associated clock. Which clock is used is user-agent defined та may be media resource-dependent, but it should approximate the user's wall clock.
All the media elements that share current media controller use the same clock for their media timeline.
Media elements have a current playback position, which must initially (i.e. in the absence of media data) be zero seconds. The current playback position is a time on the media timeline.
Media elements also have an official playback position, which must initially be set to zero seconds. The official playback position is an approximation of the current playback position that is kept stable while scripts are running.
Media elements also have a default playback start position, which must initially be set to zero seconds. This time is used to allow the element to be seeked even before the media is loaded.
Each media element has a show
poster flag. When a media element
is created, this flag must be set to true. This flag is used to control
when the user agent is to show a poster frame for a video
element instead of showing the video contents.
The currentTime
attribute must, on getting, return the media
element's default
playback start position, unless that is zero, in which case it
must return the element's official
playback position. The returned value must be expressed in
seconds. On setting, if the media element
has a current media controller,
then the user agent must throw an InvalidStateError
exception; otherwise, if the media element's
readyState
is HAVE_NOTHING
,
then it must set the media element's default
playback start position to the new value; otherwise, it must set
the official playback position
to the new value and then seek
to the new value. The new value must be interpreted as being in seconds.
Media elements have an initial playback position, which must initially (i.e. in the absence of media data) be zero seconds. The initial playback position is updated when a media resource is loaded. The initial playback position is a time on the media timeline.
Якщо the media resource is a streaming resource, then the user agent might be unable щоб отримати certain parts of the resource after it has expired from its buffer. Similarly, some media resources might have a media timeline that doesn't start at zero. The earliest possible position is the earliest position in the stream or resource that the user agent can ever obtain again. It is also a time on the media timeline.
The earliest
possible position is not explicitly exposed in the API; it
corresponds to the start time of the first range in the seekable
attribute's TimeRanges
object, if any, or the current playback position
otherwise.
When the earliest possible
position changes, then: if the current
playback position is before the earliest
possible position, the user agent must seek to the earliest
possible position; otherwise, if the user agent has not fired a timeupdate
event at the element in the past 15 to 250ms and is not still running
event handlers for such an event, then the user agent must queue
a task to fire a simple event
named timeupdate
at the element.
Because of the above requirement and the requirement in the resource fetch algorithm that kicks in when the metadata of the clip becomes known, the current playback position can never be less than the earliest possible position.
Якщо at any time the user agent learns that an audio or video track has
ended and all media data relating to that
track corresponds to parts of the media
timeline що є before the earliest
possible position, the user agent may queue
a task to first remove the track from the audioTracks
attribute's AudioTrackList
object or the videoTracks
attribute's VideoTrackList
object as appropriate and then fire a trusted event with the name removetrack
,
that does not bubble and is not cancelable та that uses the TrackEvent
interface, with the track
attribute initialized to the AudioTrack
or VideoTrack
object
representing the track, at the media element's
aforementioned AudioTrackList
or VideoTrackList
object.
The duration
attribute must return the time of the end of the media
resource, in seconds, on the media
timeline. Якщо no media data is
available, then the attributes must return the Not-a-Number (NaN) value.
Якщо the media resource is not known to
be bounded (e.g. streaming radio, or a live event with no announced end
time), then the attribute must return the positive Infinity value.
The user agent must determine the duration of the media
resource before playing any part of the media
data and before setting readyState
to a value equal
to or greater than HAVE_METADATA
, even if
doing so requires fetching multiple parts of the resource.
When the length of the media
resource changes to a known value (e.g. from being unknown to
known, or from a previously established length to a new length) the user
agent must queue a task to fire
a simple event named durationchange
at the
media element. (The event is not fired when
the duration is reset as part of loading a new media resource.) Якщо the
duration is changed such that the current
playback position ends up being greater than the time of the end
of the media resource, then the user
agent must also seek
to the time of the end of the media resource.
Якщо an "infinite" stream ends for some reason, then
the duration would change from positive Infinity to the time of the last
frame or sample in the stream та the durationchange
event
would be fired. Similarly, if the user agent initially estimated the media resource's duration instead of
determining it precisely та later revises the estimate based on new
information, then the duration would change and the durationchange
event
would be fired.
Some video files also have an explicit date and time corresponding to the zero time in the media timeline, known as the timeline offset. Initially, the timeline offset must be set to Not-a-Number (NaN).
The getStartDate()
method must return a
new Date
object representing the current timeline
offset.
The loop
attribute is a boolean attribute that,
if specified, indicates that the media element
is to seek back to the start of the media
resource upon reaching the end.
The loop
attribute has no effect while the element has a current
media controller.
The loop
IDL attribute must reflect the content attribute
of the same name.
readyState
Returns a value that expresses the current state of the element with respect to rendering the current playback position, from the codes in the list below.
Media elements have a ready state, which describes to what degree they are ready to be rendered at the current playback position. The possible values наступні; the ready state of a media element at any particular time is the greatest value describing the state of the element:
HAVE_NOTHING
(numeric value 0)No information regarding the media
resource is available. No data for the current
playback position is available. Media elements whose networkState
attribute
are set to NETWORK_EMPTY
are always in the HAVE_NOTHING
state.
HAVE_METADATA
(numeric value 1)Enough of the resource has been obtained that the duration of the
resource is available. In the case of a video
element, the dimensions of the video are also available. The API will
no longer throw an exception when seeking. No media
data is available for the immediate current
playback position.
HAVE_CURRENT_DATA
(numeric value 2)Data for the immediate current
playback position is available, but either not enough data is
available that the user agent could successfully advance the current
playback position in the direction
of playback at all without immediately reverting to the HAVE_METADATA
state, or
there is no more data щоб отримати in the direction
of playback. For example, in video this corresponds to the user
agent having data from the current frame, but not the next frame, when
the current playback position
is at the end of the current frame; and to when playback has ended.
HAVE_FUTURE_DATA
(numeric value 3)Data for the immediate current
playback position is available, as well as enough data for the
user agent to advance the current
playback position in the direction
of playback at least a little without immediately reverting to
the HAVE_METADATA
state та the text tracks are
ready. For example, in video this corresponds to the user agent
having data for at least the current frame and the next frame when the
current playback position is
at the instant in time between the two frames, or to the user agent
having the video data for the current frame and audio data to keep
playing at least a little when the current
playback position is in the middle of a frame. The user agent
cannot be in this state if playback
has ended, as the current
playback position can never advance in this case.
HAVE_ENOUGH_DATA
(numeric value 4)All the conditions described for the HAVE_FUTURE_DATA
state are met та, in addition, either of the following conditions is
also true:
In practice, the difference between HAVE_METADATA
and HAVE_CURRENT_DATA
is
negligible. Really the only time the difference is relevant is when
painting a video
element
onto a canvas
, where it
distinguishes the case where something will be drawn (HAVE_CURRENT_DATA
or
greater) from the case where nothing is drawn (HAVE_METADATA
or less).
Similarly, the difference between HAVE_CURRENT_DATA
(only
the current frame) and HAVE_FUTURE_DATA
(at
least this frame and the next) can be negligible (in the extreme, only one
frame). The only time that distinction really matters is when a page
provides an interface for "frame-by-frame" navigation.
When the ready state of a media element
whose networkState
is not NETWORK_EMPTY
changes, the user agent must follow the steps given below:
Apply the first applicable set of substeps from the following list:
HAVE_NOTHING
та the new ready state is HAVE_METADATA
Queue a task to fire
a simple event named loadedmetadata
at the element.
Before this task is run, as part of the event
loop mechanism, the rendering will have been updated to
resize the video
element if appropriate.
HAVE_METADATA
and
the new ready state is HAVE_CURRENT_DATA
or greaterЯкщо this is the first time this occurs
for this media element since the load()
algorithm was last invoked, the user agent must queue
a task to fire a simple
event named loadeddata
at the
element.
Якщо the new ready state is HAVE_FUTURE_DATA
or HAVE_ENOUGH_DATA
,
then the relevant steps below must then be run also.
HAVE_FUTURE_DATA
or more та the new ready state is HAVE_CURRENT_DATA
or lessЯкщо the media
element was potentially
playing before its readyState
attribute
changed to a value lower than HAVE_FUTURE_DATA
та the element has not ended playback
та playback has not stopped
due to errors, paused
for user interaction, or paused
for in-band content, the user agent must queue
a task to fire a simple
event named timeupdate
at the
element та queue a task to fire
a simple event named waiting
at the
element.
HAVE_CURRENT_DATA
or less та the new ready state is HAVE_FUTURE_DATA
The user agent must queue a task
to fire a simple event named
canplay
at the element.
Якщо the element's paused
attribute is
false, the user agent must queue a task
to fire a simple event named
playing
at the element.
HAVE_ENOUGH_DATA
Якщо the previous ready state was HAVE_CURRENT_DATA
or less, the user agent must queue a
task to fire a simple
event named canplay
at the
element та, if the element's paused
attribute is
false, queue a task to fire
a simple event named playing
at the
element.
Якщо the autoplaying flag є
true та the paused
attribute є true та the media element
has an autoplay
attribute specified та the media
element's Document
's
active sandboxing flag set
does not have the sandboxed
automatic features browsing context flag set, then the
user agent may also run the following substeps:
paused
attribute to false.play
at the element.playing
at the
element.User agents do not need to support autoplay та it
is suggested that user agents honor user preferences on the
matter. Authors are urged to use the autoplay
attribute
rather than using script to force the video to play, so as to
allow the user to override the behavior if so desired.
In any case, the user agent must finally queue
a task to fire a simple
event named canplaythrough
at the element.
Якщо the media element has a current media controller, then report the controller state for the media element's current media controller.
It is possible for the ready state of a media element to
jump between these states discontinuously. For example, the state of a
media element can jump straight from HAVE_METADATA
to HAVE_ENOUGH_DATA
without
passing through the HAVE_CURRENT_DATA
and HAVE_FUTURE_DATA
states.
The readyState
IDL attribute must, on getting, return the value described above that
describes the current ready state of the media
element.
The autoplay
attribute is a boolean attribute. When
present, the user agent (as described in the algorithm
described herein) will automatically begin playback of the media
resource as soon as it can do so without stopping.
Authors are urged to use the autoplay
attribute rather than
using script to trigger automatic playback, as this allows the user to
override the automatic playback when it is not desired, e.g. when using a
screen reader. Authors are also encouraged to consider not using the
automatic playback behavior at all та instead to let the user agent wait
for the user to start playback explicitly.
The autoplay
IDL attribute must reflect the content attribute
of the same name.
paused
Returns true if playback is paused; false otherwise.
ended
Returns true if playback has reached the end of the media resource.
defaultPlaybackRate
[ = value ]Returns the default rate of playback, for when the user is not fast-forwarding or reversing through the media resource.
Can be set, to change the default rate of playback.
The default rate has no direct effect on playback, but if the user switches to a fast-forward mode, when they return to the normal playback mode, it is expected that the rate of playback will be returned to the default rate of playback.
When the element has a current
media controller, the defaultPlaybackRate
attribute is ignored and the current
media controller's defaultPlaybackRate
is used instead.
playbackRate
[ = value
]Returns the current rate playback, where 1.0 is normal speed.
Can be set, to change the rate of playback.
When the element has a current
media controller, the playbackRate
attribute
is ignored and the current media
controller's playbackRate
is used instead.
played
Returns a TimeRanges
object
that represents the ranges of the media
resource that the user agent has played.
play
()Sets the paused
attribute to false, loading the media
resource and beginning playback if necessary. Якщо the playback
had ended, will restart it from the start.
pause
()Sets the paused
attribute to true, loading the media
resource if necessary.
The paused
attribute represents whether the media element
is paused or not. The attribute must initially be true.
A media element is a blocked
media element if its readyState
attribute is in
the HAVE_NOTHING
state, the HAVE_METADATA
state, or the HAVE_CURRENT_DATA
state, or if the element has paused
for user interaction or paused
for in-band content.
A media element is said to be potentially
playing when its paused
attribute is false, the element has not ended
playback, playback has not stopped
due to errors, the element either has no current
media controller or has a current
media controller but is not blocked
on its media controller та the element is not a blocked
media element.
A waiting
DOM event can be fired as a
result of an element that is potentially
playing stopping playback due to its readyState
attribute
changing to a value lower than HAVE_FUTURE_DATA
.
A media element is said to have ended playback when:
readyState
attribute is HAVE_METADATA
or greater та Either:
loop
attribute specified, or the media
element has a current
media controller. Or:
The ended
attribute must return true if, the last time the event
loop reached step 1, the media element
had ended playback and the direction
of playback was forwards та false otherwise.
A media element is said to have stopped
due to errors when the element's readyState
attribute is HAVE_METADATA
or greater та the user agent encounters
a non-fatal error during the processing of the media
data та due to that error, is not able to play the content at the
current playback position.
A media element is said to have paused
for user interaction when its paused
attribute is false, the readyState
attribute is either HAVE_FUTURE_DATA
or HAVE_ENOUGH_DATA
and the user agent has reached a point in the media
resource where the user has to make a selection for the resource
to continue. Якщо the media element has a
current media controller when
this happens, then the user agent must report
the controller state for the media
element's current media
controller. Якщо the media element
has a current media controller
when the user makes a selection, allowing playback to resume, the user
agent must similarly report the
controller state for the media element's
current media controller.
It is possible for a media element to have both ended playback and paused for user interaction at the same time.
When a media element that is potentially
playing stops playing because it has paused
for user interaction, the user agent must queue
a task to fire a simple event
named timeupdate
at the element.
A media element is said to have paused
for in-band content when its paused
attribute is false, the readyState
attribute is either HAVE_FUTURE_DATA
or HAVE_ENOUGH_DATA
and the user agent has suspended playback of the media
resource in order to play content that is temporally anchored to
the media resource and has a non-zero
length, or to play content that is temporally anchored to a segment of
the media resource but has a length
longer than that segment. Якщо the media
element has a current media
controller when this happens, then the user agent must report
the controller state for the media
element's current media
controller. Якщо the media element
has a current media controller
when the user agent unsuspends playback, the user agent must similarly report the controller state
for the media element's current
media controller.
One example of when a media element would be paused for in-band content is when the user agent is playing audio descriptions from an external WebVTT file та the synthesized speech generated for a cue is longer than the time between the text track cue start time and the text track cue end time.
When the current playback position reaches the end of the media resource when the direction of playback is forwards, then the user agent must follow these steps:
Якщо the media element has a loop
attribute specified and
does not have a current media
controller, then seek
to the earliest possible
position of the media resource
and abort these steps.
As defined above, the ended
IDL attribute starts
returning true once the event loop's
current task
ends.
Queue a task to fire
a simple event named timeupdate
at the media element.
Queue a task that, if the media
element does not have a current
media controller та the media
element has still ended playback
та the direction of playback
is still forwards та paused
is false, changes paused
to true and fires
a simple event named pause
at the media
element.
Queue a task to fire
a simple event named ended
at the media
element.
Якщо the media element has a current media controller, then report the controller state for the media element's current media controller.
When the current playback
position reaches the earliest
possible position of the media resource
when the direction of playback is
backwards, then the user agent must only queue
a task to fire a simple event
named timeupdate
at the element.
The defaultPlaybackRate
attribute gives the desired speed at which the media
resource is to play, as a multiple of its intrinsic speed. The
attribute is mutable: on getting it must return the last value it was
set to, or 1.0 if it hasn't yet been set; on setting the attribute must
be set to the new value.
The defaultPlaybackRate
is used by the user agent when it exposes a user interface
to the user.
The playbackRate
attribute gives the effective
playback rate (assuming there is no current
media controller overriding it), which is the speed at which the media resource plays, as a multiple of its
intrinsic speed. Якщо it is not equal to the defaultPlaybackRate
,
then the implication is that the user is using a feature such as fast
forward or slow motion playback. The attribute is mutable: on getting it
must return the last value it was set to, or 1.0 if it hasn't yet been
set; on setting the attribute must be set to the new value та the
playback will change speed (if the element is potentially
playing and there is no current
media controller).
When the defaultPlaybackRate
or playbackRate
attributes change value (either by being set by script or by being
changed directly by the user agent, e.g. in response to user control)
the user agent must queue a task to fire
a simple event named ratechange
at the media
element.
The defaultPlaybackRate
and playbackRate
attributes have no effect when the media
element has a current media
controller; the namesake attributes on the MediaController
object are used instead in that situation.
The played
attribute must return a new static normalized
TimeRanges
object that represents the ranges of
points on the media timeline of the media
resource reached through the usual monotonic increase of the current
playback position during normal playback, if any, at the time the
attribute is evaluated.
When the play()
method on a media element is invoked, the
user agent must run the following steps.
Якщо the media element's networkState
attribute
has the value NETWORK_EMPTY
,
invoke the media element's resource selection algorithm.
Якщо the playback has ended and the direction of playback is forwards та the media element does not have a current media controller, seek to the earliest possible position of the media resource.
This will cause the user
agent to queue a task to fire
a simple event named timeupdate
at the media element.
Якщо the media element has a current media controller, then bring the media element up to speed with its new media controller.
Якщо the media element's paused
attribute є true, run
the following substeps:
Change the value of paused
to false.
Якщо the show poster flag є true, set the element's show poster flag to false and run the time marches on steps.
Queue a task to fire
a simple event named play
at the element.
Якщо the media element's readyState
attribute
has the value HAVE_NOTHING
, HAVE_METADATA
,
or HAVE_CURRENT_DATA
,
queue a task to fire
a simple event named waiting
at the
element.
Інакше the media element's readyState
attribute has the value HAVE_FUTURE_DATA
or HAVE_ENOUGH_DATA
:
queue a task to fire
a simple event named playing
at the
element.
Set the media element's autoplaying flag to false.
Якщо the media element has a current media controller, then report the controller state for the media element's current media controller.
When the pause()
method is invoked та when the user agent is required to pause the media
element, the user agent must run the following steps:
Якщо the media element's networkState
attribute
has the value NETWORK_EMPTY
,
invoke the media element's resource selection algorithm.
Set the media element's autoplaying flag to false.
Якщо the media element's paused
attribute is false,
run the following steps:
Change the value of paused
to true.
Queue a task to fire
a simple event named timeupdate
at the
element.
Queue a task to fire
a simple event named pause
at the element.
Set the official playback position to the current playback position.
Якщо the media element has a current media controller, then report the controller state for the media element's current media controller.
The effective playback rate is
not necessarily the element's playbackRate
. When a media
element has a current media
controller, its effective
playback rate is the MediaController
's
media controller playback rate.
Інакше the effective playback rate
is just the element's playbackRate
. Thus, the current media controller
overrides the media element.
Якщо the effective playback rate is positive or zero, then the direction of playback is forwards. Інакше it is backwards.
When a media element
is potentially playing and its Document
is a fully
active Document
, its current
playback position must increase monotonically at effective
playback rate units of media time per unit time of the media
timeline's clock. (This specification always refers to this as an
increase, but that increase could actually be a decrease
if the effective playback rate
is negative.)
The effective playback
rate can be 0.0, in which case the current
playback position doesn't move, despite playback not being paused
(paused
doesn't become true та the pause
event doesn't fire).
This specification doesn't define how the user agent achieves the appropriate playback rate — depending on the protocol and media available, it is plausible that the user agent could negotiate with the server to have the server provide the media data at the appropriate rate, so that (except for the period between when the rate is changed and when the server updates the stream's playback rate) the client doesn't actually have to drop or interpolate any frames.
Any time the user agent provides a stable state, the official playback position must be set to the current playback position.
When the direction of playback is backwards, any corresponding audio must be muted. When the effective playback rate is so low or so high that the user agent cannot play audio usefully, the corresponding audio must also be muted. Якщо the effective playback rate is not 1.0, the user agent may apply pitch adjustments to the audio as necessary to render it faithfully.
Media
elements що є potentially playing
while not in a Document
must
not play any video, but should play any audio component. Media elements
must not stop playing just because all references to them have been
removed; only once a media element is in a state where no further audio
could ever be played by that element may the element be garbage
collected.
It is possible for an element to which no explicit references exist to play audio, even if such an element is not still actively playing: for instance, it could have a current media controller that still has references and can still be unpaused, or it could be unpaused but stalled waiting for content to buffer.
Each media element has a list of newly introduced cues, which must be initially empty. Whenever a text track cue is added to the list of cues of a text track that is in the list of text tracks for a media element, that cue must be added to the media element's list of newly introduced cues. Whenever a text track is added to the list of text tracks for a media element, all of the cues in that text track's list of cues must be added to the media element's list of newly introduced cues. When a media element's list of newly introduced cues has new cues added while the media element's show poster flag is not set, then the user agent must run the time marches on steps.
When a text track cue is removed from the list of cues of a text track that is in the list of text tracks for a media element та whenever a text track is removed from the list of text tracks of a media element, if the media element's show poster flag is not set, then the user agent must run the time marches on steps.
When the current playback position of a media element changes (e.g. due to playback or seeking), the user agent must run the time marches on steps. Якщо the current playback position changes while the steps are running, then the user agent must wait for the steps to complete та then must immediately rerun the steps. (These steps are thus run as often as possible or needed — if one iteration takes a long time, this can cause certain cues to be skipped over as the user agent rushes ahead to "catch up".)
The time marches on steps наступні:
Нехай current cues be a list of cues, initialized to contain all the cues of all the hidden or showing text tracks of the media element (not the disabled ones) whose start times are less than or equal to the current playback position and whose end times are greater than the current playback position.
Нехай other cues be a list of cues, initialized to contain all the cues of hidden and showing text tracks of the media element що є not present in current cues.
Нехай last time be the current playback position at the time this algorithm was last run for this media element, if this is not the first time it has run.
Якщо the current playback position has, since the last time this algorithm was run, only changed through its usual monotonic increase during normal playback, then let missed cues be the list of cues in other cues whose start times are greater than or equal to last time and whose end times are less than or equal to the current playback position. Інакше let missed cues be an empty list.
Remove all the cues in missed cues що є also in the media element's list of newly introduced cues та then empty the element's list of newly introduced cues.
Якщо the time was reached through the usual monotonic increase of
the current playback position
during normal playback та if the user agent has not fired a timeupdate
event at
the element in the past 15 to 250ms and is not still running event
handlers for such an event, then the user agent must queue
a task to fire a simple event
named timeupdate
at the element. (In the other cases, such as explicit seeks,
relevant events get fired as part of the overall process of changing
the current playback position.)
The event thus is not to be fired faster than about 66Hz or slower than 4Hz (assuming the event handlers don't take longer than 250ms to run). User agents are encouraged to vary the frequency of the event based on the system load and the average cost of processing the event each time, so that the UI updates are not any more frequent than the user agent can comfortably handle while decoding the video.
Якщо all of the cues in current cues have their text track cue active flag set, none of the cues in other cues have their text track cue active flag set та missed cues is empty, then abort these steps.
Якщо the time was reached through the usual monotonic increase of the current playback position during normal playback та there are cues in other cues that have their text track cue pause-on-exit flag set and that either have their text track cue active flag set or are also in missed cues, then immediately pause the media element.
In the other cases, such as explicit seeks, playback is not paused by going past the end time of a cue, even if that cue has its text track cue pause-on-exit flag set.
Нехай events be a list of tasks, initially empty. Each task in this list will be associated with a text track, a text track cue та a time, which are used to sort the list before the tasks are queued.
Нехай affected tracks be a list of text tracks, initially empty.
When the steps below say to prepare an event named event for a text track cue target with a time time, the user agent must виконати ці підкроки:
Нехай track be the text track with which the text track cue target is associated.
Create a task to fire a simple event named event at target.
Add the newly created task to events, associated with the time time, the text track track та the text track cue target.
Add track to affected tracks.
For each text
track cue in missed cues, prepare an event named enter
for the TextTrackCue
object with the text track cue
start time.
For each text
track cue in other cues that
either has its text track cue
active flag set or is in missed cues,
prepare an event named exit
for the TextTrackCue
object with the later of the text
track cue end time and the text
track cue start time.
For each text
track cue in current cues that
does not have its text track
cue active flag set, prepare an
event named enter
for the TextTrackCue
object with the text track cue
start time.
Sort the tasks in events in ascending time order (tasks with earlier times first).
Further sort tasks in events that have the same time by the relative text track cue order of the text track cues associated with these tasks.
Finally, sort tasks
in events that have the same time
and same text track cue order
by placing tasks
that fire enter
events
before those that fire exit
events.
Sort affected tracks in the same order as the text tracks appear in the media element's list of text tracks та remove duplicates.
For each text track in affected
tracks, in the list order, queue a
task to fire a simple event
named cuechange
at
the TextTrack
object та, if
the text track has a corresponding track
element, to then fire a simple event named cuechange
at the track
element
as well.
Set the text track cue active flag of all the cues in the current cues та unset the text track cue active flag of all the cues in the other cues.
Run the rules for updating the text track rendering of each of the text tracks in affected tracks що є showing. For example, for text tracks based on WebVTT, the rules for updating the display of WebVTT text tracks. [WEBVTT]
For the purposes of the algorithm above, a text track cue is considered to be part of a text track only if it is listed in the text track list of cues, not merely if it is associated with the text track.
Якщо the media element's Document
stops being a fully
active document, then the playback will stop
until the document is active again.
When a media element is removed from a Document
,
the user agent must run the following steps:
Asynchronously await a stable
state, allowing the task
that removed the media element from
the Document
to continue. The
synchronous section consists of
all the remaining steps of this algorithm. (Steps in the synchronous
section are marked with ⌛.)
⌛ Якщо the media element is in
a Document
, abort these steps.
⌛ Якщо the media element's networkState
attribute
has the value NETWORK_EMPTY
,
abort these steps.
⌛ Pause the media element.
seeking
Returns true if the user agent is currently seeking.
seekable
Returns a TimeRanges
object
that represents the ranges of the media
resource to which it is possible for the user agent to seek.
The seeking
attribute must initially have the value false.
When the user agent is required to seek to a particular new playback position in the media resource, optionally with the approximate-for-speed flag set, it means that the user agent must run the following steps. This algorithm interacts closely with the event loop mechanism; in particular, it has a synchronous section (which is triggered as part of the event loop algorithm). Steps in that section are marked with ⌛.
Set the media element's show poster flag to false.
Якщо the media element's readyState
is HAVE_NOTHING
, abort
these steps.
Якщо the element's seeking
IDL attribute є true, then another instance of this algorithm is
already running. Abort that other instance of the algorithm without
waiting for the step that it is running to complete.
Set the seeking
IDL attribute to true.
Якщо the seek was in response to a DOM method call or setting of an IDL attribute, then continue the script. The remainder of these steps must be run asynchronously. With the exception of the steps marked with ⌛, they could be aborted at any time by another instance of this algorithm being invoked.
Якщо the new playback position is later than the end of the media resource, then let it be the end of the media resource instead.
Якщо the new playback position is less than the earliest possible position, let it be thв позициї instead.
Якщо the (possibly now changed) new
playback position is not in one of the ranges given in the seekable
attribute, then let it be the position in one of the ranges given in
the seekable
attribute that is the nearest to the new
playback position. Якщо two positions both satisfy that
constraint (i.e. the new playback position
є точно in the middle between two ranges in the seekable
attribute) then
use the position that is closest to the current
playback position. Якщо there are no ranges given in the seekable
attribute then set the seeking
IDL attribute to
false and abort these steps.
Якщо the approximate-for-speed flag is set, adjust the new playback position to a value that will allow for playback to resume promptly. Якщо new playback position before this step is before current playback position, then the adjusted new playback position must also be before the current playback position. Similarly, if the new playback position before this step is after current playback position, then the adjusted new playback position must also be after the current playback position.
For example, the user agent could snap to the nearest key frame, so that it doesn't have to spend time decoding then discarding intermediate frames before resuming playback.
Queue a task to fire
a simple event named seeking
at the element.
Set the current playback position to the given new playback position.
Якщо the media element
was potentially playing
immediately before it started seeking, but seeking caused its readyState
attribute to change to a value lower than HAVE_FUTURE_DATA
,
then a waiting
will be fired at the
element.
The currentTime
attribute
does not get updated asynchronously, as it returns the official
playback position, not the current
playback position.
Wait until the user agent has established whether or not the media data for the new playback position is available та, if it is, until it has decoded enough data to play back thв позициї.
Await a stable state. The synchronous section consists of all the remaining steps of this algorithm. (Steps in the synchronous section are marked with ⌛.)
⌛ Set the seeking
IDL attribute to false.
⌛ Run the time marches on steps.
⌛ Queue a task to fire
a simple event named timeupdate
at the
element.
⌛ Queue a task to fire
a simple event named seeked
at the element.
The seekable
attribute must return a new static normalized
TimeRanges
object that represents the ranges of the media resource, if any, that the user agent
is able to seek to, at the time the attribute is evaluated.
Якщо the user agent can seek to anywhere in the media
resource, e.g. because it is a simple movie file and the user
agent and the server support HTTP Range requests, then the attribute
would return an object with one range, whose start is the time of the
first frame (the earliest
possible position, typically zero) та whose end is the same as the
time of the first frame plus the duration
attribute's value
(which would equal the time of the last frame та might be positive
Infinity).
The range might be continuously changing, e.g. if the user agent is buffering a sliding window on an infinite stream. This is the behavior seen with DVRs viewing live TV, for instance.
Media resources might be internally scripted or interactive. Thus, a media element could play in a non-linear fashion. Якщо this happens, the user agent must act as if the algorithm for seeking was used whenever the current playback position changes in a discontinuous fashion (so that the relevant events fire). Якщо the media element has a current media controller, then the user agent must seek the media controller appropriately instead.
A media resource can have multiple embedded audio and video tracks. For example, in addition to the primary video and audio tracks, a media resource could have foreign-language dubbed dialogues, director's commentaries, audio descriptions, alternative angles, or sign-language overlays.
audioTracks
Returns an AudioTrackList
object representing the audio tracks available in the media
resource.
videoTracks
Returns a VideoTrackList
object representing the video tracks available in the media
resource.
The audioTracks
attribute of a media element must return a
live AudioTrackList
object representing the audio tracks available in the media
element's media resource. The same
object must be returned each time.
The videoTracks
attribute of a media element must return a
live VideoTrackList
object representing the video tracks available in the media
element's media resource. The same
object must be returned each time.
There are only ever one AudioTrackList
object and one VideoTrackList
object per media element, even if another
media resource is loaded into the element:
the objects are reused. (The AudioTrack
and VideoTrack
objects are not,
though.)
In this example, a script defines a function that takes a URL to a video and a reference to an element where the video is to be placed. That function then tries to load the video та, once it is loaded, checks to see if there is a sign-language track available. Якщо there is, it also displays that track. Both tracks are just placed in the given container; it's assumed that styles have been applied to make this work in a pretty way!
<script> function loadVideo(url, container) { var controller = new MediaController(); var video = document.createElement('video'); video.src = url; video.autoplay = true; video.controls = true; video.controller = controller; container.appendChild(video); video.onloadedmetadata = function (event) { for (var i = 0; i < video.videoTracks.length; i += 1) { if (video.videoTracks[i].kind == 'sign') { var sign = document.createElement('video'); sign.src = url + '#track=' + video.videoTracks[i].id; sign.autoplay = true; sign.controller = controller; container.appendChild(sign); return; } } }; } </script>
AudioTrackList
and VideoTrackList
objectsThe AudioTrackList
and VideoTrackList
interfaces are used
by attributes defined in the previous section.
interface AudioTrackList : EventTarget { readonly attribute unsigned long length; getter AudioTrack (unsigned long index); AudioTrack? getTrackById(DOMString id); attribute EventHandler onchange; attribute EventHandler onaddtrack; attribute EventHandler onremovetrack; }; interface AudioTrack { readonly attribute DOMString id; readonly attribute DOMString kind; readonly attribute DOMString label; readonly attribute DOMString language; attribute boolean enabled; }; interface VideoTrackList : EventTarget { readonly attribute unsigned long length; getter VideoTrack (unsigned long index); VideoTrack? getTrackById(DOMString id); readonly attribute long selectedIndex; attribute EventHandler onchange; attribute EventHandler onaddtrack; attribute EventHandler onremovetrack; }; interface VideoTrack { readonly attribute DOMString id; readonly attribute DOMString kind; readonly attribute DOMString label; readonly attribute DOMString language; attribute boolean selected; };
audioTracks
. length
videoTracks
. length
Returns the number of tracks in the list.
audioTracks
[index]videoTracks
[index]Returns the specified AudioTrack
or VideoTrack
object.
audioTracks
. getTrackById
(
id )videoTracks
. getTrackById
(
id )Returns the AudioTrack
or VideoTrack
object with the given
identifier, or null if no track has that identifier.
id
id
Returns the ID of the given track. This is the ID that can be used
with a fragment identifier if the format supports the Media
Fragments URI syntax та that can be used with the getTrackById()
method. [MEDIAFRAG]
kind
kind
Returns the category the given track falls into. The possible track categories are given below.
label
label
Returns the label of the given track, if known, or the empty string otherwise.
language
language
Returns the language of the given track, if known, or the empty string otherwise.
enabled
[ = value
]Returns true if the given track is active та false otherwise.
Can be set, to change whether the track is enabled or not. Якщо multiple audio tracks are enabled simultaneously, they are mixed.
videoTracks
. selectedIndex
Returns the index of the currently selected track, if any, or −1 otherwise.
selected
[ = value
]Returns true if the given track is active та false otherwise.
Can be set, to change whether the track is selected or not. Either zero or one video track is selected; selecting a new track while a previous one is selected will unselect the previous one.
An AudioTrackList
object
represents a dynamic list of zero or more audio tracks, of which zero or
more can be enabled at a time. Each audio track is represented by an AudioTrack
object.
A VideoTrackList
object
represents a dynamic list of zero or more video tracks, of which zero or
one can be selected at a time. Each video track is represented by a VideoTrack
object.
Tracks in AudioTrackList
and VideoTrackList
objects
must be consistently ordered. Якщо the media
resource is in a format that defines an order, then that order
must be used; otherwise, the order must be the relative order in which
the tracks are declared in the media resource.
The order used is called the natural order of the list.
Each track in a TrackList
thus has an index;
the first has the index 0 та each subsequent track is numbered one
higher than the previous one. Якщо a media
resource dynamically adds or removes audio or video tracks, then
the indices of the tracks will change dynamically. Якщо the media
resource changes entirely, then all the previous tracks will be
removed and replaced with new tracks.
The AudioTrackList.length
and VideoTrackList.length
attributes must return the number of tracks represented by their objects
at the time of getting.
The supported property indices
of AudioTrackList
and VideoTrackList
objects at any
instant are the numbers from zero to the number of tracks represented by
the respective object minus one, if any tracks are represented. Якщо an
AudioTrackList
or VideoTrackList
object represents no tracks, it has no supported
property indices.
To determine the
value of an indexed property for a given index index
in an AudioTrackList
or VideoTrackList
object list,
the user agent must return the AudioTrack
or VideoTrack
object that
represents the indexth track in list.
The AudioTrackList.getTrackById(id)
and VideoTrackList.getTrackById(id)
methods must return the
first AudioTrack
or VideoTrack
object (respectively) in the AudioTrackList
or VideoTrackList
object
(respectively) whose identifier is equal to the value of the id
argument (in the natural order of the list, as defined above). When no
tracks match the given argument, the methods must return null.
The AudioTrack
and VideoTrack
objects represent specific tracks of a media
resource. Each track can have an identifier, category, label та
language. These aspects of a track are permanent for the lifetime of the
track; even if a track is removed from a media
resource's AudioTrackList
or VideoTrackList
objects,
those aspects do not change.
In addition, AudioTrack
objects
can each be enabled or disabled; this is the audio track's enabled
state. When an AudioTrack
is created, its enabled state must be set to false (disabled).
The resource
fetch algorithm can override this.
Similarly, a single VideoTrack
object per VideoTrackList
object can be selected, this is the video track's selection state.
When a VideoTrack
is created,
its selection state must be set to false (not selected). The resource
fetch algorithm can override this.
The AudioTrack.id
and VideoTrack.id
attributes must return the identifier of the track, if it has one, or
the empty string otherwise. Якщо the media
resource is in a format that supports the Media Fragments
URI fragment identifier syntax, the identifier returned for a
particular track must be the same identifier that would enable the track
if used as the name of a track in the track dimension of such a fragment
identifier. [MEDIAFRAG]
For example, in Ogg files, this would be the Name header field of the track. [OGGSKELETONHEADERS]
The AudioTrack.kind
and VideoTrack.kind
attributes must return the category of the track, if it has one, or the
empty string otherwise.
The category of a track is the string given in the first column of the
table below that is the most appropriate for the track based on the
definitions in the table's second and third columns, as determined by
the metadata included in the track in the media
resource. The cell in the third column of a row says what the
category given in the cell in the first column of that row applies to; a
category is only appropriate for an audio track if it applies to audio
tracks та a category is only appropriate for video tracks if it applies
to video tracks. Categories must only be returned for AudioTrack
objects if they are appropriate for audio та must only be returned for VideoTrack
objects if they are
appropriate for video.
Category | Definition | Applies to... |
---|---|---|
"alternative "
|
A possible alternative to the main track, e.g. a different take of a song (audio), or a different angle (video). | Audio and video. |
"captions "
|
A version of the main video track with captions burnt in. (For legacy content; new content would use text tracks.) | Video only. |
"descriptions "
|
An audio description of a video track. | Audio only. |
"main "
|
The primary audio or video track. | Audio and video. |
"main-desc "
|
The primary audio track, mixed with audio descriptions. | Audio only. |
"sign "
|
A sign-language interpretation of an audio track. | Video only. |
"subtitles "
|
A version of the main video track with subtitles burnt in. (For legacy content; new content would use text tracks.) | Video only. |
"translation "
|
A translated version of the main audio track. | Audio only. |
"commentary "
|
Commentary on the primary audio or video track, e.g. a director's commentary. | Audio and video. |
" "
(empty string) |
No explicit kind, or the kind given by the track's metadata is not recognised by the user agent. | Audio and video. |
The AudioTrack.label
and VideoTrack.label
attributes must return the label of the track, if it has one, or the
empty string otherwise.
The AudioTrack.language
and VideoTrack.language
attributes must return the BCP 47 language tag of the language of the
track, if it has one, or the empty string otherwise. Якщо the user agent
is not able to express that language as a BCP 47 language tag (for
example because the language information in the media
resource's format is a free-form string without a defined
interpretation), then the method must return the empty string, as if the
track had no language.
Source attribute values for id, kind, label and language of multitrack audio and video tracks as described for the relevant media resource format. [INBANDTRACKS]
The AudioTrack.enabled
attribute, on getting, must return true if the track is currently
enabled та false otherwise. On setting, it must enable the track if the
new value є true та disable it otherwise. (Якщо the track is no longer
in an AudioTrackList
object,
then the track being enabled or disabled has no effect beyond changing
the value of the attribute on the AudioTrack
object.)
Whenever an audio track in an AudioTrackList
is enabled or disabled, the user agent must queue
a task to fire a simple event
named change
at the AudioTrackList
object.
The VideoTrackList.selectedIndex
attribute must return the index of the currently selected track, if any.
Якщо the VideoTrackList
object does not currently represent any tracks, or if none of the tracks
are selected, it must instead return −1.
The VideoTrack.selected
attribute, on getting, must return true if the track is currently
selected та false otherwise. On setting, it must select the track if the
new value є true та unselect it otherwise. Якщо the track is in a VideoTrackList
, then all the other
VideoTrack
objects in that list
must be unselected. (Якщо the track is no longer in a VideoTrackList
object, then the track being selected or unselected has no effect beyond
changing the value of the attribute on the VideoTrack
object.)
Whenever a track in a VideoTrackList
that was previously not selected is selected, the user agent must queue
a task to fire a simple event
named change
at the VideoTrackList
object. This task
must be queued
before the task
that fires the resize
event, if any.
The following are the event handlers
(and their corresponding event handler event types)
that must be supported, as event
handler IDL attributes, by all objects implementing the AudioTrackList
and VideoTrackList
interfaces:
Event handler | Event handler event type |
---|---|
onchange
|
change
|
onaddtrack
|
addtrack
|
onremovetrack
|
removetrack
|
The task source for the tasks listed in this section is the DOM manipulation task source.
The audioTracks
and videoTracks
attributes allow scripts to select which track should play, but it is also
possible to select specific tracks declaratively, by specifying particular
tracks in the fragment identifier of the URL of the media
resource. The format of the fragment identifier depends on the MIME
type of the media resource. [RFC2046]
[URL]
In this example, a video that uses a format that supports the Media Fragments URI fragment identifier syntax is embedded in such a way that the alternative angles labeled "Alternative" are enabled instead of the default video track. [MEDIAFRAG]
<video src="myvideo#track=Alternative"></video>
Each media element can have a MediaController
.
A MediaController
is an
object that coordinates the playback of multiple media elements, for instance so that a
sign-language interpreter track can be overlaid on a video track, with the
two being kept in sync.
By default, a media element has no MediaController
. An implicit MediaController
can be assigned
using the mediagroup
content attribute. An explicit MediaController
can be assigned directly using the controller
IDL attribute.
Media elements
with a MediaController
are
said to be slaved to their controller. The MediaController
modifies the playback rate and the playback volume of each of the media elements slaved to it та ensures that
when any of its slaved media
elements unexpectedly stall, the others are stopped at the same
time.
When a media element is slaved to a MediaController
, its playback rate
is fixed to that of the other tracks in the same MediaController
та any looping is disabled.
enum MediaControllerPlaybackState { "waiting", "playing", "ended" }; [Constructor] interface MediaController : EventTarget { readonly attribute unsigned short readyState; // uses HTMLMediaElement.readyState's values readonly attribute TimeRanges buffered; readonly attribute TimeRanges seekable; readonly attribute unrestricted double duration; attribute double currentTime; readonly attribute boolean paused; readonly attribute MediaControllerPlaybackState playbackState; readonly attribute TimeRanges played; void pause(); void unpause(); void play(); // calls play() on all media elements as well attribute double defaultPlaybackRate; attribute double playbackRate; attribute double volume; attribute boolean muted; attribute EventHandler onemptied; attribute EventHandler onloadedmetadata; attribute EventHandler onloadeddata; attribute EventHandler oncanplay; attribute EventHandler oncanplaythrough; attribute EventHandler onplaying; attribute EventHandler onended; attribute EventHandler onwaiting; attribute EventHandler ondurationchange; attribute EventHandler ontimeupdate; attribute EventHandler onplay; attribute EventHandler onpause; attribute EventHandler onratechange; attribute EventHandler onvolumechange; };
MediaController
()Returns a new MediaController
object.
controller
[ = controller
]Returns the current MediaController
for the media element, if any; returns
null otherwise.
Can be set, to set an explicit MediaController
.
Doing so removes the mediagroup
attribute, if
any.
readyState
Returns the state that the MediaController
was in the last time it fired events as a result of reporting the controller state.
The values of this attribute are the same as for the readyState
attribute of media
elements.
buffered
Returns a TimeRanges
object
that represents the intersection of the time ranges for which the user
agent has all relevant media data for all the slaved media elements.
seekable
Returns a TimeRanges
object
that represents the intersection of the time ranges into which the
user agent can seek for all the slaved media elements.
duration
Returns the difference between the earliest playable moment and the latest playable moment (not considering whether the data in question is actually buffered or directly seekable, but not including time in the future for infinite streams). Will return zero if there is no media.
currentTime
[ = value ]Returns the current playback
position, in seconds, as a position between zero time and the
current duration
.
Can be set, to seek to the given time.
paused
Returns true if playback is paused; false otherwise. When this attribute є true, any media element slaved to this controller will be stopped.
playbackState
Returns the state that the MediaController
was in the last time it fired events as a result of reporting the controller state.
The value of this attribute is either "playing
",
indicating that the media is actively playing, "ended
", indicating
that the media is not playing because playback has reached the end of
all the slaved media elements,
or "waiting
",
indicating that the media is not playing for some other reason (e.g.
the MediaController
is
paused).
pause
()Sets the paused
attribute to true.
unpause
()Sets the paused
attribute to false.
play
()Sets the paused
attribute to false and invokes the play()
method of each slaved media element.
played
Returns a TimeRanges
object
that represents the union of the time ranges in all the slaved media elements that have been played.
defaultPlaybackRate
[ = value ]Returns the default rate of playback.
Can be set, to change the default rate of playback.
This default rate has no direct effect on playback, but if the user
switches to a fast-forward mode, when they return to the normal
playback mode, it is expected that rate of playback (playbackRate
)
will be returned to this default rate.
playbackRate
[ =
value ]Returns the current rate of playback.
Can be set, to change the rate of playback.
volume
[ = value
]Returns the current playback volume multiplier, as a number in the range 0.0 to 1.0, where 0.0 is the quietest and 1.0 the loudest.
Can be set, to change the volume multiplier.
Throws an IndexSizeError
exception if the new value is not in the range 0.0 .. 1.0.
muted
[ = value
]Returns true if all audio is muted (regardless of other attributes either on the controller or on any media elements slaved to this controller) та false otherwise.
Can be set, to change whether the audio is muted or not.
A media element can have a current
media controller, which is a MediaController
object. When a media element is created
without a mediagroup
attribute, it does not have a current
media controller. (Якщо it is created with such an
attribute, then that attribute initializes the current
media controller, as defined below.)
The slaved media elements of a MediaController
are the media elements whose current
media controller is that MediaController
.
All the slaved media elements of a
MediaController
must use the
same clock for their definition of their media
timeline's unit time. When the user agent is required to act on
each slaved media element in
turn, they must be processed in the order that they were last associated
with the MediaController
.
The controller
attribute on a media element, on getting,
must return the element's current
media controller, if any, or null otherwise. On setting, the user
agent must run the following steps:
Нехай m be the media element in question.
Нехай old controller be m's current media controller, if it currently has one та null otherwise.
Нехай new controller be null.
Нехай m have no current media controller, if it currently has one.
Remove the element's mediagroup
content
attribute, if any.
Якщо the new value is null, then jump to the update controllers step below.
Нехай m's current media controller be the new value.
Нехай new controller be m's current media controller.
Bring the media element up to speed with its new media controller.
Update controllers: Якщо old controller and new controller are the same (whether both null or both the same controller) then abort these steps.
Якщо old controller is not null and still has one or more slaved media elements, then report the controller state for old controller.
Якщо new controller is not null, then report the controller state for new controller.
The MediaController()
constructor, when invoked, must return a newly created MediaController
object.
The readyState
attribute must return the value to which it was most recently set. When
the MediaController
object
is created, the attribute must be set to the value 0 (HAVE_NOTHING
). The value
is updated by the report the
controller state algorithm below.
The seekable
attribute must return a new static normalized
TimeRanges
object that represents the intersection of
the ranges of the media
resources of the slaved media
elements that the user agent is able to seek to, at the time the
attribute is evaluated.
The buffered
attribute must return a new static normalized
TimeRanges
object that represents the intersection of
the ranges of the media
resources of the slaved media
elements that the user agent has buffered, at the time the
attribute is evaluated. Users agents must accurately determine the
ranges available, even for media streams where this can only be
determined by tedious inspection.
The duration
attribute must return the media
controller duration.
Every 15 to 250ms, or whenever the MediaController
's
media controller duration
changes, whichever happens least often, the user agent must queue
a task to fire a simple event
named durationchange
at the MediaController
.
Якщо the MediaController
's
media controller duration
decreases such that the media
controller position is greater than the media
controller duration, the user agent must immediately seek
the media controller to media
controller duration.
The currentTime
attribute must return the media
controller position on getting та on setting must seek
the media controller to the new value.
Every 15 to 250ms, or whenever the MediaController
's
media controller position
changes, whichever happens least often, the user agent must queue
a task to fire a simple event
named timeupdate
at the MediaController
.
When a MediaController
is
created it is a playing media
controller. It can be changed into a paused
media controller and back either via the user agent's user
interface (when the element is exposing a user interface
to the user) or by script using the APIs defined in this section
(see below).
The paused
attribute must return true if the MediaController
object is a paused media controller
та false otherwise.
When the pause()
method is invoked, if the MediaController
is a playing media controller
then the user agent must change the MediaController
into a paused media controller,
queue a task to fire
a simple event named pause
at the MediaController
та then report
the controller state of the MediaController
.
When the unpause()
method is invoked, if the MediaController
is a paused media controller,
the user agent must change the MediaController
into a playing media controller,
queue a task to fire
a simple event named play
at the MediaController
та then report
the controller state of the MediaController
.
When the play()
method is invoked, the user agent must invoke the play()
method of each slaved media element in turn та then
invoke the unpause
method of the MediaController
.
The playbackState
attribute must return the value to which it was most recently set. When
the MediaController
object
is created, the attribute must be set to the value "waiting
". The value
is updated by the report the
controller state algorithm below.
The played
attribute must return a new static normalized
TimeRanges
object that represents the union of the
ranges of points on the media
timelines of the media
resources of the slaved media
elements that the user agent has so far reached through the usual
monotonic increase of their current playback
positions during normal playback, at the time the attribute is
evaluated.
A MediaController
has a media controller default
playback rate and a media
controller playback rate, which must both be set to 1.0 when the
MediaController
object is
created.
The defaultPlaybackRate
attribute, on getting, must return the MediaController
's
media controller
default playback rate та on setting, must set the MediaController
's
media controller
default playback rate to the new value, then queue
a task to fire a simple event
named ratechange
at the MediaController
.
The playbackRate
attribute, on getting, must return the MediaController
's
media controller playback rate
та on setting, must set the MediaController
's
media controller playback rate
to the new value, then queue a task to fire a simple event named ratechange
at
the MediaController
.
A MediaController
has a media controller volume
multiplier, which must be set to 1.0 when the MediaController
object is created та a media
controller mute override, much must initially be false.
The volume
attribute, on getting, must return the MediaController
's
media controller volume
multiplier та on setting, if the new value is in the range 0.0 to
1.0 inclusive, must set the MediaController
's
media controller volume
multiplier to the new value and queue a
task to fire a simple event
named volumechange
at the MediaController
.
Якщо the new value is outside the range 0.0 to 1.0 inclusive, then, on
setting, an IndexSizeError
exception must be thrown instead.
The muted
attribute, on getting, must return the MediaController
's
media controller mute override
та on setting, must set the MediaController
's
media controller mute override
to the new value and queue a task to fire
a simple event named volumechange
at the MediaController
.
The media
resources of all the slaved
media elements of a MediaController
have a defined temporal relationship which provides relative offsets
between the zero time of each such media
resource: for media
resources with a timeline offset,
their relative offsets are the difference between their timeline
offset; the zero times of all the media resources without a timeline
offset are not offset from each other (i.e. the origins of their
timelines are cotemporal); and finally, the zero time of the media
resource with the earliest timeline
offset (if any) is not offset from the zero times of the media resources without a timeline
offset (i.e. the origins of media resources without a timeline
offset are further cotemporal with the earliest defined point on
the timeline of the media resource with
the earliest timeline offset).
The media resource end position of a media resource in a media element is defined as follows: if the media resource has a finite and known duration, the media resource end position is the duration of the media resource's timeline (the last defined position on that timeline); otherwise, the media resource's duration is infinite or unknown та the media resource end position is the time of the last frame of media data currently available for that media resource.
Each MediaController
also
has its own defined timeline. On this timeline, all the media resources of all the slaved
media elements of the MediaController
are temporally aligned according to their defined offsets. The media
controller duration of that MediaController
is the time from the earliest earliest
possible position, relative to this MediaController
timeline, of any of the media
resources of the slaved media
elements of the MediaController
,
to the time of the latest media
resource end position of the media resources of the slaved
media elements of the MediaController
,
again relative to this MediaController
timeline.
Each MediaController
has a
media controller position.
This is the time on the MediaController
's
timeline at which the user agent is trying to play the slaved
media elements. When a MediaController
is created, its media controller
position is initially zero.
When the user agent is to bring
a media element up to speed with its new media controller, it
must seek
that media element to the MediaController
's
media controller position
relative to the media element's timeline.
When the user agent is to seek the media controller to a particular new playback position, it must follow these steps:
Якщо the new playback position is less than zero, then set it to zero.
Якщо the new playback position is greater than the media controller duration, then set it to the media controller duration.
Set the media controller position to the new playback position.
Seek each slaved media element to the new playback position relative to the media element timeline.
A MediaController
is a restrained media controller if
the MediaController
is a playing media controller та none
of its slaved media elements are blocked
media elements, but either at least one of its slaved
media elements whose autoplaying flag
є true still has its paused
attribute set to true, or, all of its slaved
media elements have their paused
attribute set to true.
A MediaController
is a blocked media controller if the MediaController
is a paused
media controller, or if any of its slaved
media elements are blocked
media elements, or if any of its slaved
media elements whose autoplaying flag
є true still have their paused
attribute set to true, or if all of its slaved
media elements have their paused
attribute set to true.
A media element is blocked
on its media controller if the MediaController
is a blocked media controller,
or if its media controller
position is either before the media
resource's earliest
possible position relative to the MediaController
's
timeline or after the end of the media
resource relative to the MediaController
's
timeline.
When a MediaController
is not a blocked media controller
and it has at least one slaved
media element whose Document
is a fully active Document
,
the MediaController
's media
controller position must increase monotonically at media
controller playback rate units of time on the MediaController
's
timeline per unit time of the clock used by its slaved
media elements.
When the zero point on the timeline of a MediaController
moves relative to the timelines of the slaved
media elements by a time difference ΔT,
the MediaController
's media
controller position must be decremented by ΔT.
In some situations, e.g. when playing back a live stream without buffering anything, the media controller position would increase monotonically as described above at the same rate as the ΔT described in the previous paragraph decreases it, with the end result that for all intents and purposes, the media controller position would appear to remain constant (probably with the value 0).
A MediaController
has a most recently reported
readiness state, which is a number from 0 to 4 derived from the
numbers used for the media element readyState
attribute
та a most recently
reported playback state, which is either playing, waiting,
or ended.
When a MediaController
is
created, its most
recently reported readiness state must be set to 0 та its most
recently reported playback state must be set to waiting.
When a user agent is required to report
the controller state for a MediaController
,
the user agent must run the following steps:
Якщо the MediaController
has no slaved media elements,
let new readiness state be 0.
Інакше let it have the lowest value of the readyState
IDL
attributes of all of its slaved
media elements.
Якщо the MediaController
's
most recently
reported readiness state is less than the new
readiness state, тоді виконайте ці субкроки:
Нехай next state be the MediaController
's most
recently reported readiness state.
Loop: Increment next state by one.
Queue a task to run the following steps:
Set the MediaController
's
readyState
attribute to the value next state.
Fire a simple event at
the MediaController
object, whose name is the event name corresponding to the
value of next state given in
the table below.
Якщо next state is less than new readiness state, then return to the step labeled loop.
Інакше if the MediaController
's
most recently
reported readiness state is greater than new
readiness state then queue a task
to fire a simple event at the MediaController
object, whose
name is the event name corresponding to the value of new
readiness state given in the table below.
Value of new readiness state | Event name |
---|---|
0 | emptied |
1 | loadedmetadata
|
2 | loadeddata
|
3 | canplay |
4 | canplaythrough
|
Нехай the MediaController
's
most recently
reported readiness state be new
readiness state.
Initialize new playback state by setting it to the state given for the first matching condition from the following list:
MediaController
has no slaved media elementsMediaController
's
slaved media elements have ended playback and the media
controller playback rate is positive or zeroMediaController
is a blocked media controllerЯкщо the MediaController
's
most recently
reported playback state is not equal to new
playback state and the new
playback state is ended, then queue
a task that, if the MediaController
object is a playing media
controller та all of the MediaController
's
slaved media elements have
still ended playback та the media
controller playback rate is still positive or zero, changes
the MediaController
object to a paused media
controller and then fires a simple event named pause
at the MediaController
object.
Якщо the MediaController
's
most recently
reported playback state is not equal to new
playback state then queue a task
to run the following steps:
Set the MediaController
's
playbackState
attribute to the value given in the second column of the row of
the following table whose first column contains the new
playback state.
Fire a simple event at the MediaController
object,
whose name is the value given in the third column of the row of
the following table whose first column contains the new
playback state.
New playback state | New value for playbackState
|
Event name |
---|---|---|
playing | "playing "
|
playing
|
waiting | "waiting "
|
waiting
|
ended | "ended "
|
ended
|
Нехай the MediaController
's
most recently
reported playback state be new
playback state.
The following are the event handlers
(and their corresponding event handler event types)
that must be supported, as event
handler IDL attributes, by all objects implementing the MediaController
interface:
Event handler | Event handler event type |
---|---|
onemptied
|
emptied
|
onloadedmetadata
|
loadedmetadata
|
onloadeddata
|
loadeddata
|
oncanplay
|
canplay
|
oncanplaythrough
|
canplaythrough
|
onplaying
|
playing
|
onended
|
ended
|
onwaiting
|
waiting
|
ondurationchange
|
durationchange
|
ontimeupdate
|
timeupdate
|
onplay
|
play
|
onpause
|
pause
|
onratechange
|
ratechange
|
onvolumechange
|
volumechange
|
The task source for the tasks listed in this section is the DOM manipulation task source.
The mediagroup
content attribute on media
elements can be used to link multiple media elements together by implicitly
creating a MediaController
.
The value is text; media
elements with the same value are automatically linked by the user
agent.
When a media element is created with a mediagroup
attribute та when a media element's mediagroup
attribute is set, changed, or removed, the user agent must run the
following steps:
Нехай m be the media element in question.
Нехай old controller be m's current media controller, if it currently has one та null otherwise.
Нехай new controller be null.
Нехай m have no current media controller, if it currently has one.
Якщо m's mediagroup
attribute is
being removed, then jump to the update controllers step
below.
Якщо there is another media element
whose Document
is the same as
m's Document
(even if one or both of these elements are not actually in the Document
)
та which also has a mediagroup
attribute та
whose mediagroup
attribute has the same value as the new value of m's
mediagroup
attribute, then let controller be
that media element's current
media controller.
Інакше let controller be a newly
created MediaController
.
Нехай m's current media controller be controller.
Нехай new controller be m's current media controller.
Bring the media element up to speed with its new media controller.
Update controllers: Якщо old controller and new controller are the same (whether both null or both the same controller) then abort these steps.
Якщо old controller is not null and still has one or more slaved media elements, then report the controller state for old controller.
Якщо new controller is not null, then report the controller state for new controller.
The mediaGroup
IDL attribute on media
elements must reflect the mediagroup
content
attribute.
Multiple media
elements referencing the same media
resource will share a single network request. This can be used to
efficiently play two (video) tracks from the same media
resource in two different places on the screen. Used with the mediagroup
attribute, these elements can also be kept synchronised.
In this example, a sign-languge interpreter track from a movie file is
overlaid on the primary video track of that same video file using two video
elements, some CSS та an
implicit MediaController
:
<article> <style> div { margin: 1em auto; position: relative; width: 400px; height: 300px; } video { position; absolute; bottom: 0; right: 0; } video:first-child { width: 100%; height: 100%; } video:last-child { width: 30%; } </style> <div> <video src="movie.vid#track=Video&track=English" autoplay controls mediagroup=movie></video> <video src="movie.vid#track=sign" autoplay mediagroup=movie></video> </div> </article>
A media element can have a group of associated text tracks, known as the media element's list of text tracks. The text tracks are sorted as follows:
track
element children of the media element, in
tree order.addTextTrack()
method, in the order they were added, oldest first.A text track consists of:
This decides how the track is handled by the user agent. The kind is represented by a string. The possible strings are:
subtitles
captions
descriptions
chapters
metadata
The kind
of track can change dynamically, in the case of a text
track corresponding to a track
element.
This is a human-readable string intended to identify the track for the user.
The label
of a track can change dynamically, in the case of a text
track corresponding to a track
element.
When a text track label is the empty string, the user agent should automatically generate an appropriate label from the text track's other properties (e.g. the kind of text track and the text track's language) for use in its user interface. This automatically-generated label is not exposed in the API.
This is a string extracted from the media resource specifically for in-band metadata tracks to enable such tracks to be dispatched to different scripts in the document.
For example, a traditional TV station broadcast streamed on the Web and augmented with Web-specific interactive features could include text tracks with metadata for ad targeting, trivia game data during game shows, player states during sports games, recipe information during food programs та so forth. As each program starts and ends, new tracks might be added or removed from the stream та as each one is added, the user agent could bind them to dedicated script modules using the value of this attribute.
Other than for in-band metadata text tracks, the in-band metadata track dispatch type is the empty string. How this value is populated for different media formats is described in steps to expose a media-resource-specific text track.
This is a string (a BCP 47 language tag) representing the language of the text track's cues. [BCP47]
The language
of a text track can change dynamically, in the case of a text
track corresponding to a track
element.
One of the following:
Indicates that the text track's cues have not been obtained.
Indicates that the text track is loading and there have been no fatal errors encountered so far. Further cues might still be added to the track by the parser.
Indicates that the text track has been loaded with no fatal errors.
Indicates that the text track was enabled, but when the user agent attempted щоб отримати it, this failed in some way (e.g. URL could not be resolved, network error, unknown text track format). Some or all of the cues are likely missing and will not be obtained.
The readiness state of a text track changes dynamically as the track is obtained.
One of the following:
Indicates that the text track is not active. Other than for the purposes of exposing the track in the DOM, the user agent is ignoring the text track. No cues are active, no events are fired та the user agent will not attempt щоб отримати the track's cues.
Indicates that the text track is active, but that the user agent is not actively displaying the cues. Якщо no attempt has yet been made щоб отримати the track's cues, the user agent will perform such an attempt momentarily. The user agent is maintaining a list of which cues are active та events are being fired accordingly.
Indicates that the text track is active. Якщо no attempt has yet
been made щоб отримати the track's cues, the user agent will
perform such an attempt momentarily. The user agent is maintaining
a list of which cues are active та events are being fired
accordingly. In addition, for text tracks whose kind is subtitles
or captions
,
the cues are being overlaid on the video as appropriate; for text
tracks whose kind
is descriptions
,
the user agent is making the cues available to the user in a
non-visual fashion; and for text tracks whose kind is chapters
, the
user agent is making available to the user a mechanism by which
the user can navigate to any point in the media
resource by selecting a cue.
A list of text track cues, along with rules for updating the text track rendering. For example, for WebVTT, the rules for updating the display of WebVTT text tracks. [WEBVTT]
The list of cues of a text track can change dynamically, either because the text track has not yet been loaded or is still loading, or due to DOM manipulation.
Each text track has a corresponding TextTrack
object.
Each media element has a list of pending text tracks, which must initially be empty, a blocked-on-parser flag, which must initially be false та a did-perform-automatic-track-selection flag, which must also initially be false.
When the user agent is required to populate the list of pending text tracks of a media element, the user agent must add to the element's list of pending text tracks each text track in the element's list of text tracks whose text track mode is not disabled and whose text track readiness state is loading.
Whenever a track
element's
parent node changes, the user agent must remove the corresponding text
track from any list of
pending text tracks that it is in.
Whenever a text track's text track readiness state changes to either loaded or failed to load, the user agent must remove it from any list of pending text tracks that it is in.
When a media element is created by an HTML parser or XML parser, the user agent must set the element's blocked-on-parser flag to true. When a media element is popped off the stack of open elements of an HTML parser or XML parser, the user agent must honor user preferences for automatic text track selection, populate the list of pending text tracks та set the element's blocked-on-parser flag to false.
The text tracks of a media element are ready when both the element's list of pending text tracks is empty and the element's blocked-on-parser flag is false.
Each media element has a pending text track change notification flag, which must initially be unset.
Whenever a text track that is in a media element's list of text tracks has its text track mode change value, the user agent must run the following steps for the media element:
Якщо the media element's pending text track change notification flag is set, abort these steps.
Set the media element's pending text track change notification flag.
Queue a task that runs the following substeps:
Unset the media element's pending text track change notification flag.
Fire a simple event named change
at the media element's textTracks
attribute's
TextTrackList
object.
Якщо the media element's show poster flag is not set, run the time marches on steps.
The task source for the tasks listed in this section is the DOM manipulation task source.
A text track cue is the unit of time-sensitive data in a text track, corresponding for instance for subtitles and captions to the text that appears at a particular time and disappears at another time.
Each text track cue consists of:
An arbitrary string.
The time, in seconds and fractions of a second, that describes the beginning of the range of the media data to which the cue applies.
The time, in seconds and fractions of a second, that describes the end of the range of the media data to which the cue applies.
A boolean indicating whether playback of the media resource is to pause when the end of the range to which the cue applies is reached.
Additional fields, as needed for the format. For example, WebVTT has a text track cue writing direction and so forth. [WEBVTT]
The raw data of the cue та rules for rendering the cue in isolation.
The precise nature of this data is defined by the format. For example, WebVTT uses text.
The text track cue start time and text track cue end time can be negative. (The current playback position can never be negative, though, so cues entirely before time zero cannot be active.)
Each text track cue has a corresponding TextTrackCue
object (or more
specifically, an object that inherits from TextTrackCue
— for example, WebVTT cues use the VTTCue
interface). A text track cue's in-memory representation can
be dynamically changed through this TextTrackCue
API. [WEBVTT]
A text track cue is associated with rules
for updating the text track rendering, as defined by the
specification for the specific kind of text
track cue. These rules are used specifically when the object
representing the cue is added to a TextTrack
object using the addCue()
method.
In addition, each text track cue has two pieces of dynamic information:
This flag must be initially unset. The flag is used to ensure events are fired appropriately when the cue becomes active or inactive та to make sure the right cues are rendered.
The user agent must synchronously unset this flag whenever the text
track cue is removed from its text track's
text track list of cues;
whenever the text track itself is removed
from its media element's list
of text tracks or has its text track
mode changed to disabled; and whenever the media
element's readyState
is changed back to HAVE_NOTHING
. When the
flag is unset in this way for one or more cues in text tracks that were showing prior to the relevant
incident, the user agent must, after having unset the flag for all the
affected cues, apply the rules
for updating the text track rendering of those text tracks. For example, for text tracks based on WebVTT,
the rules
for updating the display of WebVTT text tracks. [WEBVTT]
This is used as part of the rendering model, to keep cues in a consistent position. It must initially be empty. Whenever the text track cue active flag is unset, the user agent must empty the text track cue display state.
The text track cues of a media element's text tracks are ordered relative to each other in the text track cue order, which is determined as follows: first group the cues by their text track, with the groups being sorted in the same order as their text tracks appear in the media element's list of text tracks; then, within each group, cues must be sorted by their start time, earliest first; then, any cues with the same start time must be sorted by their end time, latest first; and finally, any cues with identical end times must be sorted in the order they were last added to their respective text track list of cues, oldest first (so e.g. for cues from a WebVTT file, that would initially be the order in which the cues were listed in the file). [WEBVTT]
A media-resource-specific text track is a text track that corresponds to data found in the media resource.
Rules for processing and rendering such data are defined by the relevant specifications, e.g. the specification of the video format if the media resource is a video.
When a media resource contains data that the user agent recognises and supports as being equivalent to a text track, the user agent runs the steps to expose a media-resource-specific text track with the relevant data, as follows.
Associate the relevant data with a new text
track and its corresponding new TextTrack
object. The text track is a media-resource-specific
text track.
Set the new text track's kind, label та language based on the semantics of the relevant data, as defined for the relevant format [INBANDTRACKS]. Якщо there is no label in that data, then the label must be set to the empty string.
Associate the text track list of cues with the rules for updating the text track rendering appropriate for the format in question.
Якщо the new text track's kind is metadata
, then
set the text
track in-band metadata track dispatch type as follows, based
on the type of the media resource:
CodecID
element. [WEBMCG]stsd
box of
the first stbl
box of the first
minf
box of the first mdia
box of the text track's trak
box in the first moov
box of the
file be the stsd box, if any. Якщо the file has no stsd
box, or if the stsd box has neither a mett
box nor a metx
box, then the text
track in-band metadata track dispatch type must be set to
the empty string. Інакше if the stsd box has a mett
box then the text
track in-band metadata track dispatch type must be set to
the concatenation of the string "mett
",
a U+0020 SPACE character та the value of the first mime_format
field of the first mett
box of
the stsd box, or the empty string if that field is absent
in that box. Інакше if the stsd box has no mett
box but has a metx
box then the
text
track in-band metadata track dispatch type must be set to
the concatenation of the string "metx
",
a U+0020 SPACE character та the value of the first namespace
field of the first metx
box of
the stsd box, or the empty string if that field is absent
in that box. [MPEG4] Populate the new text track's list of cues with the cues parsed so far, following the guidelines for exposing cues та begin updating it dynamically as necessary.
Set the new text track's readiness state to loaded.
Set the new text track's mode to the mode consistent with the user's preferences and the requirements of the relevant specification for the data.
Add the new text track to the media element's list of text tracks.
Fire
a trusted
event with the name addtrack
, that does not
bubble and is not cancelable та that uses the TrackEvent
interface, with the track
attribute
initialized to the text track's TextTrack
object, at the media
element's textTracks
attribute's TextTrackList
object.
When a track
element is
created, it must be associated with a new text
track (with its value set as defined below) and its corresponding
new TextTrack
object.
The text track kind is determined from
the state of the element's kind
attribute according to the
following table; for a state given in a cell of the first column, the kind is
the string given in the second column:
State | String |
---|---|
Subtitles | subtitles
|
Captions | captions
|
Descriptions | descriptions
|
Chapters | chapters
|
Metadata | metadata
|
The text track label is the element's track label.
The text track language is the element's track language, if any, or the empty string otherwise.
As the kind
,
label
та srclang
attributes are set, changed, or removed, the text
track must update accordingly, as per the definitions above.
Changes to the track URL are handled in the algorithm below.
The text track readiness state is initially not loaded та the text track mode is initially disabled.
The text track list of cues is initially empty. It is dynamically modified when the referenced file is parsed. Associated with the list are the rules for updating the text track rendering appropriate for the format in question; for WebVTT, this is the rules for updating the display of WebVTT text tracks. [WEBVTT]
When a track
element's
parent element changes and the new parent is a media
element, then the user agent must add the track
element's corresponding text track to the media element's list
of text tracks та then queue a task
to fire
a trusted
event with the name addtrack
,
that does not bubble and is not cancelable та that uses the TrackEvent
interface, with the track
attribute initialized to the text track's TextTrack
object, at the media
element's textTracks
attribute's TextTrackList
object.
When a track
element's
parent element changes and the old parent was a media
element, then the user agent must remove the track
element's corresponding text track from the media element's list
of text tracks та then queue a task
to fire
a trusted
event with the name removetrack
, that does
not bubble and is not cancelable та that uses the TrackEvent
interface, with the track
attribute initialized to the text track's TextTrack
object, at the media
element's textTracks
attribute's TextTrackList
object.
When a text track corresponding to a track
element is added to a media element's list
of text tracks, the user agent must queue
a task to run the following steps for the media
element:
Якщо the element's blocked-on-parser flag є true, abort these steps.
Якщо the element's did-perform-automatic-track-selection flag є true, abort these steps.
Honor user preferences for automatic text track selection for this element.
When the user agent is required to honor user preferences for automatic text track selection for a media element, the user agent must run the following steps:
Perform automatic
text track selection for subtitles
and captions
.
Якщо there are any text
tracks in the media element's list of text tracks whose text
track kind is metadata
that
correspond to track
elements with a default
attribute set whose text track mode
is set to disabled,
then set the text track mode of all
such tracks to hidden
Set the element's did-perform-automatic-track-selection flag to true.
When the steps above say to perform automatic text track selection for one or more text track kinds, it means to run the following steps:
Нехай candidates be a list consisting of the text tracks in the media element's list of text tracks whose text track kind is one of the kinds that were passed to the algorithm, if any, in the order given in the list of text tracks.
Якщо candidates is empty, then abort these steps.
Якщо any of the text tracks in candidates have a text track mode set to showing, abort these steps.
Якщо the user has expressed an interest in having a track from candidates enabled based on its text track kind, text track language та text track label, then set its text track mode to showing.
For example, the user could have set a browser preference to the effect of "I want French captions whenever possible", or "Якщо there is a subtitle track with 'Commentary' in the title, enable it", or "Якщо there are audio description tracks available, enable one, ideally in Swiss German, but failing that in Standard Swiss German or Standard German".
Інакше if there are any text
tracks in candidates that
correspond to track
elements with a default
attribute set whose text track mode
is set to disabled,
then set the text track mode of the
first such track to showing.
When a text track corresponding to a track
element experiences any
of the following circumstances, the user agent must start
the track
processing model for that text
track and its track
element:
track
element is
created.track
element's
parent element changes and the new parent is a media
element.When a user agent is to start
the track
processing model for a text
track and its track
element, it must run the following algorithm. This algorithm interacts
closely with the event loop mechanism; in
particular, it has a synchronous section
(which is triggered as part of the event loop
algorithm). The steps in that section are marked with ⌛.
Якщо another occurrence of this algorithm is already running for
this text track and its track
element, abort these steps, letting that other algorithm take care
of this element.
Якщо the text track's text track mode is not set to one of hidden or showing, abort these steps.
Якщо the text track's track
element does not have a media element
as a parent, abort these steps.
Run the remainder of these steps asynchronously, allowing whatever caused these steps to run to continue.
Top: Await a stable state. The synchronous section consists of the following steps. (The steps in the synchronous section are marked with ⌛.)
⌛ Set the text track readiness state to loading.
⌛ Якщо the track
element's parent is a media element
then let CORS mode be the state of
the parent media element's crossorigin
content
attribute. Інакше let CORS mode be No
CORS.
End the synchronous section, continuing the remaining steps asynchronously.
Якщо URL is not the empty string,
perform a potentially
CORS-enabled fetch of URL,
with the mode being CORS mode,
the origin being the origin
of the track
element's Document
та the default
origin behaviour set to fail.
The resource obtained in this fashion, if any, contains the text track data. Якщо any data is obtained, it is by definition CORS-same-origin (cross-origin resources що є not suitably CORS-enabled do not get this far).
The tasks queued by the fetching algorithm on the networking task source to process the data as it is being fetched must determine the type of the resource. Якщо the type of the resource is not a supported text track format, the load will fail, as described below. Інакше the resource's data must be passed to the appropriate parser (e.g. the WebVTT parser) as it is received, with the text track list of cues being used for that parser's output. [WEBVTT]
The appropriate parser will synchronously (during these networking task source tasks) and incrementally (as each such task is run with whatever data has been received from the network) update the text track list of cues.
This specification does not currently say whether or how to check the MIME types of text tracks, or whether or how to perform file type sniffing using the actual file data. Implementors differ in their intentions on this matter and it is therefore unclear what the right solution is. In the absence of any requirement here, the HTTP specification's strict requirement to follow the Content-Type header prevails ("Content-Type specifies the media type of the underlying data." ... "Якщо and only if the media type is not given by a Content-Type field, the recipient МОЖЕ attempt to guess the media type via inspection of its content and/or the name extension(s) of the URI used to identify the resource.").
Якщо the fetching algorithm fails for any reason (network error, the server returns an error code, a cross-origin check fails, etc), if URL is the empty string, or if the type of the resource is not a supported text track format, then run these steps:
Queue a task to first change the text track readiness state
to failed
to load and then fire a
simple event named error
at the track
element.
Wait until the text track readiness state is no longer set to loading.
Wait until the track URL is no longer equal to URL, at the same time as the text track mode is set to hidden or showing.
Jump to the step labeled top.
Якщо the fetching algorithm does not fail, then the final task that is queued by the networking task source must run the following steps after it has tried to parse the data:
Change the text track readiness state to loaded.
Якщо the file was successfully processed, fire
a simple event named load
at the track
element.
Інакше the file was not successfully processed (e.g. the format
in question is an XML format and the file contained a
well-formedness error that the XML specification requires be
detected and reported to the application); fire
a simple event named error
at the track
element.
Wait until the track URL is no longer equal to URL, at the same time as the text track mode is set to hidden or showing.
Jump back to the step labeled top.
Якщо, while the fetching algorithm is active, either:
...then the user agent must run the following steps:
Abort the fetching algorithm, discarding any pending tasks generated by that algorithm (and in particular, not adding any cues to the text track list of cues after the moment the URL changed).
Jump back to the step labeled top.
Until one of the above circumstances occurs, the user agent must remain on this step.
Whenever a track
element
has its src
attribute set, changed, or removed, the user agent must synchronously
empty the element's text track's text
track list of cues. (This also causes the algorithm above to stop
adding cues from the resource being obtained using the previously given
URL, if any.)
How a specific format's text track cues are to be interpreted for the purposes of processing by an HTML user agent is defined by that format [INBANDTRACKS]. In the absence of such a specification, this section provides some constraints within which implementations can attempt to consistently expose such formats.
To support the text track model of HTML, each unit of timed data is converted to a text track cue. Where the mapping of the format's features to the aspects of a text track cue as defined in this specification are not defined, implementations must ensure that the mapping is consistent with the definitions of the aspects of a text track cue as defined above, as well as with the following constraints:
Should be set to the empty string if the format has no obvious analogue to a per-cue identifier.
Should be set to false.
interface TextTrackList : EventTarget { readonly attribute unsigned long length; getter TextTrack (unsigned long index); TextTrack? getTrackById(DOMString id); attribute EventHandler onchange; attribute EventHandler onaddtrack; attribute EventHandler onremovetrack; };
textTracks
. length
Returns the number of text
tracks associated with the media
element (e.g. from track
elements). This is the number of text
tracks in the media element's list of text tracks.
textTracks[
n
]
Returns the TextTrack
object
representing the nth text
track in the media element's list
of text tracks.
textTracks
. getTrackById
(
id )Returns the TextTrack
object
with the given identifier, or null if no track has that identifier.
track
Returns the TextTrack
object
representing the track
element's text track.
A TextTrackList
object
represents a dynamically updating list of text tracks in a given order.
The textTracks
attribute of media
elements must return a TextTrackList
object representing the TextTrack
objects of the text
tracks in the media element's list
of text tracks, in the same order as in the list
of text tracks. The same object must be returned each time the
attribute is accessed. [WEBIDL]
The length
attribute of a TextTrackList
object must return the number of text
tracks in the list represented by the TextTrackList
object.
The supported property indices
of a TextTrackList
object at
any instant are the numbers from zero to the number of text tracks in the list represented by the TextTrackList
object minus one, if
any. Якщо there are no text
tracks in the list, there are no supported
property indices.
To determine the
value of an indexed property of a TextTrackList
object for a given index index, the user
agent must return the indexth text
track in the list represented by the TextTrackList
object.
The getTrackById(id)
method must return the
first TextTrack
in the TextTrackList
object whose id
IDL attribute would return a
value equal to the value of the id
argument. When no tracks match the given argument, the method must
return null.
enum TextTrackMode { "disabled", "hidden", "showing" }; enum TextTrackKind { "subtitles", "captions", "descriptions", "chapters", "metadata" }; interface TextTrack : EventTarget { readonly attribute TextTrackKind kind; readonly attribute DOMString label; readonly attribute DOMString language; readonly attribute DOMString id; readonly attribute DOMString inBandMetadataTrackDispatchType; attribute TextTrackMode mode; readonly attribute TextTrackCueList? cues; readonly attribute TextTrackCueList? activeCues; void addCue(TextTrackCue cue); void removeCue(TextTrackCue cue); attribute EventHandler oncuechange; };
addTextTrack
(
kind [, label
[, language ] ] )Creates and returns a new TextTrack
object, which is also added to the media
element's list of text tracks.
kind
Returns the text track kind string.
label
Returns the text track label, if there is one, or the empty string otherwise (indicating that a custom label probably needs to be generated from the other attributes of the object if the object is exposed to the user).
language
Returns the text track language string.
id
Returns the ID of the given track.
For in-band tracks, this is the ID that can be used with a fragment
identifier if the format supports the Media Fragments URI
syntax та that can be used with the getTrackById()
method. [MEDIAFRAG]
For TextTrack
objects
corresponding to track
elements, this is the ID of the track
element.
inBandMetadataTrackDispatchType
Returns the text track in-band metadata track dispatch type string.
mode
[ = value
]Returns the text track mode, represented by a string from the following list:
disabled
"The text track disabled mode.
hidden
"The text track hidden mode.
showing
"The text track showing mode.
Can be set, to change the mode.
cues
Returns the text track list of
cues, as a TextTrackCueList
object.
activeCues
Returns the text
track cues from the text
track list of cues що є currently active (i.e. that start before
the current playback position
and end after it), as a TextTrackCueList
object.
addCue
( cue
)Adds the given cue to textTrack's text track list of cues.
removeCue
( cue
)Removes the given cue from textTrack's text track list of cues.
The addTextTrack(kind, label,
language)
method of media elements, when invoked, must run the
following steps:
Create a new TextTrack
object.
Create a new text track corresponding to the new object та set its text track kind to kind, its text track label to label, its text track language to language, its text track readiness state to the text track loaded state, its text track mode to the text track hidden mode та its text track list of cues to an empty list.
Initially, the text track list of cues is not associated with any rules for updating the text track rendering. When a text track cue is added to it, the text track list of cues has its rules permanently set accordingly.
Add the new text track to the media element's list of text tracks.
Queue a task to fire a trusted event with the name addtrack
,
that does not bubble and is not cancelable та that uses the TrackEvent
interface, with the track
attribute initialized to the new text track's
TextTrack
object, at the media
element's textTracks
attribute's TextTrackList
object.
Повернути new TextTrack
object.
The kind
attribute must return the text track kind
of the text track that the TextTrack
object represents.
The label
attribute must return the text track label
of the text track that the TextTrack
object represents.
The language
attribute must return the text track
language of the text track that the TextTrack
object represents.
The id
attribute returns the track's identifier, if it has one, or the empty
string otherwise. For tracks that correspond to track
elements, the track's identifier is the value of the element's id
attribute, if any. For
in-band tracks, the track's identifier is specified by the media
resource. Якщо the media resource
is in a format that supports the Media Fragments URI
fragment identifier syntax, the identifier returned for a particular
track must be the same identifier that would enable the track if used as
the name of a track in the track dimension of such a fragment
identifier. [MEDIAFRAG]
The inBandMetadataTrackDispatchType
attribute must return the text
track in-band metadata track dispatch type of the text
track that the TextTrack
object represents.
The mode
attribute, on getting, must return the string corresponding to the text
track mode of the text track that the TextTrack
object represents, as defined
by the following list:
disabled
"hidden
"showing
"On setting, if the new value isn't equal to what the attribute would currently return, the new value must be processed as follows:
disabled
"Set the text track mode of the text track that the TextTrack
object represents to the text track
disabled mode.
hidden
"Set the text track mode of the text track that the TextTrack
object represents to the text track
hidden mode.
showing
"Set the text track mode of the text track that the TextTrack
object represents to the text track
showing mode.
Якщо the text track mode of the text
track that the TextTrack
object represents is not the text track
disabled mode, then the cues
attribute must return
a live TextTrackCueList
object that represents the subset of the text
track list of cues of the text track
that the TextTrack
object
represents whose end
times occur at or after the earliest
possible position when the script started, in text
track cue order. Інакше it must return null. When an object is
returned, the same object must be returned each time.
The earliest possible position when the script started is whatever the earliest possible position was the last time the event loop reached step 1.
Якщо the text track mode of the text
track that the TextTrack
object represents is not the text track
disabled mode, then the activeCues
attribute
must return a live TextTrackCueList
object that represents the subset of the text
track list of cues of the text track
that the TextTrack
object
represents whose active
flag was set when the script started, in text
track cue order. Інакше it must return null. When an object is
returned, the same object must be returned each time.
A text track cue's active flag was set when the script started if its text track cue active flag was set the last time the event loop reached step 1.
The addCue(cue)
method of TextTrack
objects, when invoked, must run the following steps:
Якщо the text track list of cues does not yet have any associated rules for updating the text track rendering, then associate the text track list of cues with the rules for updating the text track rendering appropriate to cue.
Якщо text track list of cues'
associated rules
for updating the text track rendering are not the same rules
for updating the text track rendering as appropriate for cue, then throw an InvalidStateError
exception and abort these steps.
Якщо the given cue is in a text track list of cues, then remove cue from that text track list of cues.
Add cue to the method's TextTrack
object's text track's text
track list of cues.
The removeCue(cue)
method of TextTrack
objects, when invoked, must run the following steps:
Якщо the given cue is not currently
listed in the method's TextTrack
object's text track's text
track list of cues, then throw a NotFoundError
exception and abort these steps.
Remove cue from the method's TextTrack
object's text
track's text track list of
cues.
In this example, an audio
element is used to play a specific sound-effect from a sound file
containing many sound effects. A cue is used to pause the audio, so that
it ends exactly at the end of the clip, even if the browser is busy
running some script. Якщо the page had relied on script to pause the
audio, then the start of the next clip might be heard if the browser was
not able to run the script at the exact time specified.
var sfx = new Audio('sfx.wav'); var sounds = sfx.addTextTrack('metadata'); // add sounds we care about function addFX(start, end, name) { var cue = new VTTCue(start, end, ''); cue.id = name; cue.pauseOnExit = true; sounds.addCue(cue); } addFX(12.783, 13.612, 'dog bark'); addFX(13.612, 15.091, 'kitten mew')) function playSound(id) { sfx.currentTime = sounds.getCueById(id).startTime; sfx.play(); } // play a bark as soon as we can sfx.oncanplaythrough = function () { playSound('dog bark'); } // meow when the user tries to leave window.onbeforeunload = function () { playSound('kitten mew'); return 'Are you sure you want to leave this awesome page?'; }
interface TextTrackCueList { readonly attribute unsigned long length; getter TextTrackCue (unsigned long index); TextTrackCue? getCueById(DOMString id); };
length
Returns the number of cues in the list.
Returns the text track cue with index index in the list. The cues are sorted in text track cue order.
getCueById
( id )Returns the first text track cue (in text track cue order) with text track cue identifier id.
Returns null if none of the cues have the given identifier or if the argument is the empty string.
A TextTrackCueList
object
represents a dynamically updating list of text track cues in a given order.
The length
attribute must return the number of cues in the list represented by the TextTrackCueList
object.
The supported property indices
of a TextTrackCueList
object at any instant are the numbers from zero to the number of cues in the list represented by the TextTrackCueList
object minus
one, if any. Якщо there are no cues
in the list, there are no supported
property indices.
To determine the
value of an indexed property for a given index index,
the user agent must return the indexth text track cue in the list represented by
the TextTrackCueList
object.
The getCueById(id)
method, when called
with an argument other than the empty string, must return the first text track cue in the list represented by
the TextTrackCueList
object whose text track cue
identifier is id, if any, or null
otherwise. Якщо the argument is the empty string, then the method must
return null.
interface TextTrackCue : EventTarget { readonly attribute TextTrack? track; attribute DOMString id; attribute double startTime; attribute double endTime; attribute boolean pauseOnExit; attribute EventHandler onenter; attribute EventHandler onexit; };
Returns the TextTrack
object
to which this text track cue belongs,
if any, or null otherwise.
Returns the text track cue identifier.
Can be set.
Returns the text track cue start time, in seconds.
Can be set.
Returns the text track cue end time, in seconds.
Can be set.
Returns true if the text track cue pause-on-exit flag is set, false otherwise.
Can be set.
The track
attribute, on getting, must return the TextTrack
object of the text track in whose list of cues the text
track cue that the TextTrackCue
object represents finds itself, if any; or null otherwise.
The id
attribute, on getting, must return the text
track cue identifier of the text track
cue that the TextTrackCue
object represents. On setting, the text
track cue identifier must be set to the new value.
The startTime
attribute, on getting, must return the text
track cue start time of the text track
cue that the TextTrackCue
object represents, in seconds. On setting, the text
track cue start time must be set to the new value, interpreted in
seconds; then, if the TextTrackCue
object's text track cue is in a text
track's list
of cues та that text track is in a media element's list
of text tracks та the media element's
show poster flag is not set, then run
the time marches on steps for
that media element.
The endTime
attribute, on getting, must return the text
track cue end time of the text track
cue that the TextTrackCue
object represents, in seconds. On setting, the text
track cue end time must be set to the new value, interpreted in
seconds; then, if the TextTrackCue
object's text track cue is in a text
track's list
of cues та that text track is in a media element's list
of text tracks та the media element's
show poster flag is not set, then run
the time marches on steps for
that media element.
The pauseOnExit
attribute, on getting, must return true if the text
track cue pause-on-exit flag of the text
track cue that the TextTrackCue
object represents is set; or false otherwise. On setting, the text
track cue pause-on-exit flag must be set if the new value є true
та must be unset otherwise.
Chapters are segments of a media resource with a given title. Chapters can be nested, in the same way that sections in a document outline can have subsections.
Each text track cue in a text track being used for describing chapters has three key features: the text track cue start time, giving the start time of the chapter, the text track cue end time, giving the end time of the chapter та the text track cue data giving the chapter title.
The rules for constructing the chapter tree from a text track наступні. They produce a potentially nested list of chapters, each of which have a start time, end time, title та a list of nested chapters. This algorithm discards cues that do not correctly nest within each other, or що є out of order.
Нехай list be a copy of the list of cues of the text track being processed.
Remove from list any text track cue whose text track cue end time is before its text track cue start time.
Нехай output be an empty list of chapters, where a chapter is a record consisting of a start time, an end time, a title та a (potentially empty) list of nested chapters. For the purpose of this algorithm, each chapter also has a parent chapter.
Нехай current chapter be a stand-in chapter whose start time is negative infinity, whose end time is positive infinity та whose list of nested chapters is output. (This is just used to make the algorithm easier to describe.)
Loop: Якщо list is empty, jump to the step labeled end.
Нехай current cue be the first cue in list та then remove it from list.
Якщо current cue's text track cue start time is less than the start time of current chapter, then return to the step labeled loop.
While current cue's text track cue start time is greater than or equal to current chapter's end time, let current chapter be current chapter's parent chapter.
Якщо current cue's text track cue end time is greater than the end time of current chapter, then return to the step labeled loop.
Create a new chapter new chapter, whose start time is current cue's text track cue start time, whose end time is current cue's text track cue end time, whose title is current cue's text track cue data interpreted according to its rules for rendering the cue in isolation та whose list of nested chapters is empty.
For WebVTT, the rules for rendering the cue in isolation are the rules for interpreting WebVTT cue text. [WEBVTT]
Append new chapter to current chapter's list of nested chapters та let current chapter be new chapter's parent.
Нехай current chapter be new chapter.
Повернутиto the step labeled loop.
End: Повернутиoutput.
The following snippet of a WebVTT file shows how nested chapters can be marked up. The file describes three 50-minute chapters, "Astrophysics", "Computational Physics" та "General Relativity". The first has three subchapters, the second has four та the third has two. [WEBVTT]
WEBVTT 00:00:00.000 --> 00:50:00.000 Astrophysics 00:00:00.000 --> 00:10:00.000 Introduction to Astrophysics 00:10:00.000 --> 00:45:00.000 The Solar System 00:00:00.000 --> 00:10:00.000 Coursework Description 00:50:00.000 --> 01:40:00.000 Computational Physics 00:50:00.000 --> 00:55:00.000 Introduction to Programming 00:55:00.000 --> 01:30:00.000 Data Structures 01:30:00.000 --> 01:35:00.000 Answers to Last Exam 01:35:00.000 --> 01:40:00.000 Coursework Description 01:40:00.000 --> 02:30:00.000 General Relativity 01:40:00.000 --> 02:00:00.000 Tensor Algebra 02:00:00.000 --> 02:30:00.000 The General Relativistic Field Equations
The following are the event handlers
that (and their corresponding event handler event types) must
be supported, as event handler
IDL attributes, by all objects implementing the TextTrackList
interface:
Event handler | Event handler event type |
---|---|
onchange
|
change
|
onaddtrack
|
addtrack
|
onremovetrack
|
removetrack
|
The following are the event handlers
that (and their corresponding event handler event types) must
be supported, as event handler
IDL attributes, by all objects implementing the TextTrack
interface:
Event handler | Event handler event type |
---|---|
oncuechange
|
cuechange |
The following are the event handlers
that (and their corresponding event handler event types) must
be supported, as event handler
IDL attributes, by all objects implementing the TextTrackCue
interface:
Event handler | Event handler event type |
---|---|
onenter
|
enter |
onexit
|
exit |
The controls
attribute is a boolean attribute. Якщо
present, it indicates that the author has not provided a scripted
controller and would like the user agent to provide its own set of
controls.
Якщо the attribute is present, or if scripting is disabled for the media element, then the user agent should expose a user interface to the user. This user interface should include features to begin playback, pause playback, seek to an arbitrary position in the content (if the content supports arbitrary seeking), change the volume, change the display of closed captions or embedded sign-language tracks, select different audio tracks or turn on audio descriptions та show the media content in manners more suitable to the user (e.g. full-screen video or in an independent resizable window). Other controls may also be made available.
Якщо the media element has a current
media controller, then the user agent should expose audio tracks
from all the slaved media elements
(although avoiding duplicates if the same media
resource is being used several times). Якщо a media
resource's audio track exposed in this way has no known name та it
is the only audio track for a particular media
element, the user agent should use the element's title
attribute, if any, as the name
(or as part of the name) of that track.
Even when the attribute is absent, however, user agents may provide
controls to affect playback of the media resource (e.g. play, pause,
seeking та volume controls), but such features should not interfere with
the page's normal rendering. For example, such features could be exposed
in the media element's context menu. The
user agent may implement this simply by exposing a user interface
to the user as described above (as if the controls
attribute was
present).
Якщо the user agent exposes a user interface
to the user by displaying controls over the media
element, then the user agent should suppress any user interaction
events while the user agent is interacting with this interface. (For
example, if the user clicks on a video's playback control, mousedown
events and so forth would not simultaneously be fired at elements on the
page.)
Where possible (specifically, for starting, stopping, pausing та unpausing playback, for seeking, for changing the rate of playback, for fast-forwarding or rewinding, for listing, enabling та disabling text tracks та for muting or changing the volume of the audio), user interface features exposed by the user agent must be implemented in terms of the DOM API described above, so that, e.g., all the same events fire.
When a media element has a current
media controller, the user agent's user interface for pausing and
unpausing playback, for seeking, for changing the rate of playback, for
fast-forwarding or rewinding та for muting or changing the volume of
audio of the entire group must be implemented in terms of the MediaController
API exposed on
that current media controller.
When a media element has a current
media controller та all the slaved
media elements of that MediaController
are paused, the user agent should also unpause all the slaved
media elements when the user invokes a user agent interface
control for beginning playback.
The "play" function in the user agent's interface must set the playbackRate
attribute to the value of the defaultPlaybackRate
attribute before invoking the play()
method. When a media element has a current
media controller, the attributes and method with those names on
that MediaController
object
must be used. Інакше the attributes and method with those names on the media element itself must be used.
Features such as fast-forward or rewind must be implemented by only
changing the playbackRate
attribute
(and not the defaultPlaybackRate
attribute). Again, when a media element
has a current media controller,
the attributes with those names on that MediaController
object must be used; otherwise, the attributes with those names on the media element itself must be used.
When a media element has a current
media controller, seeking must be implemented in terms of the currentTime
attribute on that MediaController
object. Інакше the user agent must directly seek to the requested position in the media
element's media timeline. For media
resources where seeking to an arbitrary position would be slow, user
agents are encouraged to use the approximate-for-speed flag when
seeking in response to the user manipulating an approximate position
interface such as a seek bar.
When a media element has a current
media controller, user agents may additionally provide the user
with controls that directly manipulate an individual media
element without affecting the MediaController
,
but such features are considered relatively advanced and unlikely to be
useful to most users.
The activation behavior of a media element that is exposing a user interface to the user must be to run the following steps:
Якщо the media element has a current
media controller та that current
media controller is a restrained
media controller, then invoke the play()
method of the
MediaController
.
Інакше if the media element has a current media controller та
that current media controller
is a paused media controller,
then invoke the unpause()
method
of the MediaController
.
Інакше if the media element has a current media controller,
then that current media
controller is a playing
media controller; invoke the pause()
method of
the MediaController
.
Інакше the media element has no current
media controller; if the media
element's paused
attribute є true, then invoke the play()
method on the media
element.
Інакше the media element has no current
media controller та the media
element's paused
attribute is false; invoke the pause()
method on the media
element.
For the purposes of listing chapters in the media
resource, only text tracks in the media
element's list of text tracks
що є showing
and whose text track kind is chapters
should be
used. Such tracks must be interpreted according to the rules
for constructing the chapter tree from a text track. When seeking
in response to a user maniplating a chapter selection interface, user
agents should not use the approximate-for-speed flag.
The controls
IDL attribute must reflect the content attribute
of the same name.
volume
[ = value
]Returns the current playback volume, as a number in the range 0.0 to 1.0, where 0.0 is the quietest and 1.0 the loudest.
Can be set, to change the volume.
Throws an IndexSizeError
exception if the new value is not in the range 0.0 .. 1.0.
muted
[ = value
]Returns true if audio is muted, overriding the volume
attribute та false if
the volume
attribute is being honored.
Can be set, to change whether the audio is muted or not.
The volume
attribute must return the playback volume of any audio portions of the media element, in the range 0.0 (silent) to
1.0 (loudest). Initially, the volume should be 1.0, but user agents may
remember the last set value across sessions, on a per-site basis or
otherwise, so the volume may start at other values. On setting, if the
new value is in the range 0.0 to 1.0 inclusive, the playback volume of
any audio portions of the media element
must be set to the new value. Якщо the new value is outside the range
0.0 to 1.0 inclusive, then, on setting, an IndexSizeError
exception must be thrown instead.
The muted
attribute must return true if the audio output is muted and false
otherwise. Initially, the audio output should not be muted (false), but
user agents may remember the last set value across sessions, on a
per-site basis or otherwise, so the muted state may start as muted
(true). On setting, if the new value є true then the audio output should
be muted and if the new value is false it should be unmuted.
Whenever either of the values that would be returned by the volume
and muted
attributes change, the user
agent must queue a task to fire
a simple event named volumechange
at the media element.
An element's effective media volume is determined as follows:
Якщо the user has indicated that the user agent is to override the volume of the element, then the element's effective media volume is the volume desired by the user. Abort these steps.
Якщо the element's audio output is muted, the element's effective media volume is zero. Abort these steps.
Якщо the element has a current
media controller and that MediaController
object's media controller
mute override є true, the element's effective
media volume is zero. Abort these steps.
Нехай volume be the playback volume of the audio portions of the media element, in range 0.0 (silent) to 1.0 (loudest).
Якщо the element has a current
media controller, помножити volume
by that MediaController
object's media
controller volume multiplier.
The element's effective media volume is volume, interpreted relative to the range 0.0 to 1.0, with 0.0 being silent та 1.0 being the loudest setting, values in between increasing in loudness. The range need not be linear. The loudest setting may be lower than the system's loudest possible setting; for example the user could have set a maximum volume.
The muted
attribute on media elements is a boolean
attribute that controls the default state of the audio output of the
media resource, potentially overriding user
preferences.
When a media element is created, if it
has a muted
attribute specified, the user agent must mute the media
element's audio output, overriding any user preference.
The defaultMuted
IDL attribute must reflect the muted
content attribute.
This attribute has no dynamic effect (it only controls the default state of the element).
This video (an advertisement) autoplays, but to avoid annoying users, it does so without sound та allows the user to turn the sound on.
<video src="adverts.cgi?kind=video" controls autoplay loop muted></video>
Objects implementing the TimeRanges
interface represent a list of ranges (periods) of time.
interface TimeRanges { readonly attribute unsigned long length; double start(unsigned long index); double end(unsigned long index); };
length
Returns the number of ranges in the object.
start
(index)Returns the time for the start of the range with the given index.
Throws an IndexSizeError
exception if the index is out of range.
end
(index)Returns the time for the end of the range with the given index.
Throws an IndexSizeError
exception if the index is out of range.
The length
IDL attribute must return the number of ranges represented by the
object.
The start(index)
method must return
the position of the start of the indexth
range represented by the object, in seconds measured from the start of
the timeline that the object covers.
The end(index)
method must return
the position of the end of the indexth
range represented by the object, in seconds measured from the start of
the timeline that the object covers.
These methods must throw IndexSizeError
exceptions if called with an index
argument greater than or equal to the number of ranges represented by
the object.
When a TimeRanges
object is
said to be a normalized TimeRanges
object, the ranges it represents must obey the following
criteria:
In other words, the ranges in such an object are ordered, don't overlap, aren't empty та don't touch (adjacent ranges are folded into one bigger range).
Ranges in a TimeRanges
object
must be inclusive.
Thus, the end of a range would be equal to the start of a following adjacent (touching but not overlapping) range. Similarly, a range covering a whole timeline anchored at zero would have a start equal to zero and an end equal to the duration of the timeline.
The timelines used by the objects returned by the buffered
, seekable
and played
IDL attributes of media elements must be that element's media
timeline.
[Constructor(DOMString type, optional TrackEventInit eventInitDict)] interface TrackEvent : Event { readonly attribute (VideoTrack or AudioTrack or TextTrack) track; }; dictionary TrackEventInit : EventInit { (VideoTrack or AudioTrack or TextTrack) track; };
track
Returns the track object (TextTrack
,
AudioTrack
, or VideoTrack
)
to which the event relates.
The track
attribute must return the value it was initialized to. When the object
is created, this attribute must be initialized to null. It represents
the context information for the event.
Цей розділ не є нормативним.
The following events fire on media elements as part of the processing model described above:
Event name | Interface | Fired when... | Preconditions |
---|---|---|---|
loadstart
|
Event |
The user agent begins looking for media data, as part of the resource selection algorithm. | networkState
equals NETWORK_LOADING
|
progress
|
Event |
The user agent is fetching media data. | networkState
equals NETWORK_LOADING
|
suspend
|
Event |
The user agent is intentionally not currently fetching media data. | networkState
equals NETWORK_IDLE
|
abort
|
Event |
The user agent stops fetching the media data before it is completely downloaded, but not due to an error. | error
is an object with the code MEDIA_ERR_ABORTED .
networkState
equals either NETWORK_EMPTY
or NETWORK_IDLE ,
depending on when the download was aborted. |
error
|
Event |
An error occurs while fetching the media data. | error
is an object with the code MEDIA_ERR_NETWORK
or higher. networkState
equals either NETWORK_EMPTY
or NETWORK_IDLE ,
depending on when the download was aborted. |
emptied
|
Event |
A media element whose networkState was
previously not in the NETWORK_EMPTY state
has just switched to that state (either because of a fatal error
during load that's about to be reported, or because the load() method was invoked
while the resource
selection algorithm was already running). |
networkState
is NETWORK_EMPTY ;
all the IDL attributes are in their initial states. |
stalled
|
Event |
The user agent is trying to fetch media data, but data is unexpectedly not forthcoming. | networkState
is NETWORK_LOADING .
|
loadedmetadata
|
Event |
The user agent has just determined the duration and dimensions of the media resource and the text tracks are ready. | readyState
is newly equal to HAVE_METADATA or
greater for the first time. |
loadeddata
|
Event |
The user agent can render the media data at the current playback position for the first time. | readyState
newly increased to HAVE_CURRENT_DATA
or greater for the first time. |
canplay
|
Event |
The user agent can resume playback of the media data, but estimates that if playback were to be started now, the media resource could not be rendered at the current playback rate up to its end without having to stop for further buffering of content. | readyState
newly increased to HAVE_FUTURE_DATA
or greater. |
canplaythrough
|
Event |
The user agent estimates that if playback were to be started now, the media resource could be rendered at the current playback rate all the way to its end without having to stop for further buffering. | readyState
is newly equal to HAVE_ENOUGH_DATA .
|
playing
|
Event |
Playback is ready to start after having been paused or delayed due to lack of media data. | readyState
is newly equal to or greater than HAVE_FUTURE_DATA
and paused
is false, or paused
is newly false and readyState is equal to
or greater than HAVE_FUTURE_DATA .
Even if this event fires, the element might still not be potentially
playing, e.g. if the element is blocked
on its media controller (e.g. because the current
media controller is paused, or another slaved media element is stalled
somehow, or because the media resource
has no data corresponding to the media
controller position), or the element is paused
for user interaction or paused
for in-band content. |
waiting
|
Event |
Playback has stopped because the next frame is not available, but the user agent expects that frame to become available in due course. | readyState
is equal to or less than HAVE_CURRENT_DATA
та paused
is false. Either seeking
є true, or the current
playback position is not contained in any of the ranges in buffered .
It is possible for playback to stop for other reasons without paused
being false, but those reasons do not fire this event (and when
those situations resolve, a separate playing event is not
fired either): e.g. the element is newly blocked
on its media controller, or playback ended, or playback stopped
due to errors, or the element has paused
for user interaction or paused
for in-band content. |
seeking
|
Event |
The seeking
IDL attribute changed to true та the user agent has started seeking
to a new position. |
|
seeked
|
Event |
The seeking
IDL attribute changed to false after the current
playback position was changed. |
|
ended
|
Event |
Playback has stopped because the end of the media resource was reached. | currentTime
equals the end of the media resource;
ended
є true. |
durationchange
|
Event |
The duration
attribute has just been updated. |
|
timeupdate
|
Event |
The current playback position changed as part of normal playback or in an especially interesting way, for example discontinuously. | |
play
|
Event |
The element is no longer paused. Fired after the play() method has returned, or
when the autoplay
attribute has caused playback to begin. |
paused
is newly false. |
pause
|
Event |
The element has been paused. Fired after the pause() method has returned.
|
paused
is newly true. |
ratechange
|
Event |
Either the defaultPlaybackRate
or the playbackRate
attribute has just been updated. |
|
resize
|
Event |
One or both of the videoWidth and videoHeight attributes
have just been updated. |
Media element is a video
element; readyState
is not HAVE_NOTHING
|
volumechange
|
Event |
Either the volume
attribute or the muted
attribute has changed. Fired after the relevant attribute's setter
has returned. |
|
The following events fire on MediaController
objects:
Event name | Interface | Fired when... |
---|---|---|
emptied
|
Event |
All the slaved media elements
newly have readyState
set to HAVE_NOTHING
or greater, or there are no longer any slaved
media elements. |
loadedmetadata
|
Event |
All the slaved media elements
newly have readyState
set to HAVE_METADATA
or greater. |
loadeddata
|
Event |
All the slaved media elements
newly have readyState
set to HAVE_CURRENT_DATA
or greater. |
canplay
|
Event |
All the slaved media elements
newly have readyState
set to HAVE_FUTURE_DATA
or greater. |
canplaythrough
|
Event |
All the slaved media elements
newly have readyState
set to HAVE_ENOUGH_DATA
or greater. |
playing
|
Event |
The MediaController
is no longer a blocked media
controller. |
ended
|
Event |
The MediaController
has reached the end of all the slaved
media elements. |
waiting
|
Event |
The MediaController
is now a blocked media
controller. |
ended
|
Event |
All the slaved media elements have newly ended playback. |
durationchange
|
Event |
The duration
attribute has just been updated. |
timeupdate
|
Event |
The media controller position changed. |
play
|
Event |
The paused
attribute is newly false. |
pause
|
Event |
The paused
attribute is newly true. |
ratechange
|
Event |
Either the defaultPlaybackRate
attribute or the playbackRate
attribute has just been updated. |
volumechange
|
Event |
Either the volume attribute
or the muted
attribute has just been updated. |
The following events fire on AudioTrackList
,
VideoTrackList
та TextTrackList
objects:
Event name | Interface | Fired when... |
---|---|---|
change
|
Event |
One or more tracks in the track list has been enabled or disabled. |
addtrack
|
TrackEvent |
A track has been added to the track list. |
removetrack
|
TrackEvent |
A track has been removed from the track list. |
The main security and privacy implications of the video
and audio
elements come
from the ability to embed media cross-origin. There are two directions
that threats can flow: from hostile content to a victim page та from a
hostile page to victim content.
Якщо a victim page embeds hostile content, the threat is that the
content might contain scripted code that attempts to interact with the Document
that embeds the content. To
avoid this, user agents must ensure that there is no access from the
content to the embedding page. In the case of media content that uses
DOM concepts, the embedded content must be treated as if it was in its
own unrelated top-level browsing
context.
For instance, if an SVG animation was embedded in a video
element, the user agent
would not give it access to the DOM of the outer page. From the
perspective of scripts in the SVG resource, the SVG file would appear to
be in a lone top-level browsing context with no parent.
Якщо a hostile page embeds victim content, the threat is that the
embedding page could obtain information from the content that it would
not otherwise have access to. The API does expose some information: the
existence of the media, its type, its duration, its size та the
performance characteristics of its host. Such information is already
potentially problematic, but in practice the same information can more
or less be obtained using the img
element та so it has been deemed acceptable.
However, significantly more sensitive information could be obtained if
the user agent further exposes metadata within the content such as
subtitles or chapter titles. Such information is therefore only exposed
if the video resource passes a CORS resource
sharing check. The crossorigin
attribute
allows authors to control how this check is performed. [CORS]
Without this restriction, an attacker could trick a user running within a corporate network into visiting a site that attempts to load a video from a previously leaked location on the corporation's intranet. Якщо such a video included confidential plans for a new product, then being able to read the subtitles would present a serious confidentiality breach.
Цей розділ не є нормативним.
Playing audio and video resources on small devices such as set-top boxes
or mobile phones is often constrained by limited hardware resources in the
device. For example, a device might only support three simultaneous
videos. For this reason, it is a good practice to release resources held
by media
elements when they are done playing, either by being very careful
about removing all references to the element and allowing it to be garbage
collected, or, even better, by removing the element's src
attribute and any source
element descendants та invoking the element's load()
method.
Similarly, when the playback rate не є точно 1.0, hardware, software, or format limitations can cause video frames to be dropped and audio to be choppy or muted.
Цей розділ не є нормативним.
How accurately various aspects of the media element API are implemented is considered a quality-of-implementation issue.
For example, when implementing the buffered
attribute, how precise an implementation reports the ranges that have
been buffered depends on how carefully the user agent inspects the data.
Since the API reports ranges as times, but the data is obtained in byte
streams, a user agent receiving a variable-bit-rate stream might only be
able to determine precise times by actually decoding all of the data.
User agents aren't required to do this, however; they can instead return
estimates (e.g. based on the average bit rate seen so far) which get
revised as more information becomes available.
As a general rule, user agents are urged to be conservative rather than optimistic. For example, it would be bad to report that everything had been buffered when it had not.
Another quality-of-implementation issue would be playing a video backwards when the codec is designed only for forward playback (e.g. there aren't many key frames та they are far apart та the intervening frames only have deltas from the previous frame). User agents could do a poor job, e.g. only showing key frames; however, better implementations would do more work and thus do a better job, e.g. actually decoding parts of the video forwards, storing the complete frames та then playing the frames backwards.
Similarly, while implementations are allowed to drop buffered data at any time (there is no requirement that a user agent keep all the media data obtained for the lifetime of the media element), it is again a quality of implementation issue: user agents with sufficient resources to keep all the data around are encouraged to do so, as this allows for a better user experience. For example, if the user is watching a live stream, a user agent could allow the user only to view the live video; however, a better user agent would buffer everything and allow the user to seek through the earlier material, pause it, play it forwards and backwards, etc.
When multiple tracks are synchronised with a MediaController
,
it is possible for scripts to add and remove media elements from the MediaController
's list of slaved
media elements, even while these tracks are playing. How smoothly
the media plays back in such situations is another
quality-of-implementation issue.
When a media element that is paused is removed from a document and not reinserted before the next time the event loop spins, implementations що є resource constrained are encouraged to take that opportunity to release all hardware resources (like video planes, networking resources та data buffers) used by the media element. (User agents still have to keep track of the playback position and so forth, though, in case playback is later restarted.)
map
elementname
- Name of image map to reference from the usemap
attributeinterface HTMLMapElement : HTMLElement { attribute DOMString name; readonly attribute HTMLCollection areas; readonly attribute HTMLCollection images; };
The map
element, in
conjunction with an img
element and any area
element
descendants, defines an image map. The element represents its children.
The name
attribute gives the map a name so that it can be referenced. The attribute
must be present and must have a non-empty value with no space characters. The value of the name
attribute must not be a compatibility-caseless match for
the value of the name
attribute of another map
element in the same document. Якщо the id
attribute is also specified,
both attributes must have the same value.
areas
Returns an HTMLCollection
of the area
elements in
the map
.
images
Returns an HTMLCollection
of the img
and object
elements that use the
map
.
The areas
attribute must return an HTMLCollection
rooted at the map
element,
whose filter matches only area
elements.
The images
attribute must return an HTMLCollection
rooted at the Document
node, whose
filter matches only img
and
object
elements що є
associated with this map
element according to the image map processing
model.
The IDL attribute name
must reflect the content attribute of the same
name.
Image maps can be defined in conjunction with other content on the page, to ease maintenance. This example is of a page with an image map at the top of the page and a corresponding set of text links at the bottom.
<!DOCTYPE HTML> <TITLE>Babies™: Toys</TITLE> <HEADER> <H1>Toys</H1> <IMG SRC="/images/menu.gif" ALT="Babies™ navigation menu. Select a department to go to its page." USEMAP="#NAV"> </HEADER> ... <FOOTER> <MAP NAME="NAV"> <P> <A HREF="/clothes/">Clothes</A> <AREA ALT="Clothes" COORDS="0,0,100,50" HREF="/clothes/"> | <A HREF="/toys/">Toys</A> <AREA ALT="Toys" COORDS="0,0,100,50" HREF="/toys/"> | <A HREF="/food/">Food</A> <AREA ALT="Food" COORDS="0,0,100,50" HREF="/food/"> | <A HREF="/books/">Books</A> <AREA ALT="Books" COORDS="0,0,100,50" HREF="/books/"> </MAP> </FOOTER>
area
elementmap
element ancestor or a template
element ancestor.alt
- Replacement text for use when images are not availablecoords
- Coordinates for the shape to be created in an image
mapdownload
- Whether to download the resource instead of navigating to it та its
file name if sohref
- Address of the hyperlinkhreflang
- Language of the linked resourcerel
Relationship between the document containing the hyperlink and the
destination resourceshape
- The kind of shape to be created in an image maptarget
- Browsing context for hyperlink
navigationtype
- Hint for the type of the referenced resourcelink
role
(default - do not set).aria-*
attributes applicable
to the allowed roles.interface HTMLAreaElement : HTMLElement { attribute DOMString alt; attribute DOMString coords; attribute DOMString shape; attribute DOMString target; attribute DOMString download; attribute DOMString rel; readonly attribute DOMTokenList relList; attribute DOMString hreflang; attribute DOMString type; }; HTMLAreaElement implements URLUtils;
The area
element represents
either a hyperlink with some text and a corresponding area on an image
map, or a dead area on an image map.
An area
element with a
parent node must have a map
element ancestor or a template
element ancestor.
Якщо the area
element has
an href
attribute, then the area
element represents a hyperlink. In this case,
the alt
attribute must be present. It specifies the text of the hyperlink. Its
value must be text that, when presented with the texts specified for the
other hyperlinks of the image map та with the
alternative text of the image, but without the image itself, provides the
user with the same kind of choice as the hyperlink would when used without
its text but with its shape applied to the image. The alt
attribute may be left blank if
there is another area
element in the same image map that points to the
same resource and has a non-blank alt
attribute.
Якщо the area
element has
no href
attribute, then the area represented by the element cannot be selected та
the alt
attribute must be omitted.
In both cases, the shape
and coords
attributes specify the area.
The shape
attribute is an enumerated attribute.
The following table lists the keywords defined for this attribute. The
states given in the first cell of the rows with keywords give the states
to which those keywords map. Some of the keywords are
non-conforming, as noted in the last column.
State | Keywords | Notes |
---|---|---|
Circle state | circle
|
|
circ |
Non-conforming | |
Default state | default
|
|
Polygon state | poly
|
|
polygon |
Non-conforming | |
Rectangle state | rect
|
|
rectangle
|
Non-conforming |
The attribute may be omitted. The missing value default is the rectangle state.
The coords
attribute must, if specified, contain a valid
list of integers. This attribute gives the coordinates for the shape
described by the shape
attribute. The processing for this attribute is
described as part of the image map processing
model.
In the circle
state, area
elements
must have a coords
attribute present, with three integers, the last of which must be
non-negative. The first integer must be the distance in CSS pixels from
the left edge of the image to the center of the circle, the second integer
must be the distance in CSS pixels from the top edge of the image to the
center of the circle та the third integer must be the radius of the
circle, again in CSS pixels.
In the default
state state, area
elements must not have a coords
attribute. (The area is the whole image.)
In the polygon
state, area
elements
must have a coords
attribute with at least six integers та the number of integers must be
even. Each pair of integers must represent a coordinate given as the
distances from the left and the top of the image in CSS pixels
respectively та all the coordinates together must represent the points of
the polygon, in order.
In the rectangle
state, area
elements
must have a coords
attribute with exactly four integers, the first of which must be less than
the third та the second of which must be less than the fourth. The four
points must represent, respectively, the distance from the left edge of
the image to the left side of the rectangle, the distance from the top
edge to the top side, the distance from the left edge to the right side та
the distance from the top edge to the bottom side, all in CSS pixels.
When user agents allow users to follow hyperlinks or download hyperlinks created using
the area
element, as
described in the next section, the href
, target
, download
та
attributes decide how the link is followed. The rel
, hreflang
та type
attributes may be used
to indicate to the user the likely nature of the target resource before
the user follows the link.
The target
,
download
,
rel
,
hreflang
та type
attributes must be omitted if the href
attribute is not present.
The activation behavior of area
elements is to run the
following steps:
Якщо the area
element's Document
is not fully active, then abort these steps.
Якщо the area
element
has a download
attribute and the algorithm is not allowed
to show a popup, or the element's target
attribute is
present and applying the
rules for choosing a browsing context given a browsing context
name, using the value of the target
attribute as the
browsing context name, would result in there not being a chosen
browsing context, тоді виконайте ці субкроки:
Якщо there is an entry
settings object, throw an InvalidAccessError
exception.
Abort these steps without following the hyperlink.
Інакше the user agent must follow the hyperlink or download the hyperlink created
by the area
element,
if any та as determined by the download
attribute
and any expressed user preference.
The IDL attributes alt
,
coords
,
target
,
download
,
rel
,
hreflang
та type
,
each must reflect the respective content
attributes of the same name.
The IDL attribute shape
must reflect the shape
content attribute.
The IDL attribute relList
must reflect the rel
content attribute.
The area
element also
supports the URLUtils
interface. [URL]
When the element is created та whenever the element's href
content attribute is
set, changed, or removed, the user agent must invoke the element's URLUtils
interface's set the input algorithm with the
value of the href
content attribute, if any, or the empty string otherwise, as the given
value.
The element's URLUtils
interface's get
the base algorithm must simply return the
element's base URL.
The element's URLUtils
interface's query
encoding is the document's
character encoding.
When the element's URLUtils
interface invokes its update
steps with a string value, the
user agent must set the element's href
content attribute to the
string value.
An image map allows geometric areas on an image to be associated with hyperlinks.
An image, in the form of an img
element or an object
element representing an image, may be associated with an image map (in the
form of a map
element) by
specifying a usemap
attribute on the img
or object
element. The usemap
attribute, if
specified, must be a valid hash-name
reference to a map
element.
Consider an image that looks as follows:
Якщо we wanted just the colored areas to be clickable, we could do it as follows:
<p> Please select a shape: <img src="shapes.png" usemap="#shapes" alt="Four shapes are available: a red hollow box, a green circle, a blue triangle та a yellow four-pointed star."> <map name="shapes"> <area shape=rect coords="50,50,100,100"> <!-- the hole in the red box --> <area shape=rect coords="25,25,125,125" href="red.html" alt="Red box."> <area shape=circle coords="200,75,50" href="green.html" alt="Green circle."> <area shape=poly coords="325,25,262,125,388,125" href="blue.html" alt="Blue triangle."> <area shape=poly coords="450,25,435,60,400,75,435,90,450,125,465,90,500,75,465,60" href="yellow.html" alt="Yellow star."> </map> </p>
Якщо an img
element or an
object
element
representing an image has a usemap
attribute specified,
user agents must process it as follows:
First, rules
for parsing a hash-name reference to a map
element must be followed. Це буде повертати або element (the map)
or null.
Якщо that returned null, then abort these steps. The image is not associated with an image map after all.
Інакше the user agent must collect all the area
elements що є descendants of the map.
Нехай those be the areas.
Having obtained the list of area
elements that form the image map (the areas),
interactive user agents must process the list in one of two ways.
Якщо the user agent intends to show the text that the img
element represents, then it must use the following steps.
In user agents that do not support images, or that have
images disabled, object
elements cannot represent images та thus this section never applies (the
fallback content is shown instead). The
following steps therefore only apply to img
elements.
Remove all the area
elements in areas that have no href
attribute.
Remove all the area
elements in areas that have no alt
attribute, or whose alt
attribute's value is the empty string, if there is another
area
element in areas
with the same value in the href
attribute and with a
non-empty alt
attribute.
Each remaining area
element in areas represents a hyperlink.
Those hyperlinks should all be made available to the user in a
manner associated with the text of the img
.
In this context, user agents may represent area
and img
elements with
no specified alt
attributes, or
whose alt
attributes are the empty
string or some other non-visible text, in a user-agent-defined
fashion intended to indicate the lack of suitable author-provided
text.
Якщо the user agent intends to show the image and allow interaction
with the image to select hyperlinks, then the image must be associated
with a set of layered shapes, taken from the area
elements in areas, in reverse tree order
(so the last specified area
element in the map is the bottom-most
shape та the first element in the map,
in tree order, is the top-most shape).
Each area
element in areas must be processed as follows щоб
отримати a shape to layer onto the image:
Find the state that the element's shape
attribute represents.
Use the rules for
parsing a list of integers to parse the element's coords
attribute, if it is
present та let the result be the coords
list. Якщо the attribute is absent, let the coords
list be the empty list.
Якщо the number of items in the coords
list is less than the minimum number given for the area
element's current state, as per the following table, then the shape
is empty; abort these steps.
State | Minimum number of items |
---|---|
Circle state | 3 |
Default state | 0 |
Polygon state | 6 |
Rectangle state | 4 |
Check for excess items in the coords
list as per the entry in the following list corresponding to the shape
attribute's state:
Якщо the shape
attribute represents the rectangle state та the first
number in the list is numerically less than the third number in the
list, then swap those two numbers around.
Якщо the shape
attribute represents the rectangle state та the second
number in the list is numerically less than the fourth number in the
list, then swap those two numbers around.
Якщо the shape
attribute represents the circle state та the third
number in the list is less than or equal to zero, then the shape is
empty; abort these steps.
Now, the shape represented by the element is the one described for
the entry in the list below corresponding to the state of the shape
attribute:
Нехай x be the first number in coords, y be the second number та r be the third number.
The shape is a circle whose center is x CSS pixels from the left edge of the image and y CSS pixels from the top edge of the image та whose radius is r pixels.
The shape is a rectangle that exactly covers the entire image.
Нехай xi be the (2i)th entry in coords та yi be the (2i+1)th entry in coords (the first entry in coords being the one with index 0).
Нехай the coordinates be (xi, yi), interpreted in CSS pixels measured from the top left of the image, for all integer values of i from 0 to (N/2)-1, where N is the number of items in coords.
The shape is a polygon whose vertices are given by the coordinates та whose interior is established using the even-odd rule. [GRAPHICS]
Нехай x1 be the first number in coords, y1 be the second number, x2 be the third number та y2 be the fourth number.
The shape is a rectangle whose top-left corner is given by the coordinate (x1, y1) and whose bottom right corner is given by the coordinate (x2, y2), those coordinates being interpreted as CSS pixels from the top left corner of the image.
For historical reasons, the coordinates must be interpreted
relative to the displayed image after any stretching
caused by the CSS 'width' and 'height' properties (or, for non-CSS
browsers, the image element's width
and height
attributes — CSS
browsers map those attributes to the aforementioned CSS properties).
Browser zoom features and transforms applied using CSS or SVG do not affect the coordinates.
Pointing device interaction with an image associated with a set of
layered shapes per the above algorithm must result in the relevant user
interaction events being first fired to the top-most shape covering the
point that the pointing device indicated, if any, or to the image
element itself, if there is no shape covering that point. User agents
may also allow individual area
elements representing hyperlinks
to be selected and activated (e.g. using a keyboard).
Because a map
element (and its area
elements) can be associated with multiple img
and object
elements, it
is possible for an area
element to correspond to multiple focusable areas of the document.
Image maps are live; if the DOM is mutated, then the user agent must act as if it had rerun the algorithms for image maps.
The math
element from the MathML
namespace falls into the embedded
content, phrasing content та flow content categories for the purposes of
the content models in this specification.
User agents must handle text other than inter-element
whitespace found in MathML elements whose content models do not
allow straight text by pretending for the purposes of MathML content
models, layout та rendering that that text is actually wrapped in an mtext
element in the MathML
namespace. (Such text is not, however, conforming.)
User agents must act as if any MathML element whose contents does not
match the element's content model was replaced, for the purposes of
MathML layout and rendering, by an merror
element in the MathML namespace
containing some appropriate error message.
To enable authors to use MathML tools that only accept MathML in its XML form, interactive HTML user agents are encouraged to provide a way to export any MathML fragment as an XML namespace-well-formed XML fragment.
The semantics of MathML elements are defined by the MathML specification and other applicable specifications. [MATHML]
Here is an example of the use of MathML in an HTML document:
<!DOCTYPE html> <html> <head> <title>The quadratic formula</title> </head> <body> <h1>The quadratic formula</h1> <p> <math> <mi>x</mi> <mo>=</mo> <mfrac> <mrow> <mo form="prefix">−</mo> <mi>b</mi> <mo>±</mo> <msqrt> <msup> <mi>b</mi> <mn>2</mn> </msup> <mo>−</mo> <mn>4</mn> <mo></mo> <mi>a</mi> <mo></mo> <mi>c</mi> </msqrt> </mrow> <mrow> <mn>2</mn> <mo></mo> <mi>a</mi> </mrow> </mfrac> </math> </p> </body> </html>
The svg
element from the SVG
namespace falls into the embedded
content, phrasing content та flow content categories for the purposes of
the content models in this specification.
To enable authors to use SVG tools that only accept SVG in its XML form, interactive HTML user agents are encouraged to provide a way to export any SVG fragment as an XML namespace-well-formed XML fragment.
When the SVG foreignObject
element
contains elements from the простір імен HTML,
such elements must all be flow content. [SVG]
The content model for title
elements in
the SVG namespace inside HTML
documents is phrasing content.
(This further constrains the requirements given in the SVG specification.)
The semantics of SVG elements are defined by the SVG specification and other applicable specifications. [SVG]
The SVG specification includes requirements regarding the handling of
elements in the DOM що є not in the SVG namespace, що є in SVG fragments
та що є not included in a foreignObject
element. This specification does not define any processing for
elements in SVG fragments що є not in the простір імен HTML; they are
considered neither conforming nor non-conforming from the perspective of
this specification.
Author requirements: The width
and height
attributes on img
, iframe
, embed
,
object
, video
та, when their type
attribute is in the Image
Button state, input
elements may be specified to give the dimensions of the visual content of
the element (the width and height respectively, relative to the nominal
direction of the output medium), in CSS pixels. The attributes, if
specified, must have values що є valid non-negative integers.
The specified dimensions given may differ from the dimensions specified in the resource itself, since the resource may have a resolution that differs from the CSS pixel resolution. (On screens, CSS pixels have a resolution of 96ppi, but in general the CSS pixel resolution depends on the reading distance.) Якщо both attributes are specified, then one of the following statements must be true:
The target ratio is the ratio of the
intrinsic width to the intrinsic height in the resource. The specified
width and specified height are the
values of the width
and height
attributes respectively.
The two attributes must be omitted if the resource in question does not have both an intrinsic width and an intrinsic height.
Якщо the two attributes are both zero, it indicates that the element is not intended for the user (e.g. it might be a part of a service to count page views).
The dimension attributes are not intended to be used to stretch the image.
User agent requirements: User agents are expected to use these attributes as hints for the rendering.
The width
and height
IDL attributes on the iframe
,
embed
, object
та video
elements must reflect the respective content attributes of the
same name.
For iframe
,
embed
та object
the IDL attributes are DOMString
; for video
the IDL attributes are unsigned long
.
The corresponding IDL attributes for img
and input
elements are defined in
those respective elements' sections, as they are slightly more specific
to those elements' other behaviors.
Links are a conceptual construct, created by a
,
area
та link
elements, that represent
a connection between two resources, one of which is the current Document
. There are two kinds of links in
HTML:
These are links to resources що є to be used to augment the current document, generally automatically processed by the user agent.
These are links to other resources що є generally exposed to the user by the user agent so that the user can cause the user agent to navigate to those resources, e.g. to visit them in a browser or download them.
For link
elements with an href
attribute and a rel
attribute, links must be created for the keywords of the rel
attribute, as defined for those
keywords in the link types section.
Similarly, for a
and area
elements with an href
attribute and a rel
attribute, links must be
created for the keywords of the rel
attribute as defined for
those keywords in the link types section. Unlike
link
elements, however, a
and area
element with an href
attribute that either do not have a rel
attribute, or whose rel
attribute has no keywords що
є defined as specifying hyperlinks,
must also create a hyperlink. This implied
hyperlink has no special meaning (it has no link
type) beyond linking the element's document to the resource given by
the element's href
attribute.
A hyperlink can have one or more hyperlink annotations that modify the processing semantics of that hyperlink.
a
and area
elementsThe href
attribute on a
and area
elements must have a value that is a valid
URL potentially surrounded by spaces.
The href
attribute on a
and area
elements is not required; when those elements do not have href
attributes they do not
create hyperlinks.
The target
attribute, if present, must be a valid
browsing context name or keyword. It gives the name of the browsing
context that will be used. User agents use this
name when following hyperlinks.
When an a
or area
element's activation behavior is
invoked, the user agent may allow the user to indicate a preference
regarding whether the hyperlink is to be used for navigation or whether the resource it specifies is
to be downloaded.
In the absence of a user preference, the default should be navigation if
the element has no download
attribute та should be to download the specified resource if it does.
Whether determined by the user's preferences or via the presence or absence of the attribute, if the decision is to use the hyperlink for navigation then the user agent must follow the hyperlink та if the decision is to use the hyperlink to download a resource, the user agent must download the hyperlink. These terms are defined in subsequent sections below.
The download
attribute, if present, indicates that the author intends the hyperlink to
be used for downloading a resource. The attribute may have a value; the
value, if any, specifies the default file name that the author recommends
for use in labeling the resource in a local file system. There are no
restrictions on allowed values, but authors are cautioned that most file
systems have limitations with regard to what punctuation is supported in
file names та user agents are likely to adjust file names accordingly.
The rel
attribute on a
and area
elements controls what kinds of links the elements create. The attribute's
value must be a set of
space-separated tokens. The allowed keywords
and their meanings are defined below.
The rel
attribute has no default value. Якщо the attribute is omitted or if none
of the values in the attribute are recognized by the user agent, then the
document has no particular relationship with the destination resource
other than there being a hyperlink between the two.
The hreflang
attribute on a
and area
elements that create hyperlinks,
if present, gives the language of the linked resource. It is purely
advisory. The value must be a valid BCP 47 language tag. [BCP47]
User agents must not consider this attribute
authoritative — upon fetching the resource, user agents must use only
language information associated with the resource to determine its
language, not metadata included in the link to the resource.
The type
attribute, if present, gives the MIME type of
the linked resource. It is purely advisory. The value must be a valid
MIME type. User agents must not consider the type
attribute authoritative — upon fetching the resource, user agents must
not use metadata included in the link to the resource to determine its
type.
When a user follows a hyperlink created by an element subject, the user agent must run the following steps:
Нехай replace be false.
Нехай source be the browsing
context that contains the Document
object with which subject in
question is associated.
Якщо the user indicated a specific browsing context when following the hyperlink, or if the user agent is configured to follow hyperlinks by navigating a particular browsing context, then let target be that browsing context.
Інакше if subject is an a
or area
element that
has a target
attribute, then let target be the browsing context that is chosen by
applying the
rules for choosing a browsing context given a browsing context
name, using the value of the target
attribute as the
browsing context name. Якщо these rules result in the creation of a
new browsing context, set replace
to true.
Інакше if target is an a
or area
element with
no target
attribute, but the Document
contains a base
element with a target
attribute, then let target be the browsing context that is chosen by
applying the
rules for choosing a browsing context given a browsing context
name, using the value of the target
attribute of the
first such base
element as the browsing context name. Якщо these rules result in the
creation of a new browsing context,
set replace to true.
Інакше let target be the browsing context that subject itself is in.
Resolve
the URL given by the href
attribute of that
element, relative to that element.
Якщо that is successful, let URL be the resulting absolute URL.
Інакше if resolving the URL failed, the user agent may report the error to the user in a user-agent-specific manner, may queue a task to navigate the target browsing context to an error page to report the error, or may ignore the error and do nothing. In any case, the user agent must then abort these steps.
In the case of server-side image maps, append the hyperlink suffix to URL.
Queue a task to navigate the target browsing context to URL. Якщо replace є true, the navigation must be performed with replacement enabled. The source browsing context must be source.
The task source for the tasks mentioned above is the DOM manipulation task source.
In some cases, resources are intended for later use rather than immediate
viewing. To indicate that a resource is intended to be downloaded for use
later, rather than immediately used, the download
attribute can be
specified on the a
or area
element that creates the hyperlink to that resource.
The attribute can furthermore be given a value, to specify the file name
that user agents are to use when storing the resource in a file system.
This value can be overridden by the Content-Disposition
HTTP header's filename parameters. [RFC6266]
In cross-origin situations, the download
attribute has to
be combined with the Content-Disposition
HTTP header, specifically with the attachment
disposition type, to avoid the user being warned of possibly nefarious
activity. (This is to protect users from being made to download sensitive
personal or confidential information without their full understanding.)
When a user downloads a hyperlink created by an element, the user agent must run the following steps:
Resolve
the URL given by the href
attribute of that
element, relative to that element.
Якщо resolving the URL fails, the user agent may report the error to the user in a user-agent-specific manner, may navigate to an error page to report the error, or may ignore the error and do nothing. In either case, the user agent must abort these steps.
Інакше let URL be the resulting absolute URL.
In the case of server-side image maps, append the hyperlink suffix to URL.
Повернутиto whatever algorithm invoked these steps and continue these steps asynchronously.
Fetch URL and handle the resulting resource as a download.
When a user agent is to handle a resource obtained from a fetch algorithm as a download, it should provide the user with a way to save the resource for later use, if a resource is successfully obtained; or otherwise should report any problems downloading the file to the user.
Якщо the user agent needs a file name for a resource being handled as a download, it should select one using the following algorithm.
This algorithm is intended to mitigate security dangers involved in downloading files from untrusted sites та user agents are strongly urged to follow it.
Нехай filename be the void value.
Якщо the resource has a Content-Disposition
header, that header specifies the attachment
disposition type та the header includes file name information, then
let filename have the value
specified by the header та jump to the step labeled sanitize
below. [RFC6266]
Нехай interface origin be the origin
of the Document
in which the download
or navigate action resulting in the
download was initiated, if any.
Нехай resource origin be the origin
of the URL of the resource being downloaded, unless that URL's scheme component is data
,
in which case let resource origin be
the same as the interface origin, if
any.
Якщо there is no interface origin, then let trusted operation be true. Інакше let trusted operation be true if resource origin is the same origin as interface origin та false otherwise.
Якщо trusted operation є true and
the resource has a Content-Disposition
header and that header includes file name information, then let filename have the value specified by the
header та jump to the step labeled sanitize below. [RFC6266]
Якщо the download was not initiated from a hyperlink
created by an a
or area
element, or if the
element of the hyperlink from which it was
initiated did not have a download
attribute
when the download was initiated, or if there was such an attribute
but its value when the download was initiated was the empty string,
then jump to the step labeled no proposed file name.
Нехай proposed filename have the
value of the download
attribute of the element of the hyperlink
that initiated the download at the time the download was initiated.
Якщо trusted operation є true, let filename have the value of proposed filename та jump to the step labeled sanitize below.
Якщо the resource has a Content-Disposition
header and that header specifies the attachment
disposition type, let filename have
the value of proposed filename та
jump to the step labeled sanitize below. [RFC6266]
No proposed file name: Якщо trusted operation є true, or if the user indicated a preference for having the resource in question downloaded, let filename have a value derived from the URL of the resource in a user-agent-defined manner та jump to the step labeled sanitize below.
Act in a user-agent-defined manner to safeguard the user from a potentially hostile cross-origin download. Якщо the download is not to be aborted, then let filename be set to the user's preferred file name or to a file name selected by the user agent та jump to the step labeled sanitize below.
Якщо the algorithm reaches this step, then a download was begun
from a different origin than the resource being downloaded та the
origin did not mark the file as suitable for downloading та the
download was not initiated by the user. This could be because a download
attribute was used to trigger the download, or because the
resource in question is not of a type that the user agent
supports.
This could be dangerous, because, for instance, a hostile server could be trying to get a user to unknowingly download private information and then re-upload it to the hostile server, by tricking the user into thinking the data is from the hostile server.
Thus, it is in the user's interests that the user be somehow notified that the resource in question comes from quite a different source та to prevent confusion, any suggested file name from the potentially hostile interface origin should be ignored.
Sanitize: Optionally, allow the user to influence filename. For example, a user agent could prompt the user for a file name, potentially providing the value of filename as determined above as a default value.
Adjust filename to be suitable for the local file system.
For example, this could involve removing characters що є not legal in file names, or trimming leading and trailing whitespace.
Якщо the platform conventions do not in any way use extensions to determine the types of file on the file system, then return filename as the file name and abort these steps.
Нехай claimed type be the type given by the resource's Content-Type metadata, if any is known. Нехай named type be the type given by filename's extension, if any is known. For the purposes of this step, a type is a mapping of a MIME type to an extension.
Якщо named type is consistent with the user's preferences (e.g. because the value of filename was determined by prompting the user), then return filename as the file name and abort these steps.
Якщо claimed type and named type are the same type (i.e. the type given by the resource's Content-Type metadata is consistent with the type given by filename's extension), then return filename as the file name and abort these steps.
Якщо the claimed type is known, then alter filename to add an extension corresponding to claimed type.
Інакше if named type is known to be
potentially dangerous (e.g. it will be treated by the platform
conventions as a native executable, shell script, HTML application,
or executable-macro-capable document) then optionally alter filename
to add a known-safe extension
(e.g. ".txt
").
This last step would make it impossible to download executables, which might not be desirable. As always, implementors are forced to balance security and usability in this matter.
Повернутиfilename as the file name.
For the purposes of this algorithm, a file extension consists of any part of the
file name that platform conventions dictate will be used for identifying
the type of the file. For example, many operating systems use the part
of the file name following the last dot (".
")
in the file name to determine the type of the file та from that the
manner in which the file is to be opened or executed.
User agents should ignore any directory or path information provided by
the resource itself, its URL та any download
attribute, in
deciding where to store the resulting file in the user's file system.
The following table summarizes the link types що є defined by this specification. This table is non-normative; the actual definitions for the link types are given in the next few sections.
In this section, the term referenced document refers to the resource identified by the element representing the link та the term current document refers to the resource within which the element representing the link finds itself.
To determine which link types apply to a link
,
a
, or area
element, the element's rel
attribute
must be split
on spaces. The resulting tokens are the link types that apply to
that element.
Except where otherwise specified, a keyword must not be specified more
than once per rel
attribute.
Link types are always ASCII чутливі до реєстру та must be compared as such.
Thus, rel="next"
is the
same as rel="NEXT"
.
Link type | Effect on... | Brief description | |
---|---|---|---|
link |
a and area |
||
alternate |
Hyperlink | Hyperlink | Gives alternate representations of the current document. |
author |
Hyperlink | Hyperlink | Gives a link to the author of the current document or article. |
bookmark |
not allowed | Hyperlink | Gives the permalink for the nearest ancestor section. |
help |
Hyperlink | Hyperlink | Provides a link to context-sensitive help. |
icon |
External Resource | not allowed | Imports an icon to represent the current document. |
license |
Hyperlink | Hyperlink | Indicates that the main content of the current document is covered by the copyright license described by the referenced document. |
next |
Hyperlink | Hyperlink | Indicates that the current document is a part of a series та that the next document in the series is the referenced document. |
nofollow |
not allowed | Annotation | Indicates that the current document's original author or publisher does not endorse the referenced document. |
noreferrer |
not allowed | Annotation | Requires that the user agent not send an HTTP Referer
(sic) header if the user follows the hyperlink. |
prefetch |
External Resource | External Resource | Specifies that the target resource should be preemptively cached. |
prev |
Hyperlink | Hyperlink | Indicates that the current document is a part of a series та that the previous document in the series is the referenced document. |
search |
Hyperlink | Hyperlink | Gives a link to a resource that can be used to search through the current document and its related pages. |
stylesheet |
External Resource | not allowed | Imports a stylesheet. |
tag |
not allowed | Hyperlink | Gives a tag (identified by the given address) that applies to the current document. |
Some of the types described below list synonyms for these values. These are to be handled as specified by user agents, but must not be used in documents.
alternate
"The alternate
keyword may be used with link
,
a
та area
elements.
The meaning of this keyword depends on the values of the other attributes.
link
element and the rel
attribute also contains the keyword stylesheet
The alternate
keyword modifies the meaning of the stylesheet
keyword in the
way described for that keyword. The alternate
keyword does not create
a link of its own.
alternate
keyword is used with the type
attribute set to the
value application/rss+xml
or the value
application/atom+xml
The keyword creates a hyperlink referencing a syndication feed (though not necessarily syndicating exactly the same content as the current page).
The first link
, a
, or area
element in the document (in tree order) with the alternate
keyword used with the
type
attribute set to the value application/rss+xml
or the value application/atom+xml
must be treated as the default syndication feed for the purposes of
feed autodiscovery.
The following link
element gives the syndication feed for the current page:
<link rel="alternate" type="application/atom+xml" href="data.xml">
The following extract offers various different syndication feeds:
<p>You can access the planets database using Atom feeds:</p> <ul> <li><a href="recently-visited-planets.xml" rel="alternate" type="application/atom+xml">Recently Visited Planets</a></li> <li><a href="known-bad-planets.xml" rel="alternate" type="application/atom+xml">Known Bad Planets</a></li> <li><a href="unexplored-planets.xml" rel="alternate" type="application/atom+xml">Unexplored Planets</a></li> </ul>
The keyword creates a hyperlink referencing an alternate representation of the current document.
The nature of the referenced document is given by the hreflang
та type
attributes.
Якщо the alternate
keyword is used with the hreflang
attribute та
that attribute's value differs from the root
element's language, it indicates that
the referenced document is a translation.
Якщо the alternate
keyword is used with the type
attribute, it
indicates that the referenced document is a reformulation of the
current document in the specified format.
The hreflang
and type
attributes can be combined when specified with the alternate
keyword.
For example, the following link is a French translation that uses the PDF format:
<link rel=alternate type=application/pdf hreflang=fr href=manual-fr>
This relationship is transitive — that is, if a document links to two
other documents with the link type "alternate
", then, in addition to
implying that those documents are alternative representations of the
first document, it is also implying that those two documents are
alternative representations of each other.
author
"The author
keyword may be used with link
,
a
та area
elements. This keyword creates a hyperlink.
For a
and area
elements, the author
keyword indicates that the referenced document provides further
information about the author of the nearest article
element ancestor of the element defining the hyperlink, if there is one,
or of the page as a whole, otherwise.
For link
elements, the author
keyword indicates that the referenced document provides further
information about the author for the page as a whole.
The "referenced document" can be та often is, a mailto:
URL giving the e-mail address of the author. [MAILTO]
Synonyms: For historical reasons, user agents must
also treat link
, a
та area
elements that have a rev
attribute
with the value "made
" as having the author
keyword specified as a
link relationship.
bookmark
"The bookmark
keyword may be used with a
and
area
elements. This keyword
creates a hyperlink.
The bookmark
keyword gives a permalink for the nearest ancestor article
element of the linking element in question, or of the
section the linking element is most closely associated with, if
there are no ancestor article
elements.
The following snippet has three permalinks. A user agent could determine which permalink applies to which part of the spec by looking at where the permalinks are given.
... <body> <h1>Example of permalinks</h1> <div id="a"> <h2>First example</h2> <p><a href="a.html" rel="bookmark">This permalink applies to only the content from the first H2 to the second H2</a>. The DIV isn't exactly that section, but it roughly corresponds to it.</p> </div> <h2>Second example</h2> <article id="b"> <p><a href="b.html" rel="bookmark">This permalink applies to the outer ARTICLE element</a> (which could be, e.g., a blog post).</p> <article id="c"> <p><a href="c.html" rel="bookmark">This permalink applies to the inner ARTICLE element</a> (which could be, e.g., a blog comment).</p> </article> </article> </body> ...
help
"The help
keyword may be used with link
,
a
та area
elements. This keyword creates a hyperlink.
For a
and area
elements, the help
keyword indicates that the referenced document provides further help
information for the parent of the element defining the hyperlink та its
children.
In the following example, the form control has associated context-sensitive help. The user agent could use this information, for example, displaying the referenced document if the user presses the "Help" or "F1" key.
<p><label> Topic: <input name=topic> <a href="help/topic.html" rel="help">(Help)</a></label></p>
For link
elements, the help
keyword indicates that the referenced document provides help for the page
as a whole.
For a
and area
elements, on some browsers, the help
keyword causes the link to use a different cursor.
icon
"The icon
keyword may be used with link
elements. This keyword creates an external resource link.
The specified resource is an icon representing the page or site та should be used by the user agent when representing the page in the user interface.
Icons could be auditory icons, visual icons, or other kinds of icons. Якщо multiple icons are provided, the user agent must
select the most appropriate icon according to the type
, media
та sizes
attributes. Якщо there are
multiple equally appropriate icons, user agents must use the last one
declared in tree order at the time that the
user agent collected the list of icons. Якщо the user agent tries to use
an icon but that icon is determined, upon closer examination, to in fact
be inappropriate (e.g. because it uses an unsupported format), then the
user agent must try the next-most-appropriate icon as determined by the
attributes.
User agents are not required to update icons when the list of icons changes, but are encouraged to do so.
There is no default type for resources given by the icon
keyword. However, for the purposes
of determining the type of the
resource, user agents must expect the resource to be an image.
The sizes
attribute gives the sizes of icons for visual media. Its value, if
present, is merely advisory. User agents may use the value to decide which
icon(s) to use if multiple icons are available.
Якщо specified, the attribute must have a value that is an unordered
set of unique space-separated tokens which are ASCII
чутливі до реєстру. Each value must be either an ASCII
чутливі до реєстру match for the string "any
", or a value that consists
of two valid non-negative
integers that do not have a leading "0" (U+0030) character and що є
separated by a single U+0078 LATIN SMALL LETTER X or U+0058 LATIN CAPITAL
LETTER X character.
The keywords represent icon sizes in raw pixels (as opposed to CSS pixels).
An icon that is 50 CSS pixels wide intended for displays with a device pixel density of two device pixels per CSS pixel (2x, 192dpi) would have a width of 100 raw pixels. This feature does not support indicating that a different resource is to be used for small high-resolution icons vs large low-resolution icons (e.g. 50×50 2x vs 100×100 1x).
To parse and process the attribute's value, the user agent must first split the attribute's value on spaces та must then parse each resulting keyword to determine what it represents.
The any
keyword represents that the resource contains a scalable icon, e.g. as
provided by an SVG image.
Other keywords must be further parsed as follows to determine what they represent:
Якщо the keyword doesn't contain exactly one U+0078 LATIN SMALL LETTER X or U+0058 LATIN CAPITAL LETTER X character, then this keyword doesn't represent anything. Abort these steps for that keyword.
Нехай width string буде рядком
before the "x
" or "X
".
Нехай height string буде рядком
after the "x
" or "X
".
Якщо either width string or height string start with a "0" (U+0030) character or contain any characters other than цифрами ASCII, then this keyword doesn't represent anything. Abort these steps for that keyword.
Apply the rules for parsing non-negative integers to width string щоб отримати width.
Apply the rules for parsing non-negative integers to height string щоб отримати height.
The keyword represents that the resource contains a bitmap icon with a width of width device pixels and a height of height device pixels.
The keywords specified on the sizes
attribute must not represent
icon sizes що є not actually available in the linked resource.
In the absence of a link
with the icon
keyword, for Document
s obtained
over HTTP or HTTPS, user agents may instead attempt to fetch
and use an icon with the absolute URL
obtained by resolving the URL "/favicon.ico
"
against the document's address,
as if the page had declared that icon using the icon
keyword.
The following snippet shows the top part of an application with several icons.
<!DOCTYPE HTML> <html> <head> <title>lsForums — Inbox</title> <link rel=icon href=favicon.png sizes="16x16" type="image/png"> <link rel=icon href=windows.ico sizes="32x32 48x48" type="image/vnd.microsoft.icon"> <link rel=icon href=mac.icns sizes="128x128 512x512 8192x8192 32768x32768"> <link rel=icon href=iphone.png sizes="57x57" type="image/png"> <link rel=icon href=gnome.svg sizes="any" type="image/svg+xml"> <link rel=stylesheet href=lsforums.css> <script src=lsforums.js></script> <meta name=application-name content="lsForums"> </head> <body> ...
For historical reasons, the icon
keyword may be preceded by the keyword "shortcut
".
Якщо the "shortcut
" keyword is present,
it must be come immediately before the icon
keyword and the two keywords must be
separated by only a single U+0020 SPACE character.
license
"The license
keyword may be used with link
,
a
та area
elements. This keyword creates a hyperlink.
The license
keyword indicates that the referenced document provides the copyright
license terms under which the main content of the current document is
provided.
This specification defines the main content of a document and content
that is not deemed to be part of that main content via the main
element. The distinction should be made clear to the user.
Consider a photo sharing site. A page on that site might describe and show a photograph та the page might be marked up as follows:
<!DOCTYPE HTML> <html> <head> <title>Exampl Pictures: Kissat</title> <link rel="stylesheet" href="/style/default"> </head> <body> <h1>Kissat</h1> <nav> <a href="../">Повернутиto photo index</a> </nav> <main> <figure> <img src="/pix/39627052_fd8dcd98b5.jpg"> <figcaption>Kissat</figcaption> </figure> <p>One of them has six toes!</p> <p><small>This photograph is <a rel="license" href="http://www.opensource.org/licenses/mit-license.php">MIT Licensed</a></small></p> </main> <footer> <a href="/">Home</a> | <a href="../">Photo index</a> <p><small>© copyright 2009 Exampl Pictures. All Rights Reserved.</small></p> </footer> </body> </html>
In this case the license
applies to just the photo (the main content of the document), not the
whole document. In particular not the design of the page itself, which
is covered by the copyright given at the bottom of the document. This
should be made clear in the text referencing the licensing link and
could also be made clearer in the styling (e.g. making the license link
prominently positioned near the photograph, while having the page
copyright in small text at the foot of the page, or adding a border to
the main
element.)
Synonyms: For historical reasons, user agents must
also treat the keyword "copyright
" like
the license
keyword.
nofollow
"The nofollow
keyword may be used with a
and
area
elements. This keyword
does not create a hyperlink, but annotates any other hyperlinks created
by the element (the implied hyperlink, if no other keywords create one).
The nofollow
keyword indicates that the link is not endorsed by the original author or
publisher of the page, or that the link to the referenced document was
included primarily because of a commercial relationship between people
affiliated with the two pages.
noreferrer
"The noreferrer
keyword may be used with a
and
area
elements. This keyword
does not create a hyperlink, but annotates any other hyperlinks created
by the element (the implied hyperlink, if no other keywords create one).
It indicates that no referrer information is to be leaked when following the link.
Якщо a user agent follows a link defined by an a
or area
element that has
the noreferrer
keyword, the user agent must not include a Referer
(sic) HTTP header (or equivalent for other
protocols) in the request.
This keyword also causes the opener
attribute to remain null if the hyperlink creates a new browsing
context.
prefetch
"The prefetch
keyword may be used with link
,
a
та area
elements. This keyword creates an external resource link.
The prefetch
keyword indicates that preemptively fetching and caching the specified
resource is likely to be beneficial, as it is highly likely that the user
will require this resource.
There is no default type for resources given by the prefetch
keyword.
search
"The search
keyword may be used with link
,
a
та area
elements. This keyword creates a hyperlink.
The search
keyword indicates that the referenced document provides an interface
specifically for searching the document and its related resources.
OpenSearch description documents can be used with link
elements and the search
link type to enable user
agents to autodiscover search interfaces. [OPENSEARCH]
stylesheet
"The stylesheet
keyword may be used with link
elements. This keyword creates an external resource link that
contributes to the styling processing model.
The specified resource is a resource that describes how to present the document. Exactly how the resource is to be processed depends on the actual type of the resource.
Якщо the alternate
keyword is also specified on the link
element, then the link is
an alternative stylesheet; in this case, the title
attribute must be specified on the
link
element, with a
non-empty value.
The default type for resources given by the stylesheet
keyword is text/css
.
The appropriate times щоб отримати the resource are:
When the external
resource link's link
element is inserted into a document.
When the external
resource link is created on a link
element that is already in a Document
.
When the href
attribute of the link
element of an external
resource link that is already in a Document
is changed.
Quirk: Якщо the document has been set to quirks
mode, has the same origin as the URL
of the external resource та the Content-Type metadata of the external
resource is not a supported style sheet type, the user agent must
instead assume it to be text/css
.
tag
"The tag
keyword may be used with a
and
area
elements. This keyword
creates a hyperlink.
The tag
keyword indicates that the tag that the referenced document
represents applies to the current document.
Since it indicates that the tag applies to the current document, it would be inappropriate to use this keyword in the markup of a tag cloud, which lists the popular tags across a set of pages.
This document is about some gems та so it is tagged with "http://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/Gemstone
" to
unambiguously categorise it as applying to the "jewel" kind of gems та
not to, say, the towns in the US, the Ruby package format, or the Swiss
locomotive class:
<!DOCTYPE HTML> <html> <head> <title>My Precious</title> </head> <body> <header><h1>My precious</h1> <p>Summer 2012</p></header> <p>Recently I managed to dispose of a red gem that had been bothering me. I now have a much nicer blue sapphire.</p> <p>The red gem had been found in a bauxite stone while I was digging out the office level, but nobody was willing to haul it away. The same red gem stayed there for literally years.</p> <footer> Tags: <a rel=tag href="http://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/Gemstone">Gemstone</a> </footer> </body> </html>
In this document, there are two articles. The "tag
" link, however, applies to the
whole page (and would do so wherever it was placed, including if it was
within the article
elements).
<!DOCTYPE HTML> <html> <head> <title>Gem 4/4</title> </head> <body> <article> <h1>801: Steinbock</h1> <p>The number 801 Gem 4/4 electro-diesel has an ibex and was rebuilt in 2002.</p> </article> <article> <h1>802: Murmeltier</h1> <figure> <img src="http://upload.wikimedia.org/wikipedia/commons/b/b0/Trains_de_la_Bernina_en_hiver_2.jpg" alt="The 802 was red with pantographs and tall vents on the side."> <figcaption>The 802 in the 1980s, above Lago Bianco.</figcaption> </figure> <p>The number 802 Gem 4/4 electro-diesel has a marmot and was rebuilt in 2003.</p> </article> <p class="topic"><a rel=tag href="http://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/Rhaetian_Railway_Gem_4/4">Gem 4/4</a></p> </body> </html>
Some documents form part of a sequence of documents.
A sequence of documents is one where each document can have a previous sibling and a next sibling. A document with no previous sibling is the start of its sequence, a document with no next sibling is the end of its sequence.
A document may be part of multiple sequences.
next
"The next
keyword may be used with link
,
a
та area
elements. This keyword creates a hyperlink.
The next
keyword indicates that the document is part of a sequence та that the link
is leading to the document that is the next logical document in the
sequence.
prev
"The prev
keyword may be used with link
,
a
та area
elements. This keyword creates a hyperlink.
The prev
keyword indicates that the document is part of a sequence та that the link
is leading to the document that is the previous logical document in the
sequence.
Synonyms: For historical reasons, user agents must
also treat the keyword "previous
" like
the prev
keyword.
Extensions to the predefined set of link types may be registered in the microformats wiki existing-rel-values page. [MFREL]
Anyone is free to edit the microformats wiki existing-rel-values page at any time to add a type. Extension types must be specified with the following information:
The actual value being defined. The value should not be confusingly similar to any other defined value (e.g. differing only in case).
Якщо the value contains a ":" (U+003A) character, it must also be an absolute URL.
link
One of the following:
link
elements.link
element; it creates a hyperlink.link
element; it creates an external
resource link.a
and area
One of the following:
a
and area
elements.a
and area
elements; it
creates a hyperlink.a
and area
elements; it
creates an external resource link.a
and area
elements; it
annotates
other hyperlinks
created by the element.A short non-normative description of what the keyword's meaning is.
A link to a more detailed description of the keyword's semantics and requirements. It could be another page on the Wiki, or a link to an external page.
A list of other keyword values that have exactly the same processing requirements. Authors should not use the values defined to be synonyms, they are only intended to allow user agents to support legacy content. Anyone may remove synonyms що є not used in practice; only names that need to be processed as synonyms for compatibility with legacy content are to be registered in this way.
One of the following:
Якщо a keyword is found to be redundant with existing values, it should be removed and listed as a synonym for the existing value.
Якщо a keyword is registered in the "proposed" state for a period of a month or more without being used or specified, then it may be removed from the registry.
Якщо a keyword is added with the "proposed" status and found to be redundant with existing values, it should be removed and listed as a synonym for the existing value. Якщо a keyword is added with the "proposed" status and found to be harmful, then it should be changed to "discontinued" status.
Anyone can change the status at any time, but should only do so in accordance with the definitions above.
Conformance checkers may use the information given on the microformats wiki existing-rel-values page to establish if a value is allowed or not: values defined in this specification or marked as "proposed" or "ratified" must be accepted when used on the elements for which they apply as described in the "Effect on..." field, whereas values marked as "discontinued" or values not containing a U+003A COLON character but not listed in either this specification or on the aforementioned page must be reported as invalid. The remaining values must be accepted as valid if they are absolute URLs containing US-ASCII characters only and rejected otherwise. Conformance checkers may cache this information (e.g. for performance reasons or to avoid the use of unreliable network connectivity).
Even URL-valued link types are compared ASCII-чутливі до реєструly. Validators might choose to warn about characters U+0041 (LATIN CAPITAL LETTER A) through U+005A (LATIN CAPITAL LETTER Z) (inclusive) in the pre-case-folded form of link types that contain a colon.
When an author uses a new type not defined by either this specification or the Wiki page, conformance checkers should offer to add the value to the Wiki, with the details described above, with the "proposed" status.
Types defined as extensions in the microformats
wiki existing-rel-values page with the status "proposed" or
"ratified" may be used with the rel
attribute on link
, a
та area
elements in accordance to the "Effect on..." field. [MFREL]
table
elementcaption
element, followed by zero or more colgroup
elements, followed optionally by a thead
element, followed optionally by a tfoot
element, followed by either zero or more tbody
elements or one or more tr
elements, followed optionally by a tfoot
element (but there can only be one tfoot
element child in total), optionally intermixed with one or more script-supporting
elements.border
sortable
- Enables
a sorting interface for the tablearia-*
attributes applicable
to the allowed roles.interface HTMLTableElement : HTMLElement { attribute HTMLTableCaptionElement? caption; HTMLElement createCaption(); void deleteCaption(); attribute HTMLTableSectionElement? tHead; HTMLElement createTHead(); void deleteTHead(); attribute HTMLTableSectionElement? tFoot; HTMLElement createTFoot(); void deleteTFoot(); readonly attribute HTMLCollection tBodies; HTMLElement createTBody(); readonly attribute HTMLCollection rows; HTMLElement insertRow(optional long index = -1); void deleteRow(long index); attribute DOMString border; };
The table
element represents
data with more than one dimension, in the form of a table.
The table
element takes part in the table model.
Tables have rows, columns та cells given by their descendants. The rows
and columns form a grid; a table's cells must completely cover that grid
without overlap.
Precise rules for determining whether this conformance requirement is met are described in the description of the table model.
Authors are encouraged to provide information describing how to interpret complex tables. Guidance on how to provide such information is given below.
Tables should not be used as layout aids. Historically, many Web authors have tables in HTML as a way to control their page layout making it difficult to extract tabular data from such documents. In particular, users of accessibility tools, like screen readers, are likely to find it very difficult to navigate pages with tables used for layout. Якщо a table is to be used for layout it must be marked with the attribute role="presentation" for a user agent to properly represent the table to an assistive technology and to properly convey the intent of the author to tools that wish to extract tabular data from the document.
There are a variety of alternatives to using HTML tables for layout, primarily using CSS positioning and the CSS table model. [CSS]
The border
attribute may be specified on a table
element to explicitly indicate that the table
element is not being used for layout purposes. Якщо specified, the
attribute's value must either be the empty string or the value "1
".
The attribute is used by certain user agents as an indication that borders
should be drawn around cells of the table.
Tables can be complicated to understand and navigate. To help users with this, user agents should clearly delineate cells in a table from each other, unless the user agent has classified the table as a layout table.
Authors and implementors are encouraged to consider using some of the table design techniques described below to make tables easier to navigate for users.
User agents, especially those that do table analysis on arbitrary content, are encouraged to find heuristics to determine which tables actually contain data and which are merely being used for layout. This specification does not define a precise heuristic, but the following are suggested as possible indicators:
Feature | Indication |
---|---|
The use of the role
attribute with the value presentation |
Probably a layout table |
The use of the border
attribute with the non-conforming value 0 |
Probably a layout table |
The use of the non-conforming cellspacing and cellpadding
attributes with the value 0 |
Probably a layout table |
The use of caption ,
thead , or th elements |
Probably a non-layout table |
The use of the headers
and scope
attributes |
Probably a non-layout table |
The use of the border
attribute with a value other than 0 |
Probably a non-layout table |
Explicit visible borders set using CSS | Probably a non-layout table |
The use of the summary
attribute |
Not a good indicator (both layout and non-layout tables have historically been given this attribute) |
It is quite possible that the above suggestions are wrong. Implementors are urged to provide feedback elaborating on their experiences with trying to create a layout table detection heuristic.
caption
[ = value
]Returns the table's caption
element.
Can be set, to replace the caption
element. Якщо the new value is not a caption
element, throws a HierarchyRequestError
exception.
createCaption
()Ensures the table has a caption
element та returns it.
deleteCaption
()Ensures the table does not have a caption
element.
tHead
[ = value
]Returns the table's thead
element.
Can be set, to replace the thead
element. Якщо the new value is not a thead
element, throws a HierarchyRequestError
exception.
createTHead
()Ensures the table has a thead
element та returns it.
deleteTHead
()Ensures the table does not have a thead
element.
tFoot
[ = value
]Returns the table's tfoot
element.
Can be set, to replace the tfoot
element. Якщо the new value is not a tfoot
element, throws a HierarchyRequestError
exception.
createTFoot
()Ensures the table has a tfoot
element та returns it.
deleteTFoot
()Ensures the table does not have a tfoot
element.
tBodies
Returns an HTMLCollection
of the tbody
elements
of the table.
createTBody
()Creates a tbody
element, inserts it into the table та returns it.
rows
Returns an HTMLCollection
of the tr
elements of the
table.
insertRow
(
[ index ] )Creates a tr
element,
along with a tbody
if
required, inserts them into the table at the position given by the
argument та returns the tr
.
The position is relative to the rows in the table. The index −1, which is the default if the argument is omitted, is equivalent to inserting at the end of the table.
Якщо the given position is less than −1 or greater than the number of
rows, throws an IndexSizeError
exception.
deleteRow
(index)Removes the tr
element
with the given position in the table.
The position is relative to the rows in the table. The index −1 is equivalent to deleting the last row of the table.
Якщо the given position is less than −1 or greater than the index of
the last row, or if there are no rows, throws an IndexSizeError
exception.
The caption
IDL attribute must return, on getting, the first caption
element child of the table
element, if any, or null otherwise. On setting, if the new value is a caption
element, the first caption
element child of the
table
element, if any,
must be removed та the new value must be inserted as the first node of
the table
element. Якщо
the new value is not a caption
element, then a HierarchyRequestError
DOM exception must be thrown instead.
The createCaption()
method must return the first caption
element child of the table
element, if any; otherwise a new caption
element must be created, inserted as the first node of the table
element та then returned.
The deleteCaption()
method must remove the first caption
element child of the table
element, if any.
The tHead
IDL attribute must return, on getting, the first thead
element child of the table
element, if any, or null otherwise. On setting, if the new value is a thead
element, the first thead
element child of the table
element, if any, must be
removed та the new value must be inserted immediately before the first
element in the table
element that is neither a caption
element nor a colgroup
element, if any, or at the end of the table if there are no such
elements. Якщо the new value is not a thead
element, then a HierarchyRequestError
DOM exception must be thrown instead.
The createTHead()
method must return the first thead
element child of the table
element, if any; otherwise a new thead
element must be created and inserted immediately before the first
element in the table
element that is neither a caption
element nor a colgroup
element, if any, or at the end of the table if there are no such
elements та then that new element must be returned.
The deleteTHead()
method must remove the first thead
element child of the table
element, if any.
The tFoot
IDL attribute must return, on getting, the first tfoot
element child of the table
element, if any, or null otherwise. On setting, if the new value is a tfoot
element, the first tfoot
element child of the table
element, if any, must be
removed та the new value must be inserted immediately before the first
element in the table
element that is neither a caption
element, a colgroup
element, nor a thead
element, if any, or at the end of the table if there are no such
elements. Якщо the new value is not a tfoot
element, then a HierarchyRequestError
DOM exception must be thrown instead.
The createTFoot()
method must return the first tfoot
element child of the table
element, if any; otherwise a new tfoot
element must be created and inserted immediately before the first
element in the table
element that is neither a caption
element, a colgroup
element, nor a thead
element, if any, or at the end of the table if there are no such
elements та then that new element must be returned.
The deleteTFoot()
method must remove the first tfoot
element child of the table
element, if any.
The tBodies
attribute must return an HTMLCollection
rooted at the table
node,
whose filter matches only tbody
elements що є children of the table
element.
The createTBody()
method must create a new tbody
element, insert it immediately after the last tbody
element child in the table
element, if any, or at the end of the table
element if the table
element has no tbody
element children та then must return the new tbody
element.
The rows
attribute must return an HTMLCollection
rooted at the table
node,
whose filter matches only tr
elements що є either children of the table
element, or children of thead
,
tbody
, or tfoot
elements що є themselves children of the table
element. The elements in the collection must be ordered such that those
elements whose parent is a thead
are included first, in tree order, followed by those elements whose
parent is either a table
or tbody
element, again
in tree order, followed finally by those elements whose parent is a tfoot
element, still in tree
order.
The behavior of the insertRow(index)
method depends on
the state of the table. When it is called, the method must act as
required by the first item in the following list of conditions that
describes the state of the table and the index
argument:
rows
collection:IndexSizeError
exception.rows
collection has zero elements in it та the table
has no tbody
elements
in it:tbody
element, then create a tr
element, then append the tr
element to the tbody
element, then append the tbody
element to the table
element та finally return the tr
element.rows
collection has zero elements in it:tr
element, append it to the last tbody
element in the table та return the tr
element.rows
collection:tr
element та append it to the parent of the last tr
element in the rows
collection. Then, the newly created tr
element must be returned.tr
element, insert it immediately before the indexth
tr
element in the rows
collection, in the same
parent та finally must return the newly created tr
element.When the deleteRow(index)
method is called,
the user agent must run the following steps:
Якщо index is equal to −1, then index must be set to the number of items
in the rows
collection, minus one.
Now, if index is less than zero, or
greater than or equal to the number of elements in the rows
collection, the method
must instead throw an IndexSizeError
exception та these steps must be aborted.
Інакше the method must remove the indexth
element in the rows
collection from its parent.
The border
IDL attribute must reflect the content attribute
of the same name.
Here is an example of a table being used to mark up a Sudoku puzzle. Observe the lack of headers, which are not necessary in such a table.
<section> <style> table { border-collapse: collapse; border: solid thick; } colgroup, tbody { border: solid medium; } td { border: solid thin; height: 1.4em; width: 1.4em; text-align: center; padding: 0; } </style> <h1>Today's Sudoku</h1> <table> <colgroup><col><col><col> <colgroup><col><col><col> <colgroup><col><col><col> <tbody> <tr> <td> 1 <td> <td> 3 <td> 6 <td> <td> 4 <td> 7 <td> <td> 9 <tr> <td> <td> 2 <td> <td> <td> 9 <td> <td> <td> 1 <td> <tr> <td> 7 <td> <td> <td> <td> <td> <td> <td> <td> 6 <tbody> <tr> <td> 2 <td> <td> 4 <td> <td> 3 <td> <td> 9 <td> <td> 8 <tr> <td> <td> <td> <td> <td> <td> <td> <td> <td> <tr> <td> 5 <td> <td> <td> 9 <td> <td> 7 <td> <td> <td> 1 <tbody> <tr> <td> 6 <td> <td> <td> <td> 5 <td> <td> <td> <td> 2 <tr> <td> <td> <td> <td> <td> 7 <td> <td> <td> <td> <tr> <td> 9 <td> <td> <td> 8 <td> <td> 2 <td> <td> <td> 5 </table> </section>
For tables that consist of more than just a grid of cells with headers in the first row and headers in the first column та for any table in general where the reader might have difficulty understanding the content, authors should include explanatory information introducing the table. This information is useful for all users, but is especially useful for users who cannot see the table, e.g. users of screen readers.
Such explanatory information should introduce the purpose of the table, outline its basic cell structure, highlight any trends or patterns та generally teach the user how to use the table.
For instance, the following table:
Negative | Characteristic | Positive |
---|---|---|
Sad | Mood | Happy |
Failing | Grade | Passing |
...might benefit from a description explaining the way the table is laid out, something like "Characteristics are given in the second column, with the negative side in the left column and the positive side in the right column".
There are a variety of ways to include this information, such as:
<p id="summary">In the following table, characteristics are given in the second column, with the negative side in the left column and the positive side in the right column.</p> <table aria-describedby="summary"> <caption>Characteristics with positive and negative sides</caption> <thead> <tr> <th id="n"> Negative <th> Characteristic <th> Positive <tbody> <tr> <td headers="n r1"> Sad <th id="r1"> Mood <td> Happy <tr> <td headers="n r2"> Failing <th id="r2"> Grade <td> Passing </table>
In the example above the
aria-describedby
attribute is used to explicitly associate the information with the
table for assistive technology users.
caption
<table> <caption> <strong>Characteristics with positive and negative sides.</strong> <p>Characteristics are given in the second column, with the negative side in the left column and the positive side in the right column.</p> </caption> <thead> <tr> <th id="n"> Negative <th> Characteristic <th> Positive <tbody> <tr> <td headers="n r1"> Sad <th id="r1"> Mood <td> Happy <tr> <td headers="n r2"> Failing <th id="r2"> Grade <td> Passing </table>
figure
<figure> <figcaption>Characteristics with positive and negative sides</figcaption> <p>Characteristics are given in the second column, with the negative side in the left column and the positive side in the right column.</p> <table> <thead> <tr> <th id="n"> Negative <th> Characteristic <th> Positive <tbody> <tr> <td headers="n r1"> Sad <th id="r1"> Mood <td> Happy <tr> <td headers="n r2"> Failing <th id="r2"> Grade <td> Passing </table> </figure>
figure
's
figcaption
<figure> <figcaption> <strong>Characteristics with positive and negative sides</strong> <p>Characteristics are given in the second column, with the negative side in the left column and the positive side in the right column.</p> </figcaption> <table> <thead> <tr> <th id="n"> Negative <th> Characteristic <th> Positive <tbody> <tr> <td headers="n r1"> Sad <th id="r1"> Mood <td> Happy <tr> <td headers="n r2"> Failing <th id="r2"> Grade <td> Passing </table> </figure>
Authors may also use other techniques, or combinations of the above techniques, as appropriate.
The best option, of course, rather than writing a description explaining the way the table is laid out, is to adjust the table such that no explanation is needed.
In the case of the table used in the examples above, a simple
rearrangement of the table so that the headers are on the top and left
sides removes the need for an explanation as well as removing the need
for the use of headers
attributes:
<table> <caption>Characteristics with positive and negative sides</caption> <thead> <tr> <th> Characteristic <th> Negative <th> Positive <tbody> <tr> <th> Mood <td> Sad <td> Happy <tr> <th> Grade <td> Failing <td> Passing </table>
Good table design is key to making tables more readable and usable.
In visual media, providing column and row borders and alternating row backgrounds can be very effective to make complicated tables more readable.
For tables with large volumes of numeric content, using monospaced fonts can help users see patterns, especially in situations where a user agent does not render the borders. (Unfortunately, for historical reasons, not rendering borders on tables is a common default.)
In speech media, table cells can be distinguished by reporting the corresponding headers before reading the cell's contents та by allowing users to navigate the table in a grid fashion, rather than serializing the entire contents of the table in source order.
Authors are encouraged to use CSS to achieve these effects.
User agents are encouraged to render tables using these techniques whenever the page does not use CSS and the table is not classified as a layout table.
caption
elementtable
element.table
elements.aria-*
attributes applicable
to the allowed roles.interface HTMLTableCaptionElement : HTMLElement {};
The caption
element represents the title of the table
that is its parent, if it has a parent and that is a table
element.
The caption
element
takes part in the table model.
When a table
element is
the only content in a figure
element other than the figcaption
,
the caption
element
should be omitted in favor of the figcaption
.
A caption can introduce context for a table, making it significantly easier to understand.
Consider, for instance, the following table:
|
1 | 2 | 3 | 4 | 5 | 6 |
---|---|---|---|---|---|---|
1 | 2 | 3 | 4 | 5 | 6 | 7 |
2 | 3 | 4 | 5 | 6 | 7 | 8 |
3 | 4 | 5 | 6 | 7 | 8 | 9 |
4 | 5 | 6 | 7 | 8 | 9 | 10 |
5 | 6 | 7 | 8 | 9 | 10 | 11 |
6 | 7 | 8 | 9 | 10 | 11 | 12 |
In the abstract, this table is not clear. However, with a caption giving the table's number (for reference in the main prose) and explaining its use, it makes more sense:
<caption> <p>Table 1. <p>This table shows the total score obtained from rolling two six-sided dice. The first row represents the value of the first die, the first column the value of the second die. The total is given in the cell that corresponds to the values of the two dice. </caption>
This provides the user with more context:
|
1 | 2 | 3 | 4 | 5 | 6 |
---|---|---|---|---|---|---|
1 | 2 | 3 | 4 | 5 | 6 | 7 |
2 | 3 | 4 | 5 | 6 | 7 | 8 |
3 | 4 | 5 | 6 | 7 | 8 | 9 |
4 | 5 | 6 | 7 | 8 | 9 | 10 |
5 | 6 | 7 | 8 | 9 | 10 | 11 |
6 | 7 | 8 | 9 | 10 | 11 | 12 |
colgroup
elementtable
element, after any caption
elements and before any thead
,
tbody
, tfoot
та tr
elements.span
attribute is present: Empty.span
attribute is absent: Zero or more col
and template
elements.span
- Number of columns spanned by the elementcolgroup
element's
end tag
may be omitted if the colgroup
element is not immediately followed by a space
character or a comment.
A colgroup
element's end tag
may be omitted if the colgroup
element is not immediately followed by a space
character or a comment.interface HTMLTableColElement : HTMLElement { attribute unsigned long span; };
The colgroup
element represents a group of one or more columns in the table
that is its parent, if it has a parent and that is a table
element.
Якщо the colgroup
element contains no col
elements, then the element may have a span
content attribute
specified, whose value must be a valid
non-negative integer greater than zero.
The colgroup
element
and its span
attribute take part in the table model.
The span
IDL attribute must reflect the content attribute
of the same name. The value must be limited
to only non-negative numbers greater than zero.
col
elementcolgroup
element that doesn't have a span
attribute.span
- Number of columns spanned by the elementHTMLTableColElement
,
same as for colgroup
elements. This interface defines one member, span
.
Якщо a col
element has a
parent and that is a colgroup
element that itself has a parent that is a table
element, then the col
element
represents one or more columns in the column group represented by that colgroup
.
The element may have a span
content attribute specified, whose value must be a valid
non-negative integer greater than zero.
The col
element and its span
attribute take part in the table model.
The span
IDL attribute must reflect the content attribute
of the same name. The value must be limited
to only non-negative numbers greater than zero.
tbody
elementtable
element, after any caption
,
colgroup
та thead
elements, but only if there are no tr
elements що є children of the table
element.tr
and script-supporting elementstbody
element's start tag may be omitted if the first
thing inside the tbody
element is a tr
element та
if the element is not immediately preceded by a tbody
,
thead
, or tfoot
element whose end
tag has been omitted. (It can't be omitted if the element is
empty.). A tbody
element's end
tag may be omitted if the tbody
element is immediately followed by a tbody
or tfoot
element, or if
there is no more content in the parent element.aria-*
attributes applicable
to the allowed roles.interface HTMLTableSectionElement : HTMLElement { readonly attribute HTMLCollection rows; HTMLElement insertRow(optional long index = -1); void deleteRow(long index); };
The HTMLTableSectionElement
interface is also used for thead
and tfoot
elements.
The tbody
element represents
a block
of rows that
consist of a body of data for the parent table
element, if the tbody
element has a parent and it is a table
.
The tbody
element takes
part in the table model.
rows
Returns an HTMLCollection
of the tr
elements of the
table section.
insertRow
(
[ index ] )Creates a tr
element,
inserts it into the table section at the position given by the
argument та returns the tr
.
The position is relative to the rows in the table section. The index −1, which is the default if the argument is omitted, is equivalent to inserting at the end of the table section.
Якщо the given position is less than −1 or greater than the number of
rows, throws an IndexSizeError
exception.
deleteRow
(index)Removes the tr
element
with the given position in the table section.
The position is relative to the rows in the table section. The index −1 is equivalent to deleting the last row of the table section.
Якщо the given position is less than −1 or greater than the index of
the last row, or if there are no rows, throws an IndexSizeError
exception.
The rows
attribute must return an HTMLCollection
rooted at the element, whose filter matches only tr
elements що є children of the element.
The insertRow(index)
method must, when
invoked on an element table section, act
as follows:
Якщо index is less than −1 or greater
than the number of elements in the rows
collection, the method must
throw an IndexSizeError
exception.
Якщо index is −1 or equal to the number
of items in the rows
collection, the method must create a tr
element, append it to the element table
section та return the newly created tr
element.
Інакше the method must create a tr
element, insert it as a child of the table
section element, immediately before the indexth
tr
element in the rows
collection та finally must
return the newly created tr
element.
The deleteRow(index)
method must remove
the indexth element in the rows
collection from its parent.
Якщо index is less than zero or greater
than or equal to the number of elements in the rows
collection, the method must
instead throw an IndexSizeError
exception.
thead
elementtable
element, after any caption
та colgroup
elements
and before any tbody
, tfoot
та tr
elements, but only if there are no other thead
elements що є children of the table
element.tr
and script-supporting elementsthead
element's end tag may be omitted if the thead
element is immediately followed by a tbody
or tfoot
element.aria-*
attributes applicable
to the allowed roles.HTMLTableSectionElement
,
as defined for tbody
elements.The thead
element represents
the block
of rows that
consist of the column labels (headers) for the parent table
element, if the thead
element has a parent and it is a table
.
The thead
element takes
part in the table model.
This example shows a thead
element being used. Notice the use of both th
and td
elements in the thead
element: the first row is
the headers та the second row is an explanation of how to fill in the
table.
<table> <caption> School auction sign-up sheet </caption> <thead> <tr> <th><label for=e1>Name</label> <th><label for=e2>Product</label> <th><label for=e3>Picture</label> <th><label for=e4>Price</label> <tr> <td>Your name here <td>What are you selling? <td>Link to a picture <td>Your reserve price <tbody> <tr> <td>Ms Danus <td>Doughnuts <td><img src="http://example.com/mydoughnuts.png" title="Doughnuts from Ms Danus"> <td>$45 <tr> <td><input id=e1 type=text name=who required form=f> <td><input id=e2 type=text name=what required form=f> <td><input id=e3 type=url name=pic form=f> <td><input id=e4 type=number step=0.01 min=0 value=0 required form=f> </table> <form id=f action="/auction.cgi"> <input type=button name=add value="Submit"> </form>
tfoot
elementtable
element, after any caption
,
colgroup
та thead
elements and before any tbody
and tr
elements, but only if
there are no other tfoot
elements що є children of the table
element.table
element, after any caption
,
colgroup
, thead
,
tbody
та tr
elements, but only if there are no other tfoot
elements що є children of the table
element.tr
and script-supporting elementstfoot
element's end tag may be omitted if the tfoot
element is immediately followed by a tbody
element, or if there is no more content in the parent element.aria-*
attributes applicable
to the allowed roles.HTMLTableSectionElement
,
as defined for tbody
elements.The tfoot
element represents
the block
of rows that
consist of the column summaries (footers) for the parent table
element, if the tfoot
element has a parent and it is a table
.
The tfoot
element takes
part in the table model.
tr
elementthead
element.tbody
element.tfoot
element.table
element, after any caption
,
colgroup
та thead
elements, but only if there are no tbody
elements що є children of the table
element.td
, th
та script-supporting elementstr
element's end tag may be omitted if the tr
element is immediately followed by another tr
element, or if there is no more content in the parent element.aria-*
attributes applicable
to the allowed roles.interface HTMLTableRowElement : HTMLElement { readonly attribute long rowIndex; readonly attribute long sectionRowIndex; readonly attribute HTMLCollection cells; HTMLElement insertCell(optional long index = -1); void deleteCell(long index); };
The tr
element represents
a row of cells in a table.
The tr
element takes part
in the table model.
rowIndex
Returns the position of the row in the table's rows
list.
Returns −1 if the element isn't in a table.
sectionRowIndex
Returns the position of the row in the table section's rows
list.
Returns −1 if the element isn't in a table section.
cells
Returns an HTMLCollection
of the td
and th
elements of the row.
insertCell
(
[ index ] )Creates a td
element,
inserts it into the table row at the position given by the argument та
returns the td
.
The position is relative to the cells in the row. The index −1, which is the default if the argument is omitted, is equivalent to inserting at the end of the row.
Якщо the given position is less than −1 or greater than the number of
cells, throws an IndexSizeError
exception.
deleteCell
(index)Removes the td
or th
element with the given
position in the row.
The position is relative to the cells in the row. The index −1 is equivalent to deleting the last cell of the row.
Якщо the given position is less than −1 or greater than the index of
the last cell, or if there are no cells, throws an IndexSizeError
exception.
The rowIndex
attribute must, if the element has a parent table
element, or a parent tbody
,
thead
, or tfoot
element and a grandparent table
element, return the index of the tr
element in that table
element's rows
collection. Якщо there is no such table
element, then the attribute must return −1.
The sectionRowIndex
attribute must, if the element has a parent table
,
tbody
, thead
,
or tfoot
element, return
the index of the tr
element
in the parent element's rows
collection (for tables, that's the HTMLTableElement.rows
collection;
for table sections, that's the HTMLTableRowElement.rows
collection). Якщо there is no such parent element, then the attribute
must return −1.
The cells
attribute must return an HTMLCollection
rooted at the tr
element,
whose filter matches only td
and th
elements що є
children of the tr
element.
The insertCell(index)
method must act as
follows:
Якщо index is less than −1 or greater
than the number of elements in the cells
collection, the method must
throw an IndexSizeError
exception.
Якщо index is equal to −1 or equal to
the number of items in cells
collection, the method must create a td
element, append it to the tr
element та return the newly created td
element.
Інакше the method must create a td
element, insert it as a child of the tr
element, immediately before the indexth
td
or th
element in the cells
collection та finally must return the newly created td
element.
The deleteCell(index)
method must remove
the indexth element in the cells
collection from its parent.
Якщо index is less than zero or greater
than or equal to the number of elements in the cells
collection, the method must
instead throw an IndexSizeError
exception.
td
elementtr
element.colspan
- Number of columns that the cell is to spanrowspan
- Number of rows that the cell is to spanheaders
- The header cells for this celltd
element's end tag may be omitted if the td
element is immediately followed by a td
or th
element, or if there
is no more content in the parent element.aria-*
attributes applicable
to the allowed roles.interface HTMLTableDataCellElement : HTMLTableCellElement {};
The td
element represents
a data cell
in a table.
The td
element and its colspan
,
rowspan
та headers
attributes take part in the table model.
User agents, especially in non-visual environments or where displaying
the table as a 2D grid is impractical, may give the user context for the
cell when rendering the contents of a cell; for instance, giving its
position in the table model, or listing the
cell's header cells (as determined by the algorithm
for assigning header cells). When a cell's header cells are being
listed, user agents may use the value of abbr
attributes on those header
cells, if any, instead of the contents of the header cells themselves.
th
elementtr
element.header
,
footer
, sectioning
content, or heading content
descendants.colspan
- Number of columns that the cell is to spanrowspan
- Number of rows that the cell is to spanheaders
- The headers for this cellscope
- Specifies which cells the header cell applies toabbr
- Alternative label to use for the header cell when referencing the cell
in other contextssorted
- Column
sort direction and ordinalityth
element's end tag may be omitted if the th
element is immediately followed by a td
or th
element, or if there
is no more content in the parent element.aria-*
attributes applicable
to the allowed roles.interface HTMLTableHeaderCellElement : HTMLTableCellElement {
attribute DOMString scope;
attribute DOMString abbr;
};
The th
element represents
a header cell
in a table.
The th
element may have a scope
content attribute specified. The scope
attribute is an enumerated
attribute with five states, four of which have explicit keywords:
row
keyword, which maps to the row statecol
keyword, which maps to the column staterowgroup
keyword, which maps to the row group stateth
element's scope
attribute must not be in the row group state if the element is
not anchored in a row
group.colgroup
keyword, which maps to the column group stateth
element's scope
attribute must not be in the column group state if the element
is not anchored in a column
group.The scope
attribute's missing value default is the auto state.
The th
element may have an abbr
content attribute specified. Its value must be an alternative label for
the header cell, to be used when referencing the cell in other contexts
(e.g. when describing the header cells that apply to a data cell). It is
typically an abbreviated form of the full header cell, but can also be an
expansion, or merely a different phrasing.
The th
element and its colspan
,
rowspan
,
headers
та scope
attributes take part in the table model.
The scope
IDL attribute must reflect the content attribute
of the same name, limited to
only known values.
The following example shows how the scope
attribute's rowgroup
value affects
which data cells a header cell applies to.
Here is a markup fragment showing a table:
The tbody
elements in this example identify the range of the row groups.
<table> <caption>Measurement of legs and tails in Cats and English speakers</caption> <thead> <tr> <th> ID <th> Measurement <th> Average <th> Maximum <tbody> <tr> <td> <th scope=rowgroup> Cats <td> <td> <tr> <td> 93 <th scope=row> Legs <td> 3.5 <td> 4 <tr> <td> 10 <th scope=row> Tails <td> 1 <td> 1 </tbody> <tbody> <tr> <td> <th scope=rowgroup> English speakers <td> <td> <tr> <td> 32 <th scope=row> Legs <td> 2.67 <td> 4 <tr> <td> 35 <th scope=row> Tails <td> 0.33 <td> 1 </tbody> </table>
This would result in the following table:
ID | Measurement | Average | Maximum |
---|---|---|---|
|
Cats | |
|
93 | Legs | 3.5 | 4 |
10 | Tails | 1 | 1 |
|
English speakers | |
|
32 | Legs | 2.67 | 4 |
35 | Tails | 0.33 | 1 |
The header cells in row 1 ('ID', 'Measurement', 'Average' and 'Maximum') each apply only to the cells in their column.
The header cells with a scope=rowgroup
('Cats'
and 'English speakers') apply to all the cells in their row group other
than the cells (to their left) in column 1:
The header 'Cats' (row 2, column 2) applies to the headers 'Legs' (row 3, column 2) and 'Tails' (row 4, column 2) and to the data cells in rows 2, 3 and 4 of the 'Average' and 'Maximum' columns.
The header 'English speakers' (row 5, column 2) applies to the headers 'Legs' (row 6, column 2) and 'Tails' (row 7, column 2) and to the data cells in rows 5, 6 and 7 of the 'Average' and 'Maximum' columns.
Each of the 'Legs' and 'Tails' header cells has a scope=row
and therefore apply to the data cells (to the right) in their row, from
the 'Average' and 'Maximum' columns.
td
and th
elementsThe td
and th
elements may have a colspan
content attribute specified, whose value must be a valid
non-negative integer greater than zero.
The td
and th
elements may also have a rowspan
content attribute specified, whose value must be a valid
non-negative integer. For this attribute, the value zero means that
the cell is to span all the remaining rows in the row group.
These attributes give the number of columns and rows respectively that the cell is to span. These attributes must not be used to overlap cells, as described in the description of the table model.
The td
and th
element may have a headers
content attribute specified. The headers
attribute, if specified,
must contain a string consisting of an unordered
set of unique space-separated tokens що є case-sensitive,
each of which must have the value of an ID of a th
element taking part in the same table
as the td
or th
element (as defined by the table
model).
A th
element with ID id is said to
be directly targeted by all td
and th
elements in the same table that
have headers
attributes whose values include as one of their tokens the ID id. A th
element A
is said to be targeted by a th
or td
element B
if either A is directly targeted
by B or if there exists an element C
that is itself targeted by the element B
and A is directly targeted by C.
A th
element must not be targeted
by itself.
The colspan
,
rowspan
та headers
attributes take part in the table model.
The td
and th
elements implement interfaces that inherit from the HTMLTableCellElement
interface:
interface HTMLTableCellElement : HTMLElement {
attribute unsigned long colSpan;
attribute unsigned long rowSpan;
[PutForwards=value] readonly attribute DOMSettableTokenList headers;
readonly attribute long cellIndex;
};
cellIndex
Returns the position of the cell in the row's cells
list. This does not
necessarily correspond to the x-position
of the cell in the table, since earlier cells might cover multiple
rows or columns.
Returns −1 if the element isn't in a row.
The colSpan
IDL attribute must reflect the colspan
content attribute. Its
default value is 1.
The rowSpan
IDL attribute must reflect the rowspan
content attribute. Its
default value is 1.
The headers
IDL attribute must reflect the content attribute
of the same name.
The cellIndex
IDL attribute must, if the element has a parent tr
element, return the index of the cell's element in the parent element's
cells
collection. Якщо there is no such parent element, then the attribute
must return −1.
The various table elements and their content attributes together define the table model.
A table
consists of cells aligned on a two-dimensional grid of slots with coordinates (x,
y). The grid is finite та is either empty
or has one or more slots. Якщо the grid has one or more slots, then the
x coordinates are always in the range 0 ≤ x < xwidth
та the y coordinates are always in the
range 0 ≤ y < yheight.
Якщо one or both of xwidth
and yheight
are zero, then the table is empty (has no slots). Tables correspond to table
elements.
A cell is
a set of slots anchored at a slot (cellx,
celly) та
with a particular width and height
such that the cell covers all the slots with coordinates (x,
y) where cellx ≤ x < cellx+width
and celly ≤ y < celly+height.
Cells can either be data cells or header cells. Data
cells correspond to td
elements та header cells correspond to th
elements. Cells of both types can have zero or more associated header
cells.
It is possible, in certain error cases, for two cells to occupy the same slot.
A row is a
complete set of slots from x=0
to x=xwidth-1, for a particular
value of y. Rows usually correspond to tr
elements, though a row group can have some implied rows at the end in some cases involving cells spanning multiple rows.
A column
is a complete set of slots from y=0
to y=yheight-1, for a particular
value of x. Columns can correspond to col
elements. In the absence of col
elements, columns are
implied.
A row
group is a set of rows
anchored at a slot (0, groupy)
with a particular height such that the
row group covers all the slots with coordinates (x,
y) where 0 ≤ x < xwidth and groupy ≤ y < groupy+height.
Row groups correspond to tbody
,
thead
та tfoot
elements. Not every row is necessarily in a row group.
A column
group is a set of columns
anchored at a slot (groupx,
0) with a particular width such that the
column group covers all the slots with coordinates (x,
y) where groupx ≤ x < groupx+width
and 0 ≤ y < yheight.
Column groups correspond to colgroup
elements. Not every column is necessarily in a column group.
Row groups cannot overlap each other. Similarly, column groups cannot overlap each other.
A cell cannot cover slots що є from two or more row groups. It is, however, possible for a cell to be in multiple column groups. All the slots that form part of one cell are part of zero or one row groups and zero or more column groups.
In addition to cells,
columns,
rows, row groups та column groups, tables can have a caption
element associated with them. This gives the table a heading, or legend.
A table model error is an error with
the data represented by table
elements and their descendants. Documents must not have table model
errors.
To determine which elements correspond to which slots in a table associated with a table
element, to determine the dimensions of the table (xwidth and yheight) та to determine if there are
any table model errors, user agents must use
the following algorithm:
Нехай xwidth be zero.
Нехай yheight be zero.
Нехай pending tfoot
elements be a list of tfoot
elements, initially empty.
Нехай the table be the table represented by the table
element. The xwidth
and yheight
variables give the table's
dimensions. The table is initially
empty.
Якщо the table
element has no children elements, then return the
table (which will be empty) та abort these steps.
Associate the first caption
element child of the table
element with the table. Якщо there
are no such children, then it has no associated caption
element.
Нехай the current element be the
first element child of the table
element.
Якщо a step in this algorithm ever requires the current
element to be advanced to the next child of the table
when there is no such next child, then the user agent must jump to
the step labeled end, near the end of this algorithm.
While the current element is not
one of the following elements, advance the current
element to the next child of the table
:
Якщо the current element is a colgroup
, follow these
substeps:
Column groups: Process the current element according to the appropriate case below:
col
element
childrenFollow these steps:
Нехай xstart have the value of xwidth.
Нехай the current column
be the first col
element child of the colgroup
element.
Columns: Якщо the current
column col
element has a span
attribute,
then parse its value using the rules
for parsing non-negative integers.
Якщо the result of parsing the value is not an error or zero, then let span be that value.
Інакше if the col
element has no span
attribute, or
if trying to parse the attribute's value resulted in an
error or zero, then let span
be 1.
Increase xwidth by span.
Нехай the last span columns
in the table correspond
to the current column col
element.
Якщо current column is
not the last col
element child of the colgroup
element, then let the current
column be the next col
element child of the colgroup
element та return to the step labeled columns.
Нехай all the last columns in the
table from x=xstart to x=xwidth-1
form a new column
group, anchored at the slot (xstart, 0), with
width xwidth-xstart,
corresponding to the colgroup
element.
col
element
childrenЯкщо the colgroup
element has a span
attribute, then parse its value using the rules
for parsing non-negative integers.
Якщо the result of parsing the value is not an error or zero, then let span be that value.
Інакше if the colgroup
element has no span
attribute, or if trying to parse the attribute's value
resulted in an error or zero, then let span
be 1.
Increase xwidth by span.
Нехай the last span columns
in the table form a new
column
group, anchored at the slot (xwidth-span, 0), with
width span,
corresponding to the colgroup
element.
Просуньте
the current element to the next
child of the table
.
While the current element is
not one of the following elements, advance the current
element to the next child of the table
:
Якщо the current element is a colgroup
element,
jump to the step labeled column groups above.
Нехай ycurrent be zero.
Нехай the list of downward-growing cells be an empty list.
Rows: While the current element
is not one of the following elements, advance the current
element to the next child of the table
:
Якщо the current element is a tr
, then run the algorithm
for processing rows, advance the current
element to the next child of the table
та return to the step labeled rows.
Run the algorithm for ending a row group.
Якщо the current element is a tfoot
, then add that
element to the list of pending tfoot
elements, advance
the current element to the next
child of the table
та
return to the step labeled rows.
The current element is either a thead
or a tbody
.
Run the algorithm for processing row groups.
Просуньте
the current element to the next
child of the table
.
Повернутиto the step labeled rows.
End: For each tfoot
element in the list of pending tfoot
elements, in tree order, run the algorithm
for processing row groups.
Якщо there exists a row or column in the table containing only slots that do not have a cell anchored to them, then this is a table model error.
Повернути table.
The algorithm for
processing row groups, which is invoked by the set of steps
above for processing thead
,
tbody
та tfoot
elements, is:
Нехай ystart have the value of yheight.
For each tr
element
that is a child of the element being processed, in tree order, run
the algorithm for
processing rows.
Якщо yheight > ystart, then let all the last rows in the table from y=ystart to y=yheight-1 form a new row group, anchored at the slot with coordinate (0, ystart), with height yheight-ystart, corresponding to the element being processed.
Run the algorithm for ending a row group.
The algorithm for ending a row group, which is invoked by the set of steps above when starting and ending a block of rows, is:
While ycurrent is less than yheight, follow these steps:
Increase ycurrent by 1.
Empty the list of downward-growing cells.
The algorithm for processing
rows, which is invoked by the set of steps above for processing
tr
elements, is:
Якщо yheight is equal to ycurrent, then increase yheight by 1. (ycurrent is never greater than yheight.)
Нехай xcurrent be 0.
Якщо the tr
element
being processed has no td
or th
element children,
then increase ycurrent
by 1, abort this set of steps та return to the algorithm above.
Нехай current cell be the first td
or th
element child in the tr
element being processed.
Cells: While xcurrent is less than xwidth and the slot with coordinate (xcurrent, ycurrent) already has a cell assigned to it, increase xcurrent by 1.
Якщо xcurrent is equal to xwidth, increase xwidth by 1. (xcurrent is never greater than xwidth.)
Якщо the current cell has a colspan
attribute, then parse that
attribute's value та let colspan
be the result.
Якщо parsing that value failed, or returned zero, or if the attribute is absent, then let colspan be 1, instead.
Якщо the current cell has a rowspan
attribute, then parse that
attribute's value та let rowspan
be the result.
Якщо parsing that value failed or if the attribute is absent, then let rowspan be 1, instead.
Якщо rowspan is zero and the table
element's Document
is not set to quirks mode, then let cell grows downward be true та set rowspan to 1. Інакше let cell
grows downward be false.
Якщо xwidth < xcurrent+colspan, then let xwidth be xcurrent+colspan.
Якщо yheight < ycurrent+rowspan, then let yheight be ycurrent+rowspan.
Нехай the slots with coordinates (x, y) such that xcurrent ≤ x < xcurrent+colspan and ycurrent ≤ y < ycurrent+rowspan be covered by a new cell c, anchored at (xcurrent, ycurrent), which has width colspan and height rowspan, corresponding to the current cell element.
Якщо the current cell element is a
th
element, let this new
cell c be a header cell; otherwise,
let it be a data cell.
To establish which header cells apply to the current cell element, use the algorithm for assigning header cells described in the next section.
Якщо any of the slots involved already had a cell covering them, then this is a table model error. Those slots now have two cells overlapping.
Якщо cell grows downward є true, then add the tuple {c, xcurrent, colspan} to the list of downward-growing cells.
Increase xcurrent by colspan.
Якщо current cell is the last td
or th
element child in the tr
element being processed, then increase ycurrent by 1, abort this set of
steps та return to the algorithm above.
Нехай current cell be the next td
or th
element child in the tr
element being processed.
Повернутиto the step labeled cells.
When the algorithms above require the user agent to run the algorithm for growing downward-growing cells, the user agent must, for each {cell, cellx, width} tuple in the list of downward-growing cells, if any, extend the cell cell so that it also covers the slots with coordinates (x, ycurrent), where cellx ≤ x < cellx+width.
Each cell can be assigned zero or more header cells. The algorithm for assigning header cells to a cell principal cell is as follows.
Нехай header list be an empty list of cells.
Нехай (principalx, principaly) be the coordinate of the slot to which the principal cell is anchored.
headers
attribute specifiedTake the value of the principal
cell's headers
attribute
and split it on spaces, letting
id list be the list of tokens
obtained.
For each token in the id list,
if the first element in the Document
with an ID
equal to the token is a cell in the same table та that cell is not the principal cell, then add that
cell to header list.
headers
attribute specifiedНехай principalwidth be the width of the principal cell.
Нехай principalheight be the height of the principal cell.
For each value of y from principaly to principaly+principalheight-1, run the internal algorithm for scanning and assigning header cells, with the principal cell, the header list, the initial coordinate (principalx,y) та the increments Δx=−1 and Δy=0.
For each value of x from principalx to principalx+principalwidth-1, run the internal algorithm for scanning and assigning header cells, with the principal cell, the header list, the initial coordinate (x,principaly) та the increments Δx=0 and Δy=−1.
Якщо the principal cell is anchored in a row group, then add all header cells що є row group headers and are anchored in the same row group with an x-coordinate less than or equal to principalx+principalwidth-1 and a y-coordinate less than or equal to principaly+principalheight-1 to header list.
Якщо the principal cell is anchored in a column group, then add all header cells що є column group headers and are anchored in the same column group with an x-coordinate less than or equal to principalx+principalwidth-1 and a y-coordinate less than or equal to principaly+principalheight-1 to header list.
Remove all the empty cells from the header list.
Remove any duplicates from the header list.
Remove principal cell from the header list if it is there.
Assign the headers in the header list to the principal cell.
The internal algorithm for scanning and assigning header cells, given a principal cell, a header list, an initial coordinate (initialx, initialy) та Δx and Δy increments, is as follows:
Нехай x equal initialx.
Нехай y equal initialy.
Нехай opaque headers be an empty list of cells.
Нехай in header block be true та let headers from current header block be a list of cells containing just the principal cell.
Нехай in header block be false and let headers from current header block be an empty list of cells.
Loop: Increment x by Δx; increment y by Δy.
For each invocation of this algorithm, one of Δx and Δy will be −1 та the other will be 0.
Якщо either x or y is less than 0, then abort this internal algorithm.
Якщо there is no cell covering slot (x, y), or if there is more than one cell covering slot (x, y), return to the substep labeled loop.
Нехай current cell be the cell covering slot (x, y).
Set in header block to true.
Add current cell to headers from current header block.
Нехай blocked be false.
Якщо there are any cells in the opaque headers list anchored with the same x-coordinate as the current cell та with the same width as current cell, then let blocked be true.
Якщо the current cell is not a column header, then let blocked be true.
Якщо there are any cells in the opaque headers list anchored with the same y-coordinate as the current cell та with the same height as current cell, then let blocked be true.
Якщо the current cell is not a row header, then let blocked be true.
Якщо blocked is false, then add the current cell to the headers list.
Set in header block to false. Add all the cells in headers from current header block to the opaque headers list та empty the headers from current header block list.
Повернутиto the step labeled loop.
A header cell anchored at the slot with coordinate (x, y) with width width and height height is said to be a column header if any of the following conditions are true:
scope
attribute is in the column
state, orscope
attribute is in the auto
state та there are no data cells in any of the cells covering slots
with y-coordinates y
.. y+height-1.A header cell anchored at the slot with coordinate (x, y) with width width and height height is said to be a row header if any of the following conditions are true:
scope
attribute is in the row
state, orscope
attribute is in the auto
state, the cell is not a column header
та there are no data cells in any of the cells covering slots with x-coordinates x
.. x+width-1.A header cell is said to be a column
group header if its scope
attribute is in the column
group state.
A header cell is said to be a row group
header if its scope
attribute is in the row
group state.
A cell is said to be an empty cell if it contains no elements and its text content, if any, consists only of White_Space characters.
Цей розділ не є нормативним.
A form is a component of a Web page that has form controls, such as text fields, buttons, checkboxes, range controls, or color pickers. A user can interact with such a form, providing data that can then be sent to the server for further processing (e.g. returning the results of a search or calculation). No client-side scripting is needed in many cases, though an API is available so that scripts can augment the user experience or use forms for purposes other than submitting data to a server.
Writing a form consists of several steps, which can be performed in any order: writing the user interface, implementing the server-side processing та configuring the user interface to communicate with the server.
Цей розділ не є нормативним.
For the purposes of this brief introduction, we will create a pizza ordering form.
Any form starts with a form
element, inside which are placed the controls. Most controls are
represented by the input
element, which by default provides a one-line text field. To label a
control, the label
element
is used; the label text and the control itself go inside the label
element. Each part of a form is considered a paragraph
та is typically separated from other parts using p
elements. Putting this together, here is how one might ask for the
customer's name:
<form> <p><label>Customer name: <input></label></p> </form>
To let the user select the size of the pizza, we can use a set of radio
buttons. Radio buttons also use the input
element, this time with a type
attribute with the value radio
. To make
the radio buttons work as a group, they are given a common name using the
name
attribute. To group a batch of controls together, such as, in this case,
the radio buttons, one can use the fieldset
element. The title of such a group of controls is given by the first
element in the fieldset
,
which has to be a legend
element.
<form> <p><label>Customer name: <input></label></p> <fieldset> <legend> Pizza Size </legend> <p><label> <input type=radio name=size> Small </label></p> <p><label> <input type=radio name=size> Medium </label></p> <p><label> <input type=radio name=size> Large </label></p> </fieldset> </form>
Changes from the previous step are highlighted.
To pick toppings, we can use checkboxes. These use the input
element with a type
attribute with the value checkbox
:
<form> <p><label>Customer name: <input></label></p> <fieldset> <legend> Pizza Size </legend> <p><label> <input type=radio name=size> Small </label></p> <p><label> <input type=radio name=size> Medium </label></p> <p><label> <input type=radio name=size> Large </label></p> </fieldset> <fieldset> <legend> Pizza Toppings </legend> <p><label> <input type=checkbox> Bacon </label></p> <p><label> <input type=checkbox> Extra Cheese </label></p> <p><label> <input type=checkbox> Onion </label></p> <p><label> <input type=checkbox> Mushroom </label></p> </fieldset> </form>
The pizzeria for which this form is being written is always making
mistakes, so it needs a way to contact the customer. For this purpose, we
can use form controls specifically for telephone numbers (input
elements with their type
attribute set to tel
)
and e-mail addresses (input
elements with their type
attribute set to email
):
<form> <p><label>Customer name: <input></label></p> <p><label>Telephone: <input type=tel></label></p> <p><label>E-mail address: <input type=email></label></p> <fieldset> <legend> Pizza Size </legend> <p><label> <input type=radio name=size> Small </label></p> <p><label> <input type=radio name=size> Medium </label></p> <p><label> <input type=radio name=size> Large </label></p> </fieldset> <fieldset> <legend> Pizza Toppings </legend> <p><label> <input type=checkbox> Bacon </label></p> <p><label> <input type=checkbox> Extra Cheese </label></p> <p><label> <input type=checkbox> Onion </label></p> <p><label> <input type=checkbox> Mushroom </label></p> </fieldset> </form>
We can use an input
element with its type
attribute set to time
to ask for a delivery time. Many of these form controls have attributes to
control exactly what values can be specified; in this case, three
attributes of particular interest are min
, max
та step
. These set the minimum time,
the maximum time та the interval between allowed values (in seconds). This
pizzeria only delivers between 11am and 9pm та doesn't promise anything
better than 15 minute increments, which we can mark up as follows:
<form> <p><label>Customer name: <input></label></p> <p><label>Telephone: <input type=tel></label></p> <p><label>E-mail address: <input type=email></label></p> <fieldset> <legend> Pizza Size </legend> <p><label> <input type=radio name=size> Small </label></p> <p><label> <input type=radio name=size> Medium </label></p> <p><label> <input type=radio name=size> Large </label></p> </fieldset> <fieldset> <legend> Pizza Toppings </legend> <p><label> <input type=checkbox> Bacon </label></p> <p><label> <input type=checkbox> Extra Cheese </label></p> <p><label> <input type=checkbox> Onion </label></p> <p><label> <input type=checkbox> Mushroom </label></p> </fieldset> <p><label>Preferred delivery time: <input type=time min="11:00" max="21:00" step="900"></label></p> </form>
The textarea
element
can be used to provide a free-form text field. In this instance, we are
going to use it to provide a space for the customer to give delivery
instructions:
<form> <p><label>Customer name: <input></label></p> <p><label>Telephone: <input type=tel></label></p> <p><label>E-mail address: <input type=email></label></p> <fieldset> <legend> Pizza Size </legend> <p><label> <input type=radio name=size> Small </label></p> <p><label> <input type=radio name=size> Medium </label></p> <p><label> <input type=radio name=size> Large </label></p> </fieldset> <fieldset> <legend> Pizza Toppings </legend> <p><label> <input type=checkbox> Bacon </label></p> <p><label> <input type=checkbox> Extra Cheese </label></p> <p><label> <input type=checkbox> Onion </label></p> <p><label> <input type=checkbox> Mushroom </label></p> </fieldset> <p><label>Preferred delivery time: <input type=time min="11:00" max="21:00" step="900"></label></p> <p><label>Delivery instructions: <textarea></textarea></label></p> </form>
Finally, to make the form submittable we use the button
element:
<form> <p><label>Customer name: <input></label></p> <p><label>Telephone: <input type=tel></label></p> <p><label>E-mail address: <input type=email></label></p> <fieldset> <legend> Pizza Size </legend> <p><label> <input type=radio name=size> Small </label></p> <p><label> <input type=radio name=size> Medium </label></p> <p><label> <input type=radio name=size> Large </label></p> </fieldset> <fieldset> <legend> Pizza Toppings </legend> <p><label> <input type=checkbox> Bacon </label></p> <p><label> <input type=checkbox> Extra Cheese </label></p> <p><label> <input type=checkbox> Onion </label></p> <p><label> <input type=checkbox> Mushroom </label></p> </fieldset> <p><label>Preferred delivery time: <input type=time min="11:00" max="21:00" step="900"></label></p> <p><label>Delivery instructions: <textarea></textarea></label></p> <p><button>Submit order</button></p> </form>
Цей розділ не є нормативним.
The exact details for writing a server-side processor are out of scope
for this specification. For the purposes of this introduction, we will
assume that the script at https://pizza.example.com/order.cgi
is configured to accept submissions using the application/x-www-form-urlencoded
format, expecting the following parameters sent in an HTTP POST body:
custname
custtel
custemail
size
small
, medium
, or large
topping
bacon
, cheese
,
onion
та mushroom
delivery
comments
Цей розділ не є нормативним.
Form submissions are exposed to servers in a variety of ways, most
commonly as HTTP GET or POST requests. To specify the exact method used,
the method
attribute is specified on the form
element. This doesn't specify how the form data is encoded, though; to
specify that, you use the enctype
attribute. You also have to specify the URL of the service
that will handle the submitted data, using the action
attribute.
For each form control you want submitted, you then have to give a name
that will be used to refer to the data in the submission. We already
specified the name for the group of radio buttons; the same attribute (name
)
also specifies the submission name. Radio buttons can be distinguished
from each other in the submission by giving them different values, using
the value
attribute.
Multiple controls can have the same name; for example, here we give all
the checkboxes the same name та the server distinguishes which checkbox
was checked by seeing which values are submitted with that name — like the
radio buttons, they are also given unique values with the value
attribute.
Given the settings in the previous section, this all becomes:
<form method="post" enctype="application/x-www-form-urlencoded" action="https://pizza.example.com/order.cgi"> <p><label>Customer name: <input name="custname"></label></p> <p><label>Telephone: <input type=tel name="custtel"></label></p> <p><label>E-mail address: <input type=email name="custemail"></label></p> <fieldset> <legend> Pizza Size </legend> <p><label> <input type=radio name=size value="small"> Small </label></p> <p><label> <input type=radio name=size value="medium"> Medium </label></p> <p><label> <input type=radio name=size value="large"> Large </label></p> </fieldset> <fieldset> <legend> Pizza Toppings </legend> <p><label> <input type=checkbox name="topping" value="bacon"> Bacon </label></p> <p><label> <input type=checkbox name="topping" value="cheese"> Extra Cheese </label></p> <p><label> <input type=checkbox name="topping" value="onion"> Onion </label></p> <p><label> <input type=checkbox name="topping" value="mushroom"> Mushroom </label></p> </fieldset> <p><label>Preferred delivery time: <input type=time min="11:00" max="21:00" step="900" name="delivery"></label></p> <p><label>Delivery instructions: <textarea name="comments"></textarea></label></p> <p><button>Submit order</button></p> </form>
There is no particular significance to the way some of the attributes have their values quoted and others don't. The HTML syntax allows a variety of equally valid ways to specify attributes, as discussed in the syntax section.
For example, if the customer entered "Denise Lawrence" as their name, "555-321-8642" as their telephone number, did not specify an e-mail address, asked for a medium-sized pizza, selected the Extra Cheese and Mushroom toppings, entered a delivery time of 7pm та left the delivery instructions text field blank, the user agent would submit the following to the online Web service:
custname=Denise+Lawrence&custtel=555-321-8624&custemail=&size=medium&topping=cheese&topping=mushroom&delivery=19%3A00&comments=
Цей розділ не є нормативним.
Forms can be annotated in such a way that the user agent will check the user's input before the form is submitted. The server still has to verify the input is valid (since hostile users can easily bypass the form validation), but it allows the user to avoid the wait incurred by having the server be the sole checker of the user's input.
The simplest annotation is the required
attribute, which can
be specified on input
elements to indicate that the form is not to be submitted until a value is
given. By adding this attribute to the customer name, pizza size та
delivery time fields, we allow the user agent to notify the user when the
user submits the form without filling in those fields:
<form method="post" enctype="application/x-www-form-urlencoded" action="https://pizza.example.com/order.cgi"> <p><label>Customer name: <input name="custname" required></label></p> <p><label>Telephone: <input type=tel name="custtel"></label></p> <p><label>E-mail address: <input type=email name="custemail"></label></p> <fieldset> <legend> Pizza Size </legend> <p><label> <input type=radio name=size required value="small"> Small </label></p> <p><label> <input type=radio name=size required value="medium"> Medium </label></p> <p><label> <input type=radio name=size required value="large"> Large </label></p> </fieldset> <fieldset> <legend> Pizza Toppings </legend> <p><label> <input type=checkbox name="topping" value="bacon"> Bacon </label></p> <p><label> <input type=checkbox name="topping" value="cheese"> Extra Cheese </label></p> <p><label> <input type=checkbox name="topping" value="onion"> Onion </label></p> <p><label> <input type=checkbox name="topping" value="mushroom"> Mushroom </label></p> </fieldset> <p><label>Preferred delivery time: <input type=time min="11:00" max="21:00" step="900" name="delivery" required></label></p> <p><label>Delivery instructions: <textarea name="comments"></textarea></label></p> <p><button>Submit order</button></p> </form>
It is also possible to limit the length of the input, using the maxlength
attribute. By adding
this to the textarea
element, we can limit users to 1000 characters, preventing them from
writing huge essays to the busy delivery drivers instead of staying
focused and to the point:
<form method="post" enctype="application/x-www-form-urlencoded" action="https://pizza.example.com/order.cgi"> <p><label>Customer name: <input name="custname" required></label></p> <p><label>Telephone: <input type=tel name="custtel"></label></p> <p><label>E-mail address: <input type=email name="custemail"></label></p> <fieldset> <legend> Pizza Size </legend> <p><label> <input type=radio name=size required value="small"> Small </label></p> <p><label> <input type=radio name=size required value="medium"> Medium </label></p> <p><label> <input type=radio name=size required value="large"> Large </label></p> </fieldset> <fieldset> <legend> Pizza Toppings </legend> <p><label> <input type=checkbox name="topping" value="bacon"> Bacon </label></p> <p><label> <input type=checkbox name="topping" value="cheese"> Extra Cheese </label></p> <p><label> <input type=checkbox name="topping" value="onion"> Onion </label></p> <p><label> <input type=checkbox name="topping" value="mushroom"> Mushroom </label></p> </fieldset> <p><label>Preferred delivery time: <input type=time min="11:00" max="21:00" step="900" name="delivery" required></label></p> <p><label>Delivery instructions: <textarea name="comments" maxlength=1000></textarea></label></p> <p><button>Submit order</button></p> </form>
When a form is submitted, invalid
events are fired at each form control that is invalid та then at the form
element itself. This can be
useful for displaying a summary of the problems with the form, since
typically the browser itself will only report one problem at a time.
Цей розділ не є нормативним.
In this pizza delivery example, the times are specified in the format "HH:MM": two digits for the hour, in 24-hour format та two digits for the time. (Seconds could also be specified, though they are not necessary in this example.)
In some locales, however, times are often expressed differently when presented to users. For example, in the United States, it is still common to use the 12-hour clock with an am/pm indicator, as in "2pm". In France, it is common to separate the hours from the minutes using an "h" character, as in "14h00".
Similar issues exist with dates, with the added complication that even the order of the components is not always consistent — for example, in Cyprus the first of February 2003 would typically be written "1/2/03", while that same date in Japan would typically be written as "2003年02月01日" — and even with numbers, where locales differ, for example, in what punctuation is used as the decimal separator and the thousands separator.
It is therefore important to distinguish the time, date та number formats used in HTML and in form submissions, which are always the formats defined in this specification (and based on the well-established ISO 8601 standard for computer-readable date and time formats), from the time, date та number formats presented to the user by the browser and accepted as input from the user by the browser.
The format used "on the wire", i.e. in HTML markup and in form submissions, is intended to be computer-readable and consistent irrespective of the user's locale. Dates, for instance, are always written in the format "YYYY-MM-DD", as in "2003-02-01". Users are not expected to ever see this format.
The time, date, or number given by the page in the wire format is then translated to the user's preferred presentation (based on user preferences or on the locale of the page itself), before being displayed to the user. Similarly, after the user inputs a time, date, or number using their preferred format, the user agent converts it back to the wire format before putting it in the DOM or submitting it.
This allows scripts in pages and on servers to process times, dates та numbers in a consistent manner without needing to support dozens of different formats, while still supporting the users' needs.
See also the implementation notes regarding localization of form controls.
Mostly for historical reasons, elements in this section fall into several overlapping (but subtly different) categories in addition to the usual ones like flow content, phrasing content та interactive content.
A number of the elements are form-associated elements, which means they can have a form owner.
The form-associated elements fall into several subcategories:
Denotes elements що є listed in the form.elements
and fieldset.elements
APIs.
Denotes elements that can be used for constructing
the form data set when a form
element is submitted.
Some submittable elements can be, depending on their attributes, buttons. The prose below defines when an element is a button. Some buttons are specifically submit buttons.
Denotes elements that can be affected when a form
element is reset.
Denotes elements that have a form
content attribute та a
matching form
IDL attribute, that allow authors to specify an explicit form
owner.
Some elements, not all of them form-associated, are кваліфікується
as labelable
elements. These are elements that can be associated with a label
element.
button
input
(if the type
attribute is not
in the Hidden
state)keygen
meter
output
progress
select
textarea
form
elementform
element descendants.accept-charset
- Character encodings to use for form
submissionaction
- URL to use for form
submissionautocomplete
- Default setting for autofill feature for controls in the form enctype
- Form data set encoding type to use for form
submissionmethod
- HTTP method to use for form submissionname
- Name of form to use in the document.forms
APInovalidate
- Bypass form control validation for form
submissiontarget
- Browsing context for form
submissionaria-*
attributes applicable
to the allowed roles.[OverrideBuiltins] interface HTMLFormElement : HTMLElement { attribute DOMString acceptCharset; attribute DOMString action; attribute DOMString autocomplete; attribute DOMString enctype; attribute DOMString encoding; attribute DOMString method; attribute DOMString name; attribute boolean noValidate; attribute DOMString target; readonly attribute HTMLFormControlsCollection elements; readonly attribute long length; getter Element (unsigned long index); getter (RadioNodeList or Element) (DOMString name); void submit(); void reset(); boolean checkValidity(); };
The form
element represents
a collection of form-associated
elements, some of which can represent editable values that can be
submitted to a server for processing.
The accept-charset
attribute gives the character encodings що є to be used for the
submission. Якщо specified, the value must be an ordered
set of unique space-separated tokens що є ASCII
чутливі до реєстру та each token must be an ASCII
чутливі до реєстру match for one of the labels of an ASCII-compatible
character encoding. [ENCODING]
The name
attribute represents the form
's
name within the forms
collection. The value must not be the empty string та the value must be
unique amongst the form
elements in the forms
collection that it is in, if any.
The autocomplete
attribute is an enumerated attribute.
The attribute has two states. The on
keyword maps to the on state та the off
keyword maps to the off state. The attribute may
also be omitted. The missing value default is the on state. The off state indicates that by
default, form controls in the form will have their autofill field
name set to "off
"; the on state indicates that by
default, form controls in the form will have their autofill field
name set to "on
".
The action
,
enctype
,
method
,
novalidate
та target
attributes are attributes for
form submission.
elements
Returns an HTMLCollection
of the form controls in the form (excluding image buttons for
historical reasons).
length
Returns the number of form controls in the form (excluding image buttons for historical reasons).
Returns the indexth element in the form (excluding image buttons for historical reasons).
Returns the form control (or, if there are several, a RadioNodeList
of the form controls) in the form with the given ID or name
(excluding image buttons for
historical reasons); or, if there are none, returns the img
element with the given ID.
Once an element has been referenced using a particular name, that
name will continue being available as a way to reference that element
in this method, even if the element's actual ID or name
changes, for as long as the
element remains in the Document
.
Якщо there are multiple matching items, then a RadioNodeList
object containing all those elements is returned.
submit
()Submits the form.
reset
()Resets the form.
checkValidity
()Returns true if the form's controls are all valid; otherwise, returns false.
The autocomplete
IDL attribute must reflect the content attribute
of the same name, limited to
only known values.
The name
IDL attribute must reflect the content attribute
of the same name.
The acceptCharset
IDL attribute must reflect the accept-charset
content
attribute.
The elements
IDL attribute must return an HTMLFormControlsCollection
rooted at the Document
node while
the form
element is in
a Document
and rooted at the form
element itself when it is not, whose filter matches listed elements whose form
owner is the form
element, with the exception of input
elements whose type
attribute is in the Image
Button state, which must, for historical reasons, be excluded from
this particular collection.
The length
IDL attribute must return the number of nodes represented by the elements
collection.
The supported property indices
at any instant are the indices supported by the object returned by the elements
attribute at that instant.
When a form
element is indexed for
indexed property retrieval, the user agent must return the value
returned by the item
method on the elements
collection, when invoked with the given index as its argument.
Each form
element has a
mapping of names to elements called the past
names map. It is used to persist names of controls even when
they change names.
The supported property names consist of the names obtained from the following algorithm, in the order obtained from this algorithm:
Нехай sourced names be an initially empty ordered list of tuples consisting of a string, an element, a source, where the source is either id, name, or past та, if the source is past, an age.
For each listed
element candidate whose form
owner is the form
element, with the exception of any input
elements whose type
attribute is in the Image
Button state, виконати ці підкроки:
Якщо candidate has an id
attribute, add an
entry to sourced names with that
id
attribute's value as the string, candidate
as the element та id as the source.
Якщо candidate has a name
attribute, add an entry
to sourced names with that name
attribute's value as the string, candidate
as the element та name as the source.
For each img
element candidate whose form
owner is the form
element, виконати ці підкроки:
Якщо candidate has an id
attribute, add an
entry to sourced names with that
id
attribute's value as the string, candidate
as the element та id as the source.
Якщо candidate has a name
attribute, add an
entry to sourced names with that
name
attribute's value as the string, candidate
as the element та name as the source.
For each entry past entry in the past names map add an entry to sourced names with the past entry's name as the string, past entry's element as the element, past as the source та the length of time past entry has been in the past names map as the age.
Sort sourced names by tree order of the element entry of each tuple, sorting entries with the same element by putting entries whose source is id first, then entries whose source is name та finally entries whose source is past та sorting entries with the same element and source by their age, oldest first.
Remove any entries in sourced names that have the empty string as their name.
Remove any entries in sourced names that have the same name as an earlier entry in the map.
Повернути list of names from sourced names, maintaining their relative order.
The properties exposed in this way must not be enumerable.
When a form
element is indexed
for named property retrieval, the user agent must run the
following steps:
Нехай candidates be a live
RadioNodeList
object
containing all the listed
elements whose form owner is the form
element that have
either an id
attribute or a name
attribute equal to name, with the
exception of input
elements whose type
attribute is in the Image
Button state, in tree order.
Якщо candidates is empty, let candidates be a live
RadioNodeList
object
containing all the img
elements що є descendants of the form
element and that have either an id
attribute or a name
attribute equal to name,
in tree order.
Якщо candidates is empty, name
is the name of one of the entries in the form
element's past names map: return the
object associated with name in that
map.
Якщо candidates contains more than one node, return candidates and abort these steps.
Інакше candidates contains exactly
one node. Add a mapping from name to
the node in candidates in the form
element's past
names map, replacing the previous entry with the same name, if
any.
Повернути node in candidates.
Якщо an element listed in a form
element's past names map changes form
owner, then its entries must be removed from that map.
The submit()
method, when invoked, must submit
the form
element from the
form
element itself, with
the submitted from submit()
method flag set.
The reset()
method, when invoked, must run the following steps:
Якщо the form
element
is marked as locked for reset,
then abort these steps.
Mark the form
element
as locked for reset.
Unmark the form
element as locked for reset.
Якщо the checkValidity()
method is invoked, the user agent must statically
validate the constraints of the form
element та return true if the constraint validation return a positive
result та false if it returned a negative result.
This example shows two search forms:
<form action="http://www.google.com/search" method="get"> <label>Google: <input type="search" name="q"></label> <input type="submit" value="Search..."> </form> <form action="http://www.bing.com/search" method="get"> <label>Bing: <input type="search" name="q"></label> <input type="submit" value="Search..."> </form>
label
elementlabel
elements.form
- Associates the control with a form
elementfor
- Associate the label with form controlinterface HTMLLabelElement : HTMLElement { readonly attribute HTMLFormElement? form; attribute DOMString htmlFor; readonly attribute HTMLElement? control; };
The label
element represents
a caption in a user interface. The caption can be associated with a
specific form control, known as the label
element's labeled control,
either using the for
attribute, or by putting the form control inside the label
element itself.
Except where otherwise specified by the following rules, a label
element has no labeled control.
The for
attribute may be specified to indicate a form control with which the
caption is to be associated. Якщо the attribute is specified, the
attribute's value must be the ID
of a labelable
element in the same Document
as the label
element. Якщо the attribute is specified and there is an element in
the Document
whose ID is equal to the value of the for
attribute та the first such
element is a labelable
element, then that element is the label
element's labeled control.
Якщо the for
attribute is not specified, but the label
element has a labelable
element descendant, then the first such descendant in tree
order is the label
element's labeled control.
The label
element's
exact default presentation and behavior, in particular what its activation
behavior might be, if anything, should match the platform's label
behavior. The activation behavior of
a label
element for
events targeted at interactive content
descendants of a label
element та any descendants of those interactive
content descendants, must be to do nothing.
For example, on platforms where clicking a checkbox label checks the
checkbox, clicking the label
in the following snippet could trigger the user agent to run
synthetic click activation steps on the input
element, as if the element itself had been triggered by the user:
<label><input type=checkbox name=lost> Lost</label>
On other platforms, the behavior might be just to focus the control, or do nothing.
The form
attribute is used to explicitly associate the label
element with its form owner.
The following example shows three form controls each with a label, two of which have small text showing the right format for users to use.
<p><label>Full name: <input name=fn> <small>Format: First Last</small></label></p> <p><label>Age: <input name=age type=number min=0></label></p> <p><label>Post code: <input name=pc> <small>Format: AB12 3CD</small></label></p>
control
Returns the form control that is associated with this element.
The htmlFor
IDL attribute must reflect the for
content attribute.
The control
IDL attribute must return the label
element's labeled control, if any, or
null if there isn't one.
The form
IDL attribute is part of the element's forms API.
labels
Returns a NodeList
of all the label
elements that the form
control is associated with.
Labelable
elements have a NodeList
object associated with them that represents the list of label
elements, in tree order, whose labeled
control is the element in question. The labels
IDL attribute of labelable elements, on getting, must return
that NodeList
object.
input
elementtype
attribute is not in the Hidden state: Interactive
content.type
attribute is not in the Hidden state: Listed, labelable, submittable, resettable та reassociateable form-associated
element.type
attribute is in the Hidden
state: Listed,
submittable,
resettable
та reassociateable
form-associated element.type
attribute is not in the Hidden state: Palpable
content.accept
- Hint for expected file type in file upload controlsalt
- Replacement text for use when images are not availableautocomplete
- Hint for form autofill featureautofocus
- Automatically focus the form control when the page is loadedchecked
- Whether the command or control is checkeddirname
- Name of form field to use for sending the element's directionality in form
submissiondisabled
- Whether the form control is disabledform
- Associates the control with a form
elementformaction
- URL to use for form
submissionformenctype
- Form data set encoding type to use for form
submissionformmethod
- HTTP method to use for form submissionformnovalidate
- Bypass form control validation for form
submissionformtarget
- Browsing context for form
submissionheight
- Vertical dimensioninputmode
- Hint for
selecting an input modalitylist
- List of autocomplete optionsmax
- Maximum valuemaxlength
- Maximum length of valuemin
- Minimum valueminlength
- Minimum length of valuemultiple
- Whether to allow multiple valuesname
- Name of form control to use for form
submission and in the form.elements
API
pattern
- Pattern to be matched by the form control's valueplaceholder
- User-visible label to be placed within the form controlreadonly
- Whether to allow the value to be edited by the userrequired
- Whether the control is required for form
submissionsize
- Size of the controlsrc
- Address of the resourcestep
- Granularity to be matched by the form control's valuetype
- Type of form controlvalue
- Value of the form controlwidth
- Horizontal dimensiontitle
attribute has special
semantics on this element when used in conjunction with the pattern
attribute.type
attribute.aria-*
attributes applicable
to the allowed roles.interface HTMLInputElement : HTMLElement {
attribute DOMString accept;
attribute DOMString alt;
attribute DOMString autocomplete;
attribute boolean autofocus;
attribute boolean defaultChecked;
attribute boolean checked;
attribute DOMString dirName;
attribute boolean disabled;
readonly attribute HTMLFormElement? form;
readonly attribute FileList? files;
attribute DOMString formAction;
attribute DOMString formEnctype;
attribute DOMString formMethod;
attribute boolean formNoValidate;
attribute DOMString formTarget;
attribute unsigned long height;
attribute boolean indeterminate;
readonly attribute HTMLElement? list;
attribute DOMString max;
attribute long maxLength;
attribute DOMString min;
attribute long minLength;
attribute boolean multiple;
attribute DOMString name;
attribute DOMString pattern;
attribute DOMString placeholder;
attribute boolean readOnly;
attribute boolean required;
attribute unsigned long size;
attribute DOMString src;
attribute DOMString step;
attribute DOMString type;
attribute DOMString defaultValue;
[TreatNullAs=EmptyString] attribute DOMString value;
attribute Date? valueAsDate;
attribute unrestricted double valueAsNumber;
attribute unsigned long width;
void stepUp(optional long n = 1);
void stepDown(optional long n = 1);
readonly attribute boolean willValidate;
readonly attribute ValidityState validity;
readonly attribute DOMString validationMessage;
boolean checkValidity();
void setCustomValidity(DOMString error);
readonly attribute NodeList labels;
void select();
attribute unsigned long selectionStart;
attribute unsigned long selectionEnd;
attribute DOMString selectionDirection;
void setRangeText(DOMString replacement);
void setRangeText(DOMString replacement, unsigned long start, unsigned long end, optional SelectionMode selectionMode = "preserve");
void setSelectionRange(unsigned long start, unsigned long end, optional DOMString direction);
};
The input
element represents
a typed data field, usually with a form control to allow the user to edit
the data.
The type
attribute controls the data type (and associated control) of the element.
It is an enumerated attribute. The
following table lists the keywords and states for the attribute — the
keywords in the left column map to the states in the cell in the second
column on the same row as the keyword.
Keyword | State | Data type | Control type |
---|---|---|---|
hidden
|
Hidden | An arbitrary string | n/a |
text
|
Text | Text with no line breaks | A text field |
search
|
Search | Text with no line breaks | Search field |
tel
|
Telephone | Text with no line breaks | A text field |
url
|
URL | An absolute URL | A text field |
email
|
An e-mail address or list of e-mail addresses | A text field | |
password
|
Password | Text with no line breaks (sensitive information) | A text field that obscures data entry |
date
|
Date | A date (year, month, day) with no time zone | A date control |
time
|
Time | A time (hour, minute, seconds, fractional seconds) with no time zone | A time control |
number
|
Number | A numerical value | A text field or spinner control |
range
|
Range | A numerical value, with the extra semantic that the exact value is not important | A slider control or similar |
color
|
Color | An sRGB color with 8-bit red, green та blue components | A color well |
checkbox
|
Checkbox | A set of zero or more values from a predefined list | A checkbox |
radio
|
Radio Button | An enumerated value | A radio button |
file
|
File Upload | Zero or more files each with a MIME type and optionally a file name | A label and a button |
submit
|
Submit Button | An enumerated value, with the extra semantic that it must be the last value selected and initiates form submission | A button |
image
|
Image Button | A coordinate, relative to a particular image's size, with the extra semantic that it must be the last value selected and initiates form submission | Either a clickable image, or a button |
reset
|
Reset Button | n/a | A button |
button
|
Button | n/a | A button |
The missing value default is the Text state.
Which of the accept
,
alt
,
autocomplete
,
checked
,
dirname
,
formaction
,
formenctype
,
formmethod
,
formnovalidate
,
formtarget
,
height
,
list
,
max
,
maxlength
,
min
,
minlength
,
multiple
,
pattern
,
placeholder
,
readonly
,
required
,
size
,
src
,
step
та width
content attributes, the checked
,
files
,
valueAsDate
,
valueAsNumber
та list
IDL attributes, the select()
method, the selectionStart
,
selectionEnd
та selectionDirection
,
IDL attributes, the setRangeText()
та
встановитиSelectionRange()
methods, the stepUp()
and stepDown()
methods та the input
and change
events apply
to an input
element depends
on the state of its type
attribute. The subsections that define each type also clearly define in
normative "bookkeeping" sections which of these feature apply та which do not apply, to each type. The behavior of
these features depends on whether they apply or not, as defined in their
various sections (q.v. for content
attributes, for APIs, for
events).
The following table is non-normative and summarizes which of those content attributes, IDL attributes, methods та events apply to each state:
|
Hidden | Text, Search | URL, Telephone | Password | Date, Time | Number | Range | Color | Checkbox, Radio Button | File Upload | Submit Button | Image Button | Reset Button, Button | |
---|---|---|---|---|---|---|---|---|---|---|---|---|---|---|
Content attributes | ||||||||||||||
accept
|
· | · | · | · | · | · | · | · | · | · | Yes | · | · | · |
alt
|
· | · | · | · | · | · | · | · | · | · | · | · | Yes | · |
autocomplete
|
· | Yes | Yes | Yes | Yes | Yes | Yes | Yes | Yes | · | · | · | · | · |
checked
|
· | · | · | · | · | · | · | · | · | Yes | · | · | · | · |
dirname
|
· | Yes | · | · | · | · | · | · | · | · | · | · | · | · |
formaction
|
· | · | · | · | · | · | · | · | · | · | · | Yes | Yes | · |
formenctype
|
· | · | · | · | · | · | · | · | · | · | · | Yes | Yes | · |
formmethod
|
· | · | · | · | · | · | · | · | · | · | · | Yes | Yes | · |
formnovalidate
|
· | · | · | · | · | · | · | · | · | · | · | Yes | Yes | · |
formtarget
|
· | · | · | · | · | · | · | · | · | · | · | Yes | Yes | · |
height
|
· | · | · | · | · | · | · | · | · | · | · | · | Yes | · |
inputmode |
· | Yes | · | · | Yes | · | · | · | · | · | · | · | · | · |
list
|
· | Yes | Yes | Yes | · | Yes | Yes | Yes | Yes | · | · | · | · | · |
max
|
· | · | · | · | · | Yes | Yes | Yes | · | · | · | · | · | · |
maxlength
|
· | Yes | Yes | Yes | Yes | · | · | · | · | · | · | · | · | · |
min
|
· | · | · | · | · | Yes | Yes | Yes | · | · | · | · | · | · |
minlength
|
· | Yes | Yes | Yes | Yes | · | · | · | · | · | · | · | · | · |
multiple
|
· | · | · | Yes | · | · | · | · | · | · | Yes | · | · | · |
pattern
|
· | Yes | Yes | Yes | Yes | · | · | · | · | · | · | · | · | · |
placeholder
|
· | Yes | Yes | Yes | Yes | · | Yes | · | · | · | · | · | · | · |
readonly
|
· | Yes | Yes | Yes | Yes | Yes | Yes | · | · | · | · | · | · | · |
required
|
· | Yes | Yes | Yes | Yes | Yes | Yes | · | · | Yes | Yes | · | · | · |
size
|
· | Yes | Yes | Yes | Yes | · | · | · | · | · | · | · | · | · |
src
|
· | · | · | · | · | · | · | · | · | · | · | · | Yes | · |
step
|
· | · | · | · | · | Yes | Yes | Yes | · | · | · | · | · | · |
width
|
· | · | · | · | · | · | · | · | · | · | · | · | Yes | · |
IDL attributes and methods | ||||||||||||||
checked
|
· | · | · | · | · | · | · | · | · | Yes | · | · | · | · |
files
|
· | · | · | · | · | · | · | · | · | · | Yes | · | · | · |
value
|
default | value | value | value | value | value | value | value | value | default/on | filename | default | default | default |
valueAsDate
|
· | · | · | · | · | Yes | · | · | · | · | · | · | · | · |
valueAsNumber
|
· | · | · | · | · | Yes | Yes | Yes | · | · | · | · | · | · |
list
|
· | Yes | Yes | Yes | · | Yes | Yes | Yes | Yes | · | · | · | · | · |
select()
|
· | Yes | Yes | · | Yes | · | · | · | · | · | · | · | · | · |
selectionStart
|
· | Yes | Yes | · | Yes | · | · | · | · | · | · | · | · | · |
selectionEnd
|
· | Yes | Yes | · | Yes | · | · | · | · | · | · | · | · | · |
selectionDirection
|
· | Yes | Yes | · | Yes | · | · | · | · | · | · | · | · | · |
setRangeText()
|
· | Yes | Yes | · | Yes | · | · | · | · | · | · | · | · | · |
setSelectionRange()
|
· | Yes | Yes | · | Yes | · | · | · | · | · | · | · | · | · |
stepDown()
|
· | · | · | · | · | Yes | Yes | Yes | · | · | · | · | · | · |
stepUp()
|
· | · | · | · | · | Yes | Yes | Yes | · | · | · | · | · | · |
Events | ||||||||||||||
input event |
· | Yes | Yes | Yes | Yes | Yes | Yes | Yes | Yes | Yes | Yes | · | · | · |
change event |
· | Yes | Yes | Yes | Yes | Yes | Yes | Yes | Yes | Yes | Yes | · | · | · |
Some states of the type
attribute define a value
sanitization algorithm.
Each input
element has a
value,
which is exposed by the value
IDL attribute. Some states define an algorithm to convert a string
to a number, an algorithm to convert a number
to a string, an algorithm to convert a string to
a Date
object та an algorithm to convert a Date
object to a string, which are used by max
, min
, step
, valueAsDate
, valueAsNumber
, stepDown()
та stepUp()
.
Each input
element has a
boolean dirty
value flag. The dirty value flag must be
initially set to false when the element is created та must be set to
true whenever the user interacts with the control in a way that changes
the value.
(It is also set to true when the value is programmatically changed, as
described in the definition of the value
IDL attribute.)
The value
content attribute gives the default value of the input
element. When the value
content attribute is
added, set, or removed, if the control's dirty value flag is false,
the user agent must set the value
of the element to the value of the value
content attribute, if
there is one, or the empty string otherwise та then run the current value sanitization algorithm,
if one is defined.
Each input
element has a
checkedness,
which is exposed by the checked
IDL attribute.
Each input
element has a
boolean dirty
checkedness flag. When it є true, the element is said to have a
dirty
checkedness. The dirty checkedness flag
must be initially set to false when the element is created та must be
set to true whenever the user interacts with the control in a way that
changes the checkedness.
The checked
content attribute is a boolean attribute
that gives the default checkedness
of the input
element. When the checked
content attribute is added, if the control does not have dirty checkedness, the
user agent must set the checkedness
of the element to true; when the checked
content attribute is
removed, if the control does not have dirty checkedness, the
user agent must set the checkedness
of the element to false.
The reset
algorithm for input
elements is to set the dirty value flag and dirty checkedness flag
back to false, set the value
of the element to the value of the value
content attribute, if
there is one, or the empty string otherwise, set the checkedness of the element to true if
the element has a checked
content attribute and false if it does not, empty the list of selected files та then
invoke the value sanitization
algorithm, if the type
attribute's current state defines one.
Each input
element can
be mutable.
Except where otherwise specified, an input
element is always mutable.
Similarly, except where otherwise specified, the user agent should not
allow the user to modify the element's value or checkedness.
When an input
element is
disabled,
it is not mutable.
The readonly
attribute can also in some cases (e.g. for the Date state, but not the Checkbox state) stop an
input
element from being mutable.
The cloning
steps for input
elements must propagate the value,
dirty
value flag, checkedness
та dirty
checkedness flag from the node being cloned to the copy.
When an input
element is
first created, the element's rendering and behavior must be set to the
rendering and behavior defined for the type
attribute's state та the value sanitization algorithm,
if one is defined for the type
attribute's state, must be invoked.
When an input
element's
type
attribute changes state, the user agent must run the following steps:
Якщо the previous state of the element's type
attribute put the value
IDL attribute in the value mode та the
element's value
is not the empty string та the new state of the element's type
attribute puts the value
IDL attribute in either the default mode or the default/on
mode, then set the element's value
content attribute to
the element's value.
Інакше if the previous state of the element's type
attribute put the value
IDL attribute in any mode other than the value mode та the new
state of the element's type
attribute puts the value
IDL attribute in the value mode, then set the value
of the element to the value of the value
content attribute, if
there is one, or the empty string otherwise та then set the
control's dirty
value flag to false.
Update the element's rendering and behavior to the new state's.
Invoke the value
sanitization algorithm, if one is defined for the type
attribute's new state.
The name
attribute represents the element's name. The dirname
attribute controls how the
element's directionality
is submitted. The disabled
attribute is used to make the control non-interactive and to prevent its
value from being submitted. The form
attribute is used to explicitly
associate the input
element
with its form owner. The autofocus
attribute controls
focus. The autocomplete
attribute controls how the user agent provides autofill behavior.
The indeterminate
IDL attribute must initially be set to false. On getting, it must return
the last value it was set to. On setting, it must be set to the new
value. It has no effect except for changing the appearance of checkbox controls.
The accept
,
alt
,
max
,
min
,
multiple
,
pattern
,
placeholder
,
required
,
size
,
src
та step
IDL attributes must reflect the respective
content attributes of the same name. The dirName
IDL attribute must reflect the dirname
content attribute. The readOnly
IDL attribute must reflect the readonly
content attribute.
The defaultChecked
IDL attribute must reflect the checked
content attribute. The
defaultValue
IDL attribute must reflect the value
content attribute.
The type
IDL attribute must reflect the respective
content attribute of the same name, limited
to only known values. The maxLength
IDL attribute
must reflect the maxlength
content attribute,
limited to only
non-negative numbers. The minLength
IDL attribute
must reflect the minlength
content attribute,
limited to only
non-negative numbers.
The IDL attributes width
and height
must return the rendered width and height of the image, in CSS pixels,
if an image is being rendered та is being
rendered to a visual medium; or else the intrinsic width and height of
the image, in CSS pixels, if an image is available but not being rendered
to a visual medium; or else 0, if no image is available. When the input
element's type
attribute is not in the Image
Button state, then no image is available. [CSS]
On setting, they must act as if they reflected the respective content attributes of the same name.
The willValidate
,
validity
та validationMessage
IDL attributes та the checkValidity()
та setCustomValidity()
methods, are part of the constraint
validation API. The labels
IDL attribute provides a list of the element's label
s.
The select()
,
selectionStart
,
selectionEnd
,
selectionDirection
,
setRangeText()
та setSelectionRange()
methods and IDL attributes expose the element's text selection. The autofocus
,
disabled
,
form
та name
IDL attributes are part of the element's forms API.
type
attributetype=hidden
)The input
element represents
a value that is not intended to be examined or manipulated by the user.
Constraint validation: Якщо an input
element's type
attribute is in the Hidden
state, it is barred from
constraint validation.
Якщо the name
attribute is present and has a value that is a case-sensitive
match for the string "_charset_
",
then the element's value
attribute must be omitted.
The value
IDL attribute applies
to this element and is in mode default.
The following content attributes must not be specified and do
not apply to the element: accept
, alt
,
autocomplete
,
checked
,
dirname
,
formaction
,
formenctype
,
formmethod
,
formnovalidate
,
formtarget
,
height
,
list
,
max
,
maxlength
,
min
,
minlength
,
multiple
,
pattern
,
placeholder
,
readonly
,
required
,
size
,
src
,
step
та width
.
The following IDL attributes and methods do
not apply to the element: checked
, files
,
list
,
selectionStart
,
selectionEnd
, selectionDirection
,
valueAsDate
та valueAsNumber
IDL
attributes; select()
, setRangeText()
,
setSelectionRange()
,
stepDown()
та stepUp()
methods.
The input
and change
events do not apply.
type=text
) state and Search state (type=search
)textbox
(default - do not set) or combobox
.aria-*
attributes applicable
to the allowed roles.When an input
element's
type
attribute is in the Text
state or the Search
state, the rules in this section apply.
The input
element represents
a one line plain text edit control for the element's value.
The difference between the Text state and the Search state is primarily stylistic: on platforms where search fields are distinguished from regular text fields, the Search state might result in an appearance consistent with the platform's search fields rather than appearing like a regular text field.
Якщо the element is mutable, its value should be editable by the user. User agents must not allow users to insert "LF" (U+000A) or "CR" (U+000D) characters into the element's value.
Якщо the element is mutable, the user agent should allow the user to change the writing direction of the element, setting it either to a left-to-right writing direction or a right-to-left writing direction. Якщо the user does so, the user agent must then run the following steps:
Set the element's dir
attribute to "ltr
"
if the user selected a left-to-right writing direction та "rtl
" if the user selected a
right-to-left writing direction.
Queue a task to fire
a simple event that bubbles named input
at the input
element.
The value
attribute, if specified, must have a value that contains no "LF" (U+000A)
or "CR" (U+000D) characters.
The value sanitization algorithm is as follows: Strip line breaks from the value.
The following common input
element content attributes, IDL attributes та methods apply to the element: autocomplete
, dirname
, list
, maxlength
, minlength
, pattern
, placeholder
, readonly
, required
та size
content attributes; list
, selectionStart
,
selectionEnd
,
selectionDirection
та value
IDL attributes; select()
,
setRangeText()
та setSelectionRange()
methods.
The value
IDL attribute is in mode value.
The input
and change
events apply.
The following content attributes must not be specified and do
not apply to the element: accept
, alt
,
checked
,
formaction
,
formenctype
,
formmethod
,
formnovalidate
,
formtarget
,
height
,
max
,
min
,
multiple
,
src
,
step
та width
.
The following IDL attributes and methods do
not apply to the element: checked
, files
,
valueAsDate
та valueAsNumber
IDL
attributes; stepDown()
and stepUp()
methods.
type=tel
)textbox
(default - do not set) or combobox
.aria-*
attributes applicable
to the allowed roles.The input
element represents
a control for editing a telephone number given in the element's value.
Якщо the element is mutable, its value should be editable by the user. User agents may change the spacing and, with care, the punctuation of values that the user enters. User agents must not allow users to insert "LF" (U+000A) or "CR" (U+000D) characters into the element's value.
The value
attribute, if specified, must have a value that contains no "LF" (U+000A)
or "CR" (U+000D) characters.
The value sanitization algorithm is as follows: Strip line breaks from the value.
Unlike the URL
and E-mail
types, the Telephone
type does not enforce a particular syntax. This is intentional; in
practice, telephone number fields tend to be free-form fields, because
there are a wide variety of valid phone numbers. Systems that need to
enforce a particular format are encouraged to use the pattern
attribute or the setCustomValidity()
method to hook into the client-side validation mechanism.
The following common input
element content attributes, IDL attributes та methods apply to the element: autocomplete
, list
, maxlength
, minlength
, pattern
, placeholder
, readonly
, required
та size
content attributes; list
, selectionStart
,
selectionEnd
,
selectionDirection
та value
IDL attributes; select()
,
setRangeText()
та setSelectionRange()
methods.
The value
IDL attribute is in mode value.
The input
and change
events apply.
The following content attributes must not be specified and do
not apply to the element: accept
, alt
,
checked
,
dirname
,
formaction
,
formenctype
,
formmethod
,
formnovalidate
,
formtarget
,
height
,
max
,
min
,
multiple
,
src
,
step
та width
.
The following IDL attributes and methods do
not apply to the element: checked
, files
,
valueAsDate
та valueAsNumber
IDL
attributes; stepDown()
and stepUp()
methods.
type=url
)textbox
(default - do not set) or combobox
.aria-*
attributes applicable
to the allowed roles.The input
element represents
a control for editing a single absolute URL
given in the element's value.
Якщо the element is mutable, the user agent should allow the user to change the URL represented by its value. User agents may allow the user to set the value to a string that is not a valid absolute URL, but may also or instead automatically escape characters entered by the user so that the value is always a valid absolute URL (even if that isn't the actual value seen and edited by the user in the interface). User agents should allow the user to set the value to the empty string. User agents must not allow users to insert "LF" (U+000A) or "CR" (U+000D) characters into the value.
The value
attribute, if specified and not empty, must have a value that is a valid
URL potentially surrounded by spaces that is also an absolute
URL.
The value sanitization algorithm is as follows: Strip line breaks from the value, then strip leading and trailing whitespace from the value.
Constraint validation: While the value of the element is neither the empty string nor a valid absolute URL, the element is suffering from a type mismatch.
The following common input
element content attributes, IDL attributes та methods apply to the element: autocomplete
, list
, maxlength
, minlength
, pattern
, placeholder
, readonly
, required
та size
content attributes; list
, selectionStart
,
selectionEnd
,
selectionDirection
та value
IDL attributes; select()
,
setRangeText()
та setSelectionRange()
methods.
The value
IDL attribute is in mode value.
The input
and change
events apply.
The following content attributes must not be specified and do
not apply to the element: accept
, alt
,
checked
,
dirname
,
formaction
,
formenctype
,
formmethod
,
formnovalidate
,
formtarget
,
height
,
max
,
min
,
multiple
,
src
,
step
та width
.
The following IDL attributes and methods do
not apply to the element: checked
, files
,
valueAsDate
та valueAsNumber
IDL
attributes; stepDown()
and stepUp()
methods.
Якщо a document contained the following markup:
<input type="url" name="location" list="urls"> <datalist id="urls"> <option label="MIME: Format of Internet Message Bodies" value="http://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc2045"> <option label="HTML 4.01 Specification" value="http://www.w3.org/TR/html4/"> <option label="Form Controls" value="http://www.w3.org/TR/xforms/slice8.html#ui-commonelems-hint"> <option label="Scalable Vector Graphics (SVG) 1.1 Specification" value="http://www.w3.org/TR/SVG/"> <option label="Feature Sets - SVG 1.1 - 20030114" value="http://www.w3.org/TR/SVG/feature.html"> <option label="The Single UNIX Specification, Version 3" value="http://www.unix-systems.org/version3/"> </datalist>
...and the user had typed "www.w3" та the user agent had
also found that the user had visited http://www.w3.org/Consortium/#membership
and http://www.w3.org/TR/XForms/
in the recent past, then
the rendering might look like this:
The first four URLs in this sample consist of the four URLs in the author-specified list that match the text the user has entered, sorted in some UA-defined manner (maybe by how frequently the user refers to those URLs). Note how the UA is using the knowledge that the values are URLs to allow the user to omit the scheme part and perform intelligent matching on the domain name.
The last two URLs (and probably many more, given the scrollbar's indications of more values being available) are the matches from the user agent's session history data. This data is not made available to the page DOM. In this particular case, the UA has no titles to provide for those values.
type=email
)textbox
(default - do not set) or combobox
.aria-*
attributes applicable
to the allowed roles.How the E-mail
state operates depends on whether the multiple
attribute is specified
or not.
multiple
attribute is not specified on the elementThe input
element represents a control for editing an e-mail
address given in the element's value.
Якщо the element is mutable, the user agent should allow the user to change the e-mail address represented by its value. User agents may allow the user to set the value to a string that is not a valid e-mail address. The user agent should act in a manner consistent with expecting the user to provide a single e-mail address. User agents should allow the user to set the value to the empty string. User agents must not allow users to insert "LF" (U+000A) or "CR" (U+000D) characters into the value. User agents may transform the value for display and editing; in particular, user agents should convert punycode in the value to IDN in the display and vice versa.
Constraint validation: While the user interface is representing input that the user agent cannot convert to punycode, the control is suffering from bad input.
The value
attribute, if specified and not empty, must have a value that is a
single valid e-mail address.
The value sanitization algorithm is as follows: Strip line breaks from the value, then strip leading and trailing whitespace from the value.
When the multiple
attribute is removed, the user agent must run the value
sanitization algorithm.
Constraint validation: While the value of the element is neither the empty string nor a single valid e-mail address, the element is suffering from a type mismatch.
multiple
attribute is specified on the elementThe element's values are the result of splitting on commas the element's value.
The input
element represents a control for adding, removing та
editing the e-mail addresses given in the element's values.
Якщо the element is mutable, the user agent should allow the user to add, remove та edit the e-mail addresses represented by its values. User agents may allow the user to set any individual value in the list of values to a string that is not a valid e-mail address, but must not allow users to set any individual value to a string containing "," (U+002C), "LF" (U+000A), or "CR" (U+000D) characters. User agents should allow the user to remove all the addresses in the element's values. User agents may transform the values for display and editing; in particular, user agents should convert punycode in the value to IDN in the display and vice versa.
Constraint validation: While the user interface describes a situation where an individual value contains a "," (U+002C) or is representing input that the user agent cannot convert to punycode, the control is suffering from bad input.
Whenever the user changes the element's values, the user agent must run the following steps:
Нехай latest values be a copy of the element's values.
Strip leading and trailing whitespace from each value in latest values.
Нехай the element's value be the result of concatenating all the values in latest values, separating each value from the next by a single "," (U+002C) character, maintaining the list's order.
The value
attribute, if specified, must have a value that is a valid
e-mail address list.
The value sanitization algorithm is as follows:
Split on commas the element's value, strip leading and trailing whitespace from each resulting token, if any та let the element's values be the (possibly empty) resulting list of (possibly empty) tokens, maintaining the original order.
Нехай the element's value be the result of concatenating the element's values, separating each value from the next by a single "," (U+002C) character, maintaining the list's order.
When the multiple
attribute is set, the user agent must run the value
sanitization algorithm.
Constraint validation: While the value of the element is not a valid e-mail address list, the element is suffering from a type mismatch.
A valid e-mail address is a string
that matches the email
production of the
following ABNF, the character set for which is Unicode. This ABNF
implements the extensions described in RFC 1123. [ABNF]
[RFC5322] [RFC1034]
[RFC1123]
email = 1*( atext / "." ) "@" label *( "." label ) label = let-dig [ [ ldh-str ] let-dig ] ; limited to a length of 63 characters by RFC 1034 section 3.5 atext = < as defined in RFC 5322 section 3.2.3 > let-dig = < as defined in RFC 1034 section 3.5 > ldh-str = < as defined in RFC 1034 section 3.5 >
This requirement is a willful violation of RFC 5322, which defines a syntax for e-mail addresses that is simultaneously too strict (before the "@" character), too vague (after the "@" character) та too lax (allowing comments, whitespace characters та quoted strings in manners unfamiliar to most users) to be of practical use here.
The following JavaScript- and Perl-compatible regular expression is an implementation of the above definition.
/^[a-zA-Z0-9.!#$%&'*+/=?^_`{|}~-]+@[a-zA-Z0-9](?:[a-zA-Z0-9-]{0,61}[a-zA-Z0-9])?(?:\.[a-zA-Z0-9](?:[a-zA-Z0-9-]{0,61}[a-zA-Z0-9])?)*$/
A valid e-mail address list is a set of comma-separated tokens, where each token is itself a valid e-mail address. To obtain the list of tokens from a valid e-mail address list та implementation must split the string on commas.
The following common input
element content attributes, IDL attributes та methods apply to the element: autocomplete
, list
, maxlength
, minlength
, multiple
, pattern
, placeholder
, readonly
, required
та size
content attributes; list
and value
IDL attributes.
The value
IDL attribute is in mode value.
The input
and change
events apply.
The following content attributes must not be specified and do
not apply to the element: accept
, alt
,
checked
,
dirname
,
formaction
,
formenctype
,
formmethod
,
formnovalidate
,
formtarget
,
height
,
max
,
min
,
src
,
step
та width
.
The following IDL attributes and methods do
not apply to the element: checked
, files
,
selectionStart
,
selectionEnd
, selectionDirection
,
valueAsDate
та valueAsNumber
IDL
attributes; select()
, setRangeText()
,
setSelectionRange()
,
stepDown()
and stepUp()
methods.
type=password
)textbox
(default - do not set).aria-*
attributes applicable
to the allowed roles.The input
element represents
a one line plain text edit control for the element's value. The user agent should obscure the
value so that people other than the user cannot see it.
Якщо the element is mutable, its value should be editable by the user. User agents must not allow users to insert "LF" (U+000A) or "CR" (U+000D) characters into the value.
The value
attribute, if specified, must have a value that contains no "LF" (U+000A)
or "CR" (U+000D) characters.
The value sanitization algorithm is as follows: Strip line breaks from the value.
The following common input
element content attributes, IDL attributes та methods apply to the element: autocomplete
, maxlength
, minlength
, pattern
, placeholder
, readonly
, required
та size
content attributes; selectionStart
,
selectionEnd
,
selectionDirection
та value
IDL attributes; select()
,
setRangeText()
та setSelectionRange()
methods.
The value
IDL attribute is in mode value.
The input
and change
events apply.
The following content attributes must not be specified and do
not apply to the element: accept
, alt
,
checked
,
dirname
,
formaction
,
formenctype
,
formmethod
,
formnovalidate
,
formtarget
,
height
,
list
,
max
,
min
,
multiple
,
src
,
step
та width
.
The following IDL attributes and methods do
not apply to the element: checked
, files
,
list
,
valueAsDate
та valueAsNumber
IDL
attributes; stepDown()
and stepUp()
methods.
type=date
)The input
element represents
a control for setting the element's value to a string representing a specific date.
Якщо the element is mutable, the user agent should allow the user to change the date represented by its value, as obtained by parsing a date from it. User agents must not allow the user to set the value to a non-empty string that is not a valid date string. Якщо the user agent provides a user interface for selecting a date, then the value must be set to a valid date string representing the user's selection. User agents should allow the user to set the value to the empty string.
Constraint validation: While the user interface describes input that the user agent cannot convert to a valid date string, the control is suffering from bad input.
See the introduction section for a discussion of the difference between the input format and submission format for date, time та number form controls та the implementation notes regarding localization of form controls.
The value
attribute, if specified and not empty, must have a value that is a valid
date string.
The value sanitization algorithm is as follows: Якщо the value of the element is not a valid date string, then set it to the empty string instead.
The min
attribute, if specified, must have a value that is a valid
date string. The max
attribute, if specified, must have a value that is a valid
date string.
The step
attribute is expressed in days. The step scale factor is 86,400,000
(which converts the days to milliseconds, as used in the other
algorithms). The default step is 1 day.
When the element is suffering from a step mismatch, the user agent may round the element's value to the nearest date for which the element would not suffer from a step mismatch.
The algorithm
to convert a string to a number, given a string input,
is as follows: Якщо parsing a date from input
results in an error, повернути помилку; otherwise, return the number of
milliseconds elapsed from midnight UTC on the morning of 1970-01-01 (the
time represented by the value "1970-01-01T00:00:00.0Z
")
to midnight UTC on the morning of the parsed date, ignoring leap seconds.
The algorithm
to convert a number to a string, given a number input,
is as follows: Повернутиa valid
date string that represents the date that, in UTC, is current input
milliseconds after midnight UTC on the morning of 1970-01-01 (the time
represented by the value "1970-01-01T00:00:00.0Z
").
The algorithm
to convert a string to a Date
object, given a
string input, is as follows:
Якщо parsing
a date from input results in an
error, повернути помилку; otherwise, return a new Date
object
representing midnight UTC on the morning of the parsed date.
The algorithm
to convert a Date
object to a string, given a Date
object input, is as follows:
Повернутиa valid date string that
represents the date
current at the time represented by input
in the UTC time zone.
The following common input
element content attributes, IDL attributes та methods apply to the element: autocomplete
, list
, max
, min
, readonly
, required
та step
content attributes; list
, value
, valueAsDate
та valueAsNumber
IDL
attributes; stepDown()
and stepUp()
methods.
The value
IDL attribute is in mode value.
The input
and change
events apply.
The following content attributes must not be specified and do
not apply to the element: accept
, alt
,
checked
,
dirname
,
formaction
,
formenctype
,
formmethod
,
formnovalidate
,
formtarget
,
height
,
maxlength
,
minlength
,
multiple
,
pattern
,
placeholder
,
size
,
src
та width
.
The following IDL attributes and methods do
not apply to the element: checked
, selectionStart
,
selectionEnd
та selectionDirection
IDL attributes; select()
, setRangeText()
та setSelectionRange()
methods.
type=time
)The input
element represents
a control for setting the element's value to a string representing a specific time.
Якщо the element is mutable, the user agent should allow the user to change the time represented by its value, as obtained by parsing a time from it. User agents must not allow the user to set the value to a non-empty string that is not a valid time string. Якщо the user agent provides a user interface for selecting a time, then the value must be set to a valid time string representing the user's selection. User agents should allow the user to set the value to the empty string.
Constraint validation: While the user interface describes input that the user agent cannot convert to a valid time string, the control is suffering from bad input.
See the introduction section for a discussion of the difference between the input format and submission format for date, time та number form controls та the implementation notes regarding localization of form controls.
The value
attribute, if specified and not empty, must have a value that is a valid
time string.
The value sanitization algorithm is as follows: Якщо the value of the element is not a valid time string, then set it to the empty string instead.
The form control has a periodic domain.
The min
attribute, if specified, must have a value that is a valid
time string. The max
attribute, if specified, must have a value that is a valid
time string.
The step
attribute is expressed in seconds. The step scale factor is 1000 (which
converts the seconds to milliseconds, as used in the other algorithms).
The default
step is 60 seconds.
When the element is suffering from a step mismatch, the user agent may round the element's value to the nearest time for which the element would not suffer from a step mismatch.
The algorithm to convert a string to a number, given a string input, is as follows: Якщо parsing a time from input results in an error, повернути помилку; otherwise, return the number of milliseconds elapsed from midnight to the parsed time on a day with no time changes.
The algorithm to convert a number to a string, given a number input, is as follows: Повернутиa valid time string that represents the time that is input milliseconds after midnight on a day with no time changes.
The algorithm
to convert a string to a Date
object, given a
string input, is as follows:
Якщо parsing
a time from input results in an
error, повернути помилку; otherwise, return a new Date
object
representing the parsed time
in UTC on 1970-01-01.
The algorithm
to convert a Date
object to a string, given a Date
object input, is as follows:
Повернутиa valid time string that
represents the UTC time
component that is represented by input.
The following common input
element content attributes, IDL attributes та methods apply to the element: autocomplete
, list
, max
, min
, readonly
, required
та step
content attributes; list
, value
, valueAsDate
та valueAsNumber
IDL
attributes; stepDown()
and stepUp()
methods.
The value
IDL attribute is in mode value.
The input
and change
events apply.
The following content attributes must not be specified and do
not apply to the element: accept
, alt
,
checked
,
dirname
,
formaction
,
formenctype
,
formmethod
,
formnovalidate
,
formtarget
,
height
,
maxlength
,
minlength
,
multiple
,
pattern
,
placeholder
,
size
,
src
та width
.
The following IDL attributes and methods do
not apply to the element: checked
, files
,
selectionStart
,
selectionEnd
та selectionDirection
IDL attributes; select()
, setRangeText()
та setSelectionRange()
methods.
type=number
)spinbutton
(default - do not set).aria-*
attributes applicable
to the allowed roles.The input
element represents
a control for setting the element's value to a string representing a number.
Якщо the element is mutable, the user agent should allow the user to change the number represented by its value, as obtained from applying the rules for parsing floating-point number values to it. User agents must not allow the user to set the value to a non-empty string that is not a valid floating-point number. Якщо the user agent provides a user interface for selecting a number, then the value must be set to the best representation of the number representing the user's selection as a floating-point number. User agents should allow the user to set the value to the empty string.
Constraint validation: While the user interface describes input that the user agent cannot convert to a valid floating-point number, the control is suffering from bad input.
This specification does not define what user interface user agents are to use; user agent vendors are encouraged to consider what would best serve their users' needs. For example, a user agent in Persian or Arabic markets might support Persian and Arabic numeric input (converting it to the format required for submission as described above). Similarly, a user agent designed for Romans might display the value in Roman numerals rather than in decimal; or (more realistically) a user agent designed for the French market might display the value with apostrophes between thousands and commas before the decimals та allow the user to enter a value in that manner, internally converting it to the submission format described above.
The value
attribute, if specified and not empty, must have a value that is a valid
floating-point number.
The value sanitization algorithm is as follows: Якщо the value of the element is not a valid floating-point number, then set it to the empty string instead.
The min
attribute, if specified, must have a value that is a valid
floating-point number. The max
attribute, if specified, must
have a value that is a valid
floating-point number.
The step scale factor is 1. The default step is 1 (allowing only integers to be selected by the user, unless the step base has a non-integer value).
When the element is suffering from a step mismatch, the user agent may round the element's value to the nearest number for which the element would not suffer from a step mismatch. Якщо there are two such numbers, user agents are encouraged to pick the one nearest positive infinity.
The algorithm to convert a string to a number, given a string input, is as follows: Якщо applying the rules for parsing floating-point number values to input results in an error, повернути помилку; otherwise, return the resulting number.
The algorithm to convert a number to a string, given a number input, is as follows: Повернутиa valid floating-point number that represents input.
The following common input
element content attributes, IDL attributes та methods apply to the element: autocomplete
, list
, max
, min
, placeholder
, readonly
, required
та step
content attributes; list
, value
та valueAsNumber
IDL
attributes; stepDown()
and stepUp()
methods.
The value
IDL attribute is in mode value.
The input
and change
events apply.
The following content attributes must not be specified and do
not apply to the element: accept
, alt
,
checked
,
dirname
,
formaction
,
formenctype
,
formmethod
,
formnovalidate
,
formtarget
,
height
,
maxlength
,
minlength
,
multiple
,
pattern
,
size
,
src
та width
.
The following IDL attributes and methods do
not apply to the element: checked
, files
,
selectionStart
,
selectionEnd
, selectionDirection
та valueAsDate
IDL attributes;
select()
, setRangeText()
та setSelectionRange()
methods.
Here is an example of using a numeric input control:
<label>How much do you want to charge? $<input type=number min=0 step=0.01 name=price></label>
As described above, a user agent might support numeric input in the user's local format, converting it to the format required for submission as described above. This might include handling grouping separators (as in "872,000,000,000") and various decimal separators (such as "3,99" vs "3.99") or using local digits (such as those in Arabic, Devanagari, Persian та Thai).
The type=number
state is
not appropriate for input that happens to only consist of numbers but
isn't strictly speaking a number. For example, it would be inappropriate
for credit card numbers or US postal codes. A simple way of determining
whether to use type=number
is to
consider whether it would make sense for the input control to have a
spinbox interface (e.g. with "up" and "down" arrows). Getting a credit
card number wrong by 1 in the last digit isn't a minor mistake, it's as
wrong as getting every digit incorrect. So it would not make sense for the
user to select a credit card number using "up" and "down" buttons. When a
spinbox interface is not appropriate, type=text
is probably the right choice (possibly with a pattern
attribute).
type=range
)slider
(default - do not set).aria-*
attributes applicable
to the allowed roles.The input
element represents
a control for setting the element's value to a string representing a number,
but with the caveat that the exact value is not important, letting UAs
provide a simpler interface than they do for the Number state.
In this state, the range and step constraints are enforced even during user input та there is no way to set the value to the empty string.
Якщо the element is mutable, the user agent should allow the user to change the number represented by its value, as obtained from applying the rules for parsing floating-point number values to it. User agents must not allow the user to set the value to a string that is not a valid floating-point number. Якщо the user agent provides a user interface for selecting a number, then the value must be set to a best representation of the number representing the user's selection as a floating-point number. User agents must not allow the user to set the value to the empty string.
Constraint validation: While the user interface describes input that the user agent cannot convert to a valid floating-point number, the control is suffering from bad input.
The value
attribute, if specified, must have a value that is a valid
floating-point number.
The value sanitization algorithm is as follows: Якщо the value of the element is not a valid floating-point number, then set it to a valid floating-point number that represents the default value.
The min
attribute, if specified, must have a value that is a valid
floating-point number. The default minimum is 0. The max
attribute, if specified, must
have a value that is a valid
floating-point number. The default maximum is 100.
The default value is the minimum plus half the difference between the minimum and the maximum, unless the maximum is less than the minimum, in which case the default value is the minimum.
When the element is suffering from an underflow, the user agent must set the element's value to a valid floating-point number that represents the minimum.
When the element is suffering from an overflow, if the maximum is not less than the minimum, the user agent must set the element's value to a valid floating-point number that represents the maximum.
The step
scale factor is 1. The default step is 1 (allowing only
integers, unless the min
attribute has a non-integer value).
When the element is suffering from a step mismatch, the user agent must round the element's value to the nearest number for which the element would not suffer from a step mismatch та which is greater than or equal to the minimum та, if the maximum is not less than the minimum, which is less than or equal to the maximum, if there is a number that matches these constraints. Якщо two numbers match these constraints, then user agents must use the one nearest to positive infinity.
For example, the markup <input type="range" min=0 max=100 step=20 value=50>
results in a range control whose initial value is 60.
The algorithm to convert a string to a number, given a string input, is as follows: Якщо applying the rules for parsing floating-point number values to input results in an error, повернути помилку; otherwise, return the resulting number.
The algorithm to convert a number to a string, given a number input, is as follows: Повернутиa valid floating-point number that represents input.
The following common input
element content attributes, IDL attributes та methods apply to the element: autocomplete
, list
, max
, min
та step
content attributes; list
, value
та valueAsNumber
IDL
attributes; stepDown()
and stepUp()
methods.
The value
IDL attribute is in mode value.
The input
and change
events apply.
The following content attributes must not be specified and do
not apply to the element: accept
, alt
,
checked
,
dirname
,
formaction
,
formenctype
,
formmethod
,
formnovalidate
,
formtarget
,
height
,
maxlength
,
minlength
,
multiple
,
pattern
,
placeholder
,
readonly
,
required
,
size
,
src
та width
.
The following IDL attributes and methods do
not apply to the element: checked
, files
,
selectionStart
,
selectionEnd
, selectionDirection
та valueAsDate
IDL attributes;
select()
, setRangeText()
та setSelectionRange()
methods.
Here is an example of a range control using an autocomplete list with
the list
attribute. This could be useful if there are values along the full range
of the control що є especially important, such as preconfigured light
levels or typical speed limits in a range control used as a speed
control. The following markup fragment:
<input type="range" min="-100" max="100" value="0" step="10" name="power" list="powers">
<datalist id="powers">
<option value="0">
<option value="-30">
<option value="30">
<option value="++50">
</datalist>
...with the following style sheet applied:
input { height: 75px; width: 49px; background: #D5CCBB; color: black; }
...might render as:
Note how the UA determined the orientation of the control from the
ratio of the style-sheet-specified height and width properties. The
colors were similarly derived from the style sheet. The tick marks,
however, were derived from the markup. In particular, the step
attribute has not affected
the placement of tick marks, the UA deciding to only use the
author-specified completion values and then adding longer tick marks at
the extremes.
Note also how the invalid value ++50
was completely ignored.
For another example, consider the following markup fragment:
<input name=x type=range min=100 max=700 step=9.09090909 value=509.090909>
A user agent could display in a variety of ways, for instance:
Or, alternatively, for instance:
The user agent could pick which one to display based on the dimensions given in the style sheet. This would allow it to maintain the same resolution for the tick marks, despite the differences in width.
Finally, here is an example of a range control with two labeled values:
<input type="range" name="a" list="a-values"> <datalist id="a-values"> <option value="10" label="Low"> <option value="90" label="High"> </datalist>
With styles that make the control draw vertically, it might look as follows:
type=color
)The input
element represents
a color well control, for setting the element's value to a string representing a simple
color.
In this state, there is always a color picked та there is no way to set the value to the empty string.
Якщо the element is mutable, the user agent should allow the user to change the color represented by its value, as obtained from applying the rules for parsing simple color values to it. User agents must not allow the user to set the value to a string that is not a valid lowercase simple color. Якщо the user agent provides a user interface for selecting a color, then the value must be set to the result of using the rules for serializing simple color values to the user's selection. User agents must not allow the user to set the value to the empty string.
Constraint validation: While the user interface describes input that the user agent cannot convert to a valid lowercase simple color, the control is suffering from bad input.
The value
attribute, if specified and not empty, must have a value that is a valid
simple color.
The value sanitization
algorithm is as follows: Якщо the value of the element is a valid
simple color, then set it to the value of the element converted
to ASCII lowercase; otherwise, set it to the string "#000000
".
The following common input
element content attributes and IDL attributes apply to the element: autocomplete
and list
content attributes; list
and value
IDL attributes.
The value
IDL attribute is in mode value.
The input
and change
events apply.
The following content attributes must not be specified and do
not apply to the element: accept
, alt
,
checked
,
dirname
,
formaction
,
formenctype
,
formmethod
,
formnovalidate
,
formtarget
,
height
,
max
,
maxlength
,
min
,
minlength
,
multiple
,
pattern
,
placeholder
,
readonly
,
required
,
size
,
src
,
step
та width
.
The following IDL attributes and methods do
not apply to the element: checked
, files
,
selectionStart
,
selectionEnd
, selectionDirection
,
valueAsDate
та valueAsNumber
IDL
attributes; select()
, setRangeText()
,
setSelectionRange()
,
stepDown()
та stepUp()
methods.
type=checkbox
)checkbox
(default - do not set) or menuitemcheckbox
.aria-*
attributes applicable
to the allowed roles.The input
element represents
a two-state control that represents the element's checkedness state. Якщо the element's checkedness
state є true, the control represents a positive selection та if it is
false, a negative selection. Якщо the element's indeterminate
IDL attribute
is set to true, then the control's selection should be obscured as if the
control was in a third, indeterminate, state.
The control is never a true tri-state control, even if the
element's indeterminate
IDL attribute is set to true. The indeterminate
IDL attribute
only gives the appearance of a third state.
Якщо the element is mutable,
then: The pre-click activation
steps consist of setting the element's checkedness to its opposite value (i.e.
true if it is false, false if it є true) та of setting the element's indeterminate
IDL attribute to false. The canceled
activation steps consist of setting the checkedness and the element's indeterminate
IDL
attribute back to the values they had before the pre-click
activation steps were run. The activation
behavior is to fire a simple event
that bubbles named input
at
the element and then fire a simple event
that bubbles named change
at the element.
Якщо the element is not mutable, it has no activation behavior.
Constraint validation: Якщо the element is required and its checkedness is false, then the element is suffering from being missing.
indeterminate
[ = value
]When set, overrides the rendering of checkbox controls so that the current value is not visible.
The following common input
element content attributes and IDL attributes apply to the element: checked
та required
content attributes;
checked
and value
IDL attributes.
The value
IDL attribute is in mode default/on.
The input
and change
events apply.
The following content attributes must not be specified and do
not apply to the element: accept
, alt
,
autocomplete
,
dirname
,
formaction
,
formenctype
,
formmethod
,
formnovalidate
,
formtarget
,
height
,
list
,
max
,
maxlength
,
min
,
minlength
,
multiple
,
pattern
,
placeholder
,
readonly
,
size
,
src
,
step
та width
.
The following IDL attributes and methods do
not apply to the element: files
, list
,
selectionStart
,
selectionEnd
, selectionDirection
,
valueAsDate
та valueAsNumber
IDL
attributes; select()
, setRangeText()
,
setSelectionRange()
,
stepDown()
та stepUp()
methods.
type=radio
)radio
(default
- do not set) or menuitemradio
.aria-*
attributes applicable
to the allowed roles.When an input
element's
type
attribute is in the Radio
Button state, the rules in this section apply.
The input
element represents
a control that, when used in conjunction with other input
elements, forms a radio button group
in which only one control can have its checkedness state set to true. Якщо the
element's checkedness
state є true, the control represents the selected control in the group та
if it is false, it indicates a control in the group that is not selected.
The radio button group that
contains an input
element a also contains all the other input
elements b that fulfill all of the
following conditions:
input
element b's type
attribute is in the Radio Button state.name
attribute, their name
attributes are not empty та the value of a's
name
attribute is a compatibility caseless
match for the value of b's name
attribute.A document must not contain an input
element whose radio button group
contains only that element.
When any of the following phenomena occur, if the element's checkedness state є true after the occurrence, the checkedness state of all the other elements in the same radio button group must be set to false:
name
attribute is set, changed, or removed.Якщо the element is mutable,
then: The pre-click activation
steps consist of setting the element's checkedness to true. The canceled
activation steps consist of setting the element's checkedness to false. The activation
behavior is to fire a simple event
that bubbles named input
at
the element and then fire a simple event
that bubbles named change
at the element.
.
Якщо the element is not mutable, it has no activation behavior.
Constraint validation: Якщо an element in the radio
button group is required та all of the input
elements in the radio
button group have a checkedness that is false, then the
element is suffering from being
missing.
Якщо none of the radio buttons in a radio button group are checked when they are inserted into the document, then they will all be initially unchecked in the interface, until such time as one of them is checked (either by the user or by script).
The following common input
element content attributes and IDL attributes apply to the element: checked
and required
content attributes;
checked
and value
IDL attributes.
The value
IDL attribute is in mode default/on.
The input
and change
events apply.
The following content attributes must not be specified and do
not apply to the element: accept
, alt
,
autocomplete
,
dirname
,
formaction
,
formenctype
,
formmethod
,
formnovalidate
,
formtarget
,
height
,
list
,
max
,
maxlength
,
min
,
minlength
,
multiple
,
pattern
,
placeholder
,
readonly
,
size
,
src
,
step
та width
.
The following IDL attributes and methods do
not apply to the element: files
, list
,
selectionStart
,
selectionEnd
, selectionDirection
,
valueAsDate
та valueAsNumber
IDL
attributes; select()
, setRangeText()
,
setSelectionRange()
,
stepDown()
та stepUp()
methods.
type=file
)When an input
element's
type
attribute is in the File
Upload state, the rules in this section apply.
The input
element represents
a list of selected
files, each file consisting of a file name, a file type та a file
body (the contents of the file).
File names must not contain path components, even in the case that a user has selected an entire directory hierarchy or multiple files with the same name from different directories.
Unless the multiple
attribute is set, there must be no more than one file in the list of selected
files.
Якщо the element is mutable, then the element's activation behavior is to run the following steps:
Якщо the algorithm is not allowed to show a popup, then abort these steps without doing anything else.
Return, but continue running these steps asynchronously.
Optionally, wait until any prior execution of this algorithm has terminated.
Display a prompt to the user requesting that the user specify some
files. Якщо the multiple
attribute is not set, there must be no more than one file selected;
otherwise, any number may be selected. Files can be from the
filesystem or created on the fly, e.g. a picture taken from a camera
connected to the user's device.
Wait for the user to have made their selection.
Queue a task to first update the
element's selected
files so that it represents the user's selection, then fire
a simple event that bubbles named input
at the input
element
та finally fire a simple event
that bubbles named change
at the input
element.
Якщо the element is mutable,
the user agent should allow the user to change the files on the list in
other ways also, e.g. adding or removing files by drag-and-drop. When
the user does so, the user agent must queue a
task to first update the element's selected files so that it
represents the user's new selection, then fire
a simple event that bubbles named input
at the input
element та
finally fire a simple event that
bubbles named change
at
the input
element.
Якщо the element is not mutable, it has no activation behavior and the user agent must not allow the user to change the element's selection.
Constraint validation: Якщо the element is required and the list of selected files is empty, then the element is suffering from being missing.
The accept
attribute may be specified to provide user agents with a hint of what file
types will be accepted.
Якщо specified, the attribute must consist of a set of comma-separated tokens, each of which must be an ASCII чутливі до реєстру match for one of the following:
audio/*
video/*
image/*
The tokens must not be ASCII чутливі до реєстру matches for any of the other tokens (i.e. duplicates are not allowed). To obtain the list of tokens from the attribute, the user agent must split the attribute value on commas.
User agents may use the value of this attribute to display a more
appropriate user interface than a generic file picker. For instance, given
the value image/*
, a user agent could
offer the user the option of using a local camera or selecting a
photograph from their photo collection; given the value audio/*
,
a user agent could offer the user the option of recording a clip using a
headset microphone.
User agents should prevent the user from selecting files що є not accepted by one (or more) of these tokens.
Authors are encouraged to specify both any MIME types and any corresponding extensions when looking for data in a specific format.
For example, consider an application that converts Microsoft Word documents to Open Document Format files. Since Microsoft Word documents are described with a wide variety of MIME types and extensions, the site can list several, as follows:
<input type="file" accept=".doc,.docx,.xml,application/msword,application/vnd.openxmlformats-officedocument.wordprocessingml.document">
On platforms that only use file extensions to describe file types, the extensions listed here can be used to filter the allowed documents, while the MIME types can be used with the system's type registration table (mapping MIME types to extensions used by the system), if any, to determine any other extensions to allow. Similarly, on a system that does not have file names or extensions but labels documents with MIME types internally, the MIME types can be used to pick the allowed files, while the extensions can be used if the system has an extension registration table that maps known extensions to MIME types used by the system.
Extensions tend to be ambiguous (e.g. there are an untold
number of formats that use the ".dat
"
extension та users can typically quite easily rename their files to have a
".doc
" extension even if they are not
Microsoft Word documents) та MIME types tend to be unreliable (e.g. many
formats have no formally registered types та many formats are in practice
labeled using a number of different MIME types). Authors are reminded
that, as usual, data received from a client should be treated with
caution, as it may not be in an expected format even if the user is not
hostile and the user agent fully obeyed the accept
attribute's requirements.
For historical reasons, the value
IDL attribute prefixes the
file name with the string "C:\fakepath\
".
Some legacy user agents actually included the full path (which was a
security vulnerability). As a result of this, obtaining the file name
from the value
IDL attribute in a backwards-compatible way is non-trivial. The
following function extracts the file name in a suitably compatible
manner:
function extractFilename(path) { if (path.substr(0, 12) == "C:\\fakepath\\") return path.substr(12); // modern browser var x; x = path.lastIndexOf('/'); if (x >= 0) // Unix-based path return path.substr(x+1); x = path.lastIndexOf('\\'); if (x >= 0) // Windows-based path return path.substr(x+1); return path; // just the file name }
This can be used as follows:
<p><input type=file name=image onchange="updateFilename(this.value)"></p> <p>The name of the file you picked is: <span id="filename">(none)</span></p> <script> function updateFilename(path) { var name = extractFilename(path); document.getElementById('filename').textContent = name; } </script>
The following common input
element content attributes and IDL attributes apply to the element: accept
, multiple
та required
content attributes;
files
and value
IDL attributes.
The value
IDL attribute is in mode filename.
The input
and change
events apply.
The following content attributes must not be specified and do
not apply to the element: alt
, autocomplete
, checked
,
dirname
,
formaction
,
formenctype
,
formmethod
,
formnovalidate
,
formtarget
,
height
,
list
,
max
,
maxlength
,
min
,
minlength
,
pattern
,
placeholder
,
readonly
,
size
,
src
,
step
та width
.
The element's value
attribute must be omitted.
The following IDL attributes and methods do
not apply to the element: checked
, list
,
selectionStart
,
selectionEnd
, selectionDirection
,
valueAsDate
та valueAsNumber
IDL
attributes; select()
, setRangeText()
,
setSelectionRange()
,
stepDown()
та stepUp()
methods.
type=submit
)button
(default - do not set).aria-*
attributes applicable
to the allowed roles.When an input
element's
type
attribute is in the Submit
Button state, the rules in this section apply.
The input
element represents
a button that, when activated, submits the form. Якщо
the element has a value
attribute, the button's label must be the value of that attribute;
otherwise, it must be an implementation-defined string that means
"Submit" or some such. The element is a button, specifically a submit button.
Якщо the element is mutable,
then the element's activation behavior
is as follows: if the element has a form owner
та the element's Document
is fully
active, submit
the form owner from the input
element; otherwise, do nothing.
Якщо the element is not mutable, it has no activation behavior.
The formaction
,
formenctype
,
formmethod
,
formnovalidate
та formtarget
attributes are attributes for
form submission.
The formnovalidate
attribute can be used to make submit buttons that do not trigger the
constraint validation.
The following common input
element content attributes and IDL attributes apply to the element: formaction
, formenctype
, formmethod
, formnovalidate
та formtarget
content attributes;
value
IDL attribute.
The value
IDL attribute is in mode default.
The following content attributes must not be specified and do
not apply to the element: accept
, alt
,
autocomplete
,
checked
,
dirname
,
height
,
list
,
max
,
maxlength
,
min
,
minlength
,
multiple
,
pattern
,
placeholder
,
readonly
,
required
,
size
,
src
,
step
та width
.
The following IDL attributes and methods do
not apply to the element: checked
, files
,
list
,
selectionStart
,
selectionEnd
, selectionDirection
,
valueAsDate
та valueAsNumber
IDL
attributes; select()
, setRangeText()
,
setSelectionRange()
,
stepDown()
та stepUp()
methods.
The input
and change
events do not apply.
type=image
)button
(default - do not set), link
, menuitem
,
menuitemcheckbox
,
menuitemradio
or radio
.aria-*
attributes applicable
to the allowed roles.When an input
element's
type
attribute is in the Image
Button state, the rules in this section apply.
The input
element represents
either an image from which a user can select a coordinate and submit the
form, or alternatively a button from which the user can submit the form.
The element is a button,
specifically a submit
button.
The coordinate is sent to the server during form submission by
sending two entries for the element, derived from the name of the control
but with ".x
" and ".y
"
appended to the name with the x and y components of the coordinate respectively.
The image is given by the src
attribute. The src
attribute must be present та must contain a valid
non-empty URL potentially surrounded by spaces referencing a
non-interactive, optionally animated, image resource that is neither paged
nor scripted.
When any of the following events occur, unless the user agent cannot
support images, or its support for images has been disabled, or the user
agent only fetches elements on demand, or the src
attribute's value is the empty
string, the user agent must resolve
the value of the src
attribute, relative to the element та if that is successful, must fetch
the resulting absolute URL:
input
element's type
attribute is first set to the Image Button state
(possibly when the element is first created) та the src
attribute is present.input
element's type
attribute is changed back to the Image Button state
та the src
attribute is present та its value has changed since the last time the
type
attribute was in the Image
Button state.input
element's type
attribute is in the Image
Button state та the src
attribute is set or changed.Fetching the image must delay the load event of the element's document until the task that is queued by the networking task source once the resource has been fetched (defined below) has been run.
Якщо the image was successfully obtained, with no network errors та the image's type is a supported image type та the image is a valid image of that type, then the image is said to be available. Якщо this є true before the image is completely downloaded, each task that is queued by the networking task source while the image is being fetched must update the presentation of the image appropriately.
The user agent should apply the image sniffing rules to determine the type of the image, with the image's associated Content-Type headers giving the official type. Якщо these rules are not applied, then the type of the image must be the type given by the image's associated Content-Type headers.
User agents must not support non-image resources with the input
element. User agents must not run executable code embedded in the image
resource. User agents must only display the first page of a multipage
resource. User agents must not allow the resource to act in an
interactive fashion, but should honor any animation in the resource.
The task
that is queued
by the networking task source
once the resource has been fetched,
must, if the download was successful and the image is available, queue
a task to fire a simple event
named load
at the input
element; and otherwise,
if the fetching process fails without a response from the remote server,
or completes but the image is not a valid or supported image, queue
a task to fire a simple event
named error
on the input
element.
The alt
attribute provides the textual label for the button for users and user
agents who cannot use the image. The alt
attribute must be present та
must contain a non-empty string giving the label that would be appropriate
for an equivalent button if the image was unavailable.
The input
element supports
dimension attributes.
Якщо the src
attribute is set та the image is available and the user agent is
configured to display that image, then: The element represents
a control for selecting a coordinate from the
image specified by the src
attribute; if the element is mutable, the user agent should
allow the user to select this coordinate та the
element's activation behavior is as
follows: if the element has a form owner та
the element's Document
is fully
active, take the user's selected coordinate та submit the input
element's form owner from the input
element. Якщо the user activates the control without explicitly
selecting a coordinate, then the coordinate (0,0) must be assumed.
Інакше the element represents a submit
button whose label is given by the value of the alt
attribute; if the element is mutable,
then the element's activation behavior
is as follows: if the element has a form owner
та the element's Document
is fully
active, set the selected coordinate to
(0,0) та submit
the input
element's form
owner from the input
element.
In either case, if the element is mutable but has no form
owner or the element's Document
is not fully active, then its activation
behavior must be to do nothing. Якщо the element is not mutable, it has no activation
behavior.
The selected coordinate must consist of an x-component and a y-component. The coordinates represent the position relative to the edge of the image, with the coordinate space having the positive x direction to the right та the positive y direction downwards.
The x-component must be a valid integer representing a number x in the range −(borderleft+paddingleft) ≤ x ≤ width+borderright+paddingright, where width is the rendered width of the image, borderleft is the width of the border on the left of the image, paddingleft is the width of the padding on the left of the image, borderright is the width of the border on the right of the image та paddingright is the width of the padding on the right of the image, with all dimensions given in CSS pixels.
The y-component must be a valid integer representing a number y in the range −(bordertop+paddingtop) ≤ y ≤ height+borderbottom+paddingbottom, where height is the rendered height of the image, bordertop is the width of the border above the image, paddingtop is the width of the padding above the image, borderbottom is the width of the border below the image та paddingbottom is the width of the padding below the image, with all dimensions given in CSS pixels.
Where a border or padding is missing, its width is zero CSS pixels.
The formaction
,
formenctype
,
formmethod
,
formnovalidate
та formtarget
attributes are attributes for
form submission.
width
[ = value
]height
[ = value
]These attributes return the actual rendered dimensions of the image, or zero if the dimensions are not known.
They can be set, to change the corresponding content attributes.
The following common input
element content attributes and IDL attributes apply to the element: alt
, formaction
, formenctype
, formmethod
, formnovalidate
, formtarget
, height
, src
та width
content attributes; value
IDL attribute.
The value
IDL attribute is in mode default.
The following content attributes must not be specified and do
not apply to the element: accept
, autocomplete
,
checked
,
dirname
,
list
,
max
,
maxlength
,
min
,
minlength
,
multiple
,
pattern
,
placeholder
,
readonly
,
required
,
size
та step
.
The element's value
attribute must be omitted.
The following IDL attributes and methods do
not apply to the element: checked
, files
,
list
,
selectionStart
,
selectionEnd
, selectionDirection
,
valueAsDate
та valueAsNumber
IDL
attributes; select()
, setRangeText()
,
setSelectionRange()
,
stepDown()
та stepUp()
methods.
The input
and change
events do not apply.
Many aspects of this state's behavior are similar to the
behavior of the img
element.
Readers are encouraged to read that section, where many of the same
requirements are described in more detail.
Take the following form:
<form action="process.cgi"> <input type=image src=map.png name=where alt="Show location list"> </form>
Якщо the user clicked on the image at coordinate (127,40) then the URL
used to submit the form would be "process.cgi?where.x=127&where.y=40
".
(In this example, it's assumed that for users who don't see the map та who instead just see a button labeled "Show location list", clicking the button will cause the server to show a list of locations to pick from instead of the map.)
type=reset
)button
(default - do not set).aria-*
attributes applicable
to the allowed roles.When an input
element's
type
attribute is in the Reset
Button state, the rules in this section apply.
The input
element represents
a button that, when activated, resets the form. Якщо
the element has a value
attribute, the button's label must be the value of that attribute;
otherwise, it must be an implementation-defined string that means
"Reset" or some such. The element is a button.
Якщо the element is mutable,
then the element's activation behavior,
if the element has a form owner and the
element's Document
is fully
active, is to reset
the form owner; otherwise, it is to do
nothing.
Якщо the element is not mutable, it has no activation behavior.
Constraint validation: The element is barred from constraint validation.
The value
IDL attribute applies
to this element and is in mode default.
The following content attributes must not be specified and do
not apply to the element: accept
, alt
,
autocomplete
,
checked
,
dirname
,
formaction
,
formenctype
,
formmethod
,
formnovalidate
,
formtarget
,
height
,
list
,
max
,
maxlength
,
min
,
minlength
,
multiple
,
pattern
,
placeholder
,
readonly
,
required
,
size
,
src
,
step
та width
.
The following IDL attributes and methods do
not apply to the element: checked
, files
,
list
,
selectionStart
,
selectionEnd
, selectionDirection
,
valueAsDate
та valueAsNumber
IDL
attributes; select()
, setRangeText()
,
setSelectionRange()
,
stepDown()
та stepUp()
methods.
The input
and change
events do not apply.
type=button
)button
(default - do not set), link
, menuitem
,
menuitemcheckbox
,
menuitemradio
or radio
.aria-*
attributes applicable
to the allowed roles.The input
element represents
a button with no default behavior. A label for the button must be provided
in the value
attribute, though it may be the empty string. Якщо the
element has a value
attribute, the button's label must be the value of that attribute;
otherwise, it must be the empty string. The element is a button.
Якщо the element is mutable, the element's activation behavior is to do nothing.
Якщо the element is not mutable, it has no activation behavior.
Constraint validation: The element is barred from constraint validation.
The value
IDL attribute applies
to this element and is in mode default.
The following content attributes must not be specified and do
not apply to the element: accept
, alt
,
autocomplete
,
checked
,
dirname
,
formaction
,
formenctype
,
formmethod
,
formnovalidate
,
formtarget
,
height
,
list
,
max
,
maxlength
,
min
,
minlength
,
multiple
,
pattern
,
placeholder
,
readonly
,
required
,
size
,
src
,
step
та width
.
The following IDL attributes and methods do
not apply to the element: checked
, files
,
list
,
selectionStart
,
selectionEnd
, selectionDirection
,
valueAsDate
та valueAsNumber
IDL
attributes; select()
, setRangeText()
,
setSelectionRange()
,
stepDown()
та stepUp()
methods.
The input
and change
events do not apply.
Цей розділ не є нормативним.
The formats shown to the user in date, time та number controls is independent of the format used for form submission.
Browsers are encouraged to use user interfaces that present dates,
times та numbers according to the conventions of either the locale
implied by the input
element's language or the user's preferred
locale. Using the page's locale will ensure consistency with
page-provided data.
For example, it would be confusing to users if an American English page claimed that a Cirque De Soleil show was going to be showing on 02/03, but their browser, configured to use the British English locale, only showed the date 03/02 in the ticket purchase date picker. Using the page's locale would at least ensure that the date was presented in the same format everywhere. (There's still a risk that the user would end up arriving a month late, of course, but there's only so much that can be done about such cultural differences...)
input
element attributesThese attributes only apply
to an input
element if
its type
attribute is in a state whose definition declares that the attribute applies.
When an attribute doesn't
apply to an input
element, user agents must ignore the attribute,
regardless of the requirements and definitions below.
maxlength
and minlength
attributesThe maxlength
attribute, when it applies, is a form control maxlength
attribute controlled by the input
element's dirty
value flag.
The minlength
attribute, when it applies, is a form control minlength
attribute controlled by the input
element's dirty
value flag.
Якщо the input
element has
a maximum allowed value length,
then the code-unit length of the value of
the element's value
attribute must be equal to or less than the element's maximum
allowed value length.
The following extract shows how a messaging client's text entry could be arbitrarily restricted to a fixed number of characters, thus forcing any conversation through this medium to be terse and discouraging intelligent discourse.
<label>What are you doing? <input name=status maxlength=140></label>
Here, a password is given a minimum length:
<p><label>Username: <input name=u required></label> <p><label>Password: <input name=p required minlength=12></label>
size
attributeThe size
attribute gives the number of characters that, in a visual rendering, the
user agent is to allow the user to see while editing the element's value.
The size
attribute, if specified, must have a value that is a valid
non-negative integer greater than zero.
Якщо the attribute is present, then its value must be parsed using the rules for parsing non-negative integers та if the result is a number greater than zero, then the user agent should ensure that at least that many characters are visible.
The size
IDL attribute is limited
to only non-negative numbers greater than zero and has a default
value of 20.
readonly
attributeThe readonly
attribute is a boolean attribute that
controls whether or not the user can edit the form control. When
specified, the element is not mutable.
Constraint validation: Якщо the readonly
attribute is
specified on an input
element, the element is barred
from constraint validation.
The difference between disabled
and readonly
is that read-only
controls are still focusable, so the user can still select the text and
interact with it, whereas disabled controls are entirely non-interactive.
(For this reason, only text controls can be made read-only: it wouldn't
make sense for checkboxes or buttons, for instances.)
In the following example, the existing product identifiers cannot be modified, but they are still displayed as part of the form, for consistency with the row representing a new product (where the identifier is not yet filled in).
<form action="products.cgi" method="post" enctype="multipart/form-data"> <table> <tr> <th> Product ID <th> Product name <th> Price <th> Action <tr> <td> <input readonly="readonly" name="1.pid" value="H412"> <td> <input required="required" name="1.pname" value="Floor lamp Ulke"> <td> $<input required="required" type="number" min="0" step="0.01" name="1.pprice" value="49.99"> <td> <button formnovalidate="formnovalidate" name="action" value="delete:1">Delete</button> <tr> <td> <input readonly="readonly" name="2.pid" value="FG28"> <td> <input required="required" name="2.pname" value="Table lamp Ulke"> <td> $<input required="required" type="number" min="0" step="0.01" name="2.pprice" value="24.99"> <td> <button formnovalidate="formnovalidate" name="action" value="delete:2">Delete</button> <tr> <td> <input required="required" name="3.pid" value="" pattern="[A-Z0-9]+"> <td> <input required="required" name="3.pname" value=""> <td> $<input required="required" type="number" min="0" step="0.01" name="3.pprice" value=""> <td> <button formnovalidate="formnovalidate" name="action" value="delete:3">Delete</button> </table> <p> <button formnovalidate="formnovalidate" name="action" value="add">Add</button> </p> <p> <button name="action" value="update">Save</button> </p> </form>
required
attributeThe required
attribute is a boolean attribute. When
specified, the element is required.
Constraint validation: Якщо the element is required та its value
IDL attribute applies and is in the mode value та the element is mutable та the element's value is the empty string, then the
element is suffering from being
missing.
The following form has two required fields, one for an e-mail address and one for a password. It also has a third field that is only considered valid if the user types the same password in the password field and this third field.
<h1>Create new account</h1> <form action="/newaccount" method=post oninput="up2.setCustomValidity(up2.value != up.value ? 'Passwords do not match.' : '')"> <p> <label for="username">E-mail address:</label> <input id="username" type=email required name=un> <p> <label for="password1">Password:</label> <input id="password1" type=password required name=up> <p> <label for="password2">Confirm password:</label> <input id="password2" type=password name=up2> <p> <input type=submit value="Create account"> </form>
For radio buttons, the required
attribute is
satisfied if any of the radio buttons in the group is selected. Thus, in the
following example, any of the radio buttons can be checked, not just the
one marked as required:
<fieldset> <legend>Did the movie pass the Bechdel test?</legend> <p><label><input type="radio" name="bechdel" value="no-characters"> No, there are not even two female characters in the movie. </label> <p><label><input type="radio" name="bechdel" value="no-names"> No, the female characters never talk to each other. </label> <p><label><input type="radio" name="bechdel" value="no-topic"> No, when female characters talk to each other it's always about a male character. </label> <p><label><input type="radio" name="bechdel" value="yes" required> Yes. </label> <p><label><input type="radio" name="bechdel" value="unknown"> I don't know. </label> </fieldset>
To avoid confusion as to whether a radio button group is required or not, authors are encouraged to specify the attribute on all the radio buttons in a group. Indeed, in general, authors are encouraged to avoid having radio button groups that do not have any initially checked controls in the first place, as this is a state that the user cannot return to та is therefore generally considered a poor user interface.
multiple
attributeThe multiple
attribute is a boolean attribute that
indicates whether the user is to be allowed to specify more than one
value.
The following extract shows how an e-mail client's "Cc" field could accept multiple e-mail addresses.
<label>Cc: <input type=email multiple name=cc></label>
Якщо the user had, amongst many friends in his user contacts database, two friends "Arthur Dent" (with address "art@example.net") and "Adam Josh" (with address "adamjosh@example.net"), then, after the user has typed "a", the user agent might suggest these two e-mail addresses to the user.
The page could also link in the user's contacts database from the site:
<label>Cc: <input type=email multiple name=cc list=contacts></label> ... <datalist id="contacts"> <option value="hedral@damowmow.com"> <option value="pillar@example.com"> <option value="astrophy@cute.example"> <option value="astronomy@science.example.org"> </datalist>
Suppose the user had entered "bob@example.net" into this text field та
then started typing a second e-mail address starting with "a". The user
agent might show both the two friends mentioned earlier, as well as the
"astrophy" and "astronomy" values given in the datalist
element.
The following extract shows how an e-mail client's "Attachments" field could accept multiple files for upload.
<label>Attachments: <input type=file multiple name=att></label>
pattern
attributeThe pattern
attribute specifies a regular expression against which the control's value, or, when the multiple
attribute applies and is set, the control's values, are to be checked.
Якщо specified, the attribute's value must match the JavaScript Pattern production. [ECMA262]
Якщо an input
element
has a pattern
attribute specified та the attribute's value, when compiled as a
JavaScript regular expression with the global
,
ignoreCase
та multiline
flags disabled (see ECMA262 Edition 5, sections 15.10.7.2
through 15.10.7.4), compiles successfully, then the resulting regular
expression is the element's compiled
pattern regular expression. Якщо the element has no such
attribute, or if the value doesn't compile successfully, then the
element has no compiled
pattern regular expression. [ECMA262]
Constraint validation: Якщо the element's value is not the empty string та either
the element's multiple
attribute is not specified or it does not apply to the input
element given its type
attribute's current state та the element has a compiled
pattern regular expression but that regular expression does not
match the entirety of the element's value, then the element is suffering
from a pattern mismatch.
Constraint validation: Якщо the element's value is not the empty string та the
element's multiple
attribute is specified and applies
to the input
element та
the element has a compiled
pattern regular expression but that regular expression does not
match the entirety of each of the element's values, then the element is suffering from a pattern
mismatch.
The compiled pattern regular expression, when matched against a string, must have its start anchored to the start of the string and its end anchored to the end of the string.
This implies that the regular expression language used for
this attribute is the same as that used in JavaScript, except that the pattern
attribute is matched against the entire value, not just any subset
(somewhat as if it implied a ^(?:
at
the start of the pattern and a )$
at
the end).
When an input
element has a pattern
attribute specified, authors should provide a description of the pattern
in text near the control. Authors may also include a title
attribute to give a description of
the pattern. User agents may use the contents of this attribute, if it is
present, when informing the user that the pattern is not matched, or at
any other suitable time, such as in a tooltip or read out by assistive
technology when the control gains focus.
Relying on the title
attribute alone is currently discouraged as many user agents do not expose
the attribute in an accessible manner as required by this specification
(e.g. requiring a pointing device such as a mouse to cause a tooltip to
appear, which excludes keyboard-only users and touch-only users, such as
anyone with a modern phone or tablet).
For example, the following snippet includes the pattern description in
text below the input
, the
pattern description is also included in the title
attribute:
<label> Part number: <input pattern="[0-9][A-Z]{3}" name="part" data-x="A part number is a digit followed by three uppercase letters."/> </label> <p>A part number is a digit followed by three uppercase letters.</p>
The presence of the pattern description in text makes the advice available to any user regardless of device.
The presence of the pattern description in the title attribute, results in the description being announced by assistive technology such as screen readers when the input receives focus.
Якщо the user has attempted to submit the form with incorrect information, the presence of the title attribute text could also cause the UA to display an alert such as:
A part number is a digit followed by three uppercase letters. You cannot submit this form when the field is incorrect.
In this example, the pattern description is in text below the input
, but not in the title
attribute. The aria-describedby
attribute is used to explicitly associate the text description with the
control, the description is announced by assistive technology such as
screen readers when the input
receives focus:
<label> Part number: <input pattern="[0-9][A-Z]{3}" name="part" aria-describedby="description"> </label> <p id="description">A part number is a digit followed by three uppercase letters.</p>
When a control has a pattern
attribute, the title
attribute, if used, must describe the pattern. Additional information
could also be included, so long as it assists the user in filling in the
control. Інакше assistive technology would be impaired.
For instance, if the title attribute contained the caption of the control, assistive technology could end up saying something like The text you have entered does not match the required pattern. Birthday, which is not useful.
UAs may still show the title
in non-error situations (for
example, as a tooltip when hovering over the control), so authors should
be careful not to word title
s
as if an error has necessarily occurred.
min
and max
attributesSome form controls can have explicit constraints applied limiting the allowed range of values that the user can provide. Normally, such a range would be linear and continuous. A form control can have a periodic domain, however, in which case the form control's broadest possible range is finite та authors can specify explicit ranges within it that span the boundaries.
Specifically, the broadest range of a type=time
control is
midnight to midnight (24 hours) та authors can set both continuous linear
ranges (such as 9pm to 11pm) and discontinuous ranges spanning midnight
(such as 11pm to 1am).
The min
and max
attributes indicate the allowed range of values for the element.
Their syntax is defined by the section that defines the type
attribute's current state.
Якщо the element has a min
attribute та the result of applying the algorithm to convert a
string to a number to the value of the min
attribute is a number, then
that number is the element's minimum; otherwise, if the type
attribute's current state
defines a default
minimum, then that is the minimum; otherwise, the element has no minimum.
The min
attribute also defines the step base.
Якщо the element has a max
attribute та the result of applying the algorithm to convert a
string to a number to the value of the max
attribute is a number, then
that number is the element's maximum; otherwise, if the type
attribute's current state
defines a default
maximum, then that is the maximum; otherwise, the element has no maximum.
Якщо the element does not have
a periodic domain, the max
attribute's value (the maximum)
must not be less than the min
attribute's value (its minimum).
Якщо an element that does not have a periodic domain has a maximum that is less than its minimum, then so long as the element has a value, it will either be suffering from an underflow or suffering from an overflow.
An element has a reversed range if it has a periodic domain and its maximum is less than its minimum.
An element has range limitations if it has a defined minimum or a defined maximum.
Constraint validation: When the element has a minimum and does not have a reversed range та the result of applying the algorithm to convert a string to a number to the string given by the element's value is a number та the number obtained from that algorithm is less than the minimum, the element is suffering from an underflow.
Constraint validation: When the element has a maximum and does not have a reversed range та the result of applying the algorithm to convert a string to a number to the string given by the element's value is a number та the number obtained from that algorithm is more than the maximum, the element is suffering from an overflow.
Constraint validation: When an element has a reversed range та the result of applying the algorithm to convert a string to a number to the string given by the element's value is a number та the number obtained from that algorithm is more than the maximum and less than the minimum, the element is simultaneously suffering from an underflow and suffering from an overflow.
The following date control limits input to dates що є before the 1980s:
<input name=bday type=date max="1979-12-31">
The following number control limits input to whole numbers greater than zero:
<input name=quantity required="" type="number" min="1" value="1">
The following time control limits input to those minutes that occur between 9pm and 6am, defaulting to midnight:
<input name="sleepStart" type=time min="21:00" max="06:00" step="60" value="00:00">
step
attributeThe step
attribute indicates the granularity that is expected (and required) of the
value,
by limiting the allowed values. The section that
defines the type
attribute's current state also defines the default step, the step scale factor та in some cases
the default
step base, which are used in processing the attribute as
described below.
The step
attribute, if specified, must either have a value that is a valid
floating-point number that parses
to a number that is greater than zero, or must have a value that is an ASCII чутливі до реєстру match for
the string "any
".
The attribute provides the allowed value step for the element, as follows:
any
",
then there is no allowed
value step.The step base is the value returned by the following algorithm:
Якщо the element has a min
content attribute та the
result of applying the algorithm to convert a
string to a number to the value of the min
content attribute is not
an error, then return that result and abort these steps.
Якщо the element has a value
content attribute та
the result of applying the algorithm to convert a
string to a number to the value of the value
content attribute is
not an error, then return that result and abort these steps.
Якщо a default
step base is defined for this element given its type
attribute's state, then
return it and abort these steps.
Повернутиzero.
Constraint validation: When the element has an allowed value step та the result of applying the algorithm to convert a string to a number to the string given by the element's value is a number та that number subtracted from the step base is not an integral multiple of the allowed value step, the element is suffering from a step mismatch.
The following range control only accepts values in the range 0..1 та allows 256 steps in that range:
<input name=opacity type=range min=0 max=1 step=0.00392156863>
The following control allows any time in the day to be selected, with any accuracy (e.g. thousandth-of-a-second accuracy or more):
<input name=favtime type=time step=any>
Normally, time controls are limited to an accuracy of one minute.
list
attributeThe list
attribute is used to identify an element that lists predefined options
suggested to the user.
Якщо present, its value must be the ID
of a datalist
element in
the same document.
The suggestions
source element is the first element in the document in tree
order to have an ID
equal to the value of the list
attribute, if that element is a datalist
element. Якщо there is no list
attribute, or if there is no element with that ID, or if the first element with that ID is not a datalist
element, then there is no suggestions
source element.
Якщо there is a suggestions
source element, then, when the user agent is allowing the user to
edit the input
element's
value,
the user agent should offer the suggestions represented by the suggestions source element to the user
in a manner suitable for the type of control used. The user agent may
use the suggestion's label
to identify the suggestion if appropriate.
How user selections of suggestions are handled depends on whether the element is a control accepting a single value only, or whether it accepts multiple values:
multiple
attribute
specified or if the multiple
attribute does not applyWhen the user selects a suggestion, the input
element's value
must be set to the selected suggestion's value, as if the user had written
that value himself.
multiple
attribute
specified та the multiple
attribute does applyWhen the user selects a suggestion, the user agent must either add
a new entry to the input
element's values,
whose value is the selected suggestion's value, or change an existing
entry in the input
element's values
to have the value given by the selected suggestion's value, as if the user had himself
added an entry with that value, or edited an existing entry to be
that value. Which behavior is to be applied depends on the user
interface in a user-agent-defined manner.
Якщо the list
attribute does
not apply, there is no suggestions
source element.
This URL field offers some suggestions.
<label>Homepage: <input name=hp type=url list=hpurls></label> <datalist id=hpurls> <option value="http://www.google.com/" label="Google"> <option value="http://www.reddit.com/" label="Reddit"> </datalist>
Other URLs from the user's history might show also; this is up to the user agent.
This example demonstrates how to design a form that uses the autocompletion list feature while still degrading usefully in legacy user agents.
Якщо the autocompletion list is merely an aid та is not important to
the content, then simply using a datalist
element with children option
elements is enough. To prevent the values from being rendered in legacy
user agents, they need to be placed inside the value
attribute instead of
inline.
<p> <label> Enter a breed: <input type="text" name="breed" list="breeds"> <datalist id="breeds"> <option value="Abyssinian"> <option value="Alpaca"> <!-- ... --> </datalist> </label> </p>
However, if the values need to be shown in legacy UAs, then fallback
content can be placed inside the datalist
element, as follows:
<p> <label> Enter a breed: <input type="text" name="breed" list="breeds"> </label> <datalist id="breeds"> <label> or select one from the list: <select name="breed"> <option value=""> (none selected) <option>Abyssinian <option>Alpaca <!-- ... --> </select> </label> </datalist> </p>
The fallback content will only be shown in UAs that don't support datalist
. The options, on
the other hand, will be detected by all UAs, even though they are not
children of the datalist
element.
Note that if an option
element used in a datalist
is selected
,
it will be selected by default by legacy UAs (because it affects the select
), but it will not have
any effect on the input
element in UAs that support datalist
.
placeholder
attributeThe placeholder
attribute represents a short hint (a word or short phrase)
intended to aid the user with data entry when the control has no value. A
hint could be a sample value or a brief description of the expected
format. The attribute, if specified, must have a value that contains no
"LF" (U+000A) or "CR" (U+000D) characters.
The placeholder
attribute should not be used as a replacement for a label
.
For a longer hint or other advisory text, place the text next to the
control.
Use of the placeholder
attribute as a
replacement for a label
can
reduce the accessibility and usability of the control for a range of users
including older users and users with cognitive, mobility, fine motor skill
or vision impairments. While the hint given by the control's label
is shown at all times, the short hint given in the placeholder
attribute is
only shown before the user enters a value. Furthermore, placeholder
text may be
mistaken for a pre-filled value та as commonly implemented the default
color of the placeholder text provides insufficient contrast and the lack
of a separate visible label
reduces the size of the hit region available for setting focus on the
control.
User agents should present this hint to the user, after having stripped line breaks from it, when the element's value is the empty string and the control is not focused (i.e., by displaying it inside a blank unfocused control).
Here is an example of a mail configuration user interface that uses the
placeholder
attribute:
<fieldset> <legend>Mail Account</legend> <p><label>Name: <input type="text" name="fullname" placeholder="John Ratzenberger"></label></p> <p><label>Address: <input type="email" name="address" placeholder="john@example.net"></label></p> <p><label>Password: <input type="password" name="password"></label></p> <p><label>Description: <input type="text" name="desc" placeholder="My Email Account"></label></p> </fieldset>
In situations where the control's content has one directionality but the placeholder needs to have a different directionality, Unicode's bidirectional-algorithm formatting characters can be used in the attribute value:
<input name=t1 type=tel placeholder="‫ رقم الهاتف 1 ‮"> <input name=t2 type=tel placeholder="‫ رقم الهاتف 2 ‮">
For slightly more clarity, here's the same example using numeric character references instead of inline Arabic:
<input name=t1 type=tel placeholder="‫رقم الهاتف 1‮"> <input name=t2 type=tel placeholder="‫رقم الهاتف 2‮">
input
element APIsvalue
[ = value
]Returns the current value of the form control.
Can be set, to change the value.
Throws an InvalidStateError
exception if it is set to any value other than the empty string when
the control is a file upload control.
checked
[ = value
]Returns the current checkedness of the form control.
Can be set, to change the checkedness.
files
Returns a FileList
object
listing the selected
files of the form control.
Returns null if the control isn't a file control.
valueAsDate
[ = value
]Returns a Date
object representing the form control's value,
if applicable; otherwise, returns null.
Can be set, to change the value.
Throws an InvalidStateError
exception if the control isn't date- or time-based.
valueAsNumber
[ = value
]Returns a number representing the form control's value, if applicable; otherwise, returns NaN.
Can be set, to change the value. Setting this to NaN will set the underlying value to the empty string.
Throws an InvalidStateError
exception if the control is neither date- or time-based nor numeric.
stepUp
( [ n
] )stepDown
( [ n
] )Changes the form control's value
by the value given in the step
attribute, multiplied by n. The default value for n
is 1.
Throws InvalidStateError
exception if the control is neither date- or time-based nor numeric,
or if the step
attribute's value is "any
".
list
Returns the datalist
element на який вказує the list
attribute.
The value
IDL attribute allows scripts to manipulate the value of an input
element. The attribute is in one of the following modes, which define
its behavior:
On getting, it must return the current value of the element. On setting, it
must set the element's value
to the new value, set the element's dirty value flag to
true, invoke the value
sanitization algorithm, if the element's type
attribute's current
state defines one та then, if the element has a text entry cursor
position, should move the text entry cursor position to the end of
the text field, unselecting any selected text and resetting the
selection direction to none.
On getting, if the element has a value
attribute, it must
return that attribute's value; otherwise, it must return the empty
string. On setting, it must set the element's value
attribute to the new
value.
On getting, if the element has a value
attribute, it must
return that attribute's value; otherwise, it must return the string
"on
". On setting, it must set the
element's value
attribute to the new value.
On getting, it must return the string "C:\fakepath\
"
followed by the name of the first file in the list of selected files, if
any, or the empty string if the list is empty. On setting, if the
new value is the empty string, it must empty the list of selected files;
otherwise, it must throw an InvalidStateError
exception.
This "fakepath" requirement is a sad accident of history. See the example in the File Upload state section for more information.
The checked
IDL attribute allows scripts to manipulate the checkedness of an input
element. On getting, it must return the current checkedness of the element; and on
setting, it must set the element's checkedness to the new value та
встановити the element's dirty checkedness flag to
true.
The files
IDL attribute allows scripts to access the element's selected files. On
getting, if the IDL attribute applies, it must return a FileList
object that represents the current selected files. The same
object must be returned until the list of selected files changes.
Якщо the IDL attribute does
not apply, then it must instead return null. [FILEAPI]
The valueAsDate
IDL attribute represents the value
of the element, interpreted as a date.
On getting, if the valueAsDate
attribute does
not apply, as defined for the input
element's type
attribute's current state, then return null. Інакше run the algorithm to convert a string
to a Date
object defined for that state; if the
algorithm returned a Date
object, then return it,
otherwise, return null.
On setting, if the valueAsDate
attribute does
not apply, as defined for the input
element's type
attribute's current state, then throw an InvalidStateError
exception; otherwise, if the new value is null or a Date
object representing the NaN time value, then set the value of the element to the empty string;
otherwise, run the algorithm to convert a Date
object to a string, as defined for that state, on the new value та
set the value
of the element to the resulting string.
The valueAsNumber
IDL attribute represents the value
of the element, interpreted as a number.
On getting, if the valueAsNumber
attribute does not apply,
as defined for the input
element's type
attribute's current state, then return a Not-a-Number (NaN) value.
Інакше if the valueAsDate
attribute applies,
run the algorithm
to convert a string to a Date
object defined for
that state; if the algorithm returned a Date
object, then
return the time value of the object (the number of milliseconds
from midnight UTC the morning of 1970-01-01 to the time represented by
the Date
object), otherwise, return a Not-a-Number (NaN)
value. Інакше run the algorithm to convert a
string to a number defined for that state; if the algorithm
returned a number, then return it, otherwise, return a Not-a-Number
(NaN) value.
On setting, if the new value is infinite, then throw a TypeError
exception. Інакше if the valueAsNumber
attribute does not apply,
as defined for the input
element's type
attribute's current state, then throw an InvalidStateError
exception. Інакше if the new value is a Not-a-Number (NaN) value, then
set the value
of the element to the empty string. Інакше if the valueAsDate
attribute applies,
run the algorithm
to convert a Date
object to a string defined for
that state, passing it a Date
object whose time value
is the new value та set the value
of the element to the resulting string. Інакше run the algorithm to convert a
number to a string, as defined for that state, on the new value та
set the value
of the element to the resulting string.
The stepDown(n)
and stepUp(n)
methods, when invoked, must run the following algorithm:
Якщо the stepDown()
and stepUp()
methods do not apply, as defined for
the input
element's type
attribute's current state, then throw an InvalidStateError
exception та abort these steps.
Якщо the element has no allowed
value step, then throw an InvalidStateError
exception та abort these steps.
Якщо the element has a minimum and a maximum and the minimum is greater than the maximum, then abort these steps.
Якщо the element has a minimum and a maximum and there is no value greater than or equal to the element's minimum and less than or equal to the element's maximum that, when subtracted from the step base, is an integral multiple of the allowed value step, then abort these steps.
Якщо applying the algorithm to convert a string to a number to the string given by the element's value does not result in an error, then let value be the result of that algorithm. Інакше let value be zero.
Якщо value subtracted from the step
base is not an integral multiple of the allowed value step, then set value to the nearest value that, when
subtracted from the step
base, is an integral multiple of the allowed value step та that is less
than value if the method invoked was
the stepDown()
and more than value otherwise.
Otherwise (value subtracted from the step base is an integral multiple of the allowed value step), run the following substeps:
Нехай n be the argument.
Нехай delta be the allowed value step multiplied by n.
Якщо the method invoked was the stepDown()
method,
negate delta.
Нехай value be the result of adding delta to value.
Якщо the element has a minimum та value is less than that minimum, then set value to the smallest value that, when subtracted from the step base, is an integral multiple of the allowed value step та that is more than or equal to minimum.
Якщо the element has a maximum та value is greater than that maximum, then set value to the largest value that, when subtracted from the step base, is an integral multiple of the allowed value step та that is less than or equal to maximum.
Нехай value as string be the result
of running the algorithm to convert a
number to a string, as defined for the input
element's type
attribute's current state, on value.
Set the value of the element to value as string.
The list
IDL attribute must return the current suggestions source element, if any, or
null otherwise.
When the input
and change
events apply (which is the case for all input
controls other than buttons and those with the type
attribute in the Hidden state), the events
are fired to indicate that the user has interacted with the control. The
input
event fires whenever the user has modified the data of the control. The
change
event fires when the value is committed, if that makes sense for the
control, or else when the control loses focus. In all cases, the input
event comes before the
corresponding change
event
(if any).
When an input
element
has a defined activation behavior,
the rules for dispatching these events, if they apply, are given in the section above
that defines the type
attribute's state. (This is the case for all input
controls with the type
attribute in the Checkbox
state, the Radio
Button state, or the File
Upload state.)
For input
elements
without a defined activation behavior,
but to which these events apply
та for which the user interface involves both interactive manipulation
and an explicit commit action, then when the user changes the element's
value,
the user agent must queue a task to fire
a simple event that bubbles named input
at the input
element та
any time the user commits the change, the user agent must queue
a task to fire a simple event
that bubbles named change
at the input
element.
An example of a user interface involving both
interactive manipulation and a commit action would be a Range controls that use a
slider, when manipulated using a pointing device. While the user is
dragging the control's knob, input
events would fire whenever the position changed, whereas the change
event would only fire when the user let go of the knob, committing to a
specific value.
For input
elements
without a defined activation behavior,
but to which these events apply
та for which the user interface involves an explicit commit action but
no intermediate manipulation, then any time the user commits a change to
the element's value,
the user agent must queue a task to first fire a simple event that bubbles named
input
at the input
element та then fire a simple event
that bubbles named change
at the input
element.
An example of a user interface with a commit action would be a Color control that consists of a single button that brings up a color wheel: if the value only changes when the dialog is closed, then that would be the explicit commit action. On the other hand, if the control can be focused and manipulating the control changes the color interactively, then there might be no commit action.
Another example of a user interface with a commit action would be a Date control that allows both text-based user input and user selection from a drop-down calendar: while text input might not have an explicit commit step, selecting a date from the drop down calendar and then dismissing the drop down would be a commit action.
For input
elements
without a defined activation behavior,
but to which these events apply,
any time the user causes the element's value to change without an explicit
commit action, the user agent must queue a task
to fire a simple event that bubbles
named input
at the input
element. The
corresponding change
event, if any, will be fired when the control loses focus.
Examples of a user changing the element's value would include the user typing into a text field, pasting a new value into the field, or undoing an edit in that field. Some user interactions do not cause changes to the value, e.g. hitting the "delete" key in an empty text field, or replacing some text in the field with text from the clipboard that happens to be exactly the same text.
A Range control in the form of a slider that the user has focused and is interacting with using a keyboard would be another example of the user changing the element's value without a commit step.
In the case of tasks
that just fire an input
event, user agents may wait for a suitable break in the user's
interaction before queuing
the tasks; for example, a user agent could wait for the user to have not
hit a key for 100ms, so as to only fire the event when the user pauses,
instead of continuously for each keystroke.
When the user agent is to change an input
element's value
on behalf of the user (e.g. as part of a form prefilling feature), the
user agent must queue a task to first
update the value
accordingly, then fire a simple event
that bubbles named input
at
the input
element, then fire a simple event that bubbles named
change
at the input
element.
These events are not fired in response to changes made to the values of form controls by scripts. (This is to make it easier to update the values of form controls in response to the user manipulating the controls, without having to then filter out the script's own changes to avoid an infinite loop.)
The task source for these tasks is the user interaction task source.
button
elementautofocus
- Automatically focus the form control when the page is loadeddisabled
- Whether the form control is disabledform
- Associates the control with a form
elementformaction
- URL to use for form
submissionformenctype
- Form data set encoding type to use for form
submissionformmethod
- HTTP method to use for form submissionformnovalidate
- Bypass form control validation for form
submissionformtarget
- Browsing context for form
submissionmenu
- Specifies the
element's designated pop-up menuname
- Name of form control to use for form
submission and in the form.elements
API
type
- Type of buttonvalue
- Value to be used for form submissionbutton
(default
- do not set), link
, menuitem
,
menuitemcheckbox
,
menuitemradio
or radio
.aria-*
attributes applicable
to the allowed roles.interface HTMLButtonElement : HTMLElement {
attribute boolean autofocus;
attribute boolean disabled;
readonly attribute HTMLFormElement? form;
attribute DOMString formAction;
attribute DOMString formEnctype;
attribute DOMString formMethod;
attribute boolean formNoValidate;
attribute DOMString formTarget;
attribute DOMString name;
attribute DOMString type;
attribute DOMString value;
readonly attribute boolean willValidate;
readonly attribute ValidityState validity;
readonly attribute DOMString validationMessage;
boolean checkValidity();
void setCustomValidity(DOMString error);
readonly attribute NodeList labels;
};
The button
element represents
a button labeled by its contents.
The element is a button.
The type
attribute controls the behavior of the button when it is activated. It is
an enumerated attribute. The
following table lists the keywords and states for the attribute — the
keywords in the left column map to the states in the cell in the second
column on the same row as the keyword.
Keyword | State | Brief description |
---|---|---|
submit
|
Submit Button | Submits the form. |
reset
|
Reset Button | Resets the form. |
button
|
Button | Does nothing. |
The missing value default is the Submit Button state.
Якщо the type
attribute is in the Submit
Button state, the element is specifically a submit button.
Constraint validation: Якщо the type
attribute is in the Reset Button state, or the Button
state, the element is barred
from constraint validation.
When a button
element
is not disabled,
its activation behavior element is
to run the steps defined in the following list for the current state of
the element's type
attribute:
Якщо the element has a form owner and
the element's Document
is fully active, the element must submit the form
owner from the button
element.
Якщо the element has a form owner and
the element's Document
is fully active, the element must reset the form
owner.
Do nothing.
The form
attribute is used to explicitly associate the button
element with its form owner. The name
attribute represents the
element's name. The disabled
attribute is used to make the control non-interactive and to prevent its
value from being submitted. The autofocus
attribute controls
focus. The formaction
,
formenctype
,
formmethod
,
formnovalidate
та formtarget
attributes are attributes for
form submission.
The formnovalidate
attribute can be used to make submit buttons that do not trigger the
constraint validation.
The formaction
,
formenctype
,
formmethod
,
formnovalidate
та formtarget
must not be specified if the element's type
attribute is not in the Submit Button state.
The value
attribute gives the element's value for the purposes of form submission.
The element's value
is the value of the element's value
attribute, if there is one,
or the empty string otherwise.
A button (and its value) is only included in the form submission if the button itself was used to initiate the form submission.
The type
IDL attribute must reflect the content attribute
of the same name, limited to
only known values.
The willValidate
,
validity
та validationMessage
IDL attributes та the checkValidity()
та setCustomValidity()
methods, are part of the constraint
validation API. The labels
IDL attribute provides a list of the element's label
s.
The autofocus
,
disabled
,
form
та name
IDL attributes are part of the element's forms API.
The following button is labeled "Show hint" and pops up a dialog box when activated:
<button type=button onclick="alert('This 15-20 minute piece was composed by George Gershwin.')"> Show hint </button>
select
elementoption
, optgroup
та script-supporting elements.autofocus
- Automatically focus the form control when the page is loadeddisabled
- Whether the form control is disabledform
- Associates the control with a form
elementmultiple
- Whether to allow multiple valuesname
- Name of form control to use for form
submission and in the form.elements
API
required
- Whether the control is required for form
submissionsize
- Size of the controllistbox
(default - do not set) or menu
.aria-*
attributes applicable
to the allowed roles.interface HTMLSelectElement : HTMLElement { attribute boolean autofocus; attribute boolean disabled; readonly attribute HTMLFormElement? form; attribute boolean multiple; attribute DOMString name; attribute boolean required; attribute unsigned long size; readonly attribute DOMString type; readonly attribute HTMLOptionsCollection options; attribute unsigned long length; getter Element? item(unsigned long index); HTMLOptionElement? namedItem(DOMString name); void add((HTMLOptionElement or HTMLOptGroupElement) element, optional (HTMLElement or long)? before = null); void remove(); // ChildNode overload void remove(long index); setter creator void (unsigned long index, HTMLOptionElement? option); readonly attribute HTMLCollection selectedOptions; attribute long selectedIndex; attribute DOMString value; readonly attribute boolean willValidate; readonly attribute ValidityState validity; readonly attribute DOMString validationMessage; boolean checkValidity(); void setCustomValidity(DOMString error); readonly attribute NodeList labels; };
The select
element
represents a control for selecting amongst a set of options.
The multiple
attribute is a boolean attribute. Якщо
the attribute is present, then the select
element represents a control for selecting zero
or more options from the list of options. Якщо the
attribute is absent, then the select
element represents a control for selecting a
single option from the list
of options.
The size
attribute gives the number of options to show to the user. The size
attribute, if specified, must
have a value that is a valid
non-negative integer greater than zero.
The display
size of a select
element is the result of applying the rules
for parsing non-negative integers to the value of element's size
attribute, if it has one and parsing it is successful. Якщо applying
those rules to the attribute's value is not successful, or if the size
attribute is absent, then the element's display size is 4 if the element's multiple
content attribute is present та 1 otherwise.
The list
of options for a select
element consists of all the option
element children of the select
element та all the option
element children of all the optgroup
element children of the select
element, in tree order.
The required
attribute is a boolean attribute. When
specified, the user will be required to select a value before submitting
the form.
Якщо a select
element has
a required
attribute specified, does not have a multiple
attribute specified
та has a display
size of 1; and if the value
of the first option
element in the select
element's list
of options (if any) is the empty string та that option
element's parent node is the select
element (and not an optgroup
element), then that option
is the select
element's placeholder label option.
Якщо a select
element has
a required
attribute specified, does not have a multiple
attribute specified
та has a display
size of 1, then the select
element must have a placeholder label
option.
Constraint validation: Якщо the element has its required
attribute specified та either none of the option
elements in the select
element's list
of options have their selectedness set to true, or
the only option
element
in the select
element's
list
of options with its selectedness set to true is
the placeholder label option,
then the element is suffering
from being missing.
Якщо the multiple
attribute is absent та the element is not disabled, then the user agent should
allow the user to pick an option
element in its list
of options that is itself not disabled. Upon this option
element being picked
(either through a click, or through unfocusing the element after
changing its value, or through any other mechanism) та before the
relevant user interaction event
is queued (e.g. before the click
event), the user agent must set the selectedness of the picked option
element to true, set
its dirtiness
to true та then send select
update notifications.
Якщо the multiple
attribute is absent, whenever an option
element in the select
element's list
of options has its selectedness set to true та
whenever an option
element with its selectedness
set to true is added to the select
element's list
of options, the user agent must set the selectedness of all the other
option
elements in its list
of options to false.
Якщо the multiple
attribute is absent and the element's display size is greater than 1, then
the user agent should also allow the user to request that the option
whose selectedness є true, if any,
be unselected. Upon this request being conveyed to the user agent та
before the relevant user interaction event
is queued (e.g. before the click
event), the user agent must set
the selectedness
of that option
element
to false, set its dirtiness
to true та then send select
update notifications.
Якщо nodes are inserted or nodes
are removed causing the list of options to gain or lose
one or more option
elements, or if an option
element in the list
of options asks
for a reset, then, if the select
element's multiple
attribute is absent, the select
element's display
size is 1 та no option
elements in the select
element's list
of options have their selectedness set to true, the
user agent must set the selectedness of the first option
element in the list of options in tree
order that is not disabled,
if any, to true.
Якщо the multiple
attribute is present та the element is not disabled, then the user agent should
allow the user to toggle
the selectedness
of the option
elements
in its list
of options що є themselves not disabled. Upon such an element
being toggled
(either through a click, or any other mechanism) та before the relevant
user interaction event
is queued (e.g. before a related click
event), the selectedness of the option
element must be changed
(from true to false or false to true), the dirtiness of the element must be
set to true та the user agent must send
select
update notifications.
When the user agent is to send
select
update notifications, queue
a task to first fire a simple
event that bubbles named input
at the select
element та
then fire a simple event that
bubbles named change
at
the select
element,
using the user interaction task
source as the task source.
The reset
algorithm for select
elements is to go through all the option
elements in the element's list of options, set their selectedness
to true if the option
element has a selected
attribute та false otherwise, set their dirtiness to false та then have
the option
elements ask for a reset.
The form
attribute is used to explicitly associate the select
element with its form owner. The name
attribute represents the
element's name. The disabled
attribute is used to make the control non-interactive and to prevent its
value from being submitted. The autofocus
attribute controls
focus.
A select
element that is
not disabled
is mutable.
type
Returns "select-multiple
" if the
element has a multiple
attribute та "select-one
" otherwise.
options
Returns an HTMLOptionsCollection
of the list
of options.
length
[ = value
]Returns the number of elements in the list of options.
When set to a smaller number, truncates the number of option
elements in the select
.
When set to a greater number, adds new blank option
elements to the select
.
item
(index)Returns the item with index index from the list of options. The items are sorted in tree order.
namedItem
(name)Returns the first item with ID
or name
name from the list of options.
Returns null if no element with that ID could be found.
add
(element
[, before ])Inserts element before the node given by before.
The before argument can be a number, in which case element is inserted before the item with that number, or an element from the list of options, in which case element is inserted before that element.
Якщо before is omitted, null, or a number out of range, then element will be added at the end of the list.
This method will throw a HierarchyRequestError
exception if element is an ancestor of
the element into which it is to be inserted.
selectedOptions
Returns an HTMLCollection
of the list
of options що є selected.
selectedIndex
[ = value ]Returns the index of the first selected item, if any, or −1 if there is no selected item.
Can be set, to change the selection.
value
[ = value
]Returns the value of the first selected item, if any, or the empty string if there is no selected item.
Can be set, to change the selection.
The type
IDL attribute, on getting, must return the string "select-one
"
if the multiple
attribute is absent та the string "select-multiple
"
if the multiple
attribute is present.
The options
IDL attribute must return an HTMLOptionsCollection
rooted at the select
node, whose filter matches the elements in the list of options.
The options
collection is also mirrored on the HTMLSelectElement
object. The supported property
indices at any instant are the indices supported by the object
returned by the options
attribute at that instant.
The length
IDL attribute must return the number of nodes represented by the options
collection. On
setting, it must act like the attribute of the same name on the options
collection.
The item(index)
method must return
the value returned by the
method of the same name on the options
collection, when
invoked with the same argument.
The namedItem(name)
method must return
the value returned by the method of the same
name on the options
collection, when invoked with the same argument.
When the user agent is to set the value of a new indexed
property for a given property index index
to a new value value, it must instead set
the value of a new indexed property with the given property index
index to the new value value
on the options
collection.
Similarly, the add()
method must act like its namesake method on that same options
collection.
The remove()
method must act like its namesake method on that same options
collection when it has
arguments та like its namesake method on the ChildNode
interface implemented by the HTMLSelectElement
ancestor interface Element
when it
has no arguments.
The selectedOptions
IDL attribute must return an HTMLCollection
rooted at the select
node, whose filter matches the elements in the list of options that have their
selectedness
set to true.
The selectedIndex
IDL attribute, on getting, must return the index of the first option
element in the list
of options in tree order that has its selectedness
set to true, if any. Якщо there isn't one, then it must return −1.
On setting, the selectedIndex
attribute must set the selectedness of all the option
elements in the list of options to false та
then the option
element
in the list
of options whose index
is the given new value, if any, must have its selectedness set to true and
its dirtiness
set to true.
This can result in no element having a selectedness set to true even
in the case of the select
element having no multiple
attribute and a display
size of 1.
The value
IDL attribute, on getting, must return the value of the first option
element in the list
of options in tree order that has its selectedness
set to true, if any. Якщо there isn't one, then it must return the empty
string.
On setting, the value
attribute must set the selectedness of all the option
elements in the list of options to false та
then the first option
element in the list
of options, in tree order, whose value is equal to the given new
value, if any, must have its selectedness set to true and
its dirtiness
set to true.
This can result in no element having a selectedness set to true even
in the case of the select
element having no multiple
attribute and a display
size of 1.
The multiple
,
required
та size
IDL attributes must reflect the respective
content attributes of the same name. The size
IDL attribute has a default
value of zero.
For historical reasons, the default value of the size
IDL attribute does not
return the actual size used, which, in the absence of the size
content attribute, is
either 1 or 4 depending on the presence of the multiple
attribute.
The willValidate
,
validity
та validationMessage
IDL attributes та the checkValidity()
та setCustomValidity()
methods, are part of the constraint
validation API. The labels
IDL attribute provides a list of the element's label
s.
The autofocus
,
disabled
,
form
та name
IDL attributes are part of the element's forms API.
The following example shows how a select
element can be used to offer the user with a set of options from which
the user can select a single option. The default option is preselected.
<p> <label for="unittype">Select unit type:</label> <select id="unittype" name="unittype"> <option value="1"> Miner </option> <option value="2"> Puffer </option> <option value="3" selected> Snipey </option> <option value="4"> Max </option> <option value="5"> Firebot </option> </select> </p>
When there is no default option, a placeholder can be used instead:
<select name="unittype" required> <option value=""> Select unit type </option> <option value="1"> Miner </option> <option value="2"> Puffer </option> <option value="3"> Snipey </option> <option value="4"> Max </option> <option value="5"> Firebot </option> </select>
Here, the user is offered a set of options from which he can select any number. By default, all five options are selected.
<p> <label for="allowedunits">Select unit types to enable on this map:</label> <select id="allowedunits" name="allowedunits" multiple> <option value="1" selected> Miner </option> <option value="2" selected> Puffer </option> <option value="3" selected> Snipey </option> <option value="4" selected> Max </option> <option value="5" selected> Firebot </option> </select> </p>
Sometimes, a user has to select one or more items. This example shows such an interface.
<p>Select the songs from that you would like on your Act II Mix Tape:</p> <select multiple required name="act2"> <option value="s1">It Sucks to Be Me (Reprise) <option value="s2">There is Life Outside Your Apartment <option value="s3">The More You Ruv Someone <option value="s4">Schadenfreude <option value="s5">I Wish I Could Go Back to College <option value="s6">The Money Song <option value="s7">School for Monsters <option value="s8">The Money Song (Reprise) <option value="s9">There's a Fine, Fine Line (Reprise) <option value="s10">What Do You Do With a B.A. in English? (Reprise) <option value="s11">For Now </select>
datalist
elementoption
elements
descendants).option
elements.listbox
(default - do not set).aria-*
attributes applicable
to the allowed roles.interface HTMLDataListElement : HTMLElement { readonly attribute HTMLCollection options; };
The datalist
element
represents a set of option
elements that represent predefined options for other controls. In the
rendering, the datalist
element represents nothing
and it, along with its children, should be hidden.
The datalist
element
can be used in two ways. In the simplest case, the datalist
element has just option
element children.
<label> Sex: <input name=sex list=sexes> <datalist id=sexes> <option value="Female"> <option value="Male"> </datalist> </label>
In the more elaborate case, the datalist
element can be given contents що є to be displayed for down-level clients
that don't support datalist
.
In this case, the option
elements are provided inside a select
element inside the datalist
element.
<label> Sex: <input name=sex list=sexes> </label> <datalist id=sexes> <label> or select from the list: <select name=sex> <option value=""> <option>Female <option>Male </select> </label> </datalist>
The datalist
element is
hooked up to an input
element using the list
attribute on the input
element.
Each option
element that
is a descendant of the datalist
element, that is not disabled
та whose value
is a string that isn't the empty string, represents a suggestion. Each
suggestion has a value
and a label.
options
Returns an HTMLCollection
of the options
elements of the datalist
element.
The options
IDL attribute must return an HTMLCollection
rooted at the datalist
node, whose filter matches option
elements.
Constraint validation: Якщо an element has a datalist
element ancestor,
it is barred from
constraint validation.
optgroup
elementselect
element.option
and script-supporting
elements.disabled
- Whether the form control is disabledlabel
- User-visible labeloptgroup
element's end
tag may be omitted if the optgroup
element
is immediately
followed by another optgroup
element, or if
there is no more content in the parent element.interface HTMLOptGroupElement : HTMLElement { attribute boolean disabled; attribute DOMString label; };
The optgroup
element represents a group of option
elements with a common label.
The element's group of option
elements consists of the option
elements що є children of the optgroup
element.
When showing option
elements in select
elements, user agents should show the option
elements of such groups as being related to each other and separate from
other option
elements.
The disabled
attribute is a boolean attribute and can
be used to disable
a group of option
elements
together.
The label
attribute must be specified. Its value gives the name of the group, for
the purposes of the user interface. User agents should
use this attribute's value when labeling the group of option
elements in a select
element.
The disabled
and label
attributes must reflect the respective content
attributes of the same name.
The following snippet shows how a set of lessons from three courses
could be offered in a select
drop-down widget:
<form action="courseselector.dll" method="get"> <p>Which course would you like to watch today? <p><label>Course: <select name="c"> <optgroup label="8.01 Physics I: Classical Mechanics"> <option value="8.01.1">Lecture 01: Powers of Ten <option value="8.01.2">Lecture 02: 1D Kinematics <option value="8.01.3">Lecture 03: Vectors <optgroup label="8.02 Electricity and Magnestism"> <option value="8.02.1">Lecture 01: What holds our world together? <option value="8.02.2">Lecture 02: Electric Field <option value="8.02.3">Lecture 03: Electric Flux <optgroup label="8.03 Physics III: Vibrations and Waves"> <option value="8.03.1">Lecture 01: Periodic Phenomenon <option value="8.03.2">Lecture 02: Beats <option value="8.03.3">Lecture 03: Forced Oscillations with Damping </select> </label> <p><input type=submit value="▶ Play"> </form>
option
elementselect
element.datalist
element.optgroup
element.label
attribute and a value
attribute: Empty.label
attribute but no value
attribute: Text.label
attribute: Text that is not inter-element
whitespace.disabled
- Whether the form control is disabledlabel
- User-visible labelselected
- Whether the option is selected by defaultvalue
- Value to be used for form submissionoption
element's end tag
may be omitted if the option
element is immediately followed by another option
element, or if it is immediately followed by an optgroup
element, or if there is no more content in the parent element.option
(default
- do not set), menuitem
, menuitemradio
or separator
.aria-*
attributes applicable
to the allowed roles.[NamedConstructor=Option(optional DOMString text = "", optional DOMString value, optional boolean defaultSelected = false, optional boolean selected = false)] interface HTMLOptionElement : HTMLElement { attribute boolean disabled; readonly attribute HTMLFormElement? form; attribute DOMString label; attribute boolean defaultSelected; attribute boolean selected; attribute DOMString value; attribute DOMString text; readonly attribute long index; };
The option
element represents
an option in a select
element or as part of a list of suggestions in a datalist
element.
In certain circumstances described in the definition of the select
element, an option
element
can be a select
element's
placeholder label option. A placeholder
label option does not represent an actual option, but instead
represents a label for the select
control.
The disabled
attribute is a boolean attribute. An option
element is disabled if its disabled
attribute is present
or if it is a child of an optgroup
element whose disabled
attribute is present.
An option
element that
is disabled
must prevent any click
events що є queued on the user
interaction task source from being dispatched on the element.
The label
attribute provides a label for element. The label of an option
element is the value of the label
content attribute, if there
is one, or, if there is not, the value of the element's text
IDL attribute.
The label
content attribute, if specified, must not be empty.
The value
attribute provides a value for element. The value of an option
element is the value of the value
content attribute, if there
is one, or, if there is not, the value of the element's text
IDL attribute.
The selected
attribute is a boolean attribute. It
represents the default selectedness of the element.
The dirtiness
of an option
element is
a boolean state, initially false. It controls whether adding or removing
the selected
content attribute has any effect.
The selectedness
of an option
element is
a boolean state, initially false. Except where otherwise specified, when
the element is created, its selectedness must be set to
true if the element has a selected
attribute. Whenever
an option
element's selected
attribute is added, if its dirtiness is false, its selectedness must be set to
true. Whenever an option
element's selected
attribute is removed, if its dirtiness is false, its selectedness must be set to
false.
The Option()
constructor, when called with three or fewer arguments, overrides the
initial state of the selectedness state to always
be false even if the third argument є true (implying that a selected
attribute is to be
set). The fourth argument can be used to explicitly set the initial selectedness
state when using the constructor.
A select
element whose multiple
attribute is not specified must not have more than one descendant option
element with its selected
attribute set.
An option
element's index
is the number of option
elements що є in the same list of options but that come
before it in tree order. Якщо the option
element is not in a list
of options, then the option
element's index
is zero.
selected
Returns true if the element is selected та false otherwise.
Can be set, to override the current state of the element.
index
Returns the index of the element in its select
element's options
list.
form
Returns the element's form
element, if any, or null otherwise.
text
Same as textContent
, except
that spaces are collapsed and script
elements are skipped.
Option
( [ text
[, value [, defaultSelected
[, selected ] ] ] ] )Returns a new option
element.
The text argument sets the contents of the element.
The value argument sets the value
attribute.
The defaultSelected argument sets the
selected
attribute.
The selected argument sets whether or not the element is selected. Якщо it is omitted, even if the defaultSelected argument є true, the element is not selected.
The disabled
IDL attribute must reflect the content attribute
of the same name. The defaultSelected
IDL
attribute must reflect the selected
content attribute.
The label
IDL attribute, on getting, must return the element's label. On setting, the element's label
content attribute must be set to the new value.
The value
IDL attribute, on getting, must return the element's value. On setting, the element's value
content attribute must be set to the new value.
The selected
IDL attribute, on getting, must return true if the element's selectedness є true та false
otherwise. On setting, it must set the element's selectedness to the new value,
set its dirtiness
to true та then cause the element to ask for
a reset.
The index
IDL attribute must return the element's index.
The text
IDL attribute, on getting, must return the result of stripping and collapsing
whitespace from the concatenation of data of all the Text
node descendants of the option
element, in tree order, excluding any що є
descendants of descendants of the option
element що є themselves script
elements in the простір імен HTML or script
elements in the SVG
namespace.
On setting, the text
attribute must act as if the textContent
IDL attribute on the element had been set to the new value.
The form
IDL attribute's behavior depends on whether the option
element is in a select
element or not. Якщо the option
has a select
element as
its parent, or has an optgroup
element as its parent and that optgroup
element has a select
element as its parent, then the form
IDL attribute must return
the same value as the form
IDL attribute on that select
element. Інакше it must return null.
A constructor is provided for creating HTMLOptionElement
objects (in addition to the factory methods from DOM such as createElement()
):
Option(text,
value, defaultSelected,
selected)
. When invoked
as a constructor, it must return a new HTMLOptionElement
object (a new option
element). Якщо the first argument is not the empty string, the new
object must have as its only child a Text
node whose data is the value of that argument. Інакше it must have no
children. Якщо the value argument is
present, the new object must have a value
attribute set with the
value of the argument as its value. Якщо the defaultSelected
argument є true, the new object must have a selected
attribute set with
no value. Якщо the selected argument є
true, the new object must have its selectedness set to true;
otherwise the selectedness
must be set to false, even if the defaultSelected
argument є true. The element's document must be the active
document of the browsing context
of the Window
object on which the
interface object of the invoked constructor is found.
textarea
elementautocomplete
- - Hint for form autofill featureautofocus
- Automatically focus the form control when the page is loadedcols
- Maximum number of characters per linedirname
- Name of form field to use for sending the element's directionality in form
submissiondisabled
- Whether the form control is disabledform
- Associates the control with a form
elementinputmode
- Hint for
selecting an input modalitymaxlength
- Maximum length of valueminlength
- Minimum length of valuename
- Name of form control to use for form
submission and in the form.elements
API
placeholder
- User-visible label to be placed within the form controlreadonly
- Whether to allow the value to be edited by the userrequired
- Whether the control is required for form
submissionrows
- Number of lines to showwrap
- How the value of the form control is to be wrapped for form
submissiontextbox
(default - do not set).aria-*
attributes applicable
to the allowed roles.interface HTMLTextAreaElement : HTMLElement { attribute DOMString autocomplete; attribute boolean autofocus; attribute unsigned long cols; attribute DOMString dirName; attribute boolean disabled; readonly attribute HTMLFormElement? form; attribute long maxLength; attribute long minLength; attribute DOMString name; attribute DOMString placeholder; attribute boolean readOnly; attribute boolean required; attribute unsigned long rows; attribute DOMString wrap; readonly attribute DOMString type; attribute DOMString defaultValue; [TreatNullAs=EmptyString] attribute DOMString value; readonly attribute unsigned long textLength; readonly attribute boolean willValidate; readonly attribute ValidityState validity; readonly attribute DOMString validationMessage; boolean checkValidity(); void setCustomValidity(DOMString error); readonly attribute NodeList labels; void select(); attribute unsigned long selectionStart; attribute unsigned long selectionEnd; attribute DOMString selectionDirection; void setRangeText(DOMString replacement); void setRangeText(DOMString replacement, unsigned long start, unsigned long end, optional SelectionMode selectionMode = "preserve"); void setSelectionRange(unsigned long start, unsigned long end, optional DOMString direction); };
The textarea
element represents a multiline plain text edit control for the element's raw value. The contents
of the control represent the control's default value.
The raw
value of a textarea
control must be initially the empty string.
This element has rendering requirements involving the bidirectional algorithm.
The readonly
attribute is a boolean attribute used to
control whether the text can be edited by the user or not.
In this example, a text field is marked read-only because it represents a read-only file:
Filename: <code>/etc/bash.bashrc</code> <textarea name="buffer" readonly> # System-wide .bashrc file for interactive bash(1) shells. # To enable the settings / commands in this file for login shells as well, # this file has to be sourced in /etc/profile. # Якщо not running interactively, don't do anything [ -z "$PS1" ] && return ...</textarea>
Constraint validation: Якщо the readonly
attribute is
specified on a textarea
element, the element is barred
from constraint validation.
A textarea
element is
mutable
if it is neither disabled
nor has a readonly
attribute specified.
When a textarea
is mutable,
its raw
value should be editable by the user: the user agent should allow
the user to edit, insert та remove text та to insert and remove line
breaks in the form of "LF" (U+000A) characters. Any time the user causes
the element's raw
value to change, the user agent must queue
a task to fire a simple event
that bubbles named input
at
the textarea
element.
User agents may wait for a suitable break in the user's interaction
before queuing the task; for example, a user agent could wait for the
user to have not hit a key for 100ms, so as to only fire the event when
the user pauses, instead of continuously for each keystroke.
A textarea
element
has a dirty
value flag, which must be initially set to false та must be set
to true whenever the user interacts with the control in a way that
changes the raw
value.
When the textarea
element's textContent
IDL
attribute changes value, if the element's dirty value flag is false, then the
element's raw
value must be set to the value of the element's textContent
IDL attribute.
The reset
algorithm for textarea
elements is to set the element's value to the value of the
element's textContent
IDL
attribute.
Якщо the element is mutable, the user agent should allow the user to change the writing direction of the element, setting it either to a left-to-right writing direction or a right-to-left writing direction. Якщо the user does so, the user agent must then run the following steps:
Set the element's dir
attribute to "ltr
"
if the user selected a left-to-right writing direction та "rtl
" if the user selected a
right-to-left writing direction.
Queue a task to fire
a simple event that bubbles named input
at the textarea
element.
The cols
attribute specifies the expected maximum number of characters per line.
Якщо the cols
attribute is specified, its value must be a valid
non-negative integer greater than zero. Якщо
applying the rules
for parsing non-negative integers to the attribute's value results
in a number greater than zero, then the element's character width is that value;
otherwise, it is 20.
The user agent may use the textarea
element's character
width as a hint to the user as to how many characters the server
prefers per line (e.g. for visual user agents by making the width of the
control be that many characters). In visual renderings, the user agent
should wrap the user's input in the rendering so that each line is no
wider than this number of characters.
The rows
attribute specifies the number of lines to show. Якщо the rows
attribute is specified, its
value must be a valid non-negative
integer greater than zero. Якщо applying the rules for parsing
non-negative integers to the attribute's value results in a number
greater than zero, then the element's character height is that value;
otherwise, it is 2.
Visual user agents should set the height of the control to the number of lines given by character height.
The wrap
attribute is an enumerated attribute
with two keywords and states: the soft
keyword which maps
to the Soft
state та the hard
keyword which maps to the Hard state. The missing
value default is the Soft state.
The Soft
state indicates that the text in the textarea
is not to be wrapped when it is submitted (though it can still be wrapped
in the rendering).
The Hard
state indicates that the text in the textarea
is to have newlines added by the user agent so that the text is wrapped
when it is submitted.
Якщо the element's wrap
attribute is in the Hard
state, the cols
attribute must be specified.
For historical reasons, the element's value is normalised in three
different ways for three different purposes. The raw value is the value as it
was originally set. It is not normalized. The API value is the value used in
the value
IDL attribute. It is normalized so that line breaks use "LF" (U+000A)
characters. Finally, there is the form submission value. It is normalized so that line
breaks use U+000D CARRIAGE RETURN "CRLF" (U+000A) character pairs та in
addition, if necessary given the element's wrap
attribute, additional
line breaks are inserted to wrap the text at the given width.
The element's API value is defined to be the element's raw value with the following transformation applied:
Replace every U+000D CARRIAGE RETURN "CRLF" (U+000A) character pair from the raw value with a single "LF" (U+000A) character.
Replace every remaining U+000D CARRIAGE RETURN character from the raw value with a single "LF" (U+000A) character.
The element's value is defined to be the element's raw value with the following transformation applied:
Replace every occurrence of a "CR" (U+000D) character not followed by a "LF" (U+000A) character та every occurrence of a "LF" (U+000A) character not preceded by a "CR" (U+000D) character, by a two-character string consisting of a U+000D CARRIAGE RETURN "CRLF" (U+000A) character pair.
Якщо the element's wrap
attribute is in the Hard
state, insert U+000D CARRIAGE RETURN "CRLF" (U+000A) character pairs
into the string using a UA-defined algorithm so that each line has
no more than character
width characters. For the purposes of this requirement, lines
are delimited by the start of the string, the end of the string та
U+000D CARRIAGE RETURN "CRLF" (U+000A) character pairs.
The maxlength
attribute is a form
control maxlength
attribute
controlled by the textarea
element's dirty
value flag.
Якщо the textarea
element has a maximum allowed
value length, then the element's children must be such that the code-unit length of the value of the
element's textContent
IDL
attribute is equal to or less than the element's maximum
allowed value length.
The minlength
attribute is a form
control minlength
attribute
controlled by the textarea
element's dirty
value flag.
The required
attribute is a boolean attribute. When
specified, the user will be required to enter a value before submitting
the form.
Constraint validation: Якщо the element has its required
attribute specified та the element is mutable та the element's value is the empty string, then the
element is suffering from being
missing.
The placeholder
attribute represents a short hint (a word or short phrase)
intended to aid the user with data entry when the control has no value. A
hint could be a sample value or a brief description of the expected
format.
The placeholder
attribute should not be used as a replacement for a label
.
For a longer hint or other advisory text, place the text next to the
control.
Use of the placeholder
attribute as a
replacement for a label
can
reduce the accessibility and usability of the control for a range of users
including older users and users with cognitive, mobility, fine motor skill
or vision impairments. While the hint given by the control's label
is shown at all times, the short hint given in the placeholder
attribute is
only shown before the user enters a value. Furthermore, placeholder
text may be
mistaken for a pre-filled value та as commonly implemented the default
color of the placeholder text provides insufficient contrast and the lack
of a separate visible label
reduces the size of the hit region available for setting focus on the
control.
User agents should present this hint to the user when the element's value is the empty string and the control is not focused (e.g. by displaying it inside a blank unfocused control). All U+000D CARRIAGE RETURN U+000A LINE FEED character pairs (CRLF) in the hint, as well as all other "CR" (U+000D) and "LF" (U+000A) characters in the hint, must be treated as line breaks when rendering the hint.
The name
attribute represents the element's name. The dirname
attribute controls how the
element's directionality
is submitted. The disabled
attribute is used to make the control non-interactive and to prevent its
value from being submitted. The form
attribute is used to explicitly
associate the textarea
element with its form owner. The autofocus
attribute controls
focus. The autocomplete
attribute controls how the user agent provides autofill behavior.
type
Returns the string "textarea
".
value
Returns the current value of the element.
Can be set, to change the value.
The cols
,
placeholder
,
required
,
rows
та wrap
attributes must reflect the respective content
attributes of the same name. The cols
and rows
attributes are limited
to only non-negative numbers greater than zero. The cols
attribute's default value
is 20. The rows
attribute's default value is 2. The dirName
IDL attribute
must reflect the dirname
content attribute. The maxLength
IDL attribute must reflect the maxlength
content
attribute, limited to
only non-negative numbers. The minLength
IDL attribute
must reflect the minlength
content
attribute, limited to
only non-negative numbers. The readOnly
IDL attribute
must reflect the readonly
content
attribute.
The type
IDL attribute must return the value "textarea
".
The defaultValue
IDL attribute must act like the element's textContent
IDL attribute.
The value
attribute must, on getting, return the element's API value; on setting, it must
set the element's raw
value to the new value, set the element's dirty value flag to true та should
then move the text entry cursor position to the end of the text field,
unselecting any selected text and resetting the selection direction to none.
The textLength
IDL attribute must return the code-unit
length of the element's API value.
The willValidate
,
validity
та validationMessage
IDL attributes та the checkValidity()
та setCustomValidity()
methods, are part of the constraint
validation API. The labels
IDL attribute provides a list of the element's label
s.
The select()
,
selectionStart
,
selectionEnd
,
selectionDirection
,
setRangeText()
та setSelectionRange()
methods and IDL attributes expose the element's text selection. The autofocus
,
disabled
,
form
та name
IDL attributes are part of the element's forms API.
Here is an example of a textarea
being used for unrestricted free-form text input in a form:
<p>Якщо you have any comments, please let us know: <textarea cols=80 name=comments></textarea></p>
To specify a maximum length for the comments, one can use the maxlength
attribute:
<p>Якщо you have any short comments, please let us know: <textarea cols=80 name=comments maxlength=200></textarea></p>
To give a default value, text can be included inside the element:
<p>Якщо you have any comments, please let us know: <textarea cols=80 name=comments>You rock!</textarea></p>
You can also give a minimum length. Here, a letter needs to be filled out by the user; a template (which is shorter than the minimum length) is provided, but is insufficient to submit the form:
<textarea required minlength="500">Dear Madam Speaker, Regarding your letter dated ... ... Yours Sincerely, ...</textarea>
A placeholder can be given as well, to suggest the basic form to the user, without providing an explicit template:
<textarea placeholder="Dear Francine, They closed the parks this week, so we won't be able to meet your there. Should we just have dinner? Love, Daddy"></textarea>
To have the browser submit the
directionality of the element along with the value, the dirname
attribute can be
specified:
<p>Якщо you have any comments, please let us know (you may use either English or Hebrew for your comments): <textarea cols=80 name=comments dirname=comments.dir></textarea></p>
keygen
elementautofocus
- Automatically focus the form control when the page is loadedchallenge
- String to package with the generated and signed public keydisabled
- Whether the form control is disabledform
- Associates the control with a form
elementkeytype
- The type of cryptographic key to generatename
- Name of form control to use for form
submission and in the form.elements
API
interface HTMLKeygenElement : HTMLElement { attribute boolean autofocus; attribute DOMString challenge; attribute boolean disabled; readonly attribute HTMLFormElement? form; attribute DOMString keytype; attribute DOMString name; readonly attribute DOMString type; readonly attribute boolean willValidate; readonly attribute ValidityState validity; readonly attribute DOMString validationMessage; boolean checkValidity(); void setCustomValidity(DOMString error); readonly attribute NodeList labels; };
The keygen
element represents
a key pair generator control. When the control's form is submitted, the
private key is stored in the local keystore та the public key is packaged
and sent to the server.
The challenge
attribute may be specified. Its value will be packaged with the submitted
key.
The keytype
attribute is an enumerated attribute.
The following table lists the keywords and states for the attribute — the
keywords in the left column map to the states listed in the cell in the
second column on the same row as the keyword. User agents are not required
to support these values та must only recognize values whose corresponding
algorithms they support.
Keyword | State |
---|---|
rsa |
RSA |
The invalid value default state is the unknown state. The missing value default state is the RSA state, if it is supported, or the unknown state otherwise.
This specification does not specify what key types user agents are to support — it is possible for a user agent to not support any key types at all.
The user agent may expose a user interface for each keygen
element to allow the user to configure settings of the element's key
pair generator, e.g. the key length.
The reset
algorithm for keygen
elements is to set these various configuration settings back to their
defaults.
The element's value is the string returned from the following algorithm:
Use the appropriate step from the following list:
keytype
attribute is in the RSA stateGenerate an RSA key pair using the settings given by the user,
if appropriate, using the md5WithRSAEncryption
RSA signature algorithm (the signature algorithm with MD5 and
the RSA encryption algorithm) referenced in section 2.2.1 ("RSA
Signature Algorithm") of RFC 3279 та defined in RFC 3447. [RFC3279]
[RFC3447]
keytype
attribute is in the unknown stateThe given key type is not supported. Повернути empty string and abort this algorithm.
Нехай private key be the generated private key.
Нехай public key be the generated public key.
Нехай signature algorithm be the selected signature algorithm.
Якщо the element has a challenge
attribute,
then let challenge be that
attribute's value. Інакше let challenge
be the empty string.
Нехай algorithm be an ASN.1 AlgorithmIdentifier
structure as
defined by RFC 5280, with the algorithm
field giving the ASN.1 OID used to identify signature
algorithm, using the OIDs defined in section 2.2 ("Signature
Algorithms") of RFC 3279 та the parameters
field set up as required by RFC 3279 for AlgorithmIdentifier
structures for that algorithm. [X690] [RFC5280]
[RFC3279]
Нехай spki be an ASN.1 SubjectPublicKeyInfo
structure as defined by RFC 5280, with the algorithm
field set to the algorithm structure
from the previous step та the subjectPublicKey
field set to the BIT STRING value resulting from ASN.1 DER encoding
the public key. [X690]
[RFC5280]
Нехай publicKeyAndChallenge be an
ASN.1 PublicKeyAndChallenge
structure as defined below, with the spki
field set to the spki structure from
the previous step та the challenge
field set to the string challenge
obtained earlier. [X690]
Нехай signature be the BIT STRING value resulting from ASN.1 DER encoding the signature generated by applying the signature algorithm to the byte string obtained by ASN.1 DER encoding the publicKeyAndChallenge structure, using private key as the signing key. [X690]
Нехай signedPublicKeyAndChallenge
be an ASN.1 SignedPublicKeyAndChallenge
structure as defined below, with the publicKeyAndChallenge
field set to the publicKeyAndChallenge
structure, the signatureAlgorithm
field set to the algorithm structure
та the signature
field set to the
BIT STRING signature from the
previous step. [X690]
Повернути result of base64 encoding the result of ASN.1 DER encoding the signedPublicKeyAndChallenge structure. [RFC4648] [X690]
The data objects used by the above algorithm are defined as follows. These definitions use the same "ASN.1-like" syntax defined by RFC 5280. [RFC5280]
PublicKeyAndChallenge ::= SEQUENCE { spki SubjectPublicKeyInfo, challenge IA5STRING } SignedPublicKeyAndChallenge ::= SEQUENCE { publicKeyAndChallenge PublicKeyAndChallenge, signatureAlgorithm AlgorithmIdentifier, signature BIT STRING }
Constraint validation: The keygen
element is barred from
constraint validation.
The form
attribute is used to explicitly associate the keygen
element with its form owner. The name
attribute represents the
element's name. The disabled
attribute is used to make the control non-interactive and to prevent its
value from being submitted. The autofocus
attribute controls
focus.
type
Returns the string "keygen
".
The challenge
IDL attribute must reflect the content attribute
of the same name.
The keytype
IDL attribute must reflect the content attribute
of the same name, limited to
only known values.
The type
IDL attribute must return the value "keygen
".
The willValidate
,
validity
та validationMessage
IDL attributes та the checkValidity()
та setCustomValidity()
methods, are part of the constraint
validation API. The labels
IDL attribute provides a list of the element's label
s.
The autofocus
,
disabled
,
form
та name
IDL attributes are part of the element's forms API.
This specification does not specify how the private key
generated is to be used. It is expected that after receiving the SignedPublicKeyAndChallenge
(SPKAC) structure, the server will generate a client certificate and offer
it back to the user for download; this certificate, once downloaded and
stored in the key store along with the private key, can then be used to
authenticate to services that use TLS and certificate authentication.
To generate a key pair, add the private key to the user's key store та submit the public key to the server, markup such as the following can be used:
<form action="processkey.cgi" method="post" enctype="multipart/form-data"> <p><keygen name="key"></p> <p><input type=submit value="Submit key..."></p> </form>
The server will then receive a form submission with a packaged RSA
public key as the value of "key
". This
can then be used for various purposes, such as generating a client
certificate, as mentioned above.
output
elementfor
- Specifies controls from which the output was calculatedform
- Associates the control with a form
elementname
- Name of form control to use for form
submission and in the form.elements
API
status
(default
- do not set), any
role value.aria-*
attributes applicable
to the allowed roles.interface HTMLOutputElement : HTMLElement {
[PutForwards=value] readonly attribute DOMSettableTokenList htmlFor;
readonly attribute HTMLFormElement? form;
attribute DOMString name;
readonly attribute DOMString type;
attribute DOMString defaultValue;
attribute DOMString value;
readonly attribute boolean willValidate;
readonly attribute ValidityState validity;
readonly attribute DOMString validationMessage;
boolean checkValidity();
void setCustomValidity(DOMString error);
readonly attribute NodeList labels;
};
The output
element represents
the result of a calculation or user action.
The for
content attribute allows an explicit relationship to be made between the
result of a calculation and the elements that represent the values that
went into the calculation or that otherwise influenced the calculation.
The for
attribute, if specified, must contain a string consisting of an unordered
set of unique space-separated tokens що є case-sensitive,
each of which must have the value of an ID of an element in the same Document
.
The form
attribute is used to explicitly associate the output
element with its form owner. The name
attribute represents the
element's name.
The element has a value mode flag which is either value or default. Initially, the value mode flag must be set to default.
The element also has a default value. Initially, the default value must be the empty string.
When the value
mode flag is in mode default,
the contents of the element represent both the value of the element and
its default
value. When the value
mode flag is in mode value,
the contents of the element represent the value of the element only та
the default
value is only accessible using the defaultValue
IDL
attribute.
Whenever the element's descendants are changed in any way, if the value mode flag is in mode default,
the element's default
value must be set to the value of the element's textContent
IDL attribute.
The reset
algorithm for output
elements is to set the element's value mode flag to default
and then to set the element's textContent
IDL attribute to the value of the element's default value (thus replacing
the element's child nodes).
value
[ = value
]Returns the element's current value.
Can be set, to change the value.
defaultValue
[ = value
]Returns the element's current default value.
Can be set, to change the default value.
type
Returns the string "output
".
The value
IDL attribute must act like the element's textContent
IDL attribute, except that on setting, in addition, before the child
nodes are changed, the element's value mode flag must be set to value.
The defaultValue
IDL attribute, on getting, must return the element's default value. On setting, the
attribute must set the element's default value та, if the
element's value
mode flag is in the mode default,
set the element's textContent
IDL attribute as well.
The type
attribute must return the string "output
".
The htmlFor
IDL attribute must reflect the for
content attribute.
The willValidate
,
validity
та validationMessage
IDL attributes та the checkValidity()
та setCustomValidity()
methods, are part of the constraint
validation API. The labels
IDL attribute provides a list of the element's label
s.
The form
and name
IDL attributes are part of the element's forms API.
A simple calculator could use output
for its display of calculated results:
<form onsubmit="return false" oninput="o.value = a.valueAsNumber + b.valueAsNumber"> <input name=a type=number step=any> + <input name=b type=number step=any> = <output name=o for="a b"></output> </form>
In this example, an output
element is used to report the results from a remote server, as they come
in:
<output id="result"></output> <script> var primeSource = new WebSocket('ws://primes.example.net/'); primeSource.onmessage = function (event) { document.getElementById('result').value = event.data; } </script>
progress
elementprogress
element
descendants.value
- Current value of the elementmax
- Upper bound of rangeprogressbar
(default - do not set).aria-*
attributes applicable
to the allowed roles.interface HTMLProgressElement : HTMLElement { attribute double value; attribute double max; readonly attribute double position; readonly attribute NodeList labels; };
The progress
element represents the completion progress of a task. The
progress is either indeterminate, indicating that progress is being made
but that it is not clear how much more work remains to be done before the
task is complete (e.g. because the task is waiting for a remote host to
respond), or the progress is a number in the range zero to a maximum,
giving the fraction of work that has so far been completed.
There are two attributes that determine the current task completion
represented by the element. The value
attribute specifies
how much of the task has been completed та the max
attribute specifies how
much work the task requires in total. The units are arbitrary and not
specified.
To make a determinate progress bar, add a value
attribute with the
current progress (either a number from 0.0 to 1.0, or, if the max
attribute is specified, a
number from 0 to the value of the max
attribute). To make an
indeterminate progress bar, remove the value
attribute.
Authors are encouraged to also include the current value and the maximum value inline as text inside the element, so that the progress is made available to users of legacy user agents.
Here is a snippet of a Web application that shows the progress of some automated task:
<section> <h2>Task Progress</h2> <p>Progress: <progress id="p" max=100><span>0</span>%</progress></p> <script> var progressBar = document.getElementById('p'); function updateProgress(newValue) { progressBar.value = newValue; progressBar.getElementsByTagName('span')[0].textContent = newValue; } </script> </section>
(The updateProgress()
method in this example would be
called by some other code on the page to update the actual progress bar
as the task progressed.)
The value
and max
attributes, when present, must have values що є valid floating-point numbers.
The value
attribute, if present, must have a value equal to or greater than zero та
less than or equal to the value of the max
attribute, if present, or
1.0, otherwise. The max
attribute, if present, must have a value greater than zero.
The progress
element is the wrong element to use for something that is just a gauge, as
opposed to task progress. For instance, indicating disk space usage using
progress
would be
inappropriate. Instead, the meter
element is available for such use cases.
User agent requirements: Якщо the value
attribute is omitted,
then the progress bar is an indeterminate progress bar. Інакше it is a
determinate progress bar.
Якщо the progress bar is a determinate progress bar and the element has
a max
attribute, the user agent must parse the max
attribute's value according
to the rules
for parsing floating-point number values. Якщо this does not
result in an error та if the parsed value is greater than zero, then the
maximum
value of the progress bar is that value. Інакше if the element
has no max
attribute, or if it has one but parsing it resulted in an error, or if
the parsed value was less than or equal to zero, then the maximum value of the progress bar
is 1.0.
Якщо the progress bar is a determinate progress bar, user agents must
parse the value
attribute's value according to the rules
for parsing floating-point number values. Якщо this does not
result in an error та if the parsed value is less than the maximum value and greater than
zero, then the current
value of the progress bar is that parsed value. Інакше if the
parsed value was greater than or equal to the maximum value, then the current value of the progress bar
is the maximum
value of the progress bar. Інакше if parsing the value
attribute's value
resulted in an error, or a number less than or equal to zero, then the current
value of the progress bar is zero.
UA requirements for showing the progress bar: When
representing a progress
element to the user, the UA should indicate whether it is a determinate
or indeterminate progress bar та in the former case, should indicate the
relative position of the current
value relative to the maximum value.
position
For a determinate progress bar (one with known current and maximum values), returns the result of dividing the current value by the maximum value.
For an indeterminate progress bar, returns −1.
Якщо the progress bar is an indeterminate progress bar, then the position
IDL attribute must return −1. Інакше it must return the result of
dividing the current
value by the maximum
value.
Якщо the progress bar is an indeterminate progress bar, then the value
IDL attribute, on getting, must return 0. Інакше it must return the current
value. On setting, the given value must be converted to the best
representation of the number as a floating-point number and then
the value
content attribute must be set to that string.
Setting the value
IDL attribute to itself
when the corresponding content attribute is absent would change the
progress bar from an indeterminate progress bar to a determinate
progress bar with no progress.
The max
IDL attribute must reflect the content attribute
of the same name, limited
to numbers greater than zero. The default value for max
is 1.0.
The labels
IDL attribute provides a list of the element's label
s.
meter
elementmeter
element
descendants.value
- Current value of the elementmin
- Lower bound of rangemax
- Upper bound of rangelow
- High limit of low rangehigh
- Low limit of high rangeoptimum
- Optimum value in gaugeinterface HTMLMeterElement : HTMLElement { attribute double value; attribute double min; attribute double max; attribute double low; attribute double high; attribute double optimum; readonly attribute NodeList labels; };
The meter
element represents
a scalar measurement within a known range, or a fractional value; for
example disk usage, the relevance of a query result, or the fraction of a
voting population to have selected a particular candidate.
This is also known as a gauge.
The meter
element should not be used to indicate progress (as in a progress bar).
For that role, HTML provides a separate progress
element.
The meter
element also does not represent a scalar value of arbitrary range — for
example, it would be wrong to use this to report a weight, or height,
unless there is a known maximum value.
There are six attributes that determine the semantics of the gauge represented by the element.
The min
attribute specifies the lower bound of the range та the max
attribute specifies the upper
bound. The value
attribute specifies the value to have the gauge indicate as the "measured"
value.
The other three attributes can be used to segment the gauge's range into
"low", "medium" та "high" parts та to indicate which part of the gauge is
the "optimum" part. The low
attribute specifies the range that is considered to be the "low" part та
the high
attribute specifies the range that is considered to be the "high" part.
The optimum
attribute gives the position that is "optimum"; if that is higher than the
"high" value then this indicates that the higher the value, the better; if
it's lower than the "low" mark then it indicates that lower values are
better та naturally if it is in between then it indicates that neither
high nor low values are good.
Authoring requirements: The value
attribute must be specified. The value
, min
, low
, high
, max
та optimum
attributes, when
present, must have values що є valid floating-point numbers.
In addition, the attributes' values are further constrained:
Нехай value be the value
attribute's number.
Якщо the min
attribute is specified, then let minimum
be that attribute's value; otherwise, let it be zero.
Якщо the max
attribute is specified, then let maximum
be that attribute's value; otherwise, let it be 1.0.
The following inequalities must hold, as applicable:
low
≤ maximum
(if low
is specified)high
≤ maximum
(if high
is specified)optimum
≤ maximum
(if optimum
is specified)low
≤ high
(if both low
and high
are specified)Якщо no minimum or maximum is specified, then the range is assumed to be 0..1 та the value thus has to be within that range.
Authors are encouraged to include a textual representation of the gauge's
state in the element's contents, for users of user agents that do not
support the meter
element.
The following examples show three gauges that would all be three-quarters full:
Storage space usage: <meter value=6 max=8>6 blocks used (out of 8 total)</meter> Voter turnout: <meter value=0.75><img alt="75%" src="graph75.png"></meter> Tickets sold: <meter min="0" max="100" value="75"></meter>
The following example is incorrect use of the element, because it doesn't give a range (and since the default maximum is 1, both of the gauges would end up looking maxed out):
<p>The grapefruit pie had a radius of <meter value=12>12cm</meter> and a height of <meter value=2>2cm</meter>.</p> <!-- BAD! -->
Instead, one would either not include the meter element, or use the meter element with a defined range to give the dimensions in context compared to other pies:
<p>The grapefruit pie had a radius of 12cm and a height of 2cm.</p> <dl> <dt>Radius: <dd> <meter min=0 max=20 value=12>12cm</meter> <dt>Height: <dd> <meter min=0 max=10 value=2>2cm</meter> </dl>
There is no explicit way to specify units in the meter
element, but the units may be specified in the title
attribute in free-form text.
The example above could be extended to mention the units:
<dl> <dt>Radius: <dd> <meter min=0 max=20 value=12 title="centimeters">12cm</meter> <dt>Height: <dd> <meter min=0 max=10 value=2 title="centimeters">2cm</meter> </dl>
User agent requirements: User agents must parse the min
,
max
,
value
,
low
,
high
та optimum
attributes using the rules
for parsing floating-point number values.
User agents must then use all these numbers щоб отримати values for six points on the gauge, as follows. (The order in which these are evaluated is important, as some of the values refer to earlier ones.)
Якщо the min
attribute is specified and a value could be parsed out of it, then
the minimum value is that value. Інакше the minimum value is zero.
Якщо the max
attribute is specified and a value could be parsed out of it, then
the candidate maximum value is that value. Інакше the candidate
maximum value is 1.0.
Якщо the candidate maximum value is greater than or equal to the minimum value, then the maximum value is the candidate maximum value. Інакше the maximum value is the same as the minimum value.
Якщо the value
attribute is specified and a value could be parsed out of it, then
that value is the candidate actual value. Інакше the candidate
actual value is zero.
Якщо the candidate actual value is less than the minimum value, then the actual value is the minimum value.
Інакше if the candidate actual value is greater than the maximum value, then the actual value is the maximum value.
Інакше the actual value is the candidate actual value.
Якщо the low
attribute is specified and a value could be parsed out of it, then
the candidate low boundary is that value. Інакше the candidate low
boundary is the same as the minimum value.
Якщо the candidate low boundary is less than the minimum value, then the low boundary is the minimum value.
Інакше if the candidate low boundary is greater than the maximum value, then the low boundary is the maximum value.
Інакше the low boundary is the candidate low boundary.
Якщо the high
attribute is specified and a value could be parsed out of it, then
the candidate high boundary is that value. Інакше the candidate high
boundary is the same as the maximum value.
Якщо the candidate high boundary is less than the low boundary, then the high boundary is the low boundary.
Інакше if the candidate high boundary is greater than the maximum value, then the high boundary is the maximum value.
Інакше the high boundary is the candidate high boundary.
Якщо the optimum
attribute is specified and a value could be parsed out of it, then
the candidate optimum point is that value. Інакше the candidate
optimum point is the midpoint between the minimum value and the
maximum value.
Якщо the candidate optimum point is less than the minimum value, then the optimum point is the minimum value.
Інакше if the candidate optimum point is greater than the maximum value, then the optimum point is the maximum value.
Інакше the optimum point is the candidate optimum point.
All of which will result in the following inequalities all being true:
UA requirements for regions of the gauge: Якщо the optimum point is equal to the low boundary or the high boundary, or anywhere in between them, then the region between the low and high boundaries of the gauge must be treated as the optimum region та the low and high parts, if any, must be treated as suboptimal. Інакше if the optimum point is less than the low boundary, then the region between the minimum value and the low boundary must be treated as the optimum region, the region from the low boundary up to the high boundary must be treated as a suboptimal region та the remaining region must be treated as an even less good region. Finally, if the optimum point is higher than the high boundary, then the situation is reversed; the region between the high boundary and the maximum value must be treated as the optimum region, the region from the high boundary down to the low boundary must be treated as a suboptimal region та the remaining region must be treated as an even less good region.
UA requirements for showing the gauge: When
representing a meter
element to the user, the UA should indicate the relative position of the
actual value to the minimum and maximum values та the relationship
between the actual value and the three regions of the gauge.
The following markup:
<h3>Suggested groups</h3> <ul> <li> <p><a href="/group/comp.infosystems.www.authoring.stylesheets/view">comp.infosystems.www.authoring.stylesheets</a> - <a href="/group/comp.infosystems.www.authoring.stylesheets/subscribe">join</a></p> <p>Group description: <strong>Layout/presentation on the WWW.</strong></p> <p><meter value="0.5">Moderate activity,</meter> Usenet, 618 subscribers</p> </li> <li> <p><a href="/group/netscape.public.mozilla.xpinstall/view">netscape.public.mozilla.xpinstall</a> - <a href="/group/netscape.public.mozilla.xpinstall/subscribe">join</a></p> <p>Group description: <strong>Mozilla XPInstall discussion.</strong></p> <p><meter value="0.25">Low activity,</meter> Usenet, 22 subscribers</p> </li> <li> <p><a href="/group/mozilla.dev.general/view">mozilla.dev.general</a> - <a href="/group/mozilla.dev.general/subscribe">join</a></p> <p><meter value="0.25">Low activity,</meter> Usenet, 66 subscribers</p> </li> </ul>
Might be rendered as follows:
User agents may combine the value of the title
attribute and the other attributes to provide context-sensitive help or
inline text detailing the actual values.
For example, the following snippet:
<meter min=0 max=60 value=23.2 title=seconds></meter>
...might cause the user agent to display a gauge with a tooltip saying "Value: 23.2 out of 60." on one line and "seconds" on a second line.
The value
IDL attribute, on getting, must return the actual value. On setting, the given
value must be converted to the best
representation of the number as a floating-point number and then
the value
content attribute must be set to that string.
The min
IDL attribute, on getting, must return the minimum value. On setting, the given
value must be converted to the best
representation of the number as a floating-point number and then
the min
content attribute must be set to that string.
The max
IDL attribute, on getting, must return the maximum value. On setting, the given
value must be converted to the best
representation of the number as a floating-point number and then
the max
content attribute must be set to that string.
The low
IDL attribute, on getting, must return the low boundary. On setting, the given
value must be converted to the best
representation of the number as a floating-point number and then
the low
content attribute must be set to that string.
The high
IDL attribute, on getting, must return the high boundary. On setting, the given
value must be converted to the best
representation of the number as a floating-point number and then
the high
content attribute must be set to that string.
The optimum
IDL attribute, on getting, must return the optimum value. On setting, the given
value must be converted to the best
representation of the number as a floating-point number and then
the optimum
content attribute must be set to that string.
The labels
IDL attribute provides a list of the element's label
s.
The following example shows how a gauge could fall back to localized or pretty-printed text.
<p>Disk usage: <meter min=0 value=170261928 max=233257824>170 261 928 bytes used out of 233 257 824 bytes available</meter></p>
fieldset
elementlegend
element, followed by flow content.disabled
- Whether the form control is disabledform
- Associates the control with a form
elementname
- Name of form control to use for form
submission and in the form.elements
API
group
(default -
do not set) or presentation
.aria-*
attributes applicable
to the allowed roles.interface HTMLFieldSetElement : HTMLElement { attribute boolean disabled; readonly attribute HTMLFormElement? form; attribute DOMString name; readonly attribute DOMString type; readonly attribute HTMLFormControlsCollection elements; readonly attribute boolean willValidate; readonly attribute ValidityState validity; readonly attribute DOMString validationMessage; boolean checkValidity(); void setCustomValidity(DOMString error); };
The fieldset
element represents a set of form controls optionally
grouped under a common name.
The name of the group is given by the first legend
element that is a child of the fieldset
element, if any. The remainder of the descendants form the group.
The disabled
attribute, when specified, causes all the form control descendants of the
fieldset
element,
excluding those що є descendants of the fieldset
element's first legend
element child, if any, to be disabled.
The form
attribute is used to explicitly associate the fieldset
element with its form owner. The name
attribute represents the
element's name.
type
Returns the string "fieldset".
elements
Returns an HTMLFormControlsCollection
of the form controls in the element.
The disabled
IDL attribute must reflect the content attribute
of the same name.
The type
IDL attribute must return the string "fieldset
".
The elements
IDL attribute must return an HTMLFormControlsCollection
rooted at the fieldset
element, whose filter matches listed
elements.
The willValidate
,
validity
та validationMessage
attributes та the checkValidity()
та setCustomValidity()
methods, are part of the constraint
validation API. The form
and name
IDL attributes are part of the element's forms API.
This example shows a fieldset
element being used to group a set of related controls:
<fieldset> <legend>Display</legend> <div><label><input type=radio name=c value=0 checked> Black on White</label></div> <div><label><input type=radio name=c value=1> White on Black</label></div> <div><label><input type=checkbox name=g> Use grayscale</label></div> <div><label>Enhance contrast <input type=range name=e list=contrast min=0 max=100 value=0 step=1></label></div> <datalist id=contrast> <option label=Normal value=0> <option label=Maximum value=100> </datalist> </fieldset>
The div elements used in the code samples above and below are not intended to convey any semantic meaning and are used only to create a non-inline rendering of the grouped fieldset controls.
The following snippet shows a fieldset with a checkbox in the legend that controls whether or not the fieldset is enabled. The contents of the fieldset consist of two required text fields and an optional year/month control.
<fieldset name="clubfields" disabled> <legend> <label> <input type=checkbox name=club onchange="form.clubfields.disabled = !checked"> Use Club Card </label> </legend> <div><label>Name on card: <input name=clubname required></label></div> <div><label>Card number: <input name=clubnum required pattern="[-0-9]+"></label></div> <div><label>Expiry date: <input name=clubexp type=date></label></div> </fieldset>
You can also nest fieldset
elements. Here is an example expanding on the previous one that does so:
<fieldset name="clubfields" disabled> <legend> <label> <input type=checkbox name=club onchange="form.clubfields.disabled = !checked"> Use Club Card </label> </legend> <div><label>Name on card: <input name=clubname required></label></div> <fieldset name="numfields"> <legend> <label> <input type=radio checked name=clubtype onchange="form.numfields.disabled = !checked"> My card has numbers on it </label> </legend> <div><label>Card number: <input name=clubnum required pattern="[-0-9]+"></label></div> </fieldset> <fieldset name="letfields" disabled> <legend> <label> <input type=radio name=clubtype onchange="form.letfields.disabled = !checked"> My card has letters on it </label> </legend> <div><label>Card code: <input name=clublet required pattern="[A-Za-z]+"></label></> </fieldset> </fieldset>
In this example, if the outer "Use Club Card" checkbox is not checked,
everything inside the outer fieldset
,
including the two radio buttons in the legends of the two nested fieldset
s, will be disabled.
However, if the checkbox is checked, then the radio buttons will both be
enabled and will let you select which of the two inner fieldset
s
is to be enabled.
legend
elementfieldset
element.aria-*
attributes applicable
to the allowed roles.interface HTMLLegendElement : HTMLElement { readonly attribute HTMLFormElement? form; };
The legend
element represents
a caption for the rest of the contents of the legend
element's parent fieldset
element, if any.
form
Returns the element's form
element, if any, or null otherwise.
The form
IDL attribute's behavior depends on whether the legend
element is in a fieldset
element or not. Якщо the legend
has a fieldset
element
as its parent, then the form
IDL attribute must return the same value as the form
IDL attribute on that fieldset
element. Інакше it
must return null.
Form controls have a value
and a checkedness.
(The latter is only used by input
elements.) These are used to describe how the user interacts with the
control.
To define the behaviour of constraint validation in the face of the input
element's multiple
attribute, input
elements can also have separately defined values.
A form control can be designated as mutable.
This determines (by means of definitions and requirements in this specification that rely on whether an element is so designated) whether or not the user can modify the value or checkedness of a form control, or whether or not a control can be automatically prefilled.
A form-associated element can
have a relationship with a form
element, which is called the element's form owner.
Якщо a form-associated element is
not associated with a form
element, its form owner is said to be null.
A form-associated element is, by
default, associated with its nearest ancestor form
element
(as described below), but, if it is reassociateable, may have a form
attribute specified to
override this.
This feature allows authors to work around the lack of
support for nested form
elements.
Якщо a reassociateable
form-associated element has a form
attribute specified, then that attribute's value must be the ID of a form
element in the element's owner Document
.
The rules in this section are complicated by the fact that
although conforming documents will never contain nested form
elements, it is quite possible (e.g. using a script that performs DOM
manipulation) to generate documents that have such nested elements. They
are also complicated by rules in the HTML parser that, for historical
reasons, can result in a form-associated
element being associated with a form
element that is not its ancestor.
When a form-associated element is created, its form owner must be initialized to null (no owner).
When a form-associated element is to be associated with a form, its form owner must be set to that form.
When a form-associated element
or one of its ancestors is inserted
into a Document
, then the user agent must reset
the form owner of that form-associated
element. The HTML
parser overrides this requirement when inserting form controls.
When an element is removed from a Document
resulting in a form-associated
element and its form owner (if any) no
longer being in the same home subtree, then
the user agent must reset the form
owner of that form-associated
element.
When a reassociateable
form-associated element's form
attribute is set, changed, or removed, then the user agent must reset
the form owner of that element.
When a reassociateable
form-associated element has a form
attribute and the ID
of any of the elements in the Document
changes, then the user agent must reset
the form owner of that form-associated
element.
When a reassociateable
form-associated element has a form
attribute and an element with an ID
is inserted
into or removed
from the Document
, then the
user agent must reset the form owner
of that form-associated element.
When the user agent is to reset the form owner of a form-associated element, it must run the following steps:
Якщо the element's form owner is not
null та either the element is not reassociateable or its form
content attribute is not
present та the element's form owner is
its nearest form
element ancestor after the change to the ancestor chain, then do
nothing та abort these steps.
Нехай the element's form owner be null.
Якщо the element is reassociateable,
has a form
content attribute та is itself in a Document
, тоді
виконайте ці субкроки:
Якщо the first element in
the Document
to have an ID that is case-sensitively equal to the
element's form
content attribute's value is a form
element, then associate
the form-associated element
with that form
element.
Abort the "reset the form owner" steps.
Інакше if the form-associated
element in question has an ancestor form
element, then associate
the form-associated element
with the nearest such ancestor form
element.
Інакше the element is left unassociated.
In the following non-conforming snippet:
... <form id="a"> <div id="b"></div> </form> <script> document.getElementById('b').innerHTML = '<table><tr><td><form id="c"><input id="d"></table>' + '<input id="e">'; </script> ...
The form owner of "d" would be the inner nested form "c", while the form owner of "e" would be the outer form "a".
This happens as follows: First, the "e" node gets associated with "c"
in the HTML parser. Then, the innerHTML
algorithm moves the
nodes from the temporary document to the "b" element. At this point,
the nodes see their ancestor chain change та thus all the "magic"
associations done by the parser are reset to normal ancestor
associations.
This example is a non-conforming document, though, as it is a
violation of the content models to nest form
elements.
form
Returns the element's form owner.
Returns null if there isn't one.
Reassociateable
form-associated elements have a form
IDL attribute, which, on getting, must return the element's form
owner, or null if there isn't one.
name
attributeThe name
content attribute gives the name of the form control, as used in form
submission and in the form
element's elements
object. Якщо the attribute is specified, its value must not be the empty
string.
Any non-empty value for name
is allowed, but the names "_charset_
" and "isindex
" are special:
isindex
This value, if used as the name of a Text
control that is the first control in a form that is submitted using
the application/x-www-form-urlencoded
mechanism, causes the submission to only include the value of this
control, with no name.
_charset_
This value, if used as the name of a Hidden control with no value
attribute, is automatically given a value during submission consisting
of the submission character encoding.
dirname
attributeThe dirname
attribute on a form control element enables the submission of the
directionality of the element та gives the name of the field that
contains this value during form submission.
Якщо such an attribute is specified, its value must not be the empty
string.
In this example, a form contains a text field and a submission button:
<form action="addcomment.cgi" method=post> <p><label>Comment: <input type=text name="comment" dirname="comment.dir" required></label></p> <p><button name="mode" type=submit value="add">Post Comment</button></p> </form>
When the user submits the form, the user agent includes three fields, one called "comment", one called "comment.dir" та one called "mode"; so if the user types "Hello", the submission body might be something like:
comment=Hello&comment.dir=ltr&mode=add
Якщо the user manually switches to a right-to-left writing direction and enters "مرحبا", the submission body might be something like:
comment=%D9%85%D8%B1%D8%AD%D8%A8%D8%A7&comment.dir=rtl&mode=add
maxlength
attributeA form
control maxlength
attribute,
controlled by a dirty value flag, declares
a limit on the number of characters a user can input.
Якщо an element has its form
control maxlength
attribute
specified, the attribute's value must be a valid
non-negative integer. Якщо the attribute is specified and applying
the rules for parsing
non-negative integers to its value results in a number, then that
number is the element's maximum
allowed value length. Якщо the attribute is omitted or parsing its
value results in an error, then there is no maximum
allowed value length.
Constraint validation: Якщо an element has a maximum allowed value length, its dirty value flag є true, its value was last changed by a user edit (as opposed to a change made by a script) та the code-unit length of the element's value is greater than the element's maximum allowed value length, then the element is suffering from being too long.
User agents may prevent the user from causing the element's value to be set to a value whose code-unit length is greater than the element's maximum allowed value length.
minlength
attributeA form
control minlength
attribute,
controlled by a dirty value flag, declares
a lower bound on the number of characters a user can input.
The minlength
attribute does not imply the required
attribute. Якщо the form control has no minlength
attribute, then the
value can still be omitted; the minlength
attribute only kicks in
once the user has entered a value at all. Якщо the empty string is not
allowed, then the required
attribute
also needs to be set.
Якщо an element has its form
control minlength
attribute
specified, the attribute's value must be a valid
non-negative integer. Якщо the attribute is specified and applying
the rules for parsing
non-negative integers to its value results in a number, then that
number is the element's minimum
allowed value length. Якщо the attribute is omitted or parsing its
value results in an error, then there is no minimum
allowed value length.
Якщо an element has both a maximum allowed value length and a minimum allowed value length, the minimum allowed value length must be smaller than or equal to the maximum allowed value length.
Constraint validation: Якщо an element has a minimum allowed value length, its value is not the empty string та the code-unit length of the element's value is less than the element's minimum allowed value length, then the element is suffering from being too short.
In this example, there are four text fields. The first is required та has to be at least 5 characters long. The other three are optional, but if the user fills one in, the user has to enter at least 10 characters.
<form action="/events/menu.cgi" method="post"> <p><label>Name of Event: <input required minlength=5 maxlength=50 name=event></label></p> <p><label>Describe what you would like for breakfast, if anything: <textarea name="breakfast" minlength="10"></textarea></label></p> <p><label>Describe what you would like for lunch, if anything: <textarea name="lunch" minlength="10"></textarea></label></p> <p><label>Describe what you would like for dinner, if anything: <textarea name="dinner" minlength="10"></textarea></label></p> <p><input type=submit value="Submit Request"></p> </form>
disabled
attributeThe disabled
content attribute is a boolean attribute.
A form control is disabled
if its disabled
attribute is set, or if it is a descendant of a fieldset
element whose disabled
attribute is set and is not a descendant of that fieldset
element's first legend
element child, if any.
A form control that is disabled
must prevent any click
events що є queued
on the user interaction task
source from being dispatched on the element.
Constraint validation: Якщо an element is disabled, it is barred from constraint validation.
The disabled
IDL attribute must reflect the disabled
content attribute.
Attributes for form submission
can be specified both on form
elements and on submit
buttons (elements that represent buttons that submit forms, e.g. an
input
element whose type
attribute is in the Submit Button state).
The attributes for form
submission that may be specified on form
elements are action
,
enctype
,
method
,
novalidate
та target
.
The corresponding attributes
for form submission that may be specified on submit buttons are formaction
, formenctype
, formmethod
, formnovalidate
та formtarget
. When omitted, they
default to the values given on the corresponding attributes on the form
element.
The action
and formaction
content attributes, if specified, must have a value that is a valid
non-empty URL potentially surrounded by spaces.
The action
of an element is the value of the element's formaction
attribute, if the
element is a submit
button and has such an attribute, or the value of its form
owner's action
attribute, if it has one, or else the empty string.
The method
and formmethod
content attributes are enumerated
attributes with the following keywords and states:
get
,
mapping to the state GET,
indicating the HTTP GET method.post
,
mapping to the state POST,
indicating the HTTP POST method.The invalid value default for these attributes is the GET state. The missing value default
for the method
attribute is also the GET
state. (There is no missing value default for the formmethod
attribute.)
The method
of an element is one of those states. Якщо the element is a submit button and has a formmethod
attribute, then the
element's method
is that attribute's state; otherwise, it is the form
owner's method
attribute's state.
Here the method
attribute is used to explicitly specify the default value, "get
", so that the
search query is submitted in the URL:
<form method="get" action="/search.cgi"> <p><label>Search terms: <input type=search name=q></label></p> <p><input type=submit></p> </form>
On the other hand, here the method
attribute is used to
specify the value "post
", so that the
user's message is submitted in the HTTP request's body:
<form method="post" action="/post-message.cgi"> <p><label>Message: <input type=text name=m></label></p> <p><input type=submit value="Submit message"></p> </form>
The enctype
and formenctype
content attributes are enumerated
attributes with the following keywords and states:
application/x-www-form-urlencoded
"
keyword and corresponding state.multipart/form-data
"
keyword and corresponding state.text/plain
"
keyword and corresponding state.The invalid value default for these attributes is the application/x-www-form-urlencoded
state. The missing value default for the enctype
attribute is also the application/x-www-form-urlencoded
state. (There is no missing value default for the formenctype
attribute.)
The enctype
of an element is one of those three states. Якщо the element is a submit button and has a formenctype
attribute, then the
element's enctype
is that attribute's state; otherwise, it is the form
owner's enctype
attribute's state.
The target
and formtarget
content attributes, if specified, must have values що є valid browsing context
names or keywords.
The target
of an element is the value of the element's formtarget
attribute, if the
element is a submit
button and has such an attribute; or the value of its form
owner's target
attribute, if it has such an attribute; or, if the Document
contains a base
element with
a target
attribute, then the value of the target
attribute of the first such
base
element; or, if there is
no such element, the empty string.
The novalidate
and formnovalidate
content attributes are boolean
attributes. Якщо present, they indicate that the form is not to be
validated during submission.
The no-validate
state of an element є true if the element is a submit button and the element's formnovalidate
attribute is present, or if the element's form
owner's novalidate
attribute is present та false otherwise.
This attribute is useful to include "save" buttons on forms that have validation constraints, to allow users to save their progress even though they haven't fully entered the data in the form. The following example shows a simple form that has two required fields. There are three buttons: one to submit the form, which requires both fields to be filled in; one to save the form so that the user can come back and fill it in later; and one to cancel the form altogether.
<form action="editor.cgi" method="post"> <p><label>Name: <input required name=fn></label></p> <p><label>Essay: <textarea required name=essay></textarea></label></p> <p><input type=submit name=submit value="Submit essay"></p> <p><input type=submit formnovalidate name=save value="Save essay"></p> <p><input type=submit formnovalidate name=cancel value="Cancel"></p> </form>
The action
IDL attribute must reflect the content attribute
of the same name, except that on getting, when the content attribute is
missing or its value is the empty string, the
document's address must be returned instead. The target
IDL attribute must reflect
the content attribute of the same name. The method
and enctype
IDL attributes must reflect the respective content attributes of the
same name, limited to only
known values. The encoding
IDL attribute must reflect the enctype
content attribute, limited
to only known values. The noValidate
IDL attribute
must reflect the novalidate
content attribute.
The formAction
IDL attribute must reflect the formaction
content attribute,
except that on getting, when the content attribute is missing or its
value is the empty string, the
document's address must be returned instead. The formEnctype
IDL attribute
must reflect the formenctype
content
attribute, limited to only
known values. The formMethod
IDL attribute must reflect the formmethod
content attribute,
limited to only known values.
The formNoValidate
IDL attribute must reflect the formnovalidate
content
attribute. The formTarget
IDL attribute must reflect the formtarget
content attribute.
autofocus
attributeThe autofocus
content attribute allows the author to indicate that a control is to be
focused as soon as the page is loaded, allowing the user to just start
typing without having to manually focus the main control.
The autofocus
attribute is a boolean attribute.
An element's nearest ancestor autofocus scoping root element is the element's root element.
There must not be two elements with the same nearest
ancestor autofocus scoping root element that both have the autofocus
attribute specified.
When an element with the autofocus
attribute specified
is inserted
into a document, user agents should run the following steps:
Нехай target be the element's Document
.
Якщо target has no browsing context, abort these steps.
Якщо target's browsing context has no top-level browsing context (e.g. it is a nested browsing context with no parent browsing context), abort these steps.
Якщо target's active sandboxing flag set has the sandboxed automatic features browsing context flag, abort these steps.
Якщо target's origin
is not the same as the origin
of the Document
of the
currently focused element in target's
top-level browsing context,
abort these steps.
Якщо target's origin is not the same as the origin of the active document of target's top-level browsing context, abort these steps.
Якщо the user agent has already reached the last step of this list
of steps in response to an element being inserted into a Document
whose top-level
browsing context's active document
is the same as target's top-level
browsing context's active document,
abort these steps.
Якщо the user has indicated (for example, by starting to type in a form control) that he does not wish focus to be changed, then optionally abort these steps.
Queue a task that checks to see if the element is focusable та if so, runs the focusing steps for that element. User agents may also change the scrolling position of the document, or perform some other action that brings the element to the user's attention. The task source for this task is the user interaction task source.
This handles the automatic focusing during document load.
Focusing the control does not imply that the user agent must focus the browser window if it has lost focus.
The autofocus
IDL attribute must reflect the content attribute
of the same name.
In the following snippet, the text control would be focused when the document was loaded.
<input maxlength="256" name="q" value="" autofocus> <input type="submit" value="Search">
autocomplete
attributeUser agents sometimes have features for helping users fill forms in, for
example prefilling the user's address based on earlier user input. The autocomplete
content attribute can be used to hint to the user agent how to, or indeed
whether to, provide such a feature.
The attribute, if present, must have a value that is an ASCII
чутливі до реєстру match for the string "off
", or a single token
that is an ASCII чутливі до реєстру
match for the string "on
"
The "off
"
keyword indicates either that the control's input data is particularly
sensitive (for example the activation code for a nuclear weapon); or that
it is a value that will never be reused (for example a one-time-key for a
bank login) and the user will therefore have to explicitly enter the data
each time, instead of being able to rely on the UA to prefill the value
for him; or that the document provides its own autocomplete mechanism and
does not want the user agent to provide autocompletion values.
The "on
"
keyword indicates that the user agent is allowed to provide the user with
autocompletion values, but does not provide any further information about
what kind of data the user might be expected to enter. User agents would
have to use heuristics to decide what autocompletion values to suggest.
Якщо the autocomplete
attribute is omitted, the default value corresponding to the state of the
element's form owner's autocomplete
attribute is
used instead (either "on
" or "off
"). Якщо there is no form owner, then the value "on
" is used.
When an element's autofill field name is "off
", the user agent
should not remember the control's value та should not offer past values to
the user.
In addition, when an element's autofill field name
is "off
",
values are reset when traversing the history.
Banks frequently do not want UAs to prefill login information:
<p><label>Account: <input type="text" name="ac" autocomplete="off"></label></p> <p><label>PIN: <input type="password" name="pin" autocomplete="off"></label></p>
When an element's autofill field name is not "off
",
the user agent may store the control's value та may offer previously stored
values to the user.
When the autofill field name is "on
", the user agent
should attempt to use heuristics to determine the most appropriate
values to offer the user, e.g. based on the element's name
value, the position of the
element in the document's DOM, what other fields exist in the form та so
forth.
The autocompletion mechanism must be implemented by the user agent acting as if the user had modified the element's value та must be done at a time where the element is mutable (e.g. just after the element has been inserted into the document, or when the user agent stops parsing). User agents must only prefill controls using values that the user could have entered.
A user agent prefilling a form control's value must not cause that control to suffer from a type mismatch, suffer from a pattern mismatch, suffer from being too long, suffer from being too short, suffer from an underflow, suffer from an overflow, or suffer from a step mismatch. Where possible given the control's constraints, user agents must use the format given as canonical in the aforementioned table. Where it's not possible for the canonical format to be used, user agents should use heuristics to attempt to convert values so that they can be used.
A user agent may allow the user to override an element's autofill
field name, e.g. to change it from "off
" to "on
" to allow values to be
remembered and prefilled despite the page author's objections, or to
always "off
",
never remembering values. However, user agents should not allow users to
trivially override the autofill field name from "off
" to "on
" or other values, as
there are significant security implications for the user if all values
are always remembered, regardless of the site's preferences.
The autocomplete
IDL attribute, on getting, must return the element's IDL-exposed
autofill value та on setting, must reflect
the content attribute of the same name.
The input
and textarea
elements define the following members in their DOM interfaces for handling
their selection:
void select(); attribute unsigned long selectionStart; attribute unsigned long selectionEnd; attribute DOMString selectionDirection; void setRangeText(DOMString replacement); void setRangeText(DOMString replacement, unsigned long start, unsigned long end, optional SelectionMode selectionMode = "preserve"); void setSelectionRange(unsigned long start, unsigned long end, optional DOMString direction = "preserve");
The setRangeText
method uses the following enumeration:
enum SelectionMode { "select", "start", "end", "preserve" // default };
These methods and attributes expose and control the selection of input
and textarea
text fields.
select
()Selects everything in the text field.
selectionStart
[ = value ]Returns the offset to the start of the selection.
Can be set, to change the start of the selection.
selectionEnd
[ = value ]Returns the offset to the end of the selection.
Can be set, to change the end of the selection.
selectionDirection
[ = value ]Returns the current direction of the selection.
Can be set, to change the direction of the selection.
The possible values are "forward
", "backward
" та "none
".
setSelectionRange
(start, end
[, direction] )Changes the selection to cover the given substring in the given direction. Якщо the direction is omitted, it will be reset to be the platform default (none or forward).
setRangeText
(replacement [, start,
end [, selectionMode
] ] )Replaces a range of text with the new text. Якщо the start and end arguments are not provided, the range is assumed to be the selection.
The final argument determines how the selection should be set after the text has been replaced. The possible values are:
select
"start
"end
"preserve
"For input
elements,
calling these methods while they don't apply та getting or setting these
attributes while they don't apply, must throw an InvalidStateError
exception. Інакше they must act as described below.
For input
elements,
these methods and attributes must operate on the element's value. For textarea
elements, these methods and attributes must operate on the element's raw
value.
Where possible, user interface features for changing the text selection
in input
and textarea
elements must be implemented in terms of the DOM API described in this
section, so that, e.g., all the same events fire.
The selections of input
and textarea
elements
have a direction, which is either forward, backward,
or none. This direction is set when the user manipulates the
selection. The exact meaning of the selection direction depends on the
platform.
On Windows, the direction indicates the position of the caret relative to the selection: a forward selection has the caret at the end of the selection and a backward selection has the caret at the start of the selection. Windows has no none direction. On Mac, the direction indicates which end of the selection is affected when the user adjusts the size of the selection using the arrow keys with the Shift modifier: the forward direction means the end of the selection is modified та the backwards direction means the start of the selection is modified. The none direction is the default on Mac, it indicates that no particular direction has yet been selected. The user sets the direction implicitly when first adjusting the selection, based on which directional arrow key was used.
The select()
method must cause the contents of the text field to be fully selected,
with the selection direction being none, if the platform support
selections with the direction none, or otherwise forward.
The user agent must then queue a task to fire a simple event that bubbles named
select
at the element,
using the user interaction task
source as the task source.
The selectionStart
attribute must, on getting, return the offset (in logical order) to the
character that immediately follows the start of the selection. Якщо
there is no selection, then it must return the offset (in logical order)
to the character that immediately follows the text entry cursor.
On setting, it must act as if the setSelectionRange()
method had been called, with the new value as the first argument; the
current value of the selectionEnd
attribute as the second argument, unless the current value of the selectionEnd
is less than the new value, in which case the second argument must also
be the new value; and the current value of the selectionDirection
as the third argument.
The selectionEnd
attribute must, on getting, return the offset (in logical order) to the
character that immediately follows the end of the selection. Якщо there
is no selection, then it must return the offset (in logical order) to
the character that immediately follows the text entry cursor.
On setting, it must act as if the setSelectionRange()
method had been called, with the current value of the selectionStart
attribute as the first argument, the new value as the second argument та
the current value of the selectionDirection
as the third argument.
The selectionDirection
attribute must, on getting, return the string corresponding to the
current selection direction: if the direction is forward, "forward
"; if the direction is backward,
"backward
"; and otherwise, "none
".
On setting, it must act as if the setSelectionRange()
method had been called, with the current value of the selectionStart
attribute as the first argument, the current value of the selectionEnd
attribute as the second argument та the new value as the third argument.
The setSelectionRange(start, end,
direction)
method must
set the selection of the text field to the sequence of characters
starting with the character at the startth
position (in logical order) and ending with the character at the (end-1)th
position. Arguments greater than the length of the value of the text
field must be treated as pointing at the end of the text field. Якщо end is less than or equal to start
then the start of the selection and the end of the selection must both
be placed immediately before the character with offset end.
In UAs where there is no concept of an empty selection, this must set
the cursor to be just before the character with offset end.
The direction of the selection must be set to backward if direction is a case-sensitive
match for the string "backward
", forward
if direction is a case-sensitive
match for the string "forward
" or if
the platform does not support selections with the direction none
та none otherwise (including if the argument is omitted). The
user agent must then queue a task to fire
a simple event that bubbles named select
at the element, using the user
interaction task source as the task source.
The setRangeText(replacement, start,
end, selectMode)
method must run the following steps:
Якщо the method has only one argument, then let start
and end have the values of the selectionStart
attribute and the selectionEnd
attribute respectively.
Інакше let start, end have the values of the second and third arguments respectively.
Якщо start is greater than end,
then throw an IndexSizeError
exception and abort these steps.
Якщо start is greater than the length of the value of the text field, then set it to the length of the value of the text field.
Якщо end is greater than the length of the value of the text field, then set it to the length of the value of the text field.
Нехай selection start be the
current value of the selectionStart
attribute.
Нехай selection end be the current
value of the selectionEnd
attribute.
Якщо start is less than end, delete the sequence of characters starting with the character at the startth position (in logical order) and ending with the character at the (end-1)th position.
Insert the value of the first argument into the text of the value of the text field, immediately before the startth character.
Нехай new length be the length of the value of the first argument.
Нехай new end be the sum of start and new length.
Run the appropriate set of substeps from the following list:
select
"Нехай selection start be start.
Нехай selection end be new end.
start
"Нехай selection start and selection end be start.
end
"Нехай selection start and selection end be new end.
preserve
"
(the default)Нехай old length be end minus start.
Нехай delta be new length minus old length.
Якщо selection start is greater than end, then increment it by delta. (Якщо delta is negative, i.e. the new text is shorter than the old text, then this will decrease the value of selection start.)
Otherwise: if selection start is greater than start, then set it to start. (This snaps the start of the selection to the start of the new text if it was in the middle of the text that it replaced.)
Якщо selection end is greater than end, then increment it by delta in the same way.
Otherwise: if selection end is greater than start, then set it to new end. (This snaps the end of the selection to the end of the new text if it was in the middle of the text that it replaced.)
Set the selection of the text field to the sequence of characters starting with the character at the selection startth position (in logical order) and ending with the character at the (selection end-1)th position. In UAs where there is no concept of an empty selection, this must set the cursor to be just before the character with offset end. The direction of the selection must be set to forward if the platform does not support selections with the direction none та none otherwise.
Queue a task to fire
a simple event that bubbles named select
at the element, using the user
interaction task source as the task source.
All elements to which this API applies have either a selection or a text entry cursor position at all times (even for elements що є not being rendered). User agents should follow platform conventions to determine their initial state.
Characters with no visible rendering, such as U+200D ZERO WIDTH JOINER, still count as characters. Thus, for instance, the selection can include just an invisible character та the text insertion cursor can be placed to one side or another of such a character.
To obtain the currently selected text, the following JavaScript suffices:
var selectionText = control.value.substring(control.selectionStart, control.selectionEnd);
To add some text at the start of a text control, while maintaining the text selection, the three attributes must be preserved:
var oldStart = control.selectionStart; var oldEnd = control.selectionEnd; var oldDirection = control.selectionDirection; var prefix = "http://"; control.value = prefix + control.value; control.setSelectionRange(oldStart + prefix.length, oldEnd + prefix.length, oldDirection);
A submittable
element is a candidate
for constraint validation except when a condition has barred the element from
constraint validation. (For example, an element is barred
from constraint validation if it is an object
element.)
An element can have a custom
validity error message defined. Initially, an element must have
its custom validity error
message set to the empty string. When its value is not the empty
string, the element is suffering
from a custom error. It can be set using the setCustomValidity()
method. The user agent should use the custom
validity error message when alerting the user to the problem with
the control.
An element can be constrained in various ways. The following is the list of validity states that a form control can be in, making the control invalid for the purposes of constraint validation. (The definitions below are non-normative; other parts of this specification define more precisely when each state applies or does not.)
When a control has no value
but has a required
attribute (input
required
, select
required
,
textarea
required
), or, in the
case of an element in a radio
button group, any of the other elements in the group has
a required
attribute.
When a control that allows arbitrary user input has a value that is not in the correct syntax (E-mail, URL).
When a control has a value
that doesn't satisfy the pattern
attribute.
When a control has a value
that is too long for the form
control maxlength
attribute
(input
maxlength
, textarea
maxlength
).
When a control has a value
that is too short for the form
control minlength
attribute
(input
minlength
, textarea
minlength
).
When a control has a value
that is too low for the min
attribute.
When a control has a value
that is too high for the max
attribute.
When a control has a value
that doesn't fit the rules given by the step
attribute.
When a control has incomplete input and the user agent does not think the user ought to be able to submit the form in its current state.
When a control's custom
validity error message (as set by the element's setCustomValidity()
method) is not the empty string.
An element can still suffer from these states even when the element is disabled; thus these states can be represented in the DOM even if validating the form during submission wouldn't indicate a problem to the user.
An element satisfies its constraints if it is not suffering from any of the above validity states.
When the user agent is required to statically
validate the constraints of form
element form, it must run the following
steps, which return either a positive result (all the controls
in the form are valid) or a negative result (there are invalid
controls) along with a (possibly empty) list of elements що є invalid
and for which no script has claimed responsibility:
Нехай controls be a list of all the submittable elements whose form owner is form, in tree order.
Нехай invalid controls be an initially empty list of elements.
For each element field in controls, in tree order, run the following substeps:
Якщо field is not a candidate for constraint validation, then move on to the next element.
Інакше if field satisfies its constraints, then move on to the next element.
Інакше add field to invalid controls.
Якщо invalid controls is empty, then return a positive result and abort these steps.
Нехай unhandled invalid controls be an initially empty list of elements.
For each element field in invalid controls, if any, in tree order, run the following substeps:
Fire a simple event named invalid
that is
cancelable at field.
Якщо the event was not canceled, then add field to unhandled invalid controls.
Повернутиa negative result with the list of elements in the unhandled invalid controls list.
Якщо a user agent is to interactively
validate the constraints of form
element form, then the user agent must
run the following steps:
Statically validate the constraints of form та let unhandled invalid controls be the list of elements returned if the result was negative.
Якщо the result was positive, then return that result and abort these steps.
Report the problems with the constraints of at least one of the
elements given in unhandled invalid
controls to the user. User agents may focus one of those
elements in the process, by running the focusing
steps for that element та may change the scrolling position of
the document, or perform some other action that brings the element
to the user's attention. User agents may report more than one
constraint violation. User agents may coalesce related constraint
violation reports if appropriate (e.g. if multiple radio buttons in
a group
are marked as required, only one error need be reported). Якщо one
of the controls is not being rendered
(e.g. it has the hidden
attribute set) then user agents may report a script error.
Повернутиa negative result.
willValidate
Returns true if the element will be validated when the form is submitted; false otherwise.
setCustomValidity
(message)Sets a custom error, so that the element would fail to validate. The given message is the message to be shown to the user when reporting the problem to the user.
Якщо the argument is the empty string, clears the custom error.
validity
. valueMissing
Returns true if the element has no value but is a required field; false otherwise.
validity
. typeMismatch
Returns true if the element's value is not in the correct syntax; false otherwise.
validity
. patternMismatch
Returns true if the element's value doesn't match the provided pattern; false otherwise.
validity
. tooLong
Returns true if the element's value is longer than the provided maximum length; false otherwise.
validity
. tooShort
Returns true if the element's value, if it is not the empty string, is shorter than the provided minimum length; false otherwise.
validity
. rangeUnderflow
Returns true if the element's value is lower than the provided minimum; false otherwise.
validity
. rangeOverflow
Returns true if the element's value is higher than the provided maximum; false otherwise.
validity
. stepMismatch
Returns true if the element's value doesn't fit the rules given by
the step
attribute; false otherwise.
validity
. badInput
Returns true if the user has provided input in the user interface that the user agent is unable to convert to a value; false otherwise.
validity
. customError
Returns true if the element has a custom error; false otherwise.
validity
. valid
Returns true if the element's value has no validity problems; false otherwise.
checkValidity
()Returns true if the element's value has no validity problems; false
otherwise. Fires an invalid
event at the element in the latter case.
validationMessage
Returns the error message that would be shown to the user if the element was to be checked for validity.
The willValidate
attribute must return true if an element is a candidate
for constraint validation та false otherwise (i.e. false if any
conditions are barring it from constraint
validation).
The setCustomValidity(message)
, when invoked,
must set the custom validity
error message to the value of the given message
argument.
In the following example, a script checks the value of a form control
each time it is edited та whenever it is not a valid value, uses the setCustomValidity()
method to set an appropriate message.
<label>Feeling: <input name=f type="text" oninput="check(this)"></label> <script> function check(input) { if (input.value == "good" || input.value == "fine" || input.value == "tired") { input.setCustomValidity('"' + input.value + '" is not a feeling.'); } else { // input is fine -- reset the error message input.setCustomValidity(''); } } </script>
The validity
attribute must return a ValidityState
object that represents the validity states
of the element. This object is live та the same
object must be returned each time the element's validity
attribute is retrieved.
interface ValidityState { readonly attribute boolean valueMissing; readonly attribute boolean typeMismatch; readonly attribute boolean patternMismatch; readonly attribute boolean tooLong; readonly attribute boolean tooShort; readonly attribute boolean rangeUnderflow; readonly attribute boolean rangeOverflow; readonly attribute boolean stepMismatch; readonly attribute boolean badInput; readonly attribute boolean customError; readonly attribute boolean valid; };
A ValidityState
object has
the following attributes. On getting, they must return true if the
corresponding condition given in the following list є true та false
otherwise.
valueMissing
The control is suffering from being missing.
typeMismatch
The control is suffering from a type mismatch.
patternMismatch
The control is suffering from a pattern mismatch.
tooLong
The control is suffering from being too long.
tooShort
The control is suffering from being too short.
rangeUnderflow
The control is suffering from an underflow.
rangeOverflow
The control is suffering from an overflow.
stepMismatch
The control is suffering from a step mismatch.
badInput
The control is suffering from bad input.
customError
The control is suffering from a custom error.
valid
None of the other conditions are true.
When the checkValidity()
method is invoked, if the element is a candidate
for constraint validation and does not satisfy its constraints, the user agent
must fire a simple event named invalid
that is cancelable
(but in this case has no default action) at the element and return
false. Інакше it must only return true without doing anything else.
The validationMessage
attribute must return the empty string if the element is not a candidate
for constraint validation or if it is one but it satisfies its constraints; otherwise, it
must return a suitably localized message that the user agent would show
the user if this were the only form control with a validity constraint
problem. Якщо the user agent would not actually show a textual message
in such a situation (e.g. it would show a graphical cue instead), then
the attribute must return a suitably localized message that expresses
(one or more of) the validity constraint(s) that the control does not
satisfy. Якщо the element is a candidate
for constraint validation and is suffering
from a custom error, then the custom
validity error message should be present in the return value.
Servers should not rely on client-side validation. Client-side validation can be intentionally bypassed by hostile users та unintentionally bypassed by users of older user agents or automated tools that do not implement these features. The constraint validation features are only intended to improve the user experience, not to provide any kind of security mechanism.
Цей розділ не є нормативним.
When a form is submitted, the data in the form is converted into the structure specified by the enctype та then sent to the destination specified by the action using the given method.
For example, take the following form:
<form action="/find.cgi" method=get> <input type=text name=t> <input type=search name=q> <input type=submit> </form>
Якщо the user types in "cats" in the first field and "fur" in the second
та then hits the submit button, then the user agent will load /find.cgi?t=cats&q=fur
.
On the other hand, consider this form:
<form action="/find.cgi" method=post enctype="multipart/form-data"> <input type=text name=t> <input type=search name=q> <input type=submit> </form>
Given the same user input, the result on submission is quite different: the user agent instead does an HTTP POST to the given URL, with as the entity body something like the following text:
------kYFrd4jNJEgCervE Content-Disposition: form-data; name="t" cats ------kYFrd4jNJEgCervE Content-Disposition: form-data; name="q" fur ------kYFrd4jNJEgCervE--
A form
element's default
button is the first submit button in tree
order whose form owner is that form
element.
Якщо the user agent supports letting the user submit a form implicitly (for example, on some platforms hitting the "enter" key while a text field is focused implicitly submits the form), then doing so for a form whose default button has a defined activation behavior must cause the user agent to run synthetic click activation steps on that default button.
Consequently, if the default button is disabled, the form is not submitted when such an implicit submission mechanism is used. (A button has no activation behavior when disabled.)
There are pages on the Web що є only usable if there is a way to implicitly submit forms, so user agents are strongly encouraged to support this.
Якщо
the form has no submit
button, then the implicit submission mechanism must do nothing if
the form has more than one field that blocks implicit submission
та must submit
the form
element from the
form
element itself
otherwise.
For the purpose of the previous paragraph, an element is a field
that blocks implicit submission of a form
element if it is an input
element whose form owner is that form
element and whose type
attribute is in one of the following states: Text,
Search,
URL,
Telephone,
E-mail,
Password,
Date,
Time,
Number
When a form
element form is submitted from an element submitter
(typically a button), optionally with a submitted
from submit()
method flag set, the user agent must run the following steps:
Нехай form document be the form's
Document
.
Якщо form document has no associated browsing context or its active sandboxing flag set has its sandboxed forms browsing context flag set, then abort these steps without doing anything.
Нехай form browsing context be the browsing context of form document.
Якщо the submitted from submit()
method flag
is not set та the submitter
element's no-validate
state is false, then interactively
validate the constraints of form
and examine the result: if the result is negative (the constraint
validation concluded that there were invalid fields and probably
informed the user of this) then fire
a simple event named invalid
at the form element and then abort
these steps.
Якщо the submitted from submit()
method flag
is not set, then fire a simple event
that bubbles and is cancelable named submit
,
at form. Якщо the event's default
action is prevented (i.e. if the event is canceled) then abort these
steps. Інакше continue (effectively the default action is to perform
the submission).
Нехай form data set be the result of constructing the form data set for form in the context of submitter.
Нехай action be the submitter element's action.
Якщо action is the empty string, let action be the document's address of the form document.
Resolve the URL action, relative to the submitter element. Якщо this fails, abort these steps.
Нехай action be the resulting absolute URL.
Нехай action components be the resulting parsed URL.
Нехай scheme be the scheme of the resulting parsed URL.
Нехай enctype be the submitter element's enctype.
Нехай method be the submitter element's method.
Нехай target be the submitter element's target.
Якщо the user indicated a specific browsing context to use when submitting the form, then let target browsing context be that browsing context. Інакше apply the rules for choosing a browsing context given a browsing context name using target as the name and form browsing context as the context in which the algorithm is executed та let target browsing context be the resulting browsing context.
Якщо target browsing context was
created in the previous step, or, alternatively, if the form
document has not yet completely
loaded and the submitted from submit()
method flag is set, then let replace
be true. Інакше let it be false.
Інакше select the appropriate row in the table below based on the value of scheme as given by the first cell of each row. Then, select the appropriate cell on that row based on the value of method as given in the first cell of each column. Then, jump to the steps named in that cell and defined below the table.
|
GET | POST |
---|---|---|
http |
Mutate action URL | Submit as entity body |
https |
Mutate action URL | Submit as entity body |
ftp |
Get action URL | Get action URL |
javascript |
Get action URL | Get action URL |
data |
Get action URL | Post to data: |
mailto |
Mail with headers | Mail as body |
Якщо scheme is not one of those listed in this table, then the behavior is not defined by this specification. User agents should, in the absence of another specification defining this, act in a manner analogous to that defined in this specification for similar schemes.
Each form
element has
a planned navigation, which is
either null or a task;
when the form
is first
created, its planned navigation
must be set to null. In the behaviours described below, when the
user agent is required to plan to
navigate to a particular resource destination,
it must run the following steps:
Якщо the form
has
a non-null planned navigation,
remove it from its task queue.
Нехай the form
's
planned navigation be a new task
that consists of running the following steps:
Нехай the form
's
planned navigation be
null.
Navigate target browsing context to the particular resource destination. Якщо replace є true, then target browsing context must be navigated with replacement enabled.
For the purposes of this task, target browsing context and replace are the variables that were set up when the overall form submission algorithm was run, with their values as they stood when this planned navigation was queued.
Queue
the task that is the form
's
new planned navigation.
The task source for this task is the DOM manipulation task source.
The behaviors наступні:
Нехай query be the result of
encoding the form data set using
the application/x-www-form-urlencoded
encoding algorithm, interpreted as a US-ASCII string.
Set parsed action's query component to query.
Нехай destination be a new URL formed by applying the URL serializer algorithm to parsed action.
Plan to navigate to destination.
Нехай entity body be the result of encoding the form data set using the appropriate form encoding algorithm.
Нехай MIME type be determined as follows:
application/x-www-form-urlencoded
application/x-www-form-urlencoded
".multipart/form-data
multipart/form-data;
",
a U+0020 SPACE character, the string "boundary=
"
та the multipart/form-data
boundary string generated by the multipart/form-data
encoding
algorithm.text/plain
text/plain
".Інакше plan to navigate to action using the HTTP method given by method and with entity body as the entity body, of type MIME type.
Plan to navigate to action.
The form data set is discarded.
Нехай data be the result of encoding the form data set using the appropriate form encoding algorithm.
Якщо action contains the string
"%%%%
" (four U+0025 PERCENT
SIGN characters), then percent encode
all bytes in data that, if
interpreted as US-ASCII, are not characters in the URL default
encode set та then, treating the result as a US-ASCII
string, UTF-8 percent encode
all the U+0025 PERCENT SIGN characters in the resulting string
and replace the first occurrence of "%%%%
"
in action with the resulting
doubly-escaped string. [URL]
Інакше if action contains the
string "%%
" (two U+0025 PERCENT
SIGN characters in a row, but not four), then UTF-8
percent encode all characters in data
that, if interpreted as US-ASCII, are not characters in the URL
default encode set та then,
treating the result as a US-ASCII string, replace the first
occurrence of "%%
" in action
with the resulting escaped string. [URL]
Plan to navigate to the
potentially modified action
(which will be a data:
URL).
Нехай headers be the resulting
encoding the form data set using
the application/x-www-form-urlencoded
encoding algorithm, interpreted as a US-ASCII string.
Replace occurrences of "+" (U+002B) characters in headers
with the string "%20
".
Нехай destination consist of all the characters from the first character in action to the character immediately before the first "?" (U+003F) character, if any, or the end of the string if there are none.
Append a single "?" (U+003F) character to destination.
Append headers to destination.
Plan to navigate to destination.
Нехай body be the resulting of encoding the form data set using the appropriate form encoding algorithm and then percent encoding all the bytes in the resulting byte string that, when interpreted as US-ASCII, are not characters in the URL default encode set. [URL]
Нехай destination have the same value as action.
Якщо destination does not contain a "?" (U+003F) character, append a single "?" (U+003F) character to destination. Інакше append a single U+0026 AMPERSAND character (&).
Append the string "body=
" to destination.
Append body, interpreted as a US-ASCII string, to destination.
Plan to navigate to destination.
The appropriate form encoding algorithm is determined as follows:
application/x-www-form-urlencoded
application/x-www-form-urlencoded
encoding algorithm.multipart/form-data
multipart/form-data
encoding
algorithm.text/plain
text/plain
encoding algorithm.The algorithm to construct the form data set for a form form optionally in the context of a submitter submitter is as follows. Якщо not specified otherwise, submitter is null.
Нехай controls be a list of all the submittable elements whose form owner is form, in tree order.
Нехай the form data set be a list of name-value-type tuples, initially empty.
Loop: For each element field in controls, in tree order, run the following substeps:
Якщо any of the following conditions are met, then skip these substeps for this element:
datalist
element
ancestor.input
element whose type
attribute is in the Checkbox
state and whose checkedness
is false.input
element whose type
attribute is in the Radio Button
state and whose checkedness
is false.input
element
whose type
attribute is in the Image Button
state та either the field
element does not have a name
attribute specified,
or its name
attribute's value is the empty string.object
element that
is not using a plugin.Інакше process field as follows:
Нехай type be the value of the
type
IDL attribute of field.
Якщо the field element is an input
element whose type
attribute is in the Image Button
state, then run these further nested substeps:
Якщо the field element has
a name
attribute specified and its value is not the empty string,
let name be that value
followed by a single "." (U+002E) character. Інакше let name be the empty string.
Нехай namex буде рядком consisting of the concatenation of name and a single U+0078 LATIN SMALL LETTER X character (x).
Нехай namey буде рядком consisting of the concatenation of name and a single U+0079 LATIN SMALL LETTER Y character (y).
The field element is submitter та before this algorithm was invoked the user indicated a coordinate. Нехай x be the x-component of the coordinate selected by the user та let y be the y-component of the coordinate selected by the user.
Append an entry to the form data set with the name namex, the value x та the type type.
Append an entry to the form data set with the name namey and the value y та the type type.
Skip the remaining substeps for this element: if there are any more elements in controls, return to the top of the loop step, otherwise, jump to the end step below.
Нехай name be the value of the
field element's name
attribute.
Якщо the field element is a select
element, then
for each option
element in the select
element's list
of options whose selectedness є true
and that is not disabled,
append an entry to the form data set
with the name as the name, the value
of the option
element as the value та type as
the type.
Інакше if the field element is
an input
element
whose type
attribute is in the Checkbox state
or the Radio
Button state, then run these further nested substeps:
Якщо the field element has
a value
attribute specified, then let value
be the value of that attribute; otherwise, let value
буде рядком "on
".
Append an entry to the form data set with name as the name, value as the value та type as the type.
Інакше if the field element is
an input
element
whose type
attribute is in the File Upload
state, then for each file selected in the input
element, append
an entry to the form data set
with the name as the name, the
file (consisting of the name, the type та the body) as the value
та type as the type. Якщо there
are no selected
files, then append an entry to the form
data set with the name
as the name, the empty string as the value та application/octet-stream
as the type.
Інакше if the field element is
an object
element: try щоб отримати a form submission value from the plugin та if that
is successful, append an entry to the form
data set with name as
the name, the returned form submission value as the value та the
string "object
" as the type.
Інакше append an entry to the form data set with name as the name, the value of the field element as the value та type as the type.
Якщо the element has a dirname
attribute та that
attribute's value is not the empty string, тоді виконайте ці
субкроки:
Нехай dirname be the value
of the element's dirname
attribute.
Нехай dir буде рядком "ltr
" if the
directionality of the element is 'ltr' та "rtl
"
otherwise (i.e. when the
directionality of the element is 'rtl').
Append an entry to the form data
set with dirname as
the name, dir as the value
та the string "direction
"
as the type.
An element can only have a dirname
attribute if it
is a textarea
element or an input
element whose type
attribute is in either the Text
state or the Search
state.
End: For the name of each entry in the form
data set та for the value of each entry in the form
data set whose type is not "file
"
or "textarea
", replace every
occurrence of a "CR" (U+000D) character not followed by a "LF"
(U+000A) character та every occurrence of a "LF" (U+000A) character
not preceded by a "CR" (U+000D) character, by a two-character string
consisting of a U+000D CARRIAGE RETURN "CRLF" (U+000A) character
pair.
In the case of the value of textarea
elements, this newline normalization is already performed during the
conversion of the control's raw value into the
control's value
(which also performs any necessary line wrapping). In the case of input
elements type
attributes in the File Upload state,
the value is not normalized.
Повернути form data set.
Якщо the user agent is to pick an encoding for a form, optionally with an allow non-ASCII-compatible encodings flag set, it must run the following substeps:
Нехай input be the value of the form
element's accept-charset
attribute.
Нехай candidate encoding labels be the result of splitting input on spaces.
Нехай candidate encodings be an empty list of character encodings.
For each token in candidate encoding labels in turn (in the order in which they were found in input), get an encoding for the token and, if this does not result in failure, append the encoding to candidate encodings.
Якщо the allow non-ASCII-compatible encodings flag is not set, remove any encodings що є not ASCII-compatible character encodings from candidate encodings.
Якщо candidate encodings is empty, return UTF-8 and abort these steps.
Each character encoding in candidate encodings can represent a finite number of characters. (For example, UTF-8 can represent all 1.1 million or so Unicode code points, while Windows-1252 can only represent 256.)
For each encoding in candidate encodings, determine how many of the characters in the names and values of the entries in the form data set the encoding can represent (without ignoring duplicates). Нехай max be the highest such count. (For UTF-8, max would equal the number of characters in the names and values of the entries in the form data set.)
Повернути first encoding in candidate encodings that can encode max characters in the names and values of the entries in the form data set.
This form data set encoding is in many ways an aberrant monstrosity, the result of many years of implementation accidents and compromises leading to a set of requirements necessary for interoperability, but in no way representing good design practices. In particular, readers are cautioned to pay close attention to the twisted details involving repeated (and in some cases nested) conversions between character encodings and byte sequences.
The application/x-www-form-urlencoded
encoding algorithm is as follows:
Нехай result be the empty string.
Якщо the form
element
has an accept-charset
attribute, let the selected character encoding be the result of picking an encoding for
the form.
Інакше if the form
element has no accept-charset
attribute, but the document's
character encoding is an ASCII-compatible
character encoding, then that is the selected character
encoding.
Інакше let the selected character encoding be UTF-8.
Нехай charset be the name of the selected character encoding.
For each entry in the form data set, perform these substeps:
Якщо the entry's name is "_charset_
" and its
type is "hidden
", replace its
value with charset.
Якщо the entry's type is "file
",
replace its value with the file's name only.
For each character in the entry's name and value that cannot be expressed using the selected character encoding, replace the character by a string consisting of a U+0026 AMPERSAND character (&), a "#" (U+0023) character, one or more цифрами ASCII representing the Unicode code point of the character in base ten та finally a ";" (U+003B) character.
Encode the entry's name and value using the encoder for the selected character encoding. The entry's name and value are now byte strings.
For each byte in the entry's name and value, apply the appropriate subsubsteps from the following list:
Leave the byte as is.
Нехай s be a string consisting of a U+0025 PERCENT SIGN character (%) followed by uppercase шестнадцятеричними символами ASCII representing the hexadecimal value of the byte in question (zero-padded if necessary).
Encode the string s as US-ASCII, so that it is now a byte string.
Replace the byte in question in the name or value being processed by the bytes in s, preserving their relative order.
Інтерпретувати the entry's name and value as Unicode strings encoded in US-ASCII. (All of the bytes в рядку will be in the range 0x00 to 0x7F; the high bit will be zero throughout.) The entry's name and value are now Unicode strings again.
Якщо the entry's name is "isindex
", its type
is "text
" та this is the first
entry in the form data set, then
append the value to result and
skip the rest of the substeps for this entry, moving on to the
next entry, if any, or the next step in the overall algorithm
otherwise.
Якщо this is not the first entry, append a single U+0026 AMPERSAND character (&) to result.
Append the entry's name to result.
Append a single "=" (U+003D) character to result.
Append the entry's value to result.
Encode result as US-ASCII and return the resulting byte stream.
To decode application/x-www-form-urlencoded
payloads, the following algorithm should be used. This algorithm
uses as inputs the payload itself, payload,
consisting of a Unicode string using only characters in the range U+0000
to U+007F; a default character encoding encoding;
and optionally an isindex flag indicating
that the payload is to be processed as if it had been generated for a form
containing an isindex
control. The output of this algorithm is a sorted list of name-value
pairs. Якщо the isindex flag is set and
the first control really was an isindex
control, then the
first name-value pair will have as its name the empty string.
Which default character encoding to use can only be determined on a case-by-case basis, but generally the best character encoding to use as a default is the one that was used to encode the page on which the form used to create the payload was itself found. In the absence of a better default, UTF-8 is suggested.
The isindex flag is for legacy use only. Forms in conforming HTML documents will not generate payloads that need to be decoded with this flag set.
Нехай strings be the result of strictly splitting the string payload on U+0026 AMPERSAND characters (&).
Якщо the isindex flag is set and the first string in strings does not contain a "=" (U+003D) character, insert a "=" (U+003D) character at the start of the first string in strings.
Нехай pairs be an empty list of name-value pairs.
For each string string in strings, виконати ці підкроки:
Якщо string contains a "=" (U+003D) character, then let name be the substring of string from the start of string up to but excluding its first "=" (U+003D) character та let value be the substring from the first character, if any, after the first "=" (U+003D) character up to the end of string. Якщо the first "=" (U+003D) character is the first character, then name will be the empty string. Якщо it is the last character, then value will be the empty string.
Інакше string contains no "=" (U+003D) characters. Нехай name have the value of string and let value be the empty string.
Replace any "+" (U+002B) characters in name and value with U+0020 SPACE characters.
Replace any escape in name and value with the character represented by the escape. This replacement must not be recursive.
An escape is a "%" (U+0025) character followed by two шестнадцятеричними символами ASCII.
The character represented by an escape is the Unicode character whose code point is equal to the value of the two characters after the "%" (U+0025) character, interpreted як шестнадцятеричне число (in the range 0..255).
So for instance the string "A%2BC
"
would become "A+C
". Similarly,
the string "100%25AA%21
" becomes
the string "100%AA!
".
Convert the name and value strings to their byte representation in ISO-8859-1 (i.e. convert the Unicode string to a byte string, mapping code points to byte values directly).
Add a pair consisting of name and value to pairs.
Якщо any of the name-value pairs in pairs
have a name component consisting of the string "_charset_
"
encoded in US-ASCII та the value component of the first such pair,
when decoded as US-ASCII, is the name of a supported character
encoding, then let encoding be that
character encoding (replacing the default passed to the algorithm).
Convert the name and value components of each name-value pair in pairs to Unicode by interpreting the bytes according to the encoding encoding.
Повернутиpairs.
Parameters on the application/x-www-form-urlencoded
MIME type are ignored. In particular, this MIME type does not support the
charset
parameter.
The multipart/form-data
encoding algorithm is as follows:
Нехай result be the empty string.
Якщо the algorithm was invoked with an explicit character encoding,
let the selected character encoding be that encoding. (This
algorithm is used by other specifications, which provide an explicit
character encoding to avoid the dependency on the form
element described in the next paragraph.)
Інакше if the form
element has an accept-charset
attribute, let the selected character encoding be the result of picking an encoding for
the form.
Інакше if the form
element has no accept-charset
attribute, but the document's
character encoding is an ASCII-compatible
character encoding, then that is the selected character
encoding.
Інакше let the selected character encoding be UTF-8.
Нехай charset be the name of the selected character encoding.
For each entry in the form data set, perform these substeps:
Якщо the entry's name is "_charset_
" and its
type is "hidden
", replace its
value with charset.
For each character in the entry's name and value that cannot be expressed using the selected character encoding, replace the character by a string consisting of a U+0026 AMPERSAND character (&), a "#" (U+0023) character, one or more цифрами ASCII representing the Unicode code point of the character in base ten та finally a ";" (U+003B) character.
Encode the (now mutated) form data set
using the rules described by RFC 2388, Returning Values from
Forms: multipart/form-data
та return the resulting byte stream. [RFC2388]
Each entry in the form data set is a field, the name of the entry is the field name and the value of the entry is the field value.
The order of parts must be the same as the order of fields in the form data set. Multiple entries with the same name must be treated as distinct fields.
In particular, this means that multiple files
submitted as part of a single <input type=file multiple>
element will result in each file having its own field; the "sets of
files" feature ("multipart/mixed
")
of RFC 2388 is not used.
The parts of the generated multipart/form-data
resource that correspond to non-file fields must not have a Content-Type
header specified.
Their names and values must be encoded using the character encoding
selected above (field names in particular do not get converted to a
7-bit safe encoding as suggested in RFC 2388).
File names included in the generated multipart/form-data
resource (as part of file fields) must use the character encoding
selected above, though the precise name may be approximated if
necessary (e.g. newlines could be removed from file names, quotes
could be changed to "%22" та characters not expressible in the
selected character encoding could be replaced by other characters).
User agents must not use the RFC 2231 encoding suggested by RFC
2388.
The boundary used by the user agent in generating the return value
of this algorithm is the multipart/form-data
boundary string.
(This value is used to generate the MIME type of the form submission
payload generated by this algorithm.)
For details on how to interpret multipart/form-data
payloads, see RFC 2388. [RFC2388]
The text/plain
encoding algorithm is as follows:
Нехай result be the empty string.
Якщо the form
element
has an accept-charset
attribute, let the selected character encoding be the result of picking an encoding for
the form, with the allow non-ASCII-compatible encodings
flag unset.
Інакше if the form
element has no accept-charset
attribute, then that is the selected character encoding.
Нехай charset be the name of the selected character encoding.
Якщо the entry's name is "_charset_
" and its type
is "hidden
", replace its value with
charset.
Якщо the entry's type is "file
",
replace its value with the file's name only.
For each entry in the form data set, perform these substeps:
Append the entry's name to result.
Append a single "=" (U+003D) character to result.
Append the entry's value to result.
Append a "CR" (U+000D) "LF" (U+000A) character pair to result.
Encode result using the encoder for the selected character encoding and return the resulting byte stream.
Payloads using the text/plain
format are intended to be
human readable. They are not reliably interpretable by computer, as the
format is ambiguous (for example, there is no way to distinguish a literal
newline in a value from the newline at the end of the value).
When a form
element form is reset, the user agent must fire
a simple event named reset
,
that bubbles and is cancelable, at form
та then, if that event is not canceled, must invoke the reset algorithm of each resettable element whose form
owner is form.
Each resettable
element defines its own reset algorithm. Changes made to
form controls as part of these algorithms do not count as changes caused
by the user (and thus, e.g., do not cause input
events to fire).
Scripts allow authors to add interactivity to their documents.
Authors are encouraged to use declarative alternatives to scripting where possible, as declarative mechanisms are often more maintainable та many users disable scripting.
Authors are also encouraged to make their applications degrade gracefully in the absence of scripting support.
script
elementsrc
attribute, depends on the value of the type
attribute, but must match script content
restrictions.src
attribute, the element must
be either empty or contain only script
documentation that also matches script
content restrictions.src
- Address of the resourcetype
- Type of embedded resourcecharset
- Character encoding of the external script resourceasync
- Execute script asynchronouslydefer
- Defer script executioncrossorigin
- How the element handles crossorigin requestsinterface HTMLScriptElement : HTMLElement { attribute DOMString src; attribute DOMString type; attribute DOMString charset; attribute boolean async; attribute boolean defer; attribute DOMString crossOrigin; attribute DOMString text; };
The script
element allows
authors to include dynamic script and data blocks in their documents. The
element does not represent
content for the user.
When used to include dynamic scripts, the scripts may either be embedded
inline or may be imported from an external file using the src
attribute. Якщо the language is
not that described by "text/javascript
",
then the type
attribute must be present, as described below. Whatever language is used,
the contents of the script
element must conform with the requirements of that language's
specification.
When used to include data blocks (as opposed to scripts), the data must
be embedded inline, the format of the data must be given using the type
attribute, the src
attribute must not be specified та the contents of the script
element must conform to the requirements defined for the format used.
The type
attribute gives the language of the script or format of the data. Якщо the
attribute is present, its value must be a valid
MIME type. The charset
parameter
must not be specified. The default, which is used if the attribute is
absent, is "text/javascript
".
The src
attribute, if specified, gives the address of the external script resource
to use. The value of the attribute must be a valid
non-empty URL potentially surrounded by spaces identifying a script
resource of the type given by the type
attribute, if the attribute
is present, or of the type "text/javascript
",
if the attribute is absent. A resource is a script resource of a given
type if that type identifies a scripting language and the resource
conforms with the requirements of that language's specification.
The charset
attribute gives the character encoding of the external script resource.
The attribute must not be specified if the src
attribute is not present. Якщо
the attribute is set, its value must be an ASCII
чутливі до реєстру match for one of the labels of an encoding
та must specify the same encoding as the charset
parameter of the Content-Type
metadata of the external file, if any. [ENCODING]
The async
and defer
attributes are boolean attributes that indicate how
the script should be executed. The defer
and async
attributes must not be
specified if the src
attribute is not present.
There are three possible modes that can be selected using these
attributes. Якщо the async
attribute is present, then the script will be executed asynchronously, as
soon as it is available. Якщо the async
attribute is not present
but the defer
attribute is present, then the script is executed when the page has
finished parsing. Якщо neither attribute is present, then the script is
fetched and executed immediately, before the user agent continues parsing
the page.
The exact processing details for these attributes are, for
mostly historical reasons, somewhat non-trivial, involving a number of
aspects of HTML. The implementation requirements are therefore by
necessity scattered throughout the specification. The algorithms below (in
this section) describe the core of this processing, but these algorithms
reference and are referenced by the parsing rules for script
start and end tags
in HTML, in foreign content та in
XML, the rules for the document.write()
method, the
handling of scripting, etc.
The defer
attribute may be specified even if the async
attribute is specified, to
cause legacy Web browsers that only support defer
(and not async
) to fall back to the defer
behavior instead of the synchronous blocking behavior that is the default.
The crossorigin
attribute is a CORS settings attribute.
It controls, for scripts що є obtained from other origins, whether error information will be exposed.
Changing the src
,
type
,
charset
,
async
,
defer
та crossorigin
attributes dynamically has no direct effect; these attribute are only used
at specific times described below.
A script
element has
several associated pieces of state.
The first is a flag indicating whether or not the script block has been
"already started". Initially, script
elements must have this
flag unset (script blocks, when created, are not "already started"). The
cloning
steps for script
elements must set the "already started" flag on the copy if it is set on
the element being cloned.
The second is a flag indicating whether the element was "parser-inserted".
Initially, script
elements must have this flag unset. It is set by the HTML
parser and the XML parser on script
elements they insert
and affects the processing of those elements.
The third is a flag indicating whether the element will "force-async".
Initially, script
elements must have this flag set. It is unset by the HTML
parser and the XML parser on script
elements they insert.
In addition, whenever a script
element whose "force-async" flag is set has
a async
content attribute added, the element's "force-async"
flag must be unset.
The fourth is a flag indicating whether or not the script block is "ready to be parser-executed".
Initially, script
elements must have this flag unset (script blocks, when created, are not
"ready to be parser-executed"). This flag is used only for elements що є
also "parser-inserted", to let the
parser know when to execute the script.
The last few pieces of state are the
script block's type, the
script block's character encoding та the
script block's fallback character encoding. They are
determined when the script is prepared, based on the attributes on the
element at that time та the Document
of the script
element.
When a script
element
that is not marked as being "parser-inserted"
experiences one of the events listed in the following list, the user
agent must synchronously prepare
the script
element:
script
element
gets inserted
into a document, at the time the node is inserted according to the
DOM, after any other script
elements inserted at the same time що є earlier in the Document
in tree order.script
element
is in a Document
and a
node or document fragment is inserted into the script
element, after any script
elements inserted at that time.script
element
is in a Document
and has a
src
attribute set where previously the element had no such attribute.To prepare a script, the user agent must act as follows:
Якщо the script
element is marked as having "already
started", then the user agent must abort these steps at this
point. The script is not executed.
Якщо the element has its "parser-inserted" flag set, then set was-parser-inserted to true and unset the element's "parser-inserted" flag. Інакше set was-parser-inserted to false.
This is done so that if parser-inserted script
elements fail to run when the parser tries to run them, e.g. because
they are empty or specify an unsupported scripting language, another
script can later mutate them and cause them to run again.
Якщо was-parser-inserted є true and
the element does not have an async
attribute, then set
the element's "force-async" flag to
true.
This is done so that if a parser-inserted script
element fails to run when the parser tries to run it, but it is
later executed after a script dynamically updates it, it will
execute asynchronously even if the async
attribute isn't set.
Якщо the element has no src
attribute та its child
nodes, if any, consist only of comment nodes and empty Text
nodes, then the user agent must abort these steps at this point. The
script is not executed.
Якщо the element is not in a Document
,
then the user agent must abort these steps at this point. The script
is not executed.
Якщо either:
script
element has a type
attribute and its value is the empty string, orscript
element has no type
attribute but it has a language
attribute and
that attribute's value is the empty string, orscript
element has neither a type
attribute nor a language
attribute, then...let the script
block's type for this script
element be "text/javascript
".
Інакше if the script
element has a type
attribute, let the script
block's type for this script
element be the value of that attribute with any leading or trailing
sequences of space
characters removed.
Інакше the element has a non-empty language
attribute; let
the script block's type
for this script
element be the concatenation of the string "text/
"
followed by the value of the language
attribute.
The language
attribute is
never conforming та is always ignored if there is a type
attribute present.
Якщо the user agent does not support
the scripting language given by the
script block's type for this script
element, then the user agent must abort these steps at this point.
The script is not executed.
Якщо was-parser-inserted є true, then flag the element as "parser-inserted" again та set the element's "force-async" flag to false.
The user agent must set the element's "already started" flag.
The state of the element at this moment is later used to determine the script source.
Якщо the element is flagged as "parser-inserted",
but the element's Document
is
not the Document
of the parser
that created the element, then abort these steps.
Якщо scripting
is disabled for the script
element, then the user agent must abort these steps at this point.
The script is not executed.
The definition of scripting is disabled means that,
amongst others, the following scripts will not execute: scripts in XMLHttpRequest
's responseXML
documents, scripts in DOMРозберітьr
-created documents,
scripts in documents created by XSLTProcessor
's transformToDocument
feature та scripts що є first inserted by a script into a Document
that was created using the
createDocument()
API. [XHR] [DOMPARSING]
[DOM]
Якщо the script
element has an event
attribute and a for
attribute, тоді виконайте ці субкроки:
Нехай for be the value of the for
attribute.
Нехай event be the value of the
event
attribute.
Strip leading and trailing whitespace from event and for.
Якщо for is not an ASCII
чутливі до реєстру match for the string "window
",
then the user agent must abort these steps at this point. The
script is not executed.
Якщо event is not an ASCII
чутливі до реєстру match for either the string "onload
"
or the string "onload()
", then
the user agent must abort these steps at this point. The script
is not executed.
Якщо the script
element has a charset
attribute, then let the
script block's character encoding for this script
element be the result of getting an
encoding from the value of the charset
attribute.
Інакше let the
script block's fallback character encoding for this script
element be the same
as the
encoding of the document itself.
Only one of these two pieces of state is set.
Якщо the element has a src
content attribute,
виконати ці підкроки:
Нехай src be the value of the
element's src
attribute.
Якщо src is the empty string, queue a task to fire
a simple event named error
at the element та abort these steps.
Resolve src relative to the element.
Якщо the previous step failed, queue a
task to fire a simple
event named error
at the element та abort these steps.
Do a potentially
CORS-enabled fetch of the resulting absolute
URL, with the mode being the current state of the
element's crossorigin
content attribute, the origin being
the origin of the script
element's Document
та the
default origin behaviour set to taint.
The resource obtained in this fashion can be either CORS-same-origin or CORS-cross-origin. This only affects how error reporting happens.
For performance reasons, user agents may start fetching the
script (as defined above) as soon as the src
attribute is set,
instead, in the hope that the element will be inserted into the
document (and that the crossorigin
attribute won't change value in the meantime). Either way, once
the element is inserted into the
document, the load must have started as described in this
step. Якщо the UA performs such prefetching, but the element is
never inserted in the document, or the src
attribute is
dynamically changed, or the crossorigin
attribute is dynamically changed, then the user agent will not
execute the script so obtained та the fetching process will have
been effectively wasted.
Then, the first of the following options that describes the situation must be followed:
src
attribute та the
element has a defer
attribute та the element has been flagged as "parser-inserted"
та the element does not have an async
attributeThe element must be added to the end of the list
of scripts that will execute when the document has finished
parsing associated with the Document
of the parser that created the element.
The task that the networking task source places on the task queue once the fetching algorithm has completed must set the element's "ready to be parser-executed" flag. The parser will handle executing the script.
src
attribute та the element has been flagged as "parser-inserted"
та the element does not have an async
attributeThe element is the pending
parsing-blocking script of the Document
of the parser that created the element. (There can only be one
such script per Document
at a time.)
The task that the networking task source places on the task queue once the fetching algorithm has completed must set the element's "ready to be parser-executed" flag. The parser will handle executing the script.
src
attribute та the element has been flagged as "parser-inserted"
та either the parser that created the script
is an XML parser or it's an HTML
parser whose script nesting
level is not greater than one та the Document
of the HTML parser or XML
parser that created the script
element has
a style sheet that is blocking scriptsThe element is the pending
parsing-blocking script of the Document
of the parser that created the element. (There can only be one
such script per Document
at a time.)
Set the element's "ready to be parser-executed" flag. The parser will handle executing the script.
src
attribute, does not
have an async
attribute та does not have the "force-async"
flag setThe element must be added to the end of the list
of scripts that will execute in order as soon as possible
associated with the Document
of the script
element at the time the prepare a
script algorithm started.
The task that the networking task source places on the task queue once the fetching algorithm has completed must run the following steps:
Якщо the element is not now the first element in the list of scripts that will execute in order as soon as possible to which it was added above, then mark the element as ready but abort these steps without executing the script yet.
Execution: Execute the script block corresponding to the first script element in this list of scripts that will execute in order as soon as possible.
Remove the first element from this list of scripts that will execute in order as soon as possible.
Якщо this list of scripts that will execute in order as soon as possible is still not empty and the first entry has already been marked as ready, then jump back to the step labeled execution.
src
attributeThe element must be added to the set
of scripts that will execute as soon as possible of the
Document
of the script
element at the time the prepare a
script algorithm started.
The task that the networking task source places on the task queue once the fetching algorithm has completed must execute the script block and then remove the element from the set of scripts that will execute as soon as possible.
Fetching an external script must delay the load event of the element's document until the task that is queued by the networking task source once the resource has been fetched (defined above) has been run.
The pending parsing-blocking
script of a Document
is
used by the Document
's parser(s).
Якщо a script
element that blocks a parser gets moved to another Document
before it would normally have stopped blocking that parser, it
nonetheless continues blocking that parser until the condition that
causes it to be blocking the parser no longer applies (e.g. if the
script is a pending
parsing-blocking script because there was a
style sheet that is blocking scripts when it was parsed, but then
the script is moved to another Document
before the style sheet loads, the script still blocks the parser until
the style sheets are all loaded, at which time the script executes and
the parser is unblocked).
When the user agent is required to execute a script block, it must run the following steps:
Якщо the element is flagged as "parser-inserted",
but the element's Document
is
not the Document
of the parser
that created the element, then abort these steps.
Jump to the appropriate set of steps from the list below:
Executing the script block must just consist of firing a simple event named error
at the element.
Executing the script block must consist of running the
following steps. For the purposes of these steps, the script is
considered to be from an external file if, while the prepare a script algorithm above
was running for this script, the script
element had a src
attribute specified.
Initialize the script block's source as follows:
The contents of that file, interpreted as a Unicode string, are the script source.
To obtain the Unicode string, the user agent run the following steps:
Якщо the resource's Content Type metadata, if any, specifies a character encoding та the user agent supports that encoding, then let character encoding be that encoding та jump to the bottom step in this series of steps.
Якщо the algorithm above set the script block's character encoding, then let character encoding be that encoding та jump to the bottom step in this series of steps.
Нехай character encoding be the script block's fallback character encoding.
Якщо the specification for the script block's type gives specific rules for decoding files in that format to Unicode, follow them, using character encoding as the character encoding specified by higher-level protocols, if necessary.
Інакше decode the file to Unicode, using character encoding as the fallback encoding.
The decode algorithm overrides character encoding if the file contains a BOM.
The external file is the script source. When it is later executed, it must be interpreted in a manner consistent with the specification defining the language given by the script block's type.
The value of the text
IDL
attribute at the time the element's "already
started" flag was last set is the script source.
The child nodes of the script
element at the time the element's "already
started" flag was last set are the script source.
Fire a simple event
named beforescriptexecute
that bubbles and is cancelable at the script
element.
Якщо the event is canceled, then abort these steps.
Якщо the script is from an external file, then increment
the ignore-destructive-writes
counter of the script
element's Document
.
Нехай neutralized doc be
that Document
.
Create a script, using the script block's
source, the URL from which the
script was obtained, the
script block's type as the scripting language
та the script settings
object of the script
element's Document
's Window
object.
Якщо the script came from a resource that was fetched in the steps above та the resource was CORS-cross-origin, then pass the muted errors flag to the create a script algorithm as well.
This is where the script is compiled and actually executed.
Decrement the ignore-destructive-writes counter of neutralized doc, if it was incremented in the earlier step.
Fire a simple event
named afterscriptexecute
that bubbles (but is not cancelable) at the script
element.
Якщо the script is from an external file, fire
a simple event named load
at the script
element.
Інакше the script is internal; queue
a task to fire a
simple event named load
at the script
element.
The IDL attributes src
,
type
,
charset
,
defer
,
each must reflect the respective content
attributes of the same name.
The crossOrigin
IDL attribute must reflect the crossorigin
content
attribute, limited to only
known values.
The async
IDL attribute controls whether the element will execute asynchronously
or not. Якщо the element's "force-async"
flag is set, then, on getting, the async
IDL attribute must return
true та on setting, the "force-async" flag
must first be unset та then the content attribute must be removed if the
IDL attribute's new value is false та must be set to the empty string if
the IDL attribute's new value є true. Якщо the element's "force-async"
flag is not set, the IDL attribute must reflect
the async
content attribute.
text
[ = value
]Returns the contents of the element, ignoring child nodes що єn't Text
nodes.
Can be set, to replace the element's children with the given value.
The IDL attribute text
must return a concatenation of the contents of all the Text
nodes що є children of the script
element (ignoring any other nodes such as comments or elements), in tree
order. On setting, it must act the same way as the textContent
IDL attribute.
When inserted using the document.write()
method, script
elements execute
(typically synchronously), but when inserted using innerHTML
and outerHTML
attributes, they do not
execute at all.
In this example, two script
elements are used. One embeds an external script та the other includes
some data.
<script src="game-engine.js"></script> <script type="text/x-game-map"> ........U.........e o............A....e .....A.....AAA....e .A..AAA...AAAAA...e </script>
The data in this case might be used by the script to generate the map of a video game. The data doesn't have to be used that way, though; maybe the map data is actually embedded in other parts of the page's markup та the data block here is just used by the site's search engine to help users who are looking for particular features in their game maps.
The following sample shows how a script element can be used to define a
function that is then used by other parts of the document. It also shows
how a script
element can
be used to invoke script while the document is, що буде розібраний, in
this case to initialize the form's output.
<script> function calculate(form) { var price = 52000; if (form.elements.brakes.checked) price += 1000; if (form.elements.radio.checked) price += 2500; if (form.elements.turbo.checked) price += 5000; if (form.elements.sticker.checked) price += 250; form.elements.result.value = price; } </script> <form name="pricecalc" onsubmit="return false" onchange="calculate(this)"> <fieldset> <legend>Work out the price of your car</legend> <p>Base cost: £52000.</p> <p>Select additional options:</p> <ul> <li><label><input type=checkbox name=brakes> Ceramic brakes (£1000)</label></li> <li><label><input type=checkbox name=radio> Satellite radio (£2500)</label></li> <li><label><input type=checkbox name=turbo> Turbo charger (£5000)</label></li> <li><label><input type=checkbox name=sticker> "XZ" sticker (£250)</label></li> </ul> <p>Total: £<output name=result></output></p> </fieldset> <script> calculate(document.forms.pricecalc); </script> </form>
A user agent is said to support the scripting language if each component of the script block's type is an ASCII чутливі до реєстру match for the corresponding component in the MIME type string of a scripting language that the user agent implements.
The following lists the MIME type strings that user agents must recognize та the languages to which they refer:
application/ecmascript
"application/javascript
"application/x-ecmascript
"application/x-javascript
"text/ecmascript
"text/javascript
"text/javascript1.0
"text/javascript1.1
"text/javascript1.2
"text/javascript1.3
"text/javascript1.4
"text/javascript1.5
"text/jscript
"text/livescript
"text/x-ecmascript
"text/x-javascript
"User agents may support other MIME types for other languages, but must not support other MIME types for the languages in the list above. User agents are not required to support the languages listed above.
The following MIME types (with or without parameters) must not be interpreted as scripting languages:
text/plain
" text/xml
"
application/octet-stream
" application/xml
"
These types are explicitly listed here because they are poorly-defined types що є nonetheless likely to be used as formats for data blocks та it would be problematic if they were suddenly to be interpreted as script by a user agent.
When examining types to determine if they represent supported languages, user agents must not ignore MIME parameters. Types are to be compared including all parameters.
For example, types that include the charset
parameter will not be recognized as referencing any of the scripting
languages listed above.
script
elementsThe easiest and safest way to avoid the rather strange
restrictions described in this section is to always escape "<!--
"
as "<\!--
", "<script
"
as "<\script
" та "</script
"
as "<\/script
" when these sequences
appear in literals in scripts (e.g. in strings, regular expressions, or
comments) та to avoid writing code that uses such constructs in
expressions. Doing so avoids the pitfalls that the restrictions in this
section are prone to triggering: namely, that, for historical reasons,
parsing of script
blocks
in HTML is a strange and exotic practice that acts unintuitively in the
face of these sequences.
The textContent
of a script
element must match the script
production
in the following ABNF, the character set for which is Unicode. [ABNF]
script = outer *( comment-open inner comment-close outer ) outer = < any string that doesn't contain a substring that matches not-in-outer > not-in-outer = comment-open inner = < any string that doesn't contain a substring that matches not-in-inner > not-in-inner = comment-close / script-open comment-open = "<!--" comment-close = "-->" script-open = "<" s c r i p t tag-end s = %x0053 ; U+0053 LATIN CAPITAL LETTER S s =/ %x0073 ; U+0073 LATIN SMALL LETTER S c = %x0043 ; U+0043 LATIN CAPITAL LETTER C c =/ %x0063 ; U+0063 LATIN SMALL LETTER C r = %x0052 ; U+0052 LATIN CAPITAL LETTER R r =/ %x0072 ; U+0072 LATIN SMALL LETTER R i = %x0049 ; U+0049 LATIN CAPITAL LETTER I i =/ %x0069 ; U+0069 LATIN SMALL LETTER I p = %x0050 ; U+0050 LATIN CAPITAL LETTER P p =/ %x0070 ; U+0070 LATIN SMALL LETTER P t = %x0054 ; U+0054 LATIN CAPITAL LETTER T t =/ %x0074 ; U+0074 LATIN SMALL LETTER T tag-end = %x0009 ; "tab" (U+0009) tag-end =/ %x000A ; "LF" (U+000A) tag-end =/ %x000C ; "FF" (U+000C) tag-end =/ %x0020 ; U+0020 SPACE tag-end =/ %x002F ; "/" (U+002F) tag-end =/ %x003E ; ">" (U+003E)
When a script
element
contains script
documentation, there are further restrictions on the contents of the
element, as described in the section below.
The following script illustrates this issue. Suppose you have a script that contains a string, as in:
var example = 'Consider this string: <!-- <script>'; console.log(example);
Якщо one were to put this string directly in a script
block, it would violate the restrictions above:
<script> var example = 'Consider this string: <!-- <script>'; console.log(example); </script>
The bigger problem, though та the reason why it would violate those
restrictions, is that actually the script would get parsed weirdly: the
script block above is not terminated. That is, what looks like a
"</script>
" end tag in this
snippet is actually still part of the script
block. The script doesn't execute (since it's not terminated); if it
somehow were to execute, as it might if the markup looked as follows, it
would fail because the script (highlighted here) is not valid
JavaScript:
<script> var example = 'Consider this string: <!-- <script>'; console.log(example); </script> <!-- despite appearances, this is actually part of the script still! --> <script> ... // this is the same script block still... </script>
What is going on here is that for legacy reasons, "<!--
"
and "<script
" strings in script
elements in HTML need to be balanced in order for the parser to consider
closing the block.
By escaping the problematic strings as mentioned at the top of this section, the problem is avoided entirely:
<script> var example = 'Consider this string: <\!-- <\script>'; console.log(example); </script> <!-- this is just a comment between script blocks --> <script> ... // this is a new script block </script>
It is possible for these sequences to naturally occur in script expressions, as in the following examples:
if (x<!--y) { ... } if ( player<script ) { ... }
In such cases the characters cannot be escaped, but the expressions can be rewritten so that the sequences don't occur, as in:
if (x < !--y) { ... } if (!--y > x) { ... } if (!(--y) > x) { ... } if (player < script) { ... } if (script > player) { ... }
Doing this also avoids a different pitfall as well: for related historical reasons, the string "<!--" in JavaScript is actually treated as a line comment start, just like "//".
Якщо a script
element's src
attribute is specified, then the contents of the script
element, if any, must be such that the value of the text
IDL attribute, which is
derived from the element's contents, matches the documentation
production in the following ABNF, the character set for which is Unicode.
[ABNF]
documentation = *( *( space / tab / comment ) [ line-comment ] newline ) comment = slash star *( not-star / star not-slash ) 1*star slash line-comment = slash slash *not-newline ; characters tab = %x0009 ; "tab" (U+0009) newline = %x000A ; "LF" (U+000A) space = %x0020 ; U+0020 SPACE star = %x002A ; "*" (U+002A) slash = %x002F ; "/" (U+002F) not-newline = %x0000-0009 / %x000B-10FFFF ; a Unicode character other than "LF" (U+000A) not-star = %x0000-0029 / %x002B-10FFFF ; a Unicode character other than "*" (U+002A) not-slash = %x0000-002E / %x0030-10FFFF ; a Unicode character other than "/" (U+002F)
This corresponds to putting the contents of the element in JavaScript comments.
This requirement is in addition to the earlier restrictions
on the syntax of contents of script
elements.
This allows authors to include documentation, such as license
information or API information, inside their documents while still
referring to external script files. The syntax is constrained so that
authors don't accidentally include what looks like valid script while
also providing a src
attribute.
<script src="cool-effects.js"> // create new instances using: // var e = new Effect(); // start the effect using .play, stop using .stop: // e.play(); // e.stop(); </script>
script
elements and XSLTЦей розділ не є нормативним.
This specification does not define how XSLT interacts with the script
element. However, in
the absence of another specification actually defining this, here are
some guidelines for implementors, based on existing implementations:
When an XSLT transformation program is triggered by an <?xml-stylesheet?>
processing instruction and the browser implements a direct-to-DOM
transformation, script
elements created by the XSLT processor need to be marked "parser-inserted"
and run in document order (modulo scripts marked defer
or async
), asynchronously
while the transformation is occurring.
The XSLTProcessor.transformToDocument()
method adds elements to a Document
that is not in a browsing context
та, accordingly, any script
elements they create need to have their "already
started" flag set in the prepare
a script algorithm and never get executed (scripting is disabled). Such script
elements still need
to be marked "parser-inserted",
though, such that their async
IDL attribute will
return false in the absence of an async
content attribute.
The XSLTProcessor.transformToFragment()
method needs to create a fragment that is equivalent to one built
manually by creating the elements using document.createElementNS()
.
For instance, it needs to create script
elements що єn't "parser-inserted"
and that don't have their "already
started" flag set, so that they will execute when the fragment
is inserted into a document.
The main distinction between the first two cases and the last case is
that the first two operate on Document
s
and the last operates on a fragment.
noscript
elementhead
element of an
HTML
document, if there are no ancestor noscript
elements.noscript
elements.head
element: in any order, zero or more link
elements, zero or more style
elements та zero or more meta
elements.head
element: transparent, but there must be no noscript
element
descendants.HTMLElement
.The noscript
element represents nothing if scripting is enabled та represents
its children if scripting
is disabled. It is used to present different markup to user agents
that support scripting and those that don't support scripting, by
affecting how the document is parsed.
When used in HTML documents, the allowed content model is as follows:
head
element, if scripting
is disabled for the noscript
elementThe noscript
element must contain only link
,
style
та meta
elements.
head
element, if scripting
is enabled for the noscript
elementThe noscript
element must contain only text, except that invoking the HTML
fragment parsing algorithm
with the noscript
element as the context element and
the text contents as the input must
result in a list of nodes that consists only of link
,
style
та meta
elements that would be conforming if they were children of the noscript
element та no parse errors.
head
elements, if scripting
is disabled for the noscript
elementThe noscript
element's content model is transparent,
with the additional restriction that a noscript
element must not have a noscript
element as an ancestor (that is, noscript
can't be nested).
head
elements, if scripting
is enabled for the noscript
elementThe noscript
element must contain only text, except that the text must be such that
running the following algorithm results in a conforming document with
no noscript
elements
and no script
elements
та such that no step in the algorithm causes an HTML
parser to flag a parse error:
script
element from the document.noscript
element in the document. For every noscript
element in that list, perform the following steps:
noscript
element.noscript
element та call these elements the
before children.noscript
element та call these elements the
after children.Text
node
children of the noscript
element.innerHTML
attribute of the parent element
to the value of s. (This, as a
side-effect, causes the noscript
element to be removed from the document.)All these contortions are required because, for historical
reasons, the noscript
element is handled differently by the HTML parser
based on whether scripting
was enabled or not when the parser was invoked.
The noscript
element
must not be used in XML documents.
The noscript
element is only effective in the HTML syntax, it
has no effect in the XHTML syntax. This
is because the way it works is by essentially "turning off" the parser
when scripts are enabled, so that the contents of the element are treated
as pure text and not as real elements. XML does not define a mechanism by
which to do this.
The noscript
element
has no other requirements. In particular, children of the noscript
element are not exempt from form
submission, scripting та so forth, even when scripting is enabled for the element.
In the following example, a noscript
element is used to provide fallback for a script.
<form action="calcSquare.php"> <p> <label for=x>Number</label>: <input id="x" name="x" type="number"> </p> <script> var x = document.getElementById('x'); var output = document.createElement('p'); output.textContent = 'Type a number; it will be squared right then!'; x.form.appendChild(output); x.form.onsubmit = function () { return false; } x.oninput = function () { var v = x.valueAsNumber; output.textContent = v + ' squared is ' + v * v; }; </script> <noscript> <input type=submit value="Calculate Square"> </noscript> </form>
When script is disabled, a button appears to do the calculation on the server side. When script is enabled, the value is computed on-the-fly instead.
The noscript
element
is a blunt instrument. Sometimes, scripts might be enabled, but for some
reason the page's script might fail. For this reason, it's generally
better to avoid using noscript
та to instead design the script to change the page from being a
scriptless page to a scripted page on the fly, as in the next example:
<form action="calcSquare.php"> <p> <label for=x>Number</label>: <input id="x" name="x" type="number"> </p> <input id="submit" type=submit value="Calculate Square"> <script> var x = document.getElementById('x'); var output = document.createElement('p'); output.textContent = 'Type a number; it will be squared right then!'; x.form.appendChild(output); x.form.onsubmit = function () { return false; } x.oninput = function () { var v = x.valueAsNumber; output.textContent = v + ' squared is ' + v * v; }; var submit = document.getElementById('submit'); submit.parentNode.removeChild(submit); </script> </form>
The above technique is also useful in XHTML, since noscript
is not supported in the XHTML syntax.
template
elementcolgroup
element that doesn't have a span
attribute.ol
and ul
elements.dl
elements.figure
elements.ruby
elements.object
elements.video
and audio
elements.table
elements.colgroup
elements.thead
,
tbody
та tfoot
elements.tr
elements.fieldset
elements.select
elements.interface HTMLTemplateElement : HTMLElement { readonly attribute DocumentFragment content; };
The template
element is
used to declare fragments of HTML that can be cloned and inserted in the
document by script.
Templates provide a method for declaring inert DOM subtrees and manipulating them to instantiate document fragments with identical contents.
When web pages dynamically alter the contents of their documents (e.g. in response to user interaction or new data arriving from the server), it is common that they require fragments of HTML which may require further modification before use, such as the insertion of values appropriate for the usage context.
The template
element allows for the declaration of document fragments which are unused
by the document when loaded, but are parsed as HTML and are available at
runtime for use by the web page.
In a rendering, the template
element represents nothing.
content
Returns the contents of the template
,
which are stored in a DocumentFragment
associated with a different Document
so as to avoid the template
contents interfering with the main Document
.
(For example, this avoids form controls from being submitted, scripts
from executing та so forth.)
Each template
element
has an associated DocumentFragment
object that is its template contents.
When a template
element is created, the user agent must run the following steps to
establish the template contents:
Нехай doc be the template
element's ownerDocument
's
appropriate
template contents owner document.
Create a DocumentFragment
object whose ownerDocument
is doc.
Set the template
element's template contents to the
newly created DocumentFragment
object.
A Document
doc's
appropriate
template contents owner document is the Document
returned by the following algorithm:
Якщо doc is not a Document
created by this algorithm, виконати ці підкроки:
Якщо doc does not yet have an associated inert template document тоді виконайте ці субкроки:
Нехай new doc be a new Document
(that does not have
a browsing context). This
is "a Document
created
by this algorithm" for the purposes of the step above.
Якщо doc is an HTML document, mark new doc as an HTML document also.
Нехай doc's associated inert template document be new doc.
Set doc to doc's associated inert template document.
Each Document
not created by this algorithm thus gets a single Document
to act as its proxy for owning the template
contents of all its template
elements, so that they aren't in a browsing
context and thus remain inert (e.g. scripts do not run).
Meanwhile, template
elements inside Document
objects що є created by this algorithm just reuse the same
Document
owner for their
contents.
Повернутиdoc.
When a template
element changes ownerDocument
,
the user agent must run the following steps:
Нехай doc be the template
element's new ownerDocument
's
appropriate
template contents owner document.
Adopt
the template
element's template contents (a DocumentFragment
object)
into doc.
The content
IDL attribute must return the template
element's template contents.
The cloning
steps for a template
element node being cloned to a copy copy must run the following steps:
Якщо the clone children flag is not set in the calling clone algorithm, abort these steps.
Нехай copied contents be the result
of cloning
all the children of node's template
contents, with ownerDocument
set to copy's template
contents's ownerDocument
та with
the clone children flag set.
Append copied contents to copy's template contents.
In this example, a script populates a table with data from a data
structure, using a template
to provide the element structure instead of manually generating the
structure from markup.
<!DOCTYPE html> <title>Cat data</title> <script> // Data is hard-coded here, but could come from the server var data = [ { name: 'Pillar', color: 'Ticked Tabby', sex: 'Female (neutered)', legs: 3 }, { name: 'Hedral', color: 'Tuxedo', sex: 'Male (neutered)', legs: 4 }, ]; </script> <table> <thead> <tr> <th>Name <th>Color <th>Sex <th>Legs <tbody> <template id="row"> <tr><td><td><td><td> </template> </table> <script> var template = document.querySelector('#row'); for (var i = 0; i < data.length; i += 1) { var cat = data[i]; var clone = template.content.cloneNode(true); var cells = clone.querySelectorAll('td'); cells[0].textContent = cat.name; cells[1].textContent = cat.color; cells[2].textContent = cat.sex; cells[3].textContent = cat.legs; template.parentNode.appendChild(clone); } </script>
template
elements
with XSLT and XPathЦей розділ не є нормативним.
This specification does not define how XSLT and XPath interact with the
template
element.
However, in the absence of another specification actually defining this,
here are some guidelines for implementors, which are intended to be
consistent with other processing described in this specification:
An XSLT processor based on an XML parser that acts as described in this specification needs to
act as if template
elements contain as descendants their template
contents for the purposes of the transform.
An XSLT processor that outputs a DOM needs to ensure that nodes
that would go into a template
element are instead placed into the element's template
contents.
XPath evaluation using the XPath DOM API when applied to a Document
parsed using the HTML
parser or the XML parser described
in this specification needs to ignore template
contents.
canvas
elementwidth
- Horizontal dimensionheight
- Vertical dimensionaria-*
attributes applicable
to the allowed roles.width
height
typedef (CanvasRenderingContext2D or WebGLRenderingContext) RenderingContext;
interface HTMLCanvasElement : HTMLElement {
attribute unsigned long width;
attribute unsigned long height;
RenderingContext? getContext(DOMString contextId, any... arguments);
DOMString toDataURL(optional DOMString type, any... arguments);
void toBlob(FileCallback? _callback, optional DOMString type, any... arguments);
};
The canvas
element
provides scripts with a resolution-dependent bitmap canvas, which can be
used for rendering graphs, game graphics, art, or other visual images on
the fly.
Authors should not use the canvas
element in a document when a more suitable element is available. For
example, it is inappropriate to use a canvas
element to render a page heading: if the desired presentation of the
heading is graphically intense, it should be marked up using appropriate
elements (typically h1
)
and then styled using CSS and supporting technologies such as XBL.
When authors use the canvas
element, they must also provide content that, when presented to the user,
conveys essentially the same function or purpose as the canvas
'
bitmap. This content may be placed as content of the canvas
element. The contents of the canvas
element, if any, are the element's fallback
content.
In interactive visual media, if scripting
is enabled for the canvas
element та if support for canvas
elements has been enabled, the canvas
element represents embedded
content consisting of a dynamically created image, the element's
bitmap.
In non-interactive, static, visual media, if the canvas
element has been previously associated with a rendering context (e.g. if
the page was viewed in an interactive visual medium and is now being
printed, or if some script that ran during the page layout process painted
on the element), then the canvas
element represents embedded
content with the element's current bitmap and size. Інакше the
element represents its fallback content
instead.
In non-visual media та in visual media if scripting is disabled for the canvas
element or if support for canvas
elements has been disabled, the canvas
element represents its fallback
content instead.
When a canvas
element represents embedded
content, the user can still focus descendants of the canvas
element (in the fallback content). When
an element is focused, it is the target of keyboard interaction events
(even though the element itself is not visible). This allows authors to
make an interactive canvas keyboard-accessible: authors should have a
one-to-one mapping of interactive regions to focusable elements in the fallback content. (Focus has no effect on
mouse interaction events.) [DOMEVENTS]
The canvas
element has
two attributes to control the size of the element's bitmap: width
and height
. These attributes,
when specified, must have values що є valid non-negative integers. The rules
for parsing non-negative integers must be used щоб отримати their
numeric values. Якщо an attribute is missing, or if parsing its value
returns an error, then the default value must be used instead.
The width
attribute defaults to 300 та the height
attribute defaults to
150.
The intrinsic dimensions of the canvas
element when it represents embedded
content are equal to the dimensions of the element's bitmap.
A canvas
element can be sized arbitrarily by a style sheet, its bitmap is then
subject to the 'object-fit' CSS property. [CSSIMAGES]
The bitmaps of canvas
elements, as well as some of the bitmaps of rendering contexts, such as
those described in the HTML Canvas 2D Context specification [CANVAS2D],
have an origin-clean
flag, which can be set to true or false. Initially, when the canvas
element is created, its bitmap's origin-clean flag must be set
to true.
A canvas
bitmap can
also have a hit region list, as described in the CanvasRenderingContext2D
section below.
A canvas
element can
have a rendering context bound to it. Initially, it does not have a
bound rendering context. To keep track of whether it has a rendering
context or not та what kind of rendering context it is, a canvas
also has a canvas
context mode, which is initially none but can be changed to either direct-2d,
direct-webgl,
indirect,
or proxied
by algorithms defined in this specification.
When its canvas
context mode is none,
a canvas
element has no
rendering context та its bitmap must be fully transparent black with an
intrinsic width equal to the numeric value of the element's width
attribute and an
intrinsic height equal to the numeric value of the element's height
attribute, those values
being interpreted in CSS pixels та being updated as the attributes are
set, changed, or removed.
When a canvas
element
represents embedded content, it provides
a paint source whose width is the element's intrinsic width, whose
height is the element's intrinsic height та whose appearance is the
element's bitmap.
Whenever the width
and height
content attributes are set, removed, changed, or redundantly set to the
value they already have, if the canvas context mode is direct-2d,
the user agent must set bitmap dimensions
to the numeric values of the width
and height
content attributes.
The width
and height
IDL attributes must reflect the respective
content attributes of the same name, with the same defaults.
The bitmaps used with canvas
elements can have arbitrary pixel densities. Typically, the density will
match that of the user's screen.
getContext
(contextId [, ... ])Returns an object that exposes an API for drawing on the canvas. The
first argument specifies the desired API, either "2d
" or "webgl
". Subsequent
arguments are handled by that API.
The list of defined contexts is given on the WHATWG Wiki CanvasContexts page. [WHATWGWIKI]
Example contexts are the "2d
" [CANVAS2D]
and the "webgl
"
context [WEBGL].
Returns null if the given context ID is not supported or if the
canvas has already been initialized with some other (incompatible)
context type (e.g. trying to get a "2d
" context after getting a "webgl
"
context).
Each rendering context has a context bitmap mode, which is one of fixed, unbound, or bound. Initially, rendering contexts must be in the unbound mode.
The getContext(contextId, arguments...)
method of the canvas
element, when invoked, must run the steps in the cell of the following
table whose column header describes the canvas
element's canvas
context mode and whose row header describes the method's first
argument.
|
none | direct-2d | direct-webgl | indirect | proxied |
---|---|---|---|---|---|
"2d "
|
Set the canvas
element's context
mode to direct-2d,
obtain a CanvasRenderingContext2D object as defined
in the HTML Canvas 2D Context specification [CANVAS2D],
set the obtained CanvasRenderingContext2D object's context
bitmap mode to fixed
та return the CanvasRenderingContext2D object |
Повернути same object as was return the last time the method was invoked with this same argument. | Повернутиnull. | Throw an InvalidStateError
exception. |
Throw an InvalidStateError
exception. |
"webgl ",
if the user agent supports the WebGL feature in its current
configuration |
Follow the instructions given in the WebGL specification's Context
Creation section щоб отримати either a WebGLRenderingContext
or null; if the returned value is null, then return null and abort
these steps, otherwise, set the canvas
element's context
mode to direct-webgl,
set the new WebGLRenderingContext
object's context bitmap mode
to fixed
та return the WebGLRenderingContext
object‡ [WEBGL] |
Повернутиnull. | Повернути same object as was return the last time the method was invoked with this same argument. | Throw an InvalidStateError
exception. |
Throw an InvalidStateError
exception. |
A vendor-specific extension* | Behave as defined for the extension. | Behave as defined for the extension. | Behave as defined for the extension. | Throw an InvalidStateError
exception. |
Throw an InvalidStateError
exception. |
An unsupported value† | Повернутиnull. | Повернутиnull. | Повернутиnull. | Throw an InvalidStateError
exception. |
Throw an InvalidStateError
exception. |
* Vendors may define experimental contexts
using the syntax vendorname-context
, for example, moz-3d
.
† For example, the "webgl
" value in the case
of a user agent having exhausted the graphics hardware's abilities and
having no software fallback implementation.
‡ The second (and subsequent) argument(s) to the method, if any, are ignored in all cases except this one. See the WebGL specification for details.
toDataURL
(
[ type, ... ] )Returns a data:
URL for the image in the
canvas.
The first argument, if provided, controls the type of the image to be
returned (e.g. PNG or JPEG). The default is image/png
;
that type is also used if the given type isn't supported. The other
arguments are specific to the type та control the way that the image
is generated, as given in
the table below.
When trying to use types other than "image/png
", authors
can check if the image was really returned in the requested format by
checking to see if the returned string starts with one of the exact
strings "data:image/png,
" or "data:image/png;
".
Якщо it does, the image is PNG та thus the requested type was not
supported. (The one exception to this is if the canvas hяк або no
height or no width, in which case the result might simply be "data:,
".)
The toDataURL()
method returns the data at a resolution of 96dpi.
toBlob
(callback
[, type, ... ])Creates a Blob
object representing
a file containing the image in the canvas та invokes a callback with a
handle to that object.
The second argument, if provided, controls the type of the image to
be returned (e.g. PNG or JPEG). The default is image/png
;
that type is also used if the given type isn't supported. The other
arguments are specific to the type та control the way that the image
is generated, as given in
the table below.
The toBlob()
method provides the data at a resolution of 96dpi.
The toDataURL()
method must run the following steps:
Якщо the canvas
element's bitmap's origin-clean flag is set
to false, throw a SecurityError
exception and abort these steps.
Якщо the canvas
element's bitmap has no pixels (i.e. either its horizontal dimension
or its vertical dimension is zero) then return the string "data:,
"
and abort these steps. (This is the shortest data:
URL;
it represents the empty string in a text/plain
resource.)
Нехай file be a serialization of
the canvas
element's bitmap as a file, using the
method's arguments (if any) as the arguments.
The toBlob()
method must run the following steps:
Якщо the canvas
element's bitmap's origin-clean flag is set
to false, throw a SecurityError
exception and abort these steps.
Нехай callback be the first argument.
Нехай arguments be the second and subsequent arguments to the method, if any.
Якщо the canvas
element's bitmap has no pixels (i.e. either its horizontal dimension
or its vertical dimension is zero) then let result
be null.
Інакше let result be a Blob
object representing a serialization of
the canvas
element's bitmap as a file, using arguments. [FILEAPI]
Return, but continue running these steps asynchronously.
Якщо callback is null, abort these steps.
Queue a task to invoke the FileCallback
callback with result
as its argument. The task source for
this task is the canvas
blob serialization task source.
The canvas
APIs must
perform color correction at only two points: when rendering images with
their own gamma correction and color space information onto a bitmap, to
convert the image to the color space used by the bitmaps (e.g. using the
2D Context's drawImage()
method with an HTMLImageElement
object) та when rendering the actual canvas bitmap to the output device.
Thus, in the 2D context, colors used to draw shapes onto
the canvas will exactly match colors obtained through the getImageDataHD()
method.
The toDataURL()
method must not include color space information in the resources it
returns. Where the output format allows it, the color of pixels in
resources created by toDataURL()
must match those returned by the getImageData()
method.
In user agents that support CSS, the color space used by a canvas
element must match the color space used for processing any colors for
that element in CSS.
The gamma correction and color space information of images must be
handled in such a way that an image rendered directly using an img
element would use the same
colors as one painted on a canvas
element that is then itself rendered. Furthermore, the rendering of
images that have no color correction information (such as those returned
by the toDataURL()
method) must be rendered with no color correction.
When a user agent is to create a serialization of the bitmap as a file, optionally with some given arguments, it must create an image file in the format given by the first value of arguments, or, if there are no arguments, in the PNG format. [PNG]
Якщо if the bitmap has one pixel per coordinate space unit then the image file must have the same pixel data (before compression, if applicable) as the bitmap та if the file format used supports encoding resolution metadata, the resolution of that bitmap (device pixels per coordinate space units being interpreted as image pixels per CSS pixel) must be given as well.
Інакше the image file's pixel data must be the bitmap's pixel data scaled to one image pixel per coordinate space unit та if the file format used supports encoding resolution metadata, the resolution must be given as 96dpi (one image pixel per CSS pixel).
Якщо arguments is not empty, the first value must be interpreted as a MIME type giving the format to use. Якщо the type has any parameters, it must be treated as not supported.
For example, the value "image/png
" would
mean to generate a PNG image, the value "image/jpeg
" would
mean to generate a JPEG image та the value "image/svg+xml
"
would mean to generate an SVG image (which would require that the user
agent track how the bitmap was generated, an unlikely, though
potentially awesome, feature).
User agents must support PNG ("image/png
"). User agents
may support other types. Якщо the user agent does not support the
requested type, it must create the file using the PNG format. [PNG]
User agents must convert the provided type to ASCII lowercase before establishing if they support that type.
For image types that do not support an alpha channel, the serialized image must be the bitmap image composited onto a solid black background using the source-over operator.
Якщо the first argument in arguments gives a type corresponding to one of the types given in the first column of the following table та the user agent supports that type, then the subsequent arguments, if any, must be treated as described in the second cell of that row.
Type | Other arguments | Reference |
---|---|---|
image/jpeg |
The second argument, if it is a number in the range 0.0 to 1.0 inclusive, must be treated as the desired quality level. Якщо it is not a number or is outside that range, the user agent must use its default value, as if the argument had been omitted. | [JPEG] |
For the purposes of these rules, an argument is considered to be a
number if it is converted to an IDL double value by the rules for
handling arguments of type any
in the
Web IDL specification. [WEBIDL]
Other arguments must be ignored and must not cause the user agent to throw an exception. A future version of this specification will probably define other parameters to be passed to these methods to allow authors to more carefully control compression settings, image metadata, etc.
canvas
elementsЦей розділ не є нормативним.
Information leakage can occur if scripts from one origin can access information (e.g. read pixels) from images from another origin (one that isn't the same).
To mitigate this, bitmaps used with canvas
elements are defined to have a flag indicating whether they are origin-clean. All bitmaps
start with their origin-clean
set to true. The flag is set to false when cross-origin images or fonts
are used.
The toDataURL()
,
toBlob()
,
getImageData()
та getImageDataHD()
methods check the flag and will throw a SecurityError
exception rather than leak cross-origin data.
The flag can be reset in certain situations; for example, when a CanvasRenderingContext2D
is bound to a new canvas
,
the bitmap is cleared and its flag reset.
HTML does not have a dedicated mechanism for marking up subheadings, alternative titles or taglines. Here are the suggested alternatives.
h1
–h6
elements
must not be used to markup subheadings, subtitles, alternative titles and
taglines unless intended to be the heading for a new section or
subsection.
In the following example the title and subtitles of a web page are
grouped using a header
element. As the author does not want the subtitles to be included the
table of contents and they are not intended to signify the start of a
new section, they are marked up using p
elements. A sample CSS styled rendering of the title and subtitles is
provided below the code example.
<header> <h1>HTML 5.1 Nightly</h1> <p>A vocabulary and associated APIs for HTML and XHTML</p> <p>Editor's Draft 9 May 2013</p> </header>
In the following example the subtitle of a book is on the same line as the title separated by a colon. A sample CSS styled rendering of the title and subtitle is provided below the code example.
<h1>The Lord of the Rings: The Two Towers</h1>
In the following example part of an album title is included in a span
element, allowing it to be
styled differently from the rest of the title. A br
element is used to place the album title on a new line. A sample CSS
styled rendering of the heading is provided below the code example.
<h1>Ramones <br> <span>Hey! Ho! Нехай's Go</span> </h1>
In the following example the title and tagline for a news article are
grouped using a header
element. The title is marked up using a h2
element and the tagline is in a p
element. A sample CSS styled rendering of the title and tagline is
provided below the code example.
<header> <h2>3D films set for popularity slide </h2> <p>First drop in 3D box office projected for this year despite hotly tipped summer blockbusters, according to Fitch Ratings report</p> </header>
In this last example the title and taglines for a news magazine are
grouped using a header
element. The title is marked up using a h1
element and the taglines are each in a p
element. A sample CSS styled rendering of the title and taglines is
provided below the code example.
<header> <p>Magazine of the Decade</p> <h1>THE MONTH</h1> <p>The Best of UK and Foreign Media</p> </header>
This specification does not provide a machine-readable way of describing
bread-crumb navigation menus. Authors are encouraged to markup bread-crumb
navigation as a list. The nav
element can be used to mark the list containing links as being a
navigation block.
In the following example, the current page can be reached via the path indicated. The path is indicated using the right arrow symbol "→". A text label is provided to give the user context. The links are structured as a list, which provides users with an indication of item number.
<nav> <h2>You are here:</h2> <ul id="navlist"> <li><a href="/">Main</a> →</li> <li><a href="/products/">Products</a> →</li> <li><a href="/products/dishwashers/">Dishwashers</a> →</li> <li><a>Second hand</a></li> </ul> </nav>
The breadcrumb code example could be styled as a horizonatal list using CSS:
The use of the right angle bracket symbol ">" to indicate path direction is discouraged as its meaning, in the context used, is not clearly conveyed to all users.
This specification does not define any markup specifically
for marking up lists of keywords that apply to a group of pages (also
known as tag clouds). In general, authors are encouraged to either
mark up such lists using ul
elements with explicit inline counts що є then hidden and turned into a
presentational effect using a style sheet, or to use SVG.
Here, three tags are included in a short tag cloud:
<style> @media screen, print, handheld, tv { /* should be ignored by non-visual browsers */ .tag-cloud > li > span { display: none; } .tag-cloud > li { display: inline; } .tag-cloud-1 { font-size: 0.7em; } .tag-cloud-2 { font-size: 0.9em; } .tag-cloud-3 { font-size: 1.1em; } .tag-cloud-4 { font-size: 1.3em; } .tag-cloud-5 { font-size: 1.5em; } } </style> ... <ul class="tag-cloud"> <li class="tag-cloud-4"><a title="28 instances" href="/t/apple">apple</a> <span>(popular)</span> <li class="tag-cloud-2"><a title="6 instances" href="/t/kiwi">kiwi</a> <span>(rare)</span> <li class="tag-cloud-5"><a title="41 instances" href="/t/pear">pear</a> <span>(very popular)</span> </ul>
The actual frequency of each tag is given using the title
attribute. A CSS style sheet is
provided to convert the markup into a cloud of differently-sized words,
but for user agents that do not support CSS or are not visual, the
markup contains annotations like "(popular)" or "(rare)" to categorize
the various tags by frequency, thus enabling all users to benefit from
the information.
The ul
element is used
(rather than ol
) because the
order is not particularly important: while the list is in fact ordered
alphabetically, it would convey the same information if ordered by, say,
the length of the tag.
The tag
rel
-keyword
is not used on these a
elements because they do not represent tags that apply to the page
itself; they are just part of an index listing the tags themselves.
This specification does not define a specific element for marking up conversations, meeting minutes, chat transcripts, dialogues in screenplays, instant message logs та other situations where different players take turns in discourse.
Instead, authors are encouraged to mark up conversations using p
elements and punctuation. Authors
who need to mark the speaker for styling purposes are encouraged to use span
or b
.
Paragraphs with their text wrapped in the i
element can be used for marking up stage directions.
This example demonstrates this using an extract from Abbot and Costello's famous sketch, Who's on first:
<p> Costello: Look, you gotta first baseman? <p> Abbott: Certainly. <p> Costello: Who's playing first? <p> Abbott: That's right. <p> Costello becomes exasperated. <p> Costello: When you pay off the first baseman every month, who gets the money? <p> Abbott: Every dollar of it.
The following extract shows how an IM conversation log could be marked
up, using the data
element
to provide Unix timestamps for each line. Note that the timestamps are
provided in a format that the time
element does not support, so the data
element is used instead (namely, Unix time_t
timestamps). Had the author wished to mark up the data using one of the
date and time formats supported by the time
element, that element could have been used instead of data
.
This could be advantageous as it would allow data analysis tools to
detect the timestamps unambiguously, without coordination with the page
author.
<p> <data value="1319898155">14:22</data> <b>egof</b> I'm not that nerdy, I've only seen 30% of the star trek episodes <p> <data value="1319898192">14:23</data> <b>kaj</b> if you know what percentage of the star trek episodes you have seen, you are inarguably nerdy <p> <data value="1319898200">14:23</data> <b>egof</b> it's unarguably <p> <data value="1319898228">14:23</data> <i>* kaj blinks</i> <p> <data value="1319898260">14:24</data> <b>kaj</b> you are not helping your case
HTML does not have a good way to mark up graphs, so descriptions of
interactive conversations from games are more difficult to mark up. This
example shows one possible convention using dl
elements to list the possible responses at each point in the
conversation. Another option to consider is describing the conversation
in the form of a DOT file та outputting the result as an SVG image to
place in the document. [DOT]
<p> Next, you meet a fisherman. You can say one of several greetings: <dl> <dt> "Hello there!" <dd> <p> He responds with "Hello, how may I help you?"; you can respond with: <dl> <dt> "I would like to buy a fish." <dd> <p> He sells you a fish and the conversation finishes. <dt> "Can I borrow your boat?" <dd> <p> He is surprised and asks "What are you offering in return?". <dl> <dt> "Five gold." (if you have enough) <dt> "Ten gold." (if you have enough) <dt> "Fifteen gold." (if you have enough) <dd> <p> He lends you his boat. The conversation ends. <dt> "A fish." (if you have one) <dt> "A newspaper." (if you have one) <dt> "A pebble." (if you have one) <dd> <p> "No thanks", he replies. Your conversation options at this point are the same as they were after asking to borrow his boat, minus any options you've suggested before. </dl> </dd> </dl> </dd> <dt> "Vote for me in the next election!" <dd> <p> He turns away. The conversation finishes. <dt> "Sir, are you aware that your fish are running away?" <dd> <p> He looks at you skeptically and says "Fish cannot run, sir". <dl> <dt> "You got me!" <dd> <p> The fisherman sighs and the conversation ends. <dt> "Only kidding." <dd> <p> "Good one!" he retorts. Your conversation options at this point are the same as those following "Hello there!" above. <dt> "Oh, then what are they doing?" <dd> <p> He looks at his fish, giving you an opportunity to steal his boat, which you do. The conversation ends. </dl> </dd> </dl>
In some games, conversations are simpler: each character merely has a fixed set of lines that they say. In this example, a game FAQ/walkthrough lists some of the known possible responses for each character:
<section> <h1>Dialogue</h1> <p><small>Some characters repeat their lines in order each time you interact with them, others randomly pick from amongst their lines. Those who respond in order have numbered entries in the lists below.</small> <h2>The Shopkeeper</h2> <ul> <li>How may I help you? <li>Fresh apples! <li>A loaf of bread for madam? </ul> <h2>The pilot</h2> <p>Before the accident: <ul> </li>I'm about to fly out, sorry! </li>Sorry, I'm just waiting for flight clearance and then I'll be off! </ul> <p>After the accident: <ol> <li>I'm about to fly out, sorry! <li>Ok, I'm not leaving right now, my plane is being cleaned. <li>Ok, it's not being cleaned, it needs a minor repair first. <li>Ok, ok, stop bothering me! Truth is, I had a crash. </ol> <h2>Clan Leader</h2> <p>During the first clan meeting: <ul> <li>Hey, have you seen my daughter? I bet she's up to something nefarious again... <li>Nice weather we're having today, eh? <li>The name is Bailey, Jeff Bailey. How can I help you today? <li>A glass of water? Fresh from the well! </ul> <p>After the earthquake: <ol> <li>Everyone is safe in the shelter, we just have to put out the fire! <li>I'll go and tell the fire brigade, you keep hosing it down! </ol> </section>
HTML does not have a dedicated mechanism for marking up footnotes. Here are the suggested alternatives.
For
annotations, the a
element should be used, pointing to an element later in the document. The
convention is that the contents of the link be a number in square
brackets.
In this example, a footnote in the dialogue links to a paragraph below the dialogue. The paragraph then reciprocally links back to the dialogue, allowing the user to return to the location of the footnote.
<p> Announcer: Number 16: The <i>hand</i>. <p> Interviewer: Good evening. I have with me in the studio tonight Mr Norman St John Polevaulter, who for the past few years has been contradicting people. Mr Polevaulter, why <em>do</em> you contradict people? <p> Norman: I don't. <sup><a href="#fn1" id="r1">[1]</a></sup> <p> Interviewer: You told me you did! ... <section> <p id="fn1"><a href="#r1">[1]</a> This is, naturally, a lie, but paradoxically if it were true he could not say so without contradicting the interviewer and thus making it false.</p> </section>
For side notes, longer annotations that apply to entire sections of the
text rather than just specific words or sentences, the aside
element should be used.
In this example, a sidebar is given after a dialogue, giving it some context.
<p> <span class="speaker">Customer</span>: I will not buy this record, it is scratched. <p> <span class="speaker">Shopkeeper</span>: I'm sorry? <p> <span class="speaker">Customer</span>: I will not buy this record, it is scratched. <p> <span class="speaker">Shopkeeper</span>: No no no, this's'a tobacconist's. <aside> <p>In 1970, the British Empire lay in ruins та foreign nationalists frequented the streets — many of them Hungarians (not the streets — the foreign nationals). Sadly, Alexander Yalt has been publishing incompetently-written phrase books. </aside>
For figures or tables, footnotes can be included in the relevant figcaption
or caption
element, or in surrounding prose.
In this example, a
table has cells with footnotes що є given in prose. A figure
element is used to give
a single legend to the combination of the table and its footnotes.
<figure> <figcaption>Table 1. Alternative activities for knights.</figcaption> <table> <tr> <th> Activity <th> Location <th> Cost <tr> <td> Dance <td> Wherever possible <td> £0<sup><a href="#fn1">1</a></sup> <tr> <td> Routines, chorus scenes<sup><a href="#fn2">2</a></sup> <td> Undisclosed <td> Undisclosed <tr> <td> Dining<sup><a href="#fn3">3</a></sup> <td> Camelot <td> Cost of ham, jam та spam<sup><a href="#fn4">4</a></sup> </table> <p id="fn1">1. Assumed.</p> <p id="fn2">2. Footwork impeccable.</p> <p id="fn3">3. Quality described as "well".</p> <p id="fn4">4. A lot.</p> </figure>
An element is said to be actually disabled if it falls into one of the following categories:
button
elements що є disabledinput
elements що є disabledselect
elements що є disabledtextarea
elements що
є disabledoptgroup
elements
that have a disabled
attributeoption
elements що є disabledfieldset
elements
that have a disabled
attributeThis definition is used to determine what elements can be focused and which elements match
the :disabled
pseudo-class.
The Selectors specification leaves the case-sensitivity of IDs, classes, element names, attribute names та attribute values to be defined by the host language. [SELECTORS]
The unique identifier of HTML elements in documents що є in quirks mode must be treated as ASCII чутливі до реєстру for the purposes of selector matching.
Classes from the class
attribute of HTML elements in documents що
є in quirks mode must be treated as ASCII
чутливі до реєстру for the purposes of selector matching.
When comparing a CSS element type selector to the names of HTML elements in HTML documents, the CSS element type selector must first be converted to ASCII lowercase. The same selector when compared to other elements must be compared according to its original case. In both cases, the comparison is case-sensitive.
When comparing the name part of a CSS attribute selector to the names of namespace-less attributes on HTML elements in HTML documents, the name part of the CSS attribute selector must first be converted to ASCII lowercase. The same selector when compared to other attributes must be compared according to its original case. In both cases, the comparison is case-sensitive.
Everything else (attribute values on HTML elements, IDs and classes in no-quirks mode and limited-quirks mode та element names, attribute names та attribute values in XML documents) must be treated as case-sensitive for the purposes of selector matching.
There are a number of dynamic selectors that can be used with HTML. This section defines when these selectors match HTML elements. [SELECTORS]
:link
:visited
All a
elements that have
an href
attribute, all area
elements that have an href
attribute та all link
elements that have an href
attribute, must match one of :link
and :visited
.
Other specifications might apply more specific rules regarding how these elements are to match these pseudo-classes, to mitigate some privacy concerns that apply with straightforward implementations of this requirement.
:active
The :active
pseudo-class is defined to match an element while
an element is being activated by the user
. For the
purposes of defining the :active
pseudo-class only, an
HTML user agent must consider an element as being activated
if it is:
An element falling into one of the following categories between the time the user begins to indicate an intent to trigger the element's activation behavior and either the time the user stops indicating an intent to trigger the element's activation behavior, or the time the element's activation behavior has finished running, which ever comes first:
a
elements that
have an href
attributearea
elements
that have an href
attributelink
elements
that have an href
attributebutton
elements що є not disabledinput
elements
whose type
attribute is in the Submit Button,
Image
Button, Reset
Button, or Button stateFor example, if the user is using a keyboard to
push a button
element by pressing the space bar, the element would match this
pseudo-class in between the time that the element received the keydown
event and the
time the element received the keyup
event.
An element that the user indicates using a pointing device while that pointing device is in the "down" state (e.g. for a mouse, between the time the mouse button is pressed and the time it is depressed).
An element that has a descendant that is currently matching the
:active
pseudo-class.
:hover
The :hover
pseudo-class is defined to match an element while
the user designates an element with a pointing device
.
For the purposes of defining the :hover
pseudo-class only, an
HTML user agent must consider an element as being one that the user
designates if it is:
An element that the user indicates using a pointing device.
An element that has a descendant that the user indicates using a pointing device.
An element that is the labeled
control of a label
element that is currently matching :hover.
Consider in particular a fragment such as:
<p> <label for=c> <input id=a> </label> <span id=b> <input id=c> </span> </p>
Якщо the user designates the element with ID "a
"
with their pointing device, then the p
element (and all its ancestors not shown in the snippet above),
the label
element,
the element with ID "a
" та the
element with ID "c
" will match
the :hover
pseudo-class. The element with ID "a
"
matches it from condition 1, the label
and p
elements match it
because of condition 2 (one of their descendants is designated) та
the element with ID "c
" matches
it through condition 3 (its label
element matches :hover).
However, the element with ID "b
"
does not match :hover:
its descendant is not designated, even though it matches :hover.
:enabled
The :enabled
pseudo-class must match any element falling into one of the
following categories:
a
elements that have
an href
attributearea
elements that
have an href
attributelink
elements that
have an href
attributebutton
elements
що є not disabledinput
elements що
є not disabledselect
elements
що є not disabledtextarea
elements що є not disabledoptgroup
elements that do not have a disabled
attributeoption
elements
що є not disabledfieldset
elements that do not have a disabled
attribute:disabled
The :disabled
pseudo-class must match any element that is actually disabled.
:checked
The :checked
pseudo-class must match any element falling into one of the
following categories:
input
elements
whose type
attribute is in the Checkbox state
and whose checkedness
state є trueinput
elements
whose type
attribute is in the Radio
Button state and whose checkedness state є trueoption
elements
whose selectedness
є true:indeterminate
The :indeterminate
pseudo-class must match any element falling into one of the
following categories:
input
elements
whose type
attribute is in the Checkbox state
and whose indeterminate
IDL attribute is set to trueinput
elements
whose type
attribute is in the Radio
Button state and whose radio
button group contains no input
elements whose checkedness
state є true.progress
elements with no value
content attribute:default
The :default
pseudo-class must match any element falling into one of the
following categories:
button
elements
що є their form's default buttoninput
elements
whose type
attribute is in the Submit Button
or Image
Button state та що є their form's default
buttoninput
elements to
which the checked
attribute applies and that have a checked
attributeoption
elements
that have a selected
attribute:valid
The :valid
pseudo-class must match any element falling into one of the
following categories:
form
elements що є
not the form owner of any elements that
themselves are candidates for
constraint validation but do not satisfy their constraintsfieldset
elements that have no descendant elements that themselves are candidates
for constraint validation but do not satisfy their constraints:invalid
The :invalid
pseudo-class must match any element falling into one of the
following categories:
form
elements що є
the form owner of one or more elements
that themselves are candidates for
constraint validation but do not satisfy their constraintsfieldset
elements that have of one or more descendant elements that
themselves are candidates for
constraint validation but do not satisfy their constraints:in-range
The :in-range
pseudo-class must match all elements що є candidates for
constraint validation, have
range limitations та що є neither suffering
from an underflow nor suffering
from an overflow.
:out-of-range
The :out-of-range
pseudo-class must match all elements що є candidates for
constraint validation, have
range limitations та що є either suffering
from an underflow or suffering
from an overflow.
:required
The :required
pseudo-class must match any element falling into one of the
following categories:
:optional
The :optional
pseudo-class must match any element falling into one of the
following categories:
:read-only
:read-write
The :read-write
pseudo-class must match any element falling into one of the
following categories, which for the purposes of Selectors are thus
considered user-alterable: [SELECTORS]
input
elements to
which the readonly
attribute applies та що є mutable (i.e. that do not
have the readonly
attribute specified and що є not disabled)textarea
elements that do not have a readonly
attribute
та що є not disabledinput
elements nor textarea
elementsThe :read-only
pseudo-class must match all other HTML
elements.
Another section of this specification defines the target
element used with the :target
pseudo-class.
This specification does not define when an element matches
the :focus
or :lang()
dynamic pseudo-classes, as those are all defined in sufficient detail in
a language-agnostic fashion in the Selectors specification. [SELECTORS]
This section describes features that apply most directly to Web browsers. Having said that, except where specified otherwise, the requirements defined in this section do apply to all user agents, whether they are Web browsers or not.
A browsing context is an environment in
which Document
objects are presented
to the user.
A tab or window in a Web browser typically contains a browsing
context, as does an iframe
or frame
s in a frameset
.
Each browsing context has a
corresponding WindowProxy
object.
A browsing context has a session
history, which lists the Document
objects that that browsing context has
presented, is presenting, or will present. At any time, one Document
in each browsing context is designated
the active document. A Document
's
browsing context is that browsing
context whose session history
contains the Document
, if any. (A Document
created using an API such as createDocument()
has no browsing context.)
Each Document
in a browsing
context is associated
with a Window
object. A browsing
context's WindowProxy
object forwards everything to the browsing
context's active document's Window
object.
In general, there is a 1-to-1 mapping from the Window
object to the Document
object. There
are two exceptions. First, a Window
can be reused for the presentation of a second Document
in the same browsing context, such that
the mapping is then 1-to-2. This occurs when a browsing
context is navigated
from the initial about:blank
Document
to another, with replacement
enabled. Second, a Document
can end up being reused for several Window
objects when the document.open()
method is used, such that the mapping is then many-to-1.
A Document
does not
necessarily have a browsing context
associated with it. In particular, data mining tools are likely to never
instantiate browsing contexts.
A browsing context can have a creator browsing context, the browsing context that was responsible for its creation. Якщо a browsing context has a parent browsing context, then that is its creator browsing context. Інакше if the browsing context has an opener browsing context, then that is its creator browsing context. Інакше the browsing context has no creator browsing context.
Якщо a browsing context A
has a creator browsing context,
then the Document
that was the active
document of that creator
browsing context at the time A was
created is the creator Document
.
When a browsing context is first
created, it must be created with a single Document
in its session history, whose address is about:blank
,
which is marked as being an HTML document, whose character encoding is
UTF-8 та which is both ready for
post-load tasks and completely
loaded immediately, along with a new Window
object that the Document
is
associated with. The Document
must
have a single child html
node, which itself has two empty child nodes: a head
element та a body
element.
As soon as this Document
is
created, the user agent must implement
the sandboxing for it. Якщо the browsing
context has a creator Document
,
then the browsing context's Document
's
referrer
must be set to the
address of that creator Document
at the time of the browsing context's
creation.
Якщо the browsing context is created specifically to be immediately navigated, then that initial navigation will have replacement enabled.
The origin and effective
script origin of the about:blank
Document
are set when the Document
is created. Якщо the new browsing
context has a creator
browsing context, then the origin of the
about:blank
Document
is an alias
to the origin of the creator
Document
and the effective
script origin of the about:blank
Document
is initially an alias to the effective
script origin of the creator Document
.
Інакше the origin of the about:blank
Document
is a globally unique
identifier assigned when the new browsing
context is created and the effective
script origin of the about:blank
Document
is initially an alias to its origin.
Certain elements (for example, iframe
elements) can instantiate further browsing contexts. These are called nested browsing contexts. Якщо a
browsing context P has a Document
D with an element E
that nests another browsing context C
inside it, then C is said to be nested through D
та E is said to be the browsing
context container of C. Якщо the browsing context container
element E is in the Document
D, then P
is said to be the parent browsing
context of C and C
is said to be a child browsing context
of P. Інакше the nested
browsing context C has no parent
browsing context.
A browsing context A is said to be an ancestor of a browsing context B if there exists a browsing context A' that is a child browsing context of A and that is itself an ancestor of B, or if the browsing context A is the parent browsing context of B.
A browsing context that is not a nested browsing context has no parent browsing context та is the top-level browsing context of all the browsing contexts for which it is an ancestor browsing context.
The transitive closure of parent browsing contexts for a nested browsing context gives the list of ancestor browsing contexts.
The list of the
descendant browsing contexts of a Document
d is the (ordered) list returned by the
following algorithm:
Нехай list be an empty list.
For each child browsing context
of d that is nested through an
element that is in the Document
d,
in the tree order of the elements nesting
those browsing
contexts, виконати ці підкроки:
Append that child browsing context to the list list.
Append the list of the descendant browsing contexts of the active document of that child browsing context to the list list.
Повернути constructed list.
A Document
is said to be fully
active when it is the active document
of its browsing context та either its
browsing context is a top-level
browsing context, or it has a parent
browsing context and the Document
through
which it is nested
is itself fully active.
Because they are nested through an element, child browsing contexts are always
tied to a specific Document
in their
parent browsing context. User
agents must not allow the user to interact with child browsing contexts of
elements що є in Document
s що є not
themselves fully active.
A nested browsing context can be
put into a delaying load
events mode. This is used when it is navigated, to delay
the load event of the browsing
context container iframe
element before the new Document
is
created.
The document family of a browsing
context consists of the union of all the Document
objects in that browsing context's session
history and the document
families of all those Document
objects. The document family of a Document
object consists of the union of
all the document
families of the browsing
contexts що є nested through the
Document
object.
top
Returns the WindowProxy
for
the top-level browsing context.
parent
Returns the WindowProxy
for
the parent browsing context.
frameElement
Returns the Element
for the browsing context container.
Returns null if there isn't one.
Throws a SecurityError
exception in cross-origin situations.
The top
IDL attribute on the Window
object
of a Document
in a browsing
context b must return the WindowProxy
object of its top-level
browsing context (which would be its own WindowProxy
object if it was a top-level
browsing context itself), if it has one, or its own WindowProxy
object otherwise (e.g. if it was a detached nested
browsing context).
The parent
IDL attribute on the Window
object
of a Document
in a browsing
context b must return the WindowProxy
object of the parent
browsing context, if there is one (i.e. if b
is a child browsing context), or
the WindowProxy
object of the browsing context b
itself, otherwise (i.e. if it is a top-level
browsing context or a detached nested
browsing context).
The frameElement
IDL attribute on the Window
object
of a Document
d,
on getting, must run the following algorithm:
Якщо d is not a Document
in a nested browsing context,
return null and abort these steps.
Якщо the browsing context
container's Document
does not have the same
effective script origin as
the effective script origin
specified by the entry settings
object, then throw a SecurityError
exception and abort these steps.
Повернути browsing context container for b.
It is possible to create new browsing contexts що є related to a top-level browsing context without being nested through an element. Such browsing contexts are called auxiliary browsing contexts. Auxiliary browsing contexts are always top-level browsing contexts.
An auxiliary browsing context has an opener browsing context, which is the browsing context from which the auxiliary browsing context was created.
The opener
IDL attribute on the Window
object, on
getting, must return the WindowProxy
object of the browsing context from which
the current browsing context was created
(its opener browsing context), if
there is one, if it is still available та if the current browsing
context has not disowned its
opener; otherwise, it must return null. On setting, if the new
value is null then the current browsing
context must disown
its opener; if the new value is anything else then the user agent
must
call the [[DefineOwnProperty]]
internal method of the Window
object,
passing the property name "opener
" as the
property key та the Property Descriptor { [[Value]]: value,
[[Writable]]: true, [[Enumerable]]: true, [[Configurable]]: true } as the
property descriptor,
where value
is the new value.
User agents may support secondary browsing contexts, which are browsing contexts that form part of the user agent's interface, apart from the main content area.
A browsing context A is familiar with a second browsing context B if one of the following conditions є true:
A browsing context A is allowed to navigate a second browsing context B if the following algorithm terminates positively:
Якщо A is not the same browsing context as B та A is not one of the ancestor browsing contexts of B та B is not a top-level browsing context та A's active document's active sandboxing flag set has its sandboxed navigation browsing context flag set, then abort these steps negatively.
Інакше if B is a top-level
browsing context та is one of the ancestor browsing contexts
of A та A's
Document
's active
sandboxing flag set has its sandboxed
top-level navigation browsing context flag set, then abort
these steps negatively.
Інакше if B is a top-level
browsing context та is neither A
nor one of the ancestor
browsing contexts of A та A's Document
's
active sandboxing flag set
has its sandboxed
navigation browsing context flag set та A
is not the one
permitted sandboxed navigator of B,
then abort these steps negatively.
Інакше terminate positively!
An element has a browsing
context scope origin if its Document
's
browsing context is a top-level
browsing context or if all of its Document
's
ancestor
browsing contexts all have active documents whose origin
are the same origin as the element's Document
's origin.
Якщо an element has a browsing
context scope origin, then its value is the origin
of the element's Document
.
Each browsing context is defined as having a list of one or more directly reachable browsing contexts. These are:
The transitive closure of all the browsing contexts що є directly reachable browsing contexts forms a unit of related browsing contexts.
Each unit of related
browsing contexts is then further divided into the smallest number
of groups such that every member of each group has an active
document with an effective
script origin that, through appropriate manipulation of the document.domain
attribute, could be made to be the same as other members of the group,
but could not be made the same as members of any other group. Each such
group is a unit
of related similar-origin browsing contexts.
There is also at most one event loop per unit of related similar-origin browsing contexts (though several units of related similar-origin browsing contexts can have a shared event loop).
Browsing contexts can have a browsing context name. By default, a browsing context has no name (its name is not set).
A valid browsing context name is any string with at least one character that does not start with a U+005F LOW LINE character. (Names starting with an underscore are reserved for special keywords.)
A valid browsing
context name or keyword is any string that is either a valid
browsing context name or that is an ASCII
чутливі до реєстру match for one of: _blank
,
_self
, _parent
,
or _top
.
These values have different meanings based on whether the page is
sandboxed or not, as summarized in the following (non-normative) table. In
this table, "current" means the browsing
context that the link or script is in, "parent" means the parent
browsing context of the one the link or script is in, "master" means
the nearest ancestor browsing
context of the one the link or script is in, "top" means the top-level
browsing context of the one the link or script is in, "new" means a
new top-level browsing context
or auxiliary browsing context
is to be created, subject to various user preferences and user agent
policies, "none" means that nothing will happen та "maybe new" means the
same as "new" if the "allow-popups
"
keyword is also specified on the sandbox
attribute (or if the
user overrode the sandboxing) та the same as "none" otherwise.
Keyword | Ordinary effect | Effect in an iframe
with... |
|
---|---|---|---|
sandbox="" |
sandbox="allow-top-navigation" |
||
none specified, for links and form submissions | current | current | current |
empty string | current | current | current |
_blank |
new | maybe new | maybe new |
_self |
current | current | current |
_parent if there isn't a parent |
current | current | current |
_parent if parent is also top |
parent/top | none | parent/top |
_parent if there is one and it's
not top |
parent | none | none |
_top if top is current |
current | current | current |
_top if top is not current |
top | none | top |
name that doesn't exist | new | maybe new | maybe new |
name that exists and is a descendant | specified descendant | specified descendant | specified descendant |
name that exists and is current | current | current | current |
name that exists and is an ancestor that is top | specified ancestor | none | specified ancestor/top |
name that exists and is an ancestor that is not top | specified ancestor | none | none |
other name that exists with common top | specified | none | none |
name that exists with different top, if familiar and one permitted sandboxed navigator | specified | specified | specified |
name that exists with different top, if familiar but not one permitted sandboxed navigator | specified | none | none |
name that exists with different top, not familiar | new | maybe new | maybe new |
Most of the restrictions on sandboxed browsing contexts are applied by other algorithms, e.g. the navigation algorithm, not the rules for choosing a browsing context given a browsing context name given below.
An algorithm is allowed to show a popup if any of the following conditions є true:
The task
in which the algorithm is running is currently processing an activation
behavior whose click
event was trusted.
The task in which the algorithm is running is currently running the event listener for a trusted event whose type is in the following list:
change
click
dblclick
mouseup
reset
submit
The task in which the algorithm is running was queued by an algorithm that was allowed to show a popup та the chain of such algorithms started within a user-agent defined timeframe.
For example, if a user clicked a button, it might be acceptable for a popup to result from that after 4 seconds, but it would likely not be acceptable for a popup to result from that after 4 hours.
The rules for choosing a browsing context given a browsing context name наступні. The rules assume that they are being applied in the context of a browsing context, as part of the execution of a task.
Якщо the given browsing context name is the empty string or _self
, then the chosen browsing context
must be the current one.
Якщо the given browsing context name is _self
,
then this is an explicit self-navigation override.
Якщо the given browsing context name is _parent
,
then the chosen browsing context must be the parent
browsing context of the current one, unless there isn't one,
in which case the chosen browsing context must be the current
browsing context.
Якщо the given browsing context name is _top
,
then the chosen browsing context must be the top-level
browsing context of the current one, if there is one, or else
the current browsing context.
Якщо the given browsing context name is not _blank
and there exists a browsing context whose name is the same as the given
browsing context name та the current browsing context is familiar
with that browsing context та the user agent determines that
the two browsing contexts are related enough that it is ok if they
reach each other, then that browsing context must be the chosen one.
Якщо there are multiple matching browsing contexts, the user agent
should select one in some arbitrary consistent manner, such as the
most recently opened, most recently focused, or more closely
related.
Якщо the browsing context is chosen by this step to be the current browsing context, then this is also an explicit self-navigation override.
Інакше a new browsing context is being requested та what happens depends on the user agent's configuration and abilities — it is determined by the rules given for the first applicable option from the following list:
There is no chosen browsing context. The user agent may inform the user that a popup has been blocked.
Typically, there is no chosen browsing context.
The user agent may offer to create a new top-level browsing context or reuse an existing top-level browsing context. Якщо the user picks one of those options, then the designated browsing context must be the chosen one (the browsing context's name isn't set to the given browsing context name). The default behaviour (if the user agent doesn't offer the option to the user, or if the user declines to allow a browsing context to be used) must be that there must not be a chosen browsing context.
Якщо this case occurs, it means that an author has explicitly sandboxed the document that is trying to open a link.
noreferrer
keywordA new top-level browsing
context must be created. Якщо the given browsing context
name is not _blank
, then the
new top-level browsing context's name must be the given browsing
context name (otherwise, it has no name). The chosen browsing
context must be this new browsing context. The creation of such
a browsing context is a
new start for session storage.
Якщо it is immediately navigated, then the navigation will be done with replacement enabled.
noreferrer
keyword
doesn't applyA new auxiliary browsing
context must be created, with the opener
browsing context being the current one. Якщо the given
browsing context name is not _blank
,
then the new auxiliary browsing context's name must be the given
browsing context name (otherwise, it has no name). The chosen
browsing context must be this new browsing context.
Якщо it is immediately navigated, then the navigation will be done with replacement enabled.
The chosen browsing context is the current browsing context.
There must not be a chosen browsing context.
User agent implementors are encouraged to provide a way for users to configure the user agent to always reuse the current browsing context.
Якщо the current browsing context's active document's active sandboxing flag set has the sandboxed navigation browsing context flag set and the chosen browsing context picked above, if any, is a new browsing context (whether top-level or auxiliary), then all the flags що є set in the current browsing context's active document's active sandboxing flag set when the new browsing context is created must be set in the new browsing context's popup sandboxing flag set та the current browsing context must be set as the new browsing context's one permitted sandboxed navigator.
Window
object[Global] /*sealed*/ interface Window : EventTarget { // the current browsing context [Unforgeable] readonly attribute WindowProxy window; [Replaceable] readonly attribute WindowProxy self; [Unforgeable] readonly attribute Document document; attribute DOMString name; [PutForwards=href, Unforgeable] readonly attribute Location location; readonly attribute History history; [Replaceable] readonly attribute BarProp locationbar; [Replaceable] readonly attribute BarProp menubar; [Replaceable] readonly attribute BarProp personalbar; [Replaceable] readonly attribute BarProp scrollbars; [Replaceable] readonly attribute BarProp statusbar; [Replaceable] readonly attribute BarProp toolbar; attribute DOMString status; void close(); readonly attribute boolean closed; void stop(); void focus(); void blur(); // other browsing contexts [Replaceable] readonly attribute WindowProxy frames; [Replaceable] readonly attribute unsigned long length; [Unforgeable] readonly attribute WindowProxy top; attribute WindowProxy? opener; readonly attribute WindowProxy parent; readonly attribute Element? frameElement; WindowProxy open(optional DOMString url = "about:blank", optional DOMString target = "_blank", optional DOMString features = "", optional boolean replace = false); getter WindowProxy (unsigned long index); getter object (DOMString name); // the user agent readonly attribute Navigator navigator; readonly attribute External external; readonly attribute ApplicationCache applicationCache; // user prompts void alert(optional DOMString message = ""); boolean confirm(optional DOMString message = ""); DOMString? prompt(optional DOMString message = "", optional DOMString default = ""); void print(); }; Window implements GlobalEventHandlers; Window implements WindowEventHandlers;
window
frames
self
These attributes all return window.
document
Returns the Document
associated
with window.
defaultView
Returns the Window
object of the
active document.
The Window
interface must only be exposed
to JavaScript if the JavaScript
global environment is a document
environment.
The window
,
frames
та self
IDL attributes must all return the Window
object's browsing context's WindowProxy
object.
The document
IDL attribute must return the Window
object's
newest Document
object.
The defaultView
IDL attribute of the Document
interface must return the Document
's
browsing context's WindowProxy
object, if there is one, or null otherwise.
For historical reasons, Window
objects must also have a writable, configurable, non-enumerable property
named HTMLDocument
whose
value is the Document
interface
object.
This section describes a security model that is
underdefined, imperfect та does not match implementations. Work is
ongoing to attempt to resolve this, but in the meantime, please do not
rely on this section for precision. Implementors are urged to send their
feedback on how cross-origin cross-global access to Window
and Location
objects should work.
See bug
20701.
User agents must throw a SecurityError
exception whenever any properties of a Window
object are accessed when the incumbent
settings object specifies an effective
script origin that is not the same
as the
Window
object's Document
's effective
script origin, with the following exceptions:
location
attribute postMessage()
method window
attribute frames
attribute self
attribute top
attribute parent
attribute opener
attribute closed
attribute close()
method blur()
method focus()
method When the incumbent settings
object specifies an effective
script origin that is different than a Window
object's Document
's
effective script origin, the user
agent must act as if any changes to that Window
object's properties, getters, setters, etc, were not present та as if
all the properties of that Window
object had their [[Enumerable]] attribute set to false.
For members that return objects (including function objects), each
distinct effective script origin
that is not the same as the Window
object's Document
's effective
script origin must be provided with a separate set of objects.
These objects must have the prototype chain appropriate for the script
for which the objects are created (not those that would be appropriate
for scripts whose global object, as
specified by their settings object, is
the Window
object in question).
open
(
[ url [, target
[, features [, replace
] ] ] ] )Opens a window to show url (defaults
to about:blank
) та returns
it. The target argument gives the name
of the new window. Якщо a window exists with that name already, it is
reused. The replace attribute, if
true, means that whatever page is currently open in that window will
be removed from the window's session history. The features
argument is ignored.
name
[ = value
]Returns the name of the window.
Can be set, to change the name.
close
()Closes the window.
closed
Returns true if the window has been closed, false otherwise.
stop
()Cancels the document load.
The open()
method on Window
objects provides a
mechanism for navigating
an existing browsing context or opening
and navigating an auxiliary
browsing context.
The method has four arguments, though they are all optional.
The first argument, url, must be a valid non-empty URL for a page to load
in the browsing context. Якщо the first argument is the empty string,
then the url argument must be
interpreted as "about:blank
".
Інакше the argument must be resolved
to an absolute URL (or an error), relative
to the API base URL specified by the entry
settings object when the method was invoked.
The second argument, target, specifies the name of the browsing context that is to be navigated. It must be a valid browsing context name or keyword.
The third argument, features, has no defined effect and is mentioned for historical reasons only. User agents may interpret this argument as instructions to set the size and position of the browsing context, but are encouraged to instead ignore the argument entirely.
The fourth argument, replace, specifies whether or not the new page will replace the page currently loaded in the browsing context, when target identifies an existing browsing context (as opposed to leaving the current page in the browsing context's session history).
When the method is invoked, the user agent must first select a browsing context to navigate by applying the rules for choosing a browsing context given a browsing context name using the target argument as the name and the browsing context of the script as the context in which the algorithm is executed, unless the user has indicated a preference, in which case the browsing context to navigate may instead be the one на який вказує the user.
For example, suppose there is a user agent that
supports control-clicking a link to open it in a new tab. Якщо a user
clicks in that user agent on an element whose onclick
handler uses the window.open()
API to open a page in an
iframe, but, while doing so, holds the control key down, the user agent
could override the selection of the target browsing context to instead
target a new tab.
Якщо applying the
rules for choosing a browsing context given a browsing context name
using the target argument would result
in there not being a chosen browsing context, then throw an InvalidAccessError
exception and abort these steps.
Інакше if url is not "about:blank
",
the user agent must navigate
the selected browsing context to the absolute URL obtained from resolving url
earlier, with exceptions enabled.
Якщо the replace є true or if the browsing
context was just created as part of the
rules for choosing a browsing context given a browsing context name,
then replacement
must be enabled also. The navigation must be done with the responsible
browsing context specified by the incumbent
settings object as the source
browsing context. Якщо the resolve a URL
algorithm failed, then the user agent may either instead navigate
to an inline error page, with exceptions
enabled and using the same replacement behavior and source
browsing context behavior as described earlier in this paragraph; or
treat the url as "about:blank
",
acting as described in the next paragraph.
Якщо url is "about:blank
"
та the browsing context was just
created as part of the
rules for choosing a browsing context given a browsing context name,
then the user agent must instead queue a task
to fire a simple event named load
at the selected browsing
context's Window
object, but
with its target
set to the selected browsing context's
Window
object's Document
object (and the currentTarget
set to the Window
object).
The method must return the WindowProxy
object of the browsing context that was
navigated, or null if no browsing context was navigated.
The name
attribute of the Window
object must,
on getting, return the current name of the browsing
context та, on setting, set the name of the browsing
context to the new value.
The name gets reset when the browsing context is navigated to another domain.
The close()
method on Window
objects should, if
all the following conditions are met, close the browsing
context A:
A browsing context is script-closable
if it is an auxiliary browsing
context that was created by a script (as opposed to by an action
of the user), or if it is a browsing
context whose session history
contains only one Document
.
The closed
attribute on Window
objects must
return true if the Window
object's browsing context has been discarded та false
otherwise.
The stop()
method on Window
objects should, if
there is an existing attempt to navigate the browsing context and that attempt is not
currently running the unload a document
algorithm, cancel that navigation;
then, it must abort the active
document of the browsing context
of the Window
object on which it was
invoked.
length
Returns the number of child browsing contexts.
Returns the indicated child browsing context.
The length
IDL attribute on the Window
interface must return the number of child browsing contexts що є nested through elements що
є in the Document
that is the active document of that Window
object, if that Window
's
browsing context shares the same event
loop as the responsible document
specified by the entry settings object
accessing the IDL attribute; otherwise, it must return zero.
The supported property indices
on the Window
object at any instant
are the numbers in the range 0 .. n-1,
where n is the number returned by the length
IDL attribute. Якщо n is zero then there
are no supported property indices.
To determine
the value of an indexed property index
of a Window
object, the user agent
must return the WindowProxy
object of the indexth child
browsing context of the Document
that is nested through an element that is in the Document
, sorted in the
tree order of the elements nesting those browsing contexts.
These properties are the dynamic nested browsing context properties.
Window
objectReturns the indicated element or collection of elements.
The Window
interface supports named properties. The supported property names at any
moment consist of the following, in tree order,
ignoring later duplicates:
name
content
attribute for all a
, applet
, area
,
embed
, form
,
frameset
, img
та object
elements in
the active document that have a
non-empty name
content attribute таid
content attribute of any HTML element in the active
document with a non-empty id
content attribute.To determine the
value of a named property name
when the
Window
object is indexed for property retrieval,
the user agent must return the value obtained using the following steps:
Нехай objects be the list of named objects with the name name in the active document.
There will be at least one such object, by definition.
Якщо objects contains a nested
browsing context, then return the WindowProxy
object of the nested browsing
context corresponding to the first browsing
context container in tree order
whose browsing context is in objects та abort these steps.
Інакше if objects has only one element, return that element and abort these steps.
Otherwise return an HTMLCollection
rooted at the Document
node,
whose filter matches only named objects with the
name name. (By definition, these
will all be elements.)
Named objects with the name name, for the purposes of the above algorithm, are those що є either:
a
, applet
,
area
, embed
,
form
, frameset
,
img
, or object
elements that have a name
content attribute whose value is name,
orid
content attribute whose
value is name.A browsing context has a strong
reference to each of its Document
s
and its WindowProxy
object та
the user agent itself has a strong reference to its top-level browsing contexts.
A Document
has a strong reference
to its Window
object.
A Window
object has a strong reference to its Document
object through its document
attribute. Thus,
references from other scripts to either of those objects will keep both
alive. Similarly, both Document
and Window
objects have implied strong references to the
WindowProxy
object.
Each script has a strong reference to its settings object та each script settings object has strong references to its global object, responsible browsing context та responsible document.
When a browsing context is to discard
a Document
, the user agent must run the following
steps:
Set the Document
's salvageable state
to false.
Run any unloading
document cleanup steps for the Document
що є defined by this specification and other
applicable specifications.
Remove any tasks
associated with the Document
in any task source, without running
those tasks.
Discard
all the child browsing contexts
of the Document
.
Lose the strong reference from the Document
's
browsing context to the Document
.
Whenever a Document
object is discarded, it is also removed from
the list of the worker's Document
s
of each worker whose list contains that Document
.
When a browsing
context is discarded, the strong reference from
the user agent itself to the browsing
context must be severed та all the Document
objects for all the entries in the browsing
context's session history must be discarded as well.
User agents may discard top-level browsing contexts at
any time (typically, in response to user requests, e.g. when a user
force-closes a window containing one or more top-level browsing contexts).
Other browsing
contexts must be discarded once their WindowProxy
object is eligible for garbage collection.
When the user agent is required to close a browsing context, it must run the following steps:
Нехай specified browsing context be the browsing context being closed.
Prompt to unload the active document of the specified browsing context. Якщо the user refused to allow the document to be unloaded, then abort these steps.
Unload the active document of the specified browsing context with the recycle parameter set to false.
Remove the specified browsing context from the user interface (e.g. close or hide its tab in a tabbed browser).
Discard the specified browsing context.
User agents should offer users the ability to arbitrarily close any top-level browsing context.
To allow Web pages to integrate with Web browsers, certain Web browser interface elements are exposed in a limited way to scripts in Web pages.
Each interface element is represented by a BarProp
object:
interface BarProp { attribute boolean visible; };
locationbar
. visible
Returns true if the location bar is visible; otherwise, returns false.
menubar
. visible
Returns true if the menu bar is visible; otherwise, returns false.
personalbar
. visible
Returns true if the personal bar is visible; otherwise, returns false.
scrollbars
. visible
Returns true if the scroll bars are visible; otherwise, returns false.
statusbar
. visible
Returns true if the status bar is visible; otherwise, returns false.
toolbar
. visible
Returns true if the toolbar is visible; otherwise, returns false.
The visible attribute, on getting, must return either true or a value determined by the user agent to most accurately represent the visibility state of the user interface element that the object represents, as described below. On setting, the new value must be discarded.
The following BarProp
objects
exist for each Document
object in
a browsing context. Some of the user
interface elements represented by these objects might have no equivalent
in some user agents; for those user agents, except when otherwise
specified, the object must act as if it was present and visible (i.e.
its visible
attribute must return true).
BarProp
objectBarProp
objectBarProp
objectBarProp
objectBarProp
objectvisible
attribute may
return false).BarProp
objectvisible
attribute may return false).The locationbar
attribute must return the
location bar BarProp
object.
The menubar
attribute must return the menu
bar BarProp
object.
The personalbar
attribute must return the
personal bar BarProp
object.
The scrollbars
attribute must return the
scrollbar BarProp
object.
The statusbar
attribute must return the
status bar BarProp
object.
The toolbar
attribute must return the toolbar
BarProp
object.
For historical reasons, the status
attribute on the Window
object must, on getting, return the
last string it was set to та on setting, must set itself to the new
value. When the Window
object is
created, the attribute must be set to the empty string. It does not do
anything else.
WindowProxy
objectAs mentioned earlier, each browsing
context has a WindowProxy
object. This object is unusual in that all operations that would be
performed on it must be performed on the Window
object of the browsing context's active
document instead. It is thus indistinguishable from that Window
object in every way until the browsing
context is navigated.
There is no WindowProxy
interface object.
The WindowProxy
object allows scripts to act as if each browsing
context had a single Window
object, while still keeping separate Window
objects for each Document
.
In the following example, the variable x
is set to the WindowProxy
object returned by the window
accessor on the global object. All of the expressions following the
assignment return true, because in every respect, the WindowProxy
object acts like the underlying Window
object.
var x = window; x instanceof Window; // true x === this; // true
Origins are the fundamental currency of the Web's security model. Two actors in the Web platform that share an origin are assumed to trust each other and to have the same authority. Actors with differing origins are considered potentially hostile versus each other та are isolated from each other to varying degrees.
For example, if Example Bank's Web site, hosted at bank.example.com
, tries to examine the DOM of
Example Charity's Web site, hosted at charity.example.org
,
a SecurityError
exception will
be raised.
The origin of a resource and the effective script origin of a resource are both either opaque identifiers or tuples consisting of a scheme component, a host component, a port component та optionally extra data.
The extra data could include the certificate of the site when using encrypted connections, to ensure that if the site's secure certificate changes, the origin is considered to change as well.
An origin or effective script origin can be defined as an alias to another origin or effective script origin. The value of the origin or effective script origin is then the value of the origin or effective script origin to which it is an alias.
These characteristics are defined as follows:
The origin and effective script origin of the URL are the origin defined in The Web Origin Concept. [ORIGIN]
Document
objectsDocument
's
active sandboxing flag set
has its sandboxed
origin browsing context flag setThe origin is a globally unique
identifier assigned when the Document
is created.
The effective script origin
is initially an alias
to the origin of the Document
.
Document
was served
over the network and has an address that uses a URL scheme with a
server-based naming authorityThe origin is an alias to the origin
of the Document
's
address.
The effective script origin
is initially an alias
to the origin of the Document
.
Document
was
generated from a data:
URL found in another Document
or in a scriptThe origin is an alias to the origin
specified by the incumbent
settings object when the navigate
algorithm was invoked, or, if no script was involved, of the Document
of the element that
initiated the navigation
to that URL.
The effective script origin
is initially an alias
to the effective script
origin of that same script
settings object or Document
.
Document
is the
initial "about:blank
"
documentThe origin and effective
script origin of the Document
are those it was assigned when
its browsing context was created.
Document
was
created as part of the processing for javascript:
URLsThe origin is an alias to the origin of the active document of the browsing context being navigated when the navigate algorithm was invoked.
The effective script origin
is initially an alias
to the effective script
origin of that same Document
.
Document
is an
iframe
srcdoc
documentThe origin of the Document
is an alias
to the origin of the Document
's
browsing context's browsing
context container's Document
.
The effective script origin
is initially an alias
to the effective script
origin of the Document
's
browsing context's browsing
context container's Document
.
Document
was
obtained in some other manner (e.g. a data:
URL
typed in by the user or that was returned as the location of an
HTTP redirect (or equivalent in other
protocols), a Document
created using the createDocument()
API, etc)The default behavior as defined in the DOM standard applies. [DOM].
The origin is a globally
unique identifier assigned when the Document
is created та the effective
script origin is initially an alias to the origin
of the Document
.
The effective
script origin of a Document
can be manipulated using the document.domain
IDL
attribute.
img
elementsimg
element's
Document
.Images do not have an effective script origin.
audio
and video
elementsDocument
.Media elements do not have an effective script origin.
The origin of a downloadable Web font is an alias to the origin of the absolute URL used щоб отримати the font (after any redirects). [CSSFONTS] [CSSFONTLOAD]
The origin of a locally installed system
font is an alias
to the origin of the Document
in which that font is being used.
Fonts do not have an effective script origin.
Other specifications can override the above definitions by themselves
specifying the origin of a particular URL, Document
,
image, media element, or font.
The Unicode serialization of an origin is the string obtained by applying the following algorithm to the given origin:
Якщо the origin in question is not a
scheme/host/port tuple, then return the literal string "null
"
and abort these steps.
Інакше let result be the scheme part of the origin tuple.
Append the string "://
" to result.
Apply the IDNA ToUnicode algorithm to each component of the host part of the origin tuple та append the results — each component, in the same order, separated by "." (U+002E) characters — to result. [RFC5890]
Якщо the port part of the origin tuple gives a port that is different from the default port for the protocol given by the scheme part of the origin tuple, then append a ":" (U+003A) character and the given port, in base ten, to result.
Повернутиresult.
The ASCII serialization of an origin is the string obtained by applying the following algorithm to the given origin:
Якщо the origin in question is not a
scheme/host/port tuple, then return the literal string "null
"
and abort these steps.
Інакше let result be the scheme part of the origin tuple.
Append the string "://
" to result.
Apply the IDNA ToASCII algorithm to the host part of the origin tuple, with both the AllowUnassigned and UseSTD3ASCIIRules flags set та append the results to result.
Якщо ToASCII fails to convert one of the components of the string, e.g. because it is too long or because it contains invalid characters, then return the empty string and abort these steps. [RFC5890]
Якщо the port part of the origin tuple gives a port that is different from the default port for the protocol given by the scheme part of the origin tuple, then append a ":" (U+003A) character and the given port, in base ten, to result.
Повернутиresult.
Two origins are said to be the same origin if the following algorithm returns true:
Нехай A be the first origin being compared та B be the second origin being compared.
Якщо A and B are both opaque identifiers та their value is equal, then return true.
Інакше if either A or B or both are opaque identifiers, return false.
Якщо A and B have scheme components що є not identical, return false.
Якщо A and B have host components що є not identical, return false.
Якщо A and B have port components що є not identical, return false.
Якщо either A or B have additional data, but that data is not identical for both, return false.
Повернутиtrue.
domain
[ = domain
]Returns the current domain used for security checks.
Can be set to a value that removes subdomains, to change the effective
script origin to allow pages on other subdomains of the same
domain (if they do the same thing) to access each other. (Can't be set
in sandboxed iframe
s.)
The domain
attribute on Document
objects must
be initialized to the document's
domain, if it has one та the empty string otherwise. Якщо the
document's domain starts with a "[" (U+005B) character and ends
with a "]" (U+005D) character, it is an IPv6 address; these square
brackets must be omitted when initializing the attribute's value.
On getting, the attribute must return its current value, unless the Document
has no browsing
context, in which case it must return the empty string.
On setting, the user agent must run the following algorithm:
Якщо the Document
has no browsing context, throw a SecurityError
exception and abort these steps.
Якщо the Document
's active
sandboxing flag set has its sandboxed
document.domain
browsing context flag set, throw a SecurityError
exception and abort these steps.
Якщо the new value is an IPv4 or IPv6 address, let new value be the new value. Інакше apply the IDNA ToASCII algorithm to the new value, with both the AllowUnassigned and UseSTD3ASCIIRules flags set та let new value be the result of the ToASCII algorithm.
Якщо ToASCII fails to convert one of the components of the string,
e.g. because it is too long or because it contains invalid
characters, then throw a SecurityError
exception and abort these steps. [RFC5890]
Якщо new value не є точно equal to
the current value of the document.domain
attribute, тоді виконайте ці субкроки:
Якщо the current value is an IPv4 or IPv6 address, throw a SecurityError
exception and
abort these steps.
Якщо new value, prefixed by a
"." (U+002E), does not exactly match the end of the current
value, throw a SecurityError
exception and abort these steps.
Якщо the new value is an IPv4 or IPv6 address, it cannot match the new value in this way and thus an exception will be thrown here.
Якщо new value matches a suffix
in the Public Suffix List, or, if new
value, prefixed by a "." (U+002E), matches the end of a
suffix in the Public Suffix List, then throw a SecurityError
exception and abort these steps. [PSL]
Suffixes must be compared after applying the IDNA ToASCII algorithm to them, with both the AllowUnassigned and UseSTD3ASCIIRules flags set, in an ASCII чутливі до реєстру manner. [RFC5890]
Release the storage mutex.
Set the attribute's value to new value.
Якщо the effective script
origin of the Document
is an alias,
set it to the value of the effective
script origin (essentially de-aliasing the effective
script origin).
Якщо new value is not the empty string, тоді виконайте ці субкроки:
Set the host part of the effective
script origin tuple of the Document
to new value.
Set the port part of the effective
script origin tuple of the Document
to "manual override" (a value that, for the purposes of comparing origins, is identical to
"manual override" but not identical to any other value).
The domain
of a Document
is the host part of
the document's origin, if the value of that origin is a scheme/host/port tuple. Якщо it
isn't, then the document does not have a domain.
The domain
attribute is used to enable pages on different hosts of a domain to access
each others' DOMs.
Do not use the document.domain
attribute when
using shared hosting. Якщо an untrusted third party is able to host an
HTTP server at the same IP address but on a different port, then the
same-origin protection that normally protects two different sites on the
same host will fail, as the ports are ignored when comparing origins after
the document.domain
attribute has been used.
A sandboxing flag set is a set of zero or more of the following flags, which are used to restrict the abilities that potentially untrusted resources have:
This flag prevents content from navigating browsing contexts other than the sandboxed browsing context itself (or browsing contexts further nested inside it), auxiliary browsing contexts (which are protected by the sandboxed auxiliary navigation browsing context flag defined next) та the top-level browsing context (which is protected by the sandboxed top-level navigation browsing context flag defined below).
Якщо the sandboxed auxiliary navigation browsing context flag is not set, then in certain cases the restrictions nonetheless allow popups (new top-level browsing contexts) to be opened. These browsing contexts always have one permitted sandboxed navigator, set when the browsing context is created, which allows the browsing context that created them to actually navigate them. (Інакше the sandboxed navigation browsing context flag would prevent them from being navigated even if they were opened.)
This flag prevents content from
creating new auxiliary browsing contexts, e.g. using the target
attribute, or the window.open()
method.
This flag prevents content from navigating their top-level browsing context and prevents content from closing their top-level browsing context.
When the sandboxed top-level navigation browsing context flag is not set, content can navigate its top-level browsing context, but other browsing contexts are still protected by the sandboxed navigation browsing context flag and possibly the sandboxed auxiliary navigation browsing context flag.
This flag prevents content from instantiating plugins, whether using the
embed
element, the
object
element, the
applet
element, or through navigation
of a nested browsing context,
unless those plugins
can be secured.
This flag forces content into a unique origin, thus preventing it from accessing other content from the same origin.
This flag also prevents script from
reading from or writing to the document.cookie
IDL attribute та blocks access to localStorage
.
[WEBSTORAGE]
This flag blocks form submission.
This flag disables the Pointer Lock API. [POINTERLOCK]
This flag blocks script execution.
This flag blocks features that trigger automatically, such as automatically playing a video or automatically focusing a form control.
This flag prevents content from using the requestFullscreen()
method.
document.domain
browsing context flagThis flag prevents content from using the document.domain
feature to
change the effective script origin.
When the user agent is to parse a sandboxing directive, given a string input, a sandboxing flag set output та optionally an allow fullscreen flag, it must run the following steps:
Split input on spaces, щоб отримати tokens.
Нехай output be empty.
Add the following flags to output:
The sandboxed
auxiliary navigation browsing context flag, unless tokens
contains the allow-popups
keyword.
The sandboxed
top-level navigation browsing context flag, unless tokens
contains the allow-top-navigation
keyword.
The sandboxed
origin browsing context flag, unless the tokens
contains the allow-same-origin
keyword.
The allow-same-origin
keyword is intended for two cases.
First, it can be used to allow content from the same site to be sandboxed to disable scripting, while still allowing access to the DOM of the sandboxed content.
Second, it can be used to embed content from a third-party site, sandboxed to prevent that site from opening pop-up windows, etc, without preventing the embedded page from communicating back to its originating site, using the database APIs to store data, etc.
The sandboxed
forms browsing context flag, unless tokens
contains the allow-forms
keyword.
The sandboxed
pointer lock browsing context flag, unless tokens
contains the allow-pointer-lock
keyword.
The sandboxed
scripts browsing context flag, unless tokens
contains the allow-scripts
keyword.
The sandboxed
automatic features browsing context flag, unless tokens
contains the allow-scripts
keyword (defined above).
This flag is relaxed by the same keyword as scripts, because when scripts are enabled these features are trivially possible anyway та it would be unfortunate to force authors to use script to do them when sandboxed rather than allowing them to use the declarative features.
The sandboxed fullscreen browsing context flag, unless the allow fullscreen flag was passed to the parse a sandboxing directive flag.
Every top-level browsing context has a popup sandboxing flag set, which is a sandboxing flag set. When a browsing context is created, its popup sandboxing flag set must be empty. It is populated by the rules for choosing a browsing context given a browsing context name.
Every nested browsing context has
an iframe
sandboxing
flag set, which is a sandboxing
flag set. Which flags in a nested
browsing context's iframe
sandboxing flag set are set at any particular time is determined by
the iframe
element's sandbox
attribute.
Every Document
has an active
sandboxing flag set, which is a sandboxing
flag set. When the Document
is
created, its active sandboxing flag
set must be empty. It is populated by the navigation algorithm.
Every resource that is obtained by the navigation algorithm has a forced sandboxing flag set, which is a sandboxing flag set. A resource by default has no flags set in its forced sandboxing flag set, but other specifications can define that certain flags are set.
In particular, the forced sandboxing flag set is used by the Content Security Policy specification. [CSP]
When a user agent is to implement the
sandboxing for a Document
,
it must populate Document
's active
sandboxing flag set with the union of the flags що є present in the
following sandboxing
flag sets at the time the Document
object is created:
Якщо the Document
's browsing
context is a top-level
browsing context, then: the flags set on the browsing
context's popup sandboxing
flag set.
Якщо the Document
's browsing
context is a nested browsing
context, then: the flags set on the browsing
context's iframe
sandboxing flag set.
Якщо the Document
's browsing
context is a nested browsing
context, then: the flags set on the browsing
context's parent browsing
context's active document's active sandboxing flag set.
The flags set on the Document
's
resource's forced sandboxing
flag set, if it has one.
The sequence of Document
s in a browsing context is its session
history. Each browsing context,
including nested browsing contexts, has a
distinct session history. A browsing context's
session history consists of a flat list of session history entries. Each session
history entry consists, at a minimum, of a URL та
each entry may in addition have a state object,
a title, a Document
object, form
data, a scroll position та other information associated with it.
Each entry, when first created, has a Document
.
However, when a Document
is not active, it's
possible for it to be discarded
to free resources. The URL and other data in a session
history entry is then used to bring a new Document
into being to take the place of the original, should the user agent find
itself having to reactivate that Document
.
Titles associated with session history entries need not have
any relation with the current title
of the Document
. The title of a session history entry is intended to
explain the state of the document at that point, so that the user can
navigate the document's history.
URLs without associated state objects are added to the session history as the user (or script) navigates from page to page.
Each Document
object in a browsing
context's session history is
associated with a unique History
object which must all model the same underlying session
history.
The history
attribute of the Window
interface
must return the object implementing the History
interface for that Window
object's newest Document
.
A state object is an object representing a user interface state.
Pages can add state objects to the session history. These are then returned to the script when the user (or script) goes back in the history, thus enabling authors to use the "navigation" metaphor even in one-page applications.
State objects
are intended to be used for two main purposes: first, storing a
preparsed description of the state in the URL so that in
the simple case an author doesn't have to do the parsing (though one
would still need the parsing for handling URLs
passed around by users, so it's only a minor optimization) та second, so
that the author can store state that one wouldn't store in the URL
because it only applies to the current Document
instance and it would have to be reconstructed if a new Document
were opened.
An example of the latter would be something like keeping track of the
precise coordinate from which a pop-up div
was made to animate, so that if the user goes back, it can be made to
animate to the same location. Or alternatively, it could be used to keep
a pointer into a cache of data that would be fetched from the server
based on the information in the URL, so that when going
back and forward, the information doesn't have to be fetched again.
At any point, one of the entries in the session history is the current entry. This is the entry representing the active document of the browsing context. Which entry is the current entry is changed by the algorithms defined in this specification, e.g. during session history traversal.
The current entry is usually
an entry for the address of the Document
. However, it can also be one of
the entries for state
objects added to the history by that document.
An entry with persisted user state is one that also has user-agent defined state. This specification does not specify what kind of state can be stored.
For example, some user agents might want to persist the scroll position, or the values of form controls.
User agents that persist the value of form controls are
encouraged to also persist their directionality (the value of the
element's dir
attribute). This prevents values from being displayed incorrectly after a
history traversal when the user had originally entered the values with an
explicit, non-default directionality.
Entries that consist of state
objects share the same Document
as the entry for the page that was active when they were added.
Contiguous entries that differ just by fragment identifier also share the
same Document
.
All entries that share the same Document
(and що є therefore merely different states of one particular document)
are contiguous by definition.
Each Document
in a browsing
context can also have a latest entry.
This is the entry or that Document
that was most the recently traversed to. When a Document
is created, it initially has no latest entry.
User agents may discard
the Document
objects of entries
other than the current entry що є not
referenced from any script, reloading the pages afresh when the user or
script navigates back to such pages. This specification does not specify
when user agents should discard Document
objects and when they should cache them.
Entries that have had their Document
objects discarded must, for the purposes of the algorithms given below,
act as if they had not. When the user or script navigates back or
forwards to a page which has no in-memory DOM objects, any other entries
that shared the same Document
object with it must share the new object as well.
History
interfaceinterface History { readonly attribute long length; readonly attribute any state; void go(optional long delta); void back(); void forward(); void pushState(any data, DOMString title, optional DOMString? url = null); void replaceState(any data, DOMString title, optional DOMString? url = null); };
history
. length
Returns the number of entries in the joint session history.
history
. state
Returns the current state object.
history
. go
( [ delta
] )Goes back or forward the specified number of steps in the joint session history.
A zero delta will reload the current page.
Якщо the delta is out of range, does nothing.
history
. back
()Goes back one step in the joint session history.
Якщо there is no previous page, does nothing.
history
. forward
()Goes forward one step in the joint session history.
Якщо there is no next page, does nothing.
history
. pushState
(data,
title [, url
] )Pushes the given data onto the session history, with the given title та, if provided and not null, the given URL.
history
. replaceState
(data,
title [, url
] )Updates the current entry in the session history to have the given data, title та, if provided and not null, URL.
The joint session history of a top-level browsing context is the
union of all the session
histories of all browsing contexts of all the fully
active Document
objects that
share that top-level browsing
context, with all the entries що є current entries in their respective session histories removed except for the
current entry of the
joint session history.
The current entry of the joint session history is the entry that most recently became a current entry in its session history.
Entries in the joint session history are ordered chronologically by the time they were added to their respective session histories. Each entry has an index; the earliest entry has index 0 та the subsequent entries are numbered with consecutively increasing integers (1, 2, 3, etc).
Since each Document
in
a browsing context might have a different
event loop, the actual state of the joint
session history can be someone nebulous. For example, two sibling iframe
elements could both traverse from one unique origin to
another at the same time, so their precise order might not be
well-defined; similarly, since they might only find out about each other
later, they might disagree about the length of the joint
session history.
All the getters та встановитиters for attributes та all the methods,
defined on the History
interface,
when invoked on a History
object
associated with a Document
that is
not fully active, must throw a SecurityError
exception instead of operating as described below.
The length
attribute of the History
interface must return the number of entries in the top-level
browsing context's joint session
history.
The actual entries are not accessible from script.
The state
attribute of the History
interface must return the last value it was set to by the user agent.
Initially, its value must be null.
When the go(delta)
method is invoked,
if the argument to the method was omitted or has the value zero, the
user agent must act as if the location.reload()
method was
called instead. Інакше the user agent must traverse
the history by a delta whose value is the value of the method's
argument.
When the back()
method is invoked, the user agent must traverse
the history by a delta −1.
When the forward()
method
is invoked, the user agent must traverse
the history by a delta +1.
Each top-level browsing context has a session history traversal queue, initially empty, to which tasks can be added.
Each top-level browsing context, when created, must asynchronously begin running the following algorithm, known as the session history event loop for that top-level browsing context:
Wait until this top-level browsing context's session history traversal queue is not empty.
Pull the first task from this top-level browsing context's session history traversal queue та execute it.
Повернутиto the first step of this algorithm.
The session history event loop helps coordinate cross-browsing-context transitions of the joint session history: since each browsing context might, at any particular time, have a different event loop (this can happen if the user agent has more than one event loop per unit of related browsing contexts), transitions would otherwise have to involve cross-event-loop synchronisation.
To traverse the history by a delta delta, the user agent must append a task to this top-level browsing context's session history traversal queue, the task consisting of running the following steps:
Нехай delta be the argument to the method.
Якщо the index of the current entry of the joint session history plus delta is less than zero or greater than or equal to the number of items in the joint session history, then abort these steps.
Нехай specified entry be the entry in the joint session history whose index is the sum of delta and the index of the current entry of the joint session history.
Нехай specified browsing context be the browsing context of the specified entry.
Якщо the specified browsing context's active document's unload a document algorithm is currently running, abort these steps.
Queue a task that consists of running the following substeps. The relevant event loop is that of the specified browsing context's active document. The task source for the queued task is the history traversal task source.
Якщо there is an ongoing attempt to navigate specified
browsing context that has not yet matured (i.e. it has not
passed the point of making its Document
the active document), then
cancel that attempt to navigate the browsing
context.
Якщо the specified browsing context's
active document is not the same Document
as the Document
of the specified entry, тоді
виконайте ці субкроки:
Prompt to unload the active document of the specified browsing context. Якщо the user refused to allow the document to be unloaded, then abort these steps.
Unload the active document of the specified browsing context with the recycle parameter set to false.
Traverse the history of the specified browsing context to the specified entry.
When the user navigates through a browsing context, e.g. using a browser's back and forward buttons, the user agent must traverse the history by a delta equivalent to the action specified by the user.
The pushState(data, title,
url)
method adds a state
object entry to the history.
The replaceState(data, title,
url)
method updates the
state object, title та optionally the URL of the current
entry in the history.
When either of these methods is invoked, the user agent must run the following steps:
Нехай cloned data be a structured clone of the specified data. Якщо this throws an exception, then rethrow that exception and abort these steps.
Якщо the third argument is not null, виконати ці підкроки:
SecurityError
exception and abort these steps.SecurityError
exception and abort these steps.SecurityError
exception and abort these steps. (This prevents sandboxed content
from spoofing other pages on the same origin.)Нехай new URL be the resulting absolute URL.
For the purposes of the comparisons in the above substeps, the path and query components can only be the same if the scheme component of both parsed URLs are relative schemes.
Якщо the third argument is null, then let new URL be the URL of the current entry.
Якщо the method invoked was the pushState()
method:
Remove all the entries in the browsing context's session history after the current entry. Якщо the current entry is the last entry in the session history, then no entries are removed.
This doesn't necessarily have to affect the user agent's user interface.
Remove any tasks
queued by the history
traversal task source що є associated with any Document
objects in the top-level
browsing context's document
family.
Якщо appropriate, update the current entry to reflect any state that the user agent wishes to persist. The entry is then said to be an entry with persisted user state.
Add a state object entry to the session history, after the current entry, with cloned data as the state object, the given title as the title та new URL as the URL of the entry.
Update the current entry to be this newly added entry.
Інакше if the method invoked was the replaceState()
method:
Update the current entry in the session history so that cloned data is the entry's new state object, the given title is the new title та new URL is the entry's new URL.
Якщо the current entry in the session history represents a non-GET request (e.g. it was the result of a POST submission) then update it to instead represent a GET request (or equivalent).
Set the document's address to new URL.
Since this is neither a navigation of the browsing
context nor a history
traversal, it does not cause a hashchange
event to be
fired.
Set history.state
to a structured clone of cloned
data.
Нехай the latest entry of the Document
of the current
entry be the current entry.
The title is purely advisory. User agents might use the title in the user interface.
User agents may limit the number of state objects added to the session
history per page. Якщо a page hits the UA-defined limit, user agents
must remove the entry immediately after the first entry for that Document
object in the session history
after having added the new entry. (Thus the state history acts as a FIFO
buffer for eviction, but as a LIFO buffer for navigation.)
Consider a game where the user can navigate along a line, such that the user is always at some coordinate та such that the user can bookmark the page corresponding to a particular coordinate, to return to it later.
A static page implementing the x=5 position in such a game could look like the following:
<!DOCTYPE HTML> <!-- this is http://example.com/line?x=5 --> <title>Line Game - 5</title> <p>You are at coordinate 5 on the line.</p> <p> <a href="?x=6">Просуньте to 6</a> or <a href="?x=4">retreat to 4</a>? </p>
The problem with such a system is that each time the user clicks, the whole page has to be reloaded. Here instead is another way of doing it, using script:
<!DOCTYPE HTML> <!-- this starts off as http://example.com/line?x=5 --> <title>Line Game - 5</title> <p>You are at coordinate <span id="coord">5</span> on the line.</p> <p> <a href="?x=6" onclick="go(1); return false;">Просуньте to 6</a> or <a href="?x=4" onclick="go(-1); return false;">retreat to 4</a>? </p> <script> var currentPage = 5; // prefilled by server function go(d) { setupPage(currentPage + d); history.pushState(currentPage, document.title, '?x=' + currentPage); } onpopstate = function(event) { setupPage(event.state); } function setupPage(page) { currentPage = page; document.title = 'Line Game - ' + currentPage; document.getElementById('coord').textContent = currentPage; document.links[0].href = '?x=' + (currentPage+1); document.links[0].textContent = 'Просуньте to ' + (currentPage+1); document.links[1].href = '?x=' + (currentPage-1); document.links[1].textContent = 'retreat to ' + (currentPage-1); } </script>
In systems without script, this still works like the previous example. However, users that do have script support can now navigate much faster, since there is no network access for the same experience. Furthermore, contrary to the experience the user would have with just a naïve script-based approach, bookmarking and navigating the session history still work.
In the example above, the data argument
to the pushState()
method is the same information as would be sent to the server, but in a
more convenient form, so that the script doesn't have to parse the URL
each time the user navigates.
Applications might not use the same title for a session
history entry as the value of the document's title
element at that time. For example, here is a simple page that shows a
block in the title
element. Clearly, when navigating backwards to a previous state the user
does not go back in time та therefore it would be inappropriate to put
the time in the session history title.
<!DOCTYPE HTML> <TITLE>Line</TITLE> <SCRIPT> setInterval(function () { document.title = 'Line - ' + new Date(); }, 1000); var i = 1; function inc() { set(i+1); history.pushState(i, 'Line - ' + i); } function set(newI) { i = newI; document.forms.F.I.value = newI; } </SCRIPT> <BODY ONPOPSTATE="set(event.state)"> <FORM NAME=F> State: <OUTPUT NAME=I>1</OUTPUT> <INPUT VALUE="Increment" TYPE=BUTTON ONCLICK="inc()"> </FORM>
Location
interfaceEach Document
object in a browsing
context's session history is associated with a unique instance of a
Location
object.
location
[ = value
]location
[ = value
]Returns a Location
object with
the current page's location.
Can be set, to navigate to another page.
The location
attribute of the Document
interface must return the Location
object for that Document
object,
if it is in a browsing context та null
otherwise.
The location
attribute of the Window
interface
must return the Location
object
for that Window
object's Document
.
Location
objects provide a
representation of the address of the active
document of their Document
's browsing context та allow the current
entry of the browsing context's
session history to be changed, by adding or replacing entries in the history
object.
[Unforgeable] interface Location { void assign(DOMString url); void replace(DOMString url); void reload(); }; Location implements URLUtils;
assign
(url)Navigates to the given page.
replace
(url)Removes the current page from the session history and navigates to the given page.
reload
()Reloads the current page.
The relevant Document
is
the Location
object's associated Document
object's browsing
context's active document.
When the assign(url)
method is invoked, the
UA must resolve
the argument, relative to the API base URL
specified by the entry settings object
та if that is successful, must navigate
the browsing context to the specified url, with exceptions
enabled. Якщо the browsing context's
session history contains only one Document
та that was the about:blank
Document
created when the browsing
context was created, then the navigation must be done with replacement
enabled.
When the replace(url)
method is invoked, the
UA must resolve
the argument, relative to the API base URL
specified by the entry settings object
та if that is successful, navigate
the browsing context to the specified url with replacement
enabled and exceptions enabled.
Navigation for the assign()
and replace()
methods must be done with the responsible
browsing context specified by the incumbent
settings object as the source
browsing context.
Якщо the resolving
step of the assign()
and replace()
methods is not successful, then the user agent must instead throw a SyntaxError
exception.
When the reload()
method is invoked, the user agent must run the appropriate steps from
the following list:
resize
event in response to the user resizing the browsing
contextRepaint the browsing context and abort these steps.
iframe
srcdoc
documentReprocess
the iframe
attributes of the browsing
context's browsing
context container.
Perform an overridden reload, with the browsing context being navigated as the responsible browsing context.
Navigate the browsing context to the document's address with replacement enabled and exceptions enabled. The source browsing context must be the browsing context being navigated.
When a user requests that the active
document of a browsing context be
reloaded through a user interface element, the user agent should navigate the browsing context to the
same resource as that Document
,
with replacement enabled. In the
case of non-idempotent methods (e.g. HTTP POST), the user agent should
prompt the user to confirm the operation first, since otherwise
transactions (e.g. purchases or database modifications) could be
repeated. User agents may allow the user to explicitly override any
caches when reloading. Якщо browsing
context's active document's reload
override flag is set, then the user agent may instead perform an overridden reload rather than the
navigation described in this paragraph (with the browsing
context being reloaded as the source
browsing context).
The Location
interface also
supports the URLUtils
interface. [URL]
When the object is created та whenever the the address of the relevant Document
changes, the user agent
must invoke the object's URLUtils
interface's set
the input algorithm with the address of the relevant Document
as the given value.
The object's URLUtils
interface's
get
the base algorithm must return the API
base URL specified by the entry
settings object, if there is one, or null otherwise.
The object's URLUtils
interface's
query
encoding is the document's
character encoding.
When the object's URLUtils
interface invokes its update
steps with the string value, the
user agent must run the following steps:
Якщо any of the following conditions are met, let mode be normal navigation; otherwise, let it be replace navigation:
Location
object's relevant
Document
has completely
loaded, orclick
event was trusted, orclick
event is being handled.Якщо mode is normal navigation,
then act as if the assign()
method had been
called with value as its argument.
Інакше act as if the replace()
method had
been called with value as its
argument.
This section describes a security model that is
underdefined, imperfect та does not match implementations. Work is
ongoing to attempt to resolve this, but in the meantime, please do not
rely on this section for precision. Implementors are urged to send their
feedback on how cross-origin cross-global access to Window
and Location
objects should work.
See bug
20701.
User agents must throw a SecurityError
exception whenever any properties of a Location
object are accessed when the entry
settings object specifies an effective
script origin that is not the same
as the Location
object's
associated Document
's browsing
context's active document's effective
script origin, with the following exceptions:
href
setter, if the responsible
browsing context specified by the entry
settings object is familiar with
the browsing context with which the Location
object is associated
replace()
method, if the responsible
browsing context specified by the entry
settings object is familiar with
the browsing context with which the Location
object is associated
Location
object or indirectly via one of those properties (e.g. toString()
,
which is defined via the stringifier
keyword), if the effective script
origin specified by the entry
settings object is the same origin
as the Location
object's
associated Document
's effective
script origin When the effective script origin
specified by the entry settings object
is different than a Location
object's associated Document
's effective script origin, the user
agent must act as if any changes to that Location
object's properties, getters, setters, etc, were not present та as if
all the properties of that Location
object had their [[Enumerable]] attribute set to false.
For members that return objects (including function objects), each
distinct effective script origin
that is not the same origin as the Location
object's Document
's
effective script origin must be
provided with a separate set of objects. These objects must have the
prototype chain appropriate for the script for which the objects are
created (not those that would be appropriate for scripts whose settings
object specifies a global object
that is the Location
object's Document
's Window
object).
Цей розділ не є нормативним.
The History
interface is not
meant to place restrictions on how implementations represent the session
history to the user.
For example, session history could be implemented in a tree-like
manner, with each page having multiple "forward" pages. This
specification doesn't define how the linear list of pages in the history
object are derived from the actual session history as seen from the
user's perspective.
Similarly, a page containing two iframe
s
has a history
object distinct from the iframe
s'
history
objects, despite the fact that typical Web browsers present the user
with just one "Back" button, with a session history that interleaves the
navigation of the two inner frames and the outer page.
Security: It is suggested that to avoid letting a page
"hijack" the history navigation facilities of a UA by abusing pushState()
, the UA provide
the user with a way to jump back to the previous page (rather than just
going back to the previous state). For example, the back button could
have a drop down showing just the pages in the session history та not
showing any of the states. Similarly, an aural browser could have two
"back" commands, one that goes back to the previous state та one that
jumps straight back to the previous page.
In addition, a user agent could ignore calls to pushState()
що є invoked on
a timer, or from event listeners що є not triggered in response to a
clear user action, or що є invoked in rapid succession.
Features described in this section can at times prove difficult to test in order to assess interoperability. As a result, at present, their test coverage is less than much of the other features with all the stability implications this may have.
Certain actions cause the browsing context to navigate to a new resource. A user agent may provide various ways for the user to explicitly cause a browsing context to navigate, in addition to those defined in this specification.
For example, following a hyperlink, form submission та the window.open()
and location.assign()
methods can
all cause a browsing context to navigate.
A resource has a URL, but that might not be the
only information necessary to identify it. For example, a form
submission that uses HTTP POST would also have the HTTP method and
payload. Similarly, an iframe
srcdoc
document
needs to know the data it is to use.
Navigation always involves source browsing context, which is the browsing context which was responsible for starting the navigation.
When a browsing context is navigated to a new resource, the user agent must run the following steps:
Release the storage mutex.
Якщо the source browsing context is not allowed to navigate the browsing context being navigated, then abort these steps.
Якщо these steps are aborted here, the user agent may instead offer to open the new resource in a new top-level browsing context or in the top-level browsing context of the source browsing context, at the user's option, in which case the user agent must navigate that designated top-level browsing context to the new resource as if the user had requested it independently.
Doing so, however, can be dangerous, as it means that the user is overriding the author's explicit request to sandbox the content.
Якщо the navigate algorithm was invoked
with exceptions enabled та it is
aborted on this step, then in addition to aborting this algorithm,
the user agent must also throw a SecurityError
exception.
Якщо there is a preexisting attempt to navigate the browsing context та the source browsing context is the same as the browsing context being navigated та that attempt is currently running the unload a document algorithm та the origin of the URL of the resource being loaded in that navigation is not the same origin as the origin of the URL of the resource being loaded in this navigation, then abort these steps without affecting the preexisting attempt to navigate the browsing context.
Якщо a task queued by the traverse the history by a delta algorithm is running the unload a document algorithm for the active document of the browsing context being navigated, then abort these steps without affecting the unload a document algorithm or the aforementioned history traversal task.
Якщо the prompt to unload a document algorithm is being run for the active document of the browsing context being navigated, then abort these steps without affecting the prompt to unload a document algorithm.
Нехай gone async be false.
The handle redirects step later in this algorithm can in certain cases jump back to the step labeled fragment identifiers. Since, between those two steps, this algorithm goes from operating synchronously in the context of the calling task to operating asynchronously independent of the event loop, some of the intervening steps need to be able to handle both being synchronous and being asynchronous. The gone async flag is thus used to make these steps aware of which mode they are operating in.
Якщо gone async is false, cancel
any preexisting but not yet mature attempt to navigate the
browsing context, including
canceling any instances of the fetch algorithm
started by those attempts. Якщо one of those attempts has already created a new Document
object, abort that Document
also. (Navigation attempts that have matured already have session
history entries та are therefore handled during the update
the session history with the new page algorithm, later.)
Якщо the new resource is to be handled using a mechanism that does not affect the browsing context, e.g. ignoring the navigation request altogether because the specified scheme is not one of the supported protocols, then abort these steps and proceed with that mechanism instead.
Якщо gone async is false, prompt to unload the Document
object. Якщо the user refused
to allow the document to be unloaded, then abort these steps.
Якщо this instance of the navigation algorithm gets canceled while this step is running, the prompt to unload a document algorithm must nonetheless be run to completion.
Якщо gone async is false, abort the active document of the browsing context.
Якщо the new resource is to be handled by displaying some sort of inline content, e.g. an error message because the specified scheme is not one of the supported protocols, or an inline prompt to allow the user to select a registered handler for the given scheme, then display the inline content and abort these steps.
In the case of a registered handler being used, the algorithm will be reinvoked with a new URL to handle the request.
Якщо the browsing context being
navigated is a nested browsing
context, then put it in the delaying
load
events mode.
The user agent must take this nested
browsing context out of the delaying
load
events mode
when this navigation
algorithm later matures,
or when it terminates (whether due to having run all the steps, or
being canceled, or being aborted), whichever happens first.
This is the step that attempts щоб отримати the resource, if necessary. Jump to the first appropriate substep:
object
element's new child browsing
context)Skip this step. The data is already available.
javascript
Queue a task to run these "javascript:
URL" steps, associated with the active
document of the browsing
context being navigated:
Якщо the origin of the source browsing context is not the same origin as the origin of the active document of the browsing context being navigated, then act as if the result of evaluating the script was the void value та jump to the step labeled process results below.
Apply the URL parser to the URL being navigated.
Нехай parsed URL be the result of the URL parser.
Нехай script source be the empty string.
Append parsed URL's scheme data component to script source.
Якщо parsed URL's query component is not null, then first append a "?" (U+003F) character to script source та then append parsed URL's query component to script source.
Якщо parsed URL's fragment component is not null, then first append a "#" (U+0023) character to script source та then append parsed URL's fragment component to script source.
Replace script source with the result of applying the percent decode algorithm to script source.
Replace script source with the result of applying the UTF-8 decode algorithm to script source.
Нехай address be the address of the active document of the browsing context being navigated.
Create a script, using script source as the script
source, address as the
script source URL, JavaScript as the scripting language та
the script settings
object of the Window
object of the active document
of the browsing context
being navigated.
Нехай result be the return value of the code entry-point of this script. Якщо an exception was thrown, let result be void instead. (The result will be void also if scripting is disabled.)
Process results: Якщо the result of executing the script is void (there is no return value), then the result of obtaining the resource for the URL is equivalent to an HTTP resource with an HTTP 204 No Content response.
Інакше the result of obtaining the resource for the URL is
equivalent
to an HTTP resource with a 200 OK response whose Content-Type metadata is text/html
and whose
response body is the return value converted to a string
value.
When it comes time to set the document's address in the navigation algorithm, use address as the override URL.
The task source for this task is the DOM manipulation task source.
So for example a javascript:
URL in an href
attribute of an a
element would only be evaluated when the link was followed, while such a URL
in the src
attribute of an iframe
element would be evaluated in the context of the iframe
's
own nested browsing
context when the iframe
is being set up; once evaluated, its return value (if it was
not void) would replace that browsing
context's document, thus also changing the Window
object of that browsing context.
Fetch the resource from the most appropriate application cache of those that match.
For example, imagine an HTML page with an associated application cache displaying an image and a form, where the image is also used by several other application caches. Якщо the user right-clicks on the image and chooses "View Image", then the user agent could decide to show the image from any of those caches, but it is likely that the most useful cache for the user would be the one that was used for the aforementioned HTML page. On the other hand, if the user submits the form та the form does a POST submission, then the user agent will not use an application cache at all; the submission will be made to the network.
Fetch the new resource, with the manual redirect flag set.
Якщо the steps above invoked the fetch algorith, the following requirements also apply:
Якщо the resource is being fetched using a method other than one equivalent to HTTP's GET, or, if the navigation algorithm was invoked as a result of the form submission algorithm, then the fetching algorithm must be invoked from the origin of the active document of the source browsing context, if any.
Інакше if the browsing context being navigated is a child browsing context, then the fetching algorithm must be invoked from the browsing context scope origin of the browsing context container of the browsing context being navigated, if it has one.
Якщо gone async is false, return to whatever algorithm invoked the navigation steps and continue running these steps asynchronously.
Нехай gone async be true.
Wait for one or more bytes to be available or for the user agent to establish that the resource in question is empty. During this time, the user agent may allow the user to cancel this navigation attempt or start other navigation attempts.
Fallback in prefer-online mode: Якщо the resource was not fetched from an application cache та was to be fetched using HTTP GET or equivalent та there are relevant application caches що є identified by a URL with the same origin as the URL in question та that have this URL as one of their entries, excluding entries marked as foreign та whose mode is prefer-online та the user didn't cancel the navigation attempt during the earlier step та the navigation attempt failed (e.g. the server returned a 4xx or 5xx status code or equivalent, or there was a DNS error), then:
Нехай candidate be the resource identified by the URL in question from the most appropriate application cache of those that match.
Якщо candidate is not marked as foreign, then the user agent must discard the failed load and instead continue along these steps using candidate as the resource. The user agent may indicate to the user that the original page load failed та that the page used was a previously cached resource.
This does not affect the address of the resource from which Request-URIs are obtained, as used to set the document's referrer in the create a Document object steps below; they still use the value as computed by the original fetch algorithm.
Fallback for fallback entries: Якщо the resource was not fetched from an application cache та was to be fetched using HTTP GET or equivalent та its URL matches the fallback namespace of one or more relevant application caches та the most appropriate application cache of those that match does not have an entry in its online whitelist that has the same origin as the resource's URL and that is a prefix match for the resource's URL та the user didn't cancel the navigation attempt during the previous step та the navigation attempt failed (e.g. the server returned a 4xx or 5xx status code or equivalent, or there was a DNS error), then:
Нехай candidate be the fallback resource specified for the fallback namespace in question. Якщо multiple application caches match, the user agent must use the fallback of the most appropriate application cache of those that match.
Якщо candidate is not marked as foreign, then the user agent must discard the failed load and instead continue along these steps using candidate as the resource. The document's address, if appropriate, will still be the originally requested URL, not the fallback URL, but the user agent may indicate to the user that the original page load failed, that the page used was a fallback resource та what the URL of the fallback resource actually is.
This does not affect the address of the resource from which Request-URIs are obtained, as used to set the document's referrer in the create a Document object steps below; they still use the value as computed by the original fetch algorithm.
Resource handling: Якщо the resource's out-of-band metadata (e.g. HTTP headers), not counting any type information (such as the Content-Type HTTP header), requires some sort of processing that will not affect the browsing context, then perform that processing and abort these steps.
Such processing might be triggered by, amongst other things, the following:
Responses with HTTP Content-Disposition
headers specifying the attachment
disposition type must be handled as a
download.
HTTP 401 responses that do not include a challenge recognized by the user agent must be processed as if they had no challenge, e.g. rendering the entity body as if the response had been 200 OK.
User agents may show the entity body of an HTTP 401 response even when the response does include a recognized challenge, with the option to login being included in a non-modal fashion, to enable the information provided by the server to be used by the user before authenticating. Similarly, user agents should allow the user to authenticate (in a non-modal fashion) against authentication challenges included in other responses such as HTTP 200 OK responses, effectively allowing resources to present HTTP login forms without requiring their use.
Нехай type be the sniffed type of the resource.
Якщо the user agent has been configured to process resources of the given type using some mechanism other than rendering the content in a browsing context, then skip this step. Інакше if the type is one of the following types, jump to the appropriate entry in the following list та process the resource as described there:
text/html
"application/xml
"text/xml
"image/svg+xml
"application/xhtml+xml
"+xml
"
that is not an explicitly
supported XML typetext/plain
"multipart/x-mixed-replace
"An explicitly supported
XML type is one for which the user agent is configured to
use an external application to render the content (either a plugin
rendering directly in the browsing
context, or a separate application), or one for which the user
agent has dedicated processing rules (e.g. a Web browser with a
built-in Atom feed viewer would be said to explicitly support the application/atom+xml
MIME type), or one for which the user agent has a dedicated handler
(e.g. one registered using registerContentHandler()
).
Setting
the document's address: Якщо there is no override
URL, then any Document
created by these steps must have its address set to the URL
that was originally to be fetched,
ignoring any other data that was used щоб отримати the resource
(e.g. the entity body in the case of a POST submission is not part
of the document's address,
nor is the URL of the fallback resource in the case of the original
load having failed and that URL having been found to match a fallback namespace).
However, if there is an override
URL, then any Document
created by these steps must have its address set to that URL
instead.
An override
URL is set when dereferencing
a javascript:
URL and when performing an
overridden reload.
Creating
a new Document
object: when a Document
is created as part of the above steps, the user agent must
additionally run the following algorithm as part of creating the new
object:
Create a new Window
object
та associate it with the Document
,
with one exception: if the browsing
context's only entry in its session
history is the about:blank
Document
that was added
when the browsing context was
created та navigation is occurring with replacement
enabled та that Document
has the same origin as the new Document
, then use the Window
object of that Document
instead та change the document
attribute of the
Window
object to point to the
new Document
.
Set the document's referrer to the address of the resource from which Request-URIs are obtained as determined when the fetch algorithm obtained the resource, if that algorithm was used and determined such a value; otherwise, set it to the empty string.
Implement the sandboxing
for the Document
.
Якщо the active
sandboxing flag set of the Document
's
browsing context or any of its ancestor
browsing contexts (if any) have the sandboxed
fullscreen browsing context flag set, then skip this step.
Якщо the Document
's browsing
context has a browsing
context container and either it is not an iframe
element, or its Document
does not have the fullscreen
enabled flag set, then also skip this step.
Інакше set the Document
's
fullscreen enabled flag.
Інакше the document's type is such that the resource will not affect the browsing context, e.g. because the resource is to be handed to an external application or because it is an unknown type that will be processed as a download. Process the resource appropriately.
Some of the sections below, to which the above algorithm defers in
certain cases, require the user agent to update
the session history with the new page. When a user agent is
required to do this, it must queue a task
(associated with the Document
object of the current entry, not the new
one) to run the following steps:
Unload
the Document
object of the current entry, with the recycle
parameter set to false.
Якщо this instance of the navigation algorithm is canceled while this step is running the unload a document algorithm, then the unload a document algorithm must be allowed to run to completion, but this instance of the navigation algorithm must not run beyond this step. (In particular, for instance, the cancelation of this algorithm does not abort any event dispatch or script execution occurring as part of unloading the document or its descendants.)
Replace the Document
of the entry being updated та any other entries that
referenced the same document as that entry, with the new Document
.
Traverse the history to the new entry.
This can only happen if the entry being updated is
not the current entry та can never
happen with replacement enabled.
(It happens when the user tried to traverse to a session history
entry that no longer had a Document
object.)
Remove all the entries in the browsing context's session history after the current entry. Якщо the current entry is the last entry in the session history, then no entries are removed.
This doesn't necessarily have to affect the user agent's user interface.
Append a new entry at the end of the History
object representing the new resource and its Document
object and related state.
Traverse the history to the new entry. Якщо the navigation was initiated with replacement enabled, then the traversal must itself be initiated with replacement enabled.
The navigation algorithm has now matured.
Fragment identifier loop: Spin the event loop for a user-agent-defined amount of time, as desired by the user agent implementor. (This is intended to allow the user agent to optimize the user experience in the face of performance concerns.)
Якщо the Document
object has
no parser, or its parser has stopped parsing, or the user agent has
reason to believe the user is no longer interested in scrolling to
the fragment identifier, then abort these steps.
Scroll to the fragment identifier given in the document's address. Якщо this fails to find an indicated part of the document, then return to the fragment identifier loop step.
The task source for this task is the networking task source.
When an HTML document is to be loaded in a browsing
context, the user agent must queue a task
to create a Document
object, mark it as being an HTML document, set its content type to "text/html
",
create an HTML parser та associate it with
the document. Each task
that the networking task source
places on the task queue while the fetching algorithm runs must then fill the parser's
input byte stream with the fetched
bytes and cause the HTML parser to perform
the appropriate processing of the input stream.
The input byte stream converts bytes into characters for use in the tokenizer. This process relies, in part, on character encoding information found in the real Content-Type metadata of the resource; the "sniffed type" is not used for this purpose.
When no more bytes are available, the user agent must queue
a task for the parser to process the implied EOF character, which
eventually causes a load
event to be fired.
After creating the Document
object, but before any script execution, certainly before the parser stops, the
user agent must update
the session history with the new page.
Application cache selection happens in the HTML parser.
The task source for the two tasks mentioned in this section must be the networking task source.
When faced with displaying an XML file inline, user agents must first create a Document
object, following the requirements of the XML and Namespaces in
XML recommendations, RFC 7303, DOM та other relevant specifications. [XML] [XMLNS] [RFC7303]
[DOM]
The actual HTTP headers and other metadata, not the headers as mutated or implied by the algorithms given in this specification, are the ones that must be used when determining the character encoding according to the rules given in the above specifications. Once the character encoding is established, the document's character encoding must be set to that character encoding.
Якщо the root element, as parsed according to the XML specifications
cited above, is found to be an html
element with an attribute manifest
whose value is not
the empty string, then, as soon as the element is inserted
into the document, the user agent must resolve the value of that attribute relative
to that element та if that is successful, must apply the URL serializer algorithm to the
resulting parsed URL with the exclude
fragment flag set щоб отримати manifest
URL та then run the application cache selection algorithm
with manifest URL as the manifest URL,
passing in the newly-created Document
.
Інакше if the attribute is absent, its value is the empty string, or
resolving its value fails, then as soon as the root element is inserted into the
document, the user agent must run the application cache selection algorithm
with no manifest та passing in the Document
.
Because the processing of the manifest
attribute happens
only once the root element is parsed, any URLs referenced by processing
instructions before the root element (such as <?xml-stylesheet?>
and <?xbl?>
PIs) will be fetched
from the network and cannot be cached.
User agents may examine the namespace of the root Element
node of this Document
object to
perform namespace-based dispatch to alternative processing tools, e.g.
determining that the content is actually a syndication feed and passing
it to a feed handler. Якщо such processing is to take place, abort the
steps in this section та jump to the
next step (labeled non-document content) in the navigate
steps above.
Інакше then, with the newly created Document
,
the user agent must update
the session history with the new page. User agents may do this
before the complete document has been parsed (thus achieving incremental
rendering) та must do this before any scripts are to be executed.
Error messages from the parse process (e.g. XML namespace
well-formedness errors) may be reported inline by mutating the Document
.
When a plain text document is to be loaded in a browsing
context, the user agent must queue a task
to create a Document
object, mark it as being an HTML document, set its content type to "text/plain
",
create an HTML parser, associate it with the
document, act as if the tokenizer had emitted a start tag token with the
tag name "pre" followed by a single "LF" (U+000A) character та switch the HTML parser's tokenizer to
the PLAINTEXT state. Each task that the networking
task source places on the task queue
while the fetching algorithm
runs must then fill the parser's input
byte stream with the fetched bytes and cause the HTML
parser to perform the appropriate processing of the input stream.
The rules for how to convert the bytes of the plain text document into actual characters та the rules for actually rendering the text to the user, are defined in RFC 2046, RFC 3676 та subsequent versions thereof. [RFC2046] [RFC3676]
The document's character encoding must be set to the character encoding used to decode the document.
Upon creation of the Document
object, the user agent must run the application cache selection algorithm
with no manifest та passing in the newly-created Document
.
When no more bytes are available, the user agent must queue
a task for the parser to process the implied EOF character, which
eventually causes a load
event to be fired.
After creating the Document
object, but potentially before the page has finished parsing, the user
agent must update
the session history with the new page.
User agents may add content to the head
element of the Document
, e.g.
linking to a style sheet or an XBL binding, providing script, giving the
document a title
, etc.
In particular, if the user agent supports the Format=Flowed
feature of RFC 3676 then the user agent would need to apply extra
styling to cause the text to wrap correctly and to handle the quoting
feature. This could be performed using, e.g., an XBL binding or a CSS
extension.
The task source for the two tasks mentioned in this section must be the networking task source.
multipart/x-mixed-replace
resourcesWhen a resource with the type multipart/x-mixed-replace
is to be loaded in a browsing context,
the user agent must parse the resource using the rules for multipart
types. [RFC2046]
For each body part obtained from the resource, the user agent must run
a new instance of the navigate algorithm,
starting from the resource handling step, using the new body
part as the resource being navigated, with replacement
enabled if a previous body part from the same resource resulted in
a Document
object being created та otherwise using the
same setup as the navigate attempt that caused
this section to be invoked in the first place.
For the purposes of algorithms processing these body parts as if they were complete stand-alone resources, the user agent must act as if there were no more bytes for those resources whenever the boundary following the body part is reached.
Thus, load
events (and for that matter unload
events) do fire for each body part loaded.
When an image, video, or audio resource is to be loaded in a browsing
context, the user agent should create
a Document
object, mark it as being an HTML document, set its content type to the sniffed
MIME type of the resource (type in the navigate algorithm), append an html
element to the Document
, append a
head
element and a body
element to the html
element, append an element host element
for the media, as described below, to the body
element та set the appropriate attribute of the element host
element, as described below, to the address of the image, video,
or audio resource.
The element host element to create for the media is the element given in the table below in the second cell of the row whose first cell describes the media. The appropriate attribute to set is the one given by the third cell in that same row.
Type of media | Element for the media | Appropriate attribute |
---|---|---|
Image | img |
src
|
Video | video |
src
|
Audio | audio |
src
|
Then, the user agent must act as if it had stopped parsing.
Upon creation of the Document
object, the user agent must run the application cache selection algorithm
with no manifest та passing in the newly-created Document
.
After creating the Document
object, but potentially before the page has finished fully loading, the
user agent must update
the session history with the new page.
User agents may add content to the head
element of the Document
, or
attributes to the element host element,
e.g. to link to a style sheet or an XBL binding, to provide a script, to
give the document a title
,
to make the media autoplay,
etc.
When a resource that requires an external resource to be rendered is to
be loaded in a browsing context, the
user agent should create a Document
object, mark it as being an HTML document and mark it as being a plugin document, set its content type to the sniffed
MIME type of the resource (type in the navigate algorithm), append an html
element to the Document
, append a
head
element and a body
element to the html
element, append an embed
to the body
element та set
the src
attribute of the embed
element to the address of the resource.
The term plugin document
is used by the Content Security Policy specification as part of the
mechanism that ensures iframe
s
can't be used to evade plugin-types
directives. [CSP]
Then, the user agent must act as if it had stopped parsing.
Upon creation of the Document
object, the user agent must run the application cache selection algorithm
with no manifest та passing in the newly-created Document
.
After creating the Document
object, but potentially before the page has finished fully loading, the
user agent must update
the session history with the new page.
User agents may add content to the head
element of the Document
, or
attributes to the embed
element, e.g. to link to a style sheet or an XBL binding, or to give the
document a title
.
When the user agent is to display a user agent page inline in a browsing
context, the user agent should create
a Document
object, mark it as being an HTML document, set its content type to "text/html
"
та then either associate that Document
with a custom rendering that is not rendered using the normal Document
rendering rules, or mutate that
Document
until it represents the
content the user agent wants to render.
Once the page has been set up, the user agent must act as if it had stopped parsing.
Upon creation of the Document
object, the user agent must run the application cache selection algorithm
with no manifest, passing in the newly-created Document
.
After creating the Document
object, but potentially before the page has been completely set up, the
user agent must update
the session history with the new page.
When a user agent is supposed to navigate to a fragment identifier, then the user agent must run the following steps:
Remove all the entries in the browsing context's session history after the current entry. Якщо the current entry is the last entry in the session history, then no entries are removed.
This doesn't necessarily have to affect the user agent's user interface.
Remove any tasks
queued by the history
traversal task source що є associated with any Document
objects in the top-level
browsing context's document family.
Append a new entry at the end of the History
object representing the new resource and its Document
object and related state. Its URL must be set to the
address to which the user agent was navigating. The title must be left unset.
Traverse the history to the new entry, with the asynchronous events flag set. This will scroll to the fragment identifier given in what is now the document's address.
Якщо the scrolling fails because the relevant ID has not yet been parsed, then the original navigation algorithm will take care of the scrolling instead, as the last few steps of its update the session history with the new page algorithm.
When the user agent is required to scroll to the fragment identifier and the indicated part of the document, if any, is being rendered, the user agent must either change the scrolling position of the document using the following algorithm, or perform some other action such that the indicated part of the document is brought to the user's attention. Якщо there is no indicated part, or if the indicated part is not being rendered, then the user agent must do nothing. The aforementioned algorithm is as follows:
Нехай target be the indicated part of the document, as defined below.
Якщо target is the top of the
document, then scroll
to the beginning of the document for the Document
та abort these steps. [CSSOMVIEW]
Use the scroll an element into view algorithm to scroll target into view, with the align to top flag set. [CSSOMVIEW]
Якщо target is a focusable element, run the focusing steps for that element.
The indicated part of the
document is the one that the fragment identifier, if any,
identifies. The semantics of the fragment identifier in terms of mapping
it to a specific DOM Node is defined by the specification that defines
the MIME type used by the Document
(for example, the processing of fragment identifiers for XML MIME types is the responsibility of
RFC7303). [RFC7303]
For HTML documents (and HTML MIME types), the following processing model must be followed to determine what the indicated part of the document is.
Apply the URL parser algorithm to the URL та let fragid be the fragment component of the resulting parsed URL.
Якщо fragid is the empty string, then the indicated part of the document is the top of the document; stop the algorithm here.
Нехай fragid bytes be the result of percent-decoding fragid.
Нехай decoded fragid be the result of applying the UTF-8 decoder algorithm to fragid bytes. Якщо the UTF-8 decoder emits a decoder error, abort the decoder and instead jump to the step labeled no decoded fragid.
Якщо there is an element in the DOM that has an ID exactly equal to decoded fragid, then the first such element in tree order is the indicated part of the document; stop the algorithm here.
No decoded fragid: Якщо there is an a
element in the DOM that has a name
attribute whose value є
точно equal to fragid (not
decoded fragid), then the first such
element in tree order is the
indicated part of the document; stop the algorithm here.
Якщо fragid is an ASCII
чутливі до реєстру match for the string top
,
then the indicated
part of the document is the top of the document; stop the
algorithm here.
Інакше there is no indicated part of the document.
For the purposes of the interaction of HTML with Selectors' :target
pseudo-class, the target element
is the indicated part of
the document, if that is an element; otherwise there is no target element. [SELECTORS]
The task source for the task mentioned in this section must be the DOM manipulation task source.
When a user agent is required to traverse the history to a specified entry, optionally with replacement enabled та optionally with the asynchronous events flag set, the user agent must act as follows.
This algorithm is not just invoked when explicitly going back or forwards in the session history — it is also invoked in other situations, for example when navigating a browsing context, as part of updating the session history with the new page.
Якщо there is no longer a Document
object for the entry in question, navigate
the browsing context to the
resource for that entry to perform an entry
update of that entry та abort these steps. The "navigate"
algorithm reinvokes this "traverse" algorithm to complete the
traversal, at which point there is a Document
object and so this step gets skipped. The navigation must be done
using the same source browsing
context as was used the first time this entry was created.
(This can never happen with replacement
enabled.)
Якщо the resource was obtained usign a non-idempotent action, for example a POST form submission, or if the resource is no longer available, for example because the computer is now offline and the page wasn't cached, navigating to it again might not be possible. In this case, the navigation will result in a different page than previously; for example, it might be an error message explaining the problem or offering to resubmit the form.
Якщо the current entry's title was
not set by the pushState()
or replaceState()
methods, then set its title to the value returned by the document.title
IDL attribute.
Якщо appropriate, update the current
entry in the browsing context's
Document
object's History
object to reflect any state that the user agent wishes to persist.
The entry is then said to be an
entry with persisted user state.
Якщо the specified entry has a
different Document
object than
the current entry, then run the
following substeps:
Remove any tasks
queued by the history
traversal task source що є associated with any Document
objects in the top-level
browsing context's document
family.
Якщо the origin of the Document
of the specified entry is not
the same
as the origin of the Document
of the current entry, then run the
following sub-sub-steps:
The current browsing
context name must be stored with all the entries in
the history що є associated with Document
objects with the same origin as
the active document and
що є contiguous with the current
entry.
Якщо the browsing context is a top-level browsing context, but not an auxiliary browsing context, then the browsing context's browsing context name must be unset.
Make the specified entry's Document
object the active
document of the browsing
context.
Якщо the specified entry has a browsing context name stored with it, then run the following sub-sub-steps:
Set the browsing context's browsing context name to the name stored with the specified entry.
Clear any browsing
context names stored with all entries in the history
що є associated with Document
objects with the same origin as
the new active document and
що є contiguous with the specified entry.
Якщо the specified entry's Document
has any form controls
whose autofill field name is "off
", invoke the
reset
algorithm of each of those elements.
Якщо the current
document readiness of the specified
entry's Document
is "complete
", queue
a task to run the following sub-sub-steps:
Якщо the Document
's page showing flag є true, then
abort this task (i.e. don't fire the event below).
Set the Document
's page showing flag to true.
Run any session
history document visibility change steps for Document
що є defined by other applicable
specifications.
This is specifically intended for use by the Page Visibility specification. [PAGEVIS]
Fire
a trusted
event with the name pageshow
at the Window
object of that Document
, but with its target
set to the Document
object (and the currentTarget
set to the Window
object), using the PageTransitionEvent
interface, with the persisted
attribute initialized to true. This event must not bubble,
must not be cancelable та has no default action.
Set the document's address to the URL of the specified entry.
Якщо the specified entry has a URL
whose fragment identifier differs from that of the current
entry's when compared in a case-sensitive
manner та the two share the same Document
object, then let hash changed be
true та let old URL be the URL of
the current entry and new
URL be the URL of the specified
entry. Інакше let hash changed
be false.
Якщо the traversal was initiated with replacement enabled, remove the entry immediately before the specified entry in the session history.
Якщо the specified entry is not an entry with persisted user state, but its URL has a fragment identifier, scroll to the fragment identifier.
Якщо the entry is an entry with persisted user state, the user agent may update aspects of the document and its rendering, for instance the scroll position or values of form fields, that it had previously recorded.
This can even include updating the dir
attribute of textarea
elements or input
elements whose type
attribute is in either the Text
state or the Search
state, if the persisted state includes the directionality of user
input in such controls.
Якщо the entry is a state object entry, let state be a structured clone of that state object. Інакше let state be null.
Set history.state
to state.
Нехай state changed be true if the
Document
of the specified
entry has a latest entry та
that entry is not the specified entry;
otherwise let it be false.
Нехай the latest entry of the Document
of the specified
entry be the specified entry.
Якщо the asynchronous events flag is not set, then run the following steps synchronously. Інакше the asynchronous events flag is set; queue a task to run the following substeps.
Якщо state changed є true, fire
a trusted
event with the name popstate
at the Window
object of the Document
,
using the PopStateEvent
interface, with the state
attribute
initialized to the value of state.
This event must bubble but not be cancelable and has no default
action.
Якщо hash changed є true, then
fire
a trusted
event with the name hashchange
at the browsing
context's Window
object, using the HashChangeEvent
interface, with the oldURL
attribute initialized to old URL
and the newURL
attribute initialized to new URL.
This event must bubble but not be cancelable and has no default
action.
The current entry is now the specified entry.
The task source for the tasks mentioned above is the DOM manipulation task source.
The popstate
event is fired in certain cases when navigating to a session
history entry.
[Constructor(DOMString type, optional PopStateEventInit eventInitDict)] interface PopStateEvent : Event { readonly attribute any state; }; dictionary PopStateEventInit : EventInit { any state; };
state
Returns a copy of the information that was provided to pushState()
or replaceState()
.
The state
attribute must return the value it was initialized to. When the object
is created, this attribute must be initialized to null. It represents
the context information for the event, or null, if the state represented
is the initial state of the Document
.
The hashchange
event is fired when navigating to a session
history entry whose URL differs from that of the
previous one only in the fragment identifier.
[Constructor(DOMString type, optional HashChangeEventInit eventInitDict)] interface HashChangeEvent : Event { readonly attribute DOMString oldURL; readonly attribute DOMString newURL; }; dictionary HashChangeEventInit : EventInit { DOMString oldURL; DOMString newURL; };
oldURL
Returns the URL of the session history entry that was previously current.
newURL
Returns the URL of the session history entry that is now current.
The oldURL
attribute must return the value it was initialized to. When the object
is created, this attribute must be initialized to null. It represents
context information for the event, specifically the URL of the session
history entry that was traversed from.
The newURL
attribute must return the value it was initialized to. When the object
is created, this attribute must be initialized to null. It represents
context information for the event, specifically the URL of the session
history entry that was traversed to.
The pageshow
event is fired when traversing
to a session history entry.
The pagehide
event is fired when traversing from a session
history entry. The specification uses the page
showing flag to ensure that scripts receive these events in a
consistent manner (e.g. that they never receive two pagehide
events in a row without an
intervening pageshow
,
or vice versa).
[Constructor(DOMString type, optional PageTransitionEventInit eventInitDict)] interface PageTransitionEvent : Event { readonly attribute boolean persisted; }; dictionary PageTransitionEventInit : EventInit { boolean persisted; };
persisted
For the pageshow
event, returns false if the page is newly being loaded (and the load
event will fire). Інакше
returns true.
For the pagehide
event, returns false if the page is going away for the last time.
Інакше returns true, meaning that (if nothing conspires to make the
page unsalvageable) the page might be reused if the user navigates
back to this page.
Things that can cause the page to be unsalvageable include:
document.open()
beforeunload
events unload
events iframe
s що
є not salvageable WebSocket
objects Document
The persisted
attribute must return the value it was initialized to. When the object
is created, this attribute must be initialized to false. It represents
the context information for the event.
A Document
has a salvageable state,
which must initially be true, a fired unload
flag, which must initially be false та a page
showing flag, which must initially be false.
Event loops have a termination nesting level counter, which must initially be zero.
When a user agent is to prompt to unload a document, it must run the following steps.
Increase the event loop's termination nesting level by one.
Increase the Document
's ignore-opens-during-unload
counter by one.
Нехай event be a new trusted BeforeUnloadEvent
event object with the name beforeunload
,
which does not bubble but is cancelable.
Decrease the event loop's termination nesting level by one.
Release the storage mutex.
Якщо any event listeners were triggered by the earlier dispatch
step, then set the Document
's
salvageable
state to false.
Якщо the returnValue
attribute of the event object is not
the empty string, or if the event was canceled, then the user agent
should ask the user to confirm that they wish to unload the
document.
The prompt shown by the user agent may include the string of the returnValue
attribute, or some leading subset thereof. (A user agent may want to
truncate the string to 1024 characters for display, for instance.)
The user agent must pause while waiting for the user's response.
Якщо the user did not confirm the page navigation, then the user agent refused to allow the document to be unloaded.
Якщо this algorithm was invoked by another instance of the "prompt to unload a document" algorithm (i.e. through the steps below that invoke this algorithm for all descendant browsing contexts), then jump to the step labeled end.
Нехай descendants be the list
of the descendant browsing contexts of the Document
.
Якщо descendants is not an empty list, then for each browsing context b in descendants run the following substeps:
Prompt to unload the active document of the browsing context b. Якщо the user refused to allow the document to be unloaded, then the user implicitly also refused to allow this document to be unloaded; jump to the step labeled end.
Якщо the salvageable state of the active document of the browsing context b is false, then set the salvageable state of this document to false also.
End: Decrease the Document
's
ignore-opens-during-unload
counter by one.
When a user agent is to unload a document,
it must run the following steps. These steps are passed an argument, recycle, which is either true or false,
indicating whether the Document
object is going to be re-used. (This is set by the document.open()
method.)
Increase the event loop's termination nesting level by one.
Increase the Document
's ignore-opens-during-unload
counter by one.
Якщо the Document
's page
showing flag is false, then jump to the step labeled unload
event below (i.e. skip firing the pagehide
event and don't rerun
the unloading
document visibility change steps).
Set the Document
's page
showing flag to false.
Fire
a trusted
event with the name pagehide
at the Window
object of the Document
, but with its target
set to the Document
object (and the currentTarget
set to the Window
object), using
the PageTransitionEvent
interface, with the persisted
attribute initialized to true if the Document
object's salvageable
state є true та false otherwise. This event must not bubble, must
not be cancelable та has no default action.
Run any unloading
document visibility change steps for Document
що є defined by other
applicable specifications.
This is specifically intended for use by the Page Visibility specification. [PAGEVIS]
Unload event: Якщо the Document
's
fired unload flag is false, fire
a simple event named unload
at the Document
's Window
object.
Decrease the event loop's termination nesting level by one.
Release the storage mutex.
Якщо any event listeners were triggered by the earlier unload
event step, then set the Document
object's salvageable
state to false та встановити the Document
's
fired unload flag to true.
Run any unloading
document cleanup steps for Document
що є defined by this specification and other
applicable specifications.
Якщо this algorithm was invoked by another instance of the "unload a document" algorithm (i.e. by the steps below that invoke this algorithm for all descendant browsing contexts), then jump to the step labeled end.
Нехай descendants be the list
of the descendant browsing contexts of the Document
.
Якщо descendants is not an empty list, then for each browsing context b in descendants run the following substeps:
Unload the active document of the browsing context b with the recycle parameter set to false.
Якщо the salvageable state of the active document of the browsing context b is false, then set the salvageable state of this document to false also.
Якщо both the Document
's salvageable
state and recycle are false, then
the Document
's browsing
context must discard the Document
.
End: Decrease the Document
's
ignore-opens-during-unload
counter by one.
This specification defines the following unloading document cleanup steps. Other specifications can define more.
Make disappear any WebSocket
objects
that were created by the WebSocket()
constructor from the Document
's
Window
object.
Якщо this affected any WebSocket
objects, then set Document
's salvageable state
to false.
Якщо the Document
's salvageable state
is false, forcibly
close any EventSource
objects that whose constructor was invoked from the Document
's
Window
object.
Якщо the Document
's salvageable state
is false, empty the Document
's
Window
's list
of active timers.
interface BeforeUnloadEvent : Event { attribute DOMString returnValue; };
returnValue
[ =
value ]Returns the current return value of the event (the message to show the user).
Can be set, to update the message.
There are no BeforeUnloadEvent
-specific
initialization methods.
The returnValue
attribute represents the message to show the user. When the event is
created, the attribute must be set to the empty string. On getting, it
must return the last value it was set to. On setting, the attribute must
be set to the new value.
Якщо a Document
is aborted, the user agent must run the
following steps:
Abort
the active
documents of every child
browsing context. Якщо this results in any of those Document
objects having their salvageable state
set to false, then set this Document
's
salvageable
state to false also.
Cancel any instances of the fetch
algorithm in the context of this Document
,
discarding any tasks
queued
for them та discarding any further data received from the network
for them. Якщо this resulted in any instances of the fetch algorithm being canceled or any queued tasks or any network data getting
discarded, then set the Document
's
salvageable
state to false.
Якщо the Document
has an active parser, then abort that parser та встановити the Document
's salvageable state
to false.
User agents may allow users to explicitly invoke the abort a document algorithm for a Document
. Якщо the user does so, then,
if that Document
is an active
document, the user agent should queue a
task to fire a simple event
named abort
at that Document
's Window
object before invoking the abort algorithm.
Цей розділ не є нормативним.
In order to enable users to continue interacting with Web applications and documents even when their network connection is unavailable — for instance, because they are traveling outside of their ISP's coverage area — authors can provide a manifest which lists the files що є needed for the Web application to work offline and which causes the user's browser to keep a copy of the files for use offline.
To illustrate this, consider a simple clock applet consisting of an HTML
page "clock.html
", a CSS style sheet "clock.css
" та a JavaScript script "clock.js
".
Before adding the manifest, these three files might look like this:
EXAMPLE offline/clock/clock1.html
EXAMPLE offline/clock/clock1.css
EXAMPLE offline/clock/clock1.js
Якщо the user tries to open the "clock.html
"
page while offline, though, the user agent (unless it happens to have it
still in the local cache) will fail with an error.
The author can instead provide a manifest of the three files, say "clock.appcache
":
EXAMPLE offline/clock/clock2.appcache
With a small change to the HTML file, the manifest (served as text/cache-manifest
)
is linked to the application:
EXAMPLE offline/clock/clock2.html
Now, if the user goes to the page, the browser will cache the files and make them available even when the user is offline.
Authors are encouraged to include the main page in the manifest also, but in practice the page that referenced the manifest is automatically cached even if it isn't explicitly mentioned.
With the exception of "no-store" directive, HTTP cache
headers and restrictions on caching pages served over TLS (encrypted,
using https:
) are overridden by
manifests. Thus, pages will not expire from an application cache before
the user agent has updated it та even applications served over TLS can be
made to work offline.
Цей розділ не є нормативним.
The application cache feature works best if the application logic is
separate from the application and user data, with the logic (markup,
scripts, style sheets, images, etc) listed in the manifest and stored in
the application cache, with a finite number of static HTML pages for the
application та with the application and user data stored in Web Storage or
a client-side Indexed Database, updated dynamically using Web Sockets, XMLHttpRequest
, server-sent events,
or some other similar mechanism.
This model results in a fast experience for the user: the application immediately loads та fresh data is obtained as fast as the network will allow it (possibly while stale data shows).
Legacy applications, however, tend to be designed so that the user data and the logic are mixed together in the HTML, with each operation resulting in a new HTML page from the server.
For example, consider a news application. The typical architecture of such an application, when not using the application cache feature, is that the user fetches the main page та the server returns a dynamically-generated page with the current headlines and the user interface logic mixed together.
A news application designed for the application cache feature, however,
would instead have the main page just consist of the logic та would then
have the main page fetch the data separately from the server, e.g. using
XMLHttpRequest
.
The mixed-content model does not work well with the application cache feature: since the content is cached, it would result in the user always seeing the stale data from the previous time the cache was updated.
While there is no way to make the legacy model work as fast as the
separated model, it can at least be retrofitted for offline use
using the prefer-online
application
cache mode. To do so, list all the static resources used by the HTML
page you want to have work offline in an application cache manifest, use
the manifest
attribute to select that manifest from the HTML file та then add the
following line at the bottom of the manifest:
SETTINGS: prefer-online NETWORK: *
This causes the application cache to only be used for master entries when the user is offline та causes the application cache to be used as an atomic HTTP cache (essentially pinning resources listed in the manifest), while allowing all resources not listed in the manifest to be accessed normally when the user is online.
Цей розділ не є нормативним.
When the user visits a page that declares a manifest, the browser will try to update the cache. It does this by fetching a copy of the manifest and, if the manifest has changed since the user agent last saw it, redownloading all the resources it mentions and caching them anew.
As this is going on, a number of events get fired on the ApplicationCache
object to keep the script updated as to the state of the cache update, so
that the user can be notified appropriately. The events наступні:
Event name | Interface | Fired when... | Next events |
---|---|---|---|
checking
|
Event |
The user agent is checking for an update, or attempting to download the manifest for the first time. This is always the first event in the sequence. | noupdate ,
downloading ,
obsolete ,
error
|
noupdate
|
Event |
The manifest hadn't changed. | Last event in sequence. |
downloading
|
Event |
The user agent has found an update and is fetching it, or is downloading the resources listed by the manifest for the first time. | progress ,
error ,
cached ,
updateready
|
progress
|
ProgressEvent |
The user agent is downloading resources listed by the manifest.
The event object's total
attribute returns the total number of files to be downloaded. The
event object's loaded
attribute returns the number of files processed so far. |
progress ,
error ,
cached ,
updateready
|
cached
|
Event |
The resources listed in the manifest have been downloaded та the application is now cached. | Last event in sequence. |
updateready
|
Event |
The resources listed in the manifest have been newly redownloaded
та the script can use swapCache() to switch
to the new cache. |
Last event in sequence. |
obsolete
|
Event |
The manifest was found to have become a 404 or 410 page, so the application cache is being deleted. | Last event in sequence. |
error
|
Event |
The manifest was a 404 or 410 page, so the attempt to cache the application has been aborted. | Last event in sequence. |
The manifest hadn't changed, but the page referencing the manifest failed to download properly. | |||
A fatal error occurred while fetching the resources listed in the manifest. | |||
The manifest changed while the update was being run. | The user agent will try fetching the files again momentarily. |
These events are cancelable; their default action is for the user agent to show download progress information. Якщо the page shows its own update UI, canceling the events will prevent the user agent from showing redundant progress information.
An application cache is a set of cached resources consisting of:
One or more resources (including their out-of-band metadata, such as HTTP headers, if any), identified by URLs, each falling into one (or more) of the following categories:
These are documents that were added to the cache
because a browsing context was
navigated to
that document and the document indicated that this was its
cache, using the manifest
attribute.
This is the resource corresponding to the URL that
was given in a master entry's html
element's manifest
attribute. The manifest is fetched and processed during the application cache
download process. All the master entries have the same origin
as the manifest.
These are the resources that were listed in the cache's manifest in an explicit section.
These are the resources that were listed in the cache's manifest in a fallback section.
Explicit
entries and Fallback
entries can be marked as foreign, which means that they
have a manifest
attribute but that it doesn't point at this cache's manifest.
A URL in the list can be flagged with multiple different types та thus an entry can end up being кваліфікується as multiple entries. For example, an entry can be a manifest entry and an explicit entry at the same time, if the manifest is listed within the manifest.
Zero or more fallback namespaces, each of which is mapped to a fallback entry.
These are URLs used as prefix match patterns for resources що є to be fetched from the network if possible, or to be replaced by the corresponding fallback entry if not. Each namespace URL has the same origin as the manifest.
Zero or more URLs that form the online whitelist namespaces.
These are used as prefix match patterns та declare URLs for which the user agent will ignore the application cache, instead fetching them normally (i.e. from the network or local HTTP cache as appropriate).
An online whitelist wildcard flag, which is either open or blocking.
The open state indicates that any URL not listed as cached is to be implicitly treated as being in the online whitelist namespaces; the blocking state indicates that URLs not listed explicitly in the manifest are to be treated as unavailable.
A cache mode flag, which is either in the fast state or the prefer-online state.
Each application cache has a completeness flag, which is either complete or incomplete.
An application cache group is a group of application caches, identified by the absolute URL of a resource manifest which is used to populate the caches in the group.
An application cache is newer than another if it was created after the other (in other words, application caches in an application cache group have a chronological order).
Only the newest application cache in an application cache group can have its completeness flag set to incomplete; the others are always all complete.
Each application cache group has an update status, which is one of the following: idle, checking, downloading.
A relevant application cache is an application cache that is the newest in its group to be complete.
Each application cache group
has a list
of pending master entries. Each entry in this list consists of a
resource and a corresponding Document
object. It is used during the application
cache download process to ensure that new master entries are
cached even if the application
cache download process was already running for their application
cache group when they were loaded.
An application cache group can be marked as obsolete, meaning that it must be ignored when looking at what application cache groups exist.
A cache host is a Document
or a SharedWorkerGlobalScope
object. A cache
host can be associated with an application
cache. [WEBWORKERS]
A Document
initially is not
associated with an application cache,
but can become associated with one early during the page load process,
when steps in the parser and in the navigation sections
cause cache
selection to occur.
A SharedWorkerGlobalScope
can be associated with an application
cache when it is created. [WEBWORKERS]
Each cache host has an associated ApplicationCache
object.
Multiple application caches in different application cache groups can contain the same resource, e.g. if the manifests all reference that resource. Якщо the user agent is to select an application cache from a list of relevant application caches that contain a resource, the user agent must use the application cache that the user most likely wants to see the resource from, taking into account the following:
A URL matches a fallback namespace if there exists a relevant application cache whose manifest's URL has the same origin as the URL in question та that has a fallback namespace that is a prefix match for the URL being examined. Якщо multiple fallback namespaces match the same URL, the longest one is the one that matches. A URL looking for a fallback namespace can match more than one application cache at a time, but only matches one namespace in each cache.
Якщо a manifest http://example.com/app1/manifest
declares that http://example.com/resources/images
is a fallback namespace та the user navigates to HTTP://EXAMPLE.COM:80/resources/images/cat.png
,
then the user agent will decide that the application cache identified
by http://example.com/app1/manifest
contains a namespace with a match for that URL.
Цей розділ не є нормативним.
This example manifest requires two images and a style sheet to be cached and whitelists a CGI script.
CACHE MANIFEST # the above line is required # this is a comment # there can be as many of these anywhere in the file # they are all ignored # comments can have spaces before them # but must be alone on the line # blank lines are ignored too # these are files that need to be cached they can either be listed # first, or a "CACHE:" header could be put before them, as is done # lower down. images/sound-icon.png images/background.png # note that each file has to be put on its own line # here is a file for the online whitelist -- it isn't cached та # references to this file will bypass the cache, always hitting the # network (or trying to, if the user is offline). NETWORK: comm.cgi # here is another set of files to cache, this time just the CSS file. CACHE: style/default.css
It could equally well be written as follows:
CACHE MANIFEST NETWORK: comm.cgi CACHE: style/default.css images/sound-icon.png images/background.png
Offline application cache manifests can use absolute paths or even absolute URLs:
CACHE MANIFEST /main/home /main/app.js /settings/home /settings/app.js http://img.example.com/logo.png http://img.example.com/check.png http://img.example.com/cross.png
The following manifest defines a catch-all error page that is displayed for any page on the site while the user is offline. It also specifies that the online whitelist wildcard flag is open, meaning that accesses to resources on other sites will not be blocked. (Resources on the same site are already not blocked because of the catch-all fallback namespace.)
So long as all pages on the site reference this manifest, they will get cached locally as they are fetched, so that subsequent hits to the same page will load the page immediately from the cache. Until the manifest is changed, those pages will not be fetched from the server again. When the manifest changes, then all the files will be redownloaded.
Subresources, such as style sheets, images, etc, would only be cached using the regular HTTP caching semantics, however.
CACHE MANIFEST FALLBACK: / /offline.html NETWORK: *
Manifests must be served using the text/cache-manifest
MIME type. All resources served using the text/cache-manifest
MIME
type must follow the syntax of application cache manifests, as
described in this section.
An application cache manifest is a text file, whose text is encoded using UTF-8. Data in application cache manifests is line-based. Newlines must be represented by "LF" (U+000A) characters, "CR" (U+000D) characters, or "CR" (U+000D) "LF" (U+000A) pairs. [RFC3629]
This is a willful violation
of RFC 2046, which requires all text/*
types to only allow CRLF line breaks. This requirement, however, is
outdated; the use of CR, LF та CRLF line breaks is commonly supported and
indeed sometimes CRLF is not supported by text editors. [RFC2046]
The first line of an application cache manifest must consist of the string "CACHE", a single U+0020 SPACE character, the string "MANIFEST" та either a U+0020 SPACE character, a "tab" (U+0009) character, a "LF" (U+000A) character, or a "CR" (U+000D) character. The first line may optionally be preceded by a "BOM" (U+FEFF) character. Якщо any other text is found on the first line, it is ignored.
Subsequent lines, if any, must all be one of the following:
Blank lines must consist of zero or more U+0020 SPACE and "tab" (U+0009) characters only.
Comment lines must consist of zero or more U+0020 SPACE and "tab" (U+0009) characters, followed by a single "#" (U+0023) character, followed by zero or more characters other than "LF" (U+000A) and "CR" (U+000D) characters.
Comments must be on a line on their own. Якщо they were to be included on a line with a URL, the "#" would be mistaken for part of a fragment identifier.
Section headers change the current section. There are four possible section headers:
CACHE:
FALLBACK:
NETWORK:
SETTINGS:
Section header lines must consist of zero or more U+0020 SPACE and "tab" (U+0009) characters, followed by one of the names above (including the ":)" (U+003A) character followed by zero or more U+0020 SPACE and "tab" (U+0009) characters.
Ironically, by default, the current section is the explicit section.
The format that data lines must take depends on the current section.
When the current section is the explicit section, data lines must consist of zero or more U+0020 SPACE and "tab" (U+0009) characters, a valid URL identifying a resource other than the manifest itself та then zero or more U+0020 SPACE and "tab" (U+0009) characters.
When the current section is the fallback section, data lines must consist of zero or more U+0020 SPACE and "tab" (U+0009) characters, a valid URL identifying a resource other than the manifest itself, one or more U+0020 SPACE and "tab" (U+0009) characters, another valid URL identifying a resource other than the manifest itself та then zero or more U+0020 SPACE and "tab" (U+0009) characters.
When the current section is the online whitelist section, data lines must consist of zero or more U+0020 SPACE and "tab" (U+0009) characters, either a single "*" (U+002A) character or a valid URL identifying a resource other than the manifest itself та then zero or more U+0020 SPACE and "tab" (U+0009) characters.
When the current section is the settings section, data lines must consist of zero or more U+0020 SPACE and "tab" (U+0009) characters, a setting та then zero or more U+0020 SPACE and "tab" (U+0009) characters.
Currently only one setting is defined:
prefer-online
".
It sets the cache
mode to prefer-online.
(The cache
mode defaults to fast.)Within a settings section, each setting must occur no more than once.
Manifests may contain sections more than once. Sections may be empty.
URLs що є to be fallback pages associated with fallback namespaces та those namespaces themselves, must be given in fallback sections, with the namespace being the first URL of the data line та the corresponding fallback page being the second URL. All the other pages to be cached must be listed in explicit sections.
Fallback namespaces and fallback entries must have the same origin as the manifest itself.
A fallback namespace must not be listed more than once.
Namespaces that the user agent is to put into the online whitelist must all be specified in online whitelist sections. (This is needed for any URL that the page is intending to use to communicate back to the server.) To specify that all URLs are automatically whitelisted in this way, a "*" (U+002A) character may be specified as one of the URLs.
Authors should not include namespaces in the online whitelist for which another namespace in the online whitelist is a prefix match.
Relative URLs must be given relative to the manifest's own URL. All URLs in the manifest must have the same scheme as the manifest itself (either explicitly or implicitly, through the use of relative URLs). [URL]
URLs in manifests must not have fragment identifiers (i.e. the U+0023 NUMBER SIGN character isn't allowed in URLs in manifests).
Fallback namespaces and namespaces in the online whitelist are matched by prefix match.
When a user agent is to parse a manifest, it means that the user agent must run the following steps:
UTF-8 decode the byte stream corresponding with the manifest to be parsed.
The UTF-8 decode algorithm strips a leading BOM, if any.
Нехай base URL be the absolute URL representing the manifest.
Apply the URL parser steps to the base URL, so that the components from its parsed URL can be used by the subseqent steps of this algorithm.
Нехай explicit URLs be an initially empty list of absolute URLs for explicit entries.
Нехай fallback URLs be an initially empty mapping of fallback namespaces to absolute URLs for fallback entries.
Нехай online whitelist namespaces be an initially empty list of absolute URLs for an online whitelist.
Нехай online whitelist wildcard flag be blocking.
Нехай cache mode flag be fast.
Нехай input be the decoded text of the manifest's byte stream.
Нехай position буде вказівником в input, initially pointing at the first character.
Якщо символs starting from position are "CACHE", followed by a U+0020 SPACE character, followed by "MANIFEST", then advance position до наступного символа after those. Інакше this isn't a cache manifest; abort this algorithm with a failure while checking for the magic signature.
Якщо символ в позициї position is neither a U+0020 SPACE character, a "tab" (U+0009) character, "LF" (U+000A) character, nor a "CR" (U+000D) character, then this isn't a cache manifest; abort this algorithm with a failure while checking for the magic signature.
This is a cache manifest. The algorithm cannot fail beyond this point (though bogus lines can get ignored).
Зібрати колекцію символів що є not "LF" (U+000A) or "CR" (U+000D) characters та ignore those characters. (Extra text on the first line, after the signature, is ignored.)
Нехай mode be "explicit".
Start of line: Якщо position після кінця input, then jump to the last step. Інакше collect a sequence of characters що є "LF" (U+000A), "CR" (U+000D), U+0020 SPACE, or "tab" (U+0009) characters.
Now, collect a sequence of characters що є not "LF" (U+000A) or "CR" (U+000D) characters та let the result be line.
Drop any trailing U+0020 SPACE and "tab" (U+0009) characters at the end of line.
Якщо line is the empty string, then jump back to the step labeled start of line.
Якщо the first character in line is a "#" (U+0023) character, then jump back to the step labeled start of line.
Якщо line equals "CACHE:" (the word "CACHE" followed by a ":)" (U+003A) character, then set mode to "explicit" and jump back to the step labeled start of line.
Якщо line equals "FALLBACK:" (the word "FALLBACK" followed by a ":)" (U+003A) character, then set mode to "fallback" and jump back to the step labeled start of line.
Якщо line equals "NETWORK:" (the word "NETWORK" followed by a ":)" (U+003A) character, then set mode to "online whitelist" and jump back to the step labeled start of line.
Якщо line equals "SETTINGS:" (the word "SETTINGS" followed by a ":)" (U+003A) character, then set mode to "settings" and jump back to the step labeled start of line.
Якщо line ends with a ":" (U+003A) character, then set mode to "unknown" and jump back to the step labeled start of line.
This is either a data line or it is syntactically incorrect.
Нехай position буде вказівником в line, що спочатку вказує на початок рядка.
Нехай tokens be a list of strings, initially empty.
While position doesn't point past the end of line:
Нехай current token be an empty string.
While position doesn't point past the end of line and the character в позициї is neither a U+0020 SPACE nor a "tab" (U+0009) character, add the character в позициї to current token and advance position до наступного символа в input.
Add current token to the tokens list.
While position doesn't point past the end of line and the character в позициї is either a U+0020 SPACE or a "tab" (U+0009) character, advance position до наступного символа в input.
Process tokens as follows:
Resolve the first item in tokens, relative to base URL, with the URL character encoding set to UTF-8; ignore the rest.
Якщо this fails, then jump back to the step labeled start of line.
Якщо the resulting parsed URL has a different scheme component than base URL (the manifest's URL), then jump back to the step labeled start of line.
Нехай new URL be the result of applying the URL serializer algorithm to the resulting parsed URL, with the exclude fragment flag set.
Add new URL to the explicit URLs.
Нехай part one be the first token in tokens та let part two be the second token in tokens.
Resolve part one and part two, relative to base URL, with the URL character encoding set to UTF-8.
Якщо either fails, then jump back to the step labeled start of line.
Якщо the absolute URL corresponding to either part one or part two does not have the same origin as the manifest's URL, then jump back to the step labeled start of line.
Нехай part one be the result of applying the URL serializer algorithm to the first resulting parsed URL, with the exclude fragment flag set.
Нехай part two be the result of applying the URL serializer algorithm to the second resulting parsed URL, with the exclude fragment flag set.
Якщо part one is already in the fallback URLs mapping as a fallback namespace, then jump back to the step labeled start of line.
Інакше add part one to the fallback URLs mapping as a fallback namespace, mapped to part two as the fallback entry.
Якщо the first item in tokens is a "*" (U+002A) character, then set online whitelist wildcard flag to open and jump back to the step labeled start of line.
Інакше resolve the first item in tokens, relative to base URL, with the URL character encoding set to UTF-8; ignore the rest.
Якщо this fails, then jump back to the step labeled start of line.
Якщо the resulting parsed URL has a different scheme component than base URL (the manifest's URL), then jump back to the step labeled start of line.
Нехай new URL be the result of applying the URL serializer algorithm to the resulting parsed URL, with the exclude fragment flag set.
Add new URL to the online whitelist namespaces.
Якщо tokens contains a single
token та that token is a case-sensitive
match for the string "prefer-online
",
then set cache mode flag to prefer-online and jump back to the
step labeled start of line.
Інакше the line is an unsupported setting: do nothing; the line is ignored.
Do nothing. The line is ignored.
Jump back to the step labeled start of line. (That step jumps to the next та last, step when the end of the file is reached.)
Повернути explicit URLs list, the fallback URLs mapping, the online whitelist namespaces, the online whitelist wildcard flag та the cache mode flag.
The resource that declares the manifest (with the manifest
attribute) will
always get taken from the cache, whether it is listed in the cache or
not, even if it is listed in an online whitelist namespace.
Якщо a resource is listed in the explicit section or as a fallback entry in the fallback section, the resource will always be taken from the cache, regardless of any other matching entries in the fallback namespaces or online whitelist namespaces.
When a fallback namespace and an online whitelist namespace overlap, the online whitelist namespace has priority.
The online whitelist wildcard flag is applied last, only for URLs that match neither the online whitelist namespace nor the fallback namespace and що є not listed in the explicit section.
When the user agent is required (by other parts of this specification) to start the application cache download process for an absolute URL purported to identify a manifest, or for an application cache group, potentially given a particular cache host та potentially given a master resource, the user agent must run the steps below. These steps are always run asynchronously, in parallel with the event loop tasks.
Some of these steps have requirements that only apply if the user agent
shows caching progress. Support
for this is optional. Caching progress UI could consist of a progress
bar or message panel in the user agent's interface, or an overlay, or
something else. Certain events fired during the application
cache download process allow the script to override the display of
such an interface. (Such events are delayed until after the load
event has fired.) The goal of this is to allow Web applications to
provide more seamless update mechanisms, hiding from the user the
mechanics of the application cache mechanism. User agents may display
user interfaces independent of this, but are encouraged to not show
prominent update progress notifications for applications that cancel the
relevant events.
The application cache download process steps наступні:
Optionally, wait until the permission to start the application cache download process has been obtained from the user and until the user agent is confident that the network is available. This could include doing nothing until the user explicitly opts-in to caching the site, or could involve prompting the user for permission. The algorithm might never get past this point. (This step is particularly intended to be used by user agents running on severely space-constrained devices or in highly privacy-sensitive environments).
Atomically, so as to avoid race conditions, perform the following substeps:
Pick the appropriate substeps:
Нехай manifest URL be that absolute URL.
Якщо there is no application cache group identified by manifest URL, then create a new application cache group identified by manifest URL. Initially, it has no application caches. One will be created later in this algorithm.
Нехай manifest URL be the absolute URL of the manifest used to identify the application cache group to be updated.
Якщо that application cache group is obsolete, then abort this instance of the application cache download process. This can happen if another instance of this algorithm found the manifest to be 404 or 410 while this algorithm was waiting in the first step above.
Нехай cache group be the application cache group identified by manifest URL.
Якщо these steps were invoked with a master resource, then add
the resource, along with the resource's Document
,
to cache group's list of pending
master entries.
Якщо these steps were invoked with a cache
host та the status of cache
group is checking or downloading, then queue a post-load task to fire a simple event named checking
that is cancelable at the ApplicationCache
singleton of that cache host. The
default action of this event must be, if the user agent shows
caching progress, the display of some sort of user
interface indicating to the user that the user agent is checking
to see if it can download the application.
Якщо these steps were invoked with a cache
host та the status of cache
group is downloading, then also queue
a post-load task to fire a
simple event named downloading
that is cancelable at the ApplicationCache
singleton of that cache host. The
default action of this event must be, if the user agent shows
caching progress, the display of some sort of user
interface indicating to the user the application is being
downloaded.
Якщо the status of the cache group is either checking or downloading, then abort this instance of the application cache download process, as an update is already in progress.
Set the status of cache group to checking.
For each cache host associated with
an application cache in cache group, queue
a post-load task to fire a
simple event that is cancelable named checking
at the ApplicationCache
singleton of the cache host. The
default action of these events must be, if the user agent shows
caching progress, the display of some sort of user
interface indicating to the user that the user agent is checking
for the availability of updates.
The remainder of the steps run asynchronously.
Якщо cache group already has an application cache in it, then this is an upgrade attempt. Інакше this is a cache attempt.
Якщо this is a cache
attempt, then this algorithm was invoked with a cache
host; queue a post-load
task to fire a simple event
named checking
that is cancelable at the ApplicationCache
singleton of that cache host. The default
action of this event must be, if the user agent shows
caching progress, the display of some sort of user interface
indicating to the user that the user agent is checking for the
availability of updates.
Fetching the manifest: Fetch the resource from manifest URL with the synchronous flag set та let manifest be that resource. HTTP caching semantics should be honored for this request.
Розберіть manifest according to the rules for parsing manifests, obtaining a list of explicit entries, fallback entries and the fallback namespaces that map to them, entries for the online whitelist та values for the online whitelist wildcard flag and the cache mode flag.
The MIME type of the
resource is ignored — it is assumed to be text/cache-manifest
.
In the future, if new manifest formats are supported, the different
types will probably be distinguished on the basis of the file
signatures (for the current format, that is the "CACHE MANIFEST
"
string at the top of the file).
Якщо fetching the manifest fails due to a 404 or 410 response or equivalent, тоді виконайте ці субкроки:
Mark cache group as obsolete. This cache
group no longer exists for any purpose other than the
processing of Document
objects already associated with an application
cache in the cache group.
Нехай task list be an empty list of tasks.
For each cache host associated with
an application cache in cache group, create a task to fire
a simple event named obsolete
that is
cancelable at the ApplicationCache
singleton of the cache host та append
it to task list. The default
action of these events must be, if the user agent shows
caching progress, the display of some sort of user
interface indicating to the user that the application is no
longer available for offline use.
For each entry in cache group's
list
of pending master entries, create a task to fire
a simple event that is cancelable named error
(not obsolete
!) at the
ApplicationCache
singleton of the Document
for this entry, if there still is one та append it to task
list. The default action of this event must be, if the
user agent shows caching
progress, the display of some sort of user interface
indicating to the user that the user agent failed to save the
application for offline use.
Якщо cache group has an application cache whose completeness flag is incomplete, then discard that application cache.
Якщо appropriate, remove any user interface indicating that an update for this cache is in progress.
Нехай the status of cache group be idle.
For each task in task list, queue that task as a post-load task.
Abort the application cache download process.
Інакше if fetching the manifest fails in some other way (e.g. the server returns another 4xx or 5xx response or equivalent, or there is a DNS error, or the connection times out, or the user cancels the download, or the parser for manifests fails when checking the magic signature), or if the server returned a redirect, then run the cache failure steps. [HTTP]
Якщо this is an upgrade attempt and the newly downloaded manifest is byte-for-byte identical to the manifest found in the newest application cache in cache group, or the server reported it as "304 Not Modified" or equivalent, тоді виконайте ці субкроки:
Нехай cache be the newest application cache in cache group.
Нехай task list be an empty list of tasks.
For each entry in cache group's list of pending master entries, wait for the resource for this entry to have either completely downloaded or failed.
Якщо the download failed (e.g. the server returns a 4xx or 5xx
response or
equivalent, or there is a DNS error, the connection times
out, or the user cancels the download), or if the resource is
labeled with the "no-store" cache directive, then create a task to fire
a simple event that is cancelable named error
at the ApplicationCache
singleton of the Document
for this entry, if there still is one та append it to task
list. The default action of this event must be, if the
user agent shows caching
progress, the display of some sort of user interface
indicating to the user that the user agent failed to save the
application for offline use.
Інакше associate the Document
for this entry with cache; store
the resource for this entry in cache,
if it isn't already there та categorize its entry as a master entry. Якщо
applying the URL parser algorithm
to the resource's URL results in a parsed
URL that has a non-null fragment component, the URL
used for the entry in cache must
instead be the absolute URL
obtained from applying the URL serializer algorithm to
the parsed URL with the exclude
fragment flag set (application caches never include
fragment identifiers).
For each cache host associated with
an application cache in cache group, create a task to fire
a simple event that is cancelable named noupdate
at the ApplicationCache
singleton of the cache host та append
it to task list. The default
action of these events must be, if the user agent shows
caching progress, the display of some sort of user
interface indicating to the user that the application is up to
date.
Empty cache group's list of pending master entries.
Якщо appropriate, remove any user interface indicating that an update for this cache is in progress.
Нехай the status of cache group be idle.
For each task in task list, queue that task as a post-load task.
Abort the application cache download process.
Нехай new cache be a newly created application cache in cache group. Set its completeness flag to incomplete.
For each entry in cache group's list
of pending master entries, associate the Document
for this entry with new cache.
Set the status of cache group to downloading.
For each cache host associated with an application cache in cache
group, queue a post-load
task to fire a simple event
that is cancelable named downloading
at the
ApplicationCache
singleton of the cache host. The default
action of these events must be, if the user agent shows
caching progress, the display of some sort of user interface
indicating to the user that a new version is being downloaded.
Нехай file list be an empty list of URLs with flags.
Add all the URLs in the list of explicit entries obtained by parsing manifest to file list, each flagged with "explicit entry".
Add all the URLs in the list of fallback entries obtained by parsing manifest to file list, each flagged with "fallback entry".
Якщо this is an upgrade attempt, then add all the URLs of master entries in the newest application cache in cache group whose completeness flag is complete to file list, each flagged with "master entry".
Якщо any URL is in file list more than once, then merge the entries into one entry for that URL, that entry having all the flags that the original entries had.
For each URL in file list, run the
following steps. These steps may be run in parallel for two or more
of the URLs at a time. Якщо, while running these steps, the ApplicationCache
object's abort()
method sends
a signal to this instance of the application
cache download process algorithm, then run the cache
failure steps instead.
Якщо the resource URL being processed was flagged as neither an "explicit entry" nor or a "fallback entry", then the user agent may skip this URL.
This is intended to allow user agents to expire resources not listed in the manifest from the cache. Generally, implementors are urged to use an approach that expires lesser-used resources first.
For each cache host associated with
an application cache in cache group, queue
a post-load task to fire a trusted event with the name
progress
,
which does not bubble, which is cancelable та which uses the ProgressEvent
interface, at
the ApplicationCache
singleton of the cache host. The lengthComputable
attribute must be set to true, the total
attribute must be set to the number of files in file
list та the loaded
attribute must be set to the number of files in file
list that have been either downloaded or skipped so far.
The default action of these events must be, if the user agent shows caching progress, the
display of some sort of user interface indicating to the user
that a file is being downloaded in preparation for updating the
application. [PROGRESS-EVENTS]
Fetch the resource, from the origin of the URL manifest URL, with the synchronous flag set and the manual redirect flag set. Якщо this is an upgrade attempt, then use the newest application cache in cache group as an HTTP cache та honor HTTP caching semantics (such as expiration, ETags та so forth) with respect to that cache. User agents may also have other caches in place що є also honored.
Якщо the resource in question is already being downloaded for other reasons then the existing download process can sometimes be used for the purposes of this step, as defined by the fetching algorithm.
An example of a resource that might already be
being downloaded is a large image on a Web page that is being
seen for the first time. The image would get downloaded to
satisfy the img
element on the page, as well as being listed in the cache
manifest. According to the rules for fetching that image only need be downloaded
once та it can be used both for the cache and for the rendered
Web page.
Якщо the previous step fails (e.g. the server returns a 4xx or 5xx response or equivalent, or there is a DNS error, or the connection times out, or the user cancels the download), or if the server returned a redirect, or if the resource is labeled with the "no-store" cache directive, then run the first appropriate step from the following list: [HTTP]
Якщо these steps are being run in parallel for any other URLs in file list, then abort these steps for those other URLs. Run the cache failure steps.
Redirects are fatal because they are either indicative of a network problem (e.g. a captive portal); or would allow resources to be added to the cache under URLs that differ from any URL that the networking model will allow access to, leaving orphan entries; or would allow resources to be stored under URLs different than their true URLs. All of these situations are bad.
Skip this resource. It is dropped from the cache.
Copy the resource and its metadata from the newest application cache in cache group whose completeness flag is complete та act as if that was the fetched resource, ignoring the resource obtained from the network.
User agents may warn the user of these errors as an aid to development.
These rules make errors for resources listed in the manifest fatal, while making it possible for other resources to be removed from caches when they are removed from the server, without errors та making non-manifest resources survive server-side errors.
Except for the "no-store" directive, HTTP caching rules that would cause a file to be expired or otherwise not cached are ignored for the purposes of the application cache download process.
Інакше the fetching succeeded. Store the resource in the new cache.
Якщо the user agent is not able to store the resource (e.g. because of quota restrictions), the user agent may prompt the user or try to resolve the problem in some other manner (e.g. automatically pruning content in other caches). Якщо the problem cannot be resolved, the user agent must run the cache failure steps.
Якщо the URL being processed was flagged as an "explicit entry" in file list, then categorize the entry as an explicit entry.
Якщо the URL being processed was flagged as a "fallback entry" in file list, then categorize the entry as a fallback entry.
Якщо the URL being processed was flagged as an "master entry" in file list, then categorize the entry as a master entry.
As an optimization, if the resource is an HTML or XML file
whose root element is an html
element with a manifest
attribute whose value doesn't match the manifest URL of the
application cache being processed, then the user agent should
mark the entry as being foreign.
For each cache host associated with an application cache in cache
group, queue a post-load
task to fire
a trusted
event with the name progress
, which does
not bubble, which is cancelable та which uses the ProgressEvent
interface, at the ApplicationCache
singleton of the cache host. The lengthComputable
attribute must be set to true, the total
and the loaded
attributes must be set to the number of files in file
list. The default action of these events must be, if the
user agent shows caching progress,
the display of some sort of user interface indicating to the user
that all the files have been downloaded. [PROGRESS-EVENTS]
Store the list of fallback namespaces та the URLs of the fallback entries that they map to, in new cache.
Store the URLs that form the new online whitelist in new cache.
Store the value of the new online whitelist wildcard flag in new cache.
Store the value of the new cache mode flag in new cache.
For each entry in cache group's list of pending master entries, wait for the resource for this entry to have either completely downloaded or failed.
Якщо the download failed (e.g. the server returns a 4xx or 5xx response or equivalent, or there is a DNS error, the connection times out, or the user cancels the download), or if the resource is labeled with the "no-store" cache directive, тоді виконайте ці субкроки:
Unassociate the Document
for this entry from new cache.
Queue a post-load task to
fire a simple event that is
cancelable named error
at the ApplicationCache
singleton of the Document
for this entry, if there still is one. The default action of
this event must be, if the user agent shows
caching progress, the display of some sort of user
interface indicating to the user that the user agent failed to
save the application for offline use.
Якщо this is a cache attempt and this entry is the last entry in cache group's list of pending master entries, then run these further substeps:
Discard cache group and its only application cache, new cache.
Якщо appropriate, remove any user interface indicating that an update for this cache is in progress.
Abort the application cache download process.
Інакше remove this entry from cache group's list of pending master entries.
Інакше store the resource for this entry in new cache, if it isn't already there та categorize its entry as a master entry.
Fetch the resource from manifest URL again, with the synchronous flag set та let second manifest be that resource. HTTP caching semantics should again be honored for this request.
Since caching can be honored, authors are encouraged to avoid setting the cache headers on the manifest in such a way that the user agent would simply not contact the network for this second request; otherwise, the user agent would not notice if the cache had changed during the cache update process.
Якщо the previous step failed for any reason, or if the fetching attempt involved a redirect, or if second manifest and manifest are not byte-for-byte identical, then schedule a rerun of the entire algorithm with the same parameters after a short delay та run the cache failure steps.
Інакше store manifest in new cache, if it's not there already та categorize its entry as the manifest.
Set the completeness flag of new cache to complete.
Нехай task list be an empty list of tasks.
Якщо this is a cache
attempt, then for each cache host
associated with an application cache
in cache group, create a task to fire
a simple event that is cancelable named cached
at the ApplicationCache
singleton
of the cache host та append it to task
list. The default action of these events must be, if the
user agent shows caching progress,
the display of some sort of user interface indicating to the user
that the application has been cached and that they can now use it
offline.
Інакше it is an upgrade
attempt. For each cache host
associated with an application cache
in cache group, create a task to fire
a simple event that is cancelable named updateready
at the
ApplicationCache
singleton of the cache host та append it
to task list. The default action of
these events must be, if the user agent shows
caching progress, the display of some sort of user interface
indicating to the user that a new version is available and that they
can activate it by reloading the page.
Якщо appropriate, remove any user interface indicating that an update for this cache is in progress.
Set the update status of cache group to idle.
For each task in task list, queue that task as a post-load task.
The cache failure steps наступні:
Нехай task list be an empty list of tasks.
For each entry in cache group's list of pending master entries, run the following further substeps. These steps may be run in parallel for two or more entries at a time.
Wait for the resource for this entry to have either completely downloaded or failed.
Unassociate the Document
for this entry from its application
cache, if it has one.
Create a task
to fire a simple event that
is cancelable named error
at the ApplicationCache
singleton of the Document
for this entry, if there still is one та append it to task
list. The default action of these events must be, if the
user agent shows caching
progress, the display of some sort of user interface
indicating to the user that the user agent failed to save the
application for offline use.
For each cache host still associated
with an application cache in cache group, create a task to fire
a simple event that is cancelable named error
at the ApplicationCache
singleton of the cache host та append it
to task list. The default action of
these events must be, if the user agent shows
caching progress, the display of some sort of user interface
indicating to the user that the user agent failed to save the
application for offline use.
Empty cache group's list of pending master entries.
Якщо cache group has an application cache whose completeness flag is incomplete, then discard that application cache.
Якщо appropriate, remove any user interface indicating that an update for this cache is in progress.
Нехай the status of cache group be idle.
Якщо this was a cache attempt, discard cache group altogether.
For each task in task list, queue that task as a post-load task.
Abort the application cache download process.
Attempts to fetch resources as part of the application cache download process may be done with cache-defeating semantics, to avoid problems with stale or inconsistent intermediary caches.
User agents may invoke the application cache download process, in the background, for any application cache group, at any time (with no cache host). This allows user agents to keep caches primed and to update caches even before the user visits a site.
Each Document
has a list of pending
application cache download process tasks that is used to delay
events fired by the algorithm above until the document's load
event has fired. When the Document
is created, the list must be empty.
When the steps above say to queue a
post-load task task, where task is a task that dispatches an event on a target ApplicationCache
object target,
the user agent must run the appropriate steps from the following list:
Document
is ready for post-load tasksQueue the task task.
Add task to target's
Document
's list of pending
application cache download process tasks.
The task source for these tasks is the networking task source.
When the application
cache selection algorithm algorithm is invoked with a Document
document
and optionally a manifest URL manifest
URL, the user agent must run the first applicable set of steps
from the following list:
Mark the entry for the resource from which document was taken in the application cache from which it was loaded as foreign.
Restart the current navigation from the top of the navigation algorithm, undoing any changes that were made as part of the initial load (changes can be avoided by ensuring that the step to update the session history with the new page is only ever completed after this application cache selection algorithm is run, though this is not required).
The navigation will not result in the same resource being loaded, because "foreign" entries are never picked during navigation.
User agents may notify the user of the inconsistency between the cache manifest and the document's own metadata, to aid in application development.
Associate document with the application cache from which it was loaded. Invoke, in the background, the application cache download process for that application cache's application cache group, with document as the cache host.
Invoke, in the background, the application cache download process for manifest URL, with document as the cache host and with the resource from which document was parsed as the master resource.
Якщо there are relevant application caches що є identified by a URL with the same origin as the URL of document та that have this URL as one of their entries, excluding entries marked as foreign, then the user agent should use the most appropriate application cache of those that match as an HTTP cache for any subresource loads. User agents may also have other caches in place що є also honored.
The Document
is not
associated with any application cache.
Якщо there was a manifest URL, the user agent may report to the user that it was ignored, to aid in application development.
When a cache host is associated with an application cache whose completeness flag is complete, any and all loads for resources related to that cache host other than those for child browsing contexts must go through the following steps instead of immediately invoking the mechanisms appropriate to that resource's scheme:
Якщо the resource is not to be fetched using the HTTP GET mechanism or equivalent, or if applying the URL parser algorithm to both its URL and the application cache's manifest's URL results in two parsed URLs with different scheme components, then fetch the resource normally and abort these steps.
Якщо the resource's URL is a master entry, the manifest, an explicit entry, or a fallback entry in the application cache, then get the resource from the cache (instead of fetching it) та abort these steps.
Якщо there is an entry in the application cache's online whitelist that has the same origin as the resource's URL and that is a prefix match for the resource's URL, then fetch the resource normally and abort these steps.
Якщо the resource's URL has the same origin as the manifest's URL та there is a fallback namespace f in the application cache that is a prefix match for the resource's URL, then:
Fetch the resource normally. Якщо this results in a redirect to a resource with another origin (indicative of a captive portal), or a 4xx or 5xx status code or equivalent, or if there were network errors (but not if the user canceled the download), then instead get, from the cache, the resource of the fallback entry corresponding to the fallback namespace f. Abort these steps.
Якщо the application cache's online whitelist wildcard flag is open, then fetch the resource normally and abort these steps.
Fail the resource load as if there had been a generic network error.
The above algorithm ensures that so long as the online whitelist wildcard flag is blocking, resources що є not present in the manifest will always fail to load (at least, after the application cache has been primed the first time), making the testing of offline applications simpler.
As a general rule, user agents should not expire application caches, except on request from the user, or after having been left unused for an extended period of time.
Application caches and cookies have similar implications with respect to privacy (e.g. if the site can identify the user when providing the cache, it can store data in the cache that can be used for cookie resurrection). Implementors are therefore encouraged to expose application caches in a manner related to HTTP cookies, allowing caches to be expunged together with cookies and other origin-specific data.
For example, a user agent could have a "delete site-specific data" feature that clears all cookies, application caches, local storage, databases, etc, from an origin all at once.
User agents should consider applying constraints on disk usage of application caches та care should be taken to ensure that the restrictions cannot be easily worked around using subdomains.
User agents should allow users to see how much space each domain is using та may offer the user the ability to delete specific application caches.
For predictability, quotas should be based on the uncompressed size of data stored.
How quotas are presented to the user is not defined by this specification. User agents are encouraged to provide features such as allowing a user to indicate that certain sites are trusted to use more than the default quota, e.g. by asynchronously presenting a user interface while a cache is being updated, or by having an explicit whitelist in the user agent's configuration interface.
interface ApplicationCache : EventTarget { // update status const unsigned short UNCACHED = 0; const unsigned short IDLE = 1; const unsigned short CHECKING = 2; const unsigned short DOWNLOADING = 3; const unsigned short UPDATEREADY = 4; const unsigned short OBSOLETE = 5; readonly attribute unsigned short status; // updates void update(); void abort(); void swapCache(); // events attribute EventHandler onchecking; attribute EventHandler onerror; attribute EventHandler onnoupdate; attribute EventHandler ondownloading; attribute EventHandler onprogress; attribute EventHandler onupdateready; attribute EventHandler oncached; attribute EventHandler onobsolete; };
applicationCache
(In a window.) Returns the ApplicationCache
object that applies to the active document
of that Window
.
applicationCache
(In a shared worker.) Returns the ApplicationCache
object that applies to the current shared worker.
status
Returns the current status of the application cache, as given by the constants defined below.
update
()Invokes the application cache download process.
Throws an InvalidStateError
exception if there is no application cache to update.
Calling this method is not usually necessary, as user agents will generally take care of updating application caches automatically.
The method can be useful in situations such as long-lived applications. For example, a Web mail application might stay open in a browser tab for weeks at a time. Such an application could want to test for updates each day.
abort
()Cancels the application cache download process.
This method is intended to be used by Web application showing their own caching progress UI, in case the user wants to stop the update (e.g. because bandwidth is limited).
swapCache
()Switches to the most recent application cache, if there is a newer
one. Якщо there isn't, throws an InvalidStateError
exception.
This does not cause previously-loaded resources to be reloaded; for example, images do not suddenly get reloaded and style sheets and scripts do not get reparsed or reevaluated. The only change is that subsequent requests for cached resources will obtain the newer copies.
The updateready
event will fire before this method can be called. Once it fires, the
Web application can, at its leisure, call this method to switch the
underlying cache to the one with the more recent updates. To make
proper use of this, applications have to be able to bring the new
features into play; for example, reloading scripts to enable new
features.
An easier alternative to swapCache()
is just to
reload the entire page at a time suitable for the user, using location.reload()
.
There is a one-to-one mapping from cache
hosts to ApplicationCache
objects. The applicationCache
attribute on Window
objects must
return the ApplicationCache
object associated with the Window
object's active document. The applicationCache
attribute on SharedWorkerGlobalScope
objects must return
the ApplicationCache
object associated with the worker.
A Window
or SharedWorkerGlobalScope
object has an associated ApplicationCache
object even if that cache host has no actual
application cache.
The status
attribute, on getting, must return the current state of the application
cache that the ApplicationCache
object's cache host is associated with, if
any. This must be the appropriate value from the following list:
UNCACHED
(numeric value 0)The ApplicationCache
object's cache host is not associated with
an application cache at this time.
IDLE
(numeric value 1)The ApplicationCache
object's cache host is associated with an application cache whose application
cache group's update
status is idle та that application
cache is the newest
cache in its application cache
group та the application
cache group is not marked as obsolete.
CHECKING
(numeric value 2)The ApplicationCache
object's cache host is associated with an application cache whose application
cache group's update
status is checking.
DOWNLOADING
(numeric value 3)The ApplicationCache
object's cache host is associated with an application cache whose application
cache group's update
status is downloading.
UPDATEREADY
(numeric value 4)The ApplicationCache
object's cache host is associated with an application cache whose application
cache group's update
status is idle та whose application
cache group is not marked as obsolete, but that application
cache is not the newest cache in its group.
OBSOLETE
(numeric value 5)The ApplicationCache
object's cache host is associated with an application cache whose application
cache group is marked as obsolete.
Якщо the update()
method is invoked, the user agent must invoke the application
cache download process, in the background, for the application
cache group of the application cache
with which the ApplicationCache
object's cache host is associated, but
without giving that cache host to the
algorithm. Якщо there is no such application
cache, or if its application
cache group is marked as obsolete, then the method must
throw an InvalidStateError
exception instead.
Якщо the abort()
method is invoked, the user agent must send a
signal to the current application
cache download process for the application
cache group of the application cache
with which the ApplicationCache
object's cache host is associated, if any.
Якщо there is no such application cache,
or it does not have a current application
cache download process, then do nothing.
Якщо the swapCache()
method is invoked, the user agent must run the following steps:
Check that ApplicationCache
object's cache host is associated with an
application cache. Якщо it is not,
then throw an InvalidStateError
exception and abort these steps.
Нехай cache be the application
cache with which the ApplicationCache
object's cache host is associated. (By
definition, this is the same as the one that was found in the
previous step.)
Якщо cache's application
cache group is marked as obsolete, then unassociate
the ApplicationCache
object's cache host from cache
and abort these steps. (Resources will now load from the network
instead of the cache.)
Check that there is an application cache in the same application
cache group as cache whose completeness
flag is complete and that is newer than cache.
Якщо there is not, then throw an InvalidStateError
exception and abort these steps.
Нехай new cache be the newest application cache in the same application cache group as cache whose completeness flag is complete.
Unassociate the ApplicationCache
object's cache host from cache
and instead associate it with new cache.
The following are the event handlers
(and their corresponding event handler event types)
that must be supported, as event
handler IDL attributes, by all objects implementing the ApplicationCache
interface:
Event handler | Event handler event type |
---|---|
onchecking
|
checking
|
onerror
|
error
|
onnoupdate
|
noupdate
|
ondownloading
|
downloading
|
onprogress
|
progress
|
onupdateready
|
updateready
|
oncached
|
cached
|
onobsolete
|
obsolete
|
[NoInterfaceObject] interface NavigatorOnLine { readonly attribute boolean onLine; };
navigator
. onLine
Returns false if the user agent is definitely offline (disconnected from the network). Returns true if the user agent might be online.
The events online
and offline
are fired when the value of this attribute changes.
The navigator.onLine
attribute must return false if the user agent will not contact the
network when the user follows links or when a script requests a remote
page (or knows that such an attempt would fail) та must return true
otherwise.
When the value that would be returned by the navigator.onLine
attribute
of a Window
or WorkerGlobalScope
changes from true to false, the user agent must queue
a task to fire a simple event
named offline
at the Window
or WorkerGlobalScope
object.
On the other hand, when the value that would be returned by the navigator.onLine
attribute of a Window
or WorkerGlobalScope
changes from false to true, the user agent must queue
a task to fire a simple event
named online
at the Window
or WorkerGlobalScope
object.
The task source for these tasks is the networking task source.
This attribute is inherently unreliable. A computer can be connected to a network without having Internet access.
In this example, an indicator is updated as the browser goes online and offline.
<!DOCTYPE HTML> <html> <head> <title>Online status</title> <script> function updateIndicator() { document.getElementById('indicator').textContent = navigator.onLine ? 'online' : 'offline'; } </script> </head> <body onload="updateIndicator()" ononline="updateIndicator()" onoffline="updateIndicator()"> <p>The network is: <span id="indicator">(state unknown)</span> </body> </html>
Various mechanisms can cause author-provided executable code to run in the context of a document. These mechanisms include, but are probably not limited to:
script
elements.javascript:
URLs.addEventListener()
,
by explicit event handler
content attributes, by event
handler IDL attributes, or otherwise.Scripting is enabled in a browsing context when all of the following conditions are true:
Scripting is disabled in a browsing context when any of the above conditions are false (i.e. when scripting is not enabled).
Scripting
is enabled for a node if the Document
object of the node (the node
itself, if it is itself a Document
object) has an associated browsing context
та scripting
is enabled in that browsing context.
Scripting is disabled for a node if there is no such browsing context, or if scripting is disabled in that browsing context.
This specification describes three kinds of JavaScript global environments: the document environment, the dedicated worker environment та the shared worker environment. The dedicated worker environment and the shared worker environment are both types of worker environments.
Except where otherwise specified, a JavaScript global environment is a document environment.
A script has:
A code entry-point represents a block of executable code that the script exposes to other scripts and to the user agent. Typically, the code corresponding to the code entry-point is executed immediately after the script is parsed, but for event handlers, it is called each time the handler is invoked.
In JavaScript script
blocks, this corresponds to the execution context of the global
code.
A flag which, if set, means that error information will not be provided for errors in this script (used to mute errors for cross-origin scripts, since that can leak private information).
A script settings object, various settings що є shared with other scripts in the same context.
A script settings object specifies algorithms for obtaining the following:
The characteristics of the script execution environment depend on the language та are not defined by this specification.
In JavaScript, the script execution environment
consists of the interpreter, the stack of execution contexts,
the global code and function code and the Function
objects resulting та so forth.
An object that provides the APIs that can be called by the code in scripts that use this settings object.
This is typically a Window
object or a WorkerGlobalScope
object. When a global
object is an empty object, it can't do anything that interacts
with the environment.
Якщо the global object is a Window
object, then, in JavaScript,
the ThisBinding of the global execution context for this script must
be the Window
object's WindowProxy
object, rather than
the global object. [ECMA262]
This is a willful
violation of the JavaScript specification current at the time
of writing (ECMAScript edition 5, as defined in section 10.4.1.1
Initial Global Execution Context, step 3). The JavaScript
specification requires that the this
keyword in the global scope return the global object, but this is
not compatible with the security design prevalent in implementations
as specified herein. [ECMA262]
A browsing context that is assigned responsibility for actions taken by the scripts that use this script settings object.
When a script creates and navigates a new top-level
browsing context, the opener
attribute of the new browsing
context's Window
object
will be set to the responsible
browsing context's WindowProxy
object.
A Document
that is assigned
responsibility for actions taken by the scripts that use this script
settings object.
For example, the address of the responsible
document is used to set the address of any Document
s
created using createDocument()
.
An event loop that is used when it would not be immediately clear what event loop to use.
Either a Document
(specifically, the responsible
document), or a URL, which is used by some APIs
to determine what value to use for the Referer
(sic) header in calls to the fetching
algorithm.
A character encoding used to encode URLs by APIs called by scripts that use this script settings object.
An absolute URL used by APIs called by scripts that use this script settings object to resolve relative URLs.
An instrument used in security checks.
The relevant settings object for a global object o is the script settings object whose global object is o. (There is always a 1:1 mapping of global objects to script settings objects.)
The relevant settings object for a script s is the settings object of s.
Whenever a new Window
object is
created, it must also create a script
settings object whose algorithms are defined as follows:
When the script settings object is created, for each language supported by the user agent, create an appropriate execution environment as defined by the relevant specification.
When a script execution environment is needed, return the appropriate one from those created when the script settings object was created.
Повернути Window
object itself.
Повернути browsing context with
which the Window
object is
associated.
Повернути Document
with which
the Window
is currently
associated.
Повернути event loop that is associated
with the unit
of related similar-origin browsing contexts to which the Window
object's browsing
context belongs.
Повернути Document
with which
the Window
is currently
associated.
Повернути current character encoding of
the Document
with which the Window
is currently associated.
Повернути current base
URL of the Document
with
which the Window
is currently
associated.
Повернути origin of the Document
with which the Window
is
currently associated.
Повернути effective script
origin of the Document
with which the Window
is
currently associated.
Each unit of related similar-origin browsing contexts has a stack of script settings objects, which must be initially empty. When a new script settings object is pushed onto this stack, the specified script settings object is to be added to the stack; when the script settings object on this stack that was most recently pushed onto it is to be popped from the stack, it must be removed. Entries on this stack can be labeled as candidate entry settings objects.
When a user agent is to jump to a code entry-point for a script s, the user agent must run the following steps:
Нехай context be the settings object of s.
Prepare to run a callback with context as the script settings object. Якщо this returns "do not run" then abort these steps.
Make the appropriate script execution environment specified by context execute the s's code entry-point.
The steps to prepare to run a callback with a script settings object o наступні. They return either "run" or "do not run".
Якщо the global object specified by o is a Window
object whose Document
object
is not fully active, then return "do
not run" and abort these steps.
Якщо scripting is disabled for the responsible browsing context specified by o, then return "do not run" and abort these steps.
Push o onto the stack of script settings objects та label it as a candidate entry settings object.
Повернути"run".
The steps to clean up after running a callback наступні:
Pop the current incumbent settings object from the stack of script settings objects.
Якщо the stack of script settings objects is now empty, run the global script clean-up jobs. (These cannot run scripts.)
Якщо the stack of script settings objects is now empty, perform a microtask checkpoint. (Якщо this runs scripts, these algorithms will be invoked reentrantly.)
These algorithms are not invoked by one script directly calling another, but they can be invoked reentrantly in an indirect manner, e.g. if a script dispatches an event which has event listeners registered.
When a JavaScript SourceElements production is to be evaluated, the settings object of the script corresponding to that SourceElements must be pushed onto the stack of script settings objects before the evaluation begins та popped when the evaluation ends (regardless of whether it's an abrupt completion or not).
The entry settings object is the most-recently added script settings object in the stack of script settings objects that is labeled as a candidate entry settings object. Якщо the stack is empty, or has no entries labeled as such, then there is no entry settings object. It is used щоб отримати, amongst other things, the API base URL to resolve relative URLs used in scripts running in that unit of related similar-origin browsing contexts.
The incumbent settings object is the script settings object in the stack of script settings objects that was most-recently added (i.e. the last one on the stack). Якщо the stack is empty, then there is no incumbent settings object. It is used in some security checks.
The WebIDL specification also uses these algorithms. [WEBIDL]
Each unit
of related similar-origin browsing contexts has a performing
a microtask checkpoint flag, which must initially be false. It
is used to prevent reentrant invocation of the algorithm to invoke MutationObserver
objects. For the purposes of MutationObserver
objects, each unit
of related similar-origin browsing contexts is a distinct scripting
environment.
Each unit
of related similar-origin browsing contexts has a global
script clean-up jobs list, which must initially be empty. A
global script clean-up job cannot run scripts та cannot be sensitive to
the order in which other clean-up jobs are executed. The File API uses
this to release blob:
URLs. [FILEAPI]
When the user agent is to run the global script clean-up jobs, the user agent must perform each of the jobs in the global script clean-up jobs list and then empty the list.
When the specification says that a script is to be created, given some script source, a script source URL, its scripting language, a script settings object та optionally a muted errors flag, the user agent must run the following steps:
Нехай script be a new script that this algorithm will subsequently initialize.
Якщо scripting is disabled for browsing context passed to this algorithm, then abort these steps, as if the script source described a program that did nothing but return void.
Obtain the appropriate script execution environment for the given scripting language from the script settings object provided.
Розберіть/compile/initialize the source of the script using the script execution environment, as appropriate for the scripting language та thus obtain script's code entry-point.
Нехай script's settings object be the script settings object provided.
Якщо the muted errors flag was set, then set script's muted errors flag.
Якщо all the steps above succeeded (in particular, if the script was compiled successfully), Jump to script's code entry-point.
Інакше report the error for script, with the problematic position (line number and column number), using the global object specified by the script settings object as the target. Якщо the error is still not handled after this, then the error may be reported to the user.
User agents may impose resource limitations on scripts, for example CPU
quotas, memory limits, total execution time limits, or bandwidth
limitations. When a script exceeds a limit, the user agent may either
throw a QuotaExceededError
exception, abort the script without an exception, prompt the user, or
throttle script execution.
For example, the following script never terminates. A user agent could, after waiting for a few seconds, prompt the user to either terminate the script or let it continue.
<script> while (true) { /* loop */ } </script>
User agents are encouraged to allow users to disable scripting whenever
the user is prompted either by a script (e.g. using the window.alert()
API) or because of a
script's actions (e.g. because it has exceeded a time limit).
Якщо scripting is disabled while a script is executing, the script should be terminated immediately.
User agents may allow users to specifically disable scripts just for the purposes of closing a browsing context.
For example, the prompt mentioned in the example above
could also offer the user with a mechanism to just close the page
entirely, without running any unload
event handlers.
When the user agent is required to report an error for a particular script script with a particular position line:col, using a particular target target, it must run these steps, after which the error is either handled or not handled:
Якщо target is in error reporting mode, then abort these steps; the error is not handled.
Нехай target be in error reporting mode.
Нехай message be a
user-agent-defined string describing the error in a helpful manner.
Нехай error object be the object
that represents the error: in the case of an uncaught exception,
that would be the object that was thrown; in the case of a
JavaScript error that would be an Error
object. Якщо
there is no corresponding object, then the null value must be used
instead.
Нехай location be an absolute URL that corresponds to the resource from which script was obtained.
The resource containing the script will typically be
the file from which the Document
was parsed, e.g. for inline script
elements or event
handler content attributes; or the JavaScript file that the
script was in, for external scripts. Even for dynamically-generated
scripts, user agents are strongly encouraged to attempt to keep
track of the original source of a script. For example, if an
external script uses the document.write()
API to
insert an inline script
element during parsing, the URL of the resource containing the
script would ideally be reported as being the external script та the
line number might ideally be reported as the line with the document.write()
call or
where the string passed to that call was first constructed.
Naturally, implementing this can be somewhat non-trivial.
User agents are similarly encouraged to keep careful
track of the original line numbers, even in the face of document.write()
calls
mutating the document as it is parsed, or event
handler content attributes spanning multiple lines.
Якщо script has muted
errors, then set message to "Script error.
", set location
to the empty string, set line and col to 0 та set error
object to null.
Нехай event be a new trusted ErrorEvent
object that does not bubble but is cancelable та which has the event
name error
.
Initialize event's message
attribute to message.
Initialize event's filename
attribute to
location.
Initialize event's lineno
attribute to line.
Initialize event's colno
attribute to col.
Initialize event's error
attribute to error object.
Dispatch event at target.
Нехай target no longer be in error reporting mode.
Якщо event was canceled, then the error is handled. Інакше the error is not handled.
Whenever an uncaught runtime script error occurs in one of the scripts
associated with a Document
, the
user agent must report the error for
the relevant script,
with the problematic position (line number and column number) in the
resource containing the script, using the global
object specified by the script's settings
object as the target. Якщо the error is still not handled after this,
then the error may be reported to the user.
ErrorEvent
interface[Constructor(DOMString type, optional ErrorEventInit eventInitDict)] interface ErrorEvent : Event { readonly attribute DOMString message; readonly attribute DOMString filename; readonly attribute unsigned long lineno; readonly attribute unsigned long colno; readonly attribute any error; }; dictionary ErrorEventInit : EventInit { DOMString message; DOMString filename; unsigned long lineno; unsigned long colno; any error; };
The message
attribute must return the value it was initialized to. When the object is
created, this attribute must be initialized to the empty string. It
represents the error message.
The filename
attribute must return the value it was initialized to. When the object is
created, this attribute must be initialized to the empty string. It
represents the absolute URL of the script in
which the error originally occurred.
The lineno
attribute must return the value it was initialized to. When the object is
created, this attribute must be initialized to zero. It represents the
line number where the error occurred in the script.
The colno
attribute must return the value it was initialized to. When the object is
created, this attribute must be initialized to zero. It represents the
column number where the error occurred in the script.
The error
attribute must return the value it was initialized to. When the object is
created, this attribute must be initialized to null. Where appropriate, it
is set to the object representing the error (e.g. the exception object in
the case of an uncaught DOM exception).
To coordinate events, user interaction, scripts, rendering, networking та so forth, user agents must use event loops as described in this section.
There must be at least one event loop per user agent та at most one event loop per unit of related similar-origin browsing contexts.
When there is more than one event loop for a unit of related browsing contexts, complications arise when a browsing context in that group is navigated such that it switches from one unit of related similar-origin browsing contexts to another. This specification does not currently describe how to handle these complications.
An event loop always has at least one browsing context. Якщо an event loop's browsing contexts all go away, then the event loop goes away as well. A browsing context always has an event loop coordinating its activities.
An event loop has one or more task queues. A task queue is an ordered list of tasks, which are algorithms що є responsible for such work as:
Asynchronously dispatching an Event
object at a particular EventTarget
object is often done by a dedicated task.
Not all events are dispatched using the task queue, many are dispatched synchronously during other tasks.
The HTML parser tokenizing one or more bytes та then processing any resulting tokens, is typically a task.
Calling a callback asynchronously is often done by a dedicated task.
When an algorithm fetches a resource, if the fetching occurs asynchronously then the processing of the resource once some or all of the resource is available is performed by a task.
Some elements have tasks that trigger in response to DOM manipulation, e.g. when that element is inserted into the document.
Each task
is associated with a Document
; if
the task was queued in the context of an element, then it is the
element's Document
; if the task
was queued in the context of a browsing
context, then it is the browsing
context's active document at the
time the task was queued; if the task was queued by or for a script then the document is the responsible
document specified by the script's settings
object.
A task is
intended for a specific event loop: the event
loop that is handling tasks
for the task's
associated Document
.
When a user agent is to queue a task, it must add the given task to one of the task queues of the relevant event loop.
Each task
is defined as coming from a specific task source.
All the tasks from one particular task source
and destined to a particular event loop (e.g.
the callbacks generated by timers of a Document
,
the events fired for mouse movements over that Document
,
the tasks queued for the parser of that Document
)
must always be added to the same task queue,
but tasks
from different task
sources may be placed in different task queues.
For example, a user agent could have one task queue for mouse and key events (the user interaction task source) та another for everything else. The user agent could then give keyboard and mouse events preference over other tasks three quarters of the time, keeping the interface responsive but not starving other task queues та never processing events from any one task source out of order.
A user agent may have one storage mutex. This mutex is used to control access to shared state like cookies. At any one point, the storage mutex is either free, or owned by a particular event loop or instance of the fetching algorithm.
Якщо a user agent does not implement a storage mutex, it is exempt from implementing the requirements that require it to acquire or release it.
User agent implementors have to make a choice between two evils. On the one hand, not implementing the storage mutex means that there is a risk of data corruption: a site could, for instance, try to read a cookie, increment its value, then write it back out, using the new value of the cookie as a unique identifier for the session; if the site does this twice in two different browser windows at the same time, it might end up using the same "unique" identifier for both sessions, with potentially disastrous effects. On the other hand, implementing the storage mutex has potentially serious performance implications: whenever a site uses Web Storage or cookies, all other sites that try to use Web Storage or cookies are blocked until the first site finishes.
Whenever a script calls into a plugin та whenever a plugin calls into a script, the user agent must release the storage mutex.
An event loop must continually run through the following steps for as long as it exists:
Run the oldest task
on one of the event loop's task queues, if any, ignoring tasks whose
associated Document
s are not fully active. The user agent may pick any
task queue.
Якщо the storage mutex is now owned by the event loop, release it so that it is once again free.
Якщо a task was run in the first step above, remove that task from its task queue.
Якщо this event loop is not a worker's event loop, виконати ці підкроки:
Якщо necessary, update the rendering or user interface of any Document
or browsing
context to reflect the current state.
Інакше if this event loop is running for
a WorkerGlobalScope
, but there are no events in the event loop's task queues and the WorkerGlobalScope
object's closing
flag є true, then destroy the event loop,
aborting these steps.
Повернутиto the first step of the event loop.
When a user agent is to perform a microtask checkpoint, if the performing a microtask checkpoint flag is false, then the user agent must run the following steps:
Нехай the performing a microtask checkpoint flag be true.
Perform a custom elements checkpoint. [CUSTOM]
Sort the tables with pending sorts.
Invoke
MutationObserver
objects for the unit
of related similar-origin browsing contexts to which the responsible
browsing context specified by the script's settings
object belongs, using the task
wrapper algorithm as the steps to invoke each callback.
This will typically invoke scripted callbacks, which eventually calls the clean up after running a callback steps, which call this perform a microtask checkpoint algorithm again, which is why we use the performing a microtask checkpoint flag to avoid reentrancy.
Нехай the performing a microtask checkpoint flag be false.
When the user agent is to provide a stable state, if any asynchronously-running algorithms are awaiting a stable state, then the user agent must run their synchronous section and then resume running their asynchronous algorithm (if appropriate).
A synchronous section never mutates the DOM, runs any script, or has any side-effects detectable from another synchronous section та thus synchronous sections can be run in any order та cannot spin the event loop.
Steps in synchronous sections are marked with ⌛.
The task wrapper algorithm, which is implicitly invoked in the context of an event loop and is used to invoke a given callback in a specific way, is as follows:
Invoke callback as specified.
The above will change in due course; see bug 20821.
When an algorithm says to spin the event loop until a condition goal is met, the user agent must run the following steps:
Нехай task source be the task source of the currently running task.
Нехай old stack of script settings objects be a copy of the stack of script settings objects.
Empty the stack of script settings objects.
Stop the currently running task, allowing the event loop to resume, but continue these steps asynchronously.
This causes the event loop to move on to the second step of its processing model (defined above).
Wait until the condition goal is met.
Queue a task to continue running these steps, using the task source task source. Wait until this task runs before continuing these steps.
Replace the stack of script settings objects with the old stack of script settings objects.
Повернутиto the caller.
Some of the algorithms in this specification, for historical reasons, require the user agent to pause while running a task until a condition goal is met. This means running the following steps:
Якщо any asynchronously-running algorithms are awaiting a stable state, then run their synchronous section and then resume running their asynchronous algorithm. (See the event loop processing model definition above for details.)
Якщо necessary, update the rendering or user interface of any Document
or browsing
context to reflect the current state.
Wait until the condition goal is met. While a user agent has a paused task, the corresponding event loop must not run further tasks та any script in the currently running task must block. User agents should remain responsive to user input while paused, however, albeit in a reduced capacity since the event loop will not be doing anything.
When a user agent is щоб отримати the storage mutex as part of running a task, it must run through the following steps:
Якщо the storage mutex is already owned by this task's event loop, then abort these steps.
Інакше pause until the storage mutex can be taken by the event loop.
Take ownership of the storage mutex.
The following task sources are used by a number of mostly unrelated features in this and other specifications.
This task source is used for features that react to DOM manipulations, such as things that happen asynchronously when an element is inserted into the document.
This task source is used for features that react to user interaction, for example keyboard or mouse input.
Asynchronous events sent in response to user input (e.g. click
events) must be fired using
tasks queued
with the user interaction
task source. [DOMEVENTS]
This task source is used for features that trigger in response to network activity.
This task source is used to queue calls
to history.back()
and similar APIs.
Many objects can have event handlers specified. These act as non-capture event listeners for the object on which they are specified. [DOM]
An event
handler has a name, which always starts with "on
"
and is followed by the name of the event for which it is intended.
An event
handler can either have the value null, or be set to a callback
object, or be set to an internal
raw uncompiled handler. The EventHandler
callback function type describes how this is exposed to scripts. Initially,
event handlers must be set to null.
Event handlers are exposed in one of two ways.
The first way, common to all event handlers, is as an event handler IDL attribute.
The second way is as an event handler content attribute.
Event handlers on HTML elements and some of
the event handlers on Window
objects
are exposed in this way.
An event handler IDL attribute is an IDL attribute for a specific event handler. The name of the IDL attribute is the same as the name of the event handler.
Event handler IDL attributes, on setting, must set the corresponding event handler to their new value та on getting, must return the result of getting the current value of the event handler in question (this can throw an exception, in which case the getting propagates it to the caller, it does not catch it).
Якщо an event handler IDL attribute exposes an event handler of an object that doesn't exist, it must always return null on getting and must do nothing on setting.
This can happen in particular for event handler IDL attribute
on body
elements that do
not have corresponding Window
objects.
Certain event handler IDL attributes have additional
requirements, in particular the onmessage
attribute of MessagePort
objects.
An event handler content attribute is a content attribute for a specific event handler. The name of the content attribute is the same as the name of the event handler.
Event handler content
attributes, when specified, must contain valid JavaScript code
which, when parsed, would match the FunctionBody
production after automatic semicolon insertion. [ECMA262]
When an event handler content attribute is set, the user agent must set the corresponding event handler to an internal raw uncompiled handler consisting of the attribute's new value and the script location where the attribute was set to this value
When an event handler content attribute is removed, the user agent must set the corresponding event handler to null.
When an event
handler H of an element or object
T implementing the EventTarget
interface is first set to a non-null value, the user agent must append
an event
listener to the list of event listeners associated with T with type set to the event
handler event type corresponding to H,
capture set to false та listener set to the
event handler processing algorithm defined below. [DOM]
The listener is emphatically not the event handler itself. Every event handler ends up registering the same listener, the algorithm defined below, which takes care of invoking the right callback та processing the callback's return value.
This only happens the first time the event handler's value is set. Since
listeners are called in the order they were registered, the order of
event listeners for a particular event type will always be first the
event listeners registered with addEventListener()
before the first time the event
handler was set to a non-null value, then the callback to which it
is currently set, if any та finally the event listeners registered with
addEventListener()
after the first time the event handler was set to a non-null value.
This example demonstrates the order in which event listeners are invoked. Якщо the button in this example is clicked by the user, the page will show four alerts, with the text "ONE", "TWO", "THREE" та "FOUR" respectively.
<button id="test">Start Demo</button> <script> var button = document.getElementById('test'); button.addEventListener('click', function () { alert('ONE') }, false); button.setAttribute('onclick', "alert('NOT CALLED')"); // event handler listener is registered here button.addEventListener('click', function () { alert('THREE') }, false); button.onclick = function () { alert('TWO'); }; button.addEventListener('click', function () { alert('FOUR') }, false); </script>
The interfaces implemented by the event object do not influence whether an event handler is triggered or not.
The event handler
processing algorithm for an event handler H
and an Event
object E
is as follows:
Нехай callback be the result of getting the current value of the event handler H.
Якщо callback is null, then abort these steps.
Process the Event
object E
as follows:
ErrorEvent
object and the event handler
IDL attribute's type is OnErrorEventHandler
Invoke
callback with five arguments, the
first one having the value of E's
message
attribute, the second having the value of E's
filename
attribute, the third having the value of E's
lineno
attribute, the fourth having the value of E's
colno
attribute, the fifth having the value of E's
error
attribute та with the callback
this value set to E's currentTarget
.
Нехай return value be the
callback's return value. [WEBIDL]
Invoke
callback with one argument, the
value of which is the Event
object E, with the callback
this value set to E's currentTarget
.
Нехай return value be the
callback's return value. [WEBIDL]
In this step, invoke means to run the jump to a code entry-point algorithm.
Process return value as follows:
mouseover
error
and E is an ErrorEvent
objectЯкщо return value is a WebIDL boolean true value, then cancel the event.
beforeunload
The event handler IDL
attribute's type is OnBeforeUnloadEventHandler
та the return value will
therefore have been coerced into either the value null or a
DOMString.
Якщо the return value is null, then cancel the event.
Інакше Якщо the Event
object
E is a BeforeUnloadEvent
object та the Event
object E's returnValue
attribute's value is the empty string, then set the returnValue
attribute's value to return value.
Якщо return value is a WebIDL boolean false value, then cancel the event.
The EventHandler
callback
function type represents a callback used for event handlers. It is
represented in Web IDL as follows:
[TreatNonCallableAsNull] callback EventHandlerNonNull = any (Event event); typedef EventHandlerNonNull? EventHandler;
In JavaScript, any Function
object implements
this interface.
For example, the following document fragment:
<body onload="alert(this)" onclick="alert(this)">
...leads to an alert saying "[object Window]
"
when the document is loaded та an alert saying "[object HTMLBodyElement]
"
whenever the user clicks something in the page.
The return value of the function affects whether the event
is canceled or not: as described above, if the
return value is false, the event is canceled (except for mouseover
events, where the return value has to be true to cancel the event). With beforeunload
events, the
value is instead used to determine the message to show the user.
For historical reasons, the onerror
handler has different
arguments:
[TreatNonCallableAsNull] callback OnErrorEventHandlerNonNull = any ((Event or DOMString) event, optional DOMString source, optional unsigned long lineno, optional unsigned long column, optional any error); typedef OnErrorEventHandlerNonNull? OnErrorEventHandler;
Similarly, the onbeforeunload
handler has a different return value:
[TreatNonCallableAsNull] callback OnBeforeUnloadEventHandlerNonNull = DOMString? (Event event); typedef OnBeforeUnloadEventHandlerNonNull? OnBeforeUnloadEventHandler;
An internal raw uncompiled handler is a tuple with the following information:
When the user agent is to get the current value of the event handler H, it must run these steps:
Якщо H's value is an internal raw uncompiled handler, виконати ці підкроки:
Якщо H is an element's event handler, then let element
be the element та document be
the element's Document
.
Інакше H is a Window
object's event handler: let element
be null та let document be the Document
most recently
associated with that Window
object.
Якщо document is not in a browsing context, or if scripting is enabled for document's browsing context, then return null and abort the algorithm for getting the current value of the event handler.
Нехай body be the uncompiled script body in the internal raw uncompiled handler.
Нехай location be the location where the script body originated, as given by the internal raw uncompiled handler.
Якщо element is not null and element has a form owner, let form owner be that form owner. Інакше let form owner be null.
Нехай script settings be the script settings object
created for the Window
object with which document is
currently associated.
Obtain the script execution environment for JavaScript from script settings.
Якщо body is not parsable as FunctionBody or if parsing detects an early error, then follow these substeps:
Set H's value to null.
Report the error for the appropriate script and with the appropriate position (line number and column number) given by location, using the global object specified by script settings as the target. Якщо the error is still not handled after this, then the error may be reported to the user.
Jump to the step labeled end below.
FunctionBody is defined in ECMAScript edition 5 section 13 Function Definition. Early error is defined in ECMAScript edition 5 section 16 Errors. [ECMA262]
Якщо body begins with a Directive Prologue that contains a Use Strict Directive then let strict be true, otherwise let strict be false.
The terms "Directive Prologue" and "Use Strict Directive" are defined in ECMAScript edition 5 section 14.1 Directive Prologues and the Use Strict Directive. [ECMA262]
Using the script execution environment obtained above, create a function object (as defined in ECMAScript edition 5 section 13.2 Creating Function Objects), with:
onerror
event handler of a Window
objectevent
,
source
, lineno
,
colno
та error
.event
.NewObjectEnvironment() is defined in ECMAScript edition 5 section 10.2.2.3 NewObjectEnvironment (O, E). [ECMA262]
Нехай function be this new function.
Нехай script be a new script.
Нехай script's code entry-point be function.
Нехай script's settings object be script settings.
Set H to function.
End: ПовернутиH's value.
Document
objects та Window
objectsThe following are the event handlers (and
their corresponding event handler event types)
that must be supported by all HTML
elements, as both event
handler content attributes and event
handler IDL attributes; and that must be
supported by all Document
and Window
objects, as event
handler IDL attributes:
Event handler | Event handler event type |
---|---|
onabort
|
abort |
oncancel
|
cancel |
oncanplay
|
canplay
|
oncanplaythrough
|
canplaythrough
|
onchange
|
change
|
onclick
|
click
|
oncuechange
|
cuechange |
ondblclick
|
dblclick
|
ondurationchange
|
durationchange
|
onemptied
|
emptied
|
onended
|
ended
|
oninput
|
input |
oninvalid
|
invalid |
onkeydown
|
keydown
|
onkeypress
|
keypress
|
onkeyup
|
keyup
|
onloadeddata
|
loadeddata
|
onloadedmetadata
|
loadedmetadata
|
onloadstart
|
loadstart
|
onmousedown
|
mousedown
|
onmouseenter
|
mouseenter
|
onmouseleave
|
mouseleave
|
onmousemove
|
mousemove
|
onmouseout
|
mouseout
|
onmouseover
|
mouseover
|
onmouseup
|
mouseup
|
onmousewheel
|
mousewheel
|
onpause
|
pause
|
onplay
|
play
|
onplaying
|
playing
|
onprogress
|
progress
|
onratechange
|
ratechange
|
onreset
|
reset |
onseeked
|
seeked
|
onseeking
|
seeking
|
onselect
|
select
|
onshow
|
show |
onstalled
|
stalled
|
onsubmit
|
submit
|
onsuspend
|
suspend
|
ontimeupdate
|
timeupdate
|
ontoggle
|
toggle |
onvolumechange
|
volumechange
|
onwaiting
|
waiting
|
The following are the event handlers (and
their corresponding event handler event types)
that must be supported by all HTML
elements other than body
and frameset
elements, as both event
handler content attributes and event
handler IDL attributes; that must be
supported by all Document
objects,
as event handler IDL attributes;
and that must be supported by all Window
objects, as event handler IDL
attributes on the Window
objects
themselves та with corresponding event
handler content attributes and event
handler IDL attributes exposed on all body
and frameset
elements що є owned by
that
Window
object's Document
s:
Event handler | Event handler event type |
---|---|
onblur
|
blur
|
onerror
|
error |
onfocus
|
focus
|
onload
|
load |
onresize
|
resize |
onscroll
|
scroll |
The following are the event handlers (and
their corresponding event handler event types)
that must be supported by Window
objects, as event handler IDL
attributes on the Window
objects
themselves та with corresponding event
handler content attributes and event
handler IDL attributes exposed on all body
and frameset
elements що є owned by
that
Window
object's Document
s:
Event handler | Event handler event type |
---|---|
onafterprint
|
afterprint |
onbeforeprint
|
beforeprint |
onbeforeunload
|
beforeunload
|
onhashchange
|
hashchange
|
onmessage
|
message
|
onoffline
|
offline
|
ononline
|
online
|
onpagehide
|
pagehide
|
onpageshow
|
pageshow
|
onpopstate
|
popstate
|
onstorage
|
storage
|
onunload
|
unload
|
The following are the event handlers (and
their corresponding event handler event types)
that must be supported on Document
objects as event handler IDL
attributes:
Event handler | Event handler event type |
---|---|
onreadystatechange
|
readystatechange
|
[NoInterfaceObject] interface GlobalEventHandlers { attribute EventHandler onabort; attribute EventHandler onblur; attribute EventHandler oncancel; attribute EventHandler oncanplay; attribute EventHandler oncanplaythrough; attribute EventHandler onchange; attribute EventHandler onclick; attribute EventHandler oncuechange; attribute EventHandler ondblclick; attribute EventHandler ondurationchange; attribute EventHandler onemptied; attribute EventHandler onended; attribute OnErrorEventHandler onerror; attribute EventHandler onfocus; attribute EventHandler oninput; attribute EventHandler oninvalid; attribute EventHandler onkeydown; attribute EventHandler onkeypress; attribute EventHandler onkeyup; attribute EventHandler onload; attribute EventHandler onloadeddata; attribute EventHandler onloadedmetadata; attribute EventHandler onloadstart; attribute EventHandler onmousedown; [LenientThis] attribute EventHandler onmouseenter; [LenientThis] attribute EventHandler onmouseleave; attribute EventHandler onmousemove; attribute EventHandler onmouseout; attribute EventHandler onmouseover; attribute EventHandler onmouseup; attribute EventHandler onmousewheel; attribute EventHandler onpause; attribute EventHandler onplay; attribute EventHandler onplaying; attribute EventHandler onprogress; attribute EventHandler onratechange; attribute EventHandler onreset; attribute EventHandler onresize; attribute EventHandler onscroll; attribute EventHandler onseeked; attribute EventHandler onseeking; attribute EventHandler onselect; attribute EventHandler onshow; attribute EventHandler onstalled; attribute EventHandler onsubmit; attribute EventHandler onsuspend; attribute EventHandler ontimeupdate; attribute EventHandler ontoggle; attribute EventHandler onvolumechange; attribute EventHandler onwaiting; }; [NoInterfaceObject] interface WindowEventHandlers { attribute EventHandler onafterprint; attribute EventHandler onbeforeprint; attribute OnBeforeUnloadEventHandler onbeforeunload; attribute EventHandler onhashchange; attribute EventHandler onmessage; attribute EventHandler onoffline; attribute EventHandler ononline; attribute EventHandler onpagehide; attribute EventHandler onpageshow; attribute EventHandler onpopstate; attribute EventHandler onstorage; attribute EventHandler onunload; };
Certain operations and methods are defined as firing events on
elements. For example, the click()
method on the HTMLElement
interface is defined as firing a click
event on the element. [DOMEVENTS]
Firing
a simple event named e means
that a trusted
event with the name e, which does not
bubble (except where otherwise stated) and is not cancelable (except
where otherwise stated) та which uses the Event
interface, must be created and dispatched at the given target.
Firing
a synthetic mouse event named e
means that an event with the name e,
which is trusted
(except where otherwise stated), does not bubble (except where otherwise
stated), is not cancelable (except where otherwise stated) та which uses
the MouseEvent
interface, must
be created and dispatched at the given target. The event object must
have its screenX
, screenY
,
clientX
, clientY
та button
attributes initialized to 0,
its ctrlKey
, shiftKey
,
altKey
та metaKey
attributes initialized according to the current state of the key input
device, if any (false for any keys що є not available), its detail
attribute initialized to 1 та its relatedTarget
attribute initialized to null (except where otherwise stated). The getModifierState()
method on the object
must return values appropriately describing the state of the key input
device at the time the event is created.
Firing
a click
event means
firing
a synthetic mouse event named click
,
which bubbles and is cancelable.
The default action of these events is to do nothing except where otherwise stated.
Window
objectWhen an event is dispatched at a DOM node in a Document
in a browsing context, if the event is
not a load
event, the user
agent must act as if, for the purposes of event dispatching, the Window
object is the parent of the Document
object. [DOM]
The atob()
and btoa()
methods allow authors to transform content to and from the base64
encoding.
[NoInterfaceObject] interface WindowBase64 { DOMString btoa(DOMString btoa); DOMString atob(DOMString atob); }; Window implements WindowBase64;
In these APIs, for mnemonic purposes, the "b" can be considered to stand for "binary" та the "a" for "ASCII". In practice, though, for primarily historical reasons, both the input and output of these functions are Unicode strings.
btoa
(
data )Takes the input data, in the form of a Unicode string containing only characters in the range U+0000 to U+00FF, each representing a binary byte with values 0x00 to 0xFF respectively та converts it to its base64 representation, which it returns.
Throws an InvalidCharacterError
exception if the input string contains any out-of-range characters.
atob
(
data )Takes the input data, in the form of a Unicode string containing base64-encoded binary data, decodes it та returns a string consisting of characters in the range U+0000 to U+00FF, each representing a binary byte with values 0x00 to 0xFF respectively, corresponding to that binary data.
Throws an InvalidCharacterError
exception if the input string is not valid base64 data.
The WindowBase64
interface adds to the Window
interface and the WorkerGlobalScope
interface (part of Web
workers).
The btoa()
method must throw an InvalidCharacterError
exception if the method's first argument contains any character whose
code point is greater than U+00FF. Інакше the user agent must convert
that argument to a sequence of octets whose nth
octet is the eight-bit representation of the code point of the nth
character of the argument та then must apply the base64 algorithm to
that sequence of octets та return the result. [RFC4648]
The atob()
method must run the following steps to parse the string passed in the
method's first argument:
Нехай input буде рядком, що буде розібраний.
Нехай position буде вказівником в input, що спочатку вказує на початок рядка.
Remove all space characters from input.
Якщо the length of input divides by 4 leaving no remainder, then: if input ends with one or two "=" (U+003D) characters, remove them from input.
Якщо the length of input divides by
4 leaving a remainder of 1, throw an InvalidCharacterError
exception and abort these steps.
Якщо input contains a character
that is not in the following list of characters and character
ranges, throw an InvalidCharacterError
exception and abort these steps:
Нехай output be a string, initially empty.
Нехай buffer be a buffer that can have bits appended to it, initially empty.
While position does not point past the end of input, виконати ці підкроки:
Find the character pointed to by position in the first column of the following table. Нехай n be the number given in the second cell of the same row.
Character | Number |
---|---|
A | 0 |
B | 1 |
C | 2 |
D | 3 |
E | 4 |
F | 5 |
G | 6 |
H | 7 |
I | 8 |
J | 9 |
K | 10 |
L | 11 |
M | 12 |
N | 13 |
O | 14 |
P | 15 |
Q | 16 |
R | 17 |
S | 18 |
T | 19 |
U | 20 |
V | 21 |
W | 22 |
X | 23 |
Y | 24 |
Z | 25 |
a | 26 |
b | 27 |
c | 28 |
d | 29 |
e | 30 |
f | 31 |
g | 32 |
h | 33 |
i | 34 |
j | 35 |
k | 36 |
l | 37 |
m | 38 |
n | 39 |
o | 40 |
p | 41 |
q | 42 |
r | 43 |
s | 44 |
t | 45 |
u | 46 |
v | 47 |
w | 48 |
x | 49 |
y | 50 |
z | 51 |
0 | 52 |
1 | 53 |
2 | 54 |
3 | 55 |
4 | 56 |
5 | 57 |
6 | 58 |
7 | 59 |
8 | 60 |
9 | 61 |
+ | 62 |
/ | 63 |
Append to buffer the six bits corresponding to number, most significant bit first.
Якщо buffer has accumulated 24 bits, interpret them as three 8-bit big-endian numbers. Append the three characters with code points equal to those numbers to output, in the same order та then empty buffer.
Просуньте position by one character.
Якщо buffer is not empty, it contains either 12 or 18 bits. Якщо it contains 12 bits, discard the last four and interpret the remaining eight as an 8-bit big-endian number. Якщо it contains 18 bits, discard the last two and interpret the remaining 16 as two 8-bit big-endian numbers. Append the one or two characters with code points equal to those one or two numbers to output, in the same order.
The discarded bits mean that, for instance, atob("YQ")
and atob("YR")
both return "a
".
Повернутиoutput.
APIs for dynamically inserting markup into the document interact with the parser та thus their behavior varies depending on whether they are used with HTML documents (and the HTML parser) or XHTML in XML documents (and the XML parser).
The open()
method comes in several variants with different numbers of arguments.
open
(
[ type [, replace
] ] )Causes the Document
to be
replaced in-place, as if it was a new Document
object, but reusing the previous object, which is then returned.
Якщо the type argument is omitted or
has the value "text/html
", then
the resulting Document
has an
HTML parser associated with it, which can be given data to parse using
document.write()
.
Інакше all content passed to document.write()
will be
parsed as plain text.
Якщо the replace argument is present
and has the value "replace
", the
existing entries in the session history for the Document
object are removed.
The method has no effect if the Document
is still, що буде розібраний.
Throws an InvalidStateError
exception if the Document
is an
XML document.
open
(
url, name,
features [, replace
] )Works like the window.open()
method.
Document
objects have an ignore-opens-during-unload
counter, which is used to prevent scripts from invoking the document.open()
method (directly or indirectly) while the document is being unloaded. Initially, the counter
must be set to zero.
When called with two arguments, the document.open()
method must act
as follows:
Якщо the Document
object is
not flagged as an HTML
document, throw an InvalidStateError
exception and abort these steps.
Якщо the Document
object is
not an active document, then abort
these steps.
Нехай type be the value of the first argument.
Якщо the second argument is an ASCII чутливі до реєстру match for the value "replace", then let replace be true.
Інакше if the browsing context's session history contains only one Document
та that was the about:blank
Document
created when the browsing
context was created та that Document
has never had the unload a document
algorithm invoked on it (e.g. by a previous call to document.open()
), then let
replace be true.
Інакше let replace be false.
Якщо the Document
has an active parser whose script
nesting level is greater than zero, then the method does
nothing. Abort these steps and return the Document
object on which the method was invoked.
This basically causes document.open()
to be
ignored when it's called in an inline script found during parsing,
while still letting it have an effect when called asynchronously.
Similarly, if the Document
's
ignore-opens-during-unload
counter is greater than zero, then the method does nothing.
Abort these steps and return the Document
object on which the method was invoked.
This basically causes document.open()
to be
ignored when it's called from a beforeunload
pagehide
,
or unload
event
handler while the Document
is
being unloaded.
Release the storage mutex.
Set the Document
's salvageable state
to false.
Prompt
to unload the Document
object. Якщо the user refused
to allow the document to be unloaded, then abort these steps
and return the Document
object
on which the method was invoked.
Unload
the Document
object, with the
recycle parameter set to true.
Unregister all event listeners registered on the Document
node and its descendants.
Remove any tasks
associated with the Document
in any task source.
Remove all child nodes of the document, without firing any mutation events.
Replace the Document
's
singleton objects with new instances of those objects. (This
includes in particular the Window
,
Location
, History
,
ApplicationCache
та Navigator
, objects, the various BarProp
objects, the two Storage
objects, the various HTMLCollection
objects та objects defined by other specifications, like Selection
and the document's UndoManager
. It also includes all
the Web IDL prototypes in the JavaScript binding, including the Document
object's prototype.)
The new Window
object has a new script settings
object.
Change the document's character encoding to UTF-8.
Якщо the Document
is ready
for post-load tasks, then set the Document
object's reload override flag
та встановити the Document
's reload override buffer to the
empty string.
Set the Document
's salvageable state
back to true.
Change the document's address to the address of the responsible document specified by the entry settings object.
Якщо the Document
's iframe
load in progress flag is set, set the Document
's
mute iframe load flag.
Create a new HTML parser and associate
it with the document. This is a script-created
parser (meaning that it can be closed by the document.open()
and document.close()
methods та that the tokenizer will wait for an explicit call to document.close()
before emitting an end-of-file token). The encoding confidence is irrelevant.
Set the current document
readiness of the document to "loading
".
Якщо type is an ASCII
чутливі до реєстру match for the string "replace
",
then, for historical reasons, set it to the string "text/html
".
Otherwise:
Якщо the type string contains a ";" (U+003B) character, remove the first such character and all characters from it up to the end of the string.
Strip leading and trailing whitespace from type.
Якщо type is not now an ASCII чутливі до реєстру match
for the string "text/html
",
then act as if the tokenizer had emitted a start tag token with the
tag name "pre" followed by a single "LF" (U+000A) character,
then switch the HTML parser's tokenizer
to the PLAINTEXT state.
Remove all the entries in the browsing context's session history after the current entry. Якщо the current entry is the last entry in the session history, then no entries are removed.
This doesn't necessarily have to affect the user agent's user interface.
Remove any tasks
queued by the history
traversal task source що є associated with any Document
objects in the top-level
browsing context's document family.
Document
.Якщо replace is false, then add a
new entry, just before the last entry та associate with the new
entry the text that was parsed by the previous parser associated
with the Document
object, as
well as the state of the document at the start of these steps. This
allows the user to step backwards in the session history to see the
page before it was blown away by the document.open()
call. This
new entry does not have a Document
object, so a new one will be created if the session history is
traversed to that entry.
Finally, set the insertion point to point at just before the end of the input stream (which at this point will be empty).
Повернути Document
on which
the method was invoked.
The document.open()
method does not affect whether a Document
is ready for post-load tasks
or completely loaded.
When called with four arguments, the open()
method on the Document
object must call the open()
method on the Window
object of the Document
object,
with the same arguments as the original call to the open()
method та return
whatever that method returned. Якщо the Document
object has no Window
object, then
the method must throw an InvalidAccessError
exception.
close
()Closes the input stream that was opened by the document.open()
method.
Throws an InvalidStateError
exception if the Document
is an
XML document.
The close()
method must run the following steps:
Якщо the Document
object is
not flagged as an HTML
document, throw an InvalidStateError
exception and abort these steps.
Якщо there is no script-created parser associated with the document, then abort these steps.
Insert an explicit "EOF" character at the end of the parser's input stream.
Якщо there is a pending parsing-blocking script, then abort these steps.
Run the tokenizer, processing resulting tokens as they are emitted та stopping when the tokenizer reaches the explicit "EOF" character or spins the event loop.
document.write()
write
(text...)In general, adds the given string(s) to the Document
's
input stream.
This method has very idiosyncratic behavior. In some
cases, this method can affect the state of the HTML
parser while the parser is running, resulting in a DOM that does
not correspond to the source of the document (e.g. if the string
written is the string "<plaintext>
"
or "<!--
"). In other cases, the
call can clear the current page first, as if document.open()
had been
called. In yet more cases, the method is simply ignored, or throws an
exception. To make matters worse, the exact behavior of this method
can in some cases be dependent on network latency,
which can lead to failures що є very hard to debug. For all
these reasons, use of this method is strongly discouraged.
This method throws an InvalidStateError
exception when invoked on XML documents.
Document
objects have an ignore-destructive-writes
counter, which is used in conjunction with the processing of script
elements to prevent
external scripts from being able to use document.write()
to blow away
the document by implicitly calling document.open()
. Initially, the
counter must be set to zero.
The document.write(...)
method must act as follows:
Якщо the method was invoked on an XML document, throw an InvalidStateError
exception and abort these steps.
Якщо the Document
object is
not an active document, then abort
these steps.
Якщо the insertion point is
undefined and either the Document
's
ignore-opens-during-unload
counter is greater than zero or the Document
's
ignore-destructive-writes
counter is greater than zero, abort these steps.
Якщо the insertion point is
undefined, call the open()
method on the document
object (with no arguments). Якщо the user refused
to allow the document to be unloaded, then abort these steps.
Інакше the insertion point will
point at just before the end of the (empty) input
stream.
Insert the string consisting of the concatenation of all the arguments to the method into the input stream just before the insertion point.
Якщо the Document
object's reload override flag is set, then
append the string consisting of the concatenation of all the
arguments to the method to the Document
's
reload override buffer.
Якщо there is no pending
parsing-blocking script, have the HTML
parser process the characters that were inserted, one at a
time, processing resulting tokens as they are emitted та stopping
when the tokenizer reaches the insertion point or when the
processing of the tokenizer is aborted by the tree construction
stage (this can happen if a script
end tag token is emitted by the tokenizer).
Якщо the document.write()
method
was called from script executing inline (i.e. executing because the
parser parsed a set of script
tags), then this is a reentrant invocation
of the parser.
Finally, return from the method.
document.writeln()
writeln
(text...)Adds the given string(s) to the Document
's
input stream, followed by a newline character. Якщо necessary, calls
the open()
method implicitly first.
This method throws an InvalidStateError
exception when invoked on XML documents.
The document.writeln(...)
method, when invoked, must act as if the document.write()
method had
been invoked with the same argument(s), plus an extra argument
consisting of a string containing a single line feed character (U+000A).
The setTimeout()
та
встановитиInterval()
methods
allow authors to schedule timer-based callbacks.
[NoInterfaceObject] interface WindowTimers { long setTimeout(Function handler, optional long timeout, any... arguments); long setTimeout(DOMString handler, optional long timeout, any... arguments); void clearTimeout(long handle); long setInterval(Function handler, optional long timeout, any... arguments); long setInterval(DOMString handler, optional long timeout, any... arguments); void clearInterval(long handle); }; Window implements WindowTimers;
setTimeout
(
handler [, timeout
[, arguments... ] ] )Schedules a timeout to run handler after timeout milliseconds. Any arguments are passed straight through to the handler.
setTimeout
(
code [, timeout
] )Schedules a timeout to compile and run code after timeout milliseconds.
clearTimeout
( handle )Cancels the timeout set with setTimeout()
identified by handle.
setInterval
(
handler [, timeout
[, arguments... ] ] )Schedules a timeout to run handler every timeout milliseconds. Any arguments are passed straight through to the handler.
setInterval
(
code [, timeout
] )Schedules a timeout to compile and run code every timeout milliseconds.
clearInterval
( handle )Cancels the timeout set with setInterval()
identified by handle.
Timers can be nested; after five such nested timers, however, the interval is forced to be at least four milliseconds.
This API does not guarantee that timers will run exactly on schedule. Delays due to CPU load, other tasks, etc, are to be expected.
The WindowTimers
interface adds to the Window
interface and the WorkerGlobalScope
interface (part of Web
workers).
Each object that implements the WindowTimers
interface has a list of active timers.
Each entry in this lists is identified by a number, which must be unique
within the list for the lifetime of the object that implements the WindowTimers
interface.
The setTimeout()
method must return the value returned by the timer
initialization steps, passing them the method's arguments, the
object on which the method for which the algorithm is running is
implemented (a Window
or WorkerGlobalScope
object) as the method context та the repeat flag set to false.
The setInterval()
method must return the value returned by the timer
initialization steps, passing them the method's arguments, the
object on which the method for which the algorithm is running is
implemented (a Window
or WorkerGlobalScope
object) as the method context та the repeat flag set to true.
The clearTimeout()
and clearInterval()
methods must clear the entry identified as handle
from the list of active timers of
the WindowTimers
object on
which the method was invoked, where handle
is the argument passed to the method, if any. (Якщо handle
does not identify an entry in the list
of active timers of the WindowTimers
object on which the method was invoked, the method does nothing.)
The timer initialization steps, which are invoked with some method arguments, a method context, a repeat flag which can be true or false та optionally (and only if the repeat flag є true) a previous handle, наступні:
Нехай method context proxy be method context if that is a WorkerGlobalScope
object, or else the WindowProxy
that corresponds to method context.
Якщо previous handle was provided, let handle be previous handle; otherwise, let handle be a user-agent-defined integer that is greater than zero that will identify the timeout to be set by this call in the list of active timers.
Якщо previous handle was not provided, add an entry to the list of active timers for handle.
Нехай task be a task that runs the following substeps:
Якщо the entry for handle in the list of active timers has been cleared, then abort this task's substeps.
Run the appropriate set of steps from the following list:
Function
Call the Function
. Use the third and
subsequent method arguments (if any) as the arguments for
invoking the Function
. Use method
context proxy as the thisArg
for invoking the Function
. [ECMA262]
Нехай script source be the first method argument.
Нехай script language be JavaScript.
Нехай settings object be method context's script settings object.
Create a script using script source as the script source, the URL where script source can be found, scripting language as the scripting language та settings object as the script settings object.
Якщо the repeat flag є true, then call timer initialization steps again, passing them the same method arguments, the same method context, with the repeat flag still set to true та with the previous handle set to handler.
Нехай timeout be the second method argument, or zero if the argument was omitted.
Якщо the currently running task is a task that was created by this algorithm, then let nesting level be the task's timer nesting level. Інакше let nesting level be zero.
Якщо nesting level is greater than 5 та timeout is less than 4, then increase timeout to 4.
Increment nesting level by one.
Нехай task's timer nesting level be nesting level.
Повернутиhandle та then continue running this algorithm asynchronously.
Якщо method context is a Window
object, wait until the Document
associated with method
context has been fully active
for a further timeout milliseconds
(not necessarily consecutively).
Інакше method context is a WorkerGlobalScope
object; wait until timeout
milliseconds have passed with the worker not suspended (not
necessarily consecutively).
Wait until any invocations of this algorithm that had the same method context, that started before this one та whose timeout is equal to or less than this one's, have completed.
Argument conversion as defined by Web IDL (for
example, invoking toString()
methods on objects passed as the first argument) happens in the
algorithms defined in Web IDL, before this algorithm is invoked.
So for example, the following rather silly code will result in
the log containing "ONE TWO
":
var log = ''; function logger(s) { log += s + ' '; } setTimeout({ toString: function () { setTimeout("logger('ONE')", 100); return "logger('TWO')"; } }, 100);
Optionally, wait a further user-agent defined length of time.
This is intended to allow user agents to pad timeouts as needed to optimise the power usage of the device. For example, some processors have a low-power mode where the granularity of timers is reduced; on such platforms, user agents can slow timers down to fit this schedule instead of requiring the processor to use the more accurate mode with its associated higher power usage.
Once the task has been processed, if the repeat flag is false, it is safe to remove the entry for handle from the list of active timers (there is no way for the entry's existence to be detected past this point, so it does not technically matter one way or the other).
The task source for these tasks is the timer task source.
To run tasks of several milliseconds back to back without any delay, while still yielding back to the browser to avoid starving the user interface (and to avoid the browser killing the script for hogging the CPU), simply queue the next timer before performing work:
function doExpensiveWork() { var done = false; // ... // this part of the function takes up to five milliseconds // set done to true if we're done // ... return done; } function rescheduleWork() { var handle = setTimeout(rescheduleWork, 0); // preschedule next iteration if (doExpensiveWork()) clearTimeout(handle); // clear the timeout if we don't need it } function scheduleWork() { setTimeout(rescheduleWork, 0); } scheduleWork(); // queues a task to do lots of work
alert
(message)Displays a modal alert with the given message та waits for the user to dismiss it.
A call to the navigator.yieldForStorageUpdates()
method is implied when this method is invoked.
confirm
(message)Displays a modal OK/Cancel prompt with the given message, waits for the user to dismiss it та returns true if the user clicks OK and false if the user clicks Cancel.
A call to the navigator.yieldForStorageUpdates()
method is implied when this method is invoked.
prompt
(message [, default]
)Displays a modal text field prompt with the given message, waits for the user to dismiss it та returns the value that the user entered. Якщо the user cancels the prompt, then returns null instead. Якщо the second argument is present, then the given value is used as a default.
A call to the navigator.yieldForStorageUpdates()
method is implied when this method is invoked.
The alert(message)
method, when
invoked, must run the following steps:
Якщо the event loop's termination nesting level is non-zero, optionally abort these steps.
Release the storage mutex.
Optionally, abort these steps. (For example, the user agent might give the user the option to ignore all alerts та would thus abort at this step whenever the method was invoked.)
Show the given message to the user.
Optionally, pause while waiting for the user to acknowledge the message.
The confirm(message)
method, when
invoked, must run the following steps:
Якщо the event loop's termination nesting level is non-zero, optionally abort these steps, returning false.
Release the storage mutex.
Optionally, return false and abort these steps. (For example, the user agent might give the user the option to ignore all prompts та would thus abort at this step whenever the method was invoked.)
Show the given message to the user та ask the user to respond with a positive or negative response.
Pause until the user responds either positively or negatively.
Якщо the user responded positively, return true; otherwise, the user responded negatively: return false.
The prompt(message, default)
method, when invoked, must run the following steps:
Якщо the event loop's termination nesting level is non-zero, optionally abort these steps, returning null.
Release the storage mutex.
Optionally, return null and abort these steps. (For example, the user agent might give the user the option to ignore all prompts та would thus abort at this step whenever the method was invoked.)
Show the given message to the user та ask the user to either respond with a string value or abort. The response must be defaulted to the value given by default.
Pause while waiting for the user's response.
Якщо the user aborts, then return null; otherwise, return the string that the user responded with.
print
()Prompts the user to print the page.
A call to the navigator.yieldForStorageUpdates()
method is implied when this method is invoked.
When the print()
method is invoked, if the Document
is ready for post-load tasks,
then the user agent must synchronously run the printing
steps. Інакше the user agent must only set the print
when loaded flag on the Document
.
User agents should also run the printing steps whenever the user asks for the opportunity щоб отримати a physical form (e.g. printed copy), or the representation of a physical form (e.g. PDF copy), of a document.
The printing steps наступні:
The user agent may display a message to the user or abort these steps (or both).
For instance, a kiosk browser could silently ignore
any invocations of the print()
method.
For instance, a browser on a mobile device could detect that there are no printers in the vicinity and display a message saying so before continuing to offer a "save to PDF" option.
The user agent must fire a simple
event named beforeprint
at the Window
object of the Document
that is being printed, as
well as any nested browsing contexts in it.
The beforeprint
event can be used to annotate the printed copy, for instance adding
the time at which the document was printed.
The user agent must release the storage mutex.
The user agent should offer the user the opportunity щоб отримати a physical form (or the representation of a physical form) of the document. The user agent may wait for the user to either accept or decline before returning; if so, the user agent must pause while the method is waiting. Even if the user agent doesn't wait at this point, the user agent must use the state of the relevant documents as they are at this point in the algorithm if and when it eventually creates the alternate form.
The user agent must fire a simple
event named afterprint
at the Window
object of the Document
that is being printed, as
well as any nested browsing contexts in it.
The afterprint
event can be used to revert annotations added in the earlier event,
as well as showing post-printing UI. For instance, if a page is
walking the user through the steps of applying for a home loan, the
script could automatically advance to the next step after having
printed a form or other.
Navigator
objectThe navigator
attribute of the Window
interface
must return an instance of the Navigator
interface, which represents the identity and state of the user agent
(the client) та allows Web pages to register themselves as potential
protocol and content handlers:
interface Navigator { // objects implementing this interface also implement the interfaces given below }; Navigator implements NavigatorID; Navigator implements NavigatorLanguage; Navigator implements NavigatorOnLine; Navigator implements NavigatorContentUtils; Navigator implements NavigatorStorageUtils; Navigator implements NavigatorPlugins;
These interfaces are defined separately so that other specifications
can re-use parts of the Navigator
interface.
[NoInterfaceObject] interface NavigatorID { readonly attribute DOMString appCodeName; // constant "Mozilla" readonly attribute DOMString appName; readonly attribute DOMString appVersion; readonly attribute DOMString platform; readonly attribute DOMString product; // constant "Gecko" boolean taintEnabled(); // constant false readonly attribute DOMString userAgent; };
In certain cases, despite the best efforts of the entire industry, Web browsers have bugs and limitations that Web authors are forced to work around.
This section defines a collection of attributes that can be used to determine, from script, the kind of user agent in use, in order to work around these issues.
Client detection should always be limited to detecting known current versions; future versions and unknown versions should always be assumed to be fully compliant.
navigator
. appCodeName
Returns the string "Mozilla
".
navigator
. appName
Returns the name of the browser.
navigator
. appVersion
Returns the version of the browser.
navigator
. platform
Returns the name of the platform.
navigator
. product
Returns the string "Gecko
".
navigator
. taintEnabled
()Returns false.
navigator
. userAgent
Returns the complete User-Agent header.
appCodeName
Must return the string "Mozilla
".
appName
Must return either the string "Netscape
"
or the full name of the browser, e.g. "Mellblom
Browsernator
".
appVersion
Must return either the string "4.0
"
or a string representing the version of the browser in detail, e.g.
"1.0 (VMS; en-US) Mellblomenator/9000
".
platform
Must return either the empty string or a string representing the
platform on which the browser is executing, e.g. "MacIntel
",
"Win32
", "FreeBSD
i386
", "WebTV OS
".
product
Must return the string "Gecko
".
taintEnabled()
Must return false.
userAgent
Must return the string used for the value of the "User-Agent
"
header in HTTP requests, or the empty string if no such header is
ever sent.
Any information in this API that varies from user to
user can be used to profile the user. In fact, if enough such
information is available, a user can actually be uniquely identified.
For this reason, user agent implementors are strongly urged to include
as little information in this API as possible.
[NoInterfaceObject] interface NavigatorLanguage { readonly attribute DOMString? language; };
navigator
. language
Returns a language tag representing the user's preferred language.
language
Must return a valid BCP 47 language tag representing either a plausible language or the user's preferred language. [BCP47]
To determine a plausible language, the user agent should bear in mind the following:
en-US
" is suggested; if all users of the
service use that same value, that reduces the possibility of
distinguishing the users from each other.[NoInterfaceObject] interface NavigatorContentUtils { // content handler registration void registerProtocolHandler(DOMString scheme, DOMString url, DOMString title); void registerContentHandler(DOMString mimeType, DOMString url, DOMString title); void unregisterProtocolHandler(DOMString scheme, DOMString url); void unregisterContentHandler(DOMString mimeType, DOMString url); };
The registerProtocolHandler()
method allows Web sites to register themselves as possible handlers for
particular schemes. For example, an online telephone messaging service
could register itself as a handler of the sms:
scheme, so
that if the user clicks on such a link, he is given the opportunity to use
that Web site. Analogously, the registerContentHandler()
method allows Web sites to register themselves as possible handlers for
content in a particular MIME type. For example,
the same online telephone messaging service could register itself as a
handler for text/vcard
files, so that if the user has no
native application capable of handling vCards, his Web browser can instead
suggest he use that site to view contact information stored on vCards that
he opens. [RFC5724] [RFC6350]
navigator
. registerProtocolHandler
(scheme, url,
title)navigator
. registerContentHandler
(mimeType, url,
title)Registers a handler for the given scheme or content type, at the given URL, with the given title.
The string "%s
" in the URL is used
as a placeholder for where to put the URL of the content to be
handled.
Throws a SecurityError
exception if the user agent blocks the registration (this might happen
if trying to register as a handler for "http", for instance).
Throws a SyntaxError
exception if the "%s
" string is
missing in the URL.
User agents may, within the constraints described in this section, do whatever they like when the methods are called. A UA could, for instance, prompt the user and offer the user the opportunity to add the site to a shortlist of handlers, or make the handlers his default, or cancel the request. UAs could provide such a UI through modal UI or through a non-modal transient notification interface. UAs could also simply silently collect the information, providing it only when relevant to the user.
User agents should keep track of which sites have registered handlers (even if the user has declined such registrations) so that the user is not repeatedly prompted with the same request.
The arguments to the methods have the following meanings and corresponding implementation requirements. The requirements that involve throwing exceptions must be processed in the order given below, stopping at the first exception thrown. (So the exceptions for the first argument take precedence over the exceptions for the second argument.)
registerProtocolHandler()
only)A scheme, such as mailto
or web+auth
.
The scheme must be compared in an ASCII
чутливі до реєстру manner by user agents for the purposes of
comparing with the scheme part of URLs that they consider against
the list of registered handlers.
The scheme value, if it contains a
colon (as in "mailto:
"), will never match anything,
since schemes don't contain colons.
Якщо the registerProtocolHandler()
method is invoked with a scheme that is neither a whitelisted
scheme nor a scheme whose value starts with the substring "web+
" and otherwise contains only lowercase
ASCII letters та whose length is at least five characters
(including the "web+
" prefix), the
user agent must throw a SecurityError
exception.
The following schemes are the whitelisted schemes:
bitcoin
geo
im
irc
ircs
magnet
mailto
mms
news
nntp
sip
sms
smsto
ssh
tel
urn
webcal
wtai
xmpp
This list can be changed. Якщо there are schemes that should be added, please send feedback.
This list excludes any schemes that could reasonably
be expected to be supported inline, e.g. in an iframe
,
such as http
or (more
theoretically) gopher
. Якщо those
were supported, they could potentially be used in man-in-the-middle
attacks, by replacing pages that have frames with such content with
content under the control of the protocol handler. Якщо the user
agent has native support for the schemes, this could further be used
for cookie-theft attacks.
registerContentHandler()
only)A MIME type, such as model/vnd.flatland.3dml
or application/vnd.google-earth.kml+xml
. The MIME
type must be compared in an ASCII
чутливі до реєстру manner by user agents for the purposes of
comparing with MIME types of documents that they consider against
the list of registered handlers.
User agents must compare the given values only to the MIME type/subtype parts of content types, not to the complete type including parameters. Thus, if mimeType values passed to this method include characters such as commas or whitespace, or include MIME parameters, then the handler being registered will never be used.
The type is compared to the MIME type used by the user agent after the sniffing algorithms have been applied.
Якщо the registerContentHandler()
method is invoked with a MIME type that is
in the type blacklist or that the
user agent has deemed a privileged type, the user agent must throw a
SecurityError
exception.
The following MIME types are in the type blacklist:
application/x-www-form-urlencoded
application/xhtml+xml
application/xml
image/gif
image/jpeg
image/png
image/svg+xml
multipart/x-mixed-replace
text/cache-manifest
text/css
text/html
text/ping
text/plain
text/xml
application/rss+xml
and application/atom+xml
This list can be changed. Якщо there are MIME types that should be added, please send feedback.
A string used to build the URL of the page that will handle the requests.
User agents must throw a SyntaxError
exception if the url argument passed
to one of these methods does not contain the exact literal string "%s
".
User agents must throw a SyntaxError
exception if resolving the url
argument relative to the API base URL
specified by the entry settings
object is not successful.
The resulting absolute URL
would by definition not be a valid URL as
it would include the string "%s
"
which is not a valid component in a URL.
User agents must throw a SecurityError
exception if the resulting absolute URL
has an origin that differs from the origin
specified by the entry settings
object.
This is forcibly the case if the %s
placeholder is in the scheme, host, or port parts of the URL.
The resulting absolute URL is the proto-URL. It identifies the handler for the purposes of the methods described below.
When the user agent uses this handler, it must replace the first
occurrence of the exact literal string "%s
"
in the url argument with an escaped
version of the absolute URL of the
content in question (as defined below), then resolve the resulting URL, relative to
the API base URL specified by the entry
settings object at the time the registerContentHandler()
or registerProtocolHandler()
methods were invoked та then navigate
an appropriate browsing context to
the resulting URL using the GET method (or equivalent for non-HTTP
URLs).
To get the escaped version of the absolute URL of the content in question, the user agent must replace every character in that absolute URL that is not a character in the URL default encode set with the result of UTF-8 percent encoding that character.
Якщо the user had visited a site at http://example.com/
that made the following call:
navigator.registerContentHandler('application/x-soup', 'soup?url=%s', 'SoupWeb™')
...and then, much later, while visiting http://www.example.net/
,
clicked on a link such as:
<a href="chickenkïwi.soup">Download our Chicken Kïwi soup!</a>
...then, assuming this chickenkïwi.soup
file was
served with the MIME type application/x-soup
,
the UA might navigate to the following URL:
http://example.com/soup?url=http://www.example.net/chickenk%C3%AFwi.soup
This site could then fetch the chickenkïwi.soup
file and do whatever it is that it does with soup (synthesize it
and ship it to the user, or whatever).
A descriptive title of the handler, which the UA might use to remind the user what the site in question is.
This section does not define how the pages registered by these methods are used, beyond the requirements on how to process the url value (see above). To some extent, the processing model for navigating across documents defines some cases where these methods are relevant, but in general UAs may use this information wherever they would otherwise consider handing content to native plugins or helper applications.
UAs must not use registered content handlers to handle content that was returned as part of a non-GET transaction (or rather, as part of any non-idempotent transaction), as the remote site would not be able to fetch the same data.
In addition to the registration methods, there are also methods for determining if particular handlers have been registered та for unregistering handlers.
navigator
. unregisterProtocolHandler
(scheme, url)navigator
. unregisterContentHandler
(mimeType, url)Unregisters the handler given by the arguments.
The handler state strings are the following strings. Each string describes several situations, as given by the following list.
new
registered
declined
The unregisterProtocolHandler()
method must unregister the handler described by the two arguments to the
method, where the first argument gives the scheme and the second gives
the string used to build the URL of the page that will
handle the requests.
The first argument must be compared to the schemes for which custom protocol handlers are registered in an ASCII чутливі до реєстру manner to find the relevant handlers.
The second argument must be preprocessed as described below та if that is successful, must then be matched against the proto-URLs of the relevant handlers to find the described handler.
The unregisterContentHandler()
method must unregister the handler described by the two arguments to the
method, where the first argument gives the MIME
type and the second gives the string used to build the URL
of the page that will handle the requests.
The first argument must be compared to the MIME types for which custom content handlers are registered in an ASCII чутливі до реєстру manner to find the relevant handlers.
The second argument must be preprocessed as described below та if that is successful, must then be matched against the proto-URLs of the relevant handlers to find the described handler.
The second argument of the four methods described above must be preprocessed as follows:
Якщо the string does not contain the substring "%s
",
abort these steps. There's no matching handler.
Resolve the string relative to the API base URL specified by the entry settings object.
Якщо this fails, then throw a SyntaxError
exception, aborting the method.
Якщо the resulting absolute URL's origin is not the same
origin as the origin specified by the
entry settings object, throw a
SecurityError
exception,
aborting the method.
Повернути resulting absolute URL as the result of preprocessing the argument.
These mechanisms can introduce a number of concerns, in particular privacy concerns.
Hijacking all Web usage. User agents should not allow
schemes що є key to its normal operation, such as http
or
https
, to be rerouted through third-party sites. This would
allow a user's activities to be trivially tracked та would allow user
information, even in secure connections, to be collected.
Hijacking defaults. User agents are strongly urged to not automatically change any defaults, as this could lead the user to send data to remote hosts that the user is not expecting. New handlers registering themselves should never automatically cause those sites to be used.
Registration spamming. User agents should consider the
possibility that a site will attempt to register a large number of
handlers, possibly from multiple domains (e.g. by redirecting through a
series of pages each on a different domain та each registering a handler
for video/mpeg
— analogous practices abusing other Web
browser features have been used by pornography Web sites for many
years). User agents should gracefully handle such hostile attempts,
protecting the user.
Misleading titles. User agents should not rely wholly
on the title argument to the methods
when presenting the registered handlers to the user, since sites could
easily lie. For example, a site hostile.example.net
could
claim that it was registering the "Cuddly Bear Happy Content Handler".
User agents should therefore use the handler's domain in any UI along
with any title.
Hostile handler metadata. User agents should protect against typical attacks against strings embedded in their interface, for example ensuring that markup or escape characters in such strings are not executed, that null bytes are properly handled, that over-long strings do not cause crashes or buffer overruns та so forth.
Leaking Intranet URLs. The mechanism described in this section can result in secret Intranet URLs being leaked, in the following manner:
No actual confidential file data is leaked in this manner, but the URLs
themselves could contain confidential information. For example, the URL
could be http://www.corp.example.com/upcoming-aquisitions/the-sample-company.egf
,
which might tell the third party that Example Corporation is intending
to merge with The Sample Company. Implementors might wish to consider
allowing administrators to disable this feature for certain subdomains,
content types, or schemes.
Leaking secure URLs. User agents should not send HTTPS
URLs to third-party sites registered as content handlers without the
user's informed consent, for the same reason that user agents sometimes
avoid sending Referer
(sic) HTTP headers from secure sites to third-party sites.
Leaking credentials. User agents must never send username or password information in the URLs що є escaped and included sent to the handler sites. User agents may even avoid attempting to pass to Web-based handlers the URLs of resources що є known to require authentication to access, as such sites would be unable to access the resources in question without prompting the user for credentials themselves (a practice that would require the user to know whether to trust the third-party handler, a decision many users are unable to make or even understand).
Interface interference. User agents should be prepared to handle intentionally long arguments to the methods. For example, if the user interface exposed consists of an "accept" button and a "deny" button, with the "accept" binding containing the name of the handler, it's important that a long name not cause the "deny" button to be pushed off the screen.
Fingerprinting users. Since a site can detect if it has attempted to register a particular handler or not, whether or not the user responds, the mechanism can be used to store data. User agents are therefore strongly urged to treat registrations in the same manner as cookies: clearing cookies for a site should also clear all registrations for that site та disabling cookies for a site should also disable registrations.
Цей розділ не є нормативним.
A simple implementation of this feature for a desktop Web browser might work as follows.
The registerContentHandler()
method could display a modal dialog box:
In this dialog box, "Kittens at work" is the title of the page that
invoked the method, "http://kittens.example.org/" is the URL of that
page, "application/x-meowmeow" is the string that was passed to the registerContentHandler()
method as its first argument (mimeType),
"http://kittens.example.org/?show=%s" was the second argument (url)
та "Kittens-at-work displayer" was the third argument (title).
Якщо the user clicks the Cancel button, then nothing further happens. Якщо the user clicks the "Trust" button, then the handler is remembered.
When the user then attempts to fetch a URL that uses the "application/x-meowmeow" MIME type, then it might display a dialog as follows:
In this dialog, the third option is the one that was primed by the site registering itself earlier.
Якщо the user does select that option, then the browser, in accordance with the requirements described in the previous two sections, will redirect the user to "http://kittens.example.org/?show=data%3Aapplication/x-meowmeow;base64,S2l0dGVucyBhcmUgdGhlIGN1dGVzdCE%253D".
The registerProtocolHandler()
method would work equivalently, but for schemes instead of unknown
content types.
[NoInterfaceObject] interface NavigatorStorageUtils { readonly attribute boolean cookieEnabled; void yieldForStorageUpdates(); };
navigator
. cookieEnabled
Returns false if setting a cookie will be ignored та true otherwise.
navigator
. yieldForStorageUpdates
()Якщо a script uses the document.cookie
API, or the
localStorage
API, the
browser will block other scripts from accessing cookies or storage
until the first script finishes. [WEBSTORAGE]
Calling the navigator.yieldForStorageUpdates()
method tells the user agent to unblock any other scripts that may be
blocked, even though the script hasn't returned.
Values of cookies and items in the Storage
objects of localStorage
attributes
can change after calling this method, whence its name. [WEBSTORAGE]
The cookieEnabled
attribute must return true if the user agent attempts to handle cookies
according to the cookie specification та false if it ignores cookie
change requests. [COOKIES]
The yieldForStorageUpdates()
method, when invoked, must, if the storage
mutex is owned by the event loop of the
task that
resulted in the method being called, release the storage
mutex so that it is once again free. Інакше it must do nothing.
[NoInterfaceObject] interface NavigatorPlugins { readonly attribute PluginArray plugins; readonly attribute MimeTypeArray mimeTypes; readonly attribute boolean javaEnabled; }; interface PluginArray { void refresh(optional boolean reload = false); readonly attribute unsigned long length; getter Plugin? item(unsigned long index); getter Plugin? namedItem(DOMString name); }; interface MimeTypeArray { readonly attribute unsigned long length; getter MimeType? item(unsigned long index); getter MimeType? namedItem(DOMString name); }; interface Plugin { readonly attribute DOMString name; readonly attribute DOMString description; readonly attribute DOMString filename; readonly attribute unsigned long length; getter MimeType? item(unsigned long index); getter MimeType? namedItem(DOMString name); }; interface MimeType { readonly attribute DOMString type; readonly attribute DOMString description; readonly attribute DOMString suffixes; // comma-separated readonly attribute Plugin enabledPlugin; };
navigator
. plugins
. refresh
( [ refresh
] )Updates the lists of supported plugins and MIME types for this page та reloads the page if the lists have changed.
navigator
. plugins
. length
Returns the number of plugins, represented by Plugin
objects, that the user agent
reports.
navigator
. plugins
. item
(index)navigator
. plugins
[index]Returns the specified Plugin
object.
navigator
. plugins
. item
(name)navigator
. plugins
[name]Returns the Plugin
object for the plugin with the given name.
navigator
. mimeTypes
. length
Returns the number of MIME types, represented by MimeType
objects, supported by the plugins that the user agent reports.
navigator
. mimeTypes
. item
(index)navigator
. mimeTypes
[index]Returns the specified MimeType
object.
navigator
. mimeTypes
. item
(name)navigator
. mimeTypes
[name]Returns the MimeType
object for
the given MIME type.
name
Returns the plugin's name.
description
Returns the plugin's description.
filename
Returns the plugin library's filename, if applicable on the current platform.
length
Returns the number of MIME types, represented by MimeType
objects, supported by the plugin.
item
(index)Returns the specified MimeType
object.
item
(name)Returns the MimeType
object for
the given MIME type.
type
Returns the MIME type.
description
Returns the MIME type's description.
suffixes
Returns the MIME type's typical file extensions, in a comma-separated list.
enabledPlugin
Returns the Plugin
object that implements this MIME type.
navigator
. javaEnabled
Returns true if there's a plugin that supports the MIME type "application/x-java-vm
".
The navigator.plugins
attribute must return a PluginArray
object. The same object must be returned each time.
The navigator.mimeTypes
attribute must return a MimeTypeArray
object. The same object must be returned each time.
A PluginArray
object
represents none, some, or all of the plugins
supported by the user agent, each of which is represented by a Plugin
object. Each of these Plugin
objects may be hidden plugins. A hidden
plugin can't be enumerated, but can still be inspected by using
its name.
The fewer plugins
are represented by the PluginArray
object та of those, the more що є hidden, the more the user's privacy will be
protected. Each exposed plugin increases the number of bits that can be
derived for fingerprinting. Hiding a plugin helps, but unless it is an
extremely rare plugin, it is likely that a site attempting to derive the
list of plugins can still determine whether the plugin is supported or
not by probing for it by name (the names of popular plugins are widely
known). Therefore not exposing a plugin at all is preferred.
Unfortunately, many legacy sites use this feature to determine, for
example, which plugin to use to play video. Not exposing any plugins at
all might therefore not be entirely plausible.
The PluginArray
objects
created by a user agent must not be live. The set
of plugins represented by the objects must not change once an object is
created, except when it is updated by the refresh()
method.
Each plugin represented by a PluginArray
can support a number of MIME
types. For each such plugin, the user agent
must pick one or more of these MIME
types to be those що є explicitly
supported.
The explicitly supported
MIME types of a plugin are those що є exposed through the Plugin
and MimeTypeArray
interfaces. As with plugins
themselves, any variation between users regarding what is exposed allows
sites to fingerprint users. User agents are therefore encouraged to
expose the same MIME
types for all users of a plugin, regardless
of the actual types supported... at least, within the constraints
imposed by compatibility with legacy content.
The supported property indices
of a PluginArray
object are the
numbers from zero to the number of non-hidden plugins
represented by the object, if any.
The length
attribute must return the number of non-hidden plugins
represented by the object.
The item()
method of a PluginArray
object
must return null if the argument is not one of the object's supported
property indices та otherwise must return the result of running
the following steps, using the method's argument as index:
Нехай list be the Plugin
objects representing the
non-hidden
plugins represented
by the PluginArray
object.
Повернути indexth entry in list.
It is important for privacy that the order of plugins not leak additional information, e.g. the order in which plugins were installed.
The supported property names
of a PluginArray
object are the
values of the name
attributes of all the Plugin
objects represented by the PluginArray
object. The properties exposed in this way must not be enumerable.
The namedItem()
method of a PluginArray
object
must return null if the argument is not one of the object's supported
property names та otherwise must return the Plugin
object, of those represented by
the PluginArray
object, that
has a name
equal to the method's argument.
The refresh()
method of the PluginArray
object of a Navigator
object,
when invoked, must check to see if any plugins
have been installed or reconfigured since the user agent created the PluginArray
object. Якщо so та the
method's argument є true, then the user agent must act as if the location.reload()
method was called instead. Інакше the user agent must update the PluginArray
object and MimeTypeArray
object created for attributes of that Navigator
object та the Plugin
and MimeType
objects created for
those PluginArray
and MimeTypeArray
objects, using the
same Plugin
objects for cases where the name
is the same та the same MimeType
objects for cases where the type
is the same та creating new objects for cases where there were no
matching objects immediately prior to the refresh()
call. Old Plugin
and MimeType
objects must continue
to return the same values that they had prior to the update, though
naturally now the data is stale and may appear inconsistent (for
example, an old MimeType
entry
might list as its enabledPlugin
a Plugin
object that no longer lists that MimeType
as a supported MimeType
).
A MimeTypeArray
object
represents the MIME
types explicitly supported by
plugins supported by the
user agent, each of which is represented by a MimeType
object.
The MimeTypeArray
objects
created by a user agent must not be live. The set
of MIME types represented by the objects must not change once an object
is created, except when it is updated by the PluginArray
object's refresh()
method.
The supported property indices
of a MimeTypeArray
object are
the numbers from zero to the number of MIME types explicitly
supported by non-hidden
plugins represented by
the corresponding PluginArray
object, if any.
The length
attribute must return the number of MIME
types explicitly supported by
non-hidden
plugins represented by
the corresponding PluginArray
object, if any.
The item()
method of a MimeTypeArray
object must return null if the argument is not one of the object's supported
property indices та otherwise must return the result of running
the following steps, using the method's argument as index:
Нехай list be the MimeType
objects representing the MIME
types explicitly supported
by non-hidden plugins
represented by the corresponding PluginArray
object, if any.
Повернути indexth entry in list.
It is important for privacy that the order of MIME types not leak additional information, e.g. the order in which plugins were installed.
The supported property names
of a MimeTypeArray
object are
the values of the type
attributes of all the MimeType
objects represented by the MimeTypeArray
object. The properties exposed in this way must not be enumerable.
The namedItem()
method of a MimeTypeArray
object must return null if the argument is not one of the object's supported
property names та otherwise must return the MimeType
object that has a type
equal to the method's argument.
A Plugin
object represents a plugin. It has several
attributes to provide details about the plugin та can be enumerated щоб
отримати the list of MIME
types that it explicitly
supports.
The Plugin
objects created by a user agent must not be live.
The set of MIME types represented by the objects та the values of the
objects' attributes, must not change once an object is created, except
when updated by the PluginArray
object's refresh()
method.
The reported MIME types for a Plugin
object are the MIME
types explicitly supported by
the corresponding plugin when this object was
last created or updated by PluginArray.refresh()
,
whichever happened most recently.
The supported property indices
of a Plugin
object are the numbers from zero to the number of reported
MIME types.
The length
attribute must return the number of reported
MIME types.
The item()
method of a Plugin
object must return null if the argument is not one of the object's supported
property indices та otherwise must return the result of running
the following steps, using the method's argument as index:
Нехай list be the MimeType
objects representing the reported
MIME types.
Повернути indexth entry in list.
It is important for privacy that the order of MIME types not leak additional information, e.g. the order in which plugins were installed.
The supported property names
of a Plugin
object are the values of the type
attributes of the MimeType
objects representing the reported
MIME types. The properties exposed in this way must not be
enumerable.
The namedItem()
method of a Plugin
object must return null if the argument is not one of the object's supported
property names та otherwise must return the MimeType
object that has a type
equal to the method's argument.
The name
attribute must return the plugin's name.
The description
and filename
attributes must return user-agent-defined (or, in all likelihood, plugin-defined)
strings. In each case, the same string must be returned each time,
except that the strings returned may change when the PluginArray.refresh()
method updates the object.
Якщо the values returned by the description
or filename
attributes vary
between versions of a plugin, they can be used
both as a fingerprinting vector and, even more importantly, as a trivial
way to determine what security vulnerabilities a plugin
(and thus a browser) may have. It is thus highly recommended that the description
attribute just return the same value as the name
attribute та that the filename
attribute return the empty string.
A MimeType
object represents a MIME type that is, or was, explicitly
supported by a plugin.
The MimeType
objects created by a
user agent must not be live. The values of the
objects' attributes must not change once an object is created, except
when updated by the PluginArray
object's refresh()
method.
The type
attribute must return the valid
MIME type with no parameters describing the MIME
type.
The description
and suffixes
attributes must return user-agent-defined (or, in all likelihood, plugin-defined)
strings. In each case, the same string must be returned each time,
except that the strings returned may change when the PluginArray.refresh()
method updates the object.
Якщо the values returned by the description
or suffxies
attributes vary
between versions of a plugin, they can be used
both as a fingerprinting vector and, even more importantly, as a trivial
way to determine what security vulnerabilities a plugin
(and thus a browser) may have. It is thus highly recommended that the description
attribute just return the same value as the type
attribute та that the suffixes
attribute return the empty string.
Commas in the suffixes
attribute are
interpreted as separating subsequent filename extensions, as in "htm,html
".
The enabledPlugin
attribute must return the Plugin
object that represents the plugin that explicitly
supported the MIME type that this MimeType
object represents when this
object was last created or updated by PluginArray.refresh()
,
whichever happened most recently.
The navigator.javaEnabled
attribute must return true if the user agent supports a plugin
that supports the MIME type "application/x-java-vm
".
External
interfaceThe external
attribute of the Window
interface
must return an instance of the External
interface. The same object must be returned each time.
interface External { void AddSearchProvider(DOMString engineURL); unsigned long IsSearchProviderInstalled(DOMString engineURL); };
external
. AddSearchProvider
(
url )Adds the search engine described by the OpenSearch description document at url. [OPENSEARCH]
The OpenSearch description document has to be on the same server as the script that calls this method.
external
. IsSearchProviderInstalled
(
url )Returns a value based on comparing url to the URLs of the results pages of the installed search engines.
The url is compared to the URLs of the results pages of the installed search engines using a prefix match. Only results pages on the same domain as the script that calls this method are checked.
Another way of exposing search engines using OpenSearch
description documents is using a link
element with the search
link type.
The AddSearchProvider()
method, when invoked, must run the following steps:
Optionally, abort these steps. User agents may implement the method as a stub method that never does anything, or may arbitrarily ignore invocations with particular arguments for security, privacy, or usability reasons.
Resolve the value of the method's first argument relative to the API base URL specified by the entry settings object.
Якщо this fails, abort these steps.
Process the resulting absolute URL as the URL to an OpenSearch description document. [OPENSEARCH]
The IsSearchProviderInstalled()
method, when invoked, must run the following steps:
Optionally, return 0 and abort these steps. User agents may implement the method as a stub method that never returns a non-zero value, or may arbitrarily ignore invocations with particular arguments for security, privacy, or usability reasons.
Якщо the origin specified by the entry settings object is an opaque identifier (i.e. it has no host component), then return 0 and abort these steps.
Нехай host1 be the host component of the origin specified by the entry settings object.
Resolve the scriptURL argument relative to the API base URL specified by the entry settings object.
Якщо this fails, return 0 and abort these steps.
Нехай host2 be the host component of the resulting parsed URL.
Якщо the longest suffix in the Public Suffix List that matches the end of host1 is different than the longest suffix in the Public Suffix List that matches the end of host2, then return 0 and abort these steps. [PSL]
Якщо the next domain component of host1 and host2 after their common suffix are not the same, then return 0 and abort these steps.
Нехай search engines be the list of
search engines known by the user agent and made available to the
user by the user agent for which the resulting absolute
URL is a prefix match of the
search engine's URL, if any. For search engines
registered using OpenSearch description documents, the URL
of the search engine corresponds to the URL given in a Url
element whose rel
attribute is "results
" (the default). [OPENSEARCH]
Якщо search engines is empty, return 0 and abort these steps.
Якщо the user's default search engine (as determined by the user agent) is one of the search engines in search engines, then return 2 and abort these steps.
Повернути1.
hidden
attributeAll HTML elements may have the hidden
content attribute set.
The hidden
attribute is a boolean attribute. When
specified on an element, it indicates that the element is not yet, or is
no longer, directly relevant to the page's current state, or that it is
being used to declare content to be reused by other parts of the page as
opposed to being directly accessed by the user. User
agents should not render elements that have the hidden
attribute specified.
This requirement may be implemented indirectly through the style layer.
For example, an HTML+CSS user agent could implement these requirements using the rules suggested in the Rendering section.
Because this attribute is typically implemented using CSS,
it's also possible to override it using CSS. For instance, a rule that
applies 'display: block' to all elements will cancel the effects of the hidden
attribute. Authors therefore have to take care when writing their style
sheets to make sure that the attribute is still styled as expected.
In the following skeletal example, the attribute is used to hide the Web game's main screen until the user logs in:
<h1>The Example Game</h1> <section id="login"> <h2>Login</h2> <form> ... <!-- calls login() once the user's credentials have been checked --> </form> <script> function login() { // switch screens document.getElementById('login').hidden = true; document.getElementById('game').hidden = false; } </script> </section> <section id="game" hidden> ... </section>
The hidden
attribute must not be used to hide content that could legitimately be
shown in another presentation. For example, it is incorrect to use hidden
to hide panels in a tabbed dialog, because the tabbed interface is merely
a kind of overflow presentation — one could equally well just show all the
form controls in one big page with a scrollbar. It is similarly incorrect
to use this attribute to hide content just from one presentation — if
something is marked hidden
,
it is hidden from all presentations, including, for instance, printers.
Elements що є not themselves hidden
must not hyperlink to elements що є hidden
. The for
attributes of label
and output
elements що є not
themselves hidden
must similarly not refer to elements що є hidden
. In both cases, such
references would cause user confusion.
Elements and scripts may, however, refer to elements що є hidden
in other contexts.
For example, it would be incorrect to use the href
attribute to link to a
section marked with the hidden
attribute. Якщо the content is not applicable or relevant, then there is
no reason to link to it.
It would be fine, however, to use the ARIA aria-describedby
attribute to refer to descriptions що є themselves hidden
. While hiding the
descriptions implies that they are not useful alone, they could be
written in such a way that they are useful in the specific context of
being referenced from the images that they describe.
Similarly, a canvas
element with the hidden
attribute could be used by a scripted graphics engine as an off-screen
buffer та a form control could refer to a hidden form
element using its form
attribute.
Accessibility APIs are encouraged to provide a way to expose structured content while marking it as hidden in the default view. Such content should not be perceivable to users in the normal document flow in any modality, whether using Assistive Technology (AT) or mainstream User Agents.
When such features are available, User Agents may use them to expose the
full semantics of hidden
elements to AT when appropriate, if such content is referenced indirectly
by an ID reference
or valid hash-name reference.
This allows ATs to access the structure of these hidden
elements upon user
request, while keeping the content hidden in all presentations of the
normal document flow. Authors who wish to prevent user-initiated viewing
of a hidden
element should not reference the element with such a mechanism.
Because some User Agents have flattened hidden content when
exposing such content to AT, authors should not reference hidden
content which would
lose essential meaning when flattened.
For example, it would be incorrect to use the href
attribute to link to a
section marked with the hidden
attribute. Якщо the content is not applicable or relevant, then there is
no reason to link to it.
It would be fine, however, to use the ARIA aria-describedby
attribute to refer to descriptions що є themselves hidden
. While hiding the
descriptions implies that they are not useful alone, they could be
written in such a way that they are useful in the specific context of
being referenced from the images that they describe.
Similarly, a canvas
element with the hidden
attribute could be used by a scripted graphics engine as an off-screen
buffer та a form control could refer to a hidden form
element using its form
attribute.
Elements in a section hidden by the hidden
attribute are still
active, e.g. scripts and form controls in such sections still execute and
submit respectively. Only their presentation to the user changes.
The hidden
IDL attribute must reflect the content attribute
of the same name.
A node (in particular elements and text nodes) can be marked as inert. When a node is inert, then the user agent must act as if the node was absent for the purposes of targeting user interaction events, may ignore the node for the purposes of text search user interfaces (commonly known as "find in page") та may prevent the user from selecting text in that node. User agents should allow the user to override the restrictions on search and text selection, however.
For example, consider a page that consists of just a
single inert paragraph positioned in the middle of a
body
. Якщо a user moves their
pointing device from the body
over to the inert paragraph and clicks on the
paragraph, no mouseover
event would be fired та the mousemove
and click
events would be fired on the body
element rather than the paragraph.
When a node is inert, it also can't be focusable.
An entire Document
can be marked as
blocked by a modal dialog subject. While a Document
is so marked, every node that is in
the Document
, with the exception of the subject
element and its descendants, must be marked inert.
(The elements excepted by this paragraph can additionally be marked inert
through other means; being part of a modal dialog does not "protect" a
node from being marked inert.)
Only one element at a time can mark a Document
as being blocked by a modal dialog.
click
()Acts as if the element was clicked.
The click()
method must run
synthetic click activation steps on the element.
When an element is focused, key events received by the document
must be targeted at that element. There may be no element focused; when
no element is focused, key events received by the document must be
targeted at the body element, if
there is one, or else at the Document
's
root element, if there is one. Якщо there is no root element, key events
must not be fired.
User agents may track focus for each browsing
context or Document
individually, or may support only one focused element per top-level
browsing context — user agents should follow platform conventions
in this regard.
Which elements within a top-level browsing context currently have focus must be independent of whether or not the top-level browsing context itself has the system focus.
When a child browsing context is focused, its browsing context container must also have focus.
When an element is focused, the element matches the CSS :focus
pseudo-class.
tabindex
attributeThe tabindex
content attribute allows authors to control whether an element is supposed
to be focusable, whether it is supposed to be reachable using sequential
focus navigation та what is to be the relative order of the element for
the purposes of sequential focus navigation. The name "tab index" comes
from the common use of the "tab" key to navigate through the focusable
elements. The term "tabbing" refers to moving forward through the
focusable elements that can be reached using sequential focus navigation.
The tabindex
attribute, if specified, must have a value that is a valid
integer.
Each element can have a tabindex focus flag set, as defined below. This flag is a factor that contributes towards determining whether an element is focusable, as described in the next section.
Якщо the attribute is specified, it must be parsed using the rules for parsing integers. The attribute's values have the following meanings:
The user agent should follow platform conventions to determine if the element's tabindex focus flag is set and, if so, whether the element can be reached using sequential focus navigation та if so, what its relative order should be.
Modulo platform conventions, it is suggested that for the following elements, the tabindex focus flag be set:
a
elements that have
an href
attributelink
elements that
have an href
attributebutton
elementsinput
elements
whose type
attribute are not in the Hidden stateselect
elementstextarea
elementsOne valid reason to ignore the platform conventions and always allow an element to be focused (by setting its tabindex focus flag) would be if the user's only mechanism for activating an element is through a keyboard action that triggers the focused element.
The user agent must set the element's tabindex focus flag, but should not allow the element to be reached using sequential focus navigation.
One valid reason to ignore the requirement that
sequential focus navigation not allow the author to lead to the
element would be if the user's only mechanism for moving the focus
is sequential focus navigation. For instance, a keyboard-only user
would be unable to click on a text field with a negative tabindex
, so that user's user
agent would be well justified in allowing the user to tab to the
control regardless.
The user agent must set the element's tabindex focus flag, should allow the element to be reached using sequential focus navigation та should follow platform conventions to determine the element's relative order.
The user agent must set the element's tabindex focus flag, should allow the element to be reached using sequential focus navigation та should place the element in the sequential focus navigation order so that it is:
tabindex
attribute has been omitted or whose value, when parsed, returns an
error,tabindex
attribute has a value equal to or less than zero,tabindex
attribute has a
value greater than zero but less than the value of the tabindex
attribute on the
element,tabindex
attribute has a
value equal to the value of the tabindex
attribute on the
element but that is earlier in the document in tree
order than the element,tabindex
attribute has a
value equal to the value of the tabindex
attribute on the
element but that is later in the document in tree
order than the element таtabindex
attribute has a
value greater than the value of the tabindex
attribute on the
element.An element that has its tabindex focus flag set but does not otherwise have an activation behavior defined has an activation behavior that does nothing.
This means that an element that is only focusable because
of its tabindex
attribute will fire a click
event in response to a non-mouse activation (e.g. hitting the "enter"
key while the element is focused).
The tabIndex
IDL attribute must reflect the value of the tabindex
content attribute. Its default value is 0 for elements що є focusable
and −1 for elements що є not focusable.
An element is focusable if all of the following conditions are met:
canvas
element that represents embedded
content.In addition, each shape that is generated for an area
element, any user-agent-provided interface components of media elements (e.g. a play button) та
distinct user interface components of form controls (e.g. "up" and
"down" buttons on an <input type=number>
spin control), should be focusable, unless
platform conventions dictate otherwise or unless their corresponding
element is disabled.
(A single area
element can
correspond to multiple shapes, since image maps can be reused with
multiple images on a page.)
Notwithstanding the above, user agents may make any element or part of an element focusable, especially to aid with accessibility or to better match platform conventions.
The focusing steps for an element наступні:
Якщо the element is not in
a Document
, or if the element's Document
has no browsing context, or if the
element's Document
's browsing
context has no top-level
browsing context, or if the element is not focusable,
or if the element is already focused, then abort these steps.
Якщо focusing the element will remove the focus from another element, then run the unfocusing steps for that element.
Make the element the currently focused element in its top-level browsing context.
Some elements, most notably area
,
can correspond to more than one distinct focusable area. Якщо a
particular area was indicated when the element was focused, then
that is the area that must get focus; otherwise, e.g. when using the
focus()
method, the first such region in tree order is the one that must be
focused.
The user agent may apply relevant platform-specific conventions for focusing widgets.
For example, some platforms select the contents of a text field when that field is focused.
Fire a simple event named focus
at the element.
User agents must synchronously run the focusing steps for an element whenever the user moves the focus to a focusable element.
The unfocusing steps for an element наступні:
Якщо the element is an input
element та the change
event applies to the element та the element does not have a defined
activation behavior та the user
has changed the element's value
or its list of selected files while
the control was focused without committing that change, then fire
a simple event that bubbles named change
at the element.
Unfocus the element.
Fire a simple event named blur
at the element.
When an element that is focused stops being a focusable element, or stops being focused without another element being explicitly focused in its stead, the user agent should synchronously run the unfocusing steps for the affected element only.
For example, this might happen because the element is
removed from its Document
, or has
a hidden
attribute added. It would also happen to an input
element when the element gets disabled.
activeElement
Returns the currently focused element.
hasFocus
()Returns true if the document has focus; otherwise, returns false.
focus
()Focuses the window. Use of this method is discouraged. Allow the user to control window focus instead.
blur
()Unfocuses the window. Use of this method is discouraged. Allow the user to control window focus instead.
The activeElement
attribute on Document
objects must
return the element in the document that is focused. Якщо no element in
the Document
is focused, this must
return the body element.
When a child browsing
context is focused, its browsing
context container is also focused, by
definition. For example, if the user moves the focus to a text
field in an iframe
, the
iframe
is the element
with focus in the parent browsing
context.
The hasFocus()
method on Document
objects must
return true if the Document
's browsing context is focused та all its ancestor
browsing contexts are also focused та the top-level
browsing context has the system focus. Якщо the Document
has no browsing
context or if its browsing context
has no top-level browsing context,
then the method will always return false.
The focus()
method on the Window
object, when
invoked, provides a hint to the user agent that the script believes the
user might be interested in the contents of the browsing
context of the Window
object
on which the method was invoked.
User agents are encouraged to have this focus()
method trigger some kind
of notification.
The blur()
method on the Window
object, when
invoked, provides a hint to the user agent that the script believes the
user probably is not currently interested in the contents of the browsing
context of the Window
object
on which the method was invoked, but that the contents might become
interesting again in the future.
User agents are encouraged to ignore calls to this blur()
method entirely.
Historically the focus()
and blur()
methods actually affected
the system focus, but hostile sites widely abuse this behavior to the
user's detriment.
focus
()Focuses the element.
blur
()Unfocuses the element. Use of this method is discouraged. Focus another element instead.
Do not use this method to hide the focus ring. Do not use any other method that hides the focus ring from keyboard users, in particular do not use a CSS rule to override the 'outline' property. Removal of the focus ring leads to serious accessibility issues for users who navigate and interact with interactive content using the keyboard.
The focus()
method, when invoked, must run the following algorithm:
Якщо the element is marked as locked for focus, then abort these steps.
Mark the element as locked for focus.
Run the focusing steps for the element.
Unmark the element as locked for focus.
The blur()
method, when invoked, should run the unfocusing
steps for the element on which the method was called instead. User
agents may selectively or uniformly ignore calls to this method for
usability reasons.
For example, if the blur()
method is unwisely being used to
remove the focus ring for aesthetics reasons, the page would become
unusable by keyboard users. Ignoring calls to this method would thus
allow keyboard users to interact with the page.
Цей розділ не є нормативним.
Each element that can be activated or focused can be assigned a single
key combination to activate it, using the accesskey
attribute.
The exact shortcut is determined by the user agent, based on information
about the user's keyboard, what keyboard shortcuts already exist on the
platform та what other shortcuts have been specified on the page, using
the information provided in the accesskey
attribute as a
guide.
In order to ensure that a relevant keyboard shortcut is available on a
wide variety of input devices, the author can provide a number of
alternatives in the accesskey
attribute.
Each alternative consists of a single character, such as a letter or digit.
User agents can provide users with a list of the keyboard shortcuts, but
authors are encouraged to do so also. The accessKeyLabel
IDL attribute
returns a string representing the actual key combination assigned by the
user agent.
In this example, an author has provided a button that can be invoked using a shortcut key. To support full keyboards, the author has provided "C" as a possible key. To support devices equipped only with numeric keypads, the author has provided "1" as another possibly key.
<input type=button value=Collect onclick="collect()" accesskey="C 1" id=c>
To tell the user what the shortcut key is, the author has this script here opted to explicitly add the key combination to the button's label:
function addShortcutKeyLabel(button) { if (button.accessKeyLabel != '') button.value += ' (' + button.accessKeyLabel + ')'; } addShortcutKeyLabel(document.getElementById('c'));
Browsers on different platforms will show different labels, even for the same key combination, based on the convention prevalent on that platform. For example, if the key combination is the Control key, the Shift key та the letter C, a Windows browser might display "Ctrl+Shift+C", whereas a Mac browser might display "^⇧C", while an Emacs browser might just display "C-C". Similarly, if the key combination is the Alt key and the Escape key, Windows might use "Alt+Esc", Mac might use "⌥⎋" та an Emacs browser might use "M-ESC" or "ESC ESC".
In general, therefore, it is unwise to attempt to parse the value
returned from the accessKeyLabel
IDL attribute.
accesskey
attributeAll HTML elements may have the accesskey
content attribute
set. The accesskey
attribute's value is used by the user agent as a guide for creating a
keyboard shortcut that activates or focuses the element.
Якщо specified, the value must be an ordered set of unique space-separated tokens що є case-sensitive, each of which must be exactly one Unicode code point in length.
In the following example, a variety of links are given with access keys so that keyboard users familiar with the site can more quickly navigate to the relevant pages:
<nav> <p> <a title="Consortium Activities" accesskey="A" href="/Consortium/activities">Activities</a> | <a title="Technical Reports and Recommendations" accesskey="T" href="/TR/">Technical Reports</a> | <a title="Alphabetical Site Index" accesskey="S" href="/Consortium/siteindex">Site Index</a> | <a title="About This Site" accesskey="B" href="/Consortium/">About Consortium</a> | <a title="Contact Consortium" accesskey="C" href="/Consortium/contact">Contact</a> </p> </nav>
In the following example, the search field is given two possible access keys, "s" and "0" (in that order). A user agent on a device with a full keyboard might pick Ctrl+Alt+S as the shortcut key, while a user agent on a small device with just a numeric keypad might pick just the plain unadorned key 0:
<form action="/search"> <label>Search: <input type="search" name="q" accesskey="s 0"></label> <input type="submit"> </form>
In the following example, a button has possible access keys described. A script then tries to update the button's label to advertise the key combination the user agent selected.
<input type=submit accesskey="N @ 1" value="Compose"> ... <script> function labelButton(button) { if (button.accessKeyLabel) button.value += ' (' + button.accessKeyLabel + ')'; } var inputs = document.getElementsByTagName('input'); for (var i = 0; i < inputs.length; i += 1) { if (inputs[i].type == "submit") labelButton(inputs[i]); } </script>
On one user agent, the button's label might become "Compose (⌘N)". On another, it might become "Compose (Alt+⇧+1)". Якщо the user agent doesn't assign a key, it will be just "Compose". The exact string depends on what the assigned access key is та on how the user agent represents that key combination.
An element's assigned access key
is a key combination derived from the element's accesskey
content
attribute. Initially, an element must not have an assigned
access key.
Whenever an element's accesskey
attribute is set, changed, or removed, the user agent must update the
element's assigned access key by
running the following steps:
Якщо the element has no accesskey
attribute,
then skip to the fallback step below.
Інакше split the attribute's value on spaces та let keys be the resulting tokens.
For each value in keys in turn, in the order the tokens appeared in the attribute's value, run the following substeps:
Якщо the value is not a string exactly one Unicode code point in length, then skip the remainder of these steps for this value.
Якщо the value does not correspond to a key on the system's keyboard, then skip the remainder of these steps for this value.
Якщо the user agent can find a mix of zero or more modifier keys that, combined with the key that corresponds to the value given in the attribute, can be used as the access key, then the user agent may assign that combination of keys as the element's assigned access key and abort these steps.
Fallback: Optionally, the user agent may assign a key combination of its choosing as the element's assigned access key and then abort these steps.
Якщо this step is reached, the element has no assigned access key.
Once a user agent has selected and assigned an access key for an
element, the user agent should not change the element's assigned
access key unless the accesskey
content
attribute is changed or the element is moved to another Document
.
User agents might expose elements that have an accesskey
attribute in
other ways as well, e.g. in a menu displayed in response to a specific
key combination.
The accessKey
IDL attribute must reflect the accesskey
content
attribute.
The accessKeyLabel
IDL attribute must return a string that represents the element's assigned
access key, if any. Якщо the element does not have one, then the
IDL attribute must return the empty string.
contenteditable
content attributeThe contenteditable
attribute is an enumerated attribute
whose keywords are the empty string, true
та false
. The empty string and the true
keyword map to the true state.
The false
keyword maps to the false
state. In addition, there is a third state, the inherit state,
which is the missing value default (and the invalid value
default).
The true state indicates that the element is editable. The inherit state indicates that the element is editable if its parent is. The false state indicates that the element is not editable.
contentEditable
[ = value
]Returns "true
", "false
",
or "inherit
", based on the state of
the contenteditable
attribute.
Can be set, to change that state.
Throws a SyntaxError
exception if the new value isn't one of those strings.
isContentEditable
Returns true if the element is editable; otherwise, returns false.
The contentEditable
IDL attribute, on getting, must return the string "true
"
if the content attribute is set to the true state, "false
"
if the content attribute is set to the false state та "inherit
"
otherwise. On setting, if the new value is an ASCII
чутливі до реєстру match for the string "inherit
"
then the content attribute must be removed, if the new value is an ASCII
чутливі до реєстру match for the string "true
"
then the content attribute must be set to the string "true
",
if the new value is an ASCII чутливі
до реєстру match for the string "false
"
then the content attribute must be set to the string "false
"
та otherwise the attribute setter must throw a SyntaxError
exception.
The isContentEditable
IDL attribute, on getting, must return true if the element is either an
editing host or editable
та false otherwise.
designMode
IDL attributeDocuments have a designMode
,
which can be either enabled or disabled.
designMode
[ = value
]Returns "on
" if the document is
editable та "off
" if it isn't.
Can be set, to change the document's current state. This focuses the document and resets the selection in that document.
The designMode
IDL attribute on the Document
object takes two values, "on
" and "off
". On setting, the new value must be
compared in an ASCII чутливі до
реєстру manner to these two values; if it matches the "on
"
value, then designMode
must be enabled та if it matches the "off
"
value, then designMode
must be disabled. Other values must be ignored.
On getting, if designMode
is enabled, the IDL attribute must return the value "on
";
otherwise it is disabled та the attribute must return the value "off
".
The last state set must persist until the document is destroyed or the
state is changed. Initially, documents must have their designMode
disabled.
When the designMode
changes from being disabled to being enabled, the user agent must
synchronously reset the document's active range's
start and end boundary points to be at the start of the Document
and then run the focusing steps for the
root element of the Document
, if
any.
Authors are encouraged to set the 'white-space' property on editing hosts and on markup that was originally created through these editing mechanisms to the value 'pre-wrap'. Default HTML whitespace handling is not well suited to WYSIWYG editing та line wrapping will not work correctly in some corner cases if 'white-space' is left at its default value.
As an example of problems that occur if the default 'normal' value is used instead, consider the case of the user typing "yellow␣␣ball", with two spaces (here represented by "␣") between the words. With the editing rules in place for the default value of 'white-space' ('normal'), the resulting markup will either consist of "yellow ball" or "yellow ball"; i.e., there will be a non-breaking space between the two words in addition to the regular space. This is necessary because the 'normal' value for 'white-space' requires adjacent regular spaces to be collapsed together.
In the former case, "yellow⍽" might wrap to the next line ("⍽" being used here to represent a non-breaking space) even though "yellow" alone might fit at the end of the line; in the latter case, "⍽ball", if wrapped to the start of the line, would have visible indentation from the non-breaking space.
When 'white-space' is set to 'pre-wrap', however, the editing rules will instead simply put two regular spaces between the words та should the two words be split at the end of a line, the spaces would be neatly removed from the rendering.
The definition of the terms active range, editing host та editable,
the user interface requirements of elements що є editing hosts or editable,
the execCommand()
,
queryCommandEnabled()
,
queryCommandIndeterm()
,
queryCommandState()
,
queryCommandSupported()
та queryCommandValue()
methods, text selections та the delete the
selection algorithm are defined in the HTML Editing APIs
specification. The interaction of editing and the undo/redo features in
user agents is defined by the UndoManager and DOM Transaction
specification. [EDITING] [UNDO]
User agents can support the checking of spelling and grammar of
editable text, either in form controls (such as the value of textarea
elements), or in elements in an editing host
(e.g. using contenteditable
).
For each element, user agents must establish a default behavior, either through defaults or through preferences expressed by the user. There are three possible default behaviors for each element:
The spellcheck
attribute is an enumerated attribute
whose keywords are the empty string, true
and false
. The empty string and the true
keyword map to the true state.
The false
keyword maps to the false
state. In addition, there is a third state, the default state,
which is the missing value default (and the invalid value
default).
The true state indicates that the element is to have
its spelling and grammar checked. The default state indicates that
the element is to act according to a default behavior, possibly based on
the parent element's own spellcheck
state, as defined below. The false state indicates that the
element is not to be checked.
spellcheck
[ = value
]Returns true if the element is to have its spelling and grammar checked; otherwise, returns false.
Can be set, to override the default та встановити the spellcheck
content attribute.
The spellcheck
IDL attribute, on getting, must return true if the element's spellcheck
content attribute is
in the true state, or if the element's spellcheck
content attribute is
in the default state and the element's default behavior є
true-by-default,
or if the element's spellcheck
content attribute is in the default state and the element's default
behavior is inherit-by-default and
the element's parent element's spellcheck
IDL attribute would
return true; otherwise, if none of those conditions applies, then the
attribute must instead return false.
The spellcheck
IDL attribute is not affected by user preferences that override the spellcheck
content attribute та therefore might not reflect the actual
spellchecking state.
On setting, if the new value є true, then the element's spellcheck
content attribute must
be set to the literal string "true
",
otherwise it must be set to the literal string "false
".
User agents must only consider the following pieces of text as checkable for the purposes of this feature:
input
elements whose
type
attributes are in the Text,
Search,
URL,
or E-mail
states and що є mutable
(i.e. that do not have the readonly
attribute
specified and що є not disabled).textarea
elements
that do not have a readonly
attribute and
що є not disabled.Text
nodes що є children
of editing
hosts or editable elements.For text that is part of a Text
node, the element with which the text is associated is the element that
is the immediate parent of the first character of the word, sentence, or
other piece of text. For text in attributes, it is the attribute's
element. For the values of input
and textarea
elements,
it is the element itself.
To determine if a word, sentence, or other piece of text in an applicable element (as defined above) is to have spelling- and grammar-checking enabled, the UA must use the following algorithm:
spellcheck
content attribute, then: if that attribute is in the true
state, then checking is enabled; otherwise, if that attribute is in
the false state, then checking is disabled.spellcheck
content attribute
that is not in the default state, then: if the nearest such
ancestor's spellcheck
content attribute is in the true state, then checking is
enabled; otherwise, checking is disabled.Якщо the checking is enabled for a word/sentence/text, the user agent
should indicate spelling and grammar errors in that text. User agents
should take into account the other semantics given in the document when
suggesting spelling and grammar corrections. User agents may use the
language of the element to determine what spelling and grammar rules to
use, or may use the user's preferred language settings. UAs should use input
element attributes such
as pattern
to ensure that the resulting value is valid, where possible.
Якщо checking is disabled, the user agent should not indicate spelling or grammar errors for that text.
Even when checking is enabled, user agents may opt to not report spelling or grammar errors in text that the user agent deems the user has no interest in having checked (e.g. text that was already present when the page was loaded, or that the user did not type, or text in controls that the user has not focused, or in parts of e-mail addresses that the user agent is not confident were misspelt).
The element with ID "a" in the following example would be the one used to determine if the word "Hello" is checked for spelling errors. In this example, it would not be.
<div contenteditable="true"> <span spellcheck="false" id="a">Hell</span><em>o!</em> </div>
The element with ID "b" in the following example would have checking
enabled (the leading space character in the attribute's value on the input
element causes the
attribute to be ignored, so the ancestor's value is used instead,
regardless of the default).
<p spellcheck="true"> <label>Name: <input spellcheck=" false" id="b"></label> </p>
This specification does not define the user interface for spelling and grammar checkers. A user agent could offer on-demand checking, could perform continuous checking while the checking is enabled, or could use other interfaces.
This section only describes the rules for resources labeled with an HTML MIME type. Rules for XML resources are discussed in the section below entitled "The XHTML syntax".
This section only applies to documents, authoring tools та markup generators. In particular, it does not apply to conformance checkers; conformance checkers must use the requirements given in the next section ("parsing HTML documents").
Documents must consist of the following parts, in the given order:
html
element.The various types of content mentioned above are described in the next few sections.
In addition, there are some restrictions on how character encoding declarations are to be serialized, as discussed in the section on that topic.
Space characters before the root html
element та space characters at the start of the html
element and before the head
element, will be dropped when the document is parsed; space characters after
the root html
element will
be parsed as if they were at the end of the body
element. Thus, space characters around the root element do not
round-trip.
It is suggested that newlines be inserted after the DOCTYPE, after any
comments що є before the root element, after the html
element's start tag (if it is not omitted) та after any comments що є
inside the html
element
but before the head
element.
Many strings in the HTML syntax (e.g. the names of elements and their attributes) are чутливі до реєстру, but only for uppercase ASCII letters and lowercase ASCII letters. For convenience, in this section this is just referred to as "чутливі до реєстру".
A DOCTYPE is a required preamble.
DOCTYPEs are required for legacy reasons. When omitted, browsers tend to use a different rendering mode that is incompatible with some specifications. Including the DOCTYPE in a document ensures that the browser makes a best-effort attempt at following the relevant specifications.
A DOCTYPE must consist of the following components, in this order:
<!DOCTYPE
".html
".In other words, <!DOCTYPE html>
, чутливі
до реєструly.
For the purposes of HTML generators that cannot output HTML markup with
the short DOCTYPE "<!DOCTYPE html>
",
a DOCTYPE legacy string may be
inserted into the DOCTYPE (in the position defined above). This string
must consist of:
SYSTEM
".about:legacy-compat
".In other words, <!DOCTYPE html SYSTEM
"about:legacy-compat">
or <!DOCTYPE html SYSTEM
'about:legacy-compat'>
, чутливі до реєструly except for the
part in single or double quotes.
The DOCTYPE legacy string should not be used unless the document is generated from a system that cannot output the shorter string.
To help authors transition from HTML4 and XHTML1, an obsolete permitted DOCTYPE string can be inserted into the DOCTYPE (in the position defined above). This string must consist of:
PUBLIC
".Public identifier | System identifier | System identifier optional? |
---|---|---|
-//W3C//DTD HTML 4.0//EN
|
http://www.w3.org/TR/REC-html40/strict.dtd
|
Yes |
-//W3C//DTD HTML 4.01//EN
|
http://www.w3.org/TR/html4/strict.dtd
|
Yes |
-//W3C//DTD XHTML 1.0 Strict//EN
|
http://www.w3.org/TR/xhtml1/DTD/xhtml1-strict.dtd
|
No |
-//W3C//DTD XHTML 1.1//EN
|
http://www.w3.org/TR/xhtml11/DTD/xhtml11.dtd
|
No |
A DOCTYPE containing an obsolete permitted DOCTYPE string is an obsolete permitted DOCTYPE. Authors should not use obsolete permitted DOCTYPEs, as they are unnecessarily long.
There are five different kinds of elements: void elements, raw text elements, escapable raw text elements, foreign elements та normal elements.
area
, base
,
br
, col
,
embed
, hr
,
img
, input
,
keygen
, link
,
meta
, param
,
source
, track
,
wbr
script
, style
textarea
, title
Tags are used to delimit the start and end of elements in the markup. Raw text, escapable raw text та normal elements have a start tag to indicate where they begin та an end tag to indicate where they end. The start and end tags of certain normal elements can be omitted, as described below in the section on optional tags. Those that cannot be omitted must not be omitted. Void elements only have a start tag; end tags must not be specified for void elements. Foreign elements must either have a start tag and an end tag, or a start tag that is marked as self-closing, in which case they must not have an end tag.
The contents of the element must be placed between just after the start tag (which might be implied, in certain cases) and just before the end tag (which again, might be implied in certain cases). The exact allowed contents of each individual element depend on the content model of that element, as described earlier in this specification. Elements must not contain content that their content model disallows. In addition to the restrictions placed on the contents by those content models, however, the five types of elements have additional syntactic requirements.
Void elements can't have any contents (since there's no end tag, no content can be put between the start tag and the end tag).
Raw text elements can have text, though it has restrictions described below.
Escapable raw text elements can have text and character references, but the text must not contain an ambiguous ampersand. There are also further restrictions described below.
Foreign elements whose start tag is marked as self-closing can't have any contents (since, again, as there's no end tag, no content can be put between the start tag and the end tag). Foreign elements whose start tag is not marked as self-closing can have text, character references, CDATA sections, other elements та comments, but the text must not contain the character "<" (U+003C) or an ambiguous ampersand.
The HTML syntax does not support namespace declarations, even in foreign elements.
For instance, consider the following HTML fragment:
<p> <svg> <metadata> <!-- this is invalid --> <cdr:license xmlns:cdr="http://www.example.com/cdr/metadata" name="MIT"/> </metadata> </svg> </p>
The innermost element, cdr:license
,
is actually in the SVG namespace, as the "xmlns:cdr
"
attribute has no effect (unlike in XML). In fact, as the comment in the
fragment above says, the fragment is actually non-conforming. This is
because the SVG specification does not define any elements called "cdr:license
" in the SVG namespace.
Normal elements can have text, character references, other elements та comments, but the text must not contain the character "<" (U+003C) or an ambiguous ampersand. Some normal elements also have yet more restrictions on what content they are allowed to hold, beyond the restrictions imposed by the content model and those described in this paragraph. Those restrictions are described below.
Tags contain a tag name, giving the element's name. HTML elements all have names that only use alphanumeric ASCII characters. In the HTML syntax, tag names, even those for foreign elements, may be written with any mix of lower- and uppercase letters that, when converted to all-lowercase, matches the element's tag name; tag names are чутливі до реєстру.
Start tags must have the following format:
End tags must have the following format:
Attributes for an element are expressed inside the element's start tag.
Attributes have a name and a value. Attribute names must consist of one or more characters other than the space characters, U+0000 NULL, U+0022 QUOTATION MARK ("), U+0027 APOSTROPHE ('), ">" (U+003E), "/" (U+002F) та "=" (U+003D) characters, the control characters та any characters що є not defined by Unicode. In the HTML syntax, attribute names, even those for foreign elements, may be written with any mix of lower- and uppercase letters що є an ASCII чутливі до реєстру match for the attribute's name.
Attribute values are a mixture of text and character references, except with the additional restriction that the text cannot contain an ambiguous ampersand.
Attributes can be specified in four different ways:
Just the attribute name. The value is implicitly the empty string.
In the following example, the disabled
attribute is given
with the empty attribute syntax:
<input disabled>
Якщо an attribute using the empty attribute syntax is to be followed by another attribute, then there must be a space character separating the two.
The attribute name, followed by zero or more space characters, followed by a single U+003D EQUALS SIGN character, followed by zero or more space characters, followed by the attribute value, which, in addition to the requirements given above for attribute values, must not contain any literal space characters, any U+0022 QUOTATION MARK characters ("), U+0027 APOSTROPHE characters ('), "=" (U+003D) characters, "<" (U+003C) characters, ">" (U+003E) characters, or U+0060 GRAVE ACCENT characters (`) та must not be the empty string.
In the following example, the value
attribute is given
with the unquoted attribute value syntax:
<input value=yes>
Якщо an attribute using the unquoted attribute syntax is to be followed by another attribute or by the optional "/" (U+002F) character allowed in step 6 of the start tag syntax above, then there must be a space character separating the two.
The attribute name, followed by zero or more space characters, followed by a single U+003D EQUALS SIGN character, followed by zero or more space characters, followed by a single "'" (U+0027) character, followed by the attribute value, which, in addition to the requirements given above for attribute values, must not contain any literal "'" (U+0027) characters та finally followed by a second single "'" (U+0027) character.
In the following example, the type
attribute is given with
the single-quoted attribute value syntax:
<input type='checkbox'>
Якщо an attribute using the single-quoted attribute syntax is to be followed by another attribute, then there must be a space character separating the two.
The attribute name, followed by zero or more space characters, followed by a single U+003D EQUALS SIGN character, followed by zero or more space characters, followed by a single """ (U+0022) character, followed by the attribute value, which, in addition to the requirements given above for attribute values, must not contain any literal U+0022 QUOTATION MARK characters (") та finally followed by a second single """ (U+0022) character.
In the following example, the name
attribute is given with the
double-quoted attribute value syntax:
<input name="be evil">
Якщо an attribute using the double-quoted attribute syntax is to be followed by another attribute, then there must be a space character separating the two.
There must never be two or more attributes on the same start tag whose names are an ASCII чутливі до реєстру match for each other.
When a foreign element has one of the namespaced attributes given by the local name and namespace of the first and second cells of a row from the following table, it must be written using the name given by the third cell from the same row.
Local name | Namespace | Attribute name |
---|---|---|
actuate |
XLink namespace | xlink:actuate |
arcrole |
XLink namespace | xlink:arcrole |
href |
XLink namespace | xlink:href |
role |
XLink namespace | xlink:role |
show |
XLink namespace | xlink:show |
title |
XLink namespace | xlink:title |
type |
XLink namespace | xlink:type |
base |
XML namespace | xml:base |
lang |
XML namespace | xml:lang |
space |
XML namespace | xml:space |
xmlns |
XMLNS namespace | xmlns |
xlink |
XMLNS namespace | xmlns:xlink |
No other namespaced attribute can be expressed in the HTML syntax.
Whether the attributes in the table above are conforming or not is defined by other specifications (e.g. the SVG and MathML specifications); this section only describes the syntax rules if the attributes are serialized using the HTML syntax.
Certain tags can be omitted.
Omitting an element's start tag in the situations described below
does not mean the element is not present; it is implied, but it is still
there. For example, an HTML document always has a root html
element, even if the string <html>
doesn't appear anywhere in the markup.
An html
element's start tag may be omitted if the first thing
inside the html
element is
not a comment.
An html
element's end tag may be omitted if the html
element is not immediately followed by a comment.
A head
element's start tag may be omitted if the element is
empty, or if the first thing inside the head
element is an element.
A head
element's end tag may be omitted if the head
element is not immediately followed by a space
character or a comment.
A body
element's start tag may be omitted if the element is
empty, or if the first thing inside the body
element is not a space character or a comment,
except if the first thing inside the body
element is a meta
, link
, script
,
style
, or template
element.
A body
element's end tag may be omitted if the body
element is not immediately followed by a comment.
An li
element's end tag may be omitted if the li
element is immediately followed by another li
element or if there is no more content in the parent element.
A dt
element's end tag may be omitted if the dt
element is immediately followed by another dt
element or a dd
element.
A dd
element's end tag may be omitted if the dd
element is immediately followed by another dd
element or a dt
element, or if
there is no more content in the parent element.
A p
element's end tag may be omitted if the p
element is immediately followed by an address
,
article
, aside
,
blockquote
, div
,
dl
, fieldset
,
footer
, form
,
h1
, h2
, h3
, h4
, h5
, h6
, header
, hgroup
,
hr
, main
,
nav
, ol
,
p
, pre
,
section
, table
,
or ul
, element, or if there is
no more content in the parent element and the parent element is not an a
element.
An rb
element's end tag may be omitted if the rb
element is immediately followed by an rb
,
rt
, rtc
or rp
element, or if there is
no more content in the parent element.
An rt
element's end tag may be omitted if the rt
element is immediately followed by an rb
,
rt
, rtc
,
or rp
element, or if there is
no more content in the parent element.
An rtc
element's end tag may be omitted if the rtc
element is immediately followed by an rb
,
rtc
or rp
element, or if there is no more content in the parent element.
An rp
element's end tag may be omitted if the rp
element is immediately followed by an rb
,
rt
, rtc
or rp
element, or if there is
no more content in the parent element.
An optgroup
element's end tag may
be omitted if the optgroup
element
is immediately
followed by another optgroup
element, or if
there is no more content in the parent element.
An option
element's end tag may be omitted if the option
element is immediately followed by another option
element, or if it is immediately followed by an optgroup
element, or if there is no more content in the parent element.
A colgroup
element's start tag
may be omitted if the first thing inside the colgroup
element is a col
element та
if the element is not immediately preceded by another colgroup
element whose end
tag has been omitted. (It can't be omitted if the element is empty.)
A colgroup
element's end tag may
be omitted if the colgroup
element is not immediately followed by a space
character or a comment.
A thead
element's end tag may be omitted if the thead
element is immediately followed by a tbody
or tfoot
element.
A tbody
element's start tag may be omitted if the first thing
inside the tbody
element is
a tr
element та if the element
is not immediately preceded by a tbody
,
thead
, or tfoot
element whose end
tag has been omitted. (It can't be omitted if the element is empty.)
A tbody
element's end tag may be omitted if the tbody
element is immediately followed by a tbody
or tfoot
element, or if
there is no more content in the parent element.
A tfoot
element's end tag may be omitted if the tfoot
element is immediately followed by a tbody
element, or if there is no more content in the parent element.
A tr
element's end tag may be omitted if the tr
element is immediately followed by another tr
element, or if there is no more content in the parent element.
A td
element's end tag may be omitted if the td
element is immediately followed by a td
or th
element, or if there is
no more content in the parent element.
A th
element's end tag may be omitted if the th
element is immediately followed by a td
or th
element, or if there is
no more content in the parent element.
However, a start tag must never be omitted if it has any attributes.
For historical reasons, certain elements have extra restrictions beyond even the restrictions given by their content model.
A table
element must not
contain tr
elements, even
though these elements are technically allowed inside table
elements according to the content models described in this specification.
(Якщо a tr
element is put
inside a table
in the
markup, it will in fact imply a tbody
start tag before it.)
A single newline
may be placed immediately after the start tag of pre
and textarea
elements.
Якщо the element's contents are intended to start with a newline, two consecutive newlines thus need
to be included by the author.
The text in raw
text and escapable raw text
elements must not contain any occurrences of the string "</
"
(U+003C LESS-THAN SIGN, U+002F SOLIDUS) followed by characters that
чутливі до реєструly match the tag name of the element followed by one of
"tab" (U+0009), "LF" (U+000A), "FF" (U+000C), "CR" (U+000D), U+0020 SPACE,
">" (U+003E), or "/" (U+002F).
Text is allowed inside elements, attribute values та comments. Extra constraints are placed on what is and what is not allowed in text based on where the text is to be put, as described in the other sections.
Newlines in HTML may be represented either as "CR" (U+000D) characters, "LF" (U+000A) characters, or pairs of "CR" (U+000D), "LF" (U+000A) characters in that order.
Where character references are allowed, a character reference of a "LF" (U+000A) character (but not a "CR" (U+000D) character) also represents a newline.
In certain cases described in other sections, text may be mixed with character references. These can be used to escape characters that couldn't otherwise legally be included in text.
Character references must start with a U+0026 AMPERSAND character (&). Following this, there are three possible kinds of character references:
The numeric character reference forms described above are allowed to reference any Unicode code point other than U+0000, U+000D, permanently undefined Unicode characters (noncharacters), surrogates (U+D800–U+DFFF) та control characters other than space characters.
An ambiguous ampersand є символом U+0026 AMPERSAND character (&) that is followed by one or more alphanumeric ASCII characters, followed by a ";" (U+003B) character, where these characters do not match any of the names given in the named character references section.
CDATA sections must consist of the following components, in this order:
<![CDATA[
".]]>
".]]>
".CDATA sections can only be used in foreign content (MathML or SVG). In
this example, a CDATA section is used to escape the contents of an ms
element:
<p>You can add a string to a number, but this stringifies the number:</p> <math> <ms><![CDATA[x<y]]></ms> <mo>+</mo> <mn>3</mn> <mo>=</mo> <ms><![CDATA[x<y3]]></ms> </math>
Comments
must start with the four character sequence U+003C LESS-THAN SIGN, U+0021
EXCLAMATION MARK, U+002D HYPHEN-MINUS, U+002D HYPHEN-MINUS (<!--
).
Following this sequence, the comment may have text, with the additional restriction that the
text must not start with a single ">" (U+003E) character, nor start
with a U+002D HYPHEN-MINUS character (-) followed by a ">" (U+003E)
character, nor contain two consecutive U+002D HYPHEN-MINUS characters (--
), nor end with a U+002D HYPHEN-MINUS
character (-). Finally, the comment must be ended by the three character
sequence U+002D HYPHEN-MINUS, U+002D HYPHEN-MINUS, U+003E GREATER-THAN
SIGN (-->
).
This section only applies to user agents, data mining tools та conformance checkers.
The rules for parsing XML documents into DOM trees are covered by the next section, entitled "The XHTML syntax".
User agents must use the parsing rules described in this section to
generate the DOM trees from text/html
resources. Together, these rules define what is referred to as the HTML parser.
While the HTML syntax described in this specification bears a close resemblance to SGML and XML, it is a separate language with its own parsing rules.
Some earlier versions of HTML (in particular from HTML2 to HTML4) were based on SGML and used SGML parsing rules. However, few (if any) web browsers ever implemented true SGML parsing for HTML documents; the only user agents to strictly handle HTML as an SGML application have historically been validators. The resulting confusion — with validators claiming documents to have one representation while widely deployed Web browsers interoperably implemented a different representation — has wasted decades of productivity. This version of HTML thus returns to a non-SGML basis.
Authors interested in using SGML tools in their authoring pipeline are encouraged to use XML tools and the XML serialization of HTML.
This specification defines the parsing rules for HTML documents, whether they are syntactically correct or not. Certain points in the parsing algorithm are said to be parse errors. The error handling for parse errors is well-defined (that's the processing rules described throughout this specification), but user agents, while parsing an HTML document, may abort the parser at the first parse error that they encounter for which they do not wish to apply the rules described in this specification.
Conformance checkers must report at least one parse error condition to the user if one or more parse error conditions exist in the document and must not report parse error conditions if none exist in the document. Conformance checkers may report more than one parse error condition if more than one parse error condition exists in the document.
Розберіть errors are only errors with the syntax of HTML. In addition to checking for parse errors, conformance checkers will also verify that the document obeys all the other conformance requirements described in this specification.
For the purposes of conformance checkers, if a resource is determined to be in the HTML syntax, then it is an HTML document.
As stated in the terminology section, references to element types
that do not explicitly specify a namespace always refer to elements in
the простір імен HTML. For example, if
the spec talks about "a div
element", then that is an element with the local name "div
",
the namespace "http://www.w3.org/1999/xhtml
"
та the interface HTMLDivElement
.
Where possible, references to such elements are hyperlinked to their
definition.
The input to the HTML parsing process consists of a stream of Unicode code points, which is passed
through a tokenization stage followed by a
tree construction stage. The output is
a Document
object.
Implementations that do not
support scripting do not have to actually create a DOM Document
object, but the DOM tree in such cases is still used as the model for
the rest of the specification.
In the common case, the data handled by the tokenization stage comes
from the network, but it
can also come from script running in the user agent, e.g. using
the document.write()
API.
There is only one set of states for the tokenizer stage and the tree construction stage, but the tree construction stage is reentrant, meaning that while the tree construction stage is handling one token, the tokenizer might be resumed, causing further tokens to be emitted and processed before the first token's processing is complete.
In the following example, the tree construction stage will be called upon to handle a "p" start tag token while handling the "script" end tag token:
... <script> document.write('<p>'); </script> ...
To handle these cases, parsers have a script nesting level, which must be initially set to zero та a parser pause flag, which must be initially set to false.
The stream of Unicode code points that comprises the input to the tokenization stage will be initially seen by the user agent as a stream of bytes (typically coming over the network or from the local file system). The bytes encode the actual characters according to a particular character encoding, which the user agent uses to decode the bytes into characters.
For XML documents, the algorithm user agents must use to determine the character encoding is given by the XML specification. This section does not apply to XML documents. [XML]
Usually, the encoding sniffing algorithm defined below is used to determine the character encoding.
Given a character encoding, the bytes in the input byte stream must be converted to Unicode code points for the tokenizer's input stream, as described by the rules for that encoding's decoder.
Bytes or sequences of bytes in the original byte stream that did not conform to the encoding specification (e.g. invalid UTF-8 byte sequences in a UTF-8 input byte stream) are errors that conformance checkers are expected to report.
Leading Byte Order Marks (BOMs) are not stripped by the decoder algorithms, they are stripped by the algorithm below.
The decoder algorithms describe how to handle invalid input; for security reasons, it is imperative that those rules be followed precisely. Differences in how invalid byte sequences are handled can result in, amongst other problems, script injection vulnerabilities ("XSS").
When the HTML parser is decoding an input byte stream, it uses a character encoding and a confidence. The confidence is either tentative, certain, or irrelevant. The encoding used та whether the confidence in that encoding is tentative or certain, is used during the parsing to determine whether to change the encoding. Якщо no encoding is necessary, e.g. because the parser is operating on a Unicode stream and doesn't have to use a character encoding at all, then the confidence is irrelevant.
Some algorithms feed the parser by directly adding characters to the input stream rather than adding bytes to the input byte stream.
When the HTML parser is to operate on an input byte stream that has a known definite encoding, then the character encoding is that encoding and the confidence is certain.
In some cases, it might be impractical to unambiguously determine the encoding before parsing the document. Because of this, this specification provides for a two-pass mechanism with an optional pre-scan. Implementations are allowed, as described below, to apply a simplified parsing algorithm to whatever bytes they have available before beginning to parse the document. Then, the real parser is started, using a tentative encoding derived from this pre-parse and other out-of-band metadata. Якщо, while the document is being loaded, the user agent discovers a character encoding declaration that conflicts with this information, then the parser can get reinvoked to perform a parse of the document with the real encoding.
User agents must use the following algorithm, called the encoding sniffing algorithm, to determine the character encoding to use when decoding a document in the first pass. This algorithm takes as input any out-of-band metadata available to the user agent (e.g. the Content-Type metadata of the document) and all the bytes available so far та returns a character encoding and a confidence that is either tentative or certain.
Якщо the user has explicitly instructed the user agent to override the document's character encoding with a specific encoding, optionally return that encoding with the confidence certain and abort these steps.
Typically, user agents remember such user requests
across sessions та in some cases apply them to documents in iframe
s as well.
The user agent may wait for more bytes of the resource to be available, either in this step or at any later step in this algorithm. For instance, a user agent might wait 500ms or 1024 bytes, whichever came first. In general preparsing the source to find the encoding improves performance, as it reduces the need to throw away the data structures used when parsing upon finding the encoding information. However, if the user agent delays too long щоб отримати data to determine the encoding, then the cost of the delay could outweigh any performance improvements from the preparse.
The authoring conformance requirements for character encoding declarations limit them to only appearing in the first 1024 bytes. User agents are therefore encouraged to use the prescan algorithm below (as invoked by these steps) on the first 1024 bytes, but not to stall beyond that.
For each of the rows in the following table, starting with the first one and going down, if there are as many or more bytes available than the number of bytes in the first column та the first bytes of the file match the bytes given in the first column, then return the encoding given in the cell in the second column of that row, with the confidence certain та abort these steps:
Bytes in Hexadecimal | Encoding |
---|---|
FE FF | Big-endian UTF-16 |
FF FE | Little-endian UTF-16 |
EF BB BF | UTF-8 |
This step looks for Unicode Byte Order Marks (BOMs).
That this step happens before the next one honoring
the HTTP Content-Type
header is a willful violation of
the HTTP specification, motivated by a desire to be maximally
compatible with legacy content. [HTTP]
Якщо the transport layer specifies a character encoding та it is supported, return that encoding with the confidence certain та abort these steps.
Optionally prescan the byte stream to determine its encoding. The end condition is that the user agent decides that scanning further bytes would not be efficient. User agents are encouraged to only prescan the first 1024 bytes. User agents may decide that scanning any bytes is not efficient, in which case these substeps are entirely skipped.
The aforementioned algorithm either aborts unsuccessfully or returns a character encoding. Якщо it returns a character encoding, then this algorithm must be aborted, returning the same encoding, with confidence tentative.
Якщо the HTML parser for which this
algorithm is being run is associated with a Document
that is itself in a nested
browsing context, виконати ці підкроки:
Нехай new document be the Document
with which the HTML
parser is associated.
Нехай parent document be the Document
through which new
document is nested (the active
document of the parent
browsing context of new document).
Якщо parent document's origin is not the same origin as new document's origin, then abort these substeps.
Якщо parent document's character encoding is not an ASCII-compatible character encoding, then abort these substeps.
Повернутиparent document's character encoding, with the confidence tentative та abort the encoding sniffing algorithm's steps.
Інакше if the user agent has information on the likely encoding for this page, e.g. based on the encoding of the page when it was last visited, then return that encoding, with the confidence tentative та abort these steps.
The user agent may attempt to autodetect the character encoding from applying frequency analysis or other algorithms to the data stream. Such algorithms may use information about the resource other than the resource's contents, including the address of the resource. Якщо autodetection succeeds in determining a character encoding та that encoding is a supported encoding, then return that encoding, with the confidence tentative та abort these steps. [UNIVCHARDET]
The UTF-8 encoding has a highly detectable bit pattern. Documents that contain bytes with values greater than 0x7F which match the UTF-8 pattern are very likely to be UTF-8, while documents with byte sequences that do not match it are very likely not. User-agents are therefore encouraged to search for this common encoding. [PPUTF8] [UTF8DET]
Інакше return an implementation-defined or user-specified default character encoding, with the confidence tentative.
In controlled environments or in environments where the encoding of
documents can be prescribed (for example, for user agents intended
for dedicated use in new networks), the comprehensive UTF-8
encoding is suggested.
In other environments, the default encoding is typically dependent on the user's locale (an approximation of the languages та thus often encodings, of the pages that the user is likely to frequent). The following table gives suggested defaults based on the user's locale, for compatibility with legacy content. Locales are identified by BCP 47 language tags. [BCP47] [ENCODING]
Locale language | Suggested default encoding | |
---|---|---|
ar | Arabic | windows-1256 |
ba | Bashkir | windows-1251 |
be | Belarusian | windows-1251 |
bg | Bulgarian | windows-1251 |
cs | Czech | windows-1250 |
el | Greek | ISO-8859-7 |
et | Estonian | windows-1257 |
fa | Persian | windows-1256 |
he | Hebrew | windows-1255 |
hr | Croatian | windows-1250 |
hu | Hungarian | ISO-8859-2 |
ja | Japanese | Shift_JIS |
kk | Kazakh | windows-1251 |
ko | Korean | euc-kr |
ku | Kurdish | windows-1254 |
ky | Kyrgyz | windows-1251 |
lt | Lithuanian | windows-1257 |
lv | Latvian | windows-1257 |
mk | Macedonian | windows-1251 |
pl | Polish | ISO-8859-2 |
ru | Russian | windows-1251 |
sah | Yakut | windows-1251 |
sk | Slovak | windows-1250 |
sl | Slovenian | ISO-8859-2 |
sr | Serbian | windows-1251 |
tg | Tajik | windows-1251 |
th | Thai | windows-874 |
tr | Turkish | windows-1254 |
tt | Tatar | windows-1251 |
uk | Ukrainian | windows-1251 |
vi | Vietnamese | windows-1258 |
zh-CN | Chinese (People's Republic of China) | GB18030 |
zh-TW | Chinese (Taiwan) | Big5 |
All other locales | windows-1252 |
The contents of this table are derived from the intersection of Windows, Chrome та Firefox defaults.
The document's character encoding must immediately be set to the value returned from this algorithm, at the same time as the user agent uses the returned value to select the decoder to use for the input byte stream.
When an algorithm requires a user agent to prescan a byte stream to determine its encoding, given some defined end condition, then it must run the following steps. These steps either abort unsuccessfully or return a character encoding. Якщо at any point during these steps (including during instances of the get an attribute algorithm invoked by this one) the user agent either runs out of bytes (meaning the position pointer created in the first step below goes beyond the end of the byte stream obtained so far) or reaches its end condition, then abort the prescan a byte stream to determine its encoding algorithm unsuccessfully.
Нехай position буде вказівником to a byte in the input byte stream, initially pointing at the first byte.
Loop: Якщо position points to:
Просуньте the position pointer so that it points at the first 0x3E byte which is preceded by two 0x2D bytes (i.e. at the end of an ASCII '-->' sequence) and comes after the 0x3C byte that was found. (The two 0x2D bytes can be the same as the those in the '<!--' sequence.)
Просуньте the position pointer so that it points at the next 0x09, 0x0A, 0x0C, 0x0D, 0x20, or 0x2F byte (the one in sequence of characters matched above).
Нехай attribute list be an empty list of strings.
Нехай got pragma be false.
Нехай need pragma be null.
Нехай charset be the null value (which, for the purposes of this algorithm, is distinct from an unrecognised encoding or the empty string).
Attributes: Get an attribute and its value. Якщо no attribute was sniffed, then jump to the processing step below.
Якщо the attribute's name is already in attribute list, then return to the step labeled attributes.
Add the attribute's name to attribute list.
Run the appropriate step from the following list, if one applies:
http-equiv
"Якщо the attribute's value is "content-type
",
then set got pragma to
true.
content
"Apply the algorithm
for extracting a character encoding from a meta
element, giving the attribute's value as the
string to parse. Якщо a character encoding is returned
та if charset is still
set to null, let charset
be the encoding returned та set need
pragma to true.
charset
"Нехай charset be the result of getting an encoding from the attribute's value та set need pragma to false.
Повернутиto the step labeled attributes.
Processing: Якщо need pragma is null, then jump to the step below labeled next byte.
Якщо need pragma є true but got pragma is false, then jump to the step below labeled next byte.
Якщо charset is a UTF-16 encoding, change the value of charset to UTF-8.
Якщо charset is not a supported character encoding, then jump to the step below labeled next byte.
Abort the prescan a byte stream to determine its encoding algorithm, returning the encoding given by charset.
Просуньте the position pointer so that it points at the next 0x09 (ASCII TAB), 0x0A (ASCII LF), 0x0C (ASCII FF), 0x0D (ASCII CR), 0x20 (ASCII space), or 0x3E (ASCII >) byte.
Repeatedly get an attribute until no further attributes can be found, then jump to the step below labeled next byte.
Просуньте the position pointer so that it points at the first 0x3E byte (ASCII >) that comes after the 0x3C byte that was found.
Do nothing with that byte.
When the prescan a byte stream to determine its encoding algorithm says to get an attribute, it means doing this:
Якщо the byte в позициї is one of 0x09 (ASCII TAB), 0x0A (ASCII LF), 0x0C (ASCII FF), 0x0D (ASCII CR), 0x20 (ASCII space), or 0x2F (ASCII /) then advance position to the next byte and redo this step.
Якщо the byte в позициї is 0x3E (ASCII >), then abort the get an attribute algorithm. There isn't one.
Інакше the byte в позициї is the start of the attribute name. Нехай attribute name and attribute value be the empty string.
Process the byte в позициї as follows:
Просуньте position to the next byte and return to the previous step.
Spaces: Якщо the byte в позициї is one of 0x09 (ASCII TAB), 0x0A (ASCII LF), 0x0C (ASCII FF), 0x0D (ASCII CR), or 0x20 (ASCII space) then advance position to the next byte, then, repeat this step.
Якщо the byte в позициї is not 0x3D (ASCII =), abort the get an attribute algorithm. The attribute's name is the value of attribute name, its value is the empty string.
Просуньте position past the 0x3D (ASCII =) byte.
Value: Якщо the byte в позициї is one of 0x09 (ASCII TAB), 0x0A (ASCII LF), 0x0C (ASCII FF), 0x0D (ASCII CR), or 0x20 (ASCII space) then advance position to the next byte, then, repeat this step.
Process the byte в позициї as follows:
Process the byte в позициї as follows:
Просуньте position to the next byte and return to the previous step.
For the sake of interoperability, user agents should not use a pre-scan algorithm that returns different results than the one described above. (But, if you do, please at least let us know, so that we can improve this algorithm and benefit everyone...)
User agents must support the encodings defined in the Encoding standard. User agents should not support other encodings.
User agents must not support the CESU-8, UTF-7, BOCU-1 and SCSU encodings. [CESU8] [UTF7] [BOCU1] [SCSU]
Support for encodings based on EBCDIC is especially discouraged. This encoding is rarely used for publicly-facing Web content. Support for UTF-32 is also especially discouraged. This encoding is rarely used та frequently implemented incorrectly.
This specification does not make any attempt to support EBCDIC-based encodings and UTF-32 in its algorithms; support and use of these encodings can thus lead to unexpected behavior in implementations of this specification.
When the parser requires the user agent to change the encoding, it must run the following steps. This might happen if the encoding sniffing algorithm described above failed to find a character encoding, or if it found a character encoding that was not the actual encoding of the file.
The input stream consists of the characters pushed into it as the input byte stream is decoded or from the various APIs that directly manipulate the input stream.
One leading U+FEFF BYTE ORDER MARK character must be ignored if any are present in the input stream.
The requirement to strip a U+FEFF BYTE ORDER MARK character regardless of whether that character was used to determine the byte order is a willful violation of Unicode, motivated by a desire to increase the resilience of user agents in the face of naïve transcoders.
Any occurrences of any characters in the ranges U+0001 to U+0008, U+000E to U+001F, U+007F to U+009F, U+FDD0 to U+FDEF та characters U+000B, U+FFFE, U+FFFF, U+1FFFE, U+1FFFF, U+2FFFE, U+2FFFF, U+3FFFE, U+3FFFF, U+4FFFE, U+4FFFF, U+5FFFE, U+5FFFF, U+6FFFE, U+6FFFF, U+7FFFE, U+7FFFF, U+8FFFE, U+8FFFF, U+9FFFE, U+9FFFF, U+AFFFE, U+AFFFF, U+BFFFE, U+BFFFF, U+CFFFE, U+CFFFF, U+DFFFE, U+DFFFF, U+EFFFE, U+EFFFF, U+FFFFE, U+FFFFF, U+10FFFE та U+10FFFF are parse errors. These are all control characters or permanently undefined Unicode characters (noncharacters).
Any character that is a not a Unicode
character, i.e. any isolated surrogate, is a parse
error. (These can only find their way into the input stream via
script APIs such as document.write()
.)
"CR" (U+000D) characters and "LF" (U+000A) characters are treated specially. All CR characters must be converted to LF characters та any LF characters that immediately follow a CR character must be ignored. Thus, newlines in HTML DOMs are represented by LF characters та there are never any CR characters in the input to the tokenization stage.
The next input character is the first character in the input stream that has not yet been consumed or explicitly ignored by the requirements in this section. Initially, the next input character is the first character in the input. The current input character is the last character to have been consumed.
The insertion point is the position
(just before a character or just before the end of the input stream)
where content inserted using document.write()
is actually
inserted. The insertion point is relative to the position of the
character immediately after it, it is not an absolute offset into the
input stream. Initially, the insertion point is undefined.
The "EOF" character in the tables below is a conceptual character
representing the end of the input stream.
Якщо the parser is a script-created
parser, then the end of the input stream
is reached when an explicit "EOF"
character (inserted by the document.close()
method) is
consumed. Інакше the "EOF" character is not a real character in the
stream, but rather the lack of any further characters.
The handling of U+0000 NULL characters varies based on where the characters are found. In general, they are ignored except where doing so could plausibly introduce an attack vector. This handling is, by necessity, spread across both the tokenization stage and the tree construction stage.
The insertion mode is a state variable that controls the primary operation of the tree construction stage.
Initially, the insertion mode is "initial". It can change to "before html", "before head", "in head", "in head noscript", "after head", "in body", "text", "in table", "in table text", "in caption", "in column group", "in table body", "in row", "in cell", "in select", "in select in table", "in template", "after body", "in frameset", "after frameset", "after after body" та "after after frameset" during the course of the parsing, as described in the tree construction stage. The insertion mode affects how tokens are processed and whether CDATA sections are supported.
Several of these modes, namely "in head", "in body", "in table" та "in select", are special, in that the other modes defer to them at various times. When the algorithm below says that the user agent is to do something "using the rules for the m insertion mode", where m is one of these modes, the user agent must use the rules described under the m insertion mode's section, but must leave the insertion mode unchanged unless the rules in m themselves switch the insertion mode to a new value.
When the insertion mode is switched to "text" or "in table text", the original insertion mode is also set. This is the insertion mode to which the tree construction stage will return.
Similarly, to parse nested template
elements, a stack of
template insertion modes is used. It is initially empty. The current template insertion mode
is the insertion mode that was most recently added to the stack
of template insertion modes. The algorithms in the sections below
will push insertion modes onto this stack, meaning that the
specified insertion mode is to be added to the stack та pop
insertion modes from the stack, which means that the most recently added
insertion mode must be removed from the stack.
When the steps below require the UA to reset the insertion mode appropriately, it means the UA must follow these steps:
Нехай last be false.
Нехай node be the last node in the stack of open elements.
Loop: Якщо node is the first node in the stack of open elements, then set last to true та, if the parser was originally created as part of the HTML fragment parsing algorithm (fragment case) set node to the context element.
Якщо node is a select
element, виконати ці підкроки:
Якщо last є true, jump to the step below labeled done.
Нехай ancestor be node.
Loop: Якщо ancestor is the first node in the stack of open elements, jump to the step below labeled done.
Нехай ancestor be the node before ancestor in the stack of open elements.
Якщо ancestor is a template
node, jump to the step below labeled done.
Якщо ancestor is a table
node, switch the insertion mode
to "in
select in table" and abort these steps.
Jump back to the step labeled loop.
Done: Switch the insertion mode to "in select" and abort these steps.
Якщо node is a td
or th
element and last is false, then switch the insertion
mode to "in
cell" and abort these steps.
Якщо node is a tr
element, then switch the insertion mode
to "in
row" and abort these steps.
Якщо node is a tbody
,
thead
, or tfoot
element, then switch the insertion mode
to "in
table body" and abort these steps.
Якщо node is a caption
element, then switch the insertion mode
to "in
caption" and abort these steps.
Якщо node is a colgroup
element, then switch the insertion mode
to "in
column group" and abort these steps.
Якщо node is a table
element, then switch the insertion mode
to "in
table" and abort these steps.
Якщо node is a template
element, then switch the insertion mode
to the current template
insertion mode and abort these steps.
head
element and last є true, then switch
the insertion mode to "in body" ("in body"! not "in head"!) and abort these
steps. (fragment case)Якщо node is a head
element and last is false, then
switch the insertion mode to "in head" and abort these steps.
Якщо node is a body
element, then switch the insertion mode
to "in
body" and abort these steps.
Якщо node is a frameset
element, then switch the insertion mode
to "in
frameset" and abort these steps. (fragment
case)
Якщо node is an html
element, виконати ці підкроки:
Якщо the head
element pointer is null, switch the insertion
mode to "before head" and
abort these steps. (fragment case)
Інакше the head
element pointer is not null, switch the insertion
mode to "after head" and
abort these steps.
Якщо last є true, then switch the insertion mode to "in body" and abort these steps. (fragment case)
Нехай node now be the node before node in the stack of open elements.
Повернутиto the step labeled loop.
Initially, the stack of open elements is empty. The stack grows downwards; the topmost node on the stack is the first one added to the stack та the bottommost node of the stack is the most recently added node in the stack (notwithstanding when the stack is manipulated in a random access fashion as part of the handling for misnested tags).
The "before
html" insertion mode creates the html
root element node, which is
then added to the stack.
In the fragment case, the stack of open elements is
initialized to contain an html
element that is created as part of that
algorithm. (The fragment case skips
the "before
html" insertion mode.)
The html
node, however it
is created, is the topmost node of the stack. It only gets popped off
the stack when the parser finishes.
The current node is the bottommost node in this stack of open elements.
The adjusted current node is the context element if the stack of open elements has only one element in it and the parser was created by the HTML fragment parsing algorithm; otherwise, the adjusted current node is the current node.
Elements in the stack of open elements fall into the following categories:
The following elements have varying levels of special parsing
rules: HTML's address
,
applet
, area
,
article
, aside
,
base
, basefont
,
bgsound
, blockquote
,
body
, br
,
button
, caption
,
center
, col
,
colgroup
, dd
, details
, dir
, div
,
dl
, dt
,
embed
, fieldset
,
figcaption
, figure
, footer
,
form
, frame
,
frameset
, h1
,
h2
,
h3
,
h4
,
h5
,
h6
,
head
, header
,
hgroup
, hr
,
html
, iframe
,
img
, input
,
isindex
, li
,
link
, listing
,
main
, marquee
,
meta
, nav
,
noembed
, noframes
,
noscript
, object
, ol
,
p
, param
,
plaintext
, pre
,
script
, section
,
select
, source
,
style
, summary
,
table
, tbody
,
td
, template
,
textarea
, tfoot
, th
,
thead
, title
,
tr
, track
,
ul
, wbr
та xmp
; MathML's mi
,
mo
, mn
,
ms
, mtext
та annotation-xml
; and SVG's foreignObject
, desc
та title
.
The following HTML elements are those that end up in the list
of active formatting elements: a
,
b
, big
,
code
, em
,
font
, i
,
nobr
, s
,
small
, strike
,
strong
, tt
та u
.
All other elements found while parsing an HTML document.
The stack of open elements is said to have an element target node in a specific scope consisting of a list of element types list when the following algorithm terminates in a match state:
Initialize node to be the current node (the bottommost node of the stack).
Якщо node is the target node, terminate in a match state.
Інакше if node is one of the element types in list, terminate in a failure state.
Інакше set node to the previous
entry in the stack of open
elements and return to step 2. (This will never fail, since
the loop will always terminate in the previous step if the top of
the stack — an html
element — is reached.)
The stack of open elements is said to have a particular element in scope when it has that element in the specific scope consisting of the following element types:
applet
in the простір
імен HTMLcaption
in the простір
імен HTMLhtml
in the простір
імен HTMLtable
in the простір
імен HTMLtd
in the простір
імен HTMLth
in the простір
імен HTMLmarquee
in the простір імен HTMLobject
in the простір
імен HTMLtemplate
in the простір імен HTMLmi
in the MathML
namespacemo
in the MathML
namespacemn
in the MathML
namespacems
in the MathML
namespacemtext
in the MathML
namespaceannotation-xml
in the MathML
namespaceforeignObject
in the SVG
namespacedesc
in the SVG
namespacetitle
in the SVG
namespaceThe stack of open elements is said to have a particular element in list item scope when it has that element in the specific scope consisting of the following element types:
ol
in the простір
імен HTMLul
in the простір
імен HTMLThe stack of open elements is said to have a particular element in button scope when it has that element in the specific scope consisting of the following element types:
button
in the простір
імен HTMLThe stack of open elements is said to have a particular element in table scope when it has that element in the specific scope consisting of the following element types:
html
in the простір
імен HTMLtable
in the простір
імен HTMLtemplate
in the простір імен HTMLThe stack of open elements is said to have a particular element in select scope when it has that element in the specific scope consisting of all element types except the following:
optgroup
in the простір імен HTMLoption
in the простір
імен HTMLNothing happens if at any time any of the elements in the stack
of open elements are moved to a new location in, or removed from,
the Document
tree. In particular,
the stack is not changed in this situation. This can cause, amongst
other strange effects, content to be appended to nodes що є no longer in
the DOM.
In some cases (namely, when closing misnested formatting elements), the stack is manipulated in a random-access fashion.
Initially, the list of active formatting elements is empty. It is used to handle mis-nested formatting element tags.
The list contains elements in the formatting
category та scope markers. The scope markers are inserted when entering
applet
elements, buttons,
object
elements,
marquees, table cells та table captions та are used to prevent
formatting from "leaking" into applet
elements, buttons, object
elements, marquees та tables.
The scope markers are unrelated to the concept of an element being in scope.
In addition, each element in the list of active formatting elements is associated with the token for which it was created, so that further elements can be created for that token if necessary.
When the steps below require the UA to push onto the list of active formatting elements an element element, the UA must perform the following steps:
Якщо there are already three elements in the list of active formatting elements after the last list marker, if any, or anywhere in the list if there are no list markers, that have the same tag name, namespace та attributes as element, then remove the earliest such element from the list of active formatting elements. For these purposes, the attributes must be compared as they were when the elements were created by the parser; two elements have the same attributes if all their parsed attributes can be paired such that the two attributes in each pair have identical names, namespaces та values (the order of the attributes does not matter).
This is the Noah's Ark clause. But with three per family instead of two.
Add element to the list of active formatting elements.
When the steps below require the UA to reconstruct the active formatting elements, the UA must perform the following steps:
Якщо there are no entries in the list of active formatting elements, then there is nothing to reconstruct; stop this algorithm.
Якщо the last (most recently added) entry in the list of active formatting elements is a marker, or if it is an element that is in the stack of open elements, then there is nothing to reconstruct; stop this algorithm.
Нехай entry be the last (most recently added) element in the list of active formatting elements.
Rewind: Якщо there are no entries before entry in the list of active formatting elements, then jump to the step labeled create.
Нехай entry be the entry one earlier than entry in the list of active formatting elements.
Якщо entry is neither a marker nor an element that is also in the stack of open elements, go to the step labeled rewind.
Просуньте: Нехай entry be the element one later than entry in the list of active formatting elements.
Create: Insert an HTML element for the token for which the element entry was created, щоб отримати new element.
Replace the entry for entry in the list with an entry for new element.
Якщо the entry for new element in the list of active formatting elements is not the last entry in the list, return to the step labeled advance.
This has the effect of reopening all the formatting elements that were opened in the current body, cell, or caption (whichever is youngest) that haven't been explicitly closed.
The way this specification is written, the list of active formatting elements always consists of elements in chronological order with the least recently added element first and the most recently added element last (except for while steps 8 to 11 of the above algorithm are being executed, of course).
When the steps below require the UA to clear the list of active formatting elements up to the last marker, the UA must perform the following steps:
Нехай entry be the last (most recently added) entry in the list of active formatting elements.
Remove entry from the list of active formatting elements.
Якщо entry was a marker, then stop the algorithm at this point. The list has been cleared up to the last marker.
Go to step 1.
Initially, the head
element pointer and the form
element pointer are both null.
Once a head
element has
been parsed (whether implicitly or explicitly) the head
element pointer gets set to
point to this node.
The form
element pointer points to the last form
element that was opened and whose end tag has not yet been seen. It is
used to make form controls associate with forms in the face of
dramatically bad markup, for historical reasons. It is ignored inside template
elements.
The scripting flag is set to "enabled"
if scripting
was enabled for the Document
with which the parser is associated when the parser was created та
"disabled" otherwise.
The scripting flag can be
enabled even when the parser was originally created for the HTML
fragment parsing algorithm, even though script
elements don't execute in that case.
The frameset-ok flag is set to "ok" when the parser is created. It is set to "not ok" after certain tokens are seen.
Implementations must act as if they used the following state machine to tokenize HTML. The state machine must start in the data state. Most states consume a single character, which may have various side-effects та either switches the state machine to a new state to reconsume the same character, or switches it to a new state to consume the next character, or stays in the same state to consume the next character. Some states have more complicated behavior and can consume several characters before switching to another state. In some cases, the tokenizer state is also changed by the tree construction stage.
The exact behavior of certain states depends on the insertion mode and the stack of open elements. Certain states also use a temporary buffer to track progress.
The output of the tokenization step is a series of zero or more of the following tokens: DOCTYPE, start tag, end tag, comment, character, end-of-file. DOCTYPE tokens have a name, a public identifier, a system identifier та a force-quirks flag. When a DOCTYPE token is created, its name, public identifier та system identifier must be marked as missing (which is a distinct state from the empty string) та the force-quirks flag must be set to off (its other state is on). Start and end tag tokens have a tag name, a self-closing flag та a list of attributes, each of which has a name and a value. When a start or end tag token is created, its self-closing flag must be unset (its other state is that it be set) та its attributes list must be empty. Comment and character tokens have data.
When a token is emitted, it must immediately be handled by the tree
construction stage. The tree construction stage can affect the
state of the tokenization stage та can insert additional characters into
the stream. (For example, the script
element can result in scripts executing and using the dynamic
markup insertion APIs to insert characters into the stream being
tokenized.)
Creating a token and emitting it are distinct actions. It is possible for a token to be created but implicitly abandoned (never emitted), e.g. if the file ends unexpectedly while processing the characters що є, що буде розібраний into a start tag token.
When a start tag token is emitted with its self-closing flag set, if the flag is not acknowledged when it is processed by the tree construction stage, that is a parse error.
When an end tag token is emitted with attributes, that is a parse error.
When an end tag token is emitted with its self-closing flag set, that is a parse error.
An appropriate end tag token is an end tag token whose tag name matches the tag name of the last start tag to have been emitted from this tokenizer, if any. Якщо no start tag has been emitted from this tokenizer, then no end tag token is appropriate.
Before each step of the tokenizer, the user agent must first check the parser pause flag. Якщо it є true, then the tokenizer must abort the processing of any nested invocations of the tokenizer, yielding control back to the caller.
The tokenizer state machine consists of the states defined in the following subsections.
Consume the next input character:
Switch to the data state.
Attempt to consume a character reference, with no additional allowed character.
Якщо nothing is returned, emit a U+0026 AMPERSAND character (&) token.
Інакше emit the character tokens that were returned.
Consume the next input character:
Switch to the RCDATA state.
Attempt to consume a character reference, with no additional allowed character.
Якщо nothing is returned, emit a U+0026 AMPERSAND character (&) token.
Інакше emit the character tokens that were returned.
Consume the next input character:
Consume the next input character:
Consume the next input character:
Consume the next input character:
Consume the next input character:
Consume the next input character:
Consume the next input character:
Consume the next input character:
Consume the next input character:
Consume the next input character:
Consume the next input character:
Consume the next input character:
Consume the next input character:
Consume the next input character:
Consume the next input character:
Consume the next input character:
Consume the next input character:
Consume the next input character:
Consume the next input character:
Consume the next input character:
Consume the next input character:
Consume the next input character:
Consume the next input character:
Consume the next input character:
script
", then switch
to the script data double
escaped state. Інакше switch to the script
data escaped state. Emit the current
input character as a character token.Consume the next input character:
Consume the next input character:
Consume the next input character:
Consume the next input character:
Consume the next input character:
script
", then switch
to the script data escaped state.
Інакше switch to the script
data double escaped state. Emit the current
input character as a character token.Consume the next input character:
Consume the next input character:
When the user agent leaves the attribute name state (and before emitting the tag token, if appropriate), the complete attribute's name must be compared to the other attributes on the same token; if there is already an attribute on the token with the exact same name, then this is a parse error and the new attribute must be removed from the token.
Якщо an attribute is so removed from a token, it, along with the value that gets associated with it, if any, are never subsequently used by the parser та are therefore effectively discarded. Removing the attribute in this way does not change its status as the "current attribute" for the purposes of the tokenizer, however.
Consume the next input character:
Consume the next input character:
Consume the next input character:
Consume the next input character:
Consume the next input character:
Attempt to consume a character reference.
Якщо nothing is returned, append a U+0026 AMPERSAND character (&) to the current attribute's value.
Інакше append the returned character tokens to the current attribute's value.
Finally, switch back to the attribute value state that switched into this state.
Consume the next input character:
Consume the next input character:
Consume every character up to and including the first ">" (U+003E)
character or the end of the file (EOF), whichever comes first. Emit a
comment token whose data is the concatenation of all the characters
starting from and including the character that caused the state machine
to switch into the bogus comment state, up to and including the
character immediately before the last consumed character (i.e. up to the
character just before the U+003E or EOF character), but with any U+0000
NULL characters replaced by U+FFFD REPLACEMENT CHARACTER characters.
(Якщо the comment was started by the end of the file (EOF), the token is
empty. Similarly, the token is empty if it was generated by the string "<!>
".)
Switch to the data state.
Якщо the end of the file was reached, reconsume the EOF character.
Якщо the next two characters are both "-" (U+002D) characters, consume those two characters, create a comment token whose data is the empty string та switch to the comment start state.
Інакше if the next seven characters are an ASCII чутливі до реєстру match for the word "DOCTYPE", then consume those characters and switch to the DOCTYPE state.
Інакше if there is an adjusted current node and it is not an element in the простір імен HTML and the next seven characters are a case-sensitive match for the string "[CDATA[" (the five uppercase letters "CDATA" with a U+005B LEFT SQUARE BRACKET character before and after), then consume those characters and switch to the CDATA section state.
Інакше this is a parse error. Switch to the bogus comment state. The next character that is consumed, if any, is the first character that will be in the comment.
Consume the next input character:
Consume the next input character:
Consume the next input character:
Consume the next input character:
Consume the next input character:
Consume the next input character:
Consume the next input character:
Consume the next input character:
Consume the next input character:
Consume the next input character:
Якщо the six characters starting from the current input character are an ASCII чутливі до реєстру match for the word "PUBLIC", then consume those characters and switch to the after DOCTYPE public keyword state.
Інакше if the six characters starting from the current input character are an ASCII чутливі до реєстру match for the word "SYSTEM", then consume those characters and switch to the after DOCTYPE system keyword state.
Інакше this is a parse error. Set the DOCTYPE token's force-quirks flag to on. Switch to the bogus DOCTYPE state.
Consume the next input character:
Consume the next input character:
Consume the next input character:
Consume the next input character:
Consume the next input character:
Consume the next input character:
Consume the next input character:
Consume the next input character:
Consume the next input character:
Consume the next input character:
Consume the next input character:
Consume the next input character:
Switch to the data state.
Consume every character up to the next occurrence of the three
character sequence U+005D RIGHT SQUARE BRACKET U+005D RIGHT SQUARE
BRACKET U+003E GREATER-THAN SIGN (]]>
),
or the end of the file (EOF), whichever comes first. Emit a series of
character tokens consisting of all the characters consumed except the
matching three character sequence at the end (if one was found before
the end of the file).
Якщо the end of the file was reached, reconsume the EOF character.
This section defines how to consume a character reference, optionally with an additional allowed character, which, if specified where the algorithm is invoked, adds a character to the list of characters that cause there to not be a character reference.
This definition is used when parsing character references in text and in attributes.
The behavior depends on the identity of the next character (the one immediately after the U+0026 AMPERSAND character), as follows:
Consume the U+0023 NUMBER SIGN.
The behavior further depends on the character after the U+0023 NUMBER SIGN:
Consume the X.
Follow the steps below, but using шестнадцятеричними символами ASCII.
When it comes to interpreting the number, interpret it як шестнадцятеричне число.
Follow the steps below, but using цифрами ASCII.
When it comes to interpreting the number, interpret it as a decimal number.
Consume as many characters as match the range of characters given above (шестнадцятеричними символами ASCII or цифрами ASCII).
Якщо no characters match the range, then don't consume any characters (and unconsume the U+0023 NUMBER SIGN character and, if appropriate, the X character). This is a parse error; nothing is returned.
Інакше if the next character є символом U+003B SEMICOLON, consume that too. Якщо it isn't, there is a parse error.
Якщо one or more characters match the range, then take them all and interpret the string of characters as a number (either hexadecimal or decimal as appropriate).
Якщо that number is one of the numbers in the first column of the following table, then this is a parse error. Find the row with that number in the first column та return a character token for the Unicode character given in the second column of that row.
Number | Unicode character | |
---|---|---|
0x00 | U+FFFD | REPLACEMENT CHARACTER |
0x80 | U+20AC | EURO SIGN (€) |
0x82 | U+201A | SINGLE LOW-9 QUOTATION MARK (‚) |
0x83 | U+0192 | LATIN SMALL LETTER F WITH HOOK (ƒ) |
0x84 | U+201E | DOUBLE LOW-9 QUOTATION MARK („) |
0x85 | U+2026 | HORIZONTAL ELLIPSIS (…) |
0x86 | U+2020 | DAGGER (†) |
0x87 | U+2021 | DOUBLE DAGGER (‡) |
0x88 | U+02C6 | MODIFIER LETTER CIRCUMFLEX ACCENT (ˆ) |
0x89 | U+2030 | PER MILLE SIGN (‰) |
0x8A | U+0160 | LATIN CAPITAL LETTER S WITH CARON (Š) |
0x8B | U+2039 | SINGLE LEFT-POINTING ANGLE QUOTATION MARK (‹) |
0x8C | U+0152 | LATIN CAPITAL LIGATURE OE (Œ) |
0x8E | U+017D | LATIN CAPITAL LETTER Z WITH CARON (Ž) |
0x91 | U+2018 | LEFT SINGLE QUOTATION MARK (‘) |
0x92 | U+2019 | RIGHT SINGLE QUOTATION MARK (’) |
0x93 | U+201C | LEFT DOUBLE QUOTATION MARK (“) |
0x94 | U+201D | RIGHT DOUBLE QUOTATION MARK (”) |
0x95 | U+2022 | BULLET (•) |
0x96 | U+2013 | EN DASH (–) |
0x97 | U+2014 | EM DASH (—) |
0x98 | U+02DC | SMALL TILDE (˜) |
0x99 | U+2122 | TRADE MARK SIGN (™) |
0x9A | U+0161 | LATIN SMALL LETTER S WITH CARON (š) |
0x9B | U+203A | SINGLE RIGHT-POINTING ANGLE QUOTATION MARK (›) |
0x9C | U+0153 | LATIN SMALL LIGATURE OE (œ) |
0x9E | U+017E | LATIN SMALL LETTER Z WITH CARON (ž) |
0x9F | U+0178 | LATIN CAPITAL LETTER Y WITH DIAERESIS (Ÿ) |
Інакше if the number is in the range 0xD800 to 0xDFFF or is greater than 0x10FFFF, then this is a parse error. Повернутиa U+FFFD REPLACEMENT CHARACTER character token.
Інакше return a character token for the Unicode character whose code point is that number. Additionally, if the number is in the range 0x0001 to 0x0008, 0x000D to 0x001F, 0x007F to 0x009F, 0xFDD0 to 0xFDEF, or is one of 0x000B, 0xFFFE, 0xFFFF, 0x1FFFE, 0x1FFFF, 0x2FFFE, 0x2FFFF, 0x3FFFE, 0x3FFFF, 0x4FFFE, 0x4FFFF, 0x5FFFE, 0x5FFFF, 0x6FFFE, 0x6FFFF, 0x7FFFE, 0x7FFFF, 0x8FFFE, 0x8FFFF, 0x9FFFE, 0x9FFFF, 0xAFFFE, 0xAFFFF, 0xBFFFE, 0xBFFFF, 0xCFFFE, 0xCFFFF, 0xDFFFE, 0xDFFFF, 0xEFFFE, 0xEFFFF, 0xFFFFE, 0xFFFFF, 0x10FFFE, or 0x10FFFF, then this is a parse error.
Consume the maximum number of characters possible, with the consumed characters matching one of the identifiers in the first column of the named character references table (in a case-sensitive manner).
Якщо no match can be made, then no characters are consumed та nothing is returned. In this case, if the characters after the U+0026 AMPERSAND character (&) consist of a sequence of one or more alphanumeric ASCII characters followed by a U+003B SEMICOLON character (;), then this is a parse error.
Якщо символ reference is being consumed as part of an attribute та the last character matched is not a ";" (U+003B) character та the next character is either a "=" (U+003D) character or an alphanumeric ASCII character, then, for historical reasons, all the characters that were matched after the U+0026 AMPERSAND character (&) must be unconsumed та nothing is returned. However, if this next character is in fact a "=" (U+003D) character, then this is a parse error, because some legacy user agents will misinterpret the markup in those cases.
Інакше a character reference is parsed. Якщо the last character matched is not a ";" (U+003B) character, there is a parse error.
Повернутиone or two character tokens for the character(s) corresponding to the character reference name (as given by the second column of the named character references table).
Якщо the markup contains (not in an attribute) the string I'm ¬it; I tell you
, the
character reference is parsed as "not", as in, I'm
¬it; I tell you
(and this is a parse error). But if the
markup was I'm ∉ I tell you
,
the character reference would be parsed as "notin;", resulting in
I'm ∉ I tell you
(and no parse
error).
The input to the tree construction stage is a sequence of tokens from
the tokenization stage. The tree
construction stage is associated with a DOM Document
object when a parser is created. The "output" of this stage consists of
dynamically modifying or extending that document's DOM tree.
This specification does not define when an interactive user agent has
to render the Document
so that it
is available to the user, or when it has to begin accepting user input.
As each token is emitted from the tokenizer, the user agent must follow the appropriate steps from the following list, known as the tree construction dispatcher:
annotation-xml
element in the
MathML namespace and the token is a
start tag whose tag name is "svg"The next token is the token that is about to be processed by the tree construction dispatcher (even if the token is subsequently just ignored).
A node is a MathML text integration point if it is one of the following elements:
mi
element in the MathML
namespacemo
element in the MathML
namespacemn
element in the MathML
namespacems
element in the MathML
namespacemtext
element in the MathML
namespaceA node is an HTML integration point if it is one of the following elements:
annotation-xml
element in the MathML namespace whose start tag token
had an attribute with the name "encoding" whose value was an ASCII
чутливі до реєстру match for the string "text/html
"annotation-xml
element in the MathML namespace whose start tag token
had an attribute with the name "encoding" whose value was an ASCII
чутливі до реєстру match for the string "application/xhtml+xml
"foreignObject
element in the SVG namespacedesc
element in the SVG
namespacetitle
element in the SVG
namespaceNot all of the tag names mentioned below are conformant tag names in this specification; many are included to handle legacy content. They still form part of the algorithm that implementations are required to implement to claim conformance.
The algorithm described below places no limit on the depth
of the DOM tree generated, or on the length of tag names, attribute
names, attribute values, Text
nodes,
etc. While implementors are encouraged to avoid arbitrary limits, it is
recognized that practical concerns
will likely force user agents to impose nesting depth constraints.
While the parser is processing a token, it can enable or disable foster parenting. This affects the following algorithm.
The appropriate place for inserting a node, optionally using a particular override target, is the position in an element returned by running the following steps:
Якщо there was an override target specified, then let target be the override target.
Інакше let target be the current node.
Determine the adjusted insertion location using the first matching steps from the following list:
table
, tbody
, tfoot
,
thead
, or tr
elementFoster parenting happens when content is misnested in tables.
виконати ці підкроки:
Нехай last template be the
last template
element in the stack of
open elements, if any.
Нехай last table be the
last table
element in the stack of
open elements, if any.
Якщо there is a last template and either there is no last table, or there is one, but last template is lower (more recently added) than last table in the stack of open elements, then: let adjusted insertion location be inside last template's template contents, after its last child (if any) та abort these substeps.
Якщо there is no last table,
then let adjusted
insertion location be inside the first element in
the stack of open
elements (the html
element), after its last child (if any) та abort these
substeps. (fragment case)
Якщо last table has a parent element, then let adjusted insertion location be inside last table's parent element, immediately before last table та abort these substeps.
Нехай previous element be the element immediately above last table in the stack of open elements.
Нехай adjusted insertion location be inside previous element, after its last child (if any).
These steps are involved in part because it's
possible for elements, the table
element in this case in particular, to have been moved by a
script around in the DOM, or indeed removed from the DOM
entirely, after the element was inserted by the parser.
Нехай adjusted insertion location be inside target, after its last child (if any).
Якщо the adjusted insertion location
is inside a template
element, let it instead be inside the template
element's template contents, after
its last child (if any).
Повернути adjusted insertion location.
When the steps below require the UA to create an element for a token in a particular given namespace and with a particular intended parent, the UA must run the following steps:
Create a node implementing the interface appropriate for the
element type corresponding to the tag name of the token in given
namespace (as given in the specification that defines that
element, e.g. for an a
element in the простір імен HTML,
this specification defines it to be the HTMLAnchorElement
interface), with the tag name being the name of that element, with
the node being in the given namespace та with the attributes on the
node being those given in the given token.
The interface appropriate for an element in the простір
імен HTML that is not defined in this specification (or other
applicable specifications) is HTMLUnknownElement
.
Elements in other namespaces whose interface is not defined by that
namespace's specification must use the interface Element
.
The ownerDocument
of the newly created element must be the same as that of the intended
parent.
Якщо the newly created element has an xmlns
attribute in the XMLNS namespace
whose value не є точно the same as the element's namespace, that is
a parse error. Similarly, if the newly
created element has an xmlns:xlink
attribute in the XMLNS namespace
whose value is not the XLink Namespace,
that is a parse error.
Якщо the newly created element is a resettable element, invoke its reset algorithm. (This initializes the element's value and checkedness based on the element's attributes.)
Якщо the element is a form-associated
element та the form
element pointer is not null та there is no template
element on the stack of open
elements та the newly created element is either not reassociateable or doesn't have a form
attribute та the intended parent is
in the same home subtree as the element
pointed to by the form
element pointer, associate the newly created
element with the form
element pointed to by the form
element pointer та suppress the running of the reset
the form owner algorithm when the parser subsequently attempts
to insert the element.
Повернути newly created element.
When the steps below require the user agent to insert a foreign element for a token in a given namespace, the user agent must run these steps:
Нехай the adjusted insertion location be the appropriate place for inserting a node.
Create an element for the token in the given namespace, with the intended parent being the element in which the adjusted insertion location finds itself.
Якщо it is possible to insert an element at the adjusted insertion location, then insert the newly created element at the adjusted insertion location.
Якщо the adjusted insertion
location cannot accept more elements, e.g. because it's a Document
that already has an element
child, then the newly created element is dropped on the floor.
Push the element onto the stack of open elements so that it is the new current node.
Повернути newly created element.
When the steps below require the user agent to insert an HTML element for a token, the user agent must insert a foreign element for the token, in the простір імен HTML.
When the steps below require the user agent to adjust
MathML attributes for a token, then, if the token has an
attribute named definitionurl
, change
its name to definitionURL
(note the
case difference).
When the steps below require the user agent to adjust SVG attributes for a token, then, for each attribute on the token whose attribute name is one of the ones in the first column of the following table, change the attribute's name to the name given in the corresponding cell in the second column. (This fixes the case of SVG attributes що є not all lowercase.)
Attribute name on token | Attribute name on element |
---|---|
attributename |
attributeName |
attributetype |
attributeType |
basefrequency |
baseFrequency |
baseprofile |
baseProfile |
calcmode |
calcMode |
clippathunits |
clipPathUnits |
contentscripttype |
contentScriptType |
contentstyletype |
contentStyleType |
diffuseconstant |
diffuseConstant |
edgemode |
edgeMode |
externalresourcesrequired |
externalResourcesRequired |
filterres |
filterRes |
filterunits |
filterUnits |
glyphref |
glyphRef |
gradienttransform |
gradientTransform |
gradientunits |
gradientUnits |
kernelmatrix |
kernelMatrix |
kernelunitlength |
kernelUnitLength |
keypoints |
keyPoints |
keysplines |
keySplines |
keytimes |
keyTimes |
lengthadjust |
lengthAdjust |
limitingconeangle |
limitingConeAngle |
markerheight |
markerHeight |
markerunits |
markerUnits |
markerwidth |
markerWidth |
maskcontentunits |
maskContentUnits |
maskunits |
maskUnits |
numoctaves |
numOctaves |
pathlength |
pathLength |
patterncontentunits |
patternContentUnits |
patterntransform |
patternTransform |
patternunits |
patternUnits |
pointsatx |
pointsAtX |
pointsaty |
pointsAtY |
pointsatz |
pointsAtZ |
preservealpha |
preserveAlpha |
preserveaspectratio |
preserveAspectRatio |
primitiveunits |
primitiveUnits |
refx |
refX |
refy |
refY |
repeatcount |
repeatCount |
repeatdur |
repeatDur |
requiredextensions |
requiredExtensions |
requiredfeatures |
requiredFeatures |
specularconstant |
specularConstant |
specularexponent |
specularExponent |
spreadmethod |
spreadMethod |
startoffset |
startOffset |
stddeviation |
stdDeviation |
stitchtiles |
stitchTiles |
surfacescale |
surfaceScale |
systemlanguage |
systemLanguage |
tablevalues |
tableValues |
targetx |
targetX |
targety |
targetY |
textlength |
textLength |
viewbox |
viewBox |
viewtarget |
viewTarget |
xchannelselector |
xChannelSelector |
ychannelselector |
yChannelSelector |
zoomandpan |
zoomAndPan |
When the steps below require the user agent to adjust
foreign attributes for a token, then, if any of the attributes
on the token match the strings given in the first column of the
following table, let the attribute be a namespaced attribute, with the
prefix being the string given in the corresponding cell in the second
column, the local name being the string given in the corresponding cell
in the third column та the namespace being the namespace given in the
corresponding cell in the fourth column. (This fixes the use of
namespaced attributes, in particular lang
attributes
in the XML namespace.)
Attribute name | Prefix | Local name | Namespace |
---|---|---|---|
xlink:actuate |
xlink |
actuate |
XLink namespace |
xlink:arcrole |
xlink |
arcrole |
XLink namespace |
xlink:href |
xlink |
href |
XLink namespace |
xlink:role |
xlink |
role |
XLink namespace |
xlink:show |
xlink |
show |
XLink namespace |
xlink:title |
xlink |
title |
XLink namespace |
xlink:type |
xlink |
type |
XLink namespace |
xml:base |
xml |
base |
XML namespace |
xml:lang |
xml |
lang |
XML namespace |
xml:space |
xml |
space |
XML namespace |
xmlns |
(none) | xmlns |
XMLNS namespace |
xmlns:xlink |
xmlns |
xlink |
XMLNS namespace |
When the steps below require the user agent to insert a character while processing a token, the user agent must run the following steps:
Нехай data be the characters passed to the algorithm, or, if no characters were explicitly specified, the character of the character token being processed.
Нехай the adjusted insertion location be the appropriate place for inserting a node.
Якщо the adjusted insertion location
is in a Document
node, then
abort these steps.
The DOM will not let Document
nodes have Text
node children,
so they are dropped on the floor.
Якщо there is a Text
node
immediately before the adjusted insertion
location, then append data
to that Text
node's data.
Інакше create a new Text
node
whose data is data and whose ownerDocument
is the same as that of the element in which the adjusted
insertion location finds itself та insert the newly created
node at the adjusted insertion location.
Here are some sample inputs to the parser and the corresponding
number of Text
nodes that they
result in, assuming a user agent that executes scripts.
Input | Number of Text nodes |
---|---|
A<script> var script = document.getElementsByTagName('script')[0]; document.body.removeChild(script); </script>B |
One Text node in the
document, containing "AB". |
A<script> var text = document.createTextNode('B'); document.body.appendChild(text); </script>C |
Three Text nodes; "A"
before the script, the script's contents та "BC" after the
script (the parser appends to the Text
node created by the script). |
A<script> var text = document.getElementsByTagName('script')[0].firstChild; text.data = 'B'; document.body.appendChild(text); </script>C |
Two adjacent Text nodes in
the document, containing "A" and "BC". |
A<table>B<tr>C</tr>D</table> |
One Text node before the
table, containing "ABCD". (This is caused by foster parenting.) |
A<table><tr> B</tr> C</table> |
One Text node before the
table, containing "A B C" (A-space-B-space-C). (This
is caused by foster
parenting.) |
A<table><tr> B</tr> </em>C</table> |
One Text node before the
table, containing "A BC" (A-space-B-C) та one Text
node inside the table (as a child of a tbody )
with a single space character. (Space characters separated from
non-space characters by non-character tokens are not affected by
foster
parenting, even if those other tokens then get ignored.) |
When the steps below require the user agent to insert a comment while processing a comment token, optionally with an explicitly insertion position position, the user agent must run the following steps:
Нехай data be the data given in the comment token being processed.
Якщо position was specified, then let the adjusted insertion location be position. Інакше let adjusted insertion location be the appropriate place for inserting a node.
Create a Comment
node whose
data
attribute is set to data
and whose ownerDocument
is the same as that of the node in which the adjusted
insertion location finds itself.
Insert the newly created node at the adjusted insertion location.
DOM mutation events must not fire for
changes caused by the UA parsing the document. This includes the parsing
of any content inserted using document.write()
and document.writeln()
calls. [DOMEVENTS]
However, mutation observers do fire, as required by the DOM specification.
The generic raw text element parsing algorithm and the generic RCDATA element parsing algorithm consist of the following steps. These algorithms are always invoked in response to a start tag token.
Insert an HTML element for the token.
Якщо the algorithm that was invoked is the generic raw text element parsing algorithm, switch the tokenizer to the RAWTEXT state; otherwise the algorithm invoked was the generic RCDATA element parsing algorithm, switch the tokenizer to the RCDATA state.
Нехай the original insertion mode be the current insertion mode.
Then, switch the insertion mode to "text".
When the steps below require the UA to generate
implied end tags, then, while the current
node is a dd
element,
a dt
element, an li
element, an option
element, an optgroup
element, a p
element, an rb
element, an rp
element, an rt
element, or
an rtc
element, the UA must
pop the current node off the stack
of open elements.
Якщо a step requires the UA to generate implied end tags but lists an element to exclude from the process, then the UA must perform the above steps as if that element was not in the above list.
When the user agent is to apply the rules for the "initial" insertion mode, the user agent must handle the token as follows:
Ignore the token.
Insert a comment as the last child
of the Document
object.
Якщо the DOCTYPE token's name is not a case-sensitive
match for the string "html
", or the
token's public identifier is not missing, or the token's system
identifier is neither missing nor a case-sensitive
match for the string "about:legacy-compat
"
та none of the sets of conditions in the following list are matched,
then there is a parse error.
html
", the
token's public identifier is the case-sensitive
string "-//W3C//DTD HTML 4.0//EN
"
та the token's system identifier is either missing or the case-sensitive
string "http://www.w3.org/TR/REC-html40/strict.dtd
".html
", the
token's public identifier is the case-sensitive
string "-//W3C//DTD HTML 4.01//EN
"
та the token's system identifier is either missing or the case-sensitive
string "http://www.w3.org/TR/html4/strict.dtd
".html
", the
token's public identifier is the case-sensitive
string "-//W3C//DTD XHTML 1.0 Strict//EN
"
та the token's system identifier is the case-sensitive
string "http://www.w3.org/TR/xhtml1/DTD/xhtml1-strict.dtd
".html
", the
token's public identifier is the case-sensitive
string "-//W3C//DTD XHTML 1.1//EN
"
та the token's system identifier is the case-sensitive
string "http://www.w3.org/TR/xhtml11/DTD/xhtml11.dtd
".Conformance checkers may, based on the values (including presence or lack thereof) of the DOCTYPE token's name, public identifier, or system identifier, switch to a conformance checking mode for another language (e.g. based on the DOCTYPE token a conformance checker could recognize that the document is an HTML4-era document та defer to an HTML4 conformance checker.)
Append a DocumentType
node to the Document
node,
with the name
attribute set to the
name given in the DOCTYPE token, or the empty string if the name was
missing; the publicId
attribute
set to the public identifier given in the DOCTYPE token, or the
empty string if the public identifier was missing; the systemId
attribute set to the system identifier given in the DOCTYPE token,
or the empty string if the system identifier was missing; and the
other attributes specific to DocumentType
objects set to null and empty lists as appropriate. Associate the DocumentType
node with the Document
object so that it is
returned as the value of the doctype
attribute of the Document
object.
Then, if the document is not an iframe
srcdoc
document та the DOCTYPE token matches one of the conditions in
the following list, then set the Document
to quirks mode:
html
"
(compared case-sensitively).
+//Silmaril//dtd
html Pro v0r11 19970101//
" -//AdvaSoft
Ltd//DTD HTML 3.0 asWedit + extensions//
" -//AS//DTD
HTML 3.0 asWedit + extensions//
" -//IETF//DTD
HTML 2.0 Level 1//
" -//IETF//DTD
HTML 2.0 Level 2//
" -//IETF//DTD
HTML 2.0 Strict Level 1//
" -//IETF//DTD
HTML 2.0 Strict Level 2//
" -//IETF//DTD
HTML 2.0 Strict//
" -//IETF//DTD
HTML 2.0//
" -//IETF//DTD
HTML 2.1E//
" -//IETF//DTD
HTML 3.0//
" -//IETF//DTD
HTML 3.2 Final//
" -//IETF//DTD
HTML 3.2//
" -//IETF//DTD
HTML 3//
" -//IETF//DTD
HTML Level 0//
" -//IETF//DTD
HTML Level 1//
" -//IETF//DTD
HTML Level 2//
" -//IETF//DTD
HTML Level 3//
" -//IETF//DTD
HTML Strict Level 0//
" -//IETF//DTD
HTML Strict Level 1//
" -//IETF//DTD
HTML Strict Level 2//
" -//IETF//DTD
HTML Strict Level 3//
" -//IETF//DTD
HTML Strict//
" -//IETF//DTD
HTML//
" -//Metrius//DTD
Metrius Presentational//
" -//Microsoft//DTD
Internet Explorer 2.0 HTML Strict//
" -//Microsoft//DTD
Internet Explorer 2.0 HTML//
" -//Microsoft//DTD
Internet Explorer 2.0 Tables//
" -//Microsoft//DTD
Internet Explorer 3.0 HTML Strict//
" -//Microsoft//DTD
Internet Explorer 3.0 HTML//
" -//Microsoft//DTD
Internet Explorer 3.0 Tables//
" -//Netscape
Comm. Corp.//DTD HTML//
" -//Netscape
Comm. Corp.//DTD Strict HTML//
" -//O'Reilly
and Associates//DTD HTML 2.0//
" -//O'Reilly
and Associates//DTD HTML Extended 1.0//
" -//O'Reilly
and Associates//DTD HTML Extended Relaxed 1.0//
"
-//SoftQuad
Software//DTD HoTMetaL PRO 6.0::19990601::extensions to HTML
4.0//
" -//SoftQuad//DTD
HoTMetaL PRO 4.0::19971010::extensions to HTML 4.0//
"
-//Spyglass//DTD
HTML 2.0 Extended//
" -//SQ//DTD
HTML 2.0 HoTMetaL + extensions//
" -//Sun
Microsystems Corp.//DTD HotJava HTML//
" -//Sun
Microsystems Corp.//DTD HotJava Strict HTML//
" -//W3C//DTD
HTML 3 1995-03-24//
" -//W3C//DTD
HTML 3.2 Draft//
" -//W3C//DTD
HTML 3.2 Final//
" -//W3C//DTD
HTML 3.2//
" -//W3C//DTD
HTML 3.2S Draft//
" -//W3C//DTD
HTML 4.0 Frameset//
" -//W3C//DTD
HTML 4.0 Transitional//
" -//W3C//DTD
HTML Experimental 19960712//
" -//W3C//DTD
HTML Experimental 970421//
" -//W3C//DTD
W3 HTML//
" -//W3O//DTD
W3 HTML 3.0//
" -//W3O//DTD
W3 HTML Strict 3.0//EN//
" -//WebTechs//DTD
Mozilla HTML 2.0//
" -//WebTechs//DTD
Mozilla HTML//
" -/W3C/DTD
HTML 4.0 Transitional/EN
" HTML
"
http://www.ibm.com/data/dtd/v11/ibmxhtml1-transitional.dtd
"
-//W3C//DTD HTML 4.01
Frameset//
" -//W3C//DTD HTML 4.01
Transitional//
" Інакше if the document is not an
iframe
srcdoc
document та the DOCTYPE token matches one of the conditions in
the following list, then set the Document
to limited-quirks mode:
-//W3C//DTD
XHTML 1.0 Frameset//
" -//W3C//DTD
XHTML 1.0 Transitional//
" -//W3C//DTD HTML 4.01
Frameset//
" -//W3C//DTD HTML 4.01
Transitional//
" The system identifier and public identifier strings must be compared to the values given in the lists above in an ASCII чутливі до реєстру manner. A system identifier whose value is the empty string is not considered missing for the purposes of the conditions above.
Then, switch the insertion mode to "before html".
Якщо the document is not an
iframe
srcdoc
document, then this is a parse error;
set the Document
to quirks
mode.
In any case, switch the insertion mode to "before html", then reprocess the token.
When the user agent is to apply the rules for the "before html" insertion mode, the user agent must handle the token as follows:
Розберіть error. Ignore the token.
Insert a comment as the last child
of the Document
object.
Ignore the token.
Create an element for
the token in the простір імен
HTML, with the Document
as the intended parent. Append it to the Document
object. Put this element in the stack
of open elements.
Якщо the Document
is being loaded as part of navigation
of a browsing context, then: if the
newly created element has a manifest
attribute whose
value is not the empty string, then resolve the value of that attribute to
an absolute URL, relative to the newly
created element та if that is successful, run the application cache selection
algorithm with the result of applying the URL serializer algorithm to the
resulting parsed URL with the exclude
fragment flag set; otherwise, if there is no such attribute,
or its value is the empty string, or resolving its value fails, run
the application
cache selection algorithm with no manifest. The algorithm must
be passed the Document
object.
Switch the insertion mode to "before head".
Act as described in the "anything else" entry below.
Розберіть error. Ignore the token.
Create an html
element whose ownerDocument
is the Document
object. Append
it to the Document
object. Put
this element in the stack of open
elements.
Якщо the Document
is being
loaded as part of navigation
of a browsing context, then: run
the application
cache selection algorithm with no manifest, passing it the Document
object.
Switch the insertion mode to "before head", then reprocess the token.
The root element can end up being removed from the Document
object, e.g. by scripts; nothing in particular happens in such cases,
content continues being appended to the nodes as described in the next
section.
When the user agent is to apply the rules for the "before head" insertion mode, the user agent must handle the token as follows:
Ignore the token.
Розберіть error. Ignore the token.
Process the token using the rules for the "in body" insertion mode.
Insert an HTML element for the token.
Set the head
element pointer to the newly created head
element.
Switch the insertion mode to "in head".
Act as described in the "anything else" entry below.
Розберіть error. Ignore the token.
Insert an HTML element for a "head" start tag token with no attributes.
Set the head
element pointer to the newly created head
element.
Switch the insertion mode to "in head".
Reprocess the current token.
When the user agent is to apply the rules for the "in head" insertion mode, the user agent must handle the token as follows:
Розберіть error. Ignore the token.
Process the token using the rules for the "in body" insertion mode.
Insert an HTML element for the token. Immediately pop the current node off the stack of open elements.
Acknowledge the token's self-closing flag, if it is set.
Insert an HTML element for the token. Immediately pop the current node off the stack of open elements.
Acknowledge the token's self-closing flag, if it is set.
Якщо the element has a charset
attribute та getting
an encoding from its value results in a supported ASCII-compatible
character encoding or a UTF-16
encoding та the confidence is currently tentative,
then change the encoding to the
resulting encoding.
Інакше if the element has an http-equiv
attribute
whose value is an ASCII чутливі
до реєстру match for the string "Content-Type
"
та the element has a content
attribute та
applying the algorithm
for extracting a character encoding from a meta
element to that attribute's value returns a supported ASCII-compatible
character encoding or a UTF-16
encoding та the confidence is currently tentative,
then change the encoding to the
extracted encoding.
Follow the generic RCDATA element parsing algorithm.
Follow the generic raw text element parsing algorithm.
Insert an HTML element for the token.
Switch the insertion mode to "in head noscript".
Run these steps:
Нехай the adjusted insertion location be the appropriate place for inserting a node.
Create an element for the token in the простір імен HTML, with the intended parent being the element in which the adjusted insertion location finds itself.
Mark the element as being "parser-inserted" and unset the element's "force-async" flag.
This ensures that, if the script is external, any
document.write()
calls in the script will execute in-line, instead of blowing the
document away, as would happen in most other cases. It also
prevents the script from executing until the end tag is seen.
Якщо the parser was originally created for the HTML
fragment parsing algorithm, then mark the script
element as "already started". (fragment case)
Insert the newly created element at the adjusted insertion location.
Push the element onto the stack of open elements so that it is the new current node.
Switch the tokenizer to the script data state.
Нехай the original insertion mode be the current insertion mode.
Switch the insertion mode to "text".
Pop the current node (which will be
the head
element) off
the stack of open elements.
Switch the insertion mode to "after head".
Act as described in the "anything else" entry below.
Insert an HTML element for the token.
Insert a marker at the end of the list of active formatting elements.
Set the frameset-ok flag to "not ok".
Switch the insertion mode to "in template".
Push "in template" onto the stack of template insertion modes so that it is the new current template insertion mode.
Якщо there is no template
element on the stack of open
elements, then this is a parse error;
ignore the token.
Інакше run these steps:
Якщо the current node is not a template
element,
then this is a parse error.
Pop elements from the stack
of open elements until a template
element has been popped from the stack.
Pop the current template insertion mode off the stack of template insertion modes.
Розберіть error. Ignore the token.
Pop the current node (which will be
the head
element) off
the stack of open elements.
Switch the insertion mode to "after head".
Reprocess the token.
When the user agent is to apply the rules for the "in head noscript" insertion mode, the user agent must handle the token as follows:
Розберіть error. Ignore the token.
Process the token using the rules for the "in body" insertion mode.
Pop the current node (which will be a
noscript
element)
from the stack of open elements;
the new current node will be a head
element.
Switch the insertion mode to "in head".
Process the token using the rules for the "in head" insertion mode.
Act as described in the "anything else" entry below.
Розберіть error. Ignore the token.
Pop the current node (which will be a
noscript
element)
from the stack of open elements;
the new current node will be a head
element.
Switch the insertion mode to "in head".
Reprocess the token.
When the user agent is to apply the rules for the "after head" insertion mode, the user agent must handle the token as follows:
Розберіть error. Ignore the token.
Process the token using the rules for the "in body" insertion mode.
Insert an HTML element for the token.
Set the frameset-ok flag to "not ok".
Switch the insertion mode to "in body".
Insert an HTML element for the token.
Switch the insertion mode to "in frameset".
Push the node pointed to by the head
element pointer onto the stack of open elements.
Process the token using the rules for the "in head" insertion mode.
Remove the node pointed to by the head
element pointer from the stack of open elements. (It
might not be the current node at this
point.)
The head
element pointer cannot be null at this point.
Process the token using the rules for the "in head" insertion mode.
Act as described in the "anything else" entry below.
Розберіть error. Ignore the token.
Insert an HTML element for a "body" start tag token with no attributes.
Switch the insertion mode to "in body".
Reprocess the current token.
When the user agent is to apply the rules for the "in body" insertion mode, the user agent must handle the token as follows:
Розберіть error. Ignore the token.
Reconstruct the active formatting elements, if any.
Set the frameset-ok flag to "not ok".
Розберіть error. Ignore the token.
Якщо there is a template
element on the stack of open
elements, then ignore the token.
Інакше for each attribute on the token, check to see if the attribute is already present on the top element of the stack of open elements. Якщо it is not, add the attribute and its corresponding value to that element.
Process the token using the rules for the "in head" insertion mode.
Якщо the second element on the stack
of open elements is not a body
element, if the stack of open
elements has only one node on it, or if there is a template
element on the stack of open
elements, then ignore the token. (fragment
case)
Інакше set the frameset-ok flag to
"not ok"; then, for each attribute on the token, check to see if the
attribute is already present on the body
element (the second element) on the stack
of open elements та if it is not, add the attribute and its
corresponding value to that element.
Якщо the stack of open elements
has only one node on it, or if the second element on the stack
of open elements is not a body
element, then ignore the token. (fragment
case)
Якщо the frameset-ok flag is set to "not ok", ignore the token.
Інакше run the following steps:
Remove the second element on the stack of open elements from its parent node, if it has one.
Pop all the nodes from the bottom of the stack
of open elements, from the current
node up to, but not including, the root html
element.
Insert an HTML element for the token.
Switch the insertion mode to "in frameset".
Якщо there is a node in the stack
of open elements that is not either a dd
element, a dt
element,
an li
element, a p
element, a tbody
element, a td
element, a
tfoot
element, a th
element, a thead
element, a tr
element,
the body
element, or
the html
element, then
this is a parse error.
Якщо the stack of template insertion modes is not empty, then process the token using the rules for the "in template" insertion mode.
Інакше stop parsing.
Якщо the stack of open elements
does not have a body
element in
scope, this is a parse error;
ignore the token.
Інакше if there is a node in the stack
of open elements that is not either a dd
element, a dt
element,
an li
element, an optgroup
element, an option
element, a p
element, an rb
element, an rp
element,
an rt
element, an rtc
element, a tbody
element, a td
element, a
tfoot
element, a th
element, a thead
element, a tr
element,
the body
element, or
the html
element, then
this is a parse error.
Switch the insertion mode to "after body".
Якщо the stack of open elements
does not have a body
element in
scope, this is a parse error;
ignore the token.
Інакше if there is a node in the stack
of open elements that is not either a dd
element, a dt
element,
an li
element, an optgroup
element, an option
element, a p
element, an rb
element, an rp
element,
an rt
element, an rtc
element, a tbody
element, a td
element, a
tfoot
element, a th
element, a thead
element, a tr
element,
the body
element, or
the html
element, then
this is a parse error.
Switch the insertion mode to "after body".
Reprocess the token.
Якщо the stack of open elements
has
a p
element in button scope, then close
a p
element.
Insert an HTML element for the token.
Якщо the stack of open elements
has
a p
element in button scope, then close
a p
element.
Якщо the current node is an HTML element whose tag name is one of "h1", "h2", "h3", "h4", "h5", or "h6", then this is a parse error; pop the current node off the stack of open elements.
Insert an HTML element for the token.
Якщо the stack of open elements
has
a p
element in button scope, then close
a p
element.
Insert an HTML element for the token.
Якщо the next token is a "LF" (U+000A)
character token, then ignore that token and move on to the next one.
(Newlines at the start of pre
blocks are ignored as an authoring convenience.)
Set the frameset-ok flag to "not ok".
Якщо the form
element pointer is not null та there is no template
element on the stack of open
elements, then this is a parse error;
ignore the token.
Otherwise:
Якщо the stack of open elements
has
a p
element in button scope, then close
a p
element.
Insert an HTML element for
the token та, if there is no template
element on the stack of open
elements, set the form
element pointer to point to the element created.
Run these steps:
Set the frameset-ok flag to "not ok".
Initialize node to be the current node (the bottommost node of the stack).
Loop: Якщо node is an li
element, тоді виконайте
ці субкроки:
Generate implied end
tags, except for li
elements.
Якщо the current node is not
an li
element,
then this is a parse error.
Pop elements from the stack
of open elements until an li
element has been popped from the stack.
Jump to the step labeled done below.
Якщо node is in the special
category, but is not an address
,
div
, or p
element, then jump to the step labeled done below.
Інакше set node to the previous entry in the stack of open elements and return to the step labeled loop.
Done: Якщо the stack
of open elements has a p
element in button scope, then close
a p
element.
Finally, insert an HTML element for the token.
Run these steps:
Set the frameset-ok flag to "not ok".
Initialize node to be the current node (the bottommost node of the stack).
Loop: Якщо node is a dd
element, тоді виконайте
ці субкроки:
Generate implied end
tags, except for dd
elements.
Якщо the current node is not a
dd
element, then
this is a parse error.
Pop elements from the stack
of open elements until a dd
element has been popped from the stack.
Jump to the step labeled done below.
Якщо node is a dt
element, тоді виконайте ці субкроки:
Generate implied end
tags, except for dt
elements.
Якщо the current node is not a
dt
element, then
this is a parse error.
Pop elements from the stack
of open elements until a dt
element has been popped from the stack.
Jump to the step labeled done below.
Якщо node is in the special
category, but is not an address
,
div
, or p
element, then jump to the step labeled done below.
Інакше set node to the previous entry in the stack of open elements and return to the step labeled loop.
Done: Якщо the stack
of open elements has a p
element in button scope, then close
a p
element.
Finally, insert an HTML element for the token.
Якщо the stack of open elements
has
a p
element in button scope, then close
a p
element.
Insert an HTML element for the token.
Switch the tokenizer to the PLAINTEXT state.
Once a start tag with the tag name "plaintext" has been seen, that will be the last token ever seen other than character tokens (and the end-of-file token), because there is no way to switch out of the PLAINTEXT state.
Якщо the stack of open
elements has
a button
element in scope, тоді виконайте ці
субкроки:
Pop elements from the stack
of open elements until a button
element has been popped from the stack.
Insert an HTML element for the token.
Set the frameset-ok flag to "not ok".
Якщо the stack of open elements does not have an element in scope that is an HTML element and with the same tag name as that of the token, then this is a parse error; ignore the token.
Інакше run these steps:
Якщо the current node is not an HTML element with the same tag name as that of the token, then this is a parse error.
Pop elements from the stack of open elements until an HTML element with the same tag name as the token has been popped from the stack.
Якщо there is no template
element on the stack of open
elements, тоді виконайте ці субкроки:
Нехай node be the element that
the form
element pointer is set to, or null if it is not set to an
element.
Set the form
element pointer to null. Інакше let node
be null.
Якщо node is null or if the stack of open elements does not have node in scope, then this is a parse error; abort these steps and ignore the token.
Якщо the current node is not node, then this is a parse error.
Remove node from the stack of open elements.
Якщо there is a template
element on the stack of open
elements, тоді виконайте ці субкроки instead:
Якщо the stack of open
elements does not have a form
element in
scope, then this is a parse error;
abort these steps and ignore the token.
Якщо the current node is not a form
element, then this
is a parse error.
Pop elements from the stack
of open elements until a form
element has been popped from the stack.
Якщо the stack of open elements
does not have a p
element
in button scope, then this is a parse
error; insert an HTML
element for a "p" start tag token with no attributes.
Якщо the stack of open elements
does not have an li
element in list item scope, then this is a parse
error; ignore the token.
Інакше run these steps:
Generate implied end tags,
except for li
elements.
Якщо the current node is not an li
element, then this is a
parse error.
Pop elements from the stack
of open elements until an li
element has been popped from the stack.
Якщо the stack of open elements does not have an element in scope that is an HTML element and with the same tag name as that of the token, then this is a parse error; ignore the token.
Інакше run these steps:
Generate implied end tags, except for HTML elements with the same tag name as the token.
Якщо the current node is not an HTML element with the same tag name as that of the token, then this is a parse error.
Pop elements from the stack of open elements until an HTML element with the same tag name as the token has been popped from the stack.
Якщо the stack of open elements does not have an element in scope that is an HTML element and whose tag name is one of "h1", "h2", "h3", "h4", "h5", or "h6", then this is a parse error; ignore the token.
Інакше run these steps:
Якщо the current node is not an HTML element with the same tag name as that of the token, then this is a parse error.
Pop elements from the stack of open elements until an HTML element whose tag name is one of "h1", "h2", "h3", "h4", "h5", or "h6" has been popped from the stack.
Take a deep breath, then act as described in the "any other end tag" entry below.
Якщо the list of
active formatting elements contains an a
element between the end of the list and the last marker on the list
(or the start of the list if there is no marker on the list), then
this is a parse error; run the adoption
agency algorithm for the tag name "a", then remove that
element from the list
of active formatting elements and the stack
of open elements if the adoption
agency algorithm didn't already remove it (it might not have
if the element is not in table scope).
In the non-conforming stream <a href="a">a<table><a href="b">b</table>x
,
the first a
element would
be closed upon seeing the second one та the "x" character would be
inside a link to "b", not to "a". This is despite the fact that the
outer a
element is not in
table scope (meaning that a regular </a>
end tag
at the start of the table wouldn't close the outer a
element). The result is that the two a
elements are indirectly nested inside each other — non-conforming
markup will often result in non-conforming DOMs when parsed.
Reconstruct the active formatting elements, if any.
Insert an HTML element for the token. Push onto the list of active formatting elements that element.
Reconstruct the active formatting elements, if any.
Insert an HTML element for the token. Push onto the list of active formatting elements that element.
Reconstruct the active formatting elements, if any.
Якщо the stack of open elements
has
a nobr
element in scope, then this is a parse
error; run the adoption
agency algorithm for the tag name "nobr", then once again reconstruct the
active formatting elements, if any.
Insert an HTML element for the token. Push onto the list of active formatting elements that element.
Run the adoption agency algorithm for the token's tag name.
Reconstruct the active formatting elements, if any.
Insert an HTML element for the token.
Insert a marker at the end of the list of active formatting elements.
Set the frameset-ok flag to "not ok".
Якщо the stack of open elements does not have an element in scope that is an HTML element and with the same tag name as that of the token, then this is a parse error; ignore the token.
Інакше run these steps:
Якщо the current node is not an HTML element with the same tag name as that of the token, then this is a parse error.
Pop elements from the stack of open elements until an HTML element with the same tag name as the token has been popped from the stack.
Якщо the Document
is not
set to quirks mode та the stack
of open elements has a p
element in button scope, then close
a p
element.
Insert an HTML element for the token.
Set the frameset-ok flag to "not ok".
Switch the insertion mode to "in table".
Розберіть error. Act as described in the next entry, as if this was a "br" start tag token, rather than an end tag token.
Reconstruct the active formatting elements, if any.
Insert an HTML element for the token. Immediately pop the current node off the stack of open elements.
Acknowledge the token's self-closing flag, if it is set.
Set the frameset-ok flag to "not ok".
Reconstruct the active formatting elements, if any.
Insert an HTML element for the token. Immediately pop the current node off the stack of open elements.
Acknowledge the token's self-closing flag, if it is set.
Якщо the token does not have an attribute with the name "type", or
if it does, but that attribute's value is not an ASCII
чутливі до реєстру match for the string "hidden
",
then: set the frameset-ok flag to
"not ok".
Insert an HTML element for the token. Immediately pop the current node off the stack of open elements.
Acknowledge the token's self-closing flag, if it is set.
Якщо the stack of open elements
has
a p
element in button scope, then close
a p
element.
Insert an HTML element for the token. Immediately pop the current node off the stack of open elements.
Acknowledge the token's self-closing flag, if it is set.
Set the frameset-ok flag to "not ok".
Розберіть error. Change the token's tag name to "img" and reprocess it. (Don't ask.)
Якщо there is no template
element on the stack of open
elements and the form
element pointer is not null, then ignore the token.
Otherwise:
Acknowledge the token's self-closing flag, if it is set.
Set the frameset-ok flag to "not ok".
Якщо the stack of open elements
has
a p
element in button scope, then close
a p
element.
Insert an HTML element for a
"form" start tag token with no attributes та, if there is no template
element on the
stack of open elements, set
the form
element pointer to point to the element created.
Якщо the token has an attribute called "action", set the action
attribute on the
resulting form
element
to the value of the "action" attribute of the token.
Insert an HTML element for an "hr" start tag token with no attributes. Immediately pop the current node off the stack of open elements.
Reconstruct the active formatting elements, if any.
Insert an HTML element for a "label" start tag token with no attributes.
Insert characters (see below for what they should say).
Insert an HTML element for an
"input" start tag token with all the attributes from the "isindex"
token except "name", "action" та "prompt" та with an attribute named
"name" with the value "isindex". (This creates an input
element with the name
attribute set to the magic balue "isindex
".) Immediately
pop the current node off the stack
of open elements.
Insert more characters (see below for what they should say).
Pop the current node (which will be
the label
element
created earlier) off the stack of
open elements.
Insert an HTML element for an "hr" start tag token with no attributes. Immediately pop the current node off the stack of open elements.
Pop the current node (which will be
the form
element
created earlier) off the stack of
open elements та, if there is no template
element on the stack of open
elements, set the form
element pointer back to null.
Prompt:
Якщо the token has an attribute with the name "prompt", then the
first stream of characters must be the same string as given in that
attribute та the second stream of characters must be empty. Інакше
the two streams of character tokens together should, together with
the input
element,
express the equivalent of "This is a searchable index. Enter search
keywords: (input field)" in the user's preferred language.
Run these steps:
Insert an HTML element for the token.
Якщо the next token is a "LF"
(U+000A) character token, then ignore that token and move on to
the next one. (Newlines at the start of textarea
elements are ignored as an authoring convenience.)
Switch the tokenizer to the RCDATA state.
Нехай the original insertion mode be the current insertion mode.
Set the frameset-ok flag to "not ok".
Switch the insertion mode to "text".
Якщо the stack of open elements
has
a p
element in button scope, then close
a p
element.
Reconstruct the active formatting elements, if any.
Set the frameset-ok flag to "not ok".
Follow the generic raw text element parsing algorithm.
Set the frameset-ok flag to "not ok".
Follow the generic raw text element parsing algorithm.
Follow the generic raw text element parsing algorithm.
Reconstruct the active formatting elements, if any.
Insert an HTML element for the token.
Set the frameset-ok flag to "not ok".
Якщо the insertion mode is one of "in table", "in caption", "in table body", "in row", or "in cell", then switch the insertion mode to "in select in table". Інакше switch the insertion mode to "in select".
Якщо the current node is an option
element, then pop
the current node off the stack
of open elements.
Reconstruct the active formatting elements, if any.
Insert an HTML element for the token.
Якщо the stack of open elements
has
a ruby
element in scope, then generate
implied end tags. Якщо the current
node is not then a ruby
element, this is a parse error.
Insert an HTML element for the token.
Якщо the stack of open elements
has
a ruby
element in scope, then generate
implied end tags, except for rtc
elements. Якщо the current node is not
then a ruby
element or
an rtc
element, this is
a parse error.
Insert an HTML element for the token.
Reconstruct the active formatting elements, if any.
Adjust MathML attributes for the token. (This fixes the case of MathML attributes що є not all lowercase.)
Adjust foreign attributes for the token. (This fixes the use of namespaced attributes, in particular XLink.)
Insert a foreign element for the token, in the MathML namespace.
Якщо the token has its self-closing flag set, pop the current node off the stack of open elements and acknowledge the token's self-closing flag.
Reconstruct the active formatting elements, if any.
Adjust SVG attributes for the token. (This fixes the case of SVG attributes що є not all lowercase.)
Adjust foreign attributes for the token. (This fixes the use of namespaced attributes, in particular XLink in SVG.)
Insert a foreign element for the token, in the SVG namespace.
Якщо the token has its self-closing flag set, pop the current node off the stack of open elements and acknowledge the token's self-closing flag.
Розберіть error. Ignore the token.
Reconstruct the active formatting elements, if any.
Insert an HTML element for the token.
This element will be an ordinary element.
Run these steps:
Initialize node to be the current node (the bottommost node of the stack).
Loop: Якщо node is an HTML element with the same tag name as the token, then:
Generate implied end tags, except for HTML elements with the same tag name as the token.
Якщо node is not the current node, then this is a parse error.
Pop all the nodes from the current node up to node, including node, then stop these steps.
Інакше if node is in the special category, then this is a parse error; ignore the token та abort these steps.
Set node to the previous entry in the stack of open elements.
Повернутиto the step labeled loop.
When the steps above say the user agent is to close
a p
element, it means that the user agent must run
the following steps:
Generate implied end tags,
except for p
elements.
Якщо the current node is not a p
element, then this is a parse
error.
Pop elements from the stack of
open elements until a p
element has been popped from the stack.
The adoption agency algorithm, which takes as its only argument a tag name subject for which the algorithm is being run, consists of the following steps:
Якщо the current node is an HTML element whose tag name is subject, тоді виконайте ці субкроки:
Нехай element be the current node.
Pop element off the stack of open elements.
Якщо element is also in the list of active formatting elements, remove the element from the list.
Abort the adoption agency algorithm.
Нехай outer loop counter be zero.
Outer loop: Якщо outer loop counter is greater than or equal to eight, then abort these steps.
Increment outer loop counter by one.
Нехай formatting element be the last element in the list of active formatting elements that:
Якщо there is no such element, then abort these steps and instead act as described in the "any other end tag" entry above.
Якщо formatting element is not in the stack of open elements, then this is a parse error; remove the element from the list та abort these steps.
Якщо formatting element is in the stack of open elements, but the element is not in scope, then this is a parse error; abort these steps.
Якщо formatting element is not the current node, this is a parse error. (But do not abort these steps.)
Нехай furthest block be the topmost node in the stack of open elements that is lower in the stack than formatting element та is an element in the special category. There might not be one.
Якщо there is no furthest block, then the UA must first pop all the nodes from the bottom of the stack of open elements, from the current node up to and including formatting element, then remove formatting element from the list of active formatting elements та finally abort these steps.
Нехай common ancestor be the element immediately above formatting element in the stack of open elements.
Нехай a bookmark note the position of formatting element in the list of active formatting elements relative to the elements on either side of it in the list.
Нехай node and last node be furthest block. Follow these steps:
Нехай inner loop counter be zero.
Inner loop: Increment inner loop counter by one.
Нехай node be the element immediately above node in the stack of open elements, or if node is no longer in the stack of open elements (e.g. because it got removed by this algorithm), the element that was immediately above node in the stack of open elements before node was removed.
Якщо node is formatting element, then go to the next step in the overall algorithm.
Якщо inner loop counter is greater than three and node is in the list of active formatting elements, then remove node from the list of active formatting elements.
Якщо node is not in the list of active formatting elements, then remove node from the stack of open elements and then go back to the step labeled inner loop.
Create an element for the token for which the element node was created, in the простір імен HTML, with common ancestor as the intended parent; replace the entry for node in the list of active formatting elements with an entry for the new element, replace the entry for node in the stack of open elements with an entry for the new element та let node be the new element.
Якщо last node is furthest block, then move the aforementioned bookmark to be immediately after the new node in the list of active formatting elements.
Insert last node into node, first removing it from its previous parent node if any.
Нехай last node be node.
Повернутиto the step labeled inner loop.
Insert whatever last node ended up being in the previous step at the appropriate place for inserting a node, but using common ancestor as the override target.
Create an element for the token for which formatting element was created, in the простір імен HTML, with furthest block as the intended parent.
Take all of the child nodes of furthest block and append them to the element created in the last step.
Append that new element to furthest block.
Remove formatting element from the list of active formatting elements та insert the new element into the list of active formatting elements at the position of the aforementioned bookmark.
Remove formatting element from the stack of open elements та insert the new element into the stack of open elements immediately below the position of furthest block in that stack.
Jump back to the step labeled outer loop.
This algorithm's name, the "adoption agency algorithm", comes from the way it causes elements to change parents та is in contrast with other possible algorithms for dealing with misnested content, which included the "incest algorithm", the "secret affair algorithm" та the "Heisenberg algorithm".
When the user agent is to apply the rules for the "text" insertion mode, the user agent must handle the token as follows:
This can never be a U+0000 NULL character; the tokenizer converts those to U+FFFD REPLACEMENT CHARACTER characters.
Якщо the current node is a script
element, mark the script
element as "already started".
Pop the current node off the stack of open elements.
Switch the insertion mode to the original insertion mode and reprocess the token.
Perform a microtask checkpoint.
Нехай script be the current
node (which will be a script
element).
Pop the current node off the stack of open elements.
Switch the insertion mode to the original insertion mode.
Нехай the old insertion point have the same value as the current insertion point. Нехай the insertion point be just before the next input character.
Increment the parser's script nesting level by one.
Prepare the script. This might cause some script to execute, which might cause new characters to be inserted into the tokenizer та might cause the tokenizer to output more tokens, resulting in a reentrant invocation of the parser.
Decrement the parser's script nesting level by one. Якщо the parser's script nesting level is zero, then set the parser pause flag to false.
Нехай the insertion point have the value of the old insertion point. (In other words, restore the insertion point to its previous value. This value might be the "undefined" value.)
At this stage, if there is a pending parsing-blocking script, then:
Set the parser pause flag to true та abort the processing of any nested invocations of the tokenizer, yielding control back to the caller. (Tokenization will resume when the caller returns to the "outer" tree construction stage.)
The tree construction stage of this particular
parser is being called reentrantly,
say from a call to document.write()
.
Run these steps:
Нехай the script be the pending parsing-blocking script. There is no longer a pending parsing-blocking script.
Block the tokenizer for this instance of the HTML parser, such that the event loop will not run tasks that invoke the tokenizer.
Якщо the parser's Document
has a
style sheet that is blocking scripts or the
script's "ready
to be parser-executed" flag is not set: spin
the event loop until the parser's Document
has
no style sheet that is blocking scripts and the
script's "ready
to be parser-executed" flag is set.
Якщо this parser has been aborted in the meantime, abort these steps.
This could happen if, e.g., while the spin
the event loop algorithm is running, the browsing
context gets closed, or the document.open()
method gets invoked on the Document
.
Unblock the tokenizer for this instance of the HTML parser, such that tasks that invoke the tokenizer can again be run.
Нехай the insertion point be just before the next input character.
Increment the parser's script nesting level by one (it should be zero before this step, so this sets it to one).
Execute the script.
Decrement the parser's script nesting level by one. Якщо the parser's script nesting level is zero (which it always should be at this point), then set the parser pause flag to false.
Нехай the insertion point буде невизначеним again.
Якщо there is once again a pending parsing-blocking script, then repeat these steps from step 1.
Pop the current node off the stack of open elements.
Switch the insertion mode to the original insertion mode.
When the user agent is to apply the rules for the "in table" insertion mode, the user agent must handle the token as follows:
table
, tbody
,
tfoot
, thead
,
or tr
elementНехай the pending table character tokens be an empty list of tokens.
Нехай the original insertion mode be the current insertion mode.
Switch the insertion mode to "in table text" and reprocess the token.
Розберіть error. Ignore the token.
Clear the stack back to a table context. (See below.)
Insert a marker at the end of the list of active formatting elements.
Insert an HTML element for the token, then switch the insertion mode to "in caption".
Clear the stack back to a table context. (See below.)
Insert an HTML element for the token, then switch the insertion mode to "in column group".
Clear the stack back to a table context. (See below.)
Insert an HTML element for a "colgroup" start tag token with no attributes, then switch the insertion mode to "in column group".
Reprocess the current token.
Clear the stack back to a table context. (See below.)
Insert an HTML element for the token, then switch the insertion mode to "in table body".
Clear the stack back to a table context. (See below.)
Insert an HTML element for a "tbody" start tag token with no attributes, then switch the insertion mode to "in table body".
Reprocess the current token.
Якщо the stack of open elements
does not have a table
element in table scope, ignore the token.
Otherwise:
Pop elements from this stack until a table
element has been popped from the stack.
Reset the insertion mode appropriately.
Reprocess the token.
Якщо the stack of open elements
does not have a table
element in table scope, this is a parse
error; ignore the token.
Otherwise:
Pop elements from this stack until a table
element has been popped from the stack.
Розберіть error. Ignore the token.
Process the token using the rules for the "in head" insertion mode.
Якщо the token does not have an attribute with the name "type", or
if it does, but that attribute's value is not an ASCII
чутливі до реєстру match for the string "hidden
",
then: act as described in the "anything else" entry below.
Otherwise:
Insert an HTML element for the token.
Pop that input
element off the stack of open
elements.
Acknowledge the token's self-closing flag, if it is set.
Якщо there is a template
element on the stack of open
elements, or if the form
element pointer is not null, ignore the token.
Otherwise:
Insert an HTML element for
the token та set the form
element pointer to point to the element created.
Pop that form
element
off the stack of open elements.
Process the token using the rules for the "in body" insertion mode.
Розберіть error. Enable foster parenting, process the token using the rules for the "in body" insertion mode та then disable foster parenting.
When the steps above require the UA to clear
the stack back to a table context, it means that the UA must,
while the current node is not a table
,
template
, or html
element, pop elements from
the stack of open elements.
The current node being an html
element after this process
is a fragment case.
When the user agent is to apply the rules for the "in table text" insertion mode, the user agent must handle the token as follows:
Розберіть error. Ignore the token.
Append the character token to the pending table character tokens list.
Якщо any of the tokens in the pending table character tokens list are character tokens що є not space characters, then reprocess the character tokens in the pending table character tokens list using the rules given in the "anything else" entry in the "in table" insertion mode.
Інакше insert the characters given by the pending table character tokens list.
Switch the insertion mode to the original insertion mode and reprocess the token.
When the user agent is to apply the rules for the "in caption" insertion mode, the user agent must handle the token as follows:
Якщо the stack of open elements
does not have a caption
element in table scope, this is a parse
error; ignore the token. (fragment
case)
Otherwise:
Now, if the current node is not a caption
element, then
this is a parse error.
Pop elements from this stack until a caption
element has been popped from the stack.
Clear the list of active formatting elements up to the last marker.
Switch the insertion mode to "in table".
Якщо the stack of open elements
does not have a caption
element in table scope, ignore the token. (fragment
case)
Otherwise:
Pop elements from this stack until a caption
element has been popped from the stack.
Clear the list of active formatting elements up to the last marker.
Switch the insertion mode to "in table".
Reprocess the token.
Розберіть error. Ignore the token.
Process the token using the rules for the "in body" insertion mode.
When the user agent is to apply the rules for the "in column group" insertion mode, the user agent must handle the token as follows:
Розберіть error. Ignore the token.
Process the token using the rules for the "in body" insertion mode.
Insert an HTML element for the token. Immediately pop the current node off the stack of open elements.
Acknowledge the token's self-closing flag, if it is set.
Якщо the current node is not a colgroup
element, then
this is a parse error; ignore the token.
Інакше pop the current node from the stack of open elements. Switch the insertion mode to "in table".
Розберіть error. Ignore the token.
Process the token using the rules for the "in head" insertion mode.
Process the token using the rules for the "in body" insertion mode.
Якщо the current node is not a colgroup
element, then
this is a parse error; ignore the token.
Інакше pop the current node from the stack of open elements.
Switch the insertion mode to "in table".
Reprocess the token.
When the user agent is to apply the rules for the "in table body" insertion mode, the user agent must handle the token as follows:
Clear the stack back to a table body context. (See below.)
Insert an HTML element for the token, then switch the insertion mode to "in row".
Clear the stack back to a table body context. (See below.)
Insert an HTML element for a "tr" start tag token with no attributes, then switch the insertion mode to "in row".
Reprocess the current token.
Якщо the stack of open elements does not have an element in table scope that is an HTML element and with the same tag name as the token, this is a parse error; ignore the token.
Otherwise:
Clear the stack back to a table body context. (See below.)
Pop the current node from the stack of open elements. Switch the insertion mode to "in table".
Якщо the stack of open elements
does not have a tbody
, thead
,
or tfoot
element in table scope, this is a parse
error; ignore the token.
Otherwise:
Clear the stack back to a table body context. (See below.)
Pop the current node from the stack of open elements. Switch the insertion mode to "in table".
Reprocess the token.
Розберіть error. Ignore the token.
Process the token using the rules for the "in table" insertion mode.
When the steps above require the UA to clear
the stack back to a table body context, it means that the UA
must, while the current node is not a tbody
, tfoot
,
thead
, template
,
or html
element, pop
elements from the stack of open
elements.
The current node being an html
element after this process
is a fragment case.
When the user agent is to apply the rules for the "in row" insertion mode, the user agent must handle the token as follows:
Clear the stack back to a table row context. (See below.)
Insert an HTML element for the token, then switch the insertion mode to "in cell".
Insert a marker at the end of the list of active formatting elements.
Якщо the stack of open elements
does not have a tr
element
in table scope, this is a parse error;
ignore the token.
Otherwise:
Clear the stack back to a table row context. (See below.)
Pop the current node (which will be a
tr
element) from the stack of open elements. Switch
the insertion mode to "in table body".
Якщо the stack of open elements
does not have a tr
element
in table scope, this is a parse error;
ignore the token.
Otherwise:
Clear the stack back to a table row context. (See below.)
Pop the current node (which will be a
tr
element) from the stack of open elements. Switch
the insertion mode to "in table body".
Reprocess the token.
Якщо the stack of open elements does not have an element in table scope that is an HTML element and with the same tag name as the token, this is a parse error; ignore the token.
Якщо the stack of open elements
does not have a tr
element
in table scope, ignore the token.
Otherwise:
Clear the stack back to a table row context. (See below.)
Pop the current node (which will be a
tr
element) from the stack of open elements. Switch
the insertion mode to "in table body".
Reprocess the token.
Розберіть error. Ignore the token.
Process the token using the rules for the "in table" insertion mode.
When the steps above require the UA to clear
the stack back to a table row context, it means that the UA
must, while the current node is not a tr
, template
,
or html
element, pop
elements from the stack of open
elements.
The current node being an html
element after this process
is a fragment case.
When the user agent is to apply the rules for the "in cell" insertion mode, the user agent must handle the token as follows:
Якщо the stack of open elements does not have an element in table scope that is an HTML element and with the same tag name as that of the token, then this is a parse error; ignore the token.
Otherwise:
Now, if the current node is not an HTML element with the same tag name as the token, then this is a parse error.
Pop elements from the stack of open elements stack until an HTML element with the same tag name as the token has been popped from the stack.
Clear the list of active formatting elements up to the last marker.
Switch the insertion mode to "in row".
Якщо the stack of open elements
does not have a td
or th
element in table scope, then this is a parse error; ignore the token. (fragment
case)
Інакше close the cell (see below) and reprocess the token.
Розберіть error. Ignore the token.
Якщо the stack of open elements does not have an element in table scope that is an HTML element and with the same tag name as that of the token, then this is a parse error; ignore the token.
Інакше close the cell (see below) and reprocess the token.
Process the token using the rules for the "in body" insertion mode.
Where the steps above say to close the cell, they mean to run the following algorithm:
Якщо the current node is not now a td
element or a th
element, then this is a parse error.
Pop elements from the stack of
open elements stack until a td
element or a th
element
has been popped from the stack.
Clear the list of active formatting elements up to the last marker.
Switch the insertion mode to "in row".
The stack of open
elements cannot have both a td
and a th
element in table scope at the same
time, nor can it have neither when the close
the cell algorithm is invoked.
When the user agent is to apply the rules for the "in select" insertion mode, the user agent must handle the token as follows:
Розберіть error. Ignore the token.
Розберіть error. Ignore the token.
Process the token using the rules for the "in body" insertion mode.
Якщо the current node is an option
element, pop that
node from the stack of open
elements.
Insert an HTML element for the token.
Якщо the current node is an option
element, pop that
node from the stack of open
elements.
Якщо the current node is an optgroup
element, pop
that node from the stack of open
elements.
Insert an HTML element for the token.
First, if the current node is an option
element та the node
immediately before it in the stack
of open elements is an optgroup
element, then pop the current node from
the stack of open elements.
Якщо the current node is an optgroup
element, then
pop that node from the stack of
open elements. Інакше this is a parse
error; ignore the token.
Якщо the current node is an option
element, then pop
that node from the stack of open
elements. Інакше this is a parse error;
ignore the token.
Якщо the stack of open elements
does not have a select
element in select scope, this is a parse
error; ignore the token. (fragment
case)
Otherwise:
Pop elements from the stack of
open elements until a select
element has been popped from the stack.
Pop elements from the stack of
open elements until a select
element has been popped from the stack.
Reset the insertion mode appropriately.
It just gets treated like an end tag.
Якщо the stack of open elements
does not have a select
element in select scope, ignore the token. (fragment
case)
Pop elements from the stack of
open elements until a select
element has been popped from the stack.
Reset the insertion mode appropriately.
Reprocess the token.
Process the token using the rules for the "in head" insertion mode.
Process the token using the rules for the "in body" insertion mode.
Розберіть error. Ignore the token.
When the user agent is to apply the rules for the "in select in table" insertion mode, the user agent must handle the token as follows:
Pop elements from the stack of
open elements until a select
element has been popped from the stack.
Reset the insertion mode appropriately.
Reprocess the token.
Якщо the stack of open elements does not have an element in table scope that is an HTML element and with the same tag name as that of the token, then ignore the token.
Otherwise:
Pop elements from the stack of
open elements until a select
element has been popped from the stack.
Reset the insertion mode appropriately.
Reprocess the token.
Process the token using the rules for the "in select" insertion mode.
When the user agent is to apply the rules for the "in template" insertion mode, the user agent must handle the token as follows:
Process the token using the rules for the "in body" insertion mode.
Process the token using the rules for the "in head" insertion mode.
Pop the current template insertion mode off the stack of template insertion modes.
Push "in table" onto the stack of template insertion modes so that it is the new current template insertion mode.
Switch the insertion mode to "in table" та reprocess the token.
Pop the current template insertion mode off the stack of template insertion modes.
Push "in column group" onto the stack of template insertion modes so that it is the new current template insertion mode.
Switch the insertion mode to "in column group" та reprocess the token.
Pop the current template insertion mode off the stack of template insertion modes.
Push "in table body" onto the stack of template insertion modes so that it is the new current template insertion mode.
Switch the insertion mode to "in table body" та reprocess the token.
Pop the current template insertion mode off the stack of template insertion modes.
Push "in row" onto the stack of template insertion modes so that it is the new current template insertion mode.
Switch the insertion mode to "in row" та reprocess the token.
Pop the current template insertion mode off the stack of template insertion modes.
Push "in body" onto the stack of template insertion modes so that it is the new current template insertion mode.
Switch the insertion mode to "in body" та reprocess the token.
Розберіть error. Ignore the token.
Якщо there is no template
element on the stack of open
elements, then stop parsing. (fragment case)
Інакше this is a parse error.
Pop elements from the stack of
open elements until a template
element has been popped from the stack.
Clear the list of active formatting elements up to the last marker.
Pop the current template insertion mode off the stack of template insertion modes.
Reset the insertion mode appropriately.
Reprocess the token.
When the user agent is to apply the rules for the "after body" insertion mode, the user agent must handle the token as follows:
Process the token using the rules for the "in body" insertion mode.
Insert a comment as the last child
of the first element in the stack
of open elements (the html
element).
Розберіть error. Ignore the token.
Process the token using the rules for the "in body" insertion mode.
Якщо the parser was originally created as part of the HTML fragment parsing algorithm, this is a parse error; ignore the token. (fragment case)
Інакше switch the insertion mode to "after after body".
Розберіть error. Switch the insertion mode to "in body" and reprocess the token.
When the user agent is to apply the rules for the "in frameset" insertion mode, the user agent must handle the token as follows:
Розберіть error. Ignore the token.
Process the token using the rules for the "in body" insertion mode.
Insert an HTML element for the token.
Якщо the current node is the root html
element, then this is a
parse error; ignore the token. (fragment
case)
Інакше pop the current node from the stack of open elements.
Якщо the parser was not originally created as part of the
HTML fragment parsing
algorithm (fragment case) та the
current node is no longer a frameset
element, then switch the insertion mode
to "after
frameset".
Insert an HTML element for the token. Immediately pop the current node off the stack of open elements.
Acknowledge the token's self-closing flag, if it is set.
Process the token using the rules for the "in head" insertion mode.
Якщо the current node is not the root
html
element, then this
is a parse error.
The current node can only
be the root html
element in the fragment case.
Розберіть error. Ignore the token.
When the user agent is to apply the rules for the "after frameset" insertion mode, the user agent must handle the token as follows:
Розберіть error. Ignore the token.
Process the token using the rules for the "in body" insertion mode.
Switch the insertion mode to "after after frameset".
Process the token using the rules for the "in head" insertion mode.
Розберіть error. Ignore the token.
When the user agent is to apply the rules for the "after after body" insertion mode, the user agent must handle the token as follows:
Insert a comment as the last child
of the Document
object.
Process the token using the rules for the "in body" insertion mode.
Розберіть error. Switch the insertion mode to "in body" and reprocess the token.
When the user agent is to apply the rules for the "after after frameset" insertion mode, the user agent must handle the token as follows:
Insert a comment as the last child
of the Document
object.
Process the token using the rules for the "in body" insertion mode.
Process the token using the rules for the "in head" insertion mode.
Розберіть error. Ignore the token.
When the user agent is to apply the rules for parsing tokens in foreign content, the user agent must handle the token as follows:
Розберіть error. Insert a U+FFFD REPLACEMENT CHARACTER character.
Set the frameset-ok flag to "not ok".
Розберіть error. Ignore the token.
Якщо the parser was originally created for the HTML fragment parsing algorithm, then act as described in the "any other start tag" entry below. (fragment case)
Otherwise:
Pop an element from the stack of open elements та then keep popping more elements from the stack of open elements until the current node is a MathML text integration point, an HTML integration point, or an element in the простір імен HTML.
Then, reprocess the token.
Якщо the adjusted current node is an element in the MathML namespace, adjust MathML attributes for the token. (This fixes the case of MathML attributes що є not all lowercase.)
Якщо the adjusted current node is an element in the SVG namespace та the token's tag name is one of the ones in the first column of the following table, change the tag name to the name given in the corresponding cell in the second column. (This fixes the case of SVG elements що є not all lowercase.)
Tag name | Element name |
---|---|
altglyph |
altGlyph |
altglyphdef |
altGlyphDef |
altglyphitem |
altGlyphItem |
animatecolor |
animateColor |
animatemotion |
animateMotion |
animatetransform |
animateTransform |
clippath |
clipPath |
feblend |
feBlend |
fecolormatrix |
feColorMatrix |
fecomponenttransfer |
feComponentTransfer |
fecomposite |
feComposite |
feconvolvematrix |
feConvolveMatrix |
fediffuselighting |
feDiffuseLighting |
fedisplacementmap |
feDisplacementMap |
fedistantlight |
feDistantLight |
fedropshadow |
feDropShadow |
feflood |
feFlood |
fefunca |
feFuncA |
fefuncb |
feFuncB |
fefuncg |
feFuncG |
fefuncr |
feFuncR |
fegaussianblur |
feGaussianBlur |
feimage |
feImage |
femerge |
feMerge |
femergenode |
feMergeNode |
femorphology |
feMorphology |
feoffset |
feOffset |
fepointlight |
fePointLight |
fespecularlighting |
feSpecularLighting |
fespotlight |
feSpotLight |
fetile |
feTile |
feturbulence |
feTurbulence |
foreignobject |
foreignObject |
glyphref |
glyphRef |
lineargradient |
linearGradient |
radialgradient |
radialGradient
|
textpath |
textPath |
Якщо the adjusted current node is an element in the SVG namespace, adjust SVG attributes for the token. (This fixes the case of SVG attributes що є not all lowercase.)
Adjust foreign attributes for the token. (This fixes the use of namespaced attributes, in particular XLink in SVG.)
Insert a foreign element for the token, in the same namespace as the adjusted current node.
Якщо the token has its self-closing flag set, then run the appropriate steps from the following list:
Acknowledge the token's self-closing flag та then act as described in the steps for a "script" end tag below.
Pop the current node off the stack of open elements and acknowledge the token's self-closing flag.
script
element in the SVG namespacePop the current node off the stack of open elements.
Нехай the old insertion point have the same value as the current insertion point. Нехай the insertion point be just before the next input character.
Increment the parser's script nesting level by one. Set the parser pause flag to true.
Process
the script
element according
to the SVG rules, if the user agent supports SVG. [SVG]
Even if this causes new characters to be inserted into the tokenizer, the parser will not be executed reentrantly, since the parser pause flag є true.
Decrement the parser's script nesting level by one. Якщо the parser's script nesting level is zero, then set the parser pause flag to false.
Нехай the insertion point have the value of the old insertion point. (In other words, restore the insertion point to its previous value. This value might be the "undefined" value.)
Run these steps:
Initialize node to be the current node (the bottommost node of the stack).
Якщо node's tag name, converted to ASCII lowercase, is not the same as the tag name of the token, then this is a parse error.
Loop: Якщо node is the topmost element in the stack of open elements, abort these steps. (fragment case)
Якщо node's tag name, converted to ASCII lowercase, is the same as the tag name of the token, pop elements from the stack of open elements until node has been popped from the stack та then abort these steps.
Set node to the previous entry in the stack of open elements.
Якщо node is not an element in the простір імен HTML, return to the step labeled loop.
Інакше process the token according to the rules given in the section corresponding to the current insertion mode in HTML content.
Once the user agent stops parsing the document, the user agent must run the following steps:
Set the current document
readiness to "interactive
"
and the insertion
point to undefined.
Pop all the nodes off the stack of open elements.
Якщо the list of scripts that will execute when the document has finished parsing is not empty, виконати ці підкроки:
Spin the event loop until
the first script
in the list
of scripts that will execute when the document has finished
parsing has its "ready
to be parser-executed" flag set and the parser's
Document
has
no style sheet that is blocking scripts.
Execute
the first script
in the list
of scripts that will execute when the document has finished
parsing.
Remove the first script
element from the list
of scripts that will execute when the document has finished
parsing (i.e. shift out the first entry in the list).
Якщо the list of scripts that will execute when the document has finished parsing is still not empty, repeat these substeps again from substep 1.
Queue a task to fire
a simple event that bubbles named DOMContentLoaded
at the Document
.
Spin the event loop until the set of scripts that will execute as soon as possible and the list of scripts that will execute in order as soon as possible are empty.
Spin the event loop until there
is nothing that delays the load event in the Document
.
Queue a task to run the following substeps:
Set the current document
readiness to "complete
".
Якщо the Document
is in a
browsing context, create a trusted event named load
that does not bubble
and is not cancelable and which uses the Event
interface та dispatch
it at the Document
's Window
object, with target
override set to the Document
object.
Якщо the Document
is in a browsing context, then queue
a task to run the following substeps:
Якщо the Document
's page
showing flag є true, then abort this task (i.e. don't fire
the event below).
Set the Document
's page
showing flag to true.
Fire
a trusted
event with the name pageshow
at the Window
object of the Document
,
but with its target
set to the Document
object
(and the currentTarget
set to the Window
object),
using the PageTransitionEvent
interface, with the persisted
attribute initialized to false. This event must not bubble, must
not be cancelable та has no default action.
Якщо the Document
has any pending
application cache download process tasks, then queue each such task in the order they were added to the
list of pending
application cache download process tasks та then empty the
list of pending
application cache download process tasks. The task
source for these tasks
is the networking task source.
Якщо the Document
's print
when loaded flag is set, then run the printing
steps.
The Document
is now ready
for post-load tasks.
Queue a task to mark the Document
as completely loaded.
When the user agent is to abort a parser, it must run the following steps:
Throw away any pending content in the input stream та discard any future content that would have been added to it.
Set the current document
readiness to "interactive
".
Pop all the nodes off the stack of open elements.
Set the current document
readiness to "complete
".
Except where otherwise specified, the task source for the tasks mentioned in this section is the DOM manipulation task source.
When an application uses an HTML parser in
conjunction with an XML pipeline, it is possible that the constructed
DOM is not compatible with the XML tool chain in certain subtle ways.
For example, an XML toolchain might not be able to represent attributes
with the name xmlns
, since they
conflict with the Namespaces in XML syntax. There is also some data that
the HTML parser generates that isn't
included in the DOM itself. This section specifies some rules for
handling these issues.
Якщо the XML API being used doesn't support DOCTYPEs, the tool may drop DOCTYPEs altogether.
Якщо the XML API doesn't support attributes in no namespace що є named
"xmlns
", attributes whose names start
with "xmlns:
", or attributes in the XMLNS namespace, then the tool may drop
such attributes.
The tool may annotate the output with any namespace declarations required for proper operation.
Якщо the XML API being used restricts the allowable characters in the local names of elements and attributes, then the tool may map all element and attribute local names that the API wouldn't support to a set of names що є allowed, by replacing any character that isn't supported with the uppercase letter U and the six digits of the character's Unicode code point when expressed in hexadecimal, using digits 0-9 and capital letters A-F as the symbols, in increasing numeric order.
For example, the element name foo<bar
,
which can be output by the HTML parser,
though it is neither a legal HTML element name nor a well-formed XML
element name, would be converted into fooU00003Cbar
,
which is a well-formed XML element name (though it's still not
legal in HTML by any means).
As another example, consider the attribute xlink:href
.
Used on a MathML element, it becomes, after being adjusted, an attribute with a
prefix "xlink
" and a local name "href
". However, used on an HTML element, it
becomes an attribute with no prefix and the local name "xlink:href
",
which is not a valid NCName та thus might not be accepted by an XML API.
It could thus get converted, becoming "xlinkU00003Ahref
".
The resulting names from this conversion conveniently can't clash with any attribute generated by the HTML parser, since those are all either lowercase or those listed in the adjust foreign attributes algorithm's table.
Якщо the XML API restricts comments from having two consecutive U+002D HYPHEN-MINUS characters (--), the tool may insert a single U+0020 SPACE character between any such offending characters.
Якщо the XML API restricts comments from ending in a "-" (U+002D) character, the tool may insert a single U+0020 SPACE character at the end of such comments.
Якщо the XML API restricts allowed characters in character data, attribute values, or comments, the tool may replace any "FF" (U+000C) character with a U+0020 SPACE character та any other literal non-XML character with a U+FFFD REPLACEMENT CHARACTER.
Якщо the tool has no way to convey out-of-band information, then the tool may drop the following information:
form
element
ancestor (use of the form
element pointer in the parser)template
elements.The mutations allowed by this section apply after
the HTML parser's rules have been applied.
For example, a <a::>
start tag
will be closed by a </a::>
end
tag та never by a </aU00003AU00003A>
end tag, even if the user agent is using the rules above to then
generate an actual element in the DOM with the name aU00003AU00003A
for that start tag.
Цей розділ не є нормативним.
This section examines some erroneous markup and discusses how the HTML parser handles these cases.
Цей розділ не є нормативним.
The most-often discussed example of erroneous markup is as follows:
<p>1<b>2<i>3</b>4</i>5</p>
The parsing of this markup is straightforward up to the "3". At this point, the DOM looks like this:
Here, the stack of open elements
has five elements on it: html
,
body
, p
,
b
та i
.
The list of active
formatting elements just has two: b
and i
. The insertion
mode is "in
body".
Upon receiving the end tag token with the tag name "b", the "adoption
agency algorithm" is invoked. This is a simple case, in that the formatting element is the b
element та there is no furthest block.
Thus, the stack of open elements
ends up with just three elements: html
,
body
та p
,
while the list of active
formatting elements has just one: i
.
The DOM tree is unmodified at this point.
The next token is a character ("4"), triggers the reconstruction
of the active formatting elements, in this case just the i
element. A new i
element is thus created for the "4" Text
node. After the end tag token for the "i" is also received та the "5" Text
node is inserted, the DOM looks as
follows:
Цей розділ не є нормативним.
A case similar to the previous one is the following:
<b>1<p>2</b>3</p>
Up to the "2" the parsing here is straightforward:
The interesting part is when the end tag token with the tag name "b" is parsed.
Before that token is seen, the stack
of open elements has four elements on it: html
,
body
, b
та p
. The list
of active formatting elements just has the one: b
.
The insertion mode is "in body".
Upon receiving the end tag token with the tag name "b", the "adoption
agency algorithm" is invoked, as in the previous example. However,
in this case, there is a furthest
block, namely the p
element. Thus, this time the adoption agency algorithm isn't skipped
over.
The common ancestor is the body
element. A conceptual "bookmark" marks the position of the b
in the list of active
formatting elements, but since that list has only one element in
it, the bookmark won't have much effect.
As the algorithm progresses, node ends
up set to the formatting element (b
)
та last node ends up set to the furthest
block (p
).
The last node gets appended (moved) to the common ancestor, so that the DOM looks like:
A new b
element is created
та the children of the p
element are moved to it:
Finally, the new b
element
is appended to the p
element,
so that the DOM looks like:
The b
element is removed
from the list of active
formatting elements and the stack
of open elements, so that when the "3" is parsed, it is appended
to the p
element:
Цей розділ не є нормативним.
Error handling in tables is, for historical reasons, especially strange. For example, consider the following markup:
<table><b><tr><td>aaa</td></tr>bbb</table>ccc
The highlighted b
element
start tag is not allowed directly inside a table like that та the parser
handles this case by placing the element before the table.
(This is called foster
parenting.) This can be seen by examining the DOM tree as it
stands just after the table
element's start tag has been seen:
...and then immediately after the b
element start tag has been seen:
At this point, the stack of open
elements has on it the elements html
,
body
, table
та b
(in that order, despite
the resulting DOM tree); the list
of active formatting elements just has the b
element in it; and the insertion mode is
"in table".
The tr
start tag causes the
b
element to be popped off the
stack and a tbody
start
tag to be implied; the tbody
and tr
elements are then
handled in a rather straight-forward manner, taking the parser through
the "in
table body" and "in row" insertion modes, after which the
DOM looks as follows:
Here, the stack of open elements
has on it the elements html
,
body
, table
,
tbody
та tr
;
the list of active
formatting elements still has the b
element in it; and the insertion mode is
"in
row".
The td
element start tag
token, after putting a td
element on the tree, puts a marker on the list
of active formatting elements (it also switches to the "in cell" insertion
mode).
The marker means that when the "aaa" character tokens are seen, no b
element is created to hold the
resulting Text
node:
The end tags are handled in a straight-forward manner; after handling
them, the stack of open elements
has on it the elements html
,
body
, table
та tbody
; the list
of active formatting elements still has the b
element in it (the marker having been removed by the "td" end tag
token); and the insertion mode is "in table body".
Thus it is that the "bbb" character tokens are found. These trigger the
"in table text"
insertion mode to be used (with the original
insertion mode set to "in table body"). The character tokens
are collected та when the next token (the table
element end tag) is seen, they are processed as a group. Since they are
not all spaces, they are handled as per the "anything else" rules in the
"in
table" insertion mode, which defer to the "in body" insertion mode but with foster parenting.
When the active
formatting elements are reconstructed, a b
element is created and foster parented та then the "bbb" Text
node is appended to it:
The stack of open elements has
on it the elements html
, body
, table
,
tbody
та the new b
(again, note that this doesn't
match the resulting tree!); the list
of active formatting elements has the new b
element in it; and the insertion mode is
still "in
table body".
Had the character tokens been only space characters instead of "bbb", then
those space
characters would just be appended to the tbody
element.
Finally, the table
is
closed by a "table" end tag. This pops all the nodes from the stack
of open elements up to and including the table
element, but it doesn't affect the list
of active formatting elements, so the "ccc" character tokens after
the table result in yet another b
element being created, this time after the table:
Цей розділ не є нормативним.
Consider the following markup, which for this example we will assume is
the document with URL http://example.com/inner
,
being rendered as the content of an iframe
in another document with the URL http://example.com/outer
:
<div id=a> <script> var div = document.getElementById('a'); parent.document.body.appendChild(div); </script> <script> alert(document.URL); </script> </div> <script> alert(document.URL); </script>
Up to the first "script" end tag, before the script is parsed, the result is relatively straightforward:
After the script is parsed, though, the div
element and its child script
element are gone:
They are, at this point, in the Document
of the aforementioned outer browsing
context. However, the stack of
open elements still contains the div
element.
Thus, when the second script
element is parsed, it is inserted into the outer Document
object.
Those parsed into different Document
s
than the one the parser was created for do not execute, so the first
alert does not show.
Once the div
element's end
tag is parsed, the div
element is popped off the stack та so the next script
element is in the inner Document
:
This script does execute, resulting in an alert that says "http://example.com/inner".
Цей розділ не є нормативним.
Elaborating on the example in the previous section, consider the case
where the second script
element is an external script (i.e. one with a src
attribute). Since the element
was not in the parser's Document
when it was created, that external script is not even downloaded.
In a case where a script
element with a src
attribute is parsed normally into its parser's Document
,
but while the external script is being downloaded, the element is moved
to another document, the script continues to download, but does not
execute.
In general, moving script
elements between Document
s is
considered a bad practice.
Цей розділ не є нормативним.
The following markup shows how nested formatting elements (such as b
) get collected and continue to be
applied even as the elements they are contained in are closed, but that
excessive duplicates are thrown away.
<!DOCTYPE html> <p><b class=x><b class=x><b><b class=x><b class=x><b>X <p>X <p><b><b class=x><b>X <p></b></b></b></b></b></b>X
The resulting DOM tree is as follows:
Note how the second p
element in the markup has no explicit b
elements, but in the resulting DOM, up to three of each kind of
formatting element (in this case three b
elements with the class attribute та two unadorned b
elements) get reconstructed before the element's "X".
Also note how this means that in the final paragraph only six b
end tags are needed to completely
clear the list of formatting elements, even though nine b
start tags have been seen up to this point.
The following steps form the HTML
fragment serialization algorithm. The algorithm takes as input a
DOM Element
, Document
,
or DocumentFragment
referred to as the node та either
returns a string or throws an exception.
This algorithm serializes the children of the node being serialized, not the node itself.
Нехай s be a string та initialize it to the empty string.
Якщо the node is a template
element, then let the node instead
be the template
element's template contents (a DocumentFragment
node).
For each child node of the node, in tree order, run the following steps:
Нехай current node be the child node being processed.
Append the appropriate string from the following list to s:
Element
Якщо current node is an element in the простір імен HTML, the MathML namespace, or the SVG namespace, then let tagname be current node's local name. Інакше let tagname be current node's qualified name.
Append a "<" (U+003C) character, followed by tagname.
For HTML elements
created by the HTML parser or Document.createElement()
, tagname will be lowercase.
For each attribute that the element has, append a U+0020 SPACE character, the attribute's serialized name as described below, a "=" (U+003D) character, a U+0022 QUOTATION MARK character ("), the attribute's value, escaped as described below in attribute mode та a second U+0022 QUOTATION MARK character (").
An attribute's serialized name for the purposes of the previous paragraph must be determined as follows:
The attribute's serialized name is the attribute's local name.
For attributes on HTML
elements set by the HTML
parser or by Element.setAttribute()
,
the local name will be lowercase.
The attribute's serialized name is the string "xml:
"
followed by the attribute's local name.
xmlns
The attribute's serialized name is the string "xmlns
".
xmlns
The attribute's serialized name is the string "xmlns:
"
followed by the attribute's local name.
The attribute's serialized name is the string "xlink:
"
followed by the attribute's local name.
The attribute's serialized name is the attribute's qualified name.
While the exact order of attributes is UA-defined та may depend on factors such as the order that the attributes were given in the original markup, the sort order must be stable, such that consecutive invocations of this algorithm serialize an element's attributes in the same order.
Append a ">" (U+003E) character.
Якщо current node is an area
, base
,
basefont
, bgsound
,
br
, col
,
embed
, frame
, hr
,
img
, input
,
keygen
, link
, meta
,
param
, source
, track
or wbr
element, then
continue on to the next child node at this point.
Якщо current node is a pre
, textarea
,
or listing
element та
the first child node of the element, if any, is a Text
node whose character data
has as its first character a "LF" (U+000A) character, then
append a "LF" (U+000A) character.
Append the value of running the HTML fragment serialization algorithm on the current node element (thus recursing into this algorithm for that element), followed by a "<" (U+003C) character, a U+002F SOLIDUS character (/), tagname again та finally a U+003E GREATER-THAN SIGN character (>).
Text
nodeЯкщо the parent of current node
is a style
, script
, xmp
, iframe
,
noembed
, noframes
,
or plaintext
element,
or if the parent of current node
is a noscript
element and scripting
is enabled for the node, then append the value of current node's data
IDL attribute literally.
Інакше append the value of current
node's data
IDL
attribute, escaped
as described below.
Comment
Append the literal string <!--
(U+003C
LESS-THAN SIGN, U+0021 EXCLAMATION MARK, U+002D
HYPHEN-MINUS, U+002D HYPHEN-MINUS), followed by the value of
current node's data
IDL attribute, followed by the literal string -->
(U+002D HYPHEN-MINUS, U+002D HYPHEN-MINUS, U+003E
GREATER-THAN SIGN).
ProcessingInstruction
Append the literal string <?
(U+003C
LESS-THAN SIGN, U+003F QUESTION MARK), followed by the value
of current node's target
IDL attribute, followed by a single U+0020 SPACE character,
followed by the value of current
node's data
IDL
attribute, followed by a single ">" (U+003E) character.
DocumentType
Append the literal string <!DOCTYPE
(U+003C LESS-THAN SIGN, U+0021 EXCLAMATION MARK, U+0044
LATIN CAPITAL LETTER D, U+004F LATIN CAPITAL LETTER O,
U+0043 LATIN CAPITAL LETTER C, U+0054 LATIN CAPITAL LETTER
T, U+0059 LATIN CAPITAL LETTER Y, U+0050 LATIN CAPITAL
LETTER P, U+0045 LATIN CAPITAL LETTER E), followed by a
space (U+0020 SPACE), followed by the value of current
node's name
IDL
attribute, followed by the literal string >
(U+003E GREATER-THAN SIGN).
The result of the algorithm is the string s.
It is possible that the output of this algorithm, if parsed with an HTML parser, will not return the original tree structure.
For instance, if a textarea
element to which a Comment
node has
been appended is serialized and the output is then reparsed, the
comment will end up being displayed in the text field. Similarly, if,
as a result of DOM manipulation, an element contains a comment that
contains the literal string "-->
",
then when the result of serializing the element is parsed, the comment
will be truncated at that point and the rest of the comment will be
interpreted as markup. More examples would be making a script
element contain a Text
node with
the text string "</script>
", or having a p
element that contains a ul
element (as the ul
element's start
tag would imply the end tag for the p
).
This can enable cross-site scripting attacks. An example of this
would be a page that lets the user enter some font family names що є
then inserted into a CSS style
block via the DOM and which then uses the innerHTML
IDL attribute to get
the HTML serialization of that style
element: if the user enters "</style><script>attack</script>
"
as a font family name, innerHTML
will return markup that, if parsed in a different context, would
contain a script
node,
even though no script
node existed in the original DOM.
Escaping a string (for the purposes of the algorithm above) consists of running the following steps:
Replace any occurrence of the "&
"
character by the string "&
".
Replace any occurrences of the U+00A0 NO-BREAK SPACE character by
the string "
".
Якщо the algorithm was invoked in the attribute mode,
replace any occurrences of the ""
"
character by the string ""
".
Якщо the algorithm was not invoked in the attribute
mode, replace any occurrences of the "<
"
character by the string "<
"
та any occurrences of the ">
"
character by the string ">
".
The following steps form the HTML
fragment parsing algorithm. The algorithm optionally takes as
input an Element
node, referred to
as the context
element, which gives the context for the parser, as well as input,
a string to parse та returns a list of zero or more nodes.
Parts marked fragment case in algorithms in the parser section are parts that only occur if the parser was created for the purposes of this algorithm (and with a context element). The algorithms have been annotated with such markings for informational purposes only; such markings have no normative weight. Якщо it is possible for a condition described as a fragment case to occur even when the parser wasn't created for the purposes of handling this algorithm, then that is an error in the specification.
Create a new Document
node та
mark it as being an HTML document.
Якщо there is a context element та
the Document
of the context element is
in quirks mode, then let the Document
be in quirks mode. Інакше if there is a
context
element та the Document
of the
context
element is in limited-quirks mode,
then let the Document
be in limited-quirks mode. Інакше leave
the Document
in no-quirks
mode.
Create a new HTML parser та associate
it with the just created Document
node.
Якщо there is a context element, виконати ці підкроки:
Set the state of the HTML parser's tokenization stage as follows:
title
or textarea
elementstyle
,
xmp
, iframe
,
noembed
, or noframes
elementscript
elementnoscript
elementplaintext
elementFor performance reasons, an implementation that does not report errors and that uses the actual state machine described in this specification directly could use the PLAINTEXT state instead of the RAWTEXT and script data states where those are mentioned in the list above. Except for rules regarding parse errors, they are equivalent, since there is no appropriate end tag token in the fragment case, yet they involve far fewer state transitions.
Нехай root be a new html
element with no attributes.
Append the element root to the
Document
node created
above.
Set up the parser's stack of open elements so that it contains just the single element root.
Якщо the context element
is a template
element, push "in template" onto the stack of template
insertion modes so that it is the new current
template insertion mode.
Reset the parser's insertion mode appropriately.
The parser will reference the context element as part of that algorithm.
Set the parser's form
element pointer to the nearest node to the context element
that is a form
element (going straight up the ancestor chain та including the
element itself, if it is a form
element), if any. (Якщо there is no such form
element, the form
element pointer keeps its initial value, null.)
Place into the input stream for the HTML parser just created the input. The encoding confidence is irrelevant.
Start the parser and let it run until it has consumed all the characters just inserted into the input stream.
Якщо there is a context element, return the child nodes of root, in tree order.
Інакше return the children of the Document
object, in tree order.
This table lists the character reference names що є supported by HTML та the code points to which they refer. It is referenced by the previous sections.
Name | Character(s) | Glyph |
---|---|---|
Aacute; |
U+000C1 | Á |
Aacute |
U+000C1 | Á |
aacute; |
U+000E1 | á |
aacute |
U+000E1 | á |
Abreve; |
U+00102 | Ă |
abreve; |
U+00103 | ă |
ac; |
U+0223E | ∾ |
acd; |
U+0223F | ∿ |
acE; |
U+0223E U+00333 | ∾̳ |
Acirc; |
U+000C2 | Â |
Acirc |
U+000C2 | Â |
acirc; |
U+000E2 | â |
acirc |
U+000E2 | â |
acute; |
U+000B4 | ´ |
acute |
U+000B4 | ´ |
Acy; |
U+00410 | А |
acy; |
U+00430 | а |
AElig; |
U+000C6 | Æ |
AElig |
U+000C6 | Æ |
aelig; |
U+000E6 | æ |
aelig |
U+000E6 | æ |
af; |
U+02061 | |
Afr; |
U+1D504 | 𝔄 |
afr; |
U+1D51E | 𝔞 |
Agrave; |
U+000C0 | À |
Agrave |
U+000C0 | À |
agrave; |
U+000E0 | à |
agrave |
U+000E0 | à |
alefsym; |
U+02135 | ℵ |
aleph; |
U+02135 | ℵ |
Alpha; |
U+00391 | Α |
alpha; |
U+003B1 | α |
Amacr; |
U+00100 | Ā |
amacr; |
U+00101 | ā |
amalg; |
U+02A3F | ⨿ |
AMP; |
U+00026 | & |
AMP |
U+00026 | & |
amp; |
U+00026 | & |
amp |
U+00026 | & |
And; |
U+02A53 | ⩓ |
and; |
U+02227 | ∧ |
andand; |
U+02A55 | ⩕ |
andd; |
U+02A5C | ⩜ |
andslope; |
U+02A58 | ⩘ |
andv; |
U+02A5A | ⩚ |
ang; |
U+02220 | ∠ |
ange; |
U+029A4 | ⦤ |
angle; |
U+02220 | ∠ |
angmsd; |
U+02221 | ∡ |
angmsdaa; |
U+029A8 | ⦨ |
angmsdab; |
U+029A9 | ⦩ |
angmsdac; |
U+029AA | ⦪ |
angmsdad; |
U+029AB | ⦫ |
angmsdae; |
U+029AC | ⦬ |
angmsdaf; |
U+029AD | ⦭ |
angmsdag; |
U+029AE | ⦮ |
angmsdah; |
U+029AF | ⦯ |
angrt; |
U+0221F | ∟ |
angrtvb; |
U+022BE | ⊾ |
angrtvbd; |
U+0299D | ⦝ |
angsph; |
U+02222 | ∢ |
angst; |
U+000C5 | Å |
angzarr; |
U+0237C | ⍼ |
Aogon; |
U+00104 | Ą |
aogon; |
U+00105 | ą |
Aopf; |
U+1D538 | 𝔸 |
aopf; |
U+1D552 | 𝕒 |
ap; |
U+02248 | ≈ |
apacir; |
U+02A6F | ⩯ |
apE; |
U+02A70 | ⩰ |
ape; |
U+0224A | ≊ |
apid; |
U+0224B | ≋ |
apos; |
U+00027 | ' |
ApplyFunction; |
U+02061 | |
approx; |
U+02248 | ≈ |
approxeq; |
U+0224A | ≊ |
Aring; |
U+000C5 | Å |
Aring |
U+000C5 | Å |
aring; |
U+000E5 | å |
aring |
U+000E5 | å |
Ascr; |
U+1D49C | 𝒜 |
ascr; |
U+1D4B6 | 𝒶 |
Assign; |
U+02254 | ≔ |
ast; |
U+0002A | * |
asymp; |
U+02248 | ≈ |
asympeq; |
U+0224D | ≍ |
Atilde; |
U+000C3 | Ã |
Atilde |
U+000C3 | Ã |
atilde; |
U+000E3 | ã |
atilde |
U+000E3 | ã |
Auml; |
U+000C4 | Ä |
Auml |
U+000C4 | Ä |
auml; |
U+000E4 | ä |
auml |
U+000E4 | ä |
awconint; |
U+02233 | ∳ |
awint; |
U+02A11 | ⨑ |
backcong; |
U+0224C | ≌ |
backepsilon; |
U+003F6 | ϶ |
backprime; |
U+02035 | ‵ |
backsim; |
U+0223D | ∽ |
backsimeq; |
U+022CD | ⋍ |
Backslash; |
U+02216 | ∖ |
Barv; |
U+02AE7 | ⫧ |
barvee; |
U+022BD | ⊽ |
Barwed; |
U+02306 | ⌆ |
barwed; |
U+02305 | ⌅ |
barwedge; |
U+02305 | ⌅ |
bbrk; |
U+023B5 | ⎵ |
bbrktbrk; |
U+023B6 | ⎶ |
bcong; |
U+0224C | ≌ |
Bcy; |
U+00411 | Б |
bcy; |
U+00431 | б |
bdquo; |
U+0201E | „ |
becaus; |
U+02235 | ∵ |
Because; |
U+02235 | ∵ |
because; |
U+02235 | ∵ |
bemptyv; |
U+029B0 | ⦰ |
bepsi; |
U+003F6 | ϶ |
bernou; |
U+0212C | ℬ |
Bernoullis; |
U+0212C | ℬ |
Beta; |
U+00392 | Β |
beta; |
U+003B2 | β |
beth; |
U+02136 | ℶ |
between; |
U+0226C | ≬ |
Bfr; |
U+1D505 | 𝔅 |
bfr; |
U+1D51F | 𝔟 |
bigcap; |
U+022C2 | ⋂ |
bigcirc; |
U+025EF | ◯ |
bigcup; |
U+022C3 | ⋃ |
bigodot; |
U+02A00 | ⨀ |
bigoplus; |
U+02A01 | ⨁ |
bigotimes; |
U+02A02 | ⨂ |
bigsqcup; |
U+02A06 | ⨆ |
bigstar; |
U+02605 | ★ |
bigtriangledown; |
U+025BD | ▽ |
bigtriangleup; |
U+025B3 | △ |
biguplus; |
U+02A04 | ⨄ |
bigvee; |
U+022C1 | ⋁ |
bigwedge; |
U+022C0 | ⋀ |
bkarow; |
U+0290D | ⤍ |
blacklozenge; |
U+029EB | ⧫ |
blacksquare; |
U+025AA | ▪ |
blacktriangle; |
U+025B4 | ▴ |
blacktriangledown; |
U+025BE | ▾ |
blacktriangleleft; |
U+025C2 | ◂ |
blacktriangleright; |
U+025B8 | ▸ |
blank; |
U+02423 | ␣ |
blk12; |
U+02592 | ▒ |
blk14; |
U+02591 | ░ |
blk34; |
U+02593 | ▓ |
block; |
U+02588 | █ |
bne; |
U+0003D U+020E5 | =⃥ |
bnequiv; |
U+02261 U+020E5 | ≡⃥ |
bNot; |
U+02AED | ⫭ |
bnot; |
U+02310 | ⌐ |
Bopf; |
U+1D539 | 𝔹 |
bopf; |
U+1D553 | 𝕓 |
bot; |
U+022A5 | ⊥ |
bottom; |
U+022A5 | ⊥ |
bowtie; |
U+022C8 | ⋈ |
boxbox; |
U+029C9 | ⧉ |
boxDL; |
U+02557 | ╗ |
boxDl; |
U+02556 | ╖ |
boxdL; |
U+02555 | ╕ |
boxdl; |
U+02510 | ┐ |
boxDR; |
U+02554 | ╔ |
boxDr; |
U+02553 | ╓ |
boxdR; |
U+02552 | ╒ |
boxdr; |
U+0250C | ┌ |
boxH; |
U+02550 | ═ |
boxh; |
U+02500 | ─ |
boxHD; |
U+02566 | ╦ |
boxHd; |
U+02564 | ╤ |
boxhD; |
U+02565 | ╥ |
boxhd; |
U+0252C | ┬ |
boxHU; |
U+02569 | ╩ |
boxHu; |
U+02567 | ╧ |
boxhU; |
U+02568 | ╨ |
boxhu; |
U+02534 | ┴ |
boxminus; |
U+0229F | ⊟ |
boxplus; |
U+0229E | ⊞ |
boxtimes; |
U+022A0 | ⊠ |
boxUL; |
U+0255D | ╝ |
boxUl; |
U+0255C | ╜ |
boxuL; |
U+0255B | ╛ |
boxul; |
U+02518 | ┘ |
boxUR; |
U+0255A | ╚ |
boxUr; |
U+02559 | ╙ |
boxuR; |
U+02558 | ╘ |
boxur; |
U+02514 | └ |
boxV; |
U+02551 | ║ |
boxv; |
U+02502 | │ |
boxVH; |
U+0256C | ╬ |
boxVh; |
U+0256B | ╫ |
boxvH; |
U+0256A | ╪ |
boxvh; |
U+0253C | ┼ |
boxVL; |
U+02563 | ╣ |
boxVl; |
U+02562 | ╢ |
boxvL; |
U+02561 | ╡ |
boxvl; |
U+02524 | ┤ |
boxVR; |
U+02560 | ╠ |
boxVr; |
U+0255F | ╟ |
boxvR; |
U+0255E | ╞ |
boxvr; |
U+0251C | ├ |
bprime; |
U+02035 | ‵ |
Breve; |
U+002D8 | ˘ |
breve; |
U+002D8 | ˘ |
brvbar; |
U+000A6 | ¦ |
brvbar |
U+000A6 | ¦ |
Bscr; |
U+0212C | ℬ |
bscr; |
U+1D4B7 | 𝒷 |
bsemi; |
U+0204F | ⁏ |
bsim; |
U+0223D | ∽ |
bsime; |
U+022CD | ⋍ |
bsol; |
U+0005C | \ |
bsolb; |
U+029C5 | ⧅ |
bsolhsub; |
U+027C8 | ⟈ |
bull; |
U+02022 | • |
bullet; |
U+02022 | • |
bump; |
U+0224E | ≎ |
bumpE; |
U+02AAE | ⪮ |
bumpe; |
U+0224F | ≏ |
Bumpeq; |
U+0224E | ≎ |
bumpeq; |
U+0224F | ≏ |
Cacute; |
U+00106 | Ć |
cacute; |
U+00107 | ć |
Cap; |
U+022D2 | ⋒ |
cap; |
U+02229 | ∩ |
capand; |
U+02A44 | ⩄ |
capbrcup; |
U+02A49 | ⩉ |
capcap; |
U+02A4B | ⩋ |
capcup; |
U+02A47 | ⩇ |
capdot; |
U+02A40 | ⩀ |
CapitalDifferentialD; |
U+02145 | ⅅ |
caps; |
U+02229 U+0FE00 | ∩︀ |
caret; |
U+02041 | ⁁ |
caron; |
U+002C7 | ˇ |
Cayleys; |
U+0212D | ℭ |
ccaps; |
U+02A4D | ⩍ |
Ccaron; |
U+0010C | Č |
ccaron; |
U+0010D | č |
Ccedil; |
U+000C7 | Ç |
Ccedil |
U+000C7 | Ç |
ccedil; |
U+000E7 | ç |
ccedil |
U+000E7 | ç |
Ccirc; |
U+00108 | Ĉ |
ccirc; |
U+00109 | ĉ |
Cconint; |
U+02230 | ∰ |
ccups; |
U+02A4C | ⩌ |
ccupssm; |
U+02A50 | ⩐ |
Cdot; |
U+0010A | Ċ |
cdot; |
U+0010B | ċ |
cedil; |
U+000B8 | ¸ |
cedil |
U+000B8 | ¸ |
Cedilla; |
U+000B8 | ¸ |
cemptyv; |
U+029B2 | ⦲ |
cent; |
U+000A2 | ¢ |
cent |
U+000A2 | ¢ |
CenterDot; |
U+000B7 | · |
centerdot; |
U+000B7 | · |
Cfr; |
U+0212D | ℭ |
cfr; |
U+1D520 | 𝔠 |
CHcy; |
U+00427 | Ч |
chcy; |
U+00447 | ч |
check; |
U+02713 | ✓ |
checkmark; |
U+02713 | ✓ |
Chi; |
U+003A7 | Χ |
chi; |
U+003C7 | χ |
cir; |
U+025CB | ○ |
circ; |
U+002C6 | ˆ |
circeq; |
U+02257 | ≗ |
circlearrowleft; |
U+021BA | ↺ |
circlearrowright; |
U+021BB | ↻ |
circledast; |
U+0229B | ⊛ |
circledcirc; |
U+0229A | ⊚ |
circleddash; |
U+0229D | ⊝ |
CircleDot; |
U+02299 | ⊙ |
circledR; |
U+000AE | ® |
circledS; |
U+024C8 | Ⓢ |
CircleMinus; |
U+02296 | ⊖ |
CirclePlus; |
U+02295 | ⊕ |
CircleTimes; |
U+02297 | ⊗ |
cirE; |
U+029C3 | ⧃ |
cire; |
U+02257 | ≗ |
cirfnint; |
U+02A10 | ⨐ |
cirmid; |
U+02AEF | ⫯ |
cirscir; |
U+029C2 | ⧂ |
ClockwiseContourIntegral; |
U+02232 | ∲ |
CloseCurlyDoubleQuote; |
U+0201D | ” |
CloseCurlyQuote; |
U+02019 | ’ |
clubs; |
U+02663 | ♣ |
clubsuit; |
U+02663 | ♣ |
Colon; |
U+02237 | ∷ |
colon; |
U+0003A | : |
Colone; |
U+02A74 | ⩴ |
colone; |
U+02254 | ≔ |
coloneq; |
U+02254 | ≔ |
comma; |
U+0002C | , |
commat; |
U+00040 | @ |
comp; |
U+02201 | ∁ |
compfn; |
U+02218 | ∘ |
complement; |
U+02201 | ∁ |
complexes; |
U+02102 | ℂ |
cong; |
U+02245 | ≅ |
congdot; |
U+02A6D | ⩭ |
Congruent; |
U+02261 | ≡ |
Conint; |
U+0222F | ∯ |
conint; |
U+0222E | ∮ |
ContourIntegral; |
U+0222E | ∮ |
Copf; |
U+02102 | ℂ |
copf; |
U+1D554 | 𝕔 |
coprod; |
U+02210 | ∐ |
Coproduct; |
U+02210 | ∐ |
COPY; |
U+000A9 | © |
COPY |
U+000A9 | © |
copy; |
U+000A9 | © |
copy |
U+000A9 | © |
copysr; |
U+02117 | ℗ |
CounterClockwiseContourIntegral; |
U+02233 | ∳ |
crarr; |
U+021B5 | ↵ |
Cross; |
U+02A2F | ⨯ |
cross; |
U+02717 | ✗ |
Cscr; |
U+1D49E | 𝒞 |
cscr; |
U+1D4B8 | 𝒸 |
csub; |
U+02ACF | ⫏ |
csube; |
U+02AD1 | ⫑ |
csup; |
U+02AD0 | ⫐ |
csupe; |
U+02AD2 | ⫒ |
ctdot; |
U+022EF | ⋯ |
cudarrl; |
U+02938 | ⤸ |
cudarrr; |
U+02935 | ⤵ |
cuepr; |
U+022DE | ⋞ |
cuesc; |
U+022DF | ⋟ |
cularr; |
U+021B6 | ↶ |
cularrp; |
U+0293D | ⤽ |
Cup; |
U+022D3 | ⋓ |
cup; |
U+0222A | ∪ |
cupbrcap; |
U+02A48 | ⩈ |
CupCap; |
U+0224D | ≍ |
cupcap; |
U+02A46 | ⩆ |
cupcup; |
U+02A4A | ⩊ |
cupdot; |
U+0228D | ⊍ |
cupor; |
U+02A45 | ⩅ |
cups; |
U+0222A U+0FE00 | ∪︀ |
curarr; |
U+021B7 | ↷ |
curarrm; |
U+0293C | ⤼ |
curlyeqprec; |
U+022DE | ⋞ |
curlyeqsucc; |
U+022DF | ⋟ |
curlyvee; |
U+022CE | ⋎ |
curlywedge; |
U+022CF | ⋏ |
curren; |
U+000A4 | ¤ |
curren |
U+000A4 | ¤ |
curvearrowleft; |
U+021B6 | ↶ |
curvearrowright; |
U+021B7 | ↷ |
cuvee; |
U+022CE | ⋎ |
cuwed; |
U+022CF | ⋏ |
cwconint; |
U+02232 | ∲ |
cwint; |
U+02231 | ∱ |
cylcty; |
U+0232D | ⌭ |
Dagger; |
U+02021 | ‡ |
dagger; |
U+02020 | † |
daleth; |
U+02138 | ℸ |
Darr; |
U+021A1 | ↡ |
dArr; |
U+021D3 | ⇓ |
darr; |
U+02193 | ↓ |
dash; |
U+02010 | ‐ |
Dashv; |
U+02AE4 | ⫤ |
dashv; |
U+022A3 | ⊣ |
dbkarow; |
U+0290F | ⤏ |
dblac; |
U+002DD | ˝ |
Dcaron; |
U+0010E | Ď |
dcaron; |
U+0010F | ď |
Dcy; |
U+00414 | Д |
dcy; |
U+00434 | д |
DD; |
U+02145 | ⅅ |
dd; |
U+02146 | ⅆ |
ddagger; |
U+02021 | ‡ |
ddarr; |
U+021CA | ⇊ |
DDotrahd; |
U+02911 | ⤑ |
ddotseq; |
U+02A77 | ⩷ |
deg; |
U+000B0 | ° |
deg |
U+000B0 | ° |
Del; |
U+02207 | ∇ |
Delta; |
U+00394 | Δ |
delta; |
U+003B4 | δ |
demptyv; |
U+029B1 | ⦱ |
dfisht; |
U+0297F | ⥿ |
Dfr; |
U+1D507 | 𝔇 |
dfr; |
U+1D521 | 𝔡 |
dHar; |
U+02965 | ⥥ |
dharl; |
U+021C3 | ⇃ |
dharr; |
U+021C2 | ⇂ |
DiacriticalAcute; |
U+000B4 | ´ |
DiacriticalDot; |
U+002D9 | ˙ |
DiacriticalDoubleAcute; |
U+002DD | ˝ |
DiacriticalGrave; |
U+00060 | ` |
DiacriticalTilde; |
U+002DC | ˜ |
diam; |
U+022C4 | ⋄ |
Diamond; |
U+022C4 | ⋄ |
diamond; |
U+022C4 | ⋄ |
diamondsuit; |
U+02666 | ♦ |
diams; |
U+02666 | ♦ |
die; |
U+000A8 | ¨ |
DifferentialD; |
U+02146 | ⅆ |
digamma; |
U+003DD | ϝ |
disin; |
U+022F2 | ⋲ |
div; |
U+000F7 | ÷ |
divide; |
U+000F7 | ÷ |
divide |
U+000F7 | ÷ |
divideontimes; |
U+022C7 | ⋇ |
divonx; |
U+022C7 | ⋇ |
DJcy; |
U+00402 | Ђ |
djcy; |
U+00452 | ђ |
dlcorn; |
U+0231E | ⌞ |
dlcrop; |
U+0230D | ⌍ |
dollar; |
U+00024 | $ |
Dopf; |
U+1D53B | 𝔻 |
dopf; |
U+1D555 | 𝕕 |
Dot; |
U+000A8 | ¨ |
dot; |
U+002D9 | ˙ |
DotDot; |
U+020DC | ◌⃜ |
doteq; |
U+02250 | ≐ |
doteqdot; |
U+02251 | ≑ |
DotEqual; |
U+02250 | ≐ |
dotminus; |
U+02238 | ∸ |
dotplus; |
U+02214 | ∔ |
dotsquare; |
U+022A1 | ⊡ |
doublebarwedge; |
U+02306 | ⌆ |
DoubleContourIntegral; |
U+0222F | ∯ |
DoubleDot; |
U+000A8 | ¨ |
DoubleDownArrow; |
U+021D3 | ⇓ |
DoubleLeftArrow; |
U+021D0 | ⇐ |
DoubleLeftRightArrow; |
U+021D4 | ⇔ |
DoubleLeftTee; |
U+02AE4 | ⫤ |
DoubleLongLeftArrow; |
U+027F8 | ⟸ |
DoubleLongLeftRightArrow; |
U+027FA | ⟺ |
DoubleLongRightArrow; |
U+027F9 | ⟹ |
DoubleRightArrow; |
U+021D2 | ⇒ |
DoubleRightTee; |
U+022A8 | ⊨ |
DoubleUpArrow; |
U+021D1 | ⇑ |
DoubleUpDownArrow; |
U+021D5 | ⇕ |
DoubleVerticalBar; |
U+02225 | ∥ |
DownArrow; |
U+02193 | ↓ |
Downarrow; |
U+021D3 | ⇓ |
downarrow; |
U+02193 | ↓ |
DownArrowBar; |
U+02913 | ⤓ |
DownArrowUpArrow; |
U+021F5 | ⇵ |
DownBreve; |
U+00311 | ◌̑ |
downdownarrows; |
U+021CA | ⇊ |
downharpoonleft; |
U+021C3 | ⇃ |
downharpoonright; |
U+021C2 | ⇂ |
DownLeftRightVector; |
U+02950 | ⥐ |
DownLeftTeeVector; |
U+0295E | ⥞ |
DownLeftVector; |
U+021BD | ↽ |
DownLeftVectorBar; |
U+02956 | ⥖ |
DownRightTeeVector; |
U+0295F | ⥟ |
DownRightVector; |
U+021C1 | ⇁ |
DownRightVectorBar; |
U+02957 | ⥗ |
DownTee; |
U+022A4 | ⊤ |
DownTeeArrow; |
U+021A7 | ↧ |
drbkarow; |
U+02910 | ⤐ |
drcorn; |
U+0231F | ⌟ |
drcrop; |
U+0230C | ⌌ |
Dscr; |
U+1D49F | 𝒟 |
dscr; |
U+1D4B9 | 𝒹 |
DScy; |
U+00405 | Ѕ |
dscy; |
U+00455 | ѕ |
dsol; |
U+029F6 | ⧶ |
Dstrok; |
U+00110 | Đ |
dstrok; |
U+00111 | đ |
dtdot; |
U+022F1 | ⋱ |
dtri; |
U+025BF | ▿ |
dtrif; |
U+025BE | ▾ |
duarr; |
U+021F5 | ⇵ |
duhar; |
U+0296F | ⥯ |
dwangle; |
U+029A6 | ⦦ |
DZcy; |
U+0040F | Џ |
dzcy; |
U+0045F | џ |
dzigrarr; |
U+027FF | ⟿ |
Eacute; |
U+000C9 | É |
Eacute |
U+000C9 | É |
eacute; |
U+000E9 | é |
eacute |
U+000E9 | é |
easter; |
U+02A6E | ⩮ |
Ecaron; |
U+0011A | Ě |
ecaron; |
U+0011B | ě |
ecir; |
U+02256 | ≖ |
Ecirc; |
U+000CA | Ê |
Ecirc |
U+000CA | Ê |
ecirc; |
U+000EA | ê |
ecirc |
U+000EA | ê |
ecolon; |
U+02255 | ≕ |
Ecy; |
U+0042D | Э |
ecy; |
U+0044D | э |
eDDot; |
U+02A77 | ⩷ |
Edot; |
U+00116 | Ė |
eDot; |
U+02251 | ≑ |
edot; |
U+00117 | ė |
ee; |
U+02147 | ⅇ |
efDot; |
U+02252 | ≒ |
Efr; |
U+1D508 | 𝔈 |
efr; |
U+1D522 | 𝔢 |
eg; |
U+02A9A | ⪚ |
Egrave; |
U+000C8 | È |
Egrave |
U+000C8 | È |
egrave; |
U+000E8 | è |
egrave |
U+000E8 | è |
egs; |
U+02A96 | ⪖ |
egsdot; |
U+02A98 | ⪘ |
el; |
U+02A99 | ⪙ |
Element; |
U+02208 | ∈ |
elinters; |
U+023E7 | ⏧ |
ell; |
U+02113 | ℓ |
els; |
U+02A95 | ⪕ |
elsdot; |
U+02A97 | ⪗ |
Emacr; |
U+00112 | Ē |
emacr; |
U+00113 | ē |
empty; |
U+02205 | ∅ |
emptyset; |
U+02205 | ∅ |
EmptySmallSquare; |
U+025FB | ◻ |
emptyv; |
U+02205 | ∅ |
EmptyVerySmallSquare; |
U+025AB | ▫ |
emsp; |
U+02003 | |
emsp13; |
U+02004 | |
emsp14; |
U+02005 | |
ENG; |
U+0014A | Ŋ |
eng; |
U+0014B | ŋ |
ensp; |
U+02002 | |
Eogon; |
U+00118 | Ę |
eogon; |
U+00119 | ę |
Eopf; |
U+1D53C | 𝔼 |
eopf; |
U+1D556 | 𝕖 |
epar; |
U+022D5 | ⋕ |
eparsl; |
U+029E3 | ⧣ |
eplus; |
U+02A71 | ⩱ |
epsi; |
U+003B5 | ε |
Epsilon; |
U+00395 | Ε |
epsilon; |
U+003B5 | ε |
epsiv; |
U+003F5 | ϵ |
eqcirc; |
U+02256 | ≖ |
eqcolon; |
U+02255 | ≕ |
eqsim; |
U+02242 | ≂ |
eqslantgtr; |
U+02A96 | ⪖ |
eqslantless; |
U+02A95 | ⪕ |
Equal; |
U+02A75 | ⩵ |
equals; |
U+0003D | = |
EqualTilde; |
U+02242 | ≂ |
equest; |
U+0225F | ≟ |
Equilibrium; |
U+021CC | ⇌ |
equiv; |
U+02261 | ≡ |
equivDD; |
U+02A78 | ⩸ |
eqvparsl; |
U+029E5 | ⧥ |
erarr; |
U+02971 | ⥱ |
erDot; |
U+02253 | ≓ |
Escr; |
U+02130 | ℰ |
escr; |
U+0212F | ℯ |
esdot; |
U+02250 | ≐ |
Esim; |
U+02A73 | ⩳ |
esim; |
U+02242 | ≂ |
Eta; |
U+00397 | Η |
eta; |
U+003B7 | η |
ETH; |
U+000D0 | Ð |
ETH |
U+000D0 | Ð |
eth; |
U+000F0 | ð |
eth |
U+000F0 | ð |
Euml; |
U+000CB | Ë |
Euml |
U+000CB | Ë |
euml; |
U+000EB | ë |
euml |
U+000EB | ë |
euro; |
U+020AC | € |
excl; |
U+00021 | ! |
exist; |
U+02203 | ∃ |
Exists; |
U+02203 | ∃ |
expectation; |
U+02130 | ℰ |
ExponentialE; |
U+02147 | ⅇ |
exponentiale; |
U+02147 | ⅇ |
fallingdotseq; |
U+02252 | ≒ |
Fcy; |
U+00424 | Ф |
fcy; |
U+00444 | ф |
female; |
U+02640 | ♀ |
ffilig; |
U+0FB03 | ffi |
fflig; |
U+0FB00 | ff |
ffllig; |
U+0FB04 | ffl |
Ffr; |
U+1D509 | 𝔉 |
ffr; |
U+1D523 | 𝔣 |
filig; |
U+0FB01 | fi |
FilledSmallSquare; |
U+025FC | ◼ |
FilledVerySmallSquare; |
U+025AA | ▪ |
fjlig; |
U+00066 U+0006A | fj |
flat; |
U+0266D | ♭ |
fllig; |
U+0FB02 | fl |
fltns; |
U+025B1 | ▱ |
fnof; |
U+00192 | ƒ |
Fopf; |
U+1D53D | 𝔽 |
fopf; |
U+1D557 | 𝕗 |
ForAll; |
U+02200 | ∀ |
forall; |
U+02200 | ∀ |
fork; |
U+022D4 | ⋔ |
forkv; |
U+02AD9 | ⫙ |
Fouriertrf; |
U+02131 | ℱ |
fpartint; |
U+02A0D | ⨍ |
frac12; |
U+000BD | ½ |
frac12 |
U+000BD | ½ |
frac13; |
U+02153 | ⅓ |
frac14; |
U+000BC | ¼ |
frac14 |
U+000BC | ¼ |
frac15; |
U+02155 | ⅕ |
frac16; |
U+02159 | ⅙ |
frac18; |
U+0215B | ⅛ |
frac23; |
U+02154 | ⅔ |
frac25; |
U+02156 | ⅖ |
frac34; |
U+000BE | ¾ |
frac34 |
U+000BE | ¾ |
frac35; |
U+02157 | ⅗ |
frac38; |
U+0215C | ⅜ |
frac45; |
U+02158 | ⅘ |
frac56; |
U+0215A | ⅚ |
frac58; |
U+0215D | ⅝ |
frac78; |
U+0215E | ⅞ |
frasl; |
U+02044 | ⁄ |
frown; |
U+02322 | ⌢ |
Fscr; |
U+02131 | ℱ |
fscr; |
U+1D4BB | 𝒻 |
gacute; |
U+001F5 | ǵ |
Gamma; |
U+00393 | Γ |
gamma; |
U+003B3 | γ |
Gammad; |
U+003DC | Ϝ |
gammad; |
U+003DD | ϝ |
gap; |
U+02A86 | ⪆ |
Gbreve; |
U+0011E | Ğ |
gbreve; |
U+0011F | ğ |
Gcedil; |
U+00122 | Ģ |
Gcirc; |
U+0011C | Ĝ |
gcirc; |
U+0011D | ĝ |
Gcy; |
U+00413 | Г |
gcy; |
U+00433 | г |
Gdot; |
U+00120 | Ġ |
gdot; |
U+00121 | ġ |
gE; |
U+02267 | ≧ |
ge; |
U+02265 | ≥ |
gEl; |
U+02A8C | ⪌ |
gel; |
U+022DB | ⋛ |
geq; |
U+02265 | ≥ |
geqq; |
U+02267 | ≧ |
geqslant; |
U+02A7E | ⩾ |
ges; |
U+02A7E | ⩾ |
gescc; |
U+02AA9 | ⪩ |
gesdot; |
U+02A80 | ⪀ |
gesdoto; |
U+02A82 | ⪂ |
gesdotol; |
U+02A84 | ⪄ |
gesl; |
U+022DB U+0FE00 | ⋛︀ |
gesles; |
U+02A94 | ⪔ |
Gfr; |
U+1D50A | 𝔊 |
gfr; |
U+1D524 | 𝔤 |
Gg; |
U+022D9 | ⋙ |
gg; |
U+0226B | ≫ |
ggg; |
U+022D9 | ⋙ |
gimel; |
U+02137 | ℷ |
GJcy; |
U+00403 | Ѓ |
gjcy; |
U+00453 | ѓ |
gl; |
U+02277 | ≷ |
gla; |
U+02AA5 | ⪥ |
glE; |
U+02A92 | ⪒ |
glj; |
U+02AA4 | ⪤ |
gnap; |
U+02A8A | ⪊ |
gnapprox; |
U+02A8A | ⪊ |
gnE; |
U+02269 | ≩ |
gne; |
U+02A88 | ⪈ |
gneq; |
U+02A88 | ⪈ |
gneqq; |
U+02269 | ≩ |
gnsim; |
U+022E7 | ⋧ |
Gopf; |
U+1D53E | 𝔾 |
gopf; |
U+1D558 | 𝕘 |
grave; |
U+00060 | ` |
GreaterEqual; |
U+02265 | ≥ |
GreaterEqualLess; |
U+022DB | ⋛ |
GreaterFullEqual; |
U+02267 | ≧ |
GreaterGreater; |
U+02AA2 | ⪢ |
GreaterLess; |
U+02277 | ≷ |
GreaterSlantEqual; |
U+02A7E | ⩾ |
GreaterTilde; |
U+02273 | ≳ |
Gscr; |
U+1D4A2 | 𝒢 |
gscr; |
U+0210A | ℊ |
gsim; |
U+02273 | ≳ |
gsime; |
U+02A8E | ⪎ |
gsiml; |
U+02A90 | ⪐ |
GT; |
U+0003E | > |
GT |
U+0003E | > |
Gt; |
U+0226B | ≫ |
gt; |
U+0003E | > |
gt |
U+0003E | > |
gtcc; |
U+02AA7 | ⪧ |
gtcir; |
U+02A7A | ⩺ |
gtdot; |
U+022D7 | ⋗ |
gtlPar; |
U+02995 | ⦕ |
gtquest; |
U+02A7C | ⩼ |
gtrapprox; |
U+02A86 | ⪆ |
gtrarr; |
U+02978 | ⥸ |
gtrdot; |
U+022D7 | ⋗ |
gtreqless; |
U+022DB | ⋛ |
gtreqqless; |
U+02A8C | ⪌ |
gtrless; |
U+02277 | ≷ |
gtrsim; |
U+02273 | ≳ |
gvertneqq; |
U+02269 U+0FE00 | ≩︀ |
gvnE; |
U+02269 U+0FE00 | ≩︀ |
Hacek; |
U+002C7 | ˇ |
hairsp; |
U+0200A | |
half; |
U+000BD | ½ |
hamilt; |
U+0210B | ℋ |
HARDcy; |
U+0042A | Ъ |
hardcy; |
U+0044A | ъ |
hArr; |
U+021D4 | ⇔ |
harr; |
U+02194 | ↔ |
harrcir; |
U+02948 | ⥈ |
harrw; |
U+021AD | ↭ |
Hat; |
U+0005E | ^ |
hbar; |
U+0210F | ℏ |
Hcirc; |
U+00124 | Ĥ |
hcirc; |
U+00125 | ĥ |
hearts; |
U+02665 | ♥ |
heartsuit; |
U+02665 | ♥ |
hellip; |
U+02026 | … |
hercon; |
U+022B9 | ⊹ |
Hfr; |
U+0210C | ℌ |
hfr; |
U+1D525 | 𝔥 |
HilbertSpace; |
U+0210B | ℋ |
hksearow; |
U+02925 | ⤥ |
hkswarow; |
U+02926 | ⤦ |
hoarr; |
U+021FF | ⇿ |
homtht; |
U+0223B | ∻ |
hookleftarrow; |
U+021A9 | ↩ |
hookrightarrow; |
U+021AA | ↪ |
Hopf; |
U+0210D | ℍ |
hopf; |
U+1D559 | 𝕙 |
horbar; |
U+02015 | ― |
HorizontalLine; |
U+02500 | ─ |
Hscr; |
U+0210B | ℋ |
hscr; |
U+1D4BD | 𝒽 |
hslash; |
U+0210F | ℏ |
Hstrok; |
U+00126 | Ħ |
hstrok; |
U+00127 | ħ |
HumpDownHump; |
U+0224E | ≎ |
HumpEqual; |
U+0224F | ≏ |
hybull; |
U+02043 | ⁃ |
hyphen; |
U+02010 | ‐ |
Iacute; |
U+000CD | Í |
Iacute |
U+000CD | Í |
iacute; |
U+000ED | í |
iacute |
U+000ED | í |
ic; |
U+02063 | |
Icirc; |
U+000CE | Î |
Icirc |
U+000CE | Î |
icirc; |
U+000EE | î |
icirc |
U+000EE | î |
Icy; |
U+00418 | И |
icy; |
U+00438 | и |
Idot; |
U+00130 | İ |
IEcy; |
U+00415 | Е |
iecy; |
U+00435 | е |
iexcl; |
U+000A1 | ¡ |
iexcl |
U+000A1 | ¡ |
iff; |
U+021D4 | ⇔ |
Якщоr; |
U+02111 | ℑ |
ifr; |
U+1D526 | 𝔦 |
Igrave; |
U+000CC | Ì |
Igrave |
U+000CC | Ì |
igrave; |
U+000EC | ì |
igrave |
U+000EC | ì |
ii; |
U+02148 | ⅈ |
iiiint; |
U+02A0C | ⨌ |
iiint; |
U+0222D | ∭ |
iinfin; |
U+029DC | ⧜ |
iiota; |
U+02129 | ℩ |
IJlig; |
U+00132 | IJ |
ijlig; |
U+00133 | ij |
Im; |
U+02111 | ℑ |
Imacr; |
U+0012A | Ī |
imacr; |
U+0012B | ī |
image; |
U+02111 | ℑ |
ImaginaryI; |
U+02148 | ⅈ |
imagline; |
U+02110 | ℐ |
imagpart; |
U+02111 | ℑ |
imath; |
U+00131 | ı |
imof; |
U+022B7 | ⊷ |
imped; |
U+001B5 | Ƶ |
Implies; |
U+021D2 | ⇒ |
in; |
U+02208 | ∈ |
incare; |
U+02105 | ℅ |
infin; |
U+0221E | ∞ |
infintie; |
U+029DD | ⧝ |
inodot; |
U+00131 | ı |
Int; |
U+0222C | ∬ |
int; |
U+0222B | ∫ |
intcal; |
U+022BA | ⊺ |
integers; |
U+02124 | ℤ |
Integral; |
U+0222B | ∫ |
intercal; |
U+022BA | ⊺ |
Intersection; |
U+022C2 | ⋂ |
intlarhk; |
U+02A17 | ⨗ |
intprod; |
U+02A3C | ⨼ |
InvisibleComma; |
U+02063 | |
InvisibleTimes; |
U+02062 | |
IOcy; |
U+00401 | Ё |
iocy; |
U+00451 | ё |
Iogon; |
U+0012E | Į |
iogon; |
U+0012F | į |
Iopf; |
U+1D540 | 𝕀 |
iopf; |
U+1D55A | 𝕚 |
Iota; |
U+00399 | Ι |
iota; |
U+003B9 | ι |
iprod; |
U+02A3C | ⨼ |
iquest; |
U+000BF | ¿ |
iquest |
U+000BF | ¿ |
Iscr; |
U+02110 | ℐ |
iscr; |
U+1D4BE | 𝒾 |
isin; |
U+02208 | ∈ |
isindot; |
U+022F5 | ⋵ |
isinE; |
U+022F9 | ⋹ |
isins; |
U+022F4 | ⋴ |
isinsv; |
U+022F3 | ⋳ |
isinv; |
U+02208 | ∈ |
it; |
U+02062 | |
Itilde; |
U+00128 | Ĩ |
itilde; |
U+00129 | ĩ |
Iukcy; |
U+00406 | І |
iukcy; |
U+00456 | і |
Iuml; |
U+000CF | Ï |
Iuml |
U+000CF | Ï |
iuml; |
U+000EF | ï |
iuml |
U+000EF | ï |
Jcirc; |
U+00134 | Ĵ |
jcirc; |
U+00135 | ĵ |
Jcy; |
U+00419 | Й |
jcy; |
U+00439 | й |
Jfr; |
U+1D50D | 𝔍 |
jfr; |
U+1D527 | 𝔧 |
jmath; |
U+00237 | ȷ |
Jopf; |
U+1D541 | 𝕁 |
jopf; |
U+1D55B | 𝕛 |
Jscr; |
U+1D4A5 | 𝒥 |
jscr; |
U+1D4BF | 𝒿 |
Jsercy; |
U+00408 | Ј |
jsercy; |
U+00458 | ј |
Jukcy; |
U+00404 | Є |
jukcy; |
U+00454 | є |
Kappa; |
U+0039A | Κ |
kappa; |
U+003BA | κ |
kappav; |
U+003F0 | ϰ |
Kcedil; |
U+00136 | Ķ |
kcedil; |
U+00137 | ķ |
Kcy; |
U+0041A | К |
kcy; |
U+0043A | к |
Kfr; |
U+1D50E | 𝔎 |
kfr; |
U+1D528 | 𝔨 |
kgreen; |
U+00138 | ĸ |
KHcy; |
U+00425 | Х |
khcy; |
U+00445 | х |
KJcy; |
U+0040C | Ќ |
kjcy; |
U+0045C | ќ |
Kopf; |
U+1D542 | 𝕂 |
kopf; |
U+1D55C | 𝕜 |
Kscr; |
U+1D4A6 | 𝒦 |
kscr; |
U+1D4C0 | 𝓀 |
lAarr; |
U+021DA | ⇚ |
Lacute; |
U+00139 | Ĺ |
lacute; |
U+0013A | ĺ |
laemptyv; |
U+029B4 | ⦴ |
lagran; |
U+02112 | ℒ |
Lambda; |
U+0039B | Λ |
lambda; |
U+003BB | λ |
Lang; |
U+027EA | ⟪ |
lang; |
U+027E8 | ⟨ |
langd; |
U+02991 | ⦑ |
langle; |
U+027E8 | 〈 |
lap; |
U+02A85 | ⪅ |
Laplacetrf; |
U+02112 | ℒ |
laquo; |
U+000AB | « |
laquo |
U+000AB | « |
Larr; |
U+0219E | ↞ |
lArr; |
U+021D0 | ⇐ |
larr; |
U+02190 | ← |
larrb; |
U+021E4 | ⇤ |
larrbfs; |
U+0291F | ⤟ |
larrfs; |
U+0291D | ⤝ |
larrhk; |
U+021A9 | ↩ |
larrlp; |
U+021AB | ↫ |
larrpl; |
U+02939 | ⤹ |
larrsim; |
U+02973 | ⥳ |
larrtl; |
U+021A2 | ↢ |
lat; |
U+02AAB | ⪫ |
lAtail; |
U+0291B | ⤛ |
latail; |
U+02919 | ⤙ |
late; |
U+02AAD | ⪭ |
lates; |
U+02AAD U+0FE00 | ⪭︀ |
lBarr; |
U+0290E | ⤎ |
lbarr; |
U+0290C | ⤌ |
lbbrk; |
U+02772 | ❲ |
lbrace; |
U+0007B | { |
lbrack; |
U+0005B | [ |
lbrke; |
U+0298B | ⦋ |
lbrksld; |
U+0298F | ⦏ |
lbrkslu; |
U+0298D | ⦍ |
Lcaron; |
U+0013D | Ľ |
lcaron; |
U+0013E | ľ |
Lcedil; |
U+0013B | Ļ |
lcedil; |
U+0013C | ļ |
lceil; |
U+02308 | ⌈ |
lcub; |
U+0007B | { |
Lcy; |
U+0041B | Л |
lcy; |
U+0043B | л |
ldca; |
U+02936 | ⤶ |
ldquo; |
U+0201C | “ |
ldquor; |
U+0201E | „ |
ldrdhar; |
U+02967 | ⥧ |
ldrushar; |
U+0294B | ⥋ |
ldsh; |
U+021B2 | ↲ |
lE; |
U+02266 | ≦ |
le; |
U+02264 | ≤ |
LeftAngleBracket; |
U+027E8 | 〈 |
LeftArrow; |
U+02190 | ← |
Leftarrow; |
U+021D0 | ⇐ |
leftarrow; |
U+02190 | ← |
LeftArrowBar; |
U+021E4 | ⇤ |
LeftArrowRightArrow; |
U+021C6 | ⇆ |
leftarrowtail; |
U+021A2 | ↢ |
LeftCeiling; |
U+02308 | ⌈ |
LeftDoubleBracket; |
U+027E6 | ⟦ |
LeftDownTeeVector; |
U+02961 | ⥡ |
LeftDownVector; |
U+021C3 | ⇃ |
LeftDownVectorBar; |
U+02959 | ⥙ |
LeftFloor; |
U+0230A | ⌊ |
leftharpoondown; |
U+021BD | ↽ |
leftharpoonup; |
U+021BC | ↼ |
leftleftarrows; |
U+021C7 | ⇇ |
LeftRightArrow; |
U+02194 | ↔ |
Leftrightarrow; |
U+021D4 | ⇔ |
leftrightarrow; |
U+02194 | ↔ |
leftrightarrows; |
U+021C6 | ⇆ |
leftrightharpoons; |
U+021CB | ⇋ |
leftrightsquigarrow; |
U+021AD | ↭ |
LeftRightVector; |
U+0294E | ⥎ |
LeftTee; |
U+022A3 | ⊣ |
LeftTeeArrow; |
U+021A4 | ↤ |
LeftTeeVector; |
U+0295A | ⥚ |
leftthreetimes; |
U+022CB | ⋋ |
LeftTriangle; |
U+022B2 | ⊲ |
LeftTriangleBar; |
U+029CF | ⧏ |
LeftTriangleEqual; |
U+022B4 | ⊴ |
LeftUpDownVector; |
U+02951 | ⥑ |
LeftUpTeeVector; |
U+02960 | ⥠ |
LeftUpVector; |
U+021BF | ↿ |
LeftUpVectorBar; |
U+02958 | ⥘ |
LeftVector; |
U+021BC | ↼ |
LeftVectorBar; |
U+02952 | ⥒ |
lEg; |
U+02A8B | ⪋ |
leg; |
U+022DA | ⋚ |
leq; |
U+02264 | ≤ |
leqq; |
U+02266 | ≦ |
leqslant; |
U+02A7D | ⩽ |
les; |
U+02A7D | ⩽ |
lescc; |
U+02AA8 | ⪨ |
lesdot; |
U+02A7F | ⩿ |
lesdoto; |
U+02A81 | ⪁ |
lesdotor; |
U+02A83 | ⪃ |
lesg; |
U+022DA U+0FE00 | ⋚︀ |
lesges; |
U+02A93 | ⪓ |
lessapprox; |
U+02A85 | ⪅ |
lessdot; |
U+022D6 | ⋖ |
lesseqgtr; |
U+022DA | ⋚ |
lesseqqgtr; |
U+02A8B | ⪋ |
LessEqualGreater; |
U+022DA | ⋚ |
LessFullEqual; |
U+02266 | ≦ |
LessGreater; |
U+02276 | ≶ |
lessgtr; |
U+02276 | ≶ |
LessLess; |
U+02AA1 | ⪡ |
lesssim; |
U+02272 | ≲ |
LessSlantEqual; |
U+02A7D | ⩽ |
LessTilde; |
U+02272 | ≲ |
lfisht; |
U+0297C | ⥼ |
lfloor; |
U+0230A | ⌊ |
Lfr; |
U+1D50F | 𝔏 |
lfr; |
U+1D529 | 𝔩 |
lg; |
U+02276 | ≶ |
lgE; |
U+02A91 | ⪑ |
lHar; |
U+02962 | ⥢ |
lhard; |
U+021BD | ↽ |
lharu; |
U+021BC | ↼ |
lharul; |
U+0296A | ⥪ |
lhblk; |
U+02584 | ▄ |
LJcy; |
U+00409 | Љ |
ljcy; |
U+00459 | љ |
Ll; |
U+022D8 | ⋘ |
ll; |
U+0226A | ≪ |
llarr; |
U+021C7 | ⇇ |
llcorner; |
U+0231E | ⌞ |
Lleftarrow; |
U+021DA | ⇚ |
llhard; |
U+0296B | ⥫ |
lltri; |
U+025FA | ◺ |
Lmidot; |
U+0013F | Ŀ |
lmidot; |
U+00140 | ŀ |
lmoust; |
U+023B0 | ⎰ |
lmoustache; |
U+023B0 | ⎰ |
lnap; |
U+02A89 | ⪉ |
lnapprox; |
U+02A89 | ⪉ |
lnE; |
U+02268 | ≨ |
lne; |
U+02A87 | ⪇ |
lneq; |
U+02A87 | ⪇ |
lneqq; |
U+02268 | ≨ |
lnsim; |
U+022E6 | ⋦ |
loang; |
U+027EC | ⟬ |
loarr; |
U+021FD | ⇽ |
lobrk; |
U+027E6 | ⟦ |
LongLeftArrow; |
U+027F5 | ⟵ |
Longleftarrow; |
U+027F8 | ⟸ |
longleftarrow; |
U+027F5 | ⟵ |
LongLeftRightArrow; |
U+027F7 | ⟷ |
Longleftrightarrow; |
U+027FA | ⟺ |
longleftrightarrow; |
U+027F7 | ⟷ |
longmapsto; |
U+027FC | ⟼ |
LongRightArrow; |
U+027F6 | ⟶ |
Longrightarrow; |
U+027F9 | ⟹ |
longrightarrow; |
U+027F6 | ⟶ |
looparrowleft; |
U+021AB | ↫ |
looparrowright; |
U+021AC | ↬ |
lopar; |
U+02985 | ⦅ |
Lopf; |
U+1D543 | 𝕃 |
lopf; |
U+1D55D | 𝕝 |
loplus; |
U+02A2D | ⨭ |
lotimes; |
U+02A34 | ⨴ |
lowast; |
U+02217 | ∗ |
lowbar; |
U+0005F | _ |
LowerLeftArrow; |
U+02199 | ↙ |
LowerRightArrow; |
U+02198 | ↘ |
loz; |
U+025CA | ◊ |
lozenge; |
U+025CA | ◊ |
lozf; |
U+029EB | ⧫ |
lpar; |
U+00028 | ( |
lparlt; |
U+02993 | ⦓ |
lrarr; |
U+021C6 | ⇆ |
lrcorner; |
U+0231F | ⌟ |
lrhar; |
U+021CB | ⇋ |
lrhard; |
U+0296D | ⥭ |
lrm; |
U+0200E | |
lrtri; |
U+022BF | ⊿ |
lsaquo; |
U+02039 | ‹ |
Lscr; |
U+02112 | ℒ |
lscr; |
U+1D4C1 | 𝓁 |
Lsh; |
U+021B0 | ↰ |
lsh; |
U+021B0 | ↰ |
lsim; |
U+02272 | ≲ |
lsime; |
U+02A8D | ⪍ |
lsimg; |
U+02A8F | ⪏ |
lsqb; |
U+0005B | [ |
lsquo; |
U+02018 | ‘ |
lsquor; |
U+0201A | ‚ |
Lstrok; |
U+00141 | Ł |
lstrok; |
U+00142 | ł |
LT; |
U+0003C | < |
LT |
U+0003C | < |
Lt; |
U+0226A | ≪ |
lt; |
U+0003C | < |
lt |
U+0003C | < |
ltcc; |
U+02AA6 | ⪦ |
ltcir; |
U+02A79 | ⩹ |
ltdot; |
U+022D6 | ⋖ |
lthree; |
U+022CB | ⋋ |
ltimes; |
U+022C9 | ⋉ |
ltlarr; |
U+02976 | ⥶ |
ltquest; |
U+02A7B | ⩻ |
ltri; |
U+025C3 | ◃ |
ltrie; |
U+022B4 | ⊴ |
ltrif; |
U+025C2 | ◂ |
ltrPar; |
U+02996 | ⦖ |
lurdshar; |
U+0294A | ⥊ |
luruhar; |
U+02966 | ⥦ |
lvertneqq; |
U+02268 U+0FE00 | ≨︀ |
lvnE; |
U+02268 U+0FE00 | ≨︀ |
macr; |
U+000AF | ¯ |
macr |
U+000AF | ¯ |
male; |
U+02642 | ♂ |
malt; |
U+02720 | ✠ |
maltese; |
U+02720 | ✠ |
Map; |
U+02905 | ⤅ |
map; |
U+021A6 | ↦ |
mapsto; |
U+021A6 | ↦ |
mapstodown; |
U+021A7 | ↧ |
mapstoleft; |
U+021A4 | ↤ |
mapstoup; |
U+021A5 | ↥ |
marker; |
U+025AE | ▮ |
mcomma; |
U+02A29 | ⨩ |
Mcy; |
U+0041C | М |
mcy; |
U+0043C | м |
mdash; |
U+02014 | — |
mDDot; |
U+0223A | ∺ |
measuredangle; |
U+02221 | ∡ |
MediumSpace; |
U+0205F | |
Mellintrf; |
U+02133 | ℳ |
Mfr; |
U+1D510 | 𝔐 |
mfr; |
U+1D52A | 𝔪 |
mho; |
U+02127 | ℧ |
micro; |
U+000B5 | µ |
micro |
U+000B5 | µ |
mid; |
U+02223 | ∣ |
midast; |
U+0002A | * |
midcir; |
U+02AF0 | ⫰ |
middot; |
U+000B7 | · |
middot |
U+000B7 | · |
minus; |
U+02212 | − |
minusb; |
U+0229F | ⊟ |
minusd; |
U+02238 | ∸ |
minusdu; |
U+02A2A | ⨪ |
MinusPlus; |
U+02213 | ∓ |
mlcp; |
U+02ADB | ⫛ |
mldr; |
U+02026 | … |
mnplus; |
U+02213 | ∓ |
models; |
U+022A7 | ⊧ |
Mopf; |
U+1D544 | 𝕄 |
mopf; |
U+1D55E | 𝕞 |
mp; |
U+02213 | ∓ |
Mscr; |
U+02133 | ℳ |
mscr; |
U+1D4C2 | 𝓂 |
mstpos; |
U+0223E | ∾ |
Mu; |
U+0039C | Μ |
mu; |
U+003BC | μ |
multimap; |
U+022B8 | ⊸ |
mumap; |
U+022B8 | ⊸ |
nabla; |
U+02207 | ∇ |
Nacute; |
U+00143 | Ń |
nacute; |
U+00144 | ń |
nang; |
U+02220 U+020D2 | ∠⃒ |
nap; |
U+02249 | ≉ |
napE; |
U+02A70 U+00338 | ⩰̸ |
napid; |
U+0224B U+00338 | ≋̸ |
napos; |
U+00149 | ʼn |
napprox; |
U+02249 | ≉ |
natur; |
U+0266E | ♮ |
natural; |
U+0266E | ♮ |
naturals; |
U+02115 | ℕ |
nbsp; |
U+000A0 | |
nbsp |
U+000A0 | |
nbump; |
U+0224E U+00338 | ≎̸ |
nbumpe; |
U+0224F U+00338 | ≏̸ |
ncap; |
U+02A43 | ⩃ |
Ncaron; |
U+00147 | Ň |
ncaron; |
U+00148 | ň |
Ncedil; |
U+00145 | Ņ |
ncedil; |
U+00146 | ņ |
ncong; |
U+02247 | ≇ |
ncongdot; |
U+02A6D U+00338 | ⩭̸ |
ncup; |
U+02A42 | ⩂ |
Ncy; |
U+0041D | Н |
ncy; |
U+0043D | н |
ndash; |
U+02013 | – |
ne; |
U+02260 | ≠ |
nearhk; |
U+02924 | ⤤ |
neArr; |
U+021D7 | ⇗ |
nearr; |
U+02197 | ↗ |
nearrow; |
U+02197 | ↗ |
nedot; |
U+02250 U+00338 | ≐̸ |
NegativeMediumSpace; |
U+0200B | |
NegativeThickSpace; |
U+0200B | |
NegativeThinSpace; |
U+0200B | |
NegativeVeryThinSpace; |
U+0200B | |
nequiv; |
U+02262 | ≢ |
nesear; |
U+02928 | ⤨ |
nesim; |
U+02242 U+00338 | ≂̸ |
NestedGreaterGreater; |
U+0226B | ≫ |
NestedLessLess; |
U+0226A | ≪ |
NewLine; |
U+0000A | ␊ |
nexist; |
U+02204 | ∄ |
nexists; |
U+02204 | ∄ |
Nfr; |
U+1D511 | 𝔑 |
nfr; |
U+1D52B | 𝔫 |
ngE; |
U+02267 U+00338 | ≧̸ |
nge; |
U+02271 | ≱ |
ngeq; |
U+02271 | ≱ |
ngeqq; |
U+02267 U+00338 | ≧̸ |
ngeqslant; |
U+02A7E U+00338 | ⩾̸ |
nges; |
U+02A7E U+00338 | ⩾̸ |
nGg; |
U+022D9 U+00338 | ⋙̸ |
ngsim; |
U+02275 | ≵ |
nGt; |
U+0226B U+020D2 | ≫⃒ |
ngt; |
U+0226F | ≯ |
ngtr; |
U+0226F | ≯ |
nGtv; |
U+0226B U+00338 | ≫̸ |
nhArr; |
U+021CE | ⇎ |
nharr; |
U+021AE | ↮ |
nhpar; |
U+02AF2 | ⫲ |
ni; |
U+0220B | ∋ |
nis; |
U+022FC | ⋼ |
nisd; |
U+022FA | ⋺ |
niv; |
U+0220B | ∋ |
NJcy; |
U+0040A | Њ |
njcy; |
U+0045A | њ |
nlArr; |
U+021CD | ⇍ |
nlarr; |
U+0219A | ↚ |
nldr; |
U+02025 | ‥ |
nlE; |
U+02266 U+00338 | ≦̸ |
nle; |
U+02270 | ≰ |
nLeftarrow; |
U+021CD | ⇍ |
nleftarrow; |
U+0219A | ↚ |
nLeftrightarrow; |
U+021CE | ⇎ |
nleftrightarrow; |
U+021AE | ↮ |
nleq; |
U+02270 | ≰ |
nleqq; |
U+02266 U+00338 | ≦̸ |
nleqslant; |
U+02A7D U+00338 | ⩽̸ |
nles; |
U+02A7D U+00338 | ⩽̸ |
nless; |
U+0226E | ≮ |
nLl; |
U+022D8 U+00338 | ⋘̸ |
nlsim; |
U+02274 | ≴ |
nLt; |
U+0226A U+020D2 | ≪⃒ |
nlt; |
U+0226E | ≮ |
nltri; |
U+022EA | ⋪ |
nltrie; |
U+022EC | ⋬ |
nLtv; |
U+0226A U+00338 | ≪̸ |
nmid; |
U+02224 | ∤ |
NoBreak; |
U+02060 | |
NonBreakingSpace; |
U+000A0 | |
Nopf; |
U+02115 | ℕ |
nopf; |
U+1D55F | 𝕟 |
Not; |
U+02AEC | ⫬ |
not; |
U+000AC | ¬ |
not |
U+000AC | ¬ |
NotCongruent; |
U+02262 | ≢ |
NotCupCap; |
U+0226D | ≭ |
NotDoubleVerticalBar; |
U+02226 | ∦ |
NotElement; |
U+02209 | ∉ |
NotEqual; |
U+02260 | ≠ |
NotEqualTilde; |
U+02242 U+00338 | ≂̸ |
NotExists; |
U+02204 | ∄ |
NotGreater; |
U+0226F | ≯ |
NotGreaterEqual; |
U+02271 | ≱ |
NotGreaterFullEqual; |
U+02267 U+00338 | ≧̸ |
NotGreaterGreater; |
U+0226B U+00338 | ≫̸ |
NotGreaterLess; |
U+02279 | ≹ |
NotGreaterSlantEqual; |
U+02A7E U+00338 | ⩾̸ |
NotGreaterTilde; |
U+02275 | ≵ |
NotHumpDownHump; |
U+0224E U+00338 | ≎̸ |
NotHumpEqual; |
U+0224F U+00338 | ≏̸ |
notin; |
U+02209 | ∉ |
notindot; |
U+022F5 U+00338 | ⋵̸ |
notinE; |
U+022F9 U+00338 | ⋹̸ |
notinva; |
U+02209 | ∉ |
notinvb; |
U+022F7 | ⋷ |
notinvc; |
U+022F6 | ⋶ |
NotLeftTriangle; |
U+022EA | ⋪ |
NotLeftTriangleBar; |
U+029CF U+00338 | ⧏̸ |
NotLeftTriangleEqual; |
U+022EC | ⋬ |
NotLess; |
U+0226E | ≮ |
NotLessEqual; |
U+02270 | ≰ |
NotLessGreater; |
U+02278 | ≸ |
NotLessLess; |
U+0226A U+00338 | ≪̸ |
NotLessSlantEqual; |
U+02A7D U+00338 | ⩽̸ |
NotLessTilde; |
U+02274 | ≴ |
NotNestedGreaterGreater; |
U+02AA2 U+00338 | ⪢̸ |
NotNestedLessLess; |
U+02AA1 U+00338 | ⪡̸ |
notni; |
U+0220C | ∌ |
notniva; |
U+0220C | ∌ |
notnivb; |
U+022FE | ⋾ |
notnivc; |
U+022FD | ⋽ |
NotPrecedes; |
U+02280 | ⊀ |
NotPrecedesEqual; |
U+02AAF U+00338 | ⪯̸ |
NotPrecedesSlantEqual; |
U+022E0 | ⋠ |
NotReverseElement; |
U+0220C | ∌ |
NotRightTriangle; |
U+022EB | ⋫ |
NotRightTriangleBar; |
U+029D0 U+00338 | ⧐̸ |
NotRightTriangleEqual; |
U+022ED | ⋭ |
NotSquareSubset; |
U+0228F U+00338 | ⊏̸ |
NotSquareSubsetEqual; |
U+022E2 | ⋢ |
NotSquareSuperset; |
U+02290 U+00338 | ⊐̸ |
NotSquareSupersetEqual; |
U+022E3 | ⋣ |
NotSubset; |
U+02282 U+020D2 | ⊂⃒ |
NotSubsetEqual; |
U+02288 | ⊈ |
NotSucceeds; |
U+02281 | ⊁ |
NotSucceedsEqual; |
U+02AB0 U+00338 | ⪰̸ |
NotSucceedsSlantEqual; |
U+022E1 | ⋡ |
NotSucceedsTilde; |
U+0227F U+00338 | ≿̸ |
NotSuperset; |
U+02283 U+020D2 | ⊃⃒ |
NotSupersetEqual; |
U+02289 | ⊉ |
NotTilde; |
U+02241 | ≁ |
NotTildeEqual; |
U+02244 | ≄ |
NotTildeFullEqual; |
U+02247 | ≇ |
NotTildeTilde; |
U+02249 | ≉ |
NotVerticalBar; |
U+02224 | ∤ |
npar; |
U+02226 | ∦ |
nparallel; |
U+02226 | ∦ |
nparsl; |
U+02AFD U+020E5 | ⫽⃥ |
npart; |
U+02202 U+00338 | ∂̸ |
npolint; |
U+02A14 | ⨔ |
npr; |
U+02280 | ⊀ |
nprcue; |
U+022E0 | ⋠ |
npre; |
U+02AAF U+00338 | ⪯̸ |
nprec; |
U+02280 | ⊀ |
npreceq; |
U+02AAF U+00338 | ⪯̸ |
nrArr; |
U+021CF | ⇏ |
nrarr; |
U+0219B | ↛ |
nrarrc; |
U+02933 U+00338 | ⤳̸ |
nrarrw; |
U+0219D U+00338 | ↝̸ |
nRightarrow; |
U+021CF | ⇏ |
nrightarrow; |
U+0219B | ↛ |
nrtri; |
U+022EB | ⋫ |
nrtrie; |
U+022ED | ⋭ |
nsc; |
U+02281 | ⊁ |
nsccue; |
U+022E1 | ⋡ |
nsce; |
U+02AB0 U+00338 | ⪰̸ |
Nscr; |
U+1D4A9 | 𝒩 |
nscr; |
U+1D4C3 | 𝓃 |
nshortmid; |
U+02224 | ∤ |
nshortparallel; |
U+02226 | ∦ |
nsim; |
U+02241 | ≁ |
nsime; |
U+02244 | ≄ |
nsimeq; |
U+02244 | ≄ |
nsmid; |
U+02224 | ∤ |
nspar; |
U+02226 | ∦ |
nsqsube; |
U+022E2 | ⋢ |
nsqsupe; |
U+022E3 | ⋣ |
nsub; |
U+02284 | ⊄ |
nsubE; |
U+02AC5 U+00338 | ⫅̸ |
nsube; |
U+02288 | ⊈ |
nsubset; |
U+02282 U+020D2 | ⊂⃒ |
nsubseteq; |
U+02288 | ⊈ |
nsubseteqq; |
U+02AC5 U+00338 | ⫅̸ |
nsucc; |
U+02281 | ⊁ |
nsucceq; |
U+02AB0 U+00338 | ⪰̸ |
nsup; |
U+02285 | ⊅ |
nsupE; |
U+02AC6 U+00338 | ⫆̸ |
nsupe; |
U+02289 | ⊉ |
nsupset; |
U+02283 U+020D2 | ⊃⃒ |
nsupseteq; |
U+02289 | ⊉ |
nsupseteqq; |
U+02AC6 U+00338 | ⫆̸ |
ntgl; |
U+02279 | ≹ |
Ntilde; |
U+000D1 | Ñ |
Ntilde |
U+000D1 | Ñ |
ntilde; |
U+000F1 | ñ |
ntilde |
U+000F1 | ñ |
ntlg; |
U+02278 | ≸ |
ntriangleleft; |
U+022EA | ⋪ |
ntrianglelefteq; |
U+022EC | ⋬ |
ntriangleright; |
U+022EB | ⋫ |
ntrianglerighteq; |
U+022ED | ⋭ |
Nu; |
U+0039D | Ν |
nu; |
U+003BD | ν |
num; |
U+00023 | # |
numero; |
U+02116 | № |
numsp; |
U+02007 | |
nvap; |
U+0224D U+020D2 | ≍⃒ |
nVDash; |
U+022AF | ⊯ |
nVdash; |
U+022AE | ⊮ |
nvDash; |
U+022AD | ⊭ |
nvdash; |
U+022AC | ⊬ |
nvge; |
U+02265 U+020D2 | ≥⃒ |
nvgt; |
U+0003E U+020D2 | >⃒ |
nvHarr; |
U+02904 | ⤄ |
nvinfin; |
U+029DE | ⧞ |
nvlArr; |
U+02902 | ⤂ |
nvle; |
U+02264 U+020D2 | ≤⃒ |
nvlt; |
U+0003C U+020D2 | <⃒ |
nvltrie; |
U+022B4 U+020D2 | ⊴⃒ |
nvrArr; |
U+02903 | ⤃ |
nvrtrie; |
U+022B5 U+020D2 | ⊵⃒ |
nvsim; |
U+0223C U+020D2 | ∼⃒ |
nwarhk; |
U+02923 | ⤣ |
nwArr; |
U+021D6 | ⇖ |
nwarr; |
U+02196 | ↖ |
nwarrow; |
U+02196 | ↖ |
nwnear; |
U+02927 | ⤧ |
Oacute; |
U+000D3 | Ó |
Oacute |
U+000D3 | Ó |
oacute; |
U+000F3 | ó |
oacute |
U+000F3 | ó |
oast; |
U+0229B | ⊛ |
ocir; |
U+0229A | ⊚ |
Ocirc; |
U+000D4 | Ô |
Ocirc |
U+000D4 | Ô |
ocirc; |
U+000F4 | ô |
ocirc |
U+000F4 | ô |
Ocy; |
U+0041E | О |
ocy; |
U+0043E | о |
odash; |
U+0229D | ⊝ |
Odblac; |
U+00150 | Ő |
odblac; |
U+00151 | ő |
odiv; |
U+02A38 | ⨸ |
odot; |
U+02299 | ⊙ |
odsold; |
U+029BC | ⦼ |
OElig; |
U+00152 | Œ |
oelig; |
U+00153 | œ |
ofcir; |
U+029BF | ⦿ |
Ofr; |
U+1D512 | 𝔒 |
ofr; |
U+1D52C | 𝔬 |
ogon; |
U+002DB | ˛ |
Ograve; |
U+000D2 | Ò |
Ograve |
U+000D2 | Ò |
ograve; |
U+000F2 | ò |
ograve |
U+000F2 | ò |
ogt; |
U+029C1 | ⧁ |
ohbar; |
U+029B5 | ⦵ |
ohm; |
U+003A9 | Ω |
oint; |
U+0222E | ∮ |
olarr; |
U+021BA | ↺ |
olcir; |
U+029BE | ⦾ |
olcross; |
U+029BB | ⦻ |
oline; |
U+0203E | ‾ |
olt; |
U+029C0 | ⧀ |
Omacr; |
U+0014C | Ō |
omacr; |
U+0014D | ō |
Omega; |
U+003A9 | Ω |
omega; |
U+003C9 | ω |
Omicron; |
U+0039F | Ο |
omicron; |
U+003BF | ο |
omid; |
U+029B6 | ⦶ |
ominus; |
U+02296 | ⊖ |
Oopf; |
U+1D546 | 𝕆 |
oopf; |
U+1D560 | 𝕠 |
opar; |
U+029B7 | ⦷ |
OpenCurlyDoubleQuote; |
U+0201C | “ |
OpenCurlyQuote; |
U+02018 | ‘ |
operp; |
U+029B9 | ⦹ |
oplus; |
U+02295 | ⊕ |
Or; |
U+02A54 | ⩔ |
or; |
U+02228 | ∨ |
orarr; |
U+021BB | ↻ |
ord; |
U+02A5D | ⩝ |
order; |
U+02134 | ℴ |
orderof; |
U+02134 | ℴ |
ordf; |
U+000AA | ª |
ordf |
U+000AA | ª |
ordm; |
U+000BA | º |
ordm |
U+000BA | º |
origof; |
U+022B6 | ⊶ |
oror; |
U+02A56 | ⩖ |
orslope; |
U+02A57 | ⩗ |
orv; |
U+02A5B | ⩛ |
oS; |
U+024C8 | Ⓢ |
Oscr; |
U+1D4AA | 𝒪 |
oscr; |
U+02134 | ℴ |
Oslash; |
U+000D8 | Ø |
Oslash |
U+000D8 | Ø |
oslash; |
U+000F8 | ø |
oslash |
U+000F8 | ø |
osol; |
U+02298 | ⊘ |
Otilde; |
U+000D5 | Õ |
Otilde |
U+000D5 | Õ |
otilde; |
U+000F5 | õ |
otilde |
U+000F5 | õ |
Otimes; |
U+02A37 | ⨷ |
otimes; |
U+02297 | ⊗ |
otimesas; |
U+02A36 | ⨶ |
Ouml; |
U+000D6 | Ö |
Ouml |
U+000D6 | Ö |
ouml; |
U+000F6 | ö |
ouml |
U+000F6 | ö |
ovbar; |
U+0233D | ⌽ |
OverBar; |
U+0203E | ‾ |
OverBrace; |
U+023DE | ⏞ |
OverBracket; |
U+023B4 | ⎴ |
OverParenthesis; |
U+023DC | ⏜ |
par; |
U+02225 | ∥ |
para; |
U+000B6 | ¶ |
para |
U+000B6 | ¶ |
parallel; |
U+02225 | ∥ |
parsim; |
U+02AF3 | ⫳ |
parsl; |
U+02AFD | ⫽ |
part; |
U+02202 | ∂ |
PartialD; |
U+02202 | ∂ |
Pcy; |
U+0041F | П |
pcy; |
U+0043F | п |
percnt; |
U+00025 | % |
period; |
U+0002E | . |
permil; |
U+02030 | ‰ |
perp; |
U+022A5 | ⊥ |
pertenk; |
U+02031 | ‱ |
Pfr; |
U+1D513 | 𝔓 |
pfr; |
U+1D52D | 𝔭 |
Phi; |
U+003A6 | Φ |
phi; |
U+003C6 | φ |
phiv; |
U+003D5 | ϕ |
phmmat; |
U+02133 | ℳ |
phone; |
U+0260E | ☎ |
Pi; |
U+003A0 | Π |
pi; |
U+003C0 | π |
pitchfork; |
U+022D4 | ⋔ |
piv; |
U+003D6 | ϖ |
planck; |
U+0210F | ℏ |
planckh; |
U+0210E | ℎ |
plankv; |
U+0210F | ℏ |
plus; |
U+0002B | + |
plusacir; |
U+02A23 | ⨣ |
plusb; |
U+0229E | ⊞ |
pluscir; |
U+02A22 | ⨢ |
plusdo; |
U+02214 | ∔ |
plusdu; |
U+02A25 | ⨥ |
pluse; |
U+02A72 | ⩲ |
PlusMinus; |
U+000B1 | ± |
plusmn; |
U+000B1 | ± |
plusmn |
U+000B1 | ± |
plussim; |
U+02A26 | ⨦ |
plustwo; |
U+02A27 | ⨧ |
pm; |
U+000B1 | ± |
Poincareplane; |
U+0210C | ℌ |
pointint; |
U+02A15 | ⨕ |
Popf; |
U+02119 | ℙ |
popf; |
U+1D561 | 𝕡 |
pound; |
U+000A3 | £ |
pound |
U+000A3 | £ |
Pr; |
U+02ABB | ⪻ |
pr; |
U+0227A | ≺ |
prap; |
U+02AB7 | ⪷ |
prcue; |
U+0227C | ≼ |
prE; |
U+02AB3 | ⪳ |
pre; |
U+02AAF | ⪯ |
prec; |
U+0227A | ≺ |
precapprox; |
U+02AB7 | ⪷ |
preccurlyeq; |
U+0227C | ≼ |
Precedes; |
U+0227A | ≺ |
PrecedesEqual; |
U+02AAF | ⪯ |
PrecedesSlantEqual; |
U+0227C | ≼ |
PrecedesTilde; |
U+0227E | ≾ |
preceq; |
U+02AAF | ⪯ |
precnapprox; |
U+02AB9 | ⪹ |
precneqq; |
U+02AB5 | ⪵ |
precnsim; |
U+022E8 | ⋨ |
precsim; |
U+0227E | ≾ |
Prime; |
U+02033 | ″ |
prime; |
U+02032 | ′ |
primes; |
U+02119 | ℙ |
prnap; |
U+02AB9 | ⪹ |
prnE; |
U+02AB5 | ⪵ |
prnsim; |
U+022E8 | ⋨ |
prod; |
U+0220F | ∏ |
Product; |
U+0220F | ∏ |
profalar; |
U+0232E | ⌮ |
profline; |
U+02312 | ⌒ |
profsurf; |
U+02313 | ⌓ |
prop; |
U+0221D | ∝ |
Proportion; |
U+02237 | ∷ |
Proportional; |
U+0221D | ∝ |
propto; |
U+0221D | ∝ |
prsim; |
U+0227E | ≾ |
prurel; |
U+022B0 | ⊰ |
Pscr; |
U+1D4AB | 𝒫 |
pscr; |
U+1D4C5 | 𝓅 |
Psi; |
U+003A8 | Ψ |
psi; |
U+003C8 | ψ |
puncsp; |
U+02008 | |
Qfr; |
U+1D514 | 𝔔 |
qfr; |
U+1D52E | 𝔮 |
qint; |
U+02A0C | ⨌ |
Qopf; |
U+0211A | ℚ |
qopf; |
U+1D562 | 𝕢 |
qprime; |
U+02057 | ⁗ |
Qscr; |
U+1D4AC | 𝒬 |
qscr; |
U+1D4C6 | 𝓆 |
quaternions; |
U+0210D | ℍ |
quatint; |
U+02A16 | ⨖ |
quest; |
U+0003F | ? |
questeq; |
U+0225F | ≟ |
QUOT; |
U+00022 | " |
QUOT |
U+00022 | " |
quot; |
U+00022 | " |
quot |
U+00022 | " |
rAarr; |
U+021DB | ⇛ |
race; |
U+0223D U+00331 | ∽̱ |
Racute; |
U+00154 | Ŕ |
racute; |
U+00155 | ŕ |
radic; |
U+0221A | √ |
raemptyv; |
U+029B3 | ⦳ |
Rang; |
U+027EB | ⟫ |
rang; |
U+027E9 | ⟩ |
rangd; |
U+02992 | ⦒ |
range; |
U+029A5 | ⦥ |
rangle; |
U+027E9 | 〉 |
raquo; |
U+000BB | » |
raquo |
U+000BB | » |
Rarr; |
U+021A0 | ↠ |
rArr; |
U+021D2 | ⇒ |
rarr; |
U+02192 | → |
rarrap; |
U+02975 | ⥵ |
rarrb; |
U+021E5 | ⇥ |
rarrbfs; |
U+02920 | ⤠ |
rarrc; |
U+02933 | ⤳ |
rarrfs; |
U+0291E | ⤞ |
rarrhk; |
U+021AA | ↪ |
rarrlp; |
U+021AC | ↬ |
rarrpl; |
U+02945 | ⥅ |
rarrsim; |
U+02974 | ⥴ |
Rarrtl; |
U+02916 | ⤖ |
rarrtl; |
U+021A3 | ↣ |
rarrw; |
U+0219D | ↝ |
rAtail; |
U+0291C | ⤜ |
ratail; |
U+0291A | ⤚ |
ratio; |
U+02236 | ∶ |
rationals; |
U+0211A | ℚ |
RBarr; |
U+02910 | ⤐ |
rBarr; |
U+0290F | ⤏ |
rbarr; |
U+0290D | ⤍ |
rbbrk; |
U+02773 | ❳ |
rbrace; |
U+0007D | } |
rbrack; |
U+0005D | ] |
rbrke; |
U+0298C | ⦌ |
rbrksld; |
U+0298E | ⦎ |
rbrkslu; |
U+02990 | ⦐ |
Rcaron; |
U+00158 | Ř |
rcaron; |
U+00159 | ř |
Rcedil; |
U+00156 | Ŗ |
rcedil; |
U+00157 | ŗ |
rceil; |
U+02309 | ⌉ |
rcub; |
U+0007D | } |
Rcy; |
U+00420 | Р |
rcy; |
U+00440 | р |
rdca; |
U+02937 | ⤷ |
rdldhar; |
U+02969 | ⥩ |
rdquo; |
U+0201D | ” |
rdquor; |
U+0201D | ” |
rdsh; |
U+021B3 | ↳ |
Re; |
U+0211C | ℜ |
real; |
U+0211C | ℜ |
realine; |
U+0211B | ℛ |
realpart; |
U+0211C | ℜ |
reals; |
U+0211D | ℝ |
rect; |
U+025AD | ▭ |
REG; |
U+000AE | ® |
REG |
U+000AE | ® |
reg; |
U+000AE | ® |
reg |
U+000AE | ® |
ReverseElement; |
U+0220B | ∋ |
ReverseEquilibrium; |
U+021CB | ⇋ |
ReverseUpEquilibrium; |
U+0296F | ⥯ |
rfisht; |
U+0297D | ⥽ |
rfloor; |
U+0230B | ⌋ |
Rfr; |
U+0211C | ℜ |
rfr; |
U+1D52F | 𝔯 |
rHar; |
U+02964 | ⥤ |
rhard; |
U+021C1 | ⇁ |
rharu; |
U+021C0 | ⇀ |
rharul; |
U+0296C | ⥬ |
Rho; |
U+003A1 | Ρ |
rho; |
U+003C1 | ρ |
rhov; |
U+003F1 | ϱ |
RightAngleBracket; |
U+027E9 | 〉 |
RightArrow; |
U+02192 | → |
Rightarrow; |
U+021D2 | ⇒ |
rightarrow; |
U+02192 | → |
RightArrowBar; |
U+021E5 | ⇥ |
RightArrowLeftArrow; |
U+021C4 | ⇄ |
rightarrowtail; |
U+021A3 | ↣ |
RightCeiling; |
U+02309 | ⌉ |
RightDoubleBracket; |
U+027E7 | ⟧ |
RightDownTeeVector; |
U+0295D | ⥝ |
RightDownVector; |
U+021C2 | ⇂ |
RightDownVectorBar; |
U+02955 | ⥕ |
RightFloor; |
U+0230B | ⌋ |
rightharpoondown; |
U+021C1 | ⇁ |
rightharpoonup; |
U+021C0 | ⇀ |
rightleftarrows; |
U+021C4 | ⇄ |
rightleftharpoons; |
U+021CC | ⇌ |
rightrightarrows; |
U+021C9 | ⇉ |
rightsquigarrow; |
U+0219D | ↝ |
RightTee; |
U+022A2 | ⊢ |
RightTeeArrow; |
U+021A6 | ↦ |
RightTeeVector; |
U+0295B | ⥛ |
rightthreetimes; |
U+022CC | ⋌ |
RightTriangle; |
U+022B3 | ⊳ |
RightTriangleBar; |
U+029D0 | ⧐ |
RightTriangleEqual; |
U+022B5 | ⊵ |
RightUpDownVector; |
U+0294F | ⥏ |
RightUpTeeVector; |
U+0295C | ⥜ |
RightUpVector; |
U+021BE | ↾ |
RightUpVectorBar; |
U+02954 | ⥔ |
RightVector; |
U+021C0 | ⇀ |
RightVectorBar; |
U+02953 | ⥓ |
ring; |
U+002DA | ˚ |
risingdotseq; |
U+02253 | ≓ |
rlarr; |
U+021C4 | ⇄ |
rlhar; |
U+021CC | ⇌ |
rlm; |
U+0200F | |
rmoust; |
U+023B1 | ⎱ |
rmoustache; |
U+023B1 | ⎱ |
rnmid; |
U+02AEE | ⫮ |
roang; |
U+027ED | ⟭ |
roarr; |
U+021FE | ⇾ |
robrk; |
U+027E7 | ⟧ |
ropar; |
U+02986 | ⦆ |
Ropf; |
U+0211D | ℝ |
ropf; |
U+1D563 | 𝕣 |
roplus; |
U+02A2E | ⨮ |
rotimes; |
U+02A35 | ⨵ |
RoundImplies; |
U+02970 | ⥰ |
rpar; |
U+00029 | ) |
rpargt; |
U+02994 | ⦔ |
rppolint; |
U+02A12 | ⨒ |
rrarr; |
U+021C9 | ⇉ |
Rrightarrow; |
U+021DB | ⇛ |
rsaquo; |
U+0203A | › |
Rscr; |
U+0211B | ℛ |
rscr; |
U+1D4C7 | 𝓇 |
Rsh; |
U+021B1 | ↱ |
rsh; |
U+021B1 | ↱ |
rsqb; |
U+0005D | ] |
rsquo; |
U+02019 | ’ |
rsquor; |
U+02019 | ’ |
rthree; |
U+022CC | ⋌ |
rtimes; |
U+022CA | ⋊ |
rtri; |
U+025B9 | ▹ |
rtrie; |
U+022B5 | ⊵ |
rtrif; |
U+025B8 | ▸ |
rtriltri; |
U+029CE | ⧎ |
RuleDelayed; |
U+029F4 | ⧴ |
ruluhar; |
U+02968 | ⥨ |
rx; |
U+0211E | ℞ |
Sacute; |
U+0015A | Ś |
sacute; |
U+0015B | ś |
sbquo; |
U+0201A | ‚ |
Sc; |
U+02ABC | ⪼ |
sc; |
U+0227B | ≻ |
scap; |
U+02AB8 | ⪸ |
Scaron; |
U+00160 | Š |
scaron; |
U+00161 | š |
sccue; |
U+0227D | ≽ |
scE; |
U+02AB4 | ⪴ |
sce; |
U+02AB0 | ⪰ |
Scedil; |
U+0015E | Ş |
scedil; |
U+0015F | ş |
Scirc; |
U+0015C | Ŝ |
scirc; |
U+0015D | ŝ |
scnap; |
U+02ABA | ⪺ |
scnE; |
U+02AB6 | ⪶ |
scnsim; |
U+022E9 | ⋩ |
scpolint; |
U+02A13 | ⨓ |
scsim; |
U+0227F | ≿ |
Scy; |
U+00421 | С |
scy; |
U+00441 | с |
sdot; |
U+022C5 | ⋅ |
sdotb; |
U+022A1 | ⊡ |
sdote; |
U+02A66 | ⩦ |
searhk; |
U+02925 | ⤥ |
seArr; |
U+021D8 | ⇘ |
searr; |
U+02198 | ↘ |
searrow; |
U+02198 | ↘ |
sect; |
U+000A7 | § |
sect |
U+000A7 | § |
semi; |
U+0003B | ; |
seswar; |
U+02929 | ⤩ |
setminus; |
U+02216 | ∖ |
setmn; |
U+02216 | ∖ |
sext; |
U+02736 | ✶ |
Sfr; |
U+1D516 | 𝔖 |
sfr; |
U+1D530 | 𝔰 |
sfrown; |
U+02322 | ⌢ |
sharp; |
U+0266F | ♯ |
SHCHcy; |
U+00429 | Щ |
shchcy; |
U+00449 | щ |
SHcy; |
U+00428 | Ш |
shcy; |
U+00448 | ш |
ShortDownArrow; |
U+02193 | ↓ |
ShortLeftArrow; |
U+02190 | ← |
shortmid; |
U+02223 | ∣ |
shortparallel; |
U+02225 | ∥ |
ShortRightArrow; |
U+02192 | → |
ShortUpArrow; |
U+02191 | ↑ |
shy; |
U+000AD | |
shy |
U+000AD | |
Sigma; |
U+003A3 | Σ |
sigma; |
U+003C3 | σ |
sigmaf; |
U+003C2 | ς |
sigmav; |
U+003C2 | ς |
sim; |
U+0223C | ∼ |
simdot; |
U+02A6A | ⩪ |
sime; |
U+02243 | ≃ |
simeq; |
U+02243 | ≃ |
simg; |
U+02A9E | ⪞ |
simgE; |
U+02AA0 | ⪠ |
siml; |
U+02A9D | ⪝ |
simlE; |
U+02A9F | ⪟ |
simne; |
U+02246 | ≆ |
simplus; |
U+02A24 | ⨤ |
simrarr; |
U+02972 | ⥲ |
slarr; |
U+02190 | ← |
SmallCircle; |
U+02218 | ∘ |
smallsetminus; |
U+02216 | ∖ |
smashp; |
U+02A33 | ⨳ |
smeparsl; |
U+029E4 | ⧤ |
smid; |
U+02223 | ∣ |
smile; |
U+02323 | ⌣ |
smt; |
U+02AAA | ⪪ |
smte; |
U+02AAC | ⪬ |
smtes; |
U+02AAC U+0FE00 | ⪬︀ |
SOFTcy; |
U+0042C | Ь |
softcy; |
U+0044C | ь |
sol; |
U+0002F | / |
solb; |
U+029C4 | ⧄ |
solbar; |
U+0233F | ⌿ |
Sopf; |
U+1D54A | 𝕊 |
sopf; |
U+1D564 | 𝕤 |
spades; |
U+02660 | ♠ |
spadesuit; |
U+02660 | ♠ |
spar; |
U+02225 | ∥ |
sqcap; |
U+02293 | ⊓ |
sqcaps; |
U+02293 U+0FE00 | ⊓︀ |
sqcup; |
U+02294 | ⊔ |
sqcups; |
U+02294 U+0FE00 | ⊔︀ |
Sqrt; |
U+0221A | √ |
sqsub; |
U+0228F | ⊏ |
sqsube; |
U+02291 | ⊑ |
sqsubset; |
U+0228F | ⊏ |
sqsubseteq; |
U+02291 | ⊑ |
sqsup; |
U+02290 | ⊐ |
sqsupe; |
U+02292 | ⊒ |
sqsupset; |
U+02290 | ⊐ |
sqsupseteq; |
U+02292 | ⊒ |
squ; |
U+025A1 | □ |
Square; |
U+025A1 | □ |
square; |
U+025A1 | □ |
SquareIntersection; |
U+02293 | ⊓ |
SquareSubset; |
U+0228F | ⊏ |
SquareSubsetEqual; |
U+02291 | ⊑ |
SquareSuperset; |
U+02290 | ⊐ |
SquareSupersetEqual; |
U+02292 | ⊒ |
SquareUnion; |
U+02294 | ⊔ |
squarf; |
U+025AA | ▪ |
squf; |
U+025AA | ▪ |
srarr; |
U+02192 | → |
Sscr; |
U+1D4AE | 𝒮 |
sscr; |
U+1D4C8 | 𝓈 |
ssetmn; |
U+02216 | ∖ |
ssmile; |
U+02323 | ⌣ |
sstarf; |
U+022C6 | ⋆ |
Star; |
U+022C6 | ⋆ |
star; |
U+02606 | ☆ |
starf; |
U+02605 | ★ |
straightepsilon; |
U+003F5 | ϵ |
straightphi; |
U+003D5 | ϕ |
strns; |
U+000AF | ¯ |
Sub; |
U+022D0 | ⋐ |
sub; |
U+02282 | ⊂ |
subdot; |
U+02ABD | ⪽ |
subE; |
U+02AC5 | ⫅ |
sube; |
U+02286 | ⊆ |
subedot; |
U+02AC3 | ⫃ |
submult; |
U+02AC1 | ⫁ |
subnE; |
U+02ACB | ⫋ |
subne; |
U+0228A | ⊊ |
subplus; |
U+02ABF | ⪿ |
subrarr; |
U+02979 | ⥹ |
Subset; |
U+022D0 | ⋐ |
subset; |
U+02282 | ⊂ |
subseteq; |
U+02286 | ⊆ |
subseteqq; |
U+02AC5 | ⫅ |
SubsetEqual; |
U+02286 | ⊆ |
subsetneq; |
U+0228A | ⊊ |
subsetneqq; |
U+02ACB | ⫋ |
subsim; |
U+02AC7 | ⫇ |
subsub; |
U+02AD5 | ⫕ |
subsup; |
U+02AD3 | ⫓ |
succ; |
U+0227B | ≻ |
succapprox; |
U+02AB8 | ⪸ |
succcurlyeq; |
U+0227D | ≽ |
Succeeds; |
U+0227B | ≻ |
SucceedsEqual; |
U+02AB0 | ⪰ |
SucceedsSlantEqual; |
U+0227D | ≽ |
SucceedsTilde; |
U+0227F | ≿ |
succeq; |
U+02AB0 | ⪰ |
succnapprox; |
U+02ABA | ⪺ |
succneqq; |
U+02AB6 | ⪶ |
succnsim; |
U+022E9 | ⋩ |
succsim; |
U+0227F | ≿ |
SuchThat; |
U+0220B | ∋ |
Sum; |
U+02211 | ∑ |
sum; |
U+02211 | ∑ |
sung; |
U+0266A | ♪ |
Sup; |
U+022D1 | ⋑ |
sup; |
U+02283 | ⊃ |
sup1; |
U+000B9 | ¹ |
sup1 |
U+000B9 | ¹ |
sup2; |
U+000B2 | ² |
sup2 |
U+000B2 | ² |
sup3; |
U+000B3 | ³ |
sup3 |
U+000B3 | ³ |
supdot; |
U+02ABE | ⪾ |
supdsub; |
U+02AD8 | ⫘ |
supE; |
U+02AC6 | ⫆ |
supe; |
U+02287 | ⊇ |
supedot; |
U+02AC4 | ⫄ |
Superset; |
U+02283 | ⊃ |
SupersetEqual; |
U+02287 | ⊇ |
suphsol; |
U+027C9 | ⟉ |
suphsub; |
U+02AD7 | ⫗ |
suplarr; |
U+0297B | ⥻ |
supmult; |
U+02AC2 | ⫂ |
supnE; |
U+02ACC | ⫌ |
supne; |
U+0228B | ⊋ |
supplus; |
U+02AC0 | ⫀ |
Supset; |
U+022D1 | ⋑ |
supset; |
U+02283 | ⊃ |
supseteq; |
U+02287 | ⊇ |
supseteqq; |
U+02AC6 | ⫆ |
supsetneq; |
U+0228B | ⊋ |
supsetneqq; |
U+02ACC | ⫌ |
supsim; |
U+02AC8 | ⫈ |
supsub; |
U+02AD4 | ⫔ |
supsup; |
U+02AD6 | ⫖ |
swarhk; |
U+02926 | ⤦ |
swArr; |
U+021D9 | ⇙ |
swarr; |
U+02199 | ↙ |
swarrow; |
U+02199 | ↙ |
swnwar; |
U+0292A | ⤪ |
szlig; |
U+000DF | ß |
szlig |
U+000DF | ß |
Tab; |
U+00009 | ␉ |
target; |
U+02316 | ⌖ |
Tau; |
U+003A4 | Τ |
tau; |
U+003C4 | τ |
tbrk; |
U+023B4 | ⎴ |
Tcaron; |
U+00164 | Ť |
tcaron; |
U+00165 | ť |
Tcedil; |
U+00162 | Ţ |
tcedil; |
U+00163 | ţ |
Tcy; |
U+00422 | Т |
tcy; |
U+00442 | т |
tdot; |
U+020DB | ◌⃛ |
telrec; |
U+02315 | ⌕ |
Tfr; |
U+1D517 | 𝔗 |
tfr; |
U+1D531 | 𝔱 |
there4; |
U+02234 | ∴ |
Therefore; |
U+02234 | ∴ |
therefore; |
U+02234 | ∴ |
Theta; |
U+00398 | Θ |
theta; |
U+003B8 | θ |
thetasym; |
U+003D1 | ϑ |
thetav; |
U+003D1 | ϑ |
thickapprox; |
U+02248 | ≈ |
thicksim; |
U+0223C | ∼ |
ThickSpace; |
U+0205F U+0200A | |
thinsp; |
U+02009 | |
ThinSpace; |
U+02009 | |
thkap; |
U+02248 | ≈ |
thksim; |
U+0223C | ∼ |
THORN; |
U+000DE | Þ |
THORN |
U+000DE | Þ |
thorn; |
U+000FE | þ |
thorn |
U+000FE | þ |
Tilde; |
U+0223C | ∼ |
tilde; |
U+002DC | ˜ |
TildeEqual; |
U+02243 | ≃ |
TildeFullEqual; |
U+02245 | ≅ |
TildeTilde; |
U+02248 | ≈ |
times; |
U+000D7 | × |
times |
U+000D7 | × |
timesb; |
U+022A0 | ⊠ |
timesbar; |
U+02A31 | ⨱ |
timesd; |
U+02A30 | ⨰ |
tint; |
U+0222D | ∭ |
toea; |
U+02928 | ⤨ |
top; |
U+022A4 | ⊤ |
topbot; |
U+02336 | ⌶ |
topcir; |
U+02AF1 | ⫱ |
Topf; |
U+1D54B | 𝕋 |
topf; |
U+1D565 | 𝕥 |
topfork; |
U+02ADA | ⫚ |
tosa; |
U+02929 | ⤩ |
tprime; |
U+02034 | ‴ |
TRADE; |
U+02122 | ™ |
trade; |
U+02122 | ™ |
triangle; |
U+025B5 | ▵ |
triangledown; |
U+025BF | ▿ |
triangleleft; |
U+025C3 | ◃ |
trianglelefteq; |
U+022B4 | ⊴ |
triangleq; |
U+0225C | ≜ |
triangleright; |
U+025B9 | ▹ |
trianglerighteq; |
U+022B5 | ⊵ |
tridot; |
U+025EC | ◬ |
trie; |
U+0225C | ≜ |
triminus; |
U+02A3A | ⨺ |
TripleDot; |
U+020DB | ◌⃛ |
triplus; |
U+02A39 | ⨹ |
trisb; |
U+029CD | ⧍ |
tritime; |
U+02A3B | ⨻ |
trpezium; |
U+023E2 | ⏢ |
Tscr; |
U+1D4AF | 𝒯 |
tscr; |
U+1D4C9 | 𝓉 |
TScy; |
U+00426 | Ц |
tscy; |
U+00446 | ц |
TSHcy; |
U+0040B | Ћ |
tshcy; |
U+0045B | ћ |
Tstrok; |
U+00166 | Ŧ |
tstrok; |
U+00167 | ŧ |
twixt; |
U+0226C | ≬ |
twoheadleftarrow; |
U+0219E | ↞ |
twoheadrightarrow; |
U+021A0 | ↠ |
Uacute; |
U+000DA | Ú |
Uacute |
U+000DA | Ú |
uacute; |
U+000FA | ú |
uacute |
U+000FA | ú |
Uarr; |
U+0219F | ↟ |
uArr; |
U+021D1 | ⇑ |
uarr; |
U+02191 | ↑ |
Uarrocir; |
U+02949 | ⥉ |
Ubrcy; |
U+0040E | Ў |
ubrcy; |
U+0045E | ў |
Ubreve; |
U+0016C | Ŭ |
ubreve; |
U+0016D | ŭ |
Ucirc; |
U+000DB | Û |
Ucirc |
U+000DB | Û |
ucirc; |
U+000FB | û |
ucirc |
U+000FB | û |
Ucy; |
U+00423 | У |
ucy; |
U+00443 | у |
udarr; |
U+021C5 | ⇅ |
Udblac; |
U+00170 | Ű |
udblac; |
U+00171 | ű |
udhar; |
U+0296E | ⥮ |
ufisht; |
U+0297E | ⥾ |
Ufr; |
U+1D518 | 𝔘 |
ufr; |
U+1D532 | 𝔲 |
Ugrave; |
U+000D9 | Ù |
Ugrave |
U+000D9 | Ù |
ugrave; |
U+000F9 | ù |
ugrave |
U+000F9 | ù |
uHar; |
U+02963 | ⥣ |
uharl; |
U+021BF | ↿ |
uharr; |
U+021BE | ↾ |
uhblk; |
U+02580 | ▀ |
ulcorn; |
U+0231C | ⌜ |
ulcorner; |
U+0231C | ⌜ |
ulcrop; |
U+0230F | ⌏ |
ultri; |
U+025F8 | ◸ |
Umacr; |
U+0016A | Ū |
umacr; |
U+0016B | ū |
uml; |
U+000A8 | ¨ |
uml |
U+000A8 | ¨ |
UnderBar; |
U+0005F | _ |
UnderBrace; |
U+023DF | ⏟ |
UnderBracket; |
U+023B5 | ⎵ |
UnderParenthesis; |
U+023DD | ⏝ |
Union; |
U+022C3 | ⋃ |
UnionPlus; |
U+0228E | ⊎ |
Uogon; |
U+00172 | Ų |
uogon; |
U+00173 | ų |
Uopf; |
U+1D54C | 𝕌 |
uopf; |
U+1D566 | 𝕦 |
UpArrow; |
U+02191 | ↑ |
Uparrow; |
U+021D1 | ⇑ |
uparrow; |
U+02191 | ↑ |
UpArrowBar; |
U+02912 | ⤒ |
UpArrowDownArrow; |
U+021C5 | ⇅ |
UpDownArrow; |
U+02195 | ↕ |
Updownarrow; |
U+021D5 | ⇕ |
updownarrow; |
U+02195 | ↕ |
UpEquilibrium; |
U+0296E | ⥮ |
upharpoonleft; |
U+021BF | ↿ |
upharpoonright; |
U+021BE | ↾ |
uplus; |
U+0228E | ⊎ |
UpperLeftArrow; |
U+02196 | ↖ |
UpperRightArrow; |
U+02197 | ↗ |
Upsi; |
U+003D2 | ϒ |
upsi; |
U+003C5 | υ |
upsih; |
U+003D2 | ϒ |
Upsilon; |
U+003A5 | Υ |
upsilon; |
U+003C5 | υ |
UpTee; |
U+022A5 | ⊥ |
UpTeeArrow; |
U+021A5 | ↥ |
upuparrows; |
U+021C8 | ⇈ |
urcorn; |
U+0231D | ⌝ |
urcorner; |
U+0231D | ⌝ |
urcrop; |
U+0230E | ⌎ |
Uring; |
U+0016E | Ů |
uring; |
U+0016F | ů |
urtri; |
U+025F9 | ◹ |
Uscr; |
U+1D4B0 | 𝒰 |
uscr; |
U+1D4CA | 𝓊 |
utdot; |
U+022F0 | ⋰ |
Utilde; |
U+00168 | Ũ |
utilde; |
U+00169 | ũ |
utri; |
U+025B5 | ▵ |
utrif; |
U+025B4 | ▴ |
uuarr; |
U+021C8 | ⇈ |
Uuml; |
U+000DC | Ü |
Uuml |
U+000DC | Ü |
uuml; |
U+000FC | ü |
uuml |
U+000FC | ü |
uwangle; |
U+029A7 | ⦧ |
vangrt; |
U+0299C | ⦜ |
varepsilon; |
U+003F5 | ϵ |
varkappa; |
U+003F0 | ϰ |
varnothing; |
U+02205 | ∅ |
varphi; |
U+003D5 | ϕ |
varpi; |
U+003D6 | ϖ |
varpropto; |
U+0221D | ∝ |
vArr; |
U+021D5 | ⇕ |
varr; |
U+02195 | ↕ |
varrho; |
U+003F1 | ϱ |
varsigma; |
U+003C2 | ς |
varsubsetneq; |
U+0228A U+0FE00 | ⊊︀ |
varsubsetneqq; |
U+02ACB U+0FE00 | ⫋︀ |
varsupsetneq; |
U+0228B U+0FE00 | ⊋︀ |
varsupsetneqq; |
U+02ACC U+0FE00 | ⫌︀ |
vartheta; |
U+003D1 | ϑ |
vartriangleleft; |
U+022B2 | ⊲ |
vartriangleright; |
U+022B3 | ⊳ |
Vbar; |
U+02AEB | ⫫ |
vBar; |
U+02AE8 | ⫨ |
vBarv; |
U+02AE9 | ⫩ |
Vcy; |
U+00412 | В |
vcy; |
U+00432 | в |
VDash; |
U+022AB | ⊫ |
Vdash; |
U+022A9 | ⊩ |
vDash; |
U+022A8 | ⊨ |
vdash; |
U+022A2 | ⊢ |
Vdashl; |
U+02AE6 | ⫦ |
Vee; |
U+022C1 | ⋁ |
vee; |
U+02228 | ∨ |
veebar; |
U+022BB | ⊻ |
veeeq; |
U+0225A | ≚ |
vellip; |
U+022EE | ⋮ |
Verbar; |
U+02016 | ‖ |
verbar; |
U+0007C | | |
Vert; |
U+02016 | ‖ |
vert; |
U+0007C | | |
VerticalBar; |
U+02223 | ∣ |
VerticalLine; |
U+0007C | | |
VerticalSeparator; |
U+02758 | ❘ |
VerticalTilde; |
U+02240 | ≀ |
VeryThinSpace; |
U+0200A | |
Vfr; |
U+1D519 | 𝔙 |
vfr; |
U+1D533 | 𝔳 |
vltri; |
U+022B2 | ⊲ |
vnsub; |
U+02282 U+020D2 | ⊂⃒ |
vnsup; |
U+02283 U+020D2 | ⊃⃒ |
Vopf; |
U+1D54D | 𝕍 |
vopf; |
U+1D567 | 𝕧 |
vprop; |
U+0221D | ∝ |
vrtri; |
U+022B3 | ⊳ |
Vscr; |
U+1D4B1 | 𝒱 |
vscr; |
U+1D4CB | 𝓋 |
vsubnE; |
U+02ACB U+0FE00 | ⫋︀ |
vsubne; |
U+0228A U+0FE00 | ⊊︀ |
vsupnE; |
U+02ACC U+0FE00 | ⫌︀ |
vsupne; |
U+0228B U+0FE00 | ⊋︀ |
Vvdash; |
U+022AA | ⊪ |
vzigzag; |
U+0299A | ⦚ |
Wcirc; |
U+00174 | Ŵ |
wcirc; |
U+00175 | ŵ |
wedbar; |
U+02A5F | ⩟ |
Wedge; |
U+022C0 | ⋀ |
wedge; |
U+02227 | ∧ |
wedgeq; |
U+02259 | ≙ |
weierp; |
U+02118 | ℘ |
Wfr; |
U+1D51A | 𝔚 |
wfr; |
U+1D534 | 𝔴 |
Wopf; |
U+1D54E | 𝕎 |
wopf; |
U+1D568 | 𝕨 |
wp; |
U+02118 | ℘ |
wr; |
U+02240 | ≀ |
wreath; |
U+02240 | ≀ |
Wscr; |
U+1D4B2 | 𝒲 |
wscr; |
U+1D4CC | 𝓌 |
xcap; |
U+022C2 | ⋂ |
xcirc; |
U+025EF | ◯ |
xcup; |
U+022C3 | ⋃ |
xdtri; |
U+025BD | ▽ |
Xfr; |
U+1D51B | 𝔛 |
xfr; |
U+1D535 | 𝔵 |
xhArr; |
U+027FA | ⟺ |
xharr; |
U+027F7 | ⟷ |
Xi; |
U+0039E | Ξ |
xi; |
U+003BE | ξ |
xlArr; |
U+027F8 | ⟸ |
xlarr; |
U+027F5 | ⟵ |
xmap; |
U+027FC | ⟼ |
xnis; |
U+022FB | ⋻ |
xodot; |
U+02A00 | ⨀ |
Xopf; |
U+1D54F | 𝕏 |
xopf; |
U+1D569 | 𝕩 |
xoplus; |
U+02A01 | ⨁ |
xotime; |
U+02A02 | ⨂ |
xrArr; |
U+027F9 | ⟹ |
xrarr; |
U+027F6 | ⟶ |
Xscr; |
U+1D4B3 | 𝒳 |
xscr; |
U+1D4CD | 𝓍 |
xsqcup; |
U+02A06 | ⨆ |
xuplus; |
U+02A04 | ⨄ |
xutri; |
U+025B3 | △ |
xvee; |
U+022C1 | ⋁ |
xwedge; |
U+022C0 | ⋀ |
Yacute; |
U+000DD | Ý |
Yacute |
U+000DD | Ý |
yacute; |
U+000FD | ý |
yacute |
U+000FD | ý |
YAcy; |
U+0042F | Я |
yacy; |
U+0044F | я |
Ycirc; |
U+00176 | Ŷ |
ycirc; |
U+00177 | ŷ |
Ycy; |
U+0042B | Ы |
ycy; |
U+0044B | ы |
yen; |
U+000A5 | ¥ |
yen |
U+000A5 | ¥ |
Yfr; |
U+1D51C | 𝔜 |
yfr; |
U+1D536 | 𝔶 |
YIcy; |
U+00407 | Ї |
yicy; |
U+00457 | ї |
Yopf; |
U+1D550 | 𝕐 |
yopf; |
U+1D56A | 𝕪 |
Yscr; |
U+1D4B4 | 𝒴 |
yscr; |
U+1D4CE | 𝓎 |
YUcy; |
U+0042E | Ю |
yucy; |
U+0044E | ю |
Yuml; |
U+00178 | Ÿ |
yuml; |
U+000FF | ÿ |
yuml |
U+000FF | ÿ |
Zacute; |
U+00179 | Ź |
zacute; |
U+0017A | ź |
Zcaron; |
U+0017D | Ž |
zcaron; |
U+0017E | ž |
Zcy; |
U+00417 | З |
zcy; |
U+00437 | з |
Zdot; |
U+0017B | Ż |
zdot; |
U+0017C | ż |
zeetrf; |
U+02128 | ℨ |
ZeroWidthSpace; |
U+0200B | |
Zeta; |
U+00396 | Ζ |
zeta; |
U+003B6 | ζ |
Zfr; |
U+02128 | ℨ |
zfr; |
U+1D537 | 𝔷 |
ZHcy; |
U+00416 | Ж |
zhcy; |
U+00436 | ж |
zigrarr; |
U+021DD | ⇝ |
Zopf; |
U+02124 | ℤ |
zopf; |
U+1D56B | 𝕫 |
Zscr; |
U+1D4B5 | 𝒵 |
zscr; |
U+1D4CF | 𝓏 |
zwj; |
U+0200D | |
zwnj; |
U+0200C | |
This data is also available as a JSON file.
The glyphs displayed above are non-normative. Refer to the Unicode specifications for formal definitions of the characters listed above.
This section only describes the rules for XML resources.
Rules for text/html
resources are
discussed in the section above entitled "The HTML syntax".
The syntax for using HTML with XML, whether in XHTML documents or embedded in other XML documents, is defined in the XML and Namespaces in XML specifications. [XML] [XMLNS]
This specification does not define any syntax-level requirements beyond those defined for XML proper.
XML documents may contain a DOCTYPE
if desired, but this is
not required to conform to this specification. This specification does not
define a public or system identifier, nor provide a formal DTD.
According to the XML specification, XML processors are not
guaranteed to process the external DTD subset referenced in the DOCTYPE.
This means, for example, that using entity
references for characters in XHTML documents is unsafe if they are
defined in an external file (except for <
,
>
, &
,
"
and '
).
This section describes the relationship between XML and the DOM, with a particular emphasis on how this interacts with HTML.
An XML parser, for the purposes of this
specification, is a construct that follows the rules given in the XML
specification to map a string of bytes or characters into a Document
object.
At the time of writing, no such rules actually exist.
An XML parser is either associated with a Document
object when it is created, or
creates one implicitly.
This Document
must then be
populated with DOM nodes that represent the tree structure of the input
passed to the parser, as defined by the XML specification, the
Namespaces in XML specification та the DOM specification. DOM mutation
events must not fire for the operations that the XML
parser performs on the Document
's
tree, but the user agent must act as if elements and attributes were
individually appended та встановити respectively so as to trigger rules
in this specification regarding what happens when an element is inserted
into a document or has its attributes set та the DOM specification's
requirements regarding mutation observers mean that mutation observers are
fired (unlike mutation events). [XML] [XMLNS]
[DOM] [DOMEVENTS]
Between the time an element's start tag is parsed and the time either the element's end tag is parsed or the parser detects a well-formedness error, the user agent must act as if the element was in a stack of open elements.
This is used by the object
element to avoid instantiating plugins before the param
element children have been parsed.
This specification provides the following additional information that user agents should use when retrieving an external entity: the public identifiers given in the following list all correspond to the URL given by this link. (This URL is a DTD containing the entity declarations for the names listed in the named character references section.) [XML]
-//W3C//DTD XHTML 1.0 Transitional//EN
-//W3C//DTD XHTML 1.1//EN
-//W3C//DTD XHTML 1.0 Strict//EN
-//W3C//DTD XHTML 1.0 Frameset//EN
-//W3C//DTD XHTML Basic 1.0//EN
-//W3C//DTD XHTML 1.1 plus MathML 2.0//EN
-//W3C//DTD XHTML 1.1 plus MathML 2.0 plus SVG 1.1//EN
-//W3C//DTD MathML 2.0//EN
-//WAPFORUM//DTD XHTML Mobile 1.0//EN
Furthermore, user agents should attempt to retrieve the above external entity's content when one of the above public identifiers is used та should not attempt to retrieve any other external entity's content.
This is not strictly a violation of the XML specification, but it does contradict the spirit of the XML specification's requirements. This is motivated by a desire for user agents to all handle entities in an interoperable fashion without requiring any network access for handling external subsets. [XML]
When an XML parser creates
a script
element, it
must be marked as being "parser-inserted"
and its "force-async" flag must be unset.
Якщо the parser was originally created for the XML
fragment parsing algorithm, then the element must be marked as "already started" also. When the element's
end tag is parsed, the user agent must perform
a microtask checkpoint, provide
a stable state та then prepare
the script
element. Якщо
this causes there to be a pending
parsing-blocking script, then the user agent must run the
following steps:
Block this instance of the XML parser, such that the event loop will not run tasks that invoke it.
Spin the event loop until the
parser's Document
has
no style sheet that is blocking scripts and the pending
parsing-blocking script's "ready
to be parser-executed" flag is set.
Unblock this instance of the XML parser, such that tasks that invoke it can again be run.
There is no longer a pending parsing-blocking script.
Since the document.write()
API is not
available for XML documents, much of the
complexity in the HTML parser is not needed
in the XML parser.
When an XML parser would
append a node to a template
element, it must instead append it to the template
element's template contents (a DocumentFragment
node).
This is a willful violation
of the XML specification; unfortunately, XML is not formally extensible
in the manner that is needed for template
processing. [XML]
When an XML parser creates a Node
object, its ownerDocument
must be set to the Document
of the
node into which the newly created node is to be inserted.
Certain algorithms in this specification spoon-feed the parser characters one string at a time. In such cases, the XML parser must act as it would have if faced with a single string consisting of the concatenation of all those characters.
When an XML parser reaches the end of its input, it must stop parsing, following the same rules as the HTML parser. An XML parser can also be aborted, which must again by done in the same way as for an HTML parser.
For the purposes of conformance checkers, if a resource is determined to be in the XHTML syntax, then it is an XML document.
The XML fragment
serialization algorithm for a Document
or Element
node either returns a
fragment of XML that represents that node or throws an exception.
For Document
s, the algorithm must
return a string in the form of a document
entity, if none of the error cases below apply.
For Element
s, the algorithm must
return a string in the form of an internal
general parsed entity, if none of the error cases below apply.
In both cases, the string returned must be XML namespace-well-formed
and must be an isomorphic serialization of all of that node's relevant
child nodes, in tree order. User agents
may adjust prefixes and namespace declarations in the serialization (and
indeed might be forced to do so in some cases щоб отримати
namespace-well-formed XML). User agents may use a combination of regular
text and character references to represent Text
nodes in the DOM.
A node's relevant child nodes are those that apply given the following rules:
template
elementstemplate
element's template contents, if any.For Element
s, if any of the
elements in the serialization are in no namespace, the default namespace
in scope for those elements must be explicitly declared as the empty
string.
(This doesn't apply in the Document
case.) [XML] [XMLNS]
For the purposes of this section, an internal general parsed entity is considered XML namespace-well-formed if a document consisting of an element with no namespace declarations whose contents are the internal general parsed entity would itself be XML namespace-well-formed.
Якщо any of the following error cases are found in the DOM subtree
being serialized, then the algorithm must throw an InvalidStateError
exception instead of returning a string:
Document
node with no child
element nodes.DocumentType
node that
has an external subset public identifier that contains characters що є
not matched by the XML PubidChar
production. [XML]DocumentType
node that
has an external subset system identifier that contains both a """
(U+0022) and a "'" (U+0027) or that contains characters що є not
matched by the XML Char
production.
[XML]Name
production. [XML]Attr
node with no namespace
whose local name is the lowercase string "xmlns
".
[XMLNS]Element
node with two or
more attributes with the same local name and namespace.Attr
node, Text
node, Comment
node, or ProcessingInstruction
node whose data contains characters що є not matched by the XML Char
production. [XML]Comment
node whose data
contains two adjacent U+002D HYPHEN-MINUS characters (-) or ends with
such a character.ProcessingInstruction
node whose target name is an ASCII
чутливі до реєстру match for the string "xml
".ProcessingInstruction
node whose target name contains a ":" (U+003A).ProcessingInstruction
node whose data contains the string "?>
".These are the only ways to make a DOM unserializable. The
DOM enforces all the other XML constraints; for example, trying to
append two elements to a Document
node will throw a HierarchyRequestError
exception.
When the algorithm must produce a serialization of a template
element, the string returned must contain a serialization of the child
nodes of the template element's content
DocumentFragment
,
rather than the template
element's children.
The XML fragment parsing
algorithm either returns a Document
or throws a SyntaxError
exception. Given a string input and an
optional context element context, the algorithm
is as follows:
Create a new XML parser.
Якщо there is a context element, feed the parser just created the string corresponding to the start tag of that element, declaring all the namespace prefixes що є in scope on that element in the DOM, as well as declaring the default namespace (if any) that is in scope on that element in the DOM.
A namespace prefix is in scope if the DOM lookupNamespaceURI()
method on the element would return a non-null value for that prefix.
The default namespace is the namespace for which the DOM isDefaultNamespace()
method on the element would return true.
Якщо there is a context element, no
DOCTYPE
is passed to the parser та
therefore no external subset is referenced та therefore no entities
will be recognized.
Feed the parser just created the string input.
Якщо there is a context element, feed the parser just created the string corresponding to the end tag of that element.
Якщо there is an XML well-formedness or XML namespace
well-formedness error, then throw a SyntaxError
exception and abort these steps.
Якщо there is a context element та
the root element of the resulting Document
has any sibling nodes, then throw a SyntaxError
exception and abort these steps.
Якщо there is a context element,
then return the child nodes of the root element of the resulting Document
, in tree
order.
Інакше return the children of the Document
object, in tree order.
User agents are not required to present HTML documents in any particular way. However, this section provides a set of suggestions for rendering HTML documents that, if followed, are likely to lead to a user experience that closely resembles the experience intended by the documents' authors. So as to avoid confusion regarding the normativity of this section, RFC2119 terms have not been used. Instead, the term "expected" is used to indicate behavior that will lead to this experience. For the purposes of conformance for user agents designated as supporting the suggested default rendering, the term "expected" in this section has the same conformance implications as the RFC2119-defined term "must".
In general, user agents are expected to support CSS та many of the suggestions in this section are expressed in CSS terms. User agents that use other presentation mechanisms can derive their expected behavior by translating from the CSS rules given in this section.
In the absence of style-layer rules to the contrary (e.g. author style sheets), user agents are expected to render an element so that it conveys to the user the meaning that the element represents, as described by this specification.
The suggestions in this section generally assume a visual output medium with a resolution of 96dpi or greater, but HTML is intended to apply to multiple media (it is a media-independent language). User agent implementors are encouraged to adapt the suggestions in this section to their target media.
An element is being rendered if it has any associated CSS layout boxes, SVG layout boxes, or some equivalent in other styling languages.
Just being off-screen does not mean the element is not being rendered. The presence of the hidden
attribute normally means the element is not being
rendered, though this might be overridden by the style sheets.
User agents that do not honor author-level CSS style sheets are nonetheless expected to act as if they applied the CSS rules given in these sections in a manner consistent with this specification and the relevant CSS and Unicode specifications. [CSS] [UNICODE] [BIDI]
This is especially important for issues relating to the 'display', 'unicode-bidi' та 'direction' properties.
The CSS rules given in these subsections are, except where otherwise specified, expected to be used as part of the user-agent level style sheet defaults for all documents that contain HTML elements.
Some rules are intended for the author-level zero-specificity presentational hints part of the CSS cascade; these are explicitly called out as presentational hints.
Some of the rules regarding left and right margins are given here as appropriate for elements whose 'direction' property is 'ltr' та are expected to be flipped around on elements whose 'direction' property is 'rtl'. These are marked "LTR-specific".
These markings only affect the handling of attribute values, not attribute names or element names.
When the text below says that an attribute attribute on an element element maps to the pixel length property (or properties) properties, it means that if element has an attribute attribute set та parsing that attribute's value using the rules for parsing non-negative integers doesn't generate an error, then the user agent is expected to use the parsed value as a pixel length for a presentational hint for properties.
When the text below says that an attribute attribute on an element element maps to the dimension property (or properties) properties, it means that if element has an attribute attribute set та parsing that attribute's value using the rules for parsing dimension values doesn't generate an error, then the user agent is expected to use the parsed dimension as the value for a presentational hint for properties, with the value given as a pixel length if the dimension was an integer та with the value given as a percentage if the dimension was a percentage.
When a user agent is to align descendants
of a node, the user agent is expected to align only those descendants
that have both their 'margin-left' and 'margin-right' properties
computing to a value other than 'auto', що є over-constrained and that
have one of those two margins with a used value forced to a greater
value та that do not themselves have an applicable align
attribute. When multiple elements are to align a particular descendant, the
most deeply nested such element is expected to override the others.
Aligned elements are expected to be aligned by having the used values of
their left and right margins be set accordingly.
@namespace url(http://www.w3.org/1999/xhtml);
, area, base, basefont, datalist, head, link,
meta, noembed, noframes, param, rp, script, source, style, template, track, title {
display: none;
}
embed[hidden] { display: inline; height: 0; width: 0; }The user agent is expected to force the 'display' property of noscript
elements for whom scripting
is enabled to compute to 'none', irrespective of CSS rules.
The user agent is expected to force the 'display' property of input
elements whose type
attribute is in the Hidden state to compute to
'none', irrespective of CSS rules.
@namespace url(http://www.w3.org/1999/xhtml); html, body { display: block; }
For each property in the table below, given a body
element, the first attribute that exists maps
to the pixel length property on the body
element. Якщо none of the attributes for a property are found, or if the
value of the attribute that was found cannot be parsed successfully,
then a default value of 8px is expected to be used for that property
instead.
Property | Source |
---|---|
'margin-top' | body element's marginheight
attribute |
The body element's
container frame element's marginheight
attribute |
|
body element's topmargin
attribute |
|
'margin-right' | body element's marginwidth
attribute |
The body element's
container frame element's marginwidth
attribute |
|
body element's rightmargin
attribute |
|
'margin-bottom' | body element's marginheight
attribute |
The body element's
container frame element's marginheight
attribute |
|
body element's bottommargin
attribute |
|
'margin-left' | body element's marginwidth
attribute |
The body element's
container frame element's marginwidth
attribute |
|
body element's leftmargin
attribute |
Якщо the body
element's Document
's browsing
context is a nested browsing
context та the browsing
context container of that nested
browsing context is a frame
or
iframe
element, then the
container frame element of the body
element is that frame
or iframe
element.
Інакше there is no container frame
element.
The above requirements imply that a page can change the
margins of another page (including one from another origin)
using, for example, an iframe
.
This is potentially a security risk, as it might in some cases allow an
attack to contrive a situation in which a page is rendered not as the
author intended, possibly for the purposes of phishing or otherwise
misleading the user.
Якщо the Document
has a root
element та the Document
's browsing context is a nested
browsing context та the browsing
context container of that nested
browsing context is a frame
or
iframe
element та that
element has a scrolling
attribute, then the user agent is expected to compare the value of the
attribute in an ASCII чутливі до
реєстру manner to the values in the first column of the following
table та if one of them matches, then the user agent is expected to
treat that attribute as a presentational
hint for the aforementioned root element's 'overflow' property,
setting it to the value given in the corresponding cell on the same row
in the second column:
Attribute value | 'overflow' value |
---|---|
on |
'scroll' |
scroll |
'scroll' |
yes |
'scroll' |
off |
'hidden' |
noscroll |
'hidden' |
no |
'hidden' |
auto |
'auto' |
When a body
element has a
background
attribute set to a non-empty value, the new value is expected to be resolved relative to the element та if this is
successful, the user agent is expected to treat the attribute as a presentational hint setting the
element's 'background-image' property to the resulting absolute
URL.
When a body
element has a
bgcolor
attribute set, the new value is expected to be parsed using the rules
for parsing a legacy color value та if that does not return an
error, the user agent is expected to treat the attribute as a presentational hint setting the
element's 'background-color' property to the resulting color.
When a body
element has a
text
attribute, its value is expected to be parsed using the rules
for parsing a legacy color value та if that does not return an
error, the user agent is expected to treat the attribute as a presentational hint setting the
element's 'color' property to the resulting color.
When a body
element has a
link
attribute, its value is expected to be parsed using the rules
for parsing a legacy color value та if that does not return an
error, the user agent is expected to treat the attribute as a presentational hint setting the
'color' property of any element in the Document
matching the ':link' pseudo-class to the resulting color.
When a body
element has a
vlink
attribute, its value is expected to be parsed using the rules
for parsing a legacy color value та if that does not return an
error, the user agent is expected to treat the attribute as a presentational hint setting the
'color' property of any element in the Document
matching the ':visited' pseudo-class to the resulting color.
When a body
element has
an alink
attribute, its value is expected to be parsed using the rules
for parsing a legacy color value та if that does not return an
error, the user agent is expected to treat the attribute as a presentational hint setting the
'color' property of any element in the Document
matching the ':active' pseudo-class and either the ':link' pseudo-class
or the ':visited' pseudo-class to the resulting color.
@namespace url(http://www.w3.org/1999/xhtml); address, blockquote, center, div, figure, figcaption, footer, form, header, hr, legend, listing, p, plaintext, pre, xmp { display: block; } blockquote, figure, listing, p, plaintext, pre, xmp { margin-top: 1em; margin-bottom: 1em; } blockquote, figure { margin-left: 40px; margin-right: 40px; } address { font-style: italic; } listing, plaintext, pre, xmp { font-family: monospace; white-space: pre; }
The following rules are also expected to apply, as presentational hints:
@namespace url(http://www.w3.org/1999/xhtml); pre[wrap] { white-space: pre-wrap; }
In quirks mode, the following rules are also expected to apply:
@namespace url(http://www.w3.org/1999/xhtml); form { margin-bottom: 1em; }
The center
element та the div
element when it has an align
attribute whose value is an ASCII
чутливі до реєстру match for either the string "center
"
or the string "middle
", are expected to
center text within themselves, as if they had their 'text-align'
property set to 'center' in a presentational hint та to align
descendants to the center.
The div
element, when it
has an align
attribute whose
value is an ASCII чутливі до реєстру
match for the string "left
", is
expected to left-align text within itself, as if it had its 'text-align'
property set to 'left' in a presentational hint та to align
descendants to the left.
The div
element, when it
has an align
attribute whose
value is an ASCII чутливі до реєстру
match for the string "right
", is
expected to right-align text within itself, as if it had its
'text-align' property set to 'right' in a presentational hint та to align
descendants to the right.
The div
element, when it
has an align
attribute whose
value is an ASCII чутливі до реєстру
match for the string "justify
", is
expected to full-justify text within itself, as if it had its
'text-align' property set to 'justify' in a presentational hint та to align
descendants to the left.
@namespace url(http://www.w3.org/1999/xhtml);
cite, dfn, em, i, var { font-style: italic; }
b, strong { font-weight: bolder; }
code, kbd, samp, tt { font-family: monospace; }
big { font-size: larger; }
small { font-size: smaller; }
sub { vertical-align: sub; }
sup { vertical-align: super; }
sub, sup { line-height: normal; font-size: smaller; }
ruby { display: ruby; }
rb { display: ruby-base; white-space: nowrap; }
rt {
display: ruby-text;
white-space: nowrap;
font-size: 50%;
font-variant-east-asian: ruby;
text-emphasis: none;
}
rbc { display: ruby-base-container; }
rtc { display: ruby-text-container; }
ruby, rb, rt, rbc, rtc { unicode-bidi: isolate; }
:link { color: #0000EE; }
:visited { color: #551A8B; }
:link, :visited { text-decoration: underline; }
a:link[rel~=help], a:visited[rel~=help],
area:link[rel~=help], area:visited[rel~=help] { cursor: help; }
:focus { outline: auto; }
mark { background: yellow; color: black; } /* this color is just a suggestion and can be changed based on implementation feedback */
abbr[title], acronym[title] { text-decoration: dotted underline; }
ins, u { text-decoration: underline; }
del, s, strike { text-decoration: line-through; }
blink { text-decoration: blink; }
q::before { content: open-quote; }
q::after { content: close-quote; }
br { content: '\A'; white-space: pre; } /* this also has bidi implications */
nobr { white-space: nowrap; }
wbr { content: '\200B'; } /* this also has bidi implications */
nobr wbr { white-space: normal; }
The following rules are also expected to apply, as presentational hints:
@namespace url(http://www.w3.org/1999/xhtml); br[clear=left i] { clear: left; } br[clear=right i] { clear: right; } br[clear=all i], br[clear=both i] { clear: both; }
User agents that do not support correct ruby rendering are expected to
render parentheses around the text of rt
elements in the absence of rp
elements. [CSSRUBY]
User agents are expected to support the 'clear' property on inline
elements (in order to render br
elements with clear
attributes) in the manner described in the non-normative note to this
effect in CSS2.1.
The initial value for the 'color' property is expected to be black. The initial value for the 'background-color' property is expected to be 'transparent'. The canvas' background is expected to be white.
When a font
element has a color
attribute, its value is expected to be parsed using the rules
for parsing a legacy color value та if that does not return an
error, the user agent is expected to treat the attribute as a presentational hint setting the
element's 'color' property to the resulting color.
When a font
element has a face
attribute, the user agent is expected to treat the attribute as a presentational hint setting the
element's 'font-family' property to the attribute's value.
When a font
element has a size
attribute, the user agent is expected to use the following steps, known
as the rules for parsing
a legacy font size, to treat the attribute as a presentational hint setting the
element's 'font-size' property:
Нехай input be the attribute's value.
Нехай position буде вказівником в input, що спочатку вказує на початок рядка.
Якщо position після кінця input, there is no presentational hint. Abort these steps.
Якщо символ в позициї position is a "+" (U+002B) character, then let mode be relative-plus та просунути position до наступного символа. Інакше if the character в позициї is a "-" (U+002D) character, then let mode be relative-minus та просунути position до наступного символа. Інакше let mode be absolute.
Зібрати колекцію символів що є цифрами ASCII та let the resulting sequence be digits.
Якщо digits is the empty string, there is no presentational hint. Abort these steps.
Інтерпретувати digits як ціле по основі десять. Нехай value be the resulting number.
Якщо mode is relative-plus, then increment value by 3. Якщо mode is relative-minus, then let value be the result of subtracting value from 3.
Якщо value is greater than 7, let it be 7.
Якщо value is less than 1, let it be 1.
Set 'font-size' to the keyword corresponding to the value of value according to the following table:
value | 'font-size' keyword | Notes |
---|---|---|
1 | x-small | |
2 | small | |
3 | medium | |
4 | large | |
5 | x-large | |
6 | xx-large | |
7 | xxx-large | see below |
The 'xxx-large' value is a non-CSS value used here to indicate a font size 50% larger than 'xx-large'.
@namespace url(http://www.w3.org/1999/xhtml); [dir]:dir(ltr), bdi:dir(ltr), input[type=tel]:dir(ltr) { direction: ltr; } [dir]:dir(rtl), bdi:dir(rtl) { direction: rtl; } address, blockquote, center, div, figure, figcaption, footer, form, header, hr, legend, listing, p, plaintext, pre, xmp, article, aside, h1, h2, h3, h4, h5, h6, hgroup, main, nav, section, table, caption, colgroup, col, thead, tbody, tfoot, tr, td, th, dir, dd, dl, dt, ol, ul, li, bdi, output, [dir=ltr i], [dir=rtl i], [dir=auto i] { unicode-bidi: isolate; } bdo, bdo[dir] { unicode-bidi: isolate-override; } textarea[dir=auto i], input[type=text][dir=auto i], input[type=search][dir=auto i], input[type=tel][dir=auto i], input[type=url][dir=auto i], input[type=email][dir=auto i], pre[dir=auto i] { unicode-bidi: plaintext; } /* the rules setting the 'content' property onbr
andwbr
elements also has bidi implications */
Input fields (i.e. textarea
elements та input
elements when their type
attribute is in the Text,
Search,
Telephone,
URL,
or E-mail
state) are expected to present an editing user interface with a
directionality that matches the element's 'direction' property.
This block is automatically generated from the Unicode Common Locale Data Repository. [CLDR]
User agents are expected to use either the block below (which will be
regularly updated) or to automatically generate their own copy directly
from the source material. The language codes are derived from the CLDR
file names. The quotes are derived from the delimiter
blocks, with fallback handled as specified in the CLDR documentation.
@namespace url(http://www.w3.org/1999/xhtml); :root { quotes: '\201c' '\201d' '\2018' '\2019' } /* “ ” ‘ ’ */ :root:lang(af), :not(:lang(af)) > :lang(af) { quotes: '\201c' '\201d' '\2018' '\2019' } /* “ ” ‘ ’ */ :root:lang(agq), :not(:lang(agq)) > :lang(agq) { quotes: '\201e' '\201d' '\201a' '\2019' } /* „ ” ‚ ’ */ :root:lang(ak), :not(:lang(ak)) > :lang(ak) { quotes: '\201c' '\201d' '\2018' '\2019' } /* “ ” ‘ ’ */ :root:lang(am), :not(:lang(am)) > :lang(am) { quotes: '\00ab' '\00bb' '\2039' '\203a' } /* « » ‹ › */ :root:lang(ar), :not(:lang(ar)) > :lang(ar) { quotes: '\201d' '\201c' '\2019' '\2018' } /* ” “ ’ ‘ */ :root:lang(asa), :not(:lang(asa)) > :lang(asa) { quotes: '\201c' '\201d' '\2018' '\2019' } /* “ ” ‘ ’ */ :root:lang(az-Cyrl), :not(:lang(az-Cyrl)) > :lang(az-Cyrl) { quotes: '\00ab' '\00bb' '\2039' '\203a' } /* « » ‹ › */ :root:lang(bas), :not(:lang(bas)) > :lang(bas) { quotes: '\00ab' '\00bb' '\201e' '\201c' } /* « » „ “ */ :root:lang(bem), :not(:lang(bem)) > :lang(bem) { quotes: '\201c' '\201d' '\2018' '\2019' } /* “ ” ‘ ’ */ :root:lang(bez), :not(:lang(bez)) > :lang(bez) { quotes: '\201c' '\201d' '\2018' '\2019' } /* “ ” ‘ ’ */ :root:lang(bg), :not(:lang(bg)) > :lang(bg) { quotes: '\201e' '\201c' '\201a' '\2018' } /* „ “ ‚ ‘ */ :root:lang(bm), :not(:lang(bm)) > :lang(bm) { quotes: '\00ab' '\00bb' '\201c' '\201d' } /* « » “ ” */ :root:lang(bn), :not(:lang(bn)) > :lang(bn) { quotes: '\201c' '\201d' '\2018' '\2019' } /* “ ” ‘ ’ */ :root:lang(br), :not(:lang(br)) > :lang(br) { quotes: '\00ab' '\00bb' '\2039' '\203a' } /* « » ‹ › */ :root:lang(brx), :not(:lang(brx)) > :lang(brx) { quotes: '\201c' '\201d' '\2018' '\2019' } /* “ ” ‘ ’ */ :root:lang(bs-Cyrl), :not(:lang(bs-Cyrl)) > :lang(bs-Cyrl) { quotes: '\201e' '\201c' '\201a' '\2018' } /* „ “ ‚ ‘ */ :root:lang(ca), :not(:lang(ca)) > :lang(ca) { quotes: '\201c' '\201d' '\00ab' '\00bb' } /* “ ” « » */ :root:lang(cgg), :not(:lang(cgg)) > :lang(cgg) { quotes: '\201c' '\201d' '\2018' '\2019' } /* “ ” ‘ ’ */ :root:lang(chr), :not(:lang(chr)) > :lang(chr) { quotes: '\201c' '\201d' '\2018' '\2019' } /* “ ” ‘ ’ */ :root:lang(cs), :not(:lang(cs)) > :lang(cs) { quotes: '\201e' '\201c' '\201a' '\2018' } /* „ “ ‚ ‘ */ :root:lang(da), :not(:lang(da)) > :lang(da) { quotes: '\201c' '\201d' '\2018' '\2019' } /* “ ” ‘ ’ */ :root:lang(dav), :not(:lang(dav)) > :lang(dav) { quotes: '\201c' '\201d' '\2018' '\2019' } /* “ ” ‘ ’ */ :root:lang(de), :not(:lang(de)) > :lang(de) { quotes: '\201e' '\201c' '\201a' '\2018' } /* „ “ ‚ ‘ */ :root:lang(de-CH), :not(:lang(de-CH)) > :lang(de-CH) { quotes: '\00ab' '\00bb' '\2039' '\203a' } /* « » ‹ › */ :root:lang(dje), :not(:lang(dje)) > :lang(dje) { quotes: '\201c' '\201d' '\2018' '\2019' } /* “ ” ‘ ’ */ :root:lang(dua), :not(:lang(dua)) > :lang(dua) { quotes: '\00ab' '\00bb' '\2018' '\2019' } /* « » ‘ ’ */ :root:lang(dyo), :not(:lang(dyo)) > :lang(dyo) { quotes: '\00ab' '\00bb' '\201c' '\201d' } /* « » “ ” */ :root:lang(dz), :not(:lang(dz)) > :lang(dz) { quotes: '\201c' '\201d' '\2018' '\2019' } /* “ ” ‘ ’ */ :root:lang(ebu), :not(:lang(ebu)) > :lang(ebu) { quotes: '\201c' '\201d' '\2018' '\2019' } /* “ ” ‘ ’ */ :root:lang(ee), :not(:lang(ee)) > :lang(ee) { quotes: '\201c' '\201d' '\2018' '\2019' } /* “ ” ‘ ’ */ :root:lang(el), :not(:lang(el)) > :lang(el) { quotes: '\00ab' '\00bb' '\201c' '\201d' } /* « » “ ” */ :root:lang(en), :not(:lang(en)) > :lang(en) { quotes: '\201c' '\201d' '\2018' '\2019' } /* “ ” ‘ ’ */ :root:lang(es), :not(:lang(es)) > :lang(es) { quotes: '\201c' '\201d' '\00ab' '\00bb' } /* “ ” « » */ :root:lang(et), :not(:lang(et)) > :lang(et) { quotes: '\201e' '\201c' '\201a' '\2018' } /* „ “ ‚ ‘ */ :root:lang(eu), :not(:lang(eu)) > :lang(eu) { quotes: '\201c' '\201d' '\00ab' '\00bb' } /* “ ” « » */ :root:lang(ewo), :not(:lang(ewo)) > :lang(ewo) { quotes: '\00ab' '\00bb' '\201c' '\201d' } /* « » “ ” */ :root:lang(fa), :not(:lang(fa)) > :lang(fa) { quotes: '\00ab' '\00bb' '\2039' '\203a' } /* « » ‹ › */ :root:lang(ff), :not(:lang(ff)) > :lang(ff) { quotes: '\201e' '\201d' '\201a' '\2019' } /* „ ” ‚ ’ */ :root:lang(fi), :not(:lang(fi)) > :lang(fi) { quotes: '\201d' '\201d' '\2019' '\2019' } /* ” ” ’ ’ */ :root:lang(fr), :not(:lang(fr)) > :lang(fr) { quotes: '\00ab' '\00bb' '\00ab' '\00bb' } /* « » « » */ :root:lang(fr-CA), :not(:lang(fr-CA)) > :lang(fr-CA) { quotes: '\00ab' '\00bb' '\2039' '\203a' } /* « » ‹ › */ :root:lang(fr-CH), :not(:lang(fr-CH)) > :lang(fr-CH) { quotes: '\00ab' '\00bb' '\2039' '\203a' } /* « » ‹ › */ :root:lang(gsw), :not(:lang(gsw)) > :lang(gsw) { quotes: '\00ab' '\00bb' '\2039' '\203a' } /* « » ‹ › */ :root:lang(gu), :not(:lang(gu)) > :lang(gu) { quotes: '\201c' '\201d' '\2018' '\2019' } /* “ ” ‘ ’ */ :root:lang(guz), :not(:lang(guz)) > :lang(guz) { quotes: '\201c' '\201d' '\2018' '\2019' } /* “ ” ‘ ’ */ :root:lang(ha), :not(:lang(ha)) > :lang(ha) { quotes: '\201c' '\201d' '\2018' '\2019' } /* “ ” ‘ ’ */ :root:lang(he), :not(:lang(he)) > :lang(he) { quotes: '\0022' '\0022' '\0027' '\0027' } /* " " ' ' */ :root:lang(hi), :not(:lang(hi)) > :lang(hi) { quotes: '\201c' '\201d' '\2018' '\2019' } /* “ ” ‘ ’ */ :root:lang(hr), :not(:lang(hr)) > :lang(hr) { quotes: '\201e' '\201c' '\201a' '\2018' } /* „ “ ‚ ‘ */ :root:lang(hu), :not(:lang(hu)) > :lang(hu) { quotes: '\201e' '\201d' '\00bb' '\00ab' } /* „ ” » « */ :root:lang(id), :not(:lang(id)) > :lang(id) { quotes: '\201c' '\201d' '\2018' '\2019' } /* “ ” ‘ ’ */ :root:lang(ig), :not(:lang(ig)) > :lang(ig) { quotes: '\201c' '\201d' '\2018' '\2019' } /* “ ” ‘ ’ */ :root:lang(it), :not(:lang(it)) > :lang(it) { quotes: '\00ab' '\00bb' '\201c' '\201d' } /* « » “ ” */ :root:lang(ja), :not(:lang(ja)) > :lang(ja) { quotes: '\300c' '\300d' '\300e' '\300f' } /* 「 」 『 』 */ :root:lang(jgo), :not(:lang(jgo)) > :lang(jgo) { quotes: '\00ab' '\00bb' '\2039' '\203a' } /* « » ‹ › */ :root:lang(jmc), :not(:lang(jmc)) > :lang(jmc) { quotes: '\201c' '\201d' '\2018' '\2019' } /* “ ” ‘ ’ */ :root:lang(kab), :not(:lang(kab)) > :lang(kab) { quotes: '\00ab' '\00bb' '\201c' '\201d' } /* « » “ ” */ :root:lang(kam), :not(:lang(kam)) > :lang(kam) { quotes: '\201c' '\201d' '\2018' '\2019' } /* “ ” ‘ ’ */ :root:lang(kde), :not(:lang(kde)) > :lang(kde) { quotes: '\201c' '\201d' '\2018' '\2019' } /* “ ” ‘ ’ */ :root:lang(kea), :not(:lang(kea)) > :lang(kea) { quotes: '\201c' '\201d' '\2018' '\2019' } /* “ ” ‘ ’ */ :root:lang(khq), :not(:lang(khq)) > :lang(khq) { quotes: '\201c' '\201d' '\2018' '\2019' } /* “ ” ‘ ’ */ :root:lang(ki), :not(:lang(ki)) > :lang(ki) { quotes: '\201c' '\201d' '\2018' '\2019' } /* “ ” ‘ ’ */ :root:lang(kkj), :not(:lang(kkj)) > :lang(kkj) { quotes: '\00ab' '\00bb' '\2039' '\203a' } /* « » ‹ › */ :root:lang(kln), :not(:lang(kln)) > :lang(kln) { quotes: '\201c' '\201d' '\2018' '\2019' } /* “ ” ‘ ’ */ :root:lang(km), :not(:lang(km)) > :lang(km) { quotes: '\201c' '\201d' '\2018' '\2019' } /* “ ” ‘ ’ */ :root:lang(kn), :not(:lang(kn)) > :lang(kn) { quotes: '\201c' '\201d' '\2018' '\2019' } /* “ ” ‘ ’ */ :root:lang(ko), :not(:lang(ko)) > :lang(ko) { quotes: '\201c' '\201d' '\2018' '\2019' } /* “ ” ‘ ’ */ :root:lang(ksb), :not(:lang(ksb)) > :lang(ksb) { quotes: '\201c' '\201d' '\2018' '\2019' } /* “ ” ‘ ’ */ :root:lang(ksf), :not(:lang(ksf)) > :lang(ksf) { quotes: '\00ab' '\00bb' '\2018' '\2019' } /* « » ‘ ’ */ :root:lang(lag), :not(:lang(lag)) > :lang(lag) { quotes: '\201d' '\201d' '\2019' '\2019' } /* ” ” ’ ’ */ :root:lang(lg), :not(:lang(lg)) > :lang(lg) { quotes: '\201c' '\201d' '\2018' '\2019' } /* “ ” ‘ ’ */ :root:lang(ln), :not(:lang(ln)) > :lang(ln) { quotes: '\201c' '\201d' '\2018' '\2019' } /* “ ” ‘ ’ */ :root:lang(lo), :not(:lang(lo)) > :lang(lo) { quotes: '\201c' '\201d' '\2018' '\2019' } /* “ ” ‘ ’ */ :root:lang(lt), :not(:lang(lt)) > :lang(lt) { quotes: '\201e' '\201c' '\201e' '\201c' } /* „ “ „ “ */ :root:lang(lu), :not(:lang(lu)) > :lang(lu) { quotes: '\201c' '\201d' '\2018' '\2019' } /* “ ” ‘ ’ */ :root:lang(luo), :not(:lang(luo)) > :lang(luo) { quotes: '\201c' '\201d' '\2018' '\2019' } /* “ ” ‘ ’ */ :root:lang(luy), :not(:lang(luy)) > :lang(luy) { quotes: '\201e' '\201c' '\201a' '\2018' } /* „ “ ‚ ‘ */ :root:lang(lv), :not(:lang(lv)) > :lang(lv) { quotes: '\201c' '\201d' '\2018' '\2019' } /* “ ” ‘ ’ */ :root:lang(mas), :not(:lang(mas)) > :lang(mas) { quotes: '\201c' '\201d' '\2018' '\2019' } /* “ ” ‘ ’ */ :root:lang(mer), :not(:lang(mer)) > :lang(mer) { quotes: '\201c' '\201d' '\2018' '\2019' } /* “ ” ‘ ’ */ :root:lang(mfe), :not(:lang(mfe)) > :lang(mfe) { quotes: '\201c' '\201d' '\2018' '\2019' } /* “ ” ‘ ’ */ :root:lang(mg), :not(:lang(mg)) > :lang(mg) { quotes: '\00ab' '\00bb' '\201c' '\201d' } /* « » “ ” */ :root:lang(mgo), :not(:lang(mgo)) > :lang(mgo) { quotes: '\201c' '\201d' '\2018' '\2019' } /* “ ” ‘ ’ */ :root:lang(mk), :not(:lang(mk)) > :lang(mk) { quotes: '\201e' '\201c' '\201a' '\2018' } /* „ “ ‚ ‘ */ :root:lang(ml), :not(:lang(ml)) > :lang(ml) { quotes: '\201c' '\201d' '\2018' '\2019' } /* “ ” ‘ ’ */ :root:lang(mr), :not(:lang(mr)) > :lang(mr) { quotes: '\201c' '\201d' '\2018' '\2019' } /* “ ” ‘ ’ */ :root:lang(ms), :not(:lang(ms)) > :lang(ms) { quotes: '\201c' '\201d' '\2018' '\2019' } /* “ ” ‘ ’ */ :root:lang(mua), :not(:lang(mua)) > :lang(mua) { quotes: '\00ab' '\00bb' '\201c' '\201d' } /* « » “ ” */ :root:lang(my), :not(:lang(my)) > :lang(my) { quotes: '\201c' '\201d' '\2018' '\2019' } /* “ ” ‘ ’ */ :root:lang(naq), :not(:lang(naq)) > :lang(naq) { quotes: '\201c' '\201d' '\2018' '\2019' } /* “ ” ‘ ’ */ :root:lang(nb), :not(:lang(nb)) > :lang(nb) { quotes: '\00ab' '\00bb' '\2018' '\2019' } /* « » ‘ ’ */ :root:lang(nd), :not(:lang(nd)) > :lang(nd) { quotes: '\201c' '\201d' '\2018' '\2019' } /* “ ” ‘ ’ */ :root:lang(nl), :not(:lang(nl)) > :lang(nl) { quotes: '\201c' '\201d' '\2018' '\2019' } /* “ ” ‘ ’ */ :root:lang(nmg), :not(:lang(nmg)) > :lang(nmg) { quotes: '\201e' '\201d' '\00ab' '\00bb' } /* „ ” « » */ :root:lang(nn), :not(:lang(nn)) > :lang(nn) { quotes: '\00ab' '\00bb' '\2018' '\2019' } /* « » ‘ ’ */ :root:lang(nnh), :not(:lang(nnh)) > :lang(nnh) { quotes: '\00ab' '\00bb' '\201c' '\201d' } /* « » “ ” */ :root:lang(nus), :not(:lang(nus)) > :lang(nus) { quotes: '\201c' '\201d' '\2018' '\2019' } /* “ ” ‘ ’ */ :root:lang(nyn), :not(:lang(nyn)) > :lang(nyn) { quotes: '\201c' '\201d' '\2018' '\2019' } /* “ ” ‘ ’ */ :root:lang(pl), :not(:lang(pl)) > :lang(pl) { quotes: '\201e' '\201d' '\00ab' '\00bb' } /* „ ” « » */ :root:lang(pt), :not(:lang(pt)) > :lang(pt) { quotes: '\201c' '\201d' '\2018' '\2019' } /* “ ” ‘ ’ */ :root:lang(pt-PT), :not(:lang(pt-PT)) > :lang(pt-PT) { quotes: '\00ab' '\00bb' '\201c' '\201d' } /* « » “ ” */ :root:lang(rn), :not(:lang(rn)) > :lang(rn) { quotes: '\201d' '\201d' '\2019' '\2019' } /* ” ” ’ ’ */ :root:lang(ro), :not(:lang(ro)) > :lang(ro) { quotes: '\201e' '\201d' '\00ab' '\00bb' } /* „ ” « » */ :root:lang(rof), :not(:lang(rof)) > :lang(rof) { quotes: '\201c' '\201d' '\2018' '\2019' } /* “ ” ‘ ’ */ :root:lang(ru), :not(:lang(ru)) > :lang(ru) { quotes: '\00ab' '\00bb' '\201e' '\201c' } /* « » „ “ */ :root:lang(rw), :not(:lang(rw)) > :lang(rw) { quotes: '\00ab' '\00bb' '\2018' '\2019' } /* « » ‘ ’ */ :root:lang(rwk), :not(:lang(rwk)) > :lang(rwk) { quotes: '\201c' '\201d' '\2018' '\2019' } /* “ ” ‘ ’ */ :root:lang(saq), :not(:lang(saq)) > :lang(saq) { quotes: '\201c' '\201d' '\2018' '\2019' } /* “ ” ‘ ’ */ :root:lang(sbp), :not(:lang(sbp)) > :lang(sbp) { quotes: '\201c' '\201d' '\2018' '\2019' } /* “ ” ‘ ’ */ :root:lang(seh), :not(:lang(seh)) > :lang(seh) { quotes: '\201c' '\201d' '\2018' '\2019' } /* “ ” ‘ ’ */ :root:lang(ses), :not(:lang(ses)) > :lang(ses) { quotes: '\201c' '\201d' '\2018' '\2019' } /* “ ” ‘ ’ */ :root:lang(sg), :not(:lang(sg)) > :lang(sg) { quotes: '\00ab' '\00bb' '\201c' '\201d' } /* « » “ ” */ :root:lang(shi), :not(:lang(shi)) > :lang(shi) { quotes: '\00ab' '\00bb' '\201e' '\201d' } /* « » „ ” */ :root:lang(shi-Latn), :not(:lang(shi-Latn)) > :lang(shi-Latn) { quotes: '\00ab' '\00bb' '\201e' '\201d' } /* « » „ ” */ :root:lang(si), :not(:lang(si)) > :lang(si) { quotes: '\201c' '\201d' '\2018' '\2019' } /* “ ” ‘ ’ */ :root:lang(sk), :not(:lang(sk)) > :lang(sk) { quotes: '\201e' '\201c' '\201a' '\2018' } /* „ “ ‚ ‘ */ :root:lang(sl), :not(:lang(sl)) > :lang(sl) { quotes: '\201e' '\201c' '\201a' '\2018' } /* „ “ ‚ ‘ */ :root:lang(sn), :not(:lang(sn)) > :lang(sn) { quotes: '\201d' '\201d' '\2019' '\2019' } /* ” ” ’ ’ */ :root:lang(so), :not(:lang(so)) > :lang(so) { quotes: '\201c' '\201d' '\2018' '\2019' } /* “ ” ‘ ’ */ :root:lang(sq), :not(:lang(sq)) > :lang(sq) { quotes: '\201e' '\201c' '\201a' '\2018' } /* „ “ ‚ ‘ */ :root:lang(sr), :not(:lang(sr)) > :lang(sr) { quotes: '\201e' '\201c' '\201a' '\2018' } /* „ “ ‚ ‘ */ :root:lang(sr-Latn), :not(:lang(sr-Latn)) > :lang(sr-Latn) { quotes: '\201e' '\201c' '\201a' '\2018' } /* „ “ ‚ ‘ */ :root:lang(sv), :not(:lang(sv)) > :lang(sv) { quotes: '\201d' '\201d' '\2019' '\2019' } /* ” ” ’ ’ */ :root:lang(sw), :not(:lang(sw)) > :lang(sw) { quotes: '\201c' '\201d' '\2018' '\2019' } /* “ ” ‘ ’ */ :root:lang(swc), :not(:lang(swc)) > :lang(swc) { quotes: '\201c' '\201d' '\2018' '\2019' } /* “ ” ‘ ’ */ :root:lang(ta), :not(:lang(ta)) > :lang(ta) { quotes: '\201c' '\201d' '\2018' '\2019' } /* “ ” ‘ ’ */ :root:lang(te), :not(:lang(te)) > :lang(te) { quotes: '\201c' '\201d' '\2018' '\2019' } /* “ ” ‘ ’ */ :root:lang(teo), :not(:lang(teo)) > :lang(teo) { quotes: '\201c' '\201d' '\2018' '\2019' } /* “ ” ‘ ’ */ :root:lang(th), :not(:lang(th)) > :lang(th) { quotes: '\201c' '\201d' '\2018' '\2019' } /* “ ” ‘ ’ */ :root:lang(ti-ER), :not(:lang(ti-ER)) > :lang(ti-ER) { quotes: '\2018' '\2019' '\201c' '\201d' } /* ‘ ’ “ ” */ :root:lang(to), :not(:lang(to)) > :lang(to) { quotes: '\201c' '\201d' '\2018' '\2019' } /* “ ” ‘ ’ */ :root:lang(tr), :not(:lang(tr)) > :lang(tr) { quotes: '\201c' '\201d' '\2018' '\2019' } /* “ ” ‘ ’ */ :root:lang(twq), :not(:lang(twq)) > :lang(twq) { quotes: '\201c' '\201d' '\2018' '\2019' } /* “ ” ‘ ’ */ :root:lang(tzm), :not(:lang(tzm)) > :lang(tzm) { quotes: '\201c' '\201d' '\2018' '\2019' } /* “ ” ‘ ’ */ :root:lang(uk), :not(:lang(uk)) > :lang(uk) { quotes: '\00ab' '\00bb' '\201e' '\201c' } /* « » „ “ */ :root:lang(ur), :not(:lang(ur)) > :lang(ur) { quotes: '\201d' '\201c' '\2019' '\2018' } /* ” “ ’ ‘ */ :root:lang(vai), :not(:lang(vai)) > :lang(vai) { quotes: '\201c' '\201d' '\2018' '\2019' } /* “ ” ‘ ’ */ :root:lang(vai-Latn), :not(:lang(vai-Latn)) > :lang(vai-Latn) { quotes: '\201c' '\201d' '\2018' '\2019' } /* “ ” ‘ ’ */ :root:lang(vi), :not(:lang(vi)) > :lang(vi) { quotes: '\201c' '\201d' '\2018' '\2019' } /* “ ” ‘ ’ */ :root:lang(vun), :not(:lang(vun)) > :lang(vun) { quotes: '\201c' '\201d' '\2018' '\2019' } /* “ ” ‘ ’ */ :root:lang(xh), :not(:lang(xh)) > :lang(xh) { quotes: '\2018' '\2019' '\201c' '\201d' } /* ‘ ’ “ ” */ :root:lang(xog), :not(:lang(xog)) > :lang(xog) { quotes: '\201c' '\201d' '\2018' '\2019' } /* “ ” ‘ ’ */ :root:lang(yav), :not(:lang(yav)) > :lang(yav) { quotes: '\00ab' '\00bb' '\00ab' '\00bb' } /* « » « » */ :root:lang(yo), :not(:lang(yo)) > :lang(yo) { quotes: '\201c' '\201d' '\2018' '\2019' } /* “ ” ‘ ’ */ :root:lang(zh), :not(:lang(zh)) > :lang(zh) { quotes: '\201c' '\201d' '\2018' '\2019' } /* “ ” ‘ ’ */ :root:lang(zh-Hant), :not(:lang(zh-Hant)) > :lang(zh-Hant) { quotes: '\300c' '\300d' '\300e' '\300f' } /* 「 」 『 』 */ :root:lang(zu), :not(:lang(zu)) > :lang(zu) { quotes: '\201c' '\201d' '\2018' '\2019' } /* “ ” ‘ ’ */
@namespace url(http://www.w3.org/1999/xhtml); article, aside, h1, h2, h3, h4, h5, h6, hgroup, nav, section { display: block; } h1 { margin-top: 0.67em; margin-bottom: 0.67em; font-size: 2.00em; font-weight: bold; } h2 { margin-top: 0.83em; margin-bottom: 0.83em; font-size: 1.50em; font-weight: bold; } h3 { margin-top: 1.00em; margin-bottom: 1.00em; font-size: 1.17em; font-weight: bold; } h4 { margin-top: 1.33em; margin-bottom: 1.33em; font-size: 1.00em; font-weight: bold; } h5 { margin-top: 1.67em; margin-bottom: 1.67em; font-size: 0.83em; font-weight: bold; } h6 { margin-top: 2.33em; margin-bottom: 2.33em; font-size: 0.67em; font-weight: bold; }
The article
, aside
, nav
та section
elements are
expected to affect the margins and font size of h1
elements, as well as h2
–h5
elements that follow h1
elements in hgroup
elements, based
on the nesting depth. Якщо x is a
selector that matches elements що є either article
,
aside
, nav
,
or section
elements,
then the following rules capture what is expected:
@namespace url(http://www.w3.org/1999/xhtml); x h1 { margin-top: 0.83em; margin-bottom: 0.83em; font-size: 1.50em; } x x h1 { margin-top: 1.00em; margin-bottom: 1.00em; font-size: 1.17em; } x x x h1 { margin-top: 1.33em; margin-bottom: 1.33em; font-size: 1.00em; } x x x x h1 { margin-top: 1.67em; margin-bottom: 1.67em; font-size: 0.83em; } x x x x x h1 { margin-top: 2.33em; margin-bottom: 2.33em; font-size: 0.67em; } x hgroup > h1 ~ h2 { margin-top: 1.00em; margin-bottom: 1.00em; font-size: 1.17em; } x x hgroup > h1 ~ h2 { margin-top: 1.33em; margin-bottom: 1.33em; font-size: 1.00em; } x x x hgroup > h1 ~ h2 { margin-top: 1.67em; margin-bottom: 1.67em; font-size: 0.83em; } x x x x hgroup > h1 ~ h2 { margin-top: 2.33em; margin-bottom: 2.33em; font-size: 0.67em; } x hgroup > h1 ~ h3 { margin-top: 1.33em; margin-bottom: 1.33em; font-size: 1.00em; } x x hgroup > h1 ~ h3 { margin-top: 1.67em; margin-bottom: 1.67em; font-size: 0.83em; } x x x hgroup > h1 ~ h3 { margin-top: 2.33em; margin-bottom: 2.33em; font-size: 0.67em; } x hgroup > h1 ~ h4 { margin-top: 1.67em; margin-bottom: 1.67em; font-size: 0.83em; } x x hgroup > h1 ~ h4 { margin-top: 2.33em; margin-bottom: 2.33em; font-size: 0.67em; } x hgroup > h1 ~ h5 { margin-top: 2.33em; margin-bottom: 2.33em; font-size: 0.67em; }
@namespace url(http://www.w3.org/1999/xhtml); dir, dd, dl, dt, ol, ul { display: block; } li { display: list-item; } dir, dl, ol, ul { margin-top: 1em; margin-bottom: 1em; } dir dir, dir dl, dir ol, dir ul, dl dir, dl dl, dl ol, dl ul, ol dir, ol dl, ol ol, ol ul, ul dir, ul dl, ul ol, ul ul { margin-top: 0; margin-bottom: 0; } dd { margin-left: 40px; } /* LTR-specific: use 'margin-right' for rtl elements */ dir, ol, ul { padding-left: 40px; } /* LTR-specific: use 'padding-right' for rtl elements */ ol { list-style-type: decimal; } dir, ul { list-style-type: disc; } dir dir, dir ul, ol dir, ol ul, ul dir, ul ul { list-style-type: circle; } dir dir dir, dir dir ul, dir ol dir, dir ol ul, dir ul dir, dir ul ul, ol dir dir, ol dir ul, ol ol dir, ol ol ul, ol ul dir, ol ul ul, ul dir dir, ul dir ul, ul ol dir, ul ol ul, ul ul dir, ul ul ul { list-style-type: square; }
The following rules are also expected to apply, as presentational hints:
@namespace url(http://www.w3.org/1999/xhtml); ol[type=1], li[type=1] { list-style-type: decimal; } ol[type=a], li[type=a] { list-style-type: lower-alpha; } ol[type=A], li[type=A] { list-style-type: upper-alpha; } ol[type=i], li[type=i] { list-style-type: lower-roman; } ol[type=I], li[type=I] { list-style-type: upper-roman; } ul[type=disc i], li[type=disc i] { list-style-type: disc; } ul[type=circle i], li[type=circle i] { list-style-type: circle; } ul[type=square i], li[type=square i] { list-style-type: square; }
When rendering li
elements,
non-CSS user agents are expected to use the ordinal
value of the li
element to render the counter in the list item marker.
This specification does not
yet define the CSS-specific rules for rendering li
elements, because CSS doesn't yet provide sufficient hooks for this
purpose.
@namespace url(http://www.w3.org/1999/xhtml); table { display: table; } caption { display: table-caption; } colgroup, colgroup[hidden] { display: table-column-group; } col, col[hidden] { display: table-column; } thead, thead[hidden] { display: table-header-group; } tbody, tbody[hidden] { display: table-row-group; } tfoot, tfoot[hidden] { display: table-footer-group; } tr, tr[hidden] { display: table-row; } td, th, td[hidden], th[hidden] { display: table-cell; } colgroup[hidden], col[hidden], thead[hidden], tbody[hidden], tfoot[hidden], tr[hidden], td[hidden], th[hidden] { visibility: collapse; } table { box-sizing: border-box; border-spacing: 2px; border-collapse: separate; text-indent: initial; } td, th { padding: 1px; } th { font-weight: bold; } thead, tbody, tfoot, table > tr { vertical-align: middle; } tr, td, th { vertical-align: inherit; } table, td, th { border-color: gray; } thead, tbody, tfoot, tr { border-color: inherit; } table[rules=none i], table[rules=groups i], table[rules=rows i], table[rules=cols i], table[rules=all i], table[frame=void i], table[frame=above i], table[frame=below i], table[frame=hsides i], table[frame=lhs i], table[frame=rhs i], table[frame=vsides i], table[frame=box i], table[frame=border i], table[rules=none i] > tr > td, table[rules=none i] > tr > th, table[rules=groups i] > tr > td, table[rules=groups i] > tr > th, table[rules=rows i] > tr > td, table[rules=rows i] > tr > th, table[rules=cols i] > tr > td, table[rules=cols i] > tr > th, table[rules=all i] > tr > td, table[rules=all i] > tr > th, table[rules=none i] > thead > tr > td, table[rules=none i] > thead > tr > th, table[rules=groups i] > thead > tr > td, table[rules=groups i] > thead > tr > th, table[rules=rows i] > thead > tr > td, table[rules=rows i] > thead > tr > th, table[rules=cols i] > thead > tr > td, table[rules=cols i] > thead > tr > th, table[rules=all i] > thead > tr > td, table[rules=all i] > thead > tr > th, table[rules=none i] > tbody > tr > td, table[rules=none i] > tbody > tr > th, table[rules=groups i] > tbody > tr > td, table[rules=groups i] > tbody > tr > th, table[rules=rows i] > tbody > tr > td, table[rules=rows i] > tbody > tr > th, table[rules=cols i] > tbody > tr > td, table[rules=cols i] > tbody > tr > th, table[rules=all i] > tbody > tr > td, table[rules=all i] > tbody > tr > th, table[rules=none i] > tfoot > tr > td, table[rules=none i] > tfoot > tr > th, table[rules=groups i] > tfoot > tr > td, table[rules=groups i] > tfoot > tr > th, table[rules=rows i] > tfoot > tr > td, table[rules=rows i] > tfoot > tr > th, table[rules=cols i] > tfoot > tr > td, table[rules=cols i] > tfoot > tr > th, table[rules=all i] > tfoot > tr > td, table[rules=all i] > tfoot > tr > th { border-color: black; }
The following rules are also expected to apply, as presentational hints:
@namespace url(http://www.w3.org/1999/xhtml); table[align=left i] { float: left; } table[align=right i] { float: right; } table[align=center i] { margin-left: auto; margin-right: auto; } thead[align=absmiddle i], tbody[align=absmiddle i], tfoot[align=absmiddle i], tr[align=absmiddle i], td[align=absmiddle i], th[align=absmiddle i] { text-align: center; } caption[align=bottom i] { caption-side: bottom; } p[align=left i], h1[align=left i], h2[align=left i], h3[align=left i], h4[align=left i], h5[align=left i], h6[align=left i] { text-align: left; } p[align=right i], h1[align=right i], h2[align=right i], h3[align=right i], h4[align=right i], h5[align=right i], h6[align=right i] { text-align: right; } p[align=center i], h1[align=center i], h2[align=center i], h3[align=center i], h4[align=center i], h5[align=center i], h6[align=center i] { text-align: center; } p[align=justify i], h1[align=justify i], h2[align=justify i], h3[align=justify i], h4[align=justify i], h5[align=justify i], h6[align=justify i] { text-align: justify; } thead[valign=top i], tbody[valign=top i], tfoot[valign=top i], tr[valign=top i], td[valign=top i], th[valign=top i] { vertical-align: top; } thead[valign=middle i], tbody[valign=middle i], tfoot[valign=middle i], tr[valign=middle i], td[valign=middle i], th[valign=middle i] { vertical-align: middle; } thead[valign=bottom i], tbody[valign=bottom i], tfoot[valign=bottom i], tr[valign=bottom i], td[valign=bottom i], th[valign=bottom i] { vertical-align: bottom; } thead[valign=baseline i], tbody[valign=baseline i], tfoot[valign=baseline i], tr[valign=baseline i], td[valign=baseline i], th[valign=baseline i] { vertical-align: baseline; } td[nowrap], th[nowrap] { white-space: nowrap; } table[rules=none i], table[rules=groups i], table[rules=rows i], table[rules=cols i], table[rules=all i] { border-style: hidden; border-collapse: collapse; } table[border] { border-style: outset; } /* only if border is not equivalent to zero */ table[frame=void i] { border-style: hidden; } table[frame=above i] { border-style: outset hidden hidden hidden; } table[frame=below i] { border-style: hidden hidden outset hidden; } table[frame=hsides i] { border-style: outset hidden outset hidden; } table[frame=lhs i] { border-style: hidden hidden hidden outset; } table[frame=rhs i] { border-style: hidden outset hidden hidden; } table[frame=vsides i] { border-style: hidden outset; } table[frame=box i], table[frame=border i] { border-style: outset; } table[border] > tr > td, table[border] > tr > th, table[border] > thead > tr > td, table[border] > thead > tr > th, table[border] > tbody > tr > td, table[border] > tbody > tr > th, table[border] > tfoot > tr > td, table[border] > tfoot > tr > th { /* only if border is not equivalent to zero */ border-width: 1px; border-style: inset; } table[rules=none i] > tr > td, table[rules=none i] > tr > th, table[rules=none i] > thead > tr > td, table[rules=none i] > thead > tr > th, table[rules=none i] > tbody > tr > td, table[rules=none i] > tbody > tr > th, table[rules=none i] > tfoot > tr > td, table[rules=none i] > tfoot > tr > th, table[rules=groups i] > tr > td, table[rules=groups i] > tr > th, table[rules=groups i] > thead > tr > td, table[rules=groups i] > thead > tr > th, table[rules=groups i] > tbody > tr > td, table[rules=groups i] > tbody > tr > th, table[rules=groups i] > tfoot > tr > td, table[rules=groups i] > tfoot > tr > th, table[rules=rows i] > tr > td, table[rules=rows i] > tr > th, table[rules=rows i] > thead > tr > td, table[rules=rows i] > thead > tr > th, table[rules=rows i] > tbody > tr > td, table[rules=rows i] > tbody > tr > th, table[rules=rows i] > tfoot > tr > td, table[rules=rows i] > tfoot > tr > th { border-width: 1px; border-style: none; } table[rules=cols i] > tr > td, table[rules=cols i] > tr > th, table[rules=cols i] > thead > tr > td, table[rules=cols i] > thead > tr > th, table[rules=cols i] > tbody > tr > td, table[rules=cols i] > tbody > tr > th, table[rules=cols i] > tfoot > tr > td, table[rules=cols i] > tfoot > tr > th { border-width: 1px; border-style: none solid; } table[rules=all i] > tr > td, table[rules=all i] > tr > th, table[rules=all i] > thead > tr > td, table[rules=all i] > thead > tr > th, table[rules=all i] > tbody > tr > td, table[rules=all i] > tbody > tr > th, table[rules=all i] > tfoot > tr > td, table[rules=all i] > tfoot > tr > th { border-width: 1px; border-style: solid; } table[rules=groups i] > colgroup { border-left-width: 1px; border-left-style: solid; border-right-width: 1px; border-right-style: solid; } table[rules=groups i] > thead, table[rules=groups i] > tbody, table[rules=groups i] > tfoot { border-top-width: 1px; border-top-style: solid; border-bottom-width: 1px; border-bottom-style: solid; } table[rules=rows i] > tr, table[rules=rows i] > thead > tr, table[rules=rows i] > tbody > tr, table[rules=rows i] > tfoot > tr { border-top-width: 1px; border-top-style: solid; border-bottom-width: 1px; border-bottom-style: solid; }
In quirks mode, the following rules are also expected to apply:
@namespace url(http://www.w3.org/1999/xhtml); table { font-weight: initial; font-style: initial; font-variant: initial; font-size: initial; line-height: initial; white-space: initial; text-align: initial; }
For the purposes of the CSS table model, the col
element is expected to be treated as if it was present as many times as
its span
attribute specifies.
For the purposes of the CSS table model, the colgroup
element, if it contains no col
element, is expected to be treated as if it had as many such children as
its span
attribute specifies.
For the purposes of the CSS table model, the colspan
and rowspan
attributes on td
and th
elements are expected to provide the special
knowledge regarding cells spanning rows and columns.
In HTML documents, the user agent is
expected to force the 'display' property of form
elements що є children of table
,
thead
, tbody
,
tfoot
, or tr
elements to compute to 'none', irrespective of CSS rules.
The table
element's cellspacing
attribute maps to the
pixel length property 'border-spacing' on the element.
The table
element's cellpadding
attribute maps
to the pixel length properties 'padding-top', 'padding-right',
'padding-bottom' та 'padding-left' of any td
and th
elements that have
corresponding cells
in the table
corresponding to the table
element.
The table
element's hspace
attribute maps to the dimension
properties 'margin-left' and 'margin-right' on the table
element.
The table
element's vspace
attribute maps to the dimension
properties 'margin-top' and 'margin-bottom' on the table
element.
The table
element's height
attribute maps
to the dimension property 'height' on the table
element.
The table
element's width
attribute maps to the
dimension property 'width' on the table
element.
The col
element's width
attribute maps
to the dimension property 'width' on the col
element.
The tr
element's height
attribute maps to the
dimension property 'height' on the tr
element.
The td
and th
elements' height
attributes map
to the dimension property 'height' on the element.
The td
and th
elements' width
attributes map
to the dimension property 'width' on the element.
The caption
element
unless specified otherwise below та the thead
,
tbody
, tfoot
,
tr
, td
та th
elements when they
have an align
attribute whose value is an ASCII
чутливі до реєстру match for either the string "center
"
or the string "middle
", are expected to
center text within themselves, as if they had their 'text-align'
property set to 'center' in a presentational hint та to align
descendants to the center.
The caption
, thead
, tbody
,
tfoot
, tr
,
td
та th
elements, when they have an align
attribute whose value is an ASCII
чутливі до реєстру match for the string "left
",
are expected to left-align text within themselves, as if they had their
'text-align' property set to 'left' in a presentational hint та to align
descendants to the left.
The caption
, thead
, tbody
,
tfoot
, tr
,
td
та th
elements, when they have an align
attribute whose value is an ASCII
чутливі до реєстру match for the string "right
",
are expected to right-align text within themselves, as if they had their
'text-align' property set to 'right' in a presentational hint та to align
descendants to the right.
The caption
, thead
, tbody
,
tfoot
, tr
,
td
та th
elements, when they have an align
attribute whose value is an ASCII
чутливі до реєстру match for the string "justify
",
are expected to full-justify text within themselves, as if they had
their 'text-align' property set to 'justify' in a presentational hint та to align
descendants to the left.
User agents are expected to have a rule in their user agent stylesheet
that matches th
elements
that have a parent node whose computed value for the 'text-align'
property is its initial value, whose declaration block consists of just
a single declaration that sets the 'text-align' property to the value
'center'.
When a table
, thead
, tbody
,
tfoot
, tr
,
td
, or th
element has a background
attribute set to a non-empty value, the new value is expected to be resolved
relative to the element та if this is successful, the user agent is
expected to treat the attribute as a presentational hint setting the
element's 'background-image' property to the resulting absolute
URL.
When a table
, thead
, tbody
,
tfoot
, tr
,
td
, or th
element has a bgcolor
attribute set,
the new value is expected to be parsed using the rules
for parsing a legacy color value та if that does not return an
error, the user agent is expected to treat the attribute as a presentational hint setting the
element's 'background-color' property to the resulting color.
When a table
element has
a bordercolor
attribute, its value is expected to be parsed using the rules
for parsing a legacy color value та if that does not return an
error, the user agent is expected to treat the attribute as a presentational hint setting the
element's 'border-top-color', 'border-right-color',
'border-bottom-color' та 'border-right-color' properties to the
resulting color.
The table
element's border
attribute maps
to the pixel length properties 'border-top-width',
'border-right-width', 'border-bottom-width', 'border-left-width' on the
element. Якщо the attribute is present but parsing the attribute's value
using the rules for
parsing non-negative integers generates an error, a default value
of 1px is expected to be used for that property instead.
Rules marked "only if border is not
equivalent to zero" in the CSS block above is expected to only
be applied if the border
attribute mentioned in the selectors for the rule is not only present
but, when parsed using the rules
for parsing non-negative integers, is also found to have a value
other than zero or to generate an error.
In quirks mode, a td
element or a th
element that
has a nowrap
attribute but also has a width
attribute whose value, when parsed using the rules
for parsing dimension values, is found to be a length (not an
error or a number classified as a percentage), is expected to have a presentational
hint setting the element's 'white-space' property to 'normal',
overriding the rule in the CSS block above that sets it to 'nowrap'.
A node is substantial if it is a text node that is not inter-element whitespace, or if it is an element node.
A node is blank if it is an element that contains no substantial nodes.
The elements
with default margins are the following elements: blockquote
,
dir
, dl
,
h1
,
h2
,
h3
,
h4
,
h5
,
h6
,
listing
, multicol
,
ol
, p
,
plaintext
, pre
,
ul
, xmp
In quirks mode, any element with default
margins that is the child of a body
,
td
, or th
element and has no substantial previous
siblings is expected to have a user-agent level style sheet rule that
sets its 'margin-top' property to zero.
In quirks mode, any element with default
margins that is the child of a body
,
td
, or th
element, has no substantial
previous siblings та is blank,
is expected to have a user-agent level style sheet rule that sets its
'margin-bottom' property to zero also.
In quirks mode, any element with default
margins that is the child of a td
or th
element, has no substantial following
siblings та is blank,
is expected to have a user-agent level style sheet rule that sets its
'margin-top' property to zero.
In quirks mode, any p
element that is the child of a td
or th
element and has no substantial
following siblings, is expected to have a user-agent level style sheet
rule that sets its 'margin-bottom' property to zero.
@namespace url(http://www.w3.org/1999/xhtml); input, select, option, optgroup, button, textarea, keygen { text-indent: initial; } textarea { white-space: pre-wrap; } input[type="radio"], input[type="checkbox"], input[type="reset"], input[type="button"], input[type="submit"], select, button { box-sizing: border-box; }
In quirks mode, the following rules are also expected to apply:
@namespace url(http://www.w3.org/1999/xhtml); input:not([type=image]), textarea { box-sizing: border-box; }
Each kind of form control is also given a specific default binding, as described in subsequent sections, which implements the look and feel of the control.
hr
element@namespace url(http://www.w3.org/1999/xhtml); hr { color: gray; border-style: inset; border-width: 1px; margin: 0.5em auto; }
The following rules are also expected to apply, as presentational hints:
@namespace url(http://www.w3.org/1999/xhtml); hr[align=left] { margin-left: 0; margin-right: auto; } hr[align=right] { margin-left: auto; margin-right: 0; } hr[align=center] { margin-left: auto; margin-right: auto; } hr[color], hr[noshade] { border-style: solid; }
Якщо an hr
element hяк або
a color
attribute or a noshade
attribute та furthermore also has a size
attribute та parsing that
attribute's value using the rules
for parsing non-negative integers doesn't generate an error, then
the user agent is expected to use the parsed value divided by two as a
pixel length for presentational hints
for the properties 'border-top-width', 'border-right-width',
'border-bottom-width' та 'border-left-width' on the element.
Інакше if an hr
element has
neither a color
attribute nor a noshade
attribute, but does have a size
attribute та parsing that attribute's value using the rules
for parsing non-negative integers doesn't generate an error, then:
if the parsed value is one, then the user agent is expected to use the
attribute as a presentational
hint setting the element's 'border-bottom-width' to 0; otherwise,
if the parsed value is greater than one, then the user agent is expected
to use the parsed value minus two as a pixel length for presentational
hints for the 'height' property on the element.
The width
attribute on an hr
element maps to the dimension property
'width' on the element.
When an hr
element has a color
attribute, its value is expected to be parsed using the rules
for parsing a legacy color value та if that does not return an
error, the user agent is expected to treat the attribute as a presentational hint setting the
element's 'color' property to the resulting color.
fieldset
and legend
elements@namespace url(http://www.w3.org/1999/xhtml); fieldset { margin-left: 2px; margin-right: 2px; border: groove 2px ThreeDFace; padding: 0.35em 0.625em 0.75em; } legend { padding-left: 2px; padding-right: 2px; }
The fieldset
element
is expected to establish a new block formatting context.
Якщо the fieldset
element has a child that matches the conditions in the list below, then
the first such child is the fieldset
element's rendered legend:
legend
element.A fieldset
element's
rendered legend, if any, is expected to
be rendered over the top border edge of the fieldset
element as a 'block' box (overriding any explicit 'display' value). In
the absence of an explicit width, the box should shrink-wrap. Якщо the legend
element in question has
an align
attribute та its value is an ASCII
чутливі до реєстру match for one of the strings in the first
column of the following table, then the legend
is expected to be rendered horizontally aligned over the border edge in
the position given in the corresponding cell on the same row in the
second column. Якщо the attribute is absent or has a value that doesn't
match any of the cases in the table, then the position is expected to be
on the right if the 'direction' property on this element has a computed
value of 'rtl' та on the left otherwise.
Attribute value | Alignment position |
---|---|
left |
On the left |
right |
On the right |
center |
In the middle |
The embed
, iframe
та video
elements are
expected to be treated as replaced elements.
A canvas
element that represents embedded
content is expected to be treated as a replaced element; the
contents of such elements are the element's bitmap, if any, or else a
transparent black bitmap with the same intrinsic dimensions as the
element. Other canvas
elements are expected to be treated as ordinary elements in the
rendering model.
An object
element that
represents an image, plugin, or nested
browsing context is expected to be treated as a replaced element.
Other object
elements
are expected to be treated as ordinary elements in the rendering model.
An applet
element that
represents a plugin is
expected to be treated as a replaced element. Other applet
elements are expected to be treated as ordinary elements in the
rendering model.
The audio
element, when
it is exposing a user interface,
is expected to be treated as a replaced element about one line high, as
wide as is necessary to expose the user agent's user interface features.
When an audio
element is
not exposing
a user interface, the user agent is expected to force its
'display' property to compute to 'none', irrespective of CSS rules.
Whether a video
element
is exposing a user interface
is not expected to affect the size of the rendering; controls are
expected to be overlaid above the page content without causing any
layout changes та are expected to disappear when the user does not need
them.
When a video
element
represents a poster frame or frame of video, the poster frame or frame
of video is expected to be rendered at the largest size that maintains
the aspect ratio of that poster frame or frame of video without being
taller or wider than the video
element itself та is expected to be centered in the video
element.
Any subtitles or captions are expected to be overlayed directly on top
of their video
element,
as defined by the relevant rendering rules; for WebVTT,
those are the rules
for updating the display of WebVTT text tracks. [WEBVTT]
When the user agent starts exposing a user interface
for a video
element, the
user agent should run the rules
for updating the text track rendering of each of the text tracks in the video
element's list of text tracks що є showing
and whose text track kind is one of subtitles
or captions
(e.g., for text
tracks based on WebVTT, the rules
for updating the display of WebVTT text tracks). [WEBVTT]
Resizing video
and canvas
elements does
not interrupt video playback or clear the canvas.
The following CSS rules are expected to apply:
@namespace url(http://www.w3.org/1999/xhtml);
iframe { border: 2px inset; }
video { object-fit: contain; }
User agents are expected to render img
elements and input
elements whose type
attributes are in the Image
Button state, according to the first applicable rules from the
following list:
alt
attribute, or Document
is in quirks
mode input
elements, the element is expected to appear button-like to indicate
that the element is a button.img
element that represents
some text and the user agent does not expect this to changeimg
element that represents
nothing and the user agent does not expect this to changeinput
element that
does not represent
an image and the user agent does not expect this to changeThe icons mentioned above are expected to be relatively small so as not to disrupt most text but be easily clickable. In a visual environment, for instance, icons could be 16 pixels by 16 pixels square, or 1em by 1em if the images are scalable. In an audio environment, the icon could be a short bleep. The icons are intended to indicate to the user that they can be used to get to whatever options the UA provides for images та, where appropriate, are expected to provide access to the context menu that would have come up if the user interacted with the actual image.
All animated images with the same absolute URL and the same image data are expected to be rendered synchronized to the same timeline as a group, with the timeline starting at the time of the most recent addition to the group.
In other words, the animation loop of an animated image is restarted each time another image with the same absolute URL and image data begins to animate, e.g. after being inserted into the document.
The following CSS rules are expected to apply when the Document
is in quirks mode:
@namespace url(http://www.w3.org/1999/xhtml); img[align=left i] { margin-right: 3px; } img[align=right i] { margin-left: 3px; }
The following CSS rules are expected to apply as presentational hints:
@namespace url(http://www.w3.org/1999/xhtml); iframe[frameborder=0], iframe[frameborder=no i] { border: none; } applet[align=left i], embed[align=left i], iframe[align=left i], img[align=left i], input[type=image i][align=left i], object[align=left i] { float: left; } applet[align=right i], embed[align=right i], iframe[align=right i], img[align=right i], input[type=image i][align=right i], object[align=right i] { float: right; } applet[align=top i], embed[align=top i], iframe[align=top i], img[align=top i], input[type=image i][align=top i], object[align=top i] { vertical-align: top; } applet[align=baseline i], embed[align=baseline i], iframe[align=baseline i], img[align=baseline i], input[type=image i][align=baseline i], object[align=baseline i] { vertical-align: baseline; } applet[align=texttop i], embed[align=texttop i], iframe[align=texttop i], img[align=texttop i], input[type=image i][align=texttop i], object[align=texttop i] { vertical-align: text-top; } applet[align=absmiddle i], embed[align=absmiddle i], iframe[align=absmiddle i], img[align=absmiddle i], input[type=image i][align=absmiddle i], object[align=absmiddle i], applet[align=abscenter i], embed[align=abscenter i], iframe[align=abscenter i], img[align=abscenter i], input[type=image i][align=abscenter i], object[align=abscenter i] { vertical-align: middle; } applet[align=bottom i], embed[align=bottom i], iframe[align=bottom i], img[align=bottom i], input[type=image i][align=bottom i], object[align=bottom i] { vertical-align: bottom; }
When an applet
, embed
, iframe
,
img
, or object
element, or an input
element whose type
attribute is in the Image
Button state, has an align
attribute whose value is an ASCII
чутливі до реєстру match for the string "center
"
or the string "middle
", the user agent
is expected to act as if the element's 'vertical-align' property was set
to a value that aligns the vertical middle of the element with the
parent element's baseline.
The hspace
attribute
of applet
, embed
,
iframe
, img
,
or object
elements та input
elements with a type
attribute in the Image Button state, maps to the dimension
properties 'margin-left' and 'margin-right' on the element.
The vspace
attribute
of applet
, embed
,
iframe
, img
,
or object
elements та input
elements with a type
attribute in the Image Button state, maps to the dimension
properties 'margin-top' and 'margin-bottom' on the element.
When an img
element, object
element, or input
element with a type
attribute in the Image
Button state has a border
attribute whose value, when parsed using the rules
for parsing non-negative integers, is found to be a number greater
than zero, the user agent is expected to use the parsed value for eight
presentational hints: four setting
the parsed value as a pixel length for the element's 'border-top-width',
'border-right-width', 'border-bottom-width' та 'border-left-width'
properties та four setting the element's 'border-top-style',
'border-right-style', 'border-bottom-style' та 'border-left-style'
properties to the value 'solid'.
The width
and height
attributes on applet
, embed
, iframe
,
object
or video
elements та input
elements with a type
attribute in the Image
Button state and that either represents an image or that the user
expects will eventually represent an image, map to the dimension
properties 'width' and 'height' on the element respectively.
Shapes on an image map are expected to act,
for the purpose of the CSS cascade, as elements independent of the
original area
element that
happen to match the same style rules but inherit from the img
or object
element.
For the purposes of the rendering, only the 'cursor' property is expected to have any effect on the shape.
Thus, for example, if an area
element has a style
attribute that sets the 'cursor' property to 'help', then when the user
designates that shape, the cursor would change to a Help cursor.
Similarly, if an area
element had a CSS rule that set its 'cursor' property to 'inherit' (or
if no rule setting the 'cursor' property matched the element at all),
the shape's cursor would be inherited from the img
or object
element of the
image map, not from the parent of the area
element.
A number of elements have their rendering defined in terms of the 'binding' property. [BECSS]
The CSS snippets below set the 'binding' property to a
user-agent-defined value, represented below by keywords like button
. The rules then described for
these bindings are only expected to apply if the element's 'binding'
property has not been overridden (e.g. by the author) to have another
value.
Exactly how the bindings are implemented is not specified by this specification. User agents are encouraged to make their bindings set the 'appearance' CSS property appropriately to achieve platform-native appearances for widgets та are expected to implement any relevant animations, etc, що є appropriate for the platform. [SELECTORS]
button
element@namespace url(http://www.w3.org/1999/xhtml); button { binding: button; }
When the button binding applies to a button
element, the element is
expected to render as an 'inline-block' box rendered as a button whose
contents are the contents of the element.
input
element as a text entry widget@namespace url(http://www.w3.org/1999/xhtml); input { binding: input-textfield; } input[type=password i] { binding: input-password; } /* later rules override this for other values of type="" */
When the input-textfield binding applies to
an input
element whose type
attribute is in the Text,
Search,
Telephone,
URL,
or E-mail
state, the element is expected to render as an 'inline-block' box
rendered as a text field.
When the input-password binding applies, to
an input
element whose type
attribute is in the Password
state, the element is expected to render as an 'inline-block' box
rendered as a text field whose contents are obscured.
Якщо an input
element
whose type
attribute is in one of the above states has a size
attribute та parsing that
attribute's value using the rules
for parsing non-negative integers doesn't generate an error, then
the user agent is expected to use the attribute as a presentational hint for the 'width'
property on the element, with the value obtained from applying the converting
a character width to pixels algorithm to the value of the
attribute.
Якщо an input
element
whose type
attribute is in one of the above states does not have a size
attribute, then the user agent is expected to act as if it had a
user-agent-level style sheet rule setting the 'width' property on the
element to the value obtained from applying the converting
a character width to pixels algorithm to the number 20.
The converting a character width to pixels algorithm returns (size-1)×avg + max, where size is the character width to convert, avg is the average character width of the primary font for the element for which the algorithm is being run, in pixels та max is the maximum character width of that same font, also in pixels. (The element's 'letter-spacing' property does not affect the result.)
input
element as domain-specific widgets@namespace url(http://www.w3.org/1999/xhtml); input[type=date i] { binding: input-date; } input[type=time i] { binding: input-time; } input[type=number i] { binding: input-number; }
When the input-date binding applies to an input
element whose type
attribute is in the Date state, the element is
expected to render as an 'inline-block' box depicting a Date control.
When the input-time binding applies to an input
element whose type
attribute is in the Time state, the element is
expected to render as an 'inline-block' box depicting a Time control.
When the input-number binding applies to an
input
element whose type
attribute is in the Number
state, the element is expected to render as an 'inline-block' box
depicting a Number control.
These controls are all expected to be about one line high та about as wide as necessary to show the widest possible value.
input
element as a range
control@namespace url(http://www.w3.org/1999/xhtml); input[type=range i] { binding: input-range; }
When the input-range binding applies to an
input
element whose type
attribute is in the Range
state, the element is expected to render as an 'inline-block' box
depicting a slider control.
When the control is wider than it is tall (or square), the control is expected to be a horizontal slider, with the lowest value on the right if the 'direction' property on this element has a computed value of 'rtl' та on the left otherwise. When the control is taller than it is wide, it is expected to be a vertical slider, with the lowest value on the bottom.
Predefined suggested values (provided by the list
attribute) are expected to
be shown as tick marks on the slider, which the slider can snap to.
User agents are expected to use the used value of the 'direction' property on the element to determine the direction in which the slider operates. Typically, a left-to-right ('ltr') horizontal control would have the lowest value on the left and the highest value on the right та vice versa.
input
element as a color
well@namespace url(http://www.w3.org/1999/xhtml); input[type=color i] { binding: input-color; }
When the input-color binding applies to an
input
element whose type
attribute is in the Color
state, the element is expected to render as an 'inline-block' box
depicting a color well, which, when activated, provides the user with a
color picker (e.g. a color wheel or color palette) from which the color
can be changed.
Predefined suggested values (provided by the list
attribute) are expected to
be shown in the color picker interface, not on the color well itself.
input
element as a checkbox and radio button widgets@namespace url(http://www.w3.org/1999/xhtml); input[type=checkbox i] { binding: input-checkbox; } input[type=radio i] { binding: input-radio; }
When the input-checkbox binding applies to
an input
element whose type
attribute is in the Checkbox
state, the element is expected to render as an 'inline-block' box
containing a single checkbox control, with no label.
When the input-radio binding applies to an
input
element whose type
attribute is in the Radio
Button state, the element is expected to render as an
'inline-block' box containing a single radio button control, with no
label.
input
element as a file upload control@namespace url(http://www.w3.org/1999/xhtml); input[type=file i] { binding: input-file; }
When the input-file binding applies to an input
element whose type
attribute is in the File Upload state, the
element is expected to render as an 'inline-block' box containing a span
of text giving the file name(s) of the selected files, if any,
followed by a button that, when activated, provides the user with a file
picker from which the selection can be changed.
input
element as a button@namespace url(http://www.w3.org/1999/xhtml); input[type=submit i], input[type=reset i], input[type=button i] { binding: input-button; }
When the input-button binding applies to an
input
element whose type
attribute is in the Submit
Button, Reset
Button, or Button
state, the element is expected to render as an 'inline-block' box
rendered as a button, about one line high, containing the contents of
the element's value
attribute, if any, or text derived from the element's type
attribute in a
user-agent-defined (and probably locale-specific) fashion, if not.
marquee
element@namespace url(http://www.w3.org/1999/xhtml); marquee { binding: marquee; }
When the marquee binding applies to a marquee
element, while the
element is turned
on, the element is expected to render in an animated fashion
according to its attributes as follows:
behavior
attribute is in
the scroll
stateSlide the contents of the element in the direction described by the
direction
attribute as defined below, such that it begins off the start side
of the marquee
та
ends flush with the inner end side.
For example, if the direction
attribute is
left
(the default), then the contents would start such that their left
edge are off the side of the right edge of the marquee
's
content area та the contents would then slide up to the point where
the left edge of the contents are flush with the left inner edge of
the marquee
's
content area.
Once the animation has ended, the user agent is expected to increment the marquee current loop index. Якщо the element is still turned on after this, then the user agent is expected to restart the animation.
behavior
attribute is in
the slide
stateSlide the contents of the element in the direction described by the
direction
attribute as defined below, such that it begins off the start side
of the marquee
та
ends off the end side of the marquee
.
For example, if the direction
attribute is
left
(the default), then the contents would start such that their left
edge are off the side of the right edge of the marquee
's
content area та the contents would then slide up to the point where
the right edge of the contents are flush with the left
inner edge of the marquee
's
content area.
Once the animation has ended, the user agent is expected to increment the marquee current loop index. Якщо the element is still turned on after this, then the user agent is expected to restart the animation.
behavior
attribute is in
the alternate
stateWhen the marquee current
loop index is even (or zero), slide the contents of the
element in the direction described by the direction
attribute as
defined below, such that it begins flush with the start side of the
marquee
та ends
flush with the end side of the marquee
.
When the marquee current
loop index is odd, slide the contents of the element in the
opposite direction than that described by the direction
attribute as
defined below, such that it begins flush with the end side of the marquee
та ends flush
with the start side of the marquee
.
For example, if the direction
attribute is
left
(the default), then the contents would with their right edge flush
with the right inner edge of the marquee
's
content area та the contents would then slide up to the point where
the left edge of the contents are flush with the left
inner edge of the marquee
's
content area.
Once the animation has ended, the user agent is expected to increment the marquee current loop index. Якщо the element is still turned on after this, then the user agent is expected to continue the animation.
The direction
attribute has the meanings described in the following table:
direction
attribute state |
Direction of animation | Start edge | End edge | Opposite direction |
---|---|---|---|---|
left | ← Right to left | Right | Left | → Left to Right |
right | → Left to Right | Left | Right | ← Right to left |
up | ↑ Up (Bottom to Top) | Bottom | Top | ↓ Down (Top to Bottom) |
down | ↓ Down (Top to Bottom) | Top | Bottom | ↑ Up (Bottom to Top) |
In any case, the animation should proceed such that there is a delay given by the marquee scroll interval between each frame та such that the content moves at most the distance given by the marquee scroll distance with each frame.
When a marquee
element has a bgcolor
attribute set, the value is expected to be parsed using the rules
for parsing a legacy color value та if that does not return an
error, the user agent is expected to treat the attribute as a presentational hint setting the
element's 'background-color' property to the resulting color.
The width
and height
attributes on a marquee
element map to the dimension properties
'width' and 'height' on the element respectively.
The intrinsic height of a marquee
element with its direction
attribute in the up
or down
states is 200 CSS pixels.
The vspace
attribute of a marquee
element maps
to the dimension properties 'margin-top' and 'margin-bottom' on
the element. The hspace
attribute of a marquee
element maps
to the dimension properties 'margin-left' and 'margin-right' on
the element.
The 'overflow' property on the marquee
element is expected to be ignored; overflow is expected to always be
hidden.
meter
element@namespace url(http://www.w3.org/1999/xhtml); meter { binding: meter; }
When the meter binding applies to a meter
element, the element is
expected to render as an 'inline-block' box with a 'height' of '1em' and
a 'width' of '5em', a 'vertical-align' of '-0.2em' та with its contents
depicting a gauge.
When the element is wider than it is tall (or square), the depiction is expected to be of a horizontal gauge, with the minimum value on the right if the 'direction' property on this element has a computed value of 'rtl' та on the left otherwise. When the element is taller than it is wide, it is expected to depict a vertical gauge, with the minimum value on the bottom.
User agents are expected to use a presentation consistent with platform conventions for gauges, if any.
Requirements for what must be depicted in the gauge are
included in the definition of the meter
element.
progress
element@namespace url(http://www.w3.org/1999/xhtml); progress { binding: progress; }
When the progress binding applies to a progress
element, the
element is expected to render as an 'inline-block' box with a 'height'
of '1em' and a 'width' of '10em' та a 'vertical-align' of '-0.2em'.
When the element is wider than it is tall, the element is
expected to be depicted as a horizontal progress bar, with the start on
the right and the end on the left if the 'direction' property on this
element has a computed value of 'rtl' та with the start on the left and
the end on the right otherwise. When the element is taller than it is
wide, it is expected to depicted as a vertical progress bar, with the
lowest value on the bottom. When the element is square, it is expected
to be depicted as a direction-independent progress widget (e.g. a
circular progress ring).
User agents are expected to use a presentation consistent with platform conventions for progress bars. In particular, user agents are expected to use different presentations for determinate and indeterminate progress bars. User agents are also expected to vary the presentation based on the dimensions of the element.
For example, on some platforms for showing indeterminate progress there is an asynchronous progress indicator with square dimensions, which could be used when the element is square та an indeterminate progress bar, which could be used when the element is wide.
Requirements for how to determine if the progress bar is
determinate or indeterminate та what progress a determinate progress bar
is to show, are included in the definition of the progress
element.
select
element@namespace url(http://www.w3.org/1999/xhtml); select { binding: select; }
When the select binding applies to a select
element whose multiple
attribute is
present, the element is expected to render as a multi-select list box.
When the select binding applies to a select
element whose multiple
attribute is absent
та the element's display
size is greater than 1, the element is expected to render as a
single-select list box.
When the element renders as a list box, it is expected to render as an
'inline-block' box whose 'height' is the height necessary to contain as
many rows for items as given by the element's display size, or four rows if the
attribute is absent та whose 'width' is the width
of the select
's labels plus the width of a
scrollbar.
When the select binding applies to a select
element whose multiple
attribute is absent
та the element's display
size is 1, the element is expected to render as a one-line drop
down box whose width is the width
of the select
's labels.
In either case (list box or drop-down box), the element's items are
expected to be the element's list of options, with the
element's optgroup
element children providing headers for groups of options where
applicable.
An optgroup
element
is expected to be rendered by displaying the element's label
attribute.
An option
element is
expected to be rendered by displaying the element's label, indented under its optgroup
element if it has one.
The width of the select
's
labels is the wider of the width necessary to render the widest
optgroup
та the width
necessary to render the widest option
element in the element's list of options (including its
indent, if any).
Якщо a select
element
contains a placeholder label option,
the user agent is expected to render that option
in a manner that conveys that it is a label, rather than a valid option
of the control. This can include preventing the placeholder
label option from being explicitly selected by the user. When the
placeholder label option's selectedness є true, the
control is expected to be displayed in a fashion that indicates that no
valid option is currently selected.
User agents are expected to render the labels in a select
in such a manner that any alignment remains consistent whether the label
is being displayed as part of the page or in a menu control.
textarea
element@namespace url(http://www.w3.org/1999/xhtml); textarea { binding: textarea; white-space: pre-wrap; }
When the textarea binding applies to a textarea
element, the
element is expected to render as an 'inline-block' box rendered as a
multiline text field.
Якщо the element has a cols
attribute та parsing that
attribute's value using the rules
for parsing non-negative integers doesn't generate an error, then
the user agent is expected to use the attribute as a presentational hint for the 'width'
property on the element, with the value being the textarea
effective width (as defined below). Інакше the user agent is
expected to act as if it had a user-agent-level style sheet rule setting
the 'width' property on the element to the textarea
effective width.
The textarea effective width
of a textarea
element
is size×avg + sbw, where size
is the element's character
width, avg is the average
character width of the primary font of the element, in CSS pixels та sbw is the width of a scroll bar, in CSS
pixels. (The element's 'letter-spacing' property does not affect the
result.)
Якщо the element has a rows
attribute та parsing that
attribute's value using the rules
for parsing non-negative integers doesn't generate an error, then
the user agent is expected to use the attribute as a presentational hint for the 'height'
property on the element, with the value being the textarea
effective height (as defined below). Інакше the user agent is
expected to act as if it had a user-agent-level style sheet rule setting
the 'height' property on the element to the textarea
effective height.
The textarea effective height
of a textarea
element
is the height in CSS pixels of the number of lines specified the
element's character
height, plus the height of a scrollbar in CSS pixels.
User agents are expected to apply the 'white-space' CSS property to textarea
elements. For
historical reasons, if the element has a wrap
attribute whose value is
an ASCII чутливі до реєстру match
for the string "off
",
then the user agent is expected to treat the attribute as a presentational hint setting the
element's 'white-space' property to 'pre'.
keygen
element@namespace url(http://www.w3.org/1999/xhtml); keygen { binding: keygen; }
When the keygen binding applies to a keygen
element, the element is
expected to render as an 'inline-block' box containing a user interface
to configure the key pair to be generated.
User agent are expected to render frameset
elements as a box with the height and width of the viewport, with a
surface rendered according to the following layout algorithm:
The cols and rows variables are lists of zero or more pairs consisting of a number and a unit, the unit being one of percentage, relative та absolute.
Use the rules
for parsing a list of dimensions to parse the value of the
element's cols
attribute, if there is one. Нехай cols
be the result, or an empty list if there is no such attribute.
Use the rules
for parsing a list of dimensions to parse the value of the
element's rows
attribute, if there is one. Нехай rows
be the result, or an empty list if there is no such attribute.
For any of the entries in cols or rows that have the number zero and the unit relative, change the entry's number to one.
Якщо cols has no entries, then add a single entry consisting of the value 1 and the unit relative to cols.
Якщо rows has no entries, then add a single entry consisting of the value 1 and the unit relative to rows.
Invoke the algorithm defined below to convert
a list of dimensions to a list of pixel values using cols
as the input list та the width of the surface that the frameset
is being rendered into, in CSS pixels, as the input dimension. Нехай
sized cols be the resulting list.
Invoke the algorithm defined below to convert
a list of dimensions to a list of pixel values using rows
as the input list та the height of the surface that the frameset
is being rendered into, in CSS pixels, as the input dimension. Нехай
sized rows be the resulting list.
Split the surface into a grid of w×h rectangles, where w is the number of entries in sized cols and h is the number of entries in sized rows.
Size the columns so that each column in the grid is as many CSS pixels wide as the corresponding entry in the sized cols list.
Size the rows so that each row in the grid is as many CSS pixels high as the corresponding entry in the sized rows list.
Нехай children be the list of frame
and frameset
elements що є children of the frameset
element for which the algorithm was invoked.
For each row of the grid of rectangles created in the previous step, from top to bottom, виконати ці підкроки:
For each rectangle in the row, from left to right, виконати ці підкроки:
Якщо there are any elements left in children, take the first element in the list та assign it to the rectangle.
Якщо this is a frameset
element, then recurse the entire frameset
layout algorithm for that frameset
element, with the rectangle as the surface.
Інакше it is a frame
element; create a nested
browsing context sized to fit the rectangle.
Якщо there are any elements left in children, remove the first element from children.
Якщо the frameset
element has a border, draw an outer set of
borders around the rectangles, using the element's frame
border color.
For each rectangle, if there is an element assigned to that rectangle та that element has a border, draw an inner set of borders around that rectangle, using the element's frame border color.
For each (visible) border that does not abut a rectangle that is
assigned a frame
element with a noresize
attribute
(including rectangles in further nested frameset
elements), the user agent is expected to allow the user to move the
border, resizing the rectangles within, keeping the proportions of
any nested frameset
grids.
A frameset
or frame
element has a border if the following
algorithm returns true:
Якщо the element has a frameborder
attribute whose value is not the empty string and whose first
character is either a "1" (U+0031) character, a "y" (U+0079)
character, or a "Y" (U+0059) character, then return true.
Інакше if the element has a frameborder
attribute, return false.
Інакше if the element has a parent element that is a frameset
element, then return
true if that element has a
border та false if it does not.
Інакше return true.
The frame border color of a frameset
or frame
element is the color obtained from the following algorithm:
Якщо the element has a bordercolor
attribute та applying the rules
for parsing a legacy color value to that attribute's value
does not result in an error, then return the color so obtained.
Інакше if the element has a parent element that is a frameset
element, then return
the frame border color of
that element.
Інакше return gray.
The algorithm to convert a list of dimensions to a list of pixel values consists of the following steps:
Нехай input list be the list of numbers and units passed to the algorithm.
Нехай output list be a list of numbers the same length as input list, all zero.
Entries in output list correspond to the entries in input list that have the same position.
Нехай input dimension be the size passed to the algorithm.
Нехай count percentage be the number of entries in input list whose unit is percentage.
Нехай total percentage be the sum of all the numbers in input list whose unit is percentage.
Нехай count relative be the number of entries in input list whose unit is relative.
Нехай total relative be the sum of all the numbers in input list whose unit is relative.
Нехай count absolute be the number of entries in input list whose unit is absolute.
Нехай total absolute be the sum of all the numbers in input list whose unit is absolute.
Нехай remaining space be the value of input dimension.
Якщо total absolute is greater than remaining space, then for each entry in input list whose unit is absolute, set the corresponding value in output list to the number of the entry in input list multiplied by remaining space and divided by total absolute. Then, set remaining space to zero.
Інакше for each entry in input list whose unit is absolute, set the corresponding value in output list to the number of the entry in input list. Then, decrement remaining space by total absolute.
Якщо total percentage multiplied by the input dimension and divided by 100 is greater than remaining space, then for each entry in input list whose unit is percentage, set the corresponding value in output list to the number of the entry in input list multiplied by remaining space and divided by total percentage. Then, set remaining space to zero.
Інакше for each entry in input list whose unit is percentage, set the corresponding value in output list to the number of the entry in input list multiplied by the input dimension and divided by 100. Then, decrement remaining space by total percentage multiplied by the input dimension and divided by 100.
For each entry in input list whose unit is relative, set the corresponding value in output list to the number of the entry in input list multiplied by remaining space and divided by total relative.
Повернутиoutput list.
User agents working with integer values for frame widths (as opposed to user agents that can lay frames out with subpixel accuracy) are expected to distribute the remainder first to the last entry whose unit is relative, then equally (not proportionally) to each entry whose unit is percentage, then equally (not proportionally) to each entry whose unit is absolute та finally, failing all else, to the last entry.
User agents are expected to allow the user to control aspects of hyperlink activation and form submission, such as which browsing context is to be used for the subsequent navigation.
User agents are expected to allow users to discover the destination of hyperlinks and of forms before triggering their navigation.
User agents may allow users to navigate
browsing contexts to the resources на який вказує the cite
attributes on q
, blockquote
,
ins
та del
elements.
User agents may surface hyperlinks
created by link
elements
in their user interface.
While link
elements that create hyperlinks
will match the ':link' or ':visited' pseudo-classes, will react to
clicks if visible та so forth, this does not extend to any browser
interface constructs that expose those same links. Activating a link
through the browser's interface, rather than in the page itself, does
not trigger click
events and the like.
title
attributeUser agents are expected to expose the advisory information of elements upon user request та to make the user aware of the presence of such information.
On interactive graphical systems where the user can use a pointing device, this could take the form of a tooltip. When the user is unable to use a pointing device, then the user agent is expected to make the content available in some other fashion, e.g. by making the element focusable and always displaying the advisory information of the currently focused element, or by showing the advisory information of the elements under the user's finger on a touch device as the user pans around the screen.
"LF" (U+000A) characters are expected to cause line breaks in the tooltip; "tab" (U+0009) characters are expected to render as a non-zero horizontal shift that lines up the next glyph with the next tab stop, with tab stops occurring at points що є multiples of 8 times the width of a U+0020 SPACE character.
For example, a visual user agent could make elements with a title
attribute focusable та could
make any focused element with a title
attribute show its tooltip
under the element while the element has focus. This would allow a user
to tab around the document to find all the advisory text.
As another example, a screen reader could provide an audio cue when reading an element with a tooltip, with an associated key to read the last tooltip for which a cue was played.
The current text editing caret (i.e. the active range, if it is empty and in an editing host), if any, is expected to act like an inline replaced element with the vertical dimensions of the caret and with zero width for the purposes of the CSS rendering model.
This means that even an empty block can have the caret inside it та that when the caret is in such an element, it prevents margins from collapsing through the element.
User agents are expected to honor the Unicode semantics of text that is exposed in user interfaces, for example supporting the bidirectional algorithm in text shown in dialogs, title bars, pop-up menus та tooltips. Text from the contents of elements is expected to be rendered in a manner that honors the directionality of the element from which the text was obtained. Text from attributes is expected to be rendered in a manner that honours the directionality of the attribute.
Consider the following markup, which has Hebrew text asking for a programming language, the languages being text for which a left-to-right direction is important given the punctuation in some of their names:
<p dir="rtl" lang="he">
<label>
בחר שפת תכנות:
<select>
<option dir="ltr">C++</option>
<option dir="ltr">C#</option>
<option dir="ltr">FreePascal</option>
<option dir="ltr">F#</option>
</select>
</label>
</p>
Якщо the select
element was rendered as a drop down box, a correct rendering would
ensure that the punctuation was the same both in the drop down та in
the box showing the current selection.
The directionality of attributes depends on the attribute and on the
element's dir
attribute, as the following example demonstrates. Consider this
markup:
<table> <tr> <th abbr="(א" dir=ltr>A <th abbr="(א" dir=rtl>A <th abbr="(א" dir=auto>A </table>
Якщо the abbr
attributes are rendered, e.g. in a tooltip or other user interface,
the first will have a left parenthesis (because the direction is
'ltr'), the second will have a right parenthesis (because the
direction is 'rtl') та the third will have a right parenthesis
(because the direction is determined from the attribute value
to be 'rtl').
However, if instead the attribute was not a directionality-capable attribute, the results would be different:
<table> <tr> <th data-abbr="(א" dir=ltr>A <th data-abbr="(א" dir=rtl>A <th data-abbr="(א" dir=auto>A </table>
In this case, if the user agent were to expose the data-abbr
attribute in the user interface (e.g. in a debugging environment), the
last case would be rendered with a left parenthesis, because
the direction would be determined from the element's contents.
A string provided by a script (e.g. the argument to window.alert()
) is expected to be
treated as an independent set of one or more bidirectional algorithm
paragraphs when displayed, as defined by the bidirectional algorithm,
including, for instance, supporting the paragraph-breaking behaviour of
"LF" (U+000A) characters. For the purposes of determining the paragraph
level of such text in the bidirectional algorithm, this specification
does not provide a higher-level override of rules P2 and P3. [BIDI]
When necessary, authors can enforce a particular direction for a given paragraph by starting it with the Unicode U+200E LEFT-TO-RIGHT MARK or U+200F RIGHT-TO-LEFT MARK characters.
Thus, the following script:
alert('\u05DC\u05DE\u05D3 HTML \u05D4\u05D9\u05D5\u05DD!')
...would always result in a message reading "למד LMTH היום!" (not "דמל HTML םויה!"), regardless of the language of the user agent interface or the direction of the page or any of its elements.
For a more complex example, consider the following script:
/* Warning: this script does not handle right-to-left scripts correctly */ var s; if (s = prompt('What is your name?')) { alert(s + '! Ok, Fred, ' + s + ' та Wilma will get the car.'); }
When the user enters "Kitty", the user agent would alert "Kitty! Ok, Fred, Kitty та Wilma will get the car.". However, if the user enters "لا أفهم", then the bidirectional algorithm will determine that the direction of the paragraph is right-to-left та so the output will be the following unintended mess: "لا أفهم! derF,kO, لا أفهم, rac eht teg lliw amliW dna."
To force an alert that starts with user-provided text (or other text of unknown directionality) to render left-to-right, the string can be prefixed with a U+200E LEFT-TO-RIGHT MARK character:
var s; if (s = prompt('What is your name?')) { alert('\u200E' + s + '! Ok, Fred, ' + s + ' та Wilma will get the car.'); }
User agents are expected to allow the user to request the opportunity щоб отримати
a physical form (or a representation of a physical form) of a Document
. For example, selecting the
option to print a page or convert it to PDF format. [PDF]
When the user actually obtains
a physical form (or a representation of a physical form) of a Document
, the user agent is expected to
create a new rendering of the Document
for the print media.
HTML user agents may, in certain circumstances, find themselves rendering non-HTML documents that use vocabularies for which they lack any built-in knowledge. This section provides for a way for user agents to handle such documents in a somewhat useful manner.
While a Document
is an unstyled
document, the user agent is expected to render an
unstyled document view.
A Document
is an unstyled
document while it matches the following conditions:
Document
has no author
style sheets (whether referenced by HTTP headers, processing
instructions, elements like link
,
inline elements like style
,
or any other mechanism). Document
have any presentational hints. Document
have any CSS
styling attributes. Document
are in any of the following namespaces: простір
імен HTML, SVG namespace, MathML
namespace Document
has no focusable
elements (e.g. from XLink). Document
has no hyperlinks (e.g. from XLink). Document
as the responsible
document. Document
have any registered event listeners. An unstyled document view is
one where the DOM is not rendered according to CSS (which would, since
there are no applicable styles in this context, just result in a wall of
text), but is instead rendered in a manner that is useful for a
developer. This could consist of just showing the Document
object's source, maybe with syntax highlighting, or it could consist of
displaying just the DOM tree, or simply a message saying that the page
is not a styled document.
Якщо a Document
stops being an unstyled document, then
the conditions above stop applying та thus a user agent following these
requirements will switch to using the regular CSS rendering.
Features listed in this section will trigger warnings in conformance checkers.
Authors should not specify a border
attribute on an img
element. Якщо the attribute is present, its value must буде рядком "0
". CSS should be used instead.
Authors should not specify a language
attribute on a script
element. Якщо the
attribute is present, its value must be an ASCII
чутливі до реєстру match for the string "JavaScript
"
and either the type
attribute must be omitted or its value must be an ASCII
чутливі до реєстру match for the string "text/javascript
".
The attribute should be entirely omitted instead (with the value "JavaScript
",
it has no effect), or replaced with use of the type
attribute.
Authors should not specify the name
attribute on a
elements. Якщо the attribute is present, its value must not be the empty
string and must neither be equal to the value of any of the IDs in the element's home
subtree other than the element's own ID, if any, nor be equal to the value of any of
the other name
attributes on a
elements in the
element's home subtree. Якщо this attribute
is present and the element has an ID,
then the attribute's value must be equal to the element's ID. In earlier versions of the language, this
attribute was intended as a way to specify possible targets for fragment
identifiers in URLs. The id
attribute should be used
instead.
Authors should not, but may despite requirements to the
contrary elsewhere in this specification, specify the maxlength
and size
attributes on input
elements whose type
attributes are in the Number
state. One valid reason for using these attributes regardless is to help
legacy user agents that do not support input
elements with type="number"
to still
render the text field with a useful width.
In the HTML syntax, specifying a DOCTYPE that is an obsolete permitted DOCTYPE will also trigger a warning.
To ease the transition from HTML4 Transitional documents to the language defined in this specification та to discourage certain features що є only allowed in very few circumstances, conformance checkers are required to warn the user when the following features are used in a document. These are generally old obsolete features that have no effect та are allowed only to distinguish between likely mistakes (regular conformance errors) and mere vestigial markup or unusual and discouraged practices (these warnings).
The following features must be кваліфікується as described above:
The presence of an obsolete permitted DOCTYPE in an HTML document.
The presence of a border
attribute on an img
element if its value is the string "0
".
The presence of a language
attribute on a
script
element if its
value is an ASCII чутливі до
реєстру match for the string "JavaScript
"
and if there is no type
attribute or there is and its value is an ASCII
чутливі до реєстру match for the string "text/javascript
".
The presence of a name
attribute on an a
element, if its value is not the empty string.
The presence of a maxlength
attribute on
an input
element
whose type
attribute is in the Number
state.
The presence of a size
attribute on an input
element whose type
attribute is in the Number
state.
Conformance checkers must distinguish between pages that have no conformance errors and have none of these obsolete features та pages that have no conformance errors but do have some of these obsolete features.
For example, a validator could report some pages as "Valid HTML" and others as "Valid HTML with warnings".
Elements in the following list are entirely obsolete та must not be used by authors:
applet
acronym
Use abbr
instead.
bgsound
Use audio
instead.
dir
Use ul
instead.
frame
frameset
noframes
Either use iframe
and
CSS instead, or use server-side includes to generate complete pages
with the various invariant parts merged in.
hgroup
To mark up subheadings, consider putting the subheading into a p
element after the h1
-h6
element containing the main heading, or putting the subheading
directly within the h1
-h6
element containing the main heading, but separated from the main
heading by punctuation and/or within, for example, a span
class="subheading"
element with differentiated styling.
Headings and subheadings, alternative titles, or taglines can be
grouped using the header
or div
elements.
isindex
Use an explicit form
and text
field combination instead.
listing
nextid
Use GUIDs instead.
noembed
plaintext
Use the "text/plain
" MIME type
instead.
strike
Use del
instead if the
element is marking an edit, otherwise use s
instead.
xmp
Use pre
and code
instead та escape "<
" and "&
"
characters as "<
" and "&
"
respectively.
basefont
big
blink
center
font
marquee
multicol
nobr
spacer
tt
Use appropriate elements or CSS instead.
Where the tt
element would have been
used for marking up keyboard input, consider the kbd
element; for variables, consider the var
element; for computer code, consider the code
element; and for computer output, consider the samp
element.
Similarly, if the big
element is
being used to denote a heading, consider using the h1
element; if it is being used for marking up important passages,
consider the strong
element; and if it is being used for highlighting text for reference
purposes, consider the mark
element.
See also the text-level semantics usage summary for more suggestions with examples.
The following attributes are obsolete (though the elements are still part of the language) та must not be used by authors:
charset
on a
elementscharset
on link
elementsUse an HTTP Content-Type header on the linked resource instead.
coords
on a
elementsshape
on a
elementsmethods
on a
elementsmethods
on link
elementsUse the HTTP OPTIONS feature instead.
name
on a
elements (except as
noted in the previous section)name
on embed
elementsname
on img
elementsname
on option
elementsUse the id
attribute instead.
urn
on a
elementsurn
on link
elementsSpecify the preferred persistent identifier using the href
attribute instead.
accept
on form
elementsUse the accept
attribute directly on the input
elements instead.
nohref
on area
elementsOmitting the href
attribute is sufficient; the nohref
attribute is
unnecessary. Omit it altogether.
profile
on head
elementsWhen used for declaring which meta
terms are used in the document, unnecessary; omit it altogether та register
the names.
When used for triggering specific user agent behaviors: use a link
element instead.
version
on html
elementsUnnecessary. Omit it altogether.
ismap
on input
elementsUnnecessary. Omit it altogether. All input
elements with a type
attribute in the Image
Button state are processed as server-side image maps.
usemap
on input
elementslowsrc
on img
elementsUse a progressive JPEG image (given in the src
attribute), instead of using
two separate images.
target
on link
elementsUnnecessary. Omit it altogether.
scheme
on meta
elementsUse only one scheme per field, or make the scheme declaration part of the value.
archive
on object
elementsclassid
on object
elementscode
on object
elementscodebase
on object
elementscodetype
on object
elementsUse the data
and type
attributes to invoke plugins.
To set parameters with these names in particular, the param
element can be used.
declare
on object
elementsRepeat the object
element completely each time the resource is to be reused.
standby
on object
elementsOptimize the linked resource so that it loads quickly or, at least, incrementally.
type
on param
elementsvaluetype
on param
elementsUse the name
and value
attributes without declaring value types.
language
on script
elements
(except as noted in the previous section)Use the type
attribute instead.
event
on script
elementsfor
on script
elementsUse DOM Events mechanisms to register event listeners. [DOM]
datapagesize
on table
elementsUnnecessary. Omit it altogether.
summary
on table
elementsUse one of the techniques
for describing tables given in the table
section instead.
axis
on td
and th
elementsscope
on td
elementsUse th
elements for
heading cells.
datasrc
on a
, applet
,
button
, div
,
frame
, iframe
,
img
, input
,
label
, legend
,
marquee
, object
,
option
, select
,
span
, table
та textarea
elementsdatafld
on a
, applet
,
button
, div
,
fieldset
, frame
,
iframe
, img
,
input
, label
,
legend
, marquee
,
object
, param
,
select
, span
та textarea
elementsdataformatas
on button
, div
,
input
, label
,
legend
, marquee
,
object
, option
,
select
, span
та table
elementsUse script and a mechanism such as XMLHttpRequest
to populate the page dynamically. [XHR]
alink
on body
elementsbgcolor
on body
elementslink
on body
elementsmarginbottom
on body
elementsmarginheight
on body
elementsmarginleft
on body
elementsmarginright
on body
elementsmargintop
on body
elementsmarginwidth
on body
elementstext
on body
elementsvlink
on body
elementsclear
on br
elementsalign
on caption
elementsalign
on col
elementschar
on col
elementscharoff
on col
elementsvalign
on col
elementswidth
on col
elementsalign
on div
elementscompact
on dl
elementsalign
on embed
elementshspace
on embed
elementsvspace
on embed
elementsalign
on hr
elementscolor
on hr
elementsnoshade
on hr
elementssize
on hr
elementswidth
on hr
elementsalign
on h1
—h6
elementsalign
on iframe
elementsallowtransparency
on iframe
elementsframeborder
on iframe
elementshspace
on iframe
elementsmarginheight
on iframe
elementsmarginwidth
on iframe
elementsscrolling
on iframe
elementsvspace
on iframe
elementsalign
on input
elementshspace
on input
elementsvspace
on input
elementsalign
on img
elementsborder
on img
elements (except as
noted in the previous section)hspace
on img
elementsvspace
on img
elementsalign
on legend
elementstype
on li
elementsalign
on object
elementsborder
on object
elementshspace
on object
elementsvspace
on object
elementscompact
on ol
elementsalign
on p
elementswidth
on pre
elementsalign
on table
elementsbgcolor
on table
elementsbordercolor
on table
elementscellpadding
on table
elementscellspacing
on table
elementsframe
on table
elementsrules
on table
elementswidth
on table
elementsalign
on tbody
, thead
та tfoot
elementschar
on tbody
, thead
та tfoot
elementscharoff
on tbody
, thead
та tfoot
elementsvalign
on tbody
, thead
та tfoot
elementsalign
on td
and th
elementsbgcolor
on td
and th
elementschar
on td
and th
elementscharoff
on td
and th
elementsheight
on td
and th
elementsnowrap
on td
and th
elementsvalign
on td
and th
elementswidth
on td
and th
elementsalign
on tr
elementsbgcolor
on tr
elementschar
on tr
elementscharoff
on tr
elementsvalign
on tr
elementscompact
on ul
elementstype
on ul
elementsbackground
on body
, table
,
thead
, tbody
,
tfoot
, tr
,
td
та th
elementsUse CSS instead.
The border
attribute on the table
element can be used to provide basic fallback styling for the purpose of
making tables legible in browsing environments where CSS support is
limited or absent, such as text-based browsers, WYSIWYG editors та in
situations where CSS support is disabled or the style sheet is lost. Only
the empty string and the value "1
" may be
used as border
values for this purpose. Other values are considered obsolete. To regulate
the thickness of such borders, authors should instead use CSS.
applet
elementThe applet
element is a
Java-specific variant of the embed
element. The applet
element is now obsoleted so that all extension frameworks (Java, .NET,
Flash, etc) are handled in a consistent manner.
When the element matches any of the following conditions, it represents its contents:
Document
.Document
is not
fully active.Document
's
active sandboxing flag set
has its sandboxed
plugins browsing context flag set.object
element that is not showing its fallback
content.Інакше the user agent should instantiate a Java Language runtime plugin
та should pass the names and values of all the attributes on the
element, in the order they were added to the element, with the
attributes added by the parser being ordered in source order та then a
parameter named "PARAM" whose value is null та then all the names and
values of parameters
given by param
elements
що є children of the applet
element, in tree order, to the plugin
used. Якщо the plugin supports a scriptable
interface, the HTMLAppletElement
object representing the element should expose that interface. The applet
element represents
the plugin.
The applet
element is unaffected by the CSS 'display' property. The Java Language
runtime is instantiated even if the element is hidden with a
'display:none' CSS style.
The applet
element must
implement the HTMLAppletElement
interface.
interface HTMLAppletElement : HTMLElement { attribute DOMString align; attribute DOMString alt; attribute DOMString archive; attribute DOMString code; attribute DOMString codeBase; attribute DOMString height; attribute unsigned long hspace; attribute DOMString name; attribute DOMString _object; // the underscore is not part of the identifier attribute unsigned long vspace; attribute DOMString width; };
The align
,
alt
,
archive
,
code
,
height
,
hspace
,
name
,
object
,
vspace
та width
IDL attributes must reflect the respective
content attributes of the same name. For the purposes of reflection, the
applet
element's object
content attribute is defined as containing a URL.
The codeBase
IDL attribute must reflect the codebase
content attribute, which for the purposes of reflection is defined as
containing a URL.
marquee
elementThe marquee
element
is a presentational element that animates content. CSS transitions and
animations are a more appropriate mechanism. [CSSANIMATIONS]
[CSSTRANSITIONS]
The task source for tasks mentioned in this section is the DOM manipulation task source.
The marquee
element
must implement the HTMLMarqueeElement
interface.
interface HTMLMarqueeElement : HTMLElement { attribute DOMString behavior; attribute DOMString bgColor; attribute DOMString direction; attribute DOMString height; attribute unsigned long hspace; attribute long loop; attribute unsigned long scrollAmount; attribute unsigned long scrollDelay; attribute boolean trueSpeed; attribute unsigned long vspace; attribute DOMString width; attribute EventHandler onbounce; attribute EventHandler onfinish; attribute EventHandler onstart; void start(); void stop(); };
A marquee
element
can be turned
on or turned
off. When it is created, it is turned on.
When the start()
method is called, the marquee
element must be turned
on.
When the stop()
method is called, the marquee
element must be turned
off.
When a marquee
element is created, the user agent must queue a
task to fire a simple event
named start
at the element.
The behavior
content attribute on marquee
elements is an enumerated attribute
with the following keywords (all non-conforming):
Keyword | State |
---|---|
scroll |
scroll |
slide |
slide |
alternate |
alternate |
The missing value default is the scroll state.
The direction
content attribute on marquee
elements is an enumerated attribute
with the following keywords (all non-conforming):
Keyword | State |
---|---|
left |
left |
right |
right |
up |
up |
down |
down |
The missing value default is the left state.
The truespeed
content attribute on marquee
elements is a boolean attribute.
A marquee
element
has a marquee scroll interval,
which is obtained as follows:
Якщо the element has a scrolldelay
attribute та parsing its value using the rules
for parsing non-negative integers does not return an error,
then let delay be the parsed value.
Інакше let delay be 85.
Якщо the element does not have a truespeed
attribute та
the delay value is less than 60,
then let delay be 60 instead.
The marquee scroll interval is delay, interpreted in milliseconds.
A marquee
element
has a marquee scroll distance,
which, if the element has a scrollamount
attribute та parsing its value using the rules
for parsing non-negative integers does not return an error, is the
parsed value interpreted in CSS pixels та otherwise is 6 CSS pixels.
A marquee
element
has a marquee loop count, which, if
the element has a loop
attribute та parsing its value using the rules
for parsing integers does not return an error or a number less
than 1, is the parsed value та otherwise is −1.
The loop
IDL attribute, on getting, must return the element's marquee
loop count; and on setting, if the new value is different than the
element's marquee loop count and
either greater than zero or equal to −1, must set the element's loop
content attribute (adding it if necessary) to the valid
integer that represents the new value. (Other values are ignored.)
A marquee
element
also has a marquee current loop
index, which is zero when the element is created.
The rendering layer will occasionally increment the marquee current loop index, which must cause the following steps to be run:
Якщо the marquee loop count is −1, then abort these steps.
Increment the marquee current loop index by one.
Якщо the marquee current
loop index is now equal to or greater than the element's marquee
loop count, turn
off the marquee
element and queue a task to fire
a simple event named finish
at the marquee
element.
Інакше if the behavior
attribute is in the alternate state, then
queue a task to fire
a simple event named bounce
at the marquee
element.
Інакше queue a task to fire
a simple event named start
at the marquee
element.
The following are the event handlers
(and their corresponding event handler event types)
that must be supported, as event
handler content attributes and event
handler IDL attributes, by marquee
elements:
Event handler | Event handler event type |
---|---|
onbounce
|
bounce |
onfinish
|
finish |
onstart
|
start |
The behavior
,
direction
,
height
,
hspace
,
vspace
та width
IDL attributes must reflect the respective
content attributes of the same name.
The bgColor
IDL attribute must reflect the bgcolor
content attribute.
The scrollAmount
IDL attribute must reflect the scrollamount
content attribute. The default value is 6.
The scrollDelay
IDL attribute must reflect the scrolldelay
content attribute. The default value is 85.
The trueSpeed
IDL attribute must reflect the truespeed
content
attribute.
The frameset
element acts as the body element in documents that use
frames.
The frameset
element must
implement the HTMLFrameSetElement
interface.
interface HTMLFrameSetElement : HTMLElement { attribute DOMString cols; attribute DOMString rows; }; HTMLFrameSetElement implements WindowEventHandlers;
The cols
and rows
IDL attributes of the frameset
element must reflect the respective content
attributes of the same name.
The frameset
element exposes as event handler content
attributes a number of the event
handlers of the Window
object.
It also mirrors their event
handler IDL attributes.
The onblur
,
onerror
,
onfocus
,
onload
,
onresize
та onscroll
event handlers of the Window
object, exposed on the frameset
element, replace the generic event handlers
with the same names normally supported by HTML
elements.
The frame
element defines a nested
browsing context similar to the iframe
element, but rendered within a frameset
element.
A frame
element is said to be an active frame
element
when it is in a Document
and
its parent element, if any, is a frameset
element.
When a frame
element is created as
an active frame
element,
or becomes an active frame
element after not having been one, the user agent must create a nested browsing context та then process the frame
attributes for the first time.
When a frame
element stops being an
active frame
element,
the user agent must discard the nested
browsing context.
Whenever a frame
element with a nested browsing context has its src
attribute set, changed,
or removed, the user agent must process
the frame
attributes.
When the user agent is to process
the frame
attributes, it must run the first
appropriate steps from the following list:
src
attribute specified та the user agent is processing the frame
's
attributes for the first timeQueue a task to fire
a simple event named load
at the frame
element.
Якщо the value of the src
attribute is the empty string, let url
буде рядком "about:blank
".
Інакше resolve
the value of the src
attribute, relative to the frame
element.
Якщо that is not successful, then let url
буде рядком "about:blank
".
Інакше let url be the resulting
absolute URL.
Navigate the element's child browsing context to url.
Any navigation
required of the user agent in the process
the frame
attributes algorithm must be completed as
an explicit self-navigation override and with the frame
element's document's browsing
context as the source browsing
context.
Furthermore, if the active document of the element's child browsing context before such a navigation was not completely loaded at the time of the new navigation, then the navigation must be completed with replacement enabled.
Similarly, if the child browsing
context's session history
contained only one Document
when
the process the frame
attributes algorithm was invoked та that was the about:blank
Document
created when the child
browsing context was created, then any navigation required of the user agent in that
algorithm must be completed with replacement
enabled.
When a Document
in a frame
is marked as completely loaded, the
user agent must queue a task to fire
a simple event named load
at the frame
element.
The task source for the tasks above is the DOM manipulation task source.
When there is an active parser in the frame
та when anything in the frame
is delaying
the load event of the frame
's browsing context's active
document, the frame
must delay
the load event of its document.
When the browsing context is created, if a name
attribute is present, the browsing
context name must be set to the value of this attribute;
otherwise, the browsing context name
must be set to the empty string.
Whenever the name
attribute is set, the nested browsing
context's name
must be changed to the new value. Якщо the attribute is removed, the browsing context name must be set to
the empty string.
The frame
element must implement the
HTMLFrameElement
interface.
interface HTMLFrameElement : HTMLElement { attribute DOMString name; attribute DOMString scrolling; attribute DOMString src; attribute DOMString frameBorder; attribute DOMString longDesc; attribute boolean noResize; readonly attribute Document? contentDocument; readonly attribute WindowProxy? contentWindow; [TreatNullAs=EmptyString] attribute DOMString marginHeight; [TreatNullAs=EmptyString] attribute DOMString marginWidth; };
The name
,
scrolling
та src
IDL attributes of the frame
element
must reflect the respective content attributes
of the same name. For the purposes of reflection, the frame
element's src
content
attribute is defined as containing a URL.
The frameBorder
IDL attribute of the frame
element
must reflect the element's frameborder
content attribute.
The longDesc
IDL attribute of the frame
element
must reflect the element's longdesc
content attribute, which for the purposes of reflection is defined as
containing a URL.
The noResize
IDL attribute of the frame
element
must reflect the element's noresize
content attribute.
The contentDocument
IDL attribute of the frame
element
must return the Document
object of
the active document of the frame
element's nested browsing context,
if any and if its effective script
origin is the same origin as the effective
script origin specified by the incumbent
settings object, or null otherwise.
The contentWindow
IDL attribute must return the WindowProxy
object of the frame
element's nested
browsing context.
The marginHeight
IDL attribute of the frame
element
must reflect the element's marginheight
content attribute.
The marginWidth
IDL attribute of the frame
element
must reflect the element's marginwidth
content attribute.
User agents must treat acronym
elements in a manner equivalent to abbr
elements in terms of semantics and for purposes of rendering.
partial interface HTMLAnchorElement { attribute DOMString coords; attribute DOMString charset; attribute DOMString name; attribute DOMString shape; };
The coords
,
charset
,
name
та shape
IDL attributes of the a
element must reflect the respective content
attributes of the same name.
partial interface HTMLAreaElement { attribute boolean noHref; };
The noHref
IDL attribute of the area
element must reflect the element's nohref
content attribute.
partial interface HTMLBodyElement { [TreatNullAs=EmptyString] attribute DOMString text; [TreatNullAs=EmptyString] attribute DOMString link; [TreatNullAs=EmptyString] attribute DOMString vLink; [TreatNullAs=EmptyString] attribute DOMString aLink; [TreatNullAs=EmptyString] attribute DOMString bgColor; attribute DOMString background; };
The text
IDL attribute of the body
element must reflect the element's text
content attribute.
The link
IDL attribute of the body
element must reflect the element's link
content attribute.
The aLink
IDL attribute of the body
element must reflect the element's alink
content attribute.
The vLink
IDL attribute of the body
element must reflect the element's vlink
content attribute.
The bgColor
IDL attribute of the body
element must reflect the element's bgcolor
content attribute.
The background
IDL attribute of the body
element must reflect the element's background
content attribute.
(The background
content is not defined to contain a URL, despite
rules regarding its handling in the rendering section above.)
partial interface HTMLBRElement { attribute DOMString clear; };
The clear
IDL attribute of the br
element must reflect the content attribute of
the same name.
partial interface HTMLTableCaptionElement { attribute DOMString align; };
The align
IDL attribute of the caption
element must reflect the content attribute of
the same name.
partial interface HTMLTableColElement { attribute DOMString align; attribute DOMString ch; attribute DOMString chOff; attribute DOMString vAlign; attribute DOMString width; };
The align
and width
IDL attributes of the col
element must reflect the respective content
attributes of the same name.
The ch
IDL attribute of the col
element must reflect the element's char
content attribute.
The chOff
IDL attribute of the col
element must reflect the element's charoff
content attribute.
The vAlign
IDL attribute of the col
element must reflect the element's valign
content attribute.
User agents must treat dir
elements in
a manner equivalent to ul
elements in terms of semantics and for purposes of rendering.
The dir
element must implement the HTMLDirectoryElement
interface.
interface HTMLDirectoryElement : HTMLElement { attribute boolean compact; };
The compact
IDL attribute of the dir
element must reflect the content attribute of the same name.
partial interface HTMLDivElement { attribute DOMString align; };
The align
IDL attribute of the div
element must reflect the content attribute of
the same name.
partial interface HTMLDListElement { attribute boolean compact; };
The compact
IDL attribute of the dl
element must reflect the content attribute of
the same name.
partial interface HTMLEmbedElement { attribute DOMString align; attribute DOMString name; };
The name
and align
IDL attributes of the embed
element must reflect the respective content
attributes of the same name.
The font
element must implement the HTMLFontElement
interface.
interface HTMLFontElement : HTMLElement { [TreatNullAs=EmptyString] attribute DOMString color; attribute DOMString face; attribute DOMString size; };
The color
,
face
та size
IDL attributes of the font
element
must reflect the respective content attributes
of the same name.
partial interface HTMLHeadingElement { attribute DOMString align; };
The align
IDL attribute of the h1
–h6
elements must reflect the content attribute of
the same name.
The profile
IDL attribute on head
elements (with the HTMLHeadElement
interface) is intentionally omitted. Unless so required by another applicable
specification, implementations would therefore not support this
attribute. (It is mentioned here as it was defined in a previous version
of the DOM specifications.)
partial interface HTMLHRElement { attribute DOMString align; attribute DOMString color; attribute boolean noShade; attribute DOMString size; attribute DOMString width; };
The align
,
color
,
size
та width
IDL attributes of the hr
element must reflect the respective content
attributes of the same name.
The noShade
IDL attribute of the hr
element must reflect the element's noshade
content attribute.
partial interface HTMLHtmlElement { attribute DOMString version; };
The version
IDL attribute of the html
element must reflect the content attribute of
the same name.
partial interface HTMLIFrameElement { attribute DOMString align; attribute DOMString scrolling; attribute DOMString frameBorder; attribute DOMString longDesc; [TreatNullAs=EmptyString] attribute DOMString marginHeight; [TreatNullAs=EmptyString] attribute DOMString marginWidth; };
The align
and scrolling
IDL attributes of the iframe
element must reflect the respective content
attributes of the same name.
The frameBorder
IDL attribute of the iframe
element must reflect the element's frameborder
content
attribute.
The longDesc
IDL attribute of the iframe
element must reflect the element's longdesc
content attribute, which for the purposes of reflection is defined as
containing a URL.
The marginHeight
IDL attribute of the iframe
element must reflect the element's marginheight
content
attribute.
The marginWidth
IDL attribute of the iframe
element must reflect the element's marginwidth
content
attribute.
partial interface HTMLImageElement { attribute DOMString name; attribute DOMString lowsrc; attribute DOMString align; attribute unsigned long hspace; attribute unsigned long vspace; attribute DOMString longDesc; [TreatNullAs=EmptyString] attribute DOMString border; };
The name
,
align
,
border
,
hspace
та vspace
IDL attributes of the img
element must reflect the respective content
attributes of the same name.
The longDesc
IDL attribute of the img
element must reflect the element's longdesc
content attribute, which for the purposes of reflection is defined as
containing a URL.
The lowsrc
IDL attribute of the img
element must reflect the element's lowsrc
content attribute, which
for the purposes of reflection is defined as containing a URL.
partial interface HTMLInputElement { attribute DOMString align; attribute DOMString useMap; };
The align
IDL attribute of the input
element must reflect the content attribute of
the same name.
The useMap
IDL attribute of the input
element must reflect the element's usemap
content attribute.
partial interface HTMLLegendElement { attribute DOMString align; };
The align
IDL attribute of the legend
element must reflect the content attribute of
the same name.
partial interface HTMLLIElement { attribute DOMString type; };
The type
IDL attribute of the li
element must reflect the content attribute of
the same name.
partial interface HTMLLinkElement { attribute DOMString charset; attribute DOMString target; };
The charset
and target
IDL attributes of the link
element must reflect the respective content
attributes of the same name.
User agents must treat listing
elements in a manner equivalent to pre
elements in terms of semantics and for purposes of rendering.
partial interface HTMLMetaElement { attribute DOMString scheme; };
User agents may treat the scheme
content attribute on the
meta
element as an
extension of the element's name
content attribute when processing a meta
element with a name
attribute whose value is one that the user agent recognizes as
supporting the scheme
attribute.
User agents are encouraged to ignore the scheme
attribute and instead
process the value given to the metadata name as if it had been specified
for each expected value of the scheme
attribute.
For example, if the user agent acts on meta
elements with name
attributes having the value "eGMS.subject.keyword" та knows that the scheme
attribute is used with this metadata name, then it could take the scheme
attribute into account, acting as if it was an extension of the name
attribute. Thus the following two meta
elements could be treated as two elements giving values for two
different metadata names, one consisting of a combination of
"eGMS.subject.keyword" and "LGCL" та the other consisting of a
combination of "eGMS.subject.keyword" and "ORLY":
<!-- this markup is invalid --> <meta name="eGMS.subject.keyword" scheme="LGCL" content="Abandoned vehicles"> <meta name="eGMS.subject.keyword" scheme="ORLY" content="Mah car: kthxbye">
The suggested processing of this markup, however, would be equivalent to the following:
<meta name="eGMS.subject.keyword" content="Abandoned vehicles"> <meta name="eGMS.subject.keyword" content="Mah car: kthxbye">
The scheme
IDL attribute of the meta
element must reflect the content attribute of
the same name.
partial interface HTMLObjectElement { attribute DOMString align; attribute DOMString archive; attribute DOMString code; attribute boolean declare; attribute unsigned long hspace; attribute DOMString standby; attribute unsigned long vspace; attribute DOMString codeBase; attribute DOMString codeType; [TreatNullAs=EmptyString] attribute DOMString border; };
The align
,
archive
,
border
,
code
,
declare
,
hspace
,
standby
та vspace
IDL attributes of the object
element must reflect the respective content
attributes of the same name.
The codeBase
IDL attribute of the object
element must reflect the element's codebase
content attribute,
which for the purposes of reflection is defined as containing a URL.
The codeType
IDL attribute of the object
element must reflect the element's codetype
content attribute.
partial interface HTMLOListElement { attribute boolean compact; };
The compact
IDL attribute of the ol
element must reflect the content attribute of
the same name.
partial interface HTMLParagraphElement { attribute DOMString align; };
The align
IDL attribute of the p
element must reflect the content attribute of
the same name.
partial interface HTMLParamElement { attribute DOMString type; attribute DOMString valueType; };
The type
IDL attribute of the param
element must reflect the content attribute of
the same name.
The valueType
IDL attribute of the param
element must reflect the element's valuetype
content attribute.
User agents must treat plaintext
elements in a manner equivalent to pre
elements in terms of semantics and for purposes of rendering. (The
parser has special behavior for this element, though.)
partial interface HTMLPreElement { attribute long width; };
The width
IDL attribute of the pre
element must reflect the content attribute of
the same name.
partial interface HTMLScriptElement { attribute DOMString event; attribute DOMString htmlFor; };
The event
and htmlFor
IDL attributes of the script
element must return the empty string on getting та do nothing on
setting.
partial interface HTMLTableElement { attribute DOMString align; attribute DOMString frame; attribute DOMString rules; attribute DOMString summary; attribute DOMString width; [TreatNullAs=EmptyString] attribute DOMString bgColor; [TreatNullAs=EmptyString] attribute DOMString cellPadding; [TreatNullAs=EmptyString] attribute DOMString cellSpacing; };
The align
,
border
,
frame
,
summary
,
rules
та width
,
IDL attributes of the table
element must reflect the respective content
attributes of the same name.
The bgColor
IDL attribute of the table
element must reflect the element's bgcolor
content attribute.
The cellPadding
IDL attribute of the table
element must reflect the element's cellpadding
content
attribute.
The cellSpacing
IDL attribute of the table
element must reflect the element's cellspacing
content
attribute.
partial interface HTMLTableSectionElement { attribute DOMString align; attribute DOMString ch; attribute DOMString chOff; attribute DOMString vAlign; };
The align
IDL attribute of the tbody
,
thead
та tfoot
elements must reflect the content attribute of
the same name.
The ch
IDL attribute of the tbody
,
thead
та tfoot
elements must reflect the elements' char
content attributes.
The chOff
IDL attribute of the tbody
,
thead
та tfoot
elements must reflect the elements' charoff
content attributes.
The vAlign
IDL attribute of the tbody
,
thead
та tfoot
element must reflect the elements' valign
content attributes.
partial interface HTMLTableCellElement { attribute DOMString align; attribute DOMString axis; attribute DOMString height; attribute DOMString width; attribute DOMString ch; attribute DOMString chOff; attribute boolean noWrap; attribute DOMString vAlign; [TreatNullAs=EmptyString] attribute DOMString bgColor; };
The align
,
axis
,
height
та width
IDL attributes of the td
and
th
elements must reflect
the respective content attributes of the same name.
The ch
IDL attribute of the td
and
th
elements must reflect
the elements' char
content attributes.
The chOff
IDL attribute of the td
and
th
elements must reflect
the elements' charoff
content attributes.
The noWrap
IDL attribute of the td
and
th
elements must reflect
the elements' nowrap
content attributes.
The vAlign
IDL attribute of the td
and
th
element must reflect
the elements' valign
content attributes.
The bgColor
IDL attribute of the td
and
th
elements must reflect
the elements' bgcolor
content attributes.
partial interface HTMLTableDataCellElement { attribute DOMString abbr; };
The abbr
IDL attribute of the td
element must reflect the respective content
attributes of the same name.
partial interface HTMLTableRowElement { attribute DOMString align; attribute DOMString ch; attribute DOMString chOff; attribute DOMString vAlign; [TreatNullAs=EmptyString] attribute DOMString bgColor; };
The align
IDL attribute of the tr
element must reflect the content attribute of
the same name.
The ch
IDL attribute of the tr
element must reflect the element's char
content attribute.
The chOff
IDL attribute of the tr
element must reflect the element's charoff
content attribute.
The vAlign
IDL attribute of the tr
element must reflect the element's valign
content attribute.
The bgColor
IDL attribute of the tr
element must reflect the element's bgcolor
content attribute.
partial interface HTMLUListElement { attribute boolean compact; attribute DOMString type; };
The compact
and type
IDL attributes of the ul
element must reflect the respective content
attributes of the same name.
User agents must treat xmp
elements in
a manner equivalent to pre
elements in terms of semantics and for purposes of rendering. (The
parser has special behavior for this element though.)
The blink
, bgsound
,
isindex
, multicol
,
nextid
та spacer
elements must use the HTMLUnknownElement
interface.
partial interface Document { [TreatNullAs=EmptyString] attribute DOMString fgColor; [TreatNullAs=EmptyString] attribute DOMString linkColor; [TreatNullAs=EmptyString] attribute DOMString vlinkColor; [TreatNullAs=EmptyString] attribute DOMString alinkColor; [TreatNullAs=EmptyString] attribute DOMString bgColor; readonly attribute HTMLCollection anchors; readonly attribute HTMLCollection applets; void clear(); void captureEvents(long dummy); void releaseEvents(long dummy); readonly attribute HTMLAllCollection all; };
The attributes of the Document
object listed in the first column of the following table must reflect
the content attribute on the body element
with the name given in the corresponding cell in the second column on
the same row, if the body element is
a body
element (as opposed
to a frameset
element). When there
is no body
element or if it is a frameset
element, the attributes must instead return the empty string on getting
and do nothing on setting.
IDL attribute | Content attribute |
---|---|
fgColor
|
text
|
linkColor
|
link
|
vlinkColor
|
vlink
|
alinkColor
|
alink
|
bgColor
|
bgcolor
|
The anchors
attribute must return an HTMLCollection
rooted at the Document
node, whose
filter matches only a
elements with name
attributes.
The applets
attribute must return an HTMLCollection
rooted at the Document
node, whose
filter matches only applet
elements.
The clear()
,
captureEvents()
та releaseEvents()
methods must do nothing.
The all
attribute must return an HTMLAllCollection
rooted at the Document
node, whose
filter matches all elements.
The object returned for all
has several unusual behaviors:
The user agent must act as if the ToBoolean() operator in
JavaScript converts the object returned for all
to the false value.
The user agent must act as if, for the purposes of the ==
and !=
operators in JavaScript,
the object returned for all
compares as equal to the
undefined
and null
values. (Comparisons using the ===
operator та comparisons to other values such as strings or objects,
are unaffected.)
The user agent must act such that the typeof
operator in JavaScript returns the string undefined
when applied to the object returned for all
.
These requirements are a willful
violation of the JavaScript specification current at the time of
writing (ECMAScript edition 5). The JavaScript specification requires
that the ToBoolean() operator convert all objects to the true value та
does not have provisions for objects acting as if they were undefined
for the purposes of certain operators. This violation is motivated by a
desire for compatibility with two classes of legacy content: one that
uses the presence of document.all
as a way to detect legacy user agents та one that only supports those
legacy user agents and uses the document.all
object without
testing for its presence first. [ECMA262]
partial interface Window { void captureEvents(long dummy); void releaseEvents(long dummy); };
The captureEvents()
and releaseEvents()
methods must do nothing.
The hgroup
element does not have strong native semantics or default
implicit ARIA semantics. User agents must not implement
accessibility layer semantics for the hgroup
element that obfuscates or modifies the semantics of its children.
text/html
This registration has been filed successfully with IANA.
charset
The charset
parameter may be
provided to definitively specify the document's
character encoding, overriding any character encoding
declarations in the document. The parameter's value must be
one of the labels
of the character
encoding used to serialize the file. [ENCODING]
Entire novels have been written about the security considerations that apply to HTML documents. Many are listed in this document, to which the reader is referred for more details. Some general concerns bear mentioning here, however:
HTML is scripted language та has a large number of APIs (some of which are described in this document). Script can expose the user to potential risks of information leakage, credential leakage, cross-site scripting attacks, cross-site request forgeries та a host of other problems. While the designs in this specification are intended to be safe if implemented correctly, a full implementation is a massive undertaking and, as with any software, user agents are likely to have security bugs.
Even without scripting, there are specific features in HTML which,
for historical reasons, are required for broad compatibility with
legacy content but that expose the user to unfortunate security
problems. In particular, the img
element can be used in conjunction with some other features as a way
to effect a port scan from the user's location on the Internet. This
can expose local network topologies that the attacker would otherwise
not be able to determine.
HTML relies on a compartmentalization scheme sometimes known as the same-origin policy. An origin in most cases consists of all the pages served from the same host, on the same port, using the same protocol.
It is critical, therefore, to ensure that any untrusted content that forms part of a site be hosted on a different origin than any sensitive content on that site. Untrusted content can easily spoof any other page on the same origin, read data from that origin, cause scripts in that origin to execute, submit forms to and from that origin even if they are protected from cross-site request forgery attacks by unique tokens та make use of any third-party resources exposed to or rights granted to that origin.
multipart/x-mixed-replace
This registration has been filed successfully with IANA.
boundary
(defined in RFC2046) [RFC2046] multipart/x-mixed-replace
resource can be of any type, including types with non-trivial security
implications such as text/html
. application/xhtml+xml
This registration has been filed successfully with IANA.
xhtml
" and "xht
" are sometimes used as extensions
for XML resources that have a root element from the простір
імен HTML.application/x-www-form-urlencoded
This registration has been filed successfully with IANA.
In isolation, an application/x-www-form-urlencoded
payload poses no security risks. However, as this type is usually used
as part of a form submission, all the risks that apply to HTML forms
need to be considered in the context of this type.
These risks fall into multiple categories that pertain to the same-origin policy and cross-origin reach of HTML forms (http://www.w3.org/TR/cors/#security), general HTML application threats (http://www.w3.org/TR/html/single-page.html#writing-secure-applications-with-html) та not relying on client-side validation for anything other than user feedback (http://www.w3.org/TR/html/single-page.html#security-forms).
application/x-www-form-urlencoded
payloads are defined in this specification. text/cache-manifest
This registration has been filed successfully with IANA.
charset
The charset
parameter may be
provided. The parameter's value must be "utf-8
".
This parameter serves no purpose; it is only allowed for
compatibility with legacy servers.
Cache manifests themselves contain no executable content and pose no immediate risk unless sensitive information is included within the manifest.
Implementations however, are required to follow specific rules when populating a cache based on a cache manifest, to ensure that certain origin-based restrictions are honoured. Failure to correctly implement these rules can result in information leakage, cross-site scripting attacks та the like.
Caching mechanisms are typically subjects of poisoning attacks and the one that this file type supports is no exception. The published specification includes steps intended to mitigate such issues (notably non-malicious cache poisoning from captive portals) but implementers are advised to exercise caution in caching.
Additionally, the permanence of this caching mechanism requires care to be taken with respect to users' privacy (http://www.w3.org/TR/html/single-page.html#expiring-application-caches) and storage resources (http://www.w3.org/TR/html/single-page.html#disk-space).
web+
scheme prefixThis section describes a convention for use with the IANA URI scheme registry. It does not itself register a specific scheme. [RFC4395]
web+
"
followed by one or more letters in the range a
-z
. web+
" schemes should use UTF-8
encodings where relevant.web+
"
schemes. As such, these schemes must not be used for features intended
to be core platform features (e.g. network transfer protocols like HTTP
or FTP). Similarly, such schemes must not store confidential information
in their URLs, such as usernames, passwords, personal information, or
confidential project names. The following sections only cover conforming elements and features.
Цей розділ не є нормативним.
An asterisk (*) in a cell indicates that the actual rules are more complicated than indicated in the table above.
† Categories in the "Parents" column refer to parents that list the given
categories in their content model, not to elements that themselves are in
those categories. For example, the a
element's "Parents" column says "phrasing", so any element whose content
model contains the "phrasing" category could be a parent of an a
element. Since the "flow" category includes all the "phrasing" elements,
that means the th
element
could be a parent to an a
element.
Цей розділ не є нормативним.
Цей розділ не є нормативним.
Attribute | Element(s) | Description | Value |
---|---|---|---|
abbr |
th
|
Alternative label to use for the header cell when referencing the cell in other contexts | Text* |
accept |
input
|
Hint for expected file type in file upload controls | Set of comma-separated
tokens* consisting of valid
MIME types with no parameters or audio/* ,
video/* , or image/*
|
accept-charset |
form
|
Character encodings to use for form submission | Ordered set of unique space-separated tokens, ASCII чутливі до реєстру, consisting of labels of ASCII-compatible character encodings* |
accesskey |
HTML elements | Keyboard shortcut to activate or focus element | Ordered set of unique space-separated tokens, case-sensitive, consisting of one Unicode code point in length |
action |
form
|
URL to use for form submission | Valid non-empty URL potentially surrounded by spaces |
alt |
area ;
img ;
input
|
Replacement text for use when images are not available | Text* |
async |
script
|
Execute script asynchronously | Boolean attribute |
autocomplete |
form
|
Default setting for autofill feature for controls in the form | "on "; "off "
|
autocomplete |
input ;
select ;
textarea
|
Hint for form autofill feature | Autofill field name and related tokens* |
autofocus |
button ;
input ;
keygen ;
select ;
textarea
|
Automatically focus the form control when the page is loaded | Boolean attribute |
autoplay |
audio ;
video
|
Hint that the media resource can be started automatically when the page is loaded | Boolean attribute |
border |
table
|
Explicit indication that the table
element is not being used for layout purposes |
The empty string, or "1 " |
challenge |
keygen
|
String to package with the generated and signed public key | Text |
charset |
meta
|
Character encoding declaration | Encoding label* |
charset |
script
|
Character encoding of the external script resource | Encoding label* |
checked |
input
|
Whether the control is checked | Boolean attribute |
cite |
blockquote ;
del ;
ins ;
q
|
Link to the source of the quotation or more information about the edit | Valid URL potentially surrounded by spaces |
class |
HTML elements | Classes to which the element belongs | Set of space-separated tokens |
cols |
textarea
|
Maximum number of characters per line | Valid non-negative integer greater than zero |
colspan |
td ;
th
|
Number of columns that the cell is to span | Valid non-negative integer greater than zero |
content |
meta
|
Value of the element | Text* |
contenteditable |
HTML elements | Whether the element is editable | "true "; "false "
|
controls |
audio ;
video
|
Show user agent controls | Boolean attribute |
coords |
area
|
Coordinates for the shape to be created in an image map | Valid list of integers* |
crossorigin |
audio ;
img ;
link ;
script ;
video
|
How the element handles crossorigin requests | "anonymous ";
"use-credentials "
|
data |
object
|
Address of the resource | Valid non-empty URL potentially surrounded by spaces |
datetime |
del ;
ins
|
Date and (optionally) time of the change | Valid date string with optional time |
datetime |
time
|
Machine-readable value | Valid month string, valid date string, valid yearless date string, valid time string, valid floating date and time string, valid time-zone offset string, valid global date and time string, valid week string, valid non-negative integer, or valid duration string |
default |
track
|
Enable the track if no other text track is more suitable | Boolean attribute |
defer |
script
|
Defer script execution | Boolean attribute |
dir |
HTML elements | The text directionality of the element | "ltr ";
"rtl ";
"auto "
|
dir |
bdo |
The text directionality of the element | "ltr ";
"rtl "
|
dirname |
input ;
textarea
|
Name of form field to use for sending the element's directionality in form submission | Text* |
disabled |
button ;
fieldset ;
input ;
keygen ;
optgroup ;
option ;
select ;
textarea
|
Whether the form control is disabled | Boolean attribute |
download |
a ;
area
|
Whether to download the resource instead of navigating to it та its file name if so | Text |
enctype |
form
|
Form data set encoding type to use for form submission | "application/x-www-form-urlencoded ";
"multipart/form-data ";
"text/plain "
|
for |
label
|
Associate the label with form control | ID* |
for |
output
|
Specifies controls from which the output was calculated | Unordered set of unique space-separated tokens, case-sensitive, consisting of IDs* |
form |
button ;
fieldset ;
input ;
keygen ;
label ;
object ;
output ;
select ;
textarea
|
Associates the control with a form
element |
ID* |
formaction |
button ;
input
|
URL to use for form submission | Valid non-empty URL potentially surrounded by spaces |
formenctype |
button ;
input
|
Form data set encoding type to use for form submission | "application/x-www-form-urlencoded ";
"multipart/form-data ";
"text/plain "
|
formmethod |
button ;
input
|
HTTP method to use for form submission | "GET "; "POST "
|
formnovalidate |
button ;
input
|
Bypass form control validation for form submission | Boolean attribute |
formtarget |
button ;
input
|
Browsing context for form submission | Valid browsing context name or keyword |
headers |
td ;
th
|
The header cells for this cell | Unordered set of unique space-separated tokens, case-sensitive, consisting of IDs* |
height |
canvas ;
embed ;
iframe ;
img ;
input ;
object ;
video
|
Vertical dimension | Valid non-negative integer |
hidden |
HTML elements | Whether the element is relevant | Boolean attribute |
high |
meter
|
Low limit of high range | Valid floating-point number* |
href |
a ;
area
|
Address of the hyperlink | Valid URL potentially surrounded by spaces |
href |
link
|
Address of the hyperlink | Valid non-empty URL potentially surrounded by spaces |
href |
base
|
Document base URL | Valid URL potentially surrounded by spaces |
hreflang |
a ;
area ;
link
|
Language of the linked resource | Valid BCP 47 language tag |
http-equiv |
meta
|
Pragma directive | Text* |
id |
HTML elements | The element's ID | Text* |
ismap |
img
|
Whether the image is a server-side image map | Boolean attribute |
keytype |
keygen
|
The type of cryptographic key to generate | Text* |
kind |
track
|
The type of text track | "subtitles ";
"captions ";
"descriptions ";
"chapters ";
"metadata "
|
label |
optgroup ;
option ;
track
|
User-visible label | Text |
lang |
HTML elements | Language of the element | Valid BCP 47 language tag or the empty string |
list |
input
|
List of autocomplete options | ID* |
loop |
audio ;
video
|
Whether to loop the media resource | Boolean attribute |
low |
meter
|
High limit of low range | Valid floating-point number* |
manifest |
html
|
Application cache manifest | Valid non-empty URL potentially surrounded by spaces |
max |
input
|
Maximum value | Varies* |
max |
meter ;
progress
|
Upper bound of range | Valid floating-point number* |
maxlength |
input ;
textarea
|
Maximum length of value | Valid non-negative integer |
media |
link ;
source ;
style
|
Applicable media | Valid media query |
mediagroup |
audio ;
video
|
Groups media
elements together with an implicit MediaController
|
Text |
method |
form
|
HTTP method to use for form submission | "GET ";
"POST ";
|
min |
input
|
Minimum value | Varies* |
min |
meter
|
Lower bound of range | Valid floating-point number* |
minlength |
input ;
textarea
|
Minimum length of value | Valid non-negative integer |
multiple |
input ;
select
|
Whether to allow multiple values | Boolean attribute |
muted |
audio ;
video
|
Whether to mute the media resource by default | Boolean attribute |
name |
button ;
fieldset ;
input ;
keygen ;
output ;
select ;
textarea
|
Name of form control to use for form
submission and in the form.elements API |
Text* |
name |
form
|
Name of form to use in the document.forms API |
Text* |
name |
iframe ;
object
|
Name of nested browsing context | Valid browsing context name or keyword |
name |
map
|
Name of image map to reference from the
usemap
attribute |
Text* |
name |
meta
|
Metadata name | Text* |
name |
param
|
Name of parameter | Text |
novalidate |
form
|
Bypass form control validation for form submission | Boolean attribute |
optimum |
meter
|
Optimum value in gauge | Valid floating-point number* |
pattern |
input
|
Pattern to be matched by the form control's value | Regular expression matching the JavaScript Pattern production |
placeholder |
input ;
textarea
|
User-visible label to be placed within the form control | Text* |
poster |
video
|
Poster frame to show prior to video playback | Valid non-empty URL potentially surrounded by spaces |
preload |
audio ;
video
|
Hints how much buffering the media resource will likely need | "none ";
"metadata ";
"auto "
|
readonly |
input ;
textarea
|
Whether to allow the value to be edited by the user | Boolean attribute |
rel |
a ;
area ;
link
|
Relationship between the document containing the hyperlink and the destination resource | Set of space-separated tokens* |
required |
input ;
select ;
textarea
|
Whether the control is required for form submission | Boolean attribute |
reversed |
ol
|
Number the list backwards | Boolean attribute |
rows |
textarea
|
Number of lines to show | Valid non-negative integer greater than zero |
rowspan |
td ;
th
|
Number of rows that the cell is to span | Valid non-negative integer |
sandbox |
iframe
|
Security rules for nested content | Unordered
set of unique space-separated tokens, ASCII
чутливі до реєстру, consisting of "allow-forms ",
"allow-pointer-lock ",
"allow-popups ",
"allow-same-origin ",
"allow-scripts
and "allow-top-navigation "
|
spellcheck |
HTML elements | Whether the element is to have its spelling and grammar checked | "true "; "false "
|
scope |
th
|
Specifies which cells the header cell applies to | "row ";
"col ";
"rowgroup ";
"colgroup "
|
selected |
option
|
Whether the option is selected by default | Boolean attribute |
shape |
area
|
The kind of shape to be created in an image map | "circle ";
"default ";
"poly ";
"rect "
|
size |
input ;
select
|
Size of the control | Valid non-negative integer greater than zero |
sizes |
link
|
Sizes of the icons (for rel ="icon ") |
Unordered set of unique space-separated tokens, ASCII чутливі до реєстру, consisting of sizes* |
span |
col ;
colgroup
|
Number of columns spanned by the element | Valid non-negative integer greater than zero |
src |
audio ;
embed ;
iframe ;
img ;
input ;
script ;
source ;
track ;
video
|
Address of the resource | Valid non-empty URL potentially surrounded by spaces |
srcdoc |
iframe
|
A document to render in the iframe
|
The source of an iframe
srcdoc document*
|
srclang |
track
|
Language of the text track | Valid BCP 47 language tag |
start |
ol
|
Ordinal value of the first item | Valid integer |
step |
input
|
Granularity to be matched by the form control's value | Valid floating-point
number greater than zero, or "any "
|
style |
HTML elements | Presentational and formatting instructions | CSS declarations* |
tabindex |
HTML elements | Whether the element is focusable та the relative order of the element for the purposes of sequential focus navigation | Valid integer |
target |
a ;
area
|
Browsing context for hyperlink navigation | Valid browsing context name or keyword |
target |
base
|
Default browsing context for hyperlink navigation and form submission | Valid browsing context name or keyword |
target |
form
|
Browsing context for form submission | Valid browsing context name or keyword |
title |
HTML elements | Advisory information for the element | Text |
title |
abbr ;
dfn
|
Full term or expansion of abbreviation | Text |
title |
input |
Description of pattern (when used with pattern attribute) |
Text |
title |
link
|
Title of the link | Text |
title |
link ;
style
|
Alternative style sheet set name | Text |
translate |
HTML elements | Whether the element is to be translated when the page is localized | "yes "; "no "
|
type |
a ;
area ;
link
|
Hint for the type of the referenced resource | Valid MIME type |
type |
button
|
Type of button | "submit ";
"reset ";
"button "
|
type |
embed ;
object ;
script ;
source ;
style
|
Type of embedded resource | Valid MIME type |
type |
input
|
Type of form control | input
type keyword |
type |
ol
|
Kind of list marker | "1 ";
"a ";
"A ";
"i ";
"I "
|
typemustmatch |
object
|
Whether the type
attribute and the Content-Type value
need to match for the resource to be used |
Boolean attribute |
usemap |
img ;
object
|
Name of image map to use | Valid hash-name reference* |
value |
button ;
option
|
Value to be used for form submission | Text |
value |
data
|
Machine-readable value | Text* |
value |
input
|
Value of the form control | Varies* |
value |
li
|
Ordinal value of the list item | Valid integer |
value |
meter ;
progress
|
Current value of the element | Valid floating-point number |
value |
param
|
Value of parameter | Text |
width |
canvas ;
embed ;
iframe ;
img ;
input ;
object ;
video
|
Horizontal dimension | Valid non-negative integer |
wrap |
textarea
|
How the value of the form control is to be wrapped for form submission | "soft ";
"hard "
|
An asterisk (*) in a cell indicates that the actual rules are more complicated than indicated in the table above.
Цей розділ не є нормативним.
Цей розділ не є нормативним.
Цей розділ не є нормативним.
Event | Interface | Description |
---|---|---|
abort |
Event |
Fired at the Window when the
download was aborted by the user |
afterprint |
Event |
Fired at the Window after
printing |
beforeprint |
Event |
Fired at the Window before
printing |
beforeunload
|
BeforeUnloadEvent
|
Fired at the Window when the
page is about to be unloaded, in case the page would like to show a
warning prompt |
blur |
Event |
Fired at nodes losing focus |
change |
Event |
Fired at controls when the user commits a value change |
click
|
Event |
Fired at an element before its activation behavior is run |
DOMContentLoaded
|
Event |
Fired at the Document once
the parser has finished |
error |
Event |
Fired at elements when network and script errors occur |
focus |
Event |
Fired at nodes gaining focus |
hashchange
|
HashChangeEvent |
Fired at the Window when the
fragment identifier part of the
document's address changes |
input |
Event |
Fired at controls when the user changes the value |
invalid |
Event |
Fired at controls during form validation if they do not satisfy their constraints |
load |
Event |
Fired at the Window when the
document has finished loading; fired at an element containing a
resource (e.g. img , embed ) when its resource
has finished loading |
message |
MessageEvent |
Fired at an object when the object receives a message |
offline
|
Event |
Fired at the Window when the
network connections fails |
online
|
Event |
Fired at the Window when the
network connections returns |
pagehide
|
PageTransitionEvent
|
Fired at the Window when the
page's entry in the session history
stops being the current entry |
pageshow
|
PageTransitionEvent
|
Fired at the Window when the
page's entry in the session history
becomes the current entry |
popstate
|
PopStateEvent |
Fired at the Window when the
user navigates the session history |
readystatechange
|
Event |
Fired at the Document when
it finishes parsing and again when all its subresources have
finished loading |
reset |
Event |
Fired at a form
element when it is reset
|
submit |
Event |
Fired at a form
element when it is submitted
|
unload |
Event |
Fired at the Window object
when the page is going away |
See also media element events та application cache events.
All references are normative unless marked "Non-normative".
As of today the Web community lacks a sufficiently complete, reliable, interoperable та tested specification for the manner in which content sniffing takes place on the Web. We encourage implementers to exercise caution in this area as the Web community makes progress towards addressing this issue.
Media Type Sniffing (URL: http://tools.ietf.org/html/draft-ietf-websec-mime-sniff-03), A. Barth, I. Hickson. IETF.
Note: URLs can be used in numerous different manners, in many differing contexts. For the purpose of producing strict URLs one may wish to consider [RFC3986] [RFC3987]. The W3C URL specification defines the term URL, various algorithms for dealing with URLs та an API for constructing, parsing та resolving URLs. Developers of Web browsers are advised to keep abreast of the latest URL developments by tracking the progress of https://url.spec.whatwg.org/. We expect that the W3C URL draft will evolve along the Recommendation track as the community converges on a definition of URL processing.
Most of the URL-related terms used in the HTML specification (URL,
absolute URL, relative URL, relative
schemes, scheme component, scheme
data, username, password,
host, port, path,
query, fragment, percent
encode, get the base та UTF-8 percent encode)
can be straightforwardly mapped to the terminology of [RFC3986]
[RFC3987]. The URLUtils
(formerly known as URL
) collection of attributes (e.g.
href
and protocol
) and its required
definitions (input,
query encoding, url, update
steps, set the input) are considered
common practice nowadays. Some of the URL-related terms are still
being refined (e.g. URL parser,
parse errors, URL serializer, default encode set та percent decode).
As a word of caution, there are notable differences in the manner in which Web browsers and other software stacks outside the HTML context handle URLs. While no changes would be accepted to URL processing that would break existing Web content, some important parts of URL processing should therefore be considered as implementation-defined (e.g. parsing file: URLs or operating on URLs that would be syntax errors under the [RFC3986] [RFC3987] syntax).
URL (URL: http://www.w3.org/TR/url/), E. Arvidsson, M.[tm] Smith. W3C.
Thanks to Tim Berners-Lee for inventing HTML, without which none of this would exist.
Thanks to Aankhen, Aaron Boodman, Aaron Leventhal, Adam Barth, Adam de Boor, Adam Hepton, Adam Klein, Adam Roben, Addison Phillips, Adele Peterson, Adrian Bateman, Adrian Sutton, Agustín Fernández, Aharon (Vladimir) Lanin, Ajai Tirumali, Akatsuki Kitamura, Alan Plum, Alastair Campbell, Alejandro G. Castro, Alex Bishop, Alex Nicolaou, Alex Rousskov, Alexander Farkas, Alexander J. Vincent, Alexandre Morgaut, Alexey Feldgendler, Алексей Проскуряков (Alexey Proskuryakov), Alexis Deveria, Allan Clements, Ami Fischman, Amos Jeffries, Anders Carlsson, André E. Veltstra, Andrea Rendine, Andreas, Andreas Kling, Andrei Popescu, Andres Gomez, Andrew Barfield, Andrew Clover, Andrew Gove, Andrew Grieve, Andrew Oakley, Andrew Sidwell, Andrew Simons, Andrew Smith, Andrew W. Hagen, Andrey V. Lukyanov, Andry Rendy, Andy Earnshaw, Andy Heydon, Andy Palay, Anne van Kesteren, Anthony Boyd, Anthony Bryan, Anthony Hickson, Anthony Ricaud, Antti Koivisto, Arne Thomassen, Aron Spohr, Arphen Lin, Arthur Stolyar, Arun Patole, Aryeh Gregor, Asbjørn Ulsberg, Ashley Gullen, Ashley Sheridan, Atsushi Takayama, Aurelien Levy, Ave Wrigley, Axel Dahmen, Ben Boyle, Ben Godfrey, Ben Lerner, Ben Leslie, Ben Meadowcroft, Ben Millard, Benjamin Carl Wiley Sittler, Benjamin Hawkes-Lewis, Benoit Ren, Bert Bos, Bijan Parsia, Bil Corry, Bill Mason, Bill McCoy, Billy Wong, Bjartur Thorlacius, Björn Höhrmann, Blake Frantz, Bob Lund, Bob Owen, Boris Zbarsky, Brad Fults, Brad Neuberg, Brad Spencer, Brady Eidson, Brendan Eich, Brenton Simpson, Brett Wilson, Brett Zamir, Brian Blakely, Brian Campbell, Brian Korver, Brian Kuhn, Brian M. Dube, Brian Ryner, Brian Smith, Brian Wilson, Bryan Sullivan, Bruce Bailey, Bruce D'Arcus, Bruce Lawson, Bruce Miller, C. Williams, Cameron McCormack, Cameron Zemek, Cao Yipeng, Carlos Amengual, Carlos Gabriel Cardona, Carlos Perelló Marín, Chao Cai, 윤석찬 (Channy Yun), Charl van Niekerk, Charles Iliya Krempeaux, Charles McCathieNevile, Chris Apers, Chris Cressman, Chris Evans, Chris Morris, Chris Pearce, Chris Peterson, Chris Weber, Christian Biesinger, Christian Johansen, Christian Schmidt, Christoph Päper, Christophe Dumez, Christopher Aillon, Christopher Ferris, Chriswa, Clark Buehler, Cole Robison, Colin Fine, Collin Jackson, Corprew Reed, Craig Cockburn, Csaba Gabor, Csaba Marton, Cynthia Shelly, Dan Yoder, Daniel Barclay, Daniel Bratell, Daniel Brooks, Daniel Brumbaugh Keeney, Daniel Cheng, Daniel Davis, Daniel Glazman, Daniel Peng, Daniel Schattenkirchner, Daniel Spång, Daniel Steinberg, Daniel Trebbien, Danny Sullivan, Darin Adler, Darin Fisher, Darxus, Dave Camp, Dave Hodder, Dave Lampton, Dave Singer, Dave Townsend, David Baron, David Bloom, David Bruant, David Carlisle, David E. Cleary, David Egan Evans, David Fink, David Flanagan, David Gerard, David Håsäther, David Hyatt, David I. Lehn, David John Burrowes, David Kendal, David MacDonald, David Matja, David Remahl, David Smith, David Woolley, DeWitt Clinton, Dean Edridge, Dean Edwards, Debi Orton, Derek Featherstone, Devarshi Pant, Devdatta, Dimitri Glazkov, Dimitry Golubovsky, Dirk Pranke, Dirk Schulze, Dirkjan Ochtman, Divya Manian, Dmitry Titov, dolphinling, Domenic Denicola, Dominique Hazaël-Massieux, Don Brutzman, Doron Rosenberg, Doug Kramer, Doug Simpkinson, Drew Wilson, Edmund Lai, Eduard Pascual, Eduardo Vela, Edward O'Connor, Edward Welbourne, Edward Z. Yang, Ehsan Akhgari, Eira Monstad, Eitan Adler, Eliot Graff, Elisabeth Robson, Elizabeth Castro, Elliott Sprehn, Elliotte Harold, Eric Carlson, Eric Lawrence, Eric Rescorla, Eric Semling, Erik Arvidsson, Erik Rose, Evan Martin, Evan Prodromou, Evert, fantasai, Felix Sasaki, Francesco Schwarz, Francis Brosnan Blazquez, Franck 'Shift' Quélain, Frank Barchard, 鵜飼文敏 (Fumitoshi Ukai), Futomi Hatano, Gavin Carothers, Gavin Kistner, Gareth Rees, Garrett Smith, Geoff Richards, Geoffrey Garen, Geoffrey Sneddon, Gez Lemon, George Lund, Gianmarco Armellin, Giovanni Campagna, Giuseppe Pascale, Glenn Adams, Glenn Maynard, Graham Klyne, Greg Botten, Greg Houston, Greg Wilkins, Gregg Tavares, Gregory J. Rosmaita, Grey, Guilherme Johansson Tramontina, Gytis Jakutonis, Håkon Wium Lie, Hallvord Reiar Michaelsen Steen, Hans S. Tømmerhalt, Hans Stimer, Harald Alvestrand, Henri Sivonen, Henrik Lied, Henry Mason, Heydon Pickering, Hugh Guiney, Hugh Winkler, Ian Bicking, Ian Clelland, Ian Davis, Ian Fette, Ido Green, Ignacio Javier, Ivan Enderlin, Ivo Emanuel Gonçalves, J. King, Jacob Davies, Jacques Distler, Jake Verbaten, Jakub Łopuszański, James Craig, James Graham, James Greene, James Justin Harrell, James Kozianski, James M Snell, James Perrett, James Robinson, Jamie Lokier, Janusz Majnert, Jan-Klaas Kollhof, Jared Jacobs, Jason Duell, Jason Kersey, Jason Lustig, Jason White, Jasper Bryant-Greene, Jasper St. Pierre, Jatinder Mann, Jed Hartman, Jeff Balogh, Jeff Cutsinger, Jeff Schiller, Jeff Walden, Jeffrey Zeldman, 胡慧鋒 (Jennifer Braithwaite), Jens Bannmann, Jens Fendler, Jens Lindström, Jens Meiert, Jeremey Hustman, Jeremy Keith, Jeremy Orlow, Jeroen van der Meer, Jian Li, Jim Jewett, Jim Ley, Jim Meehan, Jim Michaels, Jirka Kosek, Jjgod Jiang, João Eiras, Joe Clark, Joe Gregorio, Joel Spolsky, Joel Verhagen, Johan Herland, John Boyer, John Bussjaeger, John Carpenter, John Daggett, John Fallows, John Foliot, John Harding, John Keiser, John Snyders, John Stockton, John-Mark Bell, Johnny Stenback, Jon Ferraiolo, Jon Gibbins, Jon Perlow, Jonas Sicking, Jonathan Cook, Jonathan Rees, Jonathan Watt, Jonathan Worent, Jonny Axelsson, Jordan Tucker, Jorgen Horstink, Jorunn Danielsen Newth, Joseph Kesselman, Joseph Mansfield, Joseph Pecoraro, Josh Aas, Josh Hart, Josh Levenberg, Joshua Bell, Joshua Randall, Joshue O Connor, Jukka K. Korpela, Jules Clément-Ripoche, Julian Reschke, Jürgen Jeka, Justin Lebar, Justin Novosad, Justin Schuh, Justin Sinclair, Ka-Sing Chou, Kai Hendry, 呂康豪 (KangHao Lu), Kartikaya Gupta, Kathy Walton, Kelly Ford, Kelly Norton, Kevin Benson, Kevin Gadd, Kevin Cole, Kornél Pál, Kornel Lesinski, Kris Northfield, Kristof Zelechovski, Krzysztof Maczyński, 黒澤剛志 (Kurosawa Takeshi), Kyle Barnhart, Kyle Hofmann, Kyle Huey, Léonard Bouchet, Léonie Watson, Lachlan Hunt, Larry Masinter, Larry Page, Lars Gunther, Lars Solberg, Laura Carlson, Laura Granka, Laura L. Carlson, Laura Wisewell, Laurens Holst, Lawrence Forooghian, Lee Kowalkowski, Leif Halvard Silli, Lenny Domnitser, Leonard Rosenthol, Leonie Watson, Leons Petrazickis, Lobotom Dysmon, Logan, Loune, Luke Kenneth Casson Leighton, Maciej Stachowiak, Magnus Kristiansen, Maik Merten, Malcolm Rowe, Manish Tripathi, Marc Hoyois, Marcus Bointon, Mark Birbeck, Mark Davis, Mark Miller, Mark Nottingham, Mark Pilgrim, Mark Rowe, Mark Schenk, Mark Vickers, Mark Wilton-Jones, Martijn Wargers, Martin Atkins, Martin Dürst, Martin Honnen, Martin Janecke, Martin Kutschker, Martin Nilsson, Martin Thomson, Masataka Yakura, Matt May, Mathias Bynens, Mathieu Henri, Matias Larsson, Matt Falkenhagen, Matt Schmidt, Matt Wright, Matthew Gregan, Matthew Mastracci, Matthew Raymond, Matthew Thomas, Mattias Waldau, Max Romantschuk, Menachem Salomon, Menno van Slooten, Micah Dubinko, Michael 'Ratt' Iannarelli, Michael A. Nachbaur, Michael A. Puls II, Michael Carter, Michael Daskalov, Michael Day, Michael Dyck, Michael Enright, Michael Gratton, Michael Nordman, Michael Powers, Michael Rakowski, Michael(tm) Smith, Michael Walmsley, Michal Zalewski, Michel Fortin, Michelangelo De Simone, Michiel van der Blonk, Mihai Şucan, Mihai Parparita, Mike Brown, Mike Dierken, Mike Dixon, Mike Hearn, Mike Schinkel, Mike Shaver, Mikko Rantalainen, Mohamed Zergaoui, Mohammad Al Houssami, Mounir Lamouri, Ms2ger, Nadia Heninger, NARUSE Yui, Neil Deakin, Neil Rashbrook, Neil Soiffer, Nicholas Shanks, Nicholas Stimpson, Nicholas Zakas, Nickolay Ponomarev, Nicolas Gallagher, Noah Mendelsohn, Noah Slater, Noel Gordon, Nolan Waite, NoozNooz42, Norbert Lindenberg, Ojan Vafai, Olaf Hoffmann, Olav Junker Kjær, Oldřich Vetešník, Oli Studholme, Oliver Hunt, Oliver Rigby, Olivier Gendrin, Olli Pettay, oSand, Pablo Flouret, Patrick Garies, Patrick H. Lauke, Patrik Persson, Paul Adenot, Paul Norman, Per-Erik Brodin, Perry Smith, Peter Beverloo, Peter Karlsson, Peter Kasting, Peter Moulder, Peter Occil, Peter Stark, Peter Van der Beken, Peter-Paul Koch, Phil Pickering, Philip Jägenstedt, Philip Taylor, Philip TAYLOR, Philippe De Ryck, Prateek Rungta, Pravir Gupta, 李普君 (Pujun Li), Rachid Finge, Rafael Weinstein, Rafał Miłecki, Raj Doshi, Rajas Moonka, Ralf Stoltze, Ralph Giles, Raphael Champeimont, Remci Mizkur, Remco, Remy Sharp, Rene Saarsoo, Rene Stach, Ric Hardacre, Rich Clark, Rich Doughty, Richard Ishida, Rigo Wenning, Rikkert Koppes, Rimantas Liubertas, Riona Macnamara, Rob Ennals, Rob Jellinghaus, Rob S, Robert Blaut, Robert Collins, Robert Kieffer, Robert Millan, Robert O'Callahan, Robert Sayre, Robin Berjon, Robin Schaufler, Rodger Combs, Roland Steiner, Roma Matusevich, Roman Ivanov, Roy Fielding, Ruud Steltenpool, Ryan King, Ryosuke Niwa, S. Mike Dierken, Salvatore Loreto, Sam Dutton, Sam Kuper, Sam Ruby, Sam Weinig, Samuel Bronson, Samy Kamkar, Sander van Lambalgen, Sarven Capadisli, Scott González, Scott Hess, Sean Fraser, Sean Hayes, Sean Hogan, Sean Knapp, Sebastian Markbåge, Sebastian Schnitzenbaumer, Seth Call, Seth Dillingham, Shanti Rao, Shaun Inman, Shiki Okasaka, Sierk Bornemann, Sigbjørn Finne, Sigbjørn Vik, Silver Ghost, Silvia Pfeiffer, Šime Vidas, Simon Montagu, Simon Pieters, Simon Spiegel, skeww, Smylers, Stanton McCandlish, Stefan Håkansson, Stefan Haustein, Stefan Santesson, Stefan Weiss, Steffen Meschkat, Stephen Ma, Stephen White, Steve Comstock, Steve Faulkner, Steve Runyon, Steven Bennett, Steven Garrity, Steven Tate, Stewart Brodie, Stuart Ballard, Stuart Langridge, Stuart Parmenter, Subramanian Peruvemba, Sunava Dutta, Susan Borgrink, Susan Lesch, Sylvain Pasche, T. J. Crowder, Tab Atkins, Takeshi Yoshino, Tantek Çelik, 田村健人 (TAMURA Kent), Ted Mielczarek, Terrence Wood, Thijs van der Vossen, Thomas Broyer, Thomas Koetter, Thomas O'Connor, Tim Altman, Tim Johansson, TJ VanToll, Toby Inkster, Todd Moody, Tom Baker, Tom Pike, Tommy Thorsen, Tony Ross, Travis Leithead, Tyler Close, Victor Carbune, Vipul Snehadeep Chawathe, Vitya Muhachev, Vladimir Katardjiev, Vladimir Vukićević, voracity, Wakaba, Wayne Carr, Wayne Pollock, Wellington Fernando de Macedo, Weston Ruter, Wilhelm Joys Andersen, Will Levine, William Chen, William Swanson, Wladimir Palant, Wojciech Mach, Wolfram Kriesing, Xan Gregg, Yang Chen, Ye-Kui Wang, Yehuda Katz, Yi-An Huang, Yngve Nysaeter Pettersen, Yonathan Randolph, Yuzo Fujishima, Zhenbin Xu, Zoltan Herczeg та Øistein E. Andersen, for their useful comments, both large and small, that have led to changes to this specification over the years.
Thanks also to everyone who has ever posted about HTML to their blogs, public mailing lists, or forums, including all the contributors to the various W3C HTML WG lists and the various WHATWG lists.
Special thanks to Richard Williamson for creating the first
implementation of canvas
in Safari, from which the canvas feature was designed.
Special thanks also to the Microsoft employees who first implemented contenteditable
and other features first widely deployed by the Windows Internet Explorer
browser.
Special thanks and $10,000 to David Hyatt who came up with a broken implementation of the adoption agency algorithm that the editor had to reverse engineer and fix before using it in the parsing section.
Thanks to the many sources that provided inspiration for the examples used in the specification.
The image of two cute kittens in a basket used in the context menu example is based on a photo by Alex G. (CC BY 2.0)
The Blue Robot Player sprite used in the canvas demo is based on a work by JohnColburn. (CC BY-SA 3.0)
Thanks also to the Microsoft blogging community for some ideas, to the attendees of the W3C Workshop on Web Applications and Compound Documents for inspiration, to the #mrt crew, the #mrt.no crew та the #whatwg crew та to Pillar and Hedral for their ideas and support.